Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
All right reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval systems,
transmitted in any form or by any means, electric, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise,
without the prior written permission ofthe authors, editors and publisher.
Parts and Harbours Bureau, Ministry ofLand, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism (MLITJ
National Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management, MLIT
Port and Airport Research Institute
2009
FOREWORD
Foreword
This book is a translation of"the Technical Standards and Commentaries for Port and Harbour Facilities
in Japan" (hereinafter called "the Technical Standards"), which summarizes the ministerial ordinance and
public notice articles as well as the related commentaries and technical notes in connection with the "Technical
Standards for Port and Harbour Facilities" established by Japan's Ministry of Land, Infrastructure, Transport
and Tourism (MLIT) based on the provisions of the Port and Harbour Law. This translation has been made
with the approval of the authors including the Ports and Harbours Bureau ofMLIT, National Institute for Land
and Infrastructure Management (NILIM; also a part of MLIT), and the Port and Airport Research Institute
(PARI; an Independent Administrative Institution).
Japan is an island nation with few underground resources. The country comprises approximately 6,800
islands, and has an area of 380,000 square kilometers and a total coastline of 34,000 km. For this reason,
industry, which supports the nation's economy, has been located in coastal areas with ports and harbors for
convenience in importing raw materials and exporting products. Given these conditions, Japan has constructed,
improved and modernized approximately 1,100 ports and harbors as well as approximately 3,000 fishing ports
during the past one and a half centuries. Because 99% of trade now depends on ports and harbors, they play
a particularly important role in Japan.
Japan was a closed country for about 220 years, from the early 17th century until the mid-19th century.
Following the Meiji Restoration of 1868, modernization progressed rapidly. During the modernization period,
young Japanese engineers learned from experienced engineers invited to Japan from abroad, and constructed
modern ports and harbors, such as the Ports of Yokohama and Kobe.
The first Japanese manual on port and harbor technology was released in 1943 and was subsequently
revised a number of times. Under the 1974 revision of the Ports and Harbours Law, "the Technical Standards
for Port and Harbour Facilities" are provided in the form of ministerial ordinances. The first edition of the
present "Technical Standards" was published by the Japan Port and Harbour Association in 1979 and it has
been revised three times as of this writing. An English-language edition of the "Technical Standards" was
first published in 1980, and was revised and reissued in 1991 and 2002 corresponding to the revisions of the
Japanese "Technical Standards."
Because many ports and harbors in Japan face the open sea, a considerable number of ports are exposed
to waves with heights exceeding !Om. Furthermore, many Japanese ports and harbors have been constructed
on thick strata of cohesive soil deposited on the sea bottom. Because Japan is also one of the world's most
earthquake-prone nations, the facilities of ports and harbors are exposed to severe natural disasters of
earthquakes and tsunamis. Many efforts for technical development have been undertaken to enable construction
of port and harbor facilities that are both safe and economical under these difficult natural conditions. As a
result of these efforts, it is fair to say that Japan possesses the world's most advanced level of technology for
wave-resistant design, earthquake-resistant design of port and harbor facilities, and countermeasures for soft
ground.
The 2007 edition of"the Technical Standards," in addition to incorporating the most advanced technology,
has fully incorporated the approach based on "performance-based design" in response to worldwide demands
that the national standards be based on "performance criteria,'' as advocated in the TBT Agreement (Agreement
on Technical Barriers to Trade). "The Technical Standards" are consistent with the following international
standards, and represent a compilation of Japan's world-class knowledge in connection with technology for
ports and harbors:
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
ACKNOWLEDGEMENT
Acknowledgement
The publisher, Overseas Coastal Area Development Institute of Japan, sincerely appreciates the persons listed below
fur their contributions in editing, translating and publishing this Technical Standards.
Members of the Editing Committee for the Japanese version of the Technical Standards published in 2007
Messrs.:
GODA Yoshirni*,
HASHIMOTO Noriaki,
HORII Osami,
IAI Susumu,
ISOSHIMA Shigeo,
KAZAMA Toru,
KITAZAWA Sosuke,
KIYOMIYA Osamu,
KOMATSU Akira,
KONDOU Kosuke,
KOYAMA Akira,
KUSAKABE Osamu,
MAEDA Susumu
MIZOUCm Toshikazu,
NAGAI Toshihiko,
ODANI Hiraku,
SAHARA Koichi,
SillRAISill Satoru,
TAKAHASill Shigeo,
TAKAYAMA Tomotsuka,
TANAKA Hiroyuki,
UEDA Shigeru,
usmnMA Ryuichiro,
YAMAMOTO Shuji,
YOKOTA Hiroshi,
The authors of the Japanese version of the Technical Standards published in 2007
Messrs.:
ENDO Kimihiko,
FUJIMORI Shugo,
FUJIMURA Kirninori,
FURUKAWAKeita,
GESHI Hiroyuki,
HACHIYA Yoshitaka,
HAMADA Hidenori,
HAMAGUCill Nobuhiko,
HASHIMOTO Noriaki,
HASHIZUME Tomoyoshi,
illGASillSHIMA Michio,
mRAISm Tetsuya,
ICHIIKoji,
ISHII Ichiro,
ITOAkira,
IWANAMI Mitsuyasu,
IWATA Naoki,
KASUGAI Yasuo,
KATASE Makoto,
KAWAI Hiroyasu,
KAWAKAMI Taiji,
KAWANA Futoshi,
KIKUCill Yoshiaki,
KITADUME Masaki,
KITAZAWA Sosuke,
KOHAMA Eiji,
KOYAMA Akira,
KOZAWA Keiji,
KUNITA Atsushi,
KURIYAMA Yoshiaki,
MAK.ITO Taketo,
MATSUMOTO Hideo,
MATSUNAGA Yasushi,
MIYAnMA Shogo,
MIYASIDTA Ken-ichiro,
MIYATA Masafumi,
MIYAWAKI Shusaku,
MIZUTANI Masahiro,
MORISIDTA Noriaki,
MORIYA Yoichi,
MOROBOSill Kazunobu,
MURAOKA Takeshi,
NAGAI Toshihiko,
NAGAO Takashi,
NAKAMICm Masato,
NAKAMURA Satoshi,
NARUSE Eiji,
NISHIZONO Katsuhide,
NODAiwao,
NOZU Atsushi,
ODA Katsuya,
OKAMA Tatsuo,
OZAKI Ryuzo,
SAHARA Koichi,
SAKAI Yoichi,
SAKAMOTO Akira,
SASSA Shinji,
SATO Hidemasa,
SillGAMasao,
SillMOSAKO Ken-ichiro,
SillRAISill Tetsuya,
SUGANO Takahiro,
SUMIYA Keiichi,
TAKAHASm Hironao,
TAKANO Seiki,
TOMITA Takashi,
UOZUMI Satoru,
WATABE Kazushige,
WATABE Yoichi
YAMADA Masao,
YAMAJI Toru,
YAMAZAKI Hiroyuki,
YOKOTA Hiroshi,
YONEYAMA Haruo,
YOSHIDA Hideki,
YOSIDNAGA Hiroshi,
YOSIDOKA Takeshi,
Members of the Editing Committee for this Technical Standards (publishing in 2009)
Messrs.:
GODA Yoshirni*,
MATSUMOTO Seiji,
MURAOKA Takeshi,
TAKAHASill Shigeo,
YAMANE Takayuki,
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Members of the Editing Sub-Committee for this Technical Standards (publishing in 2009)
Messrs.:
ITO Hironobu
MIYAJIMA Syogo,
MIYATAMasafumi,
NAGAI Tosbihiko,
NAGAO Takashi,
TUBOKAWA Yukitomo,
YAGYU Tadahiko*,
YAMAMOTO Shuji,
OKUMURA Tatsuro,
OUCHIHisao,
REID Shane
SHIOZAWA Toshihiko,
TAKAHASHI Kunio,
TANIMOTO Katsutoshi,
TSUGANE Masanori,
UEDA Hiroshi,
YAMASAKI Tsuyoshi
YOSHIMURA Yasuo,
Other contributors
Messrs.:
HIRANO Masayosbi,
KATOH Kazumasa,
KIHARA Tsutomu,
KOBUNEKoji
NODA Setsuo,
OHfSU Kohei,
ABBREVIATIONS
Abbreviations
Abbreviations English term
ANSI
AP!
ASTM
CBR
CD
Consolidated Drained
CDL
CIQ
cu
Consolidated Undrained
DOL
DT
Displacement Tonnage
DWT
FCL
FLIP
FRP
GPS
HWOST
HWL
!HO
IMO
IPCC
ISO
JP!
JSCE
LCL
LWL
LWOST
MIR
MLIT
MRI
MSL
NILIM
NOWPHAS
OCDI
PARI
PC
Prestressed Concrete
PHC
PHRI
-v-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
PIANC
RC
Reinforced Concrete
REC
RI
Radio Isotope
RWL
SALM
SCP
SI
SRC
SMB
Sverdrup-Munk-Bretshneider
TP
uu
Unconsolidated Undrained
VLCC
WTO
-vi-
SYMBOLS
Symbols
Symbols
Definitions
AP
A,
compression index
drag coefficient
lift coefficient
embedded depth of a foundation (m), pile diameter (mm), depth of waterway (m)
D,
D,
relative density
Dw
Et
EI
void ratio
j',
t.
GT
Ho
H'o
H1110
HJ/3
Hb
Hn
-vii-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
H,
H,
refraction coefficient
Kp
K,
shoaling coefficient
K,
k'
m,
N value (Number of blows in 30cm thick of soil by Standard Penatration Test), number of waves
N.,N,
Ns
PB
buoyancy (kN)
PH
Pu
Pv
Po
P1. pi,p3
Pu
surcharge load (kN/m2), water volume (cm'is), sediment transport rate per unit width (m'imls)
unconfined compression strength (kN/m2)
r,
-viii-
SYMBOLS
settlement (cm)
parameter representing the degree of directional spreading of wave energy
S(j)
s,
T1;3
v,,
v,
wl
sensitivity factor
angle ofincident wave("), inverse of distance between virtual ground surface and virtual fixed point (m-1)
friction angle on a wall (")
increment of pressure (kN/m2)
angle of shearing resistance (0 )
partial factor, unit weight (kN/m3)
unit weight in water (kN/m3)
member factor
Yt
structure factor
Yw
11'
;.,, ;.,
(}
density (tlm')
Pa
Pd
Po. Pw
'"
If/
-ix-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-x-
CONTENTS
Contents
Foreword
Acknowledgement
Abbreviations
Symbols
Part I
General
-xi-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Part II
-xii-
CONTENTS
5
6
7
8
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
ANNEX 5
-xiv-
CONTENTS
3.3
3.4
Part Ill
FACILITIES
-xv-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
1.3.2 Determination of Basic Cross Section and Characteristic Values ................................ 393
1.3.3 Actions ........................................................................................................................... 393
1.3.4 Performance Verification .............................................................................................. 395
1.4 Cellular Blocks ........................................................................................................................ 398
1.4.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 398
1.4.2 Setting of Basic Cross Section and Characteristic Values ........................................... 399
1.4.3 Actions........................................................................................................................... 399
1.4.4 Performance Verification .............................................................................................. 402
1.5 Upright Wave-absorbing Caissons ...................................................................................... 403
1.5.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification ................................................................. 404
1.5.2 Actions ........................................................................................................................... 405
1.6 Hybrid Caissons ...................................................................................................................... 407
1.6.1 General. ......................................................................................................................... 407
1.6.2 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 408
1.6.3 Actions........................................................................................................................... 409
1.6.4 Performance Verification ............................................................................................. 409
1.6.5 Corrosion Control ...........................................................................................................410
1.7 Armor Stones and Blocks ....................................................................................................... 411
1.7.1
Required Mass of Armor Stones and Blocks on Slope ................................................. 411
1.7.2 Required Mass of Armor Stones and Blocks in Composite Breakwater Foundation
Mound against Waves ....................................................................................................418
1.7.3 Required Mass of Armor Stones and Blocks against Currents .................................... 421
1.8 Scouring and Washing-out ................................................................................................... 423
2 Foundations ....................................................................................................................................... 426
2.1
General Comments ................................................................................................................ 426
2.2 Shallow Spread Foundations ................................................................................................ 426
2.2.1 General. ......................................................................................................................... 426
2.2.2 Bearing Capacity of Foundations on Sandy Ground ................................................... 426
2.2.3 Bearing Capacity of Foundations on Cohesive Soil Ground ....................................... 428
2.2.4 Bearing Capacity of Multi-layered Ground ................................................................... 429
2.2.5 Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and Inclined Actions ................................................... 429
2.3 Deep Foundations .................................................................................................................. 434
2.3.1 General. ......................................................................................................................... 434
2.3.2 Characteristic Value of Vertical Bearing Capacity ........................................................ 434
2.3.3 Horizontal Resistance Force of Deep Foundations ...................................................... 435
2.4 Pile Foundations ..................................................................................................................... 439
2.4.1 General. ......................................................................................................................... 439
2.4.2 Fundamentals of Performance Verification of Piles ...................................................... 439
2.4.3 Static Maximum Axial Pushing Resistance of Pile Foundations .................................. 439
[1] General ................................................................................................................... 439
[2] Static Maximum Axial Resistance of Single Piles due to Resistance of Ground .. 441
[3] Estimation of Static Maximum Axial Resistance from Loading Tests ..................... 442
[4] Estimation of Static Maximum Axial Resistance by Static Resistance Formulas ... 443
[5] Examination of Compressive Stress of Pile Material .............................................. 449
[6] Decrease of Bearing Capacity due to Joints ........................................................... 449
[7] Decrease of Bearing Capacity due to Slenderness Ratio ...................................... 449
[B] Bearing Capacity of Pile Groups ............................................................................. 450
[9] Examination of Negative Skin Friction .................................................................... 451
[10]Examination of Pile Settlement ............................................................................... 454
2.4.4 Static Maximum Pulling Resistance of Pile Foundations .............................................. 454
[1] General .................................................................................................................... 454
[2] Static Maximum Pulling Resistance of Single Pile .................................................. 455
[3] Items to be Considered when Calculating Design Value of Pulling Resistance
of Piles .................................................................................................................... 456
2.4.5 Static Maximum Lateral Resistance of Piles ................................................................ 456
[1] General .................................................................................................................... 456
[2] Estimation of Behavior of Piles ................................................................................ 457
[3] Estimation of Behavior of a Single Pile by Loading Tests ....................................... 457
[4] Estimation of Pile Behavior using Analytical Methods ............................................ 458
[5] Consideration of Pile Group Action ......................................................................... 466
[6] Lateral Bearing Capacity of Coupled Piles ............................................................. 466
-xvi-
CONTENTS
2.4.6
-xvii-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
4.13
4.14
4.15
4.16
4.17
4.18
-xviii-
CONTENTS
3.4.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 622
3.4.2 Setting of Basic Cross Section ..................................................................................... 622
3.4.3 Performance Verification ............................................................................................. 622
3.5 Gravity-type Breakwaters (Upright Wave-absorbing Block Type Breakwaters) .......... 625
3.5.1 Principals of Performance Verification ......................................................................... 625
3.5.2 Setting of Basic Cross Section ..................................................................................... 625
3.5.3 Performance Verification ............................................................................................. 626
3.6 Gravity-type Breakwaters (Wave-absorbing Caisson Type Breakwaters) .................... 628
3.6.1 Principals of Performance Verification ......................................................................... 628
3.6.2 Actions........................................................................................................................... 628
3.6.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section ..................................................................................... 630
3.6.4 Performance Verification ............................................................................................. 630
3.7 Gravity-type Breakwaters (Sloping-top Caisson Breakwaters) ....................................... 632
3.7.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification ................................................................. 632
3.7.2 Actions ........................................................................................................................... 632
3.7.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section ..................................................................................... 632
3. 7.4 Performance Verification .............................................................................................. 633
3.8 Pile-type Breakwaters ........................................................................................................... 635
3.8.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 635
3.8.2 Actions ........................................................................................................................... 637
3.8.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section .................................................................................... 637
3.9 Breakwaters with Wide Footing on Soft Ground ............................................................... 640
3.9.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification ................................................................. 640
3.10 Floating Breakwaters ............................................................................................................ 641
3.10.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 641
3.10.2 Setting of Basic Cross Section .................................................................................... 642
3.10.3 Performance Verification ............................................................................................. 642
4 Amenity-oriented Breakwaters ....................................................................................................... 646
5 Storm Surge Protection Breakwaters ............................................................................................ 647
5.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification ........................................................................ 647
5.2 Actions ...................................................................................................................................... 647
5.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section ............................................................................................. 647
6 Tsunami Protection Breakwaters ................................................................................................... 648
6.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification ........................................................................ 648
6.2 Actions ...................................................................................................................................... 648
6.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section ............................................................................................ 648
6.4 Performance Verification ....................................................................................................... 648
6.5 Structural Details .................................................................................................................... 650
6.6 Tsunami Reduction Effect of Tsunami Protection Breakwaters ...................................... 650
7 Sediment Control Groins ................................................................................................................. 651
7.1
General ..................................................................................................................................... 651
7.2 Performance Verification ...................................................................................................... 653
8 Seawalls ............................................................................................................................................. 654
9 Training Jetties .................................................................................................................................. 657
9.1 General ..................................................................................................................................... 657
9.2 Performance Verification ...................................................................................................... 658
10 Floodgates ......................................................................................................................................... 659
11 Locks .................................................................................................................................................. 661
12 Revetments ........................................................................................................................................ 664
12.1 Common Items for Revetments ............................................................................................ 664
12.1.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification ................................................................. 664
12.1.2 Actions ...........................................................................................................................665
12.1.3 Performance Verification ............................................................................................. 665
12.2 Revetments with Amenity Function .................................................................................... 669
13 Coastal Dikes .................................................................................................................................... 671
14 Groins ................................................................................................................................................. 672
15 Parapets ............................................................................................................................................. 673
16 Siltation Prevention Facilities .......................................................................................................... 674
16.1 General .................................................................................................................................... 674
16.2 Facilities for Trapping Littoral Drift and River Erosion Sediment .................................... 674
16.3 Wind Blown Sand Prevention Work ..................................................................................... 675
-xix-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
16.3.1 General. ......................................................................................................................... 675
Chapter 5
CONTENTS
3 Mooring Buoys ..................................................................................................................................800
3.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification ........................................................................ 802
3.2 Actions ...................................................................................................................................... 803
3.3 Performance Verification of Mooring Buoys ...................................................................... 804
4 Mooring Piles ..................................................................................................................................... 808
5 Piled Piers .......................................................................................................................................... 810
5.1 Common Items for Piled Piers ...............................................................................................817
5.2 Open-type Wharves on Vertical Piles ................................................................................. 818
5.2.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 818
5.2.2 Setting of Basic Cross-section ...................................................................................... 819
5.2.3 Actions ........................................................................................................................... 821
5.2.4 Performance Verification .............................................................................................. 826
5.2.5 Performance Verification of Structural Members ......................................................... 836
5.3 Open-type Wharves on Coupled Raking Piles .................................................................. 837
5.3.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 837
5.3.2 Setting of Basic Cross-section ...................................................................................... 837
5.3.3 Actions........................................................................................................................... 838
5.3.4 Performance Verification .............................................................................................. 838
5.4 Strutted Frame Type Pier ...................................................................................................... 841
5.5 Jacket Type Piled Piers ......................................................................................................... 842
5.6 Dolphins ...................................................................................................................................844
5.6.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 844
5.6.2 Actions ........................................................................................................................... 845
5.6.3 Performance Verification .............................................................................................. 846
[1] Pile Type Dolphins ................................................................................................... 846
[2] Steel Cell Type Dolphins ......................................................................................... 846
[3] Caisson Type Dolphins ............................................................................................ 846
5.7 Detached Piers ....................................................................................................................... 847
5.7.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 847
5.7.2 Actions ........................................................................................................................... 848
5.7.3 Performance Verification .............................................................................................. 848
6 Floating Piers ..................................................................................................................................... 851
6.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification ........................................................................ 854
6.2 Setting the Basic Cross-section ........................................................................................... 856
6.3 Actions ...................................................................................................................................... 857
6.4 Performance Verification ....................................................................................................... 858
7 Shallow Draft Wharves .................................................................................................................... 864
8 Boat Lift Yards and Landing Facilities for Air Cushion Craft.. .................................................... 865
8.1 Boat Lift Yards ......................................................................................................................... 865
8.1.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 865
8.1.2 Location Selection of Boat Lift Yard .............................................................................. 866
8.1.3 Dimensions of Each Part .............................................................................................. 866
[1] Requirements for Usability ...................................................................................... 866
[2] Height of Each Part ................................................................................................. 866
[3] Front Water Depth ................................................................................................... 867
[4] Gradient of Slipway ................................................................................................ 867
[5] Area of Front Basin ................................................................................................. 867
8.2 Landing Facilities for Air Cushion Craft .............................................................................. 867
8.2.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification .................................................................. 867
8.2.2 Selection of Location ..................................................................................................... 868
8.2.3 Dimensions of Each Part .............................................................................................. 868
[1] Slipway .................................................................................................................... 869
[2] Apron ....................................................................................................................... 869
[3] Hangar ..................................................................................................................... 869
9 Ancillary of Mooring Facilities ......................................................................................................... 870
9.1 Mooring Posts and Mooring Rings ...................................................................................... 870
9.1.1 Position of Mooring Posts and Mooring Rings .............................................................. 871
9.1.2 Actions........................................................................................................................... 872
9.1.3 Performance Verification .............................................................................................. 873
9.2 Fender Equipment .................................................................................................................. 875
-xxi-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
9.2.1
9.2.2
9.2.3
9.2.4
9.3
9.4
9.5
9.6
9.7
9.8
9.9
9.10
9.11
9.12
9.13
9.14
9.15
Chapter 6
-xxii-
CONTENTS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
-xxiii-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-xxiv-
Part I General
L-------------------------------------------l
Fig. 1.1.1. Statutory Structure of the Technical Standards for Port and Harbour Facilities
Commentaries mainly provide engineers with explanation on the background to and the basis for the Public
Notice. In addition, Technical Notes are added at many subsections for provision of further explanation and detailed
information. They are intended to assist engineers in designing facilities, by presenting explanation ofthe investigation
methods and/or related standards, specific examples of structures, and other related materials.
-3-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
combination oftwo or more actions such as accidental actions and permanent actions are considered in the performance
criteria and the performance verification.
Accidental waves
means the waves which have an extremely low possibility of attacking during the design working life of the facilities
concerned, among waves expected to attack at the location where the facilities are to be installed, although which will
have a major impact on the objective facilities in the event of an attack.
Annual exceedence probability
means the probability that an expected or greater action will occur one or more times in one year.
Cargo handling facilities
means the facilities provided for the use in port cargo handling, including stationary cargo handling equipment, railmounted cargo handling equipment, cargo handling areas and sheds.
Characteristic value
means the values representing the respective characteristics of the strengths of the materials comprising structures
and the forces acting on the structures, corresponding to certain probability conditions, by considering the deviations
of these items.
Constructability
means the performance which enables construction while securing safety in construction work within an appropriate
construction period using suitable and reliable methods.
Design value
means the value obtained by multiplying the characteristic value of a design parameter by the partial factor.
Design situation
means the combination of actions considered in the verification.
Design working life
means the period during which facilities satisfy the performance requirements which were set in the design of the
facilities.
Encounter probability
means the probability that the action greater than the action in a certain return period will occur at least once during
the lifetime of the facilities.
Expected total cost
means the total amount of the initial construction cost of facilities and the expected recovery cost of disasters expected
to occur during a certain period.
Facilities against accidental incident
means the facilities in which there is a danger of serious impact on life, property, or socioeconomic activity
accompanying damage of the objective facilities.
Facilities against accidental incident include breakwaters, revetments, seawalls, water gates, quaywalls, buoys,
floating piers, levees, and locks and water gates constructed behind densely populated areas, and in addition, facilities
which handle hazardous cargoes, port transportation facilities used by the general public and vehicles, and tunnels and
bridges for trunk port traffic needs.
-4-
concerned.
High earthquake-resistance facilities
means the port and harbour facilities which contribute to the recovery and reconstruction ofthe port and the surrounding
area when damage occurs due to a large-scale earthquake.
High earthquake-resistance facilities include quaywalls, piers, and lighter's wharfs which contribute to the transport
of the emergency supplies and the trunk line cargoes, and greenbelts, and plazas, which function as the counter
disaster bases (bases contributing to the recovery and reconstruction of the port and surrounding area).
Level 1 earthquake ground motion
means the ground motion with a high probability of occurring during the design working life of the facilities, based
on the relationship between the return period of ground motion and the design working life of the objective facilities,
among ground motions expected to occur at the location where the facilities are to be installed.
Level 2 earthquake ground motion
means the ground motion having an intensity of the maximum scale, among ground motions expected to occur at the
location where the facilities are to be installed.
Life cycle cost
means the total amount of the initial construction cost of facilities and the expected recovery cost of disasters expected
during the design working life.
Limit state design
means the design method to verify the limit state which is defined as state when a load acts on a structure and some
inconvenience on the functions or the safety of the structure occurs. The states subject to the examination are the
ultimate limit state, serviceability limit state, and fatigue limit state.
Limit state function
means the function showing the relationship between the variable resistance of the structure and the variable force
acting on the structure.
The limit state function provides the limit state of the structures, and is mainly used in calculating the probability of
failure of the structures.
Maintenanceability
means the performance which is capable of continuously securing the required performance necessary in facilities by
implementing repairs and maintenance, within the range of technically possible and economically appropriate against
the deterioration and the damage of the facilities due to the use of the facilities and expected actions.
Maintenance level
means the level ofmaintenance control set for each member comprising the facilities, considering changes over time in
the members comprising the facilities, the ease ofinspection and diagnosis, and maintenance work, and the importance
of the facilities, in accordance with the maintenance control plan for the facilities as a whole.
Mooring facilities
means the facilities where ships moor for cargo handling and passenger embarkation/disembarkation including
quaywalls, mooring buoys, mooring piles, piers, floating piers, lighter's wharfs and slipways.
Partial factor
means the factor when using the method to verify the performance of facilities by confirming that the design value of
resistance R.i exceeds the design value of the effect of actions Sd, upon defining that the design value for that factor is
the value obtained by multiplying the characteristic value of a factor by a certain coefficient.
-5-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Performance criteria
means the criteria which concretely describe performance requirements so that performance verification is possible.
Performance requirements
means the performance which facilities must possess in order to achieve their purpose.
Performance verification
means the act of confirming that facilities satisfy the performance criteria.
Permanent actions
means the actions which are expected to act on facilities continuously through the design working life, including self
weight, earth pressure, and environmental actions.
Permanent situation
means the situation in which the dominating actions are permanent actions, among the states in which one or multiple
permanent actions, or combination of permanent actions and variable actions are considered in the performance
criteria and the performance verification.
-6-
means the actions due to winds, waves, water pressure, water currents, and ship berthing force and tractive force,
and actions such as Level 1 earthquake ground motion, and surcharges which show changes over time during the
design working life that are not negligible in comparison with their average values and are not unidirectional and the
characteristic values of these actions being given probabilistically.
Variable situation
means the situation in which the dominating actions are variable actions among the states in which one or multiple
variable actions, or combination of permanent actions and variable actions are considered in the performance criteria
and the performance verification.
Variable waves
means the waves with a high possibility of attacking during the design working life of the facilities concerned, among
waves expected as attacking at the location where the facilities are to be installed.
Waterways and basins
means the water areas where ships navigate or anchor, such as navigation channels, basins, and small craft basins.
-7-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Fig. 1.3.1 shows a basic framework of the performance-based design of port facilities.S) References 1), 2), 3), and 4)
are considered as higher-level standards in this system. In the figure, the "objective" is the reason why the facility
concerned is needed, the "performance requirements" is the performance ofthe facilities needed to achieve the objective
plainly explained from the viewpoint of accountability, and the performance criteria is the technical explanation of a
set of rules needed to verify the performance requirements. According to this hierarchy consisting of the objective,
the performance requirements, and the performance criteria, the "ministerial ordinance to set technical standards for
port facilities" (hereafter referred to as ''ministerial ordinance") corresponding to the higher-level criteria specifies
the objectives and the performance requirements of facilities, and the ''public notice to set the details of technical
standards for port facilities (hereafter referred to as "public notice")" that defines the requirements conforming to the
ministerial ordinance specifies the performance criteria.
The performance verification is an act to verify that the performance criteria are satisfied. No particular method
is mondatory for it. Actual performance verification methods, allowable failure probabilities, allowable deformation
limits, etc. are left to the discretion of the designers of the facilities concerned. This document is therefore positioned
as a reference for the designers to correctly understand the standards stipulated based on the performance criteria.
This document illustrates the standard performance verification methods, allowable failure probabilities, and the
standard ways of thinking about deformation limit values with examples. This document does not, however, intend
to discourage the development and introduction of new technologies. If the designers set performance criteria for the
performance verification of the facilities concerned other than those specified by the notifications and can prove that
the performance requirements are met, they may assume that the facilities concerned conform to the criteria.
1---------....-1'
"
'' ' ' ' '
'\
1
1
'
'
Performance
requirements
'
' ',
,
.....' ,
''
,.,....~~~~~~~~
Commentary - - / '
In~
,'
Performance
criteria
Public
notice
',
'
,''
'
~:n::~
'
',,
'
Appendix
l---------------------------~
For the sake of convenience, the performance requirements specified by ministerial ordinances of the technical
standards is classified according to the range of applicable facilities, the category of performance, and the allowable
degree of damage. The range of applicable facilities means whether the performance requirements is on a facility-byfacility basis or common to all facilities. The category of performance means whether the performance requirements
are on structural responses to action or on the requirements for usability of facilities and enhancement of convenience.
Refer to Fig. 1.3.2 for the classification of performance requirements.
-8-
.-----------. .-----------:-
I
Qn 8 facility-by-
facility basis
-----------
Action/response
Serviceability
Performance
Classified according to
Restorability
Safety
requirements
Usability
.-----------.
I
Comm.onto
all facilities
Constroctability
1-------1
-----------
Maintenanceability
Classified according to
the category of performance
It includes
performance on the structural responses and structural dimensions, constructability, maintenanceability, etc. of the
facilities. Performance on structural responses of a facility is classified into three categories according to the allowable
degree of damage: (1) serviceability, (2) restorability, and (3) safety.
These categories are arranged in order of the allowable degree of damage: (3) safety > (2) restorability > (!)
serviceability. Fig. 1.3.3 shows the performance requirements for structural responses of port facilities. 5) In the
figure, the vertical and horizontal axes show the annual exceedence probability of action and the degree of damage,
respectively. The curve in the figure shows the performance of facilities. Except permanent actions, the characteristic
values of actions are generally determined depending on their annual occurrence probabilities. Different amounts of
action cause different degrees of damage to facilities. Damage to facilities caused by variable or permanent actions
with a relatively high annual exceedence probability is not acceptable. Since protecting facilities from damage by
accidental actions with a very low annual exceedence probability is economically unreasonable, a small amount of
damage to facilities caused by accidental actions is acceptable. The following summarize the basic concepts on
performance requirements for port facilities:
(!) For permanent and variable actions (with an annual exceedence probability of about 0.01 or more), the basic
requirement is serviceability. It is assumed that ensuring serviceability also ensures restorability and safety
against permanent and variable actions.
(2) As for accidental actions (with an annual exceedence probability of about 0.01 or less), satisfaction of performance
either of serviceability, restorability, or safety taking account ofthe expected functions and significance offacilities.
Except in the cases where facilities are high seismic resistance structure and where damage to facilities affects a
significant influence on human life, property, or social and economic activities, performance against accidental
actions is basically not required. It does not, however, deny the necessity of verification against accidental actions
conducted by the persons responsible for performance verification in facility owners.
The threshold value of0.01 used in the above Items (1) and (2) is just for the sake of convenience and unrestrictive.
It is only a guide for the cases where design working life falls within a standard range.
For example, when designing a facility having a function of transporting emergency supply materials immediately
after a big earthquake, it is required to set its degree of damage caused by accidental actions small as shown by the
facility A in Fig. 1.3.3 (ensuring serviceability). When designing a facility having a minimum function against
accidental actions, it is necessary to set an allowable degree of damage at a relatively large value and make sure that
the facility does not suffer fatal damage (ensuring safety).
-9-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Degree of damage
O.oJ
Serviceability
1
Fig. 1.3.3 Conceptual Diagram of the Relation Between Design situations and Required Performance
Performance requirements for structural responses ofthe subject facilities oftechnical standards given in ministerial
ordinances specify, based on the above concepts, the minimum requirements fur individual facilities to have from the
view point of public welfare. Responsible persons for the construction, improvement, and maintenance of the subject
facilities of technical standards can therefore set as necessary performance levels higher than these criteria as the
performance requirements for the facilities, taking account of their surrounding situations and required functions.
Requirements for crest heights, harbour calmness, and ancillary facilities are also given as performance requirements
for structural dimensions from the viewpoints of the usability and convenience of facilities. Ministerial ordinances
specify performance requirements for structural responses and structural factors on a facility-by-facility basis.
However, the following performance requirements for constructability and maintenanceability are factors common to
all facilities:
- Constructability:
performance required for constructing facilities. Refer to Part I, Chapter 2, Section 2
Construction of Facilities Snbject to the Technical Standards.
- Maintenanceability: performance required for maintaining facilities. Refer to Part I, Chapter 2, Section 3
Maintenance of Facilities Subject to the Technical Standards.
1.3.4 Actions
Actions are classified into three categories mainly according to time history in their amounts and their social risks to
be addressed: permanent, variable, and accidental actions. Table 1.3.1 shows examples of dominating actions to be
considered in the performance verification of port facilities.
Performance verification shall properly take account of the effects of actions on the facility concerned. The
return periods of actions taken into consideration in performance verification shall be appropriately set based on the
characteristics ofindividual actions, the significance of structures, and the design working life of the facility. It should
be noted that the return period means the average interval between the occurrence of actions of a certain amount or
more and is different from the design working life. For example, the probability that an action with a return period of
50 years (aonual exceedence probability: 1/50 = 0.02) occurs during a design working life of 50 years is 1-(1-0.02)50
= 0.64 if the past history of actions does not affect the aonual probability of exceedence. Actions with a return
period either longer or shorter than the design working life also have a certain probability of occurence in the design
working life. When the structure of the facilities under construction is different from the one expected at the time of
completion, it is necessary to take account of differences in the effects of actions on the structure during construction.
Table 1.3.1 Classification of Dominating Actions
Category
Action
Permanent
action
Self weight, earth pressure, environmental actions such as temperature stress, corrosion,
freezing and thawing, etc.
Variable
action
Waves, winds, water level (tide level), surcharge of cargo or vehicle, action due to ship
berthing/tracting, Level 1 earthquake ground motion, etc.
Accidental
action
Collision with a ship or other object except when berthing, fire, tsunami, Level 2 earthquake
ground motion, accidental waves, etc.
-10-
Actions are generally divided into dominating and non-dominating actions. In the cases where the possibility
of simultaneous occurrence of dominating and non-dominating actions is low, the characteristic values of the
non-dominating actions are likely to be those frequently occurring in a design working lire with a relatively high
annual exceedence probability. It is unreasonable to set all characteristic values of actions with a low possibility
of simultaneous occurrence at values with a low annual exceedence probability and to combine them. The general
principle on the combination of such actions is called the Turkstra's rule.
In conducting performance verification of port facilities, a design situation may have a number of situations in which
dominating actions are different from each other. This document hence uses an expression"--- situation with respect
to --- (dominating action)" to distinguish dominating actions. For example, if dominating actions are variable waves,
"variable situation in respect of waves" is written.
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
Japan Association for Earthquake Engineering: design principle for foundation structures based on performance design
concept, Mar. 2006
Nagao, T and F. Kawana: performance prescription ofthe design method for port and harbour facilities, 60th Annual Meeting
of JSCE, 2005
5)
Japan Society of Civil Engineering: Comprehensive design code (draft)-Principle and guide line for the preparation of
structural design based on performance design concept-, Mar. 2003
-11-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article2
The performance criteria for the facilities subject to the Technical Standards as specified in this Public Notice
can be used as the requirements for verification of the performance requirements. The same applies to the
performance criteria not specified in this Public Notice but proved to satisfy the performance requirements
of the facilities subject to the Technical Standards.
[Technical Nole]
Performance criteria are the technical regulations needed to verify performance requirements. Meeting the
performance criteria given here is hence considered as meeting performance requirements. Public notices specify
performance criteria on only general facilities of dominating structural types. In constructing, improving, or
maintaining other structural types of the subject facilities of technical standards, or in assuming specific design
situations, therefore, performance criteria shall be properly specified talcing account of performance criteria for
similar structural types and the surrounding situations of the facilities concerned.
Performance criteria given in public notices specify, according to performance requirements, the performance
required for facilities to have from the viewpoint of public welfare. Responsible persons for constructing, improving,
or maintaining the subject facilities of technical standards can hence set highel'-level codes than those given in public
notices. In such cases, however, the setting should be appropriately made based on a proper approach such as life cycle
cost minimization.
-12-
Article3
1 Performance verification of the facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall be conducted using a
method which can take account ofthe actions to the facilities, requirements for services, and the uncertainty
of the performance of the facilities concerned or other methods having high reliability.
2 The performance verification of the facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall be made in principle
by executing the subsequent items taking into consideration the situations in which the facilities concerned
will encounter during the design working life:
(1) Appropriately select the actions in consideration of the environmental conditions surrounding the
facilities concerned and others.
(2) Appropriately select the combination of the actions in consideration of the possible simultaneous
occurrence of dominant and non-dominant actions.
(3) Select the materials of the facilities concerned in consideration of their characteristics and the
environmental influences on them, and appropriately specify their physical properties.
[Commentary]
(1) Fundamentals of Performance Verification
CD Methods capable of taking account of actions, requirements for services, and the uncertainty of the
performance of the facilities concerned
The methods capable of taking account of requirements for services and the uncertainty of the
facility performance concerned are the performance verification methods capable of properly taking
account of the uncertainty of the performance of the facilities concerned such as the uncertainty of
actions and strengths caused by the uncertainty inherent to various design parameters such as natural
conditions, material characteristics, and analysis methods. Reliability-based design methods shall be
generally used.
The performance verification using a reliability design method needs to properly evaluate actions,
and the uncertainty inherent to various design parameters relating to the performance of the facilities
concerned and properly set target failure probabilities or reliability indices.
The performance verification using the level 1 reliability-based design method (partial factors
method) needs to properly evaluate the uncertainty of design parameters and set the partial factors
reflecting target reliability indices.
-13-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
based on past experiences may be used. When using the verification methods shown above, note the
following:
Desi1m situation
DominatinJl action
Self weight, earth pressure, winds,
Variable situation
Accidental situation
Taking account of the conformity of technical standards to international standards and the
accountability of designers, this document adopts the following methods: for the permanent and
variable situations, a reliability-based design method capable of quantitatively evaluating the stability
of facilities; for the accidental situation, a numerical analysis method capable of specifically evaluating
the amount of deformation and the degree of damage caused by actions.
A typical breakwater with a design working life of about 50 years, for example, needs to have
usability against waves with a 50 year return period. Verify the usability by checking that the
probability of failure against the sliding, overturning and foundation failure of the breakwater is not
higher than the allowable value. Setting this allowable failure probability at a value as low as about
1% shall be considered to ensure the serviceability.
In performance verification for the accidental situation, properly assume actions that have a low
possibility of occurrence in the area concerned but are unignorable to ensure social safety based
on disaster cases and scenarios, use a numerical analysis method to evaluate the responses of the
facility concerned to the actions, and judge if the degree of damage falls within a permissible range.
Persons responsible for performance verification shall properly set a permissible range of deformation
depending on the functions required for the facility after suffering damage from the actions concerned.
Other performance verification methods shall include the methods that persons in charge of
-14-
Table 1.3.3 Expected Performance Verification Methods for Each Facility or Structure Type, and for Each Design situation and Verification Item (1/4)
Facilities that can follow this
Assumed performance verification method
performance verification
method
Reliability design method
Facility or structure
typo
Design situation
Verification item
Level 1 reliability
dtJBign mllthods
(partial factor
methods)
-Composite
"-'
with waves
Accidental situation
Deformation/damage
Level 3 miability
design IIlllthods
(methods
thatcomider
probabilistic
dollxma1ioo)
Methods based
on specifications
Methods based on
ofpreviOllS
design methods
(furmal partial
similar structure
types or other
factor methods)
'"""'""
Methods based
on empirical
determinations
Upright breakwater, gravity
type special breakwater,
sediment control groin, groin,
Sliding
trainingjetty, etc.
0
Tsunami, etc.
Permanent situation
with waves
ground, etc.
-Pile type
Break.water with
wide footing on
'!:l
0
Tsunami, etc.
G"1
!:2
9:1
~
"""'
Overall
2
)>
"'
oft ground
Revetment
Lock
"""'
Overall
See mooring
facilities, etc.
0
""'
Water gate, etc.
Expected verifications are shown by o. As much as possible, this table shows all the verification items for the expeeted perfonnanoe verification methods of this document, but does not mle out verification by other appropriate methods. This table does not include determination
ofliqul!faction or 1tudy of precipitation, w a separate 1tudy is requinld.
G"1
!:2
9:1
~
"'
i;;;
a::
Table 1.3.3 Expected Performance Verification Methods for Each Facility or Structure Type,
and for Each Design situation and Verification Item (2/4)
..
Facilities that can follow this
performance verification method
Design situation
Verification item
Level 1 reliability
design methods
(partial factor
methods)
Permanent situation
associated with selfweight
Permanent situation
associated with earth
,....,..,.
Gravity type
quaywall
Deformation
(methods
that consider
probabilistic
deformation)
Numerical
Methods based on
specifications of
analysis method
(dynamic analysis
method)
previous design
methods (formal
partial factor
Methods based on
similar structure
types or other
standards
s:"'
)>
Ole.
0
Cantilevered sheet
pile type quay wall
Cl
Cl
"'
Permanent situation
associated with selfweight
I
$;
Stress ofwaling
o,.,.u
Accidental situation
associated with level 2
oarthquako ground motion
Deformation/cross-sectional
strength of sheet pile, tie rods,
and anchorage work
---
Orenill
Sl;!
);!
~
Q
:::!
c:
Cl
SE
--motion
Sheet Piled
quaywall
i5
8
~
a!
---
Permanent situation
associated with earth
I nressure
Permanent situation
associated with earth
I oressure
Variable sitmrtion associated
with level 1 earthquake
~
~
determinations
methods)
--und motion
"I'
"':c:);!
Methods based
on empirical
Level 3 reliability
design methods
r;l
$;
;g
:c:
Expected verifications are shown by Q Aa much as possible, thiB table shows all the verification itmns for the expected performance verification methods afthis document, but does not rule out verification by Dther
appropriate methods. This table does not include determination af liquefaction or study af precipitation, so a separate study is required.
Table 1.3.3 Expected Performance Verification Methods for Each Facility or Structure Type,
and for Each Design
- situation and Verification Item (3/4)
-
Facilities that can follow this
performance verification
method
Design situation
Typo
Verification item
Level 3 reliability
Level 1 reliability
design methods
design methods
(methods
(portialf'actmc
methods)
that consider
probabilistic
Methods based on
Numerical analysis
method (dynamic
analysis method)
Methods based on
similar structure
Methods based
types or other
standards
determinations
on empirical
methods)
deformation)
Double sheet piled
quaywall
specifications of
previous design
methods (formal
partial factor
All
0
Permanent situation
Sheer deformation
cell crown deformation
pressure
Permanent situation
pressure
Embedded 'fype
Cellular-Bulkhead
Quoywoll
:::;
Permanent situation
associated with earth
pressure
Permanent situation
ground motion
Accidental situation
Deformation
--Quaywall with
relieving platform
dolphin, etc.
Overall
G"1
'!:l
Overall
!:2
9:1
~
---
Mooring buoy
---
2
)>
"'
G"1
!:2
9:1
Expected verifications are shown by Q As mueh as possible, this table shows all theverifteation items for the expected performaneeverifteationmethods of this document, but does not rule out verification by other appropriate methods. This table does not indude determination
of liquefaction or study of precipitation, so a s~ study is required.
"'
i;;;
a::
Table 1.3.3 Expected Performance Verification Methods for Each Facility or Structure Type, and for Each Design situation and Verification Item (4/4)
Facilities that can fullow this
Design situation
Verification item
Level I reliability
design methods
(partial factor
methods)
Level 3 reliability
design methods
(methods
that consider
probabilistic
deformation)
specifications of
previous design
methods (form.al
partial factor
Methods based on
similar structure
types m other
stand8'ds
Methods based
on empirical
s:"'
)>
type dolphin
Open-type wharf
on vertical piles
);!
Accidental situation
associated with level 2
earthquake ground motion
Deformation/damage
Ove<all
a!
Cl
Cl
"'
section
See mooring
facilities, etc.
00
---
Shallow draft
O=all
See mooring
facilities, etc.
wharf
mooring rings
---
c:
Fenders
---
Arrangement:, etc.
0
soundness
---
$;
:c:
with loading
Cl
SE
;g
:::!
"''
$;
~
Q
i5
8
~
Sl;!
~
~
determinations
methods)
"':c:);!
Methods based on
Numerical
analysis method
(dynamic analysis
method)
r;l
Hxpeeted verifications are shown by Q As mudi as possible, this table shows all theverifi.cation items for the expeeted performance verifieation methods of this document, but does not rule out verification by other appropriate methods. This table does not indude determination
of liquefaction or stlJdy of precipitation, so a separate stlJdy is required.
performance verification can freely select. Methods of performance verification other than those
listed in Table 1.3.2 may be used for the performance verification of the subject facilities of technical
standards. The persons in charge may also adopt new verification methods. The methods capable
of specifically evaluating the performance of the facility concerned, such as those to probabilistic
evaluation of indices like a total amount of deformation incurred during the design working life and
the life cycle cost, are especially recommendable from the viewpoint of the reasonable performance
verification. There may be a method, for example, to verify the performance of the facility concerned
taking account of actions corresponding to various return periods as much as possible.
A typical example is the method to use a total amount of deformation incurred during the design
working life and the life cycle cost as verification indices and their probabilistic control. From the
viewpoint of the reasonable performance verification, such a method should be recommended because
it can specifically evaluate the performance of the facility concerned. Table 1.3.2 has no intention to
exclude these methods.
The above reliability-based design methods and numerical analysis approaches have not been
established as the performance verification methods for all types ofport facilities. They are inapplicable
to some facilities. It is therefore necessary to select appropriate performance verification methods
for such facilities, taking account of the methods based on the setting used in conventional design
methods (methods based on the conventional allowable safety factor method and the allowable stress
design method). The methods based on the setting used in conventional design methods are those that
use a verification equation in the form of partial factors with no essential change from conventional
design methods to allow the latest knowledge and findings to be immediately reflected on performance
verification. Table 1.3.3 shows the performance verification methods assumed in this document
corresponding to facility-wise and structure type-wise performance criteria given in public notices.
The verification of the variable situation of the cusing the seismic coefficient method needs to calculate
seismic coefficients for verification. This document describes the methods of calculating seismic
coefficients for verification with the examples of composite breakwaters, gravity-type quaywalls,
sheet pile quaywalls with vertical-pile anchorage, sheet pile quaywalls with coupled-pile anchorage,
open type wharves on vertical-piles, and the ground improved by the deep mixing method or the sand
compaction pile (SCP) method. As exemplified in Table 1.3.4, the methods of calculating seismic
coefficients for verification used for the above types of facilities can also be applied to the other types,
taking account of their structural characteristics. It should be noted that the performance verification
methods shown in this document are only examples and it has no intention to restrict the use of other
verification methods.
(2)Actions
The performance verification of a subject facility of technical standards needs to take account of its
design working life and the performance requirements, and properly set the amounts of actions. The
setting of actions needs to take account of various conditions like natural conditions, and as necessary,
actions during design working life affected by estuarine hydraulics, littoral drift, ground settlement,
ground liquefaction, and environmental actions. For further details on the setting of actions, refer to
the regulations and corresponding commentaries in Article 5 to Article 20 of the Public notice of the
Technical Standards.
(3) Combination of Actions
The combination of actions means the types and amounts of actions simultaneously considered in
performance verification. The setting of the combination of actions needs to properly take account of
the design working life of the facility concerned, its performance requirements, etc. For the combination
of dominating and non-dominating actions assumed in the performance criteria specified in the public
notices of the technical standards, refer to the tables shown in the commentaries of individual facilities.
In setting the combination of actions, non-dominating actions can be assumed to have an amount
with a relatively large annual exceedence probability and occur frequently in the design working life, if
the possibility of the simultaneous occurrence of dominating and non-dominating actions is low.
(4) Selection of Materials
Selection of materials needs to properly take account of their quality and durability. Materials used
for the subject facilities of technical standards include steel products, concrete, bituminous materials,
stone, wood, other metallic materials, plastics, rubber, coating materials, landfill materials (including
wastes), recycled materials (slag, coal ash, concrete mass, dredged soil, asphalt concrete mass, shells,
etc.). Materials conforming to the Japanese Industrial Standards can be assumed to have quality needed
to meet the performance requirements of the subject facilities of technical standards.
-19-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(= maximum acceleration I
JUavitational acceleration)
Seismic coefficient for verification
considering deformation
Sheet piled
quaywall
Open-type
wharf on
vertical piles
Improved
subsoil
Vertical pile
anchorage
Earthretaining
section
Deep mixing
method
SCP method
With regard to sediment control groins, training jetties, groins, coastal dikes, parapets, seawalls, locks, water gates, shallow draft
wharves, and slipways, it is possible to consider the structure type and the facility's response characteristics during seismic movements
when applying the above methods of calculating the seismic coefficient for verification.
-20-
The reliability-based design method is a method in which the possibility of failure of facilities is evaluated using a
technique based on probability theory, and comprises three design levels corresponding to the evaluation method.1>
Evaluations are performed by the failure probability Pf of the structure at Level 3, highest level, by the reliability
index p at level 2, and by a performance verification equation using partial factors, y at level I, lowest level as shown
in Table 1.6.1.
When calculating the failure probability in evaluation by the level 3 reliability-based design method, it is generally
necessary to obtain the simultaneous probability density function based on the limit state function, and to perform
multiple integrals on the result. However, conducting of standardization of the simultaneous probability density
function, and calculation of high order multiple integrals accompany difficulty, so that it is not practical normally.
For this reason, techniques such as Monte Carlo Simulation, MCS, etc. are used in numerical calculations of failure
probability. Even in such cases, from the viewpoint of reducing the computational load, it is the general practice to
apply Variance Reduction Techniques, VRT, etc. rather than the primitive crude Monte Carlo simulation. In the level
2 reliability-based design method, a reliability index which is related to the failure probability is used as an evaluation
parameter. The reliability index is calculated based on a method such as First-Order Reliability Method, FORM, or
the like. On the other hand, in the level I reliability-based design method, verification is performed by calculating
design values, which are the products of the characteristic values and partial factors, and then confirming that the
design values of resistance RJ are greater than the design values of the effects of actions Sd. Commentaries on the
reliability-based design method are available in References 3) and 4) .
Table 1.6.1 Three Levels in Reliability-based Design Method
Design
level
Level3
Level2
Level I
Performance
verification
Evaluation parameter
equation
PrT?.Pr
Failure probability
Pr
PT-sP
Reliability index
B
RJ?. sd
Design value
sd
Regardless of the method selected, in order to make an accurate quantitative evaluation of the performance of
facilities by the reliability-based design method, it is necessary to determine the various indeterminate factors,
namely the design parameters which intervene in the performance verification. If this is not achieved, the calculated
failure probability or reliability index will have no engineering meaning. Furthermore, in order to achieve design
rationalization and construction cost reduction by applying the reliability-based design method, it is necessary to strive
for improved accuracy in estimations of the controlling factors with the greatest effect on the design. This is because,
in addition to the average values of the design parameters, their standard deviations also affect the failure probability
Pf of structures. For this, firstly, it is necessary to designate the controlling factors. For example, evaluation using
sensitivity factors is extremely effective as a technique for this. Here, sensitivity factors are indices that express the
sensitivity or importance of the various design parameters in the performance of the facilities, as described in detail
in 1.6.3 Method or Setting Partial Factors. Because reliability indices and sensitivity factors are used in calculation
of the partial factors in the level I reliability-based design method, quantitative evaluation of these values has a large
engineering significance.
1.6.2 Level 1 Reliability-based Design Method (Partial Factor Method)
The international standard ISO 2394 "General Principles on Reliability for Structures" and "Basics of Civil Engineering
and Architectural Design" (Ministry of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism) recommend the partial factor
method as a standard performance verification method for facilities. Considering conformity to these upper-level
standards and simplicity and convenience in practical design work, this document adopts the level I reliability-based
design method (partial factor method) as the standard performance verification method. However, this does not
restrict the use ofthe level 2 and level 3 reliability-based design methods for performance verification. Rather, because
the partial factor method is a simple design method, as described below, adoption of level 2 or level 3 methods for
precise control of the possibility offailure is preferable.
The following summarizes the level I reliability-based design method as the standard performance verification
-21-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
method.
The level 1 reliability-based design method is a method in which characteristic values are multiplied by partial factors
in order to calculate design values, and equation (1.6.1) is used to confirm that the design value of resistance Rd is
greater than the design value of the effect of actions Sd in order to verify the performance of the facility.
Z=R -S ;>:0
(1.6.1)
The design values oftli'e effgct of actions Sd and resistance ~are given by equations (1.6.2) and (1.6.3), respectively.
(1.6.2)
(1.6.3)
The design values of the individual design parameters necessary in performance verification such as the wave
action, the ground motion, material characteristics, etc. are calculated from equations (1.6.4) and (1.6.5).
(1.6.4)
(1.6.5)
where
s1,
r1d
Equations (1.6.6) and (1.6.7) give the design values of the simplest action effects and resistance, respectively, when
i = j = 1 (suffixes i,j = 1 are omitted). Equation (1.6.8) expresses the performance verification equation in that case.
(1.6.6)
(1.6.7)
(1.6.8)
rx = (1-axPrVx )x
x,
(1.6.9)
where
In the cases where the stochastic variable X has a logarithmic normal distribution, the partial factor can be
calculated from equation (1.6.10).
-22-
(1.6.10)
The stochastic variables used in this document have a normal distribution unless otherwise noted.
1.6.4 Setting of Target Safety Level and Target Reliability Index/Partial Factors
In application of reliability-based design methods, how the target safety level is set is a key issue. Methods of
setting the target safety level include the following method 1):
@ Method based on the average safety level of conventional design criteria (safety factor method, allowable stress
method)
Method based on the investment effuct necessary for avoiding the risk of human loss
Method based on the minimization of the life cycle cost
A study 6) of the applicability of these methods to port and harbour facilities revealed the following: Method Q)
based on accident statistics has difficulty in matching statistics on accidents, which are often caused by human error,
with failure probabilities, which are caused by various levels of actions such as waves and earthquakes, whereas
method @ based on comparison with other disaster vulnerabilities and method based on the investment effuct
necessary for avoiding the risk of human loss do not have high applicability to port and harbour facilities because
they were proposed for facilities with a high possibility of direct human loss due to damage to facilities.
Taking these viewpoints into consideration, this document generally uses method @ based on calibration to
conventional design criteria as the method of setting target safety levels for cases where the probability distributions
ofparameters are known and verification methods are compatible with failure mechanisms. However, use of method
based on the minimization of life cycle cost is not rejected.
When adopting a method using the life cycle cost as the index, the cost arising during the design working life
(assumed to be 50 years) is generally defined as the life cycle cost, and the possibility of multiple disasters is
considered. Equation (1.6.11) shows the expected value of the life cycle cost. It should be noted that this is a narrow
definition oflife cycle cost.
ELC = C1 +
E1
L,-'
C1 R
J=I
(1.6.11)
(1.6.12)
E 1 =v.TP1
J
J
J
(1.6.13)
where
ELC : expected value oflife cycle cost
C; : initial construction cost
m : rank number of action of interest
T : design working life (50 years)
: expected number of damage occurrence caused by action of interest
f : cost ofrecovery after failure
i : social discount rate
P1 : failure probability due to actions of interest
vj : average annual occurrence rate of action of interest (= 1/R)
R : return period of action of interest
Fig. 1.6.1 shows the general concept of this method. Life cycle cost generally shows diffurent trends depending
on the side of the minimum value (optimum value). On the right side (dangerous side) of the minimum value, the
life cycle cost is sensitive to changes in failure probability, and rapidly increases as the failure probability increases.
On the left side (conservative side) of the minimum value, the life cycle cost gradually increases as the failure
probability decreases.
-23-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Conventional
design method
r
Initial consbuction cost
Failure probability Pt
Fig. 1.6.1
In performance verification of mooring facilities for the permanent situation, the probability distributions of
parameters are known and verification metbods are compatible with failure mechanisms. Nevertheless, the use
of method @ is not necessarily appropriate because multiple failure modes exist in each structural type and there
were large differences in the safety levels for each failure mode due to differences in setting in the conventional
design methods.7) Furthermore, the safety levels of the conventional design metbods also varied greatly due to the
autocorrelation of ground strength, which is affected by the size of the slip arc as in the case ofthe circular slip failure
mode.Bl When using metbod @, because it is not necessary to consider the action of multiple annual exceedance
probabilities in mooring facilities in the permanent situation, the expected total cost expressed by the sum of the
initial construction cost and the expected value of failure recovery cost is used as an index, and verification is
performed by finding the failure probability for minimizing this index as the optimum value. In this case, the
expected total cost is given by equation (1.6.14).
ETC=C1 +P1C1
(1.6.14)
where
ETC
C;
P1
Ct
The metbod of setting partial factors used in this document is based on the following concept.
In the cases where the probability distributions of parameters are known and verification methods are compatible
with failure mechanisms, partial factors are generally determined based on calibration to conventional design
methods using the allowable safety factor method and similar approaches.
On the other hand, when in performance verification of mooring facilities for the Permanent situation,
the probability distributions of parameters are known and the verification metbods are compatible with failure
mechanisms, but using the partial factors set based on calibration to conventional design methods (allowable safety
factor method, allowable stress method, etc.) sometimes leads to the setting of excessively safe and uneconomical
cross sections. In such cases, this document recommends the use of partial factors set based on minimization of
expected total costs.
In other cases, where the probability distributions of parameters are unknown or verification approaches are not
necessarily compatible with failure mechanisms, the setting of target safety levels/partial factors using a probability
theory is difficult. Therefore, in such cases, this document determines partial factors stochastically, considering the
settings used in conventional design methods (safety factor method, allowable stress method).
Table 1.6.2 summarizes the above-mentioned setting methods by type of facility.
-24-
Design situation
Permanent situation
Gravity type
quaywall ------------------------------------------------------Variable situation associated
with Level 1 earthquake ground
motion
Permanent situation
Failure mode
Method based on
minimization of expected
total cost
Cellularbulkhead
type
quaywall
Shear deformation
Sliding
--------------------------------------------------------------Permanent situation
Stress of cell shell
Stress of arc
------------------------------------------------------- --------------------------------------------------------------Variable situation with respect
to Level 1 earthquake ground
Sliding
motion
Stress of pile (edge yield of pile head)
Variable situation associated
with actions caused by ships
---------------------------------------------------------------
-25-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
Hoshitani M. And K. Ishii: reliability Design method of structures, Kajima Publishing Co., 1986
Noga, H: Structural reliability design as basic knowledge, Sankaido Publications, 1995
Melchers, R.E. : Structural Reliability Analysis and Prediction, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 1999
Haldar, A. aod Mahadevan, S. : Probability, Reliability aod Statistical Methods in Engineering Design, 2nd edition, John
Wiley & Sons, Inc., 2000
Box, G. E. P. and Muller, M. E. : A note nn the generation of normal deviates, Ann. Math. Stat., 29 pp.610-611, 1958
Nagao, T. Y. Kadowaki and K. Terauchi: Evaluation of Safety of Breakwaters by the Reliability Based Design Method (!st
Report: Study on the Safety against Sliding), Report of PHRI. Vol. 34, No. I, 1995
Nagao, T., Y. Kadowaki aod K. Terauchi: Overall system stability of a breakwater based on reliability design method (First
Report)- Discussion on the stability against sliding, Proceedings of Structural Eng., Vol. SIA, pp.389-400, 2005
Ozaki, R. aod T. Nagao: Study on Application of reliability based design method on circular arc slip of breakwaters,
Proceedings of Oceao Development No. 21, JSCE, pp. 963-968, 2005
-26-
f-
ffx(xt,X2,-,x.)dxidx2,.,dx.
(A-1.1)
g(x)<o
where x,, x 2, ... x. are stochastic variables,/,(x,, x,, ... x,,) is the joint probability density function
of the random variables, and g(X) is the limit state function.
The joint probability density function can be expressed by equation (A-1.2), for example, when all
random variables are normally distributed.
(A-1.2)
0 ~------------"'
X1
Z=O
Fig. A-1.1 shows the concept of failure probability for a simple case of two independent variables, where
fx1(x1) andfx2(x2) are marginal probability density functions, and the bell-shaped[x,x2 (x1, xi) is a joint probability
density function. In the cases of two variables, the joint probability density distribution can be expressed as a
bell-shaped distribution in a three-dimensional space and its multiple integrals gives the volume. The multiple
integrals in the whole domain results in the volume = I. The failure probability is given by the failure domain of
this joint probability density function, i.e., the volume of the domain shown by Z < 0 in Fig. A-1.1.
The application of this multiple integrals to actual problems is, however, difficult in many cases. Triple or
highel'order multiple integrals is generally difficult. In some cases, joint probability density functions cannot be
expressed in an explicit form. In almost all cases, therefore, the value of failure probability is not assessed directly
from equation (A-1.1) but by Monte Carlo simulation (hereafter called MCS).
The following shows the general procedure ofMCS:
-27-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
@ The uniform random numbers are transformed into random numbers having a necessary probability distribution
and a correlation.
@ The safuty of the structure concerned is evaluated using the combination of obtained random numbers.
The above evaluation is performed a large number of times, and the number of trials judged as failure is divided
by the total number of trials to determine the failure probability.
The random numbers generated by computer follow a certain rule depending on needs, and hence are called
pseudo-random numbers. Methods such as the multiplicative congruence method and linear congruence methods
have been widely used as algorithms for generating uniform random numbers. Likewise, at present, build-in
functions for various applications frequently use these methods. It should be noted, however, that the problem of
cycle length, which is one of the requirements for random number generation algorithms, has been pointed out in
the case of the linear congruence method. For this reason, other algorithms such as Mersenne Twister are often
used. The source code of Mersenne Twister is available on the internet.
The transformation of uniform random numbers into other probability distributions is carried out by inverse
operation of the probability distribution function. For example, the following equation (A-1.3) can be used for the
transformation into normal random variables:
(A-1.3)
where r; is a uniform random number, cJ) is the standard normal cumulative distribution function, and and V
are the average value and the coefficient of variation, respectively.
In addition, the method proposed by Box and Muller >) is also widely used for transformation into normal
random variables. Other transformation methods include the one using the central limit theorem, which uses the
fact that the sum of random numbers having the same probability distribution approximates a normal distribution.
However, in applying this method, care is necessary with regard to the applicability of the distribution tail,
because a very small failure probability is normally required for structures, and accurate evaluation of such a
small failure probability demands exact reproducibility of the tail of the probability distribution. Accordingly,
due consideration of the applicability of the distribution tail is necessary, especially in assessing value of failure
probability.
In the cases where random variables are correlated, independent random variables must be converted into
J- J1[g(x)s O]fx(x)dx
(A-1.4)
(A-1.5)
where I is a failure judgment function. The above expression becomes 1 for I< 0 and zero for other cases.
When using MCS, the number of trials must be set carefully because the validity of approximation in equation
(A-1.5) depends on the number of trials. In MCS, the number of trials is generally set so that the coefficient of
variations of the failure probability [equation (A-1.6)] will become sufficiently small.
(A-1.6)
where V is the coefficient of variation, Pf is the assessed value of failure probability by MCS, and N is the
number of trials.
Following Shooman, 6) the errors attributable to MCS can be calculated from equation (A-1.7).l From this,
it can be understood that a small failure probability is likely to result in large error if the number of trials is
insufficient. Therefore, evaluation of probability based on a small number of trials due to the calculation load in
each trial must absolutely be avoided.
&%=
(A-1.7)
x200%
-28-
(A-1.8)
Methods of improving calculation efficiency other than the importance sampling method include, for example,
the Adaptive Sampling method, 9), 10) the Markov Chain Monte Carlo (MCMC) method, 11) ,12) the Latin hypercube
sampling method, 13) etc. Other methods use Low Discrepancy Sequences called quasi-random numbers 14) without
using the pseudo-random numbers described above.
(2) Level 2 Reliability-based Design Method
The level 2 reliability-based design method assesses the reliability index p, instead of the failure probability, in
order to determine the cross-sectional dimensions so as to obtain a value of pgreater than the permissible value.
The failure probability of a structure decreases as the reliability index increases. In some cases, the reliability
index was formerly called the safety index. However, this document will use the term "reliability index." (The
term reliability index is also used in ISO 2394 and elsewhere.)
The reliability index f3 and the failure probability Pf have the relation shown by equation (A-1.9). Fig. A-1.2
is a graphic representation of this relationship.
(A-1.9)
~
I
1o-3
'
0.01
Pt
"
'
'
I
'
'I.
'
10..
'
10-5
10.a
'
'
' 5'
/I
Fig. A-1.2 Relationship between Reliability Index and Failure Probability
Cornell 15) first formulated the reliability index [3. Since the method uses only the first and second order
moments (called average value and variance, respectively) of limit state function, it is called the First-Order
Second-Moment (FOSM) method.
Assuming that the limit state function Z simply consists of two variables of the resistance Rand the action effect S
(Z = R - S), the reliability index can be obtained from equation (A-1.10). Fig. A-1.3 shows a graphic representation.
P=z
Uz
= R-s
(A-1.10)
~u~+~
-29-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
fz(Z)
Failure
(Z :o 0)
pf
z
Fig. A-1.3 Reliability index
The above is the expression for the case of two variables. As a more general expression in the FOSM, the
limit state function g is developed around its average value by Taylor's series expansion method. The average and
standard deviation ofthe limit state function are evaluated by using terms up to the first order as shown in equation
(A-1.1).
When the limit state function consists of mutually independent random variables x1 (i =I,---, n), the average
value and standard deviation are evaluated by equations (A-1.12) and (A-1.13), respectively. It must be noted that
the expression is different when the variables are correlated.
ofa]=
f.(ag)~ u;,
=1
ax,
(A-1.13)
where is the average value and a is the standard deviation. The mark attached to variables such as X and
xi indicates the average value of the symbol.
Equation (A-1.14) gives the reliability index.
p = (g)
(A-1.14)
u(g)
The reliability index determined by FOSM has the following defects: It does not reflect probability distribution
of random variables. It uses a linear approximation at the average value of the limit state function, and does not
consider the probability distribution based on random variables , it may give a non-negligible error when the
limit state function is nonlinear, and it gives different reliability indexes depending on differences in the form of
expression used for the limit state function (for example, Z = R-S and Z = RIS-1). At the present time, therefore,
more accurate approaches such as the FORM described below are generally used. However, in cases, where the
object ofverification is the amount of deformation and the degree of damage of the structure obtained by nonlinear
seismic response analysis, and where the calculation of the failure probability and reliability index using the MCS
described above or the FORM and SORM described below involves a heavy calculation load, using the FOSM is
considered a simple and easy option for reliability evaluation.
Hasofer and Lind 16) proposed a reliability index which overcomes the defects of FOSM. The index gives
accurate results within the range ofthe first order approximation when the random variables are normal. Rackwitz
and Fiessler 17) later proposed a method which extends that method to the cases of random variables other than
normal ones. Their method is called FORM (First-Order Reliability Method).
In FORM, random variables are transformed into mutually independent standard normal random variables,
and the limit state function in the standardized space consisting of standard normal random variable vectors is
assessed. Next, a search is made to identify the shortest distance from the origin of the standardized space to the
limit state curved surface (curved surface where the limit state function becomes zero). This distance is defined
as the reliability index.
Some points regarding the transformation into standard normal random variables should be noted. First, in
the cases of random variables other than normal ones, these are transformed into the normal random variables
-30-
g(x1', X2')=0
g(x1', X2')<0
In the cases where random variables are normal and have no mutual correlation, as dealt with by Hasofer and
Lind, 16) the reliability index is expressed by equation (A-1.15).
-31-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(A-1.15)
where
Z
X
rr
The process of calculating the reliability index requires the calculation of the sensitivity factor a expressed by
equation (A-1.16). The sensitivity factor a is a linear approximate coefficient of limit state function.
(i~l,2; ,n)
(A-1.16)
where
(A-1.17)
Equation (A-1.16) expresses the directional cosine of the reliability index to each random variable axis in the
standardized space (see Fig. A-1.5). The sensitivity factor has a positive value for the parameters on the resistance
side and a negative value for those on the action effect side, their sum of squares being 1 wheo the random
variables have no correlation with each other. As is clear from the figure, as the absolute value of the sensitivity
factor of a variable approaches 1, the standardized value at the failure point teods to coincide more closely with
the reliability index. This meaos that the variable has a large effect on the reliability index.
In cases where random variables are mutually correlated, the correlation coefficient p between the random
variables is considered in the standard deviation and sensitivity factor of the limit state fuoction, which are
expressed by equations (A-1.18) and (A-1.19), respectively.
(A-1.18)
(A-1.19)
-32-
S'
Z=O
Z<O
--
------- \ ' p
- S'*
\ __ ... __ .... --
cos-I( aR)._.--'
..... -- ....
cos-I( a,)
Index~
The application of the FORM enables accurate evaluation of the reliability index within the range of the
first-order approximation. It must be noted, however, that FORM uses the first-order approximation of the limit
state function to evaluate the reliability index. For example, when the hatched area in Fig. A-1.5 shows a real
failure domain, FORM approximates it by the dotted line in the figure, causing an error corresponding to the
area between the solid and dotted lines. Therefure, in cases where the limit state curved surface shows strong
nonlinearity, the FORM may cause error which cannot be ignored.
As an approach to solving the problem inherent to FORM, the Second-Order Reliability Method (SORM) has
been proposed.20) SORM corrects the reliability index obtained by FORM according to the curvature of the limit
state curved surface, as shown in equation (A-1.20).
(A-1.20)
where
p : reliability index obtained by the FORM, 1<1: principal curvature of the i-th limit state curved
surface.
An important point in reliability analysis is the proper selection of an accurate method according to the
characteristics of the problem concerned.
Another point to note in reliability analysis is a problem of the spatial autocorrelation of the ground
characteristics.2I) The natural sedimentary ground is thought to have a correlation distance of several tens of
meters horizontally and several meters vertically. Accordingly, the reliability index and the failure probability
must be assessed giving proper consideration to the vertical correlation in particular. This issue is critically
important in dealing with problems such as analysis of circular slip failure.
-33-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
g;;
--------Coefficient of variation V of ground strength
---~~---Coefficient
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
Hoshitani M. Aod K. Ishii: reliability Design method of structures, Kajima Publishiog Co., 1986
Naga, H: Structural reliability design as basic knowledge, Sankaido Publications, 1995
Melchers, R.E. : Structural Reliability Analysis and Prediction, Joho Wiley & Sons, Inc., 1999
Haldar, A. and Mahadevan, S. : Probability, Reliability and Statistical Methods in Engineering Design, 2nd edition, Joho
Wiley & Sons, Inc., 2000
Box, G. E. P. and Muller, M. E. : A note on the generation of normal deviates, Aon. Math. Stat., 29 pp.610-611, 1958
Shooman, M. L. : Probabilistic reliability : an engineering approach, McGraw-Hill, New York, 1968
Hohenbichler, M., Rackwitz, R.: Improvement of Second-Order Reliability estimates by Importance Sampling, Journal of
Eng. Mech., ASCE, 114, 12, pp-2195-2199, 1988
Harbitz, A.: An Efficient Sampling Method fur Probability of Failure Calculation, Structural Safety, Vol.3, No.2, pp.109-115,
1986
Karamchandani, A., Bjerager, P., and Coroell, A.C.: Adaptive Importance Sampling, Proceedings, International Conference
on Structural Safuty and Reliability (!COS SAR), San Francisco, CA, pp.855-862, 1989
Wu, Y. T.: An Adaptive Importance Sampling Method fur Structural System Reliability Analysis, Reliability technology
1992, In T.A. Cruse (Editor), ASME Winter Aonnal Meeting, Vol. AD-28, Anaheim, CA, pp.217-231, 1992
Iba, Y. et al.: computational statistics II, Markov chain Monte Carlo Method and related topics, Frontier of statistical science,
lwanami Shorten Publishiog, 2005
Gilks, W. R., Richardson, S., and Spiegelhalter, D. J. (Editors): Markov Chain Monte Carlo in Practice, Chapman & Hall/
CRC, 1996
Architectural Institute of Japan: Non-liner uncertain modeling of structure system, Applied Dynamics Series 6, 1998
14) Tezuka, S. et al.: Computational statistics I, New method for statistical calculation, Frontier of statistical science, Iwanami
Shoten Publishiog, 2005
15) Corneli C. A. : A probability based structural code, Journal of the American Concrete Institute, 66(12), pp.974- 985, 1969
16) Hasofur, A. M. and Lind, N. C. : Exact and Invariant Second Moment Code Format, Journal of the Engineering Mechanics
Division, ASCE, Vol. 100, No. EM 1, pp.111-121, 1974
17) Rackwitz, R. and Fiessler, B. : Structural Reliability under Combined Random Load Sequences, Computers & Structures,
Vol. 9, pp.489-494, 1978
18) Rosenblatt, M. : Remarks on a multivariate transformation, Aon. Math. Stat., 23, pp.470-472, 1952
-34-
-35-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
As shown by equations (1.6.9) and (1.6.10), the partial factor is set based on the estimation accuracy, sensitivity
factor, and target reliability index of the design parameter. Future progress in research, the development of new
materials, and other factors may improve the estimation accuracy of design parameter, and changes in target
safety levels from the viewpoint of life cycle cost and other considerations are also conceivable. In such cases, it
is necessary to set the partial factors properly, as the sensitivity factors of the design parameters will change. As
methods of setting the partial factor in these cases, the following are considered possible:
CD
Method of modifying the partial factor using the sensitivity factor adopted before the change in reliability.
~~------..~~----....---~~~---1._____~~
-36-
In evaluations of system reliability, it is necessary to assess the possibility of higher-order simultaneous failures
among various modes. Fig. A-2-2 shows a conceptual diagram for three modes, where Zi. Z2 , and Z 3 are failure
modes. Referring to the figure, equation (A-2.1) is a general formula for calculating the system failure probability
P(F) when the number of modes is n.
II
II
i=l
(A-2.1)
P(F)=l-IJ(l-P(Z1)]
(A-2.2)
i=l
When modes are mutually correlated, the system failure probability cannot be assessed as simply as in the above
equation. Therefore, system reliability has been evaluated with a certain latitude. Ditlevsen 25) bounds are wellknown example of this (equation (A-2.3)).
(A-2.3)
With the Ditlevsen bounds method, a very wide range of reliability may be given in some cases, depending on
conditions. Accordingly, it is generally necessary to perform the Monte Carlo Simulation (MCS) in order to assess
system reliability. In the cases of two modes, however, system reliability can be evaluated easily using the FORM
results. The system reliability in this case is given by equation (A-2.4). Use of Owen's method 26) makes it possible
to reduce the integral degree of the double integral term (third term in the right side of equation (A-2.5)) to one. In
this case, equation (A-2.5) gives the system failure probability.
(A-2.4)
1
[-1 (Pi2-2tf3i/J2 +Pi)]dt
f 2tr~exp
2
1- t
2
1-
(A-2.5)
where p 12 is the correlation coefficient of the failure modes 1 and 2 and is expressed by equation (A-2.6) using the
inner product of sensitivity factor vectors.
-37-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(A-2.6)
where ax,t is the sensitivity factor of the parameter x in the i-th failure mode.
Taking as an example the system reliability assessment method for the external stability of breakwaters
adopted in this document, system reliability can be assessed with sufficient accuracy, 27) even with the upper limits
given by equation (A-2.3), as sliding is frequently the dominant mode among the three failure modes of sliding,
overturning, and foundation failure.
In addition, research is also underway on the assessment of third or higher-order system reliability within
the framework of first-order approximation methods. The methods under study replace the problem of system
reliability in systems with correlated modes of failure with the problem of system reliability in systems having
equivalent independent modes of failure. Among them, FOMN (First-Order Multinormal approach) 28), 29) and
PCM (Product of Conditional Marginals) 30) are well known.
(3) Recent Developments in Reliability Analysis Methods
Taking as examples cases in which it is necessary to assess reliability for residual deformation and the degree of
damage of mooring facilities affected by ground motion, simple assessment of the probability distribution of the
residual deformation and degree of damage included in the limit state function is difficult because these values
must be obtained by second or higher-order nonlinear seismic response analyses, and an extremely large number
of analyses is necessary to calculate their probability distribution. In such cases, the application of methods
such as the MCS, FORM, and SORM is accompanied by difficulties. A conceivable alternative is a simple
evaluation of reliability by FOSM. Because FOSM evaluates the average and standard deviation of the limit state
function through several analyses, the calculation load is dramatically reduced. For actual research examples, see
References 31), 32), and 33).
Reliability analysis is also applicable to the optimization problems in maintenance strategies which consider
deterioration of the material of existing steel structures.34)
The use of stored data and analysis results obtained through the adoption of reliability-based design method
systems reduces variations in the evaluation of various parameters, contributing to reduced construction costs.35)
Therefore, consistent efforts to accumulate various types of statistical data are extremely important.
References
23) Yoshioka, S. and T. Nagao: Determination of partial safety coefficients in accordance with the reliability, Proceedings of
Structural Engineering, JSCE, Vol. SIA, PP.401-412, 2005
24) Miyazaki, S and T. Nagao: A study on determination of partial coefficient of gravity type breakwater having plural structural
characteristics- an example of sloping top caisson breakwater covered with wave absorbing blocks,- Technical Note of
National Institute of Land and Infrastructure Management (NILIM), No. 350, 2006
25) Ditlevsen, 0.: Narrow reliability bounds for structural systems, Jour. of Struct. Mechanics, Vol.7, No.4, pp.453-472., 1979
26) Owen, D. B.: Tables for computing bivariate normal probabilities, Ann, Math. Stat., Vol.27, pp. 1075-1090, 1956
27) Yoshioka, K., Nagao T., A. Washio and Y. Moriya : reliability analysis of external stability of gravity type breakwater,
Proceeding of Coastal Engineering No. 51, JSCE, pp.751-755,2004
28) Hohenbichler, M. and Rackwitz, R : First-order coceptSs in system reliability, Structural Safety, 1(3), pp.177-188, 1983
29) Tang, L. K. and Melchers, R. E.: Improved approximation for multi-normal integral, Structural Safety, 4, pp.81793, 1987
30) Pandey, M. D.: An effective approximation to evaluate muhinormal integrals, Structural Safety, 20 (!), pp.51-67, 1988
31) Oshima, Y., Z. Murakmi, H. Ishikawa and T. Takeda: Evaluation system of the stability of earth structure against earthquake,
5th Symposium on the safety and reliability of structures in Japan, Proceeding of JCOSSAR 2003 pp. 691-694, 2003
32) Matsumoto, T., S. Sawada, Y. Oshima, T. Sakata and E. Watanabe: Damage evaluation of underground structure with strong
non-linear behavior due to earthquake, Proceeding of Structural Engineering Vol.52A, JSCE, pp. 1159-1168, 2006
33) Nagao, T.: Simple method for the evaluation of residual deformation of a wharf, Proceeding of Structural Engineering No.
52, JSCE, 2007
34) Nagao, T. H. Sato and S. Miyajima: Discussions on the methodology to choose maintenance measures considering failure
probability, Journal of applied dynamics, Vol.9, pp. 1051-1060, 2006
35) Yoshioka, K. and T. Nagao: rational application method of Level I reliability design principle to Caisson Breakwaters, JSCE
Proceeding of Coastal Eng., Vol. 51, pp. 39-70 pp. 856-860, 2004
-38-
PA/ff I GENERAL, CHAl'TER 2 CONSTRUCTION, IMPROVEMENT, OR MAINTENANCE OF FACILITTES SUBJECT TO THE TECHNICAL STANDARDS
Ministerial Ordinance
Design of Facilities Subject to the Technical Standards
Article2
1 The facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall be properly designed to satisfy their performance
requirements and to avoid adverse effects on their structural stability during construction while considering
environmental conditions, usage conditions, and other conditions to which the facilities concerned are
subjected.
2 The design of facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall be made by properly setting their design
working life.
3 The requirements other than those specified in the preceeding two paragraphs for designing the facilities
subject to the Technical Standards shall be provided by the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Consideration for Construction and Maintenance in Designing
Article 4
Design of the facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall be conducted with due consideration for
proper construction and maintenance of the facilities.
!Technical Note]
consideration.
(2) For determining of design working life, the classification of design working life defined in ISO 2394 (1998) shown
in Table 1.1 may be referred. The standard design working life of port facilities is the one based on the values for
Class 3 in the table.
Table 1.1 Concept of Classification of Design Working Life Defined in ISO 2394 (1998)
Class
1-5
25
50
100 or longer
Example
Temporary structures
Replaceable structural elements such as bridge abutment
beams and bearings
Buildings and other public structures, structures other than
the below
Memorial buildings, special or important structures, largescale bridges
-39-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article3
The facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall be properly constructed based on the construction
standards provided by the Public Notice to satisfy their performance requirements, while considering
environmental conditions, usage conditions, and other conditions to which the facilities concerned are
subjected.
[Commentary]
Article2
1 Those who construct or improve facilities subject to the technical standards, including contractors, shall
normally prepare construction plans to accurately, smoothly, and safely construct the facilities concerned.
2 Construction plans shall normally include the subjects listed in the following items:
(1) Construction methods of the facilities concerned
(2) Supervision methods for construction work of the facilities concerned
(3) Supervision methods for construction safety of the facilities concerned
(4) Requirements other than those listed in the above three items to accurately, smoothly, and safely
construct the facilities concerned.
3 Those who construct or improve facilities subject to the technical standards shall normally modify
their construction plans when required by changes in work progress or construction site situations.
2.3 Substance Set as Construction Methods
Public Notice for Construction
Construction Methods
Article3
1 Those who construct or improve facilities subject to the technical standards shall specify construction
methods taking account of the conditions, in accordance with Article 6 of the Ministerial Ordinance,
under which the facilities concerned are placed.
2 Construction methods shall normally specify the subjects listed in the following items:
(1) Construction procedures and the construction specifications of each construction stage from the
beginning to the completion of the facilities concerned
(2) Types and specifications of the major working vessels and machines used for constructing the facilities
concerned
-40-
PA/ff I GENERAL, CHAl'TER 2 CONSTRUCTION, IMPROVEMENT, OR MAINTENANCE OF FACILITTES SUBJECT TO THE TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(3) Substance and timing of the measures taken to construct the facilities concerned other than those listed
in the preceding two items
2.4 Content of Construction Management
Public Notice for Construction
Construction Management
Article 4
1 Those who construct or improve facilities subject to the technical standards shall properly supervise
construction works in compliance with the criteria provided in the following items:
(1) Management items, content of management, management methods, quality standards, measurement
frequencies, and methods to analyze measurement results shall be specified on the materials and
structural members used for the facilities concerned, and the quality standards required for the materials
and members shall be ensured.
(2) Management items, measurement methods, measurement densities, measurement units, methods to
analyze measurement results, and allowable ranges shall be specified for the shape of the facilities
concerned, and the shape required for the facilities shall be ensured.
2 Those who construct or improve facilities subject to the technical standards shall normally supervise
progress status and work schedule management taking into account the offshore operations by working
vessels to facilitate smooth construction, in addition to the items specified in the preceding items.
3 Those who construct or improve facilities subject to the technical standards shall make use of measurement
records obtained from construction management for maintenance program so as to facilitate the proper
maintenance of the facilities concerned.
2.5 Substance Set as Construction Safety Management
Public Notice for Construction
Construction Safety Management
Article 5
Those who construct or improve facilities subject to the technical standards shall study the subjects listed in
the following items in compliance with the relevant laws and regulations concerning safety of port facility
construction work, properly perform safety management, and make efforts to prevent accidents and disasters
when constructing the facilities concerned:
(1) Measures to ensure safety under the construction conditions and construction methods of the facilities
concerned
(2) Measures to ensure safety against abnormal phenomena
(3) Measures other than those listed in the preceding two items to prevent accidents and disasters
2.6 Structural Stability during Construction
Public Notice for Construction
Structural Stability during Construction
Article 7
Those who construct or improve facilities subject to the technical standards shall perform temporary works
as necessary to prevent the structures of the facilities concerned from losing structural stability during
construction.
References
I)
Japan Port Association: Standard Specifications for Port Construction Work, Japan Port Association, 2004
2)
Working Vessels Association: Catalogue of Working Vessels in Japan, Working Vessels Association, 1991
3)
Japan Port Association: Standard Specifications for Port Design, Survey and Study, Japan Port Association, 2004
-41-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Ministerial Ordinance
Maintenance of Facilities Subject to the Technical Standards
Article 4
1 The facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall be properly maintained according to their maintenance
programs to satisfy their performance requirements through their working life.
2 The maintenance of the facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall be carried out while considering
environmental conditions, usage conditions, and other conditions to which the facilities concerned are
subjected.
3 For the maintenance of facilities subject to the Technical Standards, necessary maintenance work and
other activities shall be executed appropriately upon a comprehensive evaluation based on the results
of inspection and diagnosis of the damage, degradation, and other changes in the state of the facilities
concerned in its entirety.
4 For maintenance of facilities subject to the Technical Standards, appropriate safety countermeasures
shall be undertaken which include those such as establishing well-defined operational manuals and other
methods of hazard prevention to ensure the safe usage of the facilities concerned and other facilities
surrounding them.
5 Requirements other than those specified in the preceding paragraphs for the maintenance of facilities
subject to the Technical Standards shall be provided by the Public Notice.
[Commentary]
CD Since facilities subject to the Technical Standards are generally placed under severe natural conditions,
material deterioration, damage of members, scouring, settlement, sedimentation, etc. of the foundation
mounds, etc. often cause performance degradation during the design working life of the facilities.
Planned and proper maintenance is hence needed to prevent the facilities concerned from failing
to satisfy their performance requirements during their design working life. Effective and accurate
maintenance plans shall be established.
Facilities subject to the Technical Standards need to be properly maintained based on appropriate
maintenance plans and criteria taking into account structural types, structural characteristics of
members, and types and qualities of materials, as well as the natural conditions surrounding the
facilities concerned, their usage status, future plans, design working life, importance, substitutions,
and difficulty levels in inspection, diagnosis, and maintenance work.
@ The maintenance of facilities subject to the Technical Standards means a series of procedures to
accurately grasp changes in the facilities such as degradation and damage through timely and
appropriate inspection and diagnoses, to comprehensively evaluate the results, and to take proper
measures such as necessary maintenance work.
Here "damage" refers to the unexpected changes in structures or members caused by excessive effects
of accidental actions such as earthquakes and typhoons, and "deterioration" means the slow change
in the qualities and characteristics of materials caused by environmental effects over a period of time.
The damage and degradation, including the displacements and deformations occurring in structures
and members, are collectively called the changes of structures and members.
The maintenance of facilities subject to the Technical Standards requires the planned and proper
inspection and diagnosis, comprehensive evaluation, and maintenance work ofthe facilities concerned.
The basic concepts of the maintenance of the facilities concerned and the methods, details, timing,
frequencies, and procedures of their inspection and diagnosis shall be specified in advance as
maintenance planning documents.
Maintenance work required as a result of a comprehensive evaluation includes not only hardware side
measures, such as maintenance work, repair work, and strengthening work to recover the performance
of structures and members and prevent performance degradation from occurring, but also software
side measures such as temporary actions to stop services, restrict services, limit loads, and secure
safety.
-42-
PA/ff I GENERAL, CHAl'TER 2 CONSTRUCTION, IMPROVEMENT, OR MAINTENANCE OF FACILITTES SUBJECT TO THE TECHNICAL STANDARDS
Since facilities subject to the Technical Standards include not only structures such as protective
facilities for harbor and mooring facilities but also mechanical equipment such as cargo handling
facilities and passenger boarding facilities, the maintenance of facilities subject to the Technical
Standards requires the proper use and operation of the facilities concerned sufficiently taking account
of their characteristics. The use of the facilities concerned requires specifying in advance actual
safety measures, responsibility, and operational rules, in order to widely ensure safety to the operators
and the general public not only in normal times but also in rough weather, and to prevent other port
facilities integrally functioning with the facilities concerned, such as the quaywalls where cargo
handling facilities are installed, from having operational difficulties.
[Technical Note]
3.1 General
(1) Maintenance should be continuously performed over the design working life specified by maintenance plans so
that the performance of the structures and members of facilities does not fall below the required level. Here the
working life may be considered as the design working life of the facilities concerned at the initial stages of their
construction or improvement.
(2) Performance degradation of the structures or members of facilities advance slowly such as the deterioration of
structural materials, ground settlement, sand washing out, etc. Facilities subject to the Technical Standards are
usually exposed to marine environments, where structural materials such as concrete and steel easily deteriorate
and the soft ground tends to cause ground settlement and sand washing out. Accidental actions such as earthquakes
and impacts may also cause sudden damage to the facilities.
(3) The maintenance of facilities subject to the Technical Standards is a series of procedures to grasp the degradation
of the structures or members due to the damage caused by their physical changes and aging deterioration through
timely and accurate inspection and diagnosis, then to comprehensively evaluate the results, and to take proper
measures such as necessary maintenance work. It needs to be performed based on appropriate plans and criteria.
Here the appropriate plans refer to the maintenance programs described in Section 3.2, and appropriate criteria
indicate Technical Manual for Maintenance and Rehabilitation of Port Facilities, 1) Standard Specifications
or Concrete Structures (Maintenance), 2) etc.
(4) Corrosion control measures for steel may apply the corrosion control levels shown in Part II, Chapter 11, 2.3
Corrosion Protection taking account of the performance requirements and design working life of the facilities
concerned.
(5) Corrosion protection measures for reinforcing bars in concrete may apply Part II, Chapter 11, 3.2 Concrete
Quality and Performance Characteristics and Part III, Chapter 1, 1.1 General, taking into account the
performance requirements and design working life ofthe facilities concerned. The most basic corrosion protection
measures are a reduction of water-cement ratio, an increase in concrete quality using admixtures, or an increase in
cover depth. If these measures are insufficient, other measures such as the use of epoxy-coated reinforcing bars,
the installation of surface protection, the application of cathodic protection, etc. should be considered. If such
measures are expected to be taken during the design working life, it is desirable to consider the use of structures
for which measures can be easily taken.
(6) Soil improvement, the most common measures against the soft ground, may be performed based on Part III,
Chapter 2, 4 Soil Improvement Methods.
(7) It is desirable to conduct scheduled maintenance dredging for waterway and take measures to remedy gradual
siltation.
(8) For designing of facilities subject to the Technical Standards, it is necessary to consider in advance planned and
proper maintenance inspections and diagnoses in the implementation of maintenance for in the future.
(9) Details necessary for maintenance of the facilities subject to the Technical Standards are specified by the Public
Notice to set forth the details necessary for maintenance ofthe facilities subject of the Technical Standards (Public
Notice of Ministry of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism No. 364 of2007), which is referred to as the
"Public Notice for Maintenance" hereinafter.
-43-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article2
1 The owners of the facilities subject to the Technical Standard shall normally prepare maintenance plans.
2 Maintenance plans shall normally specify the subjects listed in the following items:
(1) The basic concepts of design working life of the facilities concerned and the maintenance of the
facilities as a whole and their structural members
(2) Planned and proper inspection and diagnosis of the damage, degradation, and other changes in the state
of the facilities concerned
(3) Planned and proper maintenance work on the damage, degradation, and other changes in the state of
the facilities concerned
(4) Maintenance efforts other than those listed in the preceding three items required for maintaining the
facilities concerned in a good state
3 The formulation determination of maintenance plans shall take into account the conditions under which
the facilities concerned are placed based on Article 6 of the Ministerial Ordinance, such conditions as
design working life, structural characteristics, material characteristics, difficulty levels in inspection,
diagnosis, maintenance work, the degree of importance of the facilities concerned, and so on.
4 For formulating the maintenance plans, it is recommended to consult with experts who have technical
knowledge on maintenance such as damage to the facilities concerned, the inspections and diagnoses
of the damage, degradation and other changes in the state of the facilities concerned, the comprehensive
evaluations of the maintenance of the whole facilities, maintenance work, and other maintenance activities.
The above shall not apply, however, to the cases where the persons responsible for the maintenance
programs are the experts in these fields.
5 Maintenance plans shall normally be modified when required by the changes in the uses of the facilities
concerned or innovations in maintenance technologies.
6 The provisions of the third and fourth items shall apply to the modification of maintenance programs.
[Commentary]
(1) The owners of facilities subject to the Technical Standards must prepare maintenance programs at
the initial time of maintenance and properly maintain the facilities concerned based on the programs.
Maintenance programs shall normally specify planned and appropriately applied maintenance items in
line with the procedure ofmaintenance and provide them in the form ofmaintenance program documents.
(2) The determination of maintenance programs shall properly specify the maintenance levels shown in
Table 3.2.1 as the basic concepts of the maintenance, taking account of the objectives of installing the
facilities concerned, their design working life, performance requirements, design concepts, substitutions,
etc.
Table 3.2.1 Maintenance Levels of Facilities Subject to the Technical Standards
Classification
Maintenance level I
Maintenance level II
-44-
PA/ff I GENERAL, CHAl'TER 2 CONSTRUCTION, IMPROVEMENT, OR MAINTENANCE OF FACILITTES SUBJECT TO THE TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(3) Maintenance plans shall specify the methods, details, and implementation timing for inspection and
diagnosis, comprehensive evaluations, and maintenance and intervention according to the maintenance
levels of the facilities concerned. In formulating the plans, it is necessary to consider the conditions
under which the facilities concerned are placed, design working life, structural characteristics, material
characteristics, difficulty levels in inspections, diagnoses and maintenance works, and the importance
of the facilities concerned. The future performance changes with time of the structural members of the
facilities concerned shall also be considered.
3.2.1 Maintenance Programs
(!) The owners of the facilities concerned shall normally prepare the maintenance programs of the facilities. The
development of the programs need a consistent philosophy throughout the planning, design, construction, and
maintenance of the facilities concerned, and it is hence most reasonable for the owners of the facilities concerned
who are the most familiar with these processes to develop the programs.
(2) Maintenance plans shall aim to deliberately and properly maintain the facilities concerned. Maintenance program
shall be normally used to specify the maintenance program documents. Other methods may also be used if it is
substantially cover the items specified in the maintenance program documents to properly maintain the facilities
concerned.
(3) The development of maintenance programs shall materialize the basic concepts of maintenance to the actual
work levels of the facilities concerned upon sufficiently studying what their maintenance should be and possible
scenarios based on the installation objectives, design working life, and performance requirements.
(4) Facilities subject to the technical standards shall maintain the performance requirements corresponding to the
maintenance levels shown in Table 3.2.1 at any time during their design working life. For that purpose, the
initial design must satisfy designated maintenance levels and properly take account of smooth implementation of
inspections, diagnoses, and maintenance works corresponding to the designated maintenance levels.
(5) The setting of maintenance levels shall be conducted estimating the performance changes with time ofthe facilities
concerned from the conditions surrounding the facilities such as natural environmental conditions and usage
statuses, the structural types of the facilities and the characteristics of their structural members, and the types
and quality of the materials used for the facilities, based on the installation objectives, design working life, and
performance requirements of the facilities. Maintenance levels are normally set for whole facilities, but in most
actual cases, estimating the performance changes with time ofthe whole facilities concerned is difficult and setting
the same maintenance levels for all members and ancillary equipment is unreasonable. Proper maintenance levels
shall be hence set for each structural member of the facilities concerned, taking account of the study results of the
performance changes with time of the structural members of the facilities and the difficulty levels in inspections
and maintenance works, the importance of the facilities, and drawing up a maintenance scenario for the facilities
as a whole.
(6) Maintenance programs shall specify inspection and diagnosis plans and the methods, details, timing, frequencies,
procedures, etc. of maintenance works, corresponding to the maintenance levels of the facilities concerned and
following the basic stages of maintenance. Fig 3.2.1 shows the standard structure of maintenance program
documents and the items to be specified.
(7) The preparation of maintenance program documents may apply Guide for the Preparation of Maintenance
Program Documents for Port Facilities 3) and Basic Concepts for the Preparation of Maintenance Program
Documents for Port Facilities.4)
-45-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
I
I
------------------------ '
Emergency response
at abnormal times
Normal times
!
General periodic
inspections and
diagnoses
''
Detailed periodic
inspections and
diagnoses
Abnormal
.
.
Abnormal
I
I
Nothing
abnormal
al al.
"+:I ii
:.=
.....
~ "'
u ...
~
OQ...
"'
al
Nothing
abnormal
,,
Nothing
abnormal
''
-- ,.
"'C
"'~~i
!e._g"' ..s Ja
,,,
''
The modification of
inspection and diagnosis
plans is needed
'
~i<s]
'
8.~
~;~~
~
~
r .
~'5 &~
~ {~
900 ...~~
.
No measures
are needed
u
~ 0
.-;: u 0 ,.g
=~i~s
i~ 8.g
....... ~
~ bO ~
..... ~ .B 0
~~:s
u~sO'
I
I~
J~
,.
bO
0
0
"'~!;! ~.B
~'5 "Cl
i:=ca"';
~
u0 c:.am.!
....
:= u
Detailed temporary
inspections and
diagnoses
al
al
;act@~
..s e~-==
..c ... ~
"Oi"CI
\..
I
I
iif
D+:1
~~8"'
~
,~
!Abnormal
1.1~
5~
o.5 ~
s.5
0"'
........
'\
General temporary
inspections and
diagnoses
!Abnormal
I
I
'i ii
j;.a
Nothing
, abnormal
al ...~
Q~
al al
,. --------------------------------
Daily
inspections
,....___ .i"'
I
I
I
I
-----------------.-----------------
Review of maintenance programs
r---
Fig. 3.2.1 Standard Structure of Maintenance Program Documents and the Items to be Specified
-46-
PA/ff I GENERAL, CHAl'TER 2 CONSTRUCTION, IMPROVEMENT, OR MAINTENANCE OF FACILITTES SUBJECT TO THE TECHNICAL STANDARDS
CD
Since the changes in the state of structural members of facilities subject to the technical standards are strongly
correlated with each other, inspection and diagnosis plans must select items, methods, and procedures for
efficient and effuctive inspections with full understanding of the link of changes in state described in Item (ii).
@ Facilities subject to the techoical standards have relatively complex structures and their structural members are
correlated with each other. Various external factors act on the structures. The occurrence and development
of changes are hence complicated. It is desirable for reasonable maintenance to select inspectable damage,
degradation that have significant effucts on component performance as major changes in state, and inspect and
diagnose them. The selection of major changes in state shall fully take account of the linked changes, which
are the progressive processes of the causes, occurrence, and effects of changes resulting in the performance
deterioration of the facilities. Focusing on and making inspection and diagnosis of the most important
linked changes are useful for reasonable maintenance. Refer to Technical Manual for Maintenance of Port
Facilities 1) for the linked changes offacilities subject to the technical standards.
@ The implementation of planned and proper inspections and diagnoses based on the above-mentioned concept
of the linked changes is essential to effectively detect the deterioration which has occurred in facilities subject
to the techoical standards. The following constitute the inspections and diagnoses of facilities subject to the
techoical standards:
(a) Initial inspections: They are performed to grasp the initial maintenance state of not only the whole facilities
concerned but also their members and ancillary equipment at the completion stages of construction or
improvement work, or at the preparation stages of maintenance programs for existing facilities. When they
are performed immediately after the completion of construction or improvement work, initial state may be
grasped based on the results of quality inspections and workmanship inspections performed at the time of
completion.
(b) Daily inspections: They are performed to check routinely inspectable parts for changes in state and their
degrees.
(c) Periodic inspections and diagnoses: They are performed to periodically check routinely uninspectable
structures and members including the details of changes in state and their degrees. They are classified into
general periodic inspections and diagnoses and detailed periodic inspections and diagnoses. The former
are conducted on the parts above the sea level mainly by visual inspections or simplified measurement at
relatively short intervals. The latter are conducted at relatively long intervals and their objects include the
parts on which the former are unpractical.
(d) General temporary inspections and diagnoses: They are performed to check the facilities for changes and their
degrees mainly by visual inspections or simplified measurement at the earliest possible stage at abnormal
times after the occurrence of earthquakes and rough weather.
(e) Detailed temporary inspections and diagnoses: They are performed when particular or unexpected
abnormalities are found from the results of periodic or general temporary inspections and diagnoses.
-47-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 4
1 The owners of facilities subject to the technical standards shall normally take measures specified in the
following items as the measures to clarify the operational methods provided in the fourth item of Article
4 of the Ministerial Ordinance and other safety measures, taking account of natural conditions, usage
statuses, and other conditions under which the facilities concerned are placed:
(1) Designation of persons responsible for inspecting or examining and implementing the measures
concerned before and after the operation of the facilities concerned
(2) Designation of persons responsible for necessary measures to safely maintain the facilities concerned
and responsible for implementing the measures concerned in rough weather
(3) Development of the operational rules required for safely maintaining the facilities concerned or the
confirmation of the operational rules prepared by the facility management bodies, in addition to those
specified in the preceding two items.
2 The measures provided in the preceding items shall be normally taken by those who have professional
knowledge and skills for ensuring of safety of facilities subject to the technical standards and their
surrounding facilities which are used integrally with mutual operational relations.
3.4 Measures Dealing with Out-of-Service Facilities
Public Notice for Maintenance
Out-of-Service Facilities Subject to the Technical Standards
Article 6
Proper actions shall be taken as necessary on out-of-service facilities subject to the technical standards such
as their removal, proper maintenance, ensuring the safety of their neighboring areas to prevent the facilities
concerned from obstructing the development, use, and maintenance of the ports.
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
Port and Airport Research Institute (Edition): Maintenance Manual for port facilities, Coastal Development Institute of
Technology. 2007
JSCE Guidelines for concrete, Standard Specifications for Concrete Structures-2001 "Maintenance", JSCE, Mar. 2005.
Port and Harbour Bureau, Ministry of Land, Infrastructure and Transport (Edition): Goideline for the Preparation of the
Maintenance Plan of Port Facilities, Coastal Development Institute of Technology. 2007
Takahashi, N., M. Iwanami and H. Yokota: Fundamental concept on Maintenance Plan of Port Facilities, Technical Report of
National Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management, No.376, 2007
-48-
PA/ff I GENERAL, CHAl'TER 2 CONSTRUCTION, IMPROVEMENT, OR MAINTENANCE OF FACILITTES SUBJECT TO THE TECHNICAL STANDARDS
4 Environmental Consideration
Ministerial Ordinance
Environmental Consideration
Article 5
1 The design, construction, and maintenance of facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall endeavor
to preserve the natural environments around a port, to form good landscapes, and to ensure the security of
the port area by considering the environmental conditions, usage conditions, and other conditions to which
the facilities concerned are subjected.
2 Installation of facilities to be utilized by an unspecified large number of people and subject to the Technical
Standards shall consider the safe and smooth usage of the facilities by seniors, handicapped persons, and
others whose daily or social lives are restricted due to physical disabilities while considering environmental
conditions, usage conditions, and other conditions to which the facilities concerned are subjected.
[Technical Nole]
4.1 General
(1) Environmental Consideration
It is desirable for the construction, improvement, and maintenance of facilities subject to the technical
standards to consider the natural environment and the good port landscapes of the regions, taking
account of the constructability, economy of the facilities concerned, when determining their layouts,
scales, and specifications, and selecting their structural types, materials used, and construction methods.
(2) Considerations for Natural Environment
In the construction, improvement, and maintenance of facilities subject to the technical standards, it is
necessary to preserve the natural environments of the ports, paying attention to creating a better natural
environment, as well as to eliminate bad effects on the natural environments. For the creation of the
better natural environments such as beaches, in particular, a comprehensive planning method, which is
one of integrated approaches through the planning, design, construction and maintenance of the facilities
concerned, and one of adaptive management methods taking account of the variability and uncertainty
of the natural environment can be applied. Here the environmental qualities of ports mean water
quality, bottom sediment quality, and air quality. It is desirable for the construction, improvement, and
maintenance of facilities subject to the technical standards to take account of the effects of the facilities
concerned on the habitation of life around of the facilities in terms of changes in the environmental
quality.
(3) Primary Factors Controlling the Natural Environment
The actions of tides and waves are the primary factors controlling material advection and diffusion
and the habitats for marine organisms related to the natural environment of ports. The construction,
improvement, and maintenance of facilities subject to the technical standards need to properly take into
consideration that the changes in these actions accompanying the construction of the facilities concerned
and related activities spread widely in time and space.
(4) Environmental Quality
CD As for water quality, it is desirable to focus not only on the level of water pollutants such as CODs,
nutrient salts, floating suspended substances, etc., but also on the phenomena such as the upwelling of
low oxygen water mass, blue tides etc., and the occurrence of red tides resulting from water pollution,
and study water quality from the viewpoint of sound material circulation.
As for bottom sediment quality, it is necessary to focus on particle size distributions and the contents
of organic matter, trace chemical substances, heavy metals, etc., and pay attention to the spread of the
influence, of their interactions with water quality, avoiding secondary pollution such as the accelerated
formation of low oxygen bottom water due to their decomposition, the accelerated elution of nutrient
salts in low oxygen environments.
It should also be noted that the bottom sediment stirred up by navigating ships tends to cause the
emission of offensive odors and the degradation of water quality and that fine particles tend to deposit
in calm areas and absorb toxic substances such as heavy metals.
-49-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
As for air quality, it is necessary to focus on the heat, gases such as NOx, SOx, C02 , , and fine particles
emitted into the air by ships, vehicles, port cargo handling equipment, and activities of firms located
in port areas, etc. They are mostly caused by port activities, although it is also necessary to carefully
select working vessels and machines for constructing and maintaining the facilities concerned.
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
Working Group for marine natural reclamation: Handbook of Marine Natural reclamation, Gyosei, 2003
Study Group for the formation ofnatural symbiotic type coast: Process to form marine natural Procedure, National Association
of Sea Coast, 2003
Kameyama, A., N. Kuramoto and Y. Hioki: Natural reclamation, Soft Science Co., 2005
Port and Harbour Bureau, Ministry of Land, Infrastructure and Transport: "Greenization " of Port Administration
(Environment friendly Administration of Ports and Harbours, Independent Administrative Institution National Printing
Bureau, 2005.
Nakamura, Y, Y. Tamura, T. Higuchi, and 0. Shinohara: Theory of Landscaping, Shokoku Publishing, 1977
Shinohara, 0: Landscape planning in Civil Engineering, Civil Engineering New Series No. 59, Gilio-Do Publications, 1982,
326p.
JSCE: Landscape design of Port, Gilio-Do Publications, Dec. 1991, 286p.
JSCE, Civil Engineering Handbook, Gilio-do Publications, 1989, 4133p.
-50-
PA/ff I GENERAL, CHAl'TER 2 CONSTRUCTION, IMPROVEMENT, OR MAINTENANCE OF FACILITTES SUBJECT TO THE TECHNICAL STANDARDS
9)
Shinohara, 0: Landscaping Dictionary, Shokoku Publishing Co., 1998
10) Port Planoing Laboratory, Port aod Harbour Research Institute, Ministry of Transport: For the Realization of Beautiful Port
landscape. 1993
11) Port and Harbour Bureau, Ministry of Laocl, Infrastructure aod Transport: Guideline for Complete lospection of Port
Landscape, 2005.
-51-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-52-
Chapter 1 General
Ministerial Ordinance
Requirements for the Setting of Environmental and Other Conditions
Article 6
In designing, constructing, and maintaining the facilities subject to the Technical Standards, required items
for the setting of the environmental conditions, usage conditions, and other conditions for the facilities
concerned shall be provided by the Public Notice..
Public Notice
Setting of Environmental and Other Conditions
Article 5
The items specified in Article 6 of the Ministerial Ordinance for the setting of the conditions surrounding
the facilities concerned shall be provided in the subsequent article through Article 20..
[Technical Note]
1 General
(1) The performance verification of port facilities need to properly set actions and material strength requirements
as design conditions according to the performance required for the facilities concerned and the situations under
which the facilities are placed.
Conditions such as natural conditions include winds, tides, waves, tsunamis, movement of sea water, estuary
hydraulics, littoral drift, ground conditions, earth and water pressures, ground settlement, ground motions, ground
liquefaction, principal dimensions of design ships, environmental actions, self weights, and surcharges.
(2) The setting of design conditions has significant effects on the performance, economic efficiency, etc. of the
facilities, and hence it should be carried out carefully. Design conditions generally need to be properly set based
on the results of sufficient preliminary surveys and tests. It is necessary to understand the methods and results of
the surveys and tests.
E1 =1-(1-1/T,)4
where
E1 : encounter probability
L 1 : design working life (year)
Tj : return period (year)
(2.1)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
needs to take all of them into account. The initial investment costs include indirect costs such as compensation
costs.
-56-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
CD
Atmospheric pressure and its distribution are factors that generate winds.
@ Winds generate waves and storm surge, and affect the wind pressure that acts upon port facilities and moored
vessels, and become a factor to interfere with cargo handling and other port operations. See 2 Winds for details.
@ The tidal level affects soil pressure and water pressure, which act on port facilities, and becomes a factor to
interfure with cargo handling and other port operations. Also, it has an effect on waves in areas of shallow water.
See 3 Tidal level for details.
@ Waves exert wave force on port facilities, and become a factor to interfure with the functioning of port facilities.
They also act on moored vessels, causing them to move and interfere with cargo handling and other port operations.
They also can raise the mean water level, which has effucts similar to the tidal level as mentioned above. See 4
Waves for details.
@ Tsunami exerts wave force and fluid force on port facilities, and becomes a factor to interfere with the functioning
of port facilities. It also acts on moored ships, causing them to move. See 5 Tsunamis for details.
@ Water currents affuct sediments on the sea bottom and become a factor to interfere with the functioning of port
facilities. See 6 Water Currents etc. for details.
-57-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2 Winds
Public Notice
Winds
Article 6
Characteristics of winds shall be set by the methods provided in the subsequent items corresponding to the
single action or combination of two or more actions to be considered in the performance criteria and the
performance verification:
(1) Ocean surface winds to be used in the estimation of waves and storm surge shall be appropriately
defined in terms of wind velocity, wind direction and others based on the long-term wind observation
or weather hindcasting.
(2) Winds to be used in the calculation of wind pressures shall be appropriately defined in terms of the
wind velocity and direction corresponding to the return period through the statistical analysis of the
long-term data of observed or hindcasted winds or other methods.
(3) Winds to be used in the calculation of wind energy shall be appropriately defined in terms of the joint
frequency distribution of wind velocity and direction for a certain duration of time, based on the longterm data of observed or hindcasted winds.
[Commentary]
I) Winds to be used in the Estimation of Waves and Storm Surge:
Winds to be used in the estimation of waves and storm surge shall be observed or hindcasted values for
30 years or more as a standard.
2) Winds to be used in the Calculation of Wind Pressure:
Winds to be used in the calculation of wind pressure shall be observed or hindcasted values for 30 years
or more as a standard.
[Technical Nole]
2.1 General
(!) Wind is one of the most distinctive meteorological phenomena, namely, the phenomenon that the air moves due
to atmospheric pressure differences and heat. The conditions under which winds blow over the ocean are usually
very different than for those over land. Wind velocities over the ocean are much higher than those over land near
the shore.!> For performance verification of port facilities, the effects of winds must be appropriately evaluated.
CD
The velocity of the gradient wind can be expressed as a function of pressure gradient, radius of curvature of
barometic isolines, latitude, and air density as in equation (2.1.1).
V:=rmsin[-1+
1+ p
t:
~.
r(i}
sm 2 (J :
(2.1.1)
where
V,, : velocity of gradient wind (mis); in the case of an anticyclone, equation (2.1.1) gives a negative
value and so the absolute value should be taken.
iJplfJr : pressure gradient (taken to be positive for a cyclone, negative for an anticyclone) (kgim2/s2)
r : radius of curvature ofbarometic isolines (m)
co : angular velocity of Earth's rotation (1/s) co =7.27xJ0-5/s
: latitude (0 )
Pa : density ofair (kg/m3)
Before performing the calculation, measurement units should first be converted into the MKS units listed
above. Note that 1 oflatitude corresponds to a distance of approximately 1.11 x JOS m, and an air pressure of
1.0 hPa is 100kg/mfs2.
-58-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
@ A gradient wind for which the barometic isolines are straight lines (i.e., their radius of curvature in equation
(2.1.1) is infinite) is called the geostrophic wind. In this case, the wind velocity is as equation (2.1.2).
(2.1.2)
2p.msin
@ The actual sea surface wind velocity is generally lower than the value obtained from the gradient wind equation.
Moreover, although the direction of a gradient wind is parallel to the barometic isolines in theory, the sea
surface wind blows at a certain angle a to the barometic isolines in reality as illustrated in Fig. 2.1.2. In the
northern hemisphere, the winds around a cyclone blow in a counterclockwise direction and inwards, whereas
the winds around an anticyclone blow in a clockwise direction and outwards. It is known that the relationship
between the velocity of gradient winds and that of the actual sea surface wind varies with the latitude. This
(~)
(b) Anticyclone
(a) Cyclone
Fig. 2.1.2 Wind Direction for a Cyclone (Low) and an Anticyclone (High)
Table 2.1.1 Relationship between Sea Surface Wind Speed and Gradient Wind Speed
Latitude (0 )
10
20
30
40
50
Angle a (
24
20
18
17
15
0.51
0.60
0.64
0.67
0.70
in the chosen equation are determined based on actual air pressure measurements in the region of typhoons.
Fujita's formula
p=p.
(2.1.3)
Myers' formula
p= p,
+exp(-~)
(2.1.4)
where
p
-59-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Forecasts (ECMWF), and America's National Center for Environmental Protection (NCEP), calculate the values
of items such as air pressure, wind velocity, wind direction, and water vapor flux, based on calculation models
for meteorological values that use a three-dimensional calculation grid, and the values at the grid points (GPV:
grid point values) are saved. These GPV's may be used instead of wind hindcastings based on equation (2.1.1)
through equation (2.1.4). However, when a grid with large spacing is used for meteorological calculations the
atmospheric pressure and winds may not be satisfactorily reproduced at places where meteorological conditions
change drastically with position, such as near the centers of typhoons. Therefore, when GPV's are used, it is
preferable to use observational values to verify the precision.
(5) Wind Energy
If winds are considered as the movement of the air then the wind energy that crosses a unit cross-sectional area in
unit time is given by equation (2.1.5).Il
Winds for estimating the wind energy shall be appropriately specified with joint statistic distributions for
velocity and direction for a fixed time (usually, one year), based on long-term (usually, three years or more)
observed or hindcasted data.
(2.1.5)
= 2.P V'
where
p,
In other words, the wind force energy is proportional to the cube of the wind velocity, so a small difference in
wind velocity can mean a big difference in energy (power generation). Therefore, during performance verification
of facilities that use wind force energy, it is important to accurately understand how the conditions change with
regard to time and space.
In the coastal zone the wind conditions varies drastically between land and sea. Also, wind velocity shows
great variation on land due to altitude, but over the sea the changes in wind velocity with altitude are gradual, so
it is possible to obtain highly stabilized winds that are appropriate for power generation at relatively low altitudes.
For example, the results of measurements in the vicinity of the Kansai International Airport, show that the wind
energy over the course of a year at a measurement tower (MT station) placed at a height of 15 meters over the
ocean were roughly the same as at a land station (C station) with an altitude of 100 meters, and about five times
greater than at a land station with an altitude of 10 meters.SJ
(2) The wind velocities obtained at the meteorological stations are the values at about 10 meters above the ground.
Therefore, when using the measured values to estimate the winds over the ocean, if the height of the target facility
is very different from the height mentioned above, then correction of the height shall be performed for the wind
velocity. The vertical distribution of wind velocity is usually shown on a logarithmic scale, however for simplicity
an exponential scale is often used during performance verification of various types of facilities.
Uh
Uo (hlho)"
(2.2.1)
where
-60-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
(3) The exponent n in equation (2.2.1) varies with the roughness of the nearby terrain and the stability of the air,
but in general it is possible to use a value of n = 1/10 to 1/4 for performance verification when specifying the
wind velocity for purposes such as calculating wind pressure, and a value of n :>'. 1/7 is often used over the ocean.
Statistical data for wind velocity is usually the mean wind velocity over 10 minutes, however depending on the
facility the mean wind velocity over a shorter time period may be required, or the maximum instantaneous wind
velocity may be required, and in such cases one should understand the characteristics of the region such as the
relationship between the main wind velocity and the maximum wind velocity, and the gust factor (defined as
the ratio between the maximum instantaneous wind speed and the IO-minute mean wind velocity) should be
estimated.
(2) Wind pressure that acts on sheds, warehouses, and cargo handling equipment shall be specified as follows.
(a) Structural standard for mobile crane
In Article 9, Structural Standard For Mobile Crane, it is specified that the wind load shall be calculated as
follows:
CD
W=qCA
(2.3.1)
where
W
q
C
A
@ The value of the velocity pressure in equation (2.3.1) can be calculated from either equation (2.3.2) or equation
2.3.3 depending on the condition of the crane:
Crane in operation:
q=83w;
(2.3.2)
Crane stopped:
q=9sow;
(2.3.3)
where
h : height (m) above ground of the surface of the crane that receives the winds
use h : 16 m if the height is less than 16 m.
@ For the value of the wind pressure coefficient it is possible to use the value found in wind tunnel tests of the
crane, or the value given in Table 2.3.1 forthe category of the surface of the crane that receives the winds. A
"surface composed offtat surfaces" in Table 2.3.1 means the surface of a structure with a box-like shape such
as a box girder, operator's cab, machine chamber, or electrical chamber. A "cylindrical surface" includes the
surface of a wire rope. The "face area" means the area of the shaded portion in Fig. 2.3.1.
-61-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 2.3.1 Wind Pressure Coefficients for the Wind Load on a Crane
w, < 0.1
0.1 < w, < 0.3
0.3 ~ w, < 0.9
0.9 < w,
w, < 5
5 ~ w, < 10
10 < w, < 15
15 < w, < 25
25 ~ W2 < 50
50 < w, < 100
100 < w,
w, < 3
Value
2.0
1.8
1.6
2.0
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.6
1.7
1.8
1.9
1.2
0.7
Projected Area
Area Occupying Ratio
w,
-lh
@ The pressure-receiving area in equation (2.3.1) shall be the area of the surface of the crane that receives the
winds projected onto a surface perpendicular to the direction of the winds (hereafter in this section referred
to as "projected area"). When there are two or more surfaces of the crane that receive the winds, the area
subject to wind pressure calculation is determined by summing up the following;
1) the projected area of the first surface in the direction of the winds
2) the areas obtained by multiplying the portions of the surface areas of the second and later surfaces in
the direction of the winds (hereafter in this paragraph "second and later surfaces") that overlap the first
surface in the direction of the winds by the reduction factors shown in Fig. 2.3.2
3) the projected areas of the portions of the surface areas of the second and later surfaces that don't overlap
the first surface in the direction of the winds.
In Fig. 2.3.2, b, h, ;, and 'I represent the following values, respectively:
b: distance between the beams of the crane that receive the winds (see Fig. 2.3.3)
h: height of the first beam in the direction of the winds, among the beams that receive the winds (see
Fig. 2.3.3)
;: the area occupying ratio of the first beam in the direction of the winds among the beams for the
surfaces of the crane that receive the winds (for surfaces that are formed of horizontal trusses ; is the
value W1 specified in the note of the table of the previous section, and for surfaces formed of fiat
surfaces or cylindrical surfaces it is 1)
'I' reduction factor
-62-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
b/h=(,
T/
0
0
0.2
0.6
0.4
0.8
;
Fig. 2.3.2 Reduction Factors for Projected Areas
1-b--IJ [}-bill
(a) Beams of Steel Structure
Q) The value of the wind load can be calculated from equation (2.3.1).
@ The velocity pressure can be calculated from equation (2.3.2).
@ For the value of the wind pressure coefficient it is possible to use the value found in wind tunnel tests of the
mobile crane that receives the winds, or the value given in Table 2.3.1 of Section a), Structural Standard
For Mobile Crane". For the value of velocity pressure in W3 calculation, the value from equation (2.3.3)
shall be used.
The pressure-receiving area can be calculated by the method of 4) in Section a) Structural Standard For
Mobile Crane.
Q) The value of the wind pressure force can be calculated from equation (2.3.4). In this case the wind velocity
is taken to be 50 mis at the time of storms, and 16 mis at all other times.
W=qCA
(2.3.4)
where
W
q
C
A
u2
q=-!.fh
30
(2.3.5)
-63-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where
@ For the value of the wind pressure coefficient it is possible to use the value found in wind tunnel tests or the
value given in Table 2.3.2 for the kind of the surface and the completeness ratio of the surface that receives
the winds.
Table 2.3.2 Wind Pressure Coefficients for the Wind Pressure Force of a Derrick
Completeness
ratio
Wmd pressure
coefficient
W1 <0.1
1.8
1.6
0.9'."'Wi
---
1.2
---
1.2
Note: The value of the area occupying ratio is the value obtained by dividing the projected area of the surface
of the crane that receives the winds by the area of the surface that receives that same winds.
@ The pressure-receiving area is the area that receives the wind projected onto a surface perpendicular to the
direction of the winds. When there are two or more surfaces that overlap in the direction of the winds, it shall
be calculated as follows;
The area subject to wind pressure calculation is determined by summing up the following;
1) In case there are two overlapping surfaces that receive the winds
i) the projected area of the first surface in the direction of the winds
ii) 60% of the areas of the portions of the second surface in the direction of the winds that overlap the first
surface
iii) the projected areas of the portions of the second surface in the direction of the winds that don't overlap
the first surface.
2) In case there are three or more surfaces that receive the winds
i) 50% of the projected areas of the portions of the third and later surfaces in the direction of the winds
that overlap the first surface
ii) the projected areas of the portions of the third and later surfaces in the direction of the winds that don't
overlap the first surface.
The wind pressure that acts upon structures such as highway bridges and elevated highways can be specified
according to the Highway Bridge Specifications and Commentary.JO) In the Highway Bridge Specifications
and Commentary, the wind pressure force that acts upon a bridge is specified by appropriately considering
the location, topography, and ground conditions of the bridge construction, the structural characteristics of
the bridge, and its cross-sectional shape.
a) Steel beams
The wind pressure force that acts on a steel beam is the value given in Table 2.3.3, which is the value per one
meter oflength in the bridge axial direction for one span.
Table 2.3.3 Wind Pressure Force for Steel Beams {Units: kN/m)
Cross-sectional shape
where
1 '."'BID<S
4.0-0.2BD D
8 '."'.BID
2.4D
B
D
=
=
6.0
6.0
-64-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Bridge
uard fence
Other than a
Measurement of D
Table 2.3.5 Wind Pressure Force on a Dual Main Truss (Unit: kN/m2)
Truss
Bridge foundation
1.25 ;ff
2.51#
1.5
3.0
0.1 ~ ; ~ 0.6
where ; = area occupying ratio of the truss (the ratio of the truss projected area to the truss enveloped area)
Table 2.3.6 Wind Pressure Force on a Standard Dual Main Truss (Units: kN/m)
Arch material
Loaded arch
1.25.../Ih ~ 3.0
2.5.../Ih ;::: 3.0
7~l/h~40
where D : total height of the bridge floor (m) (not including the height of the portion that
overlaps the arch portion as seen from the horizontal direction perpendicular to the
bridge axis) (see Fig. 2.3.5)
h : height of the arch portion (m)
). : main truss height (m) from the center of the lower arch portion to the center of the upper arch portion
-65-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
D,
--- ----Vertical
Floor
beam
beam
--~--~
Arch
portion
Floor
D~D,-h
beam
Arch
Verti"cal portion
beam
Circular shape
Polygonal shape
Members on the
windward side
0.75
1.5
1.5
3.0
side
0.75
1.5
0.75
1.5
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
Nagai, T., K. Sugahara. K. Sato and K. Kawaguchi: Characteristic of Japanese Coastal Wind Power based on Long Term
Observation, Technical Note of PHRI, No.999, p.59, 2001
Nagai, T: Observed Offshore Wind Characteristics from a View of Energy Utilization, Technical Note ofPHRI, No.1034,
p.34, 2002
Takahashi, K: Study on quantitative weather furecasting based nn extrapolation (Part 1), Study Bulletin No. 13, 1947
JSCE: The Collected Formula of Hydraulics (1985 Edition), JSCE, Nov. 1985
-66-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Nagai, T., H. Ogawa, A, Nakamura, K. Suzuki and T. Nukada: Characteristics of occurrence of offshore wind eoergy based
on observation data, JSCE Proceedings of Coastal Eng,. ,pp.1306-1310, 2003
6) Nagai, T, I. Ushiyama, Y. Nemoto, K. Kawanishi, T. Nukada, K. Suzuki aod T. Otozu: Examination offield applicatinn of
lighting system utilizing coastal wind force, Journal of the Japao Society for Marine Survey and Technology Vol. 17 No. 1,
JSMST,2005
7) Japao Meteorological Agency, Catalogue of annual maximum wind speed (1928-1966)at various places in Japao aod the
probability of occurrence, Meteorological Agency observation Technical Note No. 34, 1971
8) JSCE, Civil Engineering Haodbook, Giho-do Publications, 1974, pp. 541-544
9) Industrial Health Division, Industrial Safety aod Health Dept., Labour Standards Bureau, Ministry of Health, Labour aod
Welfare: Commentary of structural standards of various types of cranes, Japan Crane Association, 2004
10) Japao Road Associatinn: Specificatinns and commentary of highway bridges, Part I General and Part II Steel Bridge, 2002
5)
-67-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
3 Tidal Level
Public Notice
Tidal Level
Article 7
The tide level shall be appropriately specified as the water level relative to a datum level for port and harbor
management through the statistical analysis of the observed or hindcasted data and/or others, by taking into
account the astronomical tides, meteorological tides, wave setup (rise of water level by waves near the shore),
and abnormal tidal levels due to tsunamis and others.
[Commentary]
(1) Tidal Level:
When specifying the tidal level for the performance verification offacilities subject to technical standards,
appropriately consider how the tidal level affects the action of waves and water pressure. Also, when
specifying the combination of tidal level and waves in the performance verification of facilities subject
to technical standards, among the tidal levels that have a high likelihood of occurring simultaneously
with waves, take as a standard the tidal level that would be most dangerous from the viewpoint of the
performance verification of such facilities.
(2) Astronomical Tides:
With regard to astronomical tides that are considered in the specification of the tidal level, take as a
standard the specification of chart datum level, mean sea level, mean monthly-highest water level, and
mean monthly-lowest water level, based on measured values for one year or more.
(3) Storm Surge:
When specifying storm surge, appropriately consider long-term measured values. As a standard, longterm means 30 years or more. When specifying storm surge, if long-term measured values cannot
be available, then appropriately consider items such as hindcasted values of storm surge based on
meteorological conditions and records in past disasters. In the storm surge hindcasting, wave-stepup
due to wave breaking near the shore shall be appropriately considered as necessary.
[Technical Note]
-68-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
(J) Near highest high water level (NHHWL)
The water level obtained by adding the sum of the amplitudes of the four principal tidal constituents (M2, S2,
Kl and 01) to the mean sea level.
a storm surge.
(2) Causes of Storm Surge
If the atmospheric pressure at the sea surface is lowered I hPa for a sufficiently long time so that the sea surface
is in equilibrium with the atmospheric pressure at the sea surface, for example, then the ocean surface rises by
about I cm higher than normal level. Or, if the winds blow at a constant wind velocity for a long time from the
entrance of an internal bay toward the throat of the bay so that the sea surface rises toward the throat of the bay and
reaches equilibrium then the amount of sea level rise at the furthest point inside the bay is roughly proportional to
the square of the wind velocity, and it is also larger when the bay is longer or shallower. During an actual typhoon
the atmospheric pressure, wind velocity, and wind direction on the sea surface changes in a complicated way at
different locations and times.
(3) Empirical Formula to Predict Storm Surge
The tide anomaly due to a typhoon can be roughly estimated from an empirical formula, such as equation (3.2.1).5)
q =a(p0 - p)+bW2 cos6l+c
(3.2.1)
-69-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where
-70-
In Jocetlma lllt.h u a IUc ~ pcrimclcr la cloleCI er a bl)! ~ cubaxe la IUll'1'CIW IO that tbcrc la llll1c
adionae or-...wld> Ilia- o.:em tlui i-na1-1w. ..- . . . otc:!llodon wld> .. """"'"" pcrlod due"'
'Vllrillim!a iD.
llUlb u '!Yindl. Thia phll!O!Dl!lloa UI C8lllxl ICid!e. On Ille ollur band, d!o mcJlmon d!llt
- h i a bl)! er bllbarwhml-part Iii cpen tod!e om.r- ao lbat-caago In and out Iii calledhathot
:rwm_.. Bilrbol':rw-iJ1bo maiD prubllllll filc'perlilmmgo wriliNlim ofpod IM>iliUl, 11111mi ._ llllllK
um
j.,,.
.,,1io,,..
SEP. 11 2001
c rn
1 2
Locatio : TOKYO
6
9 10 11 1
I I I I I I I I I I I I I
23:59:30 LastRecord
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 0
I
I I I I I I I I I I I
320~---------~--'l'-I---------~
/\;~
290
260
230
200
140
170
Obs.
Pred.
Obs-Prod
Pres.
110
80
,"
2~: ~c..---------------------~11~~~
10:1~
-100
TYE
::::
OP
Pres.
900
-200
900
Fig. 3.3.1 Tidll LIM!I ObuMllonll Reco!lllllQll Durtlg 'l'fphoDn 2DD11S {D9n91)
-71-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
Rectangular harbor of constant depth (surroundings are closed, no water enters or leaves, Fig. 3.3.2 (a)):
(3.3.1)
where
@ Rectangular harbor of constant depth (as in Fig. 3.3.2 (b), water can freely enters and leaves in one place, and
the harbor is narrow and long):
T=-4 __f_
2m+l
(3.3.2)
..Jih
The amplitude amplification ratio often takes its maximum when mis 0 or 1, so in practice it is acceptable
to just investigate this case. In reality, not only the sea water within the harbor but also the sea water in the
outer ocean near the harbor entrance also oscillates to some extent, therefore the value of the natural frequency
period becomes somewhat longer from that given by equation (3.3.2) and becomes the value given by equation
(3.3.3) 19):
(3.3.3)
where
trb)}"
(3.3.4)
2b ( 0.9228-In
a= { 1+,..
4
1
where
7r:
b : width of a harbor
Table 3.3.1 shows values of the harbor entrance modification coefficient a for representative values of bl/, as
calculated from equation (3.3.4).
Table 3.3.1 Harbor Entrance Modification Coefficients
I
1.320
bl/
1/2
1.261
114
1/3
1.217
1.187
115
1.163
1/10
1.106
1/25
1.064
@ Rectangular harbor of constant depth (as in Fig. 3.3.2 (c), water can freely enter and leave in one place, and the
harbor entrance is narrow):
2
T
(3.3.5)
where
b : width of a harbor (m)
/ : length of a harbor
n : number of nodes in the width direction of a harbor (n = 0, 1, 2, ...)
In actual cases, the natural frequency period has a somewhat smaller value than that calculated from equation
(3.3.5) due to the effect of the harbor entrance.
-72-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
~1
f---b
(a)
(b)
(c)
.f.
m, n = 0, 1, 2, ...
-~
~
!
0
t
i
t
2bll=0.2
T2b--d/IFO.Ol
-0.1
2d
Iii"
14
12
10
1.
8
"t
18
16 'i"ii'
----
!'i' t
I Ii
i.o
'i 9 I
IE b
I
I Iii
2iJ
l''ii'
t
i
t
10
!ii'ii'
llii" I
,iii
llE
---!'i' 'ii'!1i
11" I IE
2
0 0
2b/.t=0.2
---d/b=0.01
-0.1
I"
ti::
10
;=I
8
6
(3.3.6)
1.1
111
~
7
i.o
!ii
I I
10
27rl.IL
-73-
-~
e
fl)
~
.....
0
Complete
IS92
1.0
SRES Scenario
0.8
A1B
- - AH
A1FI
A2
Bl
B2
0.6
0.4
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
j
~
...
I
0.2
.s
.L
()
iil"'
0.0
2000
2020
2040
2060
2080
several models.
Year
Fig. 3.5.1 Predicted Future Variation in the Mean Water Level of the Earth's Ocean Surface
According to IPCC's Third Evaluation Report
(From the Third IPCC Evaluation Report, First Operating Committee Report,
Climate Change 2001, Scientific Basis, Summary for Government Policy Makers)
-74-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
(2) Effect of the Mean Sea Level Rise, and its Adaptation
If the mean sea level rises, and a storm surge or tsunami occurs, the heights of the shores and river banks will be
insufficient, thereby lowering the safety of their facilities and increasing the risk of disasters. Also, there will be
an effect on the logistics infrastructure, such as usage limitations on port facilities.
Measures to take against a mean sea level rise include such measures as facility development, changes in land
use, and strengthening of disaster prevention system, and it is necessary to clearly understand the advantages
and disadvantages of such measures, taking into account factors such as the social characteristics and natural
conditions of the target areas, and combining all such measures into an adaptable plans.26) In order to develop
facilities, such as port facilities, sewer facilities, and roads (bridges), it is necessary to compensate for the effects of
mean sea level rise. However, it is necessary to keep in mind facility planning, the accompanying design working
time, cost-effectiveness, the effect on the surrounding environment, and the uncertainties in the predictions of the
sea level rise.
(2) As necessary, performance verification of port facilities must consider the velocity and discharge of seepage
within permeable foundations and facilities.
(3) Groundwater Level in Coastal Aquifer
The elevation ofbrackish groundwater intruding in a coastal aquifer may be estimated using the following equation
(see Fig. 3.6.1).
(3.6.1)
where
h : depth below the sea surface ofthe interface between fresh water and saltwater at the distance x (m)
ho : depth below the sea surface of the interface between fresh water and saltwater at x = 0 (m)
hi : depth below the sea surface of the interface between fresh water and saltwater at x = L (m)
p 1 : density of the fresh water (g/cm3)
r. :
Equation (3.6.1) cannot be applied if an impermeable layer exists close to the ground surface or in the aquifer:
For the relationship between the rise of groundwater level due to wave runup and beach profile change, see in 10.1
General [Technical Notes] (8)
x=O
I
,--x
L---~
...
Sea
-75-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
q=kiA
(3.6.2)
where
q=Khn
where
q : flow rate of permeation through a sheet pile joint per unit length in the vertical direction (cm3/s/
cm)
K : permeation coefficient for the joints (cm2-n/s)
h : pressure head difference between the front and back of a joint (cm)
n : coefficient depending on the state of the joints
(n ~ 0.5 when the joints are not filled with sand, and n ~ 1.0 when the joints are filled with
sand)
When there was sand on both sides of the sheet pile and the joints were under tension, Shoji et al. obtained
a value of 7.0 x 10-4 cm/s for Kin their experiments. However, they also pointed out that if the permeation
flow is estimated with this value, then the flow rate turns out to be as much as 30 times that observed in the
field. For actual design, it is thus necessary to pay close attention to any difference between the state of the
sheet pile wall used in the experiments and those used in the field.
q=UH
(3.6.4)
U=J2gd Ml
~
AS
where
q
-76-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Equation (3.6.4) has been proposed based on the experimental results using eight different types of stones
ofunifurm size, with the diameter ranging from 5 mm to 100 mm. The virtual flow length AS may be taken
to be as the total of the 70% to 80% of the permeable layer height and the width of the caisson base. The
coefficient ofresistance is shown in Fig. 3.6.2. When R,(~Ud /v)>IO, it is acceptable to take~ "" 20
10'
d(mm) M(cm)
>
e
"
'['...
'e
l'-c~
10
5-10
10-15
10-15
15-20
20-25
25-30
5
30-35
95
100
100
75
100
75
100
100
99
100
104
102
t=
~
1-'llQJ<Dr:m
-~~~
10
10
la2
10'
Ud
Re=-v
Fig. 3.6.2 Relationship between Resistance Coefficient (and Reynolds Number
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
-77-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Numerical Simulation, Technical Note of PHRI No.636,pp.70, 1988
19) Honda, K,, Terada, T., Yoshida, Y. and lshitani, D.: Secondary undulation of oceanic tides, Jour. Collage of Science, Univ. of
Tokyo, Vol.26, 1943
20) Goda, Y: Secondary undulation of tide in rectaogular and fan-shaped harbour, JSCE 10th conference on CoastaJ Eng., pp.
53-58, 1963
21) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Survey report on Extra-high tide level Fiscal 2002, pp. 86, 2003
22) Yoshioka, K., T. Nagao, E. Kibe, T. Shimono and H. Matsumoto: Effuct of extra-high tide on the externaJ stability of caisson
type breakwaters, Technical Note of National Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management, No.241, 2005
23) IPCC: Climate Change 2001, Scientific Basis, Cambridge University Press, p.881, 2001
24) Assemblymen in charge ofEnvironment, Synthetic Science and Technology Conference and, Cabinet Office Director-generaJ
fur Politics on Science and Technology Condition: Study Report on Climate Chaoge, Syothetic Science and Technology
Confurence, GlobaJ Warming Study Initiative, Frontier of Climate Chaoge Studies, Knowledge and Technology in the
Century ofEnvironment, 2002, p. 142, 2003
25) Nagai, T. K. Sugahara, H. Watanabe and K. Kawaguchi: Long Term Observation of the Mean Tide Level and Long Waves at
the Kuriharna-Bay, Rept. OfPHRI Vol. 35 No.4, 1996. 12, pp. 3-36
26) Task Force of the Study on Land conservation against sea level rise due to global warming: Report of the Land Conservation
Task Force on sea level rise due to the global warming, ,p.35, 2002
27) Todd, D.K.: Ground water hydrology, John Wiley & Sons,Inc.,1963
28) JSCE: The Collected Formula of Hydraulics (1985 Edition), JSCE, Nov. 1985
29) Ishihara, T. and H. Honma: Applied Hydraulics (Vol. II No. 2), Maruzen Publishing, 1966
30) Sakai, G: Geobydrology, Asakura Publishing, 1%5
31) Iwasa, Y.: Hydraulics, Asakura Publishing, p.226, 1967
32) Yamaguchi, H: Soul Mechanics, Giho-do Publishing, p.76, 1969
33) Shoji, Y. M. Kumeda and Y. Tomita: Experiments on Seepage through Interlocking Joints of Sheet Pile, Rept. PHRI Vol.21
No.4 1982.12
-78-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
4 Waves
Public Notice
Waves
Article 8
Characteristics of waves shall be set by the methods provided in the subsequent items corresponding to the
single action or combination of two or more actions to be considered in the performance criteria and the
performance verification:
(1) Waves to be employed in the verification of the structural stability of the facilities, the failure of the
section of a structural member (excluding fatigue failure), and others shall be appropriately defined in
terms of the wave height, period and direction corresponding to the return period through the statistical
analysis of the long-term data of observed or hindcasted waves or other methods.
(2) Waves to be employed in the verification of the assurance of the functions of a structural member
and the failure of its section due to fatigue shall be appropriately defined in terms of the wave height,
period, direction and others of waves having a high frequency of occurrence during the design working
life through the statistical analysis of the long-term data of observed or hindcasted waves.
(3) Waves to be employed in the verification of the harbor calmness shall be appropriately defined in terms
of the joint frequency distributions of the wave height, period and direction of waves for a certain
duration of time through the statistical analysis of the long-term data of observed or hindcasted waves.
[Commentary]
(1) Waves employed to verify the stability of facilities, to verify the failure of the section of a structural
member.
CD The verification of the assurance of the functions of the facilities relating to structural members refers
to verification of the limit state in which function-related trouble occurs in structural members, and in
addition the verification of failure of sections due to fatigue refers to verification of the limit state in
which destruction of a section occurs in a structural member due to repeated action.
The waves to be considered in the verification of the assurance of the functions of the facilities relating
to structural members employ as the standard waves for which the number of times which the waves
with a wave height greater than that strike in the design working life is about 10,000 times.
When setting the waves to be considered in the verification of destruction of a section due to fatigue,
the various conditions such as the natural condition of objective facilities are considered, and the
number of times of appearance relating to the wave height and period of the waves that occur duri~
the design working life. The period of the observed values and estimated values is based on (1) @
above.
-79-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
when setting the waves to be considered in the verification of harbor calmness, long period waves should be
included in areas where occurance of long period waves is predicted.
[Technical Nole]
g
]
! :~ ~I
90
~ 0
-3
-4
Time (s)
Fig. 4.1.1 Definition of Waves
(4.1.1)
where
-80-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
performance verification of the stability of the breakwater head of a breakwater or floating facilities, so the multi
directionality ofthe waves in waters should be examined beforehand with appropriate observation data. The wave
direction has a major effect on the results in the calculation of the degree of calmness, so the waves are calculated
as multi directional random waves.
A directional wave spectrum is employed as an index for showing the multi directionality of a wave. The
directional wave spectrum is the product of the above-described frequency spectrum S(f) and the directional
spreading function G(f, 8), and is expressed as S(f, 8) = S(f)G(f, 8). The Mitsuyasu type directional spreading
function is commonly employed in most cases as the directional spreading function. Fig. 4.1.2 shows the
distribution shape of the Mitsuyasu directional spreading function. f, f,, and I in the figure are respectively the
frequency, peak frequency of the frequency spectrum and coefficient employed when computing the directional
wave function in cosine shape. The parameter of the directional wave function Smax is the directional spreading
parameter introduced by Goda and Suzuki, 4) and the following numerical values can generally be used.
Wind waves
Swell with a short attenuation distance
Swell with a long attenuation distance
Srr==IO
s_=25
s-=75
However, the variance of the directional spreading parameter is large on-site, and when the directional wave
spectrum is observed on-site, these values should be used as a reference.
G(O}
2.5
I' lJIJ;,=-0.80)
f' 0(j!J;, =I. 00)
I' z(j!J;,=l.38)
I' 3(j!f;,=1.65)
~=5-7#---i~
~=9
~=11
~=13
-90
(!) WhenS-= 75
G(o>
7f
-90
(2) When S~ = 25
G(Ol
2
-90
7f
90
Fig. 4.1.2 The Distribution Shape of the Mitsuyasu Type Directional Spreading Function
-81-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
The directional spreading parameter Sm,. of offshore waves that expresses the directional spreading of wave
energy varies depending on the wave shape steepness, and it can be estimated with Fig. 4.1.3 in the event that
adequate observation data is not obtained. In addition, in shallow waters, the directional spreading ofwaves varies
depending on the sea bottom topography, so it is preferable to estimate this by a wave deformation calculation,
but in those cases where the coastline is close to linear having simple topography and the water depth contour is
deemed to be parallel to the shoreline, the changes in Smox may be estimated by the diagram in Fig. 4.1.4.
200
'
100
'
.
'
50
' '
' '\
20
\
10
2
I
0.005
O.Ql
0.02
0.05
Hello
Fig. 4.1.3 Changes in
J~
10
90
80
70
0
0
Smax
'
40
'\ '
30
.....
'
'
,' "
' . ,:
'
'\
(ap)o=O"
~~
:.
.... ~~-,.
----~-
6(1"-
0.05
-(~-is
... ...
-
"':'\,'
30 ----
I0
0.02
'
(S...),
"'
'~\
20
0.1
0.2
0.5
1.0
(Smax) indicates the value of offshore waves, and (tzp)o indicates the principal wave direction of offshore waves.
height of offshore waves, and h indicates the water depth.
-82-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
in descending order. And the significant wave period 1)13 is the value averaging the period of the wave employed
for calculation ofthe signiEcant wave height. The m~an of the individual waves included in all data are expressed
as the mean wave height R and mean wave period T . The wave with the greatest wave height among a series
of waves is called the highest wave, its wave height and period are respectively called the highest wave height
Hmax and highest wave period Tmax, and the action due to the waves employed in the verification of stability of a
breakwater shall be calculated from the dimensions of the highest wave. On the assumption that wave energy is
concentrated in the extremely narrow range of a certain frequency, the occurrence frequency of the wave heights
included in the wave group of offShore waves follows the Rayleigh distribution. In the event that the occurrence
frequency ofwave heights follows the Rayleigh distribution, the following relationship exists between the highest
wave height HmAX and the significant wave height H113 S)
(4.1.2)
(4.1.3)
(4.1.4)
where
H 113 =1.60H
(4.1.5)
-83-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
natural resonance of harbors and bays, has effects on not only moored ships but also the water level of the inner
part of the bay, so in the event that clear harbor resonance is found from the tide records to date, or in the event
that the topography of the harbor varies widely, it is preferable to examine this with an appropriate numerical
calculation method. 6)
(8) Wave direction
The wave direction is an important parameter for determining the direction of the forces acting on the facilities.
It is preferable to determine the principal wave direction to the greatest extent possible by observation of the
directional wave spectrum or ofthe flow speed oftwo components. 7) The principal wave direction is the orientation
where the peaks in the wave train are distributed most densely on a wave form of a certain direction, and it is
considered as an angle where the peak in directional wave spectrum appears. However, in the event that the swells
from outside the harbor or the wind waves that occur inside the harbor overlap, bidirectional waves that have
two peaks for the directional spreading function appear frequently. 8) In these cases, even if the principal wave
direction is determined, it is seldom that this principal wave direction represents the direction in which the energy
of the wave proceeds, so one should examine special measures such as carrying out the performance verification
of the facilities at the wave direction that is most dangerous, or carrying out the performance verification for the
respective wave directions, and setting the facilities to be stable for both.
(9) Setting of waves
In the performance verification, the above-described properties of waves shall be considered, and first of all the
offshore waves composing variable action or accidental action shall be determined, in accordance with the function
of the facilities. The directional concentration of the energy of the wave is set, in addition to the significant wave
height, significant wave period and wave direction, as the conditions of the waves. Next, the wave deformation
calculation shown in the next chapter is carried out in shallow waters, and the conditions of the waves that act on
the facilities shall be determined.
(4.2.1)
(4.2.2)
Fig. 4.2.1 illustrates these relational expressions (the unit of the fetch length Fin equation (4.2.1) and equation
(4.2.2) is expressed by kilometer units in Fig. 4.2.1). However, these relational expressions are for cases where
the wind is continuously blowing constantly for an adequately long time, and for a while after the wind starts
blowing it does not reach this wave height or period. The time required for a wave that occurs at the upper
extremity of the futch to reach the point at distance F(m) while it develops is called the minimum wind duration
t,,,m(s), and is expressed by the following equation.
Imm
rF
= Jo ~
(4.2.3)
where
Cg(x) is the group velocity of the waves. In addition, it is possible to make a rough estimate by means
of the following equation.I'>
-84-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
(4.2.4)
Where, tm.i.n' is the minimum wind duration (hr), and F' is the fetch length (km), and it is necessary to pay
attention to the fact that the units differ from equations (4.2.1) and (4.2.2). When the wind duration is shorter
than the minimum wind duration, the waves are in the process of developing with time. Therefore, in those cases
where the fetch length and the wind duration are simultaneously provided, the smaller ware of the two calculated
waves must be adopted.
The SMB method fundamentally applies to constant fetch, but in the event that the wind speed is changing
gradually, the waves can be hindcasted by using the equi-energy line (the line showing H 1132 Ji132 = const).
In the event that the width of the fetch is narrower than the fetch length in a lake or bay, or in the event that the
fetch length is determined by the opposite shore distance, and the opposite shore distance varies widely relative
to minute fluctuations of the wind direction, equation (4.2.1) and equation (4.2.2) provide a wave height or period
that is much larger than it really is. In such cases, it is best to employ the effective fetch length 14) provided by the
following formula.
(4.2.5)
Here, F~ff is the effective fetch length, F 1 is the opposite shore distance in the number ith direction from the
hindcasting point ofthe wave, and 8; is the angle formed by the direction of the opposite shore distance F; and the
principal wind direction, and is -45 :5: 8; ~ 45.
so
40
35
30
28
26
24
22
:::,,
20
..9
18
14
12
16
10
9
8
7
6
s
Fetch length F (km)
- - Wave height HlfJ (m)
- - Minimum wind duration t(h)
- - PeriodT]fJ
---- Equi-energy line (H1rJ2 Tl!J) = const.
In the SMB method, when the variation of the wind field is significant as in the case of a typhoon or extra
tropical cyclone, it is difficult to provide suitably the values for wind velocity U10 , fetch length For wind duration
t. A method that solves this problem is Wilson's graphical calculation method, 15) and the methods of Ijima and
Horikawa, 16). 17) which solve Wilson's equation numerically, are commonly employed.
As shown in equation (4.2.1) and equation (4.2.2), the significant wave method is nothing more than formula
that links experientially the development of wind waves with the basic parameters, and is not formula that is
constructed in line with the mechanisms of generation and development of waves. Owing to this nature, it leaves
a number ofvague points, such as how to handle cases where the wind gradually deflects, the transition from wind
waves to swells, the method for synthesizing wind waves and swells. In addition, there is also the problem that
the wave direction obtained by hindcasting displays the wind direction of the final step of calculation. However,
compared to a case where the wind field has a simple nature and the effects of swells can be ignored, it is a
practical estimation method that is simpler than the spectrum method and whose calculation time is also short.
-85-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
As far as the swells th.at wind waves propagate distant from the generation and development areas are
concerned,
(4.2.6)
(4.2.7)
Here, (lfi.13)F and (T113)F are the wave height and period of a significant wave at the terminus ofthe fetch, (H113)
and (1J.13)D are the wave height and period of a swell, F min is the minimum fetch length that generates the wave,
Dis the attenuation distance, th.at is the distance terminus ofthe wind field to the arrival point ofa swell, and k1 ~
0.4, and "2 ~ 2.0. In addition, the propagation time t of a swell is given by the following equation.
47rD
(4.2.8)
t=---
g(Tv3)v
A wave hindcasting method for shallow water area has also been proposed.19)
(3) Wave Hindcasting by the Spectrum Method
In general the following formula is employed for wave hindcasting by the spectrum method.
at
(4.2.9)
Here, Cg is the group velocity, the first term at left stands for the local temporal change in spectrum energy
E(w, (/), and the second term stands for the changes due to the transmission effect of the spectrum energy. In
addition, Snetf...OJ, (/) on the right side is the term expressing the total amount of change in energy related to the
change of the spectrum components, and in general is provided by the following formula:
(4.2.10)
Here, Sin is the energy transmitted from the wind to the waves. Sn1 is the gain and loss of energy that occurs
between the four component waves with different wave numbers, and is called transport of wave energy by
nonlinear interactions (hereinafter, "nonlinear transport of wave energy"). The nonlinear interactions due to
these four waves cause the shape of the directional wave spectrum to vary, with the total sum of energy that the
waves have constant. Sds stands for the effects where the energy of the waves dissipates due to white-cap breaking
waves or the internal viscosity of seawater.
Models based on the spectrum method are classified into the disjoined propagation (DP model), the coupled
hybrid (CH) model and the coupled disjoined (CD) model, depending on how the nonlinear transport of wave
energy Sn1 is treated. In the DP model, the nonlinear transport of wave energy term is not introduced directly,
and the respective frequency and directional components are not coupled to each other. In the CH model, the
nonlinear interactions between component waves are parameterized and introduced. In the CD model, the
nonlinear interactions are introduced directly in some form or other.
On the other hand, the models are also classified by the period when they were developed. The DP model,
which was developed from the 1960s to the beginning of the 1970s, is the first generation model, and the CH
model and CD model, which were developed from the 1970s to the 1980s, are second generation models, and the
CD model, which was developed from the latter half of the 1980s to the present, and which handles the nonlinear
interactions with higher accuracy than previously, is called the third generation model. In the third generation
model, the degree of flexibility of the scheme of the nonlinear transport of wave energy term is high, and it is
possible to hindcast with good accuracy even in the case of waves where bidirectional waves, wind waves and
swells are all present.
The wave hindcasting model of the Japan Meteorological Agency started from MRI, 20) the first generation
model, and developed into MRI-II 21) and MRI-II new, 22) the second generation models, and currently MRI-III, 23)
the third generation model, is being employed. In addition to these, the Inoue model 24) and the YamaguchiTsuchiya model 25) are known as a first generation model, and the Tohoku model 26) is known as a second generation
model. In addition, in the first generation models, a one point method where the waves at one spot are calculated
-86-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
from a calculation along the wave ray of each component wave that arrives at one spot has been developed.
(4) MRI Model 20)
The MRI model that was developed in 1973 is the model that was employed for the numerical wave report service
of the Japan Meteorological Agency over approximately a decade from 1977.
In the MRI model, the linear development and exponential development of wind waves due to wind, and the
physical mechanisms ofenergy dissipation due to the effects ofbreaking waves and internal friction and headwinds,
are taken into consideration. The effects ofnonlinear transport of wave energy Sn1 are not considered formally, but
the effucts of on-linear transport of wave energy are expressed indirectly by employing the development equation
24) for wind waves, which does not separate the nonlinear transport of wave energy Snl from the transport of wave
energy S 1n from the wind to the wave.
The total amount of change in energy Sne,(_w, B) is divided into the cases of tailwinds and headwinds, and is
expressed as follows.
Sne1
Sne1 =-Df E
s.,., =-\Br(B-Bw)+D /
E>EPM, IB-Bwl<ir/2
4
}E
(4.2.11)
IB-Bwl>ir/2
Here, f is the frequency, 0 is the wave direction, Ow is the wind direction and E = E(f, B) is the directional
spectrum of the wave. E,M is the Pierson-Moskowitz spectrwn, and is employed as the standard form of a
saturated spectrum. In addition, r (B-Ow) is the directional wave function that is proportionate to cos20, A and B
are the linear and exponential development rates 24) of wind waves per unit time, and Dis the coefficient of internal
friction (eddy viscosity).
In a DP model including the MRI model, the spectrum shape of the waves is expressed so as to gradually
approximate a saturated spectrum, by multiplying the term of the form {l - (E - EPM )2}, and - (E - EPM )2
expresses the formal energy dissipation. In addition, in the DP model, the calculation time is short, and it has
practical accuracy with respect to wave height, so it is employed currently as a wave model that can be used simply
and conveniently.
(5) WAM Model28J
The WAM model is a representative third generation wave hindcasting model that directly calculates the nonlinear
interactions of four wave resonance, by the discrete interaction approximation 29) of S. Hasselmann and K.
Hasselmann.
In the model of the spectrwn method, the transport ofwave energy from wind to wave is generally provided
by the following.
S1n=A+BE
(4.2.12)
Here, A corresponds to the Phillips resonance mechanism, and BE to the Miles instability mechanism. The
Phillips resonance mechanism is a mechanism where the random pressure fluctuations of wind that blows over a
still water surface, and the component waves that have a spatial scale and phase velocity that matches the former,
cause resonance, and owing to the phenomena a wave is generated. On the other hand, the Miles instability
mechanism is a mechanism where the airflow on the water surface is disturbed and becomes unstable owing to
the unevenness of the water surface due to the waves, and energy is efficiently transmitted from wind to waves
due to this phenomenon. In the WAM model, the following equation, from which the items related to the Phillips
resonance mechanism are omitted, is adopted:
(4.2.13)
S1n =BE
However, in this method, ifthe initial value of the spectrwn energy of the waves is assumed to be 0, no waves
are generated, so it is possible to provide as the initial value a spectrum calculated from the fetch length and initial
velocity.
In Cycle 4 of the WAM model, Janssen's quasi-linear theory 30), 31) has been incorporated in the calculation
equation for the transport of wave energy term from wind to waves. Owing to this, even in the event that the
conditions of the offshore winds are identical, it is possible to calculate closer to reality, such that the amount of
wave energy transported is greater for waves whose wave age is younger.
In the energy dissipation term of the WAM model, the effects of white-cap breaking waves and sea bottom
friction have been taken into consideration.
In the nonlinear transport of wave energy term, the nonlinear interactions of the four wave resonance have
-87-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
been taken into account. Nonlinear interactions are a phenomenon where the component waves making up the
spectrum exchange the energy that they respectively have, and although no change is imparted directly to the
total energy of the wave, effects appear themselves on the amount of energy transport from wind to waves and the
amount of energy dissipation due to the fact that the spectrum shape changes. Then, the nonlinear transport of
wave energy of four wave resonance is expressed by the following equation. 32)
s., = m4 [
(4.2.14)
Here, n(k) = E(k)lw stands for the wave action density, Q() the joint function of the spectrum components,
The delta function
othe delta function, k the wave vector, and the subscripts are the four wave components.
expresses the resonance conditions, and nonlinear interactions occur between the component waves that satisfy
the following expression.
(4.2.15)
However, an incalculable number of combinations of resonance that satisfies this expression exist. Owing to
this, an immense calculation burden is involved in calculated all of these combinations, so in the actual model one
representative combination is decided on, and s., is approximated.
A model expanded so that topographical breaking waves and wave set up based on WAM can be considered
is SWAN, 33) and this is employed for wave hindcasting in shallow waters.
phenomenon. Changes in wave height and wave direction due to refraction must therefore be considered.
(2) Refraction Calculation for Random Waves
CD
Calculation methods
Calculation method for refraction analysis for random waves include the following: CD the component wave
method, whereby the directional wave spectrum is divided into an appropriate number of component waves, a
refraction calculation is performed for each component wave, and then the wave refraction coefficient for the
random wave is evaluated by making a weighted average of the component wave energies;@ methods in which
the wave energy balance equation 37) or the mild-slope equation for wave is solved directly using a computer
with finite difference schemes. As with the component wave method, the energy balance equation is derived
by asswning that wave energy does not cut across wave rays and flow out. Tiris means that the technique is
basically the same in both cases. However, with the energy balance equation method, refraction within a microfinite region is calculated, meaning that the wave refraction coefficient does not become infinite even at a point
in which two regular wave rays may converge. On the other hand, the mild-slope equation method for wave is a
strictly analytical method, but it is difficult to apply it to a large region. When determining the wave refraction
coefficient for random waves, it is acceptable to use the component wave method, which involves the linear
superposition of wave refraction coefficients for regular waves and is thus simple and convenient. However,
when intersections of wave rays occur during a refraction calculation for a component wave, the energy balance
equation method may be used for practical purposes with the exception of the case that the degree of intersection
is large.
@ Effects of diffraction
When deepwater waves have been diffracted by an island or a headland, the wave spectrum becomes generally
different from a standard form that has been assumed initially. Thus it is necessary to use the spectral form after
diffraction when performing the refraction calculation.
-88-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
@ Diagrams of the wave refraction coefficient and angle for random waves at a coast with straight, parallel depth
contours
Figs 4.3.1 and 4.3.2 show the wave refraction coefficient Kr and the principal wave direction (a,,)0, respectively,
for random waves at a coast with straight, parallel depth contours, with the principal direction of deepwater
waves (ap)o as the parameter. The direction (ap)o is expressed as the angle between the wave direction and
the line normal to the boundary of deepwater. Smax is the maximum value of the parameter that expresses the
degree of directional spreading of wave energy (see 4.1 Basic Matters Relating to Waves).
1.0
K,
'
N"
20
0.9
...... _::..---
lz:
S<f
0.8
611'
1s-~101
0.7
1.0
'
<W<"
2<f
'"
0.9
4<f
S<f
0.8
'
~,...
0.7
'"
1.0
<W<"
--
'"
'"w-40
0.8
r
0.7
0.01
,_0.05
0.02
-:;...-
-~
IS-""251
20
0.9
~-
... -~
0.1
h!L,
IS-='75 I
0.2
0.5
1.0
Fig. 4.3.1 Wave Refraction Coefficient of Random Waves at Coast with Straight, Parallel Depth Contours
80
70
<W'"
60
,Ao/
50
ap
40
..,,:~
20
O'
// v
30
10'
/.,,
, '/
...,;:;
0.01
".;..-
;..-
'--"'
0.05
..-
1...o-f-"
0.02
v..,
~-
---
~-
~-
----- -- -
-:;.....-
,.'".
=-
I~
I<f
0.1
0.2
0.5
1.0
h!L,
Fig. 4.3.2 Change Due to Refraction in the Principal Direction aP of Random Waves at Coast with Straight,
Parallel Depth Contours
-89-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(4.3.1)
(4.3.2)
Here, S is the directional spectrum of the wave, C is the wave celerity, Cg is the group velocity of the waves,
and (}is the wave angle that is measured from clockwise to couoterclockwise of the x axis. Equation (4.3.1) can be
solved from offshore towards the direction in which the waves proceed. In equation (4.3.1), the left term is 0, and
the total energy of the wave being propagated is treated not to vary. Takayama et al.have taken into consideration
the energy loss due to breaking waves, and improved it so that the effects of breaking waves can be treated as well.
Fig. 4.3.3 is an example of improved calculation by the energy balance equation.
H113(m)
EBM
Diffi Method--
Fig. 4.3.3 Example of Calculation of the Wave Height Distribution by the Energy Balance Equation
In the figure, the solid line is the wave height based on the energy balance equation, and the broken line is
the wave height distribution calculated by taking into consideration only the refraction inside the harbor. In the
energy balance equation, there are cases where the effects of not only refraction but also diffraction are also
applied to large wave fields. Since the the invasion of wave energy due to directional dispersion of random waves
are dominant compared to that due to diffraction, it is possible to examine the wave height inside a harbor that is
shielded by a breakwater, excluding the area immediately behind it.
(4) At places where the water depth is 0.5 times or less the offshore wave height, the nature of waves as a flow is more
prominent than the nature as a wave, so the refraction calculation employed for computing the wave height and
refraction coefficient is applied to the range where the water depth is deeper than 0.5 times of the offshore wave
height.
-90-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
4.3.2 Wave Diffraction
CD
The wave height in regions in which waves are anticipated to be greatly affected by the phenomenon of diffraction
caused by obstacles such as breakwaters or islands needs to be calculated using an appropriate method.
@ Diffraction is a phenomenon whereby waves invade into a water arear sheltered by breakwaters. It is the most
important phenomenon when determining the wave height in a harbor. The irregularity of waves should be
considered in a diffraction calculation. For a harbor within which the water depth is assumed uniform, the
diffraction diagrams for random waves with regard to a semi-infinite length breakwater or straight breakwaters
with one opening are prepared. The ratio of the wave height after diffraction to the incident wave height is
called the diffraction coefficient K,,. The diffraction coefficient K,, is given by the following equation:
(4.3.3)
where
(4.3.4)
...
I/'
-7\
1'1
v" ,,f,
I
'
'I
/'
I :
'
'""I/''
,
'
'
!I
-91-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 4.3.1 Angle of Axis of Wave after Diffraction 8
(a) Smax~10 [Angle in the parentheses is the angle of deffraction relative to the angle of incidence]
Angle between breakwater and incident wave direction ()
BIL
1.0
2.0
4.0
15
30
45
60
53 (38)
46 (31)
41 (26)
58 (28)
53 (23)
49 (19)
65 (20)
62 (17)
60 (15)
71(11)
70 (10)
70 (10)
(b)Smax~5
1.0
2.0
4.0
15
30
45
60
49(34)
41(26)
36(21)
52(22)
47(17)
42(12)
6JO(J60)
57(12)
54( 9)
70(10)
67( 7)
65( 5)
1.0
2.0
4.0
15
30
45
60
41 (26)
36 (21)
30 (15)
45 (15)
41 (11)
36 ( 6)
55 (10)
52 ( 7)
49 ( 4)
66 ( 6)
64 ( 4)
62 ( 2)
-92-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
where
Kd : diffraction coefficient at the point of interest
K, : refraction coefficient at the point of interest
K, : shoaling coefficient at the harbor entrance (see 4.3.5 Wave Shoaling)
Ho : deepwater wave height
The energy balance equation method or the improved energy balance equation method 35) in which a term
representing dissipation due to wave breaking is added is appropriate as the calculation method for refraction
analysis for the ocean. Takayama's 42) harbor calmness calculation method, whereby diffraction solutions for
detached breakwaters are superimposed in order to obtain the change in the wave height of random waves within
the harbor due to diffraction and reflection, can be used for the diffraction calculation for the area within the
harbor, provided there are no complex topographic variations within the harbor.
In equation (4.3.5) the assumed wave height by multiplying K,and K,, by Ho is used as the equivalent deepwater
wave height H 0 ' and calculated with the following equation.
(4.3.6)
The equivalent deepwater wave height is the assumed deepwater wave used for the performance verification
on the results obtained from two-dimensional water tank experiments. And it is obtained by calculating the
effects of refraction and diffraction in advance, and by using wave height Ho' multiplied by H0 , it is possible to be
obtained by using the calculation diagrams shown in 4.3.5 Wave Shoaling and 4.3.6 Wave Breaking.
(3) When there are large variations in water depth even at places sheltered by breakwaters often seen in the case
with relatively small harbors and coastal areas, it is necessary to simultaneously consider both diffraction and
refraction within the harbor. If ignoring wave reflection and just examining the approximate change in wave
height, it is possible to carry out refraction and diffraction calculations separately, and then estimate the change in
wave height by multiplying together the refraction and diffraction coefficients obtained.
Calculation methods that allow simultaneous consideration of refraction and diffraction of random waves
include a method that uses time-dependent mild-slope equations for wave,43) a method in which the Boussinesq
equation is solved using the finite difterence method, 44) and the multicomponent coupling method of Nadaoka
et aJ.45) There are also references in which other calculation methods are explained.38) The wave transformation
calculation model using the Boussinesq equation has been modified and NOWT-PARI (Nonlinear wave
transformation model by Port and Airport Research Institute) has been proposed as one of the models that can be
used at ports.) Modified versions that allow simultaneous consideration ofrunup and seawall wave overtopping
in shallow waters have also been proposed.47) Designers should use appropriate numerical calculation methods,
taking into consideration water area characteristics and the application limit of the program.
-93-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Hs : significant wave height when all of the wave groups are taken together
Hi. H 2, , H,,: significant wave heights of wave groups
However, ifthe wave action varies with the wave direction, the differences in the wave directions of various
wave groups must be considered. The calculated wave height is valid for places that are at least about 0.7
wavelengths away from a reflecting boundary.
Regarding the diffraction or refraction of waves for which wave direction is an important factor, the significant
wave height is determined separately for each wave group by carrying out whatever calculation is necessary for
that wave group, when the wave directions of various wave groups differ. Then the composite wave height
is calculated by putting these significant wave heights into equation (4.3.7). An acceptable alternative is to
determine the spectrum for each wave group, add these spectra together in order to calculate the spectral form
when the wave groups coexist, and then perform direct diffraction or refraction calculations using this spectrum.
(4) Composition of Periods
The significant wave height to be used in calculating the wave force when two wave groups of different periods
are superimposed may be determined by the energy composition method (as shown in, equation (4.3.7)). The
significant wave period Ti.13 may be determined using the following equation (4.3.8) 48):
1J.13
=k
(4.3.8)
where
k
(4.3.9)
(4.3.10)
a=0.08(lnRT ) -0.15lnRT
= {
0.6
10.0
(4.3.11)
<1.0
(4.3.12)
RH= (H113}1/(H113)rr
(4.3.13)
Rr = (Tl/3}1/(Tl/3}11
(4.3.14)
(H113}i, (H113)n : significant wave heights of wave groups I and II before superimposition,
respectively (m)
(7i13)I> (T113)n : significant wave periods of wave groups I and II before superimposition,
respectively (s)
Note that, in the above equations, I is assigned to the wave group with the shorter period and II to that with
the longer period.
(5) Methods for Calculating the Effects of Reflected Waves
Calculation methods for investigating the extent of the effects of waves reflected from a structure include the
calculation method of wave height distribution around an island 49) and a simple method by means of diffraction
diagrams.
-94-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
CD
calculation method can also be applied to the reflection of random waves by means of superposing component
waves. Although the wave diffraction problems can also be analyzed with this calculation method, there will
be large errors if it is applied to the diffraction of waves by thin structures such as breakwaters.
. . -- . . 5'
,;
'
~.E!
I
\\
\
'
'
' ',
A'::,
'.~
,,,
I
\\I
\\I
'\.
't '
I'''
'
',\
,,,
---------
--------~>.+,,,,..,~~p,,i~~----------------~
-95-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Upright wall:
Submerged upright breakwater:
Rubble mound:
Wave-dissipating blocks:
Upright wave-dissipating structure:
Natural beach:
0.7-1.0
(0.7 is for the case of a low crown with much overtopping)
0.5-0.7
0.3-0.6
0.3-0.5
0.3-0.8
0.05-0.2
With the exception ofthe upright wall, the lower limits in the above ranges ofreflection coefficient correspond
to the case of steep waves and the upper limits to waves with low steepness. It should be noted, however, that with
the upright wave-dissipating structure, the wave reflection coefficient varies with the wavelength, and the shape
and dimensions of the structure. In addition, compared to swells with a period of several tens of seconds or long
period waves with a period of several tens of seconds, the wave reflection coefficient becomes higher than the
above-mentioned values in the case of deformed wave-dissipating blocks or upright wave-dissipating structures.
In recent years there have been reports about calculation methods that incorporate a function that can reproduce
the nature whereby the reflection characteristics of the waves vary in accordance with the thickness of the wavedissipating layer and the void ratio in nonlinear wave transformation model, which can calculate a wave form
temporally and spatially.so) The section on long period waves can be referred, for the wave refraction coefficient
of long period waves.
[3] Transformation of Waves at Concave Corners near the Heads of Breakwaters and around Detached
Breakwaters
(!) Around the concave corners of structures, near the heads of breakwaters, and around detached breakwaters,
the wave height becomes larger than the normal value of standing waves owing to the effects of diffraction and
reflection. This increase in wave height shall be examined thoroughly. Moreover, the irregularity of waves shall
be considered in the analysis.
(2) Influence of Wave Irregularity
When the wave height distribution near the concave corner or the head of a breakwater is calculated for regular
waves, a distributional form with large undulations is obtained. However, when wave irregularity is incorporated
into the calculation, the undulated form of the distribution becomes smoothed out, excluding the region within one
wavelength of a concave comer, and the peak value of the wave height becomes smaller. Calculation using regular
waves thus overestimates the increase in the wave height around concave corners and the heads of breakwaters.
(3) Graphs for Calculating Wave Height Distribution around a Concave Corner
Wave height distributions for random waves near a concave corner are shown in Fig. 4.3.6. This figure exhibits
the form of the distribution of the maximum value of the wave height, as obtained from numerical calculations
for each principal wave direction. It has been assumed that waves are completely reflected by the breakwater.
In the diagram, Kd is the ratio of the wave height at the front of the main breakwater to the wave height of the
incident waves. The random waves used in the calculation has a spectral form with Smax = 75, which implies
a narrow directional spreading. The long dash-dot line in each graph shows the distribution of the maximum
value of the wave height at each point as obtained using an approximate calculation. The length Ii is that of the
main breakwater, 12 is that of the wing breakwater, and Pis the angle between the main breakwater and the wing
breakwater. This figure may be used to calculate the wave height distribution near a concave corner. When it is
not easy to use the calculation program, the approximate calculation method may be used.
-%-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
~ ~ f3F#?Fd,_/J-_~~-20-_-+-_
__
--+------t-+-1=_S_LV3_,_t2-=L...
-V3_ _
-_-__,.
4 .------r------.---~-----.------.
~:fF+443d
Ii1=ao.i2=ao I
/J-16S"
t1=SL1JJ l2=L1JJ
--
, -- I
z/L"'
;c..op.mmothod
--;~lclObJlion
modtod
Fig. 4.3.6 Distribution of the Maximum Value of the Wave Height around Concave Corner 54)
-97-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
1.4
0
1.2
-~ 1.0
1!
.a
//'- .....
\
!l
ii
0.8
/"
;
..............
\ ., ,/
--
"1:i
,,
,.....,_.,,,,./
Random waves
-- Regular waves
h=IOm
Jb!Os L=92.4m
I
0
100
x(m)
200
a=30"
,,
' '
. ,,
0.41-----t-----t-----t---~c\\tl
a
50
'
100
x(m)
150
200
(I) When waves propagate into shallow waters, shoaling shall be considered in addition to refraction and diffraction.
It shall be considered that the nonlinearity of waves when calculating the shoaling coefficient.
(2) Shoaling is one of the important factors that lead to changing of the wave height in coastal waters. It exemplifies
the fact that the wave height in shallow waters is also governed by the water depth and the wave period. Fig. 4.3.9
has been drawn up based on Shuto's nonlinear long wave theory.57) It includes the linearized solution by the small
amplitude wave theory and enables the estimation of the shoaling coefficient from deep to shallow waters. In the
diagram, Ks is the shoaling coefficient, Ho' is the equivalent deepwater wave height, His the wave height at water
depth h, and 0 is the wavelength in deepwater.
-98-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
3.0
0.1
0.15
0.2
0.3
hlL,
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
4-~ ~I
"'<.1.+~
.,
.,
.,
...
2.5
'
.,
,,\,
~
\.
",
~~
"~~,
'\. '\!,-
6},
~l ,'J~"':/.I _I I 1 1 1_1
'';~o '!Lo-
. . r, ..
'
'
I ~ ., , 0.005
H 20
K, ~ H.'
. H,'IL,=-0.0005
'o,,, N
0
--
I~
"
1.5
0.r'..t11'
"\.
'- OOOL~Oo.
"
'
"
0.002
~
-~
001
..
'
''
'
.,
-. --0.02
' ....
-.
1.0
0.004
K,
0.9
OQ! I ~
'\. ,
...._.._ 0
1.0
O.Q15
0.02
0.03
0.04
-- '. :!:
0.04
!:;
0.06
0.08 0.1
hlL,
Fig. 4.3.9 Diagram for Evaluation of Shoaling Coefficient
4.3.6 Wave Breaking
(1) At places where the water depth is shallower than about three times the equivalent deepwater wave height, changing
of the wave height due to wave breaking need to be considered. Jt is standard to consider the irregularity of waves
when calculating the change in the wave height due to wave breaking.
(2) After the height of waves has increased owing to shoaling, waves break at a certain water depth and the wave
height decreases rapidly. This phenomenon is called the wave breaking. It is an important factor to be considered
when determining the wave conditions exercising on coastal structures. For regular waves, the place at which
waves break is always the same: this is referred to as the "wave breaking point". For random waves, the location
of wave breaking depends on the height and period of individual waves, and wave breaking thus occurs over a
certain distance: this area is referred to as the "breaker zone".
(3) Change in Wave Height due to Wave Breaking
The change in wave height due to wave breaking may be determined using Figs. 4.3.10 (a)- (e) or Figs. 4.3.11
(a) - (e). These figures show the change in wave height for random waves as calculated by Goda 58) using a
theoretical model of wave breaking. For the region to the right of the dash-dot line on each diagram, the change
in wave height is calculated using the shoaling coefficient (see 4.3.S Wave Shoaling). For the region to the left
of this dash-dot line, the change in wave height due to wave breaking dominates, and so the wave height must be
determined using this diagram. As for the sea bottom slope, it is appropriate to use the mean sea bottom slope
over the region where the water depth to equivalent deepwater wave height ratio h/Ho' is in the range of 1.5 to 2.5.
(4) Scope of Application of Graphs of Wave Height Change
At places where the water depth is shallower than about one half of the equivalent deepwater wave height, a major
portion of wave energy is converted to the energy of flows rather than to that of water level changes. Therefore,
when calculating the wave force acting on a structure in a very shallow water, it is preferable to use the wave
height at the place where the water depth is one half of the equivalent deepwater wave height, if the facilities in
question are highly important. However, it is necessary to estimate the wave force acting on facilities constructed
on land areas from the shoreline with another proposed equation.59)
-99-
3.0
H
11-+++-++++++++++-1
11
11
2.5 ~~;:::~~~~~!i~:~~~++.f+l'l-+l,:::;+
#i
I
I
2.5
H 0'/L0=0JJ02
H-+-H-+-r+-Hrt-+-1-+H-++t-+++_,,,_.+++++-I'-' ~ ~
~ ~ ~
O.OO~/~olM-1.,...if. . . . . . . . . .
H+H+l-+H++l++l-++t-tJH+++-t-H>'
2.0
~ ~
II
~(H , ~K,H0 ~
i"r
,
~
l++-H+-+ltirl-E'0.041+.'+f+r~H+lf+H+++~tt<-l
1.0
1-tt1~
~-YN~~J.l"l-o:os-+++-++++++-+++-1-H-<~+++~
~
~{ '~
~~
0.005 /~\rt
I Iii'
i"'r
I
I I
Vi I l!'lo.l l
o.oi . (I I I
' HT
H
~
'0.02
I I I 1-~
~K,H0 ~~1.
0'.04
1.0
I ii ~
2.0
.J.lo'!'1"
~~~
0.08
TllT
~~~
0.5
l
O'-'-'-J....U...J....U......._._........................u....L.Ju....L.Ju....L.J..L...l....L..L...1....L.......................,
h/H0 '
hiHo'
3.0 r - --
3.0
- -- -- - - r r r r r r r r r r r r r r r
. - - - -- - --
--rT"TTTT"TT"1"TTTTTT"1
2.5 H+t-++-1-+H++l++l-++t++++++++++++t-++-t-++-H+
25 t-tt-t-ttt+ttt+Ht+H-ttt-t+HH+t-tt+t+H-t++++H
H+t+H-+++++++++t+H-++++H.
, '/La=0.002
,.l"...,.
R 'IL =0.002
'
Hm
1.S
Ho'
.I'
H-H-++++f++-++H-H~'H~ 0.01-+A-+-J-H-H-H.:;.;..fd-1
H-H++++++1+H+H'1"H.l"f'Ft~
, l.H
(H
, 13 ~ KJli
11 }1~V
.u-~
'1
r-H
t-t-t-t-+++++-t-t-t-t-t-t-t-t-TTT-H-M~~ O.OOS v0
H+l-+H-+++++++++++++++>11--0.005_,_,..,,...,..,...,..,...,...,..,...,
~-
t ~ '-~~
2.0
rt
r / 'If
0.04tt+t-fff'H+~::l:ll.lt:I
1.0
,,,_,
O.S
:If'
0.08tTH-rtttTH-rtttTH
lrl 1111
0 1111111
-100-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
3.0 ~-------~~~~~~
Bottom slope 1/100
3.5
I IJI' I
IJI I
IJI I I I I
H0 '/L0=0.002
0.0.Q~
3.0
It!
11111 111
11111 111
I .-
IJ
:n u=H1
~ ~
125/.)
2.5
J
~
o.oi ~
, ~ '"~
~
'o\"
Hmax
Ho'
0.02""
,, I r"I I
1uU:
, '0.08 ..
, , "
2.0
r
ct>r'
I~
11111 111
"
1.5
1.0
...
0.5
o~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
0.5
3.5
3.5
Bottom slope 1/20
11
111
111
11 111
11 111
11 111
3.0
,v
111
H 0 '/L0 =0.002
11
iJ
/o.oo~
111
H....,..=H112so
v 11 .,
2.5
IA
,1 ~
'/L0=0.002
2.0
I
1.5
I
I
~~I~
2.5
1.0
,J
0.0'
'
1.5
,.
,"
J ,
1.0
0.5 ~
(II
1! :.c:::i
'
-0.68
,.
l'TI
"
~
0.5
o'.o4
JO~ ~"
0,:Q"
Hma.
Ho'
2.0
'
/.
~
~ 0.005,~ ~
Hma=H1n.so
~
.( 0}._o
o.o 7 rv
.
'o.<t -. .
H,_
Ha'
.~
/ ~0.01. ~
,
11
1111
-101-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
3.5
1111111111111
3.0
111+ 1H11+++++H
Bottom slope 1/100 m-H'11+H'11+H
Crc~~~~~rctt-'n,:1'~0.002
1111111111111
H. 'IL =0.002
J.O
I "
'''~'il;''
0.005
,,, :;!:
2.5
I
I
lttttti-ttttttttt-ttt-tttitttttttm0.005
H_
IVI~
'
0.02: 'V
H,'
0.04 ~
2.0
_,
0 01
muwmuwmumi::~
w.fJt
.02 ~\
JW :
2.0
H~
H,'
1.5
0.08
0.08
1.0
1.0
0.5
0.5
II
II I
11'1~
o.oi,4'{1~
1.5
11 11 11 I
1111111
'11
o~~~~~~~~~~~~~
0.5
hfHo'
hfHo'
calculate wave height changes using the following simple formula in the case of a beach with constant seabed
slope of about 1/10 tol/75.58)
0
H 3- {
V - min{(,80H 0'+ P,h),P.,..Ho',K,Ho'}
K,H
(hf Lo ?. 0.2) }
(hf Lo <0.2)
(4.3.15)
where
Po= 0.028(Ho'fLo)-o.3S exp{20tant.5o}
(4.3.16)
Pi= 0.52exp(4.2tan61)
P.,., = max{0.92, 0.32(Ho'flo)-o.2exp(2.4tan61)}
The shoaling coefficient Ks is determined using Fig. 4.3.9, the operators min{ } and max{ } express minimum
and maximum value of within the braces, respectively, and tanB is the sea bottom slope.
Similarly, an approximate calculation formula for the highest wave height H.,.. is given as follows:
l.8K,H0
H'""'
= { min{(,80H 0+ P,h),p-...xH0',l.8K,H0}
(hf Lo ?. 0.2) }
(hf Lo< 0.2)
(4.3.17)
where
Po = 0.052(Ho'fLo)--0.3S exp~O(tan61) 15 }
(4.3.18)
P, = 0.63exp(3.8tan61)
P- =max{!.65,0.53(Ho'fLoi-029 exp(2.4tanB)}
-102-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
"'
~
2.0
'
3.5
'~I'
-~
=~rt:.i
"'"
~
Ho'
"
l'o
""1
""
0.005
0.01
"
_,.......
.... ...
0.02
~q;
''
;"
"' "
2.0
"""-
~~;...;,I
"'
2.5
"'-~
'
(h 113)pou.
1.0
0.002
o'
'~ ~d'"
t:
\~it
~' ~ depthatwhichH"'isa
~ \!'ii~ maximum in the breakeuone
3.0 ::"~['ii~~~
I'
'"'
'"'~ ~~
-
1.5
I""
~
1.5
,_,_
0.05
0.1
0.05 0.1
(4.3.19)
where
tanO denotes the seabed slope.
Fig. 4.3.14 shows the limiting wave height at the point of first wave breaking. At places where the water
is shallow, the water depth increases owing to the wave setup caused by wave breaking. When estimating the
limiting wave height in the breaker zone, it is thus necessary to consider this increase in water level.
1.5
I I 11111
1.0
~1120
-
.... _
~ 1/30
1/50 or less
-- ......
------- ....
"i-.
0.5
...
I\.
.'\.
"""'-.\
r--...
I\..
hb
0.001 0.002
I I I I Ill
~-
...,
!'-!'-.
I I
o=l.56T2
~
I'~
0.05
0.1
0.2
0.5
1.0
-103-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
{ ( )}
x
-=Bexp -A Ho'
Ho'
Hx
h+TJ
+ a - 00-
Ho'
(4.3.20)
where
H 0
Hx' :significant wave height at a distance x from the tip of the reef
}
(4.3.21)
(4m>H0'~2m )
a= 0.20
{ 0.33
(H0' ~ 4m)
The coefficient B corresponds to the bottom slope at the front of the reef. Using Fig. 4.3.10, it is obtained
from the significant wave height Hx=o at water depth h as follows.
B=
Hx=O -ah+Tfco
Ho'
(4.3.22)
Ho'
(4.3.23)
where
fJ= 0.56. From the continuity of the mean water level at the tip of the reef(x = 0), Co is given by
Co =("ffx=OH'+h):~~Hx=0)
8
H.'
(4.3.24)
The term 'ix = a represents the rise in the mean water level at water depth h, which is controlled by the bottom
slope in front ofthe.
However, there are major localized variations in reef topography on actual coastlines. Wave height may
increase behind circular reefs due to wave concentration and, therefore, it is preferable to conduct experiments
using multi directional random waves wherever possible.63) Reference can be made on 4.3.8 Rise of Mean Water
Level due to Waves and Surf Beats for more information on the concept of increased mean water level. The
calculation method in the above has been derived under the assumption that the water depth h over the reef is
small and waves break over the reef. It is thus not possible to apply the method when the water is deep and wave
breaking does not occur.
Considering the breaking wave height criterion of a solitary wave, the highest wave height Hmax, x at the
distance x from the tip ofthe reef may be obtained as follows.
(4.3.25)
-104-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
where, min{a, b} is the smaller value of a or b, and 'ix= o is the rise in the mean water level at the distance x and
is given by the following equation:
'ih+h= C _'ijH")2
Ho'
o 8 Ho'
(4.3.26)
,.,l
(2) The phenomenon of wave runup is dependent upon a whole variety of factors, such as the wave characteristics,
the configuration and location of the seawall, and the sea bottom topography; thus the runup height varies in a
complex way. There are calculation diagrams and equations based on the results of past researches that may be
used, although they are applicable only under certain limited conditions. When the seawall and sea bottom are
complex in form, it is preferable to determine wave runup heights by carrying out hydraulic model tests. When
conducting the performance verification of sloping revetments, it is preferable to set the crown elevation of the
revetment to be higher than the runup height for regular waves. However, for random waves, depending on the
wave height, overflow can occur, and so ultimately the crown elevation and the form of the seawall are preferably
determined so as to make the quantity ofwave overtopping (see 4.3.7 [2] Wave Overtopping Quantity) no more
than a certain permissible value.
(3) The results proposed by Mase 64) are simple, and the scope of application is wide, for the wave runup height of
random waves to a uniform slope.
R"
H '
11
= aq , 30 ~ tan p < S
(4.3.27)
and 0.007 ~ Ho
Lo
Here, x, a and b stand for the coefficients of the statistical values and calculated values of the wave runup
height, and are provided as shown below.
Table 4.3.2 Coefficients of Equation (4.3.27)
R1'
a
b
Rm.ax
2.32
0.77
R2%
R1110
1.86
1.70
Rlllo
1.38
0.71
0.71
0.70
-R
0.88
0.69
Here, Rm.ax is the maximum value of the wave runup height, and R23 is the value at which the wave runup
height calculated in an experiment exceeds 2%. R1110, R113 and R are 1/10 and 1/3 maximum wave runup height
and the mean value respectively that can be calculated by the same method as a case in which random waves are
statistically analyzed. ~is called the surf similarity parameter, and q = tanp~H0 ' I La. tanfj is the sea bottom
slope.
It is possible to employ the following equation, which has been verified to accord well with experimental
results, for the 1/3 maximum wave runup height 65).
= 0.25+1.1,;
R113/Hs =3.0-0.15q
R113/ HS = 1.65
R113/ H,,
(O< q ~ 2.2)
(2.2 < q:s: 9.0)
(9.0< q)
-105-
(4.3.28)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(4) As for the wave runup height of a rubble slope, there is Van der Meer-Sten's equation available. 66)
ilR =aq,,,
(q,,, ~ 1.5)
(4.3.29)
Rx =bJ: c
H
.,,,,,
(q,,, ~ 1.5)
Here, the coefficient is shown in the following table. In addition, in ~,,,=tanPl~2xH.lgT,,,2, Hs is the
significant wave height at the water depth at the foot of a seawall, and T,,, is the mean period.
The following equation is proposed for the wave runup height of a slope that has permeability.
(4.3.30)
Rx
Rm.ax
R2%
R1110
Rlllo
1.12
0.96
0.77
0.77
R
0.47
1.34
1.17
0.94
0.88
0.60
0.55
0.46
0.42
0.41
0.34
2.58
1.97
1.45
1.35
0.82
(5) In the case of complex cross sections, studies into random waves are still insufficient but Saville's virtual slope
method 67) and Nakamura's modified virtual slope method 68) may be used for regular waves.
A "complex cross section" refers to the case where the sea bottom topography and the configuration and
location of the seawall are as shown in Fig. 4.3.lS.
CD
When the cross section can be considered to be complex, the runup height of the seawall is obtained as follows
(refer to Fig. 4.3.15).38)
(a) The wave breaking point B is determined from the deepwater wave characteristics.
(b) Next, the runup height R is assumed and the point A is set at the maximum runup point. Then, the points A
and B are joined by a straight line, and the gradient of this line yields the virtual gradient coto..
(c) The runup height for this virtual gradient is calculated using Fig. 4.3.16, and the calculated height is compared
with the initially assumed runup height. If the two do not agree, then a new runup height is assumed, and the
estimations are repeated. This iterative process is repeated until convergence is achieved.
(d) The value so obtained is taken to be the runup height for the complex cross section in question.
/
Actual cross section
S.W.L.
Virtual gradient a
-106-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
IO
0.002
0.004
0.001
8
6
Ho'
2 _L,
_Ji_
0.008- ~
0.012- ~
0.020
0.0290.0490.078 -
t:: J/~
1.0
Ho' 0.8
'
f-:::: ~
~ ~ ~ ~~ '\
,,,,
~0004
'~"'
~
' I'-.
'
0.6
0.4
h
l<H.'<3
0.2
'
H.'0
~ooos ~0:012
0.020
'
L,
o.18
0.1
0.1
0.2
0.4 0.60.81.0
6 810
20
40 60 80100
cot a
Fig. 4.3.16 Runup Height on a Slope
@ When the results obtained from this method are compared with actual experimental results for a complex cross
section, it is generally found that there is good agreement between the two, with the error usually being no more
than 10%. However, ifthe bottom slope is too gentle, the agreement between the two becomes poor, and so this
method is to only be used when the bottom slope is steeper than 1/30.
@ Fig. 4.3.17 shows experimental results 69) obtained for a bottom slope of lnO. This figure provides a useful
reference when estimating the runup height for a complex cross section with a gentle bottom slope.
6.0
5.0
4.0
3.0
R
2.0
R'
0
1.0
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
1
4 5 6 7 8910
20
30 40 60
cot a
Fig. 4.3.17 Runup Height on Seawall Located Closer to Land than Wave Breaking Point
-107-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
the design crown height because of wave irregularity when the crown height of a seawall is verified against the
significant waves, even if the scatter of the experimental data is not considered; in fact, in extreme cases as many
as about a half of the waves may exceed this height. Accordingly, the crown height of a seawall should not be
decided based purely on the runup height of regular waves; rather, it is necessary to give consideration to the
---.....
1.0
-- -----............
--
0.8
0.6
Kp
0.4
1
l+cos2a-tan2p (Russia)
0.050
0.060
0.2
0
10
20
30
40
so
60
p
Fig. 4.3.18 Relationship between wave Incident Angle and Runup Height
(Solid Lines: Experimental Values by Public Works Research Institute, Ministry of Construction)
4.0
3.0
->L
---- -2.0
R/Ho'
1.0
0.8
0.6
smoothW
~-- -~i:
..
~::~~~th
Surface
wave-dissifcating
concrete b oc~~- -
-::-
----
---.........::;::..:.:.: -~
....__
-...~
.......
0.4
0.3
'a.
....._
~
1:1.51:1.25
1:2
r-.. .. 1:2.5
l: 3 1:1.25
-~ '
"' "
'':; .,1:1.5
~1:2
~r~
""r-.... 1:4
0.2
1:5
0.02
0. 3 0. 6
0.04
0.1
0.2
H 0/L0
Fig. 4.3.19 Reduction in Runup Height due to Wave-dissipating Work>
-108-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Table 4.3.4 Estimated Range for the Actual Wave Overtopping Rate relative to the Estimated Value
q/~2g(H0')3
Upright seawall
Wave-dissipating
type seawall
10-2
I0-3
10-4
10-5
0.7-1.5 times
0.4-2times
0.2-3 times
0.1-5 times
0.5-2times
0.2-3 times
0.1-5 times
0.05-10 times
Note that when obtaining rough estimates for the wave overtopping rate for random waves using Figs. 4.3.20
to 4.3.23, the following should be considered:
CD
If the actual values of the bottom slope and the deepwater wave steepness do not match any of the values on
the diagram, the diagram for which the values most closely match should be used, or alternatively interpolation
should be carried out.
@ The wave-dissipating concrete blocks in the figures are made up of two layers of tetrapods (upper armor layer
at the crown consists of2 rows). Therefore, even ifthe same kind ofwave-dissipating concrete block is used, if
there are differences in the crown width, in the way, or in the form of the toe, then there is a risk that the actual
wave overtopping rate may considerably differ from the value obtained by the diagrams.
If the number of rows of concrete blocks at the crown is increased, the wave overtopping quantity tends to
decrease.75)
When there are difficulties in applying the diagrams for estimating the wave overtopping rate, the approximate
equation of Takayama et al.76) may be used.
-109-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2
.,.+-++-bt-1~-+---+--+---+---+--+--+---.l'l-=110-2
h/H0 '
q(m3/m/s)
2
2 t-----t-10-3 I----+-----.~
2
.-~7"'t------==--E---!'c--'ll<-+"ot-+-+-+"-'l"-oiiiott1~--+___,--t- +-__.,,,._,..._,,.......,~10-3
I~ ~ ,________,_,__,,____-r------,.......
~ I~
~ 104 ~=----+--~+?--+--+-~~+---+-+~l'r+'H-~
~
2 >-----,!L--------'-'1---<,_____,o+---10-5 ~--+--+--~-+---+---t-5
t------+#~-O-.-+-+----+---+----+---+--+-....+-+-+--+-->." r+-t~~...._,,,_,____.--t-+-t--t---+-t
10~
-0.5
2
10~
0.5
1.0
1.5
5 10-1
q(m3/m/s)
2
10-3
5
'"6-0 2
104
~
5
2
10-s
5
2
'6Cl
~
2
10-s
5
2
10~
10~
-0.5
0.5
1.0
1.5
3 4 56 8 10104 2
hiHo'
5 10-3 2 510-2 2
5 10-1
q(m3/m/s)
Fig. 4.3.20 Diagrams for Estimating Wave Overtopping Rate for Upright Seawall (Bottom Slope 1/30)
-110-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
------.... :::-r-... I j
---:: ------:..- __ ,.._ _... --- ~.. "~h~~I
__ ....
~ ...'... '
\.. .. ~. .... ~
0
...... -- ----- ~ ,\ ',r--..... ....:ls
...
I I I I I I I I I
I I I I
2
10-2 =h/Bot,;JJ.5 5 ===------. ':):1..,.- --- .... ,:-..-(,)~I /
,,'~
2 -\~l _,,. /.,
=:
ii;- /
.:---\
,V
I)
,........\.
//
,
, /
I I
--
'
.,s"
~I/
2
10-s
5
2
10"6
~\)
-__,..
=
- (a) H0 '/L 0=-0.0l2
I I I I
..().5
\r'
I I I I
I I I I
0.5
I I I I
1.0
'
'
':>.~/
"
,,, ....
,'
....--
....
'
'1-,I=
-----
\.'
I~ '/,' ,~
, ~I
,~
I Ill
2
10-6
5 10-1
I I Ill
I I 11 11
510-2 2
~.
...... 0.75
......
II
I S
I ,_.
1\ ~
'I
I.
1.-~
\ ,
~ ... t v
I\. /'
v.
Ir_/,.
/ /
/
5
2
/ j 'A ~~
~
'/, '/, , ,
x.c:. n.. ~ I'// '=
//'A,i~! (}'
, ir
/ / j 'A ~,~
~
/ ~ 'A I':'l
2
'::>..~/
11 / '/, ~
i ~ 'p ,'.;
I'
'i I
~
o 11 ~ ~'l
I I I
v 10-22
11
\I~.
2
10-s
5
,~
\~ol'.' \ ~ :~~
.. \ s
iJ
" \' ' ' ... .. rf1..
.. IJ ~
..~<s I
' ' ' ..... .. Iii:
~ 5
q(m3/m/s)
.....
....... r--.
--- ----- -~',\ '
~.I
(V / ~ 'A, ;'l:.~
' \:t:.~
I'
.>.
V,
N 1
.......
'/,' ,_
-~ 5
~Q-~~
v ,/ 'A I'~'l
I
'-.~I
~ 2
,/'/,- ~ 10-3
/ /
Ill
/ 10-2
hiHo'
I I
3 4 5 6 8 1010"42 5 10-32
I ll
I E
';;~s:
I I I I
1.5
I I
I =I
\' \ ' ...... /-0
.,
.....
' ' ' ~"" Ji-~
\
,'/
I ll
,,',,
I I
,~
,~l"I I Ill
3 4 5 6 8 1010-42 5
10-s
=5
=2
11 1111
10-3 2
10-6
5 10-1
11 Ill
510"2 2
q(m3/m/s)
h!Ho'
2
~~'-r-~--.---::;;;----+---=::t-t-t-t-t-H-t-+-t-~l/i=--t--t--t--t--t--t--t-~""'10-2
I~~
~
2
10-3 l=--::::;;;o"'1"-->'"-;.
5
5
2
L:..t-:..-*=~~~++++~...+-+,,j.{f-k-+-+-+- +--.1'1--bl''-""Ml'S~ 0-3
10-4 _ _....._..........,...........__,_~
~ I~
.----+----1---+'r-T-+"r++-+-+"'i-lo.rlr1=-~<t--__.,....,..:H'n~~-+-~10-4 ~
5
2
5
2
F----+-#-+--r--+-,___ _
=r-11~.,,,....~~-r---r--r---r---t-=tl0"5
10..s
10"~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~,-..~~~~~~~~-10"
-0.5
0.5
1.0
1.5
3 4 5 6
hiHo'
8 1010-42 5 10-3 2
510-2 2
q(m3/mfs)
Fig. 4.3.21 Diagrams for Estimating Wave Overtopping Rate for Upright Seawall
(Bottom Slope 1/1 O}
-111-
5 10-1
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2
I0-2
5
i"'
'SO
(a) H0/L0=0.012
" _,, , , , , . _. . . . . .
--
I ~oiJl.
....
, .,.,,,..- r-.
~ '
111
h.,/If,0
.._....._
I 11
.s,I'
I I
"'I
/
~
I0-2
5
/i
/ ,/ 2
2 - \ \ 7 ~~y'' /
_,........
... _ 0.75
/ /,~ IO-'
IO-'
'
, ,~
\':!!,,~ i" /
11"
~
,,.,~/
'5
'
r
b'" / _,,
~/r:./.,; ~ 'A
r
- /
_,,, "','Y,"
' .... ,..J.01
11.
','
2 ,,.
, / ,''",':} ~,,_, ....
,
I II
~~
1'I '
10-<
/
/
IO-'
~
'/.
'/, , <:; r~<s
I/
'
5 - ,'
~
5 ~
~
~,,
' ' ~I
I '''
/ /,. 'A //
'
2
2
"i2'
./ /, /, /
J
I
' I ,'/ WAI
IO-'
IO-'
;'
"hc:t r. ' ' / I ii ,,, , ~ ,'
/
=
5
5
-f;.>.
, I ~ ""It..~~'" \ 'd "/,
=/
!'
I
'
30
~
'
2
2
1
I I' I /1 /
I I I I
1I /1 1!1 I I
I~
'' "'
'' ""'
'' "' IO-'
2 3 4 5 6 8 lOI0-'2 5 I0-3 2 5 I0-2 2 5 I0-1
0
0.5
1.0
1.5
_,,
'
,.
,.t<'S_/
I ,,...,.
'
'
(b)H0/L0=0.017
~. . . . . . . .b :30
, ...............
2
v, I0-2
hk;'0 "-0.s
I
q(m'imis)
hfHo'
h,,j
~ I~
;'l
,_o
,,
,,,
"'"
,,
2
Io-2
5
//. 2
2
~ "/, ~
:_,,<:>/ /
cJ'
IO-'
Io-3
. -i.~~
,/
,
~
,,.,~/
~~
b
,
/
,_
5 =-'\'
,.
,,
r
/ ,
r
7 <:;">-,
'
~
11
~~/r:Y/o, ".'. "~ / ,, <:;
-
.o
2
'SO
/
,' . . ,:y t.. _,'
v / ,_,,,
A. ~:.,
II
'
I0-4
,
..........
/
,'Yl,
/
/
h
'
5 , , ,' ~\':!!
5 ~
,~
_,,, I I
/ /,- 'A //
~ ,'
~
,
2
2 ,,
I ,">-,
,
,/ /,
I' I'
I
, <:;
~
'
I0-5
IO-'
! I I "-l
~ IY, 'h /
'
5
5 ' I
~ ;~
',~)s
I
I
'
2
2
'
'
11
'~01-.
I I 11111
I I
I I 11111 IO-'
10.. I / , I I ~,"I I I 1/1 I /1 I I
"'
2 3 4 5 6 8 I0104 2 5 10-3 2 5 I0-2 2 5 I0- 1
1.0
0
0.5
1.5
i"'
Iv
,.
', ,,
" ,,,,
'- !ti~
_I
2
10-3
5
'SO 2
10-4
5
~
"'
2
10-5
5
2
IO..
he
q(m'imls)
-~
"._
'
(c) H0/L0-0.036
l II
'V
~~!1
, loo_ .........
= ;;,?/ /
= t// ""' /
'I'"/
' '1;
= / , / ,.,,,
b ~'
=/ , J
J ''
I
= ;'
I ,
-:
l11 I
/, I I !1
0.5
_,
lo'
--- -- - .. ,,.,
......~,
I /1 I
0:1~
-j.;~--
---
,':V
1.0
.... r-.._
-~.,
"
h.!li;, '=O.s
:30
....
=IO"'~
h/Ho'
2
10-2
5
~ I~
..,
I I I
1.5
.i
'
1.25
- ....
1.5
"
,,.,~/
/ I/
~~
=/
~ /
/ /,
,/
'/,
,,
v.: "A //
4
IJ5
,,
,, ,
'A //
,,,~/r/ f\>/o,".'.
A.''>1
2
10-2
5
,,
, , ,_
/,
,,~
~
=
-
2
10-'
=5
' / 'h
,,/
,~
2
IO..
3 4 5 6 8 10104 2 5 10-3 2 510-2 2 5 10-1
rrI
,;
I I Ill
I I Ill
I I
11111
q(m'lmls)
Fig. 4.3.22 Diagrams for Estimating Wave Overtopping Rate for Wave-dissipating Type Seawall {Bottom Slope 1/30)
-112-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
q(m'/m/s)
hfHo'
'
2
10'
I= h/H.o':-0.S~
5
2
10-'
5
2
10-
--''
\.?.~....-
~a,,/
~1
~
--' ,,.
......
I i
';_/ IJ
/ 111
'
0.5
'
..~'l.<s:
/
= /
~ '/,
'"
,'
, Ill
~
~
0
2
10-'
';;) 2
104
&
'
~,,v~
~~?
510-2 2
510-3 2
tf 1~
I
---. /
\);_........
~//'
/
~I
q(m'/m/s)
~1
2
I _,'
10-'
= '
5
-l
2
~.
'
I
lo-' '/,' 7'.
0
'
~~,
0.5
'
-...
--..,
Ill
I 1"'7
I i1
1.0
Ill 1 I
1.5
-'~
~/r
I I
1
.I
I=
'4
, Ill
~
/,i ~
'/. ,~
~, :~
,
3 4 5 6 8 101042
hiHo'
/ I/
~ /
T">-o..._l.s
,[7j
,, '
,,
/
'V
II
'
,,..~/
~
M,"- 'A
/ / '.1(.i"
I I
1.25
'
"t<o
I/
=
2
10-2
/
5
/ .I 2
'/., ,
/
LO
I'-~
\,";l/ ......................
"
"
o.7J
ti-
-....
...._./C,/
..........
2
10
510- 1
11 1111
I I Ill
6~0 LJJ
-..
__,
104
5 -,;,
II
(c) H0/L0=-0.036
~-
~ I~
2
10'
=
5
-
h!Ho'
2
10-2
I I 1111
456 8101042
~~"
~ "//
.,;01
1.5
,{
",~
,,
/, '.1
1.0
,,
/ v. 'A ,,,
,
{'.>.
I I
,,..~/
~/M,~ "4 /
'~
I I I I
2
10-2
/
5
/l.1
2
./, '" 10'
.I '4
'
/
l''"
~,..;._1.0
' ~
l>il u\'
.5
,,,,~
I I:
1-
'
, , c:... /,.....-
I-
'
,' I
....
"
"
~ /": ____1\-1?--/ /
11.:\l..--
~
'
';;) 2
10-4 I:
&
,..
'' "'
,,
~
-
2
10-'
5
=
-
'' "'
5 10-3 2 510-2 2
q(m'imls)
Fig. 4.3.23 Diagrams for Estimating Wave Overtopping Rate for Wave-dissipating Type Seawall (Bottom Slope 1/10)
-113-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Type
Armor Layer
Seawall
Levee
Paved behind
Not paved behind
Covered with concrete on 3 sides
Crown paving/rear slope non constructed
Crown not oaved
Table 4.3.6 Allowable Wave Overtopping Rate in view of State of Land Use
User
Pedestrian
Automobile
House
2 x J0-4
3 x 10-5
2 x J0-5
1 x J0-6
7 x J0-5
1 x J0-6
Table 4.3.6 is a table created with the results where people who watch a wave overtopping observation video
make a judgment, and indicates a wave overtopping rate that at least that percentage of people judged to be safe.
Table 4.3.7 Permissible Wave of Overtopping Rate in view of Degree of Importance of Hinterland (m'/m/s)
Around0.01
Around0.02
0.02-0.06
-114-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
upright seawall and still give the same wave overtopping quantity; in other words, the seawall under study has
a form that is effective in reducing the wave overtopping rate. Below are the reference values for the equivalent
crown height coefficient Pfur typical types of seawall.
Wave-dissipating block type seawall 76)
: p = 0.9- 0.7
Vertical-slit type seawall 76)
: p = 0.6
Parapet retreating type seawall 75)
: p = 1.0- 0.5
Stepped seawall 75)
: p = 1.7 - 1.0
When the waves are obliquely incident 82), 83):
P= {
1-sin2 6l
1-sin2 30=0.75
.,..
~
~...
1
"to
Hl"1
7~
7.2
6.8
7.2
13,3
2
l/Ulx
s
2
s
2
1o"'
lo" 2
s 10""
Gradient Llh
10"3 2
102 2
101
(m3/m2/hYm
Fig. 4.3.24 Wind Effect on Spatial Gradient of Horizontal Distribution of Wave Overtopping Quantity 1ai
-115-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
.... ,
IYTI
1~J.~
"i-.
i-. ....
d/h=0.7
0.8
~ ~~
~
0.6
0.4
'
~ ~ f'-B>ij JlI_
.
'
dlh=-0.3
::;:.g~~:
,,,' ...., ,,
' .... ..' ' '
, .... , ....
dlh=-0
~,..
0.2
....
'
,.. ........
""
-2.5
-2.0
-1.5
-1.0
--0.5
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
86)
(5) For composite breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating concrete blocks, sloping breakwaters covered with
wave-dissipating concrete blocks, and other such breakwaters, experiments on the transmitted wave height have
been carried out by the Civil Engineering Research Institute of Hokkaido Development Bureau.87), 88)
(6) Coefficient of Wave Transmission of Structures
CD
For a porous and permeable structure such as a sloping breakwater or a wave-dissipating concrete block type
breakwater, Kondo's 53) theoretical analysis may be referred to. The following empirical equation may be used
to obtain the coefficient of wave transmission of a typical structure.
Stone breakwater 89):
(4.3.31)
-116-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
where
k, : k, = 1.26(:.
r"
r"
in the case of
@ For a curtain wall type breakwater, the empirical solutions ofMorihira et al.90) may be used.
@ For the coefficient of wave transmission of an upright breakwater of permeable type that has slits in both the
front and rear walls, the experimental results 52) are available.
Types of breakwater aiming to promote the exchange of seawater include multiple-wing type permeable
breakwaters, multiple vertical-cylinder breakwaters, horizontal-plate type permeable breakwaters, and pipe
type permeable breakwaters. The coefficient of wave transmissions ofthese types of breakwater are obtained.52)
(!) When constructing structures within the breaker zone, it is preferable to consider the phenomenon of wave setup
as necessary, which occurs in the breaker zone owing to wave breaking as they approach the coast.
(2) Rise of the mean water level due to breaking waves
The phenomenon where the mean water level near the shoreline rises due to breaking waves, so-called "wave set
up", was known long ago through observations at the seashore and so on, but theoretical proof about the causes
for the occurrence of this phenomenon has been lacking. In 1962, Longuet-Higgins and Stewart 91) indicated
that when a series of waves whose wave height varies approach the shore, this becomes the conveyance of a large
momentum at the places where the wave height is large, and it becomes smaller at the places where the wave height
is small, so apparent stress ends up being generated, and the mean water level changes. This apparent stress was
termed the radiation stress. This radiation stress is an amount proportionate to the square of the wave height, and
-117-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
0.25
0.20
'.,.
8=1/10
0.15
0.10
ta
0.05
.s
-0.05
-0.10
0.20
'.,.
tanll=l/100
0.15
0.10
~~
0.05
~
.s
0.08
0
..
.r
-0.05
-0.10
0.5
0.45
0.40
).,.
'
0.35
\
\
0.30
ita
e
.s
.,.
iii!
0.25
0.20
0.15
10
'\
'
=\
'
'
-
tanll=l/10
1/20
'IJ
" 1/50
l/loo"
r--.....
...
......
r-~
....... r-.,...
~ ::::: ~
0.05 0.1
-118-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
0.35
0.3
........
"""
i::
0.25
"il
0.2
.2
fta
::s"
.......
'-.....
.~
. . . ... ....
...._
0.15
0.1
0.05
,_
......
.....
.. ::~
~
......... I"'--. ................ _
Seabed slope
r--.: ,......::::.::--1110
'~
---------- ----------
,_
.............._
r--..
~~
. ..... ,.,
!" .. ..,~ ~,
1/20
1/30
1/50
1/100
,_
...1--i- .,_
.....-::.:.:_.....
0
0.001
--- -~
O.oJ
~.:..:
,,,
I"".......
._~
......
-.
0.1
(5) Consideration of the rise in mean water level in the performance verification
Since the wave breaking point varies, and the breaking wave height becomes larger, owing to the rise of the mean
water level, it is important to consider the rise in mean water level in order to carry out accurate computation of
(!) Surf beat with a period of one to several minutes, which occurs along with wave deformation in shallow waters, is
examined, as necessary.
(2) Random wave height fluctuations lasting one to several minutes in the vicinity ofthe shoreline are called surf beat,
and this has a major effuct on the runup height of waves, wave overtopping and stability of beaches at the beach.
It is preferred that the size of the surf beat is estimated as appropriate by either Goda's approximation formulas 58)
or on-site observations.
(3) Goda's Formulas for Estimating Surf Beat Amplitude
Based on the results of field observations of surf beat, Goda 58) has proposed the following relationship:
0.04('1...... )o
0.01H0
(1
Ho' + _Ii_)
L,,
Ho'
(4.3.32)
where
C....., : root mean square amplitude of the surf beat wave profile
('Inn.Jo: root mean square amplitude of the deepwater wave profile
Ho' : equivalent deepwater wave height
Lo : wavelength in deepwater
h : water depth
This equation shows that the amplitude of the surf beat is proportional to the deepwater wave height, that it
falls as the water depth increases, and that it increases as the deepwater wave steepness (Ho 'IL 0) decreases.
-119-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
0.4
0.2
'=
0.1
0.08
<11~)0
0.06
0.04
0.02
0.01
b.
...
~-~-~-~-~~~~~~
0.1
0.2
0.4
H.'
h
[-'-(1+-,)
Lo
Ho
0.6
0.8 LO
]'/2
or soft countenneasures.93)
When conspicuous water level fluctuations within the period several minutes or longer occur at an observation
point in a harbor, it is highly likely that the phenomenon of "seiche" is taking place. This phenomenon occurs
when small disturbances in water level generated by changes in air pressure out at sea are amplified by the natural
frequency of the harbor or bay. If the amplitude of such seiche becomes significantly large, inuodation at the head
of the bay or reverse outflow from municipal drainage chancels may occur. Also high current velocities may
occur locally in a harbor, resulting in breaking of the mooring ropes of small ships. When drawing up a harbor
plan, it is thus preferable to give consideration to making the shape of the harbor to minimize the seiche motion
as much as possible. At marinas and other small ports, the natural frequency of the port may be close to the
frequency oflong-period waves and the propagation oflong-period waves from the open sea may excite the seiche
in the port. The two aspects are therefore highly correlated. If seiche excitation by long-period waves becomes
apparent from observations or numerical calculations, it is preferable to deliberate couotermeasures while giving
thought to these aspects.
(3) Critical Wave Height for Cargo Handling Works Effected by Long-period Waves
It is necessary to give due consideration to the fact that long-period waves in front of a quaywall can induce
ship surging with the amplitude of several meters through resonance. The critical wave height for smooth cargo
-120-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
handling works effected by long-period waves depends on the factors such as the wave period, the dimensions
of the ship in question, the mooring situation, and the loading conditions. Nevertheless, according to field
observations carried out in Tomakomai Bay, 96) it corresponds to a significant wave height of about 10 - 15 cm.
(4) Calculating Propagation ofLong-period Waves
It is preferable to calculate the propagation oflong-period waves into a harbor by setting up incident wave boundary
out at sea and then using either the Boussinesq equation 97) or a calculation method that uses long linear wave
equations.98)
(5) Standard Spectrum for Long-period Waves
When there are insufficient field observation data of long-period waves out at sea and the long-period waves
conditions that determine the external forces are not established, the standard spectrum shown in reference 99) or
its approximate expression may be used for the long-period waves performance verifications.
Fig. 4.4.1 shows a comparison between an observed spectrum and an approximate form of the standard
spectrum. The term a 1 in the diagram is a parameter that represents the energy level of the long-period waves.
This shows the relationship between the spectrum peak frequency of short-period wave components and boundary
frequency lb for calculating the energy oflong-period waves components. From the past observations, the value
is between 1.6 and 1.7. The smaller the value of ab the larger the energy of the long-period waves becomes.
Observed spectrum
10-1
~
.......
~
,.....
......
'-'
ti'.)
10-2
10-3
fl J;,
Fig. 4.4.1 Comparison between Standard Spectrum with Long-period Components and Observed Spectrum
-121-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
be examined beforehand and appropriate measures should be devised based on suitable numerical calculations.
There are many instances where long-period waves are reflected and amplified by the facilities in a harbor,
and in particular upright wave-dissipating revetments have almost no wave-dissipating function for long-period
waves and swells, so it is necessary to revise the reflection coefficient of the facilities in estimation of the longperiod waves height inside harbors. The Environment Assessment Manual of Long-Period Waves in Harbors JOO)
can be used as a reference for the rough order of magnitude and calculation method of the reflection coefficient.
Long-period wave-dissipating revetments that employ backfilling materials of a two-sided slit caisson wall that
has a slit wall on both sides and a gravel material with a large particle diameter allow waves to pass through and
dampen long-period waves have been developed as an engineering method that lowers the long-period waves
height inside harbors.
The width of the transmitting layer with the gravel material is preferably 50 to 100 meters. It is preferable
to set the width of the water transmitting layer, place of installation and installation range so that the maximum
effects are achieved in the hydraulic model test and numerical calculations. Since the distribution of long-period
waves is not uniform within the harbor, it is preferable to examine as well modifications of the berth location at the
planning stage in the event that it is clear that the long-period waves in the target berth exceed the limit values.
(9) Distinction between Long-period Waves and Harbor Resonance
In an ordinary harbor, the period of harbor resonance is longer than that oflong-period waves by several minutes,
and it is possible to distinguish the two from analysis of the oscillation period. However, the period of harbor
resonance may become shorter to 2 to 3 minutes in the case of small craft basins and marinas, and this makes
the discrimination difficult. In that case, it is preferable to make a judgment as suitable based on the observation
results for offshore waters and the circumstances in the surrounding harbor.
@ The problem of harbor calmness is extremely complex. It involves not only physical factors such as waves,
winds, ship motions, and the wind- and wave-resistance of working machinery, but also the factors requiring
human judgment, such as the easiness of ships entering and leaving of harbor, ship refuge during stormy
weather, and the critical conditions of works at sea. The harbor calmness is further related with the economic
factors, such as the efficiency of cargo handling works, the operating rate of ships, and the cost of constructing
the various facilities required to improve the harbor calmness. The factors that lead to wave disturbances in
harbors, which constitute the basis of the criteria for determining the harbor calmness, include the following:
(a) Waves penetrating through the harbor entrance
(b)Transmitted waves into the harbor
(c) Reflected waves
(d)Long-period waves
(e) Harbor seiche
In large harbors, wind waves generated within the harbor may require attention, and the ship waves by larger
ships may cause troubles for small ships.
(2) Points to remember when carrying out harbor calmness calculations
It is necessary to bear the following points in mind when carrying out harbor calmness calculations.
Q) Set the wave height and period frequency distribution at the port entrance.
@ In the event that the depth of navigation channel differs markedly from the surrounding water depth, or shoals
may exist inside the harbor, or the water depth changes suddenly in the port entrance, consider the water depth
change inside the harbor to the extent possible in the calculation of wave height inside the harbor.
@ Introduce the effects of the period as concerns the permissible value of the wave height in the harbor.
@ Consider the future state of the use of ports as concerns the target value for harbor calmness.
(3) Computation of Harbor Calmness
The harbor calmness can be calculated with the temporal probability of the occurrence of a wave height that does
not exceed the critical wave height for cargo handling works or the critical wave height for anchoring. The critical
wave height for cargo handling works is the wave height of the limit at which the ships moored at the quaywall or
dolphin can safely perform cargo handling activities. The critical wave height for anchoring is the wave height at
which anchoring in the basin and buoy mooring as well as mooring at the mooring facilities is possible. Here, the
temporal probability of the occurrence of a wave height that exceeds the critical wave height for cargo handling
-122-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
works is called the cargo handling operating rate, and in general the harbor calmness is assessed as the cargo
handling operating rate (see Fig. 4.5.1).
*--Hearings
from ship owners, and past disaster results
Observation, prediction and numerical analysis, etc.
using the manual for long-period waves, etc.
[No]
[Yee]
I Stringent analysis
method
.,.
,------------ --------
-~.,
Conventional
method
II
!~analysis
I Detailed analysis
II
method
'"--
.
I
----"'
CD
-123-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 4.5.1 Critical Wave Height for Cargo Handling Works for Long-Period Waves
Assumed conditions
102)
0.20
0.15
0.10
(2) Ship waves are caused when ships navigate. The large the ship is and the faster its speed is, the greater is the wave
height of ship waves. When the propagation distance of ship waves becomes larger they end up attenuating, so
they cause no serious problems in wide water areas. However, there are cases when they cause motions in small
ships under anchor, floating docks, etc. inside harbors, in narrow. In addition, there are also cases where they
have an effect on wave overtopping at revetments on both sides of a waterway, scouring and stability of armored
blocks.
(3) Pattern of Ship Waves
If ship waves are viewed from air, it appears as shown in Fig. 4.6.1. It is composed oftwo groups of waves. One
group ofwaves spread out in a shape like "JV' from a point slightly ahead ofthe bow ofthe ship. The other group
of waves is behind the ship and is such that the wave crest is perpendicular to the ship's navigation line. The
former waves are termed the "divergent waves'', while the latter are termed the ''transverse waves". The divergent
waves form concave curves; the closer to the navigation line, the smaller the gap between waves. On the other
hand, the transverse waves are approximately arcshaped, with the gap between waves being constant. In deep
water, the area over which the ship waves extend is limited within the area bounded by the two cusplines with the
angles 1928' from the navigation line and starting from the origin lying somewhat in front of the bow ofthe ship.
The divergent waves cross the transverse waves just inside the cusplines; this is where the wave height is largest.
The wave steepness is smaller for the transverse waves than for the divergent waves, implying that the transverse
waves often cannot be distinguished from an aerial photograph.
-124-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
CD
The wavelength of the transverse waves can be obtained by the numerical solution of the following equation,
which is derived from the condition that the celerity of the transverse waves must be the same as the velocity at
which the ship is navigating forward.
2
gL, tanh 1th = V 2 : (provided V = /iii):
2tr
L1
(4.6.1)
where
L1
Note however that when the water is sufficiently deep, the wavelength of the transverse waves is given by the
following equation:
(4.6.2)
where
Lo : wavelength of transverse waves at places where the water is sufficiently deep (m)
V1 : ship's navigation speed (kt); Vk = l.946V
The period of the transverse waves is equal to the period of progressive waves with the wavelength L 1 in water
of depth h. It is given by equation (4.6.3) or (4.6.4).
(4.6.3)
2n
T0 = - V = 0.330Vk
(4.6.4)
where
period of transverse waves at places where the water is sufficiently deep (s)
@ The wavelength and period of the divergent waves are given by equations (4.6.5) and (4.6.6), which are derived
from the condition that the component of the ship's speed in the direction of travel of the divergent waves must
be equal to the celerity of the divergent waves.
(4.6.5)
T4
= T, cos(}
(4.6.6)
where
-125-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
90
ii
0.9
_T/:fg~0.8!6
!.s
0
:;)~
1
80
~.
70
....0
0.8
...
'
~I
"il
60
~~
50
40
35.3
=~
.,,o"""
~ :ll
"""
/
............. l;,/r_
----
'
I
:;) I
20
il :
",s
j]
10
""
-~~
0.6
0.5
f- -~
,soJiil
;
"
oj~~l
><(.
30
0.7
,...-
cos
- 0.3
0.2
"'.....
II I
0.1
'1
~.
'
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
6.5
7.0
7.5
v !, 0.7Jih
(4.6.7)
The critical water depth above which ship waves may be regarded as deepwater waves is calculated by
equation (4.6.7), as listed in Table 4.6.1. As can be seen from this table, the waves generated by ships in normal
conditions can generally be regarded as deepwater waves. Situations in which they must be regarded as shallow
water waves include the following cases: a high-speed ferry travels through relatively shallow waters, a motorboat
travels through shallow waters, and ship waves propagate into shallow waters. Note that ship waves in shallow
water have a longer wavelength and period than those generated by the ship navigating in deep water at the same
speed.
Table 4.6.1 Conditions under which Ship waves can be regarded as Deepwater Waves
5.0
7.5
10.0
12.5
15.0
17.5
20.0
25.0
30.0
1.4
3.1
5.5
8.6
12.4
16.9
22.0
34.4
49.6
1.7
2.5
3.3
4.1
5.0
5.8
6.6
8.3
9.9
(!:_,_)
"'
100
EHPW
(4.6.8)
1620L,VK
where
Ho : characteristic wave height of ship waves (m), or the maximum wave height observed at a distance
of 100 m from the navigation line when a ship is navigating at its full-load cruising speed
L, : length of the ship (m)
VK : full-load cruising speed (kt)
EHPW : wave-generation horsepower (W)
-126-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
dimensions.
(4.6.9)
EHPW =EHP-EHPF
E HP = 0.6S HPm
(4.6.10)
1
3
EHPF=2pSV, CF
(4.6.11)
S=2.5~VL,
CF= o.01y(1og
v,:,
-2
(4.6.12)
(4.6.13)
where
SHPm
Po
V0
Cp
v
V
Po=l030(kg/m3)
Vo= 0.514VK
v"'l.2x!0-6 (m2/s)
Equation (4.6.13) has been obtained by assuming that the energy consumed through wave-generation resistance
is equal to the propagation energy of ship waves, while the values of the coefficients have been determined as
averages from the data from ship towing tank tests. The characteristic wave height H 0 varies from ship to ship,
although for medium and large-size ships it is about LO - 2.0 m. Tugboats sailing at full speed produce relatively
large ship waves.
It is considered that the wave height attenuates in proportional to s-11.1, where S is the distance of the
observation point from the navigation line. It is also considered that the wave height is proportional to the cube
of the cruising speed of the ship. Accordingly equation (4.6.13) has been obtained by assuming that the energy
consumed through wave-generation resistance is equal to the propagation energy of ship waves, while the values
ofthe coefficients have been determined as averages from the data from ship towing tank tests. The characteristic
wave height H 0 varies from ship to ship, although for medium and large-size ships it is about 1.0 - 2.0 m. Tugboats
sailing at full speed produce relatively large ship waves.
It is considered that the wave height attenuates in proportional to S-113, where Sis the distance ofthe observation
point from the navigation line. It is also considered that the wave height is proportional to the cube of the cruising
speed of the ship. Accordingly:
(4.6.14)
where
maximum height of ship waves at any chosen observation point (m)
S : distance from the observation point to the navigation line (m)
v, : actual cruising speed of the ship(kt)
Hmax :
Equation (4.6.14) cannot be applied if Sis too small. However, equation (4.6.14) can be applied when either
the ship length Ls or 100 m, whichever is the smaller.
The upper limit of the height of ship waves occurs when the wave steepness of the maximum wave of the
divergent wave reach to the breaking criterion of Hmax1L 1 = 0.14. If the angle between the wave direction and the
navigation line is assumed to be0= 50' at the point on a divergent wave where the wave height becomes largest,
the upper limit of the wave height at any given point is given by equation (4.6.15). However, the conditions for
deepwater waves shall be satisfied.
H """' =0.0IOV,
(4.6.15)
where
Hiunit : upper limit of the height of ship waves as defined by the wave breaking conditions (m)
-127-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) Among two groups of ship waves, the transverse waves propagate in the direction of ship's navigation line, and
continue to propagate even if the ship changes course or stops. In this case, the waves have a typical nature
of regular waves with the period being given by equation (4.6.3), and they propagate at the group velocity,
undergoing transformation such as refraction and others. Takeuchi and Nanasawa 105) gave an example of such
transformations. Note however that as the waves propagate, the length ofwave crest spreads out, and even when
the water is of uniform depth, the wave height attenuates in a manner inversely proportional to the square root
of the distance traveled.
@ The direction of propagation of a divergent wave varies from point to point on the wave crest. According to
Kelvin's theory of wave-generation, the angle between the direction of propagation and the navigation line
is 0= 35.3 at the outer edge of a divergent wave. As one moves inwards along the wave crest, the value of 0
approaches 90. The first wave arriving at a any particular point has the angle 0= 35.3, while 0 getting gradually
larger for subsequent waves. This spatial change in the direction of propagation of the divergent waves can be
estimated using Fig. 4.6.2.
@ The propagation celerity of a divergent wave at any point on the wave crest is the group celerity corresponding
to the period Td at that point (see equation (4.6.6)). In the illustration in Fig. 4.6.2, the time needed for a
component wave to propagate at the group celerity from the point Q at wave source to the point P is equal to
the time taken for the ship to travel at the speed V from the point Q to the point 0. Since each wave profile
propagates at the wave celerity (phase velocity), the waves appear to pass beyond the cuspline and vanish one
after the other at the outer edge of the divergent waves.
(8) Generation of Solitary Waves
When a ship navigates through shallow waters, solitary waves are generated in front of the ship if the cruising
speed Vk (mis) approaches ..fgTi. Around the river mouths, there is a possibility of small ships being affected by
such solitary waves generated by other large ships.106)
101), 10s)
-128-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
In general, it may be assumed that the larger the wave height, the greater the wave force becomes. It is thus
acceptable to focus on the wave force of the highest wave among a train of random waves attacking the structure.
However, with regard to the stabilities of concrete blocks or armor stones on the slope and wave force acting on
the floating structures and cylindrical structures with small rigidity, it is preferable to consider the effect of the
CD
The major parameters that affect the wave force acting on an upright wall are wave period, wave height, wave
direction, water level, water depth, bottom slope, water depth of the crown of the foundation mound, the front
berm width of foundation mound, slope of foundation mound, the crown height of upright wall, and water depth
at base of the upright wall. In addition, it is also necessary to consider the effect of the wall alignment. The
wave force on an upright wall with a concaved alignment may be larger than that on an upright, straight wall of
infinite length. Furthermore, if the front of upright wall is covered with wave-dissipating concrete blocks, the
characteristics of these blocks and the crown height and width will affect the wave force.
CD
Goda's formula
(a) It is standard to calculate the maximum horizontal wave force acting on an upright wall and the simultaneous
uplift using Goda's formula as shown below. Goda's formula is that proposed by Goda taking into consideration
wave pressure experiments and results of application of the formula to the existing breakwaters and modified
to include the effects of wave direction. Its single-equation formula enables one to calculate the wave force
from the standing to breaking wave conditions without making any abrupt transition. However, where the
upright wall is located on a steep seabed, or built on a high mound, and is subjected to a strong impulsive
wave pressure due to breaking waves, the formula may underestimate the wave force. It should therefore
be carefully applied with consideration of the possibility of occurrence of impulsive wave pressure due to
breaking waves (see 4.7.2 (4) Impulsive Breaking Wave Force).
The wave pressure given by Goda's formulas takes the hydrostatic pressure at the still water condition as
-129-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
the refurence value. Any hydrostatic pressure before wave action should be considered separately. Further,
the formula aims to examine the stability of the whole body of an upright wall. When breaking wave actions
exist, the formula does not necessarily express the local maximum wave pressure at the respective positions;
thus such should be considered during examination of the stress of structural members.
(b) Wave pressure on the front face according to the Goda's formulas
The wave pressure on the front face of an upright wall in the Goda's formula is a linear distribution. Wave
pressure is 0 at the height expressed as 'I* in equation (4.7.1), maximum value expressed as p 1 in equation
(4.7.2) at still water level, and expressed as p 2 in equation (4.7.3) at the sea bottom. The formula considers
wave pressure from the bottom to the crown of the upright wall (see Figs. 4.7.1and4.7.2) .
(4.7.1)
., = 0.75(1+cosp}A,H0
p
=0.5(1+cosP){ a
,A., +a
A. 2 cos 2 P )p,gH 0
Pi
(4.7.2)
(4.7.3)
p, = cosh(2nh/L)
(4.7.4)
In this equation, 11*, Pb p 2, p 3, p 0, g, p, Ab A2 , h, L, Hn, ab ai and a3 respectively represent the following
values:
11 : height above still water level at which intensity of wave pressure is 0 (m)
p 1 : intensity of wave pressure at still water level (kN/m2)
p 2 : intensity of wave pressure at sea bottom (kN/m2)
p 3 : intensity of wave pressure at toe of the upright wall (kNhn2)
p,g : unit weight of water (kN/m3)
p : angle between the most dangerous direction within the range of 15 from the main wave
direction and the line perpendicular to the faceline of the upright wall (")
.<" .< 2 : wave pressure correction factor (1.0 is the standard value)
h : water depth in front of the upright wall (m)
L : wavelength at water depth h used in calculation as specified in the item (d) below (m)
HD : wave height used in calculation as specified in the item (d) below (m)
a 1 : value expressed by the following equation:
a _ 06 +1
1
{
-
4nh/L
sinh(4nh/ L) }
(4.7.5)
_I)_
HD
_ . {hb-d(HD)' 2d}
3hb d HD
a2 - m m - - - , -
(4.7.6)
h'{1
a, =l-h
1
}
cosh(2nh/L)
(4.7.7)
In this equation, hb. d and h' respectively represent the following values:
hb :water depth at an offshore distance of 5times the significant wave height from the upright
wall(m)
d : water depth at the crest of either the foot protection works or the mound armoring units of
whichever is higher (m)
h' : water depth at toe of the upright wall (m)
-130-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
'
,'.I1/"
I
I
(4.7.8)
In this equation, Pu and l 3 respectively represent the following values:
(4.7.9)
In this equation, Hmax and H113 respectively represent the following values:
Hmax : highest wave height of incident waves as a progressive wave at the water depth of !be upright
H 113
wall(m)
significant wave height ofincident waves as a progressive wave at the water depth of the upright
wall(m)
-131-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
verifications in general, it is necessary to use the wave parameters of the largest wave force from a wave
group. The highest wave shall be subject to consideration. The occurrence of the highest wave in a random
wave group is probabilistic, and so it is not possible to determine the parameters of the wave explicitly.
Nevertheless, after examination of the results of applying the current method to breakwaters in the field, it is
standard to use 1.8 times the significant wave height as the height of the highest wave where no transformation
of breaking wave is observed. It has also become standard to use the wavelength corresponding to the
significant wave period as the wavelength of the highest wave.
In order to determine whether or not the highest wave is subject to wave breaking, the diagrams for
determining the highest wave height (Fig. 4.3.10 (a)-{e) in 4.3.6 Wave Breaking) should be used by
referring to the location of the peak wave height in the zone in the onshore side of the 2% attenuation line. It
is acceptable to consider that the highest wave is not subject to wave breaking when the water is deeper than
that at the peak height, but that it is subject to wave breaking when the water is shallower than this. If the
highest wave height is to be obtained using the approximate equation (4.3.23) in 4.3.6 Wave Breaking, hb
should be substituted ash in the first term in the braces { } on the right-hand side of the equation.
If using a value other than 1.8 as the coefficient on the right-hand side of equation (4.7.9), it is necessary to
conduct sufficient examinations into the occurrence of the highest wave and then choose an appropriate value
(see 4.1 Basic Matters Relating to Waves).
a,.
-132-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
(h) Effect of wave direction in Goda's formula
Although results from a number of experiments on the effect ofwave direction on the wave force are available,
there are still many points that are unclear. Traditionally, for standing waves, no correction has been made
for wave direction to the wave force. The effects of wave direction have been considered only for breaking
waves, by multiplying the wave force by coSJ.p. However, this has resulted in the irrational situation whereby
the breaking wave force is assumed to decrease as the wave angle increases, reaching zero at the limiting
value p ~ 90, and yet standing waves are assumed to remain at the perfect standing wave condition. In other
words, because actual breakwaters are finite in extension, when the incident angle is large (i.e., oblique wave
incidence), it takes a considerably large distance from the tip of breakwater until the wave height becomes
two times the incident height. At the limiting value offJ= 90, it becomes an infinite distance. In this case, it
is appropriate to consider that the wave pressure of progressive waves acts on the upright wall. Furthermore,
even in cases where the breakwater can be taken to extend infinitely, when using second-order approximation
finite amplitude wave theory, the wave pressure form oblique incident waves decreases slightly in comparison
to incidence at right angles and its degree becomes proportionate to the wave steepness. Considering these
points and application to the breakwaters in the field, equation (4.7.2) for wave direction has been corrected by
multiplying a2 which represents mound effects with coSJ.p, and then multiplying the whole term by 0.5(1 +cosp).
@ Wave force and significant wave period for waves composed of two wave groups with different periods
Examples of two wave groups with different periods being superimposed are such a case that waves enter a bay
from the outer sea and another group of waves are generated within the bay. Another case is the superposition
of diffracted waves coming from the entrance of a harbor and waves transmitted by wave overtopping. In such
cases, the spectrum is bimodal (i.e., having two peaks), and there are actual cases of such observations in the
field. 120) Tanimoto, Kitamura et al.121)) carried out experiments on the wave force acting on the upright section
of a composite breakwater by using waves with a bimodal spectrum, and verified that Goda's formulas can
be applied even in such a case. They also proposed a method for calculating the significant wave period to be
used in the wave force calculation (see 4 Waves). If each frequency spectrum of the two wave groups before
superimposition can be considered to be a Bretschneider-Mitsuyasu type, the significant wave period after
superimposition may be obtained using the method by Tanimoto et al. Then this significant wave period may
be used in wave force calculation.
-133-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
resultant force is not significantly different to that without the footing. It is thus acceptable to ignore the footing,
and to assume that the uplift has a triangular distribution as shown in Fig. 4.7.3, with the uplift Pu at the front
toe being given by equation (4.7.8), and the uplift at the rear toe being zero. If the footing is extremely long,
however, it is necessary to calculate the uplift appropriately, considering the change in the uplift Pu' at the front
toe of the footing.
P 'u II
pu
Q) General
When the trough of a wave is at a wall, a negative wave force acts corresponding to the trough depth of the
water surface from the still water level. A negative wave force is a wave force that obtained through suitable
hydraulic model tests or through appropriate calculations. It is a force directed seaward and may be comparable
in magnitude to a positive wave force when the water is deep and the wavelength is short.
(4.7.10)
where
In addition, the negative uplift acting on the bottom of the upright wall can be assumed to act as shown
in Fig. 4.7.4. Specifically, it can be assumed that an uplift acts downwards with its intensity being Pn as
given by equation (4.7.10) at the front toe, zero at the rear toe, and having a triangular distribution in-between.
Incidentally, it is necessary to use the highest wave height as the wave height Hn used in the performance
verification.
-134-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Seaward
Shoreward
CD
General
An impulsive breaking wave force is generated when the wave front of a breaking wave strikes a wall surface.
It has been shown from model tests that under certain conditions the maximum wave pressure may rise as much
as several tens of times the hydrostatic pressure corresponding to the wave height (l.Op.gliv}. However, such a
wave pressure acts only locally and for a very short time, and even slight changes in conditions lead to marked
reduction in the wave pressure. Because ofthe impulsive nature ofthe wave force, the effects on stability and the
stress in structural elements vary according to the dynamic properties of the structure. Accordingly, when there
is a risk of a large impulsive breaking wave force due to breaking waves being generated, it is necessary to take
appropriate countermeasures by understanding the conditions of the impulsive breaking wave force generation
and the wave force characteristics by means of hydraulic model tests. It is preferable to avoid the use of crosssectional shapes and structures that may give rise to a strong impulsive breaking wave force. Where generation
of strong impulsive breaking wave force is unavoidable due to steep sea bottom or other reasons, it would be
preferable to arrange ways of mitigating wave forces such as by installing appropriate wave-dissipating works.
@ Countermeasures
If a large impulsive wave force due to breaking waves acts on an upright wall, the wave force can be greatly
-135-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
reduced by sufficiently armoring the front with wave-dissipating concrete blocks. In particular, with a high
mound, a sufficient covering with wave-dissipating concrete blocks can prevent the generation of the impulsive
breaking wave force itself. In some cases the action of an impulsive wave force can also be avoided by using
special caissons such as perforated-wall caissons or sloping-top caissons.128) The wave direction also has a large
effect on the generation of an impulsive breaking wave force, and therefore, one possible countermeasure is to
ensure that the wave direction is not perpendicular to the breakwater alignment.
For example, the examination of the stability of upright wall as a whole is preferably conducted by sliding
experiment and the strength of members such as parapets by stress measurement experiment.
@ Impulsive breaking wave force due to breaking waves acting on an upright wall on a steep seabed.
(a) Water depth of upright wall inducing maximum wave pressure and the mean intensity of wave pressure
Mitsuyasu, 129) Hom-ma, Horikawa et al.130), Morihira, Kakisaki et al.131), Goda and Haranaka,132) Horikawa
and Noguchi, 133) and Fujisaki, Sasada et al.134) have all carried out studies on the impulsive breaking wave
force due to breaking waves acting on an upright wall on a steeply sloping sea bottom. In particular, Mitsuyasu
carried out a wide range of experiments using regular waves whereby he studied the breaking wave force
acting on an upright wall on uniform slopes of gradient 1/50, 1/25, and 1/15 for a variety of water depths. He
investigated the change in the total wave force with the water depth at the location of the upright wall, and
obtained an equation for calculating the water depth hM at the upright wall for which the impulsive wave force
is largest. When the Mitsuyasu equation is rewritten in terms of the deepwater wavelength, it becomes as
follows:
(4.7.11)
where
(4.7.12)
CM =0.59-3.2tanB
-136-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
(c) Impulsive breaking wave force acting on an upright wall on a horizontal floor adjoining a steep slope
Takahashi and Tanimoto et al.135) have carried out studies on the impulsive breaking wave force acting on an
upright wall on a horizontal floor joining to a steep slope. They employed a horizontal berm connected to a
slope of gradient 1/10 or 3/100 in a water tank, and then measured the wave pressure that acts on an upright
wall at a variety of positions with regular waves. They have proposed an equation valid for certain wave
conditions for calculating the upright wall position at which the wave force is largest and the maximum wave
force in that condition.
5.0
4.0
p
3.0
PogHb
2.0
,.
(}
I'.
0
~
--.
---. l:"::::a \
....~
1.0
0
0.5
i=l/15
1/30
1/50
'
~ ~ .....
2
3
H0 1L 0
x 10-2
10
Fig. 4.7.5 Mean Intensity of Wave Force for the Severest Wave Breaking (Upright Wall on a Steep Slope)
(4.7.13)
(4.7.14)
Fig. 4.7.6 shows the distribution of au. It attains the maximum value of! when dlh is 0.4 andBMIL is 0.12.
The impulsive breaking wave pressure coefficient a 1 takes values between 0 and 2; the larger the value of ab
the larger the impulsive breaking wave force is. When calculating the wave force using Goda's formulas,
whichever larger shall be used. The equation for a 1 has been formulated based mainly on the
among a 1 and
results of sliding experiments when Hvfh is relatively large and may be used when examining the sliding of an
upright wall on the condition ofHvf~0.5. When Hvfh<0.5, h=2Hn may be used, for the sake of convenience,
in the calculation of a 11 .136)
a,.
-137-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
magnitude of the wave force as P increases to 30 or 45. When the alignment of breakwater is oblique at
the direction of incident waves, the impulsive breaking wave force will not generate or actually be neglected
because of the weak effect of it against sliding, even if generated. By considering the fluctuation in the wave
direction, it is reasonable to assume that the condition for the generation of an impulsive wave force is that p
is less than 20.
(d) Dynamic response of the upright section to an impulsive breaking wave force and the sliding of upright
section
When an impulsive breaking wave force due to breaking waves acts on an upright section, the instantaneous
local pressure can rise up to several tens of times the hydrostatic pressure corresponding to the wave height,
although the duration time of the impulsive breaking wave force is very short. It is necessary to evaluate the
contribution of the impulsive breaking wave force to sliding in terms of the dynamic response, considering
deformation of the mound and the subsoil. Goda 137) as well as Takahashi and Shimosako, 138) have carried
out calculations of the shear force at the bottom of an upright section using dynamic models. Judging from the
results of these calculations and the results of various sliding experiments, it would seem reasonable to take
the mean intensity of the wave pressure statically equivalent to the sliding of the upright wall on the mound to
be (2.5 - 3.0) p 0 gH. The impulsive breaking wave force coefficient has been introduced based on the results
of sliding experiments with consideration of such dynamic response effects.
0.4
h-d
-h-
h
0.6
I~
hi I
0.8
d1FI
\
1.0
0.4
o~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
0.1
0.2
0.3
BM
(5) Wave Force Acting on Upright Wall Covered with Wave-dissipating Concrete Blocks
CD
General
If the front of an upright wall is covered with wave-dissipating deformed concrete blocks, the features of wave
force acting on the wall varies. The extent of this variation depends on the characteristics of incident waves,
along with the crown height and width of the wave-dissipating work, the type of wave-dissipating concrete
blocks used, and the composition of the wave-dissipating work including the presence or non-presence of core
materials such as rubble. In general, when standing waves act on an upright wall, the variation in wave force on
the upright wall is not large. However, when a large impulsive breaking wave force acts, the wave force can be
reduced significantly by covering the upright wall with wave-dissipating blocks. Nevertheless, such a reduction
in the wave force is only achieved when the wave-dissipating work has a sufficient width and crown height; in
particular, it should be noted that ifthe crown of the wave-dissipating work is below the design water level, the
wave-dissipating work often causes an increase in the wave force.
@ Wave force calculation formula for upright wall sufficiently covered with wave-dissipating concrete blocks
The wave force acting on an upright wall covered with wave-dissipating concrete blocks varies depending on
the composition of the wave-dissipating work, and therefore it should be evaluated using the results of model
tests corresponding to the design conditions. However, if the crown elevation of the wave-dissipating work
is as high as the crown of the upright wall and the wave-dissipating concrete blocks are sufficiently stable
-138-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
against the wave actions, the wave force acting on the upright wall may be calculated by applying the extended
Goda's formulas. In this method with the standard formula given in 4.7.2 (2) Wave Forces of Standing Waves
or Breaking Waves when the Peak of Waves is on the Wall Surface, the values of 71*, Pb and Pu given by
equations (4.7.1), (4.7.2), and (4.7.8) are used respectively, but it is necessary to assign appropriate values to the
wave pressure correction factors .<b .<2 and .<3 in accordance with the design conditions.
(b) The larger the wave height, the smaller the correction factor ).1 for standing wave pressure and the correction
factor .<3 for uplift become.
(c) The larger the ratio ofthe width of covering block section to the wavelength, the smaller the correction factors
.<1 and .<3 become.
(d) If even a small portion of the upper part of the upright section is left uncovered, there is a risk of the wave
force here becoming an impulsive breaking wave force. Based on such experimental results, Takahashi et
al.141) have proposed that in general, when the upright wall is sufficiently covered with wave-dissipating
concrete blocks, the wave pressure reduction coefficient .<2 may be taken to be zero, while the values of.<1 and
.<3 depend primarily on the wave height H (the highest wave height). They have thus proposed the following
equations:
1.0
A,= l.2-2(H/h)/3
{ 0.8
(4.7.15)
A, =A,
,i, =0
In the breaker zone, where breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating concrete blocks are generally used,
the above equations give .<1 =.<3 = 0.8.
wave force may increase greatly when it is not armored, and a similar large increase in the wave force may occur
also at the discontinuous part of the wave-dissipating block covering.144)
Shiomi, Yamamoto, et al.145) have conducted a hydraulic experiment for the wave force at the discontinuous
part of the wave-dissipating block armoring and examined the following calculation method. The target range
for wave force calculation of the discontinuous part is set at as from the slope toe end of the wave-dissipating
work to the point where ILW.L. crosses the slope. The armored length is divided into unit lengths/. For each
divided water depth of the wave-dissipating work is assumed to be the water depth d on the mound armored
work crest, and the wave-dissipating work crest width is assumed to be the mound crest width BM, shown in
Fig. 4.7.6 and the wave pressure and uplift intensity is calculated by Goda's formulas employed the impulsive
breaking wave pressure coefficient a 1) in 4.7.2 (2) Wave Forces of Standing Waves ot Breaking Waves when
the Peak of Waves is on the Wall Surface, and the wave pressure of each divided section is determined. The
wave force is calculated such that the mean wave pressure intensity (pb p,. p 4) and the uplift pressure intensity
(p,J of the one caisson act on the entire caisson located in the discontinuous portion. The division length I is
determined such that the full wave force over the length of one caisson becomes maximum, but in general it is
set at 1/4 to 1/1 of the partition wall interval of the caisson.
@ Morihira's formula
The formula proposed by Morihira, et. al.131) may be used for the breakwater which is located in surf zone,
where there is a significant wave height decrease by the effect of wave breaking, and is covered sufficiently with
wave-dissipating concrete blocks.
@ Wave force acting on the superstructure of a sloping breakwater covered sufficiently by wave-dissipating blocks
Tanimoto and Kojima 146) have proposed a calculation equation for the wave pressure correction factor A. for
-139-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
cases where the foundation ground exists near the still-water surface, and where it is covered sufficiently with
wave-dissipating blocks similar to the superstructure of a sloping breakwater.
!J) Block load due to wave action
Wave force as the direct action of waves and the action due to the leaning of the blocks acts on an upright wall
that is covered with wave-dissipating blocks. The latter is called the block load. Research on the block load has
been carried out by Hiromoto, Nishijima, et al.147), Tanaka, Abe, et al.143), and Takahashi, Tanimoto, et al.141),
and the results have been summarized as follows.
(a) The block load when waves are not acting is small immediately after installation, but increases along with the
action of waves, and approaches the constant value. It is possible to consider the same distribution as the earth
pressure for that load, but the value diffi:rs depending on the wave forces that act on.
(b) The block load during wave action can be ignored in ordinary cases. This is because the upright wall is
displaced, albeit slightly, by the action of the waves, and the block load decreases, and becomes almost 0 when
the wave height becomes larger. However, in the event that the wave height is small, or when the water depth
is large and the block load in still water is large, it can no longer be ignored.
CD
The wave force on sloping-top caisson breakwaters should be calculated based on the model test results that are
suited to the conditions. However, it is possible to use the following calculation equations, if the conduct of the
model test is difficult.150) (See Fig. 4.7.7)
(4.7.16)
(4.7.17)
1sin_, a]
(4.7.18)
(4.7.19)
Here,
Fx
Fz
FSH
Fsv
Fv
Fu
F1
F1
'-si'
A.v
a:
Pu
B
H
L
d,
-140-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
@ Wave force acting on sloping-top caisson breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating concrete blocks
The research of Sato, et al.152) can be referenced as concerns the wave force acting on sloping-top caisson
breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks. In addition, Katayama, et al.153) have proposed a wave force
calculation equation for the semi-submerged type, as when the lower end of the sloping part is under the water
surface.
F,
h,
FSH
aQ
VFsv
d,
h'
h
Q
F2
Q
Fv
1'.).Fu
Rubble mound
CD
General
The wave force acting on an upright wave-absorbing caisson varies in a complex way. Specifically, it varies
with the wave characteristics, the water level, the water depth, the topography of sea bottom and the shape of
the foundation mound as with the case of an ordinary upright wall, but it also varies with the structure of the
wave-dissipating structure. It is thus difficult to designate a general calculation method that can be used in all
cases. Consequently, if the calculation method that is sufficiently reliable for the structure in question is not
proposed, it is necessary to carry out studies using hydraulic model tests matched to the individual conditions.
It is preferable to sufficiently examine not only the wave force to be used in the stability examination but also the
wave force acting on structural members. Moreover, it should be noted that the wave force varies significantly
according to whether or not the top of wave chamber is covered with a ceiling slab.
involved. Nevertheless, for the ordinary case where there is no ceiling slab in the wave chamber, one can apply
the extended Goda's formulas to calculate the wave force. Takahashi, Shimosako, et al.154) have carried out
experiments on a vertical-slit wall caisson, and have presented a method for calculating the wave pressure acting
on the slit and rear walls for four representative phases, where the wave pressure given by the Goda's formulas is
multiplied by a correction factor L They give specific values for the correction factor for the slit and rear walls
for each phase. This method can be used to give not only the wave force that is severest in terms of the sliding
or overturning of the caisson, but also the wave force that is severest in terms of the performance verification of
the elements for each wall. Note, however, that the experiments which form the basis for this calculation method
-141-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
were conducted under limited structural conditions. Discretion should therefore be exercised in the scope of
application for this metbod.136)
@ Simplified method to examine the stability of a wave chamber without a ceiling slab
A simpler form of the Goda's formulas can similarly be applied when examining the stability of a caisson. In
this method, it is assumed that the wave pressure acts on the main body of the caisson disregarding the wavedissipating structure (see Fig. 4.7.8), and then the wave force is calculated using 11 obtained using equation
(4.7.1), p 1 from equation (4.7.2) and Pu from equation (4.7.8), as described in the Goda's formulas in 4.7.2 (2)
Wave Force of Standing Waves or Breaking Waves when the Peak of Waves is on the Wall Surface. In
this case, with respect to the wave-dissipating structure, buoyancy of the entire section should be taken into
account. With regards the main body of the caisson, on the other hand, buoyancy under the still water should
be considered. However, the wave pressure correction factors li. l 2 and .<3 should be assigned appropriately
according to structural conditions. There are examples of examinations 128) on the correction factors .<1 and .<2
on curved-slit caissons, 155) perforated-wall caissons and vertical-slit wall caissons; on an average, l 1=l3 =1.0 and
.1.2=0 can be applied to wave-dissipating caissons.
CD
General
When the alignment of breakwater is discontinuous, the distribution of the wave height along the alignment of
breakwater becomes non-uniform due to the effects ofwave reflection and diffraction. Ito and Tanimoto 158) have
pointed out that most damaged breakwaters having been struck by storm waves show a pattern of meandering
distribution of sliding distance. They have termed this "meandering damage", and pointed out that one of the
causes of this type of damage is the differences in the local wave forces induced by the non-uniform wave
height distribution. The variation of wave heights along the breakwater is particularly prominent when the
breakwater alignment contains a comer that is concave with respect to the direction of wave incidence (see 4.3.4
[3] Transformation of Waves at Concave Corners, near the Heads of Breakwaters, and around Detached
Breakwaters). This should be considered in the calculation of the wave forces.J59), 160) Variations in wave
heights along the breakwater alignment may also occur near the head of the breakwater. In particular, for a
detached breakwater that extends over a short length only, diffracted waves from the two ends may cause large
variations in wave heights.161) These aspects should be considered in the calculation of the wave forces, as
necessary.
@ Wave force calculation method taking increase in wave height into consideration
Wave force calculation methods that consider the effects of the shape of the breakwater alignment have not
-142-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
reached to the level ofreasonable reliability yet. It is thus preferable to carry out an examination using hydraulic
model tests. Nevertheless, there is a good correlation between the increase in the wave height owing to the
shape of the breakwater alignment and the increase in the wave force. It is thus acceptable to increase the wave
height for the performance verifications in accordance with the extent ofthe effect ofthe shape ofthe breakwater
alignment as in equation (4.7.20), and then calculate the wave force based on the standard calculation equation.
(4.7.20)
where
HD' : wave height to be used in the wave force calculation in consideration of the effect of the shape
of breakwater alignment (m)
Kc : coefficient for the increase in wave height due to the effect ofthe shape ofbreakwater alignment;
Kc~ 1.0
Kcb : limit value of increase coefficient for limiting breaker wave; Kcb ~1.4
HD : wave height used in the wave force calculation when the effects of the shape of breakwater
alignment are not considered (m)
Hb : breaking wave height at the offshore location with the distance of 5 times the significant wave
height of progressive waves from the breakwater (m)
The wave height increase coefficient Kc in equation (4.7.20) is generally expressed as in equation (4.7.21).
It can be appropriately determined based on the distribution of the standing wave height (see 4.3.4 [3]
Transformation of Waves at Concave Corners, near the Heads of Breakwaters, and around Detached
Breakwaters) along the alignment ofbreakwater as determined under the condition that the waves do not break.
(4.7.21)
where
(i) Wave force acting on an upright wall located at the seaside of the shoreline
(a) General
When the changes in wave force due to the installation depth of an upright wall on a uniform slope are
examined under conditions of the specified waves, in general the wave force reaches a maximum when the
upright wall is located somewhat to the shore side from the breaker point as the progressive wave, and the
wave forces decreases as the installation depth becomes shallower than that. Given such a tendency, it is
-143-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
considered that the wave force due to the smaller waves that break somewhat at the offing of the upright wall
is greater than wave force after the breaking of a large wave that breaks considerably toward the offing from
the upright wall, when it has a certain degree of water depth.
Goda's formula, which are stipulated in 4.7.2 (2) Wave Force of Standing Waves or Breaking Waves
when the Peak of Waves is on the Wall Surface, provide a wave force based on the waves breaking somewhat
in the offing of such an upright wall. However, in those places where the water depth in the vicinity of the
shoreline is shallow, not only does the breaking wave height vary greatly depending on the changes in water
level due to surf beat and so on, but also the breaking wave force varies greatly due to the sea bottom gradient,
the wave steepness of offshore waves and the irregularity of the waves, so it is not appropriate to employ
Goda's formulas, and it should be calculated with an equation suited to the conditions or the results of a
hydraulic model test. In addition, the fact that the water depth itself changes due to the littoral drift, or that
the effects of storm surge are great, should also be taken into consideration.
(b) Calculation method of wave force acting on an upright wall at the seaward side of shoreline
A number of different wave force formulas have been proposed for upright walls near the shoreline. It should
be necessary to carry out an appropriate wave force calculation in line with the design conditions. Very
roughly speaking, the standard formula in 4.7.2 (2) Wave Forces of Standing Waves and Breaking Waves
when the Peak of Waves is on the Wall Surface are applicable in the regions where the seabed slope is mild
and the water is relatively deep. The formula of Tominaga and Kutsumi 163) is applicable in the regions near
the shoreline. The formula of Hom-ma, Horikawa and Hase 130) is applicable in the regions where the seabed
slope is steep and the water is of intermediate depth.
When applying Goda's formula to the places where the water depth is less than one half the equivalent
deepwater wave height, it may be preferable to use the values for the wavelength and wave height at the water
depth equal to one half the equivalent deepwater wave height in the calculation.
@ Wave force acting on an upright wall located at the land side of the shoreline
(a) General
Since the wave force acting on an upright wall located at the land side ofthe shoreline varies greatly depending
on the rise in the water level due to surf beat or the runup ofthe waves, it should be calculated with an equation
suited to the conditions or the results of a hydraulic model test. In addition, the fact that the topology in the
vicinity of the shoreline changes due to the littoral drift, or that the effects of storm surge are great, should
also be taken into consideration.
(b) Calculation method of wave force acting on an upright wall at the landward side of shoreline
For an upright wall located on the landward side of the shoreline, the formula by the US Army Coastal
Engineering Research Center {CERC) 164) is available. Moreover, one may refer to the research that has been
carried out by Tominaga and Kutsumi on the wave force acting on an upright wall located on the landward
side of the shoreline.
4.7.3 Wave Force Acting on Submersed Members and Isolated Structures
CD
Morison's Formula
(a) General
Structural members such as piles that have a small diameter relative to the wavelength hardly disturb the
propagation ofwaves. The wave force acting on such members can be obtained using the Morison's formula as
shown in equation (4.7.22), in which the wave force is expressed as the sum of a drag force that is proportional
to the square of the velocity of the water particles and an inertia force that is proportional to the acceleration.
(4.7.22)
where
fn : force that acts on a small length AS (m) in the axial direction of the member, where the direction
of this force lies in the plane containing the member axis and the direction of motion of the
water particles and is perpendicular to the member axis (kN)
iin ' an: components of the water particle velocity (m/s) and acceleration (m/s2), respectively, in the
direction perpendicular to the member axis that lies within the plane containing the member
axis and the direction of motion of the water particles (i.e., the same direction as fn ) (these
components are for incident waves that are not disturbed by the presence of member)
Ii.in I : absolute value of iin (mis)
Cn : drag coefficient
-144-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
CM : inertia coefficient
D : width of the piember in the direction perpendicular to the member axis as viewed from the
u,.,
-145-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 4.7.1 Inertia Coefficient
Basic volume
-url
f+-[]Jl
-lvf+-! D
Regular
prism
Cube
~D2.f
4
D2.f
Inertia coefficient
2.0
(l'>D)
2.19 (b>D)
-LJJTv
H'D
D3
1.67
Sphere
Flat
plate
-OID
-QI
D
1t D3
-6
1.5
WhenD I .f =l, 0.61
~D2.f
4
(e) Experimental values for drag coefficient and inertia coefficient of cylinder
There are many experimental values for the drag coefficient and inertia coefficient of a vertical cylinder; for
example, those ofKeulegan and Carpenter, 169) Sarpkaya, 170), 171), 172) Goda, 173) Yamaguchi, 174) Nakamura,
17S) Chakrabarti, 176). 177) and Koderayama and Tashiro.178) There are many variations between these values.
However, there is not sufficient data in the region of high Reynolds number, which is subject to the actual
performance verification. Oda 179) has produced a summary of these researches which may be referred to.
-146-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
to view this as the continuous action of random waves. When calculating the wave force for random waves,
suitable measures may be devised for the way to provide the height of the wave crown height and the drag
coefficient, and the water particle movement component may be calculated based on small amplitude wave
theory.
force similar to the impulsive breaking wave pressure that acts on upright walls acts in addition to the drag and
inertia forces given by equation (4.7.22). Since the response characteristics ofthe facilities become the dominant
effect factor for such an impulsive action, not only a calculation of the wave force but also an examination that
includes the behavior of the entire facility as well as the structural members should be carried out.184), 185)
@Uplift
In addition to the drag and inertia forces of equation (4.7.22), wave force acting on submerged members is the
uplift acting in the direction perpendicular to the plane containing the member axis and the direction of the
water particle motion. In general, it is acceptable to ignore this uplift, but it is necessary to pay attention to the
fact that the uplift may become a problem for horizontal members that are placed near to the seabed.186), 187), 188),
189), 190), 191) Moreover, for long and thin members, it is necessary to pay attention to the fact that the uplift may
induce vibrations.
of a case where waves and a uniform flow co-exist by using the characteristic function method. A simulation
method where the random wave forms and water particle movement are simulated based on a prescribed wave
spectrum, and its time series is inputted and the wave force is calculated, is also being employed commonly as a
method for the statistical nature of random waves including the nonlinear drag and the dynamic response of the
facilities. Borgman 194) has explained this method, and there is the calculation example oflto et al.195). These
are simulations based on linear theory, but recently nonlinear simulation calculations that consider everything
up to the second order interference terms between component waves have also been carried out, 196) and in
addition nonlinear simulation calculations of multi directional random waves has also been tried.197) As for the
probability distribution of the wave force, the wave height exhibits a Rayleigh distribution, whereas its local
maximum value may become considerably larger than the Rayleigh type owing to the nonlinearity of the drag.
Tickell-Elwany 198) has calculated the theoretical value ofthe wave force distribution based on three-dimensional
random waves. In addition, Kimura et al.199) has calculated the probability distribution of the wave force acting
on a single cylindrical column based on the joint distribution of the wave height and period of random waves,
and shown a method for calculating the anticipated values for the maximum wave force.
@ Equation for calculating the breaking wave force acting on slanted columns
Tanimoto, Takahashi, et al.185) have developed the research of Goda et al.184), and have proposed a method
for calculating the breaking wave force acting on cylindrical columns based on experimental results. The
calculation of the impulsive breaking wave force acting on upright cylindrical columns or slanted cylindrical
columns installed on a sea bottom with a uniform slope may be carried out based on this method. In the
experiment both regular and random waves were employed, and were carried out with a cylindrical column
with a Dlh ~ 115, for gradients i ~ 1/100 and 1/30, and (J ~ -30, -15, 0, +15 and +30. The position of the
impulsive wave force that acts and the changes over time can be calculated by the equation, and the response of
the cylindrical column member to the impulsive wave force can also be calculated.
@ Breaking wave force acting on small diameter cylindrical columns on a reef
Goda et al.200) have proposed a method for calculating the breaking wave force that acts on upright cylindrical
columns on reefs, where the water depth changes suddenly, and it is possible to carry out calculations of the
wave force based on this method for waves like those that break on the slope of reefs.
CD
-147-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) Wave Force Acting on Large Isolated Structures
Q) General
The wave force acting on a large isolated structure whose dimensions are comparable to the wavelength can be
calculated using the velocity potential, because it is generally possible to ignore the drag force. In particular,
for structures of a simple shape, analytical solutions obtained by diffraction theory are available. However, it
is necessary to calculate the breaking wave force by hydraulic model tests if there is a possibility of breaking
wave force exerted on structure.
@ Diffraction theory
MacCamy -Fuchs 202) have determined the velocity potential of waves around an upright cylindrical column of
large diameter using diffraction theory, and calculated the wave force from the water pressure distribution at
the surface of cylinder. Goda and Yoshimura 203) have applied diffraction theory to an upright elliptic cylinder,
and presented their results in terms of the inertia coefficient CM. Yamaguchi 204) has examined the effect of
the wave nonlinearity on the wave force acting on an upright cylindrical column oflarge diameter by nonlinear
diffraction theory, and pointed out that it is necessary to consider these effects when the water is shallow.
Q) General
In the case of facilities near still water surface, such as the superstructure of piled piers on pile-type dolphins,
and in particular those facilities that are roughly parallel to the water surface, there is a risk that a rising wave
surface will strike on the bottom surface of the facilities and an impulsive wave force (hereinafter, "uplift")
will act on. In particular, it becomes a large impulsive force when the wave height is large and the clearance
with the still water surface is small. In addition, in a case where there is a reflecting wall at the rear as in the
case of open type wharf, and the waves become standing waves and act on this, the impulsive uplift should be
calculated by a suitable method such as a hydraulic model test. Due attention should also be paid to the fact that
ordinary uplift that is not an impulsive force also acts on the bottom surface of such structures, in addition to
the impulsive uplift.
-148-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
-- --
(a)
lJ
""
Wave impact
Pressure distribution
(b)
tt!!!t!!t!!ttt!!!!t!t!!!t!!t!!!t!!!J
!:'>-
Pressure distribution
LI Wave impact
Fig. 4.7.9 Impact between Wave Front and Horizontal Plate
s'
!'_)
H
H2
211h
s'=s-tr-cothL
L
(4.7.23)
(4.7.24)
where
: correction factor
: unit weight of seawater (kN/m3)
: wave height of progressive waves, generally the highest wave height Hm., (m)
: wavelength of progressive waves (m)
: width of plate (m)
: water depth (m)
: clearance of the plate above the still water surface (m)
: clearance of the plate above the level corresponding to the middle of the wave crest and trough
(m)
It is necessary to pay attention to the fact that the uplift in the above equations does not depend on the
length of the horizontal plate.
The impact force has the magnitude given by the above equations and takes the form of a pulse that lasts for
a time from the moment of the impact, that is given as follows:
(4.7.25)
Where Tis the wave period and Ris the length of the horizontal plate. Provided the length of the horizontal
plate is sufficiently short compared with the wavelength L and the bottom surface of the horizontal plate is flat,
equation (4.7.23) well represents the features of the uplift well with simple equation. Comparing calculated
-149-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
values with t; = 1.0 to experimental values, agreement is relatively good provided His' is no more than 2.
Tanimoto et al.20S) have proposed another method for calculating the uplift acting on horizontal plate based
on Wagner's theory. With this calculation method, the angle of contactP between the wave surface and the
horizontal plate as well as the impact velocity V,. are given by Stokes' third order wave theory, making it
possible to obtain the spatial distribution of the impact pressure and its change over time. Note however that
the use of Stokes' third order wave theory makes the calculation rather complex. This calculation method is
intended for use when the bottom face of the horizontal plate is flat. It cannot be applied directly to structures
of complicated shape such as an ordinary piled pier that have beams under the :floor slab; the impact between
the wave surface and the floor slab is disturbed by the beams. In general, the presence of beams causes air to
become trapped in and the wave surface to be disturbed, the result being that the impact force is less than for
a horizontal plate with a flat surface. Accordingly, the value obtained from this calculation method may be
considered as being the upper limit ofthe uplift for an ordinary piled pier.
(b) Uplift Acting on Piled Pier
Ito and Takeda 206) have conducted scale model tests of piled pier to obtain the uplift acting on an access
bridge, and it's a vibration threshold weight and a falling threshold weight. The experimental conditions were
the wave height up to 40 cm, a period of 1.0 s and 2.4 s, and a water depth of 56 cm and 60 cm. According to
the measurement records of wave pressure gauges attached to the access bridge, the peak value of the uplift
varied considerably from wave to wave even under the same conditions. Nevertheless, the mean ofthese peak
values is given approximately by the following equation (4.7.26):
(4.7.26)
where
l!.t : characteristic value of the mean peak value of the intensity ofuplift (kN/m2)
: unit weight of seawater (kN/m3)
p~
(4.7.27)
q = p 0 g(l.6H-0.9S)
The vibration threshold weight given by equation (4.7.27) is one fifth of the intensity of the uplift as given
by equation (4.7.26). The falling threshold weight was found to be 1/2 to 1/3 of the vibration threshold
weight.
In these access bridge experiments, Ito and Takeda also tested the access bridge with holes or slits of
various sizes, and investigated how the threshold weights changed when the void ratio was changed. In
general, the change in the vibration threshold weight by the void ratio is only slight compared to access
bridges without holes, when the void ratio is small i.e., around 1%, air escapes easily and the water surface
strikes the access bridge impulsively. The falling threshold weight, on the other hand, drops noticeably when
the void ratio exceeds 20%. Note that the bridge weight referred to here is the weight per unit area of the
substantial part i.e., the weight per unit area excluding the voids. In this way, since there is little change to the
vibrating threshold weight, namely the stable weight per unit area of the substantial part of the access bridge,
the weight of an entire surface area can be reduced by boring holes. What is more, the falling threshold weight
decreases with the increase in the void rate. From these two reasons, it can be concluded that it is best to raise
the void rate.
Furthermore, Ito and Takeda 206) have attached a strain gauge to the deck slab of the model of piled pier
and measured the stress. Based on their results, they proposed the following equation for the equivalent static
load (kN/m2) assumed to act with uniform distribution on the deck slab.
(4.7.28)
-150-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Note however that the value given by this equation corresponds to the upper limit of the experimental
values and should thus be considered corresponding to the case that the distance s from the water level to the
underside of the superstructure is almost 0. The equivalent static load given by equation (4.7.28) is generally
lower than the uplift acting on a horizontal plate with a fiat bottom face. It is considered that this is partly
because the beams disturb the impacting wave front and cause air to become trapped in. Experimental
research into the uplift acting on a piled pier has also been carried out by Murota and Furudoi, 207) Nagai and
Kubo et al.208), Horikawa and Nakao et al.209), and Sawaragi and Nochino.210)
1) Ito and Takeda 206) have also carried out studies on the uplift of progressive waves acting on a detached
pier. Specifically, they measured the stress occorring in the deck slabs of a detached pier model. Based
on the upper limits of their experimental results, they proposed the following equation for the uniformly
distributed equivalent static load.
(4.7.29)
2) Allsop and Cuomo, et al.212), 213), 214), 215) have undertaken a systematic examination of the uplift due
to progressive waves that act on detached pier by model tests based on random waves and theoretical
analysis. They have proposed the following calcolation equations concerning the ordinary uplift that is
not an impulsive force.
Fq,
F'
=a[T/"""'H-c,)-b
(4.7.30)
'
(4.7.31)
(4.7.32)
Here,
Fq,
: uplift that is not an impulsive force (equivalent to the maximum value in the wave group) (kN)
'1mox
According to the experimental results, the value of the coefficient a, b are 0.82 and 0.61 in the case
of horizontal plates and beams outside a harbor, 0.71 and 0.71 in the case of horizontal plates inside a
harbor, and 0.82 and 0.66 in the case of beams inside a harbor, respectively. It is necessary to calculate
the maximum rise in water level '1mox by appropriate theoretical analysis. In addition, the effects of
nonlinearity become greater as the water depth becomes shallower, and the proportion of the maximum
rise in the water level relative to the wave height becomes higher. Owing to this, even ifthe clearance and
the design wave height are the same, it is necessary to pay attention to the fact that not only does the uplift
becomes relatively great when the water depth is shallow, but also that the frequency with which the uplift
acts increases.215)
On the other hand, a comparison with the uplift has been carried out for the impulsive force,214) and
according to the experimental results it is 2.0 to 2.4 times the ordinary uplift in the case of horizontal
-151-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
plates outside the harbor, 2.0 to 2.9 times this in the case of beams outside the harbor, 1.7 to 2.3 times this
for horizontal plates inside the harbor, and 1.9 to 2.6 times this for horizontal beams inside the harbor.
However, it is necessary to pay attention to the fact that although the action time is short as described
During the performance verification ofthe facilities ofports, it is necessary to set appropriately the wave conditions
such as the wave height, period, wave direction, as the design conditions. These wave conditions are preferably
set by statistical analysis based on long-term observational data, but in the cases where the observation data are
inadequate it is common to supplement the data by wave hindcasting.219), 220), 221)
The waves for the verification of stability of the facilities and the ultimate limit state of structural members
are generally the probabilistic waves whose return period is 50 years, for facilities whose design working lifetime
is 50 years. This is the return period of waves that is generally taken into consideration in conventional design,
and conventional design is followed in order to provide for continuity with the philosophy of conventional design
methods and to avoid confusion in practical design work. Owing to this, the return period may be established
appropriately by taking into consideration the design working lifetime and degree of importance of objective
wave is used. As the mother distribution function of the return wave height is unknown in general in either case,
the Gumbel distribution, the Weibull distribution, or some other distribution function is applied. The function
form most suited to the data is found, and the return wave height in respect of the required return period, for
example 50 years or 100 years, etc., is estimated with that estimation equations.
Since the accuracy of such estimated values is dependant more on the accuracy of the data used than the
method of statistical treatment, in the event that the data for the peak waves is prepared by wave hindcasting,
care should be paid so that appropriate selection of the hindcasting method and verification based on the observed
values of the hindcasting results should be applied. Moreover, the relationship between the wave height and the
period are plotted for the data for the peak waves, which is the hindcasting data for the return wave height, and
the period corresponding to the return wave height is determined as appropriate based on the correlation of these
data.
(4) Process in the Statistical Treatment of External Waves
During the statistical treatment, the wave height is arranged in order of size, and the non-exceedance
probability for each wave height value is calculated.
Now, assuming that the number of data is N, and the number mth wave height from the larger side is Xm,N' the
probability Fm that the wave height does not exceed Xm.N is calculated by the following equation.
F =1-m-a
"
(4.8.1)
N+P
The values for each probability distribution function shown in Table 4.8.1 are employed for a and p in the
above equation. Since Gringorten has calculated the values for the Gumbel distribution, it has been set so that the
effects of the statistical variance of the data are minimized with the non-exceedance probability F corresponding
to the anticipated value of the order statistics Xm Petruaskas and Aagaard 223) have calculated the values for the
-152-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Distribution function
Gumbel distribution
Weibull distribution (k = 0.75)
Same as above (k = 0.85)
Same as above (k = 1.0)
Same as above (k = 1.1)
Same as above (k = 1.25)
Same as above (k = 1.5)
Same as above (k = 2.0)
p
0.12
0.64
0.59
0.53
0.50
0.47
0.42
0.37
CD
Following Petruaskas and Aagaard, in Reference 225), Goda has proposed a method in which eight kinds of
distribution function wherein k = 0.75, 0.85, 1.0. 1.1, 1.25, 1.5 and 2.0 are applied in the Gumbel distribution in
equation (4.8.2) and the Weibull distribution in equation (4.8.3), and the function that accords the most with the
data among these is selected with the correlation coefficient.
(4.8.2)
x~BJ}
(4.8.3)
Here, the non-exceedance probability Fm is calculated with equation (4.8.1). The values shown in Table
4.8.1 are adopted for the values of a and p.
Next, from the non-exceedance probability F ,,,, the standard amount of change is calculated by using equation
(4.8.4) in the case of the Gumbel distribution, and equation (4.8.5) in the case of the Weibull distribution,
respectively.
y,,, = -ln{-ln(F,. )}
(4.8.4)
11
(4.8.5)
Y.. ={-ln(l-F,.)}'
If the data completely accord with equation (4.8.2) or equation (4.8.3), a linear relationship exists between
x and Ym Therefore, the estimation equation for the return wave height is calculated by assuming a linear
relationship for equation (4.8.6), and establishing its coefficient by the least square method.
(4.8.6)
A
Here, A , B are the estimated value for the coefficients A and B of equation (4.8.2) and equation (4.8.3).
@ Moreover, in Reference 226), Goda has proposed the following method, which revises the above-mentioned
procedure.
(a) Modification of the fitted function (introduction of peak value type II)
The peak value type II function is given by the following equation.
(4.8.7)
-153-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Here, the examination has been done in a total of nine ways, one way with the Gumbel distribution in
equation (4.8.2), four ways with the Weibull distribution in equation (4.8.3) (k = 0.75, LO, 1.4 and 2.0), and
four ways with the peak value type II distribution in equation (4.8.7) (k = 2.5, 3.33, 5.0 and 10.0), as the fitted
functions.
In addition, formulation of the following equation is carried out instead of Table 4.8.1, for a and P in
equation (4.8.1). In other words, it is set as follows.
a=0.44, P=o.12
In the Weibull distribution:
(4.8.9)
(4.8.10)
p = 0.12-0.ll/./k
(b) Modification of the procedure for selecting the optimal coefficient by introduction ofrejection criteria
There are two kinds of criteria for rejecting unsuitable functions, the REC criterion and the DOL criterion.
In practical work a procedure is adopted where when a function has been rejected based on either of these
criteria, the optimal function is selected according not to the value of the simple correlation, but rather the
MIR criterion.
REC criterion, a criterion where the 95% non-exceedance probability of the residual of the correlation
coefficient is calculated beforehand for each distribution function, and when the residual of the correlation
coefficient when the peak value data are fit to this correlation coefficient exceeds this limit value, that function
is rejected as unsuited.
DOL criterion, a criterion wherein the maximum value in the data is made dimensionless with the overall
mean value and standard deviation, and ifthis is below the 5% value or above the 95% value in the distribution
function to which this value is fitted, that function is rejected as unsuited.
MIR criterion, a criterion consideration is given to the fact that the mean value of the residual relative to
the correlation coefficient of I differs depending on the distribution function, and something where the ratio
between the residual of the correlation coefficient of the sample and the residual mean value in the applied
distribution is judged to be most suitable.
(6) Design tide level and design waves of temporary structures
In the performance verification of temporary structures as well, the design waves are basically set based on the
above-described principles. However, since the installation period is limited in the case of temporary structures,
it is possible to set the objective return period of the action shorter. If it is a temporary structure whose period is
about 2 to3 years, it is common for verification to be carried out for action with a return period of about 10 years.
4.8.2 Setting of Wave Conditions for Verification of Harbor Calmness
The ordinary wave properties that are employed for verification of harbor calmness are generally expressed as a joint
frequency distribution table of the wave height and period by wave direction for data broken down by month, by
season and annually from the wave data. In a detailed examination of events in which the effects of the period appear
strongly, for example, the operating rate it is preferable to arrange an occurrence distribution for the equivalent wave
height and wave direction for each period band. Conducting an examination of the wave conditions with observation
data serves as the criterion. When the wave observation data are not available, the wave hindcasting results can be
utilized. However, in the utilization of the wave hindcasting results, it is preferable to undertake the verification by
observation data. It is possible to refer to the manual in Reference 228) as concerns the setting of the ordinary wave
conditions for the verification of harbor calmness.
-154-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
4.8.3 Setting of Wave Conditions for Verification of Durability, Serviceability Limit State, of the Structural
Members
(!) The waves for verification of the durability (serviceability limit state) of the structural members are set
appropriately as waves acting during the design working lifetime. For the setting of such waves, a joint frequency
distribution table of the wave height and period by wave direction is preferably calculated from wave observation
data broken down by month, by season and annually. However, since wave observation points where, continuous
wave observations have been implemented over a long period of at least three years, and statistical analysis of
the occurrence frequency of individual waves has already been conducted, are extremely rare, usually estimation
must be carried out based on an occurrence frequency of for significant wave height by class. In the event that the
design working lifutime is 50 years, this may be calculated by the following method.
CD
Wave data
It is possible to employ the NOWPHAS (Nationwide Ocean Wave Information Network for Ports and Harbors)
wave observation data, where wave observations are continuously conducted in ports throughout Japan. The
occurrence frequency statistics by wave height class of the significant waves every two hours are summarized
in the annual Wave Observation Annual Report 229) or Long-Term Statistical Report 230) issued by NOWPHAS.
Estimation of the circumstances of occurrence of individual waves within an observation time of two hours is
carried out based on the significant wave height values provided once in these two hours.
(a) The occurrence distribution of individual wave height follows a Rayleigh distribution. Assuming that the
significant wave height during two hours is constant, it is possible to assume that the distribution of several
individual wave heights occurring during the two hours follows a Rayleigh distribution where the significant
wave height is equal.
(b) The number of individual waves during the time differs depending on each observation or period, however
since it is extremely difficult to set the number of respective individual waves for each observation for two
hours, it can be hypothesized that the value obtained by dividing two hours or 7,200 seconds by the long-term
mean period of objective wave observation point is the number of waves during two hours.
that or high or above strike is the order of 104 , based on the number of the waves set by the above-mentioned
method appear. In the Design Manual for Pre-stressed Concrete Structure for Ports and Harbors Facilities,
these waves are the waves for the verification of the serviceability limit state, 231) based on the provisions of the
International PC Association, and this is applied here as well.
-155-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(4) Philosophy about the waves for the verification of stability of facilities
In the performance evaluation of facilities, it is necessary to determine the waves that are acting by considering
CD
The design tide level is set appropriately. In cases of damage examples in recent years, it has been common for
facilities for which high tide level has been used as the design tide level in wave force calculations, however,
damages occur in many cases during storm surge.237) Therefore, as in the case of the performance verification
for wave overtopping, it is preferable to consider the simultaneous occurrence with waves and to set this as the
tide level that is severest on the facilities, by for example setting this as a tide level where an appropriate storm
surge height is added to the high tide level.
!J) Adequate examination is done concerning stability of facilities during construction as well.
along with the mooring force, should be given due consideration in the performance verification of the floating
body.
(2) In general, a floating body refers to a structure that is buoyant in water and its motions within a certain range is
permitted during use 239). When verifying the performance of a floating body, it is necessary to examine both its
required fuoctions and its stability. It is necessary to pay attention that the setting of the design conditions on each
case is different in general.
(3) Mooring equipment includes a variety of types and is generally composed of a combination of mooring lines,
mooring anchors, sinkers, intermediate weights, intermediate buoys, mooring rods, connection joints, and fenders.
The mooring equipment has a large influence on the motions of a floating body, and so it is important to verify the
stability of the floating body appropriately.
(4) The floating bodies used as port facilities can be divided into floating piers 240), offshore petroleum stockpiling
bases 241), floating breakwaters 242), floating bridges 243), 244) and floating disaster-prevention bases.245), 246)
Moreover, researches for development of very large floating structures 247), 248), 249), 2so) are being carried out.
(5) Floating bodies can also be classified by the type of mooring methods. As described below, mooring methods
include catenary mooring (slack mooring}, taut mooring, and dolphin mooring.
CD
-156-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Mooring anchor
Dolphin
H
(a) Catenary mooring
Damper
W.L.
W.L.
.....
Universal joint
(4.9.1)
where
F w : wind drag force (N)
Pa : density of air (kg/m')
Aw : projected area of the part of the floating body above the sea surface as viewed from the direction
in which the wind is blowing (m2)
Uw : wind velocity (mis)
Cvw : wind drag coefficient
-157-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
The wind drag coefficient is a proportionality constant and is also known as the wind pressure coefficient. It
may be determined by wind tunnel tests. However, it is also acceptable to use a value that has been obtained in
the past experiments for a structure with a shape similar to the structure under current study.
Values such as those listed in Table 4.9.1 have been proposed as the wind drag coefficients of objects in the
uniform flow. As can be seen from this table, the wind drag coefficient varies with the shape of the floating body,
but it is also affected by the wind direction and the Reynolds number. Note that it is considered that the wind
pressure acts in the direction of the wind flow, with the point of application being the centroid of the projection
of the part of the floating body that is above the water surface. However, it is necessary to pay attention to the
fact that this may not necessarily be the case if the floating body is large. Moreover, the velocity of the actual
wind is not uniform in the vertical direction, and so the value of the wind velocity Uwused in the wind pressure
calculation is set as that at the elevation of 10 m above the sea surface.
Table 4.9.1 Wind Pressure Coefficient
>i
>i
>
<>
02
2
>
CJ1
>~
~
>
Square cross-section
2.0
[1.2]
(0.6)
Square cross-section
1.6
[1.4]
(0.7)
Rectangular cross-section
(ratio of side lengths = 1:2)
2.3
[1.6]
(0.6)
Rectangular cross-section
(ratio of side lengths = 1:2)
1.5
(0.6)
Rectangular cross-section
(when one face is in contact
with the ground)
1.2
Circular cross-section
(smooth surface)
1.2
(0.7)
(4.9.2)
where
Fc : drag force by currents (N)
Po : density offiuid (kg!m3)
Ac : projected area of the submerged part of the floating body as viewed from the direction of the
currents (m2)
Uc : velocity of the currents (m/s)
U : velocity of motion of the floating body (m/s)
Coc : drag coefficient with respect to the currents
The drag coefficient Coc is a function of the Reynolds number. When the Reynolds number is large, however,
the values for steady flow in Table 6.5.l in 6.5 Fluid Force due to Current may be used.
The drag coefficient for the currents varies with the shape of the floating body, the direction of the currents
and the Reynolds number. As with the wind pressure, the direction of the force exerted by the currents and the
-158-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
direction of the currents itself are not necessarily the same.mi In general, the deeper the draft of the floating
body relative to the water depth, the larger the drag coefficient for the currents becomes. This is referred to as the
shoaling effect, and the drag coefficient increases because the smaller the gap between the sea bottom and the base
of the floating body, the harder it is for water to flow through this gap.
(4) Wave-exciting Force
The wave-exciting force is the force exerted by incident waves on the floating body when the floating body is
considered to be fixed in the water. It is composed of a linear force that is proportional to the amplitude of the
incident waves and a nonlinear force that is proportional to the square of the amplitude of the incident waves.
The linear force is the force that the floating body receives from the incident waves as reaction when the floating
body deforms the incident waves. The velocity potential for the deformed wave motion is obtained using wave
diffraction theory. The nonlinear force, on the other hand, is composed of a force that accompanies the finite
amplitude nature of waves and a force that is proportional to the square of the flow velocity. The former force due
to finite amplitude effect can be analyzed theoretically, but in practice it is often ignored. The latter force that is
proportional to the square of the flow velocity becomes large, in particular when the diameter of the floating body
is small relative to the wavelength; it is necessary to determine this force experimentally.
(5) Wave Drift Force
When waves act on a floating body, the center of the floating body's motion gradually shifts in the direction of
wave propagation. The force that causes this shift is called the wave drift force. If it is assumed that the floating
body is two-dimensional and the wave energy is not dissipated, then the wave drift force is given by the following
equations.254) The subscript kin the equation refers to the characteristics value:
(4.9.3)
R-K
-
4
{1+ sinh(4111z/L)
11h!L }
(4.9.4)
where
par;
h
L
Fd
(4.9.5)
where
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
resistance force. This force may be determined by forcing the floating body to move through the still water and
measuring the force acting on the floating body. In general, however, an analytical method is used whereby
each mode of the floating body motions is assumed to be realized separately, and the velocity potential, which
represents the motion of the fluid around the floating body, is obtained. Only the forces that are proportional to
the motion of the floating body may be determined analytically; the nonlinear forces that are proportional to the
square of the motion cannot be determined analytically. Out of the linear forces i.e., that are proportional to the
motion of the floating body, the term that is proportional to the acceleration of the floating body is called the added
mass term, while the term that is proportional to the velocity is called the wave damping term.
(9) Solution Method for Wave-exciting Force and Wave-making Resistance Force Using Velocity Potential
The method adopted for calculating the wave-exciting force and the wave-making resistance force involves
deriviation of the velocity potential, which represents the motion of the fluid, and then calculating the wave
exciting force and the wave-making resistance force from the potential. The analytical method with the velocity
potential is the same for both the wave-exciting force and the wave-making resistance force, the only difference
being the boundary conditions. The velocity potential may be obtained using any of a number of methods, such as
a region segmentation method, an integral equation method, a strip method, or a finite element method. Outline
of the above mentioned numerical calculation methods are introduced in Reference 256) and 257).
(10) Wave Force Acting on Fixed Floating Body with Rectangular Cross Section
When a floating body is fixed in position, the velocity potential that satisfies the boundary conditions at the sea
bottom and around the floating body can yield the wave force. The wave force acting on a floating body with a
long rectangular cross section such as a floating breakwater can be determined using the approximation theory of
Ito et al.2ss).
The motions of a floating body and the mooring force need to be calculated by an appropriate analytical method
or hydraulic model tests, in accordance with the shape of the floating body and the characteristics of the external
forces and the mooring system.
(2) Motions of Floating Body
The motions of a floating body can be determined by solving the dynamic equilibrium equation, with the external
forces taken to be the forces due to winds and waves, the restoring force of the floating body itself, and the reaction
forces of the mooring lines and fenders. If the floating body is assumed to be a rigid body, then its motions are
comprised of the six components shown in Fig. 4.9.2, namely surging, swaying, heaving, pitching, rolling and
yawing. Out of these, the modes that represent motions within the horizontal plane, namely surging, swaying and
yawing, may show long-period motions with the period of a few minutes or more. Such long-period motions have
a large influence on the verification ofthe anchoring area of ships and the mooring equipment. One may thus give
separate consideration to the long-period motions, taking only the wave-drift force and the long-period fluctuating
components of the winds and waves as the external forces when doing analysis.
Ifthe floating body is very long, elastic deformation may accompany the motions of the floating body and this
should be examined, as necessary.
-160-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Surging
Swaying
CD
by using linear approximations for the nonlinear terms, the solutions can be obtained relatively easily. For
example, for a three-dimensional floating body, one ends up with a system of six simultaneous linear equations
involving the amplitudes and phases of the six modes of motions. Note that if the floating body is assumed to be
a rigid body and its motions are linear, then the motions are proportional to the external forces. In particular, if
there are no currents or wind, then the motions are proportional to the wave heigbt.
Moroishi 264) have analyzed the swinging motion of a ship moored at a buoy.
As preconditions to the numerical simulation, it is usually assumed that the fluid is an ideal fluid, that the
amplitudes ofmotions ofthe floating body are small and that the incident waves are linear and their superposition
is allowed. Ifthese assumptions cannot be held, it is necessary to carry out hydraulic model tests.
(4) Hydraulic Model Tests
Hydraulic model tests provide a powerful technique for determining the motions of a floating body and the
mooring force. Up to the present time, hydraulic model tests have been carried out for all kinds offloating bodies.
For examples, see rererences 265) and 266).
When conducting hydraulic model tests of a floating body, attention should be paid to any similarities in the
inertia moments of the floating body and the characteristics of mooring equipment.
(5) Statistical Treatment of Motions of Floating Body and Mooring Force
The motions and mooring forces for a floating body obtained by numerical simulation due to random waves and
hydraulic model tests varies irregularly with time. Therefore, the peak values of the motion amplitudes and
mooring forces for the floating body also vary. Even if the wave spectrum is identical, the maximum values
for these vary when the duration time or the series of the waves are different. In other words, since the motion
amplitudes and mooring forces for the floating body are probability variables, statistical treatment should be
performed to estimate the expected values. In the usual statistical treatment, a normal distribution or a Rayleigh
distribution are applied to the probability density distributions of the peak values, and the expected values are
estimated.
(6) Motions and Mooring Force for Rectangular Section Floating Body
Ito's approximation theory, 258) which is relatively easy to handle, can be applied for calculating the motions and
-161-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
Motion simulation
A motion simulation for adequate calculation time is performed, and the values of double amplitudes of the
motions for each wave are calculated. The number of waves needed to estimate accurately the expected value
(4.9.6)
Normal distribution:
{ ( -J'}
I
I A-A
P(A)=--exp -- ../2tru
2
u
(4.9.7)
where,
x :AJA*
A : double amplitude
A* : arbitrary base double amplitude
a : A*/(8m0)112
8m0 : A~ (square root of the square mean of the double amplitudes)
u : standard deviation
However, the value of a is 1.416 when the arbitrary base double amplitude A* is the significant valueA 113, and
= .!.(JnNy;'
(4.9.8)
On the other hand, in a normal distribution, the expected value of the double amplitudes is expressed by the
following equation.
(4.9.9)
The expected maximum value varies depending on the number of waves N. Table 4.9.2 shows the values
of xN relative to representative values of N and the values of N, which is the parameter of the deviation of a
standard normal distribution.
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
similarity laws fur the displacement and reaction furce characteristics of the mooring equipment. For example,
with a mooring rope, if the material used in the hydraulic model tests is kept the same as that used in the field and
the size is simply scaled down while maintaining the same shape, then the similarity laws will not hold; rather
it is necessary to scale down the elastic modulus of the material used in the models relative to that used in the
prototype. In practice, however, it will probably be unable to find such a material, in which case various other
100
200
500
1000
10000
Rayleigh distribution xN
1.52
1.63
1.76
1.86
2.14
Normal distribution N
2.33
2.58
2.88
3.09
3.96
maximum value
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
23)
24)
25)
26)
JSCE: Design Handbook fur Shore Protection Facilities. JSCE, pp 9-25, 2000
Goda, Y: Raodom Seas aod Design of Maritime Structures: ( Enlarged Edition), Kajima Publishing, pp. 23, 1990
Goda, Y: Raodom Seas and Design of Maritime Structures: ( Enlarged Edition), Kajima Publishing, pp. 24, 1990
Goda, Y. and Y. Suzuki: Computation of refraction and diffraction of sea waves with Mitsuyasu's directional spectrum,
Techoical Note of PHRI, No.230, pp.45, 1975
Goda, Y: Raodom Seas aod Design of Maritime Structures: (Enlarged Edition), Kajima Publishing, pp. 11-22, 1990
Takayama, T. and T. Hiraishi: Amplification Mechanism of Harbor Oscillation Derived From Field Observation And
Numerical Simnlation, Techoical Note of PHRI, No. 636, pp.70, 1988
Hashimoto, N.: Study on Estimation Methods of Directional Ocean Wave Spectrum, Technical Note of PHRI, No. 722,
pp.118, 1988
GODA, Y.: Numerical Examination of the Measuring Technique of Wave Direction with the 'Covariance Method', Rept. Of
PHRI Vol.20 No.3 1981.9
Sverdrup, H.U. aod Muok, W.H.: Wind, sea, aod swell: theory of relations for forecasting, U.S. Navy Hydrographic Office,
H.O. Pub. 601, pp.l-44, 1947
Bretschoeider, C.L.: Revised wave furecasting relationships, Proc. 2nd Conf. Coastal Engg., ASCE, 1952
Bretschoeider, C.L.: Revisions in wave forecasting, Deep and shallow water, Proc. 6th Conf. Coastal Engg., ASCE, pp.30-67,
1958
Wilson, B.W.: Numerical prediction of oceao waves in the North Atlaotic fur December, 1959, Deut, Hydrogr. Zeit, Jahrgang
18, Heft 3, pp.114-130, 1965
Goda, Y.: Revisiting Wilsoo's Formnlas fur Simplified Wind-Wave Prediction, Journal ofPort, Coast, and Ocean Engineering,
ASCE, Vol.129, Issue 2, pp.93-95, 2003
JSCE: The Collected Formula of Hydraulics, JSCE, 1971, p.508
Wilson, B.W.: Graphical approach to the forecasting of waves in moving fetches, Tech. Memo. No. 73, Beach Erosion Board,
U.S. Army Corps ofEngrs., 1955
Ijima, T.: Numerical forecast of waves, JSCE Proceedings of Summer Training on Hydranlic Engineering A, pp.2-1-2-30,
1968
Horikawa, K, H. Nishimura, Y. Ozawa and Y. Miyamoto: Wave hindcasting under typhoon in Beppu Bay, Proceedings of the
18th Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE ,pp.7-12,1971
Bretschneidcr, C.L.: Decay of ocean waves, Fundamentals of ocean engineering-Part Sb, Ocean Industry, pp.45-50, 1968
Horikawa, K.: (New Edition)Coastal Engineering, Tokyo University Press, pp, 84-88, 1991
lsozaki, I. and Uji, T.: Numerical prediction of ocean wind waves, Report of\Japan Meteorological Institute Vol. 24, No. 2,
pp. 207-231, 1973
Uji, T. : A coupled discrete wave model MRI-II, J. Oceaoogr. Soc. Japao, 40, pp.303-313, 1984
Uji, T and Ueoo K.: Wave Model MRI-II New, Japan Meteorological Institute Oceaoography Division,, p.118, 1987
Ueno, K. aod H. Takaoo: The third generation eave hindcasting model MRI-3 fur on-site operation. Proceeding ofFall Term
conference of Oceanographic Society of Japan, P. 153, 1998
Inoue, T.: On the growth of the spectrum of a wind generated sea according to a modified Miles-Philips mechanism and its
application to wave forecasting, Dept. Meteorol. and Oceaoogr., New York Univ., TR-67-5, p.74, 1967
Yamaguchi, M. and Y. Tsuchiya: Numerical forecast method for waves in finite fetch, Proceedings of the 26th Coastal
Engineering, JSCE, pp.96-100, 1979
Joseph, P. S. Kawai, S. and Toba, Y.: Ocean wave prediction by a hybrid model-combination of single-parameterized wind
waves with spectrally treated swells, Sci. Rept. Tohoku Univ., Ser. 5, Geophs., Vol. 28, No.I, pp.27-45, 1981
-163-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
27) Yamaguchi, M, Y. Hatada and Y. Utsunomiya: A shallow water predictioo model at a single location and its applicability,
Journal of the ASCE Vol.. 381/H7, pp. 151-160, 1987
28) The WAMDI Group: The WAM model- A third generation ocean wave prediction modei J. Phys. Oceaoogr., 18, pp.17751810, 1988
29) Hasselmann, S and K. Hasselamann: Computations and parameterizations of the nonlinear energy transfer in a gravity wave
spectrum, Part 1, A new method fur efficient computations of the exact ooolinear transfer integral, J. Phys. Oceanogr., 15,
pp.1369- 1377, 1985
30) Janssen, P.A.E.M.: Wave-induced stress and the drag of air !low over sea wave, Journal of Physical Oceanography, vol.19,
pp.745-754, 1989
31) Janssen, P.A.E.M.: Quasi-linear theory ofwind wave generation applied to wave forecasting, Journal ofFhysical Oceanography,
vol.21, pp.1631 1642, 1991
32) Hasselmann, K.: On the non-linear energy transfer in a gravity-wave spectrum, Part 1, General theory, J. Fluid Mech., 12,
pp.481- 500, 1%2
33) Booij, N., Holthuijsen, L. H. and R. C. Ris: The SWAN wave model for shallow water, Proceeding of 25th lnternatiooal
Conference on Coastal Engineering, Vol.I, pp. 668-676, 1996.
34) Goda, Y. and Y. Suzuki: Computation of refraction and diffraction of sea waves with Mitsuyasu's directional spectrum,
Technical Note of PHRI, No.230, pp.45,1975
35) Goda, Y: Standard wave spectrum and stochastic characteristics based oo numerical simulation, Proceedings of Coastal Eng.
JSCE, Vol.34, pp.131-135, 1987
36) JSCE: Design Handbook fur Shore Protection Facilities. JSCE, pp 33-36, 2000
37) Takayama, T., N. Ikeda and T. Hiraishi: Practical Computation Method of Directional Random Wave Thansfurmation, Report
of PHRI Vol.30 No.I, pp.21-67, 1991
38) Coastal Engineering Committee, JSCE: Coastal waves, JSCE, pp.15-118, 1994
39) Goda, Y: Random Seas and Design of Maritime Structures: ( Enlarged Edition), Kajima Publishing, pp. 41-66, 1990
40) The WAMDI Group : The WAM model- A third generation ocean wave predictioo model, J. Phys. Oceaoogr., 18, pp.17751810, 1988
41) Sato, S. and Y. Goda: Coast and Harbour, Easy-to-understand Civil Engineering Lecture, Shokokusha Publishing, pp.7275,1971
42) Takayama, T.: Wave Diffraction and Wave Height Distribution inside a Harbor, Technical Note of PAR! No367, p.140, 1981
43) Kubo, Y., Y. Kotake, M. Isobe and A. Watanabe: Time-dependent mild slope equation for random waves, Proceedings of
Coastal Engineering JSCE No. 38, pp.46-50, 1991
44) Hiraishi, T. I. Uehara and Y. Suzuki: Applicability of Wave Transformation Model in Boussinesq Equation, Technical Note
ofPHRI No.814, p.22, 1995
45) Nadaoka, K and Y Nakagawa: Derivation of fully-dispersive wave equations for irregular wave simulatioo and their
fundamental characteristics, Journal of the JSCE, No,467/H-23,pp.83-92,1993
46) Hirayama, K, et. al. : Utilizatioo of Numerical Simulation on Noolinear Irregular Wave for Port and Harbor Design, Technical
Note of Port and Airport Research Institute, No.1036, 162p, 2002
47) Hirayama, K., Y. Minam~ M. Okuno, K. Minemura, IL Kawai and T. Hiraishi: Case Study on Wave Disaster due to Typhooos
in 2004, Technical Note of PHRI, No.1101, p.42, 2005
48) Tanimoto, K., K. Kimura, A. P. dos Santos Pinto: Random Wave Forces and Design Wave Periods of Composite Breakwaters
under the Action of Double Peaked Spectral Waves, Rep!. Of PHRI, Vol.25 No.2, pp.3-25, 1986
49) Nishimura, K., H. Kato, J. Inoue, I. Nakamura and S. Muratra: Numerical simulation and hydraulic model test on wave height
distribution about an island, Proceedings of 27th Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.65-69, 1980
50) Hirayama, K: Numerical Simulation of Nonlinear Partial Standing Waves using the Boussinesq Model with New Re.Oectioo
Boundary, Rep!. of PHRI Vol. 40, No. 4, pp.3-48, 2001
51) Sawarag~ T Edition: New Coastal Engineering fur environmental sphere, Fuji Techno System, pp.251-252,1999
52) Tanaka, N. et al.: New dictionary of applied coastal engineering- waves around structures, Fuji Techno System, 1999
53) Goda, Y., Y. Suzuk~ Y. Kishira and 0. Kikuchi, Estimation of incident and Re.fleeted Waves in Random Wave Experiments,
Technical Note of PHRI No.248, p.24, 1976
54) Kobune, K and M. Osato: A Study of Wave Height Distribution along a Breakwater with a Corner, Report of PHRI, Vol. 15
No.2, 1976
55) Ito, Y. and K. Tanimoto: Meandering Damages of Composite Type Breakwaters, Technical Note of PHRI, No.112, 1971
56) Goda, Y. and T. Yoshimura: Wave Force Computation for Structures of Large Diameter, Isolated in the Offshore, Report of
PHRI
57) Shuto, N.: Transfurmation oflong wave- fur the case of changing channel width and depth-, Proceedings of 21st Conference
on Coastal Engineering JSCE, pp.57-64, 1974
58) Goda, Y.: Defurmation of Irregular Waves due to Depth-Controlled Wave Breaking, Report of PHRI, Vol. 14 No.3, 1975
59) JSCE: Design Handbook fur Shore Protectioo Facilities. JSCE, pp 90, 2000
60) Goda, Y: Rearrangement of breaker indices, Journal of Civil Engineering No. 180, JSCE, ,pp.39-49, 1970
61) Takayama, T., Y. Kamiyama and 0. Kikuchi: Wave Transfurmation On a Reef, Technical Note of PHRI No.278, pp.32, 1977
62) Egashira, K, I. Fukuda, Y. Kishira and T. Nishimura: Field observation of transformation of waves on reefs., Proceedings of
-164-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
32nd conference on Coastal Engineering, JSCE, pp.90-94, 1985
63) Hiraishi, T.: Generation and Application of Directional Random Waves in a Laboratory, Technical Note PHRI No, 723, p. 176,
1992
64) Mase H.: Random wave rnnup height on gentle slope, J. Waterway, Port, Coastal and Ocean engineering, ASCE, Vol.118,
No.5, pp.649-664, 1989
65) Van der Meer, J.W. and C.M.Stam: wave runup on smooth and rock slopes of coastal structures, J. Waterway, Port, Coastal
and Ocean Engineering, ASCE, Vol.118, No.5, pp.534-550, 1992
66) Mase, H., T.S, Hedges M. Share and S. Nagase: Study on wave overtopping rate of sloping coastal dikes considering wave up
rush,
67) Saville, T. Jr.: Wavernn-up on composite slopes, Proc. 6th Conf. on Coastal Eng., pp.691-699, 1958
68) Nakamura, A, Y. Sasaski and J. Yamada: Study on wave run-up on the composite slopes, Proceedings of 13th Conference on
Coastal Eng., JSCE, PP.309-312, 1972
69) Hosoi, M. and H. Mitsui: Wave up rush on the sea walls placed inner shore inside breaker line, Proceedings of 9th Coastal
Eng., JSCE, 1962
70) Hosoi, M. and N. Shuto: Wave up rush fur the case of diagonal incident wave, Proceedings of 9th Coastal Eng,. JSCE, pp.149152, 1962
71) Study Group on application of numerical wave tank to structural design against waves: Study and development of numerical
wave channel, Coastal Development Technology Library, CDIT, pp,156-163, 2001.
72) Sakuraba, M,, S. Hirosaki and K. Kashiyama: Numerical calculation of wave overtopping and wave run-up by CIVA/Level
set method, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. No. 51, JSCE, pp,36-40,2004,
73) Hiraishi, T. K. Hirayama and H. Kawai: A Study on Wave-Overtopping by J)'phoon No. 9918, Technical Note of PHRI
No.972, p.19, 2000
74) Goda, Y, Y. Kishira and Y. Kamiyama: Laboratory investigation on the overtopping rate of seawalls by irregular waves, Rcpt.
OfPHRI Vol. 14, No. 4, pp.3-44,1975
75) GODA Y. and Y. KISIIlRA: Experiments on irregular Wave Overtopping Characteristics of Seawalls of Low Crest Types,
Technical Note of PHRI No. 242, p.28, 1976
76) TAKAYAMA, T. T. NAGAI and K. NISHIDA: Decrease of Wave Overtopping Amount due to Seawalls of Low Crest Types,
Rept. Of PHRI Vol.21 No.2,pp.151-205,1982
77) GODA, Y: Estimation of the Rate of Irregular Wave Overtopping of Seawalls, Rept. Of PHRI Vol.9No.4,pp.3-41,1970
78) Fukuda, N. T. Uno and I. Irie: Field observation of wave overtopping at sea walls (Second Report)Proceeding s of 20th
Coastal Eng. JSCE, PP.113-118, 1973
79) Nagai, S. and A. Tak:ada: Effect of wave absorbing blocks on wave overtopping at coastal dikes, Proceeding of 11th Coastal
Eng. JSCE, pp.279-286,1964
80) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Study and Development of Numerical wave channel (CADMASSURF), Coastal Development Technology Library No. 12, 78p, 2001
81) YASUDA, T and T. lllRAISHI: Highly Accurate Inundation Simulation by MARS Method on Compound Coastal Urban
Area: Rept of PAR! Vol.43, No.2, pp.3-34,2004
82) Takayama, T. T. Nagai, K. Nishida and T. Sekiguchi: Hydraulic Model Test fur wave overtopping characteristics of sea walls
against diagonal random incident waves, Proceeding of Coastal Eng. JSCE, Vol. 31, pp.542-546, 1984
83) lllRAISIIl, T. N. MOCIIlZUKI, K. SATO, H. MARUYAMA, T. Kanazawa: Effi:ct of Wave Directionality on Overtopping
at Seawall, Rept of PHRI Vol. 35 No. I, pp. 39-64, 1996
84) Miyajima, S. S. Ogura, Y. Ogusu, T. Morikawa and S. Okuda: Experimental Study on wave overtopping rate of sloping sea
wall having parapet, Proceeding of Coastal Eng. JSCE, Vol. 51, pp. 636-640, 2004
85) Goda, Y. Y. Suzuki and Y. Kishira: Random wave model test and the characteristics, Proceedings of 21st Coastal Eng. JSCE,
pp.237-242, 1974
86) Goda, Y: Random Seas and Design of Maritime Structures, Kajima Publishing, pp. 100-102, 1990
87) Kondo, T. and I. Sato: A study on the crest height of breakwaters, Journal of Public Works Research Institute (PWRI),
Hokkaido Regional Development Bureau (HRDB)No. 117, pp.1-5, 1964
88) Sakamoto, Y. Y. Miyaji T. Uenishi and H., Takeda: Experimental study on eydraulic characteristics of sloping sea walls,
Journal of Public Works Research Institute, Hokkaido Regional Development Bureau Vol. 82, 1984
89) Kondo, T. and H. Takeda: wave absorbing facilities, Moti.kita Publishing, pp. 70-129, 1983
90) MORIHIRA, M., S. KAKIZAKI and Y. GODA: EXPERIMENTAL INVESTIGATION OF A CURTAIN-WALL
BREAKWATER, Rept. OfPHRI Vol. 3 No.I, pp. 1-27, 1%4
91) Longuet-Higgins, M.S. and R.W. Stewart: Radiation stress and mass transport in gravity waves with application to surf beats,
Jour. Fluid Mechanics Vol.13, pp.481-504, 1%2
92) Goda, Y. Design diagram of wave set-up and longshore currents under directional random waves, Proceedings of Ocean
Development Vol. 21, pp.301-306, 2005
93) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Impact Evaluation Manna! for long-period waves in ports, Coastal
Technology Library No. 21, CDIT, 2004, 86p.
94) Kondo, T. and H. Takeda: Wave Absorbing Structures, Mori.kita Publishing Co., 1983, ,pp. 70-129,
95) KATO, K., S. NAKAMURA and N. IKEDA: Estimation of lnfragravity Waves in Consideration of Wave Groups (An
-165-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Examination on Basis of Field Observation at HORF), Rep! of PHRI Vol. 30 No.I, pp.137-163, 1991
96) HIRAISHI, T, A. TADOKORO and H. FUJISAKU: Characteristics of Long Period Wave Observed in Port, Rep!. Of PHRI
Vol.35 No.3, pp.3-36,1996
97) Coastal Engineering Committee, JSCE: Coastal waves, JSCE, ,pp.15-118, 1994
98) TAKAYAMA, T. and T. HIRAISHI: Amplification Mechanism of Harbor Oscillation Derived From Field Observation And
Numerical Simulation, Technical Note of PHRI No.636, P.70, 1988
99) Hiraishi, T., S. Kawano S. Tarnaki and J. Hasegawa: Standard wave spectrum oflong period wave employed in the design of
port and habour facilities, Proceeding of Coastal Eng. JSCE No.. 44, pp.246-250, 1997
100) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Impact Evaluation Manual for !nag-period waves in ports, Coastal
Technology Library No. 21, CDIT, 2004, 86p.
101) UEDA, S., S. SHIRAISHI, H. OSHIMA and K. ASANO: Allowable Wave Height and Wharf Operation Efficiency Based on
the Oscillations of Ships Moored to Quay Walls, Technical Note ofPHRI No.779, P.44, 1994
102) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Impact Evaluation Manual fur long-period waves in ports, Coastal
Technology Library No. 21, CDIT, 2004, 86p.
103) Japan Association of Maritime Safety: Survey and study on fundamental elements of sea transport safety (Report 3)- Effect
of ship waves on small crafts, p.83, 1976
104) Japan Shipping Exchange, Inc.: The Annual "Register of Ships" (SENPAKU MEISAISHO)l975,- 1975
105) Takeuchi, T. and J. Shichizawa: So-called "Gunkan-ha" (Ship waves caused by battleships)on lmabari Coast, Journal. of the
Oceanographic Society of Japan Vol. 17 No.2, pp.80-90, 1961
106) Ertekin, R.C., W.C. Webster and J.V. Wehausen: Ship generated solution, Proc. 15th Symp. Nav. Hydlodyn., pp.347-364,
1985
107) JSCE: The Collected Formula of Hydraulics (1985 Edition), JSCE, Nov. 1985
108) Goda, Y: Random Seas and Design of Maritime Structures, Kajima Publishing, pp. 323, 1990
109) Study Group on application of numerical wave tank to structural design against waves: Study and development of numerical
wave channel, Coastal Development Technology Library, CDIT, pp,156-163, 2001.
110) Mitauyasu, H. : Theory of wave pressure, Summer Training on Hydraulic Engineering B Coast and Harbour 1%5, Hydraulic
Committee, JSCE pp.B-16-1-B-16-25,l965
111) ITO, Y. M. FUJISHIMA and T. KITATANI: ON THE STABILITY OF BREAKWATERS, Rept. Of PHRI Vol.5 No.4,p.134,
1966
112) Goda, Y. : Wave forces on port facilities, Lecture Note of Summer Training on Hydraulic Engineering B Coast and Harbour
1967, Hydraulic Committee, JSCE pp.B-10-1-B-10-34,1967
113) Tanimoto, K: Wave furces on composite breakwaters, Proceeding of Lecture Meeting of PHRI 1976, pp.1-26, 1976
114) Goda, Y. :Motion of Composite Breakwater on Elastic Foundation under the Action oflmpulsive Breaking Wave Pressure,
Rept. Of PHRI Vol. 12 No,3, pp. 31-69, 1973
115) Tanimoto, K, K. Moto, S. Ishizuka and Y. Goda: Discussions on formula of design wave forces on breakwaters, Proceedings
of 23rd Coastal Eng. JSCE pp.11-16,1976
116) Takahashi, S., K. Tanimoto, K. Shimosak:o and T. Hosoyamada: Proposal of Pressure coefficient of impact-breaking waves
on composite type breakwater considering fuundation mound profile, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 39, pp. 676-680,
1992
117) G. Sainflou: Essai sur les diques maritimas verticals, Annaled des Ponts et Chaussees Vol.98, No. 1, PP.5-48,1928
118) I. Hiroi: On a method of estimating the force of waves, Journal of School of Engineering, Tokyo Imperial University, Vol. X,
No.I, p.19, 1919
119) Kuroda, S. and T. lshiwata: Disaster Prevention Engineering, Sankaido Publishing Co., 1960, 276p>
120) Nagai, K, T. Ozawa, Y. Hishira and T. Nishimura: Characteristics offield waves having a bi-modal wave spectrum generated
ed by typhoon, Proceedings of33rd Coastal Eng. JSCE, ,pp.144-148,1986
121) Tanimoto, K, K. KIMURA, A. P. dos Santos Pinto: Random Wave Forces and Design Wave Periods ofComposite Breakwaters
under the Action of Double Peaked Spectral Waves, Rep! of PHRI Vol. 25 No.2, pp.3-25, 1986
122) Nakata, K. K. Terauchi, H. Nishida and I. Umeki: Characteristics oflow crest breakwaters, Proceedings of 31st Coastal Eng.
JSCE, ,pp.532-536,1984
123) Mizuno, Y. Y. Sugimoto, K. Kimura, K. Yamanaka and S. Kikuchi: Study of Characteristics of wave force on high crest
breakwaters, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol.
124) TANIMOTO, K., K. KIMURA: A Hydraulic Experimental Study on Trapezoidal Caisson Breakwaters, Technical Note of
PHRI No.528,p.28, 1985
125) Nagai, S, T. Kubo and K. Tokikawa: Study on Steel pile breakwater (First Report)Proceeding of Coastal Eng, JSCE ,pp.209218,1965
126) Hayashi, T, T. Kano, M. Shirai and S. Hattori: Hydraulic characteristics of cylindrical permeable breakwaters, Proceeding of
12th Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.193-197, 1%5
127) Goda, Y. and S. Kakizaki: STUDY ON FINITE AMPLITUDE STANDING WAVES AND THEIR PRESSURES UPON A
VERTICAL WALL, Repot of PHRI Vol.5 No.lO,pp.1-57,1966
128) TANIMOTO, K., S. TAKAHASHI and T. KITATANI: Experimental Study of Impact Breaking Wave Forces on a Verticalwall Caisson of Composite Breakwater, Rept ofPHRI Vol. 20 No.2, pp3-39, 1981
-166-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
129) H. Mitsuyasu: Experimental study on wave force against a wall, Report of Trans. Tech. Res. Inst. No.47, pp.1-39, 1962
130) Honma, M., K. Horikawa aud N. Hase: Wave forces on sea dikes, Proceeding of 9th Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.133- 137,1962
131) MORIHIRA, M. S. KAKIZAKI and T. KIKUYA: EXPERIMENTAL STUDY ON WAVE FORCE DAMPING EFFECTS
DUE TO DEFORMED ARTIFICIAL BLOCKS, Rept. PHRI Vol.6 No.4, pp.3-31, 1967
132) GODA, Y. and S. HARANAKA: Title AN EXPERIMENT ON THE SHOCK PRESSURE OF BREAKING WAVES,
Technical Note of PHRI No.32, pp.1-18, 1967
133) Horikawa, K. and Y. Noguchi: Relationship between breaker pressure and wave profile acting on a vertical wall, Proceeding
of 17th Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp,177-184,1970
134) Fujisaki, H, A. Sasada aud Y. Takahashi: Discussion on the construction techniques of breakwaters on steep slope sea bed,
Proceeding of Chubu Branch of JSCE, ,pp.181-183,1996
135) TAKAHASHI, S., K. TANIMOTO aud S. SUZUMURA: Generation Mechanism of Impulsive Pressure by Breaking Wave
on a Vertical Wall, Rep! ofPHRI, Vol. 22 No.4, pp.3-31, 1983
136) Shimosako, Kand N. Osaki: Study on the Application of the Calculation Methods of Wave Forces acting on the Various Type
of Composite Breakwaters, Technical Note ofPHRI, No.1107,pp.1-14,2005
137) Goda, Y: Motion of Composite Breakwater on Elastic Foundation under the Action of Impulsive Breaking Wave Pressure,
Rept. Of PHRI, Vol.12 No.3, pp.3-29, 1973
138) Dynamic response of composite type breakwaters to impact breaking waves, Proceedings of Coastal Engineering JSCE, Vol.
40,pp. 766-770, 1993
139) Tanimoto, K, M. Osato, S. Takaoka, T. Uchida aud T. lkada: An experiment on stability of breakwaters with wave-absorhing
blocks against random waves, Proceedings of the 26th Coastal Eng., JSCE, pp,343-347, 1979
140) TANIMOTO, K. S. TAKAHASHI and, K. MIYOSE: Title Experimental Study ofRaudom Wave Forces on Upright Sections
of Breakwaters, Repot ofPHRI Vol.23 No.3,pp.47-100, 1984.9
141) TAKAHASHI, S. K. TANIMOTO and K. SHIMOSAKO: Title Wave and Block Forces on a Caisson Covered with Wave
Dissipating Blocks, Rept. Of PHRI Vol.29 No.1,pp54-75, 1990.3
142) Sekino, T., T. Kadono and T. Imoto: Study on design methods for wave-absorbing block armored break.waters having un
armored parapet, Journal of Public Works Research Institute, Hokkaido Regional Development Bureau No.397, pp,14-20,
1986
143) Tanaka, H., N. Abe and M. Kato: Evaluation of horizontal wave force on wave-absorbing block armored caisson breakwater.
Proceedings of the 32nd Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.490-494, 1985
144) Kougamu, Y. and K. Tokikawa: Experimental study on the wave-pressure decreasing effect of wave absorbing blocks during
the construction, Report of the Public Works Research Institute (PWRI), Hokkaido Regional Development Bureau (HRDB)
No. 53, pp.81-95, 1970
145) Shiomi, M., H. Yamamoto, A. Tsugawa, T. Kurosawa and K. Matsumoto: Damages and countermeasures of breakwaters due
to the wave force increase at discontinuous points of wave-absorbing blocks, Proceedings of the 41st conference on Coastal
Eng. JSCE, pp.791-795,1994
146) TANIMOTO, K. and R. OilMA: Title Experimental Study ofWave Forces Acting on a Superstructure of Sloping Breakwaters
and on Block Type Composite Breakwaters, Technical Note of PHRI No.450 ,p.32, 1983.6
147) Hiromoto, F., H. Nishijima, S. Konno and I. Kimura: Load of blocks of wave-observing block armored breakwaters under
wave actions, Proceedings of the 40th Confurence on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp. 347-351, 1983
148) ARIKAWA, T., M. !KEBE, N. OSAKI, T. KURODA, T. ORITA and K. SHIMOSAKO: Title Study on punching shear
failures of caisson wall caused by the impulsive force of dissipating blocks Rep! of PAR! Vol.44 No.I, pp. 3-34, 2005.3
149) Yamaguchi, T., M. Beppu and T. Ono: Experimental study of bumping force ofwave-absorbing blocks on vertical walls under
the action of impact breaking waves, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 50, pp. 711-715, 2003
150) T. Hosoyamada, S. Takahashi aud K. Tanimoto: Application of sloping top caisson breakwater at isolated islands, proceedings
ofConfi:rence on Coastal Eng. JSCE, Vol. 41, pp.325-329, 1994
151) Morihaira, M. and 0. Kunita: An model experiments on hydraulic characteristics of sloping breakwater, Proceedings of the
26th Confi:rence on Coastal Eng. JSCE, ,pp.295-298,1979
152) Sato, T. N. Yamagata, M. Furukawa, S. Takahashi and T. Hosoyamada: Hydraulic characteristics of sloping-top breakwaters
armored with wave-absorbing blocks- Development of a new structural type of breakwaters in deep water area in Naha Port-,
Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 39, pp.556-560,1992
153) Katayama, H., T. Sekimoto, Y. Kawamata and K. Ueki: On wave force characteristics acting on submerged sloping-top
caisson breakwaters, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 45, pp. 776-780, 1998
154) TAKAHASHI, S., K. SHIMOSAKO and H. SASAKI: Title Experimental Study on Wave Forces Acting on Perforated Wall
Caisson Breakwaters Rept of PHRI Vol. 30 No.4, pp.3-34, 1991.12
155) TANIMOTO, K., S. HARANAKA, E. TOMIDA, Y. IZUMIDA aud S. SUZUMURA : Title A Hydraulic Experimental
Study on Curved Slit Caisson Rep! ofPHRI Vol. 19 No.4, pp.3-53, 1980.12
156) TANIMOTO, K., S. TAKAHASHI and T. MURANAGA: Title Uplift Forces on a Ceiling Slab of Wave Dissipating Caisson
with a Permeable Front Wall- Analytical Model for Compression of anEnclosedAir Layer-, Rep! of PHRI Vol.19 No.l,pp.3-31,
1980.3
157) TAKAHASHI, S. and K. TANIMOTO: Title Uplift Forces on a Ceiling Slab of Wave Dissipating Caisson with a Permeable
Front Wall(2nd Report)-Field Data Analysis- Rep! ofPHRI Vol. 23 No. 2, pp.3-25, 1984.6
-167-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
158) ITO, FY. And K. TANIMOTO: Title Meandering Damages of Composite J)'pe Breakwaters. Technical Note of PHRI No.112,
pp.13, 1971.3
159) Kougam~ Y., N. Fujiki and Y. Uehara: An experiment on wave height and pressure at a corner of breakwater, Journal of
Public Works Research Institute (PWRI), Hokkaido Regional Development Bureau (HRDB)No. 218, pp.1-11, 1971
160) Y. K.ougami, N. Fujiki and T. Tsutsumi: An experiment on wave height and pressure at a corner of breakwater (Second
Rep.), Journal of Public Works Research Institute (PWRI), Hokkaido Regional Development Bureau (HRDB)No. 230, pp.113,1972
161) Goda, Y, T. YOSHIMURA and M. ITO: Reflection and Diffraction of Water Waves by an Insular Breakwater, Rept of PHRI
Vol.10 No.2,pp.3-52, 1971.6
162) ITO, Y., K. TANIMOTO, K. KOBUNE, T. KITATANI and M. TODOROKI: Title An Experimental Investigation of Upright
Breakwater s on Reefs, Technical Note of OHR! No.189, 1974.6
163) Tominaga, M. and I. Kuzumi: braking wave pressure on coastal dikes, Proceedings of the 18th Conference on Coastal Eng.
JSCE, pp. 215-221, 1971
164) Coastal Engineering Research Center: Shore Protection Manual Vil.II, Department of Army Corps of Engineers, 1984
165) JSCE Edition: Guideline and commentary for design of Offshore Structures (Draft), JSCE, pp.28-53, 1973
166) J.R. Morison, M.R. O'Brien, J.W. Johonson,S.A. Schaaf: The force exerted by surface waves on piles, Petroleum Trans., 189,
TP 2846, pp.149-154, 1950
167) T.E. Stetson and R.T. Mavis: Virtual mass and acceleration in fluid, Proc. ASCE., Vol. 81, Separate No.670, pp.670-1-670-9,
1955
168) Hamada, H. and N. Hasegawa: Wave forces on structures, Proceedings of the 3rd Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE ,pp.6783, 1956,
169) Keulegan, G.H. and L.H. Carpenter: Forces on cylinders and plates in an oscillating fluid, Journal of the National Bureau of
Standards, Vol. 60, No. 5, pp.423-440, 1958
170) Sarpkaya, T.: Forces on cylinders and shores in a sinusoidally oscillating fluid, Journal of Applied Mechanics, Trans. of
ASME, Vol. 42, No. l, pp. 32-37, 1975
171) Sarpkaya, T.: In-line and transverse forves on cylinders in oscillatory !low at high Reynolds number, Proc. of the Offshore
Technology Conference, Vol.11, pp.95-108, 1976
172) Sarpkaya, T., N,J. Collins and S.R. Evans: Wave forces on rough-walled cylinders at high Reynolds numbers, Proc. Of OTC,
Vo. 111, #2901, pp.167-184, 1977
173) Y. Goda: Wave-forces on a vertical circular cylinder; Experiments and proposed method ofwaveforce computation, Report
of P.H.T.R.l., No.8, p.74, 1964
174) Yamaguchi, M.: Fundamental study on wave forces on sphere and standing waves, Kyoto Univ. Dissertation ,p.147,1974
175) Nakamura, M.: Study on wave forces on coastal structures and their dynamic response, Osaka Univ. Dissertation ,p.297, 1977
176) Chakrab~ S.K., A.L. Wollbert, and A.T. William: Wave forces on vertical circular cylinder, Journal ofWaterways, Harbors
and Coastal Engineering Division, ASCE, Vol.102, No.WW2, pp.203-221, 1976
177) Chakrab~ S.K.: Inline forces on fixed vertical cylinder in waves, Journal of the Waterway, Port, Cow and Ocean Division,
ASCE, Vol.106, WW2, pp.145' 155, 1980
178) Koterayama, W. and M. Tashiro: Wave forces on semi-submerged horizontal cylinder in diagonal incident wave and vertical
cylinder in deep water waves, Report of Research Institute for Applied Mechanics Kyushu Uuiv. Vol. 5o, pp. 35-61, 1979
179) Oda, K.: Wave forces on structures- Cylindrical structures-, Lecture note of Summer training for Hydraulic Engineering
1982, (18th)Course B, Hierodulic Committee of JSCE, pp.B-4-l-B-5-27,1982
180) Mizuno, Y. T. Kadono, Y. Nagai, 0. Momose and T. Sekino: Field experiment on offshore structure in a rough sea zone, Rept.
of the Public Works Research Institute (PWRI), Hokkaido Regional Development Bureau (HRDB)No.87,p.77,1988
181) Kim, Y.Y. and H.C. Hibbard: Analysis of simultaneous wave force and water particle velocity Measurements, Proc. of OTC,
Vol.I, No.2192, pp.461-469, 1975
182) Ogusu, A. : Wave forces on multiple row cylinders, Proceedings of the Society of Naval Architects of Japan No. 131, 1972
183) Nakamura, H. and N. Abe: Hydraulics of intake tower of power plant, Proceedings of the 19th Confurence on Coastal Eng.
JSCE, pp. 391-394, 1972
184) GODA, Y. S. HARANAKA and M. KITAHATA: Title STUDY OF IMPULSIVE BREAKING WAVE FORCES ON PILES,
Rept of PHRI Vol. 5 No.6, pp. 1-30, 1966.4
185) TANIMOTO, K. S. TAKAHASHI, T. KANEKO, K. SHIOTA and K. OGURA: Title Experimental Study on Impulsive
Forces by Breaking Waves on Circular Cylinder Rept of PHRI Vol. 25 No.2, pp.33-87, 1986.6
186) Goda, Y. : Design of marine structures- wave forces-, Jour. of JSCE Vo55 No.9, pp.2-7, 1970
187) Nagasak~ S. and K. Ogata: Wave forces on underwater pipelines (First Rept.), Proceedings of the 18th Conference on Coastal
Eng. JSCE, pp. 223-227, 1971
188) T. Sarpkaya, M. Isaacson: Mechanics of Wave Forces on Offshore Structure, Van Nostrand Reinhold Company, p.651, 1981
189) T. Yamamoto, J.H. Nath: Forces on many cylinders near a plane boundary, ASCE, National Water Resources and Ocean
Engineering Convention, Preprint No.2633, 1976
190) T. Sarpkaya: In-line and transverse forces on cylinders near a wall in oscillatory !low at high Reynolds numbers, OTC paper
No.2898, pp.161 166, 1977
191) T. Sarpkaya, F. Rajabi.: Hydrodynamic drag on bottom-mounted smooth and rough cylinders in periodic flow, OTC Paper
-168-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
No.3761, pp.219-226, 1980
192) Borgman, L.E.: Spectral analysis of ocean wave furces on pilling, Proc. ASCE, Vol.93, No. W W2, pp.129-156, 1967
193) Hino, M.: Spectral theory of wave forges on piles, Proceedings of the 15th Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp. 103-108,
1968
194) Borgman, L.E.: Ocean wave simulation for engineering design, Proc. ASCE, VoL95,No,WW4,pp.557-583, 1%9
195) ITO, Y. K. TANIMOTO and K. KOBUNE: Title Dynamic Response of an Offshore Platform to Random Waves Rep! of PHRI
Vol. 11 No.3, pp.59-86, 1972.9
196) Hudspeth, R.T.: Wave force prediction from non-linear random sea simulation, 7th OTC,# 2193, pp.471-486, 1975
197) Sharma, J. and Dean, R.G.: Second-order directional seas and associated wave forces, 11th OTC, #3645, pp.2505-2514, 1979
198) Tickell, R.G. and Elwany, M.H.S.: A probabilistic description of forces on a member in a short-crested random sea, Mechanics
of Wave-Induced Forces on Cylinders, Pitman Pub. Ltd., London, pp.561-576, 1979
199) Kimura, A. A., Seyama and A. Ueno: Stochastic characteristics of random wave forces acting on cylinder, Proceedings of
27th Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE ,pp. 373-377, 1980
200) GODA, Y. T. IKEDA, T. SASADA and Y. KISHIDA: Title Study on Design Wave Forces on Circular Cylinders Erected upon
Reefs Rep! of PHRI Vol. 11 No.4, PP.45-81, 1972.12
201) Hiraishi, T. Y. Tomita and Y. Suzuki: Effect of wave directionality on wave forces on Cylinder, Proceedings of 27th
Confurence on Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 41,pp. 836-840, 1994
202) MacCamy, R.C. and R.A. Fncbs: Wave Forces on Piles, a Diffraction Theory, U.S. Army, Corps ofEngineers, Beach Erosion
Board, Tech. Memo. No.69, p.17, 1954
203) GODA, Y. and T. YOSHIMURA: Title Wave Force Computation for Structores of Large Diameter, Isolated in the Offshore,
Rept of PHRI Vol. 10 No.4, pp.3-52, 1971.12
204) Yamaguchi, M: Wave forces on pile structures, Lectore note of Summer training for Hydraulic Engineering 1975, (11th)
Course B, Hierodulic Committee of JSCE, pp.B-6-l-B-6-26,1975
205) TANIMOTO, K., S. TAKAHASHI and Y. IZUMIDA: A Calculation Method of Uplift Forces on a Horizontal Platform, Rep!.
of PHRI Vol.17 No.2,pp.3-47,1978
206) ITO, Y. and H. TAKEDA: Uplift on Pier Deck due to Wave Motion, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 6 No. 4, pp. 37-68, 1967
207) Murota, A. and M. Furudoi: Experimental study on uplift force on deck of pier, Proceedings of the 13th Conference on
Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.i20-125,1966
208) Nagai, S. T. Kobo and K. Tokikawa: Study on uplift on piers (First Rep.), Proceedings ofthe13th Conference on Coastal Eng.
JSCE, pp. 112-119, 1966
209) Horikawa, K., T. Nakao and A. Yajima: Experimental stndy on uplift on piers, Proceedings of the14th Conference on Coastal
Eng. JSCE, pp.148-153,1967
210) Sawaragi, T. and M. Nochino: Discossion on Similarity law for hydraulic model tests on uplift acting on decks of piers,
Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 35, pp. 677-681, 1988
211) TANIMOTO, K., Shigeo TAKAHASHI, Masahiko TODOROKI and Yoshikazu IZUMIDA: Horizontal Wave Forces on a
Rigid Platform, Rep!. of PHRI Vol. 16 No.3,pp.39-68,1977
212) Tirindelli, M., Cuomo, G., Allsop, W., and McConnell, K.: Exposed jetties: Inconsistencies and gaps in design methods for
wave-induced forces, Proc. Of the 28th International Conference on Coastal Engineering, Cardiff; pp.1684-1696, 2002
213) Tirindelli, M., Cuomo, G., Allsop, W., and McConnell, K.: Physical model studies ofwave-induced loading on exposed jetties:
Towards new prediction formulae, Proc. Of the International Confereoce Coastal Structures 2003, Portland,pp,382-393,2003
214) Cuomo, G., Allsop, W., and M.cCormell, K.: Dynamic Wave Loads on Coastal Structores: Analysis ofimpulsive and pulsating
wave loads, Proc. Of the International Conference Coastal Structures 2003, Portland, pp.356-368,2003
215) Bentiba, R., Cuomo, G., Allsop, W., and Burm, N.: Probability of occurreoce of wave loading on fatty deck elements, Proc.
Of the 29th International Conference on Coastal Engineering, Lisbon, pp.4113-4125, 2004
216) Kubou, M. M. Takezawa and T. Ueki: Experimental study on wave pressure at the vicinity of wave crest, Proceedings of the
20th Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp. 279-284, 1973
217) Michio Morihira,Shusako Kakizaki and Yoshimi Goda :EXPERIMENTAL INVETIGATION OF A CURTAIN-WALL
BREAKWATER ,REPORT OF PORT AND HARBOUR TECHNICAL RESEARCH INSTITUTE MINISTRY OF
TRANSPOTATION No.l,p.16,1964
218) Sekimpto, T., H. Kondo, T. Oshita, S. Imai and M. Nakamura: Design wave force of curtain-wall type breakwater considering
incident wave aogle, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 35, pp. 657-661, 1988
219) JSCE: Design Handbook for Shore Protection Facilities (2000). JSCE, pp 301-305, 2000
220) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDI1): Commentary on analysis and applications of Coastal Waves, Coastal
Observation data, ,p.181,2000
221) Goda Y. Edition: Working Group for Analysis and application of coastal observation data: Measurement of waves (guidebook
of coastal wave observation)CDIT, ,p.212,2001
222) Gringorten, I.I : A plotting rule for extreme probability paper, J. Geophysical Res., Vol. 68, No.3, PP.813-814,1963
223) Petrnaskas, C. and R.M. Aggaard: Extrapolation of historical storm data for estimating design wave heights, Preprints 2nd
OTC, No.1190., 1970
224) Takada, E., K. Morohoshi, T. Hiraishi, T. Nagai and S. Takemura: Distribution of wave, storm and tsunami design conditions
on Japanese nationwide coastal structores, Technical Note of PAR! No.88,2003
-169-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
225) Goda, Y.: Numerical Investigations on Plotting Formulas and Confidence Intervals of Return Values in Extreme statistics,
Rep!. of PHRI Vol. 27 No. I, pp. 31-92, 1988
226) Goda, Y: Random Seas and Design of Maritime Structures: (Enlarged Edition), Kajima Publishing, Chapter 11,pp.265322,1990 (in Japanese)
227) Goda, Y. Demonstrative study on Distribution generating function of extreme wave statistics, Proceedings of Coastal Eng.
JSCE Vol. 45, JSCE, p.211-215,1998
228) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Impact Evaluation Manual fur long-period waves in ports, Coastal
Technology Library No. 21, CDIT, 2004, 86p.
229) NAGAI, T and H. OGAWA: Annual Report on Nationwide Ocean Wave information network for Ports and Harbors (
NOWPHAS 2002), Technical Note of PAR!, No.1069, p.336, 2004
230) Nagai, T: Long Term Statistics Report on Nationwide Ocean Wave information network for Ports and Harbors (NOWPHAS
1970- 1999 ), Technical Note of PAR! No.1035,p.336,2002
231) Bureau of Port and harbours: Design Manual for prestressed concrete port facilities, ,1987
232) JSCE: Design Manual for Coastal Protection Facilities, JSCE. 2000, pp. 31-68
233) TAKAYAMA, T. and H. FUJI: Probabilistic Estimation of Stability of Slide for Caisson Type Breakwater Author Tomotsuka,
Rept. of PHRI Vol. 30 No. 4, pp. 35-64, 1991
234) HIRAYAMA, K.: Utilization of Numerical Simulation on Nonlinear Irregular Wave for Port and Harbor Design, Technical
Note of PAR! No. 1036, pp. 162, 2002
235) HIRAJSHI, T.: Generation andApplicationofDirectional Random Waves in a Laboratory, Technical Note ofPHRI, Technical
Note of PHRI, No.723 1992.3
236) Coastal Development Institute ofTechnology: Manual forthe evaluation ofLong-period waves in harbors, Coastal Technology
Library No. 21,pp. 86, 2004
237) HIRAYAMA, K., Yasubiko MINAMI, Mitsuhiro OKUNO, Koji IMAMURA, Hiroyasu KAWAI and Tetsuya IRISH: Case
Study on Wave Disaster due to Typhoons in 2004,, Technical Note of PAIR No .1101, pp. 42, 2005
238) Hirayam,a, K. and K. Minemura: simple estimation methods of the amplification rate of wave height at river mouths,
Proceedings offshore Development VoL21, pp. 313-318, 2005
239) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Manual for Floating Structures, 1991 (in Japanese)
240) Kanda, K., Shiraishi, N. and Takino, Y.: On the Peculiarity of Shaking for Floating Wharfs, Proc. of Civil Engineering in the
Ocean, JSCE, Vol.2, pp.163-168, 1986 (in Japanese)
241) Toyoda, S.: Floating Offshore Oil Storage System, Proc. of the 4th Ocean Engineering Symposium, SNAI, pp.25-50, 1979 (in
Japanese)
242) Kogure, K., Suzuki, Y., Katagir~ M. and Yakuwa, T.: Design and Construction of Floating Breakwater, Proc. of the 30th
Japanese Conference on Coastal Engineering, JSCE, pp.435-439, 1983 (in Japanese)
243) Maruyama, T.: On the Construction of Swing and Floating Bridge, Proc. of the 14th Ocean Engineering Symposium, SNAI,
pp.327-334, 1998 (in Japanese)
244) Osaka City: Construction Report ofYumemai Bridge, Public Works Bureau, Osaka City, 2002 (in Japanese)
245) Miyamoto, T.: Floating Disaster Prevention Basis, Cargo Handling Japan, Japan Cargo Handling Mechanization Association,
Vol.44 No.3, pp.316-321, 1999 (in Japanese)
246) Kozawa, T., Miyao~ Y., Koizum~ T., Wada, K. and Matsushita, Y.: Provision of Floating Disaster Prevention Basis, Proc. of
Techno-Ocean 2000 lotemational Symposium, Techno-Ocean Network, pp.623-628, 2000
247) Coastal Development Institute of Technology and Floating Structures Association of Japan: Report on Study of Large-scale
Floating Structures, 1995 (in Japanese)
248) Technological Research Association of Mega-Float: Report on the Fiscal 1997 Research Results of Mega-Float Floating
Offshore Structure, 1998 (in Japanese)
249) Floating Structures Association of Japan: Large-scale Floating Structures, Kajima Institute Publishing, 2000 (in
Japanese)
250) Technological Research Association of Mega-Float: Empirical Research on Airport Applicability of Mega-Float (Report on
Technical Research Results ofMega-Float)-BriefOverview of Results in Phase II and the Fiscal 2000 Research Results-,
2001 (in Japanese)
251) Takayama, T., Hirais~ T., Furukawa, M., Sao, K. and Tachino, S.: Field Observation of Motions of a SALM Buoy and
Tensions of Mooring Hawsers, Technical Note of Port and Harbour Research Institute, No.542, 1985 (in Japanese)
252) Iwatani, F., Miyai, S. and Mishina, K.: Observations of Sea Waves with the New Structure System in Sakata Port, Proc. of
Civil Engineering in the Ocean, JSCE, Vol.2, pp.97-102, 1986 (in Japanese)
253) Tsuji, T., Mor~ N. and Yamanouchi, Y.: On the Force Acting on a Ship in Oblique Flow (Restricted Water E!Tucts), Report of
Ship Research Institute, Vol.6 No.5, pp.15-28, 1969 (in Japanese)
254) Nojiri, N. and Murayama, K.: A Study on the Drifting Force on Two-Dimensional Floating Body in Regular Waves,
Transactions of the West-Japan Society ofNaval Architects, No.51, pp.131-152, 1976 (in Japanese)
255) Motora, S., Koyama, T., Fujino, M. and Maeda, H.: Dynamics of Ships and Offshore Structures -revised edition-, Seizando,
pp.220-224, 1997 (in Japanese)
256) Coastal Engineering Committee, JSCE: Coastal Waves, Japan Society of Civil Engineers, pp.291-429, 1994 (in
Japanese)
-170-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
257) Akishima Laboratories (Mitsui Zosen): Fifteen Years of Akishima Laboratories -History of Research aod Development-,
pp.105-130, 1995 (in Japanese)
258) Ito, Y. and Chiba, S.: An Approximate Theory ofFloating Breakwaters, Report of Port and Harbour Research Institote, Vol.11
No.2, pp.15-28, 1972 (in Japanese)
259) Port and Harbour Research Institute and District Port Construction Bureaus, Ministry of Transport: Report on Development
of Floating Structures, 1985 (in Japanese)
260) Ocean Engineering Committee, SNAJ: Mega-Float Offshore Structure,Seizando, 1995 (in Japanese)
261) Ueda, S. and Shiraish~ S.: Method and Its Evaluation for Computation of Moored Ship's Motions, Report of Port and Harbour
Research Institute, Vol.22 No.4, pp.181-218, 1983 (in Japanese)
262) Cummins, W.E.: The Impulse Response Function and Ship Motions, Schiffstechnik, Bd.9 Helf 47, pp.101-109, 1962
263) Kubo, M. and Okamoto, S.: A Study on Accuracy Improvement of Time Series Analysis Using Retarded Function for a
Floating Body Moored to Quay Walls, Proc. of the 34th Japanese Confurence on Coastal Engineering, JSCE, pp.611-615,
1987 (in Japanese)
264) Suzuki, Y. and Morois~ K.: On the Motions of Ships Moored to Single-point Mooring Systems, Report of Port aod Harbour
Research Institute, Vol.21 No.2, pp.107-150, 1982 (in Japanese)
265) Suzuki, Y.: Study on the Design of Single Point Buoy Mooring, Technical Note of Port aod Harbour Research lnstitote,
No.829, 1996 (in Japanese)
266) Ueda, S.: Analytical Method of Ship Motions Moored to Quay Walls aod the Applications, Technical Note of Port and
Harbour Research Institote, No.504, 1984 (in Japanese)
-171-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
5 Tsunamis
Public Notice
Tsunamis
Article 9
Tsunamis shall be appropriately defined in terms of the tsunami height and others based on historical tsunami
records or numerical analyses.
[Commentary]
Specification of Tsunamis:
The tsunami parameters shall be specified appropriately based on historical tsunami disaster records and/
or results of numerical analysis that include estimation of initial conditions for tsunamis generated by
earthquakes and others.
[Technical Nole]
(!) Definition of Terminology Related to Tsunamis
Q) Tsunami
A tsunami is a series of waves that mainly occurs when an earthquake causes sudden uplift and subsidence of
the sea bottom, leading to a vertical fluctuation ofthe sea surface that gets transmitted to the coast. Other causes
of tsunamis are large landslides near the coast and under sea, the eruptions of undersea volcanoes, and other
impacts upon the sea surface including meteorites.
The displacement of the sea bottom due to an earthquake may extend for several tens of kilometers or more
in the relatively shallower water several kilometers deep at most. The bottom movement in the considerably
wide and thin layer is directly transmitted to the sea surface. This sea surface movement becomes the initial
tsunami profile with extremely long wavelength compared to the water depth. The sea surface movement is then
transmitted outward as a long wave.
Tsunami
wave height
CDL.
Fig. 5.1 Tsunami Terminology
the tsunami height is different from the tsunami wave height as described later.
-172-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Time series of tsunami is usually irregular. In the same way as analysis of wind waves, the tsunami can be
analyzed by the zero up-crossing method to define the tsunami wave height and period for an individual wave.
An individual wave is defined to extend from a point where the observed sea surface water level crosses over the
estimated tide level from the negative side to the positive side, to the next such point. The difference between
the highest water level and the lowest water level within the individual wave is defined as the tsunami wave
height, while the time duration of the individual wave is defined as the tsunami period. Finally, the highest value
within a series of tsunami wave heights is called the highest tsunami wave height.
@ Initial movement
This refers to the instance at which a tsunami reaches the observation point and the observed tide level starts to
shift from the estimated tide level. When the first observed sea surface water level change due to the tsunami
is higher than the estimated tide level, such initial motion is referred to as the pushing initial motion, when it is
lower than the estimated tide level, the initial motion is called the drawing initial motion.
c =..Jiih
(5.1)
where
CD
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
water depth is small then the wave height can be calculated from Green's law, as shown in equation (5.2):
H,
HI
(!3_)"' (3._)1"
b,
(5.2)
h,
where
H1
H2
:
:
the tsunami wave height for a cross-section of width b1 and water depth h1
the tsunami wave height for a cross-section of width b2 and water depth h2
However, equation (5.2) only holds if one assumes that the width and water depth change gradually and there
is no reflected wave, and it does not consider energy loss due to sea bottom friction. It cannot be applied in
places such as shallow water area and the inner portion of a bay where there is a strong effect of the reflected
wave.
(5) Bore Type Tsunamis 3)
A remarkable characteristic of the tsunami by the 1983 Nihonkai-Chubu earthquake (the 1983 sea of Japan
Earthquake) occurred along the northern shore of Akita prefecture where the shore has a mild bottom slope of
about 1/200 that extends for 30 km. Propagating toward the shore, the tsunami was greatly deformed into a bore,
accompanied by a short periodic waves of about 5 to 10 seconds. On the other hand, when this same tsunami hit
a shore with a relatively steep slope of about 1/50, such as the western shore of Oga peninsula, it did not become
a pronounced bore type tsunami, but rather similar to standing waves. For incoming tsunamis with the same
tsunami height, a bore type tsunami tends to have a greater runup height than a standing-wave type tsunami.
(6) Edge Waves
If propagates onto a continental shelf obliquely from the deep sea, the wave refraction can make the tsunami
reflected from a coast propagate along the coast and consequently part of energy of the tsunami can be trapped
near the coast. Such a wave is referred to as an edge wave. For example, the tsunami by the 2003 Tokachi-oki
earthquake in the sea off Tokachi in Hokkaido, a tsunami that could be considered an edge wave was detected
along the coast from Cape Erimo to Kushiro in the southeastern coast of Hokkaido, Japan. The fact that a tsunami
can continue for a long time due to formation of edge waves means the increase of possibility that the tsunami can
meet a high tide resulting in inundation in coastal areas.4)
(5.3)
(5.4)
P,,,=P1
(5.5)
where
11' : wave pressure acting height above the still water surface (m)
a1 : incident tsunami height (m)
PoK : unit weight of the seawater (kN/m3)
p1
Pu : uplift pressure at the lower edge of the front surface (kN/m2) P1 = 2.2 poga,
For a bore type tsunami, the still water surface is the level of the water just before the incident of the tsunami.
For a non-breaking type of tsunami, the tsunami wave height H 1 may be related to the incident tsunami height
as follows:
(5.6)
Conducting a numerical simulation with breakwaters, the tsunami wave height in front of the breakwaters
is about twice the value when there are no breakwaters because of adding the reflected tsunami. In this case the
highest water level in front of a breakwater, measured from the still water surface, may be taken as equal to the
incident wave height.
The wave force of the tsunami with soliton fission may be calculated by means of empirical formulae based
on experimental results.s)
-174-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
(5.7)
where
'I : sea surface deviation due to the tsunami (m)
C : wave celerity (m/s)
h : water depth (h)
g : gravitational acceleration (m/s2)
CD
Tide records are extremely useful as records oftsunamis. However, when using such data it is necessary to keep
in mind the following items.1)
@ Tsunami records measured at a tide station within a harbor may indicate different characteristics of tsunami,
from those in the area outside the harbor, because they are affected by facilities such as breakwaters.
@ A tsunami with a relatively short wave period will have an energy loss as the water flows through the tide
station's inlet pipe until it enters the tide well, so that it is measured to be a smaller tsunami wave than the one
that exists around the tide station.
(10) Model Experiments of Tsunamis
In model experiments, by reproducing tsunami profiles determined by numerical simulations at the boundary in
a wave basin or flume, it is possible to investigate the stability and protective effect of tsunami breakwaters 6) and
the effect of topological alterations such as reclamations on tsunamis. The scouring of a breakwater entrance
mound by the 1993 Okushiri tsunami has been investigated in the model experiments.7)
(11) Numerical Simulations of Tsunamis
CD Numerical
simulations of tsunamis must use appropriate numerical models which are based on fundamental
equations that can reproduce the subject tsunamis. The following two types of theories are mainly used for a
regional tsunamis that occurs near the coast:
(a) Non-dispersive long wave theories 8) : Among these, there are the linear long wave theory that applies to
waves whose wavelengths are long compared to the water depth, and also the ratio of wave height to water
depth is small, and nonlinear long wave theories that apply to long waves when the ratio of wave height to
water depth is not small. According to Shuto, 9) the linear long wave theory may be applied in the water 200
meters or deeper.
-175-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(b) Dispersive long wave theories: For a dispersive tsunami, such as the wave observed near the coast for the
tsunami by the 1983 Nihonkai-Chubu earthquake, the phenomenon can be explained better with a non-linear
dispersed-wave theory.JO), 11) A nonlinear dispersive wave theory includes factors that take wave dispersion
into account (dispersion terms) to a nonlinear long wave theory.
For a distant tsunami (teletsunami) that originates from a far away source, such as the 1%0 Chilean
Tsunami that traveled across the Pacific Ocean from the Chilean coast to Japanese coast, it is possible to use
linear dispersive wave theories, which add dispersion terms to the linear long wave theory. Since the tsunami
is a series of waves whose components have various periods, and a wave component with longer period has
slightly faster wave celerity. The difference of the celerity is usually negligible small for the tsunami traveling
short distance, but is not negligible for those traveling long distance. Further, accurate calculation of a distant
tsunami generally need to consider the Coriolis force and to use the spherical coordinates.
@ In numerical simulations of tsunami for a time series of the tsunami is provided as the boundary conditions
for the calculation region, and an initial tsunami profile in the source area as the initial condition. The initial
tsunami profile may be calculated as being the same as displacement of the sea bottom by the earthquake. The
displacement may be calculated from an earthquake fault model 12) by means of the elastic theory of Mansinha
and Smylie 13) and others In another way to setup the initial tsunami profile, the asperity of the fault is recently
considered.
@ In order to calculate the tsunami runup on the land, the method oflwasaki and Mano, 14) or improvements on
it 15) can be used. If the tsunami overflows structures such as breakwaters or seawalls, it is possible to use the
Honma formula 16). 17) to calculate the amount of overflow for a unit width. In order to evaluate tsunami reduction
effect of breakwaters, and other structures, momentum loss due to such facilities should be considered. The
momentum loss, which is proportional to the mean flow velocity, includes the sea bottom friction that can be
evaluated by Manning's roughness coefficients and others, and the momentum loss due to abrupt narrowing and
widening of the cross-section as seen in the opening section of breakwater. Comparing model experiments 18)
with numerical simulations for the breakwaters at the entrance to Kamaishi Bay provided a value of0.5 for the
coefficient of the momentum loss due to the breakwaters.>
Recently it has also become possible to evaluate the flows near submerged breakwaters in the opening section
of tsunami breakwater as well as the tsunami wave force that acts on the submerged breakwaters 19), 20) by using
non-hydrostatic and three-dimensional numerical models, and by using such models it should be possible to
calculate characteristics and effects of tsunami in detail including direct simulation of tsunami wave force.
CD
The largest tsunami that has previously hit the subject region.
@ Among recent tsunamis with a comparatively large amount of data, the tsunami whose scale is considered
appropriate for disaster prevention.
@ Expected tsunamis in a seismic gap region which is experienced little or no earthquake activity for a long
period.
With regard to protective facilities such as to safeguard the lives and property of the people of an area, it is
important to evaluate safety and protective ability of the facilities against the largest tsunamis that are expected
to occur in that area. It is necessary to verify the safety and protective ability against the largest tsunamis
calculated by means of fault models of previous earthquakes and possible tsunamis.
Since facilities may often suffer damage by earthquake motion before the arrival of a tsunami, it is important
to consider the earthquake resistance of facilities.
Recently, a GPS buoy system has been developed, where the horizontal and vertical position of the buoy is
determined by analysis of signals from the Global Positioning System. A sampling interval of a second or less,
makes it possible to measure sea surface fluctuation with various periods, such as tide motion, tsunamis, storm
surge, and waves. It is expected that it will be possible to use measurement records of tsunamis in the deep sea
for the performance verification of facilities.
-176-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
TAKAYAMA, T., Y. SUZUKI, H. TSURUYA, S. TAKAHASIIl, C. GOTO, T. NAGAI, N. HASHIMOTO, T. NAGAO and
T. HOSOYAMADA: Field Investigations of Tsunami Caused by 1993 Hokkaido Nansei-oki Earthquake Technical Note of
PHRI No.775,pp.225,1994
Shuto, N. H. Tomimatsu and M. Ubana: Characteristics of Off-Hokkaido Southwest Earthquake and outstanding issues
towards future, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 41, pp. 236-240, 1994
TANIMOTO, K., T. TAKAYAMA, K. MURAKAMI, S. MURATA, H. TSURUYA, S. TAKAHASIIl, M. MORIKAWA,
Y. YOSHIMOTO, S. NAKANO aod T. HIRA!Slll: Field and Laboratory Investigations of the Tsunami caused by 1983
Nihonkai Chubu Earthquake, Technical Note of PHRI No.470,pp299,1983
TOMITA, T., H. KAWAI and T. KAKINUMA: Tsunami Disasters and Tsunami Characteristics Due to the Tokachi-oki
Earthquake in 2003, Technical Note of PHRI No.1082, pp.30, 2004
Ikeno, M. M. Matsuyama and H. Tanaka: Experimental study on the transformation of Soliton wave Tsunami and its wave
forces for the design of breakwater, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol.45, pp. 366-370, 1998
TAKAYAMA, T. and T. lllRAISIIl: Hydraulic Model Tests on Tsunamis at Suzaki-port, Technical Note of PHRI
No549,pp.131, 1986
TSURUYA, K. and Y. NAKAGAWA: Model Experiment for Reproduction of Disaster at Okushlri-Higashi Breakwater by
Hokkaido-Nansei-oki Earthquake Tsunami, Technical Note of PHRI No.789,pp.20,1994
GOTO, C. and K. SATO: Development of Tsunami Numerical Simulation System for Sanriku Coast in Japao, Rept of PHRI
Author Chiaki Vol. 32 No. 2, pp.3-44, 1993
Shuto, N: Tsunami and countermeasures, Jour. Of the JSCE, No.369/II-5, pp.1-11,1986,
Iwase, H, T. Mikami and C. Goto: Practical tsunami numerical simulation model by use of non-linear dispersive wave theory,
Jour. OfJSCE, Vol. 600/ll-44,pp.119-124,1998
Iwase, H. K. Fujima. T. Mikam~ H. Shibaki and C. Goto: Calculation of Central Japan Sea Earthquake Tsunami run-up
considering wave number dispersion effect., Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 49, pp.266-270, 2002
Sato, Y., M. Abe, Y. Okada, K. Shimazaki and Y. Suzuki: Handbook of earthquake
Mansinha,L., Smylie, D.E.: The displacement fields of inclined faults, Bulletin of the Seismological Society of America,
Vol.61, No.5, pp.1433-1440, 1971
Iwasaki, T. and A. Mano: Numerical calculation of2-dimensional tsunami run-up in Euler coordinates, Proceedings of 26th
Confurence on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.70-74,1979
Ko~ Y., F. Imamura and N, Shuto: Calculation of Tsunami Ruo-up and damage estimation utilizing GIS, Proceediogs of
Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 45, pp. 356-360, 1998
Honma, M. and K. Aki:shiro: Mononobe Hydraulics, Iwaoami Publishing, pp. 232-237, 1962
JSCE: The Collected Formula of Hydraulics (1999 Edition), Maruzen Publishing, pp. 713, 1999
TANIMOTO, K., K KJMURA and K. MIYAZAKI: Study on Stability of Submerged Dike at the Opening Section ofTsunami
Protection Breakwaters, Rept of PHRI Vol. 27No. 4, pp. 93-122, 1988
Masanura, K., K. Fujima, C. Goto and K. Iida: Numerical Analysis ofTsunami by using 2D/3D hybrid model, Jour. OfJSCE,
No.670ffi-54,pp.49-61,2001
Tomita, T. T. Kakinuma and A. Shimada: Numerical calculation of effect of Tsunami breakwater utilizing 3-dimeosional
wave model, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 51,pp. 296-300, 2004
Nagai, T., H. Ogawa, Y. Terada, T. Kato and M. Kudaka: Observation of Offshore wave, tsunami and tide utilizing GPS buoy,
Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 50, pp. 1411-1415, 2003
Nagai, T.: Maritime safety by strengthening wave observation network- GPS wave gauges stationed in Fiscal 2006-, JSCE,
Journal of Civil Eng. Vol. 91, No. 9 (2006. Sep.), pp.78-79, 2006
-177-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
6 Water Currents
Article 10
Flow of water in the sea or others shall be appropriately defined in terms of the current velocity and direction
based on field measurements or numerical computation.
[Commentary]
Setting Methods for the Flow of Sea Water
In the performance verification of facilities subject to the technical standards, when combining the flow
of sea water, with other actions, out of all the possible flows of sea water that have a high probability of
occurring simultaneously with other actions, specify the current velocities and current directions that would
be the severest conditions from the viewpoint of the stability of the target facilities.
[Technical Nole]
(!)General
Movements of sea water are superpositions of currents that have various periods, caused by different natural
actions, and their current velocities and current directions are greatly affected by topography and structures, and
change in complicated ways both in space and in time. Movements of sea water cause sediment on the sea bottom
to move, causing problems such as siltation in navigation channels and basins and scouring of the area around
facilities. Also, the flow of sea water due to coastal development can cause wide-scale changes in the natural
environment, such as water quality, sedimentation changes, and biological changes.
With regard to their origins and their scales over time and space, flows of sea water are classified as ocean
currents, tide currents, wind-driven currents, density currents, and nearshore currents. These currents are greatly
affected by maritime meteorological and geological conditions, showing flow patterns that are unique to specific
Article 11
Influence of estuarine hydraulics shall be assessed with appropriate methods by taking into account the river
flow based on field measurements or numerical computation.
[Commentary]
Effect of Estuarine Hydraulics
Effects of estuarine hydraulics include such factors as tides in rivers, river runoff, density currents at river
mouth, waves entering into river mouth, and siltation. Their evaluation shall be performed appropriately
taking into account of the action from the seaside on estuaries, the river flow and sand discharge from rivers.
[Technical Nole]
(!)General
The range over which to define estuarine hydraulics is not necessarily clear, and if it is broadly taken as the
area over which fresh water and sea water interact then that is a large area extending from the limit of tidal
influence in the upstream river to the mouth of the bay. However, from the viewpoint of actions and effects that
are related to port facilities, the estuarine area is generally defined as extending from the upstream point where
salt water reaches by average tidal motion to the front portion of the estuarine terrace that is composed mainly of
sand expelling during floods (hereafter this will simply be called the estuarine areas). In the estuarine area, in
addition to actions such as tidal currents, tide motion, waves, and nearshore currents, there are also river current
fluctuations from the seaside, such as the outflow of river flood or drought. As the state of water motion and
water density change, there are complex hydraulic phenomena such as density currents, and sediment movement
phenomena such as chemical flocculation and settlement. In an estuarine area, organisms live in a fine balance
-178-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
of the physical environment and chemical environment, and the natural environment and biological environment
in the estuarine area can easily be influenced by human activities, so that the development of facilities requires
Q) The current is strong when the river flood, so that the gradient current of the river is predominant, which is a
uniform flow.
@ When the river is ordinary water, the characteristics of the water flow are complicated because that tidal currents
and density currents add into the gradient current.
@ During times of drought the tidal current characteristics take precedence. However, in estuaries where the tidal
range is small, the tide current is not so strong, and the density current characteristic is intensified.
In estuaries where the tidal range is large, the tide current characteristics tend to predominate.
management.
In places where there is a large accumulation of fine particles, the movement of high density mud and
accumulation of mud due to sediment cohesion is specifically called 'siltation'. The main difference between
'siltation' and 'littoral drift' is that mud flocculates through mixing with sea water in the estuary, which greatly
changes its settling characteristics. Also, the mud that deposit to the sea bottom are capable of changing into a
very hard sediment through consolidation over a long period of time. Their ability to be stirred up by the action of
waves and water movement is affected by factors such as mud characteristics, the salt content of the sea water, the
texture, the water content, and the organic material content, all of which change with time after deposition. These
characteristics of mud make difficult to solve problems caused by siltation.
-179-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
s). 6). 1)
Public Notice
Littoral Drift
Article 12
Influence of littoral drift shall be assessed by appropriate methods based on field measurements or numerical
prediction.
[Commentary]
(2) Littoral drift refers to either the phenomenon that the sediment composing a sea coast or lakeshore is moved by
the actions of some forces such as waves and currents, or material itself that is moved by the above processes.
(3) Although the movement of sand by winds and the sand itself that is thus moved are referred to as the wind-blown
sand, in the broad definition the littoral drift is also considered to include wind-blown sand at beaches.
(4) Sediment that furms a beach is supplied from nearby rivers, coastal cliffs, and the adjacent coastline. The sediment
is exposed to the actions of waves and currents during the supply process or after it has accreted on the beach.
This is why the sediment shows characteristics that reflect the characteristics of external furces such as waves and
currents. This is referred to as the sediment sorting action by external forces.
(5) As a natural beach is repeatedly subjected to process of erosion when storm waves attack and that of accretion
during periods when waves are moderate, it achieves a relatively balanced topography over a long period. This
balance may be lost by a reduction in the supply of sand owing to river improvements, by changes in sand supply
conditions following construction of coastal structures, and by changes in external forces such as waves and
currents. Then beach deformation will occur as the beach moves toward new equilibrium conditions. When
building structures such as breakwaters, groins, detached breakwaters, and training jetties, careful attention should
be paid to the changes that the construction works will bring about in the balance of the beach. Topographical
changes that might be induced by a construction project should be sufficiently investigated in advance. In addition,
careful attention should be paid to the defurmation conditions ofthe beach both during construction and fullowing
completion of any structure, and appropriate coastal protection countermeasures are recommended to be taken
any time when there are concerns about the possibility for disaster triggered by coastal erosion.
(6) When waves approach a coast from offshore, the movement of water particles near the sea floor does not have
the force to move the sediment in places where the water depth is sufficiently deep. At a certain water depth,
however, the sediment begins to move. The water depth at this bouodary where sediment begins to move is called
the threshold depth of sediment movement. Sato I) studied the movement of sediment by placing radioactive
glass sand on the sea floor and investigating the distribution of their movement. From this study, he defined
two conditions that are called the surface layer sediment movement and the complete sediment movement,
respectively. He applied the furmer term to the situation in which the sand in the surface layer on the sea floor is
moved collectively in the direction of wave movement. The latter term he applied to the situation that the sand
shows striking movement with a distinctly visible change in water depth.
(7) Longshore sediment transport rate refers to the rate of littoral drift in the direction parallel to the coast that is
caused by waves obliquely incident to a coast.
(8) Loogshore sediment moves in either the right or left direction along a coast, corresponding to the direction of
incoming waves. The direction with the larger volume of movement during a year is called the predominant
direction.
(9) Littoral drift parallel to the coastal line is called longshore sediment transport. In the long term, the topographical
changes due to longshore sediment transport are often irreversible. For example, considering topographical
-180-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
changes near a groin, if waves come in from the right side, looking out toward the sea from the coast, there will be
accumulation on the right side of the groin, and erosion on the left side. Or, if the waves come in from the left side
then the opposite topographical change occurs. Taking the direction perpendicular to the coastline as a standard,
it is the case for most coasts that the energy of the waves coming in from the right is not equal to the energy of the
waves coming in from the left, but rather one of them usually predominates. For example, ifthe average energy of
the waves coming in from the right is larger than that of the waves coming in from the left, then even though the
right side of the groin sees repeated accumulation and erosion, eventually the amount of accumulation will grow,
while the erosion will increase on the left side of the groin. Therefore, the topographical changes due to longshore
sediment transport can be called irreversible, so that when building port or coastal facilities it is desirable to first
understand the predominant direction of the longshore sediment transport for that coastal, as well as the longshore
sediment transport rate, so as to be able to estimate the degree of coastal deformation in that area.
the location where waves will reach normally, and the "backshore" is the zone from the landward boundary of
foreshore to the coastline, where waves will reach during stormy weather with the rise of water level.
The names shown along the top row of Fig. 6.3.1 classify regions based on the type of sediment movement.
In the surf zone the sediment is suspended due to the action of large eddies generated by breaking waves and
carried in sand clouds of high density. As for the littoral drift in the swash zone, when the wave is uprush the
sand is lifted up and carried by the agitation at the front edge of the running-up waves, but when the wave is
downwash the agitation on the sea bottom predominates and the sediment is carried as bedload.
Swash zone
Surf zone
Offshore zone
Offihoce
Shore
Longshore bar
-181-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ Foreshore topography
As shown in Fig. 6.3.3, when there is continued calmness a nearly horizontal area forms in the foreshore,
somewhat higher than the high tide level, sometimes slanting on the side toward the land. This topography
is called a berm. When conditions are rough the berm is eroded, forming the sand bar called an inner bar
near the position of the last breakers. Inner bars dissipate the wave energy when waves break upon them, and
therefore are thought to prevent further erosion of the foreshore. The sediments of the inner bars that form
during rough conditions gradually return to the foreshore when it is calm, and the foreshore eventually returns
to its condition prior to the rough period.
Berm
Q) Bedload: littoral drift that moves by tumbling, sliding or bouncing along the surface of the sea floor through the
direct action of waves and currents.
@ Suspended load: littoral drift that is suspended in seawater by turbulence of breakers and others.
@ Sheet flow: littoral drift that moves as a layer of high density flow near the bed surface
Shallow water zones can be classified into three regions as shown in Fig. 6.3.4, depending upon the physical
properties of waves that provide the external forces for the littoral drift phenomenon. The dominant mode of
the littoral drift movement in each region is as follows.
[Offshore zone]
In order for sand to be moved by the action of fluid motion, oscillatory movement, the
current velocity of the fluid must exceed a certain value. This condition is generally called
"the threshold of movement". For littoral drift the threshold of movement is defined with
the water depth, threshold depth of sediment movement. When the water depth is shallower
than the threshold depth of sediment movement, regular, small undulating topographic
contours that are called the sand ripples will form on the sea bottom surface. When sand
ripples form, vortices are generated by the fluid motion in the vicinity of the sand ripples
and movement of suspended sediment trapped in the vortices occur. As the water depth
becomes shallower, sand ripples are extinguished, and a sheet flow condition occur in which
sediment moves in stratified layers extending several layers below the sea bed surface.
-182-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
[Surf zone]
[Swash zone]
Inside the surf zone, high-density suspension of sediment is formed by the severe agitation
and action of large-scale vortices that are generated by breakers. The volume of sand
that moves near the seabed surface in a bedload state also increases. For convenience
the sand movement inside the surf zone is divided into a component called the longshore
sediment transport that moves parallel to the shoreline and a component called the crossshore sediment transport that is perpendicular to the shoreline. While the time frame
for beach deformation caused by longshore sediment transport is long, the time frame for
cross-shore sediment transport is relatively short, from a few days to about one week, like
that for periods of storms passing.
The sand movement in a swash zone differs for the times of wave runup and downfiow.
During the time of wave runup sand is put in suspension by the agitation at the front of a
wave and transported by running-up water, whereas during the downfiow sand is carried
in a bedload mode.
'::
],
.l!
~
~
!!.]
~1
I~
1 /--
,,---"'
""" ,
~~
Swash zone
Surf zone
Offshore zone
111~1 .s~
-s.c1je
.s ~. i ~
ii ~ ~
~
~0 ~~
z
E
0.
::0 "jj-S
~~~
~ "'
I
"
ii ..: ii
I i~
ii
0
;!l
~ii
J ~i
"'
-183-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Waves~
Input point
Isocount line
Isocount line
Fig. 6.3.5 Spread of Radioactive Glass Sand in Surface Layer Sediment Movement and Total Sediment Movement
Based upon the field data, two equations are proposed by Sato and Tanaka for estimating the threshold depth
of surface layer sediment movement and that of complete sediment movement.
CD
~ = 1.35 ( ~ )
sinh
~h, 1;;
(6.3.4)
2.40 (
~)
1/3
sinh Z~h,
1;;
(6.3.5)
where
Lo
H0
L
H
d
h1
Repeated calculations are required to estimate the threshold water depths using equations (6.3.4) and
(6.3.S). Calculation diagrams like those in Fig. 6.3.6 (a) and (b) have been prepared so that the depths can
be easily estimated. By specifying d/L 0 and HofL 0 , it is possible to determine h,IL0 Specific calculation
examples are shown in Reference 1).
0.1 co.o:i
8
6 ~\):-.
4
3
--
_....
.-~r-
...
2
Lo
,.....lo
1-- ......
Ho
0.01
8
6
'
o~
1-- ........
h
Ho
"
.....
--
4
10-1
, ,.
-7
3 4
2- t - t - 1.5
o~
'-'
...., , oJ:ll.
, .... "
, .... 7
T
I
3 4
...
... It
o~\
s 10-5
~-
,_
'f..'ifo
""j
6 8 10..
Y':.-
I .... ,_
~\
l-
nil'
.........
. ,. .... ..... /. - .,
r:_.).f;, ('::; ... . . i
....
...
....
..... "'_, ....
o:i _\.- '
3 4
,_,.
ii
~+
Q~....:T
1-1 I 11
I I
6 8 10
diLo
Fig. 6.3.6 (a) Calculation Diagram for Threshold Depth of Surface Layer Sediment Movement 11
-184-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
0.1
8
6
4
3
Ho
Lo
2
0.01
~o.
o~
.....
'
' ......h/Ho 5
, ,
6
I
4
10-7
o.oA-
~{~
. ....
-J
'
3 4
~,
6 8 IO""
,.....
1~
I
1.5 _.. ,..... LO
~
....
~j
J ,.....
- =;
.}
'
,.
'
o~
..
'
I .~ .....
0 .o\
7
-
....
...
i.....--
o~~
0.5-
"
3 4
3 4
s 10-5
6 8 10.,
d!Lo
Fig. 6.3.6 (b) Calculation Diagram for Threshold Depth of Total Sediment Movement l
CD
The predominant direction of longshore sediment transport is determined using the following information:
(a) Topography of the natural coast and that around coastal structures (see Fig. 6.3.7)
(b) Alongshore distribution of the sediment characteristics such as median diameter, mineral composition, etc.
(c) Direction of movement of fluorescent sand tracers
(d) Direction of incident wave energy flux
Predominant
direction
Groins
Predominant
direction
1~
River current
Predominant
direction
!7///JJ?TJ?.lr ,. .
Predominant
direction
Beach is narrow
Detached
hreakwaters
Beach is narrow
Beach is wide
Predominant
direction
Beach is wide
Predominant
direction
~t
Fig. 6.3.7 Typical Coastal Topography Showing the Predominant Direction of Littoral Drift
@ To estimate the longshore sediment transport rate, the following various data must be prepared and sufficiently
investigated:
(a) Continuous observation data of the change in sediment volume around a coastal structure
(b) Data on the alongshore component of wave energy flux
(c) Data concerning the sediment transport rate at the surrounding coast
(d) Data on past dredging volume
-185-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(e) Continuous observation data on deposition volume at the experimental dredging site
(f) Data on the volume of movement of fluorescent sand tracers placed within the surf zone
@ Various formulas can be used to estimate an approximate value oflongsbore sediment transport rate.I), 17), 18), 19)
The formulas are normally given in the expression shown in equation (6.3.6), with the coefficient a for various
formulas being as given in Table 6.3.1.
Q, =aE,
,.H'L).
,.
(6.3.6)
smacosa
b
b
where
0.022
O.o3
0.04
CD
@ Settling process during which sediment is buffeted by random external forces following breakup of organized
vortices.
Fig. 6.3.8 gives the temporal variations of suspended sediment concentration and horizontal current velocity
that were measured by Katoh et al.23) inside the surf zone in the field. The white arrows in the figure point out
the waves that broke on the seaward side of the observation point and the black arrows point out the waves
that passed the observation point and broke on the shoreward side. It is clear that the suspended sediment
concentration increased rapidly when waves broke on the seaward side. This result indicates that sediment
suspension is related to the organized vortices in particular obliquely descending vortices 24) that occur after
waves break.
-186-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
RUN B
!.[
8126
C1
15:22
8"'
-1
o,
-1
-1
-1
1 I
-3
' '
-1 -5
-1
20000ppm
-----
-------
20
60
40
80
100
120
140
160
~ = c, (tanp)""
21
.
,
~
()
(6.3.7)
where
H0
: coefficient
Based on equation (6.3.7), a shoreline will retreat when Cs":?. 18 (see Fig. 6.3.9).
ct/
Retreat
~
Ho =C (tanp)-021(.!!__)01
Lo
Lo
/
Ho
Lo
"
R<ma<Ad""""'
or
Lo
Oceanside California
Surarbkal Beach, India
Tokaimna Beach, Japan
Wes Coast, Taiwan
Prototype Experim:nt by Saville
Advance
...
"'
"
(.)
10-2
10'
(1anpr 0 21(d/Lo)'"
-187-
21)
v
0
)::(
0
D
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
10
HoRF 3/12/86-9/11/86 D.L.+l.4m
i
:a
-20
"'
'.
-10
"Cl
!"
- - Predicted values
Measured values
~Seaward
..:
.,,.I'
-~
~Shoreward
"'
....
-30
3
Month
Fig. 6.3.10 Comparison of Prediction and Measurement of Shoreline Location 28)
Katoh et al.28) revised equation (6.3.7) using deepwater wave energy flux and presented a model to predict the
daily shoreline change. Fig. 6.3.10 is a comparison of the predicted and measured results of shoreline location.
(16) Relationship between Foreshore Topographical Changes and Groundwater Level
The topographical changes that accompany the changes in the fureshore tide level can be explained as follows by
using Fig. 6.3.11.29) When the tide level changes, the beach groundwater level also changes as a response. But
because of the delay in response time, the groundwater level at the flood tide differs from that at the ebb tide even
though the tide level is the same.
(a) During the flood tide the groundwater level is low, and it is easy for the seawater running up on the beach to
permeate underground. Thus the sediment carried by the seawater when it runs up on the beach will accrete
there.
(b) On the other hand, during the ebb tide the groundwater level is high and it is difficult for seawater to run up
on the beach and to permeate underground. At certain conditions, the groundwater may flow out of the beach
surface during the ebb tide. As shown in Fig. 6.3.11, the result is that the sediment that accreted during the flood
tide will be eroded, and return to its original location.
When waves run up to a high level on a beach during storm periods, a high groundwater level condition
continues throughout the stormy weather period because the run-up seawater permeates into the beach, and the
condition becomes as shown in Fig. 6.3.11 (b). Occurrence ofrapid foreshore erosion during such the condition
has been confirmed by field data.
Some shore protection methods make use of this relationship between the foreshore groundwater level and
sand movement; i.e., lowering the groundwater level by forced means or gravity and thus preventing erosion.
The method making use of gravity, a highly water-permeable layer is installed in the foreshore sand to cause the
groundwater flow down offshore and to lower the groundwater level. With this method it is possible to preserve
beach conditions very close to those of a natural beach because no structures are visible above the beach floor.
-188-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Accretion
- .... ~oreward sand movement
-,- -
~enneation
Groundwater surface
(2) Wave characteristics that act on natural beaches can be considered as nearly constant over a long period of time.
Topographies that form in response to these characteristics are nearly stable as well. Scouring will occur when
structures are constructed and the equilibrium between external forces and topography will be disturbed locally
or over a broad area. The mechanism and amount of scouring will change according to the location of a suructure
because the wave action on the structure changes, and hence must be considered carefully when choosing scouring
prevention works.
(3) Scouring in Front of Coastal Revetment
It is well known that scouring in front ofcoastal revetment has a close relationship with wave reflection coefficient.
For example, Fig. 6.3.12 has been proposed for determining scouring or accretion by means of the reflection
coefficient K and the parameter ( H 0 /Lo) (if d50 )sina which is defined with the wave steepness H0 I L0 , mean
diameter of sediment d50 , slope gradient of coastal revetment a, for a vertical breakwater, a= 90, and the distance
I from the wave runup point on an equilibrium profile to the location of the coastal revetment. The diagram
indicates that all other conditions being equal, it is advantageous against scouring in front of revetment to make
the front surface of revetment inclined.
-189-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
0.6
....
0.5
....
0.4
K 0.3
ttl 1
-]!:--""-.!...
...
'bcf' ~h.
0.2
D
D
0
D
DDD
D
D
0.1
-..
h.
1/50
1/30
1/10
o:i.-..
D
Scouring
-...._.._
--Accretion
Fig. 6.3.12 Threshold Conditions between Scouring and A=etion in Front of Coastal Revetment '"l
CD
Legend
Water depth(h)-2m
Cl 2:5h<3
e 3:5h<4
,,
I.,
,, 0
o.,.
~(
e/e
"'"
,/a
~-
4:5h<5
5:5h<6
6:5h
Cl
0
e-' e '&
J"rJ
(H113J-(m)
-190-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
() West breakwater
Innerbreakwater
/0
I
I
I
I e
I
I
I
}p
ort
of Aki
ta
--
Port of:Kanamwa
Poct ofMikuni
0
0
c;0
0
O'---'-~-'-----'~-'----''---'-~.._-"'~-'----''---'-~'--~~~~-'
10
11
12
5
Water depth (m)
Fig. 6.3.15 Relationship between Scouring Depth and Water Depth
37)
-191-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Longshore bar
Shoreline
(i)
Shoreline
progressing
Shoreline at
standstill or receding
(iii)
(ii)
(a) The basic parameter is Ub /ro, the ratio of the maximum horizontal velocity of water particles at the bottom
by incident waves Ub to the settling velocity of sediment ro. When Ub /ro > 10, sediment will move from the
location of the node of standing waves to the location of the antinode, with scouring occurring at the node
and accretion taking place at the antinode. It is called L-type scouring. When Ub /ro < 10, the opposite
phenomenon will occur. It is called N-type scouring (refer to Fig. 6.3.17). The L-type scouring refers to
the phenomenon where accretion occurs at the antinode of standing waves and scouring occurs at the node,
whereas the N-type scouring refers to the opposite phenomenon where scouring occurs at the antinode and
L/2
Node
Antinode
Rubble mound
-192-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
given to factors such as the predicted results by an appropriate prediction method and the data of past beach
deformation at the site in question.
(2) Various methods exist as procedures for predicting beach deformation, including empirical prediction techniques,
estimation based on hydraulic model experiments especially with movable bed model experiments, and numerical
simulations. Because beach deformation is strongly governed by the characteristics of the region in question,
however, it is inappropriate to rely on any single method. Efforts are desirably made to predict beach deformation
by combining two or more procedures and by investigating the local data and information as comprehensively as
possible.
(3) Empirical Prediction Techniques
The empirical method is a procedure that, on the basis of collection and analysis of the past examples of beach
deformation, the layout and structural characteristics of structures to be built are compared with the past examples
ofsimilar nature. Based upon the similarities, the potential for beach deformation to be caused by the construction
of structures is judged. Tanaka 37) has carried out research on modeling ofthe complicated topographical changes
that occur after the construction of structures. He classified characteristics of typical topographical changes in
numerous examples ofbeach deformation. As a result ofthis research, it is possible to understand the topographical
changes in the vicinity of Japanese ports in several representative patterns (see Fig. 6.4.1). Exceptions to these
patterns are relatively rare. By judging which pattern in Fig. 6.4.1 is applicable to the coast under investigation,
a qualitative prediction of beach deformation becomes possible.
2
S1"'rt
IJ:i.locoledon0110ondofa
A=aMmnouulvcrmo1"11 I
G=
Lo.. = L
1----I
--"'-
Wilhlollgdiagoaal-
C-..ofsl>:>!Olinoduo .. tllo
fommioa.ordtdbmlltionof a
==.i'"!.~=~=--
lollgand"""""""lleach
bl:u"~--
=A
Ul[Dffe"
=
4
---===-
111Locd""""ll!lllllld-1
c [~otc111p111bmch[
_ . . . , l h e t i p of ... I
===C:::.)
eo....
~
Fig. 6.4.1 Classification of Patterns of Topographical Changes after Construction of Structures
-193-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Comparisons ofalternative plans for measures to prevent coastal erosion, such as groins or detached breakwaters.
-194-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
D,
(6.4.1)
i)y
where
Distance offshore
~--+----;-------x
---j"t' 1--------,
-1
q~LI_!
--~-q2.~~!J
~
y
Ha Cg0
.
2K2
BHa
)
(2 ) ( K 1 sm20a---cos0a-16s1-J.
tanfi
cy
(6.4.2)
where
-195-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
induced vortices.
CD
Drag force
(6.5.1)
where
Fn : drag force acting on the object in the direction of the current (kN)
Cn : drag coefficient
Po : density of water (tlm')
A : projected area of the object in the direction of the current (m2)
u : flow velocity (mis)
@Lift force
(6.5.2)
where
FL
CL
AL
: lift force acting on the object in the direction perpendicular to the current (kN)
: lift coefficient
: projected area of the object in the direction perpendicular to the current (m2)
-196-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER l METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
Standard area
Drag coefficient
Dl
1.0(l > D)
==:EJI
-I DI-
Rectangular
cylinder
=:dJl
Bl
2.0( >B)
Circular disk
==:or
!!_/)2
1.2
Rectangular plate
=:01
ab
When alb=l
"
" 2
"
" 4
"
" 10
"
" 18
"
Sphere
Cube
==:or
!!_/)2
=:L]JJv
-~
DD
D2
"
00
1.12
1.15
1.19
1.29
1.40
2.01
0.5-0.2
1.3-1.6
-197-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
23)
24)
25)
26)
27)
28)
29)
30)
31)
32)
33)
34)
Goda, Y.: Ports and Harbours (Second Edition), Easy-to-understand Civil Engineering Lecture, Shokokusha Publishing,
p.321,1998
Horikawa, K.: New Edition, Coastal Engineering- Introduction to Offshore Engineering, Tokyo Univ. Press, ,1991
Mog~ A.: Basic Lectures of Marine Science 7, Geology in Shallow Water, Shore line and serf zone, Tokyo Univ. Press, pp
109-252,1971
Toyoshima, Y.: Coastal Engineering at construction site, Morikita Publishing, 1972
Sawaragi, T.: Littoral drift and coastal erosion, Disaster Prevention Series 3, Morikita Publishing, 1992
Noda, H. and H. Hashimoto: Littoral drift and shore protection facilities, New Series Civil Engineering 79, Giho-do
Publishing, 1981
Honma, M. and K. Horikawa: Coast-environmental engineering, Tokyo Univ. Press, 1985
Sato, S.: Study related to port construction, Technical Note of PHRI, No. 5, 1962
Sonu, C.J.:Three-dimensional beach changes, Journal of Geology, Vol.SI, pp.42-64,1973
OZASA, H.: Field Investigation of Submarine Sand Banks and Large Sand Waves, Rept of PHRI Vol. 14 No.2, pp.346,1975
Horikawa, K. M. Sunarnura: Study of retreat of coastal cliff by aerial photographs, Proceedings of 14th Conference on
Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp315-324,1967
Horikawa, K. and M. Sunarnura: Experimental study on erosion of sea cliff, Proceedings of 15th Conference on coastal Eng.
JSCE, pp.315-324,1968
Horikawa, K. and M. Sunarnura: Coastal erosion at Byobuga-ura, Chiba Prefecture (!), (2), & (3), Proceedings of on Coastal
Eng. JSCE Vol..16 pp.137-146, 1969, Vol. 17 pp.289-296, 1970 and Vol. 19 pp.13-17,1972
Bascom, W.N,; The relationship between sand size and beach-face slope, Transactions of AGU, Vol.32 No.6, pp.866-874,
1951
KATO, K, N. TANAKA, H. KIMURA and M. AKAISHI: Movable-bed Model Experiments of a Large River-mouth and its
Surroundings- On Deformation of Topography at the Yoshino River- Rept of PHRI Vol.22No.2,pp.3-87,1983
Sato S. and N. Tanaka: Sand movement on horizontal bed, Proceedings of 9th Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.95100,1962
Sato, S. and N. Tanaka: Field investigation on sand drift at Port Kashima facing the Pacific Ocean, Proc.!Oth Conf. on Coastal
Eng., pp.595-614,1966
Savage, R,P.: Laboratory determination of littoral-transpor trate, Proc, of ASCE., Vol.88, WW2,1962
U,S. Army Coastal Engineering Research Center: Shore Protection Manual Vol.I, Department of the Army Corps of
Engineers,1977.
Komar, P.D.: Relative quantities of suspension versus bed-load transport on beaches, Journal of Sediment Petrology, Vol.48,
pp.921-932,1978
Sternberg, R.W., N.C. Shi and J,P. Dowing: Field observations of suspended transport in the nearshore zone, Proc. 19th lot.
Conf. on Coastal Eng., pp,1782-1798, 1984
Katoh, K., N. Tanaka, T. Kondoh, M, Akaishi and K.Terasaki: Field observation of local sand movement in the surf zone
using fluorescent sand tracer (Second Report), Report of the Port And Harbour Research Institute Vol.2 4No.4, pp.3-63,
1985
Katoh, K., N, Tanaka and I. Irie: Field observation on suspended-load in the surf zone, Proc. Of 19th Int. Conf. on Coastal
Eng., pp.1846-1862, 1984
Hino, M. K. Nadaoka and A. Omata: Organizational structure of turbulence and water particle motion in the surf zone,
Proceedings of3lstConference on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.1-5, 1984
Kana, T.W.: Surf zone measurement of suspended sediment, Proc, of 16th Int. Conf. on Coastal Eng., pp.1725-1741, 1978,
Dean, R.G.: Heurestic models of sand transport in the surf zone, Proc. Conf. on Eng. Dynamics in the surf zone, pp.208-214,
1973
Horiklawa, K., M. Sunamura, H. Kondo and S. Okada: Discussion on 2-dimensional shore line change due to waves,
Proceedings of 22nd Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.329-334,1975
Kato, K. S. Yanagishima, H. Murakami and K. Suetsugu: Trial fur modeling of short-term shore line change, Proceedings of
34th Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.297-301,1987
Komar, P.D.: Beach process and sedimentation, Prentice-Hall, Inc.,1976,
Kato, K., S. Yanagishima: Berm erosion due to infra-gravity waves, Jour. Of JSCE, No.452/II-20,pp.41-50,1992
Kato K.: Shore protection by underground permeable layer, Journal of JSCE, February, pp.18-21, 1996
Kuriyama, Y.: Long-term cross-shore movement of longshore bar and associated sediment transport, Jour. Of JSCE, No.677,
pp.115-128, 2001
Tsuchiya, Y. and Y. Kawada: Wind brown sand transport rate law based on sand particle siltation. Proceedings of 19th
Conference on Hydraulics, pp.7-12,1975,
KURIYAMA, Y., T. NAKASHIMA, K. KAMIDOZONO and N. MOCHIZUKI: Field Measurements of the Effect of
Vegetation on Beach Profile Change in the Region from a Backshore to the Foot of the Fore-dune and Modeling of Aeolian
Sand Transport with Consideration of Vegetation, Rept of PHRI Vol. 40 No. I, pp. 47-80, 2001
-198-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
35) YANAGISHIMA, S.: Field Measurement of the Effect of Vegetation on Beach Profile Change In the Backshore, Technical
Note of PHRI No.1091,p.35,2004
36) Saeki, H., T. Sato, T. Ono aod K. Hamaoaka: Experimental Study no scoring of foundation of sea walls, Proceediogs of 32od
Confurence on Coastal Eng. JSCE, pp.440-444,1985
37) Tanaka, N.: Transformation of sea bed and beach near port constructive in sandy beach, Proceedings of Lecture meeting of
PHRI 1974, pp.1-46,1974
38) Sato, S. and I. Irie: Variation of topography of sea-bed caused by the construction of breakwaters, Coastal Engineering in
Japao, Vol.13, pp.141-152,1970
39) IRIE, !., K. NADAOKA, T. KONDO aod K. TERASAKI : Two Dimensional Seabed Scour in Front of Breakwaters by
Staodiog Waves-A Study from the Standpoint of Bed load Movement- Report of PHRI Vol.23 No.I, pp.3-52, 1984
40) Kato, K.: Movable bed experiment aod field observation, Monthly Magazioe Marine Science, No,169,pp.417-423,1984
41) Shimizu, T. and T. Takagi, K. Sato aod M. Yaroada: Mutual comparison of beach deformation models, Proceediogs of
Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 44, pp506-510,1997
42) Honma, M. K. Horikawa: Coast-environmental Engineering, Theory of Coastal Process, Observation and Prediction
Methods, Tokyo Univ. Press, 1995
43) TANAKA, N. and K. NADAOKA: Development and Application of a Nuroerical Model for the Prediction of Shoreline
Changes, Technical Note of PHRI No.436,1982
44) Watanabe, A.: Nuroerical simulation of beach change, Monthly Magazine Marioe Science, Littoral Drift, Vol.
16No.7,pp.409-416,1984
45) OZASA, H. and A. H. BRAMPTON: Models for Predictiog tbe Shoreline Evolution ofBeaches Backed by Seawalls, Rep! of
PHRI Vol. 18 No. 4, pp. 77-103, 1979
46) Watanabe, A., Y. Marutama, Y. Shimizu and T. Sakakiyama: Numerical model for the prediction of s-dimensional beach
transformation due to the construction of structures, Proceedings of the 31st Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. pp.406410,1984
47) Bijker, E.W.: Longshore transport computations, J. Waterways, Harbors and Coastal Engineering Division, Vol.97, No.4,
pp.687-703, 1971
48) Bailard, J.A.: An energetics total load sediment transport model for a plane slopiog beach, J. Geophys. Res., Vol.82, No.CH,
pp.10938-10954, 1981
49) Kobayashi, H., T. Honada, S. Sato, A. Watanabe, M. lsobe and T. Ishii: A nuroerical model of three-dimensional beach
deformation due to graded sediment transport under atilt waves, Jour. Of JSCE No.740/II-64, pp. 157-169, 2003
50) Sawarag~ T. S. Ri, aod I. Deguchi: Study on nearshore current around river mouth aod model for topographic traosformation,
Proceedings of 31st Confurence on Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. pp 411-415, 1984
51) Lesser, G.R., Roelviok, L.A., vao Kester, J.A.T.M. and Stelliog, G.S.: Development and validation of a three-dimensional
morphological model, Coastal Eng., Vol.51, pp.883-915, 2004
52) Deguchi, I. and Sawaragi, T.: Calculation of the rate of net on-off shore sediment transport on the basis of fiuc concept, Proc.
19th Int. Conf. on Coastal Eng., ASCE, pp.1325-1341, 1984
53) van Rijn, L.C.: Sediment traosport: Part II, Suspended load traosport, J. Hydraulic Eng. Vol. 11, PP.1613-1641, 1984
54) van Rijn, L.C.: Principles of Sediment Transport in Rivers, Estuaries and Coastal Seas, Aqua Publications,
Amsterdaro,1993,
55) JSCE Edition: Goidelioe aod Commentary for Design of Marine Steel Structure (Draft), ,pp.28-58,1973
56) Haroada, T., H. Mitsuyasu and N. Hase: Wave force on structures, Proceedings of the 3rd Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE
Vol. pp.67-83, 1956
57) Japao Society of Mechanical Engineers: Haodbook of Mechanical Engioeeriog, pp,AS-97-106,1989
58) Iwasaki T., A. Maoo T. Nakaroura and N. Horikoshi: Experimental study on stationary fluid dynaroic force acting on mound
material of submerged breakwater and pre-packed breakwaters, Proceedings of 31st Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE,
pp.527-531,1984
59) TANIMOTO, K., K. KIMURA aod K. MIYAZAKI: Study on Stability of Submerged Dike at the Opening Section of
Tsunaroi Protection Breakwaters, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 27 No. 4, pp. 93-102, 1988
-199-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
Rain is a factor in determining the capacity of drainage facilities within the port, and can interfere with cargo
handling and other port operations.
@ Fog interferes with ship navigation and the entering and leaving of the harbor, and is a factor that can decrease the
usability of port facilities.
@ Snowfall may need to be considered with regard to its surcharge on port facilities.
Atmospheric temperature may affect the stress distributioo on port facilities, creating temperature stress.
References
I)
2)
3)
-200-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
CD
CD
CD
@ Construction Management
Tide level observations are important for performing safe and reliable maritime construction.
@ Environmental Monitoring
It is also important to understand tide level variations for environmental monitoring.
(2) Analysis of Long-Term Mean Water Level Variations
Fig. 8.2.1 is an example of a graph of monthly mean tide level variations based on long-term tide level observation.
It is known that the mean tide level varies with the season, being higher in the summer and lower in the winter. In
addition to this seasonal variation, the long-term mean tide level increases slowly. The amount of this long-term
mean tide level rise is about 4.4 mm/year.
-201-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
220
210
200
al
190
~ 180
.l;j
E= 170
160
+4.40 (mm/<)
150
1960
1970
1980
AD (year)
1990
2000
Fig. 8.2.1 Example of Long Term Fluctuation of Monthly Mean Sea Level (Kurihama Tidal Observation Station)
CD
observation towers.
However, the movement of water particles induced by deepwater waves does not reach to the sea bottom.
Consequently, water pressure type wave gauges are less sensitive to short-period waves. So, the wave profiles
recorded by these gauges are not the surface waveforms themselves but rather shapes that are the surface
waveforms from which the short-period components have been eliminated. Also, the detection of water pressure
variation is difficult in relatively deep locations, so this type of gauge has the disadvantage of being unsuitable
for taking wave measurements in places of deep water.
More recently, methods of precisely calculating surface wave profile from water pressure variations have
been developed and improved, so the scope of application for the water pressure type wave gauges, which offer
a simple and inexpensive way of measuring waves, has started to grow again. 19), 20), 21)
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
of allowing comparatively inexpensive, accurate, and direct measurement of surface wavefunns, without the
need for equipment such as towers. It can also be applied to wave measurements where the sea is deep, and there
are many examples where it has been set up in locations with depths of as much as 50 meters. On the other hand,
a type of gauge has also come into use that is placed on the bottom of the superstructure of pier and measures
the water level variations directly underneath by emitting sound through the air.24)
accelerations.
Recently, GPS buoy systems have been developed, so that instead of using the acceleration meter method,
the position coordinates of an antenna placed on a buoy are directly measured by a GPS, with short sampling
intervals of one second or less, making it possible to measure not just waves but also long period components
such as tsunamis, storm surge, and tidal motion.
@ Capacitance type wave gauges and resistance wire type wave gauges
The principle of a capacitance type wave gauge is to vertically stretch an electric wire covered by a dielectric
from under the water to the air above the sea surface, so that the electrical capacity between the wire and the sea
water will vary as the up and down of the water level. This method converts variations in electrical capacity into
a carrier voltage, which is amplified and recorded after the wave is detected, so its output has good linearity, and
there is also is good response because a high frequency electric wave is used as the transmission wave.
On the other hand, the principle of a resistance wire type wave gauge is to extend a resistance wire vertically
from the air into the water and measure the variation in the shorting distance of the resistance wire due to
the up and down movement of the water level. As in the case of a capacitance type wave gauge, this also is
characterized by good output linearity and response.
Q) Overview
Although wave direction is one of the three main components of a wave, along with wave height and period,
its measurement is more difficult than that of wave height, so less data has been collected than for wave height.
-203-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-204-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 2 METEOROLOGY AND OCEANOGRAPHY
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
23)
24)
25)
26)
27)
28)
29)
30)
31)
32)
Meteorological Ageocy: Guidelioe of Ground Weather Observation, Japao Weather Association, p.167,1993
Meteorological Ageocy: Guidelioe of Ground Weather Observation, Japao Weather Association, p.152,1990
Japan Weather association: Ground weather observation Method, p.255,1988
Takeuchi, K.: Meteorology of wind, Tokyo Univ. Press ,p.172,1997
Nagai, T., H. Ogawa, A. Nakamura, Y. Suzuki and T. Seta: Characteristic of occurrence of wind eoergy io the coastal areas
based on observation data, Proceediogs of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 50, pp, 1306-1310, 2003
Nagai, T, I. Ushiyama, Y. Nemoto, K. Kawanishi, T. Nukada, K. Suzuki and T. Otozu: Examination offield application of
lighting system utilizing coastal wind force, Journal of the Japan Society for Marine Survey and Technology Vol. 17 No. 1,
JSMST,2005
Architectural Institute of Japan: Evaluation ofWiod environment and planning, Maruzen Publishing, p. 208, 1993
Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Nukada, T. M. Asaya aod T. Nagai: Upgradiog of COMINS (Coastal
Oceanographic and Meteorological Information System), Proceediog of CDIT No. 4, CDIT, pp. 105-108, 2004
Goda. Y. Edition: Workiog group Edited by Study Group for analysis and application of coastal observation data, Measure
Tide (Guidelioe for Tide observation), Coastal Development Institute of Technology, p.188, 2002
NAGAI, T., K. SUGAHARA, Y. SHIMIZU, T. TAKAYAMA and M. KOZONO: Development of the On-Air Acoustic Tide
Gange, Technical Note of PHRI No.998,p.17,2001
NAGAI, T., N. HASHIMOTO, K. KAWAGUCHI, K. SATO aod K. SUGAHARA: Infra-gravity Wave Observation around
Japaoese Coast by the Nationwide Oceao Wave ioformation network for Ports and Harbors ( NOWPHAS ), Rep! ofPHRI Vol.
38 No. 1, pp. 29-69, 1999
Nagai, T. H. Ogawa, T. Nukada and M. Kudaka: Set-up and operation of offshore wave observation system utilizing wave
gauge network, Proceedings of Offshore Development, JSCE, Vol. 20, pp. 173-178, 2004
Nagai, T., H. Ogawa, Y. Terada, T. Kato aod M. Kudaka: Observation of Offshore wave tsunami aod tide utiliziog GPS buoy,
Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 50, pp. 1411-1415, 2003
NAGAI, T., K. SUGAHARA, H. WATANABE and K. KAWAGUCHI: Long Term Observation of the Meao Tide Level aod
Long Waves at the Kuriharoa-Bay, Rep! of PHRI Vol. 3 No. 4, pp. 3-35, 1996
Japao Coast Guard: Coastal Tide Tables 2005, Vol. 1 "Japao aod neighborhood", Catalog No. 781, 2005, 43lp.
Japao Metrological Agency: Tide Table 2001, Meteorological Ageocy, 2000, 290p.
Goda, Y. Edition: Study Group for analysis and utilization of coastal observation data: Measurement of waves (Guideline for
coastal wave observation)Coastal Development Institute of Technology, p.212, 2001
Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Commentary of analysis and utilization of coastal weaves and hydraulic
observation, p.181, 2000
HASHIMOTO, N., T. NAGAI, T. ASAI, K. SUGAHARA aod K. Park: Extension of Maximum Entropy Principle Method
(MEP)for Estimating Directional Ocean Wave Spectrum, Report of PHRI, Vol. 32 No. 1, pp. 27-51, 1993
SUGAHARA, K, T. NAGAI, N. HASHIMOTO, K. SUZUKJ, Y. SHIMIZU and M. NAMIMA: Development of the RealTime Shallow Wave Meter Teclmical Note of PHRI No. 860, p.25, 1997
Improvement and expansion of utilization of wave monitoring equipment, Maritime Survey Technology, Vol. 11, No.2, Japan
Society ofMarioe Surveys and Technology, pp.37-41, 1999
TAKAHASHI, T., H. SASAKI, K. SUGAHARA aod Y. SUZUKI: On the Ultrasonic Surface Wave Meter in Water Type,
Rept of PHRI Vol. 12 No. 1, pp.59-82, 1973
TAKAHASID, T. and H. SASAKI: Improvement of the Ultrasonic-Wave Wave meter for the Coastal Wave Observation and
Its Effects, Rept of PHRI Vol. 21 No. 1, pp.. 3-30, 1982
NAGAI, T., K. SUGAHARA, Y. SHIMIZU, T. TAKAYAMA aod M. KOZONO: Development of the On-Air Acoustic Tide
Gange Technical Note ofPHRI No.998,p.17, 2001
Nagai, T., H. Ogawa, Y. Terada, T. Kato and M. Kudaka: Observation of Offshore wave, tsunami aod tide utiliziog GPS buoy,
Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 50, pp. 1411-1415, 2003
NAGAI, T., K. SUGAHARA, N. HASHIMOTO and T. ASAI: Annual Fluctuation of the Observed Coastal Waves aod
Siogularities of High aod Low Wave Condition Rep! of PHRI Vol. 32 No. 2, pp. 45-113, 1993
NAGAI, T., N. HASHIMOTO and T. ASAI: Shelteriog Effect of Offshore Islaod on the Directional Wave Spectra-Field
Observation offNiigata- Technical Note of PHRI No.783,p.21,1994
SHIMIZU, K., T. NAGAI and Noriaki HASHIMOTO: Title On the Properties of the Directional Wave Spectra Observed io
Deep Seas (2nd Report: 7-Year Statistics of the Directional Wave Spectra offlwaki), Rept. Of PHRI Vol. 35 No. 1, pp. 65-89,
1996
Takayaroa, T., N. Hashimoto, T. Nagai, T. Takahashi aod H. Sasaki: Development of underwater Doppler directional wave
gauge (Sea bottom placement type wave probe), Proceeding of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 39, pp. 176-180, 1992
Hashimoto, et al.: Development of directional wave gauge applying underwater ultrasonic Doppler effects, Proceedings of
Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 42, pp.1081-1085, 1995
NAGAI, T., Noriaki HASHIMOTO, Tadashi ASAI The Hokkaido-Southwest-Earthquake Tsunaroi Profiles Observed at the
NOWPHAS Offshore Stations, Report ofPHRI, Vol. 32 No. 4, pp. 51-97, 1993
NAGAI, T., N. HASHIMOTO, T. HIRAISHI aod K. SHIMIZU: Characteristics of the Hokkaido-East-Off-Earthquake
-205-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Tsunami Technical note of PHRI, No.802,p .97, 1995
33) KOBUNE, K., T. NAGAI, N. HASHIMOTO, T. HIRAISHI and K. SHIMIZU: Characteristics of the Irianjaya Earthquake
Tsunami in 1996, Technical Note of PHRI No.842,p.96,1996
34) NAGAI, T. and Hideaki OGAWA: Characteristic of the 2003 Tokachi-off Earthquake Tsunami Profile, Technical Note of
PHRI No.1070,p.92,2004
35) Coastal Development Institute of Tuchnology (CDI1): Impact Evaluation Manual fur long-period waves in ports, Coastal
Technology Library No. 21, CDIT, 2004, 86p.
36) Nagai, T: Study on Japanese Coastal Wave Characteristics Obtained from the NOWPHAS Wave Observation Network,
Technical Note of PHRI No.863,p.113,1997
37) Nagai, N: Development and improvement of the Japanese Coastal Wave Observation Network (NOWPHAS)Jour. JSCE No.
609M-41, PP.1-14, 1998
38) NAGAI, T and H. OGAWA: Annual Report on Nationwide Ocean Wave information network fur Ports and Harbnrs (
NOWPHAS 2002), Technical Note of PAR!, No.1069, p.336,2004
39) Nagai, T: Long Term Statistics Report on Nationwide Ocean Wave information network fnr Ports and Harbors (NOWPHAS
1970- 1999 ), Technical Note of PAR! No.1035,p.336,2002
40) Exhibition of Home Page of NOWPHAS wave observation infurmation, The 16th Conference of presentation of study
Results, Japan Society of Marine Surveys and Technology, p. 2, 2004
41) Nukada, T., S. Moritani and T. Nagai: Upgrading of real-time infnrmation of Tsunami by COMINS, Proceedings of CDIT,
No. 4, Coastal Development Institute of Technology, pp.105-108,2004
-206-
Article 13
Geotechnical conditions shall be appropriately set in terms of the physical and mechanical properties of the
soil based on the results of ground investigations and soil tests.
[Commentary]
-207-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
facility where end bearing piles are anticipated the investigation may be terminated if stratum of a few meters
thickness is confirmed with the N value is 50 or higher. Also, for performance verification of seismic-resistance,
the investigation should continue until a stratum of engineering rock with a shear wave velocity of 300m/s or more
is confirmed.
Table 1.2.1 Guideline for Investigation Location and Spacing for Boring and Sounding Investigations
Q) In the case where the stratigraphical conditions are comparatively uniform both horizontally and vertically (Units: m)
Perpendicular to face line direction
Face line direction
Spacing layout
Boring
Sounding
300-500
100-300
50-100
20-50
Detailed survey
50-100
20-50
Spacing layout
Boring
Sounding
50
25
20-30
10-15
Sounding
50-100
Spacing layout
Boring
Sounding
Boring
Sounding
Preliminary survey
50 or less
15-20
20-30
10-15
Detailed survey
10-30
5-10
10-20
5-10
Sounding
50-100
-208-
Survey objective
Survey method
Survey details
Confirmation of
stratigraphical
conditions
Boring
Sounding
Geophysical exploration
Foundation depth
Thickness of weak strata
Sequence of strata
Classification of
soil properties
Undisturbed sampling
(structural disturbance is possible for
all except )'J
Unit weight
Water content
Soil particle density
Particle size distribution
Consistency
Ps
(Hydraulic
conductivity)
Hydraulic
conductivity
Undisturbed sampling
In-situ tests
Hydraulic conductivity
Mechanical
properties
Bearing capacity
Undisturbed sampling
Sounding
In situ tests
Physical
characteristics
----------------
Slope stability
Earth pressure
Consolidetion
characteristics
Undisturbed sampling
Compression index
Compression curve
Coefficient of consolidation
Coefficient of volume compressibility
Compaction
characteristics
Dynamic
characteristics
Undisturbed sampling
In- situ tests
Shear modulus
Attenuation coefficient
Liquefaction characteristics
References
1)
2)
Port and Harbour Bureau, Ministry of Transport: Guideline for Port Surveys. Japan Port Association, 1987
The Japan Geotechnical Society: Methodology and Commentary of Soil Survey, 2004
-209-
'Yt
w
Wi., Wp,
Clu
T
D,
Cc
e-logp
c,,
mv
'Ydmax
Wopt
G
hp
Ip
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2 Ground Constants
2.1 Estimation of Ground Constants 'l
(!)General
The ground constants/parameters used in the performance verification are generally estimated in accordance
with the flow shown in Fig. 2.1.1. However, ifthere is a rational reason based on the characteristics of the ground
investigation and the soil tests, derived values may be used as the characteristic values. For example, as a method
of estimating the derived values from measured values of the N- value obtained from standard penetration tests,
empirical equations or correlation equations have been proposed that take into consideration the variation in
the measured values, so the derived values can be used as characteristic value as they are. Also, for the shear
wave velocity measured by geophysical exploration, the measured values evaluate the complex conditions and
characteristics of the in- situ ground, and the subject being evaluated differs with each measurement location, and
there are cases where the use of statistical processing of many measurement results is not appropriate. In this case
the derived values may also be used as they are as characteristic values.
Partial factors that are multiplied by the characteristic values to calculate design values may be set based on
the variability of the ground parameters and the sensitivity to the verification result of the parameter. Therefore,
partial factors are set for each performance verification method for each facility. Also, for each individual
performance verification, it is difficult to separately take into account the extent of variation of the ground
parameters that depends on ground investigations or the soil test methods. Therefore, the characteristic values
are calculated by applying a correction corresponding to the reliability of the soil test method. This approach is a
device for simplifying the performance verification method by making the partial factors set for each performance
verification method for each facility independent of the ground investigation methods and soil test methods.
However, it is slightly different from the concepts of JGS4001 that makes "the characteristic value is the average
value of the derived values" as a principle.
I Direct results of various surveys, tests, measurements,and observations/ monitoring (measurement values) I
,.
,,
I
Classification of strata
Fig. 2.1.1 Example of Procedure for setting the Design Values of Ground Parameters 1i
CD
The method of using the measurement values as they are as derived values is, literally, direct measurement of
the ground parameters.
@ Within the method of applying primary processing only to obtain the derived values, the primary corrections are
an area correction for shear tests, a correction for the effuct of strain rate on the shear strength, and the simple
correction corresponds to just multiplying by the coefficients. Also, applying simple processing to test results,
such as applying the primary processing to calculate the water content w, the wet density p1, the soil particle
density p,, grain size distribution, obtaining the deformation modulus E from the stress-strain relationship, and
obtaining the consolidation yield stress Pc from the e-log p relationship, corresponds to this method.
-210-
@ The method of obtaining derived values by converting the measured values into different engineering quantities
is the method of converting the measured results into engineering quantities based on theoretical or empirical
equations, or, obtaining fitting parameters in accordance with theory. Converting N-values into the angle of
shear resistance rp using empirical equations, and fitting theoretical curves of consolidation to settlement-time
curves to obtain the coefficient of consolidation cv. correspond to this method.
(3) Methods of setting the Characteristic Values
CD
General
The characteristic values are set generally in accordance with the flow shown in Fig. 2.1.2.
Ifthere is a sufficient number ofthe derived value data to carry out statistical processing, and ifthe variation in
the derived values is small, as a rule, the characteristic value may be calculated as the average value, expected
value, of the derived values. Here, if the number of data entries n of the derived values is 10 or more, and the
amount of variation is not large, and if the coefficient of variation CV is less than 0.1, it is considered that a
certain reliability can be guaranteed for the statistical results, and the average value, expected value, of the
derived values may be taken to be the characteristic value. However, if there are an insufficient number of data
entries of the derived values to carry out statistical processing and if the variation in the derived values is large,
it is necessary to set the characteristic value by correcting the average value, expected value, of the derived
values based on the method shown below.
Ground parameters estimated from measured values (derived values)
CV<0.1
0.6 :S CV
Fig. 2.1.2 Example of Procedure for setting Characteristic Values of Ground Parameters
-211-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
assumed if the standard deviation of the population is known, and a t-distribution is assumed if the standard
deviation is not known. However, when dealing with ground parameters, the distribution and variation in the
derived values are due to errors in the ground investigation or soil tests, estimation errors in the derived values,
and inhomogeneity in the ground itself, and hence, this is different from dealing with quality indices of factory
products, and simple statistical processing is hardly applicable.
To obtain the ground parameters, which are obtained by adjusting the average values for the statistical errors,
and correspond to the characteristic values, for reliability-based design, it is necessary to obtain a sufficient
number oftest results for statistical processing. Also, in order to reflect the soil investigation and soil test results
in the performance verification, it is necessary to model the distribution in the depth direction of the estimated
values a of the ground parameter a as constant with depth (a*=c,.), linearly increasing with depth (a*=c,. z+"2),
or as having a quadratic distribution with depth (a*=c 1z2+c2z+c3). Here, ci. c,, and c 3 are constants. If a certain
range of depth is to be modeled, a sufficient number of tests are 10 or more data entries in order to carry out
statistical processing on the ground model. The reliability of ground parameters obtained from diffurent soil
test methods such as the undrained shear strength of cohesive soils obtained from triaxial tests and unconfined
compression tests differs, so different partial factors should be set accordingly, but it is not known to what extent
the factors should diffur. However, it is well known that the coefficients of variation of the two test results are
significantly different. Based on this the characteristic values are calculated not simply as the arithmetic mean,
but by multiplication by a correction coefficient that takes into account the variation of the derived values to the
estimated values. However, this is based on the assumption that there is a sufficient number of data entries to
carry out statistical processing, so if the number of data entries is insufficient, it is necessary to further set the
characteristic values on the safety side , by multiplying by a correction coefficient for the number of data points.
In other words, the characteristic values are calculated from the following equation (2.1.1) or equation (2.1.2).
Here, if it is reasonable to consider the variation on logarithmic axes, equation (2.1.2) is used.
where
ak =qb,a*
(2.1.1)
(2.1.2)
A specific method of setting the correction coefficient is described below. However, when dealing with the
unit weight of the in- situ ground in stability analysis, for determining the values at which the action side and
the resistance side are substantially in balance, the correction coefficients may be taken to be b1=1, b2=1.
@ Method of setting the correction coefficient for variation in the derived values
Ifthe estimated parameter for modeling the distribution oftest results is represented by a*, when considering the
variation in test results a, it is convenient to use the standard deviation of (ala*) which refers to the coefficient of
variation. Here it is assumed that a is estimated as the average value of a uniform distribution within a stratum
that is modeled, or a distribution in which errors are minimized by the least squares method or similar. It is
known that for a uniform ground, the coefficient of variation of the ground parameters obtained as a result of
taking undisturbed clay test samples using a fixed piston type thin-walled tube sampler, and carefully carrying
out each type of soil test, is 0.1 or less. In other words, even though it is a uniform ground, there is a certain
amount of non-uniformity, and there are errors caused by the soil test methods, so this extent of variation in
the results is inevitable. However, if the variation is greater, if the non-uniformity in the ground is large, if the
disturbance during sampling is large, ifthe soil test methods are inappropriate, or ifthe modeling with respect
to depth is inappropriate, the estimated values a cannot be taken to be characteristic values as they are, but it is
necessary to set the characteristic values on the safety side, taking the uncertainty factors into account.
Therefore, the correction coefficient b1 for variation ofthe derived values is set corresponding to the coefficient
of variation CV defined as the standard deviation SD of (ala*). When the parameter a is contributing to the
resistance side such as shear strength, in a performance verification, the correction coefficient b1=1-(CV!2), and
when contributing to the action side such as unit weight of an embankment, and compression index, b1= l+(CV/2)
are set, and the values shown in Table 2.1.1 should be used in the performance verification. This corrects
the value to a value corresponding to about 70% probability of non-exceedance, for use as the characteristic
value. If the coefficient of variation is 0.6 or higher, the reliability is poor, so performance verification cannot
be carried out, interpretation of the test results must be carried out again, and if necessary the modeling of the
ground must be re-investigated. In certain cases it may be necessary to carry out the soil investigation again.
-212-
Correction coefficient b1
Coefficient of variation CV
~
~
0, < 0.1
0.1, <0.15
1.0
1.05
1.1
1.15
1.25
0.75
Re-investigate the interpretation of the results or the modeling, or re-do the survey
The ground parameters include parameters whose results are evaluated as logarithmic distributions, such as
the consolidation yield stress Pc the coefficient ofconsolidation c.., and the coefficient ofvolume compressibility
tny. In order to obtain the characteristic values of these parameters, several tests are carried out, and if the
ground is to be treated as uniform, these parameters are distributed as log-normal, so it is reasonable to consider
the variation on the logarithmic axis. In other words, for the parameter a, ifthe standard deviation of (log a)/(log
a) is SD, and this becomes the coefficient of variation CV, the values in Table 2.1.1 can be used as they are as
the correction coefficient b 1 on the logarithmic axis. On the other hand, for the angle of shear resistance tP , the
variation of tP itself is not considered, but the variation of tan tP is considered. In the case of the angle of shear
resistance ofa mound material, ifthe value used in the performance verification is specified based on experience,
the specified value already has the effect ofvariation taken into consideration, so it is not necessary to consider a
correction coefficient. The correction coefficients shown here are used after carrying out statistical processing
in order to obtain the characteristic values from the reported soil test results. Therefore, it is necessary to be
aware that the coefficients of variation in Table 2.1.1 do not indicate the level of variation obtained from soil
investigations or soil test results.
Method of setting the correction coefficient for the number of data entries of the derived values
For the Method of setting the correction coefficient for variation in the derived values in above, it was
assumed that the number of data points is sufficient to carry out statistical processing. However, in the case
where the number of data points is insufficient for carrying out statistical processing, the correction coefficient
b 2 for the number of data entries of derived values is set as follows. In other words, if the number of data entries
n is 10 or more, there will be a certain reliability in the statistical results, but if the number is insufficient the
correction coefficient should be set to b2={1(0.5/n)}. Here the negative sign is used when it is necessary to
correct the characteristic value of a ground parameter used in performance verification toward smaller values
than the derived values, and the positive sign is used when it is necessary to correct the value toward larger
values than the derived values. For the performance verification there must be at least two or more data entries.
However, even in the case where there is only one data entries, if other parameters for example N-value or grain
size distribution have been obtained, and ifthe distribution in the depth direction is modeled from a correlation
with these provided only commonly known correlations are used, then that one data entry may be used in the
performance verification. In this case, b1=1, and b 2=10.5 are assumed.
Method of setting the characteristic values taking the mode of the performance verification into account
The ground constants for consolidation and the ground constants for shear are not mutually independent. In the
performance verification, if these constants are considered to be independent, the characteristic values can be
obtained taking into consideration the reliability of the respective parameters. However, if a strength increase
due to consolidation is expected for stability evaluation, the parameters in respect of consolidation and the
parameters in respect of shearing must be closely linked. In these circumstances, in the process of obtaining
characteristic values from derived values, the parameters are modeled as mutually linked when modeling the
distribution of soil test results to derive estimated values. For example, the characteristic values must be set by
statistical processing for the variation, to estimate compatible ground parameters, taking into consideration the
relationship cu=mxOCRxa'v0 between the effective soil overburden pressure a'v0, the consolidation yield stress
Pc, and the undrained shear strength Cu, using the strength increase ratio 11Fc,/pc, and the overconsolidation
ratio OCR=p/a'v0
-213-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(!) The unit weight must be obtained by collecting undisturbed samples on site, or directly obtaining it on site.
(2) The unit weight is normally the weight per unit volume in air, and includes the wet unit weight and dry unit weight
Also, the unit weight in water (weight per unit volume from which buoyancy is deducted) is referred to as the
immersed unit weight. For the measurement of the unit weight, methods of collecting undisturbed samples of
clay soils have been established, and it is possible to obtain test samples that are representative of the soil in-situ.
Therefore the unit weight of clay soils can be obtained from laboratory tests. However, the unit weight of sandy
soils or sand must be obtained directly in-situ.
The wet unit weight is one of the indices indicating the fundamental properties of a soil, and is used for
recognizing the soil stiffness, and degree of looseness, and for calculating, the weight of a soil mass and the void
ratio.
CD
r, =p,g
'ep
P' + 100
w
g
l+e
(2.2.1)
+--"'-
=---1.!!!!. p 3 g
l+e
where
e : void ratio
S, : degree of saturation(%)
w : water content (%)
Pw : density of seawater (t/m3)
g : gravitational acceleration (m/s2)
The approximate values of the unit weight of soils normally encountered in harbor areas in Japan are as
shown in Table 2.2.1.
Table 2.2.1 Unit Weight and Water Content of Representative Soils
12-16
5-14
150-30
16-20
11-14
60-20
16-20
12-18
30-10
(2.2.2)
where
Yd : dry unit weight (kN/m3)
Pd : dry density (t/m3)
Also, the relationship between the wet unit weight y1 and the dry unit weight Yd is given by the following
equation.
(2.2.3)
-214-
-r =p,-pwg
sat
(2.2.4)
l+e
where
CD
@ Radioisotopes (RI)
In recent years the use of RI has become comparatively easy, and although there are strict laws and regulations
such as the Law to Prevent Radiological Hazards Caused by Radioactive Isotopes. (Law No. 167, 1957)
and its associated regulations, there have been many cases of measurement using a y -ray densitometer as an
in- situ test where it is difficult to obtain undisturbed samples of sand and sandy soil. Incidentally, these legal
restrictions do not apply in the case of sealed radioactive sources whose radiation source strength is 3.7MBq
(megabequerel) or less.
There are two types of y -ray densitometer that use RI: a surface type and an inserted type, and these are
described in Soil Density Test Methods using RI Equipment, JGS 1614, the Standard of Geotechnical Society
of Japan. The surface type is applied to measurement near the ground surface, as implied by its name, and is
used for control of earthworks same as the sand replacement method. The surface type is further classified
into back scattering types and transmission types. Measuring equipment using the initially developed back
scattering method is frequently used, but in recent years equipment using the transmission method has become
popular because of its accuracy. On the other hand, the insertion type is applied to measuring the density
distribution in the vertical direction, in other words for surveys in the depth direction. For example, it is used
for investigating the density distribution in the depth direction for ground surveys, for determining the soil
improvement effect by density measurement of replaced sand, and measurement of the density of filled sand in
caissons.
The RI method has the advantage that it is a non-destructive test from which the in- situ density can be
directly measured. Also, although the measurement operation itself is simple so it has a high usability value,
on the other hand because there is danger associated with the radioactive material there are many regulations
regarding its handling, so it cannot be simply brought out and used in-situ. In addition, in surveys associated
with port construction, the inserted type is mainly used, so there is an operation of inserting the equipment into
the access pipe. The measurement accuracy is governed by the material and quality of the pipe, or the insertion
accuracy, in other words, the measurement accuracy is governed by the disturbance of the surroundings when
the pipe is inserted, and how good the contact between the pipe and the soil is, so caution is necessary. Recently
the RI cone penetrometer, which incorporates RI in a cone probe, is being developed as a device capable of
directly penetrating into the ground for surveys.
(4) Relative Density
The degree of compaction of sand may be expressed by the relative density using equation (2.2.S).
"max -e
Pa - Parnin
Pamax
~-emin
Pa'""" - Pam;,.
Pa
D,=-=~-
-215-
(2.2.5)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where,
D, : relative density
emu: : void ratio in the loosest state
emin : void ratio in the densest state
e : void ratio in the present state of the test sample
Pdmfil : dry density in the loosest state (g!cm')
Pdmsx : dry density in the densest state (g/cm')
Pd : dry density in the present state of the test sample (g/cm')
The density of sand is greatly affected by the shape of the particles and by the grain size composition. So
from the unit weights and the void ratios calculated from it, the density of sand cannot be correctly evaluated.
Therefore, the relative density is used to indicate the relative value within the range of void ratios that can be taken
with this soil. Measurement of e.,.., emm, (pdmfil, pdmsx} for obtaining D, can be carried out in accordance with
Japanese Industrial Standard JIS A 1224 Method of Measurement of the Minimum and Maximum Density of
Sand.
It is difficult to take undisturbed samples of sand, so the relative density is frequently measured indirectly by
sounding. (see 2.3.4(4) Angle of shear resistanee of sandy ground).
Sm
15m
250m
I
Clay
Silt
Fine sand
425m
I
I
Medium sand
I
850m
2mm
4.75mm
Coarse
Fine
sand
gmel
Sand
Fine grain fraction
Medium
gravel
19mm
75mm
Coarae
gravel
Gravel
300mm
Cobble
Boulder
Stone
Stone fraction
(Note) The word "particle" is affixed when referring to a constituent particle belonging to a particular category;
and the word "fraction" is affixed when referring to a component belonging to a particular category.
Fig. 2.2.1 The Grain Size Classifications and their Names (JGS 0051)
A large uniformity coefficient means that the grain size is broadly distributed, and such a soil is called
-216-
(1) When the seepage flow in a completely saturated ground is a steady laminar flow, the hydraulic conductivity shall
be estimated by using Darcy's law.
(2) The hydraulic conductivity le is calculated by equation (2.2.7), taking into account of the measurement of crosssectional area of soil A, hydraulic gradient i and volume of seepage flow in unit time.
k=!L
iA
(2.2.7)
where
.!!_
L
k=C/Ji.02
(2.2.8)
where
Sand
Silt
Clay
Hydraulic
conductivity
I0-2cm/s
IO-Semis
10-7cmfs
-217-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(!) When analyzing soil behavior as an elastic body, the elastic constants are determined with due consideration for
the nonlinearity of stress-strain relation of soils.
(2) When analyzing soil behavior as an elastic body, the deformation modulus and Poisson's ratio are normally used as
the elastic constants. Because of the strong nonlinearity of stress-strain relationship of soil, the elastic constants
in analysis must be determined by considering the strain level of the ground to be analyzed.
(3) Strain Dependency of Deformation Modulus
The stress-strain relation of soil usually shows a strong nonlinearity. When the strain level is within a range of
10-5 or less namely 0.001% or less, the deformation modulus is largest and nearly constant. This maximum value
Emax is corresponding to the measured value in the dynamic testing methods such as the elastic wave exploration,
and is called the dynamic elasticity modulus. As the strain level increases, the elasticity modulus decreases. The
secant modulus E 50 , determined from a conventional unconfined compression test or a triaxial compression test, is
considered as the deformation modulus when the strain is of the order of 10-3 (0.1%). When conducting an elastic
analysis of soil, it is necessary to determine the elastic constant by considering the strain level of the soil.
(4) Relationship between Undrained Shear Strength and Deformation Modulus
For cohesive soils, the approximate values for the initial tangent elastic modulus E 1, and the secant elastic modulus
E 50 can be determined by using equation (2.3.1) and equation (2.3.2).7)
(2.3.1)
E 50 =180c.
(2.3.2)
where
(!) Compression characteristics ofsoil and the coefficients for estimating settlement offoundations due to consolidation
can be calculated from the values obtained based on JIS A 1217 Test Method for Consolidation Test of Soils
Using Incremental Loading.
(2) When soil is loaded one-dimensionally, compression of the structure with the soil particles which causes
settlement is referred to as compression. Ifthe voids of the soil are saturated with water, it is necessary for the pore
water to be drained in order to contact the structure with the soil particles. For sandy soils with high hydraulic
conductivity, drainage is fast, so contraction occurs immediately after loading and is soon completed. However,
for cohesive soil ground the hydraulic conductivity is very low, so a long period of time is needed for drainage,
and compression settlement occurs slowly. This phenomenon in which compression settlement in cohesive soil
ground occurs over a long period of time is referred to as consolidation.
The consolidation characteristics of soils are used not only for calculating the settlement due to loading, but
also for estimating the increase in shear strength of soils in soil improvement work.
(3) Calculation of the final settlement due to consolidation
When the consolidation pressure and the void ratio when consolidation is completed at that pressure (after 24
hours) in a consolidation test are plotted on semi-logarithmic graph, the so-called e-log p curve or compression
curve is obtained, as shown in Fig. 2.3.1. The "abc" portion ofthe e--logp curve indicates the loading process, and
is virtually linear. The consolidation state indicated by the "abc" portion is referred to as the normal consolidation
state. On the other hand, ifthe soil is unloaded from the state at point "b", the relationship between the void ratio
and the pressure when the equilibrium state is reached under the reduced pressure describes the path "bd". If
the pressure is increased again, the path "db" is described. The state represented by "bd" and "db" is referred
-218-
to as the overconsolidation. When a consolidation test is carried out, the path "d--+b--+c" is described, the point
"b" is obtained at the boundary of "d--+b" indicating the elastic deformation and "b--+c" indicating the plastic
deformation, and the pressure corresponding to this boundary is referred to as the consolidation yield stress.
Pi P2 logp
e
Fig. 2.3.1 e-log p Relationship during Consolidation
The relationship between the void ratio e and the pressure p for the segment "abc'', normal consolidation
domain in Fig. 2.3.1 is expressed by equation (2.3.3).
(2.3.3)
where
Cc is a non-dimensional number showing the degree of inclination of segment "abc" and is called the
compression index.
The final settlement resulting from the consolidation load can be calculated using three methods: the e-log p
curve method, the Cc method, and the coefficient of volwne compressibility mv method.
The decrease in void ratio ..1e when the pressure increases from the overburden pressure in- situ p 0 to (p0+..1p) can
be determined by directly reading the e-logp relationship curve obtained from consolidation tests. Otherwise, if
the settlement is expected to be overestimated to the safe side, it can also be evaluated by equation (2.3.4) using
equation (2.3.3).
(2.3.4)
In the e-log p curve method, the settlement S is calculated by the following equation using Ae either read
directly or determined from equation (2.3.4):
S=h~
(2.3.5)
t+eo
where
h : thickness oflayer
In the Cc method, the settlement S is calculated by the following equation (2.3.6):
Cc l
Po + Ap
S -- h --Ogto~--
l+eo
(2.3.6)
Po
This equation corresponds to that whereby equation (2.3.4) is substituted in equation (2.3.S).
The coefficient of volume compressibility mv is used for estimating settlement and the amount of compression by
a load is proportional to mv. However, this is effective only with small increases in consolidation pressure such
as where mv can be assumed to be constant, because it would linearize the soil with strong nonlinearity. Equation
(2.3.7) is used to calculate the settlement S using 1nv
s =m.,Aph
where
(2.3.7)
-219-
+ Ap)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Generally, the value of mv during consolidation decreases with the increase of effective overburden pressure.
Under normally consolidated state, the relationship between p and mv plotted on a double logarithmic graph would
almost be a straight line. The mv used in equation (2.3.7) for calculating settlement is the mean value during the
change in effective overburden pressure of the ground from Po to (Fo+Llp). Usually, this would be the mv for the
geometric mean of the effective overburden pressure (
.JPo x (p
+ Ap) ).
established.
p=a'+u
(2.3.8)
Consider the case where highly permeable sand layers exist above and beneath a clay layer of thickness 2H.
When a consolidation pressure increment p is applied, the distribution with depth of u' and u are as shown in Fig.
2.3.2. In other words, at the time of start of consolidation (t=O), the state is indicated by the line DC with u=p,
u'=O, and when consolidation is completed the state is as indicated by the line AB, with u=O, u'=p. The curve AEB
is the pore water pressure distribution at the time 11 after start of consolidation. TIIis curve is called "isochrone".
As shown in the figure, the parts of soil distant from the drainage layers have relatively slow rate of consolidation.
The ratio of the effective stress increment to the consolidation pressure increment (u'lp) at a certain depth z
is referred to as the degree of consolidation CJ, at that depth. The degree of consolidation at each depth averaged
over the whole layer is referred to as the average degree of consolidation U. The average consolidation is the ratio
of the area of AEBCD to the area ABCD in Fig. 2.3.2.
Clay layer
a'
a'
The consolidation is the time-dependent settlement phenomenon. The rate of consolidation for an entire
cohesive soil layer is represented with the parameter U for the average degree of consolidation. The relationship
between U and the non-dimensional time factor Tv is obtained by the theory of consolidation. The relationship
between the non-dimensional time factor T, and the actual time t is shown by the following equation:
T =_st_
v
H .:z
(2.3.9)
where
Tv : time factor
Cv
coefficient of consolidation
-220-
the theoretical relationship between the average degree of consolidation and the time factor.
0.5
z
H
0.1
0.2
0.3 0.4
0.9
1.0
--
u,
1---1
2H---
j_
20 '
U1=Uo
40
U1 =U1
H-z
+ "2-v-
"
60
80
<100 0
'
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.7
'
'
0.8
0.9
Fig. 2.3.4 Theoretical Relationship between Average Degree of Consolidation and Time Factor
CD
The advancement in ground settlement with elapse of time subsequent to construction is having serious effects
on the facility.
@ As in the case of deep Pleistocene clayey ground, when the consolidation pressure does not exceed the
consolidation yield stress of the soil layer significantly, the contribution of secondary consolidation in an entire
settlement can not be neglected.
-221-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
~
5'
r-----=;::------.--
20
~ 40
8 60
Primlll}'
consolidation
~ 80
-ll 100
!l.
Secondary
~ 120~__co_nso_Iidati_._on~---------
<
ns
(7) Correlation between the Compression and Consolidation Coefficients and the Physical Properties
Of all the soil tests, the consolidation test requires the longest amount of time. If the results of consolidation test
can be estimated from physical test results, which require only disturbed test samples, and is a comparatively
simple test method, and moreover whose results can be quickly obtained, this would be very useful. Skempton
has proposed the correlation equation (2.3.10) as the relationship between the compression index C, and the liquid
limitwL.
C,
= 0.009(wL -10)
(2.3.10)
Equation (2.3.10) is applicable to clay that is re-molded and re-consolidated in the laboratory, or young clay
ground formed by artificial filling, but it tends to either over or underestimate the compression characteristics of
naturally deposited clays.
The reason why natural cohesive soil grounds have larger compression index values than young clay is
because in the process of sedimentation which occurs over many years, a structure is formed due to aging effects
such as cementation. When this structure is destroyed as a result of the consolidation pressure exceeding the
consolidation yield stress, high compressibility is demonstrated.
-222-
shear strength of sandy soil is determined under drained conditions, while the shear strength fur cohesive soil is
determined under undrained conditions.
(2) In general, the hydraulic conductivity of sandy soil is 103 - 105 times that of cohesive soil. For sandy soil layer, the
excess water in pores is considered to be completely drained during construction. For cohesive soil layer, on the
other hand, almost no drainage is expected during construction because the hydraulic conductivity is significantly
low. Thus in many cases fur sandy soil layer the shear strength is evaluated using the angle of shear resistance in
drained condition ; D and the cohesion in drained condition cD. Because the value of cD is usually very small,
practically cD is ignored and only ; D is used as the strength parameter.
In the case of saturated cohesive soil layer, the shear strength ofthe layer undergoes almost no change between
befure and after construction, as the drainage cannot take place during construction. The undrained shear strength
before construction is therefore used as the strength parameter. For intermediate soil that has the permeability
somewhere between those of sandy soil and cohesive soil, the soil should be viewed as sandy soil or cohesive soil
based on the coefficient of permeability and construction conditions.
(3) Considerations on Shear Strength
The shear strength T 1 ofa soil is generally expressed by the following equation.
-r1 =c+utan;
(2.3.11)
where
: shear strength
c : cohesion or apparent cohesion
; : angle of shear resistance (0 )
<1 : normal stress on the shear surface
Tf
When a stress is applied to a soil, the stress acting on the skeletal structure of the soil particles, referred to as
the effective stress, and the pore water pressure,) both change. If the total stress applied to the soil denotes <1, the
effective stress denotes q', and the pore water pressure denotes u, the following relationship can be established.
u=u'+u
(2.3.12)
u' = u-u
(2.3.13)
In equation (l.3.11), the strength constants such as cand ; , vary depending on the conditions during the
shear tests, but the condition that has the greatest effect is the drainage condition of the soil. Because soil has the
tendency of changing volumes which is known as "dilatancy" while being sheared, shear strength of soil is greatly
dependent upon whether a volume change takes place during the shear or not. The drainage condition is classified
into the following three categories and different strength parameters are used for each case:
CD
In Fig. 2.3.6, pattern diagrams are shown for the shear strength when direct shear tests are carried out under
the drainage condition CD, @, @.to) In the figure, the change in shear strength under increased or reduced normal
stress u is shown on the soil samples consolidated in advance to the pressure Po. As shown in the figure, under
the unconsolidated undrained condition CD, the strength is constant and does not depend on <1. In the case of the
consolidated undrained condition @, within the range p 0<<1 the strength increases linearly as <1 increases. Under
the consolidated drained condition , the strength is overall greater than CD, @, and this is because the void
ratio is reduced by consolidation or shearing in the case of weak cohesive soil or loose sand. However, when <1 is
significantly smaller than p 0 (in the figure this limit of the normal stress is indicated as q), the strength under the
consolidated drained condition is smaller than the strength under the consolidated undrained condition due to the
effect of swelling during shearing. Summarizing this relationship for the range of <1 the following is obtained.
In the range p 0< <1 , namely the applied loading is larger than the pre-consolidation pressure ; CD<<
In the range q< <1 <p0
namely the applied loading is somewhat smaller than the preceding consolidation
-223-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
;<<CD
Po
(J'
The shear strength used for the performance verification of ground should be the shear strength for the most
dangerous drainage conditions expected under the given load. The drainage condition and shear strength are then
as in the following:
(a) When loading takes place rapidly on the cohesive soil ground:
Because consolidation progresses and shear strength increases with the elapse of time, the most dangerous
time will be immediately after the loading when almost no drainage has occurred. This is called the shortperiod stability problem. The shear strength T/ at this time is the shear strength c,. that is determined from
unconsolidated undrained (UU) tests using the sample before loading. The parameter Cu (undrained shear
strength) is also called the apparent cohesion, and the analysis using Cu is also called the " ; =O method".
Constructions of seawalls or breakwaters without excavation, landfill, and embankments on soft cohesive soil
ground fall in this category.
(b) When ground permeability is large or when drainage from consolidated layer is almost completed during
construction period because the loading is carried out very slowly:
Because drainage from the layer occurs simultaneously with loading and an increase in strength of the
layer is expected along with the loading, the performance verification of structures should be carried out
using cv and ; 0 determined under consolidated and drained (CD) conditions. Constructions of seawalls or
breakwaters, landfill and embankments on sandy soil belong to this category.
(c) When the hydraulic conductivity of the ground is poor and the load is removed to decrease the normal stress
u on the shear plane:
In this case, the most dangerous situation is after a long time has elapsed, when the soil absorbs water,
expands, and loses its shear strength, this is called the long-term stability problem. As shown in Fig. 2.3.6,
undrained shear strength becomes the lowest after water absorption and soil expansion when the overconsolidation ratio is small, in other words, u is a little less than p 0 In this situation, therefore, the c,. value
should be used with consideration of soil swelling. Earth retaining and excavation in clayey ground or
removal of preloading on cohesive soil ground belongs to this category. On the other hand, in the case of
heavily over-consolidated ground where u is very small compared to p 0, the parameters c0 and t/J 0 are used
for performance verification because the shear strength under consolidated, drained condition is the smallest.
Usually, this often applies to cases where cut earth methods are employed but it also applies to construction
works in coastal areas such as works to deeper quaywall depth and dredging works on seabed soil.
In almost all cases for normal construction conditions of port facilities, the undrained strength in UU
conditions of (a) is used in the performance verification for cohesive soils and the strength parameter in the
CD conditions of (b) is used for sandy soils. The following equations show the strength calculation methods
respectively:
I) For cohesive soil with the sand content is less than 50%
-r=cu
(2.3.14)
-224-
(2.3.15)
where
-r : shear strength
Furthermore, because soil with a sand fraction ranging from 500/o - 800/o displays intermediate
characteristics between sandy soil and cohesive soil, it is called the intermediate soil. The evaluation of
shear strength of intermediate soil is difficult compared with that of sandy soil or cohesive soil. Hence, the
shear strength for such soil should be evaluated carefully by referring to the most recent research results.
With respect to intermediate soil that can be treated as cohesive soil, it is preferable to utilize results of
triaxial CU tests etc. rather than evaluate shear strength from unconfined compressive strength.
(4) Shear Strength of Sand
Because sandy soil has high hydraulic conductivity and is regarded in completely drained condition, the shear
strength of sand is represented by equation (2.3.15). The angle of shear resistance IP D for drained conditions
can be determined using a triaxial CD test under consolidated and drained condition. Because the value of <P D
becomes large when sand's void ratio becomes small and its density becomes high, the void ratio e 0 in- situ should
be accurately determined. Therefore, it is best to take and test an undisturbed sample. Although the <P D values
of sand with the same density will vary a little with the shear conditions, the value of <P D determined by a triaxial
CD test, which is conducted with the consolidation pressure corresponding to design conditions with undisturbed
sample, can be used as the design parameter for stability analysis. However, in the case of bearing capacity
problem for foundation, which is much influenced by progressive failure, the bearing capacity is over-estimated in
some cases ifthe value of <PD determined by a triaxial CD test is directly used as the design parameter.
Compared with the case of cohesive soil, sampling of undisturbed sand samples is technically difficult and
also very expensive. This is the reason that the shear strength for sandy soil is frequently determined from the
N-value of standard penetration test rather than from a laboratory soil test. For the equation to determine ,P 0 from
N-values, refer to l.3.4 (4) Angle of shear resistance of sandy ground.
(5) Shear Strength of Cohesive Soil
Here, soil of which the clay and silt fraction by percentage is greater than 50% is regarded as cohesive soil.
There are several methods, as presented below, to determine the undrained shear strength Cu of cohesive soil.
An appropriate method should be chosen in consideration of such factors as the past experiences, the subsoil
characteristics and the importance of the structures.
CD
qu method:
This method uses the average value of unconfined compressive strength determined from undisturbed samples.
The undrained shear strength c., used for the performance verification is given by the following equation:
(2.3.16)
In this equation, qu is the average value of unconfined compressive strength. In unconfined compression
tests, confining pressure is not applied on the test sample and therefore, the strength result obtained may be
remarkably small due to disturbance of the sample. Application is particularly difficult on clayey soil sampled
from depth such as stiff Pleistocene clayey soil in which cracks can appear easily. Caution is also needed for
application on intermediate soil with high sand content as effective stress may not be maintained in the test
sample and consequently, a remarkably small shear strength may be obtained. In this case, it is preferable to
employ other test methods such as triaxial test or direct shear test.
@ Method of using strength by triaxial tests taking initial stress and anisotropy into consideration:
Consider the stability analysis of a embankment on the clayey ground using a circular slip, as shown in Fig.
2.3.7. Directly below the embankment shearing is caused by the increase in vertical stress, so it is possible to
evaluate the shear strength corresponding to this by the triaxial consolidated undrained compression test (CUC
test), although strictly speaking there are differences in the plane strain and axial symmetry. On the other hand,
shearing occurs at the end point of the circular arc, in other words near the base of the slope, due to the increase
in horizontal stress, so it is possible to evaluate this by the triaxial consolidated undrained extension test (CUE).
-225-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Of course, there are differences in the plane strain and axial symmetry, and there is the major difference that
in contrast to the triaxial extension test in which the axial force reduces, in the failure of an embankment the
horizontal stress increases. Near the bottom of the circular arc, the deformation mode is not compression nor
extension., but virtually horizontal shearing is produced. Therefore, it is possible to evaluate this by a direct
shear test or a simple shear test.
The shear strength s., used in the performance verification may be the average value of the shear strength
s.,c obtained from a compression test and the shear strength Sue obtained from an extension test as given by the
following equation
(2.3.17)
or the direct shear strength s 113 may be used as the representative value.
s,, *=s.,,,
For most soils, the triaxial extension strength s,,e is about 70% of the triaxial compression strength Svc.
~
ll..J
Triaxial ~
extension
Sue
Box shear
Sus
Triaxial
comp:ssion
Fig. 2.3.7 Stability Problem and Strength Anisotropy for an Embankment Constructed on a Clayey Ground
Disturbance of a test specimen during sampling is inevitable to a certain extent, even if efforts are made to
minimize it. Also, it has been said for a long time that the unconfined compression test is lacking in reliability,
but the performance verification methods are frequently based on them, as in the present situation other
methods cannot be adopted. As a method of determining the undrained shear strength, the method known as
the ''recompression method" 11) is said to be the most reliable among the test methods currently proposed. This
method is based on the thinking that by reproducing the same stress state as the sampled test specimen in the
original location, the effect of disturbance in the test specimen can be made smaller by consolidation.
Elements within a ground are subject to the vertical overburden effective stress u'v0, and the horizontal
earth pressure at rest u'110 (=Kou'v0). A sampled test specimen has zero stress under atmospheric pressure, and
an isotropic residual effective stress due to suction remains to a certain extent. However, by consolidation to
u'1=u'v0, u'3=Kou'v0 in triaxial test apparatus, undrained shear tests can be carried out with the same effective
stress state as the original position reproduced. The effective overburden pressure a'vo can be calculated from
the unit weight ofthe sampled test specimens. However, a problem at this stage is how to obtain the coefficient
of earth pressure Ko. Several methods for obtaining it from in-situ tests have been proposed, but it can also be
obtained from a laboratory by a Ko consolidation test using a triaxial cell.12) Here, the Ko consolidation test is
a test in which the cell pressure a3 is controlled so that the cross-sectional area of the test specimen does not
change when the axial pressure a 1 or the axial strain e1 increases. However, Ko obtained by this method is Ko for
the normally consolidated state, frequently expressed as KoNC so it is necessary to be aware that it is not the Ko
for soil with the aging effect as in a real ground. In Japanese clays, Ko under normally consolidated conditions
is mostly in the range 0.45 to 0.55.
The recompression method is also possible with the direct shear test. In this case, the change in the diameter
of the test specimen is constrained by the shear ring, so by simply making the consolidation pressure equal to
the effective overburden pressure u'v0, there is no particular need to be aware of Ko.
Although the undrained shear strength (qu/2) obtained from a unconfined compression test has a large amount of
variation, the average value is virtually the same as the average value value of Sue and Sve of the undrained shear
strength obtained from triaxial compression and extension tests by the recompression method with consolidation
of a'..o and Koa'..o, which is capable of reproducing the same stress state as the test specimen in the original
location. The reliability of the test results using triaxial compression and extension tests by the recompression
method whose mechanical basis is clearer, is slightly higher than that of the unconfined compression tests. In
section 2.1 Estimation of Ground Constants, it is expected that triaxial tests, from which results with small
-226-
(2.3.18)
In this equation, 0.85 is a correction factor related to shear rate effect. The measured values have therefore
undergone primary processing to arrive at the derivative values.
@ Methods combining unconfined compressive strength and strength from triaxial compression tests:
One problem with the qu method is that the test's reliability is low in soil with no past records, because the test is
subject to the influence of disturbance during sampling. To resolve this problem, a combination method can be
used to determine the strength by comparing the qu of undisturbed samples with the strength from a triaxial CU
test and evaluating the quality of the sample. In this method, the sample is isotropically consolidated by in- situ
mean effective stress of2a'vof3 when Ko~0.5, after which triaxial CU test is performed in undrained compression
condition. The undrained shear strength thus obtained must be empirically corrected by multiplying 0.75. In
other words, as is the case with the direct shear test, for this triaxial test, measured values must undergo primary
processing to arrive at the derivative values. This method is used for natural soil ground and cannot be applied
to unconsolidated reclaimed ground. For more details see the references 13) aod 14).
@ Method for determining undrained shear strength from an in-situ vane shear test:
A vane shear test is conducted as described in 1.3 Selection of Investigation Methods. The average value of
the obtained shear strength cu(>) can be used in the performance verification as the undrained shear strength Cu
15). An in-situ vane shear test can be carried out rather easily with mobility at a field site. The test is able to
determine the shear strength for very soft clay for which an unconfined compression test cannot be performed
due to the difficulty in making a specimen freestanding. It can thus be applied, for example, to the construction
management where soil is being improved using vertical drains. Although the test method and principle are
simple, attention must be given to the effect of friction on the rod. Ways of reducing the friction and calibrating
its effect need to be devised.
Each method has its own characteristics, which must be duly considered in order to select the most appropriate
one.
The undrained shear strength cu of cohesive soils increases as consolidation progresses, and the higher the
consolidation load the larger the Cu after consolidation. Therefore, the consolidation pressure increases with
depth as the overburden pressure increases, so normally the Cu of a clay ground increases with depth, and the
distribution of undrained shear strength used in the performance verification is frequently expressed by the
following equation.
(2.3.19)
where
Cu : undrained shear strength at depth z from the surface of the clay layer
c.0 : undrained shear strength at surface of the clay layer
k : rate of increase of Cu with depth z
z : depth from the surface of the clay layer
-227-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
c,,/Pc= 0.2.......0.25
(2.3.20)
In view of the fact that the overconsolidation ratio OCR of naturally sedimented cohesive soil is normally in
the range from 1.0 to 1.5, and u'va=p/OCR. therefore, the data in Fig. 2.3.8 15) provides substantiation for equation
(2.3.20).
0.4
0
"co
0.3
r.!
0.2
Oo 00
0
0
00
oo
-~
b
..._,_
oO
.o
D D
D
:.
o :
Triaxial compression
o : Direct shear
0.1
: Triaxial extension
0
20
40
60
80
100
Plasticity Index /p
Fig. 2.3.8 Relationship between Plasticity Index and c,Ju'v0
;=25+3.2
lOON
(2.3.21)
l---
70+u~o
where
'
CT'vo : effective overburden pressure at the depth where the standard penetration test is performed
(kN/m2)
(2) Relationships between the N-value and many soil parameters have been established by the data at various sites.
When using these relationships, however, it is necessary to consider the background of their derivation and the
ground conditions ofthe data and to confirm the range of their applicability. As can be seen in Dunham's equation,
which has commonly been used for many years, the value of (J was determined directly from the N-values
without considering the effective overburden pressure u'v0 However, because the relative density D, varies with
u'y0 as seen in Fig. 2.3.9, a'y0 must be taken into consideration to determine D, from an N-value. This concept
was incorporated in the judgment ofliquefaction. In this judgment, liquefaction resistance is examined from N 65 ,
the equivalent N-value converted into N-value when effective overburden pressure a'vo=65kN/m2. Similarly, it
is known that even in grounds with the same tP , the N-value increases with the increase in effective overburden
pressure. Therefore, the influence of a'.,o must be taken into account when determining tP from the N-values.
50
--
: Terzaghi - + - - - - - - + - - - - - + - - - - - + - - - - - - <
>----- I
-- --.
40
u'v0
.-
40
60
80
100
CD
Density
As the density, relative density, of the subsoil increases, in particular for sandy soils, theN-value increases.
@ Water content
Apart from well compacted fine sand and silty soils, the N-value increases in the order of saturated sand, dry
sand, and wet sand.
-229-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
prescribe the relationship between the shear stress and shear strain of soil.
(2) The performance verification of seismic-resistant can be broadly classified into the static performance verification
methods and the dynamic performance verification methods. One example of static performance verification
methods is the seismic coefficient method of which the seismic force is assumed to act on the ground or structures
in the form of a static inertia force, and stability is examined from the equilibrium of forces. In the dynamic
performance verification methods, on the other hand, dynamic magnification factors or amplification values of
acceleration, speed, and deformation of subsoils shallower than bedrock and foundation ground for structures are
calculated to examine the stability of ground or structures. As for the seismic response analysis method, both the
time domain analysis and the frequency domain analysis are used. For either method, the relationship between
the shear stress and shear strain of the soils is required.
Normally the relationship between the shear stress and shear strain in ground subjected to dynamic actings
is described by a skeleton curve and a hysteresis curve, as shown in Fig. 2.4.1 (a). A skeleton curve will display
remarkable nonlinearity as the shear strain amplitude becomes larger. Since the dynamic modulus of deformation
prescribes this relationship between the shear stress and shear strain, it must be appropriately applied when
conducting a seismic response analysis.
(3) Relationship between Dynamic Shear Stress and Shear Strain of Soil
There are many models to apply the shear stress and shear strain curves of soil into analysis, such as the hyperbolic
model called Hardin-Dornevich model, and the Ramberg-Osgood model.29)
(4) Expression Method of Deformation Properties in the Equivalent Linear Model
To estimate the behavior of ground during an earthquake, the nonlinearity ofthe relationship between the dynamic
stress and strain of soil for a wide range of the shear strain amplitude must be appropriately assessed and modeled.
The relationship of the dynamic stress and strain of soil is expressed with two parameters: the shear modulus and
the damping factor in the equivalent linear model. The shear modulus G and the damping factor h are defined with
the shear strain amplitude by equation (2.4.1) and equation (2.4.2) as shown in Fig. 2.4.1 (b).
G=!_
(2.4.1)
h=
aw
(2.4.2)
2trW
where
G : shear modulus (kN/m2)
: shear stress amplitude (kN/m2)
y : shear strain amplitude
-230-
h : damping factor
W : strain energy (kN/m2)
AW : damping energy (kN/m2)
Since the values of shear modulus G and damping factor h vary nonlinearly depending on the value of y, a G/
G 0 -y curve and ah -y curve are normally drawn as shown in Fig 2.4.2, where G 0 is the shear modulus at y=.:106.
Skeleton curve
\__Hysteresis curve
i..
G : Elastic shear
coefficient
"'"'
h :Damping
L]a
constant
----2
Llw
h=-t_Llw
2.n-
I
I
1.0
0.3
0C5 o.s
0.2
0.1
0
lo-6
lo-5
IQ-4
10-3
lo-2
-231-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2.4.3)
2e.(l+v)
where
"
e0
The damping factor is calculated from equation (2-4.2) with Wand LIW obtained from the stress-strain curve
similar to that shown in Fig. 2.4.1 (b).
In-situ tests are limited to measurements of the shear modulus that only corresponds to 10- level of shear
strain amplitude. Such tests have not been put to practical application to measure the shear modulus and damping
factor for the large shear strain amplitude. But the tests possess the advantage of being able to measure the values
in- situ directly. They are also used to correct the shear modulus obtained from laboratory tests. The elastic
constant of subsoil is obtained by equations (2.4.4) to (2.4.6) from the data of elastic wave velocity measurements
by a seismic exploration using bore holes.
Go= pV,2 =
r, v,2
(2.4.4)
E0 = 2(1 + v)G0
(2.4.5)
(2.4.6)
where
E0
v : Poisson's ratio
p : density (tlm')
Yt : wet unit weight (kN/m3)
g : gravitational acceleration (m/s2)
There are various items requiring attention relating to the taking of measurements when carrying out elastic
wave exploration on soft seabed ground. These include vibration induction and reception methods for elastic
waves such as longitudinal and transverse waves, accuracy of wave profile readings and methods for protecting
bore holes.
(6) Simple Estimation of Shear Modulus and Damping Factors
In cases where it is difficult to directly measure the shear modulus and the damping factors of soils from laboratory
tests or in-situ tests, there are methods for estimating from the plasticity index, the void ratio, the unconfined
compressive strength, and the N-value.30) However, it is necessary to be aware that in the method of estimating
from the N-value, the variation in the estimated values is large, and the coefficient of variation is about 0.2. For
example, on the basis of the variation ofN-value and S wave velocities by Imai, 31) for each ground type, accuracy
examination of estimation error of S wave velocity is shown for Holocene sandy and clayey soil in Fig.2.4.3.
The horizontal axis shows the ratio of estimated values of S wave velocity converted from the N- values and the
actual values. For Holocene sandy soils the average value of the ratio is 1.12 with a standard deviation of0.29, an
-232-
extremely large variation. For Holocene clay soils the average value of the ratio is 0.95 with a standard deviation
of 0.32. In both cases the statistical distribution may be regarded as a log-normal distribution.32)
20
~~~~~~~~H-o_lo_cene~~
~~~~~~~~H~ol-o-cen~e~
sandy soil
00
clay soil
~_caVVs
~_caws
(1) Soil strength against dynamic external actions is normally determined through laboratory tests. In this case, the
properties of the external forces and the subsoil conditions need to be appropriately determined.
(2) The typical dynamic external actions encountered in ports and harbors are seismic movement and wave
force. Seismic movements are characterized by a short period and few cyclic repetitions, while wave forces
are characterized by a long period and many cyclic repetitions. At present these dynamic external actions are
normally converted into static actions like in the seismic coefficient method. There are the cases, however, in
which it is necessary to treat them as dynamic loads like in liquefaction analysis or in strength decrease analysis
of cohesive soil of foundation ground beneath structures exposed to waves. In such cases the dynamic strength
of soils are normally obtained by cyclic triaxial tests. When conducting cyclic triaxial tests, the cyclic undrained
triaxial test method explained in the Soil Testing Methods and Commentary of the Geotechnical Society of
Japan can be used.33)
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
Watabe, Y., T. Ueda, H . Saegusa and M. Tanaka and Y. Kikuchi: Practical determination method of soil parameters constants
based on for performance-based design, lour. JSCE C Vol. 63,No.2, pp. 553-565, 2007. (in Japanese)
Ogawa, F. and Matsumoto, K.: The correlation of the mechanical and index properties of soils in harbour districts, Rept. of
PHRI, Vol.17 No3, pp.31-35, 1978. (in Japanese)
Japan Geotechnical Society Edition: Soil test methods and commentary, 342p., 2000. (in Japanese)
Watabe, Y., Leroueil, S. and Le Bihan, J.-P.: Influence of compaction conditions on pore size distribution and saturated
hydraulic conductivity ofa glacial till, Canadian Geotechnical Journal, Vol.37, No.6, pp. 1184-1194, 2000.
Terzaghi, K. and Peck, P. B.: Soil Mechanics in Engineering Practice, New York John Wiley and Sons Inc., p.44, 1948.
Mukabi., J. N., Tatsuoka, F., Kohata, Y., Tsuchida, T. and Akino, N.: Small strain stiffness of Pleistocene clays in triaxial
compression, Proceedings oflnternational Symposium on Prefailure Deformation Characteristics of Geomaterials, pp.189195, 1994.
Nak:ase, A., Kobayashi, M. and Kanechika, A. : Undrained shear strength and secant modulus of clays Rept. of PHRI, Vol.
11, No.2, pp.243-259, 1972. (in Japanese)
Mikasa, M.: Consolidation of soft clay, Kajima Publications, 1966. (in Japanese)
Umehara, Y: Study on the consolidation characteristics of soils and consolidation test methods, Technical Note of PHRI
No.469, 1983. (in Japanese)
Mitaji, T.: Strength constant in designing, Chapter 2 Estimation of and reinterpretation of shear strength, pp.15-68, 1988. (in
Japanese)
Berre, T. and Bjerrum, L.: Shear strength of normally consolidated clays, Proceedings of 8th International Conference on
Soil Mechanics and Foundation Engineering, pp.39-49, 1973.
Watabe, Y., Tanaka, M., Tanaka, H. and Tsuchida, T.: Ka-consoliation in a triaxial cell and evaluation ofin-situ Ka for marine
clays with various characteristics, Soils and Foundations, Vol.43, No.1, pp. 1-20, 2003.
Tsuchida, T., Mizukami, J., Oikawa, K. and Mori, Y.: New method for determining undrained strength of clayey ground by
means of unconfined compression test and triaxia1 test, Rept. of PHRI, Vol. 28 No.3, pp.81-145, 1989. (in Japanese)
Tsuchida, T.: Study on determination of undrained strength of clayey ground by mean of triaxial test, Technical Note of
PHRI, No.688, 1990. (in Japanese)
-233-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
15) Tanaka, H. and Tanaka, M. : Determination of undrained shear strength of clayey ground measured by vane shear tests, Rept.
ofPHRI, Vol. 33, No. 4, pp.1-17, 1994. (in Japanese)
16) Nakase, A., Kobayashi M. and Katsunc M.: Change in shear strength of saturated clays through consolidation and rebound,
Rept. ofPHRI, Vol.8, No.4, pp.103-143, 1969. (in Japanese)
17) Tanaka, H.: Behavior of braced excavations in soft ground, Technical Note of PHRI, No.734, p.21, 1992. (in Japanese)
18) Kurata, S., Morishita, T., Goto, K., Suzuki, K. and Fukazawa, K.: Study on eugineering characteristics of sand-clay mixed
soil, Rept. of Transport Technical Research Institute, Vol. 11, No.9, pp.36, 1961. (in Japanese)
19) Tanaka, H., Sakakibara, M., Goto, K., Suzuki, K. and Fukazawa, K.: Properties of Japanese Normally Consolidated marine
clays obtained from static piezocone penetration test, Rept. ofPHRI, Vol.31, No.4, pp.61-92, 1992. (in Japanese)
20) Kobayashi, M., Tsuchida, T. and Kamei, Y.: Intermediate soil-Saud or clay?-Geotech-Note 2, Japanese Society of Soil
Mechanics and Foundation, 1992. (in Japanese)
21) Tsuchida, T., Kobayashi, M., Ifuku, S. and Fukuda, I.: Engineering properties of coral soils in Japanese south western islands,
-234-
Chapter 4 Earthquakes
Public Notice
Earthquake Ground Motions
Article 16
Level 1 earthquake ground motions shall be appropriately set in terms of the probabilistic time history wave
profiles based on actual measurements of earthquake ground motions and by taking into consideration the
hypocenter characteristics, the propagation path characteristics, and the site characteristics.
2 Level 2 earthquake ground motions shall be appropriately set in terms of the time history wave profiles
based on actual measurements of the earthquake ground motions, scenario parameters of earthquake
hypocenters, and/or others, and by taking into consideration the hypocenter characteristics, the propagation
path characteristics, and the site characteristics.
[Technical Notes]
1 Ground Motion
1.1 General
The three important factors that affect ground motion are the effect of the rupture process on the fault surface, namely
source effects, the effect of the propagation path from the source to the seismic bedrock, namely propagation path
effects, and the effect of the sediments on the seismic bedrock, namely site effects (see Fig. 1.1.1). Here the seismic
bedrock is strata generally made of granite having an S wave velocity of 3km/s or more. The acceleration Fourier
spectrum 0(/) of the ground motion measured on the ground surface is given in general by the product of the source
effects S(f), the propagation path effects P(f), and the site effects G(f).
o(f) = s(f)P(f)a(f)
(1.1.1)
Here/is the frequency. Also, the group delay time t8,0(f) measured on the ground surface is given by the sum of
the source effects tg!(f), the propagation path effects tg,.P(f). and the site effects tgrG(f).1)
(1.1.2)
Here the group delay time is the derivative of the Fourier phase with respect to the angular frequency m =2n- f,
having the units of time, and is approximately the arrival time of the frequency component/ In this case the arrival
time is the time measured from the start of the time history used in the analysis. The superscripts in equation (1.1.2)
have the following meanings: 0 is the actual measured value on site, S is the source effect, P is the propagation path
effect, and G is the site effect. The existence of sediments affect both the Fourier amplitude and phase of the ground
motion as shown above, but in this part the term used for the effect on the Fourier amplitude, in other words G(f)
, is "site amplification factors'', and in this part the term used for the effect on the ground motion overall is the "site
effects".
-235-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Site characteristics
Seismic bedrock
V,"'3000m'1
Fig. 1.1.1 Source Effects, Propagation Path Effects, and Site Effects
1.1.1 Source Effects
(l.1.3)
where
M0
seismic moment
fc : corner frequency
p : density of the medium of the seismic bedrock
(1.1.4)
where
-236-
are easily affi:cted by the long period component of ground motions, it is particularly necessary to pay attention to
large Magnitude earthquakes.
The maximum value of
"'ii
J"'
.a
1-M
1-M
Come< frequency,
=~=
"'.g
. The
diffi::mice of source
spectnnn with M is
On the low
frequency Ode, it
.Q
~
log (frequency)
=~
ri!
~ro
=~
log (frequency)
-1.
--""""'
Sn"11M
idw
- .
Onhi~-
" """"""'
-t,
" ~rodw
~ ~~
on! I.
=~~
Mele.
Ccm.EI' frequency' it
~ dw
'tude
~ondwlow
Mde
!
~
..2
"~
it"""""'
.Q
log (frequency)
Fig. 1.1.2 Displacement, Velocity, and Acceleration Source Spectra Depending on the ru-2 Model
(2) Directivity
The source of a large earthquake is not a single point, but is a fault surface having a definite extent of spread.
Rupture starts at a point on the fault surface, and spreads to the surroundings. At this time, the S wave velocity
in the source region and the rupture propagation velocity are about the same, so at a harbor in the direction of
propagation of the rupture, the energy of the seismic waves successively released from the fault surface arrive
at about the same time, so the amplitude becomes large. This phenomenon is referred to as the directivity of the
ground motions.
Associated with this, it is known that in the areas where the amplitude is large as a result of the effect of
directivity, it has been reported that the oscillations in the direction normal to the direction of strike of the fault
tend to be strong. 5). 6), 7), 8)
(3) Asperities
It is known that the slip on the fault surface of a large earthquake is not uniform, but non-uniform. The area on the
fault surface where the slip is particularly large is referred to as an asperity. Models that express the non-uniform
distribution of the final slip on the fault surface include the variable slip model, which expresses of final slip by a
continuous function, and the characterized source model which arranges several rectangular asperities on the fault
surface, and within these asperities the amount of slip is uniform.
The effect of propagation path on the amplitude of ground motion is frequently given by the combination of attenuation
(l/r) as the wave spreads from the source in a spherical form, and inelastic damping. The following expresses this in
the form of an equation
(1.1.5)
where
The sediments near the ground surface, see Fig. 1.1.1, have a large effect on the amplitude of the seismic waves, period
characteristics, duration, etc. The effect of the sediments is referred to as the site effects.
-237-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-238-
If records of earthquake
motion at the harbor have been
obtained but site amplification
has not been evaluated
If records of earthquake
motion at the harbor have
not been obtained
(1.3.2)
(1.2.2 (3))
(1.3.3)
Fig. 1.3.1 Procedure for Calculating the Level 2 Earthquake Ground Motion
1.3.2 Scenario Earthquakes for the Level 2 Ground Motion
It is necessary to select the scenario earthquake forthe level 2 ground motion comprehensively taking into consideration
information on past earthquakes and information on active faults. In particular, at the time of performance verification,
the active faults should be based on the latest survey results. Regarding past earthquakes, references 53) and 54) are
comprehensive documents. Reference 35) is a document that summarizes the fault parameters for the main past
earthquakes. References 33) and 34) are comprehensive documents regarding active faults. In addition to these,
after the 1995 Hyogo-ken Nambu Earthquake, active faults were surveyed, and the results were made public by the
Headquarters for Earthquake Research Promotion and local governments. By referring to the above documents, the
following should be considered:
(a) The recurrence of earthquakes that have caused significant damage in the past
(b) Earthquakes due to the activity of active faults
(c) Other earthquakes for which there is a concern over occurrence from a seismological or geological viewpoint
(d) Earthquakes postulated by the national organizations such as the Central Disaster Prevention Council and the
Headquarters for Earthquake Research Promotion
(e) Earthquakes postulated in the local disaster plans
-239-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
of the seismic response analysis will ultimately become the level 2 earthquake. When the number of earthquakes
to be considered is large, one method is to carry out in advance a simple evaluation of the ground motions using
attenuation equations, and eliminate earthquakes whose effect is clearly small. For the earthquakes postulated in
(d), refer to the following homepages:
Central Disaster Prevention Council: http://www.bousai.gojp/jishin/chubou/index.html
Headquarters for Earthquake Research Promotion: http://wwwjishin.gojp/main/p_ hyoka02.htm
The reasons for considering M6.5 right below earthquakes are as follows.SS) An active fault is the trace of
an earthquake fault, refurred to as a surface fault trace, that has appeared in the ground surface due to a large
earthquake in the past. However, in the case of comparatively small scale earthquakes, surface fault trace do not
appear, so even in locations where there is no active fault, there is the possibility of occurrence of a comparatively
small scale earthquake. Takemura et al.56) investigated the relationship between the scale of an earthquake and the
probability of appearance of surface fault trace, and the relationship between the scale of an earthquake and the
extent of damage, 32) see Fig. 1.3.2, for earthquakes within the earth's crust ofM>5.8 occurring in Japan between
1885 and 1995. According to their results, earthquakes of M<6.5 have a very low probability of appearance of
surface fault trace, but earthquakes of M":6.8 have a probability of appearance of surface fault trace of nearly
100%. Also, focusing on the fact that earthquakes ofM ~ 6.6 and 6.7 are very fuw, it is interred that this is because
the earthquake fault penetrates to the ground surface. Therefore it is considered appropriate that the scale of the
earthquake postulated at locations where there is no active fault should be about M6.5 .
e
0
- -
~
5
~
I:
Meece
"'
a;-oo o qp ce
00 00 CXX> co~
0 0
CD
IW oo CW o "8'
o e ce
0
6.0
6.5
JMAMagn;tud2
7.0
8.0
Fig. 1.3.2 Relationship between Scale of Earthquakes and Probability of Appearance of Surface Faults>
Among harbor facilities, there are some for which it is required that a tsunami be expected following the
ground motion, and the performance in these circumstances is prescribed. In this case, the ground motion to
be combined with the tsunami does not necessarily have to be the most damaging ground motion, i.e., Level
2 earthquake ground motion, expected for the harbor. For example, at a certain harbor, both an earthquake at
an active fault on land and an subduction-zone earthquake may be expected, and it may be expected that the
earthquake at the active fault on land will bring the most damaging seismic motion. In this case, a tsunami does
not accompany the earthquake at the active fault on land, so it is not rational to expect that immediately after
the ground motion of the earthquake at the active fault on land, a tsunami will attach, and this would result in
excessive investment. Therefore, there may be situations where it is necessary to evaluate the ground motions that
precede a tsunami, apart from the level 2 earthquake motion. In this case the method of evaluating the ground
motions may be to simply change the earthquake from that for the level 2 earthquake motion to the earthquake
that is the cause of the tsunami, and apply the following evaluation method as it is.
1.3.3 Setting the Source Parameters
The source parameters necessary for evaluating the Level 2 earthquake ground motion include macroscopic hypocenter
parameters, such as position of the base point, strike, dip, length, width, area and seismic moment, microscopic source
parameters, such as number of asperities, area of asperities, seismic moment of asperities and rise time, etc., and other
parameters, such as rupture starting point, rupture velocity and rupture propagation type. The meaning of these
parameters is shown in Fig. 1.3.3. The source parameters may be set in accordance with the standard method of
setting the parameters shown below, or they may be set by carrying out a separate detailed survey.
-240-
Ground surface
North
Strike;
Final slip Do
Rise time Tr
LengthL
Time
(1.3.1)
Regarding the microscopic source parameters such as asperity location, etc., an appropriate approach should
be taken depending on the volume of data for the past events. Firstly, ifthe microscopic source parameters for the
past events have been investigated well using wave profile data, etc., those parameters may be used. For example,
this is the case when considering the recurrence of the 1923 Kanto Earthquake, 60) recurrence of the 1968 Tokachi
Oki Earthquake, 44) or recurrence of the 1978 Miyagi Ken Oki Earthquake.44) Next, if wave profile data from
the past event is not available, and if the earthquake intensity distribution is known from historical documents,
microscopic source parameters set to be consistent with this earthquake intensity information may be used. For
example, this is the case when considering the recurrence of the Hoei Earthquake, the Ansei Tokai Earthquake, or
the Ansei Nankai Earthquake. As an example ofthe microscopic source parameters defined so as to be compatible
with the earthquake intensity distribution, there are the microscopic source parameters for the expected Tonankai
and Nankai earthquakes the Central Disaster Prevention Council, see Fig. 1.3.4.
The other parameters such as rupture start point etc. are dealt with in the same way as the microscopic source
parameters.
In the case of an earthquake occurring at an active fault, the average interval between activities is long, so in
almost all cases it is not possible to refer to the past events. However, as an exception, if expecting a recurrence of
the 1995 Hyogo-ken Nambu Earthquake or similar, the above consideration may be used, without using (2) When
an Earthquake is Expected to Occur at an Active Fault.
-241-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Fig. 1.3.4 Source Model of the Tonankai and Nankai Earthquakes Expected by the Central Disaster Prevention Council e1i
(1.3.2)
The microscopic source parameters for an earthquake occurring at an active fault may be defined as follows.
First, the total area of asperities as a percentage of the total fault area is assumed to be 22%.58), 62), 63), 64), 65) The
number of asperities is assumed to be 1 or 2.58) If the magnitude of the postulated earthquake is M7 or larger,
the number of asperities is assumed to be 2. When the number of asperities is assumed to be 2, the larger one
is assumed to be 16% of the total fault area, and the smaller one is assumed to be 6%.58), 64) The shape of the
asperities are taken to be rectangular as much as possible.58), 63) The seismic moment of the asperity is assumed
to be 44% of the total seismic moment.58), 63), 64) When there are two asperities, the seismic moment of the larger
one is assumed to be 36% of the total seismic moment, and the seismic moment of the smaller one is assumed to
be 8%.58), 64) The rise time l' of the asperity is defined from the width Wa of the asperity and the rupture velocity
V, using the following equation. 58)
(Wa/V, )/4
(1.3.3)
The layout of the asperity is arranged in relationship to the rupture strong point, which is discussed later,
so that the rupture of one of the asperities propagates towards the harbor. This is because due to the effect of
directivity, a particularly strong ground motion is generated in the direction of propagation of the rupture of the
asperity, and a strong ground motion generated in this way resulted in devastating damage in the 1995 Hyogo-ken
Nambu Earthquake.4) Specifically, the asperity is arranged as shown in Fig. 1.3.5. The depth of the center of the
asperity is taken to be lOkm.
Of the other parameters, the rupture starting point is located as shown in Fig. 1.3.5 in relation to the location
of the asperity. The rupture velocity is assumed to be 80% of the S wave velocity in the source region.SB) The
rupture is assumed to propagate radially.
-242-
Ground 1urfilce
Top sudiico of soismogonio !aye<
ohbout 3-4km
------------------- ....---------.
Depth of cmter of
asperity !Okm
~.a~v:__w - - - -
I+I ------
Asperity
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - ......
,---------l
RDptuni ~point 1"111'(;,---------,,i>..,1
Aspority loogth L
ofabout2Dkm
(3) When M6.5 Earthquake is Expected to Occur just Beneath the Site
The seismic moment M 0 can be calculated from the Magnitude using the following equation.66)
(1.3.4)
Therefore, the fault area Smay be obtained from equation (1.3.2). The dip angle may be assumed to be 90.
What follows is the same as in (2) When an Earthquake is Expected to Occur at an Active Fault. The number
of asperities is taken to be 1.
- 243-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2 Seismic Action
2.1 Modeling and Seismic Action of the Ground - Structure System
The ground motions described in Section 1 Ground Motion are ground motions that are independent of the facilities,
and do not depend on the type of the facilities or analysis method. This is referred to as a "reference ground motion"
in ISO 23469.1> In contrast, the seismic action, the term used in ISO 23469, necessary for performance verification
of port facilities is defined differently depending on the facility or analysis method as stated below. When setting
the seismic action for seismic performance verification, firstly the ground motion is evaluated by Section 1 Ground
Motion for the case where the facilities do not exist, and next the seismic action is evaluated corresponding to the type
of facilities or analysis method.
Normally, the analysis methods used in seismic performance verification of port facilities can be classified as
equivalent static analysis and dynamic analysis. Also, the analysis methods can be classified as simple analysis or
detailed analysis depending on whether ground-structure interaction is taken into consideration. As a result the
analysis methods used in seismic performance verification can be classified into 2x2=4 categories. Here, simplified
analysis focuses on a part of the ground-structure system, and analyzes its behavior, and the seismic action is defined
as the effect on the part under consideration from outside its boundary. On the other hand, in detailed analysis, the
total behavior of the ground - structure system, for example the gray part in Fig. 2.1.l(b), is analyzed, and in this
case the seismic action is defined as the ground motion input to the bottom end of the analysis domain. For example,
in a simplified equivalent static analysis, namely seismic coefficient method, of a caisson type quaywall, as indicated
in gray in Fig. 2.1.l(a), the part of the whole on which the focus is applied is the wall, and analysis of its behavior is
carried out. In this case the seismic action is the inertia forces, earth pressure and hydrodynamic pressure during
the earthquake acting on the wall from the external domain. In a detailed dynamic analysis, mainly effective stress
analysis, ofthe caisson type quaywall, as indicated in gray in Fig. 2.1.l(b), the focus is on the entire system comprising
the caisson, the backfill, the seawater, and the foundation grounds below the caisson, and its behavior is analyzed. In
this case the seismic action is the ground motion input to the bottom end of the analysis domain. In detailed dynamic
analysis, the earth pressure and hydrodynamic pressure during the earthquake acting on the caisson wall are produced
as the response analysis results, and are not set as an action.
The types of analysis method used for seismic performance verification of port facilities and the method of defining
the seismic action in accordance with the analysis method are discussed below.
-------_s---~
Sea
....
rnlnerti~-~: L.~:::.
Hydrodynamic pres\:
._
+-
_.+ .-
+----
Caisson + - -
-----="~--_-__-_-__-__._._-__-_-__-_-__-_-__-_-___-__-_-__-_-_\._____________________________________,
Sea bottom
Sea bottom
Film ground
Film ground
t ...... _.
...
-4111,___,...
_
Seismic motion
Fig. 2.1.1 Seismic Action in the Seismic Coefficient Method and Effective Stress Analysis
(Example of a Caisson Type Quaywall)
2)
As shown in Fig. 2.2.1, this method is considered when a rigid object is on a rigid ground. Assume the mass of the
object ism, and its weight is W. If the ground moves to the right with an acceleration a, an inertia force am acts on
the object to the left. At this time a friction force of am must act on the bottom surface of the object, in order that it
will not slide. If the static friction coefficient on the bottom surface is not sufficiently large, the object will slide, and
in most cases, depending on the changes of the acceleration force afterwards, a residual displacement will occur. At
this time, when checking whether sliding will occur, it is possible to apply a static force am to the object. This is the
fundamental idea of the seismic coefficient method.
The following equation shows the magnitude ofthe inertia force acting in the seismic coefficient method.
(2.2.1)
F=(a/g)W
If kh is written instead of a lg, the following equation is obtained.
(2.2.2)
-244-
am
a~
w
Fig. 2.2.1 Concept of the Seismic Coefficient Method
In the classification of analysis methods given in 2.1 Modeling and Seismic Action of the Ground - Structure
System, The seismic coefficient method is a simplified equivalent static analysis. Problems of the stability of facilities
in an earthquake can be converted into static equilibrium problems and conveniently analyzed, so the method is
used widely, not only for ports. In the field of ports, this method is used for the performance verification of gravity
quaywalls, sheet pile quaywalls, and cell type quaywalls subject to the Level 1 earthquake ground motions. When
applied to gravity type quaywalls, it is necessary to consider the inertia forces acting on the wall, as well as the earth
pressure and hydrodynamic pressure during the earthquake, as shown in Fig. 2.1.l(a).
For the level 1 earthquake motion, when carrying out seismic performance verification using the seismic coefficient
method, it is not necessary to take the value of the expected maximum acceleration of the ground divided by the
acceleration of gravity as the seismic coefficient for verification to be applied to the structure. For example, substituting
a =215Gal into equation (2.2.1) gives k=0.22. However, it is known from experience 2). 4) that when a ground motion
with a maximum acceleration exceeding 215Gal acts on a quaywall with a seismic coefficient for verification of 0.22,
a residual deformation does not necessarily occur. The reasons for this have not been phenomenologically explained
sufficiently, but it is considered that one of the reasons is that even if a 215Gal acceleration acts on the quaywall,
if the action is instantaneous, it is difficult to cause a visible residual deformation to the quaywall. The method of
converting the acceleration time history of the scenario Level I earthquake ground motions to the seismic coefficient
for verification varies depending on the structural form of the mooring facility. For gravity quaywalls refer to Part m
Chapter 5, 2.2.2 Actions, and for sheet piles quaywalls refur to Part III Chapter 5, 2.3.2 Actions.
When carrying out a seismic performance verification using the seismic coefficient method, the earth pressure
during the earthquake and the foundation ground properties are as discussed later. However, with the seismic
coefficient method normally it is assumed that liquefaction does not occur in the ground behind the wall or in the
foundations, and the earth pressure during the earthquake and foundation ground properties are set based on this
assumption. Therefore, when carrying out seismic performance verification by the seismic coefficient method for the
Level 1 earthquake ground motion, an analysis to predict whether liquefaction will occur in the ground behind the wall
or in the foundations is carried out, and if it is determined that liquefaction may occur, it is necessary to take measures
against it.
As can be understood from its principle, the seismic coefficient method is a method for determining whether
deformation will occur in specific modes, such as sliding, overturning, insufficient bearing capacity of the foundation
ground etc., based on static equilibrium of forces. Ifdeformation does occur, it is not possible to calculate by the seismic
coefficient method how much residual deformation is caused. This is a limitation of the seismic coefficient method,
and because of this limitation it is not practical to apply the seismic coefficient method to the Level 2 earthquake
ground motion. Normally, for very strong ground motions, such as Level 2 earthquake ground motions, it is assumed
that the facility will suffer some damage, and it is necessary to investigate the process of this damage when carrying
out the seismic performance verification.SJ. 6) The same applies to port facilities such as mooring facilities etc., in
which it is assumed that deformation will be caused by the Level 2 earthquake ground motion, and it is required to
carry out the design to limit the deformation to be equal to or less than the allowable amount In order to meet this
requirement, it is necessary to carry out a seismic response analysis of the ground - structure system, as described
later, not the analysis by the seismic coefficient method.
-245-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2)
In the case of the seismic coefficient method, the acceleration acting on the facility is equal to the acceleration acting
on the ground. In contrast, in the case of a flexible structure as shown in Fig. 2.3.1, the acceleration a' acting on the
facility is not the same as the acceleration a acting on the ground. In this case, if the dynamic characteristics of the
facility, such as the natural periods, etc., and the time history of the ground acceleration are given, it is possible to
calculate the response acceleration of the facility. By applying to the facility the equivalent static force obtained by
multiplying the maximum value of the response acceleration of the facility by its mass m, it is possible to replace the
actual phenomenon with static equilibrium of forces to carry out the seismic design. When the scope of the seismic
coefficient method is expanded in this way to structures with flexibility, it is called the modified seismic coefficient
method. Using the time history of the expected ground acceleration, if a response calculation is carried out in advance
for facilities with various natural periods, and if the maximum value of the response acceleration of the facility is
arranged as a function of the natural period, the result is referred to as an acceleration response spectrum.
a' ---+
a'm
a--+
Fig. 2.3.1 Concept of the Modified Seismic Coefficient Method
The modified seismic coefficient method is classified as a simplified equivalent static method in the classification
of analysis methods in 2.1 Modeling and Seismic Action of the Ground - Structure System. For obtaining the
response acceleration of the facility in the modified seismic coefficient method, it is frequently assumed that the
restoring force characteristics of the facility are linear. However, when a very strong earthquake acts on the structure,
the restoring force characteristic of the facility actually becomes nonlinear, as a result of plasticity in the structural
members. Therefore, the response acceleration obtained under the assumption of linearity becomes meaningless.
Therefore the modified seismic coefficient method is uosuitable for very strong ground motions, such as the Level 2
earthquake ground motion.
2)
In extended, long facilities such as buried pipelines or immersed tuonels, etc., where the apparent weight per unit
volume and stiffness are comparatively small, the acceleration applied to the facility is seldom a problem. The weight
and stiffness of these facilities is small, so the effect of the existence of these facilities on the surrounding ground
is small, and the displacements in the facility tend to be governed by the displacements in the surrouoding ground.
When the displacement in the surrounding ground is not uniform, strain is caused in the facility. This is a problem
for seismic design.
In the seismic deformation method, first the displacement of the ground for the case where the facility does not
exist there is obtained, and next the displacement and stress in the facility is obtained based on the assumption that
the displacement of the facility is the same as the displacement of the ground. In other words, in contrast to the
seismic coefficient method in which the equivalent static load is applied to the facility as the seismic action, in the
seismic deformation method the displacement of the grouod is applied to the facility as the seismic action. In cases
where the stiffness of the subsurface structure is quite high, and the error in the assumption that the facility deforms
exactly the same as the grouod is large, the displacement of the grouod can act on the facility via springs. The seismic
deformation method is classified as a simplified equivalent static aoalysis in the classification of aoalysis methods
given in 2.1 Modeling and Seismic Action of the Ground - Structure System.
-246-
2.5 Seismic Action in the Seismic Response Analysis of Ground - Structure Systems
Each of the methods described so far simplify the actual phenomena, but seismic response analysis that more truely
reproduces the overall ground - structure system behavior can also be carried out. This is classified as detailed
dynamic analysis in the classification of analysis methods given in 2.1 Modeling and Seismic Action of the Ground
- Structure System. Seismic response analysis of ground - structure systems is frequently based on the finite element
method, in particular the effective stress method, as shown in Fig. 2.5.1. In this case the seismic action is the ground
motion input at the bottom end of the analysis domain.
In general, the ground motion at the bottom end of the analysis domain is the sum of an upcoming wave E and a
downgoing wave (F). Methods of applying the input ground motions to the bottom end of the analysis domain include
the method in which the actual seismic wave motions E+F are applied to the bottom end of the analysis area, and the
method in which an seismic wave having an amplitude twice that of the seismic wave incident from below is applied to
the bottom end of the analysis domain, namely 2E wave input method. When carrying out a calculation to reproduce
damage actually incurred, or when carrying out a simulation of a shake table rest, there may be measurements of the
ground motions at the bottom end of the analysis domain, including the upcoming wave and the downgoing wave, and
in these cases the E+F wave input method can be used. However, for seismic response analysis of ground structure
systems carried out for seismic performance verification the 2E wave input method is used. In this case, if directly
below the analysis domain there is ground that can be considered to be firm ground, the ground motion at the firm
ground obtained in Section 1 Ground Motion may be used as it is. However, if directly below the analysis domain
there is ground that cannot be considered to be the firm ground, it is necessary that the ground motion defined at the
firm ground be converted to a 2E wave directly below the analysis domain by a seismic response analysis for the local
soil deposit, and this 2E wave is then inputted.
Inclination angle
4.1
Horizontal displacement
3.5m
Vertical displacement 1.5m ::i:::t--1 r..- r ,...,..,.....,.....,.....,.....,....- ........ r..-..-....-...-
\J
~-
,- ,--+4.0m
4
_ 1 _I _ _ I _
'
,/
I/
Fig. 2.5.1 Example of Residual Displacement of a Gravity Quaywall Calculated by Effective Stress Analysis
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
International Organization for Standardization: ISO 23469, Bases for design of structures- Seismic actions for design ng
geotechnical works, 2005
Tsuchida, H. and S. Iai: Earthquake Engineering for construction engineers, Sankai-do Publishing
Sano, T. : Structural theory of houses (Vol. I & II), Disaster prevention survey committee, Vol. 83, 1916
Noda, S., T. Uwabe and T. Chiba : Relation between seismic coefficient and ground acceleration for gravity quaywalls, Rept.
of PHRI Vol.14 No4, 1975
JSCE: Proposals on criteria of earthquake resistance, JSCE, 1996
JSCE: The third proposal and commentary on seismic design of civil engineering structures, JSCE, 2000
-247-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-----1-...Jir.---------~l-~'--'Ollill:lliW-+-Top
offirm ground
Sediments
Seismic bedrock
Vs23000m/s
G(f) =Od/)102(/)
-248-
. . n
-o
(A-3.1)
where
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Py(!): propagation path effects from the hypocenter of the 1lh earthquake to the seismic bedrock of the
fa observation point
G1 (f) : site amplification factors of the fa point
The propagation path effects P uif) can be expressed by the following equation, taking into consideration
geometric attenuation, l/r, of the wave spreading in spherical form from the hypocenter and inelastic damping.
(A-3.2)
rli
where
rif
distance from the hypocenter of the ith earthquake to thejth observation point
(A-3.3)
In order to simplify the expression shown here, the f which indicates dependence on frequency has been
omitted. Equation (A-3.3) includes M+N+l number of unknowns, including the source effects S 1, the site
amplification factors G1, and the Q value. Therefore, if there are more equations, namely the number of records
that can be used, than the number of unknowns, it is possible to obtain the combination of unknowns for each
frequency f, by the method of least squares so that the residual error of equation (A-3.3) is minimized. The above
is the basic concept of spectral inversion. It is also possible to have the Q value as a known quantity, and obtain
M+N number of unknown quantities.
However, there is a trade-off relationship between the source effects S1 and the site amplification factors G1 in
equation (A-3.3). For example, assuming that a certain combination ofS1 and G1 is a solution, the combination S/2
and 2G1 is also a solution. As a method for avoiding this, there is the method of assuming that the site amplification
factors are 1 at a rock observation point, referred to as the standard observation point, selected in advance. At this
time it is necessary to carefully consider the selection of the reference point. The following points19 are useful for
selecting the reference point. Firstly, select the point with the smallest site amplification characteristics for each
frequency as the reference point based on the results of preliminary analysis. However, as the amplification in
the high frequency range in weak grounds is small, the point selected as the reference point should be limited to
points with sufficiently large S wave velocities. Specifically, the reference point should be selected from points
for which the average S wave velocity from the ground surface to the depth of lOm is 400m/s or higher. Also,
in order to avoid the characteristics of each individual record greatly affecting the results, the reference point
should be limited to those points for which records of several, about 5 earthquakes, measurement records have
been obtained. Besides basing the selection of the reference point on the above criteria, it is necessary to make
the decision based on an examination of whether the low frequency part of the source effects S1 obtained from the
actual inversion results is compatible with Centroid Moment Tensor, CMT, solution 20) , for example, that of the
F-net of the National Research Institute for Earth Science and Disaster Prevention.
In addition, the points to note when actually carrying out the spectral inversion are as follows:
In spectral inversion it is normally assumed that there is geometric attenuation, l/r, of the wave spreading in
spherical form from the hypocenter. However, at distant observation points, geometric attenuation in the form
above becomes inapplicable as a result of the effect of Lg waves transmitted by reflection within the earth's
crust.12) In order to avoid this, it is necessary to exclude records of earthquakes that occur far away, about 150 200km or farther.
The records of small scale earthquakes frequently do not have good SIN ratio in the low frequency range.
When considering harbor facilities, there are times when it is necessary to ensure accuracy down to 0.2Hz on the
low frequency range, so it is necessary to use records ofM4.5 or larger. Also, it is desirable to check the SIN ratio
on the low frequency range of each of the records used in the analysis.21) On the other hand, the records oflarge
scale earthquakes are affected by the rupture process ofthe fault, so it becomes inappropriate to consider a single
source effect Si unaffected by direction. Therefore, it is desirable to avoid records for M6.0 or larger. As a result
ofthe above, earthquakes in the range M4.5 - M6.0 are frequently used in spectral inversion.
In order to avoid nonlinear behavior of the local soil deposit, it is desirable to avoid the use of records with
large amplitude. It is also necessary to pay attention to the length of the records used in the analysis. It is also
possible to extract by some method the "S wave part" ofthe observed ground motion, and use its Fourier spectrum
in the analysis. However, when considering harbor facilities, it is necessary to obtain the amplification factors of
the Fourier spectrum including later phases by analyzing not only the S wave, but also surface waves.
Nozu and Nagao 22) applied spectral inversion to a data set that contained strong motion earthquake records in
Japanese harbor areas as well as K-NET, KiK-net, and other strong ground motion records, and obtained the site
-250-
amplification factors between seismic bedrock and ground surface of the strong ground motion observation points
in each area, in particular harbors. The results are available on CD-ROM.22)
(3) Method of Evaluating the Site Amplification Factors from Simultaneous Records from the Harbor and its
Surroundings
If records have been obtained for the same earthquake at the harbor and a nearby observation point, and if the site
amplification factors have already been evaluated at the nearby observation point, the site amplification factors
at the harbor can be evaluated by the following method. Firstly, in order to be able to explain the record at the
nearby observation point, the source effects of the earthquake under consideration are appropriately set. Next, it
is possible to obtain the site amplification factors at the harbor by dividing the Fourier amplitude spectrum at the
harbor by the source effects and by the propagation path effects. 23) It is necessary to be aware that if the harbor
and the nearby observation point are in fairly different directions from the hypocenter, then it is possible that the
accuracy of the evaluation will be reduced by the dependence on direction of the source effects of the earthquake.
If the earthquake has occurred sufficiently far away, the source effects and the propagation path effects of the
harbor and the nearby measurement point can be considered to be common, so evaluation of the source effects
may be omitted, and the site amplification factors of the harbor may be evaluated by taking the ratio of the spectra
of the two points. The records of large earthquakes that have occurred particularly far away are not suitable for
spectral inversion, but the SIN ratio is frequently good down to the low frequency range, so they can frequently
be used in this manner. Fig. A-3.3 shows a comparison of the ratio of the site amplification factors obtained
from SZ0013, K-NET Shimizu, and SZ0014, K-NET Shizuoka, from the records of the Kii Hanto Nanto Oki
Earthquakes with M7.1 and M7.4, which occurred on 5th September 2004, and the ratio of the site amplification
factors based on spectral inversion. It can be seen that the ratios of the site amplification factors obtained by the
two methods agree well.
100
FH- --
..... .
-----,---,--,-.,--,--,--------------.--.-,--,-,
..
.. . .. .. , . . , ....... .,......., ...
.. .. ...... .. , . .. , .. , . ., .., ... -
::!: 10
.; ...
::!: 10
!?2
('1')
!?2
('1')
......
......
' 1 1-.
' . 1' -i' 'r ,-, rr r r 11
'
i
'
'
0. 1
4 6 8
. . . . . ...
'
.; .. ;.H-H
4 6 8
0. 1
10
. . ...
-i-11-.-,-. r,--,rr
ri-1
. .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . ...
6 8
..
''
10
Frequency (Hz)
Frequenc)' (Hz)
Fig. A-3.3 Comparison of the Ratio of Site Amplification Factors Evaluated by Two Methods
(4) Evaluation of the Site Amplification Factors when Seismic Observation Records have been Obtained at Several
Locations Near the Harbor
If ground motion records can be obtained at several locations near the harbor, it is possible to obtain several
site amplification factors. In this case, it is necessary to carry out zoning on the several site amplification factors.
In coastal areas, sudden changes are sometimes seen in the bedrock depths, due to the basin structure, so it is
necessary to be aware that if zoning is carried out according to whether the physical distance is long or short, it is
possible to make the evaluation on the dangerous side. The use of microtremors can be considered as a means of
carrying out simple zoning. There are many examples of research into the use of microtremors to determine the
subsurface structure. Among them is research focused on the ratio of the spectra of the horizontal component and
the vertical component, hereafter referred to as the HIV spectrum, obtained by measurement of three components
of microtremors, 26) and research focused on the average S wave velocity obtained from array measurements, 27)
however these are mainly for investigating the shallow subsurface structure. Also, research examples focused on
the deep subsurface structure using microtremors frequently use phase velocity by array measurement.28) There
are comparatively few examples of research on the deep subsurface structure using the HIV spectrum from 3
component measurements, but for Sato et al.29) have indicated that the microtremor spectral peak appearing in
the range with period equal to or greater than 1 second can be explained by the HIV spectral peak in the Rayleigh
wave down to the seismic bedrock, based on measurement records at Sendai.
It is considered that of the microtremor measurements, 3-component measurement is suitable for investigating
-251-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
the subsurface structure because of the simplicity of the measurements. For the deep subsurface structure, it is
also possible to consider zoning by focusing on the peak in the long period side of the microtrernor HN spectrum.
2 Probabilistic Seismic Hazard Analysis
The uniform hazard Fourier spectrum at the top of firm ground and the corresponding time history can be calculated
in accordance with the procedure shown in Fig. A-3.4.31) The following is an explanation of the flow.
Active fault data
(earthquakes whose sources
can be specified)
lit
equation)
process
Distance: random
lit
,1,
Extent of fault: probabilistic Greens function method
J,
\II
Logic tree
\II
Fig. A-3.4 Method of Calculating the Uniform Hazard Fourier Spectrum and the Corresponding Time History 31J
Firstly, the sources of earthquakes that could occur in the future near the harbor are classified into those that cannot
be easily defined and those that can be defined, and each ofthe sources are modeled. Here modeling the sources means
setting the position and size of the sources. To model the former, earthquake catalog data 32) that records earthquakes
that have occurred near the site in the past are used. To model the latter, active fault data 33), 34) obtained from
topographical and geological surveys and fault model data for past earthquakes 35) are used. For sources that cannot
be easily defined in advance, the sources may be equally spread over an area that appears to be seismically active,
hereafter referred to as a seismic area, or sources may be randomly set within the seismic area, see Fig. A-3.S(a). On
the other hand, for the sources that can be defined, the position and size of the source is set, see Fig. A-3.S(b).
After modeling the sources, the earthquake Magnitudes that could occur at these sources in the future and the
frequency of their occurrence are evaluated. ht the case of sources that are difficult to define in advance, the model of
the Gutenberg-Richter equation, namely b value model, see Fig. A-3.6(a), is assumed in which specifies relationship
between the logarithm of the frequency of occurrence of an earthquake, N, and the Magnitude, M. The earthquake
Magnitudes are the Magnitude values obtained from the earthquake Magnitude-frequency relations. Also, the
frequency of occurrence within the seismic area can be obtained from the number of occurrences of earthquakes in
the earthquake catalog data and their time of measurement. ht the case of sources that can be defined, the maximum
Magnitude model, maximum moment model, see Fig. A-3.6(b), in which the magnitude of the earthquakes that
occur is constant is frequently used. The Magnitude and frequency of earthquakes occurring on active faults are
frequently calculated from information on the length of the active fault, the average slip rate, and other topographical
and geological information.
-252-
M2
kn~~!
X3
~-
For each of the postulated earthquakes, the Fourier amplitude spectrum at the top of firm ground is calculated
taking into consideration the source effects, the propagation path effects, and the site amplification factors between
seismic bedrock and top of firm ground. For sources that can be defined, it is desirable that the Fourier amplitude
spectrum is calculated by a method capable of taking into account the finiteness of the fault, such as the probabilistic
Green function method. For sources that cannot be easily defined in advance, it can be assumed that the source effects
of the earthquakes full ow the w-2 model.
As a result of the above, many Fourier amplitude spectra are evaluated with probabilities, see top figures of Fig.
A-3.7. Therefure, these can be arranged so that the relationship between the Fourier amplitude spectrum and the
annual probability of exceedaoce hazard curve, can be obtained fur each frequency, see Fig. A-3.7. When these
are overlayed the hazard surface is obtained, see Fig. A-3.7, so that fucusing on a particular annual probability of
exceedance a unifurm hazard Fourier amplitude spectrum is obtained, see Fig. A-3.7. There are 4 samples in the
top figures of Fig. A-3.7. This means that although these are earthquakes from the same source, their manner of
b value model
~g
~g
"
!!.
...
Jl
J:
0"
Magnitude (M)
Magnitude (M)
(a) Earthquakes for which the sources
are difficult to define in advance
-253-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Earthquake I
tj
Earthquake 2
tj
/I
tj
Ji
Frequency
Earthquake 3
Frequencyf
Ji
Frequency
Frequency
fi
Hazard surface
Ji f, fi f. f,
Frequency
Fig. A-3.7 Procedure for Calculating the Uniform Hazard Fourier Amplitude Spectra
-254-
convenience of the calculation. In contrast to this, in nonlinear analysis the calculation takes into consideration
that the shear modulus etc. of the soil varies throughout the time of the ground motion. If the intention is to be
as close as possible to the actual phenomena then it is necessary to carry out nonlinear analysis, but if the strain
in the soil is not too large, it is considered that equivalent linear analysis can provide response analysis results
that are close to the actual phenomena to a certain extent. The level of strain at which equivalent linear analysis
can be applied depends on the method, but is about 0.5 to 1.0"/o or less.'). 37) Therefore, if as a result of carrying
out equivalent linear analysis it is found that the strain obtained exceeds this amount, it is necessary to change
the analysis method to nonlinear analysis.
In equivalent linear analysis the following repeated calculations are carried out. First, the effective shear
strain is obtained from the maximum shear strain for each layer, in case of 2-dimensions or higher, for each
-255-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Next, from the effective shear strain, the shear modulus and the damping factor are modified taking into
consideration the strain dependence of Fig. 2.4.2 of Chapter 3, 2.4.1 Dynamic Modulus of Deformation, and
the routine proceeds to the next step. This operation is repeated until the shear modulus converges. The earliest
equivalent-liner seismic response analysis program is SHAKE.38) When SHAKE was first developed, there were
no other competing programs, and it was widely used in design practice. Also, FLUSH, 39) the 2-dimensional
version of SHAKE, is widely used. However, in recent years the problems with SHAKE have gradually become
apparent, as a result of comparison of SHAKE calculation results with actual seismic observation records.40)
One of these problems is that the high frequency components are under-estimated. When trying to estimate
the incident waves on the firm ground based on the seismic wave observed at the surface, the high frequency
component is over-estimated). FDEL, 41) DYNEQ, 42) and other programs that are improved over SHAKE
in this respect have been proposed. In these programs the problem of under- or over-estimation of the high
frequency component is solved by using frequency dependent shear strain, instead of the effective shear strain
obtained from equation (A-4.1).
Nonlinear analysis is an analysis method that can be applied when the strain in the ground is large, about
0.5 - 1.0% or larger. However, whether the nonlinear analysis gives the correct result or not naturally depends
on the constitutive equation used and whether the soil constants are appropriate or not. There are various
types of analysis program for nonlinear analysis, using various constitutive models. It is important to use an
analysis program that has successfully reproduced vertical array observation records obtained under similar
conditions, soil properties and strain levels, in the past with good accuracy.36) Nonlinear analysis can be
classified into effective stress analysis and total stress analysis. When excess pore water pressure appears in a
ground, the effective stress is reduced. As a result, the stress state ofthe soil changes, so the soil restoring force
characteristics and damping characteristics are changed, so the response characteristics of the ground are also
changed. Effective stress analysis is capable of expressing this type of situation, and is a method that is capable
of directly obtaining the excess pore water pressure generated in a ground by calculation. On the other hand,
in total stress analysis, the excess pore water pressure is not calculated in the calculation process, so it is not
possible to take account of the change in seismic response due to the change in effective stress. If excess pore
water pressure is generated more than a certain level, about 0.5 or higher in the effective stress ratio, there is a
large possibility that the total stress analysis results will significantly differ from the actual seismic response.
Therefore, if the intention is to analyze the actual phenomena truely, it is necessary to carry out an effective
stress analysis.
One of the analysis programs for effective stress analysis is FLIP.43) Fig. A-4.1 shows the results of a
calculation 44) using FLIPver.3.3 to reproduce the vertical array records obtained at Port Island in Kobe Port
during the 1995 Hyogo-k.en Nambu Earthquake. Port Island records were obtained at the four depths: GL-83m,
GL-32m, GL-16m, and ground level. Here the NS component wave observed at GL-83m was used as the input
wave, and the waves at the other levels, GL-32m, GL-16m, and ground level, were calculated and compared with
the observed waves. The capability to reproduce the observed waves was very good. From this result, analysis
results for the 1993 Kushiro Oki Earthquake, 45) and others, it is judged that FLIP is an analysis program that
can give accurate results, provided the soil constants are appropriately set. However, in each individual case,
whether the FLIP results are correct or not depends on whether the soil constants have been properly set or not.
";;'
i
l
~:1 ~~
I
10
30
20
.._,
J_O~) il
40
_L ow.bed .....
----=-FUP
so
J_
-so
so
l'<llt~OL-16m(NS)
10
20
Tim(s)
PurtWedOW~) f
f ~:1 +
~
10
30
40
so
Time()
20
30
40
so
0
-SO
so
Time (1)
10
20
30
Time (1)
Fig. A-4.1 Reproduction of the Vertical Array Records at Port Island during the 1995
Hyogoken Nambu Earthquake using FLIP 44)
-256-
40
so
iu 1'
r
"""'
!
"""'
14 19.3 200
""
~
12 16.1 150
!40
~ 14 10.7 220
20
0.1
0.2
0.5
0.6 0.7
6 19.8 120
~ 14 18.5 220
60
12 20.6 310
Sand
-.:=
(a) Soil boring log
As shown in Fig. A-4.3, the finite element method is a method in which the ground is divided into a finite
number of elements, and the differential equations governing the system is converted into algebraic equations
in terms of the response of the system at the nodes and then solved. The finite element method is used not only
for grounds, but is used in a wide range of fields. The characteristic of this method is that it is capable of dealing
with the 2-dimentional and 3-dimentional changes in soil properties and layer thickness. FLUSH 39), FLIP 43),
and others use the finite element method as the numerical solution method. The calculations are conducted in
the domains of frequency and time.
Clay
Rock
Ii'
(b) Cross-section on left divided into elements
(2) Ground Modeling for Seismic Response Analysis of Local soil deposit
The following is an explanation ofthe modeling ofthe ground and method of determining the parameters necessary
for obtaining a solution for a seismic response analysis for the local soil deposit, focusing on I-dimension.
Q) Outline
To carry out a seismic response analysis for the local soil deposit, the ground at the objective point is modeled by
dividing it into several layers. For each layer, the layer thickness, density, and shear modulus under small strain
are necessary parameters regardless ofthe solution method. In addition, in the case of equivalent linear analysis,
the strain dependence of the shear modulus and the damping factor are necessary. The parameters necessary
for nonlinear analysis depend on the method of modeling the stress-strain relationship of the soil, but in the
case of FLIP, in addition to the above parameters, the modulus of volume, angle of shear resistance, the upper
limit value of hysteretic damping factor, and parameters to define liquefaction are necessary characteristics.
Of these, the parameters to define liquefaction characteristics are necessary only for carrying out an effective
stress analysis.
-257-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ Modeling procedure
The engineering bedrock is set taking the results of the soil investigation into account. At this time the S wave
velocity of the ground selected as the engineering bedrock must not differ significantly from the S wave velocity
of the ground selected as the engineering bedrock when setting the ground motion. The ground is divided into
layers corresponding to the changes in the soil properties. In this case, even ifthe soil classification is the same,
if S wave velocity, N value, or q. value differs significantly, they are considered to be separate layers. Each
ground is classified into either sandy soil, clay, or gravel. In an actual ground, it is rare for a soil to comprise
sand or clay only, and usually gravel, sand, silt, and clay are mixed in various proportions. Here soil with a fine,
particle size 75m or less, content of20% or less is considered to be sandy soil, and others are considered to be
cohesive soils. Rubble stones used in mounds and backfilling is considered to be gravel.
As fur soil density of each layer for which undisturbed sampling of a soil has been carried out, the density
of the soil is measured from the soil test sample, and this value is used. However, if the density has not been
measured, the values shown in Table A-4.1 may be used for convenience. The standard values shown in Table
A-4.1 are standard values for seismic response analysis, and it is necessary to be aware that they may not be used
fur other analyses in which density is a governing factor.
Table A-4.1 Standard Values of Soil Density>
Soil type
Cohesive soil
Sandy soil
Condition
Density (g/cm3)
1.5
1.7
1.8
2.0
2.0
The shear modulus under small soil strain, shear strain about 10-6, used in the response analysis can be
calculated from the S wave velocity obtained by in-situ investigation.
(A-4.2)
where
G0 : elastic shear modulus under small soil strain
p : density
V8 : S wave velocity
If the S wave velocity has not been obtained by in-situ investigation for a sandy soil, the shear modulus can
be estimated from the N value using the following equation.
G0
= 14100N68
(A-4.3)
(kN!m2)
However, this equation shows the average value obtained from number of actual data, so it is necessary to
be aware that there was a significant amount of variation 47). For details, refer to Chapter 3, 2.4.1 (6) Simple
Estimation of Shear Modnlns and Damping Factors.
If the unconfined compressive strength (q.J of cohesive soils has been obtained, the shear modulus may be
estimated from the following equation 48).
G0 =170q.
(A-4.4)
When the S wave velocity shall be estimated using the N value, if the N value prior to construction is only
available, such as for the grounds underneath a wall, the N value after construction shall be estimated, taking
into consideration the effect of the effective overburden pressure due to the wall or a mound. The following
equation may be used in the estimation.
-258-
(A-4.5)
Vs= Vso(
Uv',)B
Uvo
(A-4.6)
where
the caisson.
S wave velocity of caisson
: Vs=2000 mis
It is known that the shear modulus under small soil strain is proportional to the power of the effective
confining pressure. Equation (A-4.2) shows a relationship between the shear modulus and the S wave velocity,
so it may be inferred that the S wave velocity is proportional to the power of the effective confining pressure.
This relationship is obtained as follows from past element tests.48), 51)
(a) The shear modulus for a cohesive soil with plasticity index of Ip = 30 or higher is proportional to the effective
confining pressure to the power of I.
(b) The shear modulus for a sandy soil or a cohesive soil with plasticity index of Ip= 30 or less is proportional to the
effective confining pressure to the power of0.5.
On the other hand, Fig. A-4.4 shows a graph of the average S wave velocity for Toyoura standard sand
obtained by centrifugal model tests corresponding to the confining pressure at the middle of sand ground. The
solid line in the graph is the correlation curve Vs= K(uc '). The average value of the S wave velocity of a sand
ground increases as the centrifugal acceleration increases, which demonstrates the significant dependence on
the confining pressure. Fig. A-4.5 shows the distribution of the S wave velocity with depth determined for the
same test sample. The broken line in the graph is the curve ofthe case where the S wave velocity is proportional
to the confining pressure to the power of 0.25, and this curve was obtained using the S wave at the middle
in the sand ground as reference. In both cases the S wave velocity increases as the depth increases, and the
change with respect to depth is approximately proportional to the power of0.25. These results were obtained by
applying centrifugal acceleration varying from JOG to 50G to a 24cm thick layer of soil to artificially vary the
effective confining pressure.52)
-259-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
450
400
..."'ii
~
8 / 6'
,'8
o> /
li/
350
.s
/
/
"
.
"> 300
"[;
i<
I
I
"''
"
[;!
.Jl
~
250
v. ~100.6 (ot:)'"'
V,=167.3 (uc')0341
~"
200
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
-4
-8
Case I
500
1----1 . . . '~
J::J---r . :....
~p
-.-+--+-
Case2
-260-
(!) Outline
Methods for evaluating strong ground motions taking into consideration the source effects, the propagation path
effects, and the site amplification factors include theoretical methods and semi-empirical methods. The theoretical
methods model the medium from the source to the harbor as an elastic body, and evaluate the ground motions at
the harbor based on the theory of elastodynamics. Among the semi-empirical methods, the empirical Green's
function method is a method in which the measured ground motion from a medium or small earthquake, whose
mechanism and propagation path is common with a large earthquake, is considered to be a Green function, and
the ground motion for the large earthquake is synthesized by superposition.67). 68), 69) At this time, if a suitable
medium or small earthquake record is not available to be used, the stochastic Green's function method has been
proposed in which an artificial medium or small earthquake record is created, and then superposed, 70) and this
may be also classified as a semi-empirical method. In addition there are broad band hybrid methods in which the
long period components of the ground motions are calculated by theoretical methods, the short period components
are calculated using semi-empirical methods, and the two are superposed.71) In each of the above methods, it is
known that if theoretical methods are applied to areas with comparatively well-known subsurface structures to
periods longer than about 1 second, observed ground motions can be reproduced with good accuracy.72) However,
although information on the subsurface structure has been collected activity, 73) at present the areas for which the
subsurface structure is sufficiently well known to enable theoretical methods to be applied are very limited. On the
other hand, of the semi-empirical methods, in the empirical Green's function method, the effect of the subsurface
structure included in the records of medium and small earthquakes is directly reflected in the prediction results.
Also, in the probabilistic Green function method, which is likewise classified as a semi-empirical method, it is
possible to utilize the site amplification factors evaluated from spectral inversion 18) or similarly based on strong
motion records at the site.74) Based on the above, at harbors for which there are comparatively plentiful strong
motion records, it is desirable that semi-empirical methods are used in evaluating the design ground motion. In
areas where the subsurface structure is comparatively well known, it is possible to use theoretical methods or
broad band hybrid methods, but in this case the appropriateness of the subsurface structure model should be
verified in advance from the viewpoint of consistency with the strong motion records.
Determining whether the results of a strong motion evaluation are valid or not should, as a rule, be carried
out from the viewpoint of whether the calculation conditions and calculation procedure are in accordance with
the contents of this section. However, comparison of the calculation results with strong motion records obtained
under similar conditions is useful. For example, one can refer to strong motion records in the near source region
of the 1995 Hyogo-ken Nambu Earthquake or the 2004 Niigata-ken Chuetsu Earthquake. However, normally
the ground motions depend greatly on the source effects and the site effects, so because of these conditions it
is possible for the amplitude of the calculated ground motions to diffi:r greatly from the existing strong motion
records. Ifa calculated result whose amplitude differs greatly from the existing strong motion records is obtained,
it should be investigated whether it is possible to rationally explain the difference by the difference in the source
effects, such as differences in the size of the earthquake or the site effects, and if it is possible to rationally explain
the difference in this way, the results can be accepted. If a rational explanation is difficult, there should be a
check for errors in inputs etc. In this way, comparison with the existing strong motion records is useful from
the viewpoint of preventing simple errors. When carrying out a comparison with the existing strong motion
records, comparison of the maximum acceleration should be avoided. This is because normally the maximum
acceleration of a ground motion is easily affected by the high frequency component at 2Hz or higher. However,
the high frequency component at 2Hz or higher does not have much effect on harbor facilities, so even though
the maximum accelerations are compared, this does not verify the calculation results in the frequency range that
has a large effect on the harbor facilities. Normally the maximum velocity is a better index than the maximum
acceleration. Incidentally, the maximum velocity of the ground motions observed at the ground surface on
sediments in the near source region of the 1995 Hyogoken Nambu Earthquake and the 2004 Niigata-ken Chuetsu
Earthquake was about 100 to 150cm/s.
(2) Probabilistic Green Function Method
The probabilistic Green function method is a method in which first ground motions at the site are evaluated for a
small earthquake, which are then superposed to obtain the motions for a large earthquake. The specific procedure
is as follows.
-261-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
s(f) = ~FSPRTITN
Mo.
trf)2
4trpv,i 1+ (!
(A-5.1)
!f.J
1
r
P(f) = -exp(-trfr/QVs)
(A-5.2)
where
Moe
fc
p
Vs
RQ;
FS
PRTITN
r
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
When considering an earthquake occurring at an active fault, p =2.7glcm3 and V8 =3.5km/s may be assumed.
An average value in all directions of0.63 may be used for RQ; . When estimating the ground motion near the fault
of an earthquake occurring at an active fault within about lOkm from the fault, PRTJTN =0.85 for the component
normal to the strike direction, and 0.53 for the component parallel to the strike direction. These values are defined
taking into consideration that in the near source region of an earthquake occurring at an active fault, the Fourier
amplitude of the component normal to the strike direction is about 1.6 times 8) that of the component parallel to
the strike direction. When evaluating the ground motions far from an earthquake occurring at an active fault,
and when evaluating the ground motions due to other earthquakes, PRTITN = 0.71 may be used assuming that the
energy of the ground motion is equally distributed to the two horizontal components. In any case, it is necessary
to set PRTITN so that the sum of squares of the two horizontal components is 1. Table A-5.1 shows the standard
values of PRTITN.
Table A-5.1 Standard Values of PRTITN
Subduction-zone earthquake
0.71
0.71
0.71
0.71
0.71
-262-
1, = o.66 v. I
.rs;
(A-5.3)
where
S, : rupture area of the small earthquake
Equation (A-5.3) is "Brune's equation (36)" 76) as it is. By combining equation (A-5.3) and Esherby's equation
for a circular crack, >9) it is possible to derive the well-known equation that expresses the corner frequency as a
function of the seismic moment and the stress drop. In equation (A-5.2), an appropriate regional Q value should
be used.
The wave profile that satisfies the Fourier amplitudes at the seismic bedrock defined as above is obtained by
Boore's method 75) or by Nozu and Sugano's method, 44) and this is taken to be the stochastic Green's function at
the seismic bedrock.
Next, the ground motion from the small event, the stochastic Green's function, at the ground surface is
obtained. In this case the effect of the sediments on both the Fourier amplitude and phase of the ground motion,
namely the site effects, is taken into account. Specifically, it can be calculated by the following method.74) As
stated previously, normally the Fourier amplitude of the ground motion is given by the product of the source
effects, the propagation path effects, and the site effects, and the group delay time of the ground motion is given
by the sum of the source effects, the propagation path effects, and the site effects.I>
(see 1.1.1)
6
(f)
(see 1.1.2)
Now if an earthquake whose size and hypocentral distance are sufficiently small is observed at the site under
consideration, it is considered that expect for the shift along time axis, the group delay time in the record practically
expresses the third term on the right side of equation (1.1.2), in other words the site effects. Therefore, if the
Fourier transform of the stochastic Green's function previously obtained for the seismic bedrock is multiplied
by G(/), and the Fourier transform of the record satisfying the above conditions after adjusting its amplitude in
the frequency domain to I, then its inverse Fourier transform gives the stochastic Green's function at the ground
surface. Expressing this process in the form of a specific equation gives the following.
(A-5.4)
1s(/)I
where
A(f) : Fourier transform of the stochastic: C Green's function at the ground surface (complex
number)
Ab(/) : Fourier transform of the stochastic: C Green's function at seismic bedrock (complex number)
G(f) : site amplification factors between seismic bedrock and ground surface (real number)
Os<f): Fourier transform of medium or small earthquake record obtained at the site (complex
number)
It is desirable that the medium or small earthquake record for the site used at this time should have an incident
angle to the site as similar to that of the scenario earthquake under consideration as possible. This is because in
this way it is possible to more appropriately take into consideration the effect of the sediments on the riser phase
of the ground motions.
When evaluating the stochastic Green's function at the ground surface by this method, it is necessary that
the site amplification factors G(f) be evaluated in advance. For evaluating the site amplification factors, there are
two main approaches. One approach is to extract the S wave component from the ground motion by some kind of
method, and obtain its amplification factors.IS) The other approach is to include not just the S wave component but
also the surface waves component in the analysis, and to obtain the amplification factors of the Fourier spectrum
including later phases.23) Which approach is taken depends on the objectives, but when carrying out strong
motion prediction taking the contribution not only of the S waves but also the surface waves into account, the latter
approach is necessary. In particular, ifthe method described above is used, the contribution of the S wave and the
contribution of the surface waves are blended together in the group delay time of the medium or small earthquake
record obtained at the site, so it is necessary to consider the contribution of both to the amplitude also.
The ground surface for the ground motion from the asperity can be calculated by superposing the Green's
-263-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
function at the ground surface using the following equations, 81) see Fig. A-5.1. By carrying out this superposition,
the directivity effect in the direction of rupture propagation is taken into account.
N N
U(t) = LL(r/ru)f(t)u(t-tu)
(A-5.5)
i=l j=l
(N-l)n'[
(A-5.6)
k=l
(A-5.7)
where
U(t)
=ff ~/ru}r(t)*(Cu(l-lu))
(A-5.9)
i=lj=l
The parameters N and C associated with the superposition are defined so as to satisfy the following equation.
-264-
Moa/Moe =CN3
(A-5.10)
Sa/Se=N2
where
If the ground is significantly non-uniform in the horizontal direction within the area occupied by a structure, spatial
variation in the ground motion may be brought about as a result. Therefore, it is desirable that the non-unifurmity in
the horizontal direction of the ground conditions within the area occupied by the structure be evaluated, and if the
non-uniformity is significant, the spatial variation in the ground motion should be evaluated taking the effect of the
non-uniformity into account. For this, it is also desirable to take into consideration the effect of the non-uniformity
in the horizontal direction of the ground below the top of the firm ground. If the non-uniformity of the ground in
the horizontal direction is significant, the most effective specific method for evaluating the spatial variation of the
ground motion is the method of evaluating the ground motion at several points using the method stated in ANNEX
5, 1 Evaluation of Strong Gronnd Motion (2) and (3), based on the records of seismometers installed at several
points. Another method when the subsurface structure is sufficiently well-known is to carry out an evaluation using
an appropriate numerical analysis method such as the finite element method or the finite difference method. This is a
rather specialist discussion, but when applying the method described in ANNEX 5, 1 Evaluation of Strong Ground
Motion (2) , it is necessary to pay sufficient attention to ensure that the physical meaning of the phase differences
in the ground motions evaluated at the several points is not lost. The physical meaning of the phase differences in
the ground motions evaluated by the method described in ANNEX 5, 1 Evaluation of Strong Ground Motion (2)
can be lost if the stochastic Green's functions at the seismic bedrock of several points are separately evaluated, and
randomness is contained in the phases of the stochastic Green's functions.75) It is also possible if the origin of the
time axes of the medium and small earthquake records used in equation (A-5.4) have been shifted, for example, if the
trigger time is different at different ground points. Methods for dealing with the furmer include the method of taking
the same stochastic Green's functions at the seismic bedrock for two points that are not too far distant.
The above considerations can also be applied in cases where the non-uniformity of the ground conditions in the
horizontal direction is not significant, but a more convenient approach can be applied as described below.
If the non-uniformity in the horizontal direction of the ground conditions is not significant, the main cause of spatial
variation in the ground motion is the wave propagation effect in the horizontal direction. The strain e(m) in the ground
caused by the wave propagation effect is a function of the amplitude of the ground motion velocity v(m) and the
apparent wave propagation velocity c(m), where m is the angular frequency.
e(m)= v(m)/c(m)
(A-5.11)
-265-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
As can be seen from equation (A-5.11), (co) is a decreasing function of c(w), so the smaller the value of c(w), the
more disadvantageous it is for the structure. The seismic waves that cause a wave propagation effect include the
surface waves and S waves, but at an arbitrary co, the phase velocity of surface waves is lower than the phase velocity
of S waves. Also, among the surface waves, the phase velocity is lowest in the fundamental mode of the Love wave or
the fundamental mode of the Rayleigh wave. Therefore, taking into consideration the fundamental mode of the Love
wave or the fundamental mode of the Rayleigh wave is the most disadvantageous for the structure.
The phase velocity of the surface waves depends on the frequency. Ifit is assumed that c(w) does not depend on
w, either the effect ofthe high frequency component on the ground strain will be underestimated, or the effect of the
low frequency component will be underestimated. Therefore, it is important to evaluate the frequency dependence
of the phase velocity. It is desirable that the frequency dependence of the phase velocity be evaluated based on the
results of in-situ array measurements, on the microtremor or the earthquake motion, or based on the elastic wave
velocity structure above and below the top of the firm ground. As an example, Fig. A-5.2 shows the relationship
between the phase velocity of the Love wave and frequency at a certain location in Tokyo Bay. The solid line is the
theoretical phase velocity calculated from the S wave velocity structure model in Table A-5.2. The S wave velocity
structure model in Table A-5.2 includes the deep sediments down to the upper crust. If a model that excludes the deep
sediments is used in the calculation, the phase velocity on the long period side is underestimated. The mark in Fig.
A-5.2 are the phase velocities obtained from the array measurement results. At this point, the phase velocity of the
fundamental mode of Love wave is about 400m/s at a period of I second, and about 750m/s at a period of3 seconds.
Therefore, if a constant value of 400m/s is used as the phase velocity which does not vary with frequency, the effect
of the Love wave at a period of3 seconds will be overestimated. Conversely, if a constant value of750m/s is used, the
effect of the Love wave at a period of about 1 second will be underestimated.
:::: i:::::::::::::::::::i::::::::4-:::::i::::f.i::::i::i::f:f::::::::::...::::
IT ./]""".
. : !
2000 J2ndhigher:mode+++H+ ;
~>
.~
i i i iii
:Ftin#i~tal-mode
!.
. : : ! !! !!
!
=.,_..... .,..~ ......!....... j..... ~.... j....!.. j.. f.+ .................. ~
! ! ! ! ! !~vFwave !
0 ;...................;..........;.......;.....;... .;....;.+++:
4 5 6 7 8 910
Period (s)
Fig. A-5.2 Relationship between the Phase Velocity of the Love wave and Frequency at a Certain Location in Tokyo
Bay>
Table A-5.2 S wave Velocity Structure Model "'l
Thickness (m)
Density
(t/m3)
50
250
1.8
120
410
1.9
1580
800
1.9
1250
1200
2.1
3100
2600
2.6
3400
2.6
Normally the ground motions evaluated by the methods of 1.2 Level 1 Earthquake Ground Motions used
in Performance Verification of Facilities, and 1.3 Level 2 earthquake ground motions used in Performance
Verification or Facilities include several frequency components, and each frequency component can cause a
wave propagation effect. In this case, the spatial variation of a ground motion can be simply evaluated taking into
-266-
(2) Calculate the Fourier transform of a(t) from the following equation.
A(w) = A,,(w)exp[-i(k,x+k,y)]
(A-5.12)
k, = {w/c(w))cos8
(A-5.13)
k, = (w/c(w))sin8
(A-5.14)
where
A 0(w) : fourier transform of a0(t)
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
1)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
Sawada, S., et al.: Propagation path and site characteristics of phase spectrum of strong earthquake, The 10th Symposium of
Earthquake Engineering, pp.915-920,1998
Aki, K.: Scaling law of seismic spectrum, J. Geophys. Res., Vol.72,pp.1217-1231,1967
Aki, K.: Generation and propagation of G waves from the Niigata earthquake of Junel6, 1964. 2, Estimation of earthquake
moment, released energy, and stress-strain drop from G waves pectrum, Bulletin of the Earthquake Research Institute,
Vol.44,pp.23-88, 1966
Irikura, K: Strong motion caused Hanshin Earthquake Disaster, Annual Rept. of Disaster Prevention Center, Kyoto Univ.,
No.39A, pp.229-245, 1996
Kouketsu, K: California Disaster Earthquake and Southern Hyogo Earthquake, Science, Vol.66No.2,pp.93-97,1996
Takemura, M., T. Moroi and K. Yashiro: Characteristics of Strong motion from the viewpoint of damages due to shallow
earthquake since Meiji era, Earthquake 2, Vol50, pp.485-505,1998
Somerville, P.G., N.F. Smith, R.W. Graves and N.A. Abrahamson: Modification of empirical strong ground motion attenuation
relations to include the amplitude and duration effi:cts of rupture directivity, Seismological Research Letters 68,pp.199-222,
1997
NOZU, A., Snsumu !AI and Wilfred D. !WAN: A Study on Predominant Direction of Near-source Ground Motion and It's
Application, Technical Note of PHRI Vol. 40 No.I, pp.107-167, 2001
Nozu, A. and K. Ikeda: Layout plan of earthquake proof wharf considering the direction of tremor of earthquake ground
motion in epicentral area, Port and Harbour, Vol. 78, No. 9, pp. 48-51, 2001
Independent Administrative Corporation PAR!, Ministry of Transport: Handbook of directionality of earthquake motion for
port planoing, CD-ROM,2003
Kikuchi, M. and K. Yamanaka: Failure process of historical large earthquakes; Identification of asperity, Seismo, 5(7), pp.
6-7, Jul., 2001
Street, R., R. Herrmano and 0. Nuttli: Spectral characteristics ofthe Lg wave generated by central United States earthquakes,
Geophys, J.R. Astr, Soc., Vol.41, pp51-63, 1975
Kudo, K: Progress of earthquake engineering research in strong motion earthquakes, Earthquake 2, Vol. 46, pp.151-159,
1993,
Tsuchida, H. and S. Iai: Earthquake Engineering for construction engineers: Sankai-do Publishing, 1991
-267-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
15) Kinoshita, S.: Kyoshin Net(K-net), Seim. Res. Lett., Vol.69, pp.309-332,1998
16) Ao~ S., Ohara, K., Hor~S., Kasahara, K. and Okada, S.: New strong-motion observation network: KiK-net, EOS. Trans. Am.
Geophys. Union, Vol.329, 2000
17) Osaki, S.: new Edition Introduction to spectral analysis of earthquake motion, Kajima Publishing, 1994
18) Iwata, T., K. Irikura: An attempt to segregate characteristics of epicenter, propagation passage and the soils near the
observation point, Earthquake 2, VoL39,pp579-593,1986
19) Yamada, M., A. Nozu and T. Nagao: A study on the selection of base Rock site in the spectrum inversion, Proceeding of Joint
Confi:rence of Japan Geosciences Union, (CD-ROM), 2004
20) Aki, K. and P.B. Richards: Quantitative Seismology, Second Edition, University Science Books, 2002
21) NOZU, A., Y. SATO and Takabiro SUGANO: Characteristics of Ground Motions Observed at Haneda Airport (Second
Report)Site Amplification Factors, Rep!. of PHRI Vol.42 No.2,pp.251-283, 2003
22) NOZU, A. and T. NAGAO: Site amplification factors for strong-motion sites in Japan based on special inversion technique,
Technical Note of PHRI No .1112, 2005
23) M. Tai, K. Irikura and A. Kowada: Examination on evaluation methods for empirical site amplification characteristics,
Earthquake 2, Vol.50, pp.215-227,1997
24) Nagao, T., N. Morishita and A. Nozu: Study on effect of site characteristics in the evaluation ofKevel 1 earthquake motion,
Proceeding of Offshore Development, Vol. 22, 2006
25) Nagao, T. et al.: Study on reproduction of seismic coefficient of damage earthquake at Takamatsu Port, Proceeding of
Offshore Development, Vol. 22, 2006
26) Mori, S. and T. Tawara: Estimation of 3-dimensional structure of Matsuyama Plain by observation of micro tremor,
Proceedings of Structural Eng. Vol.47A, pp.529-538,2001
27) Adachi, M. et al.: Examination of S-wave velocity structure of Nagoya Port by observation of micro tremor, Proceedings of
the 27th Conference ofEarthquake Eng. Study, CD-ROM, 2003
28) Yamanaka, H., and N. Yamada: construction of 3-dimensional S wave velocity model of Kanto Plain by Array observation
of micro tremor, Geophysical Exploration, Vol. 55, No. 1, pp. 53-65, 2002
29) Sato, T., H. Kawase and N. Matushima: Diffi:rence between the ground characteristics determined by micro tremor and
S-wave, P-wave and coda and its theoretical interpretation, Earthquake 2, VoL51,pp.291-318,1998
30) Nagao, T., M. Yamada and A. Nozu: Study on Zoning methods ofcoastal areas considering deep ground structure, Proceedings
of Offshore Development, Vol.21, pp. 951-956, 2005
31) Nagao, T., M. Yamada and A. Nozu: Probabilistic seismic hazard analysis with focus on Fourier amplitude and group delay
time, Jour. JSCE No.801/l-73,pp.141-158, 2005
32) Utsu, T.: Earthquakes and damage earthquakes catalogue in the vicinity of Japan having magnitudes of 6.0 and higher: 18851980, Bull. Earth. Res. Inst. Univ. Tokyo, Vol.57, pp.401-463,1982
33) Active Fault Research Group Edition: (New Version)Active faults in Japan- distribntion Map and data Tokyo University
Press, 1991
34) Tanaka, K. T. Imaizumi Edition: Digital map of active fault, Tokyo University Press, 2002
35) Sato, R. (Edition): Handbook of parameters of Earthquake faults in Japan, Kajima Publishing, 1989
36) Yoshida, N. and S. Iai: Nonlinear site response and its evaluation and prediction, The Effects of Surfiu:e Geology on Seismic
Motion, Irikura, Kudo, Okada & Sasatani (eds), Balkema,1998
37) International Organization for Standardization: ISO 23469, Bases for design of structures-Seismic actions for designing
geotechnical works, 2005
38) Shnabel,P.B., J.Lysmer and H.B. Seed: SHAKE, A compnter program for earthquake response analysis of horizontally
layered sites, Report No.EERC 72-12, University of California at Berkeley, 1972
39) Lysmer,J., T. Udaka, C.F. Tsai and H.B. Seed: FLUSH, A computer program of approximate 3-D analysis of soil-structure
interaction problems, Report No. EERC75-30, University of California at Berkeley, 1975
40) Yoshida, N.: Applicability of Practical program SHAKE, Proceedings of Symposium on amplification of earthquake motion
in soft ground, Research Committee on amplification of earthquake in soft soul and the damage, Japanese Geotechnical
Society,
41) Sugito, M., H. Goda and T. Masuda: Frequency dependent equi-linearized technique for seismic response analysis ofmultilayered ground, Jour. JSCE Vol. 493ffi-27, pp.49-58, 1994,
42) Yoshida, N. and I. Suetomi: "DYNEQ" a program for the earthquake response analysis based on the equivalent linear
methods, Report of Technical Institnte, Sato Engineering, pp.61-70, 1996.
43) lai, S,, Y. Matsunaga and T. Kameoka: Strain space plasticity model for cyclic mobility, Soils and Foundations, Vol. 32, pp.115,1992
44) Nozu, A and H. Sugano: Simulation of Strong Ground Motions from Shallow Crustal and Subduction-Zone earthquake based
on site-specific amplification and phase characteristics, Technical Note of PAR! No.1120, 2006
45) lai, S., T. Morita, T. Kameoka, Y. Matsunaga and K. Abiko: Response of a dense sand deposit during 1993 Kushiro Oki
earthquake, Soils and Foundations, Vol.35, pp.115-132,1995
46) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDI1): Handbook of liquefaction of reclaimed land (Revised Edition), 197
47) Imai, T. and K, Tonouchi: Correlation ofN value with S wave velocity and Shear Modulus, Proc. 2nd ESOPT, 1982
48) Kouki ZEN, Hiroyuki YAMAZAKI, Yasnfumi UMEHARA: Experimental Study on Shear Modulus and Damping Ratio of
-268-
-269-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Proceedings of Structural Eng. Vol.48A,pp.577-586,2002
80) Kato, K.: Examinations of Epicenters, propagation path and amplification characteristics of ground of group earthquakes in
Northwest area of Kagoshima Prefecture in 1997, Proceedings of Structural Engineering, Architectural Institute of Japan,
Vol. 543, pp. 61-68, 2001
81) Irikura, K., T. Kagawa and T. Sekiguchi: Improvement of strong motion prediction method utilizing empirical Green's
function, Proceedings of Conference of Seismologic Society of Japan No.2, B25, 1997
82) Miyake, H., Iwata, T. and Irikura,K.: Source characterization for broadband round-motion simulation: kinematic
heterogenious source model and strong motion generation area, Bulletin of the Seismological Society of America,
Vol.93,pp.2531-2545,2003
83) Study Group of Theoretical Earthquake Motion Edition: Earthquake motion- synthesis and profile processing. Kajima
Publications, 1994
84) Nozn, A., M. Yasunaka, Y. Satou and T. Kanno: Characteristics of Ground Motions Observed at Haneda Airport(First
Report)Characteristics of Surface Waves, Technical Note of PARI, No.1022, 2002
-270-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 5 EARTH PRESSURE AND WATER PRESSURE
Article 14
1 Earth pressure shall be set appropriately based on the ground conditions in consideration of the structure
of the facilities concerned, imposed loads, the action of earthquake ground motions, and others.
2 Residual water pressure shall be set appropriately in consideration of the structure of the facilities
concerned, the surrounding ground conditions, tide levels, and others.
3 Dynamic water pressure shall be set appropriately in consideration of the structure of the facilities
concerned, the action of earthquake ground motions, and others.
[Technical Note]
1 Earth Pressure
1.1 General
The behavior of soil varies with physical conditions such as grain size, void ratio and water content, and with stress
history and boundary conditions, which also affect earth pressure. The earth pressure discussed in this chapter is the
pressure by ordinary soil. The earth pressure generated by improved soil and reinforced soil will require separate
consideration. The earth pressure during an earthquake for design mentioned herein, is based on the concept of the
seismic coefficient method and is different from the actual earth pressure generated during an earthquake caused
by dynamic interaction between structures, soil and water. However, this earth pressure can generally be used in
performance verifications as revealed by analyses of past damage due to earth pressures during earthquakes. The
hydrostatic pressure and dynamic water pressure acting on a structure should be calculated separately.
(3) Dynamic Water Pressure (Relating to Item 3 of the Public Notice Above)
In verifying the performance of facilities subject to the technical standard, proper consideration should be given,
as required, to the effect of dynamic water pressure.
(4) Other
In verifying the performance of facilities subject to the technical standard, buoyancy should be considered, as
required, in addition to these settings.
CD
(1.2.1)
(
) =-tan~+O+'!f-P
(
) +sect/J;+O+'!f-P
(
)
cot(;-P
-271-
(1.2.2)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where
2
cos (,-vr)
K =
m
cos2yrcos(8+vr)[1+
sin,+8sin,-P]
cos(8 + vr )cos(vr - P)
(1.2.3)
(
)
(
) ec(,-8-vr+P)
cott;,-P=taor/J,-8-vr+P+s
where
)('
cosvr-P sm,+P
(1.2.4)
_
pl -
cosyr+8 sin(ll.-8
cos (,+vr)
[
cos 2 yrcos(8+vr) I-
sin
, -8 sin , + P
]'
with
Pa;, Ppi: active and passive earth pressures, respectively, acting on the backface of the wall at the
bottom level of the i-th soil layer (kN/m2)
.p,: aogle of internal friction of the i-th soil layer (0 )
y 1 : unit weight of the i-th soil layer (kN/m3)
h1 : thickness of the i-th soil layer (m)
K0 ;, Kp;: coefficients of active and passive earth pressures, respectively, in the i-th soil layer
'I" aogle of batter ofbackface wall from vertical line (0 )
p: aogle of backfill ground surface from horizontal line (0 )
angle of friction between backfilling material and backface wall ()
I; 1 : aogle of failure surface of the i-th soil layer ()
m: uniformly distributed surcharge on the ground surface (kN/m2)
a:
(2) The earth pressure at permaoent situation is based on Coulomb's earth pressure theory.
(3) Earth pressure at rest as expressed by equation (1.2.5) may be used when there is little displacement because of
the wall being confined.
(1.2.5)
where
~
= P;-i + P; h-,
2
(1.2.6)
cosvr
Moreover, the horizontal and vertical components of the resultant force of earth pressure can be calculated
using equations (1.2.7) and (1.2.8).
P~ =P,cos(vr + 8)
(1.2.7)
-272-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 5 EARTH PRESSURE AND WATER PRESSURE
P,,,
= P, sin(\V+ o}
(1.2.8)
where
P 1h: horizontal component of the resultant force of earth pressure
{I) The earth pressure of cohesive soil acting on the backface wall of structure shall generally be calculated by
following equations:
CD
Pa
= Lr,h, + co-2c
(1.2.9)
P,
= Lr1h1 +co+2c
(1.2.10)
where
Pa : active earth pressure acting on the bottom level of the i-th soil layer (kN/m2)
Pp
: passive earth pressure acts on the bottom level of the i-th soil layer (kN/m2)
(1.2.11)
where
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(5) Cohesion of Soil
Cohesion ofsoil should be determined using an appropriate method, refer to Chapter 3, 2.3.3 Shear Characteristics.
For example, equation (1.2.12) should be used when using results of unconfined compression tests.
c=!b_
2
(1.2.12)
where
(!) Active Earth Pressure and the Angle of Failure Surface from the Horizontal Surface
P.;
(1.3.1)
(1.3.2)
where
cos (,-VF-8)
- cos8cos 2 \Vcos(li+VF+8 I+
sin
+Ii sin
p -8
]'
(2) Passive Earth Pressure and the Angle of Failure Surface from the Horizontal Surface
[~
@COS\V ]
(
) COS\V
cos VF-P
(1.3.3)
(
) =tan,-li-VF+P
(
)+sec,-li-VF+P
(
)
cot(,-p
COS\V+0-8 sin,.-O
(
). (
'
)
(1.3.4)
cos\V-P sm,+P-8
where
cos8cos \Vcos(li+VF-8) 1[
sin
-8 sin
-8
p) ]
The notations pai, Pp;' Kai, KP;' ( ;, m, ')';, h;, .,,,, p, t5 and f/J;, are the same as those defined in 1.2 Earth
Pressure at Permanent Situation, equation (1.2.1) to (1.2.4). Also, ()is defined as follows.
() : composite seismic angle(") shown as following (a) or (b):
(a) () =tan-lk
(b) () =tan-lk'
where
-274-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 5 EARTH PRESSURE AND WATER PRESSURE
(3) Apparent seismic coefficient shall be in accordance with 1.3.3 Apparent Seismic Coefficient.
(4) Earth pressure during an earthquake is based on the theories proposed by Mononobe
1)
and Okabe.2J
-275-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
700
5=15
1.0
5=15
60
0/
0.6
i
-<
v
+~ 0
.,.
.~
....--
-~
'
'
,.... = ~
'1=..
__..
10.0
40
0.1
""
"1'8
0.4
"1'
'\
I\
''
100
0
0.1
0.5
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
p:t .......
fi=40
.......
---
i.
-.t,.25
.......
r35
Oo
......
20
'
"""'3oo
I - ....... "-
.....
"" {2.0
\:J.. o~
25
r-. ~"""3$o
r- r-._
-~
N~,
5~15
'
""
I"I'<~.-...
:!oo ....... .......
30
- -- --
4.0
20
~
r--..~"~
I'-.. .......
~o
~
_'1?-
'
-~
6.0
....
/'.
5~15"
8.0
""
30
y-
k 0.3
0.2
0 .....
v v v v''~
v vv v
o"
50
~, v
'~o
"" {0.2
-<
-+~ 0
{0.4
....
....... ........
,J I
0.8
0-.....
=35
'
;==40
--
:::::: ~
...
"
\
15
'\
'
.......
5"
25"
0.1
0.2
0.4
0.3
0.1
0.5
60
0.2
k 0.3
0.4
0.5
5=15
500
3.0
'
5=15
;,,,,4-00
""
8
~
40
-- ,,
-r-
= 50
2.0
= O"
,,,,250
~
""-~ ll.O
=40
35
....
--
0.1
0.2
0.3
20
10
r-
r-
~o
,,,. !~o
-,..__
= kl"
'
.....,,
""'-
'\
30-
'=25
I
30
- --~""'
.....
-10
0.4
0.5
0.1
0.2
0.3
-276-
0.4
0.5
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 5 EARTH PRESSURE AND WATER PRESSURE
P"
(Ly;h,+w)sin('a +O)
cosOsin'a
cos'a sin'a
~y.h. +2w)
(" =tan-1 1- L,, ' ~
tanO
(1.3.5)
(1.3.6)
where
(3) The apparent seismic coefficient should be used to calculate the earth pressure of cohesive soil down to the sea
bottom during an earthquake. The apparent seismic coefficient may be set as zero when calculating the earth
pressure at the depth of 10 m from the sea bottom or deeper. However, if the earth pressure at the depth of 10 m
below the sea bottom becomes less than the earth pressure at the sea bottom, the latter should be applied.
(1) The earth pressure acting on the soil below the water level during an earthquake can be calculated according to the
procedures outlined in 1.3.1 Earth PreHure of Sandy Soil and 1.3.2 Earth Pressure of Cohesive Soil, by using
the apparent seismic coefficient which is generally determined by the following equation:
k'=~~~--'-~~~~~~-'-~~~-k
(1.3.7)
unit weight of soil layer above the residual water level (kN/m3)
thickness of the i-th soil layer above the residual water level (m)
unit weight in the air of saturated soil layer (kN/m3)
thickness of thej-th soil layer above the layer for which earth pressure is being calculated below
the residual water level (m)
(ll
: surcharge load per unit area of the ground surface (k:N/m2)
h : thickness of soil layer for which earth pressure is being calculated below the residual wat.er level (m)
k : seismic coefficient
-277-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) Presently, equation (1.3.7) 3) is generally used for calculating earth pressure during an earthquake, as it can be
applied to light-weight filling material and other new materials, and is believed to be the most rational method.
(3) On the asswnption that soil grain and water move in an integrated manner with respect to soil under the water
level during an earthquake, the force of the ground motion acting on the soil would be the product of the soil's
saturated weight multiplied by the seismic coefficient. Moreover, since the soil under the water level is endowed
with buoyancy, the vertical force acting on the soil is the soil's under-water weight. Therefore, the resultant force
on the soil under the water level during an earthquake would be different from that in the air. When calculating
earth pressure during an earthquake, the equation for determining earth pressure during an earthquake for soil in
the air can also be used with soil under water by applying apparent seismic coefficient deduced from the composite
seismic angle.
The vertical force acting on soil under water includes the weight of the soil layers above the layer for which
earth pressure is being calculated as well as the surcharge load. Hence apparent seismic coefficient is affected by
these factors.
First stratum
hi
First i stratum
Residual water level R. WL.
First stratum
Second stratum
hi
First j stratum
References
1)
2)
3)
-278-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 5 EARTH PRESSURE AND WATER PRESSURE
2 Water Pressure
2.1 Residual Water Pressure
(1) When mooring facilities etc. have watertight structures or when backfilling material and backfilling soil
(hereinafter referred to in this paragraph as "backfilling") have low permeability, there is a time delay in the water
level changes in the backfilling as opposed to the water level at the front and the difference of water level appears.
When carrying out performance verifications on mooring facilities etc., what needs to be checked is the conditions
that develop when the water level in the backfilling is higher than that at the front and when that difference is at
its greatest. Residual water pressure refers to the water pressure acting on the mooring facilities etc. under this
condition.
The magnitude of the residual water-level difference varies depending on the permeability of the walls and
surrounding materials making up the mooring facility etc. as well as the tidal range. The general values for
residual water-level difference by structural type are shown in sections relating to performance verification of the
respective facilities. Values other than these general values may be used when determining residual water-level
difference from surveys conducted on similar structures nearby or from permeability checks carried out on the
walls and surrounding ground.
(2) The residual water pressure caused by the time delay of water level changes between the sea level and the residual
water level can be calculated using the following equation:
CD
(2.1.1)
hw : water level difference between the water level in front and behind the facility (m)
(3) The residual water level is determined in consideration of factors such as permeability of backfill soil, and tidal
range. Normally the height hw will be 1/3 - 2/3 of the tidal range.
(4) After a facility is completed, the permeability of its walls and surrounding materials may diminish with time.
Therefore, when the anterior tidal range is sizeable, it would be preferable to take that into consideration in
determining residual watel'-level difference.
-279-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) When performance verifications can be performed without taking dynamic water pressure directly into
consideration due to structural characteristics;
@ When using verification methods that do not take dynamic water pressure directly into account. This would
require sufficient records of results.
More specifically, this would be in the following cases:
(a) Dynamic water pressure of pore water in the caisson filling
(b) Dynamic water pressure of pore water in backfilling materials and backfilling soil ofmooring quaywalls etc.
(c) Dynamic water pressure for the bottom slab reinforcement design of caisson
(3) The dynamic water pressure during an earthquake for structures in water and filcilities with interior spaces that
are partially or fully filled with water can be calculated using the following equation:
(2.2.1)
where
Pt1w,,
7 k
12 hpwgH
(2.2.2)
3
hdw =-H
5
Here, Pdw and hdw are the following values and kh, pw and Hare equal to the values of kh, Pw and Hin item
(3) above respectively.
resultant force of dynamic water pressure (kN/m)
hdw : depth ofthe acting point ofthe dynamic water pressure resultant force from the still water level
(m)
Pr1wk :
(4) The action of the dynamic water pressure both in the front and the back ofthe wall is directed towards the sea.
(5) In the case of structures using 1.3.3 Apparent Seismic Coefficient (equation (1.3.7)), the dynamic water pressure
acting on the front side ofthe wall should be directed seawards, and dynamic water pressure on the rear side of the
wall needs not be considered.
(6) Where the wall is inclined, the dynamic water pressure acting on that surfilce is smaller than that acting on a vertical
wall. This is because, the direction ofmotion ofthe water particles are diverted diagonally upwards along the inclined
surfilce. Dynamic water pressure in this case can be calculated using the method proposed by Zanger 2) et al.
-280-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 5 EARTH PRESSURE AND WATER PRESSURE
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
Westergaaard, H.M.: Water Pressures on Dams during Earthquakes, Journal of ASCE. Transactions, No,1835, pp.418472,1933
Zanger, C.N.: Hydrodynamic Pressure on Dams due to Horizontal Earthquake, Proc. Exper. Stress Analysis, Vol.10,
No.2,1953
Iai, S., Matsunaga,Y. and Kameoka, T.: Strain space plasticity model for cyclic mobility, Soils and Foundation, Japanese
Society of Soil Mechanics and Foundation Engineering, Vol.32, No.2, PP.1-15, 1992
Zienkiewicz, O.C.: Matrix Finite Element Metbod, Third Edition, Bai-fu Kan Publishing, 1984
-281-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Public Notice
Ground Liquefaction
Article 17
The possibility and extent of ground liquefaction shall be assessed with appropriate methods based on the
ground conditions and by taking account of the actions from earthquake ground motions.
[Commentary]
(1) Effects of Liquefaction in the Case of Level 1 Earthquake Ground Motions
As for the consideration of liquefaction in the case of level 2 earthquake ground motions, measures
against liquefaction are taken to protect the ground concerned when liquefaction is predicted and judged
to occur, taking account of the effects ofliquefaction on structures and the surrounding situations of the
facilities concerned.
(2) Effects of Liquefaction in the Case of Level 2 Earthquake Ground Motions
As for the consideration of liquefaction in the case of Level 2 earthquake ground motions, the methods
of taking measures against liquefaction and the necessity of their implementation are determined based
on a comprehensive evaluation of the situations of the facilities concerned.
[Technical Nole]
1 General
The subjects described in this Chapter may refer to Handbook of Liquefaction Measures for Reclaimed Land
(Revised Edition).'>
The following methods are for the study of grouod liquefaction in the case of Level I earthquake grouod motions.
As for the consideration of liquefaction in the case of Level 2 earthquake ground motions, the methods of taking
measures against ground liquefaction and the necessity of their implementation shall be determined based on a
comprehensive evaluation of the situations of the facilities concerned. Refer to Chapter 4 Earthquakes of this Part
II and the description on the performance verification of facilities in Part 3 for the evaluation.
CD
-282-
of liquefaction
0.01
Clay
0.1
Silt
0.005
1.0
10
Sand
Gravel
0.075
2.0
;;;
3.5)
Possibility of
liquefuction
0.01
Clay
0.1
Silt
0.005
1.0
10
Gravel
Sand
0.075
2.0
When the grain size distribution curve spans the "possibility of liquefaction" range, a suitable approach is
required to examine the possibility of liquefaction. For soil with a large portion of fine grain size distribution, a
cyclic triaxial test should be carried out. For soil with a large gravel portion, the soil is determined not to liquefy
when the coefficient of permeability is 3 cm/s or greater. When there are subsoils with poor permeability such
as clay or silt on top of the target subsoil in this case, however, it should be treated as soil that falls within the
range of''possibility ofliquefaction".
A permeability test for the soil with the permeability of larger than 3cm/s shall be a special method.'l A
method of indirect estimation of permeability is available when the permeability measurement is difficult.
However, care about the soil characteristics, such as content of fine particles shall be paid to apply the indirect
estimation method.
-283-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(N).,
N-0.019(uv'-65)
0.004l(uv'-65) + 1.0
(2.1)
where
(N)65
: equivalent N-value
: N-value of the subsoil
u,' : effective overburden pressure of the subsoil (kN/m2)
(The effective overburden pressure used here should be calculated with respect to the ground
elevation at the time of the standard penetration test.)
Fig. 2.2 shows the relationship given by equation (2.1). When using equation (2.3) described below, the N
values themselves of the soil layer are assumed to be equivalent N values.
0
ii'
~
so
100
ISO
~ 200
fl1:;
2SO
-~
!!l"
300
"
10
20
30
40
N-value
so
60
70
Fig. 2.2 Calculation Chart for Equivalent N-value, the Straight Lines show the Relationship between N-values and
Effective Overburden Pressures when Relative Densities are Constant
a_ =0.7 r_
-
u'
v
(2.2)
where
(c) Predictions and judgment using the equivalent N-value and equivalent acceleration
The subject soil layer should be classified according to the ranges labeled I - IV in Fig. 2.3, using the equivalent
N-value and the equivalent acceleration of the soil layer.
-284-
30~-~-~-~--~-~-~
(333.25)
25>---+---+----+-T-+---+-----<
20>---+---+--,_,_ _+-'m~-+-----<
>
~"
.>
g. IOr,,.-lf.:-::h,.L--t--t--t----1
"'
(66,7)
(450,16)
100
200
300
400
soo
600
@ Prediction, judgment and correction ofN-values when the fraction of fines content is relatively large.
(a) When the fines content, grain size of 75 m or less, is 5% or greater, the equivalent N-value should be
corrected before applying Fig. 2.3, then the subject soil should be evaluated to which range ofl to IV in Fig.
2.3 it falls. Corrections of the equivalent N-value are divided into the following three cases.
(b) Case 1: when the plasticity index is less than 10 or cannot be determined, or when the fines content is less
than 15%;
The equivalent N-value, after correction, should be set as (N)6sfCJ<. The correction factor CJ< is given in
Fig. 2.4. The equivalent N-value, after correction, and the equivalent acceleration are used to determine the
range in Fig. 2.4.
10
Fines content Fe(%)
(c) Case 2: when the plasticity index is greater than 10 but less than 20, and the fines content is 15% or higher;
The equivalent N-value, after correction, should be set as both (N)6,I0.5 and N + ~N. and the range should be
determined according to the following situations, where the value for ~N is given by the following equation:
AN=S+0.4(!,-10)
1)
2)
3)
4)
(2.3)
when N +AN falls within the range I, use range I.
when N + AN falls within the range II, use range II.
when N +AN falls within the range III or IV and (N)6,I0.5 is within range I, II or III, use range III.
when N + AN falls within range III or IV and (N) 6,I0.5 is within range IV, use range IV.
(d) Case 3: when the plasticity index is 20 or greater, and the fines content is 15% or higher;
The equivalent N-value, after correction, should be set as N + AN. The range should be determined according
to the equivalent N-value, after correction, and the equivalent acceleration.
(e) Fig. 2.5 shows the relationship between fines content and plasticity index which is described above (b), (c) and
(d).
-285-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
No corrections
Fig. 2.5 N-Value Correction Methods by Fine Contents and Plasticity Index
Range shown in
Fig.2.3
Prediction of liquefaction
Possibility of liquefaction
occurrence is very high
II
Possibility of liquefaction
occurrence is high
Judgment of liquefaction
III
(4) Prediction and Judgment Based on the Results of Cyclic Triaxial Tests
(j) When it may be difficult to predict and judge the possibility of subsoil liquefaction of the subject ground from
the results of grain size and N-values, the prediction and the judgment for subsoil liquefaction should be made
with the results of a seismic response analysis and cyclic triaxial tests conducted on undisturbed soil samples.
@ The proper consideration of the stress state in the ground and the irregularity of the actions caused by ground
motions is important for the results of the seismic response analyses of the ground and those of cyclic triaxial
tests to show actual phenomena in the ground.
-286-
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
Coastal Developmeot Institute of Technology (CDIT): Handbook ofliquefaction of reclaimed laod (Revised Edition), 1997
Yamazaki, H., K. Zen and F. Koike Study of the Liquefaction Prediction Based on the Grain Distribution and the SPT
N-value, Technical Note of PHRI, No.914,1998
The Japan Geotechnical Society: Soil Testing Methods and Commeotary, pp.271-288,2000
Japan Geotechnical Society: Geotechnical Engineering Handbook, pp.16-20,1999
-287-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 15
Influence of ground subsidence shall be assessed with appropriated methods based on the ground conditions
in consideration of the structures of the facilities, imposed load, and the surrounding situations of the
facilities concerned.
[Technical Nole]
1.1.1 Ground Subsidence
Ground subsidence includes immediate settlement, consolidation settlement, uneven settlement, lateral
displacement etc. The effects of ground subsidence shall be evaluated based on ground conditions using
proper methods and properly taking account of the structures of the facilities concerned, surcharges, and
the actions caused by ground motions. The evaluation of ground subsidence may refer to Chapter 3
Geotechnical Conditions of Part II and 2.5 Settlement of Foundation in Chapter 2 of Part III.
-288-
Chapter 8 Ships
Public Notice
Dimensions of Design Ships and Related Matters
Article 18
1 The dimensions of design ships (hereinafter refers to the ships used as the input data in the performance
verification of the facilities subject to the Technical Standards) shall be set according to the methods
provided in the subsequent items:
(1) In the case where design ships are identifiable, their dimensions shall be used.
(2) In the case where design ships are unidentifiable, the dimensions shall be properly set based on the
statistical analyses of the dimensions of ships in operation.
2 The actions from ship berthing, ship movements, and the traction by ships shall be set according to the
methods provided in the subsequent items corresponding to a single action or the combinations of two or
more actions to be considered in the performance criteria and the performance verification of the facilities
concerned:
(1) The actions from ship berthing shall be set with appropriate methods by taking account ofthe dimensions
of design ships, the structures of the facilities concerned, berthing methods, berthing velocities, and/or
others.
(2) The actions from ship movements shall be set with appropriate methods by taking account of the
dimensions of design ships, the structures of the facilities concerned, mooring methods, characteristics
of mooring system, and the winds, waves, water currents, and/or others acting on design ships.
(3) The actions from the traction by ships shall be set with appropriate methods by taking account of the
dimensions of design ships, mooring methods, and the winds, waves, water currents, and/or others
acting on design ships.
[Commentary]
(I) Principal Dimensions of Design Ships
Design ships are those, among the ships using the facilities concerned, which are assumed to have the
most significant effects on the performance verification of the facilities. It should be noted that design
ships vary depending on performance criteria to be applied even for the same facilities and that they
are not always the ships with the largest gross tonnage.
(2) Actions due to Ship Berthing and the Traction by Ships
-289-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) In the case where design ships are unidentifiable in advance such case as the public port facilities, the
standardized values of tonnages, lengths overall, lengths between perpendiculars, molded breadths, and full
load drafts by ship type shown in Table 1.1 may be used for the designs. The standard values in Table 1.1 are
prepared based on the statistical analysis of the dimensions of the existing ships with a coverage ratio of 75%
for each tonnage category. The data on the dimensions of small cargo vessels used for the standard values vary
widely, hence the dimensions of small cargo vessels should be set using the values in Table 1.2 as references
and taking into consideration the trends of ships in ports. The gross tonnage, GT, given in Table 1.1 basically
means international gross tonnage, but in some cases it refers to domestic gross tonnage depending on the
characteristics of the data used for setting the standard values. Such cases, where the gross tonnage, means the
domestic gross tonnage, are clearly indicated in Table 1.1. The table uses the commonly used tonnage, gross
tonnage or dead weight tonnage, of each ship type as the representative index. Fig. 1.1 shows the principal
dimensions used in the tables.
Length overall (L.)
W.L
,,
\
'l'="-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~-/iporwardperpendicular
After perpendicular
I'
I
I
W.L
I
I
---<
I
I
I
I
I
I
'-
,,
~
~
~
Dead Weight
Tonnage
DWT
(t)
Length overall
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
1,000
2,000
3,000
5,000
10,000
12,000
18,000
30,000
40,000
55,000
70,000
90,000
120,000
150,000
67
82
92
107
132
139
156
182
198
217
233
251
274
292
61
75
85
99
123
130
147
171
187
206
222
239
261
279
-290-
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
10.7
13.1
14.7
17
20.7
21.8
24.4
28.3
30.7
32.3
32.3
38.7
42
44.7
3.8
4.8
5.5
6.4
8.1
8.6
9.8
10.5
11.5
12.8
13.8
15
16.5
17.7
Dead Weight
Tonnage
Length between
Length overall
Molded breadth
perpendiculars
Reference:
Container
carrying
capacity
DWT
(t)
Loa
(m)
Lpp
(m)
B
(m)
d
(m)
(TEU)
10,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
100,000
139
177
203
241
274
294
350
129
165
191
226
258
279
335
22.0
27.1
30.6
32.3
32.3
35.9
42.8
7.9
9.9
11.2
12.1
12.7
13.4
14.7
500-890
1,300 - 1,600
2,000 - 2,400
2,800 - 3,200
3,500 -3,900
4,300 - 4, 700
7,300-7,700
3 Tankers
Dead Weight
Tonnage
DWT
(t)
1,000
2,000
3,000
5,000
10,000
15,000
20,000
30,000
50,000
70,000
90,000
100,000
150,000
300,000
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
63
77
86
100
139
154
166
184
209
228
243
250
277
334
57
72
82
97
131
146
157
175
199
217
232
238
265
321
Length overall
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
11.0
13.2
14.7
16.7
20.6
23.4
25.6
29.1
34.3
38.1
41.3
42.7
48.6
59.4
4.0
4.9
5.5
6.4
7.6
8.6
9.3
10.4
12.0
12.9
14.2
14.8
17.2
22.4
Gross Tonnage
Length overall
GT
(t)
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
3,000
5,000
10,000
20,000
40,000
60,000
120
110
140
130
172
162
189
174
194
174
208
189
(3,000, 5,000, and 10,000 GT are in Japanese gross tonnage)
-291-
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
18.9
21.4
25.3
28.0
32.3
32.3
5.8
6.5
7.7
8.7
9.7
9.7
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
5 Pure Car Carrier (PCC) ships
Gross Tonnage
Length overall
GT
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
112
130
135
158
179
185
203
103
119
123
150
175
175
194
(t)
3,000
5,000
12,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
60,000
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
18.2
20.6
21.8
24.4
26.7
31.9
32.3
5.5
6.2
6.8
7.9
8.8
9.3
10.4
Gross Tonnage
Length overall
GT
(t)
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
3,000
5,000
10,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
98
116
144
179
204
223
240
92
109
136
170
193
212
228
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
16.1
18.6
22.7
27.7
31.1
33.8
36.0
6.3
7.3
8.9
10.8
12.1
13.1
14.0
Gross Tonnage
Length overall
GT
(t)
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
20,000
30,000
50,000
80,000
100,000
174
199
235
274
294
164
188
223
260
281
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
27.8
31.4
36.7
42.4
45.4
8.4
9.2
10.4
11.5
12.1
8 Passenger ships
Gross Tonnage
Length overall
GT
(t)
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
3,000
5,000
10,000
20,000
30,000
50,000
70,000
100,000
97
115
146
186
214
255
286
324
88
104
131
165
189
224
250
281
-292-
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
16.5
18.6
21.8
25.7
28.2
32.3
32.3
32.3
4.3
5.0
6.4
7.8
7.8
7.8
8.1
8.1
(t)
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
400
700
1,000
3,000
7,000
10,000
13,000
56
70
80
124
141
166
194
47
60
71
116
130
155
179
Gross Tonnage
Length overall
GT
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
11.6
13.2
14.4
18.6
22.7
24.6
26.2
2.8
3.2
3.5
4.6
5.7
6.2
6.7
Gross Tonnage
Length overall
GT
(t)
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
6,000
10,000
15,000
20,000
147
172
197
197
135
159
183
183
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
22
25.1
28.2
28.2
6.3
6.3
6.9
6.9
Dead Weight
Tonnage
DWT
(t)
Loa
(m)
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
53
58
47
53
Length overall
500
700
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
9.4
9.5
3.3
3.3
(3) The table for the standard values of the principal dimensions of design ships shows the principal dimensions of
ships for stepwise tonnage categories. These dimensions are obtained from statistical analyses by Takahashi et
al)), 2) with overall coverage ratio of 75%. Some ships therefore have larger dimensions than those of the same
tonnage category ships given in the table, and some other ships with the tonnage category larger than that set for
design ships have dimensions smaller than those given in the table.
(4) The data of"LMIU Shipping Data (2004.1)" 3) and "Japanese Register of Ships (2004)" 4) are used for determining
the principal dimensions of design ships.
(5) Tonnage s)
The definitions of the various types of tonnage are as follows:
CD
Gross Tonnage
The measurement tonnage of sealed compartments of a ship, as stipulated in the "Law Concerning the
Measurement of the Tonnage of Ships".
@ Displacement Tonnage
The amount of water, expressed in tons, displaced by a ship when it is :floating at rest.
(6) The regression equations for gross tonnages, GT, and displacement tonnages, DSP, are shown in Tables 1.3 and
1.4, I), 2), 6) respectively. They are applicable on the condition that the coefficients of determination W and the
standard deviations a around the regression equations are taken into consideration. The regression equations
-293-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
fur each ship type in the tables are applicable within the range of the tonnages shown in Table 1.1.
(7) The container ships of under-panamax, panamax, and over-panamax types have characteristic dimensions
peculiar to each type, and hence the setting of their dimensions may refer to Tables 1.5 to 1.9. The setting of
the dimensions of very large crude oil carrier may refer to Table 1.10.
(8) The heights ofthe ships diffi:r considerably even in case ofthe same type and the same tonnage. The perfurmance
verification of bridges and other structures crossing waterways should therefore take account of the heights of
design ships from the sea surface to the highest points. The heights of ships can refer to the findings of the study
by Takahashi et aJ.7). l.
Table 1.3 Regression Equations for Dead Weight Tonnages (DWT) and Gross Tonnages (GT)
Regression
equation
Coefficient of
determination R2
GT= 0.529DWT
0.988
2,202
Container ship
GT= 0.882DWT
0.971
3,735
Tanker
GT= 0.535DWT
0.992
4,276
International
Gross tonnage
GT= l.780DWT
0.752
7,262
Domestic Gross
tonnage
GT= l.409DWT
0.825
1,528
International
Gross tonnage
GT= 2.721DWT
0.826
7,655
Domestic Gross
tonnage
GT= l.241DWT
0.781
676
LPG carrier
GT= 0.845DWT
0.988
1,513
LNG carrier
GT= l.370DWT
0.819
12,439
Passenger ship
GT= 8.939DWT
0.862
12,285
GT= 2.146DWT
0.833
1,251
GT= 2.352DWT
0.816
1,988
Ship type
1).
>
Standard
deviation a (t)
ROROship
Table 1.4 Regression Equations for Dead Weight Tonnages (DWT) or Gross Tonnages (GT) and Displacement
Tonnages (DSP) >
Ship type
Regression equation
Standard deviation
DSP = l.139DWT
0.052DWT
Container ship
DSP = l.344DWT
0.060DWT
Tanker
DSP = l.138DWT
0.145DWT
DSP = 0.880GT
0.211 GT
DSP = 0.652GT
0.147 GT
LPG carrier
0.425 GT
LNG carrier
0.154 GT
Passenger ship
DSP = 0.522GT
0.076 GT
DSP = l.052GT
0.337 GT
DSP = 1.150GT
0.135 GT
-294-
Length between
Length overall perpendiculars Molded breadth
Lpp
B
(m)
(m)
Loo
(m)
Dead Weight
Tonnage
DWT
(t)
5,000
10,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
109
139
177
203
225
101
129
165
191
211
17.9
22.0
27.0
30.4
30.6
Reference:
Container
canying
capacity
d
(m)
(TEU)
6.3
7.9
10.0
11.4
12.5
300-500
630-850
1,300 - 1,500
2,000 - 2,200
2,600 - 2,900
Dead Weight
Tonnage
1). 2i
1). 2)
Length between
Length overall perpendiculars Molded breadth Full load draft
DWT
(t)
Loa
LPP
(m)
(m)
(m)
(m)
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
201
237
270
300
187
223
255
285
32.3
32.3
32.3
32.3
11.3
12.0
12.7
13.4
Reference:
Container
carrying
capacity
(TEU)
2,100 2,800 3,400 4,000 -
2,400
3,200
3,900
4,600
Dead Weight
Tonnage
Molded
breadth
Reference:
Container
canying
capacity
DWT
(t)
Loa
(m)
Lpp
(m)
(m)
(m)
(TEU)
60,000
70,000
80,000-100,000
275 I 285
276 I 280
300 I 304
260 I 268
263 I 266
285 I 292
37.2 I 40.0
40.0 I 40.0
40.0 I 42.8
12.7 I 13.8
14.0/ 14.0
13.5 I 14.5
4,300 - 5,400
5,300 - 5,600
6,300 - 6, 700
This table does not show the results of statistical analyses, but shows the l/4th and 3/4th values in ascending order.
Dead Weight
Tonnage
Length between
Length overall perpendiculars Molded breadth
DWT
(t)
Loo
(m)
Lpp
(m)
100,870
101,570
101,612
104,696
104,700
104,750
107,500
109,000
110,000
115,700
156,907
324.0
334.1
334.0
346.0
346.0
346.0
332.0
352.0
336.7
366.9
397.6
324.0
319.0
319.0
331.5
331.5
331.5
Tius table
1S
336.4
321
351.1
376.0
Reference:
Container
canying
capacity
(m)
d
(m)
(TEU)
42.0
42.8
42.8
42.8
42.8
42.8
43.2
42.8
42.8
42.8
56.0
13.0
14.5
14.5
14.5
14.5
14.5
14.5
14.5
15.0
15.0
16.5
8,000
8,204
8,100
6,600
6,600
7,226
8,400
10,150
9,200
7,929
11,000
prepared based on "LMIU Shipping Data (2006.8)." As of August 2006, 100 container ships have a
tonnage of over 100,000 DWT. In this table, each DWT category represents a case where there are three or more
ships with the same DWT category, and shows the principal dimensions of the ship with the largest container carrying
-295-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 1.9 Principal Dimensions of the Container Ships with a Container Carrying Capacity of Over 8,000 TEU
Container
carrying
capacity
(TEU)
8,000
8,030
8,063
8,100
8,152
8,154
8,189
8,200
8,204
8,238
8,400
9,200
9,415
9,600
10,150
11,000
Length overall
Length between
Molded breadth
perpendiculars
Loa
(m)
324.0
324.8
323.0
335.5
335.0
275.0
334.0
334.1
334.0
335.0
332.4
350.6
349.0
337.0
352.0
397.6
d
(m)
B
(m)
42.0
42.0
42.8
42.8
42.8
37.1
Lpp
(m)
324.0
-
308.0
263.0
13.0
14.5
14.5
14.6
13.5
12.5
14.5
14.5
14.5
11.5
14.5
14.5
14.5
314.7
319.0
319.0
317.2
336.8
353.3
42.8
42.8
42.8
336.4
376.0
42.8
56.0
14.5
16.5
Reference:
Selfweigbt
Tonnage
DWT
(t)
100,870
104,904
99,615
103,800
97,612
68,363
101,906
101,818
110,000
97,430
108,180
112,062
117,800
115,000
109,000
156,907
This table is prepared based on "LMIU Shipping Data (2006.8)." As of August 2006, 90 container ships have a capacity
of over 8,000 TEU. In this table, ea.ch TEU category represents a case where three or more ships with the same TEU
capacity exist. The principal dimensions ofthe ship with the largest DWT among them are indicated in the table except
the largest ship of 11,000 TEU ship.
Length overall
DWT
(t)
Loa
(m)
423,000
441,893
441,823
442,470
380
380
380
380
Length between
perpendiculars
Lpp
(m)
366
366
-
Molded breadth
B
(m)
d
(m)
68.0
68.0
68.0
68.0
24.5
24.5
24.5
24.5
References
1)
Takahashi, H., Goto, F. and Abe, M.: Study on ship dimensions by statistical analysis- standard of main dimensions of design
(Draft)- National Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management No.28, 2006
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
-296-
CD
The actions caused by ship berthing are generally calculated from the berthing energy of ships. The berthing
energy ofa ship can be calculated from the following equation by using the mass ofthe ship, the berthing velocity
of the ship, the eccentricity factor, the virtual mass factor, the flexibility factor, and the berth configuration
factor. The subscript k in the equation refers to the characteristics value.
(2.2.1)
-297-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where
E1 : berthing energy of ship (kNm)
Ms : mass of ship (t)
There are methods of estimating the berthing energy of ships such as statistical methods, methods using
hydraulic model tests, and methods using fluid dynamics models in addition to kinetic energy of method.1>
However, regarding these alternative methods, the data necessary for design are insufficient and the values
of the various factors used in the calculations may not appropriately properly given. Thus, the kinetic energy
method is generally used.
@ If it is assumed that a berthing ship moves only in the abeam direction, then the kinetic energy Es (kNm)
becomes equal to M,~2 /2. However, when a ship is berthing at a dolphin, a quaywall or a berthing beam
equipped with fender systems, the energy absorbed by the fender systems, i.e., the berthing energy Ej0fthe ship,
will become E./ considering the various relevant factors, where/= C111 Ce C1 Cc
(2) Mass of Ship
The mass of ship in the calculation equation of the berthing energy of ships means the full load displacement of
the ship. Equation (2.2.2) may also be used to show the relations between the characteristic values of the full
load displacements (DT) and dead weight tonnages (DWT) or gross tonnages (GT) of ships. They were calculated
as the regression equations covering 75% of the total statistical data of full load displacements (UI') with respect
to dead weight tonnages (DWT) or gross tonnages (GT), using the regression equations and standard deviations
shown in Table 1.4 Regression Equations for Dead Weight Tonnages (DWT) or Gross Tonnages (GT) and
Displacement Tonnages (DSP) in 1. Principal Dimensions of Design Ships. These relations are applicable
within the range oftonnage shown in Table 1.1. The subscript kin the equations refers to the characteristic values.
General cargo ships
Container ships
Tankers
Roll-on roll-off (RORO) ships
Pure car carriers (PCC)
LPG carriers
LNG carriers
Passenger ships
Short-to-medium distance ferries (navigation distance ofless than 300 km)
Long distance ferries (navigation distance of300 km or more)
DT,1:=1.l14DWT
DT,1:=1.385DWT
DT,1:=1.235DWT
DT,1:=1.022GT
DT,1:=0.151GT
DT,1:=1.400GT
DT,1:=1.ll8GT
DT,1: =0.573GT
DT,1: =1.279GT
DT,1: =1.240GT
(2.2.2)
where
CD
It is preferable to determine the characteristic values of the berthing velocities of ships based on actual
measurements or references on the previous measurements of berthing velocities, taking account ofthe types of
design ships, loaded conditions, the locations and structures of mooring facilities, meteorological phenomena
and oceanographic phenomena, the usage of tugboat assistance and their sizes etc.
When large general cargo ships or large oil tankers berth, they come to a standstill temporarily, lined up parallel
to the quaywall at a certain distance away from it. They are then gently pushed by several tugboats until they
come into contact with the quaywall. When there is a strong wind toward the quaywall, such ships may berth
being pulled outwards against wind by the tugboats. When such a berthing method is adopted, it is common to
use the berthing velocity of 10 to 15 cm/s based on the past design examples.
@ Special ships such as ferries and roll-on roll-off ships and small cargo ships often use berthing methods different
from large ships, as such that they berth by themselves without using tugboats or they shift parallel to the face
lines of quaywalls if they are equipped with bow or stern lamps. The berthing velocities hence shall be carefully
determined based on actual measurements taking account of their berthing methods.
-298-
@ Fig. 2.2.1 shows the relationship between the ship maneuvering conditions and berthing velocity by ship size.
2) It has been prepared based on the empirical data collected. This figure shows that the berthing velocity must
be set high in such case that the mooring facilities are not sheltered by breakwaters and are being used by small
ships.
Difficolt berthiog
exposed
-.~j"'
Good berthiog
exposed
!J .~
exposed
:a"" B~
Difficult berthiog
sheltered
!;
Ei
Easy berthiog
s .ll
...~ -"'1;j
0
Good berthiog
sheltered
c"'
].~
~~
20
40
60
80
@ According to the study reports 3), 4) on berthing velocity, the berthing velocity is usually less than 10 cm/s
fur general cargo ships, but only in a few cases are over 10 emfs (see Fig. 2.2.2). The berthing velocity only
occasionally exceeds 10 cm/s for large oil tankers that use offshore berths (see Fig. 2.2.3). Even for ferries
which berth under their own power, the berthing velocity in many cases is less than 10 cm/s. Nevertheless, since
there are a few cases in which the berthing velocity is over 15 emfs, due care must be taken when verifying the
performance of ferry quays (see Fig. 2.2.4). Based on the above-mentioned study reports, the cargo loading
condition has a considerable influence on the berthing velocity. In other words, when a ship is fully loaded,
which results in small under-keel clearance, the berthing velocity tends to be lower, whereas when it is lightly
loaded, which results in a large under-keel clearance, the berthing velocity tends to be higher.
--"
15
c) ... 0pen~quay
0
0
....
Vr
,o
'
Y. oo
a-,,o-
._.oo
..
10,000
00
o"
0 0
00
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
-299-
>
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
IS
'
IS
10
20
30
2S
Fig. 2.2.3 Berthing Velocity and Displacement Tonnage for Large Oil Tankers l
20
D :stem berthing
...
0
:sow berthing
...
..
ii 00 0
2,000
8,000
S,000
Fig. 2.2.4 Berthing Velocity and Displacement Tonnage for Longitudinal Berthing of Ferries l
According to the survey by Moriya et al.'l, the average berthing velocities for general cargo ships, container
ships, and pure car carriers are as listed in Table 2.2.1. The relationship between the dead weight tonnage and
berthing velocity is shown in Fig. 2.2.5. This survey also shows that the larger the ship, the lower the berthing
velocity tends to be. The highest berthing velocities observed were about 15 cm/s for ships under 10,000 DWT
and about 10 cm/s for ships of 10,000 DWT or over.
Table 2.2.1 Dead Weight Tonnage and Average Berthing Velocity l
Dead Weight
Tonnage
(DWT)
Container ships
All ships
l,OOOclass
8.1
8.1
5,000class
6.7
7.8
7.2
10,000class
5.0
7.2
4.6
5.3
15,000class
4.5
4.9
4.7
4.6
30,000class
3.9
4.1
4.4
4.1
50,000class
3.5
3.4
3.4
All ships
5.2
5.0
4.6
5.0
-300-
20
R=~.38
A~~.0009
A Container ships
1F66.l
!"=AX+B
0
15
i...
x
lO
..
I\
0
0
10,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
@ Fig. 2.2.6 shows a berthing velocity frequency distribution obtained from actual measurement records of
berthing velocities at offshore berths used by large oil tankers of around 200,000 DWT. It shows that the highest
measured berthing velocity was 13 emfs. If the data are assumed to follow a Weibull distribution, then the
non-exceedence probability of the berthing velocity below the value of 13 cm/s would be 99.6%. The mean is
4.4cm/s and the standard deviation <J is 2.08 cm/s. Application of the Weibull distribution yields the probability
density functionj(Vb) as expressed in equation (2.2.3):
(2.2.3)
From this equation, the berthing velocity corresponding to the expected probability of 1/1000 becomes 14.5
cm/s. At the offshore berths where the berthing velocities were actually measured, a design berthing velocity
was set at either 15 cm/s or 20 cm/s.6>
%
30
~738
- Poisson distribution m = 3
_ .. _ .. _.,_.,_ Poisson distribution m = 4
- - - Weibull distribution
--------- Nonnal distribution
N
200
=4.41
0'=2.08
20
150
100
50
012345
<J) Small general cargo ships approach to berths by controlling their positions under their own power without
assistance of tugboats. Consequently, the berthing velocity is generally higher than that of larger ships, and
in some cases it may even exceed 30 emfs. Hence, it is necessary to pay attention to this. For small ships in
particular, it is necessary to carefully determine the berthing velocity based on actually measured data.
-301-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
In cases where cautious berthing methods such as those described above are not taken, or in the case of berthing
of small or medium-sized ships under influence of currents, it is necessary to determine the berthing velocity
based on actually measured data considering the ship drift velocity by currents.
Some studies proposed the regression equations for the berthing velocities of ships with respect to daed weight
tonnages.7), 8) Since the ranges of ship types and tonnages to which the regression equations ofberthing velocities
are applicable are limited, the results of the above studies should be carefully used.
(4) Virtual Mass Factors
CD
(2.2.4)
(2.2.5)
where
c, : block coefficient
V : displacement volume of ship (m')
: length between perpendiculars (m)
B : molded breadth (m)
d : full load draft (m)
Lpp
The calculation requires the use of the lengths between perpendiculars LPP' molded breadths B, and full load
drafts d of design ships. The cases where design ships are of a standard ship type may use the values shown in
Table 1.1 Standard Values of the Principal Dimensions of Design Ships included in Commentary.
@ When a ship berths, the ship with mass of M, and the water mass of Mw surrounding the ship simultaneously
decelerate. Accordingly, the inertial furce corresponding to the water mass is added to that of the ship itself.
The virtual mass factor is thus defined as in equation (2.2.6).
C =M,+Mw
m
M,
(2.2.6)
where
CD
Ce=
1+(~)
(2.2.7)
where
l : distance from the ship's contact point to the center of gravity of the ship measured parallel to
the face line of the mooring facility (m)
r : radius of rotation around the vertical axis passing through the center of gravity of the ship (m)
@ During the berthing process, a ship is not aligned perfectly along the face line of the berth. This means that
when the ship comes into contact with the fender systems, it starts yawing and rolling. This results in the loss
of a part of the ship's kinetic energy. The amount of energy loss by rolling is negligibly small compared with
that by yawing. Equation (2.2.7) thus only considers the amount of energy loss by yawing.
@ rl Lpp is a function of the block coefficient c, of the ship and can be obtained from Fig. 2.2.7.JO) Alternatively,
one may use the linear approximation shown in equation (2.2.8).
r=(0.19C, +O.ll)LPP
(2.2.8)
-302-
where
r : radius of rotation (radius of gyration); this is related to the moment of inertia lz around the
vertical axis of the ship by the relationship Iz=Ms1'2
Cb : block coefficient
LPP : length between perpendiculars (m)
The calculation requires the use of the lengths between perpendiculars LPP of design ships. The cases where
design ships are of a standard ship type may use the values shown in Table 1.1 Standard. Values of the
Principal Dimensions of Design Ships included in Commentary.
0.30
0.28
0.26
~/
0.24
0.22
0.20
0.5
//
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1.0
Bloclt coefficient Cb
Fig. 2.2.7 Relationship between the Radius of Gyration around the Vertical Axis and the Block Coefficient 9J
As shown in Fig. 2.2.8, when a ship comes into contact with the fenders F1 and F2 being the ship closest to
the quaywall at point P, the distance I from the point of contact to the center of gravity of the ship as measured
parallel to the mooring facilities is given by equation (2.2.9) or (2.2.10) 11); l is taken to be L 1 when k >0.5 and
L2 when k < 0.5. When k = 0.5, l is taken as whichever ofL1 or L2 that gives the higher value of Cc in equation
(2.2.7).
eLppeosB
Fig. 2.2.8 Schematic Illustration of Ship Berthing 11)
4 ={0.Sa+e(l-k)}LPPcosO
(2.2.9)
(2.2.10)
where
L1
L2
()-
distance from the point of contact to the center of gravity of the ship as measured parallel to
the mooring facilities when the ship contacts with fender Fl (m)
distance from the point of contact to the center of gravity of the ship as measured parallel to
the mooring facilities when the ship contacts with fender F2 (m)
berthing angle (the value of(} is given as a design condition; it is usually set somewhere in the
range of 0 to 10)
-303-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
e
a
k
ratio of the distance between the funders, as measured in the longitudinal direction of the ship,
to the length between perpendiculars
ratio of the length of the parallel side of the ship at the height of the point of contact with the
funder to the length between perpendiculars; this varies according to factors like the type of
ship, and the block coefficient etc., but is generally in the range of 1/3 to 1/2.
parameter that represents the relative location of the point where the ship comes closest to the
mooring facilities between the funders Fl and F2 ; k varies O<k<l, but it is generally taken at
k= 0.5.
CD
Actions caused by the motions of moored ships are generally calculated by motion calculation, by appropriately
setting wave forces, wind pressure forces, and water current pressure forces.
The ships moored to the mooring facilities constructed in the open sea or close to port entrances or in ports
where long period waves invade and those moored in rough weather are possible to move by the actions ofwaves,
winds, and water currents. The kinetic energy generated by the motions of moored ships sometimes exceeds
the berthing energy. In such cases, it is preferable fur the perfurmance verification of mooring posts and fender
systems to take account of the tractive furces and impact furces generated by the motions of moored ships.12)
In the ports facing the open sea in particular, it has been frequently reported that the long period oscillations of
moored ships caused by the long period waves resulted in a difficulty with smooth cargo handling.13), 14) Care
should be taken in such ports.
@ As a general rule, the oscillations of a moored ship should be analyzed through numerical simulation in
consideration of the random variations of the actions and the nonlinearity of the displacement-restoring force
characteristics of the mooring system. However, when such a numerical simulation of ship motions is not
possible, or when the ship is moored at a system that is considered to be more-or-less symmetrical, one may
obtain the displacement of and loads on the mooring system either by using frequency response analysis for
regular waves or by referring to the results of motion calculation on a floating body moored at a system that has
displacement-restoring force characteristics of bilinear nature.IS)
@ The wave furce acting on a ship consists of the wave-exciting furce due to incident waves and the wave-making
resistance furce accompanied by the motions of the ship.!) The wave-exciting force due to incident waves is the
wave furce calculated for the case that the motions of the ship are restrained. The wave-making resistance force is
the wave furce exerted on the ship when the ship undergoes a motion of unit amplitude for each mode of motions.
The wave-making resistance furce can be expressed as the summation of two factors, one is proportional to the
acceleration of the ship and the other is proportional to the velocity. The former can be expressed as an added
mass when it is divided by the acceleration, while the latter can be expressed as a damping coefficient when it is
divided by the velocity.17) In addition, the nonlinear fluid dynamic furce that is proportional to the square of the
wave height acts on the ship, see 4.9 Actions on Floating Body and its Motions in Chapter 2.
@ For ships that have a block coefficient of 0.7 to 0.8 such as large oil tankers, the ship can be replaced with an
elliptical cylinder fur an approximate evaluation of the wave force.!)
@ For box-shaped ships such as working crafts, the wave furce can be obtained by assuming the ship to be either
a floating body with a rectangular cross section or a rectangular prism.
(2) Wave Forces Acting on Ship
CD
The wave force acting on a moored ship shall be calculated using an appropriate method, considering the type
of ship and the wave parameters.
-304-
@ The wave force acting on a moored ship is calculated using appropriate analysis methods such as the strip
method, the source distribution method, the boundary element method, or the finite element method; the most
common method used for ships is the strip method.
(b) Froude-Kriloffforce
The Froude-Kriloff force is the force derived from the progressive waves around the ship. It is given by the
summation of the force of the incident waves and the force of the reflected waves from the quaywall.
(c) Diffraction force
The diffraction force acting on a ship is the force that is generated by the change in the pressure field when
incident waves are scattered by the ship. The diffraction force can be estimated by replacing this change in
the pressure field with the radiation force, namely the wave-making resistance force when the ship moves at
a certain velocity on a fluid at rest, for the case that the ship is moved relative to fluid. It is assumed that the
velocity of the ship in this case is equal to the relative velocity of the ship to the water particles in the incident
waves. This velocity is referred to as the equivalent relative velocity.
CD
The wind load acting on a moored ship shall be determined using an appropriate calculation formula.
@ It is preferable to determine the wind load acting on a moored ship in consideration of the time fluctuation of the
wind velocity and the characteristics of the wind drag coefficients in respect of the cross-sectional shape of the
ship.
@ The wind loads acting on a ship are calculated from equations (2.3.1) to (2.3.3) using wind drag coefficients Cx
and Cy in the X and Y directions, respectively, and wind pressure moment coefficient CM around the midship.
The subscript k in the equations refers to the characteristic values.
Rx,
=1pU
(2.3.1)
ArCx
(2.3.2)
(2.3.3)
where
-305-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ It is preferable to determine the wind drag coefficients Cx, Cy, and CM through wind tunnel tests or water tank
tests on design ships. However, since such tests require time and cost, it is acceptable to use the calculation
equations for wind drag coefficients 21), 22) that are based on wind tunnel tests 20) or water tank tests that have
been carried out in the past.
@ The maximum wind velocity, 10-minute average wind velocity, may be used as the wind velocity U.
@ Since the wind velocity varies both in time and space, it should be treated as fluctuating wind in the motion
calculation of a moored ship. Davenport 23) and Hino 24) have proposed the frequency spectra for the time
fluctuations ofthe wind velocity. The frequency spectra proposed by Davenport and Hino are given by equations
(2.3.4) and (2.3.5), respectively.
JS.(/)= 4K,U10'
X
x'
(1+x')
413
= 1200/ /U10
s.(/)=2.856K;to
(2.3.4)
{1+(~Jr"
(2.3.5)
.JK:
where
s.cn
u,.
K,
a
z
m
2=-1
10
CD
The current pressure force due to water currents acting on a ship shall be determined using an appropriate
calculation formula.
(2.3.6).
The subscript kin the equation refers to the characteristic value.
(2.3.6)
where
R1 : current pressure force (kN)
S : submerged surface area (m2)
V : current velocity (m/s)
-306-
where
R
Po
C
V
B
Water current pressure force consists of frictional resistance and pressure resistance. The currents from the bow
and the side mostly generate frictional and pressure resistances, respectively, but these two resistances cannot
be rigorously distinguished. Equation (2.3.6) is a simplified one substituting p 0 = 1.025 t/m3, t = 15C, and p0
= 0.14 into equation (2.3.8) called Froude's furmula. The subscript k in the equation refers to the characteristic
value.
r,
(2.3.8)
Pog
where
Rt : current pressure force (kN)
Pog
t
S
V
@ The current pressure coefficient C varies according to the relative current direction fJ ; the values obtained from
Fig. 2.3.1 may be used as a reference.
6.0
5.0
\.)
tl
.2
4.0
"0
"
~
3.0
IE"
a 2.0
~
./
1.0
20
40
~~..._x-x
60
80
100
120
140
160
180
Q) For the motion calculation of a moored ship, the displacement-restoring force characteristics of the mooring
system such as mooring ropes and fenders shall be modeled appropriately.
@ The displacement-restoring force characteristics of the mooring system such as mooring ropes and fenders is
generally nonlinear. Moreover, the displacement-restoring force characteristics offenders may possess hysterisis
nature. In that case, it is preferable to model these characteristics appropriately for the motion calculation of a
moored ship.25)
-307-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
directions.
Table 2.4.1
Over200 and
not more than 500
150
150
250
250
350
250
350
350
500
350
700
500
1,000
700
1,500
1,000
2,000
1,000
(4) Mooring posts are installed away from the face line of quaywall, around the both ends of a berth so that they
may be used for mooring a ship in a storm. Bollards, on the other hand, are installed close to the face line of the
mooring facilities so that they may be used for mooring, berthing, or unberthing a ship in normal operations.
(5) Regarding the layout and names ofmooring ropes of a ship, 2.1.1 (1) Dimensions of Wharves in Part m, Chapter
5 may be rererred.
(6) Regarding the layout and structure of mooring posts and bollards, see 9.1 Mooring Posts and Mooring Rings in
Part ill, Chapter 5.
(7) It is prererable to calculate the tractive forces acting on mooring posts and bollards based on the breaking loads
of the mooring ropes of design ships, meteorological and oceanographic conditions at the installation places of
mooring facilities, ship dimensions etc., taking account as necessary of the forces caused by berthing ships, the
wind pressure forces acting on moored ships, and the forces caused by the ship motions.9J. 15) The tractive forces
may also be determined according to the following Items (8) to (12).
(8) In case that the gross tonnage of a ship exceeds 5,000 tons and there is no risk of more than one mooring rope
being attached to a bollard that is used for spring lines at the middle of mooring facilities for which the berthing
ships are designated, the tractive force acting on a bollard may be taken as one half of the value listed in Table
2.4.1.
(9) The tractive forces by the ships of a gross tonnage of less than 200 tons or more than 100,000 tons, which are not
given in Table 2.4.1, those applied to the mooring facilities capable of mooring ships in rough weather, and those
applied to the mooring facilities installed in the open sea area where meteorological and oceanographic conditions
are rough need to be determined, taking account of meteorological and oceanographic conditions, the structures
The tractive force acting on a mooring post has been determined based on the wind pressure force acting on
-308-
(II) When determining the tractive force of a small ship of gross tonnage up to 200 tons, it is preferable to consider the
type of ship, the berthing situation, the structure of the mooring facilities, etc.28) For the performance verification
of mooring posts and bollards for ships of gross tonnage up to 200 tons, it is common to take the tractive force
acting on a mooring post to be 150 kN and the tractive force acting on a bollard to be 50 kN.
(12) When calculating the tractive force in case of ships such as terries, container ships, or passenger ships, caution
should be taken in using Table 2.4.1, because the wind pressure-receiving areas of such ships are large.
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
PIANC: Report of the International Commission for Improving the Design of Fender Systems, Supplement to Bulletin,
No.45, 1984
Baker, AL.L.: The Impact of Ships When Berthing, Proc. Int'! Navig. Congr. (PIANC), Rome, Sect.II, Qoest.2, pp.111-142,
1953
Mizoguchi, M. and Nakayama, T.: Studies on the Berthing Velocity, Energy of the Ships, Technical Note of Port and Harbour
Research Institute, No.170, 1973 (in Japanese)
Otani, H., Ueda, S., Ichikawa, T. and Sugihara, K.: A Study on the Berthing Impact ofthe Big Tanker, Technical Note of Port
and Harbour Research Institute, No.176, 1974 (in Japanese)
Moriya, Y., Yoshida, Y., lse, H., Miyazaki, K. and Sugiura, J.: Field Observations on the Berthing Velocities of Ships, Proc.
of Coastal Engineering, JSCE, Vol.38, pp.751-755, 1991 (in Japanese)
Ueda, S.: Study on Berthing Impact Force of Very Large Crude Oil Carriers, Report of Port and Harbour Research Institute,
Vol.20 No.2, pp.169-209, 1981 (in Japanese)
Ueda, S., Umemura, R., Shiraishi, S., Yamamoto, S., Akakura, Y. and Yarnase, S.: Study on the Statistical Design Method for
Fender System, Proc. of Coastal Engineering, JSCE, Vol.47, pp.866-870, 2000 (in Japanese)
Ueda, S., Hirano, T., Shiraishi, S., Yamamoto, S. and Yamase, S.: Reliability Design Method of Fender for Berthing Ship,
Proc. Int'! Navig. Congr. (PIANC), Sydney, pp.692-707, 2002
Ueda, S. and Doi, E.: On the Design of Fending Systems for Mooring Facilities in a Port, Technical Note of Port and Harbour
Research Institute, No.596, 1987 (in Japanese)
Myers, J.: Handbook of Ocean and Underwater Engineering, McGraw-Hill, New York, 1969
Japan Port and Harbor Association: Design Calculatioo Examples of Port and Harbour Structures (Vol.I), pp.117-119, 1992
(in Japanese)
Ueda, S. and Shiraishi, S.: On the Design ofFenders Based on the Ship Oscillations Moored to Quay Walls, Technical Note
of Port and Harbour Research Institute, No.729, 1992 (in Japanese)
Shiraishi, S.: Low-Frequency Ship Motions Due to Long-Period Waves in Habors, and Modifications to Mooring Systems
That Inhibit Such Motioos, Report of Port and Harbour Research Institute, Vol.37 No.4, pp.37-78, 1998
Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Manual for Impact Assessment of Long Period Waves in a Port, 2004 (in
Japanese)
Ueda, S.: Analytical Method of Ship Motions Moored to Quay Walls and the Applications, Technical Note of Port and
Harbour Research Institute, No.504, 1984 (in Japanese)
Motora, S., Koyama, T., Fujino, M. and Maeda, H.: Dynamics of Ships and Offshore Structures -revised edition-, Seizando,
pp.39-121, 1997 (in Japanese)
Ueda, S. and Shiraishi, S.: Method and Its Evaluation for Computation of Moored Ship's Motions, Report of Port and Harbour
-309-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Research Institute, Vol.22 No.4, pp.181-218, 1983 (in Japanese)
18) Goda, Y., Takayama, T. aod Sasada, T.: Theoretical aod Experimental Investigation of Wave Forces oo a Fixed Vessel
Approximated with ao Elliptic Cylinder, Report of Port aod Harbour Research Institute, Vol.12 No.4, pp.23-74, 1973 (in
Japanese)
19) Kobayashi, M., Yuasa, H., Kishimoto, 0., Abe, M., Kunitake, Y., Narita, H., Hirano, M. and Sugimura, Y.: A Computer
20)
21)
22)
23)
24)
25)
26)
27)
28)
Program for Theoretical Calcolation of Sea-keeping Quality of Ships (Part I-Method of Theoretical Calcolation), Mitsui
Technical Review, No.82, pp.18-Sl, 1973 (in Japaoese)
Tsuji, T., Takaishi, Y., Kan, M. aod Sato, T.: Model Test about Wind Forces Acting on the Ships, Report of Ship Research
Institute, Vol.7 No.5, pp.13-37, 1970 (in Japanese)
Isherwood, R.M.: Wind Resistaoce ofMerchaot Ships, Bulletin of the Royal Institution of Naval Architects, pp.327-338, 1972
Ueda, S., Shiraishi, S., Asano, K. and Oshima, H.: Proposal of Formula of Wind Force Coefficient and Evaluation of the
Effuct to Motions of Moored Ships, Technical Note of Port aod Harbour Research Institute, No.760, 1993 (in Japanese)
Davenport, A.G.: Gust Loading Factors, Proc. of ASCE, ST3, pp.11-34, 1967
Hino, M.: Relationships between the Instaotaoeous Peak Values aod the Evaluation Time -A Theory on the Gust Factor-,
Traosactions of the Japao Society of Civil Engineers, No.117, pp.23-33, 1965 (in Japanese)
Coastal Development Institute ofTechoology: Techoical Maoual for Floating Structures, pp.37-55, 1991 (in Japanese)
Inagaki, H., Yamaguchi, K. aod Katayama, T.: Staodardization of Mooring Posts aod Bollards for Wharf, Technical Note of
Port aod Harbour Research Institute, No.102, 1970 (in Japaoese)
Fukuda, I. aod Yagyu, T.: Tractive Force oo Bollards and Storm Bitts, Technical Note of Port and Harbour Research Institute,
No.427, 1982 (in Japanese)
Japao Fishing Port Association: Staodard Design Method for Fishing Port Structures, 1984 (in Japaoese)
-310-
Article 19
Environmental influences shall be assessed with appropriate methods by taking account of the design
working life of the facilities, material characteristics, environmental conditions, maintenance methods, and
the conditions to which the facilities concerned are subjected.
[Technical Note]
The evaluation of the effects of environmental actions may refer to Part I, Chapter 2, 3 Maintenance of Facilities
Subject to tbe Technical Standards and Chapter 11, 2.3 Corrosion Protection for steel and Part III, Chapter 2,
1.1 General for concrete.
-311-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 20
1 Self weight shall be appropriately set based on the unit weight of the material.
2 Surcharge shall be appropriately set by considering the assumed usage conditions of the facilities and
others.
[Technical Note]
1 General
(!) When verifying the performance of port facilities, self weight and surcharge shall be considered, as necessary.
CD
@ Surcharge: the weight loaded on top of the structure. This is divided into static load and live load.
(a) Static load
The actions such as general cargo and bulk cargo loaded on aprons, transit sheds, and warehouses are included
in static load. In regions with heavy snowfall, the snow on the aprons is regarded also as a kind of static load.
(b) Live load
The following shall be considered as live load as necessary, when verifying the performance of port facilities.
1) train load
2) vehicle load
3) cargo handling equipment load
4) sidewalk live load
(3) The selfweight and surcharge used in the performance verification ofport facilities must be set in due consideration
of the type of actions on the objective facilities and their loading conditions. In particular, the self weight and
surcharge have a large effect on the performance verification of circular slip failure of quaywalls, beams and
slabs of piers. Therefore, sufficient care should be taken when determining the types and sizes of self weight and
surcharge.
2 Self Weight
(!) SelfWeight
In the performance verification of the facilities to which the technical standards apply, the self weight must be
appropriately set based on the unit weight of the material.
(2) As the characteristic values of the unit weight used in the calculation of self weight, the values given in Table 2.1
1) may be generally used. However, in cases where the unit weight can be specified in preliminary survey or other
ways, the values in Table 2.1 are not always applicable.
(3) Unit weights of stone, sand, gravel, and rubble depend on the stone quality, while unit weights of materials other
than metals such as steel and aluminum vary according to individual cases. When using these materials, the
characteristic values for unit weight must be decided with care.
-312-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 10 SELF WEIGHT AND SURCHARGE
Table 2.1 Characteristic Values of Unit Weights of Materials 1)
Material
Steel and casting steel
Casting iron
71.0
Aluminum
27.5
Reinfurced concrete
Un-reinforced concrete
24.0
22.6
Timber
7.8
Asphalt concrete
Stone ( irranite)
22.6
Stone (sandstone)
25.0
16.0
26.0
18.0
20.0
References
1)
-313-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
3 Surcharge
3.1 Static Load
(!) Surcharge
Surcharge used here means the actions such as static load, snow load, train load, vehicle load, cargo handling
equipment load, and sidewalk live load, and when setting them it is necessary to appropriately consider the
assumed usage conditions of the facility.
(2) Characteristic values of surcharge shall be set appropriately, considering the usage conditions of port facilities,
such as the type, volume and the handling methods of the cargo handled.
(3) Static Load
CD
(a) When determining the characteristic values static load in permanent situations, it is preferable to adequately
consider the factors such as type of cargo handled, type of packing, volume, handling methods, and loading
time.
(b) Generally, in the performance verification, a mean value for each section in an apron, a shed, or a warehouse
is used as the static load. However in the performance verification of structural materials, the static load itself
is often used. The static load acting on an apron has a large effect on the stability verification of mooring
facilities, so it is necessary to consider it separately from the static loads on other facilities such as sheds and
warehouses. For an apron, the mean value of the static load per one block usually stays constant by the scale
of the mooring facility and the type of cargo handled, and the mean value may be determined with reference
to the previous examples of verifications. In the case of general-purpose wharves, the values from about 10
to 30 kN/m2 are often used as the characteristic values of the static load acting on aprons. As fur the aprons
where heavy cargo such as containers and steel is handled, it is preferable to determine the value of the static
load based on the study of usage conditions.
(c) The characteristic values of unit weights fur bulk cargo have been obtained based on surveys of the past actual
conditions, which are listed in Table 3.1.1. IJ
Table 3.1.1 Characteristic Values of Unit Weights for Bulk Cargo !J
Commodity
Coke
4.9
Coal (lump)
8.8-9.8
Coal (fine)
9.8-11.0
Iron ore
20.0-29.0
Cement
15.0
19.0
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 10 SELF WEIGHT AND SURCHARGE
@ SnowLoad
(a) After heavy snowfall, the snow piled up on an apron is compacted and hardened by automobiles, and then
it may be a static load. Therefore it is preferable to set an appropriate snow load in line with the actual
conditions.
(b) For quaywalls where snow removal operations will be carried out, it is often sufficient to determine the snow
load with the accumulated weight of snow over one night. In this case the snow load may be determined by
the engineer taking into consideration the past snowfall records, general climatic conditions during snowfall,
snow quality and snow removal
(c) In most cases the snow load is set as 1 kN/m2. This is equivalent to, for example, approximately 70 - 100 cm
thickness of dry and new powder snow.
(d) The relationship between normal snow conditions and snow unit weight, described in the Railway Structure
Design Standards and Commentary,3J is shown in Table 3.1.2.
Table 3.1.2 Normal Snow Conditions and Characteristic Value of Unit Weight of Snow 3)
1.2
1.7
4.5
8.5
-315-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) The vehicle load specified here corresponds to that (T load and L load) specified in the llighway Bridge
Specifications and Commentary.>)
@ The international regulations concerning the dimensions and maximum gross mass of containers are set out by
the International Organization for Standardization (ISO) as listed in Table 3.2.1.
Table 3.2.1 Standard Dimension of Containers>
Length (L)
Type
mm
Allowance
mm
ftm
Allow'""'
i in
mm
Allow=
mm
ft
Allow'""'
i in
!AAA
mm
2,896*
!AA
12,192
0
.10
40
0
-3/8
2,438
.,
0
0
-3/16
2,438
!AX
<2,438
2,896*
lBBB
!BB
9,125
0
.10
29111/4
0
-3/16
2,438
0
-3/16
2,591*
2,438
!BX
<2,438
ICC
6,058
IC
1910 112
0
-1/4
2,438
.,
0
2,591*
8
0
-3/16
2,438
Allowance
smm
ftm
.,
.,
0
0
.,
0
2,991
!DX
.,
0
993/4
0
-3/16
2,438
.,
0
0
-3/16
Some countnes regulate the total height of the vehicle and container.
-316-
2,438
<2,438
(gross mass)
Allowance
sm
0
-3/16
0
-3/16
0
-3116
kg
lb
30,480*
67,200*
30,480*
67,200*
30,480*
67,200*
10,160"
22,400*
<8
.,
0
.,
.,
0
0
0
-3/16
0
-3116
0
-3116
<8
.,
0
.,
0
<2,438
ICX
lD
.,
1B
2,591*
IA
Roting
Height (H)
Width(W)
0
-3116
0
-3/16
<8
.,
0
8
<8
0
-3/16
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 10 SELF WEIGHT AND SURCHARGE
2.44m'
1
I
Container Dimensions
(Length: 20' xWidth: 8' xHeight: 8' 6'1
2 8' 6" Low-Bed Chassis
Container Dimensions
(Length: 20' x Width: 8' xHeight: 8' 6")
3 9' 6"-40' S ecialized Chassis
:-:-------;2~9~~---11-----:-! 1~
~I
'@@ '_"'
Container Dimensions
(Length: 40' xWidth: 8' xHeight: 9' 6'1
Fig 3.2.1 Tractor-Trailer Height, etc., when Loading a Container
CD
General
(a) Cargo haodling equipment load is classified into three types: mobile, rail mounted and fixed equipmeot, and
the respective actions can generally be considered as follows:
I) As the characteristic values of mobile cargo haodling equipment load, the total selfweigbt, the maximum
wheel load, the maximum load of the outrigger operation, or the maximum ground contact pressure load
-317-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 3.2.2 Examples of Dimensions of Tire-mounted Multi-Purpose Jib Cranes
Main Chassis Dimensions (m)
'fype
Jib Crane
Double Link
Drawing
Crane
Rated
Load (t)
Total
Weight
Equipped
(t)
Maximum
Operating
Radius
Total
Width
(1)
Wheel
Base
Tread
Total
Height
(2)
34.0
34.1
289
395
24.0
30.0
8.8
11.0
8.0
25.2
4.0
3.5
37.5
48.0
Maximum Wheel
Load When Moving
(kN/wheel)
Maximum Ground
Contact Pressure During
Operation (3) (kPa)
217
255
527
174
38.0
349
32.0
11.5
8.5
3.4
51.4
147
882
40.0
34.0
370
406
34.0
30.0
12.0
13.0
9.7
15.0
4.3
5.0
59.5
42.5
142
280
358
34.1
402
30.0
12.8
15.0
5.0
45.0
139
301
34.5
37.S
425
417
28.0
32.6
11.7
12.0
10.0
8.0
4.5
39.0
52.0
294
139
314
293
Notes :
5.5
(Total Width)
3,000
10,000
(Total Height)
3,740
4670
16580
-318-
2,320
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 10 SELF WEIGHT AND SURCHARGE
2330
Type
Maximum
Total Weight
Lift Load (t) Equipped (t)
16
25
RoughTerrain Crane
All-Terrain
Crane
Tractor Crane
35
50
60
100
160
360
400
550
120
160
360
19.7
26.5
32.6
Total
Length
8.23
11.21
11.57
37.8
39.6
11.85
12.29
60.0
87.5
90.0
126.0
132.0
13.53
16.58
17.62
18.29
18.00
94.7
131.4
114.0
15.38
16.72
17.52
3.71
3.74
4.85
5.30
3.95
3.98
4.00
4.10
4.25
6.00
8.80
10.24
11.30
11.30
4.00
4.05
4.34
7.38
7.30
9.25
Notes: (1) "Main chassis dimensions" are the dimensions when moving inside the yard.
(2) "Maximum axle load" is the maximum value of the axle loads when moving inside the yard
-319-
Maximum Axle
Load (*2) (kN)
97.5
131.2
163.9
2.38
2.42
2.32
185.3
194.4
147.1
2.56
2.55
2.56
2.56
171.6
154.9
179.5
198.1
2.76/2.52
2.83/2.54
2.83/2.54
392.8
543.8
297.7
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
f-hl
LU
I~
I
!
L _ _J
,---
,--1
I
.
1----i
I
.
I
I
.
=-
"'
L ___ ____j~
11--
!
1
I I
I
.
.
I
1-----i
I
1,4000,1
3075
1600 1600
4900
15820
'~"
I
I
.
I
i---I
I
I
.
I
LJ I--
3150
Machine
Name
A
B
Handled
Rated
Containers (ft) Load (t)
20,40
20,40
20,40,45
35
40
35
15.8
12.2
17.4
4.5
5.3
4.5
Notes: (*1) "Total length" 1s the total length when handhng a 40-foot container.
-320-
13.6
12.6
13.7
8.1
7.4
8.0
Maximum
Operating
Wheel Load
(kN/wheel)
117
122
124
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 10 SELF WEIGHT AND SURCHARGE
"'
00
"'
"'
"'
8550
5780
1220
9760
8220
Total Weight
Equipped (t) Total Height
Crawler Total
Width
Crawler Shoe
Width
Crawler Ground
Contact Pressure
(kPa)
30
33
4.72
4.49
3.30
0.76
54
45
45
5.12
5.40
4.30
0.76
60
50
49
5.25
5.57
4.35
0.76
61
70
71
6.18
5.99
4.83
0.80
80
80
85
6.56
6.32
4.90
0.90
86
90
89
6.64
6.40
4.90
0.85
91
100
122
7.92
7.88
6.17
0.92
90
150
161
8.49
8.49
7.07
1.07
89
200
193
8.49
9.18
7.07
1.07
103
300
284
9.83
9.76
8.22
1.22
127
350
294
7.82
10.14
8.79
1.29
120
450
390
10.12
11.51
9.50
1.50
122
800
1,190
14.68
12.80
2.00
127
-321-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
5500
13 00
20770
2347 SP
26020
Machine
Handled
Rated
Name Containers (ft) Load (t)
A
B
c
D
E
F
G
20,40
20,40,45
20,40,45
20,40,45
20,40,45
20,40,45
20,40,45
36.0
40.6
40.6
40.6
51.0
40.6
50.0
26.1
26.0
26.3
25.8
25.8
26.0
26.0
12.0
11.3
12.2
11.7
12.7
11.3
10.7
21.5
21.1
21.8
24.4
28.3
21.1
21.8
6.4
6.4
6.4
6.4
8.0
6.4
6.4
Maximum
Operating Wheel
Load
lkN/wheel)
281
275
293
295
327
142
167
Number
of Wheels
(Wheels/
Corner)
2
2
2
2
2
4
4
-322-
PART II ACTIONS AND MATERIAL STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS, CHAPTER 10 SELF WEIGHT AND SURCHARGE
,-- -I
.;-- - -1,
I,
II
'I
,I
'
I'
I,_ - JI
~- r,r.I
'''
l,11
,11
'''1
l,1
'111
'''
l,11
'1
,,,
11,1
'1
,,,
11,1
'1
,,,
4~=+=~~
Span
30000
Backreach
I 15000 !
Handled
Machine
Containers
Name
(ft)
Outreach
Span
Backreach
10.0
27.0
68.0
20, 40
30.5
580
31.0
16.0
Total
Total Wheel
Width Height Base
18.0
Maximum
Number
Operating of Wheels
Wheel Load (Wheels/
(kN/wheel)
Corner)
406
8
20,40
30.5
627
31.0
16.0
9.0
28.0
72.0
18.0
314
20,40
30.5
668
31.0
16.0
9.5
27.0
46.0
18.0
314
20, 40
30.5
635
40.0
16.0
11.0
27.0
80.5
18.0
343
20, 40
40.6
1,127
50.0
30.0
15.0
27.0
73.1
18.0
577
F
G
20,40,45
20,40,45
20,40,45
20,40,45
20, 40, 45
40.5
40.6
40.6
50.0
65.0
890
965
1,030
993
1,360
47.1
50.0
50.5
52.0
63.0
30.0
30.5
30.0
30.0
30.0
15.0
15.0
14.0
15.0
16.0
28.0
28.0
26.5
26.5
26.5
100.0
102.3
65.0
105.0
127.2
18.0
18.0
18.0
18.0
16.5
558
394
720
744
711
8
10
8
8
8
H
I
J
-323-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
References
I)
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
-324-
Chapter 11 Materials
Public Notice
Fundamentals of Performance Verification
Article 3 (excerpts)
2 The performance verification of the facilities subject to the Technical Standards shall be made in principle
by executing the subsequent items taking into consideration the situations in which the facilities concerned
will encounter during the design working life:
(1 ), (2) (omitted)
(3) Select the materials of the facilities concerned in consideration of their characteristics and the
environmental influences on them, and appropriately specify their physical properties.
[Commentary]
Corrosion of Steel:
In the performance verification of facilities subject to the Technical Standards, appropriately consider the
corrosion of steel depending on conditions such as the natural environment. In general, steel that is used
in facilities that are subject to the Technical Standards are placed under severe corrosive environmental
conditions, and appropriate corrosion protection must be performed, using methods such as cathodic
protection and covering/coating.
[Technical Note]
1 General
Steel used in port facilities shall be selected from appropriate materials taking into account effects on actions,
deterioration, working life time, shape, constructability, economy and environment.
2 Steel
2.1 General
(!) Steel used in port facilities must have the necessary qualities to satisfy the required functionality of the facilities.
Steel that comply with the Japanese Industrial Standard (JIS) may be given as examples that satisfy such
requirements.
Table 2.1.1 and Table 2.1.2 list the steel complying with the Japanese Industrial Standard that are most often
used in port facilities.I) For each of them, JIS specifies many types of steel.
(2) In general, structural steel with a tensile strength of 490 N/mm2 or more is called high-strength steel. Highstrength steel has an important characteristic that the higher the strength it has the larger is its yield ratio, namely
the ratio of the yield strength to the tensile strength.
(3) Corrosion resistant steel has excellent resistance to particles of seawater salt above the sea level, and they may be
either W type for uncoated use or P type for coated use.
-325-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 2.1.1 Quality Standards for Steel Materials (JIS)
Type
of steel
material
Standard
JIS G 3101
Structural
steel
Steel pile
Sheet pile
Cast or
forged
items
Welding
rods
Steel
materials
used for
joining
Steel pipe
Symbols
JIS G3444
structural ournnses
JIS A5525 Steel pipe piles
JIS A5526 Steel H piles
1)
Applications
SS400
SKK400, SKK490
SHK400, SHK400]1,{,
SHK490]1,{
S"Y295, S"Y390
SK"Y400, SK"Y490
SF490A, SF540A
SC450
S30CN, S35CN
FC150, FC250
F8T,FlOT
SS400,S]l,{400,SJl.{A400
Wires
SWRS
SWRH
SW]I,{
rone
Hard steel wire, oil tempered wire,
PC hi0 h carbon steel wire, wire rone
-
SWPRl, SWPDI,
SWPR2, SWPD3.
JIS G3536 PC steel wire and strands
SWPR7, SWPR19
SR235, SR295, SD295A,
JIS G3112 Steel bars for concrete reinforcement
SD295B, SD345
Rerolled steel bars for concrete
SRR235, SRR295,
JIS G3117
reinforcement
SDR235
TypeA2:
SBPR 785/1030
Steel bar
Type Bl:
SBPR 930/1080
JIS G3109 PC Steel bars
TypeB2:
SBPR 930/1180
Type Cl:
SBPR 1080/1230
..
Notes : A symbol for steel may come m varieties m JIS, for example, for SM400 there are three varieties SM400A,
SM400B, and SM400C, but in this table these symbol suffixes that follow the number are omitted.
The carbon steel for machine structures, S30CN and S35CN, are obtained from the materials S30C and S35C specified in
JIS G 4051 by a nonnalizing heat treatment to satisfy the mechanical properties specified in the explanatory attachment to that
standard.
-326-
Type of steel
Standard
Materials used
Steel bar
JIS G 3191
Shaped steel
JIS G3192
SS400
SS400, SM400, SM490, SM490Y, SM520,
SM570,SMA.400,SMA.490, SMA.570
JIS G 3193
SS400, SM400,SM490,SM490Y,
SM520,SM570,SMA.400, SMA.490
Flat steel
JISG3194
JIS A. 5525
JIS A. 5526
SKK400, SKK490
SHK.400,SHK.400M,SHK.490M
JIS A. 5528
SY295, SY390
JIS A. 5530
SKY400, SKY490
JIS B 1180
Structural steel
Steel pile
Sheet pile
ns B 1181
JIS B 1186
F8T, FlOT
JIS G3112
JIS G 3117
PC steel bars
JIS G 3536
JISG3109
SBPR,SBPD
Wire rope
JIS G3525
SWRS,SWRH
JIS F 3303
JIS G 3551
concrete
Prestressed
concrete
Materials for
mooring
Wire mesh
SWPR, SWPD
(4) When rolled steel for general structures, rolled steel for welded structures, or corrosion resistant hot rolled steel
for welded structures is used, thickness may be chosen from Fig. 2.1.J.2) When steel with thicknesses less than
8 mm are used, follow the standards in Specifications for Highway Bridges.') In general, for reasons such
that steel with large thickoesses require a large amount of carbon for a specific strength, and during rolling fine
crystallization may be insufficient and the notch brittleness may become greater, a usable upper bound for the
thickness is specified in JIS for each steel.
Thickness (mm)
Steel tvne
Steel for
non-welded
structures
6 8
SS400
'
'
SM400A.
SM400B
SM400C
SM490A.
SM490B
SM490C
SM490YA.
SM490YB
SM520C
~---
16 25
32
40
50
100
'
~---
!- - -
" -r--~---
'
r--
SMA.400A.W
SMA.400BW
SMA.400CW
SMA.490A.W
SMA.490BW
SMA.490CW
~---
'
r-~--~---
r--
SMA.570W
Fig. 2.1.1 Standards for Selecting Thickness Based on the Steel Grade>
-327-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(5) Strength standards for PC steel wire and stranded PC steel wire are specified in JIS G 3536, and the standards for
the chemical compositions of steel are presented in JIS G 3502, Piano Wire.
(6) In facilities that have many welded portions for example, facilities with joint construction, it is necessary to pay
attention to the chemical composition and weldability of the steel. In general, welded steel materials use JIS G
3106, Rolled Steel for Welded Structures, or JIS G 3114, Corrosion Resistant Hot Rolled Steel for Welded
Structures. On the other hand, SS400, which belongs to JIS G 3101, Rolled Steel for General Structures,
should be limited to non-welded portions.
(2) In general, characteristic values for the Young's modulus, the shear modulus, Poisson's ratio, and the linear
expansion coefficient of steel and cast steel can use the values given by Table 2.2.1. 4) Also, the constants for steel
used in reinforced concrete and prestressed concrete can refur to the values given in the Standard Specification
for Concrete Structures.SJ
Table 2.2.1 Mechanical Characteristics for Steel>
Young's modulus
Shear modulus
Poisson's ratio
Linear expansion coefficient
E
G
v
a
Q) Structural steel
(a) Generally, the values listed in Table 2.2.2 can be used as characteristic values of yield strength for structural
steel based on the grade of steel and the thickness.)
-328-
Thickness
mm
~ 16
16 to 40
40 to 100
~ 100
~ 16
88400
16 to 40
40 to 75
8M400
8MA400
75 to 100
100 to 160
160 to 200
~ 16
16 to 40
40 to 75
8M490
75 to 100
100 to 160
160 to 200
~ 16
16 to 40
40 to 75
8M490Y
8MA490
75 to 100
100 to 160
160 to 200
~ 16
16 to 40
8M520
Tensile yield
N/mm2
Compressive on
yield strength
N/mm.2
2:245
2:235
2:215
2:245
2:235
2:215
141
136
124
368
353
323
2:205
;:::245
2:205
2:245
118
141
308
368
2:235
2:235
2: 215
2: 215
2: 215
2: 215
136
124
124
353
323
323
2:205
2:205
2: 195
118
2: 325
2: 315
2:295
2:295
2:285
188
308
293
488
182
170
170
473
443
443
165
159
428
413
211
205
193
548
533
strength
2: 195
2: 325
2: 315
2:295
2:295
2:285
2:275
2: 365
2: 355
N/mm.2
~335
~335
2: 325
:::: 305
2:295
;:::365
2:295
2: 365
~355
~355
400to 510
400to 510
(to 540) 'l
490to 610
503
488
458
443
188
176
170
211
205
40 to 75
2:335
2: 335
75 to 100
:2:325
2: 325
"'l:The figure within parentheses () shows the value for SMA400.
Tensile strength
N/mm2
N/mm2
113
2:275
2: 365
2:355
2: 325
;:::305
490 to 610
548
533
503
488
193
188
520to 720
(b) The van Mises yield criteria are used to calculate the shear yield strength.
(c) When the contact mechanism between two steel is a flat surface against a flat surface including cylindrical
surfaces and curved surfaces that are nearly flat, the bearing yield strength may be taken as 50% more than the
tensile yield stress. If necessary, when there is a very small contact surface between a spherical surface or a
cylindrical surface, and a flat surface, it is possible to use the Hertz formula in the Specification for Highway
Bridges.7>
@ Characteristic values for steel pile and steel pipe sheet pile
(a) As characteristic values of yield stress for steel pile and steel pipe sheet pile, generally the values of Table
2.2.3 can be used, based on the types of steels and stresses.>
Table 2.2.3 Characteristic Values of Yield Strength for Steel Pile and Steel Pipe Sheet Pile {JIS) BJ
{N/mm2)
ade
Typ
Axial tensile stress (per net cross-sectiooal area)
Bending tensile stress (per net cross-sectional area)
Bending compression stress (per total cross-sectional area)
Shear stress (per total cross-sectional area)
SKK400
SHK400
SHK400M
SKY400
235
235
235
136
SKK490
SHK490M
SKY490
315
315
315
182
(b) When it is necessary to combine the axial stress and shear stress, yield strength may be determined by
referencing the to Specifications for Highway Bridges.)
(c) Buckling strength depends on the condition ofthe member and is specified appropriately during the verificatioo
of facility.
-329-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Steel
Tune of stress
Bending tensile stress (per net cross-sectional area)
Bending compression stress (per total cross-sectional area)
Shearing stress (per total cross-sectional area)
SY295
SY390
295
295
170
390
390
225
(a) As characteristic values of yield strength fur cast and furged structures, generally the values of Table 2.2.5
can be used, based on the types of steels and stresses.Ill
Table 2.2.5 Yield Strength for Cast and Forged Structures (JIS) 111
(N/mm')
~el
ial
Type of strength
Axial tensile strength
(per net cross-sectional area)
Axial compression strength
Iner total cross-sectional area)
Bending tensile strength
Iner net cross-sectional area)
Bending compression strength
(per total cross-sectional area)
Shearing strength
(per total cross-sectional area)
Forged steel
Cast
steel
Cast iron
machine structures
SF490A
SF540A
SC450
S30CN
S35CN
FC150
FC250
245
275
225
275
305
70
105
245
275
225
275
305
140
210
245
275
225
275
305
70
105
245
275
225
275
305
140
210
141
159
130
159
178
54
88
(b) When calculations are performed with the Hertz formula, the method of calculating the bearing yield strength
follows the Highway Bridge Specifications and Commentary.12)
@ Yield strength for welded portions and steel materials used for joining
(a) As characteristic values of yield strength for welded portions, the values in Table 2.2.6 can be referred, based
on the types of steels and strength. When joining steel of different strengths generally the value for the steel
with lower strength shall be used.
Table 2.2.6 Characteristic Values of Yield Strength for Welded Portions (JIS)
(N/mm')
Type of welding
~I
SM400
SMA400
SM490
SM490Y
SM520
SMA490
SM570
SMA570
"I}'pe of streng
Compression
235
315
450
355
strength
Full penetration groove
welding
Tensile strength
235
315
450
355
Shop
Shearing strength
182
205
260
136
welding
Fillet welding, partial
penetration
groove Shearing strength
205
260
136
182
weldini?
l} As a rule, use the same values as for factory welding.
On-site welding
2) For steel oioe oile and steel nine sheet oile, use 90% of the factorv value.
(b) Technologies for on-site welding have improved, and adequate execution management and quality control have
been achieved on-site, so that on-site welding has attained the same management level as factory welding,
-330-
and therefore for yield strength it has been decided that one can take the same values fur on-site welding as
for factory welding can be taken, as specified in Specification for Highway Bridges 13). In locations where it
is difficult to verify that the environmental conditions are good for the welding of materials such as steel pipe
pile and steel pipe sheet pile, the yield strength for on-site welding can be taken to be 90% of the value for
factory welding.
(c) Table 2.2.7 lists the characteristic yield strength for anchor bolts and pins.
Table 2.2.7 Yield Strength for Anchor Bolts and Pins
(N/mm')
Type of steel
Type
I'IVne of stress
Anchor bolts
Pins
Shearing
Bending
Shearing
Bearing
SS400
S35CN
100
320
168
353
133
438
235
470
(d) It is assumed that the specified anchor bolts are used as embedded in concrete. Since construction using
anchor bolts can often be insecure, and it is necessary to maintain a strength balance with the concrete that
they support, the calculation of design values should sufficiently include an extra margin of safety.
(e) Since pins do not use bolt holes as in sheet or shaped steel, and usually do not use notches, there is no concern
that they will concentrate stress. Also, although pins are often verified for shear and bearing, their limit
values are not lowered for shear accompanied by sliding. With these considerations in mind, values for shear
yield strength are specified larger than the values listed in Table 2.2.2 and Table 2.2.S.
(f) Table 2.2.8 lists the characteristic yield strength for finished bolts.
Table 2.2.8 Yield Strength for Finished Bolts
(N/mm)
8.8
10.9
240
140
360
660
380
990
940
540
1410
fype of stress
Tensile
Shearing
Bearing
(!) Corrosion protection should be taken into consideration when using steel because of the harsh corrosive
environmental conditions. Severe localized corrosion occurs particularly in sections immediately below the mean
low water level and, therefore, appropriate measures should be taken.
(2) The distribution of corrosion rate with respect to the depth of steel driven into the sea generally is shown in Fig.
2.3.1. 16) The corrosion is particularly heavy in the splash zone, where the structure is exposed to sea water
splashes and there is an adequate supply of oxygen. In particular, the rate of corrosion is the highest in the section
immediately above the high water level.
Among the submerged sections in Fig. 2.3.1, the corrosion rate is the highest in the section immediately below
the intertidal zone. However, the corrosion rate in this section differs greatly depending on the environmental
conditions and the cross-sectional shape of the structure. In steel sheet piles and steel pipe pile structures
submerged in clean sea water, the corrosion rate in the section immediately below the mean low water level,
MLWL, is often not much different from that in submerged zone. Depending on the environmental conditions of
the structure, however, the corrosion rate in the section immediately below MLWL may be much larger than that
in the submerged zone, and in some cases may even exceed the value in the splash zone. This remarkable local
corrosion is called the concentrated corrosion.
(3) For all aspects of corrosion control, reference may be made to "Manual on Corrosion Prevention and Repair
for Port and Harbor Steel Structures (revised edition)" 15) published by the Coastal Development Institute of
Technology in Japan.
-331-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
I
Marine a1mospheric zone
----i
_ _ _ _5zone
Intertidal zone
------------------t
I
-corrosion rate
Fig_ 2.3.1 Distribution of Corrosion Rates of Steel Structures 1si
2.3.2 Corrosion Rates of Steel
(!)The corrosion rate of steel shall be determined as appropriate in view of the environmental conditions of the site
where structures are placed because the corrosion rate depends on the corrosive environmental conditions.
(2) The corrosion rate of steel used in port and harbor structures is influenced by the environmental conditions
including the weather conditions, the salinity and pollution level of the sea water, the existence of river water
inflow, etc. Therefore, the corrosion rate should be determined by referring to past cases in the vicinity and survey
results under similar conditions.
(3) The corrosion rate of steel should generally be determined by refurring to the standard values listed in Table 2.3.1,
which has been compiled on the basis of survey results on the existing steel structures. However, the values in
Table 2.3.1 are the average ones, and the actual corrosion rate may exceed them depending on the environmental
conditions of the steel material. Therefore, when determining the corrosion rate of steel, the results of corrosion
surveys under similar conditions should be referred to. It should also be noted that the values in Table 2.3.1 refer
to the corrosion rate for only one side of the steel section. Thus, when the both sides of steel section are subject
to corrosion, the sum of the corrosion rates of the both sides estimated on the basis of the values in Table 2.3.1
should be employed.
(4) The values for "HWL or higher" in Table 2.3.1 refer to the corrosion rate immediately above HWL. The corrosion
rate between the HWL and the seawater sections should be determined by refurring to actual corrosion rates in
the properties of sea water around the structures. This is because past corrosion surveys have shown that the
corrosion rate varies depending on the properties of sea water and the depth of water. The values in Table 2.3.1
are listed as references with a range of variation. In general, the corrosion in the intertidal zone should be dealt
with separately from that in the submerged zone because of the differences in the environmental conditions. The
appropriate boundary between them is around 1.0 m below LWL.
In cases of the concentrated corrosion, the corrosion rate greatly exceeds the values listed in Table 2.3.1, and
thus these values are not applicable to such cases.
(5) In oxygen-isolated spaces such as the inside of steel pipe piles, it may be assumed that corrosion cannot occur
because there is no supply of oxygen.
-332-
~
u
"'
i
]
....i
O.o3
0.1
O.o3
0.02
(6) Sand abrasion is a phenomenon in which the rust layer on the steel surface is removed by the movement of sand
to expose the bare steel and to result in increasing the corrosion rate.17> There are examples where steel sheet pile
was used as a sediment control groin aod the meao corrosion rate due to sand corrosion directly above the sand
surface was from 1.25 to 2.39 mm/year.IS) When the vertical motion of the sand surface is small, the sections of
abrasion are limited to areas immediately above the saod surface and so it is said that the corrosion rates become
larger in these sections.
(2) In the intertidal zone aod submerged zone, there is a risk of concentrated corrosion, depending on the corrosive
environmental conditions. Therefore, in principle, corrosion protection by means of the thickness allowance
should not be undertaken as a corrosion protection method for steel structures in Japao. However, in the case of
temporary structures, it is acceptable to employ the corrosion allowance method as corrosion prevention.
(3) The backfilling side of steel sheet pile has a slower corrosion rate than that of the seaward side, aod thus no
corrosion protection is required in particular. In cases where a strongly corrosive environment is conjectured
due to the influence of waste material in the backfill, however, surveys should be conducted in advance and
appropriate measures should be taken.
(4) For the most effi:ctive actual corrosion protection, the covering/coating method is used for sections above I m
below L.W.L., while cathodic protection is used for submerged sections below M.L.W.L and for sections in the
sea bottom soil, and their reliability has been verified. When the covering/coating method is used underwater it
is necessary to pay attention to durability when selecting the covering/coating material and to watch for damage,
such as during construction or from collisions with driftwood. In cases where the covering/coating is used both in
the air over the sea and in sections within the water, while the cathodic protection is used in the sea bottom soil, if
a margin to estimate the degradation and damage ofthe covering/coating material is specified for the perforroaoce
verification of the cathodic protection and then cathodic protection can compensate the degraded and damaged
parts of the portions that use covering/coating protection.
CD
The range of application of the cathodic protection shall in principle be at or below M.L.W.L.
@ Above the MLWL, corrosion control must be carried out by covering/coating. The zone between M.L.W.L aod
the L.W.L. is submerged for a shorter time than that below L.W.L., aod thus the corrosion rate is slightly lower.
Also, because the sections immediately below L.W.L. are susceptible to corrosion, the covering/coating should
extend to a certain depth below L.W.L. aod should be combined with the cathodic protection.
@ During port construction there may be a period with no corrosion protection after steel pipe pile aod steel sheet
pile have been driven in aod before the superstructure has been constructed, aod there may be periods of no
corrosion protection when the anodes used for cathodic protection are replaced. During such periods of no
corrosion protection the steel may have been exposed to concentrated corrosion, so sufficient care should be
taken.
-333-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ As listed in Table 2.3.2, the effect of the cathodic protection, the corrosion rate increases when the period of
immersion of the steel subject to corrosion in sea water is longer and decreases when it is shorter. The seawater
immersion ratio and the corrosion rate are expressed in equation (2.3.4) and (2.4.5), respectively.
(2.3.4)
Mass reduction of unelectrified test piece - Mass reduction of electrified test piece x
(%)
100
Mass reduction of unelectrified test piece
(2.3.5)
Table 2.3.2 Corrosion Control Ratio of the Cathodic Protection Method
Seawater innnersion ratio("/o)
below40%
equal to or greater than 40 % but below 80 %
equal to or greater than 80 % but below I 00 %
below40%
equal to or greater than 40 % but below 60 %
equal to or greater than 60 % but below 90 %
100%
equal to 90 % or over
@ In general, 90% is used for the standard corrosion efficiency rate for the area below M.L.W.L.
@ The cathodic protection is divided into a galvanic anode method and a impressed current method. Under the
galvanic anodes method, aluminum (AI), magnesium (Mg), zinc (Zn) and other alloy are electrically connected
to the steel structure and the electric current generated by the difference in potential between the two metals
is used as a corrosion protection current. This method is applied almost universally in cathodic protection of
port steel structures in Japan, mainly because of ease of maintenance. The characteristics of the galvanic anode
materials are listed in Table 2.3.3. Aluminum alloy anodes offer the highest flux of current generated per unit
of mass, are outstandingly economical, and are suited to both the seawater zone and seabed environments.
Therefore, aluminum alloy anodes are most commonly used for port steel structures.
Under the impressed current method, an electrode is connected to the positive pole of an external DC power
source and the steel structure is connected to the negative pole. Then a protective current is applied towards the
steel structure from the current electrode. In sea water, a platinum or oxide coating electrode is often used as
the working electrode. Since the output voltage can be arbitrary adjusted with the impressed current method,
it can be applied to the environments featuring pronounced fluctuations such as strong currents or the inflow of
river water, and the places where a fine potential control is required.
Table 2.3.3 Characteristics of Galvanic Anode Materials
Characteristics
Al-Zn-In
Specific gravity
Open circuit anode voltage (V) (SCE)
Effective voltage to iron (V)
Theoretical generated electricity flux (Ah/g)
2.6-2.8
1.08
0.25
2.87
In seawater with
lmAfcm2
2.30
3.8
2.60
3.4
1.86*
4.71
>
Pure Zn, Zn
Mg-Mn
Mg-6Al-3Zn
7.14
1.03
0.20
0.82
1.74
1.56
0.75
2.20
1.77
1.48
0.65
2.21
0.78
11.8
1.10
8.0
1.22
7.2
0.53
16.5
0.88
10.0
1.11
7.9
alloy
(J) In the galvanic anode method, the attachment of the anode to the steel material is usually accomplished by
underwater welding. There have been reports on the steel sheet pile quaywalls where the underlying soil became
liquefied during an earthquake so that an excessive amount of soil pressure acted upon the steel sheet pile and the
portion that had been welded underwater suffered brittle fracture.15l Therefore, preventative measures should
be applied, such as (1) modifying the chemical composition of steel sheet pile to adapt it to underwater welding,
or (2) before driving in the sheet pile, while still on land, welding a cover plate of steel appropriate for welding
to the portion where the anode will be attached, and then welding the anode to the cover plate underwater.
-334-
CD
In general, the protective potential of port steel structures shall be -780 mV vs. Ag/AgClc,...,J electrode.
@ When applying a protective current through a steel structure by the cathodic protection technique, the potential
of the steel structure gradually shifts to a low level. When it reaches a certain potential, corrosion is to be
protected. This potential is known as the protective potential.
@ To measure the potential of steel structures, an electrode that indicates stable reference values even in the
different environmental conditions should be used as the reference. The electrode that provides the standard
value is known as the reference electrode. In seawater, in addition to the Ag/AgCI electrode, the saturated
mercurous chloride electrode and the saturated copper sulfate electrode are sometimes used. The value of the
protective potential differs depending on the reference electrode used for measurement, as in the following:
Seawater-silver/silver-chloride electrode;
Saturated mercurous chloride electrode;
Saturated copper sulfate electrode;
-780mV
-770mV
-850mV
@ When combining the covering/coating and cathodic protection methods, particularly with the impressed current
method, care should be taken not to let the coating film deteriorate due to excessive current. The potential in
this case should ideally be -800 to -1,100 mV vs. Ag/AgCI electrode.
(3) Protective Current Density
CD
Protective current density shall be set to an appropriate value because it varies greatly depending on the marine
environment.
@ When applying the cathodic protection, a certain current density per unit surface area of the steel is needed in
order to polarize the potential of the steel to a more base value than the protective potential. This density is
known as the protective current density. The value ofthis protective current density decreases with the elapse of
time from the initial value at the start of cathodic protection, and finally reaches a constant value. The constant
value is around 40% to 50% of the initial value.
The protective current density varies with temperature, currents, waves, and water quality. Where there is
an inflow of river water or various discharges, or where there is a high concentration of sulfides, the required
protective current generally increases. Also, where the water current is fast, the required protective current
increases. When verifying performance, the performance ofthe existing facilities in the area should be referred
to for characteristic value settings.
@ The protective current density at the start of cathodic protection should be based on the standard values listed in
Table 2.3.4 for the bare steel surface in normal sea conditions.
@ As the duration of protection goes on, the generated current weakens. Therefore, the average generated current
density for calculating the life time of the anode is often taken as the following, depending on the duration of
protection:
When protected for 5 years;
When protected for 10 years;
When protected for 15 years;
If the protection is intended to last for more than 15 years, the value for 15 years should be applied.
@ If a portion covered with protective material exists within the range of application of cathodic protection, the
value of the protective current density should be set by assuming a certain rate of damage to the covering/
coating material. In seawater the following values may be set:
Paint;
Concrete;
20 +100 S (mA/m2)
10 +100 S (mAfm2)
Organic coating; 100 S (mA/m2)
where S is the rate of damage defined as the ratio of assumed damaged covered area to the total covered
area.
However, if the protective current density obtained from the above equation exceeds the values indicated in
@ values in Table 2.3.4 may be employed.
-335-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 2.3.4 Protective Current Density at Start of Cathodic Protection (mA/m2)
In seawater
In rubble mound
In soil (below seabed)
In soil (above seabed)
>
100
50
20
10
130-150
65-75
26-30
10
@ In steel sheet pile revetments in shallow sea areas, the covering/coating method is sometimes applied to the
whole length of the structure depthwise. By combining the cathodic protection and covering/coating methods
in sea water sections, the life of the galvanic anode may be extended)')
(2) Applicable Methods
CD
The covering/coating method applied to port steel structures shall be one of the following four methods:
(a) Painting
(b) Organic covering/coating
(c) Petrolatum covering/coating
(d) Inorganic covering/coating
@ The covering/coating protection method basically controls corrosion by blocking the covered/coated material
from corrosive environmental factors. The applicable range for the covering/coating protection method depends
on the type, so that there are some methods that apply mainly to the intertidal zone, the splash zone, and the
atmospheric zone, and there are other methods that apply in the seawater. In the seawater, the covering/coating
method may be used together with the cathodic corrosion protection, or coating corrosion protection may be
used alone. Moreover, some methods are only applicable to new facilities and other methods are applicable to
not only new facilities but also existing facilities.
(3) Selection of Methods
When selecting the covering/coating protection method and determining the specification it is necessary to
investigate each of the following items:
(a) Environmental conditions
(b) Range of corrosion protection
(c) Design working life
(d) Maintenance plan
(e) Construction conditions
-336-
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
Japan Standard Association: JIS Handbook, Iron and Steel I, II, Japan Industrial Standards, 2002
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. II, Steel Bridge, p. 111, 2004
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. II, Steel Bridge, p. 153, 2004
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. I, General, p.p. 59, pp. 82, 2004
JSCE: Standard Specifications for Concrete Structures, Structural performance verification, pp.38-44, 2002
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. II, Steel Bridge, p. 116, 2004
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. II, Steel Bridge, p.136-141, 2004
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. I, General, p.p. 71, 2004
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. II, Steel Bridge, p. 151-180, 2004
Japan Standard Association : JIS Handbook, Iron and Steel Part I and II, Japan Standard, 2002
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. I, General, p. 73, 2007
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. II, Steel Bridge, p.136-141, 2004
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. I, General, 2004
Japan Standard Association : JIS Handbook, Screw Part I, Japan Standard, 2002
Coastal Developmentlnstitute ofTechnology: Manual for corrosion protection and maintemmce work for port steel facilities,
iron slug hydration hardener (revised Edition), 200,
16) H.A. Humble: The cathodic protection of steel piling in seawater, Corrosion, Vol.5 No.9, p.292, 1949
17) Abe, M., T. Fukute, K. Shimizu and I. Yamamoto: Effect of cathodic corrosion protection against sand erosion in wavy sea
area., Proceeding of 42nd open forum on corrosion and corrosion protection, C-203,pp.371-374,1995
18) C. W. Ross: Deterioration of steel sheet pile groins at Palm Beach, Florida, Corrosion, Vol.5 No.10, pp.339-342,1949
-337-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
3 Concrete
3.1 Materials of Concrete
The constituent materials of concrete and their special care taken for port facilities are as follows;
(!)Cement
(2) Water
(3) Additive agent
(4) Admixture
(5) Aggregate
(6) Initial Chloride Ion Content
To reduce the risk of corrosion of steel inside the concrete, the amount of chloride ion contained in fresh concrete
should be no more than 0.30 kg/m'.
@ Methods that use aggregates known to be safe against alkali aggregate reaction
(8) Of the various types of cement, those having good seawater resistance characteristics are said to be the moderate
heat portland cement, blast-furnace slag cement, and fly ash cement. The advantages of these types of cement are
that they have excellent performance in durability against seawater, greatly promote long-term strength, and have
low hydration heat. However, they also have the disadvantage as relatively low initial strength. Therefore, when
using these types of cement, all due care needs to be given to initial curing.
The anti-corrosion properties of steel reinforcement in concrete produced with type B blast furnace slag
cement is better than concrete made with ordinary Portland cement I).
In this case, it is important to perform a sufficient initial care of concrete.
(9) Seawater must not be used as mixing water for reinforced concrete. It may be used for non-reinforced concrete
only when it is difficult to obtain clean freshwater.
One must note that, when seawater is used, the setting time of the cement becomes short, so the concrete tends
to lose its consistency at an early stage. In such cases a retarder may be used as necessary.
Q) For the characteristic values of concrete strength of an ordinary concrete to be used in the performance
verification of the main structural members of port facilities, it is usually possible to use the values given in
Table 3.2.1 as standard values.
Table 3.2.1 Standard Characteristic Values of Concrete Strength of Ordinary Concrete
Concrete type
Non-reinforced concrete
Reinforced concrete
Concrete for apron pavement
-338-
For reinforced concrete, in cases when the maximum water-to-cement ratio is specified as 50% or lower in
consideration of durability, 30 N/mm2 may be used as the characteristic value for the compression strength.
For concrete lids of non-reinforced concrete, in cases where there is a risk of wave impact or submerging in the
early stage after concrete placement, or when construction is done in a cold climate, a characteristic value of24
N/mm2 may be used for the compression strength. For large, deformed blocks of non-reinforced concrete it is
possible to specify the characteristic value based on the conditions, such as using 21 N/mm2 as the characteristic
value for compression strength for types from 35t to sot of their nominal weights.
@ Characteristic values for the bond strength of ordinary concrete in the performance verification can be
calculated from equation (3.2.1).2)
213
(3.2.1)
where
Ibo;
h,
Equation (3.2.1) applies to the use of deformed reinforcing bar conformed to JIS G 3112, Steel Bar for
Reinforced Concrete. When ordinary round steel bars are used, values that are 40% of the values calculated
from equation (3.2.1) may be used under the condition of providing semicircular hooks on the edges of the
reinforcement.
(4) Mixture conditions for concrete must be specified appropriately in consideration of durability. Table 3.2.2, which
provides standard mixture conditions for each type of structural member, is based upon verification results of
the existing concrete structures in ports and upon research results and technical knowledge on the durability of
concrete that is affected by seawater, and may be used as a reference. For the structural members for which there
have been loss in performance by chloride attack, such as the superstructures of piers, it is necessary to examine
durability, changes in performance over time, and appropriately specify the mixture conditions in order to achieve
the desired performance for the facility. Such examinations may refer to Part III, Chapter 2, 1.1.5, Examination
on Change in Performance Over Time, and Part ill, Chapter S, S.2, Open-type Wharf on Vertical Piles.
Table 3.2.2 Reference for Concrete Mixture Conditions based on the Type of Structural Member
Type
Mixture conditions
Maximum water-to-cement ratio (%)
Regions where the
Regions where
temperature rarely
freeziog and thawiog
goes below the
repeatedly occurs
Maximum
size of coarse
aggregate
Nonreinforced
concrete
Reinforced
concrete
60
65
65
40
60
65
20,25,40
50
50
20,25,40
Wave-dissipatiog block
Anchor wall,
superstructure of anchor piles
Concrete for apron pavement
55
55
20, 25 40
60
60
20,25,40
25 (20)'2), 40
(5) Concrete must have the best consistency sufficient for its working conditions. As a rule, AE concrete shall be used
when there are no special requirements, usually with an air content of 4.5%. In cold areas where there is a risk of
frost damage the air content must be appropriately specified.
(6) Recently, a high performance concrete with self-compacting characteristics has been developed.'), 4) Its
characteristics have been materialized through its high fluidity and outstanding resistance to material segregation
by the combined use of appropriate admixtures. The use of this high-performance concrete makes it possible to
place concrete into sections such as in congested reinforced sections or in spaces enclosed by steel shells in which
-339-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
concrete placing have been difficult by using ordinary concrete .
(7) Construction Joints
In case of port facilities, damage often arises from joints in the concrete.5J Therefure, construction joints should
be avoided as much as possible. When joints are inevitable in view of shrinkage of the concrete or the conditions
of construction, necessary measures should be taken on the joints. 6)
(8) Surface Protection
For facilities that experience harsh conditions such as abrasion or impact, such as from flowing water that contains
sand particles or from waves that contain pebbles, it is necessary to protect the surfaces with appropriate materials,
or to increase the material's cross-section or the concrete cover to reinforcement. Surface protection materials
include surface coatings that use timber, high quality stone, steel materials, or polymer materials, and also include
polymer-impregnated concrete.
(9) Structural Types
It is known that there is a close connection between the structural type of a facility and the occurrence of chlorideinduced deterioration. As far as the type of member is concerned, beams and slabs are more sensitive to chlorideinduced deterioration than are columns and walls. Chloride ions, oxygen, and water cause deterioration when they
penetrate through the concrete surface, so it is preferable to make the area of the concrete surface of a member
as small as possible. For example, it is easier to decrease the concrete surface area by using box-shaped beams
and slabs than by using T-shaped beams and I-shaped beams, and this is desired from the viewpoint of durability.
Assuming that there will be degradation, an additional consideration is to select structural types that permit easy
repair, strengthening, or replacement.
-340-
References
1)
Fukute, T., K. Yamamoto and H. Hamada: A study of the durability of offshore concrete mixed with sea water, Report of
PHRI, Vol.29, No. 3, 1990
2)
JSCE: Standard Specifications for Concrete Structures, Structural performance verification, 2002
3)
Fukute T., H. Hamada, K. Miura, K. Sano, A. Moriwake and K. Hamazaki: Applicability of super-workable concrete using
viscous agent to densely reinforced concrete members, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 33 No. 2, pp. 231-257, 1994
Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): High-fluidity Concrete Manual for Port Facilities, 1997
4)
5)
6)
1)
8)
9)
Seki, H., Y. OnoderaandH. Maruyama: Deterioration ofPlain Concrete for Coastal Structures Under Maritime Environments,
Technical Note of PHRI, No. 142, 1972
Otsuki, N., M. Harashige and H. Hamada: Test on the Effects of Joints on the Durability of Concrete in Marine Environment
(after 10 years' exposure), Technical Note of PHRI, No.606,1988
JSCE: Standard Specifications for Concrete Structures, Construction, 2002
Japan Port Association: Standard Specifications for Port Construction Work, Japan Port Association, 2005
Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CD!l)and Japanese Institute of Technology on Fishing Ports, Grounds and
Communities: Manual for non-disjunction underwater concrete, (Design and construction), 1989
10) JSCE: Guideline for design and construction of unti-segregation concrete in underwater (Draft), JSCE Concrete Library,
No.67, 1991
11) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CD!l): Manual for sealing concrete construction with vibrator (for immersed
tunnel element of steel and concrete sandwich structure), 2004
12) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Technical Manual for PC sheet pile for port construction work, 2000.
13) Japan Road Association: Specifications and commentary for Highway Bridges Vol. IV, Substructures, pp.418-424,2002
-341-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
4 Bituminous Materials
4.1 General
(1) Bituminous materials used in port facilities shall satisfy the required quality and performance required to achieve
the performance requirement offacilities. These shall include elasticity, cohesion, impermeability, waterproofness,
durability, and weatherproofness.
(2) Bituminous materials are rarely used alone. Asphalt, for example, is usually mixed with aggregate and used as
an asphalt mixture in asphalt concrete for pavement, asphalt mats, sand mastic asphalt, and asphalt stabilization.
The type and mix proportion of asphalt depend on its use. Therefore, it is important to select a material that will
meet the required objective.
(1) Asphalt mats shall have an appropriate structure in consideration ofthe required strength, durability, and workability
based on the purpose of their use, the location of their use, and the environmental conditions of the site.
(2) Asphalt mats are made by embedding reinforcement material and wire rope for suspension into a compound
material mixed from asphalt, limestone filler, sand and crushed stone. They are then formed into a mat-shape (see
Fig. 4.2.1).
Annealed
y steel wire --i
Steel
bands
Reinforcement
core material
Anti-slip bracket
Asphalt compound material
Wire rope
(3) Types of asphalt mats include friction enhancement mats that increase the sliding resistance of gravity type
structure walls, scouring prevention mats that prevent the scouring of structural foundations, and sand
washing out prevention mats that prevent the washing out of foundation sand mound and backfilling sand from
revetments. When asphalt mats are used sufficient care should be given to their quality, long-term durability, and
constructability, based on the purpose of their use, the location of their use, and the environmental conditions of
the site. In particular, when there are special environmental conditions such as cold regions, subtropical regions,
or tidal zones, one must consider the harsh environmental conditions with regard to long-term durability, 1), 2) and
careful studies should be made, including the determination of appropriateness.
4.2.2 Materials
(1) Asphalt mat materials shall be selected as appropriate to yield the required strength and durability.
(2) The following materials can be used in asphalt mats:
CD
Asphalt
@Sand
@Filler
Crushed Stone
-342-
Material
Asphalt
Dust
Fine aggregate
Coarse aggregate
Ratio by mass(%)
Friction enhancement mat Scouring prevention mat
10-14
14-25
20-50
30-50
10-14
14-25
30-50
25-40
5)
(2) Aprons are an example of the "areas subject to special load conditions". Traffic on pavements particularly apron
paving in port areas, unlike that on roads in city areas, almost invariably involves heavy vehicles. This includes
heavy machinery with large contact pressure. This type ofload rarely travels at high speed and is almost always
stationary or moving at low speeds. Parts of these paved areas are also used for cargo stacking. Thus, when
considering the paving materials to be applied to such areas, care should be taken to the fact that bituminous
materials are susceptible to static loading. Part m, Chapter 5, 9.14. Aprons can be used as a reference.
(3) Guss asphalt paving has the properties of being non-permeable and of following deflection well, so it is often used
for steel floor slab paving and bridge surface paving.
4.4.2 Materials
(!) Materials for sand mastic asphalt shall be selected as appropriate to meet the required strength and durability.
(2) For example, the following can be used as sand mastic materials:
CD
Asphalt
@Sand
@Filler
(3) Asphalt that is used as sand mastic in underwater construction 6), 7) should have sufficient fluidity so that, if it is
flowed down, the rubble is completely filled in with no pores.
-343-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(4) With regard to the effect of sand on mixtures, the larger the sand grains the greater is the fluidity of the mixture,
and although a certain amount of fluidity can be obtained with a small amount of asphalt the mixture readily
segregates. The smaller the grain size the less fluidity there is, creating a dense sand mastic. Therefore, it is
preferable that the sand grain sizes be continuous, where the grain-size curve changes smoothly, so that the
mixture does not segregate.
(5) When filler is mixed into asphalt mixtures, it mixes with the asphalt to fill in the spaces among the aggregate while
simultaneously working as a binding agent to decrease the fluidity of the mixture, thus increasing the viscosity
and stability. Asphalt usually adheres well to filler that is slightly alkali, so it is possible to use filler made from
slightly alkali lime powder.
4.4.3 Mix Proportion
(!) The mix proportion shall be determined through mixing tests to obtain the required :fluidity and strength in view
of the work and natural conditions.
(2) General
The values listed in Table 4.4.1 are commonly used as the mix proportion fur sand mastic asphalt applied
underwater.
Table 4.4.1 Standard Proportion for Sand Mastic Asphalt Mix
Prnnortion bv mass(%)
Material
Asphalt
Dust
Fine aggregate
16-20
18-25
55-66
Q) It should not be used in locations directly affected by powerful impulsive wave pressure or drifting objects.
@ It should not be used in locations where rapid sedimentation is anticipated.
@ The gradient of the rubble surface where sand mastic is executed is preferably gentle than 1:1.3.
Suitable reinforcement should be used on the slope shoulder, slope toe, and the edges of the execution area.
@ The relationship between the design working life of port facilities and the durability of the sand mastic asphalt
should be fully taken into account.
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
Imoto, T., Y. Mizuno and K. Yano: Research on durability of asphalt mats employed in the gravity type port facilities,
Proceedings of Offshore Developmeot, JSCE, to utilized to Survey Vol.5,pp.119-124,1989
Mizuno Y., M. Tokunaga, Y. Sugimoto, K. Murase and 0. Yasuda: Development and study of asphalt mats for friction
increase of gravity type of offshore structures in cold sea area, Proceedings of Offs shore Development Vol. 8, pp. 171-176,
1992
Kataoka, S., K. Nishi, M. Yazima and 0. Miura: Durability of asphalt mats placed under Caisson for friction increase,
Proceedings of 30th Conference on Coastal Eng, pp,643-647,1983
ltakura, T. and T. Sugahara: Recent Development of Asphalt utilization, Journal of Japanese Petroleum Institute Vol. 7, No.
8, p.9, 1964
Japao Road Association: Essential points of asphalt pavement, 1998
Study group for asphalt mixture for bydraulic structores: Asphalt mixture for hydraulic structures- materials, design aod
construction for field engineers-, Kajima Publishing, 1976
Kagawa, M. aod T. Kubo : Experimental study on stability of rubles poured sand mastic, Proceedings of 12th Confereoce on
Coastal Eng,. JSCE, 1965
-344-
5 Stone
5.1 General
(!) Stone shall be selected in view of the required quality and performance to suit its purpose and its cost.
(2) Generally, stone is used in large quantities for port facilities such as breakwaters and quaywalls. Selection of
stone materials has a major impact on the stability of the structure as well as the period and cost of construction.
(3) The types of stone mainly used in port construction and their physical properties are given in Table 5.1.1. It
should be borne in mind that the physical properties of stone of the same classification may differ depending on
the region and site of quarries.
Subclassification
Apparent density
(tlm')
Granite
Andesite
Basalt
Gabbro
Peridotite
Diabase
Tuff
Slate
Sandstone
Limestone
Chert
2.60-2.78
2.57-2.76
2.68 (absolute)
2.91 (absolute)
3.18
2.78-2.85
2.64
2.65-2.74
2.29-2.72
2.36-2.71
2.64
0.07-0.64
0.27- 1.12
1.85
0.21
0.16
0.008-0.03
0.16
0.08-1.37
0.04-3.65
0.18 -2.59
0.14
85-190
78-269
85
177
187
123 -182
377
59-185
48-1%
17-76
119
Homfels
2.68
0.22
191
Igneous rock
Sedimentary rock
Metamorphic rock
(4) "Rubble" used in ports and harbors has the equivalent performance to "riprap" prescribed by JIS A 5006.
(5) "Unscreened gravel" consists approximately half and half of sand and gravel.
(6) The slope gradient is the standard value of the natural gradient of backfilling materials executed in the sea.
Generally, a larger value is adopted when the effect of waves are small at the time of backfilling execution, and a
smaller value when the effect of waves are large.
(7) For steel slag, see 7.2 Slag.
-345-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 5.3.1 Characteristic Values for Backfilling Materials
Rubble
Ordinary type
Brittle tvne
Unit weight
Angle of shear Above residual water Below residual water
Slope gradient
resistance(0 )
level
level
(kN/m3)
(kN/m3)
40
18
10
1:1.2
16
1:1.2
35
9
Unscreened gravel
30
18
10
1:2-1:3
Cobblestone
35
18
10
1:2-1:3
(2) Normally, granular material, cement stabilized soil, or bituminous stabilized soil is used as a base course material.
Granular materials include crushed stone, steel slag, unscreened gravel, pit gravel, unscreened crushed stone,
crushed stone dust, and sand. These may be used on tbeir own or mixed witb otber granular materials.
(3) The base course serves to disperse tbe surcharge transmitted from above and to transfer it to tbe course bed.
Normally, it is divided into a lower base course and an upper base course. Materials used for tbe lower base course
are cheaper and have relatively small bearing capacity. The upper base course requires materials of good quality
witb large bearing capacity.
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
Shoj~ Y:. Study on shearing Properties of Rubbles with Large Scale Triaxial Compression Test, Rept. of PHRI Vol.22
No.4,1983
Mizukami, J. aod M. Kobayashi Soil Strength Characteristics of Rubble by Large Scale Triaxial Compression Test, Techoical
Note of PHRI No.699,p.20, 1991
Japan Road Association: Cement concrete pavement, Maruzen Publishing, 1997
Japan Road Associatioo: Essential points of asphalt pavement, 1998
-346-
6 Timber
6.1 General
Timber has the following characteristics in contrast to other construction materials. It is necessary to consider these
Bound water affects timber strength, but free water doesn't. As shown in the conceptual drawing of Fig.
6.2.1, the strength goes down as the bound water content increases from the oven dry condition to a water content
of 28%, the fiber saturation point, and the strength stays roughly the same when the water content increases
beyond the fiber saturation point and the free water increases. Under the meteorological conditions of Japan
the water content reaches equilibrium around 15%. Therefore, the standard strength characteristic values in
the Recommendation (Draft) are specified based on tests with a water content of 15%. The Recommendation
(Draft) defines constantly wet conditions to be usage environment I, intermittently wet conditions to be usage
environment II, and other environments to be usage environment III, and in usage environment I the standard
strength characteristic values are reduced by multiplication by a coefficient of0.7, while for usage environment II
they are reduced by a factor of 0.8. For port facilities all materials can be assumed to be in a wet condition, so it
is necessary to reduce the standard strength characteristic values by the coefficient for usage environment I or II.
-347-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
,s
" 1 ""'
....... _
:~------
iii
t o~~~~~~~~~~~~
U
15 28
With regard to dimensional changes of wood, expansion, or shirinkage, it is true again that bound water has
an effect but free water doesn't. The dimensions grow as the water content increases from the oven dry condition
to a water content of 28%, fiber saturation point, and the dimensions stay roughly the same as the water content
increases beyond the fiber saturation point and the free water increases. The dimensional change ratio varies
with the direction, where "direction tangential to the rings" > "direction radial with respect to the rings" "fiber
direction'', with a ratio of about 1 : 0.5 : 0.1. The total expansion ratio from the completely dry condition to the
fiber saturation point can reach about 6% for the direction tangential to the rings in Japanese cedar. In applications
where the water content below the fiber saturation point is expected to change it is necessary for the design to
consider dimensional changes from the beginning.
The specific gravity of wood varies greatly with the species and water content. In the air-dried condition,
water content 15%, the specific gravity is about 0.38 for Japanese cedar and about 0.53 for larch. For undried logs
immediately after felling and timber that is used underwater the water content may range from 800/o to 150%, so
the apparent specific gravity including the water would be as much as twice that in air dry. In the design of port
facilities it is customary to assume that the specific gravity of timber is 0.8, using a density of7.8 kN/m3, but it is
necessary to remember that the apparent specific gravity can vary greatly with species and water content, and not
to assume a specific gravity on the dangerous side.
(2) Continuous Loading Time
In the Recommendation (Draft), the relationship between continuous loading time and its effect on the influence
coefficients is given as in Fig. 6.2.2. When a load continues longer than 10 minutes, which is the standard loading
test time for wood, the standard strength characteristic value is to be multiplied by an influence coefficient for
the effect of the continuous loading time. Thus, for port facilities, it is necessary to specify continuous loading
times for such factors as the temporary loading time during construction and the long-term continuous loading
time after completion, and reduce the strength characteristic values by the influence coefficients for those effects.
1.1
110min:1.00
1
-~ 0.9
!!J
"
ii"
0
0.8
0.7
.
.9 0.6
""
""11 day:0.831
...._ 13 days:0.80
""
I '-- I
5o yrs: o.55
250 yrs: o.5o
0.5
0.00001 0.001
0.1
10
1000
Continuous loading time (Years)
-348-
6.3 Durability
Examples of degradation phenomena that occur when timber is used include discoloration, surface contamination,
morphology change, and reduction in strength. Whether these are considered as problems depends on the timber
application. Discoloration, surface contamination, and morphology change are problems in applications where
appearance is important, such as boardwalks and decks. While for construction materials that are out of sight, such as
pile, reduction in strength would be a problem.
In the air
Outdoor
In the ground
In fresh water
In the
seawater
Examples of
annlication
Residence
Outdoor
construction
Pile
River
facilities
Port facilities
Water content
condition
Drv
Wet
Dry
Wet
Wet
Saturated
Wet
Saturated
Wet
Saturated
Fungi, termites
None
Fungi
None
Architectural Institute of Japan: Recommendation for Limit State Design of Timber Structures (Draft), 2003
Japan Wood Preserving Association: Introduction for the preservation of wood 'Revised Edition'), 2001
Okada, K. Edition: Shipworm damage of wooden vessel and its countermeasures, Japan Society for the Promotion of science,
1958
Tsunoda, K. and Nishimoto, K.: Shipworm attack in the sea water log storage area and its prevention (3), Settlement season
of shipworm, Wood Industry Vol. 35, pp. 166-168, 1980
Yamada, M.: Durability Test of Untreated Wood and Wood-powder/plastic Composite in Marine Environment, Technical
Note of PAR! No.1045, 2003
Japan Wood Preservation Association: Maintenance Manual of wooden exterior structural materials, 2004
-349-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
7 Recyclable Materials
7.1 General
(!) Recyclable materials shall be used as appropriate in accordance with the characteristics of the materials and the
facilities.
(2) Recyclable materials in port construction include slag, coal ash, crushed concrete, dredged soil, and asphalt
concrete mass. Most of these can be used in landfill materials, sub-base course materials, soil improvement
materials, and concrete aggregate.
(3) Effective use of recyclable materials is extremely important. Port and harbor construction works use large
quantities of materials and it is, therefore, very important that they contribute to environmental conservation and
sustainable development by recycling and using fewer natural materials. We also need to undertake exhaustive
studies before using recycled materials to ensure that no environmental issues arise.
(4) The properties of recyclable materials are quite variable. Therefore, their physical and dynamic properties and the
volume to be supplied should be fully examined in advance to ensure the purpose of use.
7.2 Slag
(!) Slag includes ferro-slag, water granulated copper-slag, and ferronickel granulated slag
(2) Ferro-slag 2) is industrial waste generated in large quantities by the steel industry. It is broadly divided into blast
furnace slag and steel- making slag.
(3) Air-cooled blast furnace slag is a granular material mainly used as road construction material and has been
effectively utilized. Water granulated blast furnace slag is a lightweight sand-like material. As well as being used
as a raw material for blast furnace cement, it is also increasingly used as a backfilling material for ports facilities
and sand compaction material, in view of its lightness}), 4), 5)
(4) Because steel- slag causes expansion and disintegration when free lime reacts with water, in order to avoid adverse
effect, it is steam autoclaved and used as road and soil improvement materials.
Table 7.2.1 2) lists a comparison of chemical compositions of ferro-slag and ordinary earth materials. Table
7.2.2 lists the physical and dynamic properties of steel- slag and air-cooled blast-furnace slag.
Water granulated copper-slag is a sandy material obtained through high-speed cooling with water in the
copper refining process similar to the water granulated blast furnace slag. It has a higher particle density than
sand. Although it is susceptible to particle crushing, its angle of shear resistance and hydraulic conductivity are
about the same as those of beach sand. As well as being used for fine aggregate of concrete, sand mat and as a
filling material, it has been experimentally used in the sand compaction pile method. 6), 7)
Ferronickel granulated blast furnace slag is obtained during the manufacturing of ferronickel that is a raw
material for stainless steel. Its specific weigh is larger than that of sand, and has been used as a caisson filling
material.
Table 7.2.1 Chemical Compositions of Slag and Other Materials>
(Units:%)
Si02
Cao
Al20,
T-Fe
MgO
Blast furnace
slag
Converter
slag
33.8
42.0
14.4
0.3*
6.7
0.84
0.3
1.0
13.8
44.3
MnO
Ti02
Note) *: FeO,, ** : Fe,;<Ji, *** : SO:J
1.5
17.5
6.4
0.07
5.3
1.5
-350-
Andesite
Ordinary
Portland
cement
59.6
5.8
17.3
3.1'
2.8
0.2
0.8
22.0
64.2
5.5
3.o
1.5
2.0***
--------
Steel- slag
3.19-3.40
1.77-3.02
19.7-22.9
17.2-17.8
16.7-17.2
5.69-8.24
8.8-9.4
2.34-2.71
78-135
10-'-J0-3
2.18-2.21
170-204
10-'-J0-3
-
8.4-9.0
2.13-2.17
40-50
152-186
(5) Recently, hydration-hardened steel- slag is used as a civil engineering material for port facilities, such as for
deformed blocks, foot protection blocks, and dumping blocks. For details, one can refer to the HydrationHardened Steel-Slag Technical Mannal (Supplementary Edition).>
(2) When sandy dredged soil is used as reclaniation or backfill it may be statically stable but a ground forms that
liquefies extremely easily during ground motions, so some preventative measures are required against liquefaction.
Also, cohesive dredged soil becomes a very soft ground with a high water content, so soil improvement is required
after reclamation. In the past, one soil improvement method that has often been used is the installation of vertical
drains to promote consolidation after the surface layer hardens. In recent years methods of soil improvement have
been developed where dredged cohesive soil is first hardened and then used for reclamation or backfill. These
include the method that use special hardening treatment ship to mix the soil hardening agents and then use it as
reclamation, the method that mix the soil with hardening agents while it is being transported by barges and then
use it as reclamation, and the method that mix it with hardening agents on-site.
(3) Pneumatic flow mixing methods are hardening methods that have been newly developed in order to use dredged soil
more economically as a reclamation material. Such method add hardening agents while soil is being transported
by air pressure within a tube, and use unique mixing equipment to enhance the kneading effuct of the dredged
soil's plug current generated under the pressurized flow, so as to simultaneously transport and harden the dredged
soil. Proposed methods ofmixing with hardening agents include the method that pass the soil through line mixers,
the method that add and mix in powdered hardening agents, the method that first add in hardening agents and then
pass the soil through multiple curved tubes to enhance the kneading effect, and the method that provide pipes
at multiple places within the tubes to spray a hardening slurry so as to directly add the hardening agent into the
cohesive soil as it passes through the tube.
(4) Lightweight treated soil methods make dredged soil into a slurry with a water content at the liquid limit or higher,
then add in a cement hardener and a lightweight material such as foam or expanded beads. These methods have
the following characteristics:
CD
The dredged soil is used effectively, even underwater, to create a stable ground.
-351-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ The density is from 10 to 12 kN/m3, so this is effective in reducing the consolidation sedimentation of the
fuundation ground and in reducing the earth pressure.
@ The unconfined compressive strength is from 200 to 600 kN/mZ, with the same kind ofmechanical characteristics
as hard clay.
The cost of lightweight treated soil methods varies greatly depending on the scope of the project.
Besides these methods, there are also methods that perfurm dehydration at dredged soil dehydration plants to
prepare reclamation material.
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
Takahashi, K.: Utilization of Fly Ash and Steel Slug, Technical Note of PHRI, Technical Note of PHRI
Nippon Slag Association: Characteristics and versatility of slag, 1996
Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT) and Nippon Slag Association: Guideline for the utilization of granulated
blast furnace slag for port construction, 1989
Port and Airport Recycling Promotion Forum: Technical guideline for recycling technology in development of port and
airports, (http//:www.mlit.goJplkowan/recycle/),2004
Muraoka, T.: Report of test construction of Cellular type sea wall utilizing steel manufacture slag, Civil Engineering data,
Vol. 51, No. 7, 1996
Kitazume, MS. Miyajima and Y. Nishida: Loading test of back fill of SCP improved soil by copper granulated slag, Proceeding
the 50th Conference of JSCE, 1995
Kitazume, M. : E!Tuct of SCP improvement of soil by copper granulated slag on sheet pile sea wall, Proceeding of 31st
Confurence on Earthquake Engineering, 1996
Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Handbook of utilization of Eco-Slug for port construction work, CDIT, 2006
Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Manual for iron slug hydration hardener (enlarged Edition), 200,
Takahashi, K.: Geotechnical examination on improvement and replacement of port facilities, Soil and Foundation 43-2 (445),
Society of Soil Mechanics and Engineering Science,1995
Ban, K., J. Asano and K. Takahashi: Mix proportion of coal ash in deep mixing method and engineering characteristics of
improved soil, Proceeding of 50th Conference of JSCE, 1995
A. Watanabe, K. Takahashi and K. Azuma: Engineering Characteristics of Improved Soil by Deep Mixing Method Using
Coal Ash, 12th International Symposium, American Coal AsbAssosiation, 1997
Miura, M., K. Okuda, IL Kondo, K. Kawasaki and K. Suarni: Field experiments of sand compaction utilizing hardened coal
ash, Proceeding of 50th Confurence of JSCE, 1995
K. Okuda, H, Kondo and M. Miura: Utilization of Solidified Coal Ash as a Substitute for Sand and Stone,121h International
Symposium, American Coal Ash Assosiation,1997
Yokota, H. and S. Nakajima: Applicability of Recyclable Materials to Port and Harbour Construction, Technical Note of
PHRI No.824,1996
Tanaka, j., T. Fukude., H. Hamada and A. Dozono: A Study on the Properties of Concrete mixed with Crushed Concrete as
Aggregate, Rept. of PHRI Vol.36, No3,pp.37-60,1997
ltou, M., T. Fukude, T. Yarnaji and J. Tanaka: A Study on Applicability of Recycled Concrete to Marine Structures Vol. 37,
No.4, 1998
Mizukami, J., Y. Kikuchi and H. Yoshino: Characteristics of concrete debris as rubble in marine construction, Technical
Note of PHRI No.906, 1998
-352-
8 Other Materials
8.1 Plastic and Rubber
(!) When using plastics and rubbers, material shall be selected appropriately in view of the location and purpose of
CD
Geosynthetics
Geosynthetics is a general term that includes the geotextiles, namely polymer material products in the form of
permeable sheets, as well as geomernbranes, which are nonpermeable films.
@ Expanded polystyrene
This is used for buoys, pontoon floats, and other civil engineering structures, on account of its lightness.
Expanded polystyrene (EPS) blocks and EPS beads are used as civil engineering materials. Generally, EPS
blocks are used to reduce earth pressure, to counter settlement in embankments on soft ground, and to form
the foundations of temporary roads. EPS beads are mixed with cement or another cementing material together
with soils and used as a lightweight material in backfilling, in order to reduce settlement and earth pressure. 8)
(3) The standards for sand invasion prevention cloth and plate, and rubber mats normally used to prevent scouring,
piping or infiltation in port and harbor facilities are as follows:
CD
execution conditions.
Table 8.1.1 (a} Minimum Standards for Sand Invasion Prevention Sheets (Nonwoven}
Type
Nonwoven cloth
Thickness
4.2 mm or greater
Tensile strength
880N/5cmor
on:>ater
Elongation
60% or greater
Mass
500 g/m2 or
m"eater
Remarks
JIS L 1908
Note: The thickness of 4.2 mm or greater is applied for the cloth under loading of 2 kN/m2 according to IlS L 1908. With no loading, the
thickness should be 5 mm or greater.
-353-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 8.1.1 (b} Minimum Standards for Sand Invasion Prevention Sheets (Woven}
Type
Thickness
Tunsile strength
Elongation
Remarks
Woven cloth
0.47 mm or greater
15% or greater
JISL 1908
Particulars
Test item
Method
JIS K6723
Test sample No. 1 type dumbbell
JIS 6252
Test samnle uncut annle shane
JIS K6723
Tust samnle No. 1 '"""e dumbbell
Tensile strength
Tear strength
Elongation
Lateral
740N/cm or greater
Longitudinal
250 N or greater
Lateral
180% or greater
Lateral
90% or greater
Lateral
90% or greater
1.2-1.5
Longitudinal
30 N/cm or greater
Stripping strength
Standard values
Tensile direction
Test item
Tensile strength
Particulars
Method
Tensile direction
JISK6328
Standard value
4,400 N/3cm or greater
@ Rubber mats
Rubber mats used for enhancing friction may be made ofbrand-new or recycled rubber. The quality is commonly
as listed in Tables 8.1.4 and 8.1.5.
Table 8.1.4 Quality of Recycled Rubber
Test item
Tensile strength
Before aging Tear strength
Hardness
Elongation
Physical tests
Tensile strength
Tear strength
After aging Hardness
Elongation
Performance
4.9 MPa or greater
18 N/mm or greater
55-70 graduations
160% or greater
3.9 MPa or greater
Test conditions/method
JIS K6251
JIS K6252
JIS K6253
JIS K6251
JIS K6251 Aging tests are according
toJIS K6257
Within 8 of pre-aging value JIS K6253 Aging temperature 70 1
140% or greater
JIS K 6251 A1>ing time 96- 20 hours
-354-
Test item
Performance
Test conditions/method
IlSK6251
IlSK6252
IlSK6253
IlSK6251
IlS K 6251 Aging tests are according to
JISK6257
IlS K 6253 Aging temperature 70 1
IlS K 6251 Aging time 96- 20 hours
IlS K 6262 Aging temperature 70 1
A2in2 time 24-20 hours
Maintenance
(!) The grouting methods shall be selected by examining the site conditions and performed in consideration of the
(!) Grouting materials shall be selected in view of the required performance for the subsoils to be grouted.
(2) The basic properties required of grouting materials are the efficiency of seepage, filling and coagulation, the
strength and impermeability of the stabilized body. Suitability with the grouting object is particularly affucted by
the seepage efficiency of the material.
Fig. 8.3.1 shows the seepage limits ofvarious grouting materials for subsoils in view ofgrain-size distribution.
-355-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
%
100
--
Gravel
Sand
""""
'
90
Silt
Clav
80
70
Limits according
to Karon
60
50
40
30
1;!
"'
20
@!
10
20mm 10 5
1 0.5
@
~
.a
1~
"
II
Fig. 8.3.1 Seepage Limits of Grouting Materials for Subsoils in View of Grain-size Distribution l
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
-356-
Shimada, S.: The most advanced technology of chemical grouting method, Riko Tosho Publishing, ,p.161,1995
Japan Road Association: Guideline fur plant recycling of Pavement, 1992
Japao Road Association: Guideline fur surface recycling method (Draft), 1988
Japao Road Association: Guideline fur surface recycling method (Draft), 1987
Yokota, H. and S. Nakajima : Applicability of Recyclable Materials to Port aod Harbour Construction, Technical Note of
PHRI No.824,1996
20) Hashidate, Y., S. Fukuda, T. Okumura and M. Kobayashi: Engineering characteristics of saod containing oyster shells,
Proceedings of the 28th Conference of Soil Mechanics, pp.869-872,1992
21) Hashidate, Y., S. Fukuda, T. Okumura aod M. Kobayashi: Engineering characteristics of saod containing oyster shells aod
utilization for sand compaction piles, Proceedings of the 29th Conference of Soil Mechanics, pp.869-872,1994
22) Nishizuka, N.: Utilization of oyster shells for SCP method, Proceedings of 11th Conference of Port aod Harbour technology,
,pp.149-164, 1994
-357-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
9 Friction Coefficient
(!) For the friction coefficient of a material when the frictional resistance force against the sliding of a facility is
calculated, the static friction coefficient can be used. In this case the friction coefficient of the material should be
appropriately specified by considering factors such as the characteristics of the facility and the characteristics of
the material.
(2) For the characteristic values of the static friction coefficient for the performance verification of port facilities it is
generally possible to use the values given in Table 9.1. Consideration is needed as there usually is a large variation
when the friction coefficient is repeatedly measured under the same conditions. The values shown in Table 9.1
are kind of values used from the past experience, and if a value is not shown here then it is preferable to perform
experiments to determine it.
(3) The values shown in Table 9.1 are values used to verify the stability of facilities against sliding, and cannot
be used for purposes such as for determining the friction coefficient between the surface of a pile and the soil
when calculating the bearing capacity of a pile, or the friction coefficient for verifying the stability of a sloping
breakwater, or the friction coefficient used to calculate the launching of a caisson on slope, or the friction angle of
a wall to calculate earth pressure. The values shown in Table 9.1 are the static friction coefficients when a static
actions occur, but there are no appropriate references for when dynamic motions occur, such as through seismic
forces, so in fact these values are also used in such cases.
Table 9.1 Characteristic Values for the Static Friction Coefficient
0.5
0.5
0.7 to 0.8
0.6
0.8
0.75
Note 1: Under standard conditions the value 0.8 may be used for the case of underwater concrete and base rock. However. in situations such
as if the bedrock is brittle or has many cracks, or if there are places where the movement of the sand that covers the bedrock is
significant. the coefficient can be lowered under such conditions to about 0.7.
Note 2: Part III, Chapter 5, 2.2, Gravity-Type Quaywalls can be referred to for the friction coefficient in the performance
verification of cellular blocks.
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
Morihira, M., T. Kibara and H. Horikawa: Friction coefficient ofrubble mouod of composite breakwater, Proceedings of 25th
Conference on Coastal Eng., JSCE, pp,337-341,1978
Morihira, M. and K. Adachi: Friction coefficient of rubble mound of composite breakwater (Second report), Proceedings of
26th Confereoce on Coastal Eng., JSCE, pp.446-450,1979
Japan Society of Mechanical Engineers Edition: Handbook of mechanical Engineering
Ishii, Y. and T. Ishiguro : Steel pile metbod. Giho-do Publishing, 1959
Yokoyama, Y.: Design and construction of steel piles, Sankai-do Publishing, 1963
Japan Road Association: Eartb work for roads- guideline for construction of retaining wall, ,pp.20-21,1999
-358-
Kagawa, M. : Increase of friction coefficient of gravity structores, Proceedings of the 11th Conference on Coastal Eng. JSCE,
pp.217-221, 1964
Shinkai, E., 0. Kiyomiya aod Y. Kakizaki: friction coefficient of rubber mats for enlargement of friction, Proceedings of
52nd Cnnfurence of JSCE, pp.354-355,1997
Onodera, Y. aod Y. Aoki: A Study on the Coefficient of Friction between Prepacked Concrete aod Bedrock, Technical Note
of PHRI No.135, p. 8, 1972
-359-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-360-
Chapter 1 General
This Part describes items common to waterways and basins, protective facilities for harbors, mooring facilities, port
transportation facilities, cargo handling facilities, storage facilities, ship service facilities, and other port and harbor
facilities, and facilities which are subject to technical standards.
-363-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Structural Members Comprising the Facilities Subject to the Technical
Standards
Article 7
1 The performance requirements for structural members comprising the facilities subject to the Technical
Standards shall be such that the functions of the facilities concerned are not impaired and the continuous
use of them is not affected by damage due to the actions of self weight, earth pressure, water pressure,
variable waves, water currents, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, collision with floating objects, and/or
other actions in light of the conditions of the facilities concerned during construction and in service.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for the structural
members comprising the facilities of which there is a risk that damage may seriously affect human lives,
property, and/or socioeconomic activity following a disaster shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) In the event that the functions of the facilities concerned are impaired by damage due to tsunamis,
accidental waves, Level 2 earthquake ground motions, and other actions, the structural stability of
the facilities concerned shall not be affected significantly. Provided, however, that in the performance
requirements for the structural members comprising the facilities in which further improvement of
performance is necessary due to environmental conditions, social circumstances and other reasons
to which the facilities concerned are subjected, the damage due to said actions shall not affect the
restoration through minor repair works of the functions of the facilities.
(2) In the performance requirements for structural members comprising facilities which are required to
protect the landward side of the facilities concerned from tsunamis, the damage due to tsunamis, Level
2 earthquake ground motions, and/or other actions shall not affect restoration through minor repair
works of the functions of the facilities concerned.
3 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph 1, the performance requirements for the structural
members comprising high earthquake-resistance facilities shall be such that the damage due to Level 2
earthquake ground motions or other actions do not affect restoration through minor repair works of the
functions required of the facilities concerned in the aftermath of the occurrence of Level 2 earthquake
ground motions. Provided, however, that the structural members comprising the facilities in which higher
earthquake-resistant performance is required due to environmental conditions and social circumstances
surrounding the facilities concerned shall maintain the functions required of the facilities concerned in the
aftermath of the occurrence of Level 2 earthquake ground motions for the continuous use of the facilities
without impairing their functions.
4 In addition to the provisions of the preceding three paragraphs, necessary matters concerning the
performance requirements for the structural members comprising facilities subject to the Technical
Standards shall be provided by the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Structural Members Comprising the Facilities Subject to the Technical Standards
Article21
The items to be specified by the Public Notice under paragraph 4 of Article 7 of the Ministerial Ordinance
concerning the performance requirements of structural members comprising the facilities subject to the
Technical Standards shall be as provided in the subsequent article through Article 28.
Performance Criteria Common to Structural Members
Article22
1 The performance criteria common to structural members comprising the facilities subject to the Technical
Standards shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The structural members comprising the facilities of which damage may induce serious impact on
-364-
human lives, property, or socioeconomic activity shall contain the degree of the damage owing to
the accidental actions in the accidental action situation, of which the dominant actions are tsunamis,
accidental waves, or Level 2 earthquake ground motions, at the level equal to or less than the threshold
level corresponding to the performance requirements.
(2) The structural members comprising the facilities which are required to protect the landward side from
tsunamis shall contain the degree of the damage owing to the accidental actions in the accidental action
situation, of which the dominant actions are tsunamis or Level 2 earthquake ground motions, at the
level equal to or less than the threshold level.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for the structural
members comprising the high earthquake-resistance facilities shall be such that the degree of the damage
owing to the accidental actions in the accidental action situation, of which the dominant action is Level 2
earthquake ground motions, is contained at the level equal to or less than the threshold level corresponding
to the performance requirements.
3 In cases where the effects of scouring of the seabed and sand outflow on the integrity of structural members
may impair the stability of the facilities, appropriate countermeasures shall be taken.
[Technical Nole]
1.1 General
1.1.1 Basic Policy on Performance Verification
(1) This section describes verification of the structural performance of reinforced concrete members, prestressed
concrete members, and steel-concrete composite members. These provisions may also be applied to non-reinforced
concrete members and other similar members, considering their characteristics.
(2) Performance verification of structural members can be performed by substituting the limit state of the structural
members based on the performance criteria specified from the performance requirements in the facilities. In this
case, it may be generally performed by substituting either the ultimate limit state and the serviceability limit state,
or the fatigue limit state. These respective limit states are defined as follows.
Q) Limit state for cross-sectional failure due to maximum load (ultimate limit state).
@ Limit state for functional nonconforrnance due to actions that frequently occurs during the design working life
(serviceability limit state).
@ Limit state for failure due to repeated action acting during the design working life similar to the ultimate limit
state (fatigue limit state).
(3) When examining the safety of members by the limit state design method, it is necessary to set appropriate values
for the following five partial factors; namely, a material factor, a load factor, a structural analysis factor, a member
factor, and a structure factor, considering the characteristics of the facilities, the characteristics of the materials
(!) Examination of the ultimate limit state of cross-sectional failure can be performed by confirming that the value
obtained by multiplying the ratio of the design force resultant Sd to the design cross-sectional capacity 11,i by the
structure factor Y; is 1.0 or less, as below
r,Sd/Rd ,,;1.0
(1.1.1)
The design force resultant Sd can be obtained by calculating the force resultant S (S is a function of FdJ using
the design load F,,, and multiplying by structural analysis factor Ya.
sd = Lr.s(Fd)
(1.1.2)
The design cross-sectional resistance 11,i can be obtained by calculating the resistance R (Risa function ofjdJ
of the member cross section using the design strengthfa, and dividing by the member factor Yb as follows:
Rd =R(jd)/r,
(1.1.3)
-365-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Verification of the compressive stress of concrete in the permanent situation can be performed using Equation
(1.1.4).
(1.1.4)
where
u',
f,,
w
crack width (mm)
w a : limit value of crack width (mm)
@ The width w of a crack caused by bending can be calculated using equation (1.1.6).
(1.1.6)
where
k,=--+0.7
1:+20
coefficient expressing the influence of number of layers of tensile bars on crack width
k,
5(n+2)
7n+8
compressive strain for considering increase in crack width due to concrete shrinkage, creep,
etc. In general cases, on the order of 150x!O; in case of high strength concrete, a value around
IOOxIO- may be used.
tlse
@ The increment of reinforcing bar stress D'se can be obtained using equation (1.1.7), assuming the cross section is
in the elastic range.
=-dlffl
A,jd
(1.1.7)
where
-366-
@ In general, the limit values of the crack width are listed in Table 1.1.1 based on Standard Specifications for
Concrete Strnctures [Structural Performance Verification]. Provided, however, that the applicability of this
table shall be limited to concrete cover of IOOmm or less.
Table 1.1.1 Limit Values of Crack Width Caused by Bending
Wa
Environmental condition
Prestressing steel
0.0035c
Corrosion environment
0.004c
Ordinary environment
0.005c
0.004c
(c denotes for cover depth.)
Here, ''particularly severe corrosion environment" is applied in the case of exposure to severe marine
environments, for example, in the case of outside reinforcing bars of caissons and reinforcing bars on the
downside of pier superstructures. "Corrosion environment" can be applied to other cases than these, but
"ordinary environment" may also be applied in cases where pavement is laid, as in pier floor slabs, and a sealed
space, as in caisson compartments and the like.
@ Cracks in structural members due to causes other than the load acting on the structure, for example, cracks
originating in initial period defects, which do not close when the load is removed are excluded from application
of this method. Separate examination is necessary.
(3) Verification of Water-tightness
Wben water-tightness is required, verification can be performed using the crack width as an index. In this case, it
is necessary to specify the limit value of the crack width appropriately, considering the service conditions of the
facilities, the characteristics ofloads acting on the facilities, etc.
In general, the limit values presented in Table 1.1.2 can be used, based on the Standard Specifications for
Concrete Structures [Structural Performance Verification].
Table 1.1.2 Limit Value of Crack Width
Level of water-tightness requirement
Predominant
member force
Wa
for Water-tightness
High
Normal
Axial tension
-*1)
O.lmm
Flexural bending'2)
O.lmm
0.2mm
*1) Concrete stresses due to stress resultant should be in compression at whole area. Minimum compressive stress should be greater than
0.5N/mm2. In case that detailed analysis is carried out the value may be determined differently.
*2) Under the action of reversed cyclic loadings, the limit crack width should be determined in a manner similar to that under axial tension.
(4) In cases where the action of cargo handling equipment is comparatively large and deflection to an extent that will
hinder cargo handling can be expected, as in the superstructures of piers, a verification of serviceability shall be
made, using deflection as the index as necessary. The limit value of deflection in this case can be determined
referring to the performance of the crane and Specifications for Highway Bridges and Commentaries (Japan
Road Association).
-367-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
1.1.5 Examination of Change in Performance Over Time
(!) The performance possessed by structural members shall not fall below the required performance due to
deterioration of the materials or similar factors occurring during the design working lite. Therefore, it is generally
necessary to verify the following items with regard to concrete and reinforcing bars. In existing facilities with
a design working life of about 50 years, examination of changes in performance over time can be omitted for
facilities which show no remarkable reduction of performance due to deterioration caused by chloride attack
during the design working life, provided the facilities satisfy the following conditions.
CD
As the concrete cover for the outer side reinforcing bars (side in contact with sea water), a value equal to or
greater than the standard value for particularly severe corrosion environments specified in Table 1.1.4 shall be
set, and similarly, for the inner side reinforcing bars (side in contact with the filling), a value equal to or greater
than that for ordinary environments shall be set.
@ Concrete with the water-to-cement ratio specified in Table 3.2.2 of Part II, Chapter 11, 3.2 Concrete Quality
and Performance Characteristics shall be used as the maximum value.
CD
Verification of corrosion of reinforcing bar due to carbonation may be performed using equation (1.1.8).
(1.1.8)
where
y,=r"'ad,/i
(1.1.9)
where
y,b : partial factor considering deviation in the design carbonation yd. In general, 1.15 may be used.
design value of carbonation rate coefficient (mmy112)
ad=akPe'Yc
t : design working lite (y)
characteristic value of carbonation rate coefficient (mmy112)
ad
a, :
@ The characteristic value of the carbonation rate coefficient ad can be determined using Equation (1.1.10). The
predicted value of the carbonation rate of concrete shown here was obtained by regression equation 1) for
ordinary Portland cement or moderate heat Portland cement.
at =rpap
a, =-3.51+9.0W/B
(1.1.10)
where
safuty factor consider the accuracy of aP' In general, I.I may be used.
predicted value of carbonation rate coefficient of concrete (mmy112)
WIB: water-to-binder ratio of concrete
Yp
aP
@ The limit carbonation depth for reinforcing bar corrosion Yum can be obtained using Equation (1.1.11).
(1.1.11)
where
-368-
c, : remaining depth carbonation (mm). In general, 25mm should be used in marine environments.
(3) Corrosion of Reinforcing Bars due to Penetration of Chloride Ions
CD
The verification of reinforcing bar corrosion due to penetration of chloride ions can generally be performed
using Equation (1.1.12).
r,c,/c.,. ,;1.0
(1.1.12)
where
'Yi : structure factor
Cd : design value of chloride ion concentration at the position of reinforcing bar (kg!m')
Cum : limit value of chloride ion concentration for initiation of corrosion (kg!m')
In verification of reinforcing bar corrosion by chloride ions, setting of various limit states is conceivable;
here, however, the limit state is defined as the situation when corrosion of the reinforcing bars occurs,
considering a safety side assessment and the fact that a comparative assessment is possible at the current
technical level.
@ The design value of the chloride ion concentration at the position of the reinforcing bars Cd can be obtained
using Equation (1.2.13).
c = c [1-eif(~JJ
2,JD.;
0
(1.1.13)
where
C0
)=}; re-'
d7])
@ It is preferable to set the chloride ion concentration at the surface of the concrete C0 based on actual data
measured under the environmental conditions similar to those at the location where the structural member is
to be installed. In cases where the distance between the water level (H.W.L.) and the bottom surface of the
members of the concrete superstructure of an open-type wharf is on the order of 0-2.0m, C0 can be set using
equation (1.1.14), based on the measured data in Reference 2).
C0 =--{i.0x+15.1
where
C0
(1.1.14)
chloride ion concentration at the surface of concrete (kg!m'); it shall not be less than 6.0kg!m'.
: distance between H.W.L. and the bottom surface of the member (m)
Dd
Dd=r,n.+(;)(:.r Do
(1.1.15)
where
compressive strain for considering an increase in crack width due to concrete shrinkage and
creep, etc. It may be set in accordance with equation (1.1.6).
-369-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
When the concrete which will actually be used is known in advance, the characteristic value of the diffusion
coefficient for chloride ions Dk in concrete shall be set by the experiments 3) using specimens prepared from the
concrete. In other cases, D, may be set using equation (1.1.16).
=r,aD,
D,
When using ordinary Portland cement I)
logD,
(1.1.16)
=-3.9(w/c)' +7.2(w/c)-2.5
(1.1.17)
= -3.o(w/c)' +5.4(w/c)-2.2
(1.1.18)
where
a : adjusting factor; when using ordinary Portland cement, 0.65 may generally be used;
2)
when
using blast furnace cement or silica fume, 1.0 may generally be used.
Yp : partial factor considering the accuracy of Dp. In general, 1.0 may be used.
DP : predicted value of diffusion coefficient of concrete (cm2/y)
-370-
Partial factor
Ultimate limit
1.3
1.0
I.OS
Concrete
Material factor y111
limit
1.0
1.0
1.0
Fatigue limit
1.3
I.OS
I.OS
1.0-1.1
(0.9-1.0)
1.0
1.0
1.2
1.0
1.0
1.0-1.2
(0.8-1.0)
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.1-1.3
1.0-1.2
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
Variable action
Wave force
Load factor Yt
Note I) The figures in parentheses in the table shall be applied to cases where the small action results in the large risk.
Note 2) The values below may be used fur the member factor when examining the ultimate limit state.
When calculating flexual and axial capacity
1.1
When calculating upper limit of axial compressive capacity
1. 3
When calculating shear capacity borne by concrete
1.3
When calculating shear capacity borne by shear reinforcing bars
1.1
Note 3) The values below may be used for the structure factor relating to the ultimate limit state.
Superstructure of
OnAn-tvn.:>
wharf
Permanent
situation
1.2
I.I
1.0
1s1ab
Beam
Breakwater
Quaywall (caisson, etc.)
1.0
1.0
Variable situation
1.2
I.I
I.I
I.I
(only during
eartbquake: 1.0)
I.I
Accidental
situation
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
CD
The concrete cover secures the bond strength between reinforcing bars and concrete, which is a precondition
for verification of concrete structural members, and also has a large influence on durability. Accordingly, it
is necessary to set the concrete cover appropriately, considering the required durability, the functions of the
facilities, errors during construction work, etc.
@ The concrete cover should generally have values equal to or greater than those in Table 1.1.4. Provided, however,
that adequate consideration must be given to control of crack width when a concrete cover exceeds lOO:mm. In
performance verification, errors during construction work for the cover may not be considered subject to the
precondition on proper management and inspection during construction work.
Table 1.1.4 Standard Values of Concrete Cover
Environmental condition
Cover(mm)
70
Normal environment
50
-371-
Remarks
Parts in direct contact with sea water, and
parts washed with sea water,
narts ex.nosed to severe sea breeze
Parts other than the above
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ The concrete cover specified in Table 1.1.4 may be reduced provided adequate examination is performed, for
factory-manufactured concrete products.
(2) Other structural details may conform to the Standard Specifications for Concrete Structures [Structural
Performance Verification].
-372-
1. 2 Caissons
Public Notice
(2) For the outer walls of a caisson, the risk of impairing the integrity of the outer walls of the caisson
shall be equal to or less than the threshold level for a permanent action situation in which the dominant
action is the internal earth pressure and under the variable action situation in which the dominant
actions are variable waves, water pressure during floating, and Level 1 earthquake ground motions.
(3) For partition walls of a caisson, the risk of impairing the integrity of the partition walls of the caisson
shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the variable action situation in which the dominant
action is water pressure during installation.
(4) In the case of a caisson which requires flotation, the risk of overturning of the floating body during
flotation shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the variable action situation in which
the dominant action is water pressure.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Caissons
As the performance criteria of caissons and indexes corresponding to design situations, items which
require performance verification shall be set appropriately depending on the type of facilities.
<
1
5~
23
"
Design situation
Public Notice
~
<
1if
Performance
requirements
"
Situation
Dominating Non-dominating
action
Verification item
action
Cross-sectional failure
of bottom slab and
footing
Design cross-sectional
resistance (ultimate limit
state)
Serviceability of cross
section of bottom slab
andfuoting
Extrusion of bottom
slab and footing from
partition wall (yield of
reinforcing bars)
-373-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
accidental situations for the bottom slab and footing of caisson, those for the variable situation in
which the dominating action is variable waves are as shown in the Attached Table 5.
Attached Table 5 Performance Criteria and Setting of Design Situation {variable situation in which dominating action is
variable waves) for Bottom Slab and Footing of Caisson
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
~
"
<
} ~}
,!!
<
23
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Serviceability
,!!
Situation
Variable
Non-
Dominating
action
Verification item
dominating
action
Cross-sectional
water pressure, failure of bottom slab
sub-grade
and footing
reaction,
surcharge, earth
pressure
Extrusion of bottom
slab from partition
wall (yield of
reinforcing bars)
Variable
waves3)
footing
Fatigue failure of
bottom slab and
Cyclic action of
Design cross-sectional
resistance (ultimate limit
state)
Serviceability of
waves2)
footing
t): Here, among waves specified, Article 8, Paragraph 1.1 of the Public Notice, the waves shall be waves which are used in performance
verification of the structural stability of the objective facilities.
*2): Here, among the waves specified, Article 8, Paragraph 1.2 of the Public Notice, the wave having a height greater than the specified waves
which attack with a frequency on the order of 104 times during the design working life shall be used as a standard.
*3): Here, among the waves specified, Article 8, Paragraph 1.2 of the Public Notice, the waves shall be set appropriately depending on the
frequency of appearance in regard to wave height and wave period occurring during the design working life.
(c) Variable situations in which dominating action is water pressure during flotation and Level 1
earthquake ground motion
Among the performance criteria and indexes corresponding to design situations excluding
accidental situations for the bottom slab and footing of caisson, those for variable situations in which
the dominating actions are water pressure during flotation and Level 1 earthquake ground motion
are as shown in the Attached Table 6.
Attached Table 6 Performance Criteria and Setting of Design Situation {variable situations in which dominating actions
are water pressure during flotation and Level 1 earthquake ground motion) for Bottom Slab and Footing of Caisson
Ministerial
Ordinance
,.;
Public Notice
,.;
,.;
e- e-
1l
Performance
requirements
23
Serviceability
e-
Ii
1 "'
Design situation
Situation
Variable
Dominating
action
NonDominating
action
Verification item
Self weight,
Cross-sectional failure of Design cross-sectional
resistance (ultimate
water pressure, bottom slab and fuoting
ground motion sub-grade
limit state)
reaction
Level 1
earthquake
-374-
Design situation
Public Notice
u
~
23
requirements
Performance
Verification item
Non-
Situation
Dominating
Dominating
action
action
pressure
bars)
Variable
Internal water
pressure,
internal earth
pressure
Variable
waves1)
Variable
waves3)
Cyclic action
ofwaves*4)
Level 1
earthquake
ground
motion
Cross-sectional failure of
outer wa112J
Serviceability of cross
Water
Cross-sectional failure of
outer wall
pressure
during
flotation
Serviceability of cross
section of outer wall
Design cross-sectional
resistance (ultimate limit state)
Limit value of crack width
due to bending (serviceability
limit state)
Design fatigue strength
(fatigue limit state)
Design cross-sectional
resistance (ultimate limit
state)
Design cross-sectional
resistance (ultimate limit
state)
Limit value of crack width
due to bending (serviceability
limit state)
*1): Here, among waves specified, Article 8, Paragraph 1.1 of the Public Notice, the waves shall be waves which are used in performance
verification of the structural stability of the objective facilities.
*2) Limited to outer walls affected by waves.
*3) Here, among the waves specified. Article 8, Paragraph 1.2 of the Public Notice, the wave having a height greater than the specified waves
which attack with a frequency on the order of 104 times during the design working life shall be used as a standard.
*4) Here, among the waves specified, Article 8, Paragraph 1.2 of the Public Notice, waves shall be set appropriately depending on the
frequency of appearance in regard to the wave height and wave period occurring during the design working life.
~
7
"'
"'
J ~f
1
Design situation
Public Notice
23
j
3
Performance
requirements
Serviceability
Situation
Variable
Dominating
action
Water pressure during
installation
NonDominating
action
Verification item
Cross-sectional
failure of partition
wall
Design cross-sectional
resistance (ultimate limit
state)
-375-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
..,
~ ~
~ ~
~< 5
~< 5
"'
" "'
"
7
Design situation
Public Notice
..,
23
Performance
requirements
Situation
Dominating
action
Verification item
NonDominating
action
Self weight
pressure
Overturning of
floating body
[Technical Nole]
1.2.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) The description presented here may be applied to the performance verification of structural members in ordinary
Evaluation of actions
-Performance-verification
I Verification of ultimate limit state, serviceability limit state, and fatigue limit state of outer walls *1 :
.
.
.
IVerification of ultimate limit state and serviceability limit state of partition walls
I
I
'
Verification ofultimate limit state, serviceability limit state, and fatigue limit state of bottom slab :
Verification of ultimate limit state, serviceability limit state, and fatigue limit state of footing
I
I
------------------------------------ ------------------------------------
Verification of ancillaries
.I.
I Determination of dimensions I
*1 For outer walls which are not affected by waves, only verification of the serviceability limit state may be required.
*2 For the high earthquake-resistance facilities or facilities of which damage to the facilities is expected to have a serious impact on human
life, property, and social activity, it is preferable to perform, verification of accidental situations as necessary. Verification of the accidental
situation for waves is performed where hazardous cargo handling facilities are located immediately behind the objective facilities and
dam.age of the facilities is expected to have a serious impact.
-376-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
CD
@ Draft of a caisson and the water depth at the place of installation (depth above the crown of foundation mound)
@ Floating stability
Working conditions during towing and installation : tidal currents, waves, wind, etc.
@ Working conditions after installation of caisson : filling, placing upper concrete, tidal currents, waves, wind, etc.
@ Differential settlement of mound
(2) In many cases, dimensions of 0.3-0.6m for the thickness of caisson outer walls, 0.4-0.Sm for the thickness of
the bottom slab, and 0.2-0.3m for the thickness ofthe partition walls are used.
(3) As the keel clearance depth during installation, it is common to set the difference between the draft of ordinary
caissons and the mound crown as 0.5m or more.
(4) For caissons which float unassisted, a cross section capable of securing stability during flotation is set.
CD
Verification of the stability of the caisson while floating may be performed using equation (1.2.1) (see Fig.
1.2.2). This equation can be applied in cases where the caisson cross section is bilaterally symmetrical, and it
is considered that only comparatively slight inclination will occur in the caisson which afloat.
I
--CG=GM>O
(1.2.1)
where
: secondary moment of cross section around long axis at water level (m4)
C : centerofbuoyancy
G : center of gravity
M : metacenter
@ For verification of stability in case of towing using a counterballast, equation (1.2.2) or (1.2.3) may be used.
(a) When using water as the counterballast:
(1.2.2)
(b) When using sand or stone or concrete as the counterballast:
-377-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(1.2.3)
where
V', r,
i : moment of inertia of water surface in partition chambers about centerline parallel to axis of
rotation of caisson (m)
C', G' : respective values of positions when counterballast is used
1.2.3 Actions
(!) It is preferable that the combination of actions and load factors considered in performance verification be set
appropriately for each facility.
(2) The combination of actions and load factors may be set as follows.
CD The combinations ofactions considered and the standard values of the load factors to be used for multiplying
the characteristic value in perfurmance verification are shown in Table 1.2.1. Here, the footing may be treated
in the same manner as the bottom slab. The values in the upper rows of the respective boxes in the table are load
factors to be used when examining the ultimate limit state; the numerical values shown in square brackets are
load factors to be used when a small action induces a large impact. Most of these values were set considering the
relationship with external stability etc. by reliability analysis.SJ. 7) The figures in parentheses ( ) in the lower rows
of the respective boxes are load factors for examination of the serviceability limit state. For accidental situations,
a load factor of 1.0 may be used.
In recent years, reduction of the construction cost of breakwaters and other facilities by alleviating_the
leveling accuracy of the rubble mound has been studied. However, if the leveling accuracy of the rubble mound is
alleviated, a reaction greater than that in case ofthe normal leveling accuracy 5cm will act on the caisson bottom
slab, and in this case, the values shown in Table 1.2.1 cannot be used. In the case where the leveling accuracy of
the rubble mound is alleviated in the range of 30cm, the factors can be set referring to the References 8) and 9).
Table 1.2.1 Combinations of Actions and Load Factors
(a) Breakwaters
e
~
i
"
Design situation
"'
Permanent
situation for self
weight
Permanent
situation for
internal earth
lnressure
0
."'t
...
0.9
1.0
,g
J;i
"'~
.e=
;s "'
I=
1.1
1.1
(1.0)
~
e
~;
]~
]"'
"'
""~
5=-::
&.;;; =
~.g
'S
5"
~j
] i
Jl ec.
:E.c e .;:.s
-SI~
--.
~o
~
0
-'l
"'
-2.c~
~~j
~[ ~~o
iS
~e
Ol
~'<i
Outer wall
1.1
1.1
L2
L2
[09]
(1.0)
[0.9]
[0.8]
(1.0)
[08]
(1.0)
(LO)
Bottom slab
L2
(LO)
0.9
(LO)
0.9
(0.5)
.a
I"; .ll!-
I.I
(LO)
1.1
Variable
situation
for Level 1
earthquake
-ound motion
'l!
Bottom slab
[09]
situation for
waves
Variable
situation for
water pressure
while afloat
~e
(1.0)
~ Variable
]~
I.I
(LO)
(LO)
.s
1; ...-::Ie
Outer wall
L2
(LO)
1.1
(LO)
1.1
(LO)
LO
(-)
1.0
1.0
(-)
(-)
Outer wall
I.I
(0.5)
Bottom slab
I.I
(0.5)
Outer wall
Variable
situation
for water
pressure during
construction
1.1
(0.5)
-378-
Partition wall
=
-~
.~
:
Design situation
"'
.,,~
~
"'
Permanent
a.
-~
.,,e
~
j~
Ee
-~
...~~
~"'
e
~
]"'
.!l
..,~
E!l
"'
!~
~[
iS
"'
l~
~&
Loads during
construction
..,~~;
e I!!'
~-
Remarks
Imml1otioo
"'.g
Still
water
Bottom slab
(surcharge
0.9
(LO)
Ll
(LO)
Ll
(LO)
0.8
(0.5)
is equivalent
to bottom
slab reaction
comnonent'I
Permanent
Ll
(LO)
for
-~> situation
internal earth
~ lnressure
Ll
(LO)
Outer wall
Bottom slab
.!l
LO
(-)
Variable
situation
for Level I
eerthquake
ground motion
g
tl
Variable
situation for
LO
(-)
LO
(-)
(surcharge is
equivalent to
LO
(-)
LO
LO
LO
(-)
(-)
(-)
that during an
erihnuak<i)
Outer wall
Ll
0.9
(0.5)
(0.5)
water pressure
Ll
while afloat
(0.5)
"~
Variable
fur water
situation
Ll
(0.5)
pressure during
construction
afloat
@ The actions used in perfurmance verification of outer walls of breakwater caissons are shown in Figs. 1.2.3 to
1.2.5. The standard values of the load factors are shown in Tables 1.2.2 to 1.2.4.
(a) Front wall (parallel to faceline: seaside)
During wave action (wave crest)
w... earth
- pressure
pressure
while afloat
Hydrostatic pressure
pressure: .
L.W.L.
-,H,
rn this figure, H1 stands for design wave height. In verification of the ultimate limit state, Hd=Hmax may be assumed.
-379-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 1.2.2 Combinations of Actions and Load Factors for Front Wall (Breakwater)
Design situation
Direction of action
l.2H--0.9D
l.Olf-1.0D
1.ISt
O.SSr
1.ID+l.IS+l.2Lls
l.OD+l.OS+!.oLls
Not examined
From outside
From inside
During constrnction
while afloat
earth pressure
Hydrostatic pressure
in pennanent state
Dynamic
water pressure
Internal
earth pressure
1..W.L.
Design situation
Variable situation relevant to
water pressure while afloat during
construction
Direction of action
From outside
1.ISt
O.SSr
Not examined
l.OD+l.OS
l.OD+l.OS+l.OP
Not examined
-380-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
Intmnal
earth pn:ssme
Hydros111tic presmn:
pn:ssme i
ofinlmlal
pemummt situation Wlll1lr preBSUl\l
Design situation
Direction of action
From outside
1.lSt
O.SSt
From inside
1.lD+l.lS+1.2As
1.0D+l.OS+1.o4s
The actions used in performance verification of the outer walls of quaywall caissons are shown in Fig. 1.2.6.
The standard values of the load factors are shown in Table 1.2.5.
'
"' L.W.L
~\
.
'
'
'
'---
~
-
--
-381-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Internal
water
Dynamic
water
pressure
pressure
pressure
~--.------r-r--------------
L.W.L
',,',,,',,, """"
"
Direction of action
1.ISt
0.5St
Not examined
1.0Dtl.OS
1.0Dtl.OS+ I.OP
Not examined
@ The actions used in perfurmance verification of the stability of the bottom slab of breakwater caissons during
construction can be obtained by multiplying the characteristic values of the actions by the load factors shown in
Table 1.2.1. In verification of stability in service, values may be obtained using the equations shown in Table
1.2.7, considering the combination of actions shown in Fig. 1.2.7. The classification of actions is as shown in
Table 1.2.6.
IPennanent state I
ILJILJI
I I I
ILILJI
I I I
~' ! 111111 )
Hydrostatic
preuure
tllllllt 0
S.:r.' ! 111111 )
Roodionof
Reaction of
bottom slab
Composite
1ood
tttttttl
tlllllll
bottom slab
ttttttlt 0
v ~
_/ V Ii 111 +f,ill\~ -
Hydrostatic
pres'""'
[fTTV
Variable bottom
slab reaction
Uplift pressure
~@
-382-
Class of action
Action
Permanent action
Variable action
Design situation
Combination of actions
Permanent situation
0.9Do+l.1F+l.IR
0.9Do+l.IF
AR
Wt
1.1Do+l.2LIR+l.2U
Wt
1.1Do+O.SLIR+l.2U
WJ_
0.9Do+l.2LIR+0.8U
Wt
1.1Do+l.2LIR+0.8U
WJ_
0.9Do+O.SLIR+l.2U
Wt
1.1Do+O.SLIR+0.8U
WJ_
0.9Do+!.2LIR+l.2U
AR J_
AR
AR J_
Design situation
Combination of actions
Permanent situation
l.IDo+l.IF+l.OR
l.ODo+l.oAR+l.OU
Provided, however, that assuming W=D0+AR+U. and each action is represented as the signed value (positive or negative). In the case of an action
in the same direction as W, the value is positive, and in the case of an action in a direction opposite to W, the value is negative. The symbols in
the table accord with those in Fig. 1.2.7.
Note) When variable of bottom slab reaction (AR) acts downwards, an upper limit is applied to the value of 1.2 IARI, which cannot exceed 1.1 IRI.
Accordingly, if 1.21.6.Rl>LllRI, the combination of actions shall be as follows :
0.9D0+1.llRl+0.8U, or 0.9D0+1.llRl-+-0.. 8U+l.2U
@ Actions used in performance verification of the stability of the bottom slab of quaywall caissons during
construction can be obtained by multiplying the characteristic values of the actions by the load factors shown
in Table 1.2.1. In verification of stability in service, values obtained using the equations shown in Table 1.2.8
can be used, considering the combinations of actions shown in Fig. 1.2.8.
-383-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(During action of
seismic motion)
.
. ) Permanent
(Permanent s1tuat1on actions due to
I I I I I !!
t t t t t t D1 Deadweight of slab
f f f f f t S1 Hydrostatic water pressure
I I I I I +n
t t t t t fF
D co~crete lid,
t t t t t tF
(While afloat)
filhng etc.
Hydrostatic
water pressure
t t t t t t W Surcharge
.
permanent~
situation
~~~~~~
t f f f f i
[t f f LJ R !0::r:=~~on tJJ>7
Permanent situation
1.lSr
0.5Sr
1.0D+l.OF+l.OR+l.OW
Not examined
0.9D+l.1St
0.5.Dr +O.SSt
@ As the action used in performance verification of the stability of partition walls during construction works, the
hydrostatic head difference between chambers during construction works (during installation) shall be generally
used.
(J) As the action used in performance verification of the stability of partition walls in service, the action in the state
where extrusion force becomes the largest in the actions related to the bottom slab and actions related to the
outer walls is generally used.
(3) The actions used in performance verification during fabrication of caissons may be set as follows.
Q) When a caisson is fabricated on a dry dock, floating dock etc., particular study of the actions during fabrication
is not necessary. Provided, however, that when the caisson is raised with jacks to move on a slipway or caisson
platform, or loaded on a launch truck, the self weight acts as a concentrated load.
@ When examination is necessary during fabrication, examination may be performed considering the whole
caisson to a simple beam.
(4) The actions used in performance verification while the caisson launches and is afloat may be set as follows.
Q) In cases where a dry dock or floating dock, or ordinary slipway (slipway and truck) is used, the hydrostatic
pressure with an allowance added to the draft calculated as the action during launching and floating may be
used. In cases where there is a danger that greater hydrostatic pressure may act on the caisson temporarily
during launching, separate examination is necessary.
@ The water pressure acting on outer walls may be considered as a load with a triangular distribution in which the
base is the distance to the crown and height is the intensity ofthe hydrostatic water pressure (PJ at the centerline
of the bottom slab (see Fig. 1.2.9).
-384-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
1--+-<f-+-+-+--+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+~w'!Pw
f-----~~
Q) In the case ofthe outer walls and bottom slab, performance verification ofthe outer walls and bottom slab during
installation may be omitted, because it is clear that the actions while afloat and in service are larger than those
during installation.
@ Water pressure caused by the hydrostatic head difference between chambers shall be applied to the partition
walls, considering construction conditions.
(6) Actions used in performance verification of caissons in service may be set as follows.
Q) As actions on the outer walls, internal earth pressure and internal water pressure shall be considered. In the
outer walls of breakwater caissons, the influence of the action of waves shall also be considered. In addition
to the actions of waves, breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks are also affected by the impact of
the wave-dissipating blocks against the front wall, and depending on the region, by the impact force of drift
ice, driftwood, etc., freezing, and other factors. Therefore, when these influences are remarkable, they must be
considered as actions.
-385-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(c) It can be assumed that earth pressure increases to the depth equal to the width b of the wall, but does not
increase beyond that. (see Fig. 1.2.11).
In cases where strong cast-in-place concrete is located on top of caissons and it can be regarded that the
effect of the surcharge does not reach the interior ofthe caisson, the surcharge may be disregarded. Provided,
however, that the selfweight of the cast-in-place concrete shall be taken into account.
qK
For the front walls of the breakwater caissons, wave force shall be taken into account when wave crests act on
the walls.11), 12).
Determination of the internal earth pressure and internal water pressure by structural member is as shown in
Fig. 1.2.12.
(a) Breakwaters (front wall and outer walls perpendicular to face line)
Internal
Internal
Composite
load
v L.W.L.
af
Internal
Internal
Composite
earth pressure water pressure
load
-386-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(c) Quaywalls (front wall, rear wall, and outer walls perpendicular to face line)
L.WL.
a[
Int.emal
Int.emal
Composite
earth pressure water pressure
load
Fig. 1.2.12(a)-(c) Determination of Internal Earth Pressure and Internal Water Pressure
W.L.
Wave
pressure
Internal
Composite
earth pressure
load
Fig. 1.2.12(d) Determination of Internal Earth Pressure and Internal water Pressure
(7) Actions used in performance verification ofthe bottom slab may be set as follows.
CD In fixed parts surrounded by outer walls and partition walls, the bottom reaction, hydrostatic pressure, uplift
pressure, weight of the filling, weight of the concrete lid, weight of the bottom slab, and surcharge shall be taken
into account.
The distribution of the composite action often takes an irregular shape. For design purpose however, this
distribution can be modified as an appropriate uniform distribution action or triangular distribution action.
The bottom reaction acting on the body or wall can be calculated according to equations (1.2.6) and (1.2.7) (see
Fig. 1.2.13).
1
(a) In the case of e 5: (; b
=(1+ ~): }
Pi =(1- ~):
p,
(1.2.6)
1
(b) In the case of e >-b
6
P1
=J (%-e)
(1.2.7)
b'=3(~-e)
-387-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(1.2.8)
where
p 1 : characteristic value of reaction at front toe (kN/m2)
p 2 : characteristic value of reaction at rear toe (kN/m2)
V : characteristic value of vertical resultant force per unit length in direction of caisson face line
(kN/m)
H : characteristic value of horizontal resultant force per unit length in direction of caisson face line
(kN/m)
flv
b
@ Hydrostatic pressure shall be the water pressure acting on the bottom slab at the design tide level.
@ Uplift pressure shall be taken into account in cases where waves act on the body or wall. For calculating uplift
pressure, Part II, Chapter 2, 4.7 Wave Pressure and Wave Force may be used as a reference.
@ The specific weight of the filling material is normally determined by testing the material to be used.
<J) The weight of the concrete lid and bottom slab shall be the weight in air without influence of buoyancy.
The weight of soil on top of the caisson and superimposed load etc. are taken into account for the surcharge
acting on the bottom slab. Provided, however, that the surcharge may be disregarded in case where cast-in-place
concrete is placed on top of the caisson and in can be regarded that the influence of the surcharge does not reach
the interior of the caisson.
-388-
Q) The bottom reaction, weight of the footing (accounting buoyancy), and surcharge on the footing shall be taken
into account.
@ Actions may be set considering the distributions shown in Fig. 1.2.14.
fiIB
ilill
ilfil
@ For the bottom reaction acting on the footing, the values calculated using equations (1.2.6) or (1.2.7) can be
used.
The weight of the footing shall be the submerged weight accounting buoyancy.
The surcharge acting on the footing shall consider the weight ofthe wave-dissipating blocks of breakwaters etc.,
accounting buoyancy below the design water level, and the weight of overburden soil, the superimposed loads
etc., on the land side of quaywalls.
(9) The actions used in performance verification of partition walls can be set as follows.
Q) In performance verification of extrusion of outer walls from partition walls, the internal earth pressure and
internal water pressure acting on the outer wall shall be considered. It may be assumed that these actions act on
the joint between the partition wall and the outer wall (see Fig. 1.2.15).
_______,]
_______, i
45
____ _ , !
___
"-'::::: /Design load
P~Pa
Ia
...............
p,
Internal earth pressure +
internal water pressure
per Im of width
Fig. 1.2.15 Actions Used in Examination of Extrusion of Outer Wall from Partition Wall
-389-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ In verification of extrusion of the bottom slab from the partition wall, the weight of the filling material acting on
the bottom slab, the surcharge, the weight of the bottom slab, the weight of the concrete lid, the bottom reaction,
the uplift pressure, and the hydrostatic pressure shall be taken into account. It may be assumed that these
actions act on the joint between the partition wall and the bottom slab (see Fig. 1.2.16).
f H HH
wf,[
Lfi:..ti),.
fffOHw
~f r:rc-fhl P,:convc:rtedde~ign.load
3 x '=1 ! !.!'
used m exammation of
dislodging
f,-f.
wt,[A:ffi:t, P
+-f (flltPa
Wfx(I- f,>)
3fy'
Fig. 1.2.16 Actions used in Examination of Extrusion of Bottom Slab from Partition Wall
In cases where there is a possibility of actions due to non-uniform ground bearing capacity or similar factors,
this shall be examined. In this case, verification of the individual members of the caisson shall be performed
assuming a cantilever beam with a span equivalent to 1/3 of the length or width of the caisson (see Fig. 1.2.17).
Verification may also be performed using a structural analysis model in which only the parts of the ground
which can be expected to provide bearing support are converted to springs.
f/3
Fig. 1.2.17 Examination of Action due to Non-uniformity of Ground Bearing Capacity
The standard load factors of actions considered in verification of partition walls are shown in Table 1.2.9.
-390-
Design situation
Direction of action
construction
I.IS/
0.5Sr
Not examined
Direction of extrusion of
Not examined
(!) Performance verification of structural members can be performed using the method presented in 1.1 General.
Q) Performance verification of structural members shall be performed by correlating the performance criteria with
the ultimate state for the respective members. Specifically, examination is performed by setting the verification
indexes for the corresponding ultimate states for the actions on the members calculated using the procedure
presented in 1.2.3 Actions. The settings of the verification indexes are based on 1 Strnctural Members. The
partial factors used in this case may generally be set based on Table 1.1.3 in 1.1.6 Partial Factors.
(2) Performance verification of partition walls can be performed as follows.
Q) During installation, the partition wall can be regarded as comprising a slab with 3 fixed sides and 1 free side.
@ The span used in calculations shall be the interval between the centers of walls.
(3) Performance verification of the bottom slab and footing can be performed as follows.
Q) The part of the bottom slab surrounded by the outer walls and partition walls can be regarded as a 4 sided fixed
slab.
@ The span used in calculation of the part having 4 fixed sides shall be the central interval between the center of
the walls.
@ The cross section used in calculations in connection with bending and shearing of the footing shall be the front
surface of the wall. Provided, however, that the cross section used in examination of diagonal tensile type shear
failure may be assumed to be the cross section at the front face of the wall. In this case, in calculations of the
height of members at the front face of the wall, the part of the haunch with a gradient shallower than I
3 shall be considered effective.
In the case of reinforced concrete footings of normal dimensions, the caisson body is assumed to be rigid;
therefore, it may be considered that the moment occurring in the footing does not reach the main body of
caisson.
Q) In the case of quaywall caissons, in principle, verification of the fatigue limit state may be omitted.
@ In cases where a caisson is lifted with jacks for transportation or uneven settlement occurs after installation,
verification may be performed considering the entire caisson as a beam. In this case verification for punching
shear failure of the bottom slab is necessary.
-391-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article24
The performance criteria of a reinforced concrete L-shaped block (hereinafter called "L-shaped block" in
this article) shall be set such that the risk of impairing the integrity of the front wall, bottom slab, buttress
wall, and footing of the L-shaped block is equal to or less than the threshold level under the permanent
action situation in which the dominant actions are self weight and earth pressure and under the variable
action situations in which the dominant actions are Level I earthquake ground motions and variable waves
in consideration of the type of facilities.
[Commentary]
CD The
performance criteria of L-shaped blocks, shall follow the provision shown in 1.2 Caissons
regarding the performance criteria and the setting of design situation (excluding accidental situations)
of caissons. Provided, however, that "outer wall," "partition wall," and "internal earth pressure" shall
be replaced with "front wall," "buttress wall," and "earth pressure," respectively, and the provisions
in connection with flotation and installation shall be excluded. In addition to these provisions, the
performance criteria and the settings of design situations (excluding accidental situations) ofL-shaped
blocks shall be as shown in Attached Table 10.
Attached Table 10 Performance Criteria and Settings of Design Situations (excluding accidental situations) of L-shaped
Block
Ministerial
Ordinance
u
~
t:
""e-
<
1 "'
Public Notice
u
:S!
t:
<
24
""e~
"1
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Jl
Situation
Dominating Non-dominating
action
action
Level 1
Self weigh~
earthquake earth pressure.
ground
motion
water pressure,
(yielding of reinforcing
reaction of
bearing part
ban)
reaction of
bearing part
of front wall,
reaction of
bearing part of
bottom slab
Variable
Extrusion of bottom
slab from buttress wall
(yielding of reinforcing
ban)
pressure
Water pressure,
Verification item
of front wall,
reaction of
bearing part of
bottom slab
Extrusion of bottom slab or front wall from buttress wall (yielding ofreinforcing bars)
Verification of extrusion of the bottom slab or front wall from the buttress wall (yielding of
reinforcing bars) means to verify that the risk that the tensile stress of the reinforcing bars due to
extrusion of the bottom slab or front wall from the buttress wall will exceed the design yield stress is
less than the limit value.
[Technical Nole]
1.3.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) The description in this section can be applied to the performance verification of ordinary L-shaped blocks.
(2) An example of the performance verification procedure for L-shaped blocks is shown in Fig. 1.3.1.
(3) In performance verification of L-shaped blocks, 1.2 Caissons and Technical Manual for L-shape Block
Quaywalls 17) may be used as a reference.
-392-
Evaluation of actions
r--Performance verification
.
.
.
.
Verification of ultimate limit state and serviceability limit state of front wall
I
I
I Verification ofultimate limit state and serviceability limit state of buttress wall
I Verification of ultimate limit state and serviceability limit state of bottom slab
Verification of ancillaries
Detennination of dimensions
1: For the high earthquake-proof facilities and the :filcilities of which damage is expected to have a serious impact on human life, property,
and social activity, it is prefi:nble to perfmm verification for accidental situati0ll9, as neces581Y.
(!)It is desirable tbat tbe dimensions oftbe members ofL-shaped blocks be determined considering tbe following
items:
CD
(2) Actions on tbe members ofL-shaped blocks can be considered as shown in Fig. 1.3.2.
-393-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Surcharae +weight of
overbur<Ien soil
and sand+ deadweight of
bottom slab
h2,W2
llTTnnITTTrmn-+-q+(w1h1+w2'12)+wh,
------j~~~;:i::::; ki.w
where
q
: load (kN/m')
h4
K1
K2
w1
w2
w4
(3) In calculating earth pressure, Part n; Chapter S, 1 Earth Pressure can be used as a reference. For the friction
angle on the wall at the virtual back face, the angle of shear resistance of the backfill material at the virtual back
face can be used.17)
(4) In calculating bottom resistance, 1.2.3 Actions (6) can be used as a reference.
(5) In the concrete placing method ofL-shaped block fabrication, there are cases in which the wall is constructed in
the vertical direction and cases in which the wall is constructed by laying in the horizontal direction. In cases
where the wall is constructed by laying in horizontally, construction is accompanied by work in which the blocks
are raised before installation; therefore, in performance verifications, it is necessary to study the actions at the
block raising stage.
(6) In general, the actions on L-shaped blocks are not distributed uniformly. However, the non-conformity distributed
actions may be considered to be a combination of appropriately divided loads of uniform distribution. Provided,
however, that it should be avoided that the combination of divided loads causes weak points in the member
strength. Examples of the division of loads are shown in Fig. 1.3.3.
-394-
'
CCC'
Design load
-cco distribution
Bottom slab
-=~ of member
(i)
(a) Earth pressure
CD
Performance verification of the front wall can generally be performed assuming that a slab is supported by
buttress walls.
@ In the case of one buttress wall, performance verification can be performed assuming that a cantilever slab is
supported by the buttress. In case of two or more buttresses, it is assumed that the front wall is a continuous
slab supported by the buttresses.
The span of the front wall may be measured from the center of the buttress .
@ Actions from rear of the front wall can be regarded as acting on the entire length of the member.
@ The width of the front wall and the actions on the wall can be considered as shown in Fig. 1.3.4.
@ Structurally, the front wall is supported by the bottom slab as well as by the buttresses. Therefore, the front wall
may be regarded as a slab which is supported on 2 or 3 sides. However, in general, the front walls ofL-shaped
blocks with large heights, are lightly affected by the part supported by the bottom slab, and the arrangement
of reinforcing bars at the bottom slab attachment becomes complex. Considering these facts, performance
verification can generally be performed assuming that the front wall is a cantilever slab or a continuous slab.
p: earth pressure,
residual water pressure
l i. l2 : length of
member
p: earth pressure,
residual water pressure
l: length of
member
~j-+-~B~u~ttre~s~swnal~I~_
j_
,
-.
Buttress wall
~----rul
Fig. 1.3.4 Length of Front Wall Members and Actions on Front Wall
-395-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) Footing
Q) Performance verification ofthe footing can be performed assuming that a footing is regarded as a cantilever slab
supported by the position of the front wall.
@ The length of the footing may be regarded as the distance between the front edge of the footing and the front
face of the front wall.
The length of the footing and the actions on the footing can be considered as shown in Fig.1.3.5.
Footing
.f.
Q) Performance verification of the bottom slab can generally be performed assuming that the bottom slab is
supported by the buttresses. In the case of one buttress, the bottom slab can be treated as a cantilever slab
supported by the buttress, and in case of two or more buttresses, as a continuous slab.
@ The length of the bottom slab may be regarded as the distance between the centers of the buttresses.
Actions from the top side of the bottom slab can generally be regarded as acting on the entire length of the
member.
The bottom slab may be regarded as a structure supported by the front wall as well as by the buttresses. Therefore,
performance verification of the bottom slab may be performed assuming that the bottom slab is supported on 2
or 3 sides. However, for the same reason as stated in (1), verification may generally be performed assuming that
the bottom slab is a cantilever slab or a continuous slab. Accordingly, in the cases where it is advantageous in
performance verification to consider the bottom slab as a slab supported on 2 or 3 sides, Q) does not necessarily
apply.
@ Of the actions on the bottom slab, the bottom reaction acts on the entire length of the member. The action from
the top of the bottom slab which is transmitted by backfilling can be considered as acting on the clear span of
the bottom slab. However, because this type of calculation is troublesome and this does not have a large effect
on performance verification, the action on the bottom slab may generally be applied on the entire length of the
member.
In performance verification of the bottom slab, it is necessary to set the load factor considering the load under
which members are at the greatest risk. For load factors used in performance verification, Technical Manual
for L-shaped Block Quaywalls 17) may be used as a reference.
Q) Performance verification for buttress walls can be performed assuming that the buttress wall is a T-beam
integrated with the front wall.
@ Buttress walls may be examined by consideration as a cantilever beam supported at the bottom slab against the
reaction from the front wall.
Performance verification of buttress walls shall be performed for the cross sections parallel to the bottom slab.
-396-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
The buttress wall, front wall, and bottom slab shall be tightly connected. The amount of reinforcing bars for this
purpose shall be calculated independently from that of stirrups against shear stresses.
When performance verification of the front wall and bottom slab follows the description given here, actions
from behind the buttress walls may be disregarded.
The length of members of buttress walls can be considered to be the total height including the bottom slab, as
shown in Fig. 1.3.6. Provided, however, that it is necessary to consider that actions work on the superstructure
as well as the buttress.
(:!) When the cross section is calculated assuming that the buttress wall is a T-beam, attention shall be paid to the
position of the neutral axis which is located either in the front wall or in the buttress wall.
Superstructure
where
p
lh
b
H
-397-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article25
The provisions of Article 23 shall apply correspondingly to the perfurmance criteria of cellular blocks of
reinforced concrete construction.
[Technical Nole]
1.4.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!)The description in this section can be applied to the perfurmance verification of ordinary cellular blocks.
(2) An example of the performance verification procedure for cellular blocks is shown in Fig. 1.4.1.
I
I
Evaluation of actions
-Performance verification
.---------------------------------- ---------------------------------'
Verification ofultimate limit state and serviceability limit state of front wall
Verification of ultimate limit state and serviceability limit state of rear wall
Verification of ultimate limit state and serviceability limit state of outer walls
'
IVerification of ultimate limit state and serviceability limit state of partition walls:
I Verification of ultimate limit state and serviceability limit state of bottom slab
I
I
---------------------------------- -----------------------------------
Verification of ancillaries
J.
I Determination of dimensions I
t: In outer walls which are not affected by waves, verification may be limited to the serviceability limit state.
2: In the high earthquake-resistance facilities and facilities in which serious impact on human life, property, and social activity due to
damage of the objective facilities can be expected, it is preferable to perform verification for the accidental situations, as necessary.
Verification of accidental situations associated with waves shall be performed in cases where facilities which handle hazardous materials
are located immediately behind the structure, and damage to the facilities can be expected to have a serious impact.
(3) In perfurmance verification of cellular blocks, the performance verification in 1 Structural Members may be
used as a reference.
(4) Because cellular blocks have various types, in individual performance verification, 1.2 Caissons and 1.3 L-sbaped
Blocks may be used as a refurence, corresponding to the structural type.
When cellular blocks are to be used as members of breakwaters or breakwater revetments or other structures
subject to the action of wave furce, the fatigue limit state should be studied separately.
-398-
(5) "Cellular blocks" generally refur to blocks consisting of outer walls without a bottom slab. Cellular blocks function
as a wall body either in single units or multiple piled-up blocks. As a special type, cellular blocks with a bottom
slab are also used. In actual perfurmance verification, it is necessary to adopt an appropriate method based on an
adequate understanding of the characteristics of the block shape.
(6) The cross-sectional shapes of cellular blocks have various types. The cross-sectional shapes of blocks which are
commonly used in relating large numbers are shown in Fig. 1.4.2.
Outer wall
l
]
Outer wall
1 l
l
~
l
]
Outer wall
l ~
~
Rectangular section
Outer wall
Partition wall
Outer wall
1 l
l
~
lti!
Jl=
Rectangular with
partition wall
Outer wall
lti!
Outer wall
Rectangular with
flanged section
I-shaped section
(!) The dimensions of the members of cellular blocks shall be set considering the full owing items
CD
@
@
@
@
@
1.4.3 Actions
(!) The rear wall is subject to backfill earth pressure, residual water pressure etc., from outside. However, because
these are mutually cancelled out by internal earth pressure, in general cases, examination of this type of action
can be omitted.
(2) The internal earth pressure and residual water pressure acting on cellular blocks can be considered as shown in
Fig. 1.4.3. In the cases where backfilled is considered a part of the wall, the stress on the outer walls and the rear
walls due to the filling are reduced by the active earth pressure, residual water pressure etc., after backfilling is
completed. However, because in many cases filling is executed before backfilling in the construction process,
performance verification of members should be perfurmed for this condition.
-399-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Outer wall (front wall)
Filling pressure +
residual water pressure
...
8
Outer wall (rear wall)
CD
As actions on the front wall, rear wall, and outer walls, internal earth pressure and residual water pressure shall
be taken into account. Provided, however, that in the cases where cast-in-place concrete is placed on top of the
cellular block to a degree such that the surcharge may not affect the interior of the cellular block, it is generally
not necessary to consider the surcharge imposed on the cast-in-place concrete.
P2=Ky2(H1-H2)
-400-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(d) The internal earth pressure in cellular blocks is constrained by a frame and is considered to be the act similar
to the filling of a caisson. Therefore, 1.2 Caissons may be used as a reference.
I"
.f.
Partition
~1
Outer wall
(rear wall)
Fig. 1.4.5 Load for Examination of Extrusion Failure of Outer Walls from Partition Wall
(5) Wave force is generally not considered. However, in the cases where particularly strong impact wave force acts
on the wall, it is necessary to consider this action.
(6) Actions during construction have many common points with those ofL-shaped blocks. Therefore, 1.3 L-shaped
Blocks can be used as a reference.
(7) As the ordinary combinations of actions considered in the performance verifications and the load factors to be
multiplied by the characteristic values of the respective actions, the combinations of actions and the load factors
shown in 1.3.3 Actions can be used.
(8) In the cases where the actions on members of cellular blocks are divided for convenience of calculation, 1.3.3
Actions can be used as a reference.
-401-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
Outer walls
(a) The section force generated in a rectangular cellular block is solved by assuming the block as a rigid box
frame for each unit height against the equivalent uniform load converted from the actual load distribution.
(b) The span used for calculations is measured between the centers of the connected walls.
@ Partition wall
(a) The section forces acting on partition walls are calculated in the same way as that of outer walls.
(b) When any difference of filling height between neighboring chambers may occur during execution, the
partition wall should be designed against the earth pressure caused by the difference.
(c) The span used for calculations is measured between the centers of the connected walls.
@Footings
(a) Footings may be designed as cantilever slabs supported by the outer walls.
(b) The span of footing is the distance from the front of the outer wall to the tip of the footing.
-402-
CD Wave-absorbing part
(a) Variable actions in which the dominating action is variable waves (serviceability)
1) Front wall slit
The performance criteria and the setting of design situations (excluding accidental situations) of
front wall slits of upright wave-absorbing caissons shall be as shown in the Attached Table 11.
Attached Table 11 Performance Criteria and Settings for Design Situations (excluding accidental situations) of Front
Wall Slits of Upright Wave-absorbing Caissons
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
"
<
} }
-1l
e -1l
.!! "
<
26
e
.!!
Design situation
Performance
requirements
1 Serviceability
Situation
Dominating Non-dominating
action
action
Variable
Variable
Verification item
Water pressure,
axial force
Cross-sectional failure
of front wall slit
transmitted from Serviceability of cross
top of front wall section of front wall slit
waves1)
Variable
waves2)
Repeated
action of
waves3\
Design cross-sectional
strength (ultimate limit state)
*1) Here, among waves specified, Article 8, Paragraph 1.1 of the Public Notice, the waves shall be waves which are used in performance
verification of the structural stability of the objective facilities.
*2) Here, among the waves specified, Article 8, Paragraph 1.2 of the Public Notice, the wave having a height greater than the specified waves
which attack with a frequency on the order of 104 times during the design working life shall be used as a standard.
*3) Here, among the waves specified, Article 8, Paragraph 1.2 of the Public Notice, the waves shall be set appropriately depending on the
frequency of appearance in regard to wave height and wave period occurring during the design working life.
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
beams shall follow the performance criteria and the settings of design situations (excluding accidental
situations) of front wall slit shown in a), providing that the non-dominating actions are water pressure, the
support reaction transmitted by the slit part, the wave force acting on the ceiling slab, the self weight of
the ceiling slab, and the self weight of the upper beam and replacing "front wall slits" with "upper beam".
4) Lower beam
The performance criteria and the setting of design situations (excluding accidental situations) of lower
wall slits shall follow the performance criteria and the setting of design situations (excluding accidental
situations) of front wall slits shown in a), providing that the non-dominating actions are water pressure
and the support reactions transmitted by the slit part and lower slab And replacing the "front wall slits"
The performance criteria and the setting of design situations (limited to accidental situations) for
accidental situations ofin which drifting objects collided with upright wave-absorbing caissons shall
be as shown in the Attached Table 12.
Attached Table 12 Settings for Performance Criteria and Design Situations (limited to accidental situations) of Waveabsorbing Part of Upright Wave-absorbing Caissons
Ministerial
Ordinance
u
~
7
"" e
Public Notice
u
""
J ~J
,1!
26
Design situation
Perfurmance
requirements
Non-dominating
Situation Dominating
action
action
drifting
Self weigh~
water pressure
objects
Verification item
Cross-sectional failure
of members of wavedissipating part
Design cross-sectional
strength (ultimate limit state)
such as
driftwood,
etc. carried
hvwater
[Technical Nole]
1.5.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) Upright wave-absorbing caissons are caissons with a slit-shaped wall at the front face, and have an internal
wave chamber which gives the caisson a wave-absorbing function; this type of structure is used in quaywalls,
breakwaters, and similar facilities. At present, various structures have been developed as shapes for upright waveabsorbing caissons. However, these can be broadly classified into the permeable and impermeable types. As to
the slit shape, the vertical slit type is the most widely used. As other types, the horizontal slit and perforated wall
types have been used in actual facilities. In performance verification of the members, it is preferable to make an
adequate study of the characteristics of the respective structures, and to carry out hydraulic model experiments
suited to the conditions.
(2) As the procedure for performance verification of upright wave-absorbing caissons, 1.2 Caissons can be used as a
reference.
(3) The names of members of the relatively common vertical slit caisson are shown in Fig. 1.5.1.
-404-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
slab@
r
A
Slit column
aXID:ID
-l
@
CD
"'"'
;
.i::
~-
Lower slab
Bottom
, slab
Bottom slab@)
L-c
! 15
Lower beam
Uooerbeam
::::
Bottom
, slab@) ,,
Lower beam
@
,_
Outer wall
Partition wall
Section (B-B)
Outer wall
Slit column
<D
Slit column
al
Column
Wave
chamber
Partition wall
1.5.2 Actions
(1) For actions which should be considered in performance verification of upright wave-absorbing caissons, 1.2
Caissons can be used as a reference.
(2) Wave forces acting on the members of slit caissons vary significantly, depending on the structure of the water
chamber and whether or not it has a ceiling slab. Therefore, as well as referring to past cases of implementation,
appropriate hydraulic model experiments are recommended in accordance with the individual conditions prior to
design.
(3) For the wave forces acting on members, Part II, Chapter 2t 4.7.2(7) Wave Forces Acting on Upright Waveabsorbing Caisson 18) can be used as a reference.
(4) If the top of the water chamber is completely sealed by the ceiling slab, an impulsive pressure may be generated
by the compression of the air trapped beneath the top at the instant when the front of incoming wave shuts off
the slits or perforations. Provision of ventilation holes with a suitable opening ratio in the ceiling slab can reduce
impulsive pressure due to air compression. The opening ratio of these holes should be carefully designed. If too
great, the wave surface collides directly with the ceiling slab, and this could produce a greater impulsive uplift
pressure than that of no ventilation 2), 3). For details, reference 19) and 20) may be used.
(5) The actions which should be considered in performance verifications of the members of the wave chambers in
upright wave-absorbing caissons are shown in Table 1.5.1.
-405-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 1.5.1 External Forces for Design of Members of Water Chamber of Wave-dissipating Caisson
Member
Member
number
Actions
Slit column
(j)
Water pressure while afloat including wave force transmitted from sidewalls
Wave pressure (ditto)
Upper beam
Lower beam
Water pressure while afloat (reaction from slit column and lower wall, load
acting on the beam itselt)
Wave pressure (ditto)
Lower slab
Outer wall
Partition
Wave pressure acts on both sides separately in the direction parallel to face
line
=
0
Fender reaction
Wave pressure
Rear wall
Bottom slab
@!
Bottom reaction and bottom slab weight in each design situation, water head
difference, and water pressure while float
Ceiling slab
-406-
Article27
The provisions of Article 23 shall be applied to the performance criteria of a hybrid caisson (a caisson having
a composite structure of steel plates and concrete) with modification as necessary.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Hybrid Caissons
The provisions in connection with the performance criteria and design situations (excluding accidental
situations) ofhybrid caissons shall be as shown in the Attached Table 13, in addition to the performance
criteria and setting of design situations (excluding accidental situations) of caissons in 1.2 Caissons.
Attached Table 13 Performance Criteria and Setting of Design Situations {excluding accidental situations) of Hybrid
Caissons
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
.1J
"
<
} }
,!!
~<
27
Design situation
Perfurmance
requirements
,!!
Non-dominating
Situation Dominating
action
action
during
Verification item
Cross-sectional failure
of partition wall (axial
Design cross-sectional
strength (ultimate limit state)
Design cross-sectional
Extrusion of members
Cross-sectional failure
extrusion of members
Design cross-sectional
installation
Variable
wave
(Lovell
Self weigh~
surcharge,
ground
motion)
Extrusion of members
Cross-sectional
failure of outer wall of
composite structure1
(Horizontal slip shear
force'\
Cross-sectional
failure of outer wall of
composite structure1
(Bending, shear)
Design cross-sectional
strength (ultimate limit state)
Design cross-sectional
strength considering local
buckling (ultimate limit
state)
*1): Slab member (composite slab) comprising steel plate and concrete unified by shear connectors.
[Technical Note]
1.6.1 General
(!) In this chapter, caissons with a composite structural type of steel plates and concrete are defined as hybrid
caissons. By combining several different materials, composite structures achieve superior structural strength
properties that are not possible using a single material alone. In "composite structures", the member sections
consist of a combination of different materials to achieve the functions of the structure. Hybrid caissons, like
conventional steel reinforced concrete caissons, are used in breakwaters, quays, and coastal revetments. Fig. 1.6.1
shows two types of structural members of hybrid caissons commonly used in the port and harbor structures. One
is a composite member structure with steel plates arranged on ooe side only. The other is an SRC structure with
H-shaped steel embedded inside it. In this chapter the term "hybrid caisson" is used as general term for caissons
using these two structural types.
-407-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Concrete
J.
Concrete
\,
/
Shear connectors
(example of headed studs)
Steel plate
(2) SRC structure
Partition wall
(steel stiffened plate)
Steel plate Steel
reinforcement
Concrete
(2) In performance verification of hybrid caissons, the Hybrid Caisson Deign Manual 21) and References 22) and 23)
can be used as reference.
(3) For the procedure for performance verification of hybrid caissons, 1.2 Caissons can generally be used as a
reference. For composite slabs, Fig. 1.6.3 can be used as a reference.
-408-
.Ir
I Assumption of specifications of composite slab I
.Ir
I
-
Evaluation of actions
I
Performance verification
..
'
.
Verification of shear
transfer resistance
Ultimate limit state
,.
I Determination of shear. I
Determination of
number of studs
Consideration of buckling
in the case of compression
on steel plate side
The actions which should be considered in performance verification ofhybrid caissons conform to those for caissons;
therefore, 1.2.3 Actions can be used as a reference. Provided, however, that in the cases where steel partition walls
are used as the partition walls in a hybrid caisson, it is preferable to coosider the actions due to the difference in water
pressure from inside and outside of the caisson while afloat and during installation, the actions of earth pressure and
waves etc. and the bottom reaction of the bottom slabs and footings as actions acting on the partition wall.
1.6.4 Performance Verification
CD
Flexural moment
For the flexural moment, the section stress of composite slabs can be calculated as a double reinforced concrete
@ Shearing Force
The shearing force of composite slabs can be analyzed in the same manner as that of reinforced concrete slabs.
-409-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(3) Performance verification of SRC Members
Q) The steel and reinforced concrete (SRC) members shall be designed against the flexural moment and shearing
force, by taking full account of the structural characteristics due to diffi:rences in the structural type of the steel
frame.
@ SRC members can normally be classified as follows, depending on the structural type of steel frames :
(a) Full-web type
(b) Truss web type
@ For the flexural moment, the section stress can be calculated as a reinfurced concrete member by converting
steel frames to equivalent reinforcements. When the fixing of steel frame ends with concrete is insufficient in
full-web type, it should be calculated as a composite of the independent steel frame member and the reinforced
concrete member.
For shearing force, if the web is of truss type, the shear stress can be calculated as a reinforced concrete by
converting steel frames to equivalent reinforcements. If it is of full-web type, steel frames themselves can resist
against the shearing force, and they can be duly considered in design.
Q) Corners and joints shall be designed to smoothly and firmly transmit section forces, and to be easily fabricated
and executed.
@ To secure sufficient strength at corners and joints, it is desirable to firmly connect the steel materials on the
tensile side to those of the compressive side. It is also desirable to provide shear reinforced steel materials
(haunches) against concrete tensile stress of the inside of joints.
Q) Hybrid caissons use a large number of welded joints for connecting steel plates, and attaching shear connectors
and shear resistance steel. Therefore, where the members are frequently subject to repeated load, the fatigue
strength in welded parts should be examined.
@ In coastal revetments and quaywalls, the influence of repeated actions is small. However, in performance
verifications ofbreakwaters, when the stress on members due to waves as a repeated action changes significantly,
examination for fatigue failure of the caisson is needed.
(2) The main cause of deterioration of hybrid members is corrosion of the steel materials. Because there are cases
in which corrosion of the steel materials may result in developing cracks of the concrete, appropriate corrosion
prevention measures should be taken for steel plates in order to improve the durability of the hybrid members.
The deterioration characteristics of the concrete itself should be considered to be the same as that of conventional
reinforced concrete.
(3) Steel materials used on the outside of hybrid caissons are generally covered with concrete or asphalt mats. The
inside of a caisson is isolated from the external atmosphere by means of concrete lids. It is also in contact with
filling sand in a static state and with residual seawater. Thus, when designing hybrid caissons, direct contact
between the steel plates of members and the marine environment is generally avoided. For corrosion control, it is
usual to set steel plate on the inside and concrete on the outside so as to avoid direct contact of steel plate with fresh
seawater. If steel plates are in direct contact with seawater, corrosion control should be applied such as coating
methods to splash zone or tidal zone and cathodic protection methods in seawater.
-410-
Article28
The performance criteria of rubble stones and concrete blocks armoring a structure exposed to the actions
of waves and water currents as well as armor stones and armor blocks of the foundation mound shall be such
that the risk of exceeding the allowable degree of damage under the variable action situation, in which the
dominant actions are variable waves and water currents, is equal to or less than the threshold level.
[Commentary]
Ordinance
..,
e~< 5
1
"1
..,
"'
e~< 5
Jl
28
Design situation
Public Notice
"1
Performance
requirements
Serviceability
Non-
Situation
Variable
Dominating action
dominating
Verification item
Index of standard
limit value
action
Variable waves
Self weight,
water pressure
CD Extent of damage
The indexes which express the extent of damage of armor stones and blocks for the variable situations
in which the dominating actions are variable waves and water currents are the damage rate, the degree
of damage, and the deformation level.
In the performance verification of armor stones and blocks, the indexes including the degree of
damage and the limit value thereof shall be set appropriately considering the design working life of the
objective facilities, the construction work conditions, the time and cost necessary for restoration, and
the conditions of waves and water currents, etc.
[Technical Nole]
1. 7.1 Required Mass of Armor Stones and Blocks on Slope 24), 2si
(!)General
The armor units for the slopes and a sloping breakwaters are placed to protect the rubble stones inside; it is
necessary to ensure that an armor unit has a mass sufficient to be stable so that it does not scatter itself. This
stable mass, required mass, can generally be obtained by hydraulic model tests or calculations using appropriate
equations.
(2) Basic Equation for Calculation of Required Mass
When calculating the required mass of rubble stones and concrete blocks covering the slope of a sloping structure
which is affected by wave forces, Hudson's formula with the stability number N8 , which is shown in the following
equation, may be used.26) In this equation, the symbol r is a partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k
and d show the characteristic value and design value, respectively. For the partial safety factors YNS and rn in the
equation, 1.0 may be used.
3
M p,Hd
d-N 3 (S-!)3
Sd
(1.7.1)
'
where
-411-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
The design values in the equation may be calculated using the following equations.
Ha=rHHk' Nsa=YN,NSk
(3) Design Wave Height HUsed in the Performance Verification
Hudson's formula was proposed based on the results of experiments that used regular waves. When applying
it to the action of actual waves which are random, there is thus a problem of which definition of wave heights
shall be used. However, with structures that are made of rubble stones or concrete blocks, there is a tendency for
damage to occur not when one single wave having the maximum height H among a random wave train attacks the
armor units, but rather for damage to progress gradually under the continuous action of waves of various heights.
Considering this fact and past experiences, it has been decided to make it standard to use the significant wave
height of incident waves at the place where the slope is located as the wave height Hin equation (1.7.1), because
the significant wave height is representative of the overall scale of a random wave train. Consequently, it is also
standard to use the significant wave height when using the generalized Hudson's formula. Note however that for
places where the water depth is less than one half of the equivalent deepwater wave height, the significant wave
height at the water depth equal to one half of the equivalent deepwater wave height should be used.
(4) Parameters Affecting the Stability Number Ns
As shown in equation (1.7.1), the required mass of armor stones or concrete blocks varies with the wave height
and the density of the armor units, and also the stability number N8 The Ns value is a coefficient that represents
the effects of the characteristics of structure, those of armor units, wave characteristics and other factors on the
stability. The main factors that influence the Ns value are as follows.
CD
(a) Type of structure; sloping breakwater, breakwater covered with wave-dissipating concrete blocks, and
composite breakwater, etc.
(b) Gradient of the armored slope
(c) Position of armor units; breakwater head, breakwater trunk, position relative to still water level, front face and
top of slope, back face, and berm, etc.
(d) Crown height and width, and shape of superstructure
(e) hmer layer; coefficient of permeability, thickness, and degree of surface roughness
@ Wave characteristics
(a) Number of waves acting on armor layers
(b) Wave steepness
(c) Form of seabed (seabed slope, where about of reef, etc.)
(d) Ratio of wave height to water depth as indices of non-breaking or breaking wave condition, breaker type, etc.
-412-
(1.7.3)
where
: constant determined primarily by the shape of the armor units and the damage ratio
The Hudson's formula was based on the results of a wide range of model experiments and has proved itself
well in usage in-site. This formula using the KD value has thus been used in the calculation of the required mass
of armor units on a slope.
However, the Hudson's formula that uses the stability number in equation (1.7.1) has been used for quite a
while for calculating the required mass of armor units on the foundation mound of a composite breakwater as
discussed in 1.7.2 Required Mass of Armor Stones and Blocks in Composite Breakwater Foundation Mound
against Waves, and is also used for the armor units of other structures such as submerged breakwaters. It is thus
now more commonly used than the old formula with the KD value.
The stability number N8 can be derived from theKD value and the angle a of the slope from the horizontal line
by using equation (1.7.3) There is no problem with this process ifthe KD value is an established one and the slope
angle is within a range ofnormal design. However, most of the KD values obtained up to the present time have not
sufficiently incorporated various factors like the characteristics of the structure and the waves. Thus, this method
of determining the stability number Ns from the KD value cannot be guaranteed to obtain economical design
always. In order to calculate more reasonable values for the required mass, it is thus preferable to use the results
of experiments matched to the conditions in question, or else to use calculation formulas, calculation diagrams,
that include the various relevant factors as described below.
(6) Van der Meer's Formula for Armor Stones
In 1987, van der Meer carried out systematic experiments concerning the armor stones on the slope of a sloping
breakwater with a high crown. He proposed the following calculation formula for the stability number, which
can consider not only the slope gradient, but also the wave steepness, the number of waves, and the damage
leveJ.28) Note however that the following equations have been slightly altered in comparison with van der Meer's
original one in order to make calculations easier. For example, the wave height H 2% for which the probability of
exceedance is 2% has been replaced by H112o
N8 = max(N,P,,N,u)
(1.7.4)
N,,,,
N,u
13 0 2
= CHP-0 (s /
(1.7.5)
5
N' Xcota)" I!
(1.7.6)
where
N,pt : stability number for plunging breakers
stability number for surging breaker
N
I, : iribarren number (tana/S0 m0.5>), also called the surf similarity parameter
S 0 m : wave steepness(H11,!Lo)
L 0 : deepwater wavelength (L0=g7J132/2,..,g=9.8lm/s2)
1J13 : significant wave period
CH : breaking effect coefficient {=1.4/(H112ofH113)}, (=1.0 in non-breaking zone)
H113 : significant wave height
H1120 : highest one-twentieth wave height, see Fig. 1.7.1
a : angle of slope from the horizontal surface ()
D.so : nominal diameter of armor stone (=(M5ofp,)'")
M50 : 50% value of the mass distribution curve of an armor stone namely required mass of an armor
= :
P
S
A
N
stone
: permeability index of the inner layer, see Fig. 1.7.2
: deformation level (S=AfD.,02), see Table 1.7.1
: erosion area of cross section, see Fig. 1.7.3
: number of acting waves
-413-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
The wave height H 1120 in Fig. 1.7.1 is for a point at a distance 5H113 from the breakwater, and Ho' is the
equivalent deepwater wave height. The deformation level S is an index that represents the amount of deformation
of the armor stones, and it is a kind of damage ratio. It is defined as the result of the area A eroded by waves, see
Fig. 1.7.3, being divided by the square of the nominal diameter D.so of the armor stones. As shown in Table 1.7.1,
three stages are defined with regard to the deformation level of the armor stones
initial
damage,
intermediate damage, and failure. With the standard design, it is common to use the deformation level for initial
damage for N = 1000 waves. However, in case where a certain amount of deformation is permitted, usage of the
value for intermediate damage may also be envisaged.
1.4
1.3
1.2
Sea Bottom slope 1/50
1.4
H1n.ofH1f3
1.3
1.2
Sea Bott0m slope 1/30
1.4
1.3
Ho'iLo
Ho': Equivalent deepwater
wave height
-----
0.08
0.04
1.2~--O.D2
0.01
- 0.005
. 0.002
0.5
1.5
2.5
3.5
"h!Ho'
Fig. 1.7.1 Ratio of H 1120 to H 113 (H1120 Values are at a Distance 5H113 from the Breakwater)
IP~o.1 I(a)
No filter,
no oore
DnSOA =Nominal
DnSOF = Nominal
-414-
Table 1.7.1 Deformation Level S for Each Failure Stage for a Two-layered Armor
Slope
Initial damage
Intermediate damage
Failure
1:1.5
1:2
1:3
1:4
1:6
2
2
2
3
3
3-5
4-6
6--9
8-12
8-12
8
8
12
17
17
(7) Formulation for Calculating Stability Number for Armor Blocks including Wave Characteristics
Van der Meer has carried out model experiments on several kinds of precast concrete blocks, and proposed the
formulas for calculating the stability number Ns.29> In addition, other people have also conducted research into
establishing calculation formulas for precast concrete blocks. For example, Burcharth and Liu 30) have proposed
a calculation formula. However, it should be noted that these are based on the results of experiments for a sloping
breakwater with a high crown.
Takahashi et al.31) showed a performance verification method of the stability against wave action for armor stones
of a sloping breakwater using Van der Meer's formula as the verification formula, and proposed the performance
matrix used for performance verification.
(8) Formulas for Calculating Stability Number for Concrete Blocks of Breakwater Covered with Wave-dissipating
Blocks
The wave-dissipating concrete block parts of a breakwater covered with wave-dissipating blocks may have various
cross-sections. In particular, when all the front face of an upright wall is covered by wave-dissipating concrete
blocks, the stability is higher than that of armor concrete blocks of an ordinary sloping breakwater because the
permeability is high. In Japan, much research has been carried out on the stability of breakwaters covered with
wave-dissipating concrete blocks. For example, Tanimoto et al.32), Kajima et al.33), and Han2awa et aJ.34) have
carried out systematic research on the stability of wave-dissipating concrete blocks. In addition, Takahashi et
al.35J have proposed the following equation for wave-dissipating concrete blocks that are randomly placed in all
the front face of an upright wall.
{( I
(1.7.7)
degree of damage, a kind of damage rate that represents the extent of damage: it is defined as the
number of concrete blocks that have moved within a width Dn in the direction of the breakwater
aligmnent, where Dn is the nominal diameter of the concrete blocks: D.=(Mlp,)113, where Mis
the mass of a concrete block
CH : breaking effect coefficient; C~l.4/(H1 12o/H113J, in non-breaking zone CH= I.
a, b : coefficients that depend on the shape of the concrete blocks and the slope angle. With deformed
shape blocks having a Kn value of8.3, it may be assumed that a= 2.32 and b = 1.33, if cota=4/3,
and a = 2.32 and b = 1.42, if cola=1.5.
:
Takahashi et al.35J have further presented a method for calculating the cumulative degree of damage, the
expected degree of damage, over the service lifetime. In the future, reliability design methods that consider the
expected degree of damage is important as the more advanced design method. In the region where wave breaking
does not occur, if the number of waves is 1000 and the degree of damage No is 0.3, the design mass as calculated
using the method of Takahashi et al. is more-or-less the same as that calculated using the existing Kn value. The
value of No= 0.3 corresponds to the conventionally used damage rate of 1%.
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
top of the slope falling to the rear rather than the front. Therefore, rubble stones or concrete blocks which are to
be used at the head of a breakwater should have a mass greater than the value given by equation (1.7.1).
Hudson proposed increasing mass by about 10% in the case of rubble stones and about 30% in the case
of concrete blocks. However, because this is thought to be insufficient, it is preferable to use rubble stones or
concrete blocks with a mass at least 1.5 times the value given by equation (1.7.1). Kimura et al.3> have shown
that, in a case where perpendicular incident waves act on the breakwater head, the stable mass can be obtained
by increasing the required mass of the breakwater trunk by 1.5 times. In case of oblique incidence at 45, in the
breakwater head on the upper side relative to the direction of incidence ofthe waves, the necessary minimum mass
is the same as for 0 incidence, whereas, on the lower side of the breakwater head, stability is secured with the
same mass as the in the breakwater trunk.
(IO)Submerged Armor Units
Since the action of waves on a sloping breakwater below water surface is weaker than above the water surface, the
mass of stones or concrete blocks may be reduced at depths greater than l.5H113 below the still water level.
for a wave direction of0, and when the wave direction exceeds 60, the damage rate decreases. Considering these
results, when the incident wave angle is 45 or less, the required mass should not be corrected for wave direction.
Moreover, Christensen et al.3l have shown that stability increases when the directional spreading of waves is
large.
(12)Strength of Concrete Blocks
In case of deformed shape concrete block, it is necessary not only to ensure that the block has a mass sufficient
to be stable for the variable situation in respect of waves, but also to confirm that the block itself has sufficient
structural strength.
(13)Stability of Armor Blocks in Reef Area
In general, a reef rises up at a steep slope from the relatively deep sea, and forms a relatively fiat and shallow sea
bottom. Consequently, when a large wave enters at such a reef, it breaks around the slope, and then the regenerated
waves afterward propagate over the reef in the form of surge. The characteristics of waves over a reef are strongly
dependent on not only the incident wave conditions but also the water depth over the reef and the distance from
the shoulder of the reef. The stability of wave-dissipating concrete blocks situated on a reef also varies greatly
due to the same reasons. Therefore the characteristics over a reef are more complicated than that in general cases.
The stability of wave-dissipating concrete blocks situated on a reef must thus be examined based either on model
experiments matching the conditions in question or on field experiences for sites having similar conditions.
(14)Stability of Wave-dissipating Blocks on Low Crest Sloping Breakwater
For a low crown sloping breakwater with wave-dissipating blocks and without supporting wall, it is necessary to
note that the wave-dissipating blocks around its crown are easily damaged by waves.39J For example, for detached
breakwater composed of wave-dissipating blocks, unlike a caisson breakwater covered with wave-dissipating
blocks, there is no supporting wall at the back and the crown is not high. This means that the concrete blocks near
the crown in particular at the rear are easily damaged, and indeed such cases of block damage have been reported.
In the case of a detached breakwater, it is pointed out that some kind of concrete blocks at the rear of the crown
should have a larger size compared to the one at the front of the crown.
(IS)Stability of Blocks on Steep Slope Seabed
In cases where the bottom slope is steep and waves break in a plunging wave form, a large wave force may act
on the blocks, depending on their shapes. Therefore, appropriate examination should be carried out, considering
this fact.40)
(16)High-density Blocks
The required mass of blocks that are made of high-density aggregate may also be determined using the Hudson's
formula with the stability number shown in equation (1.7.1). As shown in the equation, high-density blocks have
a high stability, so a stable armor layer can be made using relatively small blocks.41)
(17)Effect of Structural Conditions
The stability ofwave-dissipating blocks varies depending on structural conditions and on the method ofplacement,
such as regular or random placement etc. According to the results of experiments under conditions of random
placement over the entire cross section and regular two-layer placement on a stone core, the regular placement
with good interlocking had remarkably higher stability in almost all cases.32J Provided, however, that if the layer
-416-
thickness of the blocks is minimal and the permeability of the core material is low, conversely, the stability of the
blocks decreases in some cases.42)
The stability of wave-dissipating blocks is also affected by the crown width and crown height of the blocks.
For example, according to the results of a number of experiments, there is a tendency of having greater stability
when the crown width and the crown height are greater.
(18)Standard Method of Hydraulic Model Tests
The stability of concrete blocks is influenced by a very large number of factors, and so it has still not been
sufficiently elucidated. This means that when actually verifying the performance, it is necessary to carry out
studies using model experiments, and it is needed to progressively accumulate the results of such tests. The
For the description of the extent of damage, in addition to the damage ratio which has been commonly used in
the past, the deformation level or the relative damage level may also be used. The deformation level is suitable
when it is difficult to count the number of armor stones or concrete blocks that have moved, while the degree
of damage is suitable when one wishes to represent the damage to wave-dissipating blocks. The damage rate is
the ratio of the number of damaged armor units in an inspection area to the total number of armor units in the
same inspection area. The inspection area is taken from the elevation of wave runup to whichever is shallower,
the depth of l.5H below the still water level or to the bottom elevation of the armor layer, where the wave height
H is inversely calculated from the Hudson's formula by inputting the mass of armor units. However, for the
deformation level and the degree of damage, there is no need to define the inspection area. For evaluating the
damage rate, an armor block is judged to be damaged if it has moved over a distance of more than about 1/2 to
1.0 times its height.
of the United States Army Corp of Engineers. This value is proposed for the breakwater trunk, parts other than
the breakwater head, in the 1984 Edition of the C.E.R.C.'s Shore Protection Manual.43) In the table, the values
not in parenthesis are based on experiment results by regular waves, and it is considered that those corresponds
to 5% or less of the damage rate due to action of random waves. The values in parentheses are estimated values.
For example, the value (1.2) for rounded rubble stones which are randomly placed in two-layer under the breaking
wave conditions is given as the value which is half of2.4, because the Kn value of two-layer angular rubble stones
under the breaking waves condition is 1/2 that under the non-breaking wave conditions.
However, in cases where the wave height of regular waves corresponds to the significant wave height, the
wave which is close to the maximum wave height of random waves acts continuously under the breaking wave
condition in the regular wave experiments. Therefore, the regular wave experiment under the breaking wave
condition falls into an extremely severe state in comparison with that under the non-breaking wave conditions. In
random waves experiments, as described previously, it is considered that so long as the significant wave height is
a standard, as the breaking wave conditions gets severe, conversely, Kn has a tendency to increase. Thus, at least
it is not necessary to reduce the value of Kv under the breaking wave conditions.
Table 1.7.2 Ko Value of Rubble Stones Proposed by C.E.R.C. {Breakwater Trunk)
Type of armor
Rubble stones (rounded)
Rubble stones (angular)
Number oflayers
Ko
Placement
Non-breaking
cola
method
Breaking waves
2
3 or more
Random
(1.2)
(1.6)
2.4
(3.2)
1.5-5.0
"
"
"
2.0
(2.2)
4.0
(4.5)
"
"
3 or more
-417-
waves
"
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
1. 7.2 Required Mass of Armor Stones and Blocks in Composite Breakwater Foundation Mound against
Waves
(!)General
The required mass of armor stones and blocks covering the foundation mound of a composite breakwater varies
depending on the wave characteristics, the water depth where the facility is placed, the shape of the foundation
mound such as thickness, front berm width and slope angle etc., and the type of armor unit, the placement method,
and the position, breakwater head or breakwater trunk etc. In particular, the effects of the wave characteristics
and the foundation mound shape are more pronounced than that on the armor stones and blocks on a sloping
breakwater. Adequate consideration should also be given to the effects of wave irregularity. Accordingly, the
required mass of armor stones and blocks on the foundation mound of composite breakwater shall be determined
by performing hydraulic model experiments or proper calculations using an appropriate equation in reference with
the results of past research and actual experiences in the field. Provided, however, that the stability of the armor
units covering the foundation mound of a composite breakwater is not necessarily determined purely by their
mass. Depending on the structure and the arrangement of the armor units it may be possible to achieve stability
even when the armor units are relatively small.
(2) Basic Equation for Calculation of Required Mass
As the equation for calculation of the required mass of armor stones and blocks in the foundation mound of a
composite breakwater, Hudson's formula with the stability number N8 , as shown in the following equation, can be
used in the same manner as with armor stones and blocks on sloping breakwater. In this equation, the symbol y is
a partial safety factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and d show the characteristic value and design value,
respectively. For the partial safety factors YNS and YH in the equation, 1.0 may be used. This partial safety factor is
the value in cases where the limit value of the damage rate is 1% or the limit value of the degree of damage is 0.3.
M
p,Ha
d
N11d '( Sr
-1 )'
(1.7.1)
This equation was widely used as the basic equation for calculating the required mass of the foundation
mounds of upright walls by Brebner and Donnelly.44) In Japan, it is also called Brebner-Donnelly's formula.
Because it has a certain degree of validity, even from a theoretical standpoint, it can also be used as the basic
equation for calculating the required mass of armor unit on the foundation mound of a composite breakwater.45)
Provided, however, that the stability number Ns varies not only with the water depth, the wave characteristics, the
shape of the foundation mound, and the characteristics of the armor units, but also with the position of placement,
breakwater trunk, breakwater head etc. Therefore, it is necessary to assign the stability number N8 appropriately
based on model experiments corresponding to the conditions. Moreover, the wave height used in the performance
verification is normally the significant wave height, and the waves used in the model experiments should be
random waves.
(3) Stability Number for Armor Stones
The stability number Ns may be obtained using the method proposed by Inagaki and Katayama, 46) which is based
on the work of Brebner and Donnelly and past damage case of armor stones. However, the following formulas
proposed by Tanimoto et al.45) are based on the current velocity in the vicinity of the foundation mound and allow
the incorporation of a variety of conditions. These formulas have been extended by Takahashi et al.47) so as to
include the effects of wave direction, and thus have high applicability.
(a) Extended Tanimoto's formulas
_
{ l.8,l.3---u,---+1.8exp
1-K h'
[-1.5-(i-Kf
h'-]}
N, -max
- -11 3
K
H113
H113
K=KJ(K2)H
4trh' IL'
K-----~
1
- sinh(4trh' IL')
(K2 )B
(1.7.8)
(1.7.9)
(1.7.10)
=max\ a, sin2 pcos2 (2tr cosp!L'), cos2 psin2 (2tr cos pl L'))
(1.7.11)
where
h' : water depth at the crown of rubble mound foundation excluding the armor layer (m) (see Fig.
1.7.4)
: in the case of normal wave incidence, the berm width of foundation mound BM(m)
-418-
in the case of oblique wave incidence, either BMor B]J, whichever gives the larger value of(KiJ
(see Fig. 1.7.4)
L' : wavelength corresponding to the design significant wave period at the water depth h' (m)
a, : correction factor for when the armor layer is horizontal (=0.45)
p : incident wave angle, angle between the line perpendicular to the breakwater face line and the
wave direction, no angle correction of 15 is applied (see Fig. 1.7.5)
H 113 : design significant wave height (m)
B
The validity of the above formulas have been verified for the breakwater trunk for oblique wave incidence
with an angle of incidence of up to 60.
Scawmd
BM
h'
d
I
:oot
111Z
ooblocla
"
Annocunits
Foot
blocks
Annorunits
Rubble mound
Breakwater head
Fig. 1.7.5 Effects of Shape of Breakwater Alignment and Effects of Wave Direction
025
(1.7.12)
where
N8 is the stability number given by the Tanimoto's formula whenN= 500 and the damage rate is 1%.
In the performance verification, it is necessary to take N = 1000 considering the progress of damage,
while the damage rate 3% to 5% can be allowed for a 2-layer armoring. IfN = 1000 and DN = 5%, then
N8* = l.44N8 . This means that the required mass decreases to about 1/3 of that required for N= 500
andDN=l%.
(4) Stability Number for Concrete Units
The stability number Nsfor concrete blocks varies according to the shape ofthe block and the method ofplacement.
It is thus desirable to evaluate the stability number by means of hydraulic model experiments.49), so) When carrying
out such experiments, it is best to employ random waves.
-419-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Based on the calculation method proposed by Tanimoto et al.,45) Fujiike et al.51) newly introduced reference
stability number, which is a specific value for blocks, and separating the terms which is determined by the
structural conditions of the composite breakwater etc., and then, presented the following equation regarding the
stability number for armor blocks in cases where wave incidence is perpendicular.
1-K h'
(i-K) h'
--+exp(-0.9----m---l }
112
Ir
H113
H113
K=K1(K2)8
refer (1.7.9)
4trh' IL'
Ki
sinh(4nn' /L')
2 27dJM
s m
--
L'
refer (1.7.10)
(
~'; ~0.15)
( 0.15 <
0.309
(1.7.13)
~'; ~ 0.25)
( 0.25<
(1.7.14)
~';)
where
Nso : reference stability number
A : constant determined based on wave force experiments ( = 0.525)
(5) Conditions for Application of Stability Number to Foundation Mound Armor Units
In cases where the water depth above the armor units on the mound is shallow, wave breaking often causes the
armor units to become unstable. Therefore, the stability number for foundation mound armor units shall be
applied only when h'IH113>1, and it is appropriate to use the stability number for armor units on a slope of a slope
structure when h'IH113 ::;I. The stability number for armor stones in the Tanimoto's formulas have not been verified
experimentally in cases where h'!H113 is small. Accordingly, when h'!H113 is approximately 1, it is preferable to
confirm the stability number by hydraulic model experiments.
On the other hand, Matsuda et al.52) carried out model experiments in connection with armor blocks, including
the case in which h 'IH113 is small and impulsive waves act on the blocks, and proposed a method that provides a
lower limit of the value of K corresponding to the value of a 1 in the case where the impulsive breaking wave force
coefficient a 1 is large.
(6) Armor Units Thickness
1\vo-layers are generally used for armor stones. It may be acceptable to use only one layer provided that
consideration is given to examples of armor units construction and experiences of damaged armor units. It also
may be possible to use one layer by setting the severe damage rate of 1% for N=lOOO acting waves in equation
(1.7.12). One layer is generally used for armor blocks. However, two layers may also be used in cases where the
shape of the blocks is favorable for two-layer placement or sea conditions are severe.
K=K1(K2)T
(1.7.15)
(K2)T =0.22
(1.7.16)
Note however that ifthe calculated mass turns out to be less than 1.5 times that for the breakwater trunk, it is
preferable to set it to 1.5 times that for the breakwater trunk.
-420-
mass in many cases. However, in cases where the mound is thick, the mass of armor units places on the slope in
deep water may be reduced.
(IO)Foundation Mound Armor Units in Breakwaters Covered with Wave-dissipating Blocks
In the case of breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks, the uplift pressure acting on the armor and the
current velocities in the vicinity of the mound are smaller than those of conventional composite breakwaters.
Fujiike et al.'l) carried out model experiments in connection with the stabilities of both the armor units of the
conventional composite breakwaters and the breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks, and proposed a
method ofmultiplicating equation (1.7.9) by the compensation rate. Namely,
(1.7.17)
where
CR : breakwater shape influence factor, it may be used 1.0 for conventional composite breakwaters
approximately 0.4 for breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks.
(ll)Flexible Armor Units
Use of bag-type foot protection units which consist of synthetic fiber net filled with stones as the armor units on
the foundation mound has various advantages: large stones are not required, and mound leveling is not virtually
needed because they have high flexibility and can adhere to the irregular sea bed. Shimosako et al.'3) proposed a
method of calculating the required mass of armor units on the foundation mound using bag-type foot protection
units, and also examined their durability.
1.7.3 Required Mass of Armor Stones and Blocks against Currents
(!)General
The required mass of rubble stones and other armor materials for foundation mounds to be stable against water
currents may be generally be determined by appropriate hydraulic model experiments or calculated using the
following equation. In this equation, the symbol y is a partial safety factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k
and d show the characteristic value and the design value, respectively.
Ma
ap,Ua
=-~~=--'--c~---~
(1.7.18)
where
M : stable mass of rubble stones or other armor material (t)
p, : density of rubble stones or other armor material (tfm3)
U : current velocity of water above rubble stones or other armor material (mis)
g : gravitational acceleration (m/s2)
y : lsbash's constant, for embedded stones, 1.20; for exposed stones, 0.86
S, : specific gravity of rubble stones or other armor material relative to water
(I : slope angle in axial direction of water channel bed(")
The design values in the equation may be calculated by using the following equations. For the partial safety
factors Yu and y,. 1.0 may be used.
This equation was proposed by the C.E.R.C. for calculation of the mass of rubble stones required to prevent
scouring by tidal currents and is called lsbash's formula.43) As also shown in the equation, attention should be
given to the fact that the required mass of armor units against currents increases rapidly as the current velocity
increases. The required mass also varies depending on the shape and density of the armor units etc.
-421-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-422-
Article22
3 In cases where the effects of scouring of the seabed and sand outflow on the integrity of structural members
may impair the stability of the facilities, appropriate countermeasures shall be taken.
[Commentary]
(1) Scouring and Washout (serviceability)
In cases where scouring of the foundation of facilities concerned and ground and outflow of sand from
the ground behind structures might impair the stability of the facilities, appropriate countermeasures
against scouring and countermeasures against washout must be taken, considering the structural type
of the objective facilities.
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
Nagao, T: Reliability based design method fur flexural design of caisson type breakwaters, Jour. JSCE Nagao, T.: No. 6961158, pp,173-184, 2002
Nagao, T.: Studies on tbe Application oftbe Limit State Design Method to Reinforced Concrete Port Structures, Rept. of
PHRI Vol. 33 No.4, 1994, pp.69-113
Nagao, T.: Case Studies on Safi:ty Factors about Seismic Stability for tbe Slob of Caisson Type Quaywalls, Technical Note of
PHRI, Technical Note of PHRI
Moriya, Y., M. Miyata and T. Nagao: Design method for bottom slab of caisson considering surface roughness of rubble
mound, Technical Note of National Institute fur Land and Infrastructure Management No. 94, 2003
Nagao T., M. Miyata, Y. Mariya and T. Sugano: A method for designing caisson bottom slabs considering mound unevenness.
Jour. JSCE C, Vol. 62, No.2, pp. 277-291, 2006
10) Kikuchi, Y., K. Takahashi and T. Ogura: Dispersion ofEarth Pressure in Experiments and Earth Pressure Change due to tbe
Relative Movement oftbe Neighboring Walls, Technical Note of PHRI No. 811, 1995
11) Taoimoto, K., K. Kobune and M. Osato: Wave Forces on a Caisson Wall and Stress Analysis of tbe Wall. fur Prototype
Breakwaters, Technical Note ofPHRI No.224, pp. 25-33, 1975
9)
12)
Shiomi, M., H. Yamamoto, A. Tsugawa, T. Kurosawa and K. Matsumoto: Damages and countermeasures of breakwaters due
to the wave force increase at discontinuous points of wave-absorbing blocks, Proceedings of the 41st conference on Coastal
Moriya, Y., M. Miyata and T. Nagao: Design method for bottom slab of caisson considering surface roughness of rubble
mound, Technical Note of National Institute fur Land aod Infrastructure Management No. 94, 2003
T. and T. Urae : Dyuamic characteristics of metal fitting for haogiog of large caisson, Proceedings of 29th
Confurence of JSCE, 1974
16) Yokota, H., K. Fukushima, T. Akimoto and M. lwanami: Examination fur Rationaliziog Structural Design of Reinforced
Concrete Caisson Structures,, Technical Note of PHRI No. 995, 2001
17) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Maoual fur L-shape block wharves, 2006
15)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
Nishibor~
Takahashi, S., K. Shimosako and H. Sasaki: Experimental Study on Wave Forces Acting on Perforated Wall Caisson
-423-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
23)
24)
25)
26)
27)
28)
29)
30)
31)
32)
33) Kashima, r., T. Sakakiyama, T. Shimizu, T. Sekimoto, H. Kunisu and 0. Kyoutani: Evaluation equation of deformation of
wave absorbing works due to random waves, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 42, pp. 795-799, 1995
34) Hanzawa, M., H. Sato, T. Takayama, S. Takahashi and K. Tanimoto: Study on evaluation equation for the stability of wave
absorbing blocks, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 42, pp.886-890, 1995
35) Takabashi, S., M. Hanzawa, H. Sato, M. Gomyou, K. Shimosako, K. Terauchi, T. Takayama and K. Tanimoto
36) Kimura, K., K. Kamikubo, Y. Sakamoto, Y. Mizuno, H. Takeda and M. Hayashi : Stability of blocks at the end of breakwaters
armored with wave absorbing blocks, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol.44, pp.956-960, 1997
37) Van de Kreeke, J.: Damage function of rubble mound breakwaters, ASCE., Journal of the Waterway and Harbors Division,
Vol.95, WW3, pp.345-354, 1969
38) F.T. Christensen, R.C. Broberg, S.E. Sand, and P. Tryde : Behavior of rubble-mound breakwater in directional and unidirectional waves, Coastal Eng., Vol.8, pp.265-278, 1984
39) Soave, T. and T. Yajima: Outstanding technical issues in designing of detached breakwaters, Lecture note of Summer training
for Hydraulic Engineering 1982, (18th)Course B, Uralic Committee ofJSCE, pp. B-5-l-B-5-24, 1982
40) Takeda, H., Y. Yamamoto, K.. Kimura and T. Sasazima: Impact wave forces and stability of wave absorbing blocks on
breakwaters placed on steep slope, Proceedings Offshore Development Vol..11, pp.287-290, 1995
41) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDI1): Technical Manual for wave absorbing blocks oflarge specific gravity,
p.45, 1995
42) Kubota, S., S. Kobayasbi, A. Maturnoto, M. Hanzawa and M. Matuoka: On the effuct of the layer tbickness and filling
materials of wave absolving blocks on their stability against waves, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 49, pp,756-760,
2002
43) Coastal Engineering Research Center: Shore Protection Manual, Vol.II, Department of Army Corps of Engineering, 1977
44) A. Brebner, D. Donnelly: Laboratory study of rubble fuundations fur vertical breakwaters, Proc. 8th Conf. of Coastal Engg.,
New Mexico City, pp.408-429, 1962
45) Tanimoto, K., T. Yanagisawa, T. Muranaga, K. Shibata and Y. Goda: Stability of Armor Units for Foundation Mounds of
Composite Breakwaters Determined by Irregular Wave Tests, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 21, No. 3, pp. 3-42, 1982
46) Inagaki, K. and T. Katayama: Analysis of damage to armor stones of mounds in composite breakwaters, Technical Note of
PHRI No.127, pp.1-22, 1971
47) Takahashi S., K. Kimura and K. Tanimoto: Stability of Armour Units of Composite Breakwater Mound against Oblique
Waves, Rep!. of PHRI Vol. 29 No. 2, pp.3-36, 1990
48) Sudo, K., K. Kimura, T. Sasajima, Y. Mizuno and H. Takeda: Estimation equation of requited weight of armour units of
rubble-mound of composite breakwaters considering the allowable deformation, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 42,
pp.896-900, 1995
49) Kougami, Y. and T. Narita: On the stability of armour layer, made with wave-absorbing blocks, of rubble foundation of
composite breakwaters, Journal of Public Works Research Institute (PWRI), Hokkaido Regional Development Bureau
(HRDB)No. 232, pp.1-13, 1972
50) Kashima, R., S. Saitou and H. Hasegawa: Required weight of armour concrete cube for rubble mound foundation of composite
breakwaters, Report of the Second Technical Research Institute of the Central Research Institute of Electric Power Industry
70022, p.18, 1971
51) Fujiike, T., K. Kimura, T. Hayashi and y. Doi: Stability against waves of armor units placed at front face of rubble-mound of
wave-absorbing-block-armored breakwaters, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 46, pp.881-885, 1999
52) Matuda, S., W. Nishikiori, A. Matumoto and M. Saitou: Estimation method of stable weight of armour blocks of rubblemound of composite breakwaters considering impact wave furce actions, Proceedings of Coastal Eng. JSCE Vol. 47, pp.896900, 2000
53) Shimosako, K., S. Kubota, A. Matumoto, M. Hanzawa, Y. Sbinomura, N. Oike, T. Iketani and S. Akiyama
54) Kudou, T.: Temporary river closing dikes and its overflow, Journal of JSCE, Vol. 58 No. 11, pp.63-69, 1973
-424-
-425-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2 Foundations
2.1 General Comments
(!) The foundation structures of the port facilities shall be selected appropriately, giving due consideration to the
importance of the facilities and soil ccnditions of the foundation ground.
(2) When the stability of the foundation structures seems to be an obstacle, countermeasures such as pile foundation
or scil improvement, etc. shall be applied as necessary.
(3) When the foundation ground is soft, excessive settlement or deformation may arise owing to the lack of the
bearing capacity. When the foundation ground consists of loose sandy soil, liquefaction due to action of ground
motion causes the structure failure or significantly damage its functions. In such cases, the stress in subsoil by the
weight of structures needs to be reduced or the foundation ground should be improved.
(4) For the stability of foundations, 2.2 Shallow Spread Foundations, and 2.3 Deep Foundations, or 3 Stability of
Slopes can be used as reference. For settlement of foundations, 2.5 Settlement of Foundations, and for liquefaction
due to action of ground motion, Part II, Chapter 6 Ground Liquefaction can be used as reference. For the
performance verification of pile foundations, 2.4 Pile Foundations can be used as reference. In cases where
it is necessary to conduct the performance verification for ground motion, the verification shall be performed
corresponding to the characteristics of the respective foundations.
(5) Methods of Reducing Ground Stress
The following are methods of reducing ground stress due to the weight of structures.
CD
(2.2.1)
where
qd : design value of foundation bearing capacity considering buoyancy of submerged part (kN/m2)
YR : partial factor for bearing capacity of sandy ground
-426-
PART Ill FACILITIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
Nrd, Nqd :
Nq =
k
NYk
p 2rfl,
l+sin9\
.
.
exp(Ktan9\) (Prandtl's solut10n)
1-sm9\
=(Nqt -l)tan(l.49\)
(Meyerhof's solution)
design value of unit weight of soil of ground above foundation bottom, or unit weight in water,
if submerged (k:N/m3)
: embedment depth of foundation in ground (m)
:
(2) When the actions on the foundation increase, first, settlement of the foundation occurs in proportion to the actions.
However, when the actions reach a certain value, settlement increases suddenly and shear failure of the ground
occurs. The intensity of the load required to cause this shear failure which is obtained by dividing the load by
the contact area is called the ultimate bearing capacity of the foundation. The bearing capacity of the foundation
can be calculated by multiplying the ultimate bearing capacity obtained from the bearing capacity formula by the
partial factor YR
Continuous
1
Square
Round
Rectangular
0.8
0.6
1-0.2(B/L)
100
I
I/
I/
.
0
.
0
~ 10
ID
~
'S
ti
Nqk/
I Nrk
I
] /
//
.f
iii
;..
"'~
10
20
30
40
50
eflt (
Fig. 2.2.1 Relationship between Bearing Capacity Factors Nrt and Nqk and Angle of Shear Resistance ;,,
-427-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2.2.3 Bearing Capacity of Foundations on Cohesive Soil Ground
(!) In calculations of the design values for foundations of cohesive soil ground in cases where the undrained shear
strength increases linearly with depth, the following equation can be used. In this case, an appropriate value
corresponding to the characteristics of the facilities shall be selected for the partial factor YR
qd=rRN,o,(l+n~}o,+J12,gD
(2.2.2)
where
qd : design value of foundation bearing capacity considering buoyancy of submerged part (kN/m2)
YR : partial factor for bearing capacity of cohesive soil ground
12
-----------------~
.~ ::-'i:i"1mm !mm
10
0.25
'
'
.......
:
I.......
N,,,. 6
Neat :
:'
:'
'I
0.20
'I
0.15 n
---.---=------1----------,----------~----------
:
I
-i l - - ~ - - -!- -: n
I
:
I
0.30
:
I
--------~----------,----------~-----------.--------
0.10
--------~-----------r----------1----------,---------
0.05
'
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
'
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
0
0
Fig. 2.2.2 Relationship of Bearing Capacity factor Ncok of Cohesive Soil Ground in which Strength Increases in Depth
Direction and Shape Factor n
-428-
PART Ill FACILITIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(4) Practical Equation for Calculating Design Value of Bearing Capacity
Based on the bearing capacity factors shown in Fig. 2.2.2, the design value of the bearing capacity of foundations
in case of continuous foundations can be calculated using the practical equation shown in equation (2.2.3) in the
range where k.,/c 0k~4. The symbols used are the same as in equation (2.2.2).
qd
(2.2.3)
(1) Examination of stability for the bearing capacity when the foundation ground has a multi-layered structure can be
performed by circular slip failure analysis. Assuming the overburden pressure above the level of the foundation
bottom as the surcharge, circular slip failure analysis is performed by the modified Fellenius method for an arc
passing through the edge of the foundation, as shown in Fig. 2.2.3. As the partial factor YR for the analysis method,
0.66 or less can be used generally, but in cases where settlement will have a large effect on the functions of the
facilities like crane, it is prefurable to use a value of no more than 0.4.
Soil layer 1
Soil layer 2
Soil layer 3
Soil layer 4
Fig. 2.2.3 Calculation of Bearing Capacity of Multi-layered Ground by Circular Slip Failure Analysis
(2) If the cohesive soil layer thickness H is significantly less than the smallest width of the foundation B (i.e., H <
0.5B), a punching shear failure, in which the cohesive soil layer is squeezed out between the surcharge plane and
the bottom of cohesive soil layer, is liable to occur. The bearing capacity against this kind of squeezed-out failure
can be calculated by the following equation 4)
(2.2.4)
: design value of bearing capacity of foundation considering the buoyancy of the submerged
part (kN/m2)
B : smallest width of foundation (m)
H : thickness of cohesive soil layer (m)
: design value of mean undrained shear strength in layer of thickness H (kN/m2)
: design value of unit weight of soil above the level of foundation bottom or unit weight in water,
if submerged (kN/m3)
YR : partial factor for bearing capacity
D : embedded depth of foundation (m)
2.2.5 Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and Inclined Actions
(!) Examination of the bearing capacity for eccentric and inclined actions acting on the foundation ground of gravitytype structures can be performed by circular slip failure analysis with the simplified Bishop method using the
following equation. In this equation, the symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k
and d indicate the characteristic value and design value, respectively. In this case, the partial factor shall be an
apprcpriate value corresponding to the characteristics of the facilities. It is necessary to set the strength constant
of the ground, the forms of the actions, and other factors appropriately considering the structural characteristics
of the facilities.
-429-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
rFJFI=~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Lkwa +qa)sinO+aPH,/R}
(2.2.5)
where
W'a
qd
(J
~
Wd
PHd
a
S
l'F/
in case of cohesive soil ground, design value of undrained shear strength, and in case of sandy
Based on equation (2.2.5), l'FJ is calculated, and stability is verified by the verification parameter Fj::I. The
design values in the equation can be calculated by the following equations. Provided, however, that in cases where
partial factors are given by structural type, the partial factor for the part concerned shall be used. In other cases
where partial factors are not particularly designated, the value of the partial factor y can be set at 1.00.
(2.2.6)
(2) In gravity-type quaywalls and gravity-type breakwaters, actions due to self weight, earth pressure, wave force,
and ground motion shall be considered. However, the resultant of these actions is normally both eccentric and
inclined. Therefore, examination for eccentric and inclined actions is necessary in examination of the bearing
capacity of foundations. Here, eccentric and inclined action means an action with an inclination ratio equal to or
greater than 0.1.
(3) Because normal gravity-type structures are two-layered structures with a rubble mound layer on foundation
ground, an examination method which adequately reflects this feature is necessary. The fact that circular slip
failure calculations by the Bishop method, simplified Bishop method, accurately express stability for bearing
capacity has been confirmed in a series of research results, including laboratory model experiments, in-situ
loading experiments, and analysis of the existing breakwaters and quaywalls, and this method is therefore used as
a general method.SJ
(4) Analysis of Bearing Capacity by Circular Slip Failure Analysis based on the Bishop Method
Analysis through circular slip failure analysis based on the Bishop method is more precise than the analysis based
on the modified Fellenius method, except when a vertical action exerts on horizontally layered sandy ground.
Therefore, the circular slip failure analysis by the Bishop method is applied under the condition that eccentric and
inclined actions exert act. As shown in Fig. 2.2.4 (a), the start point of the slip surface is set symmetrical about
the acting point of resultant load to one of the foundation edges that is closer to the load acting point. In this case,
the vertical action exerting on the rubble mound is converted into uniformly distributed load acting on the width
between fore toe of the bottom and the start point of the slip surface as indicated in Fig. 2.2.4 (b) and (c). The
horizontal force is assumed to act at the bottom of structure. When calculating the bearing capacity during an
earthquake, seismic force is assumed not to act on the rubble mound and the ground.
-430-
PART Ill FACILITIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(p~7;:> B
~1:,
b' b'
Combrn rce ofload
(a)
(b)
(c)
Fig. 2.2.4 Analysis of Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and Inclined Actions
(5) Verification Parameter and Partial Factors
CD
The verification parameter is expressed by the ratio of the sliding moment due to actions and the weight of
earth and the resistant moment due to shear resistance (see 3.2.1 Stability Analysis by Circular Slip Failure
Surface). As general values of the partial factors for the analysis method, the values shown in Table 2.2.2 can
be used. Provided, however, that in cases where partial factors are indicated by structural type, the partial factor
for the part concerned shall be used.
@ Regarding actions on breakwaters due to ground motion, few examples of damage are available, and the degree
of damage is also small. As the reasons for this, in many cases actions due to ground motion are basically
equal in the harbor direction and the outer sea direction, and large displacement does not occur due to the short
duration ofthe action. Accordingly, examination ofthe bearing capacity due to actions of ground motion may be
omitted in the case of ordinary breakwaters. Provided, however, that detailed examination by dynamic analysis
is desirable for breakwaters where stability due to actions of ground motion may be a serious problem.
Table 2.2.2 Standard Values of Partial Factor YR in Analysis Method for Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and Inclined
Actions (Bishop Method}
Quaywalls
Breakwaters
Permanent situation
:50.83
~l.00
~1.00
Note) In case partial factors are indicated by structural type, the partial factor for the part concerned shall be used.
CD
Mound materials
Model and field experiments on bearing capacity subject to eccentric and inclined actions have verified that
high precision results can be obtained by conducting circular slip failure analyses based on the simplified
Bishop method, applying the strength parameters obtained by triaxial compression tests S). Large-scale triaxial
compression test results of crushed stone have confirmed that the strength parameters oflarge diameter particles
are approximately equal to those obtained from similar grained materials with the same uniformity coefficient
6). Therefore, triaxial compression tests using samples with similar grained materials are preferably conducted
in order to estimate the strength parameters of rubbles accurately. If the strength tests are not conducted, the
values of cohesion en = 20 kN/m2 and shearing resistance angle ~D = 35 are applied as the standard strength
parameters for rubbles generally used in port construction works.
The above standard values have been determined as safe side values based on the results of large-scale
triaxial compression tests of crushed stones. The values have been proven appropriate from the analysis results
of the bearing capacity of the existing breakwaters and quaywalls. It should be noted that cohesion en = 20 kN/
m2 as a strength parameter is the apparent cohesion, taking account of variations of the shear resistance angle
-431-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
r/>o of crushed stones under variable confining pressures. Fig. 2.2. 5 shows the results of triaxial compression
tests on various types of crushed stones and rubbles 5). It shows that as the confining pressure increases, ~
decreases due to particle crushing. The solid line in the figure represents the value under the assumption that the
apparent cohesion is cv = 20 kN/m2 and the shear friction angle is 'v= 35. Here, the dependency of r/>o on the
confining pressure is well described by taking the apparent cohesion into account. These standard values can be
applied only to the stone material with an unconfined compressive strength in the mother rock of 30 MN/m2 or
more. If weak stones with the compressive strength of the mother rock of less than 30 MN/m2 are used as a part
of the mound, the strength parameters will be around cv= 20 kN/m2 and~= 30 7)
50
Test values
cD=20kNJm2, ;J)=35
45
40
'
;n(o)
35
30
25
50
100
200
400
800
1400
@ Foundation ground
Foundations subject to eccentric and inclined actions often cause shallow surface slip failure. In these cases, it
is important to evaluate the strength near the surface of foundation ground. If the foundation ground is sandy,
the strength coefficient Jv is usually estimated from N-value. The estimation formulas employed up to now
have tended to underestimate r/>o in case of shallow sandy grounds. This is because no correction has been made
regarding the effective surcharge pressure in-situ.
Fig. 2.2.6 collates the results of triaxial compression tests on undisturbed sand in Japan and presents a
comparative study of the formulas proposed in the past. Even when the N-values are less than 10, shearing
resistance angles of around 40 have been obtained. In many cases, the bearing capacity for eccentric and
inclined actions is important on the performance verification which is not under the permanent situation but
under dynamic external forces such as wave and seismic forces. In addition to the above and based on the results
of bearing capacity analysis of the structures damaged in the past, the values given below are applied as the
standard values of rf>o in foundation ground.
Sandy ground with N-value of less than 10 : rf>o= 40
Sandy ground with N-value of 10 or more : rf>o= 45
If the ground consists of cohesive soil, the strength may be determined by the method indicated in Part II,
Chapter 3, 2.3.3 Shear Characteristics.
-432-
PART Ill FACILITIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
50
,-...
0
~40
.. . I
.
. . .. . ..:...\ . . . . ........ ....
.. . . . ..
.
. . . . .. . .
+
I
... ... ""'
20
200
/
Triaxial test
I results
, ,
o a
':.
~ D= 20N
10
15 according to Osaki
50
100
500
N-value
Fig. 2.2.6 Relationship Between N-value and ; 0 0btained by Triaxial Tests of Undisturbed Sand Samples
-433-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(!) When the penetration depth of a foundation is greater than the minimum width of the foundation, it shall be
examined as a deep foundation. Means of distinguishing the deep foundations described here from pile foundations
include the method of judging whether PL (L: embedment length of pile) ;;;; 1 or not, based on calculations by the
method proposed by Y. L. Chan, see 2.4.5 Static Maximum Lateral Resistance of Piles.
(2) Foundations ofthe type described in(!) generally include the well, pneumatic caisson and continuous underground
wall. For pile foundations, see 2.4 Pile Foundations.
(3) Deep foundations support the superstructure stably by transmitting the action due to the heavy superstructure
through the weak upper strata to the strong lower strata. Accordingly, it can normally be considered that vertical
force is supported by the frictional resistance at the side surfaces of the foundation and the vertical bearing
capacity at the bottom, and the horizontal force is supported by the passive resistance of the ground.
2.3.2 Characteristic Value of Vertical Bearing Capacity
(1) The characteristic value of the vertical bearing capacity of a deep foundation shall be set taking into account the
soil conditions, the structural type, and the method of construction.
(2) Generally, the vertical bearing capacity of a deep foundation can be determined from the bearing capacity of the
foundation bottom and the resistance of the foundation sides, as shown in equation (2.3.1). However, in cases
where the amount of displacement and/or deformation of the facilities may be a problem, the deformation of deep
foundations should be estimated by assuming the ground behaves as a spring.
(2.3.1)
where
q., : characteristic value of vertical bearing capacity of deep foundation (kN/m2)
q.Jk : characteristic value of bearing capacity of foundation bottom (kN/m2)
see 2.2.2 Bearing Capacity of Foundations on Sandy Ground, 2.2.3 Bearing Capacity of
Foundations on Cohesive Soil Ground
qui; : characteristic value of bearing capacity due to resistance of foundation sides (kN/m2)
(3) The design value of the vertical bearing capacity of deep foundations shall consider a safuty margin in the
characteristic value of the vertical bearing capacity, as in equation (2.3.2). The characteristic value of the
foundation bottom bearing capacity determined as described in 2.2.2 Bearing Capacity of Foundations on
Sandy Ground and 2.2.3 Bearing Capacity of Foundations on Cohesive Soil Ground, and the partial factor y0 ,
which is used in cases where the characteristic value of the vertical bearing capacity is determined using equation
(2.3.3) and equation (2.3.5), as shown in the following, can generally be set at 0.4 or less for important facilities
and 0.66 or less for other facilities.
(2.3.2)
where
(4) Caution is required concerning the resistance of the sides of deep foundations, as there are cases in which the
surrounding ground may be disturbed by construction and, as a result, adequate bearing capacity by side resistance
cannot be expected, depending on the structural type and method of construction.
Q) The characteristic value of the bearing capacity due to the frictional resistance of the foundation sides in sandy
ground can be calculated by equation (2.3.3).
(2.3.3)
where
~
y2,
: characteristic value of coefficient of active earth pressure (S ~ 0), see Part II, Chapter 5, 1
Earth Pressure
: characteristic value of unit weight of soil above level of foundation bottom, or submerged unit
weight if submerged (kN/m3)
-434-
PART Ill FACILITIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
D : penetration depth of foundation (m)
le : characteristic value of coefficient of friction between foundation sides and sandy soil,
2
le =-tan;le
(2.3.4)
The friction angle between the foundation sides and sandy soil should not be greater than the shear resistance
angle of soil ,P, and it may be taken as (2/3) ,P for the case between concrete and sandy soil.
The characteristic value of bearing capacity due to the cohesive resistance of the foundation sides in cohesive
soil ground can be calculated by equation (2.3.5).
q.,
lk
=2(1+ B)Dc
L B
Cale
(2.3.5)
where
Cale : characteristic value of mean adhesion (mean value in embedded part) (kN/m2)
De : penetration depth of foundation below groundwater level (m)
B : width of foundation (m)
L : length of foundation (m)
In case of deep foundations in cohesive soil ground, there is generally a possibility of drying shrinkage
during summer in the soil above the groundwater level; therefore, this soil is not considered to be an effective
contact surface. Accordingly, the mean adhesion ca in equation (2.3.5) should be the mean adhesion in the
effective contact part.
As practical values of mean adhesion in cohesive soil, the values in Table 2.3.1 can be used as reference.
Table 2.3.1 Relationship between Unconfined Compression Strength and Mean Adhesion of Cohesive Soil
(kN/m2)
Class of ground at foundation side
Soft cohesive soil
Medium cohesive soil
Hard cohesive soil
Extremely hard cohesive soil
Consolidated cohesive soil
q,,
Ca
20-50
50-100
100-200
200-400
>400
-)
6-12
12-25
25-30
>30
*Note) with soft cohesive soil, side resistance should not be considered.
-435-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(4) The design value of the horizontal resistance force of deep foundations should include a safety margin in the
characteristic value, as in the following equation. When the characteristic value of the horizontal resistance force
of a deep foundation is obtained by the method presented below, the partial factors shown in Table 2.3.2 can
generally be used.
(2.3.6)
where
F.,, : design value of horizontal resistance force of deep foundation (kN/m2)
F., : characteristic value of horizontal resistance force of deep foundation (kN/m2)
Ya : partial factor
Table 2.3.2 Partial Factor Ya
Important facilities
0.66
0.40
Other facilities
0.90
0.66
CD
When a resultant force at a bottom of foundation acts inside the core, namely the eccentricity of total resultant
force acting at the bottom of foundation is within one-sixth of the foundation width from the central axis of
the foundation, the maximum horizontal subgrade reaction p 1 and maximum vertical subgrade reaction q1 can
be estimated by assuming the distributions of horizontal and vertical subgrade reaction are assumed as in Fig.
2.3.1.
No
p=kxy
(2.3.7)
where
p
-436-
PART Ill FACILITIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
When a linear distribution is assumed for vertical subgrade reaction and a resultant force acting at the bottom
of foundation is inside the core, the distribution of the vertical subgrade reaction becomes trapezoidal as shown
in Fig. 2.3.1.
@ Conditions when vertical resultant is in the core and characteristic value for horizontal resistance force in such
cases
The conditions for the case in which the vertical resultant at the bottom is in the core are expressed as in
equation (2.3.8).
N +wf
0
2
3aK{kw1 +4P,,+6M0 )
~~~'-,-~~~~~~b(t 3 + 24aK'a 3 )
(2.3.8)
The maximum horizontal subgrade reaction p 1 (kN/m2) and the maximum vertical subgrade reaction q1 (kN/
m2) in this case are obtained by equations (2.3.9) and (2.3.10), respectively.
4
4bl3
(2.3.9)
(2.3.10)
When determining the horizontal resistance force of deep foundations, the values ofp 1 and q1 obtained by
equations (2.3.9) and (2.3.10) must satisfy equations (2.3.11) and (2.3.12), respectively.
(2.3.11)
(2.3.12)
where
(2.3.13)
q.,, : design value of vertical bearing capacity at bottom level (kN/m2), see equation (2.3.2)
i'a : partial factor for horizontal resistance force
When Vertical Resultant Force at the Bottom is outside the Core 12)
When the vertical resultant force acting at the base of foundation is not inside the core, a triangular distribution
of vertical subgrade reaction is assumed as shown in Fig. 2.3.2 12). When the vertical subgrade reaction is
expressed as qd (kN/m2), the maximum subgrade reaction p 1(kN/m2) in the front ground is obtained from
equation (2.3.14).
-437-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2.3.14)
The value ofp 1 calculated by equation (2.3.14) should satisfy equation (2.3.11). In this case, his obtained by
equation (2.3.12).
h-
(2.3.15)
where
h : depth at which horizontal subgrade reaction becomes maximum (m), see Fig. 2.3.2
W : self weight of foundation (kN)
e : eccentric distance (m)
The distance e is defined as shown in Fig. 2.3.2. When the foundation bottom is rectangular with the length
of2a (m) and the width of2b (m), the value of e is calculated by equation (2.3.16).
W+No
4bq.
e=a
(2.3.16)
In the case of a round foundation bottom, the calculation may be made by replacing it with a rectangular
foundation bottom having length 2a and width 2b defined by equation (2.3.17).
2a=; D )
(2.3.17)
2b='}__D
4
where
In this way, the horizontal bearing capacity can be estimated at a safer side by approximately 10%. However,
this substitution should be applied on the basis of the appropriate judgement, by referring to reference 12).
Po
I
_!
I
I
I
I
k'!J
+w
'
I
I
I
I
1.
2a
I
_l
I
I~
3:1l
~.
-438-
(!) The design value of the axial bearing resistance of pile foundations comprising vertical piles is generally
determined based on the maximum axial bearing resistance due to the resistance of the ground to vertical single
piles as a standard value in talcing consideration of the following items.
Q) Safety margin for displacement in the axial direction based on ground failure and deformation of the ground
@ Compressive stress of pile material
@Joints
@ Slenderness ratio of piles
Action as pile group
@ Negative skin friction
IJ) Settlement of pile head
(2) The above (1) describes the general principle for determining the axial bearing resistance of pile foundations
comprising vertical piles. In order to determine the axial bearing resistance of a pile foundation, first, the static
maximum axial bearing resistance due to the resistance of the ground is determined, and a safety margin is
considered on this. Then, the above items (a) to (g) are examined, and the maximum axial bearing resistance is
reduced as necessary. The result obtained in this manner is the design value of the axial bearing resistance of the
piles which should be used in performance verification of the pile foundation.
(3) When considering the axial bearing resistance characteristics of a single pile based on the resistance ofthe ground,
the axial compressive load Po acting on the pile head of the single pile is supported by the end resistance Rp and
the shaft resistance R1 ofthe pile, and can be expressed as in equation (2.4.1).
(2.4.1)
where
Q) Typical characteristic values for the axial bearing resistance of single piles include the following.
(a) Second limit resistance: Resistance equivalent to the load at the maximum bearing resistance in a static
loading test. Provided, however, that the displacement of the end of the pile shall be within a range ofno more
than 10% of the end diameter. The static maximum axial bearing resistance given by appropriate calculations
shall be equivalent to this.
(b) First limit resistance: Resistance equivalent to the load at a clear break point appearing in the logP-logS curve
in the static compressive loading test. P represents load at the head and S means settlement value at the head
of a pile.
-439-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(c) Vertical spring constant of pile head: Slope of the secant of the pile head load displacement curve in the static
compressive loading test.
(5) Setting of Design Value of Axial Bearing Resistance of a Single Pile Based on Resistance of Ground
Q) A safety margin shall be provided in the second limit resistance. The following equations are used in this safety
margin. Provided, however, that y in the equation is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and
d indicate the characteristic value and the design value, respectively.
(2.4.2)
(2.4.3)
where
RP : bearing resistance of the end of pile
In cases where only the bearing resistance of the pile head can be obtained in the loading test, and a safuty
margin can be determined from the bearing resistance of the pile head, the following equation can be used.
(2.4.4)
where
R1
The standard values of the partial factors rru for the pile end resistance, the shaft resistance, and the axial
bearing resistance of piles shall be as shown in Table 2.4.1-Table 2.4.3. Provided, that in cases where partial
factors are determined separately by code calibrations, etc., in the design system. The subscript i represents
p,f, or t.
Table 2.4.1 Standard Values of Partial Factors for Shaft Resistance
'YR,: Partial factor
Design situation
0.40
0.66
0.40
0.66
0.40
Table 2.4.2 Standard Values of Partial factors for Pile End Resistance
Design situation
0.40
0.40
0.66 (0.50)
0.40
0.66 (0.50)
In case the end of the pile remains in an incomplete bearing stratum which appears to be unsafe, the figures in parentheses shall be used.
Friction pile
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.66
0.50
0.40
0.40
0.66
0.50
) End bearing piles and friction piles shall be as classification provided in (10).
-440-
(6) Based on information for the performance verifications of normal port facilities , the use of the partial factors
listed above may give conservative results.
(7) Because the axial bearing resistance of piles is strongly affected by the construction method, it is necessary to
carry out construction in advance with test piles and collect information for the verification by various types of
examination. Depending on the results obtained with the test piles, it may be necessary to change the dimensions
of the piles or the construction method.
(8) Among the axial resistance factors of a certain pile, when the end resistance of the pile Rp is governing, the pile is
called the end bearing pile, and when the shaft resistance R1 is governing, it is called the friction pile. According to
this definition, a pile becomes a bearing pile or a friction pile depending on load conditions such as the magnitude
of the load, loading velocity, loading duration, etc. Therefore, the distinction between end bearing piles and
friction piles cannot be considered absolute. Although the following definitions lack strictness, here, a pile which
passes through soft ground and whose end reaches bedrock or some other bearing stratum is called the end
bearing pile, and a pile whose end stops in a comparatively soft layer, and not a hard layer that could particularly
be considered a bearing stratum, is called the friction pile.
(9) In general, when a pile penetrates to a so-called bearing stratum such as bedrock, or dense sandy ground, axial
resistance is larger and settlement is smaller than when a pile only penetrates to an intermediate layer. When a
pile penetrates to a so-called bearing stratum, the pile itselfrarely settles, even when the soft layers surrounding
the pile undergo consolidation settlement. Therefore, negative skin friction acts on the pile, applying a downward
load, and the amount of settlement diffurs in the head of the pile and the surrounding ground. As these phenomena
cause a variety of problems, caution should be necessary. Although these defects are slight in piles which only
penetrate to intermediate layers, settlement due to consolidation of the ground under the pile continues, and as a
result, there is a danger of uneven settlement.
(lO)The partial factor for the serviceability limit is applied to ultimate failure phenomena of the ground. When the
designer desires to avoid yielding of the ground, the use of the first limit resistance is conceivable. The Partial
factor in this case can be set at a value on the order of0.5.
(ll)In case permanent deformation of the ground is expected to remain after an earthquake, separate examination is
necessary. Furthermore, because there are cases in which the shear strength of the soil is remarkably reduced by
the action of ground motion, caution is necessary. For example, when sensitive cohesive soil is affected by violent
motion, loss of strength is conceivable, and from past examples of earthquake damage, it has been pointed out that
liquefaction may occur in loose sandy layers as a result of the action of ground motion, causing a large decrease in
the resistance of piles. Accordingly, with friction piles, which are easily affected by phenomena of this type, due
caution is necessary in setting the partial factors.
(12)Pile group means a group of piles in which the piles are mutually affected by pile axial resistance and
displacement.
[2] Static Maximum Axial Resistance of Single Piles due to Resistance of Ground
(1) The static maximum axial resistance of single piles can be obtained by vertical loading tests or calculation by
static bearing capacity formulas after an appropriate soil investigation.
(2) As methods of estimating the static maximum axial resistance of single piles from the resistance of the ground,
the following are conceivable:
-441-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
thereon, the appropriateness of the pile axial resistance used in the performance verification should be confirmed
by conducting loading tests at the initial stage of construction.
(4) Case in which the Second Limit Resistance is not Obtained Directly by Loading Test
Although there is no problem if the second limit resistance can be obtained by a loading test, in many cases, it is
not possible to apply a sufficiently large load to confirm the second limit resistance due to constraints related to the
test equipment. In such cases, the second limit resistance can be assumed by multiplying the first limit resistance
obtained by a loading test by 1.2. This judgment is based on the results of research by Yamakata and Nagai 14) on
steel pipe piles and statistical studies by Kitajima et al.15) When the first limit resistance also cannot be obtained
in loading tests, the second limit resistance should be assumed to be 1.2 times the maximum load in the test, or a
method of setting the design value ofthe pile axial resistance which does not depend on the second limit resistance
should be examined. In either case, a condition which assumes that the pile axial resistance estimated in this way
will be larger than the pile axial resistance that can actually be expected is required.
(5) Alternative Loading Test Methods for Static Loading Test
(j) The rapid load test 17) is a loading test which shall be performed in less than 1 second. Test equipment capable
of applying a large instantaneous load is necessary; however, because various innovations have eliminated the
need for reaction piles, the test can be performed more easily than the static loading test.
@ The end loading test is a method in which a jack is installed near the bottom end of the pile, and the pile body is
pushed up while pushing the bottom end of the pile. This method enables separate measurement of the pile end
resistance and pile shaft resistance.
-442-
@ The dynamic loading test 18) is a type ofloading test which employs an ordinary pile driver. As a feature of this
test method, changes over time in the elastic strain and displacement of the pile head are measured. In this test,
there are limits to the resistance which can be obtained, depending on the magnitude of the pile-driving energy.
Therefore, when the axial resistance which is to be estimated is large, as in long or large-diameter piles, in many
cases it is not applied as a method for direct estimation of the second limit resistance. It can be used to estimate
the relationship between static resistance and driving stop control during construction.
CD
(a) When employing static resistance formulas using the results of standard penetration test results and undrained
shear strength of ground
i) End resistance of a pile
a) Equation (2.4.S) can be used in estimating end resistance of a pile when the bearing stratum is sandy
ground.
RPk =300NAP
(2.4.5)
where
Rpk : characteristic value of end resistance of a pile by static resistance formula (kN)
Ap : effective area of end of pile (m2). In determining the effective area of an open-ended pile, it is
necessary to consider the degree of closure of the end of the pile.
N : N value of ground around pile end
Provided, however, N is calculated by equation (2.4.6).
(2.4.6)
where
N1 : N-value at end of pile (N1 :5: 50)
_
N 2 : mean N-value in range above the end of pile to distance of 4B ( N2 :5: 50)
B : diameter or width of pile (m)
In equation (2.4.5), the coefficient of the equation proposed by Meyerhofbased on the correlation between
the static penetration test and the standard penetration test in sandy ground was modified to conform to real
conditions.
In estimating the ultimate pile end resistance of piles supported by ground with an N-value of 50 or more,
caution is necessary, as N-values itself is not reliable when it is measured larger than 50, and furthermore,
the applicability of equation (2.4.5) in its current form to hard ground of this kind has not been adequately
confirmed.
b) In estimation of the point resistance of piles when the point of the pile penetrates clayey ground, equation
(2.4.7) can be used.
(2.4.7)
where
6cp-4p
-443-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
As the undrained shear strength used here, the undrained shear strength c. obtained in the unconfined
compression test was commonly used up to the present.
(2.4.8)
where
Rfk : characteristic value of pile shaft resistance (kN)
'fk; : average strength of skin friction per unit of area in i-th layer (kN/m2)
A,; : circumferential area of pile in contact with ground in i-th layer (= length of outer circumference
Us x thickness of layer l) (m2)
For sandy ground, equation (2.4.9) can be used.
'ft;
=2N
(2.4.9)
where
N
(2.4.10)
where
ca
Here, the value of the adhesion of the pile may be obtained as follows.
in case c ~ 100kN/m2; ca= c
in case c > 100kN/m2; Ca = 100kN/m2
(2.4.11)
However, because theoretical problems 24) arise in obtaining the adhesion of piles from the undrained shear
strength c of the ground, the value of adhesion should be examined, paying due attention to the characteristics
of the ground and conditions of the piles.
(b) Method of estimating the end resistance of piles which remain in sandy ground from bearing capacity theory
(2.4.12)
where
Nq : bearing capacity coefficient proposed by Berezantzev, see Fig. 2.4.2
'"vO : effective overburden pressure at the end of pile (kN/m2)
When Nq is to be obtained from Fig. 2.4.2, it is necessary to obtain the shear resistance aogle. When
obtaining the shear resistance aogle, equation (2.3.21) in Part II, Chapter 3, 2.3.4 Interpretation Methods
for NValues can be used. When the shear resistaoce aogle is to be obtained by a triaxial compression test, it
is necessary to consider the fact that the shear resistance angle is reduced as a result of confining pressure.
-444-
25
35
30
40
45
=
qp
I
"
I,
3(1 +sin;,.)
[I ]C.m;;,,;c,o+.u;,,JJJ(3 - 2sin;,.
(1-sin;,.)(3-sin;,.) "
3
Joc
vo
I,
l+I,Aav
3G
(2.4.13)
where
qP : end resistance of a pile per unit area (kN/m2)
I" : corrected rigidity index
I, : rigidity index
,; : shear resistance angle in limit condition; assumes !Pov'= 30+Ai+A.,. the values of Ai and A.,
shall be as shown in Table 2.4.4.
A.,, : coefficient defining compressibility of ground. Aav = 50 (J,)-1.8
G : shear rigidity. May be obtsined as G = 7000.N0-12 (kN/m2). N is the N-value around the end of
the pile.
Table 2.4.4 t.\6,;
t.;,()
t.;;_{)
Round
Uniform (Uo<2)
Somewhat aogu1ar
Angular
-445-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
0
x Measured
300N
20
8.._,
cs
>Xo ~
'tJJ [J
x<
cf
r::l
.....c.
0
40
X<-0 0
>
t;!
60
ox
80
10
15
20
25
30
Fig. 2.4.3 Comparison of Measured End Bearing Capacity of Pile and Results of Calculation by Void Expantion Theory
Fig. 2.4.3 shows the results of a comparison of the measured end bearing capacity of pile and the results of
an estimation of end bearing capacity by the expanded void theory asswning 4'cv' = 34.
@ The vibratory pile driving method, vibro-hammer method, is increasingly being used for driving piles because
of the capacity increase of pile-driving machinery in recent years. As the principles of this method differ from
those of pile driving by hammer, the bearing capacity should be carefully estimated. When using this method,
the ground should be compacted by the method of hammer pile driving instead of vibratory pile driving in the
course of final driving, or vertical loading tests should be conducted to confirm the characteristics of bearing
capacity of the ground in question.
In recent years, the use of pile installation method by inner excavation instead of pile driving by hammer has
been increasing in port and harbor construction works. In such cases, the characteristics of the bearing capacity
of piles in question should be confirmed by vertical loading tests.
CD
Even if there is no shoe on the pile end, the end bearing area of steel piles can be considered closed, as shown
by the shaded areas in Fig. 2.4.4. In this case, the outer edge of the closed area is taken as the perimeter. This
is based on the following principle. Soil enters the interior of steel pipes or the space between the flanges of
H-shaped steel during the pile driving until the internal friction between the soil and the surface of steel pile
becomes equal to the end resistance of pile. This balance prevents soil from entering to the piles and has the
same effect as the case when the open end section is closed. But complete closure cannot be expected in the case
oflarge-diameter piles. In such cases the plugging ratio should be examined.
JI
.
.
@ Plugging ratio
The mechanism of the end resistance of open ended piles is composed of the swn of the end resistance of the
substantial part of the end of the pile and the skin friction of the inner surface of the pile as shown in Fig. 2.4.5.
-446-
The resistance from the inner surface of the pile is considered to be determined from the direct stress action on
the circumference and the inner circular area of the pile. Because the pile cross-sectional area is proportional to
the square of its diameter and its circumference is proportional to its diameter, as the diameter of a pile becomes
larger, the concept that the total cross-sectional area of the pile is effective for resistance loses validity. In piles
of this type, among the resistances which are conceivable due to closure of the pile end, only some fraction
can be expected to function as the end resistance. That fraction is called the plugging effi:ct ratio. The size of
the plugging effect ratio is affected by the diameter or width of the pile, the penetration depth of the pile, the
properties of the ground, the construction method, and cannot be determined simply by the diameter or width
of the pile alone.
actions
ile diameter
@ Different from plugging effect ratio, the plugging ratio refers to the ratio of the end resistance that can actually
be expected to the end resistance obtained by static resistance formulas. From past data, the plugging ratio can
be considered to be 100% when the diameter of steel pipe piles is less than 60 cm or H-shaped steel piles which
short side width is less than 40 cm. Numerous theoretical calculation methods 30). 31), 32), 331 34), 35) and results
of laboratory experiments 36), 37) have been presented as methods of estimating the plugging effect ratio which
consider the various factors mentioned above for piles with larger diameters or widths. There are also examples
of study by actually conducting pile loading tests. However, in addition to the fact that the plugging effect ratio
varies greatly depending on the properties of the ground, the construction method, and other factors, the state of
plugging of actual piles differs depending on the penetration depth, including the stress in the ground, making
it difficult to obtain the ratio by theoretical calculation.
The Japan Association of Steel Pipe Piles collected examples of measurements of the plugging ratio.38) Fig.
2.4.6 shows data based thereon together with additional new data. The new data added here are for piles with
diameters of llOOmm to 2000mm. According to these data, the plugging ratio for the case where equation
(2.4.5) is considered to express the end resistance for complete plugging is in the range of 30-140%. In any case,
it appears that there is virtually no correlation between the embedded length ratio in the bearing stratum and
the plugging ratio. Provided, however, that there is clearly a difference in the plugging ratio in steel pipe piles
with diameters of less than IOOOmm and those with diameters greater than IOOOmm. Caution is particularly
necessary when using large diameter steel pipe piles with diameters larger than IOOOmm. Fig. 2.4.7 shows the
results when the x-axis indicates the pile diameter. In spite of some dispersion in the data, the pile diameter has
a large effect on the plugging ratio, as can be understood by comparison with Fig. 2.4.6.
The plugging ratio is affected by construction methods and soil condition, therefore it is necessary to grasp
the plugging ratio in actual construction works and by carrying out the loading tests.
-447-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
'
ODOS650mm
OD 700-900mm
OD2: IOOOmm
0
~
>'
CJ<
0
0.5
'S
i
-~
o.
x Xo
'
'
10
12
'
1 -
"'~
:rl
I
0.5
'
~>
'
'
0
1.5
0.5
(2.4.14)
Further, the value of qu should be reduced to 112 or 1/3 ofthe measurement values depending on the conditions
of cracking in the ground. In any event, however, the value of qu should not exceed 2xJ04kN/m2.
-448-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
N=4
N=2
N=9
N; Division Number
When determining the axial resistance of piles, it is necessary to consider safety with respect to failure of the pile
material.
[6] Decrease of Bearing Capacity due to Joints
(1) If it is necessary to splice piles, the splicing work shall be executed under appropriate supervision and reliability
ofjoints of spliced pile shall be confirmed by appropriate inspection.
(2) Ifjoints are sufficiently reliable, it may not be necessary to decrease the axial bearing capacity due to joints.
(3) When spliced piles are used, the joints sometimes become the weak points in the pile. Therefore, it is necessary to
adequately examine the structural reliability of the joints. Ifthe structural reliability ofthe joints is inadequate, it
is necessary to reduce the axial resistance, in consideration of the effect of the joint on the bearing capacity of the
pile foundation as a whole.
(4) In-site circular welding by semi-automatic methods is generally employed for the splicing of steel pipe piles used
in the field of port and harbor construction works. When such highly reliable jointing methods are applied under
appropriate supervision and the reliability of the joints has been confirmed by inspection, it is not necessary to
decrease the axial bearing capacity.
(5) For other matters related to the structures ofjoints, 2.4.6[4] Joints of piles of piles can be used as reference.
[7] Decrease of Bearing Capacity due to Slenderness Ratio
(1) For piles with a very large ratio oflength to diameter, the axial bearing capacity of piles needs to be decreased in
consideration of the accuracy of installation, unless the safety of bearing capacity is confirmed by loading tests.
(2) This provision takes account of the fact that the inclination of piles during installation reduces their bearing
capacity. If loading tests are conducted on foundation piles, the ultimate bearing capacity can be determined,
accounting for the decrease of bearing capacity due to installation accuracy. Therefore, in this case the decrease
due to the slenderness ratio may not necessarily be taken into account.
(3) When decreasing the bearing capacity due to the slenderness of piles, the following values may be used as
references:
CD
0
a={ --60
(! ~60)
(!>60)
(2.4.15)
0
a={ -i -60
2d
(! ~120)
(! >120)
(2.4.16)
-449-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where
(2.4.17)
where
~
Ag :
(2.4.18)
where
~
: design value of axial resistance per pile against failure as a block (kN)
: mean unit weight of whole block including piles and soil (k.N/m3); below groundwater level, the
mean unit weight is calculated considering buoyancy, and above ground water level, using the
wet unit weight.
n : number of piles in pile group
1'2
In the case of cohesive soil, equation (2.4.18) is replaced by equation (2.4.19), where c is undrained shear
strength and 1'2 ~ y2 (12: mean unit weight of soil above the end of the pile).
Rad
(2.4.19)
where
-450-
Perimeter length U
1111111111111
Fig. 2.4.8 Pile Group Foundation
[9] Examination of Negative Skin Friction
(!) If bearing piles penetrate through a soil layer that is susceptible to consolidation, it is necessary to consider
negative skin friction when calculating the allowable axial bearing capacity of piles.
(2) When a pile penetrates through a cohesive soft layer to reach a bearing stratum, the friction force from the soft
layer acts upwards and bears a part ofthe load acting on the pile head. When the cohesive soft layer is consolidated,
the pile itself is supported by the bearing stratum and hardly settles, the direction of the friction force is reversed,
as shown in Fig. 2.4.9. The friction force on the pile circumference now ceases to resist the load acting on the pile
head, but instead turns into a load downwards and places a large burden on the end of the pile. This friction force
acting downwards on the pile circumference is called the negative skin friction or negative friction.
Weak layer
-Bearing stratum.
.
.....,...
'
.. .
. .' . :,.
..
. :
. ..
.'
,
. .
(a)
..:
(b)
(3) Although the actual value ofnegative skin friction is not well known yet, the maximum value may be obtained
from equation (2.4.20).
R.1.-. = f/JL,.f,
(2.4.20)
where
Ref.max: characteristic value ofnegative skin friction for single pile (maximum value) (kN)
-451-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
rp : circumference of piles (perimeter of closed area in the case ofH-shaped steel piles) (m)
L2
fs
(4) In the above, fs in cohesive soil ground is sometimes taken at qu/2. Ifa sand layer is located between consolidating
layers, or if a sand layer lies on top of consolidating layer, the thickness ofthe sand layer should be included in L2.
The skin friction in the sand layer is sometimes taken into account for f 8 The characteristic value of negative
skin friction in such cases is shown by equation (2.4.21).
(2.4.21)
where
_ sUH +~rLi
nf,mu.t - ---n~--
(2.4.22)
where
Rnf.mllXk: characteristic value ofnegative skin friction for pile group (kN)
Equations (2.4.20) to (2.4.22) give the conceivable maximum value for negative skin friction. The actual
value of negative skin friction is considered to be governed by the amount of consolidation settlement and the
speed of consolidation, the creep characteristics of the soft layers and the deformation characteristics of the
bearing stratum.
-452-
(7) Verification
When calculating the axial bearing capacity of piles, many uncertainties exist as to how the influence of negative
skin friction should be considered. However, at the present stage, when negative skin friction is adequately
considered, one method assumes safety when it is confirmed that the force transmitted to the end of the pile
possesses adequate safety against failure of the ground at the pile end and compressive failure of the pile material
cross section. That is, when the design value of the axial bearing capacity in the serviceability limit state is 11,,,,,
in addition to securing the required safety against ordinary loads, Ra,, satisfies equations (2.4.24) and (2.4.25).
(2.4.24)
(2.4.25)
where
Ra,,
Rp;
Rnf.=.xd
"ft
A,
YRp
Ya!
The characteristic value for end resistance of pile Rpk can be calculated using equation (2.4.5). When the
pile penetrates into the bearing stratum, the circumference resistance of that section shall be included in the pile
end bearing capacity. In this case, the characteristic value of end resistance can be calculated using the following
equation (see Fig. 2.4.11).
(2.4.26)
where
Rpk
AP
Lsi
~L1
Nsi
"'
..
{,
... r.
..
,
~-
.
;
-453-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
CD
Pulling force
YR : partial factor
The standard value of partial factors can be as shown in Table 2.4.5.
Table 2.4.5 Standard Values of Partial Factors for Total Resistance
-454-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
Design situation
Variable situation for load actiru!: due to ship berthing
Variable situation for load acting due to ship traction
Variable situation for Level 1 earthi:iuak:e 21"0und motion
Variable situation for load during crane operation
Variable situation for load acting due to waves
(5) In cases where there appears to be a possibility ofliquefaction of sandy layers during an earthquake, it is necessary
to determine pulling resistance giving due consideration to this fact.
(6) Because the selfweight ofthe pile can be expected to act reliably as pulling resistance together with the weight of
the soil in the pile, a partial factor of 1.0 may be used for this. Accordingly, it is rational to calculate the design
value of the pulling resistance due to failure of the ground from the characteristic value of pulling resistance due
to failure ofthe ground as follows. Provided, however, that when the selfweight ofthe pile is comparatively small,
this process is normally omitted. When the diameter of the pile is excessively large, it is considered that the soil
filled in the pile is not necessarily lifted with the pile, but separates and falls down.
CD
(2.4.28)
(2.4.29)
where
Rad
nJ,1
R..ttk
R..ak
(kN)
CD
Sandy ground
i?w1c =2N~
(2.4.30)
(4) In cases where the static maximum pulling resistance of a pile is to be estimated using a static bearing capacity
formula, examination is sometimes performed using Terzaghi's equation, which is shown in equation (2.4.32).
-455-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
In this case, an appropriate value shall be adopted, based on comparison of the values calculated using equation
(2.4.30) and equation (2.4.31) and the value calculated using Terzaghi's equation.
(2.4.32)
(2.4.33)
where
Rutk
Rfk
'P
L
laj;
-caik
Ks1
q;j;
k
l;
For Ca and , see 2.4.3[4] Estimation of Static Maximum Axial Resistance by Static Resistance
Formulas.
The value of the coefficient of horizontal earth pressure Ks is considered to be smaller than in the case of
pushing. In general, a value between 0.3 and 0.7, which is close to the coefficient of earth pressure at rest, is
frequently used.
[3] Items to be Considered when Calculating Design Value of Pulling Resistance of Piles
(1) When determining the pulling resistance of piles, it is necessary to consider the following items.
CD
The resistance used in verification of the pulling resistance of piles should be no more than the product of the
resistance of the pile material and the effective cross-sectional area of the pile.
In spliced piles, the pulling resistance of the pile below the joint is generally ignored. Provided, however, that
when high-quality joints can be used in steel piles, the pulling resistance of the lower pile can be considered
within the range of the tensile strength of the joint after confirming the reliability of the joint.
In case of a pile group, it is necessary to examine the pulling resistance as a single block surrounded with the
envelope surface of the outermost piles in the group of piles that act as a pile group.
When determining the pulling resistance of piles, it is necessary to consider the limit value of the upward
displacement of pile heads by pulling determined by the superstructure.
(1) The static maximum lateral resistance of a single pile shall be determined as appropriate on the basis of the
behavior of the pile when it is subject to lateral forces.
(2) The characteristic value of the static maximum lateral resistance of a pile must be determined so as to satisfy the
following two conditions:
CD
The pile material shall not fail due to stress generated in the pile body. Especially the pile material shall not fail
due to bending stress generated in the pile body.
The displacement in lateral direction and inclination of the pile head shall not exceed the limit value of the
displacement determined by the superstructure.
-456-
(!) The behavior of a single pile which is subject to lateral force can be estimated by either of the following methods
or by a combination thereof.
CD
@ Analytical methods
[3] Estimation of Behavior of a Single Pile by Loading Tests
(!) When loading tests are planned to estimate behavior of a single pile subject to lateral force, it is necessary to
consider sufficiently the diffurences in the pile and load conditions between those of actual structures and loading
tests.
(2) Loading test results and characteristic value and design value of lateral resistance
When loading tests are conducted under the same conditions as those in actual facilities, the characteristic value
-457-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
of the static maximum lateral resistance may be obtained from the loading test results by the following method.
The load-pile head displacement curve in lateral loading tests generally shows a curved form from the
beginning of the loading. Therefore, with the exception of short piles, a clear yield load or ultimate load normally
cannot be obtained. As explained previously in [1] General, this is because only gradual small-scale failure
occurs in the ground with long penetration lengths, and overall failure of the ground does not occur. Therefore,
the load-pile head displacement curve is not used to obtain the yield load or the ultimate load, but to confirm the
pile head displacement itself. In other words, the fundamental concept of the performance verification of piles
subject to lateral force is determination of the limit value of the displacement of the pile head and design so as not
to exceed that limit value.
Furthermore, the bending stress corresponding to the resistance obtained in this manner must also be
considered. Hence, it is necessary to ensure that failure associated with the bending stress of the pile material (see
Part II, Chapter 11, 2.2 Characteristic Vaines of Steel) does not occur when the expected load acts. To calculate
the allowable lateral bearing capacity of short piles, overturning of piles must be considered, in addition to the pile
head displacement and bending stress mentioned already. When the overturning load cannot be ascertained, the
maximum test load may be used instead of the overturning load.
(1) When estimating behavior of a single pile subject to lateral force by using analytical methods, it is preferable to
analyze the pile as a beam is placed on an elastic foundation.
(2) Methods of analytically estimating the behavior of a single pile subject to lateral force as a beam is placed on an
elastic foundation include the relatively simple Chang's methods well as the PHRI (Port and Harbor Research
Institute, name is changed to PARI) method.>
(3) Basic Equation for Beam on Elastic Foundation
Equation (2.4.34) is the basic equation for analytically estimating behavior of a pile as a beam placed on an elastic
foundation.
dy
El-=-P=-pB
dx4
(2.4.34)
where
EI
x
y
P
p
B
p
: subgrade reaction per unit area of pile at depthx (kN/m2)p = B
: pile width {m)
Analytical methods differ depending on how the subgrade reaction P is considered in equation (2.4.34). If the
ground is considered simply as a linear elastic body, P or p is a linear function of displacement of pile y.
P=E,y
(2.4.35)
E,
kCHY
p=-y=
or
(2.4.36)
where
E,
kcH
There is much discussion concerning the characteristics of the modulus of elasticity E,, but the simplest
concept is that E, = kcHB = constant, as proposed by Chang.6>
Shinohara, Kubo, and Hayashi proposed the PHRI method as an analytical method considering the nonlinear
elastic behavior of the ground.70). 71) This method can describe the behavior of actual piles more accurately
than other methods. The PHRI method uses equation (2.4.41) to describe the relationship between the subgrade
reaction and the pile displacement.
p=kxmy.5
(2.4.37)
where
m :indexlorO
-458-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(4) PHRI Method
(2.4.38)
(b) C-type ground
(2.4.39)
where
refer (2.4.38)
3) Actual examples: sandy ground with uniform density, and normally consolidated cohesive soil ground.
(b) C-type ground
1) Relationship between p-y is expressed asp = kcy0-S
refer (2.4.39)
3) Actual examples: sandy ground with compacted surface, and heavily-overconsolidated cohesive soil
ground.
A relationship shown in Fig. 2.4.14 exists between the rate of increase in the N-value per meter of
depth in S-type ground N and the lateral resistance of piles k9 .72) In cases where the distribution of the
N-value in the depth direction does not become 0 at the ground surface, N can be determined from the
average inclination of the N-value plotting through the zero point at the surface. In C-type ground, a
relationship of the type shown in Fig. 2.4.15 exists between the N-value itself and kc. 68), 73) Thus, a rough
estimate of k1 or kc can be made from the distribution of the N-value
-459-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
104
""
,..
g
= Q ~
uf3j , /v ~--'
103
/
~~
1.
2.
3.
4.5.
6.
7.
8.9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
V"
I"
./
--
.....
ALTON.ILLINOIS (FEAGIN)
WINFIELD.MONTANA (GLESER)
PORT HUENEME (MASON)
Hakkenbori No.1, No.2
Ibaragigawa (GOTO)
Osaka National Railways (BEPPU)
Tobata No.6, No.9
Tobata K-1 (PHRI)
Tobata K-11 (PHRI)
Tobata L-11 (PHRI)
Kurihama model experiment
Shin-Kasai Bridge (TATEISHI)
Yamanoshita (IGUCHI)
11
102
1
10
100
N-value
Fig. 2.4.14 Relationship between N-value and ks
1.
2.
3.
4.
~
....
11~
I
./
...
n
u - '
,.
,,,, ,,
~ ...,.
.......
""
_,
J;./
~~2
....
Ir
5.
Ir
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
'-H
-~
'I'
~I
10
100
N-value
Fig. 2.4.15 Relationship between N-value and kc
Effective length
For a certain pile to function as a long pile, its penetration length must be greater than its effective length.
Based on the results of model tests with short piles, Shinohara and Kubo found that the lower part of a pile
is considered to be fixed completely in the ground when the penetration length exceeds l.5l111i. and therefore
proposed using 1.51111 as effective length.77) Actually, ifthe penetration length exceeds 1.5l111i. the behavior of the
pile will not differ substantially from that of a long pile. However, as the minimum penetration length of long
-460-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
piles, 1.5lm1 should be used, considering the effects of soil fatigue or creep.
It should also be noted that the value of lm1 increases as the stiffness ofthe pile increases and decreases as the
lateral resistance of the ground increases. However, the value oflmi is virtually unaffected by the loading height
and pile head fixing conditions. Furthermore, lm1 also has the character of increasing gradually as loading
increases.
0
Legend
Pile head
displacmneot
10
""
1st Series
2nd Series
1::..
3rd Series
p-ycurve
Maximum
bending
....
A.
moment
181
~r\..
~,....._
C)
()
10
20
30
40
50
60
-461-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2.S
'\
~
~
...
""
ko : Value of k, when 8 =O
2.0
!'-
"'"
1.5
........
~
~
......
..... ~
-r--
.......
1.0
r--~
I
I
I
I
I
(in)
-(}
"'II
O : Indoor tests
6 : In-situ tests
.... i;:-.
....._ ......
o.s
_,.(out)
+(}
....._
...
'"""""
!
I
-30
-20
-10
II
10
20
30
(}
Fig. 2.4.17 Relationship between Pile Inclination Angle and Lateral Resistance Constants
Q) Calculation Equation
Using the elasticity modulus of the ground E 6 =B ken, the elasticity equation of piles is expressed as follows;
(o~x~-h)
Exposed section
Embedded section EI
d4
~2 + BkCHYi
dx
} (2.4.40)
=
(x~O)
By calculating these general solutions with B ken as a constant and inputting the boundary conditions, the
solution for piles of semi-infinite length can be obtained (see Table 2.4.6).83)
According to Yokoyama, piles of finite length may be equivalent to the piles of infinite length if PL ~ 1{.
When a pile is shorter than this, a pile must be treated as a finite length pile. Diagrams are available to simplify
this process.SS)
-462-
~H,;z:~
.... 0 (yJ
[Symbols]
dz4
.%
Embedded sections: EI
(yJ
Situation of pile
CDBasic formation
d4~, +BkcnY. =0
rb
JJ
H,
Embedded underground(h=O)
Ifpile headft11r.does
not rotate
Ht"
i=
Deflection curve y
y, =y,-61,z+-' z +-' z
2EI
6EI
=~e-"'[{1+
ftho)cosftt-fthosinftt]
2EIP
y,
().+fJh)3+l/2 H + ().+/Jh)2 M
3EIP3
,
2EIP2
,
y,
Ground level displacement Yo
_l+PhoH,
Yo - 2EIP3
Flexuralmomentofpilemembers M
IM
=-M-H,z
M =e-P.Lmiocosftt+(l+ftho)sinftt]
H,
=y-(l+/Jh)H,z2+!!.J_z3
4EIP
6EI
cos a.
Y = __!!_i__e-
2EIP3
,....
Y. =
4Blp3 e-"'{cosftt+sinftt)
H,
e, = __!!_i__
0,=0
M, =-
e-fk sinftt
/JH,
M.
S, =-H,
= -H,e-[cosftt-(1 +2ftho)sin,&]
Mo=-M,
s.
=-:P
M,,_
I. =_.!_tan-1 _ _
1_
Ki,K2,K3,.K,,
s:
S =-H
= -H:e-.tk[cosftt-/jhsin,&]
.. p
J(l+2ftho) +1
exp(-/Jl,.)
12EIP
(1+/Jh)l+2
M,,....
2/J
=-j
e-"'(cos,&-sinftt)
K _ 4EI/J ().+ph)1+112
4
-l+Ph ().+/Jh) 3 +2
2/J
fJh
s. =-H,e-"'(cosftt-sinftt)
S, =-H,e-fk cos,&
Mo=O
Mo=__.!_
d
~
Q
2p
c:::
::::!
M,_
=--0.3224 H,
p
= ..!!__ = 0.7854
I.
.. 4/J
1
lo =-tan-I
/Jh+l
p
Ph 1
L =_!_tan-1 (-/Jh)
L = 3tr
K. = K = K. 1+Ph
K1
.. p
1+2/Jh
=_.!_tan-1[-(1+2ftho)]
IK
I. =_.!_tan-1....!....
It 0 =_.!..tan-1 1+Pho
p
Pho
IL
M = 1+ fJh H = K2 H
2/J
:ti
l\J
e, =o
2/J
M, = H, e-P.[{l-/Jh)cosftt-(l+/Jh)sinftt]
3
~
Yo=Y,
= H, (1+ /Jh-2/Jz)
~
Q
y, = 4EIP3 - BkCH
Yo=Y,
M,
::::
- l+/Jh H,
Yo - 4EI/J3
2EI/J2
1Q
.!,
J,
.!,
.!1
=..!!__ = 1.5708
0
2/J
= 2.3562
4P
K1 =4EI{f
K2 = K 3 = 2EI/f
K4=2Ef/J
M ...... ---0.2079/i
H,
al
Vi
= ..!!__ = 1.5708
l
..
2/J
l =~= 2.3562
0
4/J
/J
L=~-3.1416
/J- -p
q
d
iil
~
~
r-
VI
:t;!
~
:ti
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
o.2-
kcn =-kcn1
B
(2.4.41)
where
Es
=kcHB =0.2kcn1
(2.4.42)
(2.4.43)
(2.4.44)
In sandy soil, Es is a function ofdepth and thus cannot be applied directly to Chang's method. For such
cases, Chang states that Ea can be taken the value at the depth of one third of ly1 which is the depth of the
first zero-displacement point. However, ty1 itself is a function ofE:r> thus repeated calculations have to be
made to obtain the value of E 9 Reference 87) describes the method of calculation without the repetition
calculation.
Terzaghi assumes that the value of kcH is inversely proportional to the pile width B, as shown in
equations (2.4.43) and (2.4.44). Other opinions suggest that pile width is irrelevant to kcH(see (4) @).
Hard
Very hard
Solid
100-200
16,000-32,000
200-400
32,000-64,000
400 or greater
64,000 or greater
24,000
48,000
96,000
Loose
Medium
Dense
2,200
6,600
17,600
1,300
4,400
10,800
nh
-464-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
1. Yamaborigawa
2. Tobata
/
3. Tobata K-I
4. Tobata L-II
lL
l..1
5. Tobata K-II
~#M
/
6. Tobata K-III
/
7. Tobata L-IV
8. Tobata K-IV
, /
9. Shell Ogishima
10. Ibaragigawa
11. Takagawa
12. Tokyo SupplyWarehouse
13. Kasai Bridge
14.Aoyama
15. Den-en
/
/
/
,/
,
2
~
'
14
Ir
, / 12 ~v
~'
15 "/
/
- ._
,.
'
~~
v
v
,
/
/
/
/
/
"
/
/
,, /
1
10
50
N-value
Fig. 2.4.18 Values of kCH obtained by Reverse Calculation from Horizontal Loading Tests on Piles
r201Yo
kCH
=103(EI ID
kCH
kCH
=719(EI ID
kcn = 683(EI ID
--O.J9S h--0.03S .
(2.4.45)
001
499
9
49
Yo--0
ho.oo No.6 (free
r.oos Yo
--0.sol ho.o28
pile head)
Table 2.4.9 Relationships between SPT-N-value or N-value and Respective of Subgrade Reaction
Correlation equation
Correlation coefficient
Coefficient of variation
= 540N (kN/m2.S)
654
k. = 592N. (kN/m3.S)
kr. = 3910N733 (k:N/m3)
0.872
0.111
0.966
0.077
0.917
0.754
k0
11
648
-465-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
[5] Consideration of Pile Group Action
(!) When piles are used as a pile group, the effect of pile group action on the behavior of individual piles is necessary
to be considered.
(2) When the center interval of driven piles exceeds the values in Table 2.4.10, the action of the pile group on lateral
resistance may be ignored.
Table 2.4.10 Center Intervals of Piles
Sandy soil
Cohesive soil
Transverse
Longitudinal
Transverse
Longitudinal
(!)The lateral bearing capacity ofa foundation of the structure with coupled piles is necessary to be determined as
P,
P2
v; sin82 + H 1 cos82
sin(81 +82 )
Vi sin 81 -
H 1 cos fJ.,
sin(O., + 82 )
where
P" P2 : pushing force acting on each pile or pulling force when the value is negative (kN)
8" B,_ : inclination angle of each pile ()
-466-
(2.4.46)
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
V;
\/
P1
Hi
I
Fig. 2.4.19 Axial Forces of Coupled Piles
(5) Method of Calculating Horizontal Resistance of Coupled Piles Considering Lateral Resistance of individual
Piles
Various methods of calculating the horizontal resistance of coupled piles by considering the lateral resistance of
individual piles are available. For example;
CD
Method of solution based on a condition whereby the displacement of each pile is always the same at the
intersection of the coupled piles, on the assumption that the spring characteristics of the pile head in the axial
and lateral directions are elastic.
@ Method of obtaining the ultimate resistance of the coupled piles on the assumption that the axial and lateral
resistances of the piles show elasto-plastic properties.
@ Method of calculating the load and displacement at the pile heads, or the settlement and the upward displacement
of piles by pulling in the case of(b) on the basis of empirical equations.HO)
The method CD above is to calculate the distribution of horizontal force to each pile on the assumption that the
axial and lateral resistances of a pile have elastic properties 112)
In the coupled piles shown in Fig.2.4.20, the settlement ofeach pile at the pile head is proportional to the axial
force acting on that pile and also the lateral displacement is proportional to the lateral force acting on that pile.
On this assumption, the axial and lateral forces acting on each pile of the coupled piles can be calculated using
equation (2.4.47), derived from the conditions of force equilibrium and compatibility of displacements.
-467-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
"
N2
+ l,ui sin Iii - ,sin II, cos(Oi + 11,)+ <Dz cos II, sin(Oi + 11,)}HJ
= ';[{,cos II,+ l'1 cosOi cos(Oi + 82 )+ "'1 sin Iii sin(Iii+ 02 )}v
-{,sinll, -1'1 sin Iii cos(Oi +82 )+a~ cosOi sin(Oi +82 )}H]
(2.4.47)
H 1 = l'1 [-{"'t sin Iii -<Dzsinll, cos(Oi + 11,)+ ,cos II, sin(Iii+ 11,)}v
"
H2
= '; [{<Dzsinll,-"'t sin Iii cos(Oi + 11,)+ l'1 cosOi sin(Oi + 11,)}v
+{<Dz cos II,+ "'1 cosOi cos(Oi + 11,)+ l'1 sin Iii sin(Iii+ 11,)}H]
Vertical and horizontal displacements of the pile head can be calculated by equation (2.4.48)
8{ = 82 = _!_ [( "'1 sin 2 II+ Jli cos 2 11,. + "'2 sin 2 112 + "2 cos 2 112
A
)v
,,; =
(2.4.48)
'lz = 1-[.!.{(Jli-.,,_)sin211,.
+(m, -,u,)sin211 }v
A 2
2
+{u1 sin Iii +"'1 cos Iii+ ,sin 112 +m, cos 11,)H]
where
Nb N 2
Hb H 2
V
H
II,, 02
rub ru 2
Pb
: axial force acting on each pile, compressive force is indicated by positive value (kN)
: lateral force acting on each pile (kN)
: vertical load per pair of coupled piles (kN)
: horizontal load per a pair of coupled piles (kN)
o',, o'2
1/'b '1'2
The subscript numbers attached to the symbols, as shown in Fig. 2.4.20, are "1" for the pushed pile and "2"
for the pulled pile if only a horizontal load acts.
The values listed in Table 2.4.11 may be used for the spring constants of pile head. The symbols used in
Table 2.4.llare defined below
(l+p.<f+l/2
(p.<f
(1+p.<f+2
(p.<f
P=~ 4EI
E,
(2.4.49)
where
l
,!
A
I
E,
B
KCH
The coefficient oflateral subgrade reaction k.:wmay be calculated by multiplying the value of kcnobtained
-468-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
in [4] Estimation ofPile Behavior using Analytical Methods, (5) Chang's Method by the factor obtained
from Fig. 2.4.17, in accordance with the inclination of piles.
(Out-batter pile)
(In-batter pile)
Fig. 2.4.20 Coupled Piles Considering Pile Bending and Soil Resistance due to Deflection
Table 2.4.11 Spring Constants of Pile Head
AE
w=--
A.+l
Cohesive soil
(ID)
2AE
w=-2A. +.e
Friction piles
Sandy soil
(A.=O)
W=
3AE
3A.+U
3
Es
=2Elft = -
2p
(MO)
3EI
= A3 qi4(,BA)
=4Elp3 =Es
(A.=O)
12EI
(MO)
A3qi4(pA)
-469-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
to the pile head displacement corresponding to the static maximum lateral resistance of the piles. When the
superstructure is displaced until the passive earth pressure reaches the value obtained using Coulomb's equation,
there is a danger of the pile undergoing bending failure. Therefore, when considering inclusion of the passive
earth pressure resistance at the front of this embedded section, it shall not be included in calculations without
adequate examination of these facts.
(3) For structural types in which settlement of facilities is controlled by employing piles as friction piles, for example,
piled-raft foundations, 122) or soft landing moundless structures with piles, there are cases in which it is reasonable
to consider the bearing capacity under the slab bottom.
In case of the performance verification of the facilities above, it is necessary to confirm sufficiently the
behavior characteristics of the facilities.
(4) Procedure of performance verification for pile foundations
It is generally preferable that performance verification of pile foundations be conducted by the procedure shown
in Fig. 2.4.21.
Loading tests
Static bearing capacity formulas
Soil conditions
1 4 - - - - - - f Load conditions
Allowable displacement
End
CD
In performance verification of piles, it is preferable to examine not only the loads acting after completion of
construction but also those during transportation, positioning, and driving.
-470-
PART Ill FACILmES, CHAPTER l ITEMS COMMON TO FACILITIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
Hil
,I
I. I
iTTt- ~
j ~,ll
. . .:
Weisbach's equation
-w..
J'
I ....,
,.. -. iJ:
Janbu's equation
.
..., l!-.ilh
~,~.,.
" rr ...
:i.-
...
..
Denmark's equation
Smith's equation
.
10
20
40
. ~..
60
~~}
'.Ii. :
:..: e \ 1 J'
~i":. ~:
100
200
Fig. 2.4.22 Distribution of Results of Pile Driving Formulas and Loading Tests
~reqWred
for penetration
of pile
( Impulsive )
loss
(2.4.50)
(2.4.51)
-471-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where
Rdu : ultimate pile-driving resistance; i.e., dynamic maximum bearing capacity (kN)
The term Cl + C2 + C3 in the above is the sum of elastic deformation of ground, pile, and pile head cushion.
Of these, the term Cl + C2 are equal to the rebound K measured at the pile head in pile driving tests (see
Fig. 2.4.23). With steel piles, elastic defurmation Cl is dominant, while C3 is generally smaller. Thus, if C3 is
neglected, the following can be assumed:
(2.4.53)
thus,
(2.4.54)
where
~
The design value of axial resistance ~is obtained by multiplying~ by the partial factory. Here, a partial
factor"( of0.33 can generally be used.
(2.4.55)
-472-
'
Pile
,+
~tration
of pile (s)
\
(a)
(b)
(!) Joints of piles shall be sufficiently safe against actions after completion as well as during construction.
(2) Joints shall be placed at the position where there is a sufficient margin in cross-sectional strength and relatively
free from corrosion.
(3) Depending on the position of joints, the forces acting on joints after completion of a structure are sometimes
far smaller than the strength of the piles. However, considerations should be taken to ensure the safety of joints
against the pile-driving stress during construction, load increases in future, and unexpected stresses arising within
the cross section ofjoints.
of the joint structure, considering all of the factors of bending, shear, compression, and tension. A position where
the flexural moment is small shall be selected if the joint structure is weak against bending, and a position where
shear is small shall be selected ifthe structure is weak against shear.
The durability of joints is considered to be small in comparison with the pile. For example, in steel piles,
various kinds of corrosion control treatment are considered to cause a reduction of functions due to welding at this
part. Therefore, joint positions where corrosion is slight shall be selected, and in particular, positions which are
subject to repeated wetting and drying due to changing water levels shall be avoided.
The length allotted to elements in one pile is determined by the position of joints. Limitations related to
transportation, construction equipment, and work space factors shall be considered in determining the length of
the element. It is considered advantageous to reduce the number ofjoints to the minimum and use long elements
as much as possible. Given the present transportation conditions, the maximum lengths that can be transported
are 13m by road and 20m by rail.
(5) Joints in Steel Piles
In steel piles, arc welded joints should generally be used, as this is the most reliable type of joint. However,
because gas-pressure welding and other new methods are being developed, when sufficient safety is confirmed by
the responsible engineer based on adequate study by testing, these other methods may also be used.
(6) Wood Pile Joints
It is not preferable to use the wooden joints when horizontal force or pulling force does not act.
(7) Reinforced Concrete Pile Joints and Prestressed Concrete Pile Joints
When reinforced concrete pile and prestressed concrete pile are used to the structure where horizontal force or
pulling force acts, joint structure which has been confirmed with high reliability shall be selected.
[5] Change of Plate Thickness or Material Type of Steel Pipe Piles
(!) When changing plate thickness or material type of steel pipe piles, all due considerations shall be given to the
workability and the distribution of section force on piles.
-473-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) The section furce of steel pipe piles varies with depth, generally decreasing as the depth becomes large. Therefore,
plate thickness or material type of steel pipe piles is sometimes changed over the total length from the economical
point of view.
(3) When changing plate thickness or material type of steel pipe piles, the position of the change should be at the depth
where the section furce arising in the piles does not increase. Caution is also required because such a change may
not be allowed if a large negative skin friction is active.
(4) Jointing piles with diffurent thickness and material type should be done by shop circular welding. The shape of
the welded section should comply with JIS A 5525.
Pk
( v ) (-;-)'
41 2
(2.4.56)
where
external pressure causing buckling (kN/m2)
modulus of elasticity of steel (kN/m2) E = 2.1 x 10 kN/m2
Poisson's ratio of steel v = 0.3
wall thickness of cylinder (mm)
radius of cylinder (mm)
Pk
E
v
t
r
u,
(2.4.57)
where
aPY
-474-
(2) Immediate settlement, unlike consolidation settlement, which will be described in the following, is caused by
shear deformation and occurs simultaneously with loading. Because sandy ground does not undergo long-term
consolidation settlement like that in cohesive soil ground, immediate settlement in sandy ground, as described
here, can be considered to be total settlement. On the other hand, the immediate settlement of cohesive soil
ground is a phenomenon which is caused by settlement due to undrained shear deformation and plastic :flow in the
lateral direction. In soft cohesive soil ground, there are cases in which immediate settlement may be ignored in
performance verification because it is smaller than the consolidation settlement described below.
In calculations of immediate settlement, the ground is usually assumed to be an elastic body, and the theory
of elasticity and the modulus of elasticity E and Poisson's ratio v are used. As the modulus of elasticity of soil
varies greatly depending on the strain level, it is important to make calculations using a modulus of elasticity that
corresponds to the actual strain level. For example, the strain in soft ground with a small safety factor is on the
order of 0.5% to 1.5%, while that in excavation of hard ground and deformation of foundations is no more than
0.1%. The relationship between the strain level and the elastic modulus shall follow Part Il, Chapter 3, 2.3.1
Elastic Constants.
(2) Calculations of settlements due to consolidation can be performed based on the results of consolidation tests on
undisturbed samples of cohesive soils. The final consolidation settlement, which is the amount of settlement
when consolidation caused by a load has finally completed, is determined by the compressibility properties of
the soil skeleton, and can be estimated directly from the results of consolidation tests. Time-dependent changes
in settlement up to the final consolidation settlement of a foundation are necessary to be calculated based on the
theory of consolidation.
(3) Calculation Methods of Final Consolidation Settlement of Foundation
Final consolidation settlement of foundation can be calculated by using the following equations described in
Part II, Chapter 3,2.3.2 Compression and Consolidation Characteristics.
CD
S=h~
(2.5.1)
l+e0
where
s
h
!J.e
-475-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
e0
S -h
- -Cc- l og10 Po+/!,p
l+eo
Po
(2.5.2)
where
= m,/!,ph
(2.5.3)
where
s(t)= su(1)
(2.5.4)
The finite element analysis witb visco-elasto-plasticity model for cohesive soil can be utilized for accurate
analysis of the consolidation settlement that takes account of inhomogeneity on consolidation properties of the
ground, the effect of self weight of cohesive soil layer and time-related changes in consolidation load.
(5) Division of Cohesive Soil Layer subject to Consolidation
When calculating the final consolidation settlement, the cohesive soil layer is usually divided into a number
of sub-layers as shown in Fig. 2.S.1. This is because the consolidation pressure and tbe coefficient of volume
compressibility m, vary with depth. With the m, method, the final consolidation settlement of foundation may be
calculated using equation (2.S.S).
S0 = Lm.AhAu,
(2.5.5)
where
S0
-476-
Ill,,!
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
The settlement due to secondary consolidation may be generally calculated using the following equation:
(!_)
S, =_s._hlog 10
l+e0
t0
(2.5.6)
where
t : time (d)
: start time of secondary consolidation (d)
h : clay layer thickness (m)
t0
The coefficient of secondary compression is obtained from conventional consolidation tests. It can also be
estimated from the relationship between and the compression index Cc that is generally expressed in the following
equation 147)
(2.5.7)
Ca = (0.03 - 0.05)Cc
settlement occurring in the distance of 50m can be calculated as O.llx. When applying this method to actual
problems, it is preferable to correct the values in Fig. 2.5.2 for the reference time and the depth of the ground
which is the object to settlement.ISO), 151)
-478-
0.5
-~ 0.4
Ordiruuy ground
.& Homogeneous grouod
1i
f
I
0.3
0.2
::;; 0.1
O.__~_.._~~~_._~~~~~---'
20
50
100
Fig. 2.5.2 Relationship between Distance and Uneven Settlement Ratio in Reclaimed Land
References
1)
2)
Architectural Institute of Japan: Guideline for design of architectural foundation, p.108, 2001
Davis, E.H. and Booker The effect of increasing strength with depth on the bearing capacity of clays, Geotechnique, Vol.23,
No,4, 1973
3) Nakase, A.: Bearing capacity of rectangular footings on clay of strength increasing linearly with depth, Soil and Foundations,
Vol. 21, No.4, pp.101-108, 1981
4)
Yamaguchi, K.: Soil Mechanics (Fully revised Edition), Chapter 9 Bearing strength, Giho-do Publishing, pp.273-274, 1985
5) Kobayashi, M., M. Terashi, K. Takahashi and K. Nakajima: A New Method for Calculating the Bearing Capacity of Rubble
Mounds, Rep!. of PHRI Vol.26, No.2, 1987
6) Shoj~ Y.: Study on shearing Properties of Rubbles with Large Scale Triaxial Compression Test, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 22,
No,4,1983
7) Minakami, J. and M. Kobayashi: Soil Strength Characteristics of Rubble by Large Scale Triaxial Compression Test, Rept. of
PHRI No.699, 1991
8) Japan Road Association: Specifications and commentary of highway bridges, Part IV Substructures, pp.231-273, 1996
9) Railway Technical Research Institute: Design standards for railway structures and commentary, Foundation structures, Soil
pressure resistance structure, pp.175-178, 1997
10) A.W. Skempton: The bearing capacity of clays, Proc. Building Research Congress, Div.I, pp.180-189, 1951
11) G.G. Meyerhof: The ultimate bearing capacity of foundations, Geotechnique Vol. 2, No, 4, pp.301-332, 1951
12) Takahashi, K. and M. Sawaguchi: Experimental Study on the Lateral Resistance of a Well, Rep!. of PHRI Vol. 16 No.4, pp.334, 1977
13) Japan Geothechnical Society Edition: Vertical loading tests of Geothechnical Society's Standard vertical pile, and
19) Society of Soil Mechanics and Engineering Science Edition: Design method for pile foundation and commentary,
20) G.G. Meyerhof: Penetration tests and bearing capacity of cohesionless soil, Proc. A.S.C.E., Vol. 82, S.M. 1, pp.1-10, 1956
21) Japan Road Association: Specifications and commentary of highway bridges, Part IV Substructures, pp.353-363, 2002
22) Railway Technical Research Institute: Design standards for railway structures and commentary, Foundation tructures, Soil
pressure resistance structure, SI Units version, pp.227-232, 2000
-479-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
23)
24)
25)
26)
27)
28)
29)
30)
31)
32)
33)
34)
35)
36)
37)
38)
39)
40)
41)
42)
43)
44)
45)
46)
47)
48)
49)
50)
51)
52)
53)
54)
55)
56)
57)
58)
59)
60)
61)
62)
63)
64)
65)
66)
89) Kikuchi, Y. and M. Suzuki: Variance of the subgrade reaction for the estimating the resistance of a pile perpendicular to pile
axis, ASCEGSP innovative Methods for Foundatioo Aoalysis aod Design for Geoshaoghai 2006, pp.111-118, 2006,
90) Kikuchi, Y. and M. Suzuki: A proposal on evaluation method of coefficient of subgrade reaction in the lateral direction to
pile axis, Proceedings of 41st Cooference on Geotecbnical Engineering, PP.1489-1490, 2006
91) Sawaguchi, M.: Soil Coostaots for Piles, Rept. Of PHRI Vol. 7, No.2, pp. 21-25, 1968
92) Y. L. Chang: Lateral pile loading tests, Trans., A.S.C.E, Vol.102, pp. 50-54, 1937
93) Japao Road Association: Specifications and Cmnmentary for Highway Bridges, Part IV Substructures, Maruzen Publications,
pp. 239-241, 2002
94) Takahashi, K. aod Y. Shoji: Experimental Study on Vertical Anchor Piles of Sheet Pile Wall, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 22, No.4,
pp.33-58, 1983
95) Shoji, Y.: Experimental Study on Lateral Resistance of a Pile with Embedded Head in Sand, Rep!. of PHRI Vol. 23, No.2, pp.
75-179, 1984
96) Yokoyaroa, Y.: Desigo of steel piles aod construction, Sankai-do Publishing, pp. 148-157,1963
97) Yokoyama, Y.: Calculation method of pile structures and sample calculations, Sankai-do Publishing, pp. 56-68, 1977
98) Tanigawa, M., M. Sawaguchi and M. Tanaka: Horizontal bearing capacity of piles in composite ground- Replacement ratio
of clayey soul by sand pile and Coefficient of subgrade horizontal reaction-, Proceedings of 28th Conference on Geotechnical
99)
100)
101)
102)
103)
104)
105)
106)
107)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
108) Poulos, H. G.: Behavior of laterally-loaded piles, II-pile groups, Proc., A.S.C.E., Vol.97, No. SM 5., 1971, pp.733 751
109) Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, Part IV Sustructures, Maruzen Publications,
pp.245,2002
110) Segawa, M., T. Uchida and T. Katayama: Desgin of Coupled Batter Piles (Part 2)-Two Batter, Technical Note of PHRI No.
110, pp.1-14, 1970
111) M. Sawaguchi: Experimental investigation on the horizontal resistance of coupled piles, Rept. PHRI Vol.9, No.I, pp.11-13,
1970
112) Yokoyama, Y.: Calculation methods of pile structures and sample calculations, Sankai-do Publishing, pp. 193-197, 1977
113) Aok~ Y.: Design of group piles against horizontal force, Soil and Foundation, Vol.18, No.8, pp.27-32, 1970
114) Kikuchi, Y., K. Takahashi andM. Suzuki: Experimental Study on People's Safi:ty against Overtopping Waves onBreakwatersA study on Amenity-oriented Port Structures (2nd Rept.)-, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 31 No. 4, pp. 33-60, 1992
115) Shinohara, T. and K. Kubo: Experimental study on lateral bearing capacity of piles (Part 1), Technical Research Institute of
Transport, Vol. 11, No.6, pp. 50-53, 1961
116) Kikuchi, Y., K. Takahashi and T. Hirohashi: Lateral Load Tests on Piled Slab Structures, Technical Note of PHRI No.773,
p.25,1994
117) Kubo, K. and F. Saegusa: Reciprocal loading test of model piles, Proceedings of 2nd Study Presentation Conference of PHRI,
pp.64-73, 1964
118) Kikuchi, Y.: Lateral Resistance of soft landing moundless structure with piles, Technical Note ofPARI No.1039, 2003
119) Kubo. K.: Experimental study on lateral bearing capacity of piles (Part 3), Technical Research Institute of Transport, Vol. 12,
No.2, pp. 181-205, 1962
120) Suzuk~ A., K. Kubo and Y. Tanaka: Lateral resistance of vertical piles embedded in sandy layer with sloping surface, Rept.
of PHRI Vol. 5, No.2, pp.1-20, 1966
121) Bureau of Port and Harbours Edition: Handbook of countermeasures to requifaction of reclaimed area, Coastal Development
Institute of Technology, pp.314-319, 1997
122) Japan Geothechnical Society Edition: Survey, design, construction and inspection of pile foundation, pp. 343-461, 2004
123) Sawaguchi, M.: Comparison of calculation results by various estimation methods of dynamic bearing capacities, Proceedings
of 38th Conference of JSCE, Part III, pp.605-606, 1983
124) Heutker, T. (Translated by M. Kishida ): Shokoku-sha Publishing, pp.37-41, 1978
125) Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, Part IV Substructures, Maruzen Publications,
pp. 509-510, 2002
126) R. D. Chellis : Pile foundations, McGraw Hill, p.464, 1961 R.D.Che!Hs:Pilefbundations, McGrawHill, 29-32, 1961
127) Architectual Institute of Japan: Standards and commentary for architectural steel pile foundation, pp. 31-32, 1963
128) Japan Road Association: Specifications and cmnmentary of highway bridges, Part IV Substructures, pp.353-363, 2002
129) Uto, K., M. Fuyuki and M. Sakurai: Review of monitoring formulae of pile driving depth, Proceedings of 17th Conference
on Soil Mechanics, pp.2041-2044, 1982
130) Yokoyama, Y.: Design of steel piles and construction, Sankai-do Publishing, pp.188-196,1%3
131) Kato, T.: Experiment on plastic local buckling of steel pipe piles, Proceedings of Technical Conference of Architectual
Institute of Japan:, pp.463-464, 1971
132) Kishida, H. and A. Takan: Buckling of steel pipe piles and reinforcement of the end, Proceedings of Technical Conference of
Architectual Institute of Japan:, No.213, pp.29-38, 1973
133) Suzunai, K.: Study on deformation of steel pile head due to pile driving loads, Report of Technical Research Institute of
Transport, Vol. 12, No.2, pp.57-83, 1962
134) Yokoyama, Y.: Design and construction of steel piles, Sankai-do Publishing, pp. 2351%3
135) Japan Road Association: Specifications and commentary of highway bridges, Part IV Substructures, pp.353-363, 2002
136) Architectual Institute of Japan: Guideline for design of architectural foundation, 2001
137) ~ K.: Bearing Capacity and settlement of soil, Sankai-do Publishing, 1964
138) Ishii, Y.: TschbotarioffSoil Mechanics, (Vil. l)Gihoi-do Publishing, p.212,1957
139) J. 0. Osterburg: Influence values for vertical stresses in a semi-infinite mass due to an embankment loading, Proc. 4th. Int.
Conf. S.M.F.E., Vol.2, 1957
140) Kobayashi, M., J. Minakami and T. Tsuchida: Determination of the Horizontal Coefficient of Consolidation cohesive soil,
Rept. of PHRI Vol.29, No.2, 1990
141) Nakase, A., M. Kobayashi and A. Kanechika: Consolidation Parameters of Over consolidated Clays, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 12,
No. 1, pp. 123-139, 1973
142) L.A. Palmer and P.P. Brown: Settlement analysis for areas of continuing subsidence, Proc. 4th. Int. Conf. S.M.F.E, Vol.I,
pp.395-398,1957
143) R.L. Schiffinan and R.R. Gibson: Consolidation of nonhomogeneous clay layers, Journal of S.M.F.E., ASCE, Vol.90, No. SM
5, pp.1-30,1964
144) Kobayashi, M.: Numerical Analysis of One-Dimensional Consolidation Problems, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 21, No.I, 1982
145) Kobayashi, M.: Study on the application of Finite Element Method to settlement analysis, Tokyo Institute of Technology
Dissertation, Technical Note of Soil Mechanics Laboratory, No.1,1990
146) Kobayashi, M.: Finite Element Analysis of the Effectiveness of Sand Drains, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 30, No.2, 1991
-482-
-483-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
3 Stability of Slopes
3.1 General
(!) Stability of slopes against slip failure caused by self weight of soil or surcharge may be analyzed as a twodimensional problem, assuming a circular arc slip surface or a straight sliding surface.
(2) It is necessary to perform slope stability analysis for the case in which a slope becomes least stable.
(3) In slope stability analysis, in cases where the stability of the soil mass comprising a slope is reduced by the self
weight of the soil or surcharge, as the ultimate equilibrium state, it is necessary to confirm that the design value of
shearing resistance exceeds the design value of shearing force based on actions. Calculation methods used in the
slope stability analysis can also be used to calculate the bearing capacity of foundations, in addition to the stability
of slopes, as these calculation methods are used to examine the stability of soil masses. The method described
below can be used in verification of stability against variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground
motion in addition to the Permanent situation.
-484-
Parts to be referenced
Applicable facilities
Gravity-type quaywall
Others
-485-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(!) Examination of the stability of slopes can be performed by circular slip failure analysis with the modified Fellenius
method, which is given by the following equation, or by an appropriate method equivalent to the bearing furce
in 2.2.5 Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and Inclined Actions, depending on the characteristics of the ground.
In equation (3.2.1), the partial factor Ya for the analysis method should be an appropriate value corresponding to
the characteristics of the ground and characteristics of the facilities. In general, Ya can be set at 1.30 or higher for
permanent situations, but in cases where the reliability of the constants used in verification can be considered high
based on actual data for the same ground, and in cases where monitoring work is carried out by observing the
displacement and stress of the ground during construction, values from oflarger than LIO and less than 1.30 can
be used.2) In cases where partial factors are given for the structural type of the facilities or by type of improved
soil, as shown in 3.1(7) Partial Factors, the partial factors given at the objective parts shall be used.
aPH, }]
(3.2.1)
where
cd : in case of cohesion soil ground, design value of undrained shear strength, and in case of sandy
ground, design value of apparent cohesion in drained condition (kN/m2)
l : length of bottom of slice segment (m)
W'd : design value of effective weight of slice segment per unit of length (weight of soil. When
submerged, unit weight in water) (kN/m)
qd : design value of vertical action from top of slice segment (kN/m)
(} : angle of bottom of slice segment to horizontal ()
d : in case of cohesion soil ground, 0, and in case of sandy ground, design value of angle of shear
resistance in drained condition ()
Wd : design value of total weight of slice segment per unit of length, total weight of soil and water
(kN/m)
x : horizontal distance between center of gravity of slice segment and center of circular slip failure
(m)
PHd : design value of horizontal action on soil mass of slice segment in circular slip (kN/m)
a : length of arm from center of circular slip failure at position of action of PHd (m)
S : width of slice segment (m)
Ya : partial factor for analysis method
The design values in equation (3.2.1) can be calculated using the following equation by multiplying the
characteristic value by the partial factor. If partial factors are not particularly designated, 1.00 can be used for all
partial factors in equation (3.2.2).
(3.2.2)
(2) In slope stability analysis, the causes of slip failure include the self weight of the soil, surcharge, water pressure,
wave pressure, and action due to ground motion. Elements which resist slip failure include the shearing resistance
of the soil and counterweight. Verification of safety against slip failure of slopes is performed assuming that the
shearing resistance of the soil exceeds the shearing force in the assumed slip surface. When assuming a circular
slip failure surface, this is equivalent to verifying that the moments which work to resist slip exceed the moments
which cause slip for the center of the circle.
(3) In the slice method used in circular slip failure surfaces, the soil mass inside the slip circle is divided into a number
of slices by vertical planes, the shearing force at the bottom surface of each slice and the resistant stress of the
soil are calculated considering the balance of forces in each slice. The fact that the design value of the shearing
resistance obtained by adding the stresses for all of the slices exceeds the design value of the shearing force along
the slip line is then verified. In order to solve the inter-slice balance of forces in the slice method, it is necessary
to assume statically the determinate conditions. Various methods have been proposed, which vary depending on
the assumptions used. In general, the modified Fellenius method and the simplified Bishop method are used.
-486-
based on loading" is obtained, and its value is used as the minimum ratio for that center point. The minimum ratio
of"design value of shearing resistance"f'design value of shearing force" for other center points is then obtained by
the same method. Verification can be performed for the limit state for slip failure of the slope using the minimum
value of the minimum ratios obtained by the contour for the minimum ratios.
(3.2.3)
where
F1 : verification parameter
S
W'd
ed
qd
(J
Wd
Pnd
a
in case of cohesion soil ground, design value of undrained shear strength, and in case of sandy
ground, design value of apparent cohesion in drained condition (kN/m2)
: width of slice segment (m)
: design value of effective weight of slice segment per unit of length (weight of soil. When
submerged, unit weight in water) (kN/m)
: in case of cohesion soil ground, 0, and in case of sandy ground, design value of angle of shear
resistance in drained condition (")
: design value of vertical action from top of slice segment (kN/m)
: angle of bottom of slice segment to horizontal (")
: design value of total weight of slice segment per unit of length, total weight of soil and water
(kN/m)
: design value of horizontal action on soil mass of slice segment in circular slip (kN/m)
: length of arm from center of circular slip failure at position of action of Pnd (m)
: radius of circular slip failure (m)
:
-487-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
The design values in the equation can be calculated using the following equation by multiplying the
characteristic value by the partial factor. Provided, however, that Wd shall be expressed by the sum of W'd and the
weight of water, because it is not necessary to multiply the weight of water by a partial factor. If partial factors are
not particularly designated, 1.00 can be used for all partial factors in equation (3.2.4).
(3.2.4)
(6) Applicability of Stability Analysis Methods 6), 7)
Solutions in stability analysis by the modified Fellenius method and the simplified Bishop method are in agreement
for cohesive soil in which ~ 0, when all partial factor are 1.00, but differ when the circular arc passes through
sandy ground. In Japan, circular slip failure analysis by the modified Fellenius method is widely used. This is
because it has been reported that the modified Fellenius method reasonably explains the actual behaviors of slope
failure based on the results of analysis of case histories of slip failures in port areas in Japan, 4) and also gives a
safuty side solution for sandy grouod.
However, when the foundation ground consists entirely of sandy soil layers, or when a slip circle cuts through
grouod consisting of an upper thick sandy layer and lower cohesive soil layer, it is known that the modified
Fellenius method uoderestimates stability evaluated by the ratio expressed by the design value of shearing
resistance/design value based on actions.7) From the viewpoint of the basic principles of the stability calculation
method, the simplified Bishop method is more accurate uoder such conditions. Therefore, the simplified Bishop
method is generally used in case of eccentric and inclined loads, which are particularly a problem when examining
the bearing capacity of mounds (see 2.2.5 Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and Inclined Actions). It should be
noted that the simplified Bishop method has the problem of overestimating the ratio expressed by "design value of
shearing resistance" I "design value of shearing forces based on actions" when actions on near-horizontal sandy
grouod apply vertical loads. lo such cases, a method of stability calculation can be used which assumes that the
ratio of the vertical to the horizontal forces between slices is 1/3.5 of the angle of slice inclination.) lo stability
verification in this case, calculations are made using the following equation. In this equation, the symbol y is the
partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and dare the characteristic value and design value, respectively.
(3.2.5)
Based on equation (3.2.5), YF/"iis calculated, and stability can be verified by the verification parameter Fj>:l.
The design values in this equation can be calculated using the following equation. Provided, however, that wd
shall be expressed by the sum of W'd and the weight of water, because it is not necessary to multiply the weight of
water by a partial factor. If partial factors are not particularly designated, 1.00 can be used for all partial factors
in equation (3.2.6).
(3.2.6)
where n ~ I + tanO tan (pfJ), P is a parameter which provides the ratio of the vertical force to the horizontal
force acting on the sides of the slice, and can be assumed to be p ~ 1/3.5. The other symbols are the same as those
in equation (3.2.3).
3.2.2 Stability Analysis Assuming Slip Surfaces other than Circular Slip Surface
(!) Despite the provisions stated in the previous sections, a linear or a compounded slip surface shall be assumed
in stability analysis when it is more appropriate to assume a slip surface other than a circular arc slip surfaces
according to the ground conditions.
(2) When linear slip is assumed, examination of stability against slip failure of a slope with a straight sliding surface
is calculated using the following equation.
-488-
(3.2.7)
The partial factor 'YR for the analysis method for slip failure can be ~1.2 in the permanent situation and ~LOO
for variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion.
The design values in this equation can be calculated using the following equation. Provided, however, that Wd
shall be expressed by the sum of W'd and the weight of water, because it is not necessary to multiply the weight of
water by a partial factor. If partial factors are not particularly designated, LOO can be used for all partial factors
in equation (3.2.8).
(3.2.8)
Fig. 3.2.2 Examination of Slope Stability Analysis using Linear Sliding Surface
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
-489-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
CD
Evaluation of actions
Performance verification
..
-490-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
cases where the entire layer is to be replaced and the base rock stratum is inclined, it is preferable to conduct an
examination for a composite slip which includes slip failure on the base rock.
@ Examination of settlement
When cohesive soil remains beneath the replaced cross section, such as beneath partial replacement or the slope
of foundation excavation, consolidation settlement can be expected in the cohesive soil portion. Therefore, it is
preferable to conduct an examination of the effect of this consolidation settlement on the superstructure.
is a case where the angle of shear resistance is extremely low, and therefore caution is necessary.
Examination of Liquefaction
Liquefaction is generally assessed based on the grain size distribution and the N-values of the replaced sand.
When difficult to evaluate, the liquefaction should be examined by cyclic triaxial test 41) (see Part Il, Chapter
6 Ground Liquefaction). When liquefaction is one of critical factors in the determination of the replacement
section and the characteristics of the replacement sand, it should be considered at selecting the replaced material.
Ifin sufficient strength ofthe replaced sand is expected, it is preferable to compact the replaced sand after filling.
@ The N-values of the replaced sand are affected by its grain size and grain size distribution, placement method
and sequence of placement, elapsed time and surcharge. According to some case studies, the N-values of
the replaced sand were around 10 when sand was instantaneously placed in large volume from large-capacity
hopper barges with bottom doors, around 5 when sand was placed by grab buckets from sand carriers, and even
smaller values when sand was spread by suction dredger. Several case studies show that the N-values of the
loose replaced sand increased with the application of surcharge and the elapsed time after placing the replaced
sand or rubble stones or placing caisson.
-491-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
improvement.
Q) Assure targeted strength increase.
@ Assure that residual settlement should be within the allowable value.
@ Secure the necessary stability of the facilities.
(2) An example of the performance verification procedure for the vertical drain method is shown in Fig. 4.4.1.
Bearing
capacity
of ground
Allowable
settlement
..L
I
Assumption of necessary
consolidation load
Jrl
i
Assumption of section to be improved
~
Cnnstruction I
period
I
I
I
1
Verificationofstability ,1
I against circular slip failure
I
Determination of embankment
height and consolidation period in
each stage of construction
.
.
f--
Determination of embankment
width and shape
in each stage of constructinn
Determination of type,
I
diameter, and spacing of drains I
I Comparison of economy I
Fig. 4.4.1 Example of Performance Verification Procedure for Vertical Drain Method
4.4.2 Performance Verification
(!) Determination of Height and Width of Embankment
-492-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
-----Mean width---~
Drain area
(c) In examination of the strength increase (de) of the original ground, equation (4.4.1) can be used.
c.,,;de
de= de/ Ap(p0+ay' h- Pc')U
(4.4.1)
where
-493-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
drains at small intervals rather than by placing large diameter drains at wide intervals. However, in the sand
drain method, use of sand piles with an excessively small diameter may result in clogging due to infiltration of
clayey particles, and there is a danger ofbreakage of the sand piles ifthe piles are unable to follow deformation
by loading or consolidation settlement during the consolidation period. Construction records of sand drain
method to date show that the most frequently used diameter is 40cm, and diameters normally range from
30-SOcm. In the small diameter fabri-packed drain method,43) sand piles with a diameter of 12cm are packed
into synthetic fiber bags, and four sand piles are installed simultaneously using a ligbtweigbt pile driver. This
method is frequently used with extremely soft subsoil on land. A fabri-packed drain method with a diameter
of the order of 40cm has also been developed for improvement of extremely soft subsoil at the sea bottom.441
45)
Silt
Fine sand
Gravel
Coarse sand
'
'
}@ ___________ _
'$.
r
"
80
60
iii""
'
------------~--------------
'~
-~ 40
-~gj
Q.
0.1
'
________
~Ji///?--
20
'
~~~-l~es_in Japan
---------_:__ -------------
1
Grain size(mm)
10
@ Drain interval
(a) Interval of drain piles shall be so determined that the required degree of consolidation can be obtained in a
given construction period.
(b) General
The vertical drain method can be applied when the rate of consolidation by the preloading method, surcharge
method, vacuum consolidation method, or similar methods is slow considering the time constraints of the
construction period. Fig. 4.4.4 shows the relationship between the required consolidation time t 80, drainage
-494-
distance H, and coefficient of consolidation cv of a clayey layer by the preloading method, surcharge method,
and vacuum consolidation method.
Note) In Fig. 4.4.4, the units used are consolidation time t80 (day), drainage distance H (m), and coefficient
of consolidation Cv (cm2/min).
5000
ho
(d)
I
Tn&O
- - .L -6month.s
I
10% 0.013
I
20% 0.055
Permeable layer
-30% 0.125
40% 0.222
---:~:.1~
- L I
Perineable layer
:c?i.l~
70% 0.711
80% 1.000
90% 1.497
Imperineable layer
60% 0.507
IO
50
H(m)
with square arrangement, fJ= 0.886, and with a triangular arrangement, p = 0.952.
Tn ' = c.,.!
Dw
coefficient of consolidation related to flow of water in horizontal direction (cm2/min)
consolidation time (min)
Note) The unit used for time (t) in Fig. 4.4.S and Fig. 4.4.6 is days.
-495-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
100~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
I
~
------~------+------~----
n =De
Dw
T.'
C,,A
"= D!
n 10
------~-----~--~
~-
_ _ _ _ _ _ _I _ _ _ _ _ _ _ I _ _ _ _
cw. (<mi/min)
(d)
Dw (cm)
0.001
0.01
0.1
(4.4.4)
(4.4.5)
where
Th
Cvh
t
D,
Dw
Note) In Fig. 4.4.6, the units used are coefficient of consolidation c,h (cm2/min), effective diameter of drain
area D, (cm), and elapsed time t (day).
-496-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
0.1
0.
,,. '(arr/min)
D8:(m)
t. (d)
0.3
u,
0.
- - - -1 -
--j -
r- - r-
- - - -1-
_j -
f- -
0.8
____ I _
_J _ _ _ _
L _ L __
0.
____ I _
_J _ _ _ _
L _ L __ _
0.5
f- -
De= l.128D
De= l.050D
-497-
(4.4.6)
(4.4.7)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
cement.
(2) The majority of examples of application of soil improvement by the deep mixing method in ports are breakwaters,
revetments including partition dikes, and quaywalls having caissons or the like as their superstructure. The
performance verification method presented here can be applied to improved soil when a gravity-type breakwater
revetment or quaywall is to be used as the superstructure.
(3) When applying the deep mixing method to port facilities, a high rigidity subsurface structure is formed by
mutually overlapping stabilized soil having a pile shape in the ground using a mixing machine. The pattern of
this subsurface structure is determined depending on the properties of the ground and the type and scale of the
superstructure. In general, however, the block type and the wall type shown in Fig. 4.5.1 are frequently used.
Accordingly, block type improvement and wall type improvement will be discussed here which are representative
forms of improvement in the field of port engineering.
(4) The wall type improvement consists of long and short walls as shown in Fig. 4.5.l(b). The basic concept of the
design is that the long walls function to transmit the external actions to the foundation ground, while the short
walls function to increase the integrity of the improved ground.
CD
Improved ground: Portion in which the stabilized body and untreated soil is combined. In the wall type
improvement, the untreated soil between the long walls is inclusive.
Improved subsoil system: Portion above the bottom ofthe improved subsoil, between the vertical planes passing
through the front toe and heel of the improved subsoil.
External stability: Examination of stability of unified body consisting of improved subsoil and superstructure
as a rigid body in the process up to failure.
Internal stability: Examination of internal failure of the stabilized body which is stable externally.
-498-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(J) Bottom seated type: Structural type in which the stabilized body is seated directly on the bearing stratum; in
this type of improvement, actions are transmitted to the bearing stratum by improvement of the soft ground
reaching as far as the bearing stratum.
Floating type: Structural type in which the stabilized body talces a form that floats in the soft ground; in this type
of improvement, the stabilized body is not seated on the bearing stratum, but soft ground is allowed to remain
underneath the stabilized body.
(2) Stabilized soil by the deep mixing method generally has extremely high strength and deformation modulus and
extremely small strain at failure in comparison with the soil of the original ground.60J Accordingly, a stabilized
body formed with stabilized soil can be regarded as a kind of structure. Therefore, examination of external
stability of the structure as a whole, examination of the resistance of the structure itself, and when particularly
necessary, examination of the settlement, horizontal displacement, and rotation of the stabilized body as a rigid
body shall be performed.
(3) In the performance verification of the deep mixing method, the Technical Manual for the Deep Mixing Method
in Marine Construction Works 61) can be used as a reference.
(4) An example of the procedure of the performance verification for the deep mixing method for gravity-type
structures is shown in Fig. 4.5.2.
I
I
:14--------------~
.J.
----;=~~~~~_v~~~a~~~----_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_l+-__ -_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-P-~-----~---;;i---,b.te-_-_-:~
'
:' I Verification of internal stability such as toe pressure, shear stress and dislodging
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~i.;'";~;~-~~~~~i~~ii~~~-~-;;;;;;~~~ti~~
IVerification of external stability such as sliding, overturning and bearing capacity I
I Verification of internal stability such as toe pressure, shear stress and dislodging
I
f-----~-+--1
"
I 2
i----------------------------------------1--~e~~~~~~~~~~~f!
I Examination of deformation by dynamic analysis :
:
L----------------- -----------------------r------------------------l
r----------------------------+-------------------------------------,
Permanent state
I_____________________________
t: When necessary, examination of deformation by dynamic analysis can be performed for Level 1 earthquake ground motion. In cases where
the width of the improved subsoil is smaller than the width of the foundation mound, it is preferable to conduct an examination of
deformation by dynamic analysis.
2 Depending on the performance requirements of the main body, examination for Level 2 earthquake ground motion shall be performed.
-499-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(5) The performance verification of variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion in the deep
mixing method can be conducted, equivalent to gravity-type quaywalls, by either the simplified method (seismic
coefficient method),or by a detailed method (nonlinear seismic response analysis considering dynamic interaction
of the ground and structures) presented in Part III, Chapter 5, 2.2.3 Performance Verification. In cases where
the width of the improved subsoil is smaller than the width of the foundation mound in the results of verification
by the simplified method, it is necessary to carry out an examination of deformation of the improved subsoil and
main body by a detailed method. Examination of accidental situations in respect of Level 2 earthquake ground
motion may also be necessary depending on the performance requirements of the facilities.
(6) In the performance verification of the deep mixing method, it is necessary to consider the following items.
CD
Because there is no method for the deep mixing method to determine the dimensions of the stabilized body at
once, the verification calculation is performed repeatedly until stability conditions are satisfied and the most
The limit values of deformation in the variable situations and the accidental situations can be set corresponding
to the performance requirements of the facilities, using deformation of the main structure to be supported by the
deep mixing method as an index.
In the verification of deformation of Level I earthquake ground motion and Level 2 earthquake ground motion,
it is preferable to use a numerical model or results of shaking table tests which can appropriately assess the
residual deformation of the improved subsoil caused by ground motion.
(!) Allowable stress of the stabilized body needs to be appropriately determined for the examination of the internal
stability.
(2) Design compressive strength .k can be obtained using equation (4.5.1) based on the standard design strength
In this equation, the symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and d denote the
q.,.
(4.5.1)
where
.k
a
The design values in the equation can be calculated using the following equation.
For the partial factory.., of design standard strength, the values mentioned in 4.5.4 Performance Verification,
[2] Examination of Internal Stability may be used.
(3) The design shear strength.fsh and design tensile strength/, of the stabilized body can be obtained from equation
(4.5.2) and equation (4.5.3) using the design compressive strength};.
-500-
(4.5.2)
(4.5.3)
where
hh
f,
(4) In the performance verification of the stabilized body, the stabilized body is assumed to be a material with
homogeneous strength. However, in actual construction work, because the stabilized body is formed by mutual
overlapping of piles of stabilized subsoil, there are cases in which inhomogeneous by stabilized soil remains, for
example, containing residual untreated soil or having strength differences in overlapped parts, depending on the
mixing machine used and the method ofoverlapping. The factors a and Pshown in equation (4.S.1) are factors for
treating stabilized subsoil as material having homogeneous strength. The concepts when setting these factors are
presented in the following.
Dx
.,. 1
I
Connecting surface
.fx
-501-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(4.5.4)
2) Factor for overlap
In Fig. 4.5.4, assuming the interval between the mixing shafts is D, the radius of the mixing blade is R, and
the overlap width is d, the factor a 1 for overlap can be obtained using equation (4.5.5).
(4.5.5)
In many examples, the minimum overlap width dis assumed to be 25cm, considering execution accuracy
and capacity.
a,= A,
A,
(4.5.6)
where
A1 : area enclosed by bold line in Fig. 4.5.4
A 2 : area shown by hatched lines in Fig. 4.5.4
(4.5.7)
where
: coefficient showing normal deviation, namely multiplier for standard deviation u. In general,
K = LO can be adopted.
V : coefficient of variation of unconfined compressive strength q.1 ofin-situ stabilized soil.
Because the value of Vis greatly affi:cted by the mixing machine and mixing technology, it is preferable that
Vbe set individually for each case. However, based on the past examples, V = 33 (%)can be used.
Setting of the value of the coefficient K as LO when the variation of the unconfined compressive strength q.1
of in-situ stabilized subsoil follows a normal distribution means that the characteristic value q"" of the standard
design strength is set at a strength where the defect occurrence ratio is 15.9% (see Fig. 4.5.5).
The relationship between the average value q,. of the unconfined compressive strength qef of in-situ stabilized
subsoil and the average value q.,, of the unconfined compressive strength q.1 of samples mixed in the laboratory is
given by equation (4.5.8).
(4.5.8)
The value of,! is affi:cted by numerous factors, including the mixing machine and construction conditions, type
of soil which is the object of improvement, type of stabilizer, the curing environment, and age. As a guideline, in
offshore works, ,! = I can be assumed when construction is performed by large- or medium-scale working crafts,
and.!= 0.5-1 can be assumed for small-scale working crafts. Provided, however, that the value of A. may also be
determined based on tests or the past records of construction.
_
A schematic diagram of the relationship between design standard strength q.,; and the average value q., of the
unconfined compressive strength of samples mixed in the laboratory and the average value q.r of the unconfined
compressive strength of in-situ stabilized soil is shown in Fig. 4.5.5.
-502-
0.0
.5
1.0
0.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
Fig. 4.5.5 Relationship between quck, q111 , and q""" (schematic diagram)
(1) Fig. 4.5.6 shows a schematic diagram of the loads acting on the stabilized body in the case of gravity-type
revetments and quaywalls.
(2) Because improved subsoil of wall-type improvement contains untreated soil in the improved subsoil, depending
on the performance verification items, it may be necessary to set the load conditions by separating the untreated
and stabilized subsoils.
(3) For the examination on the external stability of improved subsoil systems, Pa or Pp can be determined using the
active and passive earth pressures specified in Part IJ, Chapter 5, 1 Earth Pressure. When examining internal
stability, Pa may be considered as active earth pressure. However, it is preferable that PP be set appropriately
within the range from earth pressure at rest to passive earth pressure, considering the external stability of the
improved subsoil system.
(4) In cases where a certain amount of displacement of the improved subsoil is expected, it has been confirmed
experimentally that adhesion of untreated soil acts on the vertical planes of the active and passive sides of the
stabilized body. In the case of embankment and reclamation behind the improved subsoil, downward negative
skin friction accompanied by consolidation settlement of the untreated soil acts on the vertical plane of the active
side of the stabilized body. Therefore, these types of adhesion should be considered in the examination of the
Permanent situation.69) On the other hand, in the examination of actions associated with ground motion, safety
side assumptions, for example, that the inertia force of the stabilized body and the earth pressure during ground
motion will act simultaneously, are adopted. Therefore, Cua as a downward action and C,,p as an upward action
may be assumed in the examination of both external and internal stability. The value of Cua and C,,P in this case
are obtained from the undrained shear strength of the untreated soil under these conditions.
(5) In the case of improved subsoil by wall-type improvement, it may be assumed that both Pa and PP act uniformly
onthe long walls and the untreated soil between the long walls. Provided, however, that when the subgrade
reaction T at the bottom of the stabilized body is obtained, it is assumed that the loads acting on the stabilized
body, such as the weight of the main body, are concentrated on the long walls, and only the self-weight of the
untreated soil acts on the untreated soil between the long walls.
The shear resistance force R shall be the sum of the shear resistance forces acting on the stabilized body and
the bottom of the untreated soil.
(6) Deformation of the superstructure during action of ground motion tends to be reduced by soil improvement by
the deep mixing method. Therefore, when setting the seismic coefficient for the verification ofthe superstructure
and the improved subsoil system, it is possible to set a rational seismic coefficient for the verification based on an
appropriate evaluation of this reduction effect.
When soil improvement is performed by the deep mixing method the characteristic value k1iik of the seismic
coefficient for the verification of the superstructure and the structural elements of improved subsoil system such
as superstructure, foundation mound, backfill, reclamation and surcharge can be calculated by multiplying the
maximum value of corrected acceleration ac obtained for the untreated ground by the reduction coefficient 0.64,
as shown in equation (4.5.9) 61).
--0.55
k1i1 = 1.7
t
Da
D, )
acx0.64 +0.04
g
(4.5.9)
-503-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where
khlk
insufficient bearing capacity of foundation ground in variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake
ground motion can be used as a reference.
The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification of improved subsoil kh2k can be calculated by
multiplying the seismic coefficient for verification khlk obtained using equation (4.5.9) by the reduction coefficient
0.65 (kh2k ~ 0.65 x kh1iJ.
Provided, however, that in the characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification kh3k used in
calculations of the earth pressure during earthquakes for improved subsoil systems, in equation (4.5.9), the
maximum value of corrected acceleration shall not be multiplied by a reduction coefficient.
H,
L.W.L.
H,.....,1111
<Vertical
~~\ent>
c- {).
{J.<H~tal
<Vertical component>
/i
H,
fr
<Horizontal component> c.
H,
l
I
W, Stabiliz.ed part
w,
Untreated part
)
"' In case of wall-type improvement
JI>
LJ;
~ 81
ck
-typo.
wall
.,..
--o
'r
(depend 00 sli
;:
pre~ure
pressure
Subgrade reaction
Pa : resultant earth pressure per unit oflength acting on vertical plane of active side (kN/m)
horizontal component of resultant earth pressure per unit of length acting on vertical plane of
active side (kN/m)
P"' : vertical component of resultant earth pressure per unit of length acting on vertical plane of
active side (kN/m)
PP : resultant earth pressure per unit oflength acting on vertical plane of passive side (kN/m)
Pph : horizontal component of resultant earth pressure per unit of length acting on vertical plane of
passive side (kN/m)
P"' : vertical component of resultant earth pressure per unit of length acting on vertical plane of
passive side (kN/m)
P w : resultant residual water pressure per unit of length (kN/m)
Pdw : resultant dynamic water pressure per unit oflength (kN/m)
W1-W9 : weight per unit oflength of each part (kN/m)
H 1-H9 : inertia force per unit oflength of each part (kN/m)
P ah
-504-
Cua : resultant adhesion of vertical plane per unit of length acting on vertical plane of active side
(kN/m)
Cup : resultant adhesion of vertical plane per unit of length acting on vertical plane of passive side
(kN/m)
R
shear resistance per unit oflength acting on bottom of improved subsoil (kN/m)
T
resultant of subgrade reaction per unit of length acting on the bottom of improved soil (kN/m)
th t 2
intensity of subgrade reaction at toes of stabilized body (kN/m)
In the performance verification of actions during ground motion of strata which are subject to liquefaction,
it is necessary to consider the dynamic water pressure during the action of ground motion on the improved body.
For calculation of dynamic water pressure, Part II, Chapter 5, 2 Water PreHure can be used as a reference.
CD The improved subsoil shall secure the required stability against slip failure.
It is necessary to conduct performance verification of improved subsoil by wall-type improvement for two cases,
namely, the slip pattern 1 case which considers the frictional resistance of the bottom of the improved subsoil
as a whole as resistance to slip failure, and the slip pattern 2 case which considers the resultant of the frictional
resistance directly under the long walls and the shearing resistance of the unimproved subsoil between the walls,
considering the improved ground to be a structure in which the stabilized subsoil long walls fully demonstrates
shear strength. In the examination of the stability against slip failure, equation (4.S.10) can be used. The symbol
y in the equation is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and d denote the characteristic value and
design value, respectively.
(Slip pattern 1)
(4.5.10)
=p;(r;WLRWL1-rWLWL1>{~(rRWLRWL1-rWLWL1)+hL +rwiWI.1}
Pdw4 =!_r.
+r.WLWLk ) 2
12 ku khi p w g(i.
"1
where
R1
R2
frictional resistance of bearing ground per unit of length acting on bottom of stabilized body
(kN/m)
frictional resistance of bearing ground per unit of length acting on bottom of untreated soil
(kN/m)
-505-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
R3 : shearing resistance per unit oflength acting on bottom of untreated soil (kN/m)
P w : resultant of residual water pressure per unit oflength (kN/m)
Pdw : resultant of dynamic water pressure during earthquake per unit of length (kN/m)
H; : inertia force per unit oflength acting on respective parts (kN/m)
W, : weight per unit of length of surcharge, snperstrncture, foundation mound, backfill, reclamation
on improved subsoil comprising improved subsoil system (kN/m)
W, : weight per unit of length of stabilized body (kN/m)
W9 : weight per unit of length of untreated soil between long walls (kN/m)
B : improved width of stabilized body (m)
R1 : ratio oflong wall in stabilized body
R, : ratio of short wall in stabilized body
: static friction coefficient
c. : shear strength of bottom of untreated soil (kN/m2)
Pah : horizontal component of resultant earth pressure per unit of length acting on vertical plane of
active side (kN/m)
P~ : vertical component of resultant earth pressure per unit of length acting on vertical plane of
active side (kN/m)
Pph : horizontal component of resultant earth pressure per unit of length acting on vertical plane of
passive side (kN/m)
PP' : vertical component of resultant earth pressure per unit of length acting on vertical plane of
passive side (kN/m)
C.,, : resultant adhesion of vertical plane per unit of length acting on vertical plane of active side
(kN/m)
Cup : resultant adhesion of vertical plane per unit of length acting on vertical plane of passive side
(kN/m)
f'wg : unit weight of seawater (kN/m3)
RWL : residual water level (m)
WL : water level at front side (m)
hL : water depth at bottom of stabilized body (m)
h1 : water depth at front side of structure (m)
kht : seismic coefficient for verification when calculating inertia force acting on surcharge,
superstructure, foundation mound, backfill and reclamation on improved subsoil comprising
improved subsoil system (kN/m)
k1a : seismic coefficient for verification when calculating inertia force acting on improved subsoil
kh3 : seismic coefficient for verification when calculating earth pressure and dynamic water pressure
acting on improved subsoil system
w.1 : weight per unit of length of surcharge, superstructure, main body, foundation mound, backfill
and reclamation on improved subsoil comprising improved subsoil system. If submerged, the
weight in air when saturated with water shall be used. (kN/m)
Wn8 : weight per unit oflength of stabilized body. If submerged, the weight in air when saturated with
water shall be used. (kN/m)
Wn9 : weight per unit of length of untreated soil between long walls. If submerged, the weight in air
when saturated with water shall be used. (kN/m)
y1 : structural factor, generally be assumed to be 1.0
Ya : structural analysis factor, generally be assumed to be 1.0
@ The system reliability index Pr is set depending on the individual facilities and improved subsoil. In cases
where soil improvement is carried out by the deep mixing method, the system reliability index Pr for sliding and
overturning of the wall body, failure due to insufficient bearing capacity of the foundation ground of gravitytype quaywa!ls, failure due to toe pressure, vertical shear failure of the long wall part, vertical shear failure of
the short wall part and failure due to extrusion of untreated subsoil between thte long walls was 2.9 (failure
probability of 2.1 x 10-3) for the Permanent situation. This was the result of assessment, by reliability theory,
of the average safety level of gravity-type quaywalls for soil improvement by the deep mixing method in the
conventional design method. In the performance verification described here, the target reliability index of Pr'
~ 3.0 for each limit state is set so as to exceed the system reliability index. The partial factors determined on
this basis are as shown in Table 4.5.1 through Table 4.5.6. For partial factors for use in the examination of
slip failure of improved subsoil, the values shown in Table 4.5.1 may be used. For partial factors which are not
listed in the table, 1.00 may be used.
-506-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
Table 4.5.1 Standard Values of Partial Factors for Use in Examination of Slip Failure
(a) Permanent situation
All facilities
Target reliability index Pr
2.9
2.JxJ0-3
3.0
y
Slip pattern 1 Yw,Ywa
IX,
Weight
1.00
0.131
1.00
0.03
YP.,
yp__
1.15
--0.519
1.00
0.10
1.00
0.000
1.00
YPph
0.90
0.277
1.00
0.10
YP
1.00
0.000
1.00
Ye
1.00
0.000
1.00
Ye
1.00
0.000
1.00
Yu
0.70
1.000
1.00
0.10
Ya
1.00
Weight
1.00
0.000
1.00
1.15
-0.461
1.00
0.10
YPM
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.85
0.454
1.00
0.10
1.00
0.000
1.00
Ye
1.00
0.000
1.00
Ye
1.00
0.000
1.00
Yu
y,.
0.75
0.831
1.00
0.10
0.80
0.202
1.00
0.33
Ya
1.00
YP
ypph
YP
subsoil
-507-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
{b} Variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion
All facilities
Performance requirement
Serviceability
Slip pattern I
rwrw.
Weight
Horizontal resultant of active earth pressure
yp_.
yp_
YPph
YP_,
Ye
Ye
y.
Ya
Slip pattern 2 i'w,YwQ
yp_.
Weight
Horizontal resultant of active earth pressure
yp_
ypph
yp_,
Ye
ye
Yu
y,.
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
IX,
-
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
subsoil
Ya
a
-
Q) It is necessary that improved subsoil secure the required stability against overturning. In the examination of
the stability against overturning of improved subsoil by wall-type improvement, equation (4.5.11) and equation
(4.5.12) can be used. In these equations, the symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k
and d denote the characteristic value and design value, respectively.
(a) Permanent situation
(4.5.11)
Pph0
-rPp1s Pph
-
Wsa =rw8Ws,,,
1f9a =rw91f9J:
Pavo =rP,..PavJ:
= c.,,. CUaJ:
Paho =yp.u.Pah,,,
cuad
Pw,
-508-
(4.5.12)
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
where
distance from action line of vertical force acting on improved subsoil to front toe of stabilized
body(m)
y1, Yp Yw rm. : height from action line of horizontal force acting on improved subsoil to bottom of stabilized
body (m)
y1 : structural factor, generally be assumed to be 1.0
Ya : structural analysis factor (see Table 4.5.2)
@ For partial factors for use in the examination of overturning of improved subsoil, the values shown in Table
4.5.2 may be used. For partial factors not listed in the table, 1.00 may be used.
-509-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 4.5.2 Standard Values of Partial Factors for Use in Examination of Overturning
(a) Permanent situation
All facilities
Target reliability index /Jr
2.9
2.lxl0-3
3.0
Yw.
Yw7
Yw.
Yw.
Ye,,.
i'P
i'P_
Ya
/Xk
0.85
0.382
1.00
0.10
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.030
0.055
0.102
0.074
0.102
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.03
0.03
0.03
0.03
0.10
1.25
1.00
1.00
-0.882
0.029
1.00
1.00
0.10
0.10
Yw.
Yw7
Yw.
Yw.
Ye,,.
i'P.h
Serviceability
i'P_
Ya
/Xk
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.10
CD
Improved subsoil shall secure the required stability against failure of bearing capacity of the original ground
under the bottom of the improved subsoil. In the examination of the bearing capacity of block-type improved
subsoil, 2.2 Shallow Spread Foundations can be used as a reference.
@ For the bearing capacity of improved subsoil by wall-type improvement when the bearing ground is sandy
ground, verification can be performed using equation (4.5.13) for toe pressures t1 and t 2 , considering the effect
ofmutual interference between the long walls. In this equation, the symbol r is the partial factor for its subscript,
and the subscripts k and d denote the characteristic value and design value, respectively.
.!. O?: 3
In the case of
1/
in the case of
1~
(4.5.13)
.!.< 3
1/
where
-510-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
q.,.2a
= 7_yRpgBN,
T/=--'L,+Lll
L1 : length of long wall in direction of face line (m) (see Fig. 4.5.9)
L, : length of short wall in direction of face line (m) (see Fig. 4.5.9)
B : improvement width (m) (see Fig. 4.5.9)
(2) The stress generated in the stabilized body can be obtained by assuming that the stabilized body is an elastic body
under the conditions specified in 4.5.3 Conditions of Actions on Stabilized Body.
(3) In block-type improved subsoil and improved subsoil by wall-type improvement, internal stability can be
examined by the method presented below. Provided, however, that in cases where the shape of the stabilized body
is complex or the depth of the stabilized body is large in comparison with its width, examination by FEM analysis
is preferable.
(4) Examination of Toe Pressure 61)
Q) Examination of internal stability due to toe pressure at the bottom of the stabilized body can be performed
using equation (4.5.14), considering the effect of the confining pressure acting on the improved subsoil. In this
equation, the symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and d denote the characteristic
value and design value, respectively.
fcd;;.; r.r,
k2
-K~)w,ii,)}
(4.5.14)
where
t,,
The design values in the equation can be obtained using the following equations.
t1,2d
= rt11,2k
wid =rw;W;k
Provided, however, that it is necessary to determine the value of the confining pressure KL(w;dh;) acting
on the bottom edge of the stabilized body from the untreated subsoil considering the improvement pattern and
external stability of the improved subsoil.
@ For the partial factors for use in examination of toe pressure, the values shown in Table 4.5.3 may be used. For
partial factors not listed in the table, 1.00 may be used.
-511-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 4.5.3 Standard Values of Partial Factors for Use in Examination of Toe Pressure
(a) Permanent situation
All facilities
Target reliability indexP,
Target system failure probability P"
Reliability index p used in calculation of y
2.9
2.lx!0-3
3.0
y,,.
Yw.
y,
IX,
0.55
1.05
-0.116
1.00
0.03
1.00
0.001
1.00
0.03
1.00
All facilities
Serviceability
Performance requirement
IX,
0.67
i't1,2
Toe pressure
1.00
Yw.
y,
1.00
Toe pressure y.
1.00
(5) Examination of Shearing Stress at Vertical Plane Under Face Line of Superstructure 61)
CD
Examination of internal stability against shearing stress along the vertical plane beneath the face line of the
superstructure can be performed for the long wall part and short wall part using equation (4.5.15) and equation
(4.5.16), respectively. In these equations, the symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k
and d denote the characteristic value and design value, respectively.
(4.5.15)
where
(Tia= '!TTiJ
q"' : standard design strength (kN/m2) (q."' = yq.,q.,iJ
W1 : effective weight of stabilized body from front toe of improved subsoil to position of B1 (kN) (W1a
=ywWiJ
A : cross-sectional area of stabilized body, in case oflong wall A= Dif.,1+ D,L, (m2) (see Fig. 7.5.7)
D 1 , D, : vertical length oflong wall, namely improved depth, and vertical length of short wall (m)
L 1, L, : lengths of long wall and short wall in direction of face line, respectively (m)
y1 : structural factor, generally be assumed to be 1.0
Ya : structural analysis factor, generally be assumed to be 1.0
When a rubble mound exists between the stabilized body and the superstructure, examination may be
performed using an examination plane which considers load dispersion in the mound from the position of the
face line of the superstructure. (See Fig. 4.5.7; 8 is the angle ofload dispersion in the mound.)
-512-
Ds
---D
()
-----------
I
I
I
I
I
I
~Wt
Dl
-*P
iJrt
I:
Bf.
.I
Lt
B
For the partial factors for use in the examination of vertical shear failure of the long wall part, the values
shown in Table 4.5.4 can be used. For partial factors which are not listed in the table, 1.00 may be used.
Table 4.5.4 Standard Values of Partial Factors for Use in Examination of Vertical Shear Failure of Long Wall
(a) Permanent situation
All facilities
Target reliability index Pr
2.9
2.lxl0-3
3.0
'/
0.55
IX1
1.05
-0.115
1.00
0.03
1.00
0.005
1.00
0.03
1.00
Serviceability
'/
'/a
IX1
0.67
1.00
1.00
1.00
(4.5.16)
where
-513-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Wm
hm
-+-..c._-='::Tcrrr~~~r-
Ds
Ds
P;
I I I
L
Ls
Fig. 4.5.8 Schematic Diagram of Calculation of Vertical Shear Stress (Short Wall)
For the partial factors for use in examination of vertical shear failure of the short wall, the values shown in
Table 4.5.5 can be used. For partial factors which are not listed in the table, 1.00 may be used.
Table 4.5.5 Standard Values of Partial Factors for Use in Examination of Vertical Shear Failure of Short Wall
(a) Permanent situation
All facilities
Target reliability index PT
2.9
2.lxJ0-3
3.0
y
IX,
0.55
v
-
Toe pressure
1.05
-0.091
1.00
0.03
Yw.
1.00
-0.006
1.00
0.03
Ywy,
1.00
-0.006
1.00
0.03
1.00
Vertical shear y.
failure of
JIT,
short wall
All facilities
Performance requirement
Serviceability
IX,
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.67
Toe pressure
1.00
Yw.
Ywy,
Vertical shear y.
failure of
short wall l'T.'
-514-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(6) Examination of Extrusion 61)
Q) Because improved subsoil by wall-type improvement comprises a large number of long walls and a short wall
connecting the long walls, untreated subsoil is left between the long walls. Failures in which the untreated
subsoil between the long walls is dislodged are conceivable, depending on conditions such as the spacing
between the long walls, the strength of the untreated subsoil, the thickness of the backfill layer. Therefore, it is
necessary to examine extrusion of the untreated soil between the long walls.71)
@ A schematic diagram of extrusion of the untreated soil in improved subsoil by wall-type improvement is shown
in Fig. 4.5.9.
@ Examination of extrusion of untreated subsoil between long walls can be perfurmed by repeated calculations
using equation (4.5.17), using various values of D; in the calculations.
(4.5.17)
where
L, : length of short wall in direction of face line (m)
D, : depth from bottom edge of short wall to cross-.'!ection being examined (m)
Cu : average shear strength of untreated subsoil at intermediate depth between bottom edge of short
wall and cross section being examined (kN/m2) (C=yc. Cu;)
B : improved width (m)
Pah', Pph' : horizontal components of resultant of active earth pressure and passive earth pressure acting
on untreated subsoil between long walls, respectively, down to the depth of Di from bottom of
short wall (kN) (Pphd= yPp>Pph'a,Pahd = yP..PahkJ
kh2 : seismic coefficient for verification when calculating inertia force acting on improved subsoil
h.,
w1
Pwg
y,
Ya
(kh2d= y khlkhlkJ
: head between residual water level and water level at front of structure (m) (h..a = yh.,h,,k!
:
unit weight in air of untreated subsoil when saturated with water (kN/m3)
-515-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ For the partial factors for use in the examination of the extrusion of the untreated subsoil between long walls,
the values shown in Table 4.5.6 can be used. For partial factors which are not listed in the table, 1.00 may be
used.
Table 4.5.6 Standard Values of Partial Factors for Use in Examination of Extrusion
(a) Permanent situation
All facilities
2.9
2.JxJ0-3
3.0
IX,
0.75
1.05
a
0.955
--0.190
1.00
1.00
0.10
0.10
0.95
0.182
1.00
0.10
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.10
1.00
Extrusion
failure
Ye,.
l'P,.
i'Pph'
Yw,
y,
The partial factors for use in examination of extrusion were determined by reliability analysis of the examination position (DJ at which
the reliability index p shows its minimum value.
All facilities
Performance requirement
Extrusion
failure
Ye..
l'P,.
i'Pph'
Yw,
y,
Serviceability
y
1.00
1.00
a
-
IX,
-
1.00
1.00
1.00
The partial factors for use in examination of extrusion were determined by reliability analysis of the examination position (DJ at which
the reliability index p shows its minimum value.
CD
In the examination of the circular slip failure, 3 Stability of Slopes can be used as a reference.
@ Because the strength of the stabilized body is sufficiently greater than that of ordinary soil, examination of slip
circles passing through the stabilized body may be omitted.
(8) Examination of Displacement
CD
When the improved subsoil is of the floating type, lateral displacement due to actions in respect of reclamation
and waves and actions in respect of ground motion, and vertical displacement due to consolidation are
conceivable. Therefore, advance examination on measures capable of satisfying the performance requirements
of the facilities is necessary, based on estimations of these displacements.
@ In sliding failure and circular slip failure of improved subsoil, there is a certain degree of relationship between
the ratio ofthe design value of resistance and design value of the effects of actions, and the amount of immediate
displacement due to lateral displacement of the stabilized body. Therefore, it is possible to judge the necessity
of examination of lateral displacement of the stabilized body depending on the safety margin in these factora.
Furthermore, when the layer thickness of the untreated subsoil underneath the stabilized body is constant, and
-516-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
it is judged that the estimated displacement in the horizontal direction can satisfy the performance requirements
of the facilities, the examination of the consolidation settlement is only necessary.
@ Even in bottom seated-type improved subsoil, when a cohesive soil layer exists under the bearing stratum,
the examination of the amount of consolidation settlement is necessary, as there is a possibility of vertical
displacement of the stabilized body due to consolidation settlement.
It is preferable to determine the allowable displacement of improved subsoil appropriately, considering the
-517-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
The provisions in this section can be applied to the performance verification of the light weight treated soil
method.
@ The lightweight treated soil method is to produce artificial lightweight and stable subsoil by adding lightening
materials and hardening agents to slurry-state soil in adjusting its consisting being higher than liquid limit by
making use of dredged soil or excavated soil from construction sites, and then using the product as materials
for landfill or backfilling. When using air foam as the lightening material, it is called the foam treated soil, and
when using expanded polistyrol beads, it is called the beads treated soil. The lightweight treated soil has the
following characteristics:
(a) The weight is approximately one half of ordinary sand in the air and approximately one fifth in the seawater.
This lightness can prevent or reduce ground settlement due to landfill or backfill.
(b) Due to its light weight and high strength, the earth pressure during an earthquake is reduced. This makes it
possible to create high earthquake-resistance structures or reclaimed lands.
(c) Dredged soils, which are regularly produced and treated as waste in ports, or waste soils that are generated
by land-based construction works, are used. Thus, employment of the lightweight treated soil method can
contribute to reducing the amount of waste materials to be dealt with at waste disposal sites.
@ Refer to the "Technical Manual for the Lightweight Treated Soil Method in Ports and Airports" for further
details on the performance verification of this method.
(2) Basic Concept of Performance Verification
CD
The performance verification method described in 2 Foundations and 3 Stability of Slopes can be applied to
lightweight treated soil.
@ Apart from mix proportion tests, the performance verification method for lightweight treated soil is basically
the same with that for other earth structure.73), 74)
@ An example of the performance verification procedure when using the lightweight treated soil method in
backfilling for revetments and quaywalls is shown in Fig. 4.6.1.
-518-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
l
Assumption of strength and unit weight of lightweight treated soil :,
l
Assumption of area (or bounds, boundary) of improvement
with lightweight treated soil
'
l
Examination of ground as a whole, including lightweight
treated soil
CD Evaluation of actions
@ Examination of bearing capacity
@ Examination of circular slip failure
@ Examination of consolidation settlement
@ Examination of liquefaction of surrounding ground
l
I Performance verification of superstructure
l
IDetermination of strength/unit weight and area of improvement with lightweight treated soil I
Fig. 4.6.1 Example of Performance Verification Procedure of Lightweight Treated Soil Method
@ The properties oflightweight treated soil shall be evaluated by means oflaboratory tests that take account of the
environmental and construction conditions of the site. They may be evaluated as follows:
(a) Unit weight
The unit weight may be set within a range of y1 = 8-13 kN/m3 by adjusting the amount of lightening material
and added water. When used in port facilities, there is a risk of flotation in case of a rise of seawater level if
the unit weight is less than that of seawater. Normally, therefore, the characteristic value of the unit weight is
frequently set to the following values:
below water level:
for use uder water: Ylk = 11.5-12 kN/m3
for use in air:
Ylk = 10 kN/m3
The unit weight of lightweight treated soil will vary depending on the environmental conditions during
and after placement, and particularly the intensity of water pressure. Therefore, these factors should be
considered in advance in the mixture design.75), 76)
(b) Strength 77)
The static strength of lightweight treated soil is mainly attributable to the solidified strength due to the
cement-based solidifying agent. Standard design strength is evaluated by unconfined compressive strength
q. and can generally be set in the range of 100-500kN/m2. Because air foam or expanded beads are included
in the treated soil, no increase in strength can be expected due to increased confining pressure. However, the
residual strength is approximately 70% of the peak strength. The characteristic value of compressive strength
-519-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
shall be the standard design strength and be set to an appropriate value capable of satisfying perfurmance
requirements such as stability of the superstructure or the ground as a whole.
As the characteristic value of shear strength, undrained shear strength Cu can be used. The value of Cu can
be calculated using the fullowing equation.
c. =q./2
(4.6.1)
(c) The consolidation yield stress Py may be calculated using the following equation:
P, = I.4q.
(4.6.2)
E50 = 100~2ooq.
The defurmation modulus shown above corresponds to a strain level of 0.3-1.0%.
(4.6.3)
CD
The area to be filled with the lightweight treated soil needs to be determined as appropriate in view of the type
of structure to be built and the conditions of actions as well as the stability of the structure and the ground as a
whole.
@ The extent of filling area with lightweight treated soil is usually determined to meet the objective oflightening.
When the method is applied to control settlement or lateral displacement, it is determined from the allowable
conditions for settlement or displacement; to secure stability, it is determined from the condition of slope
stability; to reduce earth pressure, it is determined from the required conditions for earth pressure reduction.79)
(4) Concept of Mix Proportion
CD
Design of mix proportion shall be conducted to obtain the strength and the unit weight required in the field.
@ Types of solidifying agents and lightening agents shall be determined after their efficiency has been confirmed
in tests.
@ The target strength in laboratory mix proportion tests shall be set to a value obtained by multiplying the standard
design strength by a required additional rate a, considering differences in laboratory mix proportion strength
and in-situ strength and variance. The required additional rate a is expressed by the ratio of the strength in
laboratory mix proportion tests and standard design strength. Normally, the fullowing value can be used.
-520-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
CD
When using blast furnace granulated slag as backfill for quaywalls or revetments, landfill, surface covering for
soft subsoil and sand compaction material, the characteristics of the materials shall be considered.
@ Blast furnace granulated slag is a granular material. However, it has a latent hydraulic hardening property not
found in natural sand and is a material which solidifies with lapse of time.83) When used in backfill, ifits granular
state and solidified state are compared, the granular state generally gives a dangerous state in the performance
verification in many cases. Provided, however, that it is preferable to conduct an adequate examination, judging
the individual conditions, in cases where the solidified state may pose a risk to the facilities.
CD
When using granulated blast furnace slag, its physical properties are preferably to be ascertained in advance.
@ Blast furnace granulated slag is in a state like coarse sand when shipped from plants. The important characteristics
of physical properties of the blast furnace granulated slags are its small unit weight latent hydraulic hardening
property.
10
~
..
!l
..
Oil
2
I
0.
I.
10.
50.
@ Permeability
The coefficient of permeability in the granular state differs depending on the void ratio but is roughly JxJOOJxJO-lcm/s. The coefficient of permeability decreases with solidification, but even in this case is approximately
JxJ0-2cm/s.85J Provided, however, that when construction is conducted using methods that cause crushing of the
particles, for example, in the sand compaction pile method, the coefficient of permeability becomes extremely
small. Caution is required in such cases.
@ Compressibility
The time-dependent change of compressibility of blast furnace granulated slag used for backfill, landfill, or
surface covering can be ignored.
-521-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(J) Angle of shear resistance and cohesion
In the granular state, cohesion can be treated as non-existent. The angle of shear resistance in this case is 35
or greater. When solidified, shear strength is greater than in the granular state.83) In this case, the effects of
both the angle of shear resistance and cohesion on maximum shear strength can be considered. However, in
examining residual strength, only the effect of the angle of shear resistance should be considered.
(j) When using blast furnace granulated slag, appropriate consideration shall be given to its chemical properties.
@ The pH value of the leached water from blast furnace granulated slag is smaller than the pH of the leached
water from cement and lime stabilization treatment. Furthermore, its pH is also reduced by the neutralizing and
buffering action of the seawater composition and dilution by seawater. For this reason, in ordinary cases, it is
not necessary to consider the effect of the pH on the environment.
-522-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
CD
The performance verification described in this section may be applied to the performance verification of the
subsoil treated by the premixing method aimed at earth pressure reduction and liquefaction, prevention.
@ The meanings of the terms used in connection with this method are as follows:
Soil improved by stabilizer.
Treated soil:
Treated subsoil:
Subsoil improved by filling with treated soil.
Area to be filled with treated soil.
Area of improvement:
Stabilizer content:
Weight ratio of stabilizer to dry weight of parent material, expressed as a
percentage.
Reduction of earth pressure: Measures to reduce earth pressure against walls (active earth pressure).
@ In the premixing method, stabilizer and antisegregation agent are added into soil for reclamation, mixed in
advance and used as landfill materials to develop stable ground. The subsoil improvement is materialized as
cement-based stabilizers add cohesion to the soil used in landfill by means of chemical solidification action
between soil and stabilizer. This method can be applied to backfill behind quaywalls and revetments, filling of
cellular-bulkhead, replacement after sea bottom excavation and refilling.
@ Soils applicable to the treatment mentioned herein are sand and sandy soils, excluding cohesive soil. This is
because the mechanical properties ofthe treated cohesive soil differ considerably depending on the characteristic
of soil. It is necessary to conduct appropriate examination according to the property of soil subject to treatment.
@ Besides reducing earth pressure and preventing liquefaction, this method can also be used to improve the soil
strength necessary for construction of facilities on reclaimed lands. In this case, the strength of treated ground
should be evaluated appropriately.
For items in connection with the performance verification and execution when using the premixing method
CD
In performance verification, it is necessary to determine the required strength of the treated soil correctly, and
to determine the stabilizer content and area of improvement appropriately.
@ When evaluating the earth pressure reduction effect or examining the stability ofthe subsoil against circular slip
failure, the treated soil should be regarded as a "c-t/J material".
@ The treated subsoil may be thought to slide as a rigid body during an earthquake because the treated subsoil
has a rigidity considerably greater than that of the surrounding untreated subsoil. Therefore, when determining
the area of improvement, the stability against sliding of the subsoil including superstructures shall also be
examined.
@ It is preferable to determine the standard design strength and area of improvement of treated subsoil by the
procedure shown in Fig. 4.8.1.
@ In general, when the parent soil is sandy soil, the treated soil is regarded as c-0 material. Therefore, the shear
strength of the treated soil can be calculated using equation (4.8.1).
(4.8.1)
where
<t : shear strength of treated soil (kN/m2)
11'
c : cohesion (kN/m2)
and iP correspond to the cohesion cd and angle of shear resistance f!Jd obtained by the consolidated-drained
-523-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Preliminary survey and tests of untreated and treated soil
Evaluation of actions
Stability of facilities
-524-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(6) According to the results of consolidated-drained triaxial compression tests of treated soil with a stabilizer content
ofless than 10%, the angle of shear resistance of the treated soil is equal to or slightly larger than that ofthe parent
soil. Accordingly, in the performance verification, to be on the safe side, the angle of shear resistance of the
treated soil can be assumed to be the same as that of the untreated soil.
(7) When obtaining the angle of shear resistance from a triaxial compression test, the angle of shear resistance is
obtained from the consolidated-drained triaxial compression test based on the estimated density and effective
overburden pressure of the subsoil after landfilling. The angle of shear resistance used in the performance
verification is generally set at a value 5-10 smaller than that obtained from tests. When a triaxial test is not
performed, 0 can be obtained from the estimated N-value of the subsoil after landfilling. In that case, the N-value
of the untreated subsoil shall be used.
4.8.4 Design of Mix Proportion
(1) Mix proportion oftreated soil shall be determined by conducting appropriate laboratory mixing tests. A reduction
of strength shall be taken into account because the in-situ strength may be lower than the strength obtained from
laboratory mixing tests.
(2) The purpose oflaboratory mixing tests is to obtain the relationship between the strength of treated soil and the
stabilizer content, and to determine the stabilizer content so as to obtain the required strength of treated soil.
The relationship between the strength of treated soil and the stabilizer content is greatly affected by the soil type
and the density of soil. Therefore, test conditions of laboratory mixing tests is preferable to be as similar to field
conditions as possible.
(3) For the purpose of reducing earth pressure, consolidated-drained triaxial compression tests should be carried out
to obtain the relationship among the cohesion c, the angle of shear resistance ,P, and the stabilizer content. For the
purpose of preventing liquefaction, unconfined compression tests should be conducted to obtain the relationship
between the unconfined compressive strength and the stabilizer content.
(4) It is important to grasp the diffi:rence between in-situ and laboratory strengths when setting the increase factor for
mix proportion design in the field. According to past experience, the laboratory strength is larger than the in-situ
strength, and the increase factor of a~ I.I to 2.2 is used. Here, the increase factor a is defined as the ratio of the
laboratory to the field strengths in terms of unconfined compressive strength.
4.8.5 Examination of Area of Improvement
(I) The area to be improved by the premixing method needs to be determined as appropriate in view of the type of
structure to be constructed and the conditions of actions as well as the stability of subsoil and structures as a
whole.
(2) For the purpose of reducing earth pressure, the area of improvement needs to be determined in such a way that
the earth pressure of treated subsoil acting on a structure should be small enough to guarantee the stability of the
structure.
(3) For the purpose of preventing liquefaction, the area of improvement needs to be determined in such a way that
liquefaction in the adjacent untreated subsoil will not affect the stability of structure.
(4) The actions and resistances to be considered on the facilities and the treated subsoil in the case that liquefaction is
expected on the untreated subsoil behind the treated subsoil and in the case no liquefaction is expected are shown
in Fig. 4.8.2 and Fig. 4.8.3, respectively.
(5) For either reduction of earth pressure or prevention of liquefaction, it is necessary to conduct an examination of
stability against sliding during action of ground motion, including the treated subsoil and the object facilities, and
circular slip failure in the Permanent situation.
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(4.8.2)
r11fi1crwl'Wi'
Ri1d = f2 (rw2,W2'1 -1',,d) (when original subsoil under treated subsoil is sand)
(when original subsoil under treated subsoil is clay)
(4.8.3)
H2d
=r.thk1itYw2 W2"
Phd
P:,,d
= P11,i
where
R1
R2
P wl
P wl
P wJ
H1
H2
Ph
P"
Pwg
w'
kh
K0
h1
h2
Ii
tan(roc5.t +9>)
-526-
: angle of back of treated subsoil (cd) to vertical direction(), counterclockwise is positive; in Fig.
4.8.2, the value of <p is negative.
L6c
Ri,, -- Y1iJ1kYw-i'
'"
w;'
1k
R2d = f2 [r.,,.,W2/ +{r11iP"k _I_ Pwghf tanrp}] (when original subsoil under
2
(4.8.5)
where
R1
R2
P wl
P wl
H1
H2
Ph
Pwg
w'
kh
Ka
h1
h2
<p
-527-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Structure
Treated subsoil
e
H2
~
I
w;II
h1
iW,'
w.1I
t
R,
P.
h1
W.'
P..,
c
R1
Structure
e
v
H,
h,
w; II
a
R,
H2
!w,
b
h,
I
I
l W.'
w.1
P.
Static pressure
(earth+ water)
R.
-528-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(!) The performance verification of the sand compaction pile method to densify sandy soils needs to be conducted
appropriately after examining the characteristics of subsoil properties and construction methods, as well as by
taking account of the past construction records and the results of test execution.
A,
F,=-
Ao
(4.9.1)
(4) Determination of Sand Supply Rate when Existing Data are not available 87)
The sand supply rate is determined using the relationship between the sand supply rate and the N-value after
improvement shown by the fullowing equation. Provided, however, that the existing data used in deriving the
fullowing equation (4.9.2) through equation (4.9.9) are sand supply rate F v= 0.07-0.20 and fines content Fe= 60%
or less. Accordingly, caution is necessary when using conditions outside of this range.
.J2A
N1=CM( Kfi'v+r;'
c+Kfi'v +r;
(4.9.2)
where
N 1 : N-value after sand supply
CM : coefficient; here, CM= (1/0.16)2 may be used.
K : coefficient; here JC= 51Q-O.O!Fc may be used.
.
h
c : coeffic1ent;
ere c = 0.02Fc + 0.4 may b e used .
0.02Fc+2.0
c~N0 j(ACM)
l-~N0 j(ACM)
(4.9.3)
where
-529-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
A- 69+uv'
167
(4.9.4)
where
(c+ r:)~Ni/(ACM)-r:
Fv
K\l-~N1 /(ACM))
(4.9.5)
Because equation (4.9.2) and equation (4.9.3) do not consider the effect of the increase in lateral pressure
due to sand supply or the effect of coefficient of earth pressure at rest K,,, there is a tendency to underestimate
the N-value after sand supply when the sand supply rate is large. When a result is obtained in which the sand
supply rate exceeds F v = 0.2, a method 88) using the following equation, which considers the effect of K,,, is
also available. Provided, however, that caution is necessary, as predictive accuracy deteriorates due to the large
variation in the relationship between the sand supply rate and the value of K,, used in the derivation process of
the following equation. Accordingly, in order to avoid dangerous results, when using the following equation,
it shall be assumed that F v = 0.2, even when the results of calculation of the sand supply rate for obtaining the
target N-value are less than F v = 0.2.
(4.9.6)
where
CM : coefficient; here, CM= (1/0.16)2 may be used.
"
: coefficient; here K
c~N,t(AK,cM)
l-~N0 !(AK,CM)
ri where
AKI
-7~~~~~
(4.9.7)
_ 69+(l+aFv)uv'
Kl -
167
(4.9.8)
Ko
_ 69+u/
167
KO -
u0 '
(4.9.9)
Provided, however, that when the sand supply rate for the target N-value is F v < 0.2, F v = 0.2 shall be used.
(5) Setting of Sand Supply Rate, when the Existing Data are Available
The increase in the N-value after execution of the sand compaction pile method is strongly affected by the
subsoil characteristics and the execution method. Therefore, when abundant execution data are available for
the construction site or when test execution is performed, determination based on actual records of execution is
-530-
(c+r;) ~N1l(ACM)-r;
= -'-----'-----'------
1-~N1 /(ACM)}
Fv {
(4.9.10)
where
')I;*
r,*
c~N0 !(ACM)
1-~N0 !(ACM)
(4.9.11)
.
h ere c = 0.02Fc + 0.4 may b e used .
c : coeffic1ent;
0.02.f~ + 2.0
.
69+u'
A : coefficient; here A =
v
167
(4.9.12)
It is permissible to determine the relational equation for K and the fines content by obtaining K from the
respective sand supply rates and N-values before and after improvement, and arranging the relationship between
K and the fines content as shown in Fig. 4.9.1. Here, it is basically assumed that the relational equation between K
and the fines content is an exponential function as shown in (4).
In parameter setting, when there is a large difference in the fines content before and after improvement, and
when the N-value before improvement is larger, the data for that point shall not be used. When the relationship
between the value of Ko and the sand supply rate is actually measured, the parameters in equation (4.9.6) and
equation (4.9.7) which consider the influence of the value ofKo can be reset. For items related to parameter setting
in this case and related matters, Reference 2) can be used as reference.
20
15
1
- . . . I-- I
-.-
10
:
-
~~ -
- -
I- -
I. . .
I
I
I
Fv = 0. 7 - 0.20
I
.I
I.
I
I.
I
- - -
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
40
50
-:- - - - -:- - - -
I
I
I.
I
0
0
10
20
30
-531-
60
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(6) Other Methods of Setting Sand Supply Rate
The methods of setting the sand supply rate shown in the above (4) and (5) consider compaction of the original
subsoil resulting from repeated shear by sand supply under sand pile driving, and were derived by analysis of past
execution data. In addition to these methods, methods referred to as A method, B method, and C method have also
been proposed and have been used for some time.89J In the A method, the relationship between the N-value before
and after sand supply is shown in chart form, using the sand supply rate as a parameter, and thus enables simple
calculation of the sand supply rate. Provided, however, that this method has low generality in comparison with
other methods because it does not consider the effect of the overburden pressure or the effect of the fines content.
The B method uses empirical formulae for the relative density, N-value, effective overburden pressure, and grain
size, and obtains the sand supply rate for the target N-value assuming that the ground is compacted only by the
amount of the sand piles supplied. Provided, however, that this method does not consider the effect of the fines
content. The C method is proposed using a concept which is basically the same as in the B method. The major
difference with the B method is the fact that the effect of the fines content is considered. Thus, the C method has
the highest generality of these three methods. The D method is also proposed.9) The D method considers the
effect of ground rise accompanying driving of the sand piles, which is not considered in the C method.
Here, the C method is described here, as this method has the highest generality and most extensive record of
actual results among the three methods in conventional use.90)
CD
emax and emin are obtained from the fines content Fe.
emax
= 0.02Fc + 1.0
(4.9.13)
(4.9.14)
e- = 0.008Fc + 0.6
@ The relative density D,,, and e0 are obtained from the N-value of the original subsoil No and the effective
surcharge pressure Uv ".
D =Zl 100N0
ra
CTv '+ 70
(%)
(4.9.15)
"o
"mm )
(4.9.16)
@ The reduction rate p for the increase in the N-value due to the fines fraction is obtained.
P=l.0-0.SlogFc
(4.9.17)
A corrected N-value (N1') is obtained from the N-value (Ni) calculated assuming no fines fraction, considering
the reduction rate p.
N1
(N1 -No)
=No+~~p-~
(4.9.18)
e1 is obtained using equation (4.9.16) in the above @by substituting N 1' for N 0
@ Sand supply rate Fv is obtained using equation (4.9.19) from e0, "1
Fv = (e0 -e1)
l+e0
(4.9.19)
-532-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(!) The SCP method for cohesive soil ground is a method in which casing pipes are driven to the required depth at a
constant interval in cohesive soil ground, and the ground is compacted and sand piles are constructed simultaneously
with the discharge of sand into the ground from inside the casing pipes. As features of the improved subsoil, the
soil is affected in a complex manner by (a) the strength of the sand piles, (b) the sand pile replacement rate, (c) the
positional relationship of the area of improvement to structures, (d) conditions related to actions such as intensity,
direction, loading path and loading speed, (e) the strength of the ground between the sand piles, (f) the confining
pressure applied to the sand piles by the ground between the piles, (g) the effects of disturbances inside and outside
the area of improvement by sand pile driving, (h) the characteristics of the ground rise at the ground surface due
to sand pile driving, and whether this rise is to be used or not.
(2) Effect of Execution
Because a large quantity of sand piles are driven into the ground in the SCP method, the ground is forcibly pressed
out in the horizontal and upward directions, which may result in disturbance of the ground and reduction of
strength in the construction area and its surroundings. This displacement of the ground, and spills of excess sand
in the casing pipes on the ground surface, may also cause a heave in the ground surface. Thus, when applying the
SCP method, it is necessary to examine the effect of this type of ground displacement on neighboring structures.
(!) Materials for sand pile should have high permeability, low fines content ofless than 75 m, well-graded grain size
distribution, ease of compaction, and sufficient strength as well as ease of discharge out of casing. When the sand
piles with a low replacement area ratio are positively expected to function as drain piles to accelerate consolidation
of cohesive soil layer, the permeability of the sand pile material and prevention of clogging are important. The
permeability requirement is relatively less important in the case of improvement with a high replacement ratio,
that is close to the sand replacement. Therefore, materials for sand pile need to be selected considering the
replacement ratio and the purpose of improvement.
(2) There are no particular specifications on materials to be used for the sand piles. Any sand material that can be
supplied near the site may be used from the economical viewpoint as far as it satisfies the requirements. Fig.
4.10.1 shows several examples of sands used in the past. Recently, sand with a slightly higher fines content have
often been used.
-533-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
0.075
0.42
Fine sand
Silt
2.0
5.0
20.0
Coarse gravel
Coarse sand
90
----T--1
70
Case2
----1---_J __ _
~-:r~~'T-:tD..:l'.--~Case3
'
50
40
----+----
I
I
--------,----,-
- - -
- - -
- - -
I
-1- -
Case4
30
----i--1
--------------
20
'
Case5
10
0.05 0.1
(0.075)
0.01
0.5
1.0
(0.25) (0.42)
(2.0)
Grain size (mm)
____ 1 __ _
5.0
10.0
(9.52)
50.0
Fig. 4.10.1 Examples of Grain Size Distribution of Sands Used for Sand Compaction Piles
Q) The amount of ground heave accompanying sand pile driving is affected by a large number of factors, including
conditions related to the original subsoil, the replacement ratio, conditions related to execution. Therefore,
several estimation methods using statistical treatment of the existing measured data have been proposed.107), 108),
109) Shiomi and Kawamoto 107) proposed equation (4.10.1) , defining the ratio of the amount of ground heave to
the design supply of sand piles as the ground heave ratio.
=-
v,
(4.10.1)
where
a3
replacement ratio
@ Equation (4.10.1) was obtained by multiple regression analysis of 28 exan3ples of execution with 6m:sl.~Om,
adding supplementary data on six sites, including two examples of sand piles with lengths of 2lm and one
example of a length of 25.Sm. As a result of the analysis, it was found that the contribution ratio to decreases
in the order of llL, a,, q., the lowest contribution ratio being that of q., namely unconfined compressive strength
of original subsoil.
(2) Physical Properties and Strength Evaluation of Heaved Soil
Conventionally, there were many cases in which ground heave was removed. Recently, however, ground heave
has been effectively utilized as part of the foundation ground in an increasing number of cases. In such cases, it
is necessary to investigate the physical properties and strength of the heaved soil.
Where the physical properties of heaved soil due to driving of sand piles are concerned, an example 114) has
been reported in which the original subsoil was in3proved at a replacen3ent rate of70%, and the heaved soil portion
was improved so as to have a replacement ratio of 40% with 01.2m diameter of sand drain piles driven in square
arrangement of 1.7m intervals with the San3e construction equipment without compaction. Loose sand piles with
the meanN-value of3.6 had been formed in the heaved soil area, and the height of the heaved soil in the area of
improven3ent was 3-4m. Tests of this heaved soil in3mediately after sand pile driving revealed that the physical
-534-
properties such as unit weight, moisture content, and grain size composition of the heaved soil were substantially
unchanged from those of the original subsoil to a depth equivalent to the height of the heaved soil. Table 4.10.1
110) shows the results of a comparison of the unconfined compressive strength q,, of the heaved soil and qua as the
mean value of the unconfined compressive strength before improvement of the original subsoil down to a depth
equal to the height of the heaved soil. In the table, the strength ofheaved soil outside the area of improvement is
shown separately into cases within the range of 45 or 60 from the bottom end of the sand compaction piles. The
strength of the heaved soil in the improved area showed a strength decrease of approximately 50% due to driving
of the sand piles, but recovered to the original level in 1.5-3.5 months. The strength reduction of the heaved soil
outside the improved area was reportedly 30-40%, and recovery was slow, requiring 8 months after pile driving
for attain the original subsoil level.
For the final shape and physical properties of heaved soil in case of compacting in the heaved soil, the report
by Fukute et al.109) provides a useful information.
Table 4.10.1 Strength Reduction and Recovery in Heaved Soil
1101
Before construction
Immediately after
construction
1.00
1.00
1.00
0.46
0.62
0.72
0.93
0.65
In improved area
Outside improved area (45")
Outside improved area (60")
0.72
(1) Several formulae have been proposed for calculation of the shear strength of improved subsoil which is composite
ground comprising sand piles and soft cohesive soil.99) However, equation (4.10.2) is the most commonly used,
irrespective of the replacement ratio (see Fig. 4.10.2). When a8 ~ 0.7, there are many cases in which the first term
in equation (4.10.2) is ignored, and the whole area of improvement is evaluated as uniform sandy soil with 0 = 30,
disregarding equation (4.10.2).
Slip line
Sand
pile
Cohesive
soil
(4.10.2)
where
a8
c0
c 0 + kz
k
n
U
replacement ratio of sand pile = (area of one sand pile)/(effective cross-sectional area governed
by sand pile)
: undrained shear strength of original subsoil, when z = 0 (kN/m2)
: undrained shear strength of original subsoil (kN/m2)
: increase ratio in strength of original subsoil in depth direction (kN/m 3)
: stress sharing ratio ( n = LI us LI u c )
: average degree of consolidation
:
-535-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
, : stress concentration coefficient on sand pile(,= 11u, 11u,= n/{1+ (n -1) a,})
, : stress reduction coefficient of clay part(,= 11u.,I 11uz= l/{l+ (n -!) a,})
w, : unit weight of sand pile, when submerged, unit weight in water (kN/m3)
rp, : angle of shear resistance of sand pile (')
(J : angle of slip failure surface to horizontal (')
11u, : mean increment of vertical stress acting at position of object slip failure surface (kN/m2)
11u, : increment of vertical stress acting at sand pile at position of object slip failure surface (kN/m2)
Aac : increment of vertical stress acting at cohesive soil between sand piles at position of object slip
failure surface (kN/m2)
f1o I 11,, : strength increase ratio of original subsoil
0.4~a,~0.7
a,?: 0.7
n=3
n=2
n=l
'P = 30
rp, = 30-35
rp, = 35
In recent years, the number of examples in which slag and similar materials were used as materials for sand
piles has increased. Slag include materials which can be expected to have comparatively high angles of shear
resistance. When such materials are to be used, performance verification may be performed using an angle of
shear resistance close to the measured value, provided adequate caution is used in setting the stress sharing ratio.
(3) Classification of Shear Strength Formulae of Composite Ground
In the past examples of performance verification, in addition to equation (4.10.2), the following three equations are
used.llS) Equation (4.10.4) and equation (4.10.S) are those proposed as equations for shear strength of composite
ground with high replacement ratios. According to the existing survey results,9) with low replacement ratios
of a,~ 0.4, almost all examples of performance verification used equation (4.10.2), and very few examples used
equation (4.10.3). Similarly, when 0.4 ~a,~ 0.6, the majority of examples used equation (4.10.2), and examples
using equation (4.10.4) accounted for only about 1/5 of the total. When 0.6 <a,, equation (4.10.4) and equation
(4.10.5) were frequently used.
i--
T=
wmz+Auzltan.9'mcos 8
wmz+Auz i9 a9 tan.9'scos 2 8
(4.10.3)
(4.10.4)
(4.10.5)
Here, the definitions of symbols in the above equations which are different from those in equation (4.10.2) are
as follows.
: mean unit weight(wm = w,a,+w, (1- a,)
w, : unit weight of cohesive soil, when submerged, unit weight in water (kN/m3)
fl'm : mean angle of shear resistance when improved subsoil with height replacement ratio is assumed
to be uniform subsoil
'Pm =tan-I (,a, tanrp,)
Wm
4.10.5 Actions
(!) The displacement of the main body during earthquake with subsoil improved by the sand compaction pile
method tends to be reduced. When setting the seismic coefficient for verification of the main body in case
of soil improvement by the sand compaction pile method, it is possible to set a rational seismic coefficient by
appropriately evaluating this reduction effect. For the basic flow and items requiring caution when calculating the
seismic coefficient for verification, Chapter 5, 2.2.2(1) Seismic coefficient for verification used in verification
of damage due to sliding and overturning of wall body and insufficient bearing capacity of foundation
ground in variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion can be used as a reference.
-536-
The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification of gravity-type quaywalls in the case of soil
improvement by the sand compaction pile method with a replacement ratio of70% or more can be calculated using
equation (4.10.6) by multiplying the maximum value of corrected acceleration obtained for the unimproved soil by
a reduction coefficient. In calculating the maximum value of corrected acceleration for the unimproved soil, this
part, Chapter 5, 2.2.2 (1) Seismic coefficient for verification used in verification of damage due to sliding and
overturning of wall body and insufficient bearing capacity of foundation ground in variable situations in
respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion can be used as a reference. It should be noted that this reduction
coefficient was obtained based on a 2-dimensional nonlinear effective stress analysis for unimproved subsoil and
improved subsoil with a 70% replacement ratio for gravity-type quaywalls.
--0.SS
(Dr J
kh'=l.78 Da
acc+0.04
(4.10.6)
where
kh' : characteristic value of seismic coefficient for verification
ac : maximum value of corrected acceleration (cm/s2)
g : gravitational acceleration ( = 980cm/s2)
Da : allowable deformation (cm) ( = lOcm)
Dr : standard deformation (cm) ( = lOcm)
c : reduction coefficient of seismic characteristics due to improved subsoil (c = 0.75)
Q) The modified Fellenius method is frequently used in circular slip failure calculations in performance verification
of improved subsoil by the sand compaction pile method. In circular slip failure calculations by the modified
Fellenius method, the subsoil and superstructures are divided into several segments called slices, and the normal
stress on the slip surface is calculated ignoring the statically indeterminate forces acting between slices. That
is, only actions acting on the original subsoil included in a slice portion are assumed to contribute to the normal
stress on the slip surface of that slice. Hereinafter, this normal calculation method is called the "slice method".
On the other hand, in actual subsoil, loads are distributed in the ground to a certain extent. In order to reflect the
effects of this stress distribution in slip failure calculations, there is a method that the vertical stress increment
L1uz at an arbitrary point on a slip surface obtained using Boussinesq's equation applies to the modified Fellenius
method. Hereafter, this is called the "stress distribution method".
@ In the performance verification of improved subsoil by the sand compaction pile method, either the slice method
or the stress distribution method can be used. In the examination of circular slip failure, verification can be
performed using equation (4.10.7). In this equation, the subscript d denotes the design value.
(4.10.7)
where
L MD;
Case of quaywall:
qR\VL :
-537-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
w'
q
(}
In calculating the design values in the equation, Chapter 5, 2.2.3 (5) Examination of Sliding Failure of
Ground in Permanent Situation can be used as a reference for quaywalls, and Chapter 4, 3.1.4 (5) Examination
for Slip of Ground can be used for breakwaters.
The shear strength of the improved subsoil can be calculated by equations (4.10.2) to (4.10.5), depending on
the design conditions. For example, when using equation (4.10.2), the design value of the shear strength of the
improved subsoil can be calculated by the following equation. In this case, Aaz is obtained using Boussinesq's
equation.
(4.10.8)
The design values in the equation can be calculated using the following equations. The subscript k denotes
the characteristic value. For symbols, etc., equation (4.10.2) can be used as a reference.
rw, WakZ
r1an,, tanqJ3.t
tan<Osd =
For partial factors for use in the examination of circular slip failure of improved subsoil when soil improvement
is conducted by the sand compaction pile method with replacement ratios of 30% to 80%, the values shown in
Table 4.10.2 can be used as a reference 116). In this case, caution is necessary, as the partial factors for circular
slip failure shown in 3.2.1 Stability Analysis by Circular Slip Failure Surface cannot be used. In setting
the partial factors in Table 4.10.2, the case in which the slip circle surface passes through sandy subsoil deeper
than the improved subsoil is not examined. Therefore, in such cases, separate study by an appropriate method
is necessary.
-538-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
Table 4.10.2 Standard Partial Factors
(a} Permanent situation (high earthquake-resistance facilities}
Y-
Yw;
3.1
3.1
IX1
Landfill soil
1.00
0.001
1.00
0.10
0.95
0.092
1.00
0.10
0.95
0.218
1.00
0.10
0.80
0.861
1.00
0.05
1.00
--0.041
0.98
0.03
1.05
--0.041
1.02
0.03
Cohesion
Tangent of shear
resistance
1.00
0.069
1.00
0,03
1.00
0.009
1.00
0,03
Yo
Surcharge
1.35
-0.270
1.00
0.40
JIRWL
1.00
-0.022
1.00
0.05
Others
Standard reliability index PT
2.7
Y-
Yw,
Cohesion
Tangent of shear
resistance
2.7
IX1
Landfill soil
1.00
0.001
1.00
0.10
1.00
0.092
1.00
0.10
0.95
0.218
1.00
0.10
0.80
0.861
1.00
0.05
1.00
--0.041
0.98
0,03
1.00
--0.041
1.02
0.03
1.00
0.069
1.00
0,03
1.00
0.009
1.00
0.03
Yo
Surcharge
1.30
-0.270
1.00
0.40
JIRWL
1.00
-0.022
1.00
0.05
-539-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(c) Permanent situation (breakwaters)
Breakwater
Standard reliability index Pr
3.3
3.3
Cohesion
Ytan1t'
Tangent of shear
resistance
IX,
0.90
0.484
1.00
0.10
1.00
0.060
1.00
0.10
SCP t!l1l9','=0.70
0.90
0.664
1.00
0.05
1.05
-0.140
1.02
0.03
1.05
-0.140
1.02
0.03
Ywi
y,
1.00
-0.110
1.00
0.03
1.00
0.115
1.00
0.03
1.00
-0.140
0.98
0.02
Q) Calculation of consolidation
In performance verification of settlement, equation (4.10.9) can be used.
S0 <!.Sf
sf= /JS1,
sf, = m,,(po' + ar'h- p/)H(l-U)
l!.e
(4.10.9)
S, =--H(l-U)
,, l+eo
Sf, =___g,_H(log10 Po'+ p')(l-U)
1 +eo
Po'
where
Cc : compression index
h : height of embankment (m)
H : thickness of consolidation layer (m)
m,, : coefficient of volume compressibility (m2/kN)
p' : consolidation pressure (kN/m2)
p 0 ' : initial pressure (vertical pressure before construction) (kN/m2)
p/ : preconsolidation pressure (kN/m2)
S0 : allowable residual settlement (m)
U : consolidation rate
e0 : initial void ratio of original subsoil
a : coefficient of stress distribution (ratio of distributed stress in subsoil and consolidation pressure
or embankment pressure)
p : settlement reduction ratio (ratio of settlement of composite ground and settlement of unimproved
subsoil)
y' : effective unit weight of embankment (kN/m3)
lie : reduction of void ratio of original subsoil
s/O : settlement without improvement
s1 : residual settlement
with high replacement ratios and settlement reduction ratios for stress sharing ratios of n = 3, 4, and 5. From this
figure, it can be understood that the reduction of settlement due to improvement is large, this effect is influenced
by the replacement ratio, and although variations in the measured values are large, the values are close to those
calculated assuming a stress sharing ratio of approximately 4.
0.8 -
I
I
0.2 - - - -p = 1+(~-l)as
0
0.2
0.0
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
',
..
:. ','
~,
''
0.S
).
0.2
''
'
''
''
Land com1ru<lin
''
'',
-~---i...
0
..........
~
...........
_______________en_ __
c8
... ...
0
0
................ 0
'0-_
--- -- ---- -- -- -- -- --
0.1
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
Replacement rate a,
Fig. 4.10.5 Delay in Consolidation of Subsoil Improved by Sand Compaction Pile Method
-541-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
predicted values Lice (=.t1u,,Ac /LlpU) ofthe strength in unimproved subsoil. The measured values ofthe strength
increment vary, centering around stress sharing ratio n = 3-4.
(4.10.10)
where
c
Llaz
Lie /Lip
U
: stress reduction coefficient of cohesive subsoil portion (c = Llac Llaz =1 {1+{n -1 )a3 })
: mean value of vertical stress increment due to action at object depth (kN/m2)
: strength increase rate of original cohesive subsoil
: mean degree of consolidation
n=l
1.0
=d,PMzU
..d Ca : increase of cohesion based on
0.8
'<l
"'
~
0.6
11=2
-c -1-
Kasa.i-oki1
i:s
"'
'-'
~
"' 0.4
:::t..
0.2
0
- - - t- - - -t - - - t- - - -t - - -1- - -
0.0
0.1
0.2
T- -
0.3
0.4
0.5
Replacement area ratio a.
-I- -
0.6
0.7
Fig. 4.10.6 Strength Increase of Cohesive Soil between Sand Piles in Improved Subsoil
109)
In the rod compaction method, it is necessary to conduct performance verification appropriately based on the actual
records of the past execution or the result of test execution adequately considering the characteristics of the object
ground and the characteristics of the execution method.
4.11.2 Performance Verification
Because this improvement method is a method of compaction employing only vibration, its effect decreases
exponentially with distance. Accordingly, it is preferable to determine the arrangement and spacing of the vibratory
rods based on the relationship between the pitch ofthe vibratory rods obtained from the past examples or test execution
and the N-value after execution. In application to the existing sheet pile quaywalls, the spacing of the tie rods should
be considered when determining the spacing in the direction of the face line of the quaywall.
In the vibro-ftotation method, it is necessary to conduct performance verification appropriately based on the actual
records of the past execution or the result of test execution, adequately considering the characteristics of the object
ground and the characteristics ofthe execution method.
4.12.2 Performance Verification
[1] Examination using Past Results of Execution
(1) When sufficiently reliable past results such as the characteristics of the object ground, pile driving density in the
vibro-flotation method, capacity ofthe vibro-float, and correlation with the N-values ofthe ground before and after
-542-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
improvement are available, the perfurmance verification of the improvement works can be conducted based on
this.
(2) The limits of applicability of the vibro-ftotation method estimated from the examples of execution to date are
as shown in Fig. 4.12.2125). Fig. 4.12.2 is prepared based on the measured values of 11 examples of execution
using square and equilateral triangular patterns with pile spacings of 1.2-1.Sm, together with other examples of
execution, and can be used as a rough estimate of the limits of applicability of this method.
Silt
100
~
e._,
Fine sand
Coarse sand
80
.e
60
.
""
I
40
20
"'
Grain size (mm)
Fig. 4.12.2 Relationship between Grain Size of Original Subsoil and Minimum N-value after Compaction
(Case of Sandy Soil)
~
e._,
Clay
~ 100
-~
~
..
""'
E
Silt
Sand
Fine sand
Coarse sand
Gravel
Gravity
dnllnage
80
s::,r;pm
"'ell
!)l~-9<! - - - - - -
60
40
20
----------
0
0.001
0.005 0.01
0.05 0.1
0.5 1.0
-543-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) Regarding applicable soil quality, based on past records, it can be assumed that the fines content generally
comprises no more than 40% of the subsoil.
(3) In the examination of stability against circular slip failure safety side examination results should be adopted by
evaluating the improved subsoil as c material or c-1/J material.
(4) As a guideline, the improved strength for preventing liquefaction of soil with solution-type chemicals is an
unconfined compressive strength of 80-100 kN/m2. Titls improved strength is equivalent to a high liquefaction
resistance on the order of RL2o = 0.4 of cyclic shearing stress ratio in the cyclic undrained triaxial test. Here,
soil improved by solution-type chemical grout, even when its unconfined compressive strength is 100kN/m2,
is not always regarded as a material which does not liquefy due to such as its deformation characteristic under
cyclic motions. Therefore, it is necessary to specify the improved strength by calculating actions in accordance
with the performance criteria of the facilities. On the contrary, even with very low improved strength, such as
an unconfined compressive strength of the order of 16kN/m2, it has been reported that dilataney characteristics
change from loosely filled sand to dense sand, in that fluid liquefaction like that in loose sand is not observed,
and liquefaction potential is greatly improved.
4.16.2 Setting of Improvement Ratio
In principle, the improvement ratio shall be 100%, namely the entire area subject to the improvement shall be
improved. In cases where the improvement ratio is to be reduced, a careful examination should be made, for example,
by confirming that settlement and deformation which are detrimental to facilities will not occur by conducting model
tests, etc.
(2) In the pneumatic flow mixing method, stabilizer is added to the soil being improved, for example, dredged soil,
during pneumatic transportation. The object soil and stabilizer are mixed using the turbulence effi:ct of the plug
flow generated in the transport pipe, and the mixture is then placed at the designated location. For the principle
and features of this execution method, Manual on Pneumatic Flow Mixing Technology 135), 136) can be used as
a reference.
-544-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
-545-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
={(Lrr\)oos(!"-P) +w}
P
"'
COS\lf
sin((j-~+9)oos(!lf-(1)
Ci cos(!"-P)cosfli
A1 =
sin(o + p+o)
B1 = sin('!'+9';
(4.18.1)
'
('
~~~--+w
2cosrp
c =sin('!'H+o-P)sinO+sin(!"-9' +O)sin(o+P)
2c cos(!"-P)cos!llsin(o + P)cosO
(Lrh )cos(rp-P)
=~-~-+w
2cOSlf'
where
Pa;
c;
'I';
'I;
h;
'I'
p
o
Ci
ro
()
k
k'
active earth pressure intensity acting on wall by the i-th layer (kN/m2)
cohesion of soil in the i-th layer (k:N/m2)
angle of shear resistance in the i-th layer ()
unit weight of the i-th layer (k:N/m3)
thickness ofthe i-th layer (m)
angle of wall to the vertical (0 )
angle of ground surface to the horizontal ( 0 )
angle of wall friction (0 )
angle of failure surface of the i-th layer to the horizontal{)
surcharge per unit area of ground surface (k:N/m2)
resultant seismic angle (0 )8=tan-lk or O=tan-lk'
seismic coefficient
apparent seismic coefficient
(4) Equation (4.18.1) is an extension of Okabe's equation.142) This extension lacks such rigorousness that Okabe
solved the equilibrium of forces. However, when the soil is exclusively granular material with no cohesion or
exclusively cohesive material with no angle of shear resistance rp, it is consistent with the equations in Part II,
Chapter 5, 1 Earth Pressure.
-546-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
(5) The earth pressure and the angle of failure surface should be calculated separately at each soil layer with different
soil properties, while the earth pressure distribution and the failure line inside each layer are treated as linear.
Actually within a soil layer, the earth pressure and the failure line sometimes become curved when calculated for
divided sublayers. This contradicts the original assumption in Okabe's equation that is based on a linear slip on
the premise of Coulomb's earth pressure.
(6) When using the equations above, the existence of cracks sometimes has to be considered in accordance with the
characteristics of the geotechnical materials used.
[4] Cases where Improvement Width is Limited
When the area treated with solidified geotechnical materials is limited and Mononobe-Okabe's equation cannot be
applied simply, the earth pressure is evaluated by a suitable method that allows the influence of the treated area to be
assessed. When the treated area is limited, the earth pressure can be evaluated by the slice method143).
Q) With the slice method, three modes of failure are examined (see Fig. 4.18.2).
@ The earth pressure distribution is calculated by assuming that the difference between the resultant earth pressures
at adjacent depths is the earth pressure intensity for the corresponding depth
Mode 1: when a uniform slip surface is formed in the whole backfill (shear resistance mode)
Mode 2: when a cracks down to the bottom of the solidified soil layer is developed (crack failure mode)
Mode 3: when a slip surface is formed along the edge line of the solidified range (friction resistance mode)
Note: Among Mode 1, the case in which the slip surface does not pass the solidified body is categorized as Mode 0.
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
-547-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
14) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: The Deep Mixing Method-Principia, Design aod Constructioo, A.A Balkema
Publishers, pp.123, 2002
15) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Technical Manual of deep mixing method for marine works, 1999
16) Public Works Research Center: Design aod coostruction maoual of deep mixing method on laod, 2004
17) Tsuchida, T., T. Sato, S. Kou, K. Minosaku aod K. Sakai: Field placing test of lightweight treated soil at 10 m seawater depth
in Kumamoto Port, Technical Note of PAR! No.1007, 2001
18) Tsuchida, T., H. Fujisak~ M. Makibuchi, H. Shinsha, Y. Nagasaka and K. Hikosaka: Use oflight-weight treated soils of waste
soil in airport extension project, Jour. JSCE No.644NI-46, pp.13-23, 2000
19) Coastal Developmeot Institute of Technology (CDI1): Technical Manual for pneumatic flow mixing method, ,2001
20) Sato, T.: Development and Application of Pneumatic Flow Mixing Method to Reclamation for Offshore Airport, Technical
Note of PHRI No. 1076,p.81, 2004
21) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDI1): Handbook for countermeasure works for reclaimed land, pp.170-194,
1997
22) Yamamoto, M. and M. Nozu: Quiet compaction of sandy round- No vibration and low noise static compaction method for
sand pile, Journal of JSCE, Vol. 83, pp.19-21, 1998
23) Kakehashi T. et al.: Introduction of"KS-EGG Method": Low vibration aod[ low noise soil improvement method, Proceedings
of 52nd Conference of JSCE, Section III, pp.151-152, 2002
24) Kato, S., Y. Kato, H. Ichikawa and N. Mishiro: "Geo-KONG Method"; Low vibration and low noise ground compaction
method, Fouodatino Works, ,pp38-4 l,Dec., 2003
25) Soft ground handbook editing committee: New soft ground Handbook for Civil and architectural engineers, Part I, Chapter
9, pp387-390,1984
26) lshiguro, K. and H. Shimizu: Examination of better couotermeasure for liquefaction, Journal ofJSCE, VoL83,pp,17-19,1998
27) Brown, R. E.: Vibroflotation compaction of cohesionless soils, Proc. ASCE, GT-12, pp.1437-1451,1987
28) Narumi, N., A Nomura and M. Ikeda: Improvement of solid waste ground by heavy tamping method, Soil and Foundation,
Society of Soil Mechanics and Engineering Science, ,pp.49-52,June, 1992
29) Suzuk~ Y., S. Saitou, S. Onimaru, H. Kimura, A. Uchida and R. Okumura: Countermeasure work for liquefactioo by grid
soil improvement by deep mixing method, Soil and Fouodation, pp.46-48,1996
30) Society of Soil Mechanics and Engineering Science: Survey, design and construction of Chemical Grouting Method, ,1985
31) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Manual for osmotic solidification method, 2003
32) Public Works Research Institute, Ministry of Construction: Design and Construction Manual for countermeasure work for
liquefactino (draft), pp.364-374,1999
33) Japan Geotechnical Society: Countermeasure works for liquefaction, Geotechnical Engineering, Practical Business Series,
pp.326-335,2004
34) Zen K.: Development of Premixing-type stabilization method as countermeasure for liquefaction, Soil and Fouodation,
VoL38,No,6,pp.27-32,1990
35) Public Works Research Center: Design aod coostruction Maoual for Reinforces Soil "Terre Armee" wall method, 1990
36) Matsuo, 0., S. Yasuda, K. Harada, K. lshiguro and R. Uzuoka: Examination of improvement soil uoder Level-ooe earthquake,
Proceedings of 32nd Conference on Geotechnical Engineering, pp.1065-1066,1997
33) Japan Geotechnical Society: Countermeasure works for liquefaction, Geotechnical Engineering,, p.241, 2004
37) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDin: Handbook for countermeasure works for reclaimed land (Revised
Edition), pp, 230-238,1997
38) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDI1): Handbook for countermeasure works for reclaimed land (Revised
Edition), pp.285-294,1997
39) Society of Soil Mechanics and Engineering Science: Countermeasure works for soft ground- Survey, design and coostructionPart II, Chapter 10, pp.317-321,1990
40) Japao Geotechnical Society: Haodbook of Geotechnical Engineering, Part 4, Chapter 8, 1999
41) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDI1): Handbook for countermeasure works for reclaimed land (Revised
Edition), pp.114-136,1997
42) Japan Geotechnical Society: Handbook ofGeotechnical Engineering, Part 4, Chapter 8, pp.1197-1262, 1999
43) Ichikawa, N.: Soil improvement- Packed drain method-, Fouodation works, pp.91-101, May, 1978
44) Matsuo, M., J. Tsukada, Y. Kanaya and H. Shono: Trial construction of soil improvement for the fouodation works ofYokkaichi LNG Base, Journal of JSCE, PP.9-15,1984
45) Katayama, T, A. Yahiro, M. Kitazume and Nakadono: Analysis and experimental study on fabri-packed sand-drains' stability
in Tokyo International Airport extension Project, Jour. JSCE No,486 IV-22, pp.19-25, 1994
46) K. Terzaghi and P. B. Peck : Soil Mechanics (Fuodamentals), Maruzen Publishing,, 1968 (Terzag~ K. aod P. B. Peck : Soil
Mechanics in Engineering Practice, New York John Wiley aod Sons Inc., 1948)
47) Aboshi, H. and Yoshikuoi, H.: A study on the consolidation process affected by well resistance in the vertical drain method,
Soils and Fouodations, Vol. 7 No,4, pp.38-58, 1967
48) Kamon, M.: Quality and characteristics of Plastic drain materials, Fouodation Works, Vol. 13 No.8, pp.11-16, 1985
49) Yoshikuni, H.: Design aod construction supervision of vertical drain method, Chapter 3, Giho-do Publishing, 1979
-548-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
50) Japan Institute of Construction Engineering: Construction Technology
51) Nakashe, A.: Design diagram fur sand drain, Soil and Foundation, Vol.12 No. 6, pp. 35-38, 1%4
52) Amihoshi, H., Z. Koba, T. Inoue, M. Niki and H. Murase: Change of consolidation coefficient due to the construction of sand
drain, Proceedings of 19th Conference on Soil Mechanics, pp. 1573-1574,1984
53) Kamon, M.: Soil Improvement by plastic drain, Soil Improvement 8, Sogo-Doboku Kenkyu-jo ,pp.. 34-41, 1991
54) Tanaka, H., K. Oota and T. Maruyama: Perfunnance of Vertical Drains for Soft and Ununifunn Soils, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 30
No.2, pp,211-227, 1991
55) Onoue, A.: Consolidation of multi-layered anisotropic soils by vertical drains with well resistance. Soils and Foundations 28,
No.3, pp.75-90,Japanese Soc. SMFE., 1988
56) Kobayashi, M., J. Minakami and T. Tsuchida: Determination of the Horizontal Coefficient of Consolidation cohesive soil,
Rept. of PHRI Vol.29 No,2, pp.63-83, 1990
57) Katayama, T.: Katayama, T.: Study on Composite vertical drain for airport construction on soft ground. Kyu-shu Univ.
Dissertation, 1993
58) Mikasa, M.: Consolidation of soft clay, Kajima Publishing, 1%3
59) Kobayash~ M: Numerical Analysis of One-Dimensional Consolidation Problems, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 21 No.I, pp.57-79,
1982
60) Terashi, M., H. Tanaka, T. Mitumoto, Y. Niidome and J. Honma: Fundamental Properties of Lime- and Cement-Treated Soils
(2nd Report), Rept. ofPHRI Vol.19 No,!, pp.33-62, 1980
61) Coastal Developmentlnstitute of Technology: Technical Manual of deep mixing method for marine construction work, 2008,
2003
62) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Manual fur FGC deep mixing method- soft soil improvement
method utilizing fly ash I, 2004
63) Babasaki, R., M. Terashi, T. Suz~ J. Maekawa, M. Kawamura and E. Fukazawa: Influence factors on the strength of
stabilized soil, Japan Geotechnical Society, Proceedings of Symposium on Cement-Treated Soils, pp.20-41,1996
64) Terashi, M. and H. Fuseya: Practice of deep ground Improvement and problems 10, Practice and problems of deep mixing
method- Outline of deep mixing-, Soil and Foundation, Vol. 31 No.6, pp.57-64, 1983
65) Japan Geotechnical Society : Method of soil tests and commentary (First revised Edition), pp.308-316,2000
66) Nose, S., N. Taguchi and M. Terashi: Practice of deep ground Improvement and problems 11, Practice and problems of deep
mixing method- Examples of deep mixing method-, Soil and Foundation, Vol. 31 No.7, pp.73-80, 1983
67) Public Works Research Center: Design and construction manual of deep mixing method on land (Revised Edition), p.39,
2003
68) Terashi, M., M. Kitazume and T. Nakamura: External Forces Acting on a Stiff Soil Mass Improved by DMM, Rcpt. of PHRI
Vol. 27 No. 2, pp.147-184, 1988
69) Kitazume, M: .Model and Analytical Studies on Stability of improved ground by Deep Mixing Method, Technical Note of
PHRI No.774,p.73, 1994
70) Terashi, M. and M. Kitazume: Interference Effect on Bearing Capacity of Foundations on Sand, Rept. of PHRI Vol.26 No,2,
pp. 413-432, 1987
71) Yerash~ M., H. Tanaka and M. Kitazume: Dislodging failure ofwall-type improved soil by deep mixing method, Proceedings
of 18th Conference on Soil Mechanics, pp.1553-1556, 1983
72) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDI1): Technical Manual of light weight treated soil method fur ports and
airports, 1999
73) Tsuchida, T., H. Yokoyama, J. Minakam~ K. Shimizu and J. Kasai: Field Test of Light-Weight Geomaterials fur Harbor
Structures, Technical Note of PHRI No. 833, 1996
74) Tsuchida, T.: Research and development of light weight treated soil method in coastal areas and examples of practice,
Proceedings of Annual Meeting of PHRI, 1998
75) Tsuchida, T., J. Kas~ J. Minakami, Y. Yokoyama and K. Tsuchida: Effect of Curing Condition on Mechanical Properties of
Light-Weight Soils, Technical Note of PHRI No .834, 1996
76) Tsuchida, T., K. Nag~ M. Yukawa, T. Kishida and M. Yamamoto: Properties of Light-Weight Soil Used fur Backfill of Pier
Technical Note of PHRI No.835,19%
77) TANG, Y., T. TSUCHIDA, D. TAKEUCHI, M. KAGAMIDA and N. Nishida: Mechanical Properties of Light Weight Cement
Treated Soil Using Triaxial Apparatus NISHIDA No.845 1996.9
78) TSUCHIDA, T., Haruo FUZISAKI Hiroaki NAKAMURA Masaharu MAKIBUCHI Hiroshi SHINSHIA Yuji NAGASAKA
and Yasuo HIKOSAKA: Use of Light-Weight Treated Soils Made of Waste Soil in Airport Extension Project, Technical Note
of PHRI No.923,1999
79) TSUCHIDA, T., Yoshiaki KIKUCHI, Tetsuo FUKUHARA, Takeo WAKO and Kazuhiro YAMAMURA: Slice Method fur
Earth Pressure Analysis and its Application to Light-Weight Fill, Technical Note of PHRI No. 924, 1999
80) TSUCHIDA, T., Tatsuo WAKO, Yosiaki KIKUCHI, Toshio AZUMA and Hiroshi SHINSYA: Fluidity and Material Properties
of Light-Weight Treated Soil Casted Underwater, Technical Note of PHRI No. 865, 1997
81) TSUCHIDA, T., Tatsuo WAKO, Hiroshi MATSUHITA and Masahiro YOSHIWARA: Evaluation of Washout Resistance of
Light-weight Treated Soil Casted Underwater, Technical Note of PHRI No.884, 1997
-549-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
82) Wako, T., T. Tsuchida, Y. Matsunaga, K. Hamamoto, T. Kishida and T. Fukasawa: Use of artificial light weight materials
(Treated soil with air furm)fur port facilities, Jour. JSCE No,602 VI-40, pp.35-52,1998
83) Kikuchi Y., M. Ikegami aod H. Yamazaki: Field investigation on the solidification of graoulated blast furnace slag used fur
backfill of quay wati Jour. OfJSCE No.799/111-72, pp.171-182, 2005
84) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Haodbook of utilization of granulated blast furnace slag fur port construction
work, p.71, 1989
85) Kikuchi, Y. and K. Takahashi: Change of Mechanical Characteristics of the Graoulated Blast Furnace Slag according to
Age,, Technical Note of PHRI No.915, p.26, 1998
86) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Maoual for premixing-type stabilization method, 1999
87) Yamazaki, H., Y. Morikawa and F. Koike: Study on effect on fines content and drainage characteristics of sandy deposit on
sand compaction pile method, Jour. Of JSCE No.722/111-61, pp.303-314, 2002
88) Yamazaki H., Y. Morikawa aod F. Koike: Study on effect of KO-value prediction after densification by sand compaction pile
method, Jour of JSCE No.750ffil-65, pp.231-236, 2003
89) Japan Geotechnical Society: Countermeasure works for liquefaction, Geotechnical Engineering, Practical Business Series,
,pp.233-242, 2004
90) Mizuno, T., N. Suematsu and K. Okuyama: Design method of sand compaction pile in saody ground containing fine fraction
and evaluation of improvement effect, Soil and Foundation VoL35,No5,pp.21-26,1987
91) lshimaru, M. 0. Miura: Coefficient of lateral subgrade reaction of improved soils by SCP, Public Relation Magazine of
Survey and Design Office, Vol. 10 No,!, Third Port Construction Bureau, Kobe Survey aod Design Office, pp.55-64,1983
92) KITAZUME, M. and Kiyoharu MURAKAMI : Behaviour of Sheet Pile Walls in the Improved Ground by Sand Compaction
Piles of Low Replacement Area Ratio, Rept. ofPHRI Vol. 32 No. 2, pp. 183-211, 1993
93) KITAZUME, M., Hidenori TAKAHASHI and Shinji TAKEMURA: Experimental aod Aualytical Studies on Horizontal
Resistaoce of Saod Compaction Pile Improved Ground, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 42 No. 2, pp. 47-71, 2003
94) Japan Geotechnical Society: Estimation of effectiveness of soil improvement and practice, 2000
95) Sugiyama, H., S. Iai, 0. Kotsutsumi and H. Mori: Analysis of effective stress of gravity-type wharf on a clayey ground
improved by SCP during ao earthquake- (First Rept; Modeling of high replacement rate SCP improved soil.), Proceedings of
35th Conference on Geotechnical Engineering, ,pp.2055-2056, 2000
96) Sato, A., N. Yoshida, N. Iida, H. Tange, S. Tange, S. Iai and H. Mori: Analysis of effective stress of gravity-type wharf on
a clayey ground improved by SCP during an earthquake- (Second Rept; Case Study), Proceedings of 35th Conference on
Geotechnical Engineering, ,,pp.2057-2058, 2000
97) KITAZUME, M., Takahiro SUGANO, Yohsuke KAWAMATA, Naoto NISHIDA, Kazuhiro ISHIMARU aod Yoshinori
NAKAYAMA: Centrifuge Model Tests on Dynamic Properties of Sand Compaction Pile Improved Ground, Technical Note
98)
of PARI No.1029,2002
SUGANO, T., Masaki KITAZUME, Yoshinori NAKAYAMA, Yosuke KAWAMATA, Jun OBAYASHI, Naoto NISHIDA
and Kazuhiro ISHIMARU: A Study on Dynamic Properties of Saod Compaction Pile Improved Ground, Technical Note of
PARI No.1047,p.32,2003
99) Sogabe, T.: Technical problems of Design and construction of sand compaction pile method, Proceedings of 33rd annual
100)
IOI)
102)
103)
104)
105) Minami, K., H. Matsui, E. Naruse and M. Kitazume: Field test on sand compaction pile method with copper slag sand, lour.
JSCE No.574NI-36, pp,49-55, 1997
106) Hashidate, Y., S. Fukuda, T. Okumura and M. Kobayashi: Engineering characteristics of saod containing oyster shells aod
utilization for sand compaction piles, Proceedings of the 29th Conference of Soil Mechanics, pp.717-720,,1994
107) Shiomi, M. aod K. Kawamoto: Estimation of rise of ground due to SPC driving, Proceedings of the 21st Conference of Soil
Mechanics, Proceedings of the 29th Conference of Soil Mechanics, pp. 1861-1862, 1986
108) Hirao, S., H. Tsubo~ M. Matsuo and H. Taga: Profile furecast of emergence of sea bed ground due to compaction of sand piles,
Proceedings of the 8th Symposium on Geotechnical Engineering, pp.55-60, 1996
109) Fukude, T., Y. Higuchi, M. Furuichi andH. Tsuboi: Profile forecast of emergence of sea bed due to large scale sand compaction
piles, Proceedings of the 33rd Symposium on Soil Mechanaics,1988
110) Ichimoto, E.: Practical design of sand compaction pile method and examples of construction, Proceedings ofAnnual Technical
Confurence, pp.51-55, 1981
111) Ichimoto, E. and N. Suematsu: Practice of sand compaction pile method and problems, Soil and Foundation, Vol.31 No.5,
pp.83-90, 1983
112) Matsuo, M., M. Kimura, R. Nishio and H. Andou: Matsuo, M., M. Kimura, R. Nishio and Y. Ando: Study on development of
soil improvement method using construction waste soii Jour. JSCE No. 547/111-37, pp.199-209,1996
113) Nozu, M. and A. Suzuki: Effect of saod compaction piles on the consolidation of surrounding clayey ground aod its
-550-
PART Ill FACIUTIES, CHAPTER 2 ITEMS COMMON TO FACIUTIES SUBJECT TO TECHNICAL STANDARDS
utilization, Symposium on Recent Research and Practice on Clayey Ground- from observation of microscopic structure to
countermeasure technology fur extremely soft reclaimed laod-, pp. 327-323, 2002
114) Hirao, H. and M. Matsudo: Study on characteristics of upheaval part of cohesive ground caused by soil improvement, Jour.
JSCE Vol. 3761Ill-6, pp.277-285, 1986
115) KANDA, K. Masaaki TERASHI: Practical Formula fur the Composite Ground Improved by Sand Compaction Pile Method,
Technical Note of PHRI No. 669, pp.1-52, 1990
116) Nagao, T., M. Nozu Y. Imai: Application of reliability design method to circular slip failure of port facilities on sand
compaction piles, Proceedings of Offshore Development JSCE, Vol. 22, pp.727-732, 1996
117) lchimoto, E. and N. Suematsu: Practice of saod compaction pile method and problems,- Summary-, Soil and Foundation,
Vol.31 No.5, pp.83-90, 1983
118) Society of Soil Mechanics and Engineering Science: Countermeasure works for soft ground- Survey, design and constructionPartll, Chapter 3, pp.119-152,1988
119) Tanaka, Y., A. et al. : Case study on the behavior of improved ground by T-type SCP, Journal of Geotechnical Engineering,
2006
120) Tanaka, Y., A. et al.: Applicability ofT-type SCP method to soft ground, Journal ofGeotechnical Engineering, 2006
121) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Haodbook of Countermeasure against Liquefaction of Reclaimed
Laod (Revised Edition), CDIT, pp.137-255,1997
122) lshiguro, T., T. Iijima, H. Shimizu and S. Shimada: Investigation about the vibration compaction work of saturated sand
layers with elimination of excess pore-water pressure, Jour. JSCE No.505/111-29, pp.105-114, 1994
123) Japan Geotechnical Society: Countermeasure works fur liquefaction, Geotechnical Engineering, Chapter 4, 2004
124) Brown, R.E.: Vibroflotation compaction of cohesionless soils, Proc.A.S.C.E, GT12, pp.1437-1451, 1977
125) Watanabe, T.: Study ofvibro-floatation method, Publication Division, Kajima Technical Research Institute, pp.87,1962
126) Industrial Technology Service Center: Handbook of practical Technology fur countermeasure works of soft ground fur
construction engineers, Part 3, Chapter 8, pp.726-732,1993
127) K.ishida, T.: On soil improvement work of Nagoya Second Factory of Nisshin Flour Co. (Liquefaction-prevention works by
earthquake proof gravel compaction method), Proceedings of the 29th National conference on port construction, Japan Port
association, pp,82-94,1983
128) Coastal Development Institute of Technology (CDIT): Haodbook of Countermeasure against Liquefaction of Reclaimed
Laod (Revised Edition), CDIT, pp.170-194, 1997
129) Industrial Technology Service Center: Handbook of practical Technology for countermeasure works of soft ground fur
construction engineers, Part 3, Chapter 6, pp.676-689,1993
130) Japan Geotechnical Society: Geotechnical Engineering Handbook, Japan Geotechnical Society, 1999
131) Industrial Technology Service Center: Handbook of practical Technology for countermeasure works of soft ground for
construction engineers, Part 3, Chapter I, pp.619-6311993
132) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Manual fur osmotic solidification method, 2003
133) Japan Geotechnical Society: Countermeasure works fur liquefaction, Geotechnical Engineering, Practical Business Series,
pp.326-335,2004
134) Public work Research Institute, Ministry of Construction: Design and construction manual for liquefaction prevention works
(Draft), pp.364-374,1999
135) Chu-bu International Airport Survey Office, The Fifth Port Construction Bureau : Pneumatic !low mixing method, 1999
136) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Coastal Development Technology Library No. 11, Technical Manual for
pneumatic flow mixing method, pp.127, 2001
137) SATO, T.: Development aod Application of Pneumatic Flow Mixing Method to Reclamation for Offshore Airport, Technical
Note of PAR! No.1076, p.81, 2004.
138) Taguchi, H., Yamane, N., Hashimoto, F. and Sakamoto, A.: Strength characteristics of stabilized ground by plug-tiow mixing
method, IS-YOKOHAMA, 2000.
139) Shinsya, H., S. Ikeda and A. Matsumoto: Aeration-blow-type Pneumatic flow mixing method that makes large scale
solidification of dredged soil possible- Pipe mixing method-, Proceedings of 26th Kanto-district Conference, 2000
140) Yagyu, T. aod H. Ogawa: Development of Pneumatic flow mixing method for dredged soil-snake mixer method-, Annual
Rept. of Port Technology Exchange Society, 1999
141) Yamada, H., Y. Takaba aod S. Takanashi: Development of early-stage recycling technology of dredged soil by Tank and Plug
mixing method (T & P Method), Symposium of construction equipment and construction method, 1999
142) Okabe, S.: General Theory on Earth Pressure and Seismic Stability of Retaining Wall and Dam, Journal of JSCE, Vol. 10,
No.6, pp.1277-1323, 1924
143) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Manual of light weight treated soil method fur ports and airports,
1999
-551-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Ministerial Ordinance
General Provisions
Article 8
1 Waterways and basins shall be provided in appropriate locations in light of geotechnical characteristics,
meteorological characteristics, sea states and other environmental conditions, as well as ship navigation
and other usage conditions of the water area around the facilities concerned.
2 In the waterways and basins where it is necessary to maintain the calmness of the water area, measures
shall be taken to mitigate the impact of waves, water currents, winds, and/or other actions.
3 In waterways and basins in which there is risk of siltation by sediments, measures shall be taken to prevent
the occurrence thereof.
Ministerial Ordinance
Necessary Items concerning Waterways and Basins
Article 12
The necessary matters for the enforcement of the performance requirements for waterways and basins
as specified in this chapter by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism and other
requirements shall be provided by the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Waterways and Basins
Article29
The items to be specified by the Public Notices under Article 12 of the Ministerial Ordinance concerning
with the performance requirements of waterways and basins shall be as provided in the subsequent article
through Article 32.
[Technical Note]
(1) In selecting the locations for basins exclusively used by dangerous cargo ships, the following should be
considered:
(a) To minimize an encounter with general ships, especially passenger ships.
(b) To isolate them from the facilities of which surrounding environment should be protected, such as
housing areas, schools and hospitals.
(c) To be capable of encountering against accidents including hazardous goods spill.
(2) From the viewpoint of safety and efficiency in navigation and cargo handling, it is preferable to separate
the basins for passenger ships, ferries, and fishing boats and small craft basins from those for other types
of ships.
(3) In principle, it is preferable to separate timber handling facilities as a specialized terminal from other
general facilities.
-552-
2 Waterways
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Waterways
Article 9
The perfurmance requirements for waterways shall be such that the requirements specified by the Minister
of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied in light of geotechnical characteristics, waves,
water currents, and wind conditions along with the usage conditions of the surrounding water areas, for
securing the safe and smooth use by ships.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Waterways
Article JO
The performance criteria of waterways shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The waterways shall have an appropriate width that is equal to or greater than the length of the design
ship in waterways where there is a possibility of ships passing each other and equal to or greater than
one-half of the length of the design ship in waterways where there is no possibility of passing each
other, in light of the length and width of the design ship, the traffic volume of ships, the conditions of
geotechnical characteristics, waves, water currents, and winds, as well as the usage conditions of the
surrounding water areas. Provided, however, that where the mode of navigation is special, the width of
the waterway can be reduced to the width that shall not hinder the safe navigation of ships.
(2) The waterways shall have an appropriate depth that is greater than the draft of the design ship in
consideration of the trim and the degree of ship motions of the design ship due to waves, water currents,
winds, and others.
(3) The alignment of waterways shall be such that the safe ship navigation is not hindered, in light of
the geotechnical conditions, waves, water currents, and winds as well as the usage conditions of the
surrounding water areas.
(4) In waterways where ship navigation is remarkably congested, waterways shall be provided with the
lanes separated by the direction of movement or by the size of ships.
[Technical Note]
2.1 General
(!) Concept of Waterways
Waterways are considered to be a water area whose existence is clearly identified to navigators by buoys or other
means in order to contribute to safe and smooth ship navigation subject to entrance channels and passage channels
in shallow water area.
(3) In performance verification of waterways, the methods described in 2.2 Depth of Navigation Channel to 2.4
Alignment of Navigation Channel (Bends) which are proposed by Japan Institute of Navigation Standard
Committee and National Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management Port and Harbour Department I), 2)
can be used.
(4) Performance Criteria of Waterways
CD
(a) Case where the design ship and navigation environment cannot be designated
In performance verification of waterways in cases where the design ship and navigation environment cannot
be designated, the following values can be used as an appropriate depth which is greater than the maximum
draft of the design ship.
-553-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
In waterways in harbors, where the effects of waves such as swells are not expected, 1.10 times the
maximum draft.
In waterways outside of harbors, where the effects of waves such as swells are expected, 1.15 times the
maximum draft.
In waterways in the open sea, where the effects of waves such strong swells are expected, 1.20 times the
maximum draft.
(b) Case where the design ship and navigation environment can be designated
In setting the water depth of waterways in performance verification of waterways in cases where the design
ship and navigation environment can be designated, appropriate consideration shall be given to the maximum
draft of the design ship, ship squatting due to ship waves or swells, and keel clearance.
(c) Case of special methods of navigation
In setting the water depth in performance verification of waterways for entry/egress at drydocks and
waterways for use in special methods of navigation such as routes where half-loaded operation (unloading at
more than one port) is normal, notwithstanding the items mentioned in (a) and (b), the water depth shall be set
appropriately, considering the anticipated condition of use of the objective waterway.
-554-
and the radius of curvature of the centerline of the waterway at the bend shall be set to roughly fuurtimes
the length between perpendiculars of the design ship or greater.
2) Case where the design ship and navigation environment such as rudder angle can be designated
In performance verification of waterways in cases where the angle of intersection of the centerlines of the
waterway at a bend exceeds 30' and the design ship and the fuatures of the navigation environment such as
the rudder angle can be designated, the comer cut at the inner side ofthe bend shall be set appropriately, and
the radius of curvature of the centerline of the waterway at the bend shall be set appropriately, considering
the maneuverability index of turning, which shows the turning performance of the design sbip.
(c) As the shape of widened parts of width of navigation channels at bends, curved shapes other than comer cuts
can be used, considered installation of buoys.
-555-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
D2
D,
D4
;.
Lpp
TR
TE
At the actual design stage and the actual operation, the following elements should be taken into consideration.
CD
@ Tide : Generally, tide height is above the chart datum during navigation, this tide height is considered as
additional depth of water in actual operation.
@ Accuracy of depth of water : the err of depth of chart gives some risk for navigation, but usually the dredged
bottom is deeper than planned bottom. This additional dredging that is confirmed by sufficient sounding survey
can be considered as the additional depth of water in actual operation.
@ Others : Air pressure, bottom nature, obstruction in water, density of seawater and etc. should be taken into
consideration if necessary.
(a) Calculation of D 1
D 1 is calculated as follow.')
2
a) ( c. ) -+15-
u
a ( c. )' u
DI= 0.75+1.5- .
Lpp/B
where
d
D
B
c.
u
g
-556-
Lpp/B
(2.2.3)
50%value
Standard deviation
Cargo vessels
0.804
0.0712
Container ships
0.668
0.0472
Tankers
0.824
0.0381
0.667
0.0939
0.594
0.0665
LPG ships
0.737
0.0620
LNG ships
0.716
0.0399
Passenger ships
0.548
0.0452
0.516
0.0295
(b) Calculation of D 2
Maximum of D2 (Bow sink due to heaving and pitching motion) and maximum of D 3 (Bilge keel sink due to
heaving and rolling motion) do not occur at the same time. Therefore large value of D2 or D 3 shall he adopted.
D 2 in case of ).>0.45Lpp can be calculated by the value of D 2 /h 0 taken from Fig. 2.2.1)
F.=<l.l
C.=Q.70
"'..,
~
]
-~
30
-~
l!
'$
!
0
0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
fL;;i;:Note: This figure shows only the case of Cb =0.7and F11=0.l. but covers the case of deep sea where ship motion is bigger than one in shallow
water. Therefore this figure can apply to all cases regardless of Cb and F,..
(2.2.4)
-557-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where
(J = y
y =7
= 360 (0.35H113 fl ) sin
=
=
O.SB I (GM)OS
.V(.! I TW + Ucos.pj
(2.2.5)
(~
u
Ip
Ui:os'I'
(""'ilj
It is appropriate that GM is nearly equal to B/25. However, GM can be calculated by the following equation
because real value of GM varies depending on ship condition.
GM=a(B/25)
where
GM
TW
H113
B
(J
rp
(2.2.6)
(d) Calculation of D 4
D 4 is allowance of depth for sink of ship by large rudder angle to alter her course and can be calculated by the
following equation.
D4 =0.5m ~lOm
D4=0.05d d>lOm
(2.2.7)
<;; D (=d+D1+Max(D,,D3)+D4)
-558-
(2.2.9)
-559-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(1) As the necessary width for Class 1 navigation channels, the following values can generally be used.I), 2)
CD
In waterways where two-way navigation is not expected, an appropriate width of 0.5L00 or more can generally
be used. However, when the width is less than 1.0Loa> it is preferable to take adequate safety measures, such as
provision of facilities to support navigation.
@ In waterways where two-way navigation is expected, an appropriate width of 1.0L00 or more can generally be
used. Provided, however, that;
(a) when the length of the waterway is comparatively long
(b) when design ships frequently pass during navigation ofthe waterway: W=l.5L 00
(2.3.1)
(c) when design ships frequently pass during navigation of the navigation
W=2.0Laa
channel and the length of the waterway is comparatively long
where
W : width of navigation channel (m)
L 00 : length overall of design ship (m)
t), 2)
In the verification for class 2, the well-established calculations of the ship maneuvering motion 3), 4) are fully utilized,
with which versatile performance predictions can be made with sufficient accuracy. From a view point ofthe practical
use at the concept design phase, simple linear calculations and estimate equations are provided, which are derived
from the fully nonlinear motion equations. Furthermore, for the following typical 15 ships covering a wide range of
ship types and sizes, computations with respect to the width for the wind forces and the interaction forces are made
and summarized in the following tables. The 15 ships are selected as the ship types, principal particulars of which
are given in Table 2.3.1 together with hydrodynamic derivatives. Making use of these computations together with the
above simple linear calculations and estimate equations, the determination of width of navigation channel (estimations
ofthe width elements) can practically and easily be made without computers.
Table 2.3.1 Principal Particulars etc. ofType Ships
Ship Type
1
Cargo Ship
GT/GWT
5,000
GT
499
Loo(m)
L,,.,(m)
B(m)
do(m)
Cb(rri)
Y'v
N'v
Y'J
N'J
109.0
103.0
20.0
7.0
0.7402
-1.688
-0.590
-0.0723
0.0362
0.0441
GT
63.8
60.4
11.2
4.2
0.5395
-1.653
-0.597
-0.0881
77,900DWT
299.9
283.8
40.0
14.0
0.6472
-1.340
-0.457
-0.0720 0.0360
-0.0781
59,500DWT
288.3
273.0
32.2
13.3
0.6665
-1.312
-0.449
172,900DWT
289.0
279.0
45.0
17.8
0.8042
-1.612
74,000DWT
225.0
216.0
32.3
13.5
0.8383
-1.587
-0.553
10,000DWT
125.0
119.2
21.5
6.9
0.8057
-1.551
-0.519
-0.0773
280,000DWT
333.0
316.0
60.0
20.4
0.7941
-1.658
-0.564
-0.0880 0.0440
Container (Panamax)
5
6
7
8
VLCC
Small Tanker
0.0391
-0.0696 0.0348
0.0387
6,000DWT
100.6
92.0
20.0
7.0
0.7968
-1.835
-0.640
-0.0811
0.0406
21,500DWT
199.9
190.0
32.2
10.1
0.6153
-1.417
-0.484
-0.0731
0.0365
18,000DWT
190.0
180.0
32.2
8.2
0.5470
-1.287
-0.427
-0.0753
0.0376
12 LNG Ship
69,500DWT
283.0
270.0
44.8
10.8
0.7000
-1.213
-0.382
-0.0762
0.0381
10,000
GT
152.0
144.0
23.5
7.0
0.7526
-1.372
-0.451
-0.0705
0.0353
28,700
GT
192.8
160.0
24.7
6.6
0.6030
-1.214
-0.387
-0.1000
0.0500
18,000
GT
192.9
181.0
29.4
6.7
0.5547
-1.125
-0.354
-0.0875
0.0437
-560-
(2.3.2)
where
Furthermore the additional width requisite against interaction forces consists of the following three
elements.
(2.3.3)
where
WBA
a= I andb=c=O
a=2,b= I andc=O
a=4, b =I andc=2
CD
-561-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
..
:
:
I w... +Wa=LoasinP+BcosP I
The width requisite against the wind and current forces (WWM+ WcF) may be calculated with the use of the
drift angle Pas follows;
(2.3.4)
where, LoA and B denote the over all length of ship and the breadth of ship respectively, and the drift angle
Pmay be given as
(2.3.5)
where
P1
-562-
Ship 'fype
lS
30
45
60
75
90
105
120
135
ISO
165
180
0.003
0.007
0.011
0.014
0.017
0.017
0.015
0.011
0.007
0.003
0.001
0.000
Cargo Ship
/Jl
(degree)
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.017
0.049
0.102
0.169
0.233
0.276
0.284
0.257
0.204
0.138
0.068
0.001
/Jl
(degree)
0.000
0.006
0.011
0.017
0.021
0.024
0.024
0.021
0.016
0.011
0.006
0.003
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.028
0.069
0.128
0.199
0.267
0.313
0.325
0.300
0.245
0.170
0.087
0.001
Container Ship
(Over Panamax)
/Jl
(degree)
0.000
0.019
0.036
0.049
0,056
0,059
0.056
0.049
0.040
0.029
0.019
0.009
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.082
0.178
0.293
0.425
0.559
0.671
0.736
0.732
0.648
0.485
0.261
0.002
Container (Panamax)
/Jl
(degree)
0.000
0.015
0.029
0.038
0.042
0.043
0.040
0.036
0.030
0.023
0.016
0.008
0.000
81
(degree)
0.000
0.070
0.143
0.220
0.303
0.387
0.461
0.510
0.517
0.468
0.357
0.195
0.002
/Jl
(degree)
0.000
0.002
0.005
0.008
0.010
0.012
0.012
0.010
0.008
0.005
0.003
0.001
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
O.D15
0.039
0.077
0.124
0.169
0.199
0.206
0.189
0.153
0.105
0.053
0.000
/Jl
(degree)
0.000
0.002
0.004
0.006
0.008
0.009
0.009
0.008
0.006
0.004
0.002
0.001
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.015
0.036
0.067
0.104
0.139
0.162
0.167
0.153
0.124
0.085
0.043
0.000
p1
(degree)
0.000
0.006
0.012
0.018
0.024
0.027
0.026
0.023
0.018
0.012
0.006
0.003
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.027
0.070
0.135
0.217
0.296
0.351
0.367
0.340
0.278
0.194
0.099
0.001
5
6
VLCC
Pl
(degree)
0.000
0.002
0.005
0.008
0.011
0.013
0.013
0.011
0.008
0.005
0.002
0.001
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.008
0.027
0.059
0.102
0.143
0.170
0.174
0.157
0.123
0.082
0.040
0.000
Small Tailir
Pl
(degree)
0.000
0.003
0.007
0.011
0.014
0.017
0.017
O.Dl5
0.011
0.007
0.003
0.001
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.015
0.044
0.095
0.160
0.223
0.264
0.272
0.245
0.193
0.129
0.064
0.001
Pl
(degree)
0.000
0.041
0.076
0.103
0.118
0.122
a.us
0.100
0.080
0.059
0.038
0.019
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.159
0.340
0.556
0.806
1.067
1.298
1.450
1.470
1.324
1.006
0.546
0.005
p1
(degree)
0.000
0.051
0.097
0.132
0.152
0.158
0.149
0.130
0.104
0.076
0.048
0.024
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.161
0.353
0.593
0.877
1.176
1.440
1.609
1.626
1.458
1.104
0.598
0.006
Pl
(degree)
0.000
0.033
0.063
0.087
0.103
0.109
0.105
0.091
0.072
0.052
0.032
O.Dl5
0.000
81
(degree)
0.000
0.092
0.211
0.374
0.573
0.780
0.952
1.049
1.040
0.914
0.680
0.364
0.003
/Jl
(degree)
0.000
0.008
0.015
0.023
0.028
0.032
0.031
0.028
0.022
0.015
0.008
0.004
0.000
61
(degree)
0.000
0.036
0.089
0.164
0.255
0.342
0.405
0.425
0.397
0.328
0.231
0.119
0.001
14 Passenger Ship
(2shafts 2propcllers)
/Jl
(degree)
0.000
0.008
0.015
0.023
0.028
0.032
0.031
0.028
0.022
0.015
0.008
0.004
0.000
81
(degree)
0.000
0.174
0.363
0.578
0.826
1.097
1.361
1.561
1.629
1.507
1.169
0.643
0.006
15 Ferry Boat
(2shafts !propellers)
/Jl
(degree)
0.000
0.053
0.100
0.136
0.158
0.164
0.155
0.135
0.108
0.078
0.050
0.024
0.000
81
(degree)
0.000
0.113
0.253
0.438
0.662
0.900
1.111
1.244
1.257
1.126
0.851
0.460
0.004
12 LNG Ship
13 Refrigerated Cargo Carrier
For the concept design use, the drift angle P1 and its corresponding check helm 1 may practically and easily
be estimated by employing figures ofthe similar ship to the design ship given in Table 2.3.2. It is noted that the
figures in Table 2.3.2 are computed for the case of K=l.O, where K is defined as
K~Uw
(2.3.6)
where Uwand U denote the relative wind speed and the ship speed respectively.
For an arbitrary value of K, the drift angle due to the wind forces P1 (K) and its corresponding check helm
o1
P1 (K) =
(2.3.7)
(2.3.8)
In the above drift angle estimation, it should be confirmed that the check helm 1 corresponding to each
drift angle P1 be less than the maximum rudder angle (35 degree for the conventional rudder), because the ship
handling can not be made in the case of the rudder angle greater than the maximum one.
In addition to the above type-ship method, when the principal dimensions ofthe design ship are known, more
accurate estimations of the drift angle P1 and the check helm 1 can be made by the direct calculation as follows;
o,
-563-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2.3.9)
(2.3.10)
+0.4Y a
(2.3.11)
.. . .)
(
Nv \=Nv+rNa =
(2.3.12)
where
. ofsh"1p
k ( = -2d ) : aspect ratio
L
L
length of ship (between perpendiculars)
B : breadth of ship
d : draft of ship
CB: block coefficient
r (= 0.4)
In equations (2.3.9) - (2.3.12), Y'o and N'O denote the linear derivative of rudder lateral force and rudder yaw
moment respectively, and they can be estimated by the following equations.2). 4)
(2.3.13)
1 '
Na=--Ya
2
(2.3.14)
aspect ratio of rudder
rudder area.
In equations (2.3.13) and (2.3.14), e denotes the coefficient of rudder inflow speed and the followings are
practically employed in the computation.
e =1.1 for both ships with a single propeller and single rudder arrangement
and with a twin propeller and twin rudder arrangement.
e =0.7 for a ship with a twin propeller and single rudder arrangement.
In addition, aHdenotes the coefficient ofhydrodynamic force induced on the ship hull by the rudder deflection,
and aH can be estimated with the use of Fig. 2.3.2 given as a function of CB.SJ
-564-
1.0
jMODELB
MODELA
A .
.~
......
0.5
.,,
~-
.If
JI
.A.
...
A.
MODEL D
~RI 08 CONI'AINER
0.
0.5
0.7
0.6
0.8
0.9
1.0
Pw
p
As
Uw
density of air
density of water
projected lateral area above water line
relative wind speed at gravity center of ship
ship speed.
In addition, Y'w(,Ow) and N'w(,Ow) denote the coefficients of wind lateral force and wind yaw moment
respectively as functions of Ow which indicates the angle of relative wind direction at the center of gravity of
the ship. On the basis of the wind tunnel tests, Yw(,Ow) andNw(.Ow) may practically be obtained by the following
expressions with the trigonometric series.6)
3
L Cyn
y'w(Bw) =
sin(nBw)
(2.3.16)
n=l
3
N'w(Bw)= LCNnsin(nOw).
(2.3.17)
n=l
In the above equations, the regression coefficients Cy,, and CNn are estimated by the following equations, for
which the coefficients Cy,, 0, Cy,,i. CN"' CNn1 etc. are given in Table 2.3.3
As
L
Xs
L
L
B
As
Cy,,
C Nn
where
Ap
As
Xs
As
Xs
L
AF
L
B
As
AF
(2.3.18)
(2.3.19)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 2.3.3 Regression Coefficients of Wind Forces
Cy
Const.
A 8 /L2
Xs/L
VB
As/AF
Cm
Const.
A 8 /L2
Xs/L
VB
Cy2
0.509
4.904
0.022
Cml
2.650
4.634
-5.876
Cy3
0.0208
0.230
Cm2
0.105
S.306
0.0704
Cy4
--0.357
0.943
-0.075
0.0381
Cm3
0.616
-1.474
0.0161
As/AF
(2.3.20)
where
Uc : current speed perpendicular to channel center line
U : ship speed.
(j) Width requisite against the yawing motion caused by unsteady external forces WyM may be defined as the
maximum deviation (double amplitude) due to the yawing as shown in Fig. 2.3.3, and WyM may be calculated
by the following equation.
wrM
(2.3.21)
where
!I'() (=II'0
angle.
In equation (2.3.21), Ty (the yawing period)= 12 sec and t/fo (the yawing amplitude)= 4 degree may empirically
be employed in the computation.
-566-
Wvv(NEY)=2LF tanamax
(2.3.22)
where LF denotes the distance for the drift detection between the ship and the light buoys ahead along
the waterway center line, and LF = 7 x LOA (LoA: the over all length of ship) may empirically be employed
in the computation. The maximum intersecting angle corresponding to the above maximum deviation a max
may be estimated with the use of an empirical formula developed on the basis of statistical data by full scale
experiments, and it is given by
(2.3.23)
In equation (2.3.23),7> (}denotes the intersecting angle by two lines from the ship to the two buoys ahead on
both sides of the waterway as shown in Fig. 2.3.S, and it is defined as
() =2 arctan( WBuor )
~
~~
where
-567-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Buoy
Bucy
Wbuoy
LF
0.5W~Y) or O.sW~RAD) [
Fig. 2.3.5 Drift Detection by observing Light Buoys with Naked Eyes or RADAR
(2.3.25)
where y denotes the observation error of direction by RADAR, and equation (2.3.25) is rewritten for the two
cases ofy=2 and y=l as follows.
W
DD
(RAD)=0.0698WBUOY (y=2 )
sinO
(2.3.26)
=1 )
(2.3.27)
It is assumed that the perception error of GPS information on the display by naked eyes be a half of the ship
breadth, and in addition that the error of GPS information itself be 30 meters for the usual GPS and none for the
D-GPS. Then the following equations may be given with respect to the width requisite for the drift detections
by GPS and D-GPS respectively, where the errors are considered for both sides of the waterway center line.
WDD(GPS)=B+60
(m)
(2.3.28)
WDD(D-GPS)=B (m).
(2.3.29)
CD
(2.3.30)
-568-
p = y'B(?'f':o -N:B5~)y'o
(2.3.31)
Yv No-Nv Yo
where
q' =11 ( '1 : clearance between ship longitudinal center line and bank wall).
L
In equations (2.3.30) and (2.3.31), Y'B(I'/') and N'B(I'/') denote the coefficients oflateral force and yaw moment
due to bank effects respectively. The coefficients of Y'B(I'/') and N],(11') may practically be estimated with the use
of computed results> shown in Fig. 2.3.6, where CF and CM as functions of Sp(='f) in the ordinate denote Y'B('l')
and N'B(I'/') respectively and S'T in the abscissa denotes dimensionless distance (divided by the ship length) from
the midship to the bank entrance in the longitudinal direction. It is noted that the peak values in the force and
moment variations should be employed for the estimations of Y'B(I'/') and N'B(I'/') by Fig. 2.3.6
y
0.020
0.030
Repulsion
0.000
ll
0.010
~-'
--
-0.030
~-1
=0.2
0.000
-0.060
-0.010
Bow-in
Attraction
-0.09~2.0
-1.5
-1.0
-0.S
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
-2.0
-1.5
-1.0
-0.5
0.0
S',
S',
(a)
(b)
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
Fig. 2.3.6 Lateral Force and Yaw moment due to Bank Effects >
Table 2.3.4 gives the requisite clearance with respect to the bank effect forces for the 15 ship types, which are
obtained with the predetermined rudder angle of 5 degree. In Table 2.3.4 together with Fig. 2.3.7, the requisite
clearance is denoted by the term of "bank clearance" with a symbol of Wb;o It is noted that the figures of bank
clearance are obtained for the canal section with the upright wall.
-569-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
L,,,,
wbio
Wb;/B
Cargo Ship
103.0
20.0
17.4
0.87
60.4
299.9
9.8
0.87
1.39
283.8
40.0
55.5
Container (Panamax)
273.0
32.2
55.2
1.71
279.0
45.0
52.6
1.17
216.0
32.3
41.9
1.30
119.2
215.0
20.3
0.95
VLCC
316.0
60.0
49.7
0.83
Small Tanker
92.0
20.0
13.8
0.69
190.0
32.2
34.3
1.06
180.0
32.2
31.2
0.97
12 LNG Ship
270.0
44.8
47.7
1.07
144.0
23.5
26.6
1.13
160.0
24.7
25.9
1.05
181.0
29.4
30.5
1.04
(unit: meter)
B/2
IB
I
----.i
s,.
!
I
I
WBAO =
WbiO
(2.3.32)
Taking the bank effects on both sides ofthe waterway into consideration, the width for the dredged waterway
shown in Fig. 2.3.8 WBA may be obtained by
(2.3.33)
In the above equation, Cmf and CD~ denote corrections of the dredged waterway configuration to the canal
section for the left and right side banks respectively, and Cnsis given by the following equation.
Cvs
exp(--3!i_)
1-hi
(2.3.34)
-570-
where
h _Dour*
i D
_!_ D +Dour
~-~~~~:!:Im
(2.3.35)
where
1]
The coefficient of yaw moment due to the two-ship interaction N's1'..tf') in equation (2.3.35) may practically be
estimated with the use of computed results 9), 10) shown in Fig. 2.3.9 and Fig. 2.3.10. In these figures, CM1(i=l,2)
as a function ofSp12 (=11) in the ordinate denotes N's1'..tf') and S712 in the abscissa denotes the midship to midship
distance of two ships in the longitudinal direction. Fig. 2.3.9 shows N's1'..tf') for the meeting condition, and Fig.
2.3.10 shows N's1'..tf') for the overtaking condition. In the similar way to the bank effect forces, it is noted that
the peak value in the moment variation should be employed for the estimations ofN's1'..11') by Fig. 2.3.9 and Fig.
2.3.10.
BOW-OUT
CM- ___M_
tpL'd[P
Hld- 1.3
2.0
-2.0
----- E%f'.
--Cal.
BOW-IN
-0.03
-0.04
-571-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Ship2
Shipl
0.1 .-r--,------,----,----.----..------n
0.1 .-r--,---.------,-----r----.-----n
-0.l~-~~-~-~-~~
-O.l~--~1-~-~0-~-~-~
-1
0
Sru/L1
Sn.JL.
(a)
(b)
Table 2.3.5 shows the requisite clearance with respect to the two-ship interaction in the passing for the 15
ship types, which are obtained with the predetermined rudder angle of 15. In Table 2.3.5 together with Fig.
3.11, the requisite clearance is denoted by the term of "passing distance" with a symbol of We.
Table 2.3.5 Passing Distance
Ship Type
1 Cargo Ship
2 Small Cargo Ship
3
4
We
32.6
Wt:IB
20.0
60.4
299.9
17.6
1.57
1.63
283.8
40.0
105.0
2.63
273.0
32.2
103.6
3.22
279.0
216.0
45.0
32.3
98.8
79.0
2.20
119.2
215.0
38.2
1.77
VLCC
316.0
92.0
60.0
20.0
91.0
1.52
25.2
190.0
32.2
64.6
1.26
2.01
180.0
32.2
58.4
1.81
270.0
144.0
44.8
90.7
2.03
23.5
24.7
50.5
160.0
47.7
2.15
1.93
181.0
29.4
57.1
1.94
Lao
103.0
Small Tanker
Large Pure Car Carrier
Pure Car Carrier
LNG Ship
Refrigerated Cargo Carrier
Passenger Ship (2shafts 2propellers)
Ferry Boat (2shafts lpropellers)
2.45
(unit: meter)
-572-
s,,.
IB
I
For the practical design use, the width requisite against the two-ship interaction in passing WpA may easily be
estimated with the use of figures of the similar ship to the design ship given in Table 2.3.5, namely
WpA = We (figure given in Table 2.3.5).
(2.3.36)
Lnn
103.0
20.0
Wm
55.7
60.4
283.8
299.9
40.0
30.0
169.1
Container (Panamax:)
273.0
32.2
163.2
279.0
45.0
162.2
216.0
128.4
64.2
155.7
1 Cargo Ship
2 Small Cargo Ship
3
4
7
8
119.2
32.3
215.0
VLCC
Small Tanker
Large Pure Car Carrier
Pure Car Carrier
LNG Ship
Refrigerated Cargo Carrier
Passenger Ship (2shafts 2propellers)
Ferry Boat (2shafts !propellers)
316.0
60.0
92.0
20.0
44.9
190.0
180.0
270.0
32.2
32.2
44.8
106.9
98.2
150.l
144.0
23.5
83.2
160.0
181.0
24.7
29.4
78.3
94.7
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
W,,/B
2.79
2.68
4.23
5.07
3.60
3.98
2.98
2.60
2.24
3.32
3.05
3.35
3.54
3.17
3.22
(unit: meter)
-573-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
u,
s~
I
Fig. 2.3.12 Width Requisite against Two-ship Interaction in Overtaking
For the practical design use, the width requisite against the two-ship interaction in the overtaking W0 vmay
easily be estimated with the use of figures of the similar ship to the design ship given in Table 2.3.4, namely
Wov ~ W0 , (figure given in Table 2.3.6).
(2.3.37)
In addition to the above type-ship method, in the similar way to the drift angle due to the wind forces, when
the principal dimensions of the design ship are known, more accurate estimations of the width requisite against
the interaction forces may be made by the direct application of the check helm calculation.
(2.3.38)
where e =l.0 meter may be taken. In addition, regarding the assumption of Wnuor at the first step computation,
quick convergent iteration may be expected by employing a value of LoA for the one-way channel and 2LOA for the
two-way channel.
Regarding the drift detection by GPS or D-GPS, the total width ofnavigation channel can easily be determined
simply by summing up the necessary elements given in equations (2.3.1) - (2.3.3).
-574-
(1) In class 1 waterways, in cases where a bend exceeds 30 and the design ship and the features of the navigation
environment such as the rudder angle, ship speed cannot be designated, it is preferable that the centerline of the
bend in the waterway be an arc having a radius of curvature roughly 4 times the length overall ofthe design ship
Loa or more, and that the width of navigation channel be equal to or greater than the necessary width. When
the angle of intersection of the centerlines is 30 or greater, in two-way waterways having its width of W, it is
preferable that the corner cut be designed as shown in Fig. 2.4.1. Furthermore, depending on the design ship and
the navigation environment, the length between perpendiculars Lpp can be used instead of the length overall Loa.
4Lat
I
\
I
\
.\.I
(2) In class 2 waterways, in cases where a bend exceeds 30 and the design ship and the features of the navigation
environment such as the rudder angle, ship speed can be designated, the radius of curvature can be calculated
based on the manoeuverability index of turning, which shows the turning performance of ships. In the bend, it
is desirable that the width be greater than that required by corner cut, etc.
It may also be noted that in cases other than corner cut, a curved shape, etc. can be used, considering the
installation of buoys, etc., based on adjustment with the parties concerned with maritime affairs. In particular,
providing a comer cut is not necessarily effective in cases where the angle of intersection between the center
lines is large; therefore, study of a curved shape is preferable.
R=~
K"5o
(2.4.1)
where
L : length of ship (between perpendiculars) (m)
K : non-dimensional index of turning ability
0 : rudder angle (rad)
Table 2.4.1 gives the non-dimensional index of the turning ability K for 13 ship types, which are obtained by
analyzing the motion trajectories of90 degree turning computed with the use of fully nonlinear equations ofthe ship
maneuvering motion.3>. 4) The computations are made for the turning motion with 20 degree rudder in the shallow
water of Hid =l.2 under non-external forces.
For the concept design use, the turning ability index K may practically and easily be estimated by employing figures
of the similar ship to the design ship given in Table 2.4.1 as follows.
(2.4.2)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
It is noted that K is not given for the 2 types of PCCs in Table 2.4.1, for which careful attention and consideration
should be paid from a view point of the large wind force effects.
K'
Cargo Ship
0.58
0.47
0.42
Container (Panamax)
0.52
0.52
0.49
0.62
VLCC
0.62
Small Tanker
0.60
10 LNG Ship
0.15
0.63
0.66
0.55
References
Yoshimura, Y.: Mathematical model for the maneuvering ship motion in shallow water, Journal ofthe Kansai society ofnaval
architects, Japan, No.200, March 1986
2) Takahashi, H., A. Goto and M. Abe: Study on ship dimensions by statistical analysis-standard of main dimensions of design
ship (Draft), Research Report ofNational Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management, No.28, March 2006
3) VLCC Study Group: 10 sections regarding VLCC, SEIZANDOSHOTEN
4) Honda, K .: Outline of ship handling (5th edition), SEIZANDOSHOTEN, 1998
5) Takagi, M .: On the ship motion in shallow water No.3, Transactions ofthe West-Japan Society of Naval Architects, Vol. 54,
1977
6) Ohtsu, K., Yoshimura, Y., Hirano, M., Tsugane, Mand Takahashi, H.: Design Standards for Fairway in Next Generation, Asia
Navigation Conference 2006, No.26, 2006
7) The Japan Port and Harbour Association: Technical Standards and Commentaries for Port and Harbour Facilities in Japan
8) Inoue, S., Hirano, M., Kijima, K. And Takashina, J.: A Practical Calculation Method of Ship Maneuvering Motion, ISP
(International Shipbuilding Progress), Vol.28, No.325, 1981
9) Principle of Naval Architecture (2nd Revision), Vol.3, SNAME, 1989
10) Kose, K., Yumuro, A. And Yoshimura, Y.: Mathematical Model of Ship Maneuvering Motion-Interactions among Hull,
Propeller and Rudder, and its Expressions, The 3rd Ship Maneuverability Symposium Text, The Society of Naval Architects
ofJapan, 1981
11) Yamano, T. and Saito, Y.: An Estimation Method of Wind Force Acting on Ship's Hull, Journal ofthe Kansai Society ofNaval
Architects, No.228, 1997
12) Kijima, K. and Lee, Ml: On the Safe Navigation Including the Interaction Forces between Ship and Ship, Transactions ofthe
West-Japan Society ofNaval Architects, No.104, 2002
1)
-576 -
3 Basins
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Basins
Article 10
The performance requirements for basins shall be such that the requirements specified by the Minister of
Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied in light of geotechnical characteristics, waves,
water currents, and wind conditions along with the usage conditions of the surrounding water areas, for
securing the safe and smooth use by ships.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria for Basins
Article31
The performance criteria for basins shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The size of a basin shall satisfy the following standards. Provided, however, that the standards shall not
be applied to basins for design ships with the gross tonnage less than 500 tons:
(a) Basins which are provided for use in anchorage or mooring of ships excluding the basins in front
of quaywalls, mooring piles, piers, and floating piers shall have an area greater than a circle that
has a radius obtained by adding an appropriate value to the length of the design ship, in light of the
conditions of geotechnical characteristics, waves, water currents, and winds as well as the usage
condition of the surrounding water areas. Provided, however, that in cases where that the area
specified above is not required owing to the mode of anchorage or mooring, the basin size can be
reduced to the area that shall not hinder the safe anchorage or mooring of ships.
(b) Basins which are provided for use in anchorage or mooring of ships in front of quaywalls, mooring
piles, piers, and floating piers shall have an appropriate area of which the length and width are greater
than the length and width of the design ship, respectively, in light of the conditions of geotechnical
characteristics, waves, water currents, and winds, the usage condition of the surrounding water
areas, and the mode of anchorage or mooring.
(c) Basins which are provided for use in ship turning by the bow shall have an area greater than a circle
that has a radius obtained by multiplying the length of the design ship by 1.5. Provided, however, that
in cases where that the area specified above is not required owing to the method of ship turning by
the bow, the basin size can be reduced to the area that shall not hinder the safe ship turning by the
bow.
(2) The basin shall have an appropriate depth that is greater than the draft of the design ship, in light of the
degree of the motions of the design ship due to waves, water currents, winds, and others.
(3) Basins which are provided for use in anchorage or mooring of ships in front of quaywalls, mooring
piles, piers, and floating piers shall in principle secure the harbor calmness which enables the working
rate of cargo handling operation at equal to or greater than 97.5% in terms of time throughout the year.
Provided, however, that this rate shall not be applied to the basins where the mode of utilization of
mooring facilities or the water areas in front of them are regarded as special.
(4) In a basin which is provided as a harbor of refuge during stormy weather, the wave conditions during
stormy weather shall remain below the level that is admissible for refuge of the design ship.
(5) In a basin which is provided for anchorage or mooring of ships for the main purpose of timber sorting,
measures shall be taken to prevent drifting of timbers.
[Technical Note]
CD
-577-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
and buoy mooring. In determining the area of the basin in performance verification of the basin concerned,
appropriate consideration shall be given to the properties of the sea-bed, the effect of wind, the water depth,
depending on the functions required in the objective facilities and the expected condition of use of the
facilities. Cases where that area is not necessary due to the method of anchorage or mooring are defined as
cases of buoy mooring. In determining the area of the basin in the performance verification of basins in this
case, appropriate consideration shall be given to the expected condition of use of the objective facilities and
the amount of horizontal movement of buoys due to the effect of differences in sea level.
(b) Basins in front of quaywalls
In determining the proper area of basins greater than the length overall of the design ship and greater than
the width of the design ship in the performance verification of basins in front of quaywalls, mooring piles,
piers, and floating piers, when determining the length of the basin, appropriate consideration shall be given
to the necessary extension in alongside mooring of the design ship in the length overall of the design ship,
and in determining the width of the basin, appropriate consideration shall be given to safety in berthing and
unberthing of the design ships.
appropriate consideration shall be given to the method of turning of the design ship, the turning performance
of the design ship, the arrangement of the mooring facilities and waterways. Methods of turning in cases
where that area is not necessary mean turning employing a tugboat, turning using thrusters having adequate
Turning utilizing thrusters having adequate thrust may be equivalent to turning using a tugboat.
When turning under the ship's own power, a circle having a diameter 2 times the length overall of the
design ship
When turning using a tugboat, a circle having a diameter 1.5 times the length overall of the design ship
(c) Mooring/unmooring basins
In determining the scale of basins in the performance verification ofmooring/unmooring basins, appropriate
consideration shall be given to the method of turning of the design ship, whether the ship is equipped with
thrusters or not, the effects of winds and tidal currents, ease of maneuvering.
CD
An appropriate water depth greater than the draft of the design ship is a value obtained by adding a keel
clearance, which is set corresponding to the maximum draft, to the assumed maximum draft of the design ship,
such as the load draft. In determining the water depth of a basin in the performance verification of the basin,
an appropriate depth greater than the draft of the design ship under the datum level for port management shall
be secured. Provided, however, that this shall not apply to basins for use in fitting of ships and other basins
provided for use in special anchorage or mooring of ships.
-578-
CD
A single anchoring, see Fig. 3.2.l(a) and a dual anchoring, see Fig. 3.2.l(b}, are the most popular mooring
methods. A two anchoring method and a bow-and-stern anchoring method are also applied.
@ It is necessary to determine the chain length in such a way that the holding powers of the mooring anchor and
the chain lying on the sea bottom can resist the actions exerted on the ship under such conditions as the type
of ship, anchorage method, and meteorological and marine conditions. In general, the stability of the mooring
system increases as the length of the anchor chain increases.
@ The area of anchorage area is defined as a circle having a radius equivalent to the sum of the ship's length and
the horizontal distance between the bow and the center of rotation of the laying chain.
When the conditions required to calculate the length ofthe anchor chain are unknown, Table 3.2.1 may normally
be used as a reference.
Fig. 3.2.l(c) shows a single-buoy mooring, and Fig. 3.2.l(d) shows a dual-buoy mooring with the buoys
located in the bow and stern of the ship. In this double-buoy mooring, it is necessary to locate the buoys in such
a way that the line connecting the two buoys become parallel with the directions of tidal currents and winds. In
the determination of the area of these types of buoy mooring, Table 3.2.2 may be used as a reference.
@ The width of basins between multiple parallel piers can be set referring to the values specified below.
(Loa: length overall of design ship)
(a) When the number of piers on one side of a groin is approximately 3 or less: 1.0 L 00
(b) When the number of berths on one side of a pier is approximately 4 or more: 1.5 Loa
In cases where the back of the pier is to be used as a small craft basin, and when used by bunkering ships or
barges, it is preferable to consider those use conditions.
!J) In determining the anchoring method and scale in rough weather, References !)- 4) can be used as reference.
-579-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(b)Dual anchoring
(a)Single anchoring
Method of use
Single anchoring
Dual anchoring
Good anchoring
Poor anchoring
Diameter (m)
L00+6D
L00+6D+30
L00+4.5D
L00+4.5D +25
Note) Loa: length overall of design ship (m), D: water depth (m)
Method of use
Single buoy mooring
Dual buoy mooring
Q) In general, the mooringlunmooring water area and waterways can be planned at the same water area from
the viewpoints of efficient layout and the use of the port facilities. Provided, however, that it is preferable to
separate the two in cases where ship traffic is congested.
@ When examining the size of a mooring/unmooring basin using tugboats, References 5) and 6) can be used as
reference.
construction.
-580-
Table 3.2.3 Reference Values of Threshold Wave Height for Cargo Handling Works not Affected by Swell, or Long
Period Waves
Ship type
Small craft
0.3m
Medium/large ship
0.5m
0.7-1.5m
Note) Here, the small craft means ships of roughly <SOOGT class which mainly use the small craft basin, the very large ship means ships of
roughly ;::50,000GT class which mainly use large-scale dolphins or offshore berths, and the medium/large ship means ships other than
the small craft and the very large ships.
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
Iwai, A.: New Edition Ship maneuvering theory, Kaibun-do Publishing, 1977
Honda, K.: Ship maneuvering theory (Enlarged 5th Edition), Seizan-do Publishing, 1978
Japan Association for Maritime Safety Edition: Maneuvering of Guideline for Very Large ships, Seizan-do Publishing, 1975
Suzuk~ Y.: Study on the Design of Single Point Buoy Mooring, Technical Note of PHRI No.829,1996
Nakajima, T.: Maneuvering of tug boats-Technique-, Kaibun-so Publishing, 1979,
Yamagata, H.: Tug boats and their utilization method, Seizan-do Publishing, 1992
Coastal Development Institute of Tecbnology (CDI1): Impact Evaluation Manual for long-period waves in ports, Coastal
Tecbnology Library No. 21, CDIT, 2004, 86p.
-581-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Small Craft Basins
Article 11
The performance requirements for small craft basins shall be such that the requirements specified by the
Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied in light of geotechnical characteristics,
waves, water currents, and wind conditions along with the usage conditions of the surrounding water areas,
for securing the safe and smooth use by small crafts.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria for Small Craft Basins
Article32
The requirement specified in item (2) of the preceding article shall be applied to the performance criteria for
small craft basins with modification as necessary.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding item, the performance criteria for the small craft basins shall
be such that the basins have the shape, area, and calmness necessary for the safe and smooth use of ships.
[Technical Nole]
As the scale of rest facilities, it is preferable to calculate the necessary extended leogth by addiog ao appropriate width
clearance, mutual clearance between ships, based on consideration ofthe actual condition of use. In rest facilities used
by small craft such as fishiog boats, Table 4.1 cao be used as reference for the width clearaoce io case of mooring by
longitudinal mooring.
Table 4.1 Relationship between Ship Width and Width Clearance
Ship width
<2m
Width clearance
2m to<4m
1.5-2.Sm
4mormore
2.0-3.0m
1.0-2.0m
-582-
Ministerial Ordinance
General Provisions
Article 13
Protective facilities for harbors shall be installed at appropriate locations in light of geotechnical
characteristics, meteorological characteristics, sea states, and other environmental conditions, as well as
ship navigation and other usage conditions of the water areas around the facilities concerned.
Ministerial Ordinance
Necessary Items concerning Protective Facilities for Harbor
Article24
The matters necessary for the performance requirements of protective facilities for harbor as specified in
this Chapter by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism and other requirements shall
be provided by the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Protective Facilities for Harbors
Article33
The items to be specified by the Public Notice under Article 24 of the Ministerial Ordinance concerning the
performance requirements of protective facilities for harbors shall be as provided in the subsequent article
through Article 46.
[Technical Note]
(!) The purposes of protective facilities for harbors include ensuring harbor calmness, maintaining water depth,
preventing beach erosion, controlling the rise of water level in the areas behind the facilities during storm surges,
and diminishing invading waves by tsunami, as well as protecting harbor facilities and the hinterland from waves,
storm surges, and tsunamis. In recent years, water intimate amenity functions have also been required. In
general, there are many cases in which the protective facilities for harbors are expected to provide a combination
of several of these functions. Accordingly, in performance verifications, due consideration to enable the facilities
CD
When the protective facilities are constructed on a coast of sandy beach, they may cause various morphological
changes to the surrounding area such as beach accretion or erosion.
@ Construction of breakwaters may increase the wave height at the outside of the protective facilities because of
reflected waves.
@ In the inside of a harbor, the calmness of water area may be disturbed because of multiple wave reflections
triggered by construction of the new protective facilities or harbor oscillations due to the changes of harbor
shape.
@ Construction of the protective facilities may bring about changes in the surrounding tidal currents or flow
conditions of a river mouth, thus inviting localized changes of water quality.
(3) Because of the fact that the protective facilities also provide a habitat for marine organisms such as fish, marine
plants, and plankton, the biological environments must also be taken into consideration when planning a facility
layout and making structural design.
(4) When locating the protective facilities adjacent to the areas such as natural park zones or cultural facilities, it
is preferable to consider not only the functions of the facilities themselves but also external appearance such as
shape and color. In addition, in situations where water intimate amenity functions will be added to the protective
facilities, convenience and safety of people must also be taken into consideration.
-583-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(5) Because there is a danger that damage to the protective facilities may affect the safi:ty of ships in the harbor, the
mooring facilities, hinterland facilities, it is preferable to conduct an adequate examination corresponding to
the performance requirements of the protective facilities when constructing, improving, and maintaining those
facilities.
-584-
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Breakwaters
Article 14
1 The performance requirements for breakwaters shall be as specified in the subsequent items depending on
the structure type for the purpose of securing safe navigation, anchorage and mooring of ships, ensuring
smooth cargo handling, and preventing damage to buildings, structures, and other facilities in the port by
maintaining the calmness in the harbor water area.
(1) Breakwaters shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport
and Tourism so as to enable reduction of the height of waves intruding into the harbor.
(2) Damage to a breakwater due to self weight, variable waves, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, and/or
other actions shall not impair the functions of the breakwater concerned and shall not adversely affect
its continued use.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for breakwaters
mentioned in the following are specified in the respective items.
(1) The performance requirements for a breakwater which is required to protect the hinterland of the
breakwater concerned from storm surges or tsunamis shall be such that the breakwater satisfies the
requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so as to enable
appropriate reduction of the rise in water level and flow velocity due to storm surges or tsunamis in the
harbor.
(2) The performance requirements for a breakwater which is provided for use by an unspecified large
number of people shall be such that the breakwater satisfies the requirements specified by the Minister
of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so as to ensure the safety of the users of the breakwater.
(3) The performance requirements for a breakwater in the place where there is a risk of serious impact
on human lives, property, or socioeconomic activity, in consideration of its structure type, shall be
such that the damage from tsunamis, accidental waves, Level 2 earthquake ground motions and/or
other actions do not have a serious impact on the structural stability of the breakwater concerned with
respect to the breakwater types even though the damage may impair the functions of the breakwater
concerned. Provided, however, that as for the performance requirements for the breakwater which
is required to protect the hinterland of the breakwater concerned from tsunamis, the damage due to
tsunamis, Level 2 earthquake ground motions and/or other actions shall not adversely affect restoration
through minor repair works of the functions of the breakwater concerned.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria for Breakwaters
Article34
1 The performance criteria which are common for breakwaters shall be as specified in the subsequent items.
(I) Breakwaters shall be arranged appropriately so as to satisfy the harbor calmness provided in item iii)
of Article 31, and shall have the dimensions which enable the transmitted wave height to be equal to or
less than the allowable level.
(2) Breakwaters having wave-absorbing structures shall have the dimensions which enable full performance
of the intended wave-absorbing function.
2 In addition to the requirements specified in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of the
breakwaters specified in the subsequent items shall be as provided in the respective items:
(1) The performance criteria for the breakwaters which are required to protect the hinterland from storm
surge shall be such that the breakwaters are arranged appropriately so as to reduce the rise of water
level and flow velocity in the harbor due to storm surge and have the dimensions necessary for their
function.
(2) The performance criteria for the breakwaters which are required to protect the hinterland from tsunamis
shall be such that the breakwaters are arranged appropriately so as to reduce the rise of water level and
flow velocity in the harbor due to tsunamis and have the dimensions necessary for their function.
-585-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(3) The performance criteria for the breakwater which is utilized by an unspecified large number of people
shall be such that breakwaters have the dimensions necessary to secure the the safety of users in
consideration of the environmental conditions to which the facilities concerned are subjected, the
utilization conditions, and others.
(4) The performance requirements for the breakwater in the place where there is a risk of serious impact
on human lives, property, or socioeconomic activity by the damage to the breakwater concerned shall
be such that the degree of damage owing to the actions of tsunamis, accidental waves, or Level 2
earthquake ground motions, which are the dominant actions in the accidental action situation, is equal
to or less than the threshold level corresponding to the performance requirements.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria for Breakwaters
Specific breakwaters
(a) Storm surge protection breakwaters (usability)
The dimensions of storm surge protection breakwaters shall indicate the crown height, opening
width, and water depth at the opening. In setting the arrangement, crown height, opening width,
and water depth at the opening in performance verifications of storm surge protection breakwaters,
appropriate consideration shall be given to the effect of storm surge and tide levels so that the
breakwater demonstrates a peak cut effect in reducing the water and flows of water due to storm
surges.
(b) Tsunami protection breakwaters (usability)
The dimensions of tsunami protection breakwaters shall indicate the crown height, opening width,
and water depth at the opening. In setting the arrangement, crown height, opening width, and water
depth at the opening in the performance verifications of tsunami protection breakwaters, appropriate
consideration shall be given to the effect of tsunamis and tidal levels so that the breakwater
demonstrates a peak cut effect in reducing the water level and flows of water due to tsunamis.
(c) Amenity-oriented breakwaters (usability)
The dimensions of amenity-oriented breakwaters shall indicate the structure, cross-sectional
dimensions, and ancillary facilities. In setting the structure and cross-sectional dimensions in the
performance verifications of amenity-oriented breakwaters, consideration shall be given to the
effects of wave overtopping and spray, prevention of slipping, overturning, and falling into the
water of users, smooth execution of rescue activities for users who fall into the water, and ancillary
equipment such as falling prevention fences shall be installed appropriately.
(d) Breakwaters of facilities prepared for accidental incidents
The settings in connection with the performance criteria and design situations (limited to accidental
situations) which are common to breakwaters of facilities prepared for accidental incidents shall be
as shown in Attached Table 15. The reason for indicating "damages" in the ''verification items"
column of Attached Table 15 is that it is necessary to use a comprehensive term taking account that
-586-
the verification items will vary depending on the type of structure. In the performance verifications
of breakwaters of facilities prepared for accidental incidents, among the settings for the performance
criteria and the design situations in connection with accidental situations associated with Level
2 earthquake ground motion, tsunamis, and accidental waves, those for which the performance
verification is necessary shall be set appropriately, depending on the type of structure of the objective
breakwater.
Attached Table 15 Settings for Performance Criteria and Design Situations limited to Accidental Situations Common to
Breakwaters of Facilities Prepared for Accident
Ministerial
Ordinance
u
<
14
lgj>
~
~< l~
34
"
Design situation
Public Notice
"
2
Performance
requirements
Safety
Situation
Dominating
action
Index of standard
limit value
Verification item
Non-dominating action
Accidental
waves
Public Notice
~< l~
1
~ ~< ~
14
"
2
34
"
2
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Restorability
,!!
Safety
Situation
Nondominating
action
Dominating
action
Accidental L2
earthquake
ground
motion
Self weight,
water pressure
Verification item
Deformation of
breakwater body
Tsunami
Self weight,
Sliding and
water pressure, overturning of
water flows
breakwater body,
bearing capacity of
foundation ground
Accidental
Self weight,
water pressure
waves
Sliding and
overturning of
breakwater body,
bearing capacity of
foundation ground
-587-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
[Technical Note]
2.1 Principals of Performance Verification
[1] General
Maintenance of harbor calmness shall be examined from the two viewpoints which include the enabling of cargo
handling in the basin and the condition of waves enabling refuge during rough weather. For harbor calmness in the
basin and the condition of waves during rough weather, Part IJ, Chapter 2, 4.5 Concept of Harbor Calmness and
Chapter 3, 3 Basins can be used as references.
[2] Layout
(I) Breakwaters are constructed to maintain the harbor calmness, facilitate smooth cargo handling, ensure the safety
of ships during navigation or anchorage, and protect port facilities. To fulfill these requirements, the following
are required:
CD
Breakwaters should be so located that the harbor entrance is at the location not facing the direction of the most
frequent waves and the direction of the highest waves in order to reduce entrance of waves to the harbor.
@ Breakwater alignment should be arranged to protect the harbor from the most frequent waves and the highest
waves.
@ The harbor entrance should have a sufficient effuctive width so that it will not present an obstacle to ship
navigation, and it should orient the navigation channel in a direction that makes navigation easy.
Breakwaters should be located at the place where the speed of tidal currents is as slow as possible. ht cases
where the speed of tidal currents is high, it is necessary to take appropriate countermeasures.
@ The influences of reflected waves, Mach-stem waves, and wave concentration on the waterways and basins
should be minimized.
@ Breakwaters should enclose a sufficiently large water area that is needed for ship berthing, cargo handling, and
ship anchorage.
These objectives are also mutually contradictory goals, however. A narrow harbor entrance width, for
example, is best in order to achieve the calmness in a harbor but is inconvenient for navigation. The direction
of most frequent waves and the direction of the highest waves are not necessarily the same. In this situation
the breakwater layout should be determined through a comprehensive investigation of all the factors such as
conditions of ship use, construction cost, construction works, and ease or difficulty of maintenance.
(2) In situations where concerns for deterioration of water quality exist, consideration is preferably given to the
exchangeability of seawater with the outside sea so that seawater within the harbor does not stagnate.
(3) In the construction of breakwaters, economy should also be examined considering the natural conditions and
construction conditions. ht particular, it is preferable to consider the following.
CD
@ Locations where the ground is extremely poor should be avoided, considering constructability and economy.
@ The layout should consider the effects of topographical features such as capes and islands.
On sandy beaches, the layout should consider invasion of littoral drift into the harbor.
@ Adequate consideration should be given to the effect on adjacent areas after the construction of the
breakwater.
For wave concentration, Part IJ, Chapter 2, 4.3.4[3] Transformation of Waves at Concave Corners near
the Heads or Breakwaters and around Detached Breakwaters can be used as reference; for breakwaters to
be constructed on sandy beaches, Part IJ, Chapter 2, 6.3 Littoral Drift can be used as reference.
(4) Breakwaters should be so located that they do not form an obstacle to the future development of the harbor.
(5) The "effective harbor entrance width" means the width of the waterway at the specified depth of water, not
merely the width across the harbor entrance. The speed of the tidal currents cutting across the harbor entrance is
preferably less than 2 to 3 knots.
(6) In the areas surrounding shoals, the wave height often increases owing to wave refraction. ht some cases, impact
wave forces will act on the breakwater constructed on a seabed with steep slope. It should be noted that a very
large structure may be required when a breakwater is placed over or directly behind a shoal.
-588-
(7) For detached breakwaters which are to be constructed in isolation offshore, if the length of the breakwater is
less than several times that of the incident waves, the distribution of the wave heights behind the breakwater
will fluctuate greatly due to the effuct of diffracted waves from the two ends of the breakwater, which will affuct
the stability of the breakwater body; therefure, caution is necessary. For the effects of diffracted waves, Part IJ,
Chapter 2, 4.3.2 Wave Diffraction and Part IJ, Chapter 2, 4.3.4 [3] Transformation of Waves at Concave
Corners near the Heads of Breakwaters and around Detached Breakwaters can be used as reference.
[3] Selection of Structural Type and Setting of Cross Section
(!) In setting the cross sections of breakwaters, it is preferable to select the type of structure based on a comparative
examination of the layout conditions, natural conditions, use conditions, importance, construction conditions,
economy, term of construction work, ease of obtaining materials, and ease of maintenance, considering the
fi:atures of respective types of structures.
(2) Breakwaters are generally classified as shown in Fig. 2.1.1 by the type of structure and functions or purposes. In
this figure, ordinary breakwater means a breakwater having basic functions.
(3) Selection of a permeable type breakwater structure is advantageous for promoting circulation of sea water in
the harbor. However, because this also invites inflow of littoral drift and an increase in the height of transmitted
waves, adequate consideration of the merits and demerits is necessary when adopting this type.
(4) There are also cases in which creative ingenuity is used to promote adhesion of marine lite inside and outside the
harbor.!), 2). 3), 4). s). 6). 7). s). 9). 10)
(5) In cases where the layout of a breakwater includes a concave corner, the wave height around the concave corner
will increase. Therefore, it is preferable to adopt a low reflective structure around concave corners.
(6) In determining the cross-sectional dimensions of the wave-dissipating work in the wave-dissipating function of a
breakwater, it is necessary to give adequate consideration to hydraulic characteristics so that the specified wavedissipating function is demonstrated. In particular, it is prefi:rable that the crown height of the wave-dissipating
section be approximately the same as that of the breakwater body so that impulsive breaking wave pressure will
not act on the breakwater body.
Ordinary breakwater
Breakwater
of added functions
:-------,
rc~~P~~it~-b~~;-----------
''
'' Types of structures enclosed in broken line
-------'
are gravity type breakwaters.
!Upright breakwater
i
!Sloping breakwater
I
Breakwater
----[
u pn"ght wave-diss1pating
bl k
breakw
oc type
ater
l~:'.1!!_~-~~~~~~~~~~~J
Floating breakwater
Breakwater with wide footing on soft ground
-589-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) In a harbor oflarge ships' calling, where the water area behind the breakwater is so wide that wave overtopping
is allowed to some extent, the crown height is set at 0.6Hli3 above the mean monthly-highest water level in
@ In a harbor where the water area behind the breakwater is small and is used for small ships, overtopping waves
should be prevented as much as possible. Hence the crown height is set at 1.25Hl/3 above the mean monthlyhighest water level.
(3) Even in case of a harbor oflarge ships' calling with a wide water area behind the breakwaters at the harbor where
large storm waves close to the design waves attack frequently with long duration, the activities of harbor may be
limited by the influence of waves overtopping the breakwaters, if the crown height is set at of 0.6Hl/3 above the
mean monthly-highest water level. Accordingly, in such a harbor, the crown height is preferably set higher than
0.6Hl/3 above the mean monthly-highest water level.
(4) In the performance verification fur the effects of reflected waves, Part II, Chapter 2, 4.3.4 Wave Refteetion can
be used as reference.
(5) In 3.1 Gravity-type Breakwaters (Composite Breakwaters), the standard performance verification method and
the partial factors are shown in respective types of structures. However, the breakwaters used in recent years
have included types with multiple structural features. In this case, it is necessary to determine the partial factors
based on an appropriate evaluation ofthe probability distributions associated with design parameters such as wave
force, considering each structural features. Reference 11) presents a method of determining the partial factors for
a sloping-top caisson breakwater covered with wave-dissipating blocks as an example of cases of this type and can
be used as reference.
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
Furukawa, K., K. Muro and T. Hosokawa: Velocity Distribution around Uneven Surface for Promotion of Larvae Settlement
on Coastal Structure, Rep!. of PHRI Vol. 33 No. 3, pp. 3-26, 1994
ASAI, T., Hiroaki OZASA and Kazuo MURAKAMI: Effect of physical conditioos onto accommodation of attached
organisms, Technical Note of PHRI No.880, p.27, 1997
ASAI, T., Hiroaki OZASA andKazuo MURAKAMI: Field experiment ofaccommodation ofmarine organisms onto concrete
blocks, Technical Note of PHRI No. 881, p.40, 1997
Port and Harbour Bureau, Ministry of Transport Edition: Port in symbiosis with environment (Eco-port), National Printing
Bureau, Ministry of Finance, 1994
Furukawa, K., K. Muro and T. Hosokawa: Introduction to water front science for creation of coastal environment, Asakurashoten Publishing, 1994
6)
Eco-port (water area)Technical Working Group Edition: Eight viewpoints for the consideration of marine environment in
ports, Waterfront Vitalization and Environment Research Center, Port and water area environment Research Institute, 1996
7)
Port Enviromnent Creation Study Group: Revitalization of coastal enviromnent creation 21, Sankai-do Publishing,
1997Restoring
Eco-port (water area)Technical Working Group Edition: Compilatioo of examples of creation of Nature-creature-friendly
8)
marine environment, Waterfront Vitalization and Environment Research Center, Port and water area environment Research
Iostitnte, 1999
Working Group fur Regeneration of Marine Nature: Handbook of Marine nature- Planning, Technology and practice-,
Gyosei, 2003
10) Hokkaido Regional Development Bureao: Design Manual fur natural-environment-harmonious coastal structures in cold
region- Volume fur sea grass meadow and spawning, Cohl Region and Harbour Engineering Research Center, 1998
9)
-590-
Note of National Institute ofLaod and Infrastructure Maoagement (NILIM), No. 350, 2006
-591-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
3 Ordinary Breakwaters
3.1 Gravity-type Breakwaters (Composite Breakwaters)
Public Notice
Performance Criteria for Gravity-type Breakwaters
Article35
The performance criteria for gravity-type breakwaters shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is self weight, the risk of circular
slip failure of the ground shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(2) Under the variable action situation in which the dominant actions are variable waves and Level 1
earthquake ground motions, the risk of failures due to sliding and overturning of the breakwater body,
and/or insufficient bearing capacity of the foundation ground shall be equal to or less than the threshold
level.
[Commentary]
CD Composite breakwaters
(a) Among the settings in connection with the performance criteria and design situations excluding
accidental situations of gravity-type breakwaters, those pertaining to composite breakwaters shall
be as shown in Attached Table 17.
As settings pertaining to composite breakwaters, in addition to these provisions, the settings in
connection with the Public Notice, Article 22, Paragraph 3 (Scouring and Sand Washing Out) and Article
28 Performance Criteria for Armor Stones and Blocks can be applied as necessary, and the settings in
connection with Article 23 through Article 27 can be applied depending on the type of members comprising
the objective composite breakwater.
Attached Table 17 Settings in Connection with Performance Criteria and Design Situations {excluding accidental
situations) of Composite Breakwaters {Gravity-type Breakwaters)
Ministerial
Ordinance
u
...
Design situation
Public Notice
e
.1!
35
...
<
J ~J
14
Performance
Nondominating
action
e
.1!
requirements
Situation
Dominating
action
f--
Variable
Variable
waves
Self weight,
water
pressure
Verification item
LI
earthquake
ground
Self weight,
water
pressure
motion
Sliding/overturning
of breakwater body,
bearing capacity of
foundation ground
@ Upright breakwaters
(a) The performance criteria for upright breakwaters shall be applied to the performance criteria for
composite breakwaters.
@ Sloping breakwaters
Among the settings in connection with the performance criteria and designs states excluding accidental situations
of gravity-type breakwaters, those pertaining to sloping breakwaters shall be as shown in Attached Table 18.
As performance criteria for sloping breakwaters, in addition to these criteria, the settings in connection with
the Public Notice, Article 22, Paragraph 3 (Scouring and Sand Washing Out) and Article 28 Performance
Criteria for Armor Stones and Blocks shall be applied as necessary.
-593-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Attached Table 18 Settings for Performance Criteria and Design Situations {excluding accidental situations) of Sloping
Breakwaters
Ministerial
Ordinance
Design situation
Public Notice
~<
} }
14
,!!
~<
35
Performance
requirements
,!!
Situation
NonDominating dominating
action
action
Verification item
Circular slip
failure of ground
Resistant moment
Sliding and
overturning of
superstructure
Bearing capacity
of foundation
ground
LI
earthquake
ground
pressure
pressure
~
Variable
Variable
Self weight,
waves
water
pressure
ground
motion
-594-
[Technical Note]
3.1.1 Principals of Performance Verification
(!) An example of the performance verification procedure for composite breakwaters is shown in Fig. 3.1.1. Because
the assessment of the effect of liquefaction due to ground motion is not shown in the figure, it is necessary to
conduct an appropriate examination as to whether or not liquefaction can be expected and the countermeasures
for liquefaction referring to Part II, Chapter 6 Ground Liquefaction. The detailed procedure for judging the
necessity ofthe performance verification of seismic-resistant shall be as shown in 3.1.4 Performance Verification,
(11) Judgment ofNeeessity of Performance Verification of Seismic-resistant.
Determination of layout
...
...
I Assumption of cross-sectional dimensions
1
...
I
,~
Evaluation of actions
Performance verification
''-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~'
Variable situation associated with
Level 1 earthquake ground motion
Judgment of necessity of
seismic performance verification
No
,I, Yes
I
I
I 2
--
'"'
I Verification of deformation
ofupright section I
-------------------------!----------------------------------I
*3
''
'
''
''
'
''
I
1________________
_ ______ J
'
'
,--------------- ----------------------- ----------------------'! ________________
----------------
'
'
----------------------~-----------------------!
-----------------------
''
I Verification of slip of foundation ground I'
'
''---------------------------i"----------------------------------''
Permanent state :
...
1 The evaluation of the effects ofliquefiiction and settlement are not shown, so this must be separately considered.
2: The analysis of deformation due to Level 1 earthquake ground motion may be carried out by dynamic analysis when neces98J}'. For facilities where damage
to the objective facilities is assumed to have a serious impact on life, property, and social activity, it is preferable to conduct an examination of deformation
by dynamic analysis.
3: For facilities where dam.age to the objective :fitcilities is assumed to have a serious impact on life, property, and social activity, it is preferable to conduct
a verification for the accidental situations when necessacy. Verification for accidental situations associated with waves shall be conducted in cases where
facilities handling hazardous cargoes are located directly behind the breakwater and damage to the objective facilities would have a catastrophic impact.
-595-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) Examples of the cross sections of composite breakwaters are shown in Fig. 3.1.2.
Seaward side
Concrete crown
Harbor side
H.W.L
'V
Seaward side
v
H.W.L
Seaward side
sz H.W.L
Harbor side
Harbor side
v
H.W.L
Concrete blocks
Foot protection blocks
\
(d) Concrete block type composite breakwater
Fig. 3.1.2 Examples of Cross Sections of Composite Breakwaters
3.1.2 Actions
(1) The design tidal level when calculating wave force is generally examined in the condition in which the facilities
are most unstable. Specifically, in harbors where it is not necessary to consider the effect of storm surge, the
mean monthly-highest water level and mean low water level are assumed, and in harbors where consideration of
storm surge is necessary, an appropriate deviation is added to the mean monthly-highest water level and mean low
water level. For slip failure of the ground, the mean monthly-lowest water level is used, and for calculations of
settlement, the mean water level is used. Caution is required in the performance verifications, as there are cases
in which the most dangerous water level differs depending on the verification items and object of verification.
-596-
(2) The wave parameters necessary in the performance verifications are the wave height, wave direction, wavelength,
period, etc. In determining these parameters, Part IJ, Chapter 2, 4 Waves can be used as reference. For data
on wind fur use in wave hindcasting, Part IJ, Chapter 2, 2 Winds can be used as reference. It may be noted that
data on wind are necessary in calculating wind pressure when designing lighthouses. The duration of waves is
also considered to be an element which affects the stability of breakwaters. However, at present, this has not
been adequately clarified. Therefure, caution is necessary, as damage to breakwaters facing the open sea and
in particular, damage to the breakwater mound, would appear to be due to the effect of repeated waves over
an extended period of time. Furthermore, because there are also cases in which facilities are damaged during
construction, it is necessary to decide the parameters for waves during construction considering the construction
plan and construction process.
(3) Ifthe crest ofthe rubble mound is high and the berm width of the rubble mound is moderately wide, there are cases
in which these conditions induce impulsive breaking wave force. Due caution should be paid in connection with
the occurrence of impulsive breaking wave furce, referring to Part IJ, Chapter 2, 4.7.2 Wave Forces on Upright
Walls. Because there are cases in which the intensity of wave pressure will increase if the crown height of the
section differs from the most dangerous wave in mass calculations for armor units; therefore, caution is necessary.
(5) In cases where the still water level differs inside and outside the breakwater, it is preferable to consider the
hydrostatic pressure equivalent to that difference in water level.
(6) It is necessary to consider the buoyancy of the breakwater body below the still water level. When the still water
level differs inside and outside the breakwater, buoyancy can be considered fur the breakwater body below the
water surface joining the water levels on the two sides of the breakwater.
(7) In cases where erosion, sedimentation, changes in the gradient ofthe sea bottom can be expected after construction
of a breakwater, the effects of those phenomena should also be considered.
(8) For dynamic water pressure during earthquakes, Part IJ, Chapter S, 2.2 Dynamic Water Pressure can be used
as a reference.
3.1.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section
(!) In cases where the foundation ground is soft and settlement can be expected, the crown height should include a
height margin in advance, or a structure whose height can easily be increased should be adopted.
(2) In cases where the foundation ground is soft and remarkable settlement or extensive sinking of the rubble is
conceivable, countermeasures should be taken, such as soil improvement, use of mattresses under the rubble
mound to disperse actions from the body of the breakwater.
(3) The thickness ofthe concrete crown should be 1.0 m or more in situations where the design significant wave height
is 2 m or greater, and is desired at least 50 cm when the design significant wave height is less than 2 m to avoid its
destruction by overtopped waves.
(4) If the height of the caisson top is low, constraints will be encountered on caisson placement, sand filling, and
placement of the concrete lid and concrete crown. Therefore, the height of the top of caissons is generally set
higher than the mean monthly-highest water level. In case of block type breakwaters, it is preferable that the
height of the top of the uppermost layer of blocks or cellular blocks be set at least higher than the mean water level
(M.W.L.), and if possible, higher than the mean monthly-highest water level, so as to facilitate construction of the
superstructure works.
(5) It is preferable that the water depth of the crest of the rubble section be as deep as possible in order to avoid the
action of impulsive breaking wave force. Provided, however, that in the case of caissons, the upright section shall
be set at a depth at which installation is possible. The mound width on the seaward side of the rubble mound
should be sufficiently wide, depending on the wave height, paying attention to reduce the unfavorable effect of the
action ofimpulsive breaking wave force as much as possible, in referring to Part IJ, Chapter 2, 4.7.2(4) Impulsive
Breaking Wave Force.
(6) The berm width of the rubble mound shall be set so as to secure the specified stability against slip failure of
ground and eccentric and inclined loads. In addition, it is preferable that the berm width on the seaward side be
set to a width of at least Sm or more in a condition that does not include the footing, paying attention to reduce the
favorable effect of the action of impulsive breaking wave force. However, this shall not apply in the case of hybrid
caissons and other special structural types. On the harbor side, a berm width on the order to 2/3 that at the seaward
side is acceptable. Ifthis berm width is satisfied, it shall be assumed that the structure demonstrates the standard
-597-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
strength constants c'=20kN/m2, (>=35 for rubble mound in the simplified Bishop method used in the verifications
of stability for eccentric and inclined loads. The partial factors used in the performance verifications are all values
for cross sections having an adequate berm width. Caution is necessary when the berm width is narrow, as it is
considered that the structure cannot demonstrate the standard strength constants. Reference equations for the
harbor-side berm width BM2 include equation (3.1.1) as proposed by Yoshioka et al.ll and others.
BM2
(3.1.1)
where
: significant wave height (m)
He : caisson height (m)
Tu : thickness of superstructure work (m), in structures having a parapet, the parapet is not included
Be : width of breakwater body (m), in structures having a footing, the footing is not included
H113
(1) A high rubble backing is effective for increasing the sliding resistance of the upright section. However, caution
is necessary in this case, as the rubble is easily scattered by overtopped waves. When necessary, it is preferable
to provide armor using cubic blocks or deformed blocks. In the performance verifications, an appropriate
performance verification shall be performed, referring to 3.1.4 (8) When Harbor Side of Upright Section is
Strengthened, which is presented below.
(8) A rubble mound foundation is effective to spread broadly the weight of the upright section, to provide a level
ground where the upright section is placed, and to prevent scouring by waves. To achieve these functions, the
thickness of rubble mound is desired to be 1.5 m or greater.
(9) The slope gradient of the rubble mound foundation is determined based upon the calculation of stability. In many
cases, the seaward side of the breakwater normally may be a gradient between 1: 2 to 1: 3, and the harbor side may
be a gradient between 1: 1.5 to 1: 2, depending upon wave conditions.
CD
@
@
@
@
@
CD
In examination of the stability of the breakwater body against sliding, equation (3.1.2) can be used. In the
following, the subscript d denotes design values.
(3.1.2)
where
The design values in the equation can be calculated using the following equations. In the following, the
-598-
symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and d denote the characteristic value and
design value, respectively.
ft1=Y1h
(3.1.3)
Pu" =rJUPuk
PH" = rl'/{PH,,
The design value Wd ofthe weight of the breakwater body can be calculated by the following equation, using
the characteristic value WRC of the weight of reinforced concrete, the characteristic value WNc of the weight of
non-reinforced concrete, and the characteristic value WsAND of the weight of the filling sand.
(3.1.4)
In cases where a caisson has a footing with a rectangular cross section extending to both the seaward and
landward sides, the following equation can be used in calculating the design value PBd of buoyancy.
(3.1.5)
where
Pwg : unit weight of sea water (kN/m3)
w1 : water level (m)
h : installation depth (m)
Be : width of breakwater body (m)
h1 : height of footing (m)
B1 : width of footing (m)
It is preferable to determine the tidal level by calculating the ratio (hereinafter, r w~ of the highest high water
level, H.H.W.L., and the mean monthly-highest water level, H.W.L., based on the records of observation of tidal
levels. However, at harbors where tidal levels are not monitored, rwl for object harbor may be set referring to the
distribution of rwl shown in Fig. 3.1.3, and the partial factors may be selected from Table 3.1.1.
1.5
p;,;;, j 2.0
0 2.s
Fig. 3.1.3 Distribution of r wl 2)
In calculations of wave force, Part II, Chapter 2, 4.7.2 Wave Forces Acting on Upright Walls can be used as
reference.
@ In order to increase the friction coefficient between the upright section and the rubble mound surface, there are
cases in which friction enhancement mats are laid at the bottom ofthe upright section. For friction enhancement
mats, Part II, Chapter 11, 9 Friction Coefficient can be used as reference.
(3) Examination of Overturning of Breakwater Body
In examination of the stability of the breakwater body against overturning, equation (3.1.6) can be used. In the
following. the symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and d denote the characteristic
value and design value, respectively.
(3.1.6)
-599-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where
W : weight of body (kN/m)
: buoyancy (kN/m)
Pu : uplift force (kN/m)
PH : horizontal wave force (kN/m)
a 1--a4 : arm lengths of actions (m), see Fig. 3.1.4
PB
The design values PHa and Pua of the wave force in equation (3.1.6) can be calculated using equation (3.1.3);
the design value Wa of the weight of the breakwater body can be calculated using equation (3.1.4). In cases
where a caisson has a footing with a rectangular cross section extending to both the seaward and landward sides,
equation (3.1.5) can be used in calculating the design value PBd of buoyancy.
Q) Examination of the stability against foundation failure at the bottom of the upright section can be conducted in
accordance with Chapter 2, 2.2.5 Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and Inclined Actions. As standard partial
factors for use in the performance verification, the values shown in Table 3.1.1 can be used.
@ In examinations of the bearing capacity of foundation ground, equation (3.1.7) can be used. The method shown
here is the simplified Bishop method, and is one method of calculating circular slip by the discrete method. The
simplified Bishop method is adopted because it is the model which can best explain stability with respect to
bearing capacity, in comparison with the modified Fellenius method and friction circle method, by experiments
in a centrifugal field.> However, deformation experiments with rubble mounds under the action of eccentric and
inclined loads have demonstrated that when a rubble mound fails, the sliding surface does not necessarily occur
along the circular arc with the lowest stability against slip failure. Caution is also necessary in adoption of this
method as numerical analysis using the discrete element method has shown that the actual failure mechanism is
different from circular slip failure according to the simplified Bishop method.5)
In the following equation, the symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscript d denote the
characteristic value.
(3.1.7)
where
PH : horizontal wave force (kN/m)
a 1 : arm length of horizontal wave force (m)
c' : for cohesive soil ground, undrained shear strength, and for sandy ground, apparent cohesion in
drained condition (kN/m2)
s : width of slice segment (m)
w' : weight of slice segment (kN/m)
q : surcharge acting on slice segment (kN/m)
If! : apparent angle of shear resistance based on effective stress (")
8 : angle formed by slice segment with bottom (")
F1 : supplementary parameter showing ratio of design value of resistance and design value of effect
of action
R : radius of slip circle (m)
Ya : structural analysis factor
The design values in the equation can be calculated using the following equations.
-600-
c'd =rcC't
w'd =rww't
(3.1.8)
qd = rqqlc
For the load width 2b' of the surcharge, adopting the average value, using the biases of the average value of the
design parameters, is standard. In addition, the partial factor 'Yq of the surcharge is set for the average value and
not for the characteristic value. These calculations can be performed using the following equation (3.1.9) and
equation (3.1.10). In these equations, denotes the average value of the parameter of the subscript, and IX1c
denotes the bias (average value/characteristic value) of the average value of the parameter X.
(3.1.9)
(3.1.10)
where
: buoyancy (k:N/m)
: uplift force (kN/m)
: horizontal wave force (k:N/m)
:
In the equation, X denotes the average value ofthe parameter X. The bias ofthe average value ofbuoyancy
can be calculated using equation (3.1.11). In Table 3.1.1, the bias ofthe average value of tidal levels is assumed
to be 1.00; therefore, here,pBIPBI,= 1.00 should be used.
(3.1.11)
where
wr : tidal level (m)
h : installation depth (m)
Be : width of breakwater body (m)
ht : height of footing (m)
B1 : width of footing (m)
CD
It is necessary to conduct an examination of stability with respect to slip failure referring to Chapter 2, 3.2.1
Stability Analysis by Circular Slip Failure Surface, considering the characteristics of the ground and the
@ In case soil improvement is to be performed, Chapter 2, 4 Soil Improvement Methods can be used as reference.
@ As the tidal level used in examination of slip failure ofthe ground, it is preferable to use the tidal level which is
most dangerous for the facilities. In determination of the tidal level, Part II, Chapter 2, 3 Tidal Level can be
used as reference.
Verification of circular slip failure of the foundation ground in the permanent situation for self weight can be
conducted using equation (3.1.12). In the following, the symbol 'Y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the
subscripts k and d denote the characteristic value and design value, respectively.
-601-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(3.1.12)
where
c' : for cohesive soil ground, undrained shear strength, and for sandy ground, apparent cohesion in
drained condition (kN/m2)
s : width of slice segment (m)
w' : weight of slice segment (kN/m)
q : spatially distributed load acting on slice segment, obtained by dividing effective weight of
breakwater body by width of breakwater body (kN/m)
If! : apparent angle of shear resistance based on effective stress ()
(} : angle formed by slice segment with bottom (")
The design values in the equation can be calculated using the following equations.
qa =r.q,
tanlfla = Ytmf tan'k
(3.1.13)
When all of the soil layers are below water level, the design value wd of the weight of the slice segments
can be calculated using equation (3.1.14). Because the unit weights of the soil layers and mound used when
calculating the weight of the slice segments contribute to both the action side and the resistance side, the unit
weights of the soil layers and mound are classified as
and w3, considering their positional relationship,
and the partial factors ?1> y2, and y3 are set for each, respectively. Caution is necessary with regard to the soil
layers and mound falling under these divisions, as the values will differ depending on the position of the mound
as shown in Fig. 3.1.5.
w" w,.
(3.1.14)
where
Wn;
In calculating the characteristic value of buoyancy, equation (3.1.5) can be used as reference, excluding the
terms in connection with the footing.
-602-
.
Fo...ot protection \rk
~oring work
Caisson
-
Mound
J_"'...:
,' i
.\
.....
w
w
2
3
Division of
unit weight
Division of
unit weight
w,
w,
w2
w,
w2
w,
CD
For the standard system failure probability of sliding, overturning, and foundation failure of the upright section
of composite breakwarers in variable situations due to the action ofwaves, and the partial factors for the standard
failure probability for circular slip failure in the permanent situation, the values shown in Table 3.1.1 can be
used as reference 3), 6). The standard system failure probability for sliding and overturning of the upright
section of composite breakwaters, and for the bearing failure of the foundation ground, has been obtained based
on evaluation by reliability theory for the average safety level of breakwaters designed by the conventional
design method.
For circular slip failure, a value of3.3, converted to failure probability, 4.5 x 10-, is set as the reliability index
which minimizes the expected total cost. Here, the expected total cost is expressed by the sum of the initial
construction cost and the expected value of the recovery cost due to failure.
If the safety level based on minimization of the expected total cost is evaluated by reliability theory, the
partial factors are as shown in Table 3.1.1 b). If based on the average value of the safety levels in the design
methods of the past, the reliability index is 6.5, failure probability: 3.1x10-11. For details, Reference 6) can be
used as reference.
@ In the table, a, IX,, and V are the sensitivity factor of each design paramerer, bias of the average value, and
coefficient of variation, respectively.
@ For the partial factors in connection with circular slip failure, when the soil under the breakwater body is improved
by the sand compaction pile (SCP) method with a replacement ratio of 30-80%, the partial factors shown in
4.10.6 Performance Verification for the sand compaction pile method in Chapter 2, 4 Soil Improvement
Methods shall be used.
-603-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 3.1.1 Standard Partial Factors
{a} Variable situations associated with waves
2.38
8.7xJ03
2.40
IX;
Yf
Friction coefficient
0.79
0.689
1.060
0.150
YpH Ypu
1.04
-0.704
0.740
0.239
Yw1
rw1=
1.5
1.03
rw1=
2.0, 2.5
-0.059
0.825
0.251
1.000
0.200
1.06
1.000
0.400
H.H.W.L.
1.00
YwRC
Unit weight of RC
0.98
0.030
0.980
0.020
YwNC
Unit weight of NC
1.02
0.025
1.020
0.020
i'wsAND
1.01
0.150
1.020
0.040
'YPn. 'YPu
1.15
-0.968
0.740
0.239
1.31
0.825
0.251
1.000
0.200
1.000
0.400
.,
Yw1
H.H.W.L.
1.00
YwRC
Unit weight of RC
0.98
0.044
0.980
0.020
i'wNc
Unit weight of NC
1.02
0.040
1.020
0.020
YwsAND
1.00
0.232
1.020
0.040
1.12
-0.894
0.740
0.239
1.26
0.825
0.251
Yq
0.91
0.640
0.605
0.061
Yw
1.00
0.032
1.000
0.030
0.96
0.288
1.000
0.059
y,.
0.99
0.072
1.000
0.059
Ya
1.00
... ""
YPH
.s~
1.
rfl<i
":a
&l<S
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
*S:
*6:
1.17
r...,
rw1=
1.5
1.04
rw1=
2.0, 2.5
1.09
-0.092
a: sensitivity factor, /Xi: bias of average value (average value/characteristic value), V: coefficient of variation.
RC: reinforced concrete, NC: non-reinforced concrete.
Change of water depth Mild/Steep: Gradient of sea bottom <1130/~l/30.
rwl denotes the ratio of the highest high water level (H.H.W.L.) and mean monthly-high water level (H.W.L.).
y, is applied to the average value of the surcharge. The average value of the surcharge is obtained using.q = "'f.Y/2b'.
In calculations of wave force, Goda's formulas is used.
-604-
y,.
3.3
4.SxJ0-4
y
0.90
a
0.285
IX,
1.00
0.038
0.90
0.380
1.00
0.038
1.00
-0.007
0.90
0.070
1.00
O.o3
0.90
0.125
1.00
-0.007
0.90
0.90
1.10
0.070
0.125
-0.463
1.00
O.o3
1.02
0.04
y..,..
"'
'Ywi
tJ
Yo
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
resistance
Spatially-distributed load
a: sensitivity factor, /Xi: bias of average value (average value/characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation.
Ywb Ywi. and 'Yw 3 are partial factors for the weight of the slice segment; classification follows that in Fig. 3.1.5.
Wave-dissipating work, etc. includes wave-dissipating work, armoring work, foot protection work, etc.
In application of the partial factors for circular slip failure, reference shall be made to the notes shown in Chapter 2 1 3 Stability of Slope,
3.1(7) Partial Factors. When soil is improved by the sand compaction pile (SCP) method with a replacement ratio of 30--80%, the partial
factors shown in 4.10.6 Performance Verification for the sand compaction pile method in Chapter2, 4 Soil Improvement Methods shall
be used.
Importance of facilities
High
Ordinary
Low
15%
30%
50"A>
!Ocm
Sliding
displacement
30cm
5%
IO"A>
20%
IOOcm
2.5%
5%
10%
-605-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) When the harbor side of the upright section is strengthened with a mound of rubble stones or concrete blocks,
careful attention must be paid to the following matters:
(a) The possibility of hindrance to ship navigation and mooring for within the harbor.
(b) In verification ofthe stability of the upright section for sliding and overturning ignoring strengthening section
behind the breakwater, the design value of resistance assuming the partial factor is 1.0 must exceed the design
value of the actions. If design value of resistance/design value of action is small, there will be a danger of
violent rocking of the upright section, increase in the heel pressure, and sliding or overturning of the upright
section to the seaward side during wave troughs.
(c) Adequate armoring must be provided so that the strengthening section will not be damaged by overtopped
waves.
(d) The height of the strengthening section h should preferably be 1/3 or greater of the height of the upright
section, and the width b should be the same as or greater than the height h.
(e) In the case of concrete block strengthening, construction should be made to ensure that there are no voids
between the concrete blocks and the upright section.
@ When the harbor side ofthe upright section is strengthened with rubble or blocks, ifthe height ofthe strengthening
material a is greater than 1/3 of the height of the upright section, and the top width b is greater than height a,
the performance verification for sliding can be conducted using equation (3.1.15). In the following equation,
the symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and d denote the characteristic value and
design value, respectively.
(3.1.15)
where
W
PB
Pu
Pn
Among the design values used in the equation, the design values of wave force Pnd and Pud and the design
value of the weight of the breakwater body Wd can be calculated using equation (3.1.3) and equation (3.1.4),
respectively. In cases where a caisson has a footing with a rectangular cross section extending to both the
seaward and landward sides, equation (3.1.5) can be used in calculating the design value PBd of buoyancy. The
design value of sliding resistance ~can be calculated by the following equation.
(3.1.16)
The characteristic value of sliding resistance R; can be calculated by the following method.
(a) Sliding resistance of rubble.
(3.1.17)
where
W, : weight in water of rubble above sliding surface, excluding uppermost armor layer (kN/m)
(} : angle of sliding surface (0 )
Rk =aW,
(3.1.18)
-606-
where
friction coefficient
a= 0.9 + 0.2(Hlh' - 0.5)
a = 0.4 + 0.2(H/h' - 0.5)
wave height (m)
h' : installation depth of breakwater (m)
r\T7"'\
~h'
~~!~-~-t-~~----
Regarding the bearing capacity of the foundation ground and slip failure of the ground when the harbor side
of the upright section is strengthened, it is preferable to conduct an appropriate examination referring to the
above-mentioned (4) Examination of Bearing Capacity of Foundation Ground and (5) Examination of Slip
of Ground.
(9) All partial factors shown here are values when the design working life is the normal 50 years. When it is necessary
to evaluate the stability of facilities during construction, verification must be conducted appropriately, considering
the conditions in which the facilities are placed, the return period of the actions, and the relationship with the
verification of the stability of the facilities when completed. In the performance verifications, the description in
3.4.4 (6) can be used, as equivalent to breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks.
(IO)Performance Verification of Seismic-resistant
In general, the performance verification for Level 1 earthquake ground motion is frequently omitted with
breakwaters. However, in cases where the installation depth is great and the design wave height is small, there are
cases in which actions due to Level I earthquake ground motion become predominant. In such cases, performance
verification of seismic-resistant is necessary.
The general procedure for performance verification of seismic-resistant of breakwaters is as shown in Fig.
3.1.7.
-607-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Judgment of necessity of
verification of seismic-resistance
Not necessary
11
r----------------~----------------~
'.
.J.
I
'.
.J.
I
Setting of filter
-----------------r----------------
'.
I Calculation of characteristic value of seismic coefficient for use in verification (see (12)@) I
Verification based on balance of forces (see (12)(1)@)
1
Dynamic analysis by model with I degree of freedom
END
*1: For breakwaters where damage to the objective facilities is assumed to have a serious impact on life, property, and socioeconomic
activity, it is preferable to confirm the amount of deformation by dynamic analysis.
determined in the variable situation in respect of waves and Level I earthquake ground motion. The judgment
of necessity can be made based on Fig. 3.1.8, from the relationship between the maximum acceleration on the
seismic bedrock and the ratio Bwfh of the breakwater body width Bw not including the footing and the water
depth h (a condition in which the ratio of the resistance force and effect of actions is smallest). The performance
verification of seismic-resistant can be omitted for cases where the maximum acceleration on the seismic bedrock
is positioned below the curve in the figure. It should be noted that this figure is prepared assuming the allowable
value of residual deformation of the upright section of the breakwater for Level 1 earthquake ground motion is
30cm. Therefore, if other allowable values are adopted, it is preferable to conduct a concrete verification of the
deformation.
-608-
........ .......
...
..
..
450
400
..
.. ...,,,... .....-
350
1;!
300
250
.-,
..!!~
200
UN
~] 150
~~
~~
::;: ,.c
-~"'
100
50
'
'
'
'
'
'
'
2.2
CD
General
In the performance verifications for sliding and overturning of the upright section and failure due to insufficient
capacity of the foundation ground in variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion, it
is possible to evaluate whether performance is maintained by a direct evaluation of deformation by detailed
methods such as dynamic analysis methods. However, verifications can also be performed by simplified
methods such as the seismic coefficient method. In this case, the seismic coefficient for the verification which
is to be used in the performance verification needs to be set appropriately, corresponding to the deformation
of the facilities in question, considering the frequency characteristics of the ground motion. In general, the
seismic coefficient for verification assumes Level 1 earthquake ground motion in the seismic bedrock as the
input ground motion and is smaller than the seismic coefficient (a.,,,Jg) obtained as the ratio of the maximum
acceleration a.,.,, in the acceleration time history of the bottom of the caisson obtained by a one-dimensional
seismic response analysis and the gravitational acceleration g.
@ An outline of the method of calculating the seismic coefficient for verification is shown in Fig. 3.1.9. First, the
Level 1 earthquake ground motion in the seismic bedrock is set, and the acceleration time history at the bottom
of the caisson is calculated by a one-dimensional seismic response analysis using this as the input ground
motion. The result of a fast Fourier transform (FFT) of the acceleration time history obtained in this maoner is
multiplied by a filter which considers the frequency characteristics of the ground motion, and the acceleration
time history at the bottom of the caisson after filter processing is calculated by performing an inverse fast
Fourier transform (IFF1) on the result of the previous calculation. The characteristic value of the seismic
coefficient for verification is then calculated using the maximum value of this acceleration time history.
-609-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
r------------------------------------------
Bottom of caisson
Acceleration spectrum
at bottom of caisson
Engineering
bedrock
Filter
~------------------
r----------------------------
~=------------
,---------------------------,
I ~----------_!
-610-
D,., ,,depending on whether friction enhancement mats are used or not, the maximum deformation can be
D,.,
calciilated if residual deformation is given. Here, the standard allowable value of deformation
1 of a
breakwater for Level 1 earthquake ground motion can be given as D,., 1 = 30cm. The shape of the filter in
this case is as shown in Fig. 3.1.10.
-
D
mu.
D~,
Die. t
(3.1.19)
where
: maximum deformation (cm)
: target value of residual deformation (D,.. 1 = 30cm)
accmax' accmin : the maximum acceleration and the minimUm acceleration in acceleration time history
of caisson bottom (cmfs2)
Dmox
Dres_t
1
af' +bf +l
(3.1.20)
0.0145D_ -0.022
{
a= 0.0178D_ -0.0035
b = {0.0074D_ + 0.8542
0.0095D_ +0.8174
where
J : frequency (Hz)
a, b : coefficients
Dmox : maximum deformation (cm)
kh
=a-/g
(3.1.21)
where
a,.,. : the maximum value of acceleration at caisson bottom after filter processing (cm/s2)
g
(j) When conducting a performance verification based on the balance of forces, the performance verification can
be performed using equation (3.1.22) and equation (3.1.23). In this case, the cross section obtained in the
variable situation is respect of waves can be used as the cross section for verification. The tidal level shall be
the condition which gives the smallest ratio of the resistance force and the effect of actions. In the following
-611-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
equations, the symbol y is the partial factor for its subscript, and the subscripts k and d denote the characteristic
value and design value, respectively.
(Sliding stability)
(Overturning stability)
(3.1.22)
(3.1.23)
where
7
2
Pd =-k.p.gH
w
12
(3.1.24)
:n;
Here, the design value of the seismic coefficient for verification in equation (3.1.22) and equation (3.1.23) can
be calculated by the following equation. For k.,, the seismic coefficient for verification obtained by equation
(3.1.21) can be used.
(3.1.25)
The design value of the weight of the breakwater body and the design value of the buoyancy acting on the
breakwater body can be calculated using equation (3.1.4) and equation (3.1.5), respectively.
Here, all of the partial factors with the exception of the structural analysis factors can be assumed to be 1.00,
and the structural analysis factors for sliding and overturning can be assumed to be 1.2 and 1.1, respectively.
@ Verification ofthe bearing capacity can be performed referring to Chapter 2, 2.2 Shallow Spread Foundations,
giving appropriate consideration to actions due to ground motion. For breakwaters in which stability with
respect to the bearing capacity and settlement of the foundation ground due to Level I earthquake ground
motion are major problems, it is preferable to conduct a detailed examination by dynamic analysis.
(13)Performance Verification for Level 2 earthquake ground motion
The performance verification in the accidental situation in respect ofLevel 2 earthquake ground motion is equivalent
to that for the gravity-type quaywa!ls. Therefore, Part ill, Chapter 5, 2.2.3 (8) Performance Verification for
Ground Motion (Detailed Methods) can be used as reference. Provided, however, that the breakwaters are only
affected by settlement, with the exception of cases where settlement is a problem, no verification is frequently
necessary. A simplified method of predicting the amount of settlement from the results of a I-dimensional analysis
is proposed, and depending on the accuracy necessary in the predicted value of the settlement, it is also possible
to substitute the simplified method.
(14)Performance Verification for Tsunamis
CD
In performance verifications for tsunamis, 6 Tsunami Protection Breakwaters can be used as reference.
@ Partial factors
For the partial factors for use in examination of the stability of the upright section of composite breakwaters in
the accidental situation in respect of tsunamis against sliding and overturning and the stability against failure
due to insufficient bearing capacity of the foundation ground, Table 3.1.3 can be used as reference. Provided,
however, that the values shown in Table 3.1.3 are standard values which are used when setting the wave
force of the largest class tsunami assumed at the construction location of the facilities as an accidental action.
Accordingly, in cases where uncertainty is expected in calculation of the characteristic value of the tsunami
force, the structural analysis factor should be set to an appropriate value of LO or larger, as necessary.
-612-
Yt
Friction coefficient
YPn. "/pu
Tsunami force
Yw1
rwFl.5
rwF2.0,2.5
.8
H.H.W.l..
YwRC
YwNC
YwsAND
YPn, Ypu
Yw1
YwFl.5
Y,
r.,4.0, 2.5
.8
H.H.W.l..
Yw&e
YwNC
YwSAND
;,
Ya
YPH
Yq
~ ~
Yw
u 0
Yi..;
Unit weight of RC
Unit weight of NC
Unit weight offilling sand
~c
~
-~ y,.
&l <8
Ya
Unit weight of RC
Unit weight of NC
Unit weight offilling sand
Structural analysis factor
Tsunami force
Surcharge on slice segment
IX,
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
t: a: sensitivity factor, IX~ bias of average value (average value/characteristic value), V: coefficient of variation.
2: RC: reinforced concrete, NC: non-reinforced concrete.
CD
With breakwaters, the examination is conducted for slip failure of the rubble section. However, this may be
examined as slip failure due to eccentric and inclined loads.
@ For slip failure due to eccentric and inclined loads, Chapter 2, 2.2.5 Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and
Inclined Actions can be used as reference.
@ ht armor units for the rubble section, in addition to an adequate stable mass against wave force, the thickness
should be sufficient to prevent flowing out of the materials in the mound interior.
@ For the required mass of armor units, Chapter 2, 1.7.2 Required Mass of Armor Stones and Blocks in
Composite Breakwater Foundation Mound against Waves can be used as reference.
As the required mass of the rubble and blocks under the armor units, it is preferable that the mass of these
materials be approximately 1/20 or more that of the armor units. It is preferable that the mass of the stones under
these underlying materials be approximately 1/20 or more than that of the underlying materials.
CD
In comparison with the breakwater trunk, there are various unclear points regarding scouring of the foundation
-613-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
and actions affecting the heads of breakwaters. Therefore, it is preferable that the mass of the armor stones
and armor blocks be set larger for the breakwater head than for the trunk. In calculations of the mass of armor
units, Chapter 2, 1.7.2 Required Mass of Armor Stones and Blocks in Composite Breakwater Foundation
Mound against Waves can be used as reference.
@ In the case of soft ground, slip failure in the direction of the breakwater extension should also be examined. In
this case, the frictional resistance of the sides of the slip surface may also be considered.
@ In the performance verification of concave corners, increase of the wave height should be considered.
@) In breakwater alignment which includes concave corners, in addition to the concentration of waves at the
concave corner itself, an increase in wave height based on superposition of the reflected waves from the various
parts in the breakwater alignment will also occur around the corners. Because there have been examples of
damage which is considered to be attributable to this phenomenon, in determining the breakwater alignment
and calculating stability, examination can be performed using Part II, Chapter 2, 4.3 Wave Transformations
and 4.7.2(8) Calculation of Wave Force considering Effect of Alignment of Breakwater.
3.1.5 Performance Verification of Structural Members
In the performance verification ofstructural members for caissons, cellular blocks, and hybrid caissons, Chapter 2,
1 Structural Members can be used as refurence.
3.1.6 Structural Details
Items for respective types of upright sections are described in (l)to(4). Common items are described in (5) and after.
(1) Caisson Type Composite Breakwaters
Q) Various materials are used as filling in caissons, including concrete, concrete blocks, stones, gravel, sand and
slag. When selecting a filling material, it is prefurable to consider construction costs, construction conditions
and natural conditions.
In general, sand is frequently used. However, when sand or gravel is used as a filling material, it is necessary
to cover the surface completely with a concrete lid or blocks. Slag may absorb water and expand, depending
on the type of material. Accordingly, when using slag, attention should be paid to the material properties of the
slag as a filling material, including the method of treating the slag before filling the caissons.
@ The thickness of the concrete lid should normally be 30 cm or greater, and should be 50 cm or greater under
rough sea conditions. There are also examples of the thickness of 1.0 m or greater in the cases where wave
conditions are severe and the concrete lids are left without placement of crown concrete for a long time.
@ Because there are many unclear points regarding the wave forces acting on crown concrete, the concrete lid
placement should be performed in such a way that the crown concrete is integrated with the breakwater body.
Methods of further increasing integration of the concrete lid with the crown concrete include pouring of the
crown concrete in such a way that it is squeezed inside the caisson, fabrication of concave/convex shapes in the
concrete lid (frequently used with the precast concrete), use ofreinforcing bars or shape steel, see Fig. 3.1.10.
In order to unify the parapet and crown concrete, it is preferable to adopt a method such a providing tenons at
Because scouring of the foundation occurs easily at the bottom of the upright section, when the structure is not
Crown
Crown
Crown
1.
Concrete lid
..
.'
'
.' .
Concrete lid
'
..
Concrete lid
-614-
Q) Methods of stacking blocks include horizontal stacking and inclined stacking. In general, however, horizontal
stacking is used considering ease of construction work. In the crown concrete, it is prefurable to provide joints
at intervals of 10-20m in the direction of breakwater alignment. In case of horizontal stacking, in order to
maintain integration, it is prefurable that vertical joints in the cross section perpendicular to the breakwater
alignment be arranged in a cross-stitched form so as not to penetrate from the top to the bottom.
@ With concrete blocks, in order to avoid sliding, a method of mutual interlocking using concave/convex shaped
tenon joints of the shape shown in Fig. 3.1.11 is generally used. In many cases, the width a and height b of the
convex part are on the order of 50cm and 20cm, respectively, and the width d and height b' of the convex parts
are approximately 5cm larger than the corresponding parts a and b.
b'
a'
Q) It is prefurable that a footing be attached to the bottommost layer of cellar blocks secure stability.
@ Concrete or stones can be used as filling for cellular blocks. If concrete is used as the filling, poor integration
of the upright section cellular block type is eliminated.
@ Because integration is reduced if cellular blocks are laid in two layers, it is preferable to use a one block type
whenever possible. If blocks are obliged to be laid in layers, the integration should be increased by interlocking
of the upper and lower layers by fabricating convex/concave shape at the top and bottom of the wall of the
cellular blocks, as shown in Fig. 3.1.2(c).
If stones are to be used as filling, a bottom plate shall be provided on the cellular blocks in order to prevent
dislodgement of the stones From the cellular section.
@ A certain degree of irregularity on the foundation surface does not pose a serious problem. However, together
with carefully removing sand, debris, and seaweed on the bedrock in order to assure good adhesion with the
concrete, parts in contact with the shuttering form should also be leveled to improve contact with the shuttering
form.
(5) The rubble mound foundation of composite breakwater is extremely important to ensure the stability of the
upright section. Particularly if the rubble mound beneath the upright section is scoured or washed out, the upright
section will lean or easily experience sliding failure, and then the upright structure will be destroyed at worst.
It is therefore necessary to protect the rubble mound beneath the upright section with foot protection blocks and
prevent damage from scouring or washing-out due to the action of waves or currents.
(6) Uplift forces acting on blocks can be reduced and stability against waves can be greatly improved by providing
holes in foot protection blocks.
(1) Because the study by Tanimoto et al.8) shows that large holes in foot protection blocks reduce the effect of
preventing scouring and washing out, the opening ratio of about 10% is optimal.
(8) It is prefurable that two or more rows of foot protection blocks be placed on the seaward side of the upright section
and one or more rows on the harbor side.
(9) The required thickness of the foot protection blocks can be determined by using equation (3.1.26).28)
-615-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
I I H113
= df (h' I h)--0
7 7
'
(3.1.26)
where
<ft : 0.18 for the breakwater trunk, 0.21 for the breakwater head (m)
h : design water depth (m)
h' : water depth at the top of rubble mound foundation excluding the foot protection blocks (m)
the application range should be hrh=0.4-1.0.
(IO)For the determination of the dimensions of the foot protection block, the required thickness can be calculated
using equation (3.1.26) and the din3ensions listed can be determined using Table 3.1.4. Examples of the block
shapes and dimensions are shown in Fig. 3.1.12.
Mass (t/unit)
Dimensions
l(m)xb(m)xt(m)
2.5xJ.5x0.8
3.0x2.5xl.O
4.0x2.5xl.2
5.0x2.5xl.4
5.0x2.5xl.6
5.0x2.5xl.8
5.0x2.5x2.0
5.0x2.5x2.2
0.8 or less
1.0 or less
1.2 or less
1.4 or less
1.6 or less
1.8 or less
2.0 or less
2.2 or less
Block without
openings
6.90
17.25
27.60
40.25
46.00
51.75
57.50
63.25
,
b
,
4.0X2.5Xl.2
,
b
,
2.5Xl.5X0.8
3.0X2.SX1.0
Block with
openings
6.23
15.64
24.84
37.03
42.32
47.61
52.90
58.19
0.
05
1.6
3.0
0.6
b
,
3,0X2.5Xl.4
I
2.2
5.0
77 7
//7
20
"
-616-
at the toe of slope, and the placement of concrete blocks, mattress work, asphalt mats 29), 30), or composite resin
mats. For the prevention of the settlement of the rubble mound due to washing-out, mattress works and other
methods including the spreading of canvas sheets are employed.31)
-617-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Examples of the cross sections of the upright breakwaters are shown in Fig. 3.2.1.
Crown concrete
Seaward side
sz
Harbor side
H.W.L
Concrete lid
Caissons
Foot protection blocks
Seaward side
sz
Harbor side
H.W.L
Concrete blocks
Foot protection blocks
Foot protection'-----"----'
blocks \
Armor stones
/Armor stones
-618-
Examples of the cross sections of the sloping breakwaters are shown in Fig. 3.3.1.
Seaward side
Crown concrete
Harbor side
sz H.W.L
Harbor side
Precast concrete
sz
(1) The crown height can be determined by applying that ofthe composite breakwaters and can be set in accordance
with 3.1.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section.
(2) Because the sloping breakwaters transmit waves, caution is necessary in setting the crown height, as there are
cases where the transmitted wave height in the harbor is greater that with upright breakwaters having the same
crown height. For wave overtopping and transmitted waves, Part II, Chapter 2, 4.3.7 Wave Runup Hight, Wave
Overtopping and Transmitted Waves can be used as reference.
(3) The crest width can be set based on the results of appropriate model experiments.
(4) When waves overtop heavily, a sufficiently broad crown width is required because the armor units on the top of
the breakwater will become unstable.
(5) For breakwaters constructed from land as a rubble mound sloping breakwater extending from the shore, in addition
to an adequate width necessary for the performance verification, the width should also be determined considering
ease of construction.
(6) The slope gradient should be appropriately determined based upon the stability calculation.
(7) For breakwaters on soft ground, the crown height and construction method can be determined by applying those
ofthe composite breakwaters, and can be set based on 3.1.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section.
(8) If the crest of breakwater covered with deformed concrete blocks is set at an elevation of 0.6H113 above the mean
monthly-highest water level, the crown width may be equivalent to that of three or more blocks as shown in Fig.
3.3.2. Because the stability of the breakwater top section will depend upon the characteristics of the armor units
and wave conditions, however, it is desirable to determine the width based upon appropriate hydraulic model tests.
-619-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(9) There are many cases where the slope gradient for rubble mound type sloping breakwaters is about 1: 2 on
the seaward side of the breakwater and about 1: 1.5 on the harbor side, and about 1: 1.3 to 1: 1.5 in the case of
breakwaters covered with defurmed concrete blocks. When the gradient of the slope and the mass of the armor
units are different between the upper and lower portions of the slope on the seaward side of the breakwater, the
point at which the gradient and the mass of armor units change should be deeper than l.5H113 below the design
water level.
0.6H113 or more
3 blocks or more
~~_,__ _ _--l
----=~==--~~'6WL:::,WL:::,WLi.
HW.L
Concrete blocks
The number of pieces listed above are the number of hatched blocks
in the upper layer of the crown.
Fig. 3.3.2 Crown Width of Sloping Breakwater
3.3.3 Performance Verification
(!) In the verification of the stability of sloping breakwaters having a superstructure, 3.1 Gravity-type Breakwaters
(Composite Breakwaters) can be used as a reference.
(2) Performance verification of stability of superstructure
Examination of the stability of the superstructure in the variable situation in respect of waves is generally
performed for sliding and overturning of the superstructure.
(3) Performance Verification of Stability of Sloping Section
CD
In sloping breakwaters, slip failure of the rubble mound section is examined. The examination of slip of the
rubble mound section can be performed for slip due to eccentric and inclined loads.
@ For slip failure due to eccentric and inclined loads, Chapter 2, 2.2.5 Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and
Inclined Actions can be used as a reference.
@ In the armor materials of the rubble mound section, in addition to an adequate stable mass against wave forces,
the thickness should also be adequate to prevent sucking-out of the material in the mound interior.
In calculation of the necessary mass of armor units, Chapter 2, 1.7 Armor Stones and Block can be used as a
reference.
@ In case regular placing and stone panels are used rather than pellmell placing of the armor material, the
necessary mass may be determined depending on the judgment of the responsible engineer. The thickness of
the armor layer in case of pellmell placing shall generally be 2 layers.
@ As the required mass of the rubble and blocks under the armor materials, it is preferable that the mass of these
materials be approximately 1/10 to 1/15 that of the armor units or more. It is preferable that the mass of the
stones under these underlying units be approximately 1/20 that of the underlying units or more.
(4) Partial Factors
As partial factors for sliding and overturning of the superstructure of sloping breakwaters, the partial factors
shown in Table 3.3.1 may be used. The partial factors shown in Table 3.3.1 were set considering the settings in
the conventional design method.
As partial factors for use in verification of the bearing capacity of the foundation ground and circular slip
failure ofthe ground, the partial factors shown in Chapter 2, 2.2.5 Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and Inclined
Actions and Chapter 2, 3.2.1 Stability Analysis using Circular Slip Failure Surface, respectively, may be used
with the appropriate modifications.
-620-
Yr
YpH' YPu
Yw1
i~
YwNc
YwsAND
Ya
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
Unit wei2ht of RC
Unit weight of NC
Unit weight offilling sand
Structural analysis factor
YpH' Ypu
Ywl
rw1~I.5
Yw/=2.0, 2.5
H.ILW.L.
!;l
Yw1=l.S
rw/=2.0, 2.5
H.ILW.L.
Ywo~
-~
Friction coefficient
Change of water depth: Mild
Change of water depth: Steep
YWNc
l'w:C!A"ll.m
Unit weight of RC
Unit weight of NC
Unit wei2ht of filling sand
Ya
YwRC
IX1
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.20
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.20
a: sensitivity factor, /Xi: bias of average value (average value/characteristic value1 V: coefficient of variation.
RC: reinforced concrete, NC: non-reinforced concrete.
Change of water depth Mild/Steep: Gradient of sea bottom <1130/;;;:;l/30.
rwl denotes the ratio of the highest high water level (H.H.W.L.) and mean monthly-high water level (H.W.L.).
-621-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Examples of the cross sections of breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks are showo in Fig. 3.4.1.
Seaward side
Harbor side
Armor blocks
Seaward side.,,...-..,-,==-=="'
Crown concrete
dissipating
blocks
Caissons
Foot protection
works
--='"_'=-H~~W~.L~_ _ _ ,,w,ave~
Harbor side
uu
Armor stones
Fig. 3.4.1 Examples nf Cross Sections of Breakwaters Covered with Wave-dissipating Blocks
3.4.2 Setting of Basic Cross Section
(!) The crown height of the upright section is equivalent to that of composite breakwaters and shall be set to a height
which satisfies performance requirements, referring to 3.1.4 Performance Verification.
(2) When the crown height of wave-dissipating works is lower than that ofthe upright section, the impulsive breaking
wave force is likely to act on the upright section. Contrary to this, where the former crowo height is higher than
the latter, blocks at the crown will become unstable.
(3) In order to achieve a sufficient wave-dissipating performance, the crown width of the wave-dissipating works
must have the width equivalent to two or more units of wave absorbing blocks 32), 33).
(4) The thickness of the superstructure and installed crown height of caissons can be considered equivalent to those
of the upright breakwaters. The thickness of the rubble mound section can be considered equivalent to that of the
composite breakwaters.
(5) With the breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks, overtopping waves and transmitted waves will be
smaller in comparison with the upright breakwaters and the composite breakwaters with the same crown heights.
For overtopping waves and transmitted waves, Part IJ, Chapter 2, 4 Waves can be used as a reference.
(6) Wave-dissipating works have the functions of decreasing the wave pressure, overtopping waves, transmitting
waves and reflecting waves. Accurate evaluation of these functions should preferably be made based upon
hydraulic model tests.
(7) Ifthe vertical faces ofthe upright section are not fully covered with wave-dissipating blocks at the tip ofbreakwater
extension, large wave forces are likely to act on these vertical faces. Caution is necessary.
(!) Performance Verification and Partial Factors for Sliding, Overturning Foundation, Failure, and Circular Slip
Failure
CD
Partial factors
For the partial factors for the standard system failure probabilities for sliding and overturning of the upright
-622-
section of breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks and foundation failure of in the variable situation
in respect of the action ofwaves, and for the standard failure probability for circular slip failure in the permanent
situation, the values in Table 3.4.1 can be used as reference 3), 34). The standard system failure probabilities
of sliding and overturning of the upright section of breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks and
foundation failure is based on an evaluation by reliability theory of the average safuty levels of breakwaters
designed by the conventional design method.') For circular slip failure, the target reliability index is set at 3.6,
converted failure probability of 2.0 x J0-4, which minimizes the expected sum cost expressed by the total of
the initial construction cost and the expected value of the recovery costs associated with failure recovery. Ifthe
safety level based on minimization ofthe expected total cost is evaluated by reliability theory, the partial factors
are as shown in Table 3.4.1 (b).34) If based on the average safuty level of the conventional design method, the
average reliability index is 6.9, converted failure probability of3.l x J0-12_34)
Table 3.4.1 Standard Partial Factors
(a) Variable situations in respect of waves
gi>
2.38
8.7x!0-3
IX,
Friction coefficient
Y
0.77
Yr
0.750
1.060
0.150
'YPn, "IPu
0.91
-0.636
0.702
0.191
1.01
0.772
0.205
rwFl.S
1.04
1.000
0.200
YwF2.0,2.5
1.08
1.000
0.400
H.H.W.L.
1.00
Yw~
Unit weight of RC
0.98
0.030
0.980
0.020
Yw,,,
Unit weight of NC
1.02
0.031
1.020
0.020
Yw-
1.01
0.150
1.020
0.040
YPn, YPu
1.01
-0.962
0.702
0.191
1.14
0.772
0.205
Yw1
YwFl.5
YwF2.0,2.5
H.H.W.L.
1.06
1.000
0.200
1.000
0.400
Yw~
Unit weight of RC
0.98
Yw,,,
Unit weight of NC
Yw-
Y,.
Yw1
:a
~
gi>
a
~
~
;
~
y,
t"b
~"0 y.
u
~1
2.40
Ytm;'
~iB Y<"
Ya
-0.081
-0.133
1.13
0.050
0.980
0.020
1.02
0.054
1.020
0.020
1.00
0.248
1.020
0.040
0.97
-0.842
1.09
1.00
0.702
0.191
0.772
0.205
0.93
0.525
0.367
0.058
1.00
0.047
1.000
0.030
0.95
0.353
1.000
0.061
0.99
0.112
1.000
0.061
1.00
t: a: sensitivity factor, IX1 : bias of average value (average value/characteristic value), V: coefficient of variation.
-623-
q = LV/2b'
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 3.4.1 Standard Partial Factors
(b) Permanent situation
3.6
2.0xJ0-4
0.90
1.00
-0.034
0.90
-0.027
0.90
0.285
1.00
-0.034
0.90
-0.027
0.90
0.285
1.10
-0.410
1"
y..,..
Ywi
]
;a
.&
Ol
iD
y
0.90
a
0.327
0.364
sea bottom
y,
IX,
1.00
0.035
1.00
O.o35
1.00
0.03
1.00
0.03
1.02
0.04
*1: a: sensitivity factor, IX1 : bias of average value (average value/characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation.
*2: Yi. y2 , and y3 are partial factors for the weight of the slice segments.
*3: The calculated y1112 is 1.0. However, considering convenience in performance verification, the same value as for composite breakwaters,
0.9, was adopted.34)
*4: Wave-dissipating work, etc. includes wave-dissipating work, armoring work, foot protection work.
s: In application of the partial factors for circular slip failure, reference shall be made to the notes shown in Chapter 2, 3 Stability of Slopes,
3.1 (7) Partial Factors. When soil is improved by the sand compaction pile (SCP) method with a replacement ratio of 30-800/o, the partial
factors shown in 4.10.6 Performance Verification for the sand compaction pile method in Chapter 4 Soil Improvement Methods shall
be used.
CD
In calculating the necessary mass of armor unit for breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating
blocks, Chapter 2, 1.7 Armor Stones and Blocks can be used as a reference.
@ In case regular placing and stone panels are used rather than pellmell placing ofthe armor material, the necessary
mass may be determined at the judgment of the responsible engineer. The thickness of the armor layer in case
of pellmell placing shall generally be 2 layers or more.
(3) Performance Verification For Stability of Breakwater Tip
It is preferable that the tip of breakwaters covered with wave-dissipating blocks be constructed in a semi-circular
shape using armor units with a mass of 1.5 times that of the trunk or more. For calculation of the mass of wavedissipating blocks, Chapter 2, 1.7 Armor Stones and Blocks can be used as a reference.
(4) Performance Verification for Stability of Wave-dissipating Work
In the performance verifications, Chapter 2, 1.7 Armor Stones and Blocks can be used as a refi:rence.
(5) All partial factors indicated here are values for the case where the design working life is the normal 50 years.
Because techniques for the period during construction where a structure is left for a certain period with an
unfinished cross section have not been particularly examined at the present point in time, for convenience, the
verification may be carried out using the same partial factors as for composite breakwaters when completed, using
actions of waves with a probability on the order of 10 years.37)
(6) The performance verification in the accidental situation in respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion is
equivalent to that for gravity-type quaywalls. The method shown in (9) Performance Verification for Ground
Motion (detailed methods) of Chapter 5, 2.2.3 Performance Verification can be used as a reference.
-624-
Harbor side
Upright wave-absorbing blocks
Superstructure
sz
H.W.L
Ann.or stones
Rubble for foundation
Fig. 3.5.1 Example of Cross Section of Upright Wave-absorbing Block Type Breakwater
(4) It is preferable that the crown height hi be at least 0.5 times higher or more than the significant wave height used
in the stability examination of the facilities above mean monthly-high water level. It is preferable that the bottom
height hu be set to a depth 2 times or greater than the significant wave height used in the stability examination of
the facilities below the mean monthly-high water level (see Fig. 3.5.2).
-625-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
hc"i!;.1.0H11J
h~~0.5H1 /J
Crest elevation of
wav<>-absorbin block section h,
hu~2.0H113
~i----.,,,~IL~W~L~~_..h_'_,_"'-'_;_~~'-~~~-h+'l"'Uprightwav<>-absorbing
- L.W.L.
.:.-:..
blocks
Bottom elevation of
wave-absorbin block section
Foundation mound
Fig. 3.5.2 Explanatory Diagram for Crown height of Upright wave-absorbing Block Type Breakwaters
3.5.3 Performance Verification
(!) Performance Verification and Partial Factors for Sliding, Overturning, Foundation Failure of the Ground, and
Circular Slip Failure
Q) Verification of the stability of upright wave-absorbing block type breakwaters can be considered equivalent to
that for the composite breakwaters. Provided, however, that it is necessary to use the values shown below for
the standard partial factors used in the verification of sliding, overturning, and failure of the bearing capacity of
the foundation ground.
@ Partial factors
(a) As partial factors for standard system failure probabilities for sliding and overturning of the upright section
of upright wave-absorbing block type breakwaters and foundation failure of the foundation ground, in the
variable situation in respect of the action of waves, the values in Table 3.5.1 can be used as a reference.
The partial factors for the standard failure probability for circular slip failure in the permanent situation are
equivalent to those for the composite breakwaters. Table 3.1.1 of 3.1.4 (6) Performance Verification and
Partial Factors for Sliding, Overturning, Bearing Failure of Foundation Ground, and Circular Slip
-626-
2.04
2.lxJ0-2
2.12
-~
:g
"'
f
c5
.5~-~
~
&l<l
IX,
Yr
Friction coefficient
0.83
0.689
1.060
0.150
"/pH, "fPu
1.09
-0.708
0.812
0.230
1.22
0.893
0.242
Yw1
TwFl.5
1.05
1.000
0.200
0.400
-0.125
r wt=2.0, 2.5
1.11
1.000
H.H.W.L.
1.00
Yw~
Unit weight of RC
0.980
0.020
Yw=
Yw-
Unit weight of NC
1.02
0.113
1.020
0.020
1.020
0.040
'YPH, "/pu
1.20
-0.974
0.812
0.230
1.34
0.893
0.242
Yw1
rwFl.5
1.08
1.000
0.200
r wt=2.0, 2.5
1.15
1.000
0.400
H.H.W.L.
1.00
-0.182
0.980
0.020
0.172
1.020
0.020
1.020
0.040
1.15
-0.856
0.812
0.230
1.28
0.893
0.242
Yq
0.90
0.625
0.685
0.074
Yw
1.00
0.050
1.000
0.030
Yun;
0.95
0.324
1.000
0.070
y,.
0.98
0.164
1.000
0.070
Ya
0.76
Yw~
Unit weight of RC
Yw~
Unit weight of NC
1.01
'YwsAND
Yp,
'ls
.se
[;! ..
*1: a: sensitivity factor, /Xi: bias of average value (average value/characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation.
*2: RC: reinforced concrete, NC: non-reinforced concrete.
*3: Change of water depth Mild/Steep: Gradient of sea bottom <1130/~l/30.
*4: rwl denotes the ratio of the highest high water level (H.H.W.L.) and mean monthly-high water level (H.W.L.).
s: y'l is a term which is multiplied by the average value of the surcharge. The average value of the surcharge is obtained using q =
-627-
"'V/2b'.
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ It can reduce wave force. In particular, when the mound is high, there are cases in which powerful impulsive
breaking wave force acts on conventional caisson breakwaters; however, with wave-absorbing caisson type
it possesses a sea water aeration function, as the breakwater structure promotes mixing of air bubbles with the
water. In addition, the wave chamber has the effect of fish banks.46), 47)
(3) Fig. 3.6.1 shows an example of the cross section of a wave-absorbing caisson type breakwater. Depending on the
shapes of the respective elements and the combination of elements, various types of structures are conceivable,
including vertical slit-wall caissons, horizontal slit-wall caissons, curved-slit caissons, perforated-wall caissons,
and others. As the structural type for wave-absorbing caisson type breakwaters, an appropriate structure should
be selected considering the design conditions, use conditions, economy, etc. based on a careful investigation of the
wave-absorbing performance, and wave resistance of each structure.
(4) For the structures and their features of various types of wave-absorbing caisson type breakwaters the Technical
Others
Bottom slab
verification of the structural members, corresponding to the purpose of wave absorption and the wave conditions.
(2) In many cases, wave-absorbing caissons are generally adopted for the purpose of reducing reflected waves.
Consequently, it is preferable to determine the conditions of the waves which are the object of wave-absorption
and the target reflection coefficient corresponding to the required wave-absorbing performance. In particular,
because the reflection coefficient of wave-absorbing caissons differs remarkably depending on the wave periods,
-628-
the conditions ofthe waves which are the object ofwave-absorption should be determined based on an investigation
of the characteristics of wave height and wave period.
(3) It is necessary to determine wave force using calculation formulas suitable for the wave-absorbing caisson type
breakwaters or hydraulic model tests adapted to the conditions. In particular, in complex structures, in addition
to the wave force used in the stability examination of the upright section as a whole, it is preferable also to conduct
an adequate examination for the wave forces acting on the structural members. For wave forces acting on waveabsorbing caisson type breakwaters, Part II, Chapter 2, 4.7.2(7) Wave Forces on Upright Wave-absorbing
Caisson can be used as a reference.
(4) As the wave force used in the performance verification of the structural members, the most severe wave force
conditions for each member should be used. For wave forces acting on the structural members of the waveabsorbing caisson type breakwaters, Part II, Chapter 2, 4.7.2(7) Wave Forces on Upright Wave-absorbing
Caisson, and 1.5.2 Action of Chapter 2, 1.5 Upright Wave-absorbing Caissons, can be used as a reference.
-629-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) In addition to wave-absorbing performance, tbe structure and dimensions of tbe wave-absorbing section are also
related to wave overtopping, transmitted waves and wave force. Therefore, it is preferable to determine the
CD
The verification oftbe stability ofwave-absorbing caisson type breakwaters can be considered equivalent to tbat
for the composite breakwaters. Provided, however, that it is necessary to use the values shown below for the
standard partial factors used in tbe verification of sliding, overturning, and foundation failure.
@ Partial factors
As tbe standard system failure probabilities for sliding and overturning oftbe upright section of wave-absorbing
caisson type breakwaters and failure of tbe bearing capacity of tbe foundation ground, in tbe variable situation
in respect of tbe action of waves, tbe values in Table 3.6.1 can be used as a reference. The partial factors for
tbe standard failure probability for circular slip failure in tbe permanent situation are equivalent to tbose for tbe
composite breakwaters. Table 3.1.1 of 3.1.4 (6) Performance Verification and Partial Factors for Sliding,
Overtnrning, Foundation Failure, and Circnlar Slip Failure can be used as a refurence.
-630-
2.05
2.0xJ02
2.10
Friction coefficient
0.84
0.661
1.060
0.150
1.07
-0.732
0.799
0.223
1.20
0.882
0.235
Yw1
rwFl.5
1.02
1.000
0.200
rwF2.0,2.S
1.04
1.000
0.400
... .,,
H.H.W.L.
1.00
Unit weight of RC
0.98
0.059
0.980
0.020
Yw~
Unit weight of NC
1.02
0.014
1.020
0.020
Yw-
I.OJ
0.135
1.020
0.040
YPH, "IPu
1.16
-0.971
1.30
-~i
.Jl.S
0.223
0.235
1.000
0.200
1.03
YwF2.0,2.S
H.H.W.L.
1.05
1.000
0.400
1.00
Yw~
Unit weight of RC
0.97
0.124
0.980
0.020
Yw~
Unit weight of NC
1.02
0.015
1.020
0.020
Yw-
1.00
0.180
1.020
0.040
y,H
1.12
-0.852
0.799
0.223
1.25
0.882
0.235
I.OJ
1.000
0.041
~=.9:
-0.063
0.799
0.882
rwFl.5
Yw1
.s~ Yq
0
-0.053
Yw~
Yr
-~
IX,
'YPH, i'Pu
:a
-0.126
Yw
1.00
0.037
1.000
0.030
y..,..
0.96
0.350
1.000
0.060
y,.
resistance
Ground strength: Cohesion
0.99
0.o75
1.000
0.060
Ya
0.92
*1: a: sensitivity factor, /Xi: bias of average value (average value/characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation.
*2: RC: reinforced concrete, NC: non-reinforced concrete.
*3: Change of water depth Mild/Steep: Gradient of sea bottom <l/30/~l/30.
*4: rwt denotes the ratio of the highest high water level (H.H.W.L.) and mean monthly-high water level (H.W.L.).
*5: 'Yq is a term which is multiplied by the average value of the surcharge. The average value of the surcharge is obtained using q
-631-
=LY/2b'.
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(!) Normally the sloping surface ofthe sloping-top caisson breakwater is set to begin at the still water level. However,
with a semi-submerged shape in which the toe end of the sloping surface is set below the still water level, further
reduction of wave forces is possible.')
(2) When the upright part at the front of the caissons is armored with wave-dissipating blocks, there are cases in
which this causes to the generation of impulsive breaking wave pressure, depending on the crown height of the
wave-dissipating works. Furthermore, because the wave-dissipating blocks only extend as high as the still water
level, particular caution is needed with regard to the stability of the blocks.
(3) An example of the cross section of a sloping-top caisson breakwater is sbown in Fig. 3.7.1.
Harbor side
Seaward side
Superstructure
H.W.L
Foot protection blocks
Armor stones
"-,,..
1111
llll
(!) It is preferable that the wave forces acting on the sloping-top caisson breakwaters be decided based on hydraulic
model tests. However, in cases where this would be difficult, Part IJ, Chapter 2, 4.7.2(6) Wave Forces on
Sloping-top Caisson Breakwaters can be used as a reference.
(2) There is a study by Sato et al.'1) on the wave force acting on a sloping-top caisson breakwater covered with wavedissipating blocks.
3.7.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section
(!) The coefficient of wave transmission of the sloping-top caisson breakwaters is approximately 2 times that of the
upright breakwaters of the same crown height, as shown in Fig. 3.7.2. Therefore, if the crown height is set on the
same level as the significant wave height H 113, it is possible to reduce the transmitted wave height to approximately
the same as when the crown height of the upright breakwater is 0.6 times the significant wave height.
(2) With sloping-top caisson breakwaters, as the gradient of the sloping wall becomes steeper, the effectiveness of the
structure against wave transmission in the harbor increases, but conversely, wave pressure increases, reducing its
effect as a sloping-top breakwater. According to hydraulic metal tests carried out with various slope gradients, no
remarkable difference in the coefficient of wave transmission can be observed with gradients of30, 45, and 60.
Therefore, considering the effect in reducing wave pressure and convenience in construction works, it is preferable
that the slope gradient be set at 45.
-632-
.~
o.s
0.4
0
;;;
0.3
0.2
0.1
"'
~
Symbols
t:.
o o.66 cmssan
0 0.64 bn:akwater
00
X Upright breakwater
ODO O
cf>Oc9
t:. t:.
0
D t:.
x
D
t:. D
oo<2:o
t:.
~
x
II)
[;
0
d/lt
O.SS} Sl9Ping-top
00
Oo O O CD
x x
fF-45
, I~
-
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
t:.
t:.
1.2
t:.
1.4
t:.D
x t:.
1.6
1.8
2.0
h,jH113
(1) Performance verification and partial factors for sliding, overturning, foundation failure, and circular slip failure
CD
The verification ofthe stability of the sloping-top caisson type break.waters can be considered equivalent to that
for the composite break.waters. Provided, however, that it is necessary to use the values shown below for the
standard partial factors used in the verification of sliding, overturning, and foundation failure.
Partial factors
As the standard system failure probabilities for sliding and overturning ofthe upright section ofwave-dissipating
caisson break.waters and failure of the bearing capacity of the foundation ground, the values in Table 3.7.1
can be used as a reference. The partial factors for the standard failure probability for circular slip failure are
equivalent to those for the composite breakwaters. Table 3.1.1 of 3.1.4(6) Performance Verification and
Partial Factors for Sliding, Overturning, Foundation Failure and Circular Slip Failure can be used as
a reference. The sloping-top caisson break.waters covered with wave-dissipating blocks are equivalent to the
break.waters covered with wave-dissipating blocks; therefore, Table 3.4.1 of3.4.3(1) Performance Verification
and Partial Factors for Sliding, Overturning, Foundation Failure and Circular Slip Failure can be used
as a reference.
-633-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 3.7.1 Standard Partial Factors (Variable Situations in respect of Waves)
Target system reliability index PT
2.16
I.5x!0-2
Yr
... ""
~-~
rt;
&l<S
IX;
0.727
1.060
0.150
1.19
YwFl.5
1.03
YwF2.0,2.5
1.05
H.ILW.L.
1.00
Yw~
Unit weight of RC
0.98
YwNc
Unit weight of NC
1.02
Yw~
1.01
0.128
1.17
Yw1
1.33
YwFl.5
1.04
YwF2.0,2.5
1.09
H.ILW.L.
1.00
Yw~
Unit weight of RC
0.98
Yw~
Unit weight of NC
Yw~
Yw1
0.777
0.232
0.868
0.243
1.000
0.200
1.000
0.400
0.027
0.980
0.020
0.031
1.020
0.020
-0.670
-0.058
-0.970
-0.096
1.020
0.040
0.777
0.232
0.868
0.243
1.000
0.200
1.000
0.400
0.045
0.980
0.020
1.02
0.049
1.020
0.020
1.00
0.214
1.020
0.040
0.777
0.232
0.868
0.243
1.13
1.28
Yq
0.97
0.309
0.643
0.038
Yw
1.00
O.o38
0.643
0.030
'Ytan1f
0.96
0.325
1.000
0.060
0.99
0.076
1.000
0.060
1.00
YPu
-i L1,
0.80
1.05
'YPn, 'YPu
c5
Friction coefficient
Change of water depth: Mild
"'
2.24
'YPn, 'YPu
-~
:g
Y<"
Ya
-0.872
t: a: sensitivity factor, IX1 : bias of average value (average value/characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation.
*2: RC: reinforced concrete, NC: non-reinforced concrete.
*3: Change of water depth Mild/Steep: Gradient of sea bottom <l/30/~l/30.
*4: r1111 denotes the ratio of the highest high water level (H.H.W.L.) and mean monthly-high water level (H.W.L.).
s: 'Yq is a term which is multiplied by the average value of the surcharge. The average value of the surcharge is obtained using ij =
-634-
LV/2b'.
Article36
The performance criteria of the pile-type breakwaters under the variable action situations, in which the
dominant actions are variable waves and Level 1 earthquake ground motions, shall be as specified in the
subsequent items:
(1) The risk that the axial force acting on the piles may exceed the resistance based on failure of the ground
shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(2) The risk that the stress generated in the piles may exceed the yield stress shall be equal to or less than
the threshold level.
[Commentary]
(3) Performance Criteria of Pile-type Breakwaters
CD Pile-type breakwaters
Settings of the performance criteria and the design situations excluding accidental situations of piletype breakwaters shall be as shown in Attached Table 19.
The performance criteria of the superstructure and curtain wall of pile-type breakwaters shall be equivalent
to the settings in Article 23 through Article 27, corresponding to the type of members comprising the objective
pile-type breakwater.
Attached Table 19 Settings for Performance Criteria and Design Situations (excluding accidental situations) of Pile-type
Breakwaters
Ministerial
Ordinance
liii'
14
""I
<
~
2
Design situation
Public Notice
Performance
~< liii'
~
requirements
36
Serviceability
""
Situation
Variable
Non-
Dominating
Verification item
dominating
actions
actions
Level 1
Self weight,
earthquake
water pressure
ground motion
Yielding of piles
Level 1
Self weight,
earthquake
water pressure
ground motion
Yielding of piles
water pressure
water pressure
[Technical Note]
3.8.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) The pile-type breakwaters can be broadly divided into curtain wall breakwaters and steel pipe pile breakwaters.
The curtain wall breakwater is a permeable breakwater and was developed for use in waters with a comparatively
low wave height, such as enclosed bays, or locations with soft sea bottom ground. Steel pipe pile breakwater is
breakwater in which the curtain section is eliminated and waves are stopped only by the piles.
(2) For curtain wall breakwaters, it is preferable to select an appropriate structure considering the coefficient of wave
reflection and transmission, and when necessary, to conduct the performance verification by performing hydraulic
model tests.
(3) An example of the performance verification procedure for curtain wall breakwaters is shown in Fig. 3.8.1.
-635-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Determination of layout
Evaluation of actions
...
I Determination of design conditions '' .
...
I Assumption of cross-sectional dimensions : .
*!
...
-Performanceveri:fication
..I.
I
'2
--------------- -------------------------------------------------
...
t: Because assessment of the effects of liquefaction is not shown, separate consideration is necessary.
2: For facilities where damage to the facilities can be assumed to have a serious impact on life, property, and social activity, it is
preferable to conduct verification for accidental situations when necessary. Verification for accidental situations in respect of waves
shall be conducted in cases where facilities handling hazardous cargoes are located directly behind the breakwater and damage to
the objective facilities would have a catastrophic impact.
Fig. 3.8.1 Example of Performance Verification Procedure for Pile-type Breakwaters
(4) The curtain wall breakwaters can be broadly divided into the single-curtain-walled type and the double-curtainwalled type, depending how the so-called curtain wall such as concrete plates is arranged relative to the direction
ofwave propagation. Furthermore, a variety of types are conceivable, depending on the shape of the pile structure
supporting the curtain wall or the shape of slits provided in the curtain wall. Examples of the cross sections of
pile-type breakwaters are shown in Fig. 3.8.2.
-636-
Curtain
Pile
CD
The reflection coefficient can be reduced so as to the same level as in the breakwaters covered with wavedissipating blocks or less.
@ Exchange of sea water can be expected by tides and waves passing through slits provided in the curtain wall or
the gap between the lower edge of the curtain wall and the sea bed.
@ Comparing the single-curtain-walled and the double-curtain-walled breakwaters, because an energy dissipating
effect can be expected between the front and the back curtain walls with the double-curtain-walled type
breakwater, reflected waves and transmitted waves can be reduced in comparison with the single-curtain-walled
breakwaters.
@ Because the velocity of flows passing under the curtain wall is quite high, it is necessary to take appropriate
countermeasures to prevent or suppress washing-out of sand.
3.8.2 Actions
It is necessary to set the wave force acting on the curtain wall breakwaters based on the results of hydraulic model
tests, numerical analysis, or appropriate calculation formulas. When using the single-curtain-walled breakwater, the
result obtsined by subtracting the wave pressure distribution acting deeper than the lower edge of the curtain wall
from the wave pressure distribution shown in Part Il, Chapter 2, 4.7 Wave Pressure and Wave Force can be used as
the wave force acting on the curtain wall.
3.8.3 Setting of Basic Cross Section
(1) The structural type and the shape of curtain wall breakwaters shall be determined considering the condition of sea
states in the area, the target reflection coefficient, the target transmission coefficient and constructability.
(2) In setting the cross section of the curtain wall breakwaters, including the crown height, the depth of the lower
end of the curtain and the size of the slits provided in the curtain, and in the case of the double-curtain-walled
breakwaters, and the spacing between the curtain walls, it is preferable to set the cross section based on model
tests adapted to the conditions. It is preferable that the dimensions of members such as the curtain wall, and
piles be determined appropriately considering the spacing between the piles in the direction of the breakwater
extension.
(3) Examples of model tests for the single-curtain-walled breakwaters include, for example, model tests by Morihira
et al.57) The depth of the lower end of the curtain wall can be obtained from Fig. 3.8.3 ifthe wave transmission
coefficient is determined, and the crown height of the curtain wall can be obtained from Fig. 3.8.4. Provided,
-637-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
however, that the crown height of the curtain in Fig. 3.8.4 was corrected so that RIH ~ 1.25 at d/h ~ 1.0, and does
not show a crest capable of completely preventing wave overtopping. In the figure, dis the depth of the lower end
of the curtain, h is the water depth, L is the wave length, R is the crown height of the curtain, and His the wave
height. The relationship with the wave reflection coefficient of waves by a single curtain wall is shown in Fig.
3.8.5.
(4) In steel pipe pile breakwaters, if the steel pipes are driven with a space between the piles, the structure can
function as a permeable type breakwater. According to the research by Hayashi et al., 53) the relationship between
the pile spacing/pile diameter ratio b/D and the coefficient of wave transmission l'T is as shown in Fig. 3.8.6.
The moment due to wave force decreases as the spacing between the piles is increased, but this effect reaches
to the limit at around b/D ~ 0.1. With this type of breakwater, caution should also be paid regarding scouring of
the ground between the piles.
~~
1.0
jj
i
0.8
ij
0.6
I'
,,
~~
0.4
"
1"- ""
0.2
0.680
0 0
'
"-.;
h!J.,9!.078
' l!,097
'
02
'
i,;
'
!'..'
"
-dlh
141
''
0.170,.'\ ,\\
0.235
0.340
0.4
!"-..
0.6
'"
,\
~\I
--
0.8
1.0
Fig. 3.8.3 Relationship between d/h and Coefficient of Wave Transmission {Single Curtain Wall)
2.0
Il 1.0
0
0
0.5
1.0
d/h
-638-
100
;!.
:h/L=-0235
(9: =-0.097
~ 80
.
0
!El
0
u"
..::"
60
40
20
Pl
0
~7
v
0
0.2
0.4
0.8
0.6
1.0
d/h
Fig. 3.8.5 Relationship between d/h and Wave Reflection Coefficient (Single Curtain Wall)
1.0
...
0.8
0.6
;:
0.4
-!'.,
~ Hayashi, etc.
..to. Theoretical value
by Wiegel
0.2
- - Hayashi, etc.
- - - Wiegel
Oo
02
0.4
0.6
b/D
0.8
1.0
h:water depth
Fig. 3.8.6 Relationship between Ratio of Pile Spacing/Pile Diameter and Coefficient of Wave Transmission l
-639-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
[Technical Note]
3.9.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) Breakwaters with wide footing on soft ground (hereafter, soft landing breakwaters) resist against the horizontal
wave force by the piles and the cohesion between the bottom of the breakwater body and the surface layer of
the cohesive soil. On the other hand, the bottom slab and footing resist against the vertical force. In general,
because this type of structure is developed for construction of breakwaters on soft cohesive soil, there are cases
where this type is economically advantageous because the weight of the breakwater body can be reduced and soil
improvement is not required.
(2) Examples of the cross sections of soft landing breakwaters are shown in Fig. 3.9.1. Although structural types
can be broadly divided into the ''fiat base type" and the ''fiat base type with piles," the flat base type with piles is
generally used.
--------,Soft ground-:...
)////))7//7//))7////7/))7//))
/7/l/ll/177J/T/7//77J/7/J/17/
(3) Because the soft landing breakwater is constructed directly on soft ground, it is affected by scouring by waves and
water currents in the area around the breakwater body. Therefore, appropriate countermeasures shall be taken as
necessary.
-640-
Article37
The performance criteria of floating breakwaters under the variable action situation, in which the dominant
action is variable waves, shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The risk of capsizing of the floating body shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(2) The risk of impairing the integrity of the members of the floating body shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level.
(3) The risk that the stress generated in mooring lines may exceed the yield stress shall be equal to or less
than the threshold level.
(4) The risk of losing the stability due to tractive force acting on the mooring anchor shall be equal to or
less than the threshold level.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Floating Breakwaters
CD Settings in connection with the performance criteria and the design situation excluding accidental
situations of floating breakwaters shall be as shown in Attached Table 20.
Attached Table 20 Settings in Connection with Performance Criteria and Design Situations (excluding accidental
situations} of Floating Breakwaters
Ministerial
Ordinance
u
..,
e- Ii
1 "'
14
Public Notice
..,
Design situation
e- Ii
1 "'
Performance
requirements
37
Serviceability
'.$!
Situation
Variable
Nondominating
Dominating
actions
Verification item
actions
Capsizing of
wind, water
pressure,
floating body
f--
f--
Yielding of
mooring lines
Stability of
mooring anchor,
Resistance
f--
(horizontal
and
etc.
(!) Floating breakwaters are breakwaters in which transmitted waves are reduced by moored floating body. Although
the shapes of the floating body include many types, the pontoon type is widely used.
(2) An example of the performance verification procedure for floating breakwaters is shown in Fig. 3.10.1.
(3) The floating breakwaters have various advantages, including the fact that they do not prevent movement of sea
water and littoral drift, they are not affected by tidal levels changes or ground conditions, and they are moveable.
However, they also have numerous problems, in that they allow large transmitted waves, their effects differ
remarkably depending on the characteristics of waves, they can only be used in locations with small waves due to
their limited wave resistance, and the mechanism of resistance of the anchor system against repeated impulsive
actions is not adequately understood. Furthermore, because there is a danger of secondary damage due to drifting
of the floating body if the mooring lines break, appropriate measures should be taken.
-641-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Detennination of layout
'
,I,
IEvaluation of actions I
.----Performance verification
---------------------------- -------------------------------------
...
...
I
I
I
---------------------------- -------------------------------------and mooring line attachment parts
1
.-------------- ---------------------------1-------------------------
,.
--------------f-
I
I
------
t: For facilities where damage to the facilities can be assumed to have a serious impact on life, property, and social activity, it is
preferable to conduct verification for accidental situations when necessary. Verification for accidental situations in respect of waves
shall be conducted in cases where facilities handling hazardous cargoes are located directly behind the breakwater and damage to
the objective facilities would have a catastrophic impact.
The layout and the shape ofthe floating breakwaters should be set so that the required harbor calmness can be obtained.
In determining these settings, it is preferable to measure the wave transmission coefficient by conducting hydraulic
model tests. As theoretical analysis methods, Ito et al.59) proposed an approximation method for the motion of a
2-dimensional rectangular floating body, and Iijima l proposed a theory in connection with free floating bodies.
3.10.3 Performance Verification
(!) The performance verification of mooring system can be conducted referring to Part II, Chapter 2, 4.9 Actions on
Floating Body and its Motions.
CD
First stage in which the tensions that will be exerted on mooring lines and sinkers are determined through static
and dynamic analyses by assuming various conditions concerning mooring-related matters such as the mooring
method and line length.
-642-
@ Second stage in which detailed design of the actual mooring lines and sinkers is carried out and the stability is
confirmed, based on the tensions and other findings in the first stage above.
(3) Dynamic analysis of the mooring lines consists of determining the :fluctuating tension and displacement that arise
from the motions of floating body. This analysis can be classified into the following two procedures:
CD
@ Methods to analyze these factors based on the dynamic response characteristics of mooring lines.
(4) The performance verification for the mooring anchor is equivalent to that for floating piers. In addition to referring
to Chapter 5, 6.4 Performance Verification, Refurence 62) can also be used as a refurence.
(5) The structure of the floating body of a floating breakwater shall possess adequate safuty as a whole, and shall also
possess adequate local strength. With structures having a relatively long length relative to their width and depth,
such as floating breakwaters, it is generally preferable to examine the following points.
Longitudinal strength: The cross-sectional forces such as longitudinal flexural moment, shearing force and
torsional moment in the permanent situation and under action of waves shall be obtained for the floating body as
a whole.
Lateral strength: The cross-sectional forces such as flexural moment and shearing force in the direction
perpendicular to the longitudinal axis under action of waves shall be obtained for the floating body as a whole.
Local strength: The cross-sectional forces such as :flexural moment and shearing force generated in individual wall
panels and girders shall be obtained.
(6) Longitudinal strength calculation methods are divided into two categories, one of which considers floating body
motions, while other that does not. Among calculation methods that do not consider floating body motions, the
Muller equation, the Prestressed Concrete Barge Standards, and the Veritus Rule are frequently used. On the
other hand, the Ueda's formulae 63) is used as a calculation method that does take into account the :floating body
motions. A comparison of the methods of both categories is cited in the Refurences 63), which can be referred to
when applying the calculations.
(7) The performance verification for the stability of the floating body is equivalent to that for floating pier. Chapter 5,
6.4 Performance Verification can be used as a refurence. For other concepts in connection with the verification
of stability when inundated, Refurence 64) can be used as a refurence.
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
Yoshioka, T. and T. Nagao: Level-I reliability-based design method for gravity type breakwaters, Research Report of National
Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management No. 20, p.28, 2005
Nagao, t.: Reliability based design way for caisson type breakwaters, Jour. JSCE No.68911-57, pp.173-183, 2001
Yoshioka, T. and T. Nagao: Code calibration ofpartial coefficient ofexternal stability of gravity type breakwater, Proceedings
ofOffsbore Development, JSCE, Vol. 21, pp. 779-784, 2005
KOBAYASHI, M., Masaaki TERASHI, Kunio TAKAHASHI, Kenjirou NAKASHIMA and H. Kotani: A New Metbod for
Calculating tbe Bearing Capacity of Rubble Mounds, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 26 No. 2, pp. 371-411, 1987
Honda, N., T. Nagao, T. Yoshioka, T. Okiya, K. Yasuda and H. Nakase: Analysis of bearing capacity failure of rubble mound
by distinct element method, Proceedings of Offsbore Development, JSCE, Vol. 21, pp. 981-986, 2005
Nagao, T., R. Shibazaki and R. Ozaki: Ordinary Level-ooe reliability desigo method of wharves for minimizing expected
total cost considering economic losses, Proceedings of Structural Engineering, JSCE, Vol. SIA, pp. 389-400, 2005
SHIMOSAKO, K. and Shigeo TAKAHASHI: Reliability Desigo Method of Composite Breakwater using Expected Sliding
Distance, Rept. of PHRI Vol, 37, No.3, pp.3-30, 1998
Tanimoto, K., K. Furukawa and H. Nakamura: sliding fluid resistance force of upright part of composite type break.waters
and model of slide rate estimation, Proceedings of Coastal Eng., JSCE, Vol. 43, pp.846-850,1996
Kim, T-M. and T. Takayama: Computational Improvement for Expected Sliding Distance of a Caisson-Type Breakwater by
Introduction of a Doubly-Truncated Normal Distribution, Coastal Engineering Journal, Vol. 45, No.3, pp.387-419, 2003
Kim,T-M. and T. Takayama: Effect of Caisson Tilting on Sliding Distance ofa Caisson, Annual Journal of Civil Engineering
in the Ocean, Vol.20,pp.89.94,2004
Takahashi, S., K. Shimosako, M. Hanzawa and J. Sugiura: Stability verification of breakwaters and performaoce desigo- oew
desigo metbod wave-resistant structure in coastal sea areas, Proceedings of Offshore Development, JSCE, Vol. 16, pp. 415420, 2000
Study Status Review sub committee, Coastal Engineering Committee, JSCE: New estimation of waves and future design
method for coastal facilities, pp.222-223,2001
Gouda, Y. : Selection of distribution of extremes in reliability desigo of breakwaters and its influence, Proceedings of
Offsbore Development, JSCE, Vol. 17, pp. 1-6, 2001
Goda Y.: Performance-based design ofcaisson breakwaters with new approach to extreme wave statistics, Coastal Engineering
-643-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Journal, JSCE, Vol. 43 No.4, PP.289-316, 2001
15) Gouda, Y. : Foot expansion range parameter of distribution functions of extreme waves related to design waves and its
meaning, Proceedings of Coastal Engineering, JSCE, Vol. 49, pp. 171-175, 2002
16) Shimosako, K. and K. Tada: Examination on the determination of allowable slide rate for performance-based verification
type design method for composite breakwaters, Proceedings of Coastal Engineering, JSCE, Vol. 50, pp. 766-770, 2003
17) Yoshioka, T., T. Nagao and Y. Moriya: Study on determination method of partial coefficient of caisson type of breakwaters
considering sliding rate, Proceedings of Coastal Engineering, JSCE, 2005
18) Moriya, Y., A. Wasbio and T. Nagao: Level-one reliability design method based on sliding rate of caisson breakwaters,
Proceedings of Coastal Engineering, JSCE, Vol. 50, pp. 901-905, 2003
19) Yoshioka, T., T. Sanuki, T. Nagao and Y. Moriya: Study on Level-one reliability design method based on sliding rate of
caisson breakwaters considering extreme wave distribution, Proceediogs of Coastal Engineering, JSCE, Vol. 51, pp. 851-855,
2004
20) Takeda, H., T. Hirano and K. Sasaki: Effect of reinforcement of caisson breakwaters by concrete cubes and rubbles,
Proceedings of Annual Conference of JSCE, Part 3, JSCE, pp.110-111,1976
21) Kikuchi, Y., H. Sinsya and S. Eguchi: Effects of the back-filling to the stability ofa caisson, Rep!. of PHRI Vol. 37 No. 2, pp.
29-58, 1998
22) Kouichi Yamada, Shinya Eguchi, Hiroshi Shinsha, Yoshiaki Kikuchi: Effects of the back-filling to the stability of a caisson,
Proc.of!S Yokohama, pp.393-406, 2000
23) Nagao, T. and R. Ozaki: Earthquake-resistant deaign of caisson breakwaters, Proceedings of Structural Engineering, JSCE,
Vol. 50A, pp.217-228, 2004
24) Ozak~ R. and T. Nagao: Study on earthquake-resistant performance of caisson breakwaters with friction enlargement mats,
Proceedings of Offshore Development, JSCE, Vol. 20, pp. 155-160, 2004
25) Nagnya Port and Airport Technical Survey Office, Chu-bu Regional Development Bureau: Simple estimation method of
settlement of structures, Report of Nagoya Port and Airport Technical Survey Office 2004, 2005
26) Kagawa, M. and T. Kubo : Experimental study on stability of rubles poured sand mastic, Proceedings of 12th Conference on
Coastal Eng,. JSCE, 1965
27) Tanimoto, K., T. Yagyu, T. Muraoaga, K. Shibata and Y. Goda: Stability ofArmor Units for Foundation Mounds of Composite
Breakwaters Determined by Irregular Wave Tests, Rep!. of PHRI Vol.21, No.3, pp. 3-42, 1982
28) Kimura, K., Y. Mizuno, K. Sudo, S. Kuwabara and M. Hayasbi: Damage characteristics of rubble mound of composite
breakwaters at the end of breakwater alignment and estimation method of stable weight, Proceedings of Coastal Engineering,
JSCE, Vol. 43, pp. 806-810, 1996
29) Ozak~ N., Y. Kougami, K. Matsuz~ K. Tazaki and T. Nishikawa: Modeling of deflection deformation of asphalt mat and
scoring experiment, Proceedings of 32nd Conference on Coastal Engineering, JSCE, pp.450-454,1985
30) Kihara, T., M. Kai, M. Torti, N. Mochizuki: Countermeasure for scoring in front foot of breakwaters, Proceedings of 35th
Conference on Coastal Engineering, JSCE, pp.402-406,1988
31) Suzuki, K. and S. Takabashi: An experiment on settlement of blokes of wave absorbing block armoured breakwater- scoring
of under layer of mound and blocks, Proceedings of Coastal Engineering, Vol. 45, pp.821-825, 1998
32) MORIHIRA, M., Shusaku KAKIZAKI and Toru KIKUYA: Experimental study on wave force damping effects due to
deformed artificial blocks, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 6, No. 4, pp. 1-31, 1%7
33) Kougami, Y. and K. Tokikawa: Experimental Study on wave pressure dissipating effect of wave absorbing works during
construction stage, Report of Public Works Research Institute (PWRI), Hokkaido Regional Development Bureau (HRDB),
Vol. 53, pp,81-95,1970
34) Ozaki, R. T. Nagao and R. Shibazaki: Ordinary Level-one reliability design method of port facilities based on minimum
expected total cost considering economic losses, Proceedings of Structural Engineering, JSCE, Vol. 51A, pp. 389-400,
2005
35) Yoshioka, T., T. Nagao and Y. Moriya: Level-one reliability design method based on slide rate of wave absorbing block
armoured breakwaters, Proceedings of Offshore Development, JSCE, Vol. 20, pp.191-196, 2004
36) Yoshioka, T., T. Sanuki and Y. Moriya: Level-one reliability design method based on the sliding rate of wave absorbing block
armoured break.water considering extreme wave distribution, Proceedings of Offshore Development, JSCE, Vol. 21, pp.761766, 2005
37) Yoshioka, T. and T. Nagao: Study on the stability of wave absorbing blocks during construction stage utilizing LCC evaluation
method, Proceedings of Offshore Development, JSCE, Vol. 22, pp,703-708, 2006
38) Miyaw~ S. and T. Nagao: A study on determination of partial coefficient of gravity type breakwater having plural
structural characteristics- an example of sloping top caisson breakwater covered with wave absorbing blocks,- Technical
Note of National Institute of Land and Infrastructure Management (NILIM), No. 350, 2006
39) Suzuki, K. and S. Takabasbi: An experiment on settlement of blocks of wave absorbing block armoured breakwater- scoring
of under layer of mound and blocks, Proceedings of Coastal Engineering, Vol. 45, pp.821-825, 1998
40) Gomyo, M., K. S~ T. Takayama, K. Terauchi and S. Takahashi: Survey of present situation of the stability of blocks of
wave-absorbing-block armoured breakwater, Proceedings of Coastal Engineering, JSCE, Vol. 42, pp.901-905,1995
41) Gomyou, M., S. Takabas~ K. Suzuki and Y. Kang: Survey of present situation of the stability of blocks of wave-absorbingblock armoured breakwater (Second Report), Proceedings of Coastal Engineering, JSCE, Vol. 44, pp. ,961-965, 1997
-644-
-645-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
4 Amenity-oriented Breakwaters
It is necessary to examine the crown height of the amenity-oriented breakwaters which will be visited by the general
public from the viewpoint of public use and safuty, including spray, and the wave overtopping.
References
I)
2)
Coastal Development Institute of Technology : Technical Manual fur the Improvement of Port envirooment, 1991
TAKAHASHI, S., Kimihiko ENDOH and Zeo-ichirou MURO: Experimental Study on People's Safuty agaiost Overtopping
Waves on Breakwaters- A study on Amenity-oriented Port Structures (2nd Rep!.)-, Rep!. ofPHRI Vol. 31 No.4, 1992
-646-
(2) In the storm surge protection breakwaters, in addition to the stability of the facilities against the action of waves,
it is also necessary to secure the stability of the facilities considering the characteristics of attack by storm surges
such as the rise in the water level inside the breakwater.
5.2 Actions
In the examination of the stability of the upright section, the rise in the water level inside the breakwater due to the
inflow of the storm surge shall be considered. In this case, Part Il, Chapter 2, 4 Waves and Part Il, Chapter 2, 3
Tidal Level can be used as a reference for waves and tidal levels, respectively.
References
I)
-647-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
6.2 Actions
(1) For tsunamis, Part II, Chapter 2, 5 Tsunamis can be used as a reference.
(2) In the perfurmance verification for tsunamis, it is preferable that the difference in the water level inside and
outside the breakwater during action of tsunamis be evaluated appropriately based on a numerical simulation.
Attention should be paid to the fact that the water level behind the breakwater will not necessarily be the same as
the still water level, depending on inflow and outflow of tsunamis.
(3) In the calculation of tsunami force, Part II, Chapter 2, 5(7) Tsunami Wave Force can be used as a reference.
However, because many points still require clarification, it is preferable to confirm the wave force by an appropriate
method such as hydraulic model tests or the like.
CD
Sliding
(6.4.1)
where
(6.4.2)
where
a1-a4 : arm lengths of actions (see Fig. 3.1.4 of 3.1 Gravity-type Breakwaters (Composite
Breakwaters))
Ya : structural analysis factor
-648-
(3) The examination for the failure due to insufficient bearing capacity of the foundation ground for tsunamis is
equivalent to that for variable situations in respect of waves in composite breakwaters. 3.1.4 Performance
Verification can be used as a reference. Provided, however, that the partial factors used in verification shall be in
accordance with the following (4) Partial factors.
(4) Partial factors
For the partial factors used in the examination ofthe stability against sliding and overturning of the upright section
and the failure due to insufficient bearing capacity of the foundation ground for tsunami protection breakwaters
in the accidental situation in respect of tsunamis, the values in Table 6.4.1 can be used as a reference. Provided,
however, that the values shown in Table 6.4.1 are the standard values when setting the tsunami force of the largest
class as the accidental action expected at the location where the facilities are to be constructed. Here, in cases
where uncertainty is expected in calculation of the characteristic value of the tsunami force, there are examples in
which 1.2 is set as a structural analysis factor.
Table 6.4.1 Partial Factors for use in Performance Verification of Tsunami Protection Breakwaters
f
"'
YwRC
Unit weight of RC
YwNc
Unit weight of NC
YwsAND
Ya
y
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00 or over
"IPn, YPu
Tsunami force
Yw1
TwFl.5
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00 or over
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
Y1
Friction coefficient
YPn. "/pu
Tsunami force
Yw1
rwFl.5
rwF2.0,2.S
H.H.W.L.
r .t=2.0, 2.5
gi>
a
~
c5
i1
H.H.W.L.
YwRC
Unit weight of RC
YwNC
Unit weight of NC
YwsAND
Ya
YpH
Yq
~ ~ Yw
fir c
o.9 y.....
~i
!iB
*1:
2:
3:
4:
Tsunami furce
y,.
Ya
/X1
1.00
1.00 or over
a: sensitivity factor, !Xt: bias of average value (average value/characteristic value), V: coefficient of variation.
RC: reinforced concrete, NC: non-reinforced concrete.
Change of water depth mild/steep: Gradient of sea bottom <1130/ Longer than 1/30.
rwl denotes the ratio of the highest high water level (H.H.W.L.) and mean monthly-high water level (H.W.L.).
(5) The tsunami protection breakwaters are frequently constructed in locations where the water is deep. In this
case, the height of the breakwater body is also large, and the stability during action of ground motion becomes
-649-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
a particular problem. Therefore, it is prefurable to examine seismic resistance by performing seismic response
analyses considering the nonlinearity of the mound materials. In addition, it is also preferable to examine the
stability of the mound during action of ground motion. The performance verification of the mound for the
stability during action of ground motion is equivalent to that fur the composite breakwaters; 3.1.4 Performance
Verification can be used as a reference.
section at a harbor entrance and to scour prevention works for the foundation ground.
(2) Because the rubble mound becomes thicker as the water becomes deeper, it is necessary to pay careful attention to
the stability of the rubble mound against wave forces and wave transformation on the slope surface of the rubble
mound. It will also be necessary to make extra-banking for the rubble mound against large settlement of the
rubble mound by its own weight.
NagasakJM _
T~ level
Without breakwater
observation station
----N
After construction
of breakwater
10
20 30 40 50 60
Oscillation period T [min]
References
1)
2)
3)
TANIMOTO, K., Katsutoshi KIMURA aod Kciji MIYAZAKI: Stady on Stability of Submerged Dike at the Opeoing Section
of Tsunami Protection Breakwaters, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 27 No.4, pp.93-121, 1988
Horikawa, K. and H. Nishimura: Performance of Tsunami breakwaters Proceedings of 16th Conference on Coastal
Engineering, JSCE, pp.365-369,1969
ITO, Y., katsutoshi TANIMOTO aod Tsutomu KIHARA: Digital Computation on the Effect of Breakwaters against Longperiod Waves (4th Report)- On the Effi:ct of Ofunato Tsuoami Breakwater against the Tsunami caused by the Earthquake oo
May 16, 1968.-, Rept. ofPHRI Vol.7 No.4, pp.55-83, 1968
-650-
Article 15
1 The performance requirements for sediment control groins shall satisfy the requirements specified by the
Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism for the mitigation of siltation in waterways and
basins caused by littoral drift through effective control of sediment movement.
2 The provisions of the item (2) of the paragraph 1 of the preceding article shall be applied correspondingly
to the performance requirements for sediment control groins.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Sediment Control Groins
Article38
1 The provisions of Article 35 or 36 shall be applied to the performance criteria of sediment control groins
with modifications as necessary in consideration of the structural type.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of sediment control
groins shall be such that these facilities are arranged appropriately so as to enable control of littoral drift,
in consideration of the environmental conditions and others to which the facilities concerned are subjected
and have the dimensions necessary for their function.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria for Sediment Control Groins
In the performance verification for sediment control groins, appropriate consideration shall be given to
the increase in earth pressure due to the sedimentation by littoral drift and effects due to river currents.
[Technical Nole]
7.1 General
(!) Layout of Sediment Control Groins
Q) Sediment control groins shall be appropriately located by considering the characteristics of sediment transport,
so as to exercise the expected function of longshore transport control.
@ In general, the sediment control groins on the updrift side of longshore sediment transport, shall be located
perpendicular to the shoreline in the surf zone and shallower, and in deeper waters, shall be located so that
littoral drift is dispersed to the side opposite the harbor entrance.
In cases where sediment control groins are constructed on the downdrift side of longshore sediment transport
in order to prevent entrainment of littoral drift into the harbor from the shore on the downdrift side oflongshore
sediment transport, in general, the groin shall be constructed perpendicular to the coastline and shall also have
an appropriate length considering wave direction and wave transformation. Provided, however, that in cases
where a sediment control groin also functions as a breakwater, an appropriate layout considering its required
functions as a breakwater is necessary.
If a sediment control groin in required in places such as the vicinity of waterways inside a harbor, it shall be
-651-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Contour lines
~----.J//
Breaker line
c::::::>
~..,-,_:::';
K,,=1.0
. Deposition
'
.
...
'
'..
.. Deposition
.
. . ..
..
"
"""
CD
@ When there are concerns of shoaling caused by reflected waves or of causing obstruction to the navigation of
ships.
-652-
CD
after construction.
@ Sections located shallower than the breaker line depth
The crown elevation of the sediment control groin in the sections located shallower than the breaker line depth
may be 0.6H113 above the mean monthly-highest water level (HWL), where H 113 should be the significant wave
height around the tip of sediment control groin.
References
1)
2)
3)
Tanaka, N: Transformation of sea bottom and beach near port constructed within the beach, Proceedings of Annual
Conference, pp.1-46,1974
SATO, S., Norio TANAKA and Katsuhlro SASAKI: The Case History on Variation of Sea Bottom Topography Caused by
the Construction Works ofKashima Harbour, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 13 No.4, pp.3-78, 1974
Nakase, A., T. Okumura and M. Sawaguchi: Easy-to-understand Foundation works, Kajima Publishing, p.376, 1981
-653-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
8 Seawalls
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Seawalls
Article 16
1 The performance requirements for seawalls shall be as specified in the subsequent items for the purpose
of protecting the land area behind the seawall in consideration of its structure type.
(1) Seawalls shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and
Tourism so as to enable protection of the land area behind the seawall concerned from waves and storm
surges.
(2) Damage due to self weight, earth pressure, variable waves, and Level I earthquake ground motions,
and/or other actions shall not impair the functions of the seawall concerned and shall not adversely
affect its continued use.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for seawalls in the
place where there is a risk of serious impact on human lives, property, and/or socioeconomic activity by the
damage to the seawall concerned shall include the subsequent items, in consideration of the type of seawall.
(1) The performance requirements for a seawall which is required to protect the land area behind the seawall
concerned from tsunamis or accidental waves shall be such that the seawall satisfy the requirements
specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so as to enable protection of
the land area behind the seawall concerned from tsunamis or accidental waves.
(2) Damage due to tsunamis, accidental waves, Level 2 earthquake ground motions, and/or other actions
shall not have a serious impact on the structural stability of the seawall concerned, even in cases where
the functions of the seawall concerned are impaired. Provided, however, that for the performance
requirements for a seawall which requires further improvement ofits performance due to environmental,
social and/or other conditions to which the seawall concerned is subjected, the damage due to said
actions shall not adversely affect the restoration through minor repair work of the functions of the
seawall concerned.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Seawalls
Article39
1 The provisions concerning the structural stability in Article 49 through Article 52 excluding the provisions
concerning ship berthing and traction by ships shall be applied with modifications as necessary to the
performance criteria of seawalls in consideration of the type of structure.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of seawalls shall be as
specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The seawall shall be arranged appropriately so as to enable control of wave overtopping in consideration
of the environmental conditions and others to which the seawalls concerned are subjected and shall
have the dimensions necessary for their function.
(2) Under the variable action situation in which the dominant action is water pressure, the risk oflosing the
stability due to seepage failure of the ground shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(3) In the case of the structure having a parapet, the risk of sliding and overturning of the parapet under
the variable action situation in which the dominant actions are variable waves and Level 1 earthquake
ground motions shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
3 In addition to the provisions of the preceding two paragraphs, the performance criteria of the seawalls in
the place where there is a risk of serious impact on human lives, property, or socioeconomic activity by
the damage to the facilities concerned shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Seawalls which are required to protect the hinterland from tsunamis or accidental waves shall have the
dimensions as necessary for protection of the hinterland from tsunamis or accidental waves.
(2) Under the accidental action situation in which the dominant actions are tsunamis, accidental waves, or
Level 2 earthquake ground motions, the degree of damage owing to the dominant actions shall be equal
to or less than the threshold level corresponding to the performance requirements.
-654-
[Commentary]
Ordinance
~
t:
""e-
Public Notice
u
""e-
:s!
t:
<
1 "'
39
<
1 "'
16
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Usability
Situation
Variable
Verification item
Non-
Dominating
action
dominating
action
ground
~
Sliding or
Level 1
earthquake
parapet* I)
Self weigh~
earth pressure,
""
<
J J
16
~
.l! <
8
Design situation
Public Notice
39
.l!
2
Performance
requirements
Safety,
restorability
Situation
Dominating
action
Nondominating
Verification item
action
-655-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2) Degree of damage
In setting the limit value of the degree of damage for accidental situations in which the dominating
actions are Level 2 earthquake ground motion, tsunamis, and accidental waves in the performance
verifications of seawalls as facilities against accidental incidents, consideration shall not be limited
to the functions of the objective seawall, but shall also include comprehensive considerations of the
condition of implementation of the surrounding protective facilities for the harbor and other facilities
for protection of the hinterland, and soft countermeasures related to disaster reduction and disaster
prevention in the objective region. In seawalls used as facilities against accidental incidents in which
restorability is a performance requirement, appropriate consideration shall be given to the allowable
restoration period when setting the limit value of the degree of damage.
3) Accidental situation in which dominating action is tsunami
In the performance verifications in connection with tsunamis, in cases where the expected tsunami
occurs as a result of an earthquake with a hypocenter located near the objective facilities, appropriate
consideration shall be given to the fact that the facilities will be affected by the action of the ground
motion caused by the objective earthquake before they are affected by the action of the tsunami.
In other words, in cases where the dominating action is the accidental situation associated with
tsunamis, it is necessary to conduct the performance verification for tsunamis based on consideration
ofthe effects caused by the action of the ground motion which precedes a tsunami. It should be noted
that the ground motion which precedes the tsunami which is expected in this case is not necessarily
identical with the Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
References
I)
Shore protection facility Technical Committee: Technical standards and commentary for shore protection facilities, Japan
Port Association, 2004
-656-
9 Training Jetties
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Training Jetties
Article 17
1 The performance requirements for training jetties shall be such that the requirements specified by the
Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied for the prevention of closure of a
river mouth by littoral drift through effective control of sediment transport.
2 The provisions of the item (2) of the paragraph (J) of Article 14 shall be applied correspondingly to the
performance requirements for training jetties.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Training Jetties
Article 40
The provisions of Article 38 shall be applied to the performance criteria of training jetties with modifications
as necessary.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Training Jetties
The settings in connection with the Public Notice, Article 38 Performance Criteria of Sediment Control
Groins shall be applied with the necessary modifications to the performance criteria of training jetties. In the
performance verifications of training jetties, appropriate consideration shall be given to the increase of earth
pressure due to sedimentation of littoral drift and to waves and river currents.
[Technical Nole]
9.1 General
(I) Layout of Training Jetties
Examples of the layout of training jetties in relation to the direction of longshore sediment transport are shown
in Fig. 9.1.VJ The most prefurable one for maintaining the water depth of river mouth is to extend two parallel
training jetties, because a single training jetty alone is not effuctive. Where two training jetties of diffurent
lengths are put in place, usually it is effective to make the training jetty on the downdrift side longer. Bending the
updrift training jetty towards the downdrift side will prevent sediment moving into the area between two training
jetties and make the sediment transported alongshore pass smoothly to the downdrift side. For actual examples of
river mouth improvement, refer to the reference 2).
CD
The water depth at the tip of a training jetty should be equal to or greater than the water depth of the waterway
in the vicinity of the training jetty.
@ The tip of the training jetty should be located at equal to or greater water depth than the limiting wave breaker
depth.
-657-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
gut is preserved
Grows shall~:?~
Longshore
..-;..... : '.,.
,..... sedilnentttans~ ~
J~
L~gshore
sedunent transport
A narrow
but deep Grows shallow
gut
is preserved
-~
~
Longshore
.,.._Longshore
sediment transport
\ \
.
~
0 .,. "
'
Lo~shore
~ ~entttansport
Fig. 9.1.1 Varieties ofTraining Jetty Layout 'l
I)
-658-
10 Floodgates
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Floodgates
Article 18
1 The performance requirements for floodgates shall be as specified in the subsequent items for the purpose
of protecting the hinterland of the floodgate from inundation and of draining unnecessary inland water.
(1) Floodgates shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport
and Tourism for prevention of overflow due to storm surges.
(2) Floodgates shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport
and Tourism for protection of the hinterland from inundation and for drainage of unnecessary inland
water.
(3) Damage due to self weight, water pressure, variable waves, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, or
other actions shall not impair the functions of the floodgate concerned and not affect its continued use.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for floodgates
which have a risk of having a serious impact on human lives, property, and/or socioeconomic activity by
the damage to the floodgate concerned shall include the subsequent items in consideration of the type of
floodgate.
(1) In the performance requirements for a floodgate which is required to protect the hinterland of the
floodgate concerned from tsunamis or accidental waves, the floodgate shall satisfy the requirements
specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so as to enable protection of
the hinterland of the floodgate concerned from overflows by tsunamis or accidental waves.
(2) The damage due to tsunamis, accidental waves, Level 2 earthquake ground motions, or other actions
shall not have a serious impact on the structural stability of the floodgate concerned, even in cases
where the functions of the floodgate concerned are impaired. Provided, however, that as for the
performance requirements for floodgates which require further improvement in the performance due to
environmental, social, or other conditions to which the floodgates concerned are subjected, the damage
due to said actions shall not affect the restoration through minor repair works of the functions of the
floodgate concerned.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Floodgates
Article 41
1 The performance criteria of floodgates shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Floodgates shall be located appropriately so as to enable protection ofthe land behind the facilities from
inundation and drainage of unnecessary water accumulated there in consideration of the environmental
conditions and others to which the facilities concerned are subjected and shall have the dimensions
necessary for their function.
(2) Floodgates shall have the dimensions necessary in consideration of storm surges, waves, and tsunamis.
(3) Under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is self weight, the risk of impairing
the integrity ofthe members and losing the structural stability shall be equal to or less than the threshold
level.
(4) Floodgates shall satisfy the following standards under the variable action situation in which the
dominant action is water pressure:
(a) The risk of impairing the integrity of the structural members shall be equal to or less than the threshold
level.
(b) The risk oflosing the structural stability due to seepage failure of the ground shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level.
(5) Floodgates shall satisfy the following standards under the variable action situation in which the
dominant actions are variable waves and Level 1 earthquake ground motions:
-659-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
a) The risk of impairing the integrity of the structural members shall be equal to or less than the threshold
level.
b) The risk of losing the stability of floodgate system shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of floodgates in which
there is a risk of serious impact on human lives, property, or socioeconomic activity by the damage to the
facilities concerned shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Floodgates which are required to protect the hinterland from tsunamis or accidental waves shall have
the dimension necessary to control overflows.
(2) Under the accidental action situation in which the dominant actions are tsunamis, accidental waves, or
Level 2 earthquake ground motions, the degree of damage owing to the dominant actions shall be equal
to or less than the threshold level corresponding to the performance requirements.
[Technical Nole]
(!) Layout and Dimensions of Floodgates
Q) Layout
In setting the layout in the performance verifications of floodgates, it is necessary to give appropriate
consideration to installation in a position where the water gate can demonstrate its full water collecting capacity,
and to avoiding installation in positions where sediments will tend to accumulate due to the effects of wind,
waves, and water currents.
@Structure
In setting the structure of the transitional part of gate in the performance verifications of floodgates, it is
necessary to give appropriate consideration to the quality, shape, and dimensions of the materials and to a
watertight structure so as to secure the required water-tightness.
@ Cross-sectional dimensions
In setting the height and other dimensions in the performance verifications of floodgates, it is necessary to give
appropriate consideration to the dewatering capacity of the objective floodgate, the effects of littoral drift and
settlement of the ground, the water levels inside and outside the objective water gate and in the surrounding
ground. In floodgates which allow passage of ships, when setting the height, appropriate consideration shall be
given to setting a height which will not impede the passage of ships.
@ Ancillary equipment
In the performance verifications of floodgates, it is necessary to examine the installation of ancillary equipment
for use in maintenance control, such as control bridges, stairs, handrails, as necessary, so as to enable safe and
References
1)
Shore Protection Facility Technical Committee: Technical standards and commentary for shore protection facilities, Japan
-660-
11 Locks
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Locks
Article 19
1 The performance requirements for locks shall be as specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure,
Transport and Tourism for the purpose of enabling the safe and smooth navigation of ships between the
water areas having different water levels.
2 The provisions of the items (1) and (3) of the paragraph (J) and the paragraph (2) of the preceding article
shall be applied correspondingly to the performance requirements for locks.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Locks
Article 42
1 The provisions of the preceding article shall be applied to locks with modifications as necessary.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria oflocks shall be such that
the locks are located appropriately so as to enable ships to navigate safely and smoothly in consideration
of the environmental conditions to which the facilities concerned are subjected, the utilization conditions,
and others, and the locks have the dimensions necessary for their function.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria for Locks
(!)General
CD
The names of the respective parts oflocks shall be as shown in Fig. 11.1.
-661-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Lock gate
I.
Sill heiht
Plane view
. 0 - .
Side view
(d) The size and number of ships that will pass through the lock are also factors in the selection of the location.
That is, the lock must be located at the site where a sufficiently wide area of water can be secured for anchorage
and turning basin for use by waiting ships.
(e) In addition to the above, the lock's location must be selected with adequate consideration given to the
conditions of land usage or traffic conditions of the inland area.
(11.1)
(b) Generally, the clearances for the various dimensions for locks depend upon the ship size. Fukuda, however,
has proposed the following values for locks used by small ships:
Clearance for effective water depth: 0.2-1.0m
Clearance for effective width:
0.2-1.2m
Clearance for effective length:
3-10 m
-662-
Q) Lock doors
The doors oflocks should have a structure which makes it possible to secure the assumed difference in water
levels and the required stability against actions due to waves, and should also have a structure which satisfies
the following requirements.
1) It shall consider the scale of the lock, time required for opening and closing.
2) It shall be easy to inspect the machinery section and other moving parts.
3) It shall consider wear and prevention of corrosion of members.
@ Lock chamber
The lock chamber shall have a structure appropriate to meet the conditions such as the foundation condition,
water level difference between inside and outside the lock chamber, the dimensions and number of ships to be
accommodated, and the quantity of water changing and discharging of the lock chamber.
References
I)
2)
3)
Nishihata, I.: Design of Water Gate aod Lock Gate, Ohom Publishing, 2004
Fukuda, H.: Lock, Jyo-ritsu Publishing, 1955
Planning Division, The third Port Construction Bureau, Ministry of Thaosport: Storm surge countermeasure works (
Improvement of Lock gate)at the coast of Amagasaki, Nishinomiya and Ashiya, Disaster Prevention in Ports and Harbours,
Association of disaster Prevention in Ports and coast, pp.41-45,1990
-663-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
12 Revetments
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Revetments
Article20
1 The provisions of Article 16 shall be applied correspondingly to the performance requirements for
revetments.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for revetments
to be utilized by an unspecified large number of people shall satisfy the requirements specified by the
Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so as to secure the safety of the users of the
revetment concerned.
12.1 Common Items for Revetments
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Revetments
Article 43
1 The provisions of Article 39 shall be applied to the performance criteria for revetments with modifications
as necessary.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria for the revetments
which are utilized by an unspecified large number of people shall be such that the revetments have the
dimensions necessary to secure the safety of users in consideration of the environmental conditions to
which the facilities concerned are subjected, and the utilization conditions, and others.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Revetments
(!) In cases where a reclamation revetment is built adjoining to the existing land area, construction of the revetment
may cause the groundwater level to rise or may result in deterioration of groundwater quality. Adequate attention
should be paid to these aspects when studying the reclamation layout plan and revetment structure. It is preferable
to investigate the conditions ofthe groundwater in the land area in advance. In addition, in cases where it is thought
that reclamation revetment construction will cause deterioration of the groundwater quality, countermeasures
such as construction of a watertight wall must be considered in order to insulate the groundwater of the land from
the reclaimed area.
(2) In the case ofreclamation where a large water area is enclosed by revetments, the opening becomes smaller with the
progress of revetment construction, and a considerable rapid flow occurs at closing sections due to the difference
of water levels between the inside and outside of revetments. Therefore, careful consideration is required for
structure of revetments at the final closing section, which should have enough stability against the expected flow
speed.
The flow velocity at closing sections is controlled by the water area being closed, the cross-sectional area of
the closing section, the average water depth and the difference in tidal levels. In closing sections, it is preferable
that ground hardening work be conducted at a location with good ground before the flow velocity increases as
work progresses. Depending on the flow velocity at the closing section, there are also cases in which a submerged
weir or broad-crested weir is used.
-664-
12.1.2 Actions
(!) For the ground conditions of landfill soil, Part II, Chapter 3 Geotechnical Conditions can be used as a
refurence.
(2) For actions due to ground motion, Part II, Chapter 4 Earthquakes can be used as a refurence.
(3) For dynamic water pressure, Part II, Chapter 5, 2.2 Dynamic Water Pressure can be used as a reference.
(4) As the water level in reclaimed areas, two water levels are generally set, these being the water level in the
reclaimed area and the residual water level. The water level in the reclaimed area is used in seepage calculations
and the performance verification of waste water treatment facilities. The residual water level is the water level
immediately behind the revetment and is used in examination of the stability ofthe revetment. Provided, however,
that in cases where the water level at positions near the revetment is higher than the residual water level, the danger
of circular slip failure may be underestimated if the residual water level is used in the examination of circular slip
failure. In such cases, it is necessary to conduct the examination of the stability ofthe revetment for the water level
in the reclaimed area.
CD
water from the revetment and foundation ground may increase; therefore, caution is necessary. Furthermore,
attention shall also be paid to the fact that the water level inside the reclaimed area will influence the cost of
construction of the revetment and the construction and maintenance control costs of waste water treatment
facilities.
CD
The crown height shall be the height to enable preservation and use of the reclaimed land unaffected by waves
and storm surges.
@ Stability against the actions of waves, earth pressure, etc. shall be secured.
@ The structure shall prevent leakage of the landfill soil.
Consideration shall be given to the effuct on surrounding water areas, including prevention of outflow of turbid
water during reclamation work.
In amenity-oriented revetments, sate and pleasant use of the structure by users shall be possible.
-665-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) Setting of Crown Height
Q) For revetments, an appropriate crown height shall be set considering the wave overtcpping quantity, tidal level
at high tide so as to enable preservation of the landfill behind the revetment and not hinder use of the revetment
or the land behind it.
@ In setting the crown height of revetments, the following method I) can be used.
(a) The required crown height hd above the design high water level of the revetment can be set as follows, using
the required crown height h, above the water level corresponding to the importance of the hinterland, or the
required crown height he' considering ground motion and the crest settlement d3 due to consolidation obtained
from the ground conditions.
(12.1.1)
(b) The required crown height h, above the water level in equation (12.1.2) shall be a value obtained by adding
a height allowance to the calculated crown height for the design wave at the design high water level of the
revetment. The required crown height h, above the water level can be calculated by setting the exceedence
probability P for the permissible wave overtcpping rate. The exceedence probability P for the permissible
wave overtcpping rate can be calculated using equation (12.1.2). For the mean value and the standard deviation
of hJh,d, 1.00 and 0.15 can be used, respectively.
P=l-
1 !oz-A.
(12.1.2)
where
p
h,
h,d
(=~lo
(I+:)
t1
Equation (12.1.2) is shown graphically in Fig. 12.1.1. For example, asswning the exceedence probability
of the permissible wave overtcpping rate is 0.01, the required crown height h, above the water level, which is
obtained by adding a height allowance to the calculated crown height h,m is given as 1.40 times the calculated
crown height h,d.
-666-
"
.....
0.1
t8
0.01
'
'"i\
loo,
'
'
I"
'\.
0,0001
1.00
1.IS
1.30
1.45
1.60
1.75
1.90
Fig. 12.1.1 Relationship of Exceedence Probability of Permissible Wave Overtopping Rate to hJhcd
(Required Crown height above Water Level I Calculated Crown height}
(3) In order to estimate the quantity of seepage of polluted water into the sea from reclamation revetments, it is
necessary to perform an analysis of seepage flows. In general, Darcy's law can be applied to seepage flow analysis.
However, as will be discussed below, the cross section of a revetment consists of different materials, including
sheet piles and concrete members, and backfilling sand. Furthermore, permeability of sheet piles will differ at the
joints and in the sheet piles themselves. For this reason, there are cases in which Darcy's law cannot be applied.
In analysis of seepage flows in this case, it is realistic to treat the cross section of the revetment as a structure
comprising materials to which Darcy's law can be applied. Therefore, it is necessary to convert the coefficient of
permeability and the wall width, applying ingenuity in order to apply Darcy's law in an approximate manner.
In seepage flow analysis, the scope of analysis extends to the point where the water level within the reclaimed
area can be considered uniform. However, analysis can be performed by setting the scope corresponding to the
required accuracy, considering the structure of the revetment body, and condition ofbackfilling sand. Provided,
however, that caution is necessary when the permeability of the landfill soil deposited in the reclaimed area is
itself low, as the water level within the reclaimed area will have a steep gradient in the landfill soil.
CD
(a) The permeability of steel sheet pile structures cannot be derived from Darcy's law. However, it can be
applied by using an appropriate equivalent width and the equivalent coefficient of permeability for that width.
In addition, because it cannot be assured that a laboratory test could reproduce the joint conditions of the
protorype structure in proper scale, it is preferable to use the values measured in-situ.
(b) Reference 11) is available concerning the permeability of steel sheet pile-type structures. It describes the
result of analyses taking into account the in-situ measurements on residual water levels at five project sites.
In the analyses, it was assumed that the sheet pile wall below the seabed are impermeable and the part of
wall above the seabed is equivalent to the permeable layer of 1 m thick to which Darcy's law can be applied.
The results obtained for the coefficient of permeability, equivalent coefficient of permeability, were in the
range of lxl0-5 - 3xl0-S emfs. The results of the similar analysis carried out for two examples of steel pipe
pile-type quaywall with diameter of approximately 80 cm yielded a value of 6xl0-S cm/s. The coefficient of
permeability for backfilling material of the foregoing surveys was in the range of 10-2 -10-3 cm/s.
(c) The permeability of sheet pile joint has the following characteristics:
In cases without backfilling material, the sheet pile joint is similar in nature to a narrow orifice of abrupt
sectional reduction, and can be expressed in equation (12.1.3) with the constant n = 0.5 12), 13)
q=Kh~
(12.1.3)
where
In cases with backfilling material, the property of the backfilling material greatly affects the quantity of
seepage through the joint. In the vicinity of the backfilling material behind the sheet pile joint, there are areas
at which Darcy's law cannot be applied. There has been an effort to evaluate the permeability as a composite
joint that includes a certain thickness of backfill and sheet pile joint. This idea is effective for seepage
-667-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
analysis. Shoji et al.14) proposed an empirical equation based on the comprehensive tests considering both
the difference in the degree of tensile force in the joint and conditions with or without sand filling. From the
results of the tests, for the case that there is backfilling and joints are filled with sand, it was found that the
constant n could be given an approximate value of 1.0 and the K value representing the results of the tests was
derived.
-668-
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Revetments
Article20
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for revetments
to be utilized by an unspecified large number of people shall satisfy the requirements specified by the
Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so as to secure the safety of the users of the
revetment concerned.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Revetments
Article 43
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria for the revetments
which are utilized by an unspecified large number of people shall be such that the revetments have the
dimensions necessary to secure the safety of users in consideration of the environmental conditions to
which the facilities concerned are subjected, and the utilization conditions, and others.
[Technical Nole]
(!) In amenity-oriented revetments, the cross section of the revetment shall be set considering the danger of users
falling into the sea, and ancillary facilities such as fences to prevent falling shall be provided appropriately, as
necessary.
(2) In facilities where wave overlapping can be expected to reach parts where people normally walk during even high
wave conditions, it is necessary to ensure general public knowledge of the danger by appropriate means such as
signs.
(3) When facilities are used by elderly persons, and persons with physical disabilities, efforts must be made to enable
safe movement of wheelchairs when designing passages on the revetment, the width and gradient of slopes.
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
-669-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
17) Technical Committee for Coastal protection facilities: Technical standards and commentary of coastal protection facilities,
Japan Port Association, 2004
18) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Manual for Port environment upgrading, 1991
19) JSCE Editioo: Landscape design of ports and harbours, Giho-do Publishing, 1991
20) Transport Economy Research Center: Guideline of the facilities for elderly and handicapped people in public transport
terminal, 1994
-670-
13 Coastal Dikes
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Coastal Dikes
Article21
The provisions of Article 16 shall be applied correspondingly to the performance requirements for coastal
dikes.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Coastal Dikes
Article 44
The provisions of Article 39 shall be applied to the performance criteria for coastal dikes with modifications
as necessary.
References
1)
Technical Committee for Coastal Protection Facilities: Technical standards and comment\ary of coastal protection facilities,
Japan Port Association, pp. 3-19- 3-60, 2004
-671-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
14 Groins
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Groins
Article22
1 The performance requirements for groins shall be as specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure,
Transport and Tourism for the purpose of mitigating the influence oflittoral drift through effective control
of sediment transport.
2 The provisions of the item (2) of the paragraph (J) of Article 14 shall be applied correspondingly to the
performance requirements for groins.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Groins
Article 45
The provisions of Article 38 shall be applied to the performance criteria of groins with modifications as
necessary.
[Commentary]
Technical Committee for Coastal Protection Facilities: Technical standards and comment\ary of coastal protection facilities,
Japan Port Association, pp.3-77-3-85, 2004
-672-
15 Parapets
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Parapets
Article23
The provisions of Article 16 shall be applied correspondingly to the performance requirements for
parapets.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Parapets
Article 46
The provisions of Article 39 shall be applied to the performance criteria of parapets with modifications as
necessary.
-673-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
[Technical Note]
16 Siltation Prevention Facilities
16.1 General
(!) In cases where siltation of harbors and waterways is expected, the mode of siltation shall be analyzed based on
an adequate investigation of the potential causes of siltation, and appropriate countermeasures shall be taken,
considering the various types of effects caused by siltation prevention works, sate navigation of ships and economy.
CD
Invasion and accumulation of littoral drift mainly caused by waves or that caused by currents
16.2 Facilities for Trapping Littoral Drift and River Erosion Sediment
(!) When it is aimed to prevent shoaling due to littoral drift by means of maintenance dredging, an appropriate
facility to trap the sediment should be built at a proper location, at which the facility can prevent sediment from
invading to waterways or basins. The facility should be able to reduce the wave actions around it and increase the
dredging efficiency. The type and layout of these sand trap facilities is preferable to be determined by taking into
consideration their capability to trap the sediment, the dredging conditions, and the construction and operational
costs, based on adequate investigations and researches.
in Fig. 16.2.l(a), (b), and (c), or artificial conditions may be created to encourage sediments to settle out of flows
with a high concentration oflittoral drift, as shown in Fig. 16.2.l(d), (e), and (f). To identify suitable locations of
this type and capture littoral drift in the most efficient manner, an adequate understanding of the condition and
mechanism of sediment transport is indispensable. Furthermore, in selecting the positions for sediment traps, in
addition to sediment trapping efficiency, in cases where the trapped sediments will be dredged, it is preferable
to give adequate consideration to dredging conditions, in other words, to easily maintaining the water depth
necessary for navigation of dredgers and calm conditions during navigation and work.
-674-
ru(~,~oufu hmbor
~JI
Waterway
(a)
Pocket dredging
'
(b)
(c)
'-.
"-~Submerged
'-.
breakwater
......
(d)
(e)
(!)
Wind-blown sand, i.e., sand that is moved by winds, is carried into harbors or waterways where it settles and deposits,
and cause shoaling there. In some cases it also accumulates on road surfaces and is dispersed into residential areas,
disrupting the daily living of the resident. In particular, there are many instances that open digging of dune or land
reclamation cause problems related to wind-blown sand, and thorough countermeasures must be prepared in advance.
References
1)
2)
3)
OZASA, H.: Field Investigation of Submarine Sand Banks and Large Sand Waves, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 14, No. 2, pp.3-46,
1975
Tanaka, K., Y. Nakajima, H. Endou and E. Kinnai: Sabo at coast (Coastal erosion control), Sabo Science, Compendium of
Sabo Series, III-9, Japao Society of Erosion Control Engineers, lshibashi-shoten Publishing,1985
JSCE, Civil Engineering Haodbook, Vol. II, pp. 2135-2136, 1989
-675-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article25
Mooring facilities shall be installed in appropriate locations in light of geotechnical characteristics,
meteorological characteristics, sea states, and other environmental conditions, as well as ship navigation
and other usage conditions of the water area around the facilities concerned for the purpose of securing the
safe and smooth usage by ships.
Ministerial Ordinance
Necessary Items concerning Mooring Facilities
Article34
The items necessary for the performance requirements of mooring facilities as specified in this Chapter by
the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism and other requirements shall be provided by
the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Mooring Facilities
Article 47
The items to be specified by the Public Notice under Article 34 of the Ministerial Ordinance concerning
the performance requirements of mooring facilities shall be as provided in the subsequent article through
Article 73.
[Technical Note]
1.1 General
(1) Mooring facilities include quay walls, piers, lighter's wharfs, :floating piers, docks, mooring buoys, mooring
piles, dolphins, detached piers, air cushion craft landing facilities, etc. Among quaywalls, piers, and lighter's
wharfs, facilities which are particularly important from the viewpoint of earthquake preparedness and require
strengthening of seismic-resistant performance are termed high earthquake-resistance facilities, and are classified
as high earthquake-resistance facilities (specially designated (emergency supply transport)), high earthquakeresistance facilities (specially designated (trunk line cargo transport)), and high earthquake-resistance facilities
(standard (emergency supply transport)), corresponding to the functions required in the objective facilities after
action of ground motion.
(2) Examples of the standard performance verification procedure for Level 1 earthquake ground motion and Level 2
earthquake ground motion of mooring facilities are shown in Fig. 1.1.1 and Fig. 1.1.2, respectively. For details,
the descriptions of the respective structural types may be referenced.
-676-
I-dimensional seismic
response calculation
Study of
Liquefaction
counter measures
Piertipe
IResponseto acceleration
ar corresponding I
natural period of pier
i
I
r
k.~a,lg
-------------
I k,~(
(k,
D0 )
----------------------- -----------
'
Sliding, overturning,
and bearing capacity of ground:
Effect of action~ Strength
Stress:5Yield stress
Sheet pile,
tie rod,
anchor piles:
'
'
'
: Gravity type
: Sheet pile type
'
'
'
--------------~-----------------------~---------------------y___________ ,
: Pier type
1-----------------------------------------------------------------------~
Fig. 1.1.1 Example of Performance Verification Procedure for Level 1 earthquake ground motion
Pier
Deformatio:n:::
Allowable deformation
Gravity type
Fig. 1.1.2 Example of Performance Verification Procedure for Level 2 earthquake ground motion
-677-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) Mooring facilities used by passenger ships should be isolated from the areas where hazardous cargoes are
handled, and a sufficient area of land should be secured in the vicinity of the facilities fur waiting rooms and
parking lots.
@ Mooring facilities used by vessels loaded with hazardous cargoes should be located in accordance with the
following conditions:
a) Mooring facilities are isolated from such facilities as housing, schools, and hospitals.
b) The required safety distance from other mooring facilities and sailing vessels is secured.
c) Countermeasures against spills of hazardous materials are easily mobilized.
Mooring facilities where a considerable amount ofnoise may be generated by vessels or cargo handling equipment
should be isolated from such facilities as housing, schools, and hospitals to preserve a good environment for
daily living.
Mooring facilities where conspicuous dust and offensive odors may be generated during cargo handling work
should be isolated from such facilities as housing, schools, and hospitals to preserve a good environment for
daily living.
@ Offshore mooring facilities should not hinder the navigation or anchorage of vessels.
@ Whenever possible, high earthquake-resistance facilities and large-scale mooring facilities are preferably
arranged in areas with good ground conditions, as large investment may be required for ground improvement,
etc., depending on the ground conditions.
(J) Regarding facilities which may have a large effect on life, property, and social and economic activities.
If those facilities are damaged and high earthquake-resistance facilities, in cases where such facilities are
located near the hypocenter of an inland active fault, the objective facilities are preferably constructed in such
a way that the face line is orthogonal to the direction of the seismogenic fault. This is recommended because
particularly strong ground motion may occur in the direction orthogonal to the inland active fault near the fault
hypocenter, and an arrangement in which the face line of the facilities is orthogonal to the seismogenic fault is
structurally advantageous against actions due to ground movement generated by such active faults.
CD Natural condition
@ Usage condition
@ Construction condition
Economic condition
1.4 Standard Concept of Allowable Deformation of High Earthquake-resistance Facilities for Level
2 Earthquake Ground Motion
(!) The standard limit for deformation in accidental situations for Level 2 earthquake ground motion may be set
as follows, depending on the perfurmance requirements of the facilities. Provided, however, that this shall not
apply to cases in which deformation is set based on a total judgment, considering site conditions, performance
requirements, structural type, etc. of the objective facilities.
(a) High earthquake-resistance facilities (specially designated (emergency supply transport))
From the viewpoint of function, the allowable residual deformation of high earthquake-resistance facilities
(specially designated (emergency supply transport)) can be set, as a standard, at approximately 30-IOOcm, and
-678-
the allowable residual inclination angle can be set at approximately 3. For example, because materials, etc.
for emergency restoration are stockpiled at all times and a system for emergency restoration is prepared, in
cases where it is judged that serviceability can be secured even in the event of large defurmation, allowable
deformation can be set at approximately IOOcm.
(b) High earthquake-resistance facilities (specially designated (trunk line cargo transport))
The allowable residual deformation for high earthquake-resistance facilities (specially designated (trunk line
cargo transport)) is set based on the period until the expected functions can be restored. From the viewpoint of
maintaining the trunk line cargo transport function, it is more rational to set a shorter period for earthquakes
in which a wide area suffers damage, as in ocean trench type earthquakes, than that for earthquakes in which
damage is concentrated in a comparatively narrow area, as in an inland active fault earthquakes. In this case,
a smaller allowable deformation can be set for an ocean trench type earthquake than for an inland active fault
earthquake.
In high earthquake-resistance facilities (specially designated (trunk line cargo transport)), in order to secure
the same level of earthquake resistance in cranes as that of the mooring facilities, cranes with a seismic isolation/
damping mechanism are installed. In this case, a seismic response analysis which considers the dynamic
interaction of the mooring facilities and cranes is performed, and the response of the structural members of
the cranes is set within the elastic limit. The limit of the relative deformation of the rail span shall be set
depending on the characteristics of the cargo handling equipment mounted on the rails. For example, if the
elastic deformation range of the crane legs is 70cm and the limit (displacement stroke) of the seismic isolation
mechanism is 30cm, the limit of the relative deformation of the rail span may be set at JOO cm.
(c) High earthquake-resistance facilities (standard (emergency supply transport))
The allowable residual deformation for high earthquake-resistance facilities (standard (emergency supply
transport)) must be set with consideration given to enabling cargo handling after a certain period following the
action of Level 2 earthquake ground motion. An appropriate value roughly on the order of JOO cm or more can
be set for residual horizontal deformation.
References
1)
Takahashi, H., T. Nakamoto and F. Yoshimura: Analysis of maritime transportation in Kobe Port after the 1995 Hyogoken-
2)
-679-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2 Wharves
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Quaywalls
Article26
1 The performance requirements for quaywalls shall be as specified in the subsequent items in consideration
of its structural type:
(1) The performance requirements shall be such that the requirements specified by the Minister of Land,
Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied so as to enable the safe and smooth mooring of
ships, embarkation and disembarkation of people, and handling of cargo.
(2) Damage to the quaywall due to self weight, earth pressure, Level 1 earthquake ground motions,
berthing and traction by ships, imposed load or other actions shall not impair the functions of the
quaywall concerned and not adversely affect its continued use.
2 In addition to the provisions of the previous paragraph, the performance requirements for quaywalls which
are classified as high earthquake-resistance facilities shall be such that the damage due to the action of
Level 2 earthquake ground motions and other actions do not affect the restoration through minor repair
works of the functions required for the quaywall concerned in the aftermath of the occurrence of Level 2
earthquake ground motions. Provided, however, that for the performance requirements for the quaywall
which requires further improvement in earthquake-resistant performance due to environmental conditions,
social conditions or other conditions to which the quaywall concerned is subjected, the damage due to
said actions shall not affect the restoration through minor repair works of the functions of the quaywall
concerned and its continued use.
[Commentary]
(1) Wharves classified as high earthquake-resistance facilities (restorability, serviceability)
The following classifications are used as standards in provisions stipulating the appropriate performance
of high earthquake-resistance facilities, corresponding to the functions necessary after action of Level
2 earthquake ground motion and the allowable period for restoration in order to demonstrate those
functions.
CD Specially designated (emergency supply transport): Facilities which can be used by ships and perform
embarkation/disembarkation of persons and cargo handling of emergency supplies, etc. immediately
after action of Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
Specially designated (trunk line cargo transport): Facilities which can be used by ships and perform
cargo handling of trunk line cargoes within a short period after action of Level 2 earthquake ground
motion.
Standard (emergency supply transport): Facilities which can be used by ships and perform embarkation/
disembarkation of persons and cargo handling of emergency supplies, etc. within a certain period after
action of Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
[Technical Nole]
(!) Wharves Classified as High Earthquake-resistance Facilities
CD
In wharves which are classified as high earthquake-resistance facilities, it is necessary to secure restorability
fur accidental situations associated with Level 2 earthquake ground motion. In the case of wharves in which
further improvement in earthquake resistance is necessary, depending on the natural conditions and social
conditions where the wharf is installed, it is necessary to secure serviceability for the same Design situation.
Provided, however, that restorability and serviceability, as used here, refer to the performance requirements of
the functions considered necessary in the quaywall after action of Level 2 earthquake ground motion, and are
independent of the essential functions considered necessary in the objective wharf under normal conditions.
-680-
the functions required in the objective facilities after action of Level 2 earthquake ground motion, and settings
in connection with the performance criteria and design situation are given corresponding to these classifications.
For details of the classification of high earthquake-resistance facilities, see Table 2.1.
Table 2.1 Classification of Earthquake-Resistance Facilities
Slight restoration
Slight restoration
*): This performance requirement corresponds to functions (emergency supply transport) which are necessary after an earthquake, and is
different from the performance requirement of the essential functions of the facilities.
emergency supplies can be transported, after a certain period by emergency restration, even in cases in which
facilities are damaged by action of Level 2 earthquake ground motion. "Certain period," as used here, means a
period on the order of approximately I week after the action of Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
(3) Trunk Line Cargo Transport Type High Earthquake-resistance Facilities
In high earthquake-resistance facilities (specially designated (trunk line cargo transport)), it is necessary to secure
restorability with respect to accidental situations associated with Level 2 earthquake ground motion. Here,
restorability means that it is necessary to limit damage to a degree where transport of trunk line cargoes can
be performed after a short period by slight restoration, for example, within the allowable deformation set in line
with the characteristics of the cargo handling equipment, even in case of damage by action of Level 2 earthquake
ground motion. "Short period," as used here, will differ depending on the functions necessary in the facilities
concerned, and therefore should be set appropriately corresponding to the respective facilities.
-681-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 48
1 The performance criteria which are common for quaywalls shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Quaywalls shall have the water depth and length necessary for accommodating the design ships in
consideration of their dimensions.
(2) Quaywalls shall have the crown height as necessary in consideration of the range of tidal levels, the
dimensions of the design ship, and the utilization conditions of the facilities concerned.
(3) Quaywalls shall have the ancillary equipment as necessary in consideration of the utilization
conditions.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of quaywalls which are
classified as the high earthquake-resistance facilities shall be such that the degree of damage owing to
the actions of Level 2 earthquake ground motions, which are the dominant action in the accidental action
situation, is equal to or less than the threshold level corresponding to the performance requirements
[Commentary]
Public Notice
"" e
e
.1! ~
.1!
<
~<
} J
26
48
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
Nondominating
actions
Dominating
actions
Restorability, Accidental L2
Serviceability
earthquake
ground
motion
Verification item
Self weight,
Damage
water pressure,
surcharge
*)In this table, "serviceability" means serviceability with respect to "necessary function after earthquake (emergency supply transport)."
*) In this table, "restorability.. means restorability with respect to "essential function" or "necessary function after earthquake (emergency
supply transport)."
-682-
Public Notice
..,
..,
26
48
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
Restorability, Accidental L2
Serviceability
Nondominating
Dominating
actions
earthquake
ground
motion
Verification item
actions
Self weight,
Deformation of face Limit of residual deformation
earth pressure, line of quay wall
water pressure,
surcharge
**) In this table, "serviceability" means serviceability with respect to ''necessary function after earthquake (emergency supply transport)."
*) In this table, "restorability" means restorability with respect to "essential function" or "necessary function after earthquake (emergency
supply transport)."
-683-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Attached Table 27 Settings in Connection with Performance Criteria and Design situation (limited to Accidental
Situations) of Sheet Pile Quaywall type High Earthquake-resistance Facilities (Specially Designated (Emergency
Supply Transport), Specially Designated (Trunk Line Cargo Transport)
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
"' e
"' e
~
,l! ~
,l!
Q
<
J J
26
<
48
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
Dominating
actions
Restorability, Accidental L2
Serviceability
earthquake
groond
motion
Nondominating
actions
Self weight,
earth pressure,
Verification item
water pressure,
Yielding of sheet piles
surcharge
Index of standard
limit value
Limit of residual
deformation
Resistance based on
anchorage work2)
Stability of anchorage
work3)
Public Notice
Q
.c
<
J J
26
,1!
48
<
,1!
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
Dominating
Nondominating
actions
actions
Restorability Accidental L2
earthquake
ground
motion
Self weight,
earth
pressure,
water
pressure,
surcharge
Verification item
Index of standard
limit value
Deformation of face
line of quay wall
t):
2)
3)
)
Stability of anchorage
work-3)
The structural type of anchorage work is limited to the cases of vertical pile anchorage, coupled-pile anchorage, and sheet pile anchorage.
The structural type of anchorage work is limited to the case of coupled-pile anchorage.
The structural type of anchorage work is limited to the case of concrete wall anchorage.
In this table, "Restorability" means restorability with respect to "necessary function after earthquake (emergency supply transport.)''
-685-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) Length
The length of a wharf used in perfurmance verification of the wharf shall be set as the value obtained by adding
the necessary lengths of the bow and stern mooring lines to the total length of the design ship, preconditioned
on exclusive use of the objective wharf by the design ship.
@ Water depth
The water depth used io perfurmance verification of a wharf shall be set as the value obtained by adding the keel
clearance corresponding to the design ship to the maximum draft, fur example, the load draft, etc., of the design
ship in order to obtain a value which will not hamper use of the design ship.
@ The crown height of a wharf used in performance verification of the wharf shall give appropriate consideration
to the assumed use conditions of the facilities, so as to enable sore and smooth use of the wharf.
Q) It is preferable that the length and water depth of berths be set to appropriate values based on a study of the main
dimensions of ships, etc.
@ When a vessel is moored parallel to a wharf, the mooring lines shown in Fig. 2.1.1 are required. The bow and
stem lioes are usually set at an angle of30 to 45 with the quay face, because these lines are used to prevent both
the longitudinal movement (in the bow and stern directions) and lateral movement (in the onshore and offshore
directions) of the vessel.
@ The water depth of berths can be calculated using equation (2.1.1). Here, the maximum draft represents the
maximum draft in a calm water condition, such as when the ship is moored, etc., in the operating condition,
e.g. Full load draft of the design ship. For the keel clearance, in general, it is preferable to use a value equal
to approximately 10% of the maximum draft. Provided, however, io mooriog facilities where shelteriog by
ships in a moored condition in abnormal weather or the like is conceivable, addition of a keel clearance which
(2.1.1)
In case of a berth where flammable dangerous cargoes are handled, it is necessary to secure a distance of 30 m
or more from oil tanks, boilers, and workiog areas that use open fire to the cargo handling area and the mooring
vessel at the berth. However, when there is no risk that the cargo will catch fire in the event of leakage because
of the surrounding topography or structure ofthe facilities of the berth, the distance may be shortened to around
15m.
In case of a berth where flammable dangerous cargoes are handled by tankers, etc., it is necessary to secure a
distance of 30 m or more from other anchored vessels and also to secure a distance of 30 m or more from other
vessels navigating nearby in order to provide a room for their maneuvering. However, this distance may be
iocreased or decreased as necessary io consideration of the size of the cargo carrying vessel, the type and size
of vessels anchored or navigatiog nearby, and the condition of ship congestion.
-686-
A: bowline
B: stem line
C: spring lines
D: breast lines
Fig. 2.1.1 Arrangement of Mooring Ropes
Length of berth
(m)
(m)
1,000
2,000
3,000
5,000
10,000
12,000
18,000
30,000
40,000
55,000
70,000
90,000
120,000
150,000
80
100
110
130
160
170
190
240
260
280
300
320
350
370
4.5
5.5
6.5
7.5
9.0
10.0
11.0
12.0
13.0
14.0
15.0
17.0
18.0
20.0
2. Container Ships
Self weight tonnage
DWT(t)
Length ofberth
10,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
100,000
170
220
250
300
330
350
400
(m)
-687-
500
1,300
2,000
2,800
3,500
4,300
7,300
890
1,600
2,400
3,200
3,900
4,700
7,700
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
3. Tankers
Self weight tonnage
DWT(t)
Length of berth
(m)
1,000
2,000
3,000
5,000
10,000
15,000
20,000
30,000
50,000
80
100
4.5
no
130
170
190
210
230
270
5.5
6.5
7.5
9.0
10.0
11.0
12.0
14.0
Gross tonnage GT
(I)
(m)
(m)
3,000
5,000
10,000
20,000
40,000
60,000
150
180
220
240
250
270
7.0
7.5
9.0
10.0
12.0
12.0
Gross tonnage GT
(I)
3,000
5,000
10,000
20,000
30,000
50,000
70,000
100,000
6. Passenger Ships
Length of berth
Water depth of berth
(m)
130
150
180
220
260
310
340
370
-688-
(m)
5.0
5.5
7.5
9.0
9.0
9.0
9.0
9.0
7-1 Intermediate- and Short-Distance Ferries (sailing distance less than 300km in Japan)
Case of bow and stem side docking type
Gross tonnage GT
Length of bow and
Length of berth
(t)
stem side docking Water depth of berth
(m)
(m)
type quaywall (m)
400
60
20
3.5
700
80
20
4.0
1,000
90
25
4.5
3,000
140
25
5.5
7,000
160
30
7.0
10,000
190
30
7.5
13,000
220
35
8.0
(In all cases, domestic gross tonnage.)
Length of berth
(m)
60
70
@ In cases where the design ship cannot be identified, in general, the values shown in Table 2.1.2 are widely used.
It should be noted that the values in this table are expressed using the mean monthly-highest water level as a
standard.
Table 2.1.2 Standard Crown Heights of Wharves
+-0.5-1.5m
+1.0--2.0m
+0.3-1.0m
+0.5-l.5m
@ In the cross sections of a vessel, the bottom comer sections are slightly rounded and have projecting bilge keels.
In many cases, the radius of curvature of the comer sections and the height of the bilge keels are 1.0 to 1.5 m and
30 to 40 cm, respectively. Therefore the envelope of corner sections may be assumed to be nearly 90, including
the bilge keels. The planned water depths of berths are generally deeper than the load draft of the design vessel
by 0.3 m or more.
-689-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ Fig. 2.1.2 shows the clearance limit for wharves set in consideration of the above facts and past examples.!),
The clearance limit of wharves may be determined using this figure as reference. However, care should
normally be exercised in using the clearance limit shown in the figure, because the rolling, pitching, and heaving
motions of vessel at berth have not been taken into consideration in the figure.
2)
CD The design water depth of a wharf shall be determined by considering its planned water depth as well as the
structural type, the original sea bottom depth, the method and accuracy of execution of work, and the the result
of scouring in front of the mooring facility.
@ In general, the design water depth is not equal to the planned water depth. The design water depth is ordinarily
obtained by adding a margin to the planned water depth in order to guarantee the required stability of the
mooring facility. As this margin will vary according to the structural type, the water depth of the site, the
construction method and accuracy, and the result of scouring, it is important to determine the design water
depth carefully in consideration of these factors.
@ When it is difficult to determine the depth of scouring due to berthing vessels or currents, it is advisable to
provide scour prevention measures as described in 2.1.2 Protection against Scouring.
-690-
Article 49
The performance criteria of gravity-type quaywalls shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The risk of sliding failure of the ground under the permanent action situation in which the dominant
action is self weight shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(2) The risk of failure due to sliding or overturning of the quaywall body or insufficient bearing capacity
of the foundation ground under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is earth
pressure and under the variable action situation in which the main action is Level 1 earthquake ground
motions shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
[Commentary]
CD The commentary of the performance criteria and design situation (excluding accidental situations) of
gravity-type quaywalls shall be as shown in Attached Table 29. In addition to this code, the settings
in connection with the Standard Public Notice, Article 22, Paragraph 3 (Scouring and Sand Washing
Out) shall be applied as necessary, and the settings in connection with Article 23 and Article 27 shall
be applied corresponding to the type of members comprising the objective gravity-type quaywall.
Attached Table 29 Settings of Performance Criteria and Design Situation
(Excluding Accidental Situations) of Gravity-type Quaywalls
Ministerial
Ordinance
..,
e~< 5
26
"
1
<
l
5~
49
"'
Design situation
Public Notice
~
"
Performance
requirements
Situation
Dominating
actions
Nondominating
pressure,
surcharge
Self weight,
water
pressure,
surcharge
Variable
L1
earthquake
ground
motion
Index of standard
limit value
actions
Earth
pressure
Verification item
Self weight,
earth
pressure,
water
pressure,
surcharge
[Technical Note]
(!) Depending on the type ofwall structure, gravity-type quaywalls are classified as caisson type quaywalls, L-shaped
block type quaywalls, mass concrete block type quaywalls, cellular concrete block type quaywalls, cast-in-place
concrete type quaywalls, upright wave-dissipating type quaywalls, and others. The description provided herein
can be applied to performance verification of these gravity-type quaywalls. Regarding upright wave absorbing
type quaywalls, the performance verification method shown in 2.11 Upright Wave-absorbing Type Quaywalls
can be used as reference.
(2) An example of the performance verification procedure for gravity-type quaywalls is shown in Fig. 2.2.1.
-691-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
,.,,__ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ____,
1
*I
r--------------------------- ------------------------------------
'
I---------~-------~
Verification of sliding, overturning of superstructure
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~-i-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~i:~~:;:-t;;;~~
Verification in connection with sliding, overturning of wall structure,
and bearing capacity of foundation ground
1
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~;~;;,;;i~~~~~~~~~~;g;;;-~~~~~~
Verification in connection with sliding, overturning of wall structure, I
and bearing capacity of foundation ground
I
2
1_______________________________________
' ---------------------
1- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -~
i---------------- ---------------------~-~~~f~~~:i:~-~~~~~i
I
'
---------------~--- ----
'
~:::::::::::::::::::::::::::t:::::::::::::::::::::::::.;~~~i~~~
:
I
Verification of circular slip failmev
:r----------+-+~
~---------------------------i-----------------------------------~
H.W.L.
sz L.W.L.
Filling
sand
Filling
sand
~-
_Planned
_ _water _depth
_ _.4'"""-,---,.C::;:::;;::::::::;:'..'.:;:::::;:::::;:::::ulXUX_x_:u_x_:xux_
Current water depth
-692-
___:~---...
(!) Seismic coefficient fur verification used in verification of damage due to sliding and overturning of wall body and
insufficient bearing capacity of foundation ground in variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground
motion 9), 10)
CD
As tbe seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification, it is necessary to set an appropriate
seismic coefficient corresponding to the deformation of the facilities concerned, considering the effects of the
frequency characteristics and duration of tbe ground motion and other relevant factors. The procedure of the
generally-used method of calculating the seismic coefficient for verification is as shown in Fig. 2.2.3.
Acceleration time history in engineering ground
'
I-dimensional seismic response analysis (see@)
'
-------------------~-----------------
,,
r------------------------------------
''
~
'
''
iI
I
'. -----------------1- -----------------Calculatinn ofreductinn factorp (see (a))
1 x p).
'
Calculation of maximum corrected value of
'
--
Fig. 2.2.3 Example of Procedure for Calculation of Seismic Coefficient for Verification
@ The outline of the method of calculating the seismic coefficient for verification is shown in Fig. 2.2.4. First, the
acceleration time history of the ground surface is calculated by setting the Level I earthquake ground motion in
the bedrock and performing a I-dimensional seismic response analysis using this as the input ground motion.
A fast Fourier transform (FFT) is performed on the acceleration time history obtained in this manner to obtain
the acceleration spectrum of tbe ground surface. Filter processing is then performed on the result, taking into
consideration frequency characteristics corresponding to the deformation of the gravity-type quaywall. The
filter used here obtains the maximum value of acceleration at the free surface of the ground from tbe results
of a seismic response analysis performed on multiple sine waves of different frequencies in such way that
the horizontal residual displacement of the crown of the gravity-type quaywall becomes the target value, and
assesses tbe contribution to deformation of the quaywall of each frequency component of the ground motion.
Accordingly, after filtering, the spectrum is a uniform deformation spectrum. As a result, the maximum value of
acceleration obtained after an inverse fast Fourier transform (IFFn is independent of frequency and is assigned
-693-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
a correspondence with a certain amount of deformation. Next, the corrected peak acceleration a" at the ground
surface is obtained by obtaining the maximum acceleration from the acceleration time history after filtering, and
multiplying a1 by a reduction factor p which considers the duration of the ground motion. The characteristic
value of the seismic coefficient for verification is calculated using this corrected peak acceleration a c and the
allowable deformation D0 at the crown of the quaywall. It should be noted that the method of calculating
the characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification differs in cases where soil improvement is
performed using the deep mixing method and sand compaction (SCP) with a replacement rate ofmore than 70%.
Therefore, it is necessary to refer to the following (e).
Ground surface
IA___
Replaced sand
Engineering ground - - - - - - - - - - - n
: Determination of :
V
:~~~o~l___ :
+-
aT
'j_UA."
v Vyv v ---
I-dimensional seismic:
'--------------'
{1.
~~~_Y."!___ J
Consideration of
effect of duration
~--------------------------------,
: '7T\JlJljVv
AA ,.
r---------------
{!, :
I
Fast Fourier
transform (FFI)
I~-----------
=~~)
a.TA'IVA."~
yvv
Consideration of
-----------------~~~9'-~~~cs
Acceleration spectrum
of ground surface
:__ - -- - ~ !1!_~~- -- - -- - -- - -- - -- - -- _:
=-
Filter
-694-
a(f)=
i-(1-1.0)2+6.8(1 -1.0)i
II 0.34
II 0.34
1.0</
(2.2.1)
H
T,,
T,,
h=l.05--0.88-+0.96--0.23
HR
1bR
I'uR
where
imaginary unit
The value of b shall be set as a value in the range shown by equation (2.2.2) using the wall height Hof the
quaywall. However, irrespective of the range set in equation (2.2.2), in all cases, the lower limit shall be 0.28.
(2.2.2)
-695-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
1.2
1.0
0.8
0.4 _
H~l5.0m
T,~l.O?s
0.2 - T =0.57s
14
..... ~~
I
0.0
1.0
f(Hz)
0.1
10.0
(b) Calculation of natural frequency of ground and ground direct underneath of wall
In calculations of the natural frequency for equation (2.2.1), calculations may be made by equation (2.2.3)
using the thickness ofthe respective soil layers above the seismic bedrock defined in the I-dimensional seismic
response analysis and the shear wave velocity. As the natural frequency of the ground, the primary natural
period of the frequency response function obtained using linear multiple reflection theory may be used. In
this case, ifthe shear wave velocity cannot be obtained, this may be estimated from the N value of the ground
or other appropriate values, referring to Part II Chapter 3, 2.4 Dynamic Analysis. Provided, however, that,
in calculating the initial natural period ofthe ground T, and the initial natural period of the ground underneath
of the wall T., backfilling stones and rubble stones directly under the wall shall not be evaluated using the
physical properties of those materials, but by substituting the physical properties of the original ground. In
cases where soil improvement is performed on normally consolidated clay strata, etc. using replacement sand
or similar, limited to the area directly under a gravity-type quaywall, it is necessary to evaluated r, and Tu in
the state prior to soil improvement. That is, T, and T. can be calculated at the positions shown in Fig. 2.2.6.
Because the effective surcharge pressure will vary, the natural period for the ground under the sea bottom
may not be used.
(2.2.3)
where
Backfill stones
Sea bottom
Object ground in
calculation of T,
Mound
Object ground in
calculation of T.
Replaced sand
Ground below sea bottom is not used for
natural period of ground.
Engineering ground
-696-
(2.2.4)
where
reduction factor (p~l.O)
root sum square of acceleration time history after filtering (cm/s2)
maximum acceleration after filtering (cm/s2)
p
S
a1
S=/L,acc2
where
(2.2.5)
ace
a,
a1
p
kh
k
=1.78 Da
( Dr )
a, +0.04
g
(2.2.7)
where
khk : characteristic value of seismic coefficient for verification
ac : maximum correction acceleration (cm/s2)
g : acceleration of gravity (=980cm/s2)
Da : allowable deformation of quaywall crown (=lOcm)
D, : standard deformation (=!Ocrn)
(b) Setting of allowable deformation
The allowable deformation of facilities must be set appropriately depending on the functions required in the
facilities and the conditions where the facilities are located. The standard value of the allowable deformation
of gravity-type quaywalls for Level 1 earthquake ground motion can be given as Da=IOcrn. This standard
allowable deformation (Da=lOcrn) is the average value of residual deformation of existing gravity-type
quaywalls for Level 1 earthquake ground motion calculated by seismic response analysis.
-697-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(a) The method presented here was developed assuming conditions under which liquefaction does not occur. If
the method is to be applied under other conditions, its applicability must be examined.
(b) The method presented here was prepared for allowable deformation Da of 5-20cm. Therefore, care is necessary
in cases where deformation outside of this range is adopted as the allowable value.
(c) Depending on the site, Level 1 earthquake ground motion may be underestimated. Therefore, if this method
is used, there is a possibility that extremely small values will be obtained for the seismic coefficient for
verification. In such cases, the lower limit shall be set at 0.05, considering the uncertainty of hazard analysis
when calculating Level 1 earthquake ground motion, the accuracy of the method of calculating the seismic
coefficient for verification, the method of defining allowable deformation, and similar factors.
@l In cases where examination ofthe vertical direction by the seismic coefficient for verification is necessary in the
seismic coefficient method, it is necessary to set an appropriate seismic coefficient for verification depending on
the characteristics of the facilities, characteristics of the ground, etc.
(2) For the seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification of structural members in accidental
situations associated with Level 2 earthquake ground motion, calculation based on appropriate examination is
preferable. For convenience, the seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification of structural
members in accidental situations associated with Level 2 earthquake ground motion may be calculated by the
method described in the above (1), using the acceleration time history of the ground surface of the free ground
area. In this case, the allowable deformation D 0 can be set at 50cm. However, in cases where this method is used,
a value greater than the seismic coefficient for verification for Level 1 earthquake ground motion must be used,
with an upper limit of 0.25. Provided, however, that in case the seismic coefficient for verification for Level I
earthquake ground motion exceeds 0.25, the higher value shall be used.
(3) Determination of Wall Body Portion
CD
In cases where stability is to be confirmed by substituting inertia forces for seismic forces, it is necessary to
assess the inertia force based on an appropriate determination of the quaywall body. In this case, the quaywall
body may be defined as shown below, depending on the type of structure. Provided, however, that in cases
where deformation is assessed directly by a detailed method such as nonlinear effective stress analysis or the
like, examination by this method shall not be required.
@ As shown in Fig. 2.2.7, the wall body of a gravity-type quaywall can be taken as the portion between the face
line of the quaywall and the vertical plane passing through the rear toe of the quaywall. Normally backfill is
placed at the rear of the quaywall. In many types of gravity quaywalls, some part of this backfill acts as selfweight of the quaywall, and the portion of the backfill can be considered as a part of the quaywall body. It is
difficult to apply this concept to all cases unconditionally, because the extent of backfill considered as a part
of the quaywall body varies depending on the shape of the quaywall body and the mode of failure. In general,
however, the extent of backfill considered as a part of the quaywall body can be defined as shown by hatching
in Fig. 2.2.7 to simplify the design calculation, because modest changes in the location of the quaywall body
boundary plane do not affect the stability of the quaywall body significantly.
b
(b) Wall of concrete block type
@ In structures in which stability must be examined in each horizontal stratum, as in block type quaywalls, the
determination ofthe virtual wall body may be as follows. Normally, keys are provided between blocks for better
-698-
interlocking; however, in examination of the following items, it is preferable that the effect of the key structure
be ignored.
(a) Examination of sliding
As shown in Fig. l.l.8, the portion in front ofthe vertical plane passing through the rear toe at the level under
examination can be regarded as wall body.
Horizontal plane to be
---+~~~~-as,....s~~<! f~-s~~ility
Fig. 2.2.8 Determination of Wall body Portion for Stability of Sliding at Horizontal Joints
'
I'
I
@j
'
I'
I
Horizontal plane to be
assessed for stability
~
Fig. 2.2.9 Determination of Wall Body Portion for Stability Overturning
-699-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
permeability is expected over the long term, it is preferable to assume a large residual water level difference in
consideration of those conditions. In cases where waves attack the front face of the wall body, the residual water
level difference may also consider the wave trough; in general, however, it is not necessary to consider the increase
in the residual water level difference due to attack by waves in performance verification of quaywalls.11)
(5) For the wall friction angle, in general, ~~15 can be used. For L-shaped blocks, the shear resistance angle of the
backfilling material at the virtual back plane can be used. For details, the Technical Manual for L-Shaped
Block Quaywalls 12) may be used as a reference.
(6) The surcharge may be determined in accordance with Part II, Chapter 10, 3 Surcharge.
(7) Buoyancy is affected by numerous indeterminate factors. Therefure, it is preferable to set buoyancy considering
the worst-case scenario for the facilities concerned. For example, as shown in Fig. 2.2.10, buoyancy may be
calculated for the submerged portion of the wall body below the residual water level. Provided, however, that
this approach is applicable to cases in which the difference between the front water level and the residual water
level is within normal levels; in cases where the difference in water levels is remarkable, buoyancy must be set
appropriately, depending on the natural conditions where the objective facilities concerned are located, and other
relevant factors.
(8) In earth pressure during action of ground motion, it is normal practice to use the equations fur calculation of
earth pressure proposed by Monobe and Okabe, as shown in Part II, Chapter S, 1 Earth Pressure. However,
this is based on the concept of the seismic coefficient method. The actual earth pressures resulting from the
dynamic interaction of structures, soil, and water will vary. When the seismic coefficient for verification shown
in (1) is used, verification corresponding to the deformation of the quaywall considering these points is possible.
Provided, however, that in cases where the verification is not limited to the seismic coefficient method, but is
performed using a combination of the seismic coefficient method and high accuracy seismic response analysis
techniques (nonlinear effective stress analysis considering the dynamic interaction ofthe ground and structure, or
the like) and/or techniques fur actual physical assessment of deformation, such as model vibration tests, etc., when
defining the cross section for which deformation is to be verified, the earthquake pressure generated in the wall
body during earthquakes can be reduced to an intermediate value between the value given by the earth pressure
equations proposed by Monobe and Okabe and the active earth pressure in the Permanent situation. Provided,
however, that the content described herein may not be applied to structures other than gravity-type quaywalls.
(9) Effect of Earth Pressure Reduction by Backfill
In cases where good quality backfilling is placed (for example, a backfilling material with a shear resistance angle
of 40 is used for rubble), the effect of earth pressure reduction by the backfill can be obtained using an analytical
method (calculation of earth pressure by discrete method) which takes into consideration the composition of
the soil behind the wall body and the strength of each layer behind the quaywall.14) In ordinary gravity-type
quaywalls, rubble or cobble stones are used as the backfilling material. In this case, the effect of earth pressure
reduction may be assessed using the following simplified method.JS)
CD
When the cross section of backfill is triangular: When the backfill is laid in a triangular shape from the point of
intersection of the vertical line passing through the rear toe of quaywall and the ground surface with an angle
of slope less than the angle of repose a of the backfilling material, as shown in Fig. 2.2.11, it may be assumed
that the entire rear of wall is filled with the backfilling material. Provided, however, that when the reclaiming
material is slurry like cohesive soil, application of filling-up work or installation of sand invasion prevention
sheets to the surface of the backfill shall be used to prevent the slurry cohesive soil from passing through the
voids in the backfill and reaching the quaywall.
-700-
@ When the cross section of backfill is rectangular: In the case of a triangullll'-shaped backfill with a slope steeper
than the angle of repose of the backfilling material or any other irregular shape of backfill, the effect may be
considered as in the case of rectangular-shaped backfill which has an area equivalent to the backfill in question.
The effect of the rectangular backfill shown in Fig. 2.2.ll(b) may be considered as follows: When the width b
ofthe rectangular-shaped backfill is larger than the height ofthe wall, this case should be considered in the same
manner as in the case of triangular backfill Fig. 2.2.11, and when the width bis equal to 1/2 ofthe height, it shall
be assumed that the earth pressure is equivalent to the mean of earth pressure due to the backfill and that due to
the reclaimed soil. If the width b is 1/5 or less of the height of the wall, the earth pressure reduction effect due
to the backfill shall not be considered.
CD
Settlement
In cases where verification of sliding, overturning, and bearing capacity for variable situations associated
with Level 1 earthquake ground motion is to be performed by the seismic coefficient method, verification may be
performed by the following (2)-{4). However, if verification is performed by a detailed method such as dynamic
analysis or the like, this above-mentioned method cannot be applied. Verification by detailed methods such as
dynamic analysis shall be performed in accordance with (9) Performance Verification for Ground Motion
(detailed methods).
(2) Examination of sliding of the wall in the permanent situation and variable situations associated with Level 1
earthquake ground motion
CD
Examination of stability against sliding of the wall may be performed using the following equation. In this
equation, the symbol y is the partial factor, and the suffixes k and d indicate characteristic values and design
values, respectively.
fa(Wa +Pv,
where
-701-
(2.2.8)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
PdW : resultant dynamic water pressure acting on wall (kN/m) (only during action of ground motion)
PF : inertia force acting on wall (kN/m) (only during action of ground motion)
ya : structural aoalysis factor
The design values in the equation cao be calculated using the following equations.
fa =r1f
PH, = rllf PH,
Pv, =r~Pv,
(Using the horizontal component, Pv,
p
_}_
dwd -
12
r.,, k""pwgh
(2.2.9)
PF, = r.,k,,.Wa
where
(2.2.10)
The design value of the weight of the quaywall Wa cao be calculated by the following equation, using the
weight ofreinforced concrete wRC, weight of non-reinforced concrete wNC and weight of filling sand WsANO
(2.2.11)
@ In examination of sliding of the wall, vertical force can be considered as follows.
(a) The weight of the wall, not including surcharges (load of bulk cargoes, etc.) anterior to the virtual boundary
plaoe with the wall, aod subtracting buoyancy.
(b) Vertical component of earth pressure acting on virtual boundary plaoe.
(a) Horizontal component of the earth pressure acting on the virtual boundary plane with the wall, in a state with
a surcharge applied.
(b) Residual water pressure
(c) In performance verification for action of ground motion, in addition to the above, the inertia force and dynamic
water pressure acting on the wall shall be considered. As earth pressure, the horizontal component of earth
pressure during ground motion shall be used. In cases where cargo haodling equipment is present on the wall,
the horizontal force of the legs shall be considered.
@ The coefficient of friction shall conform to Part II, Chapter 11, 9 Friction Coefficient.
(3) Examination of bearing capacity of foundation ground in permanent situation and variable situations associated
with Level I earthquake ground motion
CD
In many cases, gravity-type quaywalls are structures which are susceptible to settlement and inclination of the
wall. Therefore, performance verification of the foundation shall be performed so as to avoid impairment of
-702-
@ In examinations of shallow foundations, the force acting on the bottom ofthe wall is the resultant force ofloads
acting in the vertical and horizontal directions, and therefore may be examined using Chapter 2, 2.2 Shallow
Spread Foundations, 2.2.5 Bearing Capacity for Eccentric and Inclined Actions. As the standard partial
factor used in performance verification, the values shown in Table 2.2.2 may be used.
The following equation may be used in examination of the stability of the bottom of the wall as it relates to the
bearing capacity of the ground. In the following equation, the symbol y is the partial factor, and the suffixes k
and d indicate characteristic values and design values, respectively.
L[{c'ds + (w'd + qd)tan(ld }sec0/(1 + tanOtanfd/ F1 ) ]
= F1
~ 1.0
(2.2.12)
where
c' : in case of clayey ground, undrained shear strength, and in case of sandy ground, apparent
cohesion in an undrained condition (kN/m2)
(2.2.13)
qd =rqqt
tan;d = YtMJf tant/11
In general, examination of the bearing capacity of the foundation ground is performed for a case in which no
surcharge is applied to the wall. However, when a surcharge is applied to the wall, eccentricity decreases, but
the resultant vertical force increases. Therefore, examination must also be performed in case a surcharge is
applied, as necessary.
The thickness of the foundation mound can be determined by examining inadequacy ofthe bearing capacity of
the foundation ground, the :flatness of mound surface for installing the wall body, and alleviation ofpartial stress
concentration in the ground, etc. It is preferable that the minimum thickness satisfy the following values.
(a) For a quaywall with a water depth ofless than 4.5m, a thickness of0.5m or more; provided, however, that the
thickness of the mound is at least 3 times the diameter of the rubble.
(b) For a quaywall with a water depth of 4.5m or more, a thickness of 1.0m or more; provided, however, that the
thickness of the mound is at least 3 times the diameter of the rubble.
(4) Examination of overturning of wall in permanent situation and variable situations associated with Level 1
earthquake ground motion
CD
Examination ofthe stability of the wall against overturning can be performed using the following equation. In
the following equation, the symbol y is the partial factor for the related suffix, and the suffixes k and d indicate
characteristic values and design values, respectively.
(2.1.14)
where
W : weight of materials comprising wall (kN/m)
PB : buoyancy acting on wall (kN/m)
-703-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Pv : resultant vertical earth pressure acting on wall (kN/m)
a : ann length fiom the center ofthe slip circle at the circular slip firilure of the action point ofPHd (m)
PHd : design value of horizontal action to the soil mas in the slip circle of circular slip failure (kN/m)
R : radius of slip circle (m)
Ya : structural analysis factor
The design values in the equation can be calculated using equation (2.2.9). The design value ofresidual water
pressure Pwd can be calculated referring to Part ll, Chapter S, 2.1 Residual Water Pressure, after calculating
the design value of the residual water level RWLd using equation (2.2.10). For the design value of the weight of
materials comprising the wall Wd in the equation, equation (2.2.11) can be used. In cases where caissons have
footings with a rectangular cross section on both the sea and shore sides, equation (2.2.12) can be used for the
design value of buoyancy PBd.
(5) Examination of Sliding Failure of Ground in Permanent Situation
Q) In cases where the foundation ground is weak, circular slip failure from an arbitrary point behind intersection
of the vertical plane through the rear toe of the wall and the bottom plane of the rubble may be examined.
@ Verification of circular slip failure of the foundation ground in the permanent situation as it relates to self weight
can be performed using the following equation. In the following equation, the symbol y is the partial factor for
the related suffix, and the suffix k indicates characteristic values.
(2.2.15)
where
c' : in case of clayey ground, undrained shear strength, and in case of sandy ground, apparent
cohesion in an undrained condition (kN/m2)
s : width of segment (m)
w' : weight of segment (kN/m)
q : load of surcharge acting on segment (kN/m)
qRWL : in case the residual water level (RWL) at the back of the facility is higher than the water level
(LWL) at the front of the facility, the weight of the water at the segment corresponding to the
difference in these water level Pwg(RWL - LWL)s (kN/m)
f : apparent shear resistance angle based on effective stress (0 )
() : angle of segment with horizontal plane ()
The design values in the equation can be calculated using the following equations. The design value of the
residual water level can be calculated using equation (2.2.10).
qd =rq
=
tanfd
qRWL,
r,..,. tanf,
= p,.g(RWLd -LWL)s
(2.2.16)
Q) Standard partial factors for system failure probability related to sliding and overturning of the wall, bearing
capacity of the foundation ground, and circular slip failure in the permanent situation for gravity-type quaywalls
can be determined referring to the values in Table 2.2.2(a). If based on the average safety standards in past
design methods, the average system reliability index for the stability of the wall body is 2.3 (if converted to
failure probability, 1.1 x 10-2), and the average reliability index for circular slip failure is 7.0 (failure probability,
1.1 x 1012). When considering the expected total cost expressed by the sum of the initial construction cost and
the cost of recovery incurred in case of failure, the system reliability index which minimizes the expected total
cost is 3.1 (failure probability, 1.0 x 10") for high earthquake-resistance facilities and 2.7 (failure probability,
4.0 x 10") for other quaywalls. The partial factors for sliding and overturning of the wall and bearing
capacity of the foundation ground in variable situations associated with Level 1 earthquake ground motion
can be determined referring to the values in Table 2.2.2(b). The partial factors shown in Table 2.2.2(b) were
-704-
determined considering the average system reliability of the past design method.
@ As partial factors for circular slip failure, in case of soil improvement using sand compaction (SCP) with a
replacement rate of 30-80% under the wall body, those given in this part, Chapter 2, 4 Soil Improvement
Methods for the sand compaction pile method (4.10.6 Performance Verification) shall be used.
-705-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 2.2.2 Standard Partial Factors 1oi
(a) Permanent situation
High earthquake-resistance
Other facilities
facilities
Target system reliability index PT
Target system failure probability Pff
3.1
2.7
1.0X103
4.0Xl0-3
3.31
2.89
IX,
IX,
0.55
0.946
1.06
0.15
0.60
0.935
1.06
0.15
YI
Friction coefficient
'fPH,'fPV
1.15
-0.288
1.00
0.12
1.15
-0.316
1.00
0.12
YRWL
1.00
-0.024
1.00
0.05
1.00
-0.027
1.00
0.05
YwRC
Unit weight of RC
0.95
0.026
0.98
0.02
0.95
0.028
0.98
0.02
YwNc
Unit weight of NC
1.00
0.009
1.02
0.02
1.00
0.01
1.02
0.02
>'WsAND
1.00
0.143
1.02
0.04
1.00
0.157
1.02
0.04
Ya
1.00
1.35
-0.832
.8
1.00
1.30
-0.842
YPH YPu
1RWL
1.05
-0.092
1.00
0.05
1.05
-0.092
1.00
0.05
YwRC
Unit weight of RC
0.95
0.097
0.98
0.02
0.95
0.094
0.98
0.02
>'WNC
Unit weight of NC
1.00
0.035
1.02
0.02
1.00
0.034
1.02
0.02
YwSAND
Ya
0.95
0.538
1.02
0.04
0.95
0.521
1.02
0.04
YPH
Yw
1.15
-0.328
1.00
0.12
1.15
-0.345
1.00
0.12
1.00
0.032
1.00
O.o3
1.00
0.033
1.00
O.o3
Yq
1.00
0.031
1.00
0.04
1.00
0.032
1.00
0.04
0.70
0.903
1.00
0.10
0.70
0.894
1.00
0.10
0.90
0.252
1.00
0.10
0.90
0.257
1.00
0.10
1.00
0.05
1.00
-0.024
1.00
0.05
1.00
....0 ""
.s~
1.00
1.00
0.12
1.00
1.00
0.12
y,.
Surcharge
Soil strength: Tangent of angle of
shear resistance
Soil strength: Cohesion
iJ:l .S
1RWL
1.00
-0.023
Ya
1.00
1"
0.90
0.407
1.00
0.04
0.90
0.406
1.00
0.04
0.90
0.330
1.00
0.04
0.90
0.320
1.00
0.04
1.10
-0.176
1.00
0.03
1.10
-0.173
1.00
O.o3
0.90
0.227
1.00
0.03
0.90
0.227
1.00
0.03
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.03
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.03
1.10
-0.176
1.00
0.03
1.10
-0.173
1.00
O.o3
0.90
0.227
1.00
0.03
0.90
0.227
1.00
O.o3
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.03
1.00
0.000
1.00
O.o3
1.80
-0.543
1.00
0.40
1.70
-0.551
1.00
0.40
1.10
-0.014
1.00
0.05
1.10
-0.015
1.00
0.05
i=
o.9 Ytanf
00\;j
Ytanf
~
"'
bottom
'Yw;
cJ
r.
bottom
Surcharge
1RWL
t: a: sensitivity factor, IX,;. deviation of mean value (mean value/characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation.
2: RC: reinforced concrete, NC: non-reinforced concrete.
3: When calculating the resultant of earth pressure, for the soil strength, friction angle of wall, unit weight, residual water level, surcharge,
etc., the characteristic values (values not considering partial factors) shall be used.
4: Surcharges (except in the case of circular slip) and sea level shall be set without considering partial factors.
s: Ywp Yw 2, and y'W)are partial factors for the weights of segments and shall be set in accordance with the classification in Fig. 2.2.13.
6: Wave-dissipating works, etc. include wave-dissipating works, covering work, foot protection, and the like.
1: Partial factors for the unit weight of soil and pavement at the top of caissons can be set in the same manner as the unit weight of filling
sand.
s: In application of the partial factors for circular slip failure, refer to the notes shown in this volume, Chapter 2.3 Stability of Slopes, 3.1.(7),
Partial Factors. When soil improvement is performed by the Sand Compaction Pile (SCP) method with a replacement rate of 30-80%, the
partial factors shown for the Sand Compaction Pile method in this volume, Chapter 2.4 Soil Improvement Methods, 4.10.6 Performance
Verification shall be used.
-706-
All facilities
Serviceability
a
IX,
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.10
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
Performance requirement
.9
gj>
a
~
~
.~
1ii
... "'
0
.~
Yr
Friction coefficient
YPH, YPu
y.,
YRWL
YwE
Yw,.,
Unit weight of RC
Yw~
Unit weight of NC
Ya
YPH YPu
y.,
YRWL
YwE
Unit weight of RC
Yw~
Unit weight of NC
Yw~
Ya
YPa
Y.,
y.
Yq
Surcharge
'Ytan;'
y,.
~
u
YRWL
Ya
.s
~
t: a: sensitivity factor, IX,;. deviation of mean value (mean value/characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation.
2: RC: reinforced concrete, NC: non-reinforced concrete.
3: When calculating the resultant of earth pressure, the soil strength. friction angle of wall, unit weight, and residual water level shall be
calculated without considering partial factors.
4: Surcharges and sea level shall be set without considering partial factors.
s: Partial factors for the unit weight of soil and pavement at the top of caissons can be set in the same manner as the unit weight of filling
sand.
Q) Unlike other gravity-type quaywalls, gravity-type quaywalls comprising cell blocks in which the wall body
has no bottom slab form a structure that maintains integrity with the wall body by sand filling. Therefore, in
addition to the examination of stability in other gravity-type quaywalls, overturning should be examined with
due consideration given to separation of the filling.
@ Stability verification equation for cellular blocks
Examination of overturning considering separation of the filling in cellular blocks can be performed using
the following equation.
(2.2.17)
where
W : weight of materials comprising wall (kN/m)
PB : buoyancy acting on wall (kN/m)
Pv : resultant vertical earth pressure acting on wall (kN/m)
Mf : resistant moment due to friction of wall surfaces with filling (kN-m/m)
PH : resultant horizontal earth pressure acting on wall (kN/m)
Pw : resultant residual water pressure acting on wall (kN/m)
-707-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
P dW : resultant dynamic water pressure acting on body (kN/m) (only during action of ground motion)
PF : inertia force acting on body (k.N/m) (only during action of ground motion)
a : distance from action line of resultant weight of wall to front toe of wall (m)
b : distance from action line of buoyancy to front toe of wall (m)
c : distance from action line of resultant vertical earth pressure to front toe ofwall (m)
d : distance from action line of resultant horizontal earth pressure to bottom of wall (m)
e : distance from action line of resultant residual water pressure to bottom of wall (m)
g : acceleration of gravity (m/s2)
h : distance from action line of resultant dynamic water pressure to bottom of body (m) (only
during
action of ground motion)
i'a : structural analysis factor
The design values in the equation can be calculated using equation (2.2.9) and the following equation
(2.2.18).
(2.2.18)
If (design value of resistance)/(design value of action) < 1, the overturning moment due to external forces is
larger than the sum of the resistant moment of the resultant vertical force excluding the filling and friction
between the wall surfaces and filling. As a result, the cellular block will separate, leaving the filling in place.
In such cases, it is necessary to take appropriate measures such as increasing the weight of the cellular blocks or
providing partition walls for cellular block.
@ The characteristic value ~ofthe resistant moment due to friction F 1 and F 2 between the wall surfaces and the
filling is obtained as follows. In Fig. 2.2.12, the moment around point A is 11F 1+1F2 Here, F 1=Pifand F 2= P'lf.
The value offis the coefficient of friction between the wall surface and the filling. (P 1 and P 2 are the respective
earth pressures of the filling.) The concept of the earth pressure of the filling acting on the wall may conform
to Chapter 2, 1.4 Cellular Blocks. It is also preferable to consider the frictional resistance acting on partition
walls of cellular blocks in the same manner.
IE
b-----,~
-;;.jq~p
A .________.__ ____,
I<
>I
Fig. 2.2.12 Determination of Frictional Resistance
The coefficient offriction used for the examination ofthe sliding of cellular concrete blocks with no bottom slab
should be 0.6 for reinforced concrete and 0.8 for filling stones. However, for convenience, an average value of
0.7 can be used.
-708-
based on experimental results. Standard limit values for deformation in accidental situations associated with
Level 2 earthquake ground motion may be set appropriately referring, Chapter 5, 1.4 Standard Concept of
Allowable Deformation of High Earthquake-resistance Facilities for Level 2 Earthquake Ground Motion.
Performance verification techniques for deformation, etc. of facilities can be broadly classified into two
types, namely, methods employing seismic response analysis and shaking tests using a shaking table or similar
apparatus.
(a) Methods employing seismic response analysis
Seismic response analysis can be classified as shown in Table 2.2.3. In the following, the various types of
seismic response analysis methods will be explained in accordance with these classifications. Depending on
the seismic response analysis method, in some cases, these techniques may not be suitable for the purpose of
verification of deformation, etc. Therefore, it is necessary to select an analysis technique corresponding to the
intended purpose, based on the following explanation.
Table 2.2.3 Classification of seismic response analysis
Analysis method
Effective stress analysis method, total stress analysis method
(treatment of saturated =uod
(individual t~ers aod liauid la-s, individual t~s)
Object domain of calculation (dimensions)
1 dimension, 2 dimensions, 3 dimensions
General calculation models
Material characteristics
Calculation domain
not assumed, experiments which consider confining pressure dependency are possible. Provided, however,
that consideration based on a law of similarity is necessary for the coefficient of permeability, and care is also
required with regard to the influence of the particle size of the ground material used in the test.
3) In-situ shaking table test
In this type of test, a model similar to the target structure or model of substantially the same scale is prepared,
either at the location where construction is planned or under similar ground conditions, and the response of
the model to artificial ground motion or natural ground motion is observed. Methods of generating artificial
ground motion include use of a wave vibrator, methods employing explosion, and others.
2.2.4 Performance Verification of Structural Members
In performance verification of the superstructure of parts where fenders are installed, it is permissible to consider
only the range in which the weight of the superstructure acts integrally. In cases where fenders are installed at
locations where the superstructure and body are connected with reinforcing bars, etc., at mooring posts or similar,
displacement of the superstructure where passive earth pressure functions effectively cannot be expected. Therefore,
it is desirable that resistance against the reaction of the fenders be borne completely by the reinforcing rods. In
performance verification of the superstructure cross section, the reaction of the fenders is assumed to be distributed
as a linear load in the range of width bin Fig. 2.2.13(a). and may be considered to act as shown in Fig. 2.2.13(b}. In
many examples, the vertical direction verification is performed assuming a cantilever beam with the bottom edge of
-709-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
the superstructure as a fulcrum, and the horizontal direction is verification performed assuming either a continuous
beam or a simple beam with a rigid point in the body as a fulcrum.
(a)
(b)
-710-
Article 50
1 The performance criteria of sheet pile quaywalls shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Sheet pile shall have the embedment length as necessary for structural stability and contain the degree
of risk that the stresses in the sheet piles may exceed the yield stress at the level equal to or less than the
threshold level under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is earth pressure and
under the variable action situations in which the dominant action is Level 1 earthquake ground motions.
(2) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the permanent action situation in which the dominant
action is earth pressure and under the variable action situation in which the dominant actions are Level
1 earthquake ground motions and traction by ships:
(a) For anchored structures, the anchorage shall be located in appropriate positions corresponding to
the structural type, and the risk of losing the structural stability shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level.
(b) For structures having ties and waling, the risk that the stresses in the ties and waling may exceed the
yield stress shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(c) For structures having superstructures, the risk of impairing the integrity of the members of the
superstructure shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(3) For structures having superstructures, the risk of impairing the integrity of the members of the
superstructure shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the variable action situation in
which the dominant action is ship berthing.
(4) Under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is self weight, the risk of occurrence
of slip failure in the ground below the bottom end of the sheet pile shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of cantilevered sheet
piles shall be such that the risk in which the amount of deformation of the top of the pile may exceed the
allowable limit of deformation is equal to or less than the threshold level under the permanent action
situations in which the dominant action is earth pressure and under the variable action situation in which
the dominant actions are Level 1 earthquake ground motions, ship berthing, and traction by ships.
3 In addition to the provisions in the first paragraph, the performance criteria of double sheet pile structures
shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The risk of occurrence of sliding of the structural body shall be equal to or less than the threshold level
under the permanent action situations in which the dominant action is earth pressure and under the
variable action situation in which the dominant action is Level 1 earthquake ground motions.
(2) The risk that the deformation of the top of the front or rear sheet pile may exceed the allowable limit
of deformation shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the permanent action situation
in which the dominant action is earth pressure and under the variable action situation in which the
dominant action is Level 1 earthquake ground motions.
(3) The risk oflosing the stability due to shear deformation of the structural body shall be equal to or less
than the threshold level under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is earth
pressure.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Sheet Pile Quaywalls
CD The performance criteria of sheet pile quaywalls shall use the following, in accordance with the design
situations excluding accidental situations and the constituent members.
Apart from these requirements, when necessary the setting of Article 22 Item 3 of the Public
Notice shall be applied. When sheet pile with special connections or large connections is used,
the performance criteria for the stresses occurring in the connections shall be appropriately set, as
necessary.
-711-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
"" 8 "" 8
~
~
.l! <
.l!
<
26
J J
I
Design situation
Public Notice
50
Perfurmam:e
requirements
Situation
Nondominating
action
Dominating
action
Verification item
surcharges
embedment length
Ordinance
-1l
<
"
26
} }
.l! ~
<
8
Design situation
Public Notice
50
Perfurmance
requirements
Verification item
.l!
Situation
Variable
Dominating
action
Nondominating
action
Yielding of
anchoraget)
Stability of anchor
wall3)
Yielding of
anchoraget)
Stability of anchor
wall3)
*1): Only when the structural type of the anchorage is a vertical pile anchor, a coupled pile anchor, or sheet pile anchor.
*2): Only when the structural type of the anchorage is a coupled pile anchor.
*3): Only when the structural type of the anchorage is a wall anchor.
-712-
..,
e~< 5
26
Public Notice
..,
e- ~
~< 5
"'
"1 "'2 50 "1 2b
~
Design situation
Perfurmance
requirements
Situation
Dominating
action
Nondominating
Verification item
action
Variable
Yielding of waling
Yielding of tie
Yieldin2 ofwalin2
Da= 15cm)
"
<
} }
26
-1l
e -1l
.!! "
<
2
Design situation
Public Notice
50
Perfurmance
Nondominating
action
Verification item
e
.!!
requirements
2c
Serviceability Pennanent Earth pressure Water pressure. Serviceability of cross- Limit value of bending
surcharges
section of superstructure compression stress
(serviceability limit state)
Situation
Variable
Dominating
action
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Ordinance
1
~< ~
1
26 '"
Public Notice
e
.!! ~
<
2
50
Design situation
e
.!!
requirements
Performance
Situation
Dominating
action
Nondominating
action
Verification item
pressure
1.?xl0-4)
(Other than high
earthquake-resistance
facility Pt= 4.0xl0-3)
(a) Besides complying with the performance criteria of sheet pile quaywalls, excluding those with ties
and waling, the setting of the performance criteria for cantilevered sheet pile quaywalls and the
design situations excluding accidental situations shall be in accordance with Attached Table 35.
Attached Table 35 Setting of the Performance Criteria and the Design Situations (excluding accidental situations) for
Cantilevered Sheet Pile Quaywalls
Ministerial
Ordinance
u
...
e-
Design situation
Public Notice
u
...
Performance
e-
:2
1~
:g
1~
26
50
requirements
Situation
Dominating
action
Nondominating
action
Verification item
(b) Limit value of the amount of deformation of the top of the sheet pile
The limit value of the amount of deformation of the top of the sheet pile for permanent situations
where the dominating action is earth pressure and the variable situations where dominating action
are Level 1 earthquake ground motion, traction by ships, shall be set appropriately based on the
envisaged conditions of use of the facility.
(a) Besides applying the performance criteria of sheet pile quaywalls, the setting of the performance
criteria for double sheet pile quaywalls and the design situations excluding accidental situations shall
be in accordance with Attached Table 36. The index representing the risk of occurrence of failure
due to sliding of the wall under permanent situations where dominating action is earth pressure and
the variable situations where dominating action is Level 1 earthquake ground motion indicated in
-714-
,,
e-
];!
t:
<
26
Public Notice
,,
e- ~
~
5 "' < 5 "'
"'I 2 50 "'3 I
~
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Verification item
Situation
Dominating
action
Nondominating
action
49
Variable
earth pressure,
ground
motion
water pressure,
(allowable amount of
deformation Da = lOcm)
surcharges
50
Variable
f--
ground
(1) The performance verification of structural stability for a steel sheet pile quaywall with anchorage work can
generally be conducted by checking the stabilities of the sheet pile wall, the tie rods and the anchorage work.
(2) An example of the sequence of the performance verification of sheet pile quaywalls is shown in Fig. 2.3.1.
(3) An example of the cross-section of sheet pile quaywalls is shown in Fig. 2.3.2.
-715-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
~------------91~: Setting of design conditions :"'~1---------------~
...
,________
..I
~I
!,....,___________,
I~
...
:
I
...
I
I
~-----------------------------------------------------------'
:- -----------------------1
}>;~;.;~ ~tii;ti;;,
:
I
;.;ri;bl; ~tii;ti;;hi-~(;d-:
,,
:
I
1
~--------------------------}--------------------------------:
------------------------- ----:Permanent
:I
siiu8tiiiD,-v8ri8ii1e-siti.ii:tion_iD_:
re1pect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion 1I
,..
~+--~1 --i1 Evaluation of anchorage stresses, embedment length and installation position I
:
I
!--------------------------+--------------------------------"
,,
:
L -
v&ri&ii~libi&tioili0-..e1p-eeior:
Level 1 earthquake 1
ground motion :
Evaluation of amount of deformation by dynamic analysis f---~----
---
--
--
----
--
1r
1--
----
--
--
----
---
_I
1,
! __________________________ +--------------------------------~
1: Evaluation of liquefaction and settlement are not shown, so it is necessary to consider these separately.
2: When necessary, an evaluation of the amount of deformation by dynamic analysis can be carried out for the Level 1 earthquake ground
motion.
For high earthquake-resistance facilities, it is preferable that an examination of the amount of deformation be carried out by dynamic
analysis.
3: Verification in respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion is carried out for high earthquake-resistance facilities.
-716-
Concrete paving
Subbase course
H.W.L.
L.W.L.
Backfill rocks
-
Rubble
Q) The performance verification of a sheet pile wall on soft ground such as alluvial cohesive soil on soft seabed
should preferably be conducted through comprehensive examination using performance verification methods
shown below for tie and anchorage work, as well as other performance verification methods. Unexpected large
deformation may occur in sheet piles constructed on soft ground due to lateral flows that are caused by the
settlement of the ground behind the sheet pile wall. Several methods for lateral flow prediction36) have been
proposed. Such effects should be taken into consideration in carrying out the performance verifications.
Care should be exercised in using the performance verification methods for sheet pile quaywall described in
this section, because many ofthese methods assume that a steel sheet pile wall is driven mainly into sandy soil
ground or hard clayey soil ground. For soft ground, it is preferable to perform soil improvement work. When
it is not possible to perform soil improvement work because of site conditions, it is preferable to consider using
other performance verification methods, in addition to the methods described in this section, such as dynamic
analysis methods which can accurately evaluate the nonlinear characteristics of soil, so that a comprehensive
analysis can be made.
2.3.2 Actions
(1) The active earth pressure is normally used as the earth pressure that acts on the sheet pile wall from the backside.
For the front-side reaction that acts on the embedded part of the sheet pile, it is necessary to use an appropriate
value such as passive earth pressure or a subgrade reaction that corresponds to the deflection of the wall and
modulus of subgrade reaction.
(2) When the free earth support method and the equivalent beam method are used in the performance verification for
a sheet pile wall, it should basically be assumed that the earth pressure and residual water pressure act as shown
in Fig. 2.3.3, and the pressure values can be calculated in accordance with Part II, Chapter 5, 1 Earth Pre1sure
and Part II, Chapter 5, 2.1 Residual Water Pressure. The wall friction angle used for calculation of the earth
pressure acting on the sheet pile wall may usually be taken at 15 for the active earth pressure and-15 for the
passive earth pressure, respectively when the ground is sandy soil layer.
-717-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
......
L.W.L.
" L.W.L.
~
~
a.
t"
a.
t"
---- t""
~~
a.
----------~
: ~
a.
=~ ~
<
~~
a.
t"
,::!
.<:"
.<:"
gj
gj
'
'
'
~
~
,::!
Fig. 2.3.3 Earth Pressure and Residual Water Pressure to be considered for Performance Verification of Sheet Pile Wall
(3) Since the earth pressure changes in response to displacement of the sheet pile wall, the actual earth pressure that
acts on the sheet pile wall varies depending on the following:
(a) The construction method i.e., whether backfill is executed or the ground in front of the sheet piles is dredged to
the required depth after the sheet piles have been driven in
(b) The lateral displacement of the sheet pile at the tie rod setting point
(c) The length of the embedded part of the sheet pile
(d) The relationship between the rigidity of the sheet pile and the characteristics of the sea bottom ground.
Therefore the earth pressure distribution is not necessary as showo in Fig. 2.3.3.
(4) When P. W. Rowe's method, elastic beam analysis method, is used in a sheet pile stability calculation, it is
assumed that the earth pressure and residual water pressure act as showo in Fig. 2.3.4 and a reaction earth
pressure that corresponds to the modulus of subgrade reaction and the earth pressure at rest act on the front
surface of the sheet pile.
GL.
--
L.WL.
'
'
Tie rod
Residual water level
,,
~ Subgrade reaction
earth pressure
I
I
.
,_,_
,_
I
I
----------
"\
'
I
'
L--
_,_,
--.l
Fig. 2.3.4 Earth Pressure and Residual Water Pressure to be considered for Performance Verification of Sheet Pile
Walls Using P.W. Rowe's Method
-718-
(6) In the determination of the reaction force of earth pressure that acts on the front surface of the embedded part of
the sheet pile, it is necessary to assume that dredging of the sea bottom will be executed to a certain depth below
the planned depth, in consideration of the accuracy of dredging work.
(7) In the case of an earth retaining wall of an open-type wharf, the sea bottom in front of the sheet pile wall has a
composite shape of horizontal and sloped surfaces. In such a case, the passive earth pressure may be calculated
using Coulomb's method in which the design passive earth pressure is trially calculated with several failure planes
of different angles. The smallest value among them is adopted as the passive earth pressure.41) However, it is
necessary to consider the empirical evidence by experiments that the behavior of the ground in front of the sheet
pile wall can be well predicted under the assumption of the ground being an elastic body.
(8) The residual water level to be used in the determination of the residual water pressure needs to be estimated
appropriately in consideration of the structure of the sheet pile wall and the soil conditions. The residual water
level varies depending on the characteristics ofthe subsoil and the conditions of sheet pile joints, but in many cases
the elevation with the height equivalent to two thirds of the tidal range above the mean monthly-lowest water level
(LWL) is used for sheet pile walls. In the case of a steel sheet pile wall driven into cohesive soil ground, however,
care should be exercised in the determination of the residual water level, because it is sometimes nearly the same
as the high water level. When sheet piles made of other materials are to be used, it is preferable to determine the
residual water level based on the result of investigations of similar structures.
(9) Seismic Coefficient used in Performance Verification of Sheet Pile Quaywalls with Pile Anchorage for Variable
Situation in respect of Level I Earthquake Ground Motion 42)
Q) For the performance verification of seismic-resistant of sheet piles quaywalls with pile anchorage for the variable
situation in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion, the performance verification by direct evaluation of
the amount of deformation by a detailed method such as nonlinear effective stress analysis can be carried out,
but simplified methods such as the seismic coefficient method can also be used. In this case, it is necessary to
use an appropriate seismic coefficient in the performance verification, taking into consideration the effects of
the frequency characteristics and duration of the ground motions. A typical sequence of the seismic coefficient
calculation for the verification is as shown in Fig. 2.3.S.
-719-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
'
I-dimensional seismic response analysis
'
------------------ ------------------
'
Maximum value of ground surface acceleration
time history considering frequency dependence
.
.
-
Calculation of characteristic value of seismic
coefficient for verification (see@ (a))
Fig. 2.3.5 Example of Sequence for Calculation of Seismic Coefficient for Verification
@ It is preferable that the seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification of sheet pile quaywalls
fur the variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion is set appropriately as a horizontal
ground motion for which the amount of deformation of the sheet pile quaywall does not exceed the limit value.
When Level I earthquake ground motion is acting, failure of sheet pile walls is preceded by deformation, and
if the allowable amount of deformation of a sheet pile quaywall is about 30cm, deformation will be dominant.
@ Setting of the filter considering the frequency characteristics
(a) Setting of the filter
With the same way as for gravity-type quaywalls, the acceleration response spectrum is obtained from the
Fourier transform of the acceleration time history at the ground surface obtained by I-dimensional seismic
response analysis, and this is processed with a filter considering the frequency characteristics corresponding
to the deformation of the sheet pile quaywall. For this filter the value given by equation (2.3.1) may be used.
For details refer to 2.2.2(1)@ Setting of filter considering frequency characteristics in 2.2 Gravity-type
Qnaywalls. An example of filter is shown in Fig. 2.3.6.
-720-
0 < f ,;;1.0
b
a(f)=
b=2.25~-0.88 T,
HR
TbR
(2.3.1)
l.O<f
+0.96 T. -0.96(verticalpileanchoragetype)
TllR
where,
H
T..
T.,.
TbR
The value of b shall be set within the range indicated by equation (2.3.2), using the wall height Hof the wall
body. However, regardless of the setting range indicated by equation (2.3.2), in all cases the minimum value
shall be 0.41.
0.12H -0.78,;; b,;; 0.12H -0.24 (Vertical pile anchorage)
(2 .3.2)
where,
H
1.6
1.8
1.4
1.6
1.4
1.2
1.0
1.2
so.8
" 0.6
H 15.0m
T,=l.07s
T 11 =0.51s
0.4
0.2
\
\
"0.8
0.4
H=15.0m
T,=l.07s
0.2
T 11 =0.57s
0.6
'
0.0
0.1
Sl.O
'~ ~~
1.0
f(Hz)
' '\
""'"
0.0
10.0
0.1
1.0
f(Hz)
10.0
(b) Calculation of the natural periods of the ground and the ground below the seabed surface
For calculation of the natural periods for equation (2.3.1), refer to 2.2.2(1)@ Setting of filter considering
frequency characteristics in 2.2 Gravity-type Qnaywalls. However, the initial natural period of the ground
Tb and the initial natural period of the ground below the seabed surface T. are calculated as Tb and T. at the
positions shown in Fig. 2.3.7.
-721-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Ground surface
...
'
Tie rod
Sheet pile wall
seabed surface
"'-..
Anchorage ,A
Ground for calculation of T,
sand
Engineering bedrock
(2.3.3)
where,
: reduction ratio (p :S 1.0)
S
square root of the sum of squares of the acceleration time history after filtering (cm/s2)
a1 : maximum value of the acceleration after filtering (cm/s2)
p
k"
D
kh = 1.91 ---"( D,
)-0.69
D
kh = 1.32 ---"( D,
(2.3.4(a))
(2.3.4(b))
)-0.74
where,
kh
1
ac
g
D0
D,
corrected value of the maximum acceleration of the ground at the ground surface (cm/s2)
gravitational acceleration (=980cm/s2)
allowable amount of deformation at the top of the quaywall (=15cm)
standard deformation amount (=!Ocm)
@ The calculation of the characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification for sheet pile anchorage type
and concrete wall anchorage type sheet pile quaywalls may apply that of vertical pile anchorage type sheet pile
quaywalls.
-722-
(IO)The seismic coefficient for verification of superstructure of sheet pile for the accidental situation in respect of
the Level 2 earthquake ground motion may be conveniently calculated using the method in (10) above, using
the acceleration time history of the ground surface at the free ground part. In this case, the allowable amount of
deformation Da may be taken to be 50cm. When this method is used, the upper bound value shall be 0.25, and a
value equal to or greater than the seismic coefficient for the verification of Level I earthquake ground motion must
be used. However, ifthe seismic coefficient for the verification of Level I earthquake ground motion exceeds 0.25,
that value shall be used. For the verification of the superstructure of the anchorage for the accidental situations in
respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion, the tie tension forces obtained by a dynamic analysis may be used.
(ll)For the dynamic water pressure acting during an earthquake, refer to Part II, Chapter 5, 2.2 Dynamic Water
Pressure.
(12)For the tractive forces of ships, refer to Part II, Chapter 8, 2.3 Actions Caused by Ship Motions, and Part II,
Chapter 8, 2.4 Actions due to Traction by Ships.
(13)The fender reaction force is generally considered for the performance verification of the coping. The tractive
force of ship is not considered when the foundation for bollards is to be constructed separately from the coping.
However, when bollards are to be installed on the coping of the sheet pile wall, it is necessary to consider the
tractive force of ship in the performance verification of the coping, tie rod and wale.
CD
The cross sections of sheet pile and tie member will be largely influenced by the position of the tie member
installation. The position of the tie member installation should be determined considering the difficulty of the
work of tie member attachments and the costs.
@ When the wall height of a sheet pile wall is high, tie rods may be provided at two levels to support the wall
structure at two points, to reduce the flexural moments in the wall structure.
(2) Selection of the structural type of anchorage work
The structural types of anchorage works are generally broadly classified as vertical pile anchorage, coupledpile anchorage, sheet pile anchorage, and slab anchorage. The economy, construction time, and construction
method differ depending on the structural type, so it is necessary to determine the structural type, considering the
elevation of the ground and other site conditions before construction.
CD
General
When verification for variable situation in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion is carried out using a
simplified method such as the seismic coefficient method, the following (2)-(4) may be used. In the verification
of the embedment length of the sheet pile wall, it is assumed that the embedded bottom end is fixed in the
ground. Also, for verification of stresses in the sheet pile wall, it is assumed that the point of intersection
between the sheet pile wall and the seabed surface is fixed in the ground. However, these assumptions used in
the simplified methods are not necessarily consistent with the actual mechanisms, so when these methods are
adopted, it is necessary to pay attention to this.43) If a detailed method such as dynamic analysis is used, (10)
Verification of Ground Motion by Dynamic Analysis Methods can be referred.
@ Consideration of the effect of the rigidity of the sheet pile wall cross-section
(a) The cross-section of the sheet pile shall be set appropriately considering of the cross-sectional rigidity of the
sheet pile.
(b) The behavior of sheet pile wall with the anchorage work is strongly affected by the rigidity and embedded
length of the sheet piles and the characteristics of the ground. In particular, the rigidity of the sheet piles
strongly affects the determination of the embedded length. Therefore it is essential to consider the effect of
the cross-sectional rigidity of the sheet pile in the final selection of the cross-section.
(c) The analysis method described below, which is a modified Rowe's method, examines the embedded part of
sheet piles as a beam set on an elastic bed.
Elastic beam analysis method of sheet piles
This elastic beam analysis method is applied to the sheet pile wall as the theoretical equation for beams on
elastic bed by introducing an elastic coefficient of subgrade reaction for the ground into which the sheet pile
-723-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
wall is driven. The basic equation for the embedded part is as equation (2.3.S):
(2.3.5)
where
E : Young's modulus of sheet pile CMN/m2)
I : geometrical moment of inertia of sheet pile wall per unit width (m4/m)
PAo : load intensity at the sea bottom generated by the active earth pressure and residual water
pressure CMN/m2)
h : modulus of subgrade reaction to the sheet pile wall (MN/m3)
D : embedded length of sheet pile (m)
As there is no general solution to a differential equation ofthis form, a special technique is required to solve
equation (2.3.5). Broms and Rowe proposed a method to obtain the coefficient of each term in a numerical
analysis by assuming a power series as the solution. Based on Rowe's method,46) Takahashi and Ishiguro
have published details of a method to derive a solution of the deflection curve equation of sheet pile wall and a
computer-based numerical calculation method.47) Takahashi and Kikuchi have amended this method to better
reflect the behavioral characteristics of actual sheet pile walls as follows (see Fig. 2.3.8):
(2.3.6)
where
--~
W.L.
"-
GL
~,.
~
'7
l::::::i
R.W.L.
~.
..
..
KArz
~ lh
Dft' xy
~
f
'
'
'
Korx
'
-.
'
.. KAJiYX
.
.
- .
..
..
~
'
Fig. 2.3.8 Earth Pressure Distribution for the Analysis of Sheet Pile Wall
-724-
CD
The mechanical behavior of the sheet pile wall varies depending on the embedment length. With a short
embedment length the behavior characteristics are free earth support conditions, and with a long embedment
length the behavior characteristics are fixed earth support conditions. In order to ensure stability of the sheet
pile wall uoder permaoent situations aod variable situations, It is preferable that the bottom of the sheet pile is
fixed sufficiently in the ground, in other words that fixed earth support conditions be satisfied. Conventionally,
the embedment length was obtained by the free earth support method based on classical earth pressure theory.
Takahashi and Kikuchi 49) showed that the embedment length obtained with this method by considering
appropriate partial factors is considered to be fixed earth support condition. Also, the equivalent beam method
for obtaining the cross-section of sheet piles assumes fixed earth support conditions.
@ Ifthe embedment length of sheet piles is to obtain by the free earth support method, analysis of the embedment
length of the sheet pile wall can be carried out using the following equation. This equation is obtained from the
equilibrium of moments of the earth pressure and residual water pressure about the point of installation of the
ties, as shown in Fig. 2.3.3. In the following equation, the symbol y is the partial factor corresponding to its
subscript, where the subscripts k and d indicate the characteristic value and the design value, respectively.
(2.3.7)
where,
PP
Pa
Pw
Pdw
a-<i
: resultant passive earth pressure acting on the sheet pile wall (kN/m)
: resultant active earth pressure acting on the sheet pile wall (kN/m)
In calculating the design values of earth pressure in the equation, the tangent of the angle of shearing
resistance tan', the cohesion c, the wall surface friction angled, the effective unit weight w', the surcharge
q, and the seismic coefficient for verification during earthquakes only kh may be calculated using equation
(2.3.8), and Part Il, Chapter 5, 1 Earth Pressure may be used for reference. The design value of residual
water pressure may be calculated as appropriate by reference to Part II, Chapter 5, 2.1 Residual Water
Pressure, after calculating the design value of residual water level from equation (2.3.8), taking the tide level
and tidal difference at the front surface into consideration. Also, the design value of dynamic water pressure
used in the performance verification during an earthquake may be calculated as appropriate by reference
to Part II, Chapter 5, 2.2 Dynamic Water Pressure, after first calculating the design value of seismic
coefficient for verification from equation (2.3.8). The partial coefficients used in calculation of the design
values may be obtained by reference to Table 2.3.3.
tanfld = r1an; tanfl.t
qd =r.q,
cd =reek
5d =ro5
wd =rww
RWLd = YRWLRWL1
(2.3.8)
@ In cohesive soil ground, normally if equation (2.3.9) is not satisfied, stability of embedment is not ensured.
(2.3.9)
where,
(2.3.10)
-725-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
When equation (2.3.9) is not satisfied because the soils at the seabed are weak, then either the seabed soils
should be improved by an appropriate method, or a structure such as a sheet pile wall with a relieving platform
should be adopted.
@ Characteristic embedment length considering the rigidity of the sheet pile wall cross-section
(a) According to the elastic beam analysis method described in (1) @ above, the behavior characteristics of
a sheet pile wall can vary depending on the embedment length. In other words, if the sheet piling is not
longer by a certain value, the sheet pile wall will not be stable. The ernbedment length that brings about
the limiting stability state is called the limiting ernbedment length De. If the embedment length is longer
than the limiting ernbedment length, the flexural moment in the sheet pile wall becomes the peak maximum
flexural moment Mp under free earth support conditions. The embedment length obtained above is called the
transition embedment length Dp. If the ernbedment length is increased further, the flexural moment becomes
the convergent maximum moment Mp under fixed earth support conditions. The minimum ernbedment length
at which this is achieved is called the convergent embedment length Dp.
(b) Flexibility number of the sheet pile
As a measure to indicate the rigidity of a sheet pile wall as a structure, the following flexibility number in the
equation (2.3.11) proposed by Rowe is used:
p=H 4 /EI
(2.3.11)
where
p
H
For Hinp=lf4/EI, Rowe uses the sum of total height of the sheet pile wall from the sea bottom to the top of
the sheet pile wall Hand the embedded length D of fixed earth support state as the total length of sheet pile.
Also, Takahashi and Kikuchi Et al. suggest a new index called the similarity number that is derived by using
the flexibility number and ground characteristics. The height HT from the sea bottom to the tie rod installation
point is used for the length Hin this equation:
w=p( =(H//EI)l
(2.3.12)
where,
similarity number
OJ
Loose
Medium
Dense
24
38
58
-726-
=.Ji2N +15
(2.3.13)
where,
: N-value
However, it should be noted that Fig. 2.3.10 is an expedient graph to a certain degree, as Dunham's
equations include cases that give the larger angle of shearing resistance depending on the grain size of
sandy soil.
Fig. 2.3.9 and 2.3.10 also show the values proposed by Terzaghi in addition to the values proposed by
Takahashi and Kikuchi, at al.
80
60
Values proposed by Terzaghi
40
20
Values proposed by Takahashi, Kikuchi, et al.
o~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10
20
30
40
50
N-value
Fig. 2.3.9 Relationship between Modulus of Subgrade Reaction(,,) and N-value
-727-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
,,......
80
60
=
e
40
.......
20
~
0
-~
i-a
0
~
~
15
20
25
30
35
40
Fig. 2.3.10 Relationship between Modulus of Subgrade Reaction (.t,J and Angle of Internal Friction (</I)
(d) Determination of the embedded length of sheet pile using Rowe's method
In the determination of the embedded length of sheet piles using Rowe's method, a characteristic value that
satisfies equation (2.3.14) can be used. As equation (2.3.14) takes into consideration the stiffness of the sheet
pile without the earth pressure, when reducing the earth pressure of the existing steel sheet pile quaywall
or similar improvement method, it is necessary to be aware that the earth pressure reduction effect does not
necessarily result in a shortening of the embedment length. Therefore, when considering the earth pressure
reduction effect, it is preferable to also use the methods of CD to above.
(2.3.14)
where
os
Dp
HT
m
p
E
I
lh
ratio of the embedded length of sheet pile to the height ofthe tie rod installation point above the
sea bottom
: embedded length of sheet pile (m)
: height of the tie rod installation point above the sea bottom (m)
: similarity number (=pliJ
: flexibility number (=HT4/EI) (m3/MN)
: Young's modulus of sheet pile (MN/m2)
: geometrical moment of inertia of sheet pile wall per unit width (m4/m)
: modulus of subgrade reaction to sheet pile wall (MN/m3)
:
The embedded length calculated with this equation is the converged embedded length. According to the
study conducted by Takahashi and Kikuchi, et al. an increase of just a 2o/o-plus in the maximum flexural
moment occurs when an embedded length corresponding to 70% of the converged embedded length is
employed. Therefore the use of the converged embedded length as the design embedded length secures the
safety, and there is no need to consider a margin against the safety.
Equation (2.3.14) formulates the relationship between the ratio of the convergent embedment length
Dp to the virtual wall height Hr, o=(DJ!HT), and the similarity number m shown in Fig. 2.3.11. This is
based on analysis carried out by Takahashi and Kikuchi, at al. using a simulation model for 72 cases with
a combination of conditions for water depth of the quay (-4 to -14m), soil conditions, seismic conditions
(k11=0.2), and material conditions of the steel sheet piles. In Fig. 2.3.11, for permanent situations and
earthquake conditions are obtained as ON and 08 respectively, but in equation (2.3.14) lis is used for the action
of earthquakes because it indicates large values.
Also, in this analysis by Takahashi and Kikuchi, et al. the relationship between the similarity number, the
ratio (=MJ/Mr), and the ratio -r (=TJ/Tr) were studied. The ratio is the ratio of the maximum flexural
moment Mp when there is convergent embedment length Dp in the bending curve analysis to the maximum
flexural moment MT calculated by the equivalent beam method assuming the tie installation point and the
seabed surface as the support points. The ratio -r is the ratio of tie tension force Tp when there is convergent
-728-
embedment length Dp in the bending curve analysis to the tie tension force TT calculated from the virtual
beam method. These relationships are shown in Figs. 2.3.12 to 2.3.13.
IA
1.3
I>
~~
1.1
1 0.2486
r- 6 6 -l.0284X4.9510X~ 0. 9.:59-1-
1.0
I
6n=1.9Sl0X ~ -0.2486 - -
~~
0.9
~
~
0.8
0.7
"' ~
6L
'
DM
&H
0.6
O.
t:
" Ii>
OA
1.0XIO'
S.OX102
LOX!O"
S.OXl()l
l.OXl()l
1.6
.'I.
LO
1.4
'1'
13
0.2255
' I'.
~'),
"
''~
r-.;:
12
N-3.862.SX ~ +-0.2155- ~v
I.I
~ ~ '-
.....
1.0
.A..l':,L
0.9
0.8
0.7
1.0XIOZ
~ I':..
~
DM
~'H
~.
.....
~
ti
Ii
,. .....
w
1]
S.OX102
1.0Xl()l
S.OXl()l
-729-
1.0Xl04
- ....
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
1.3
........
1.2
~~
r-... ..:.
ti,
1.l
-""
-..,.-l.8259X ~<-0.11232
0.9
0.8
~I
~ t::- ~
0
1.0
DM
ii
l.OX!O'
IL~
-t; '~
&L'.L
0.7
-~
-..,-1.269lx1.82s9xt+Y:1oi
~l'.JH
..
--..
d
l
S.OX!O'
l.OX!O'
S.OXIO'
1.0X!O'
(3) Flexural Moment of Sheet Piles and Reaction at Tie Member Installation Point
CD
The maximum flexural moment of sheet piles and reaction at the tie member installation point shall be calculated
with an appropriate method that takes into consideration the rigidity and embedded length ofthe sheet piles and
the characteristics of the ground.
The maximum flexural moment and reaction force at the tie member installation point of sheet piles may be
determined using the equivalent beam method described below or Rowe's method. However, care should be
exercised when using the equivalent beam method, because the section forces may be under estimated when the
rigidity of the sheet piles is high.
Tie member
-730-
@ The seabed surface used in calculating the flexural moment should take margin of the depth into
consideration.
The design values of maximum flexural moment in the sheet pile wall and the reaction force at the tie member
installation point can normally be calculated using the following equation. In the following equation, the
subscript d indicates the design value.
(2.3.15)
where,
AP : reaction force at the tie installation point (kN/m)
Pa : resultant active earth pressure from the top of the sheet piling to the seabed surface (kN/m)
P w : resultant residual water pressure from the top of the sheet piling to the seabed surface (kN/m)
Pdw : resultant dynamic water pressure acting on the sheet pile wall (kN/m) (only during earthquakes)
a-c : distance from the installation position of the tie member to the point of action of the resultant
force (m)
L : distance from the installation position of the tie member to the seabed surface (m)
where,
AP : reaction at the tie installation point (kN/m)
P'a : resultant active earth pressure from the top of the sheet pile to the position where the shear force
S becomes 0 (kN/m)
P'w : resultant residual water pressure from the top of the sheet pile to the position where the shear
force S becomes 0 (kN/m)
Pd. : resultant dynamic water pressure from the top of the sheet pile to the position where the shear
force Sbecomes 0 (kN/m) (during an earthquake only)
a : distance from the position where the shear force S becomes 0 to the tie member installation
position (m)
b-d : distance from the position where the shear force S becomes 0 to the point of action of the
resultant force (m)
The design values of earth pressure, residual water pressure, and resultant dynamic water pressure force
may be appropriately calculated by reference to Part II, Chapter 5, 1 Earth Pressure. Part II, Chapter
5, 2.1 Residual Water Pressure, and Part II, Chapter 5, 2.2 Dynamic Water Pressure, after calculating
the design values of the tangent of the angle of shearing resistance tanql, the cohesion c, the wall surface
friction angle the effective unit weight w', the surcharge q, the seismic coefficient for verification during
earthquakes only kh, and the residual water level RWL, from equation (2.3.8).
o,
@ When the maximum flexural moment of sheet piles and the tie member installation point reaction force are
to be determined taking the effects of the modulus of subgrade reaction and the rigidity of the sheet piles
into consideration, the following method can be used. The maximum flexural moment and reaction force are
calculated by using the equivalent beam method and the correction factors obtained from Figs. 2.3.12 and
2.3.13 are multiplied by those values. The seismic coefficient for performance verification purposes shown
in Figs. 2.3.12 and 2.3.13 has been set at 0.20. Values obtained from these figures may be used for the
performance verification for variable situation in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion unless a very
detailed verification is required.
(4) Verification of Stresses in the Sheet Pile Wall for Permanent Situation and Variable Situation in respect of Level
1 earthquake ground motion
CD
Analysis of stresses in the sheet pile wall may be carried out using the following equation. In the following
equation, the symbol y is the partial factor corresponding to its subscript, where the subscripts k and d indicate
characteristic value and the design value respectively.
M _,
u,d >
-Ya_Z
__
(2.3.17)
-731-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where,
uy
Mmox :
Equation (2.3.18) may be used for calculating the design values of bending yield stress of the steel material
in the equation. For the design value of the maximum flexural moment in the sheet pile wall, refur to (3)
Flexural Moment of Sheet Piles and Reaction at Tie Member Installation Point.
(2.3.18)
@ The joint length of steel sheet piles should be as long as possible, from the point of view of maintaining the
integrity of the sheet piles. However, taking into consideration damage to the joints during construction, the
joints do not normally extend to the bottoms of the sheet piles. Normally the bottom end of the joint is at the
depth where the active earth pressure strength and the passive earth pressure strength are equal, or is cootinuous
to the virtual fixity point (llp, refer to the virtual fixing point shown in Chapter 5, 5.2.2 Setting of Basic Crosssection), and is frequently 2-3m below the seabed surface. If the residual water level difference is large, the
joint length of steel sheet piles should be determined taking the piping phenomenon into account. The top end
of the joint is often extended up to 30-40cm above the bottom surface of the superstructure.
@ When U-shaped Steel sheet pile is subjected to bending, there is a possibility that vertical slip occur at joints
which locate at the center of the wall. In this case, the U-shaped steel sheet piles will not act integrally with the
adjacent sheet piles. In this situation the section modulus and the geometrical moment of inertia of the crosssection calculated assuming the steel sheet piles act integrally in the wall may not be obtained. Methods for
evaluating the effect of this slip in the joints include the method of reducing the cross-section performance by
multiplying by a joint efficiency coefficient.SS). 56)
(5) Verification of Stresses in the Tie Members under Permanent Situation and Variable Situations in respect of Level
I earthquake ground motion
CD
Analysis of stresses in the tie members may be carried out using the following equation. In the following
equation, the subscript d indicates the desigo value.
Td
uy, "raA
(2.3.19)
where,
uy : yield stress in tension in the tie merober (N/mm2)
Td : tension force in tie merober (N)
A : cross-sectional area of tie member (mm2)
Ya : structural analysis factor
Equation (2.3.18) may be used for calculating the design value of tensile yield stress of the tie member in the
equation. For the design value of the tension force in the tie member, refer to @ Tension force of tie member,
below.
Td =AP/sec(}
(2.3.20)
where
Td
=(
Ap/+
~ }ec(J
(2.3.21)
where
(%)
<:24
0.58
<:24
0.53
<:21
0.56
<:21
0.52
<:325
<:24
0.66
<:590
<:390
<:22
0.66
<:690
<:440
<:20
0.64
<:740
<:540
"'18
0.73
Yield stress
(N/mm2)
(dia. 40mm or less)
<:235
(dia. > 40mm)
<:215
(dia. 40mm or less)
<:275
(dia. > 40mm)
<:255
Elongation
<:490
Type
Rupture strength
(N/mm2)
88400
<:402
88490
<:490
CD
Analysis of stresses in waling may be carried out using the following equation. In the following equation, the
subscript d indicates the design value. In the equation, all the partial factors except the structural analysis factor
may be taken to be 1.0. The structural analysis factor may be taken to be 1.4 for the permanent situations, and
1.12 for the variable situations associated with Level 1 earthquake ground motion.
-733-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2.3.22)
where,
bending yield stress in the waling (Nfmm2)
maximum flexural moment in the waling (Nmm/m)
Z : section modulus of the waling (mm')
Ya : structural analysis factor
uy
Mmox :
Equation (2.3.18) may be used to calculate the design value of bending yield stress of the waling in the
equation. For the calculation of the maximum flexural moment in the waling, refer to @below.
@ Various equations for calculating the maximum flexural moment of wale have been proposed. The moment,
however, should be determined according to conditions at the site so that the cross section is sate and economical.
In general, the maximum flexural moment of wale may be calculated using equation (2.3.23). In the equation
below, subscript d stands for the design value.
=Tdl
max"
10
(2.3.23)
where
M~ : maximum flexural moment of wale (kNm)
T : tension force of a tie member calculated in accordance with (5) @ Tension force of tie member
(kN)
l : tie rod installation interval (m)
This equation is obtained by analyzing a three-span continuous bean3 supported at the tie member installation
points and subjected to the reaction at the tie installation point (Ap) as a uniformly distributed load.
@ When bollards are installed on the coping, it is necessary to verify the performance of the wale near one of the
bollards using a tie member tension force that takes into consideration the tractive force of ship in accordance
with (5) @ Tension force of tie member above. However, when the wale is embedded into the coping, the
effect of the tractive force of ship may be ignored.
(7) Analysis of Slip Failure in the Ground under permanent situations
For analysis of slip failure in the ground of sheet piles quaywalls, refer to analysis of slip failure in the ground in
2.2 Gravity-type Quaywalls. In this case, the analysis is carried out for circular slip failures passing below the
bottom of the sheet pile wall. Standard values ofthe partial factors used in the performance verification are shown
in Table 2.3.3.
(8) Partial Factors for permanent situations and variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion
CD
Partial factors for the standard system failure probabilities for the embedment length of sheet pile walls, sheet
pile wall stresses, tie rod stresses, and circular slip failure for sheet pile quaywalls under permanent situations
are shown in Table 2.3.3(a). Based on the average safety level for design methods ofthe past, the average system
reliability index for stability of wall structures is 5.6 or when converted into a failure probability 9.9xl0-9, the
average reliability index for circular slip failure is 6.0 or when converted into a failure probability 9.2x10-10.
When the expected total cost expressed by the sum of the initial construction cost and the expected value of
the restoration cost due to collapse is taken into consideration, the system reliability index that minimizes the
expected total cost is 3.6 or when converted into a failure probability I.7x!0-4 for high earthquake-resistance
facilities, and 2.7 or when converted into a failure probability 4.0xlO- for other quaywalls.358)
-734-
~
.!l
a
;;
.ll
~
'a
.!l
"
1
~
iii
"'
1
~
.e
~
.g
u
l""
=s
~
~
~
1il
~
iii
"'
.!l
a
;;
r!l
:s
.e
~
.g
u
~
~
y,.
High earthquake-resistance
facilities
3.6
I.7xJ0-4
resistance facilities
2.7
4.0xlO-'
IX,
/X1
0.65
1.000
1.00
0.100
0.75
1.000
1.000
0.100
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.100
1.00
0.000
1.000
0.100
shearing resistance
Cohesion
Effective unit weight
Wall surface friction angle
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.050
1.00
0.000
1.000
0.050
0.90
0.300
1.00
0.100
0.90
0.300
1.000
0.100
y,
Surcharge
1.00
1.00
YRWL
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.050
1.00
0.000
1.000
0.050
y,
1.00
1.00
Ytanlf
0.70
0.820
1.00
0.100
0.80
0.820
1.000
0.100
shearing resistance
Cohesion
Effective unit weight
0.75
0.700
1.00
0.100
0.80
0.700
1.000
0.100
1.05
-0.190
1.00
0.050
1.05
--0.190
1.000
0.050
0.95
0.120
1.00
0.100
0.95
0.120
1.000
0.100
y,
Surcharge
1.00
1.00
YRWL
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.050
1.00
0.000
1.000
0.050
y,
1.00
1.00
'Ytan4"'
0.75
0.760
1.00
0.100
0.85
0.760
1.000
0.100
y,.
Cohesion
Effective unit weight
Wall surface friction angle
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.100
1.00
0.000
1.000
0.100
1.05
--0.320
1.00
0.050
1.05
-0.320
1.000
0.050
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.100
1.00
0.000
1.000
0.100
y,
Surcharge
1.00
1.00
YRWL
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.050
1.00
0.000
1.000
0.050
Yv
Yuv
1.00
0.720
1.20
0.065
1.00
0.720
1.200
0.065
SKY 400
1.00
0.720
1.26
0.073
1.00
0.720
1.260
0.073
1.00
Yw
y,
y,.
Yw
y,
Yw
y,
y,
1.00
'Ytenfi'
0.80
0.500
1.00
0.100
0.85
0.500
1.00
0.100
y,.
Cohesion
Effective unit weight
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.100
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.100
1.05
-0.250
1.00
0.050
1.05
--0.250
1.00
0.050
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.100
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.100
y,
Surcharge
1.00
1.00
YRWL
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.050
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.050
Yuv
Yuv
0.90
1.000
1.20
0.065
1.00
1.000
1.20
0.065
SKY400
0.95
1.000
1.26
0.073
1.00
1.000
1.26
0.073
1.00
Yw
y,
y,
1.00
-a"
~"O
Yy
HT690
0.60
0.750
1.13
0.070
0.65
0.750
1.13
0.070
~ Yuv
0.65
0.750
1.26
0.073
0.70
0.750
1.26
0.073
iii~
SS400
"'
y,
Structural analysis
1.00
1.00
.s
~
"
~
~
-~ ""!3
...8~~
coefficient
Yuv
HT690
0.55
0.940
1.13
0.070
0.60
0.940
1.13
0.070
Yy
y,
SS400
0.65
0.940
1.26
0.073
0.70
0.940
1.26
0.073
1.00
1.00
-735-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 2.3.3 Standard Partial Factors
(a) Permanent situations (No. 2)
Other than high earthquakeresistance facilities
High earthquake-resistance
facilities
r,
r...1
~
;a
~
ta
ll.!O
u
IX,
IX,
0.90
0.309
1.00
0.040
0.90
0.329
1.00
0.040
0.90
0.398
1.00
0.040
0.90
0.396
1.00
0.040
1.10
-0.259
1.00
0.030
1.10
-0.271
1.00
0.030
y.,
Y.,
0.90
0.314
1.00
0.030
0.90
0.312
1.00
0.030
Y.,
Unitm:igbtof-soilslratabelow
1h:seabedsurli<:e
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.030
1.00
0.000
1.00
0.030
Yo
Surcharges
1.70
-0.467
1.00
0.400
1.60
-0.487
1.00
Q.400
YRWL
1.10
-0.040
1.00
0.050
1.10
-0.040
1.00
0.050
sum.:.
*1: a: sensitivity factor, /Xk: deviation of average value (average value I characteristic value), JT; coefficient of variation.
*2: It is necessary to determine which is governing in the soil composition of the foundations under consideration, the sandy soil strata or the
cohesive soil strata, and use the partial factors appropriate fur sandy soil ground or cohesive soil ground. For example, if it is determined
that the sandy soil strata are governing (sandy soil ground), when there is a thin stratum of cohesive soil, verification is carried out using
the partial factor for the cohesion of a sandy soil ground.
*3: uy indicates the yield strength of the steel material, and the partial factors are selected in accordance with the type of steel used.
*4: The design value of the tension force in the tie member is calculated from the design value of tie member installation point reaction
obtained from the verification of stresses in the sheet piles.
*S: The angle of shearing resistance I when calculating earth pressure is obtained from fl=arctan(rtan.,rtan;'k).
*6: For applying the partial factors to circular slip failure, refer to the points of caution given in Chapter 2, 3 Slope Stability, 3.1(7) Partial
Factors.
Serviceability
IX,
ti
>'tan-''
1.00
-M
'S
y,.
Cohesion
1.00
a
-
Yw'
1.00
y,
1.00
Yq
Surcharge
1.00
YRWL
1.00
Y
y.
1.00
1.20
Ytan
1.00
y,.
Cohesion
1.00
Yw'
Unit weight
1.00
y,
1.00
Y
Y,
Surcharge
1.00
1.00
YRWL
1.00
Y
Y.,
y.
1.00
1.00
1.12
1.00
1.67
1~
u ~
-ll "'
u
~
u
"'
0.
1
'8
~
j
"'
~
i"'
ti
-M
'S
~
u
~
~
ll
"'
1
~
"'
t: The design value of the tension force in the tie member is calculated from the design value of the tie member installation point reaction
obtained from the verification of sheet piling stresses.
-736-
It is necessary to determine which is dominant in the soil composition of the ground under consideration, the
sandy soil strata or the cohesive soil strata ground, and use the partial factors as appropriate. For example, if it
is determined that the sandy soil strata are dominant, when there is a thin stratum of cohesive soil, verification
is carried out using the partial factor for the cohesion of a sandy soil ground.
Regarding the partial factors of quaywalls other than high earthquake-resistance facilities, calculations shall
be carried out using a partial factor of LO or higher for the steel material yield stress for the stresses in sheet
pile walls in sandy soil ground. For the performance verification of facilities other than ports, there are no
examples of the use of design values of the steel material yield strength greater than the JIS specification values.
Therefore, in setting the partial factors, the partial factor for the tangent of the angle of shearing resistance with
a large sensitivity factor is set to a value larger than the value calculated from a reliability analysis. In this way
the flexural moment in the sheet pile wall is reduced, and a correction is carried out so that the partial factor of
the steel material strength is LO.
@ In the verification of sheet piled quaywalls, it is necessary to take into consideration both the active and passive
earth pressure. Also, there are approaches that do not necessarily evaluate the resistance on the passive side
as earth pressure and rather evaluate as a beam on an elastic foundation, so partial factors are not provided for
earth pressure in Table 2.3.3.
(9) Performance Verification of Anchorages for Sheet Pile Quaywalls on Variable Situations in respect of Level I
earthquake ground motion
CD
(a) In principle, the location of the anchorage work shall need to be set at an appropriate distance from the sheet
pile wall to ensure the structural stability of the main body of the wall and anchorage, depending on the
characteristics of the anchorage work. Normally, the further the position ofinstallation of the anchorage work
from the surface of the sheet pile wall, the more effective in restraining deformation of the sheet pile wall
during an earthquake. 59)
(b) The location of the anchorage work should be determined appropriately in consideration of the structural type
of the anchorage work, because the stability of the anchorage work itself is affected by its position and the
location at which the stability is achieved varies depending on the structural type.
(c) The location of concrete wall anchorage is preferably determined to ensure that the active failure plane starting
from the intersection of sea bottom and sheet pile wall and the passive failure plane of the slab anchorage
drawn from the bottom of the anchorage do not intersect below the ground surface as shown in Fig. 2.3.lS.
(d) The location of vertical pile anchorage is preferably determined to ensure that the passive failure plane from
the point of lml/3 below the tie member installation point of the anchorage and the active failure plane
from the intersection of sea bottom and sheet piles do not intersect at the level below the horizontal surface
containing the tie member installation point at the anchorage as shown in Fig. 2.3.16. The value of lm1 is the
depth of the first zero point of flexural moment for a free-head pile below the tie member installation point,
while the horizontal surface containing the installation point of tie member at the anchorage is assumed as the
ground surface.
W.L.
-737-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Tie member
W.L.
u
'6.
Residual water
]: leve\l" Passive
failure plane
Vertical
pile anchorage
(t) For the method to obtain the first zero point of the flexural moment of the vertical pile anchorage and sheet pile
anchorage and the method to determine whether a sheet pile anchorage can be considered as a long pile, refer
to Port and Harbour Research Institute's method described in Part Ill, Chapter 2, 2.4 Pile Foundations, 2.4
.5 Estimation of Pile Behavior using Analytical Methods.
(g) For ordinary sheet pile quaywalls whose tie members run horizontally, an angle of -15 may be used as
the wall friction angle in the determination of the passive failure plane that is drawn from the vertical pile
anchorage or sheet pile anchorage.
(h) The location of coupled-pile anchorage should be behind the active failure plane of the sheet pile wall drawn
from the sea bottom when it is assumed that the tension of the tie member is resisted only by the axial bearing
capacity of the piles as shown in Fig. 2.3.17. When the tension of the tie member is evaluated to be resisted
by both the axial and lateral bearing capacity in consideration of the bending resistance of the piles, it is
necessary to locate the anchorage in accordance with the location of the vertical pile.
(i) The partial factors used in determining the position of the anchorage work may all be taken to be 1.0.
W.L.
motion.
(2.3.24)
-738-
Ap : reaction at the tie member installation point calculated according to (3) Flexural Moment of
Sheet Pile and Reaction at Tie Member Installation Point above, using the partial factor
associated with the verification of sheet pile stress in Table 2.3.3 (N/m)
EA : resultant active earth pressure acting on slab anchorage (N/m)
ra : structural analysis factor
The design values in the equation may be calculated from the following equation. However, for calculating
the earth pressure acting on a slab anchored, normally it is assumed that the surcharge act as shown in Fig.
2.3.18, with active earth pressure considered and passive earth pressure not considered.
Ep,.
YEP
= 1.0 (Permanent situations, variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion)
Ap, =YA, Ap,
: YAP
f,
s,,s,
,/i.
,/ i'
q: Surcharge
!Nununnu
I
I
I
I
I
I
\
\
\
\
\
(b) The wall surface friction angle used in calculating the earth pressure is normally assumed to be 15 in the
case of active earth pressure and 0 in the case of passive earth pressure. However, in the case of a dead man
anchor, an upward acting tension force acts on the anchored, so the wall surface friction force acts upwards,
which is the opposite of the normal case of passive earth pressure, and the passive earth pressure will be
reduced. In this case the wall surface friction angle is normally assumed to be 15.
(c) When the active failure plane of the sheet pile and the passive failure plane of the slab anchorage drawn
in accordance with CD Location of anchorage work above intersect below the ground surface level, it
is preferable to consider the fact that the passive earth pressure acting on the vertical surface above the
intersection point does not function as a resistance force as shown in Fig. 2.3.19; it should be subtracted from
the design value of Ep of equation (2.3.24). When the intersection point is located above the residual water
level, the passive earth pressure to be subtracted may be calculated using equation (2.3.26) In the following
equation, the subscript d indicates the design value.
(2.3.26)
where
-739-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
, I
/1I
,
\
\
\
and then using equation (2.3.27). In the following equation, the subscript d indicates the design value.
M
M
_Tdf
Hd-U
vd
_Tdh
-St
(2.3.27)
where
(b) For the partial factors used in the performance verification, refer to @Partial factors.
(b) For the partial factors used in the performance verification, refer to @Partial factors.
@ Partial factors
For standard partial factors for use in the verification of the stability of vertical piles and coupled piles as
anchorage for the permanent situations and variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion
-740-
Performance requirement
"!ks'
Vertical pile
anchorage
Stress
Stress
Coupled
pile
anchorage
Y,
Serviceability
Ya,
y,
Yw
Yw,
Weight of superstructure
Yq
Surcharge
Y"'1,
Ya,
y,
y,-
Cohesion
Axial
l'N
N-value
resistance
force
l'Rll
Resistance force
Ya
IPull-out piles
IPush-in piles
y
1.00
1.00
1.35
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.45
1.00
1.00
0.40
0.45
1.00
IX,
-
a
-
*I: The design value of tie tension force is calculated from the design value of tie member installation point reaction obtained from the
verification of stresses in the sheet pile.
*2: The design value of the pile axial forces used in analysis of bearing forces in coupled-pile anchorage is obtained from the verification of
stresses in the coupled piles.
*3: The N-values and cohesion when calculating the characteristic value of resistance force used in analysis of bearing forces in coupled- pile
anchorage are characteristic values.
Serviceability
y
Vertical
pile
anchorage
Stress
Stress
Coupled
pile
anchorage
Bearing
forces
'Yks 'Ykc
Ya,
1.00
1.00
y,
1.12
Yw
Yw,
Weight of superstructure
y,
Surcharge
Y"'1,
Ya.
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
y,
1.12
y,-
Cohesion
l'N
N-value
1.00
1.00
0.40
0.66
0.50
1.00
Pull-out piles
l'Rll
y,
Resistance
furce
Push-in
piles
a
-
IX1
-
*I: The design value of tie tension force is calculated from the design value of tie member installation point reaction obtained from the
verification of stresses in the sheet pile.
2: The design value of the pile axial forces used in analysis of bearing forces in anchored coupled piles is obtained from the verification
of stresses in the coupled piles.
3: The N-values and cohesion when calculating the characteristic value of resistance force used in analysis of bearing forces in coupled
pile anchorage are characteristic values.
-741-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(a) When the sheet pile anchorage below the tie member installation point is long enough to be regarded as a long
pile, the cross section of the sheet pile anchorage may be determined in accordance with @ Examination of
stability of vertical pile anchorage above.
(b) Sheet piles anchorage that cannot be regarded as a long pile may be verified in accordance with Examination
of stability of slab anchorage above on the assumption that the earth pressure acts on a range down to lm112
point below the tie member installation point, as shown in Fig. 2.3.30. The length ml is the vertical distance
from the tie member installation point to the first zero point of the flexural moment of sheet piles assuming
that the sheet pile anchorage is a long pile.
$,
$,
, , s.
'
'
,,tlYUfft
I """ '''
II
II
'
I
I
Fig. 2.3.20 Virtual Earth Pressure for Short Sheet Pile Anchorage
Q) For performance verification of sheet pile quaywalls for ground motions by dynamic analysis methods, refer
to (9) Performance Verification for Ground Motions (detailed methods) in 2.2 Gravity-type Quaywalls,
2.2.3 Performance Verification. However, for sheet pile quaywalls the stress distribution in the soil varies
depending on the construction process, so it is necessary to select an analysis method capable of reproducing
the stress distribution in the soil before the earthquake.
@ For the accidental situations in respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion, the standard limit values when
carrying out the performance verification for the amount of deformation may be appropriately calculated by
reference to 1.4 Standard Concept of Allowable Deformation oflligh Earthqnake-resistance Facilities for
Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
(11)
Q) Superstructure may be verified as a cantilever beam that is fixed at the top of the sheet pile and subjected to
the earth pressure as an action. However, it is necessary to consider the tractive forces of ships and the active
earth pressure behind the wall for the parts on which bollards are installed and the fender reaction force and the
passive earth pressure behind the wall for the parts on which fenders are installed. The only factor that should
be considered with regard to conditions during an earthquake is the active earth pressure.
@ The tractive forces of ships and fender reactions may be applied as shown in Fig. 2.3.21 assumed to be acting
over a width b of the superstructure as shown in Fig. 2.3.21(b). In this case, normally when considering the
tractive forces, a surcharge shall be considered in the active earth pressure calculation, and when applying the
fender reactions the passive earth pressure surcharge shall not be considered. The wall surface friction angle
may be taken to be 15 for active earth pressure and 0 for passive earth pressure. For tractive forces of ships
and fender reactions, refer to Part II, Chapter 8, 2 Actions Caused by Ships.
-742-
I
_sh,
Pih
Permanent states of
active earth pressure
'
'
<E--b~4/----7
(a)
(b)
Q) Waling is normally installed sandwiching tie members, and fixed to the sheet pile with bolts or similar. If waling
is installed to the rear of the sheet pile, the cross-section of the fastening bolts can be determined from equation
(2.3.28). However, if not embedded in the coping, it is necessary to consider a corrosion allowance. In the
fullowing equation, the symbol y is the partial factor for the subscript, and the subscript d indicates the design
value.
(2.3.28)
where,
A : bolt cross-sectional area (cm2)
Ap : reaction at tie member installation point obtained from the above 2.3.4(3) Flexural Moment of
Sheet Piles and Reaction at Tie Member Installation Point (Nim)
tw : spacing of sheet pile fastened to the waling (m), when installed at one position intermediate
between tie members, equivalent to a half of the tie member spacing
n : number of bolts at one location (No.)
uy : tensile yield stress of bolt (N/cm2)
Ya : structural analysis factor
In the equation, all the partial factors except the structural analysis factor may be taken to be 1.0. If
intermediate bolts are used, the structural analysis factor may be taken to be 2.5 for permanent situations, and
1.67 fur variable situations in respect of the Level I earthquake ground motion. Also, equation (2.3.18) may
be used to calculate the design value of the tensile yield stress of the steel material.
into consideration.
(3) Installation of Anchorages and Tie Members
Q) A continuous beam along the face line of quaywall is usually constructed on top of the anchorage piles, and
the tie members are attached to the beam. This beam may be verified for performance as a continuous beam
subjected to the tie member tension force and the reaction force of the piles.
-743-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 50
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of cantilevered sheet
piles shall be such that the risk in which the amount of deformation of the top of the pile may exceed the
allowable limit of deformation is equal to or less than the threshold level under the permanent action
situations in which the dominant action is earth pressure and under the variable action situation in which
the dominant actions are Level I earthquake ground motions, ship berthing, and traction by ships.
[Technical Note]
2.4.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) The perfurmance verification methods described here apply to sheet pile walls driven into sandy soil ground, and
are not applicable to cohesive soil ground.
(2) An example of the sequence of perfurmance verification of cantilevered sheet pile quaywalls is shown in Fig.
2.4.1.
-744-
.J.
:..:::>-------------------<
*I
-------------------------------- Permanent
SituitiOn-s~
'
-- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- -- --- --- --- --- --- --- --perm.anent-sitUBtiODS,-:
variable situations of action of ships :
~-----------~~-----------~
'
~------~~------~
*2
------------------------- --vari&bfeSitUBtiODSi:Drespector:
~------------------
'
'
----
1___________________ ~----------~-----~"
*3
r-----------------
''
~------------------
:'
-------------------------r--------------------------1
:-------------------------------+-----------------------Pe~~e~t;it;;;tl;~;:
*1: Evaluation of the effect of liquefaction is not shown, so it is necessary to consider these separately.
*2: When necessary, an examination of the amount of defonnation by dynamic analysis can be carried out for the Level 1 earthquake ground
motion.
For high earthquake-resistance facilities, it is preferable that examination of the amount of defonnation be carried out by dynamic
analysis.
*3: Verification in respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion is carried out for high earthquake-resistance facilities.
Fig. 2.4.1 Example of Sequence of Performance Verification for Cantilevered Sheet Pile Quaywalls
-745-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(3) Fig. 2.4.2 shows an example of a cross-section of a cantilevered sheet pile quaywall.
Curbing
Rubberf~rf".....,~;;;;;iJi~~===::ii!ii~i::=:~~
H.W.L.
Backfill soil
Pavement curb
L.WL.
D
Fig. 2.4.2 Example of Cross-section of Cantilevered Sheet Pile Quaywall
2.4.2 Actions
(!) Forces acting on a cantilevered sheet pile wall can refer to 2.3 Sheet Pile Quaywalls.
(2) Where the seabed ground is of sandy soil, a virtual bottom surface is assumed at the elevation where the sum of
the active earth pressure and residual water pressure is equal to the passive earth pressure. It is assumed that the
earth pressure and residual water pressure will act on the part of cantilevered sheet pile wall above such the virtual
bottom surface, as illustrated in Fig. 2.4.3.
____ _
--
Virtual
'
bottom surface
(3) The characteristic value ofthe seismic coefficient for verification used in the performance verification ofcantilevered
sheet piled quaywalls under the variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion shall be
appropriately calculated taking the structural characteristics into account. For convenience, the characteristic
value ofthe seismic coefficient for verification of cantilevered sheet piled quaywalls may be calculated as the sheet
piled quaywalls with vertical pile anchorage, in 2.3 Sheet Pile Qnaywalls, 2.3.2(9) Seismic Coefficient used in
Performance Verification of Sheet Pile Qnaywalls with Pile Anchorage for Variable Situations in respect of
Level 1 earthquake ground motion.
-746-
CD
The maximum flexural moment in a sheet pile wall shall be calculated appropriately by using an analysis
method corresponding to the mechanical behavior characteristics of the wall. The maximum flexural moment
in a sheet pile wall is normally calculated by the PHRI method concerning the lateral resistance of piles.
The lateral resistance of pile can be calculated in accordance with 2.4.5[4] Estimation of Pile Behavior using
Analytical Methods in this Part, Chapter 2, 2.4 Pile Foundations.
@ When steel pipes are used as sheet piles, the secondary stress often develops in steel pipes of a sheet pile wall
due to the deformation of the steel pipe cross section (i.e. a circular cross section is deformed into an elliptic
one) that is caused by the earth and residual water pressure. Cantilevered sheet pile walls are the structures tend
to experience large displacement, and there is a risk about such walls that a relatively high secondary stress may
develop in the areas around the point where the flexural moment becomes maximum. The larger the diameter
of the steel pipe, the higher the level of secondary stress becomes. In such a case, therefore, it is preferable to
perform examination of strength against the secondary stress. The secondary stress of a steel pipe is calculated
using equation (2.4.1).
u, =ap( ~ Jx10-
(2.4.1)
where
ClII)
0.20
"!)
0.15
~0
0.10
0.05
0.00
0
30
60
90
120
150
180
Verification may be carried out using the following equation (2.4.2), based on the axial stress u1 in the pile
obtained in accordance with 5.2 Open-JYpe Wharves on Vertical Piles, and the secondary stress u1 obtained
from equation (2.4.1). In the following, the symbol y is the partial factor corresponding to the subscript, and the
subscripts k and d indicate the characteristic value and the design value, respectively. The structural analysis
factor may be taken to be 1.2 for permanent situations, and LO for variable situations in respect of Level 1
earthquake ground motion.
{2.4.2)
where,
u1
-747-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
u1
ra
The design values in the equation may be calculated from the following equation. Also, the partial factors
may be all taken to be 1.0.
u,d = Ya,u1,,
u,d =ru,ut.1:
(2.4.3)
-748-
(!) The following is applicable to the performance verification of mooring facilities in which raking piles are driven
behind the sheet pile wall, and the tops of the sheet pile wall and the raking piles are connected to support the soil
behind the sheet pile wall.
(2) An example of the sequence of performance verification of sheet piled quaywalls with raking pile anchorages is
shown in Fig. 2.5.1.
(3) An example of a cross-section of sheet pile quaywalls with raking pile anchorages is shown in Fig. 2.5.2.
Setting of design conditions
~
I~~~~~~~~~~~~~''
1
J.
---------------------------------------~
,
of Level 1 earthquake ground motion :
.
.
.
.
.
.
and action ofships'
V enfication of stresses 111 sheet pile and raking anchorage piles
:
,
-------------------------------r-------------------------------
---------------------------------------~
iD
Permanent-sifu-atiOD.S;V8ri8b1e-sitU&tiOii.S respect-:
~--------~--------~
--------------------------------
---------------------------------------~
--- --- --- --- --- --- - - --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --variable Sitll&:tiODs_iD_iespect-or-:
..
1_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _
~---------~-- ----
.. -- --- --- --- --- --- - ---- --- --- --- --- --- --- --- --
--A~cld;;w~tat; t.;;.;sp~t~i:
L------------------
-------------------------~---------------------------!
~-------------------------------~------------------------pe-..-;.;;~e~t~i~;ti~;~
t: The evaluation of the effect of liquefaction is not shown, it is necessary to consider these separately.
2: When necessary, an examination of the amount of deformation by dynamic analysis can be carried out for the Level 1 earthquake ground
motion.
For high earthquake-resistance facilities, it is preferable that the examination of the amount of deformation be carried out by dynamic
analysis.
*3: Verification in respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion is carried out for high earthquake-presistance facilities.
Fig 2.5.1 Example of Sequence of Performance Verification of Sheet Pile Quaywalls with Raking Pile Anchorages
-749-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
v H.W.L.
-
L.W.L.
Sheet pile/
Fig. 2.5.2 Example of Cross-section of Sheet Pile Quaywall with Raking Pile Anchorage
2.5.2 Actions
(!) For the action on sheet piled walls with raking pile anchorages, refer to 2.3 Sheet Pile Quaywalls.
(2) The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification of sheet pile
quaywalls with raking pile anchorages for the variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion
shall be appropriately calculated taking the structural characteristics into consideration. For convenience, the
characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification of sheet pile quaywalls with raking pile anchorages
may be calculated as the sheet pile quaywalls vertical pile anchorage, in 2.3.2(9) Seismic Coefficient used in
Performance Verification of Sheet Pile Quaywalls with Pile Anchorage for Variahle Situations in respect of
Level 1 earthquake ground motion.
2.5.3 Performance Verification
CD
For sheet pile quaywalls with raking pile anchorages, verification may be carried out for the resistance of the
sheet pile and the piles, against the actions in the horizontal and vertical direction at the connection point, earth
pressure and residual water pressure.
@ The horizontal and vertical forces acting on the connection point between a sheet pile and a raking pile can be
calculated by assuming that the connection is a pin structure.
(3) Determination of Embedded Lengths of Sheet Pile and Raking Pile
The embedded length of the sheet pile or raking anchorage pile that is required to resist the forces acting in the
axial direction as well as the direction perpendicular to the axis can be calculated in accordance with Part II,
Chapter, 2.4 Pile Foundations. However, it is preferable to examine the bearing capacity in the axial direction
of the sheet pile and that of the raking anchorage pile through loading and pulling tests.
2.5.4 Performance Verification of Structural Members
Performance verification of sheet piled quaywalls with raking pile anchorages can apply that of sheet piled quaywalls
and open type wharves on vertical piles. Refer to 2.3.4 Performance Verification, and 5.2.5 Performance Verification
of Structural Members.
-750-
2.6 Open-type Quaywall with Sheet Pile Wall Anchored by Forward Batter Piles
2.6.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!)The provisions in this section shall be applied to the performance verification of sheet pile quaywalls that are built
by coupling the sheet pile heads with the raking anchorage piles driven in the ground in front of the sheet piles
that retain the earth in the back.
(2) Open-type quaywall with sheet pile wall anchored by foreward batter piles are normally constructed with an
open-type wharf built in front of the sheet pile wall. The open-type wharf may or may not be integrated into
the sheet pile wall, but this section provides guidelines for the cases in which the open-type wharf and sheet pile
wall are integrated. For the cases in which the open-type wharf is not integrated into the sheet pile wall, refer
to 2.3 Sheet Pile Qnaywalls, 5.2 Open-l)'pe Wharves on Vertical Piles, and 5.3 Open-l)'pe Wharves on
Coupled Raking Piles. The performance verification method described in this section is based on the sheet pile
performance verification with the equivalent beam method. Therefore, the structural types covered by this section
are steel sheet pile walls driven into a sandy soil ground or a hard clayey soil ground.
(3) An example of the sequence of performance verification of Open-type Quaywall with Sheet Pile Wall Anchored
by Forward Batter Piles is shown in Fig. 2.6.1.
(4) Here, a method of carrying out the performance verification of the sheet piles and the performance verification
of the other piles in three stages is described, as a method of simple verification. Performance verification of
the sheet piles can be carried out in accordance with the methods of performance verification of sheet pile, by
considering the connection points between the raking support piles and the sheet pile to be fulcrums. Next,
the reaction at the connection points between the raking support piles and the sheet pile is considered to be a
horizontal force acting on the piled pier superstructure, and the axial forces acting in the sheet pile and the piles
are calculated in accordance with the performance verification of open type wharves on raking piles. Then, the
sheet pile and the raking support piles are considered to be a rigid frame structure fixed at a virtual fixing point,
and the moments in the top connection points due to earth pressure and other horizontal forces are calculated.
(5) An example of cross-section of open-type quaywall with sheet pile wall anchored by forward batter piles is shown
in Fig. 2.6.2.
-751-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
,_'
*I
r------------------------------- ----------------------------------------
I
I
'
''
''
''
________________________________________ !
*3
.----------------
----------------------
''
''
I
I
I
I
:'
'
------------------- ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------------
_________ I
Permanent situations :
I
I
'
'--------------------------------+---------------------------------------"
''
'
t: The evaluation of the effect of liquefaction is not shown, it is necessary to consider these separately.
2: When necessary, an examination of the amount of deformation by dynamic analysis can be carried out for the Level 1 earthquake ground
motion.
For high earthquake-resistance facilities, it is preferable that the examination of the amount of deformation be carried out by dynamic
analysis.
3: Verification in respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion is carried out for high earthquake-resistance facilities.
-752-
Backfill rocks
Fig. 2.6.2 Example of Cross-section of Open-type Quaywall with Sheet Pile Wall Anchored by Forward Batter Piles
2.6.2 Actions
(!) For the action on the piled pier part, referto 5.2 Open-Type Wharves on Vertical Piles.
(2) For the action of the sheet pile, refer to 2.3 Sheet Pile Qnaywalls.
(3) The self weight of reinforced concrete of the superstructure of open-type wharf can be calculated with a writ
weight of 21kN/m2 in the perfurmance verification of the vertical and raking piles and sheet piles in accordance
with 5.3 Open-Type Wharves on Coupled Raking Piles.
(4) The fender reaction force can be calculated using calculation methods described in 5.2 Open-Type Wharves on
Vertical Piles.
(5) The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification of open-type
quaywall with sheet pile wall anchored by foreward batter piles for the variable situations in respect of Level I
earthquake ground motion shall be appropriately calculated taking the structural characteristics into consideration.
For convenience, the characteristic value ofthe seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification
of open-type quaywall with sheet pile wall anchored by foreward batter piles may be calculated in accordance
with 5.2 Open Type Wharf on Vertical Piles, 5.2.3(10) Ground Motion nsed in Performance Verification of
Seismic-resistant.
(2) It is preferable that layout and inclination of the raking piles are determined in consideration of their positional
relationship with other piles and construction work-related constraints such as those concerning the capacity of
pile driving equipment. A pile inclination of about 20 is normally used for raking piles.
(3) For the dimensions of the superstructure, refer to dimensions of superstructure in 5.2 Open-Type Wharves on
Vertical Piles.
-753-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) For the earth pressure and residual water pressure acting on the sheet pile, the connection point between the raking
support pile and the sheet pile may be considered to be a fulcrum reaction.
(3) If it is necessary to carry out verification of rotation of the piled pier block, this shall be appropriately
considered.
Q) For the performance verification of the piled pier part, refer to 5.2 Open-type Wharves on Vertical Piles, and
5.3 Open-type Wharves on Coupled Raking Piles.
@ For assumptions regarding the seabed, refur to assumptions regarding the seabed in 5.2 Open-type Wharves
on Vertical Piles. For the horizontal resistance of piles, estimation of the behavior of the piles may be carried
out using the method ofY. L. Chang.
@ The vertical loads distributed to the pile heads can be calculated as the fulcrum reaction forces under the
assumption that the superstructure of open-type wharf is a simple beam supported at the positions of pile heads.
The axial forces on the raking pile and sheet pile should be calculated according to equation (2.4.60) in 2.4.5[6]
Lateral Bearing Capacity of Coupled Piles in Part III, Chapter 2, 2.4 Pile Foundations using the horizontal
force on the quaywall and the vertical load distributed to pile heads. For the axial force of a vertical pile, the
vertical load distributed to the pile head may be used.
The flexural moment at the connection of the raking pile and the sheet pile may be calculated as the moment due
to the earth pressure, residual water pressure and other horizontal forces, by assuming that the raking and sheet
piles constitute a rigid frame fixed at the virtual fixed point.
(5) Examination of embedded length with respect to the axial force, and examination of the embedded length with
respect to the lateral resistance can be made in accordance with 5.2 Open-type Wharves on Vertical Piles.
2.6.5 Performance Verification of Structural Members
(!) The performance verification for structural members of sheet pile wall anchored by forward batter piles can be
made by referring to the provisions in 2.3 Sheet Pile Quaywalls and 5.2 Open-type Wharves on Vertical Piles.
(2) The connecting point of the sheet pile wall and raking pile need to be structured so that the load transmission
functions adequately.
(3) The superstructure of open-type wharf shall be structured so that it fully withstands the flexural moment
transmitted from the sheet pile wall.
(4) The connecting point between the sheet pile wall and raking pile must have sufficient reinforcement, because
breakage or damage at the connecting point could lead to the collapse of the entire quaywall. The flexural moment
generated in the head of the sheet pile is transmitted to the superstructure of open-type wharf. Therefore, this
flexural moment need to be taken into consideration in the performance verification of the superstructure.
-754-
3 In addition to the provisions in the first paragraph, the performance criteria of double sheet pile structures
shall be as specified in the subsequent items
(1) The risk of occurrence of sliding of the structural body shall be equal to or less than the threshold level
under the permanent action situations in which the dominant action is earth pressure and under the
variable action situation in which the dominant action is Level 1 earthquake ground motions.
(2) The risk that the deformation of the top of the front or rear sheet pile may exceed the allowable limit
of deformation shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the permanent action situation
in which the dominant action is earth pressure and under the variable action situation in which the
dominant action is Level 1 earthquake ground motions.
(3) The risk oflosing the stability due to shear deformation of the structural body shall be equal to or less
than the threshold level under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is earth
pressure.
[Technical Nole]
2.7.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(1) The following is applicable to the performance verification of mooring facilities that use a double sheet
pile structure.
(2) A double sheet pile quaywall is a mooring facility in which two rows of sheet pile walls are driven and
connected by tie members or similar, then the space between the two walls is backfilled with soil so that
an earth retaining structure is formed.
(3) An example of the cross-section of a double sheet pile quaywall is shown in Fig. 2.7.1.
(4) An example of the sequence of performance verification of double sheet pile quaywalls is shown in Fig.
2.7.2.
Waling
~~
Waling
Apron
Filling
Paint coating
Steel pipe sheet pile
Sand filling
Fig. 2.7.1 Example of the Cross-section ofa Double Sheet Pile Quaywall
-755-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
l._~~~~-S_e_tt_in~g~o_f_d_e_s~ign~c_o_n_d_u_io_ns~~~~~.....:~
:..:~---------------<
*I
Evaluation of actions
~Performanceverification~~~~~-+-~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~--.
i----------------------------~;--------------------p;;~:;.;.;~t~t.i'atio~-:
I
L ____________________________
------------------------------------~
r---------------------------------Pennanentsituations:variab"testtiiationsoi:
,,
Level 1 earthquake ground motion :
I Determination of embedment length of sheet pile :t-----------r---+----i
I
I
1- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
i-eiii'i.;;enfsitiati~'i.8;Jin.I ;;ri;t,fe-sii.iati~'i.8 -:
of Level 1 earthquake ground motion :
and action of ships :
I
I_____________________________
:1--------------+-+---<
-------------------------------------
i- - -- - -- - -- - -- - -- - -- - -- - -- - -- - -- P;~;;;.;t-sit;ati-;,~;;~.;ci ;;rl;l,le-sit;ati-;,~;-:
,,.
of Level 1 earthquake ground motion:
Verification of stresses in waling
:
:
-----------------------------
_____________________________________ I
r------------------------------------------------------------------1
,,
~---------------------------- ------------------------------------~
*2
,,.
-----------------------------------------;------------------------,
*3
L ________________ ------------------------~-----------------------~
r------------------------------------------------------------------,
I_ - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
Permanent situations :
-t-----------------------------------
_I
i.
I
*1: The evaluation ofthe effi::ct ofliquefaction is not shown, so this must be separately considered.
*2: Analysis of the amount of deformation due to Level I earthquake ground motion may be carried out by dynamic analysis when necessary.
For high earthquake-resistance facilities, analysis of the amount of deformation by dynamic analysis is desirable.
*3: For high earthquake-resistance facilities, verification is carried out for Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
Fig_ 2.7.2 Example of the Sequence of Performance Verification of Double Sheet Pile Quaywalls
-756-
2.7.2 Actions
(!) For the action on double sheet pile quaywalls, refer to 2.9 Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls with Embedded
Sections.
(2) The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient fur verification used in performance verification of double sheet
pile quaywalls for the variable situations of Level I earthquake ground motion shall be appropriately calculated
taking into consideration the structural characteristics. For convenience, the characteristic value of the seismic
coefficient for verification of double sheet pile quaywalls may be calculated in accordance with that for anchored
vertical pile type sheet piled quaywalls, in 2.3.2(9) Performance Verification of Anchorages for Sheet Pile
Quaywalls on Variable Situation in respect of Level 1 Earthquake Ground Motion.
(2) The calculation of the deformation moment can be made in accordance with 2.9 Cellular-bnlkhead Quaywalls
with Embedded Sections.
(3) The calculation of the resistance moment can be made in accordance with 2.9 Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls
with Embedded Sections. However, the resistance moment due to the frictions at the joints between sheet piles
of the partition walls is not considered normally.
(4) The embedded length of sheet piles is determined as the longer one of either that calculated by the method for sheet
piles having ordinary anchorage referring to examination of embedded lengths of sheet piles in 2.3 Sheet Pile
Quaywalls or that satisfying the allowable limit for horizontal displacement requirement referring to examination
of stability of wall body as a whole and examination of displacement of wall top in 2.9 Cellular-bulkhead
Quaywalls with Embedded Sections
(5) A double sheet pile quaywall can be considered as a kind of gravity wall. Thus it is necessary to verify the
stability against sliding of the quaywall and the overall slope stability including the wall structure, as in the case
of a cellular-bulkhead type quaywall. In the performance verification reference can be made in accordance with
the performance verification described in 2.2 Gravity-type Quaywalls. Sliding is usually examined either at the
virtual bottom surface which is taken at the sea bottom or the horizontal plane at the toe of the sheet pile wall. In
the former case, the resistance of the sheet pile wall below the sea bottom should be ignored. In the examination
ofthe overall slope stability including the double sheet pile quaywall, the embedded length ofthe double sheet pile
quaywall must be compared with the required embedded length calculated for a corresponding single sheet pile
quaywall with anchorage. If the former is found longer than the latter, the resistance of the portion of sheet piles
below the calculated toe of the latter sheet piles should be ignored against the circular slip plane passing the level
below the toe.
(6) Performance verification of the slab and upright section of the superstructure can be made in accordance with the
performance verification of relieving platform in 2.8 Quaywalls with Relieving Platforms. Foundation piles are
sometimes driven into the filling material to support the superstructure. These piles should have sufficient safety
against the horizontal and vertical forces transmitted from the superstructure. Here it is assumed that the vertical
force transmitted from the superstructure is entirely borne by the piles, and the vertical bearing capacity ofthe pile
is calculated by ignoring the skin friction between the pile and the filling material. The horizontal force that acts
on the superstructure is transmitted to the double sheet pile quaywall partly through the piles and partly through
the sheet piles. Therefore it is necessary to determine appropriate burden shearing of the horizontal force by the
two sections.
(7) When double sheet piled wall structures are used, the amount of deformation may be evaluated by a static method
using Sawaguchi's method TI) or Ohori's method.73)
-757-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 51
The performance criteria of quaywalls with relieving platforms shall be as specified in the subsequent
items:
(1) Sheet piles shall have the embedment length as necessary for structural stability and contain the degree
of risk that the stresses in the sheet piles may exceed the yield stress at the level equal to or less than the
threshold level under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is earth pressure and
under the variable action situation in which the dominant action is Level l earthquake ground motions.
(2) The risk of occurrence of sliding or overturning to the structural body shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is earth pressure and
under the variable action situation in which the dominant action is Level l earthquake ground motions.
(3) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the permanent action situation in which the dominant
action is self weight:
(a) The risk that the axial forces acting in the relieving platform piles may exceed the resistance force
based on failure of the soils shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(b) The risk of impairing the integrity of the members of the relieving platform shall be equal to or less
than the threshold level.
(4) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the permanent action situation in which the dominant
action is earth pressure and under the variable action situation in which the dominant actions are Level
1 earthquake ground motions, ship berthing, and traction by ships:
(a) The risk that the axial forces acting on the relieving platform piles may exceed the resistance force
based on failure of the soils shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(b) The risk that the stress acting on the relieving platform piles may exceed the yield stress shall be
equal to or less than the threshold level.
(c) The risk of impairing the integrity of the members of the relieving platform shall be equal to or less
than the threshold level.
(5) The risk of occurrence of a slip failure in the ground that passes below the bottom end of the sheet
piling shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the permanent action situation in which
the dominant action is self weight.
[Commentary]
CD The performance criteria of quaywalls with relieving platforms shall use the following in accordance
with the design situations and the structure members.
Besides these requirements, when necessary the settings of the Public Notice Article 22 Paragraph
3 (Scouring and Washing Out) shall be applied.
(a) The setting for sheet pile and structural stability of the performance criteria of quaywalls with
relieving platforms and the design situations excluding accidental situations shall be in accordance
with Attached Table 37.
-758-
:g
ll
26
Public Notice
u
:g
~ ll
2
51
1
1
Design situation
Performance
Non-
Verification item
requirements
Situation
Dominating
value
dominating
action
action
pressure
Yielding of sheet pile
(High earthquake-resistance
facility Pf= l.7X)Q-3)
(Other than high
earthquake-resistance
facility Pi= 4.0xl0-0)
Variable
f--
surcharge
I.7xl0-3)
(Other than high
earthquake-resistance
facility pt= 4.0xl0-3)
Variable
1.7xlO-:fum
(Other
high
earthquake-resistance
facility Pi= 4.0xl0-3)
-759-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Attached Table 38 Settings for the Performance Criteria for the Relieving Platform and Relieving Platform Piles of
Quaywalls with Relieving Platforms and the Design situations excluding Accidental Situations
Ministerial
Ordinance
u
:g
ll
26
1
1
:g
~ ll
2
Design situation
Public Notice
51
Performance
1
1
requirements
Situation
Nondominating
action
Dominating
action
Surcharging,
water pressure
Verification item
value
(pushing, pulling)
f--
3b
4a
Variable
surcharge
f--
4b
Variable
4c
piles
L1 earthquake Selfwoigh~
ground
earth pressure,
motion
water pressure,
surcbarge
Traction of
ships
Pennanent Earth pressure Water pressure, Yielding of relieving
surcharge
platform
Ll earthquake
ground
motion
Traction of
ships
Pennanent Earth pressure
Variable
compressive stress
(serviceability limit state)
Resistance capacity based
on failure of the ground
(pushing, pulling)
Self weigh~
earth pressure,
water pressure,
surcharge
(!) The provisions in this chapter may be applied to the performance verification of quaywall with relieving platform
that comprises a relieving platform, a sheet pile wall in front of the relieving platform, and relieving platform piles.
(2) Sheet pile quaywall with a relieving platform normally comprise a relieving platform, a sheet pile wall in front
of the relieving platform, and relieving platform piles. The relieving platform is in many cases constructed
as an L-shaped structure of cast-in-place reinforced concrete and is usually buried under landfill material, but
sometimes a box shape platform is used to reduce the weight of the platform and the earthquake forces that act on
it see Fig. 2.8.1 and 2.8.2.
-760-
(3) The performance verification of a quaywall with a relieving platform can be made separately for the sheet piles,
the relieving platform, and the relieving platform piles.
W.L.
Fig. 2.8.2 Structure of Quaywall with Relieving Platform (Box Shape Platform)
(4)An example of the sequence of performance verification of a quaywall with relieving platform is shown in Fig.
2.8.3.
-761-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
'
'r
:>---------i,-1----i
I
---------------
:----------------------------------------------------p;.;.,,~~;~t~t;:.;ti;;:
1
! _________________________________________________________________
':
r------------------------------------------------------------------1
Permanent situation, and variable situations of
'
>-------~'-',-+--<
1
'
------------------------------------~
-p~~;;;nt ~ifu;tio-;.~ ;~d
;ibi-;.ti~;s- ~f-:
;;..t;bI;
'
'
_____________________________________ I
Variable situations of 1
Level 1 earthquake ground motion :
---
~ - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -~---------------------------~
'~--------------------------------------4---------------------------J'
r------------------------------------------------------------------1
Permanent situation 1
'
'
~-----------------------------~------------------------------------~
*1: The evaluation of the effect of liquefaction is not shown. so this must be separately considered.
*2: Analysis of the amount of deformation due to Level 1 earthquake ground motion may be carried out by dynamic analysis when necessary.
For high earthquake-resistance facilities, analysis of the amount of deformation by dynamic analysis is desirable.
*3: For high earthquake-resistance facilities, verification is carried out for Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
Fig. 2.8.3 Example of the Sequence of Performance Verification of a Quaywall with Relieving Platform
-762-
(!) The earth pressure and residual water pressure acting on sheet piles vary greatly according to structural
characteristics. Therefore, they shall be calculated appropriately in consideration of the height and width of the
relieving platform as well as support conditions.
(2) When the active failure surface of backfill soil from the intersection between the sea bottom and sheet piles
intersects the relieving platform, the active earth pressure acting on the sheet pile wall can be calculated on the
assumption that the bottom of the relieving platform is the virtual ground surface and no surcharge is on it as
shown in Fig. 2.8.4.
(3) The residual water pressure acting on the sheet pile wall should be considered the same as that of the case without
a relieving platform. The force to be adopted should be the residual water pressure acting on the range below the
bottom level of relieving platform, see Fig. 2.8.4.
(4) As for passive earth pressure in front of the embedded section of sheet pile, 2.3 Sheet Pile Quaywalls can be
referred.
Design water level
v (L.W.L)
Active
earth pressure
Passive
earth pressure
Fig. 2.8.4 Earth Pressure and Residual Water Pressure Acting on Sheet Pile Wall
(5) The characteristic value of seismic coefficient for verification used in the performance verification of quaywalls
with relieving platforms for the variable situations associated with Level I earthquake ground motion shall be
calculated taking the structural characteristics into consideration. For convenience, the characteristic value of
seismic coefficient for verification of quaywalls with relieving platforms may be calculated by reference to the
2.2.2(1) Seismic Coefficient for Verification used in Verification of Damage due to Sliding and Overturning
of Wall Body and Insufficient Bearing Capacity of Foundations Ground in Variable Situations in Respect of
Level 1 Earthquake Ground Motion, complying with gravity-type quaywalls.
(6) It is not desirable that the width of the relieving platform be shortened to the range where it does not intersect with
the active failure surface extending from the seabed surface. However, if the use of a short relieving platform is
unavoidable, the following method can be used as the method of calculating the active earth pressure acting on the
sheet pile.
As shown in Fig. 2.8.5, the earth pressure acting on the sheet pile wall is calculated as the earth pressure
acting in the case that there is no relieving platform below the intersection point of the active failure surface drawn
from the rear end of the relieving platform and the sheet pile, and as the earth pressure acting in (2) above, above
the point of intersection of the natural failure surface during Level I earthquake ground motion drawn from the
rear end of the relieving platform and the sheet pile. Between these two, it may be assumed that the earth pressure
varies linearly.
The design value of the angle a formed between the natural failure surface and the horizontal during an
earthquake can generally be obtained from equation (2.8.1). In the following equation, the subscript d indicates
the design value.
aa =a-tan-'k>,
(2.8.1)
where,
The design values in the equation may be calculated from the following equation. In the equation, the symbol y
is the partial factor corresponding to its subscript, and the subscripts k and d indicate the characteristic value and
-763-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
the design value, respectively. Also, the partial factors may all be assumed to be 1.0.
tan~d = Ytan~ tan9\-
kd =rtkk:
(2.8.2)
Fig. 2.8.5 Earth Pressure Acting on Sheet Pile with Narrow Relieving Platform
(1) The horizontal force transmitted from the sheet pile wall may be calculated with the same method as that for the
reaction force at the tie rod setting point obtained in accordance with 2.3.4 Performance Verification of 2.3
Sheet Pile Quaywalls by regarding the bottom elevation of relieving platform as a tie rod setting point.
(8) The tractive force of ships and fender reaction force also act on the relieving platform. These external forces
should be considered as necessary.
(9) The external forces transmitted from the sheet pile wall to the relieving platform include the horizontal force and
flexural moment. However, the transmission ofthe flexural moment is ignored for the sake of safety, because the
fixing of the sheet piles to the relieving platform may not be rigid enough.
{lO)The earth pressure and residual water pressure acting on the back of the relieving platform can be calculated in
accordance with Part II, Chapter 5, 1 Earth Pressure and Part II, Chapter 5, 2.1 Residual Water Pressure.
In the calculation of earth pressure, surcharge should be taken into consideration. In the part below the bottom of
relieving platform, the difference between action earth pressure acting on the rear and the passive earth pressure
acting on the front acts as the active earth pressure down to the depth where the two pressures are balanced. This
should be added as shown in Fig. 2.8.6. The friction angle of the wall may be taken to be 15 for active earth
pressure, and-15 for passive earth pressure.
,,..L.::;;.:__
,,
Pp
Fig. 2.8.6 External Forces to be Considered for Performance Verification of Relieving Platform
CD
The embedded length of sheet piles can be examined by assuming that the joint between the sheet pile wall and
relieving platform is a hinge support, replacing the bottom of the relieving platform with a tie rod setting point
and applying 2.3 Sheet Pile Quaywalls.
@ Verification of stresses in the sheet pile wall may be carried out in accordance with 2.3 Sheet Piled Quaywalls,
replacing the relieving platform bottom surface with the tie installation point.
@ In addition to the flexural moment due to earth pressure, the flexural moment and vertical force transmitted
from the relieving platform act on the sheet piles of a sheet pile wall. Normally the flexural moment transmitted
from the relieving platform is not taken into consideration, because it usually acts in a direction opposite to that
-764-
of the maximwn flexural moment that acts on the sheet piles and thus reduces the maximum :flexural moment.
Furthermore, the vertical force transmitted from the relieving platform to the sheet pile wall is normally not
taken into consideration when the front row ofrelieving platform piles is driven in as close to the sheet pile wall
as possible and this significantly reduces the vertical force acting on the sheet piles.
(2) Performance Verification of the Relieving Platform
A relieving platform should be verified for performance as a continuous beam for both the direction of quaywall
alignment and the direction perpendicular to the alignment (see Fig. 2.8.7). Loads should not be distributed in
the two directions. When the relieving platform is an L-shaped structure, the upright section should be verified
for performance as a cantilever beam supported at the slab section.
Vertical pile
Coupled piles
wl+wd
:fF
:fF
:fF
:fF
Bending moment
:fF
0
Mo~
~~ ~ oe:::iz:;>" ~
21
AP
&
Tensile force
CD
Performance of relieving platform piles can be verified in accordance with Part II, Chapter 2, 2.4 Pile
Foundations.
@ In principle, relieving platform piles should consist of a combination of coupled piles and vertical piles. The
horizontal external force may be borne by the coupled piles only, and the vertical external force may be borne
by the vertical piles only. It may be assumed that each ofthe coupled piles burdens the horizontal force equally.
@ In the design ofrelieving platform piles, assessment should be made for the most dangerous state of each pile by
varying the surcharge, direction of seismic forces, and sea level within the design condition ranges.
In calculating the axial load resistance of each of the relieving platform piles, it is desirable to assume that in
the ground above the sheet pile active failure surface drawn from the seabed surface, the skin friction does not
contribute as the resistance force ofthe relieving platform piles.
If it is unavoidable that the relieving platform piles are all composed by vertical piles, when distributing the
horizontal force to the vertical piles, normally it is assumed in calculating the resistance force normal to their
axes that there is no soil above the sheet pile active failure surface drawn from the seabed surface.
CD
The examination of the stability of a quaywall with relieving platform as a whole can be made by assuming that
the quaywall with relieving platform is a kind of gravity-type wall.
-765-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ For analyzing the stability of the assumed gravity-type wall structure, refer to 2.2 Gravity-type Quaywalls. In
this case, the passive earth pressure to the front of the sheet pile is considered.
@ A quaywall with relieving platform may be considered as a rectangular shape gravity-type wall defined by a
vertical plane containing the rear face of the relieving platform and a horizontal plane containing the bottom
ends of the front side batter piles of the coupled piles, as shown in Fig. 2.8.8.
W.L.
-766-
Article 52
1 The performance criteria of cellular-bulkhead quaywalls with embedded sections shall be as specified in
the subsequent items:
(1) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the permanent action situations in which the dominant
action is earth pressure:
(a) The risk of losing the stability due to shear deformation of the structural body shall be equal to or
less than the threshold level.
(b) The risk of impairing the integrity ofthe members ofthe cellular-bulkhead quaywalls with embedded
sections shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(2) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the permanent action situation in which the dominant
action is earth pressure and under the variable action situation in which the dominant action is Level 1
earthquake ground motions.
(a) The risk of occurrence of sliding of the structural body or failure due to insufficient bearing capacity
of the foundation shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(b) The risk that the amount of deformation of the top of the cells may exceed the allowable limit of
deformation shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(3) The risk of occurrence of slip failure in the ground shall be equal to or less than the threshold level
under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is self weight.
(4) The following criteria shall be satisfied by the superstructure of cellular-bulkhead quaywalls with
embedded sections under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is earth pressure
and under the variable action situation in which the dominant actions are Level 1 earthquake ground
motions, ship berthing, and traction by ships.
(a) The risk that the axial force acting in a pile may exceed the resistance force based on failure of the
ground shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(b) The risk that the stresses in the piles may exceed the yield stress shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level.
(c) The risk of impairing the integrity of the members shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria ofplacement type cellularbulkhead quaywalls with embedded sections shall be such that the risk of occurrence of overturning under
the variable action situation, in which the dominant action is Level 1 earthquake ground motions, is equal
to or less than the threshold level.
[Commentary]
-767-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Attached Table 39 Setting of Performance Criteria for Structural Stability of the Cells and the Integrity of the Members
of Cellular-bulkhead Quaywall with Embedded Sections and the Design Situations excluding Accidental Situations
Ministerial
Ordinance
u
:g
ll
26
1
1
Public Notice
u
:g
~ ll
2
52
1
1
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
Verification item
Non-
Dominating
dominating
action
value
action
Resistance moment
lb
2a
of earth pressure
Pt=
earthquake-resistance
facilities: pt= 4.0xl0-3)
Variable
"21)
-768-
Ordinance
Public Notice
~<
} }
26
e ~
,!! "
<
52
,!!
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
4b
water pressure,
surcharge
Traction of
ships
Permanent Earth pressure Water pressure, Yielding of
surcharge
Variable
motion
f--
value
action
Verification item
Nondominating
Dominating
action
motion
superstructure pilest)
water pressure,
surcharge
f--
4c
LI earthquake
ground
motion
Berthing and
traction of
ships
Self weigh~
Cross-sectional failure
earth pressure, of superstructure
water pressure,
surcharge
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(a) Performance criteria of placement type cellular-bulkhead quaywalls shall comply with the
performance criteria of the cellular-bulkhead quaywall with embedded sections, excluding the
verification items for deformation of the top of cells, and in addition with Attached Table 41.
Attached Table 41 Setting for the Performance Criteria of Placement Type Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls and the Design
Conditions excluding Accidental Situations
Ministerial
Ordinance
~< l~
26
"1
Public Notice
~< l~
e
.!!
52
"2
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Serviceability
Situation
Variable
Dominating
action
Nondominating
Verification item
action
(!) The following is applicable to the performance verification of quaywalls using a steel cellular-bulkhead structure,
hereinafter referred to as steel cellular-bulkhead quaywalls, and quaywalls having a cellular-bulkhead structure
with embedded sections, hereinafter referred to as the steel cellular-bulkhead quaywalls with embedded sections.
(2) The performance verification method described in this chapter is based on the results of cellular-bulkhead model
tests 78). ~. 80). 81) conducted on a sandy soil ground with an embedded length ratio of 0 to 1.5 and a ratio of
equivalent wall width to wall height of I to 2.5. For the cases where the embedded length ratio is very small, less
than 1/8, the equivalent wall width is very small relative to the wall height, or the quaywall is to be constructed
on a cohesive soil ground or ground improved by the sand compaction piles, etc., further examinations such as
a dynamic analysis taking into consideration nonlinear characteristics of the ground should be made as required
in addition to the examination using the performance verification method described in this section because these
cases involve factors that cannot be fully clarified with the method described here.
(3) Examples ofthe cross-section ofa steel cellular-bulkhead quaywall and an embedded-type steel cellular-bulkhead
quaywall are shown in Fig. 2.9.l(a), (b).
(4) The approach in 2.9.2 Action, and 2.9.4 Performance Verification may be used for simple verification, but it is
necessary to be careful when adopting these approaches.
(5) An example ofthe sequence ofperformance verification ofthe cellular-bulkhead quaywall with embedded sections
is shown in Fig. 2.9.2.
-770-
sz aWJ.
.,,,,,,.
l? L.W.L
1111 1111
-..l_o-===---11111111
-...,,.~~---illll 1 1
.._
1111111r-SQMlplpopllm
11111111
V.f1p0111h1'or&ndor
"" B..W.L
S?
-,...,_,_
LWJ.
'""
-711-
ooil
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
'
*I
------------------------------- -------------------------------------,
Permanent situations :
''
'
''
I
Verification of wall shear deformation, sliding,
'''
bearing
capacity
of
foundation
soils,
and
deformation
of
cell
top
I
I
'
''------------------------------- r-------------------------------------1'
r------------------------------
-------------------V"a~~bI;~ti._;ti;;;ofth;,
*2
,.
------------------
-----------------------4-------------------------J
*3
,------------------ -----------------------1-------------------------,
Accidental situations of
''
'
''
' I
'------------------- -----------------------+-------------------------''
-------------------------------i-------------------------------------,
'
Permanent situations
''
I
'------------------------------- -------------------------------------
'l-------------------------------~-------------------------------------1'
t: The evaluation of the effect of liquefaction is not shown, so this must be separately considered.
2: Analysis of the amount of deformation due to Level 1 earthquake ground motion may be carried out by dynamic analysis when necessary.
For high earthquake-resistance facilities, analysis of the amount of deformation by dynamic analysis is desirable.
*3: For high earthquake-resistance facilities, verification is carried out for Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
Fig. 2.9.2 Example of the Sequence of Performance Verification of the Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls with Embedded
Sections
(6) It is recommended that the filling material in cells is a sufficient density sand or gravel of good quality. It is not
desirable to use a clayey soil as the filling material. When clayey soil is to remain in the cells, it is necessary to
make a separate examination because the deformation of the cells may become significantly large.
(7) When a foundation for a crane, shed, or warehouse is to be built within a cell, it is desirable to use foundation piles
to transmit the load to the bearing stratum.
-772-
(!) For calculating the action to be considered in the perfurmance verification of embedded-type steel cellularbulkhead quaywalls with embedded sections, refur to Part II, Chapter 4, 2 Seismic Action, Part II, Chapter 5,
1 Earth Pressure, Part II, Chapter 5, 2 Water Pressure, and Part II, Chapter 10 Self weight and Surcharges.
(2) The rear of the wall may be subjected to active earth pressure in the examination of shear deformation of the cell
wall body (see Fig. 2.9.3). According to the model tests, it can be understood that the embedded section of the
cell is subjected to the action corresponding to the earth pressure at rest because the deformation of the embedded
section of the cell is small. According to the results of shaking table tests, the earth pressure acting on this part
works as a resisting force against overturning of the wall but acting forces. In the examining the stability of the
entire system, therefore, the earth pressure acting on the rear of the wall is normally active earth pressure above
the seabed surface, and earth pressure that is generated by surcharge such as backfilling under the seabed surface.
The characteristic value of the earth pressure that is generated by surcharge such as backfilling during permanent
situation can normally be calculated using equation (2.9.1) (see Fig. 2.9.4).
(2.9.1)
where
p., : earth pressure acting on the rear of wall below the sea bottom (kN/m2)
k : coefficient of earth pressure, k ~ 0.5 can be adopted
: unit weigbt of each layer of backfilling (kN/m3)
h : thickness of each layer of backfilling (m)
q : surcharge (kN/m2)
Surcharge
R.W.L.
L.W.L.
Wall body
Surcharge
R.W.L.
L.W.L.
Wall body
Seabed surface
Fig. 2.9.4 Earth Pressure Acting on the Rear of Wall Body for Examination of the Stability as Gravity-type Wall
(3) In principle, the residual water level of the backfilling can be taken at the elevation with the height equivalent
to two thirds of the tidal range above the mean monthly-lowest water level, LWL. However, when using a
backfilling with low permeability, the residual water level may become higher than this and thus it is desirable to
determine the residual water level based on results of investigations of similar structures. The residual water level
in the filling material in the cells may be set to the same level as that of the backfilling for the wall body.
(4) Seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification of the steel cellular-bulkhead quaywalls with
embedded sections
The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification of the steel
cellular-bulkhead quaywalls with embedded sections under variable situations associated with Level 1 earthquake
ground motion and the allowable value of the amount of deformation set corresponding to the seismic coefficient
-773-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
fur verification shall be appropriately calculated taking the structural characteristics into consideration. For
the purpose of convenience, the characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification and the allowable
value of the amount of deformation for steel cellular-bulkhead quaywalls with embedded sections may be set to
comply with 2.2 Gravity-type Quaywalls, 2.2.2 (1) Seismic Coefficient for Verification used in Verification
of Damage due to Sliding and Overturning of Wall Body and Insufficient Bearing Capacity of Foundation
Ground in Variable Situations in respect ofLevel 1 earthquake ground motion and (b) Setting of allowable
deformation, Da=lOcm.
However, it is necessary to be aware that the method described in this document does not necessarily evaluate
sufficiently the effect of the embedment of the steel cellular-bulkhead quaywall with embedded sections on the
seismic--resistant performance. For details, refur to Section 2.9.4 (2) @ (f).
(5) For the seabed and above, the seismic coefficient to be used in the calculation of the seismic inertia force that acts
on the filling material shall be the seismic coefficient fur verification. For the part below the sea bottom, this value
is reduced linearly in such a way that it becomes zero at 10 m below the seabed. In principle, the seismic inertia
furce is not considered fur the part deeper than that level, see Fig. 2.9.5.
(!) Equivalent wall width may be used for verifying performance. The equivalent wall width, in this case, shall be the
width of a rectangular virtual wall substituted the combination of cells and arc sections.
The equivalent wall width is the width of a rectangular virtual wall body that is used in place of the wall body
combined with cells and arc sections to simplify design calculations, see Fig. 2.9.6. The virtual wall is defined
in such a way that the area of the horizontal cross section of the virtual wall body becomes the same as that of the
combined cells and arc sections
Fig. 2.9.6 Plan View of Cellular-bulkhead Structure and Equivalent Wall Width B
(2) The equivalent wall width is normally determined to satisfy the analysis of the shear deformation of the wall
structure.
-774-
CD
The cell shell and filling of the cellular-bulkhead quaywall usually act as an integrated structure because the
filling is constrained in the cell shell. Therefore the deformation of the cell wall body may be ignored relative
to its displacement and the overall behavior of the cell wall body may be considered the same as that of a rigid
body. This has been verified by model tests in which the cell wall body did not show significant deformation
under loads much larger than the external forces that are expected to act on the cell wall body both under
permanent situation and variable situation associated with Level I earthquake ground motion. In the case of
normal ground and filling soil, therefore, it can be understood that shear failure does not occur in the filling.
However, when the diameter of the cell is very small or the strength of the filling material is extremely low, it
may not be possible to satisfy the assumption that the cell wall body is a rigid body. Therefore it is necessary
to make examination of the strength of the filling against shear deformation due to the loads under permanent
situation in order to remain the deformation of the cell wall body to a negligible level.
@Normally, it is possible to analyze the shear deformation of the steel cellular-bulkhead quaywalls with equations
(2.9.2) and (2.9.3), using the resistance moment and the deformation moment of the cell bottom surface, and
the resistance moment and the deformation moment of the soil within the cells at the seabed surface. Also,
analysis of the shear deformation of the steel cellular-bulkhead quaywalls can be carried out using equation
(2.9.3). The subscript din the equations indicates the design value. For calculation of the design values, refer to
@ Calculation of deformation moment, Calculation of the resistance moment at the bottom of cell, and
@ Resistance moment of the filling with respect to the seabed, below. An appropriate value of 1.2 or higher
may be used as the structural analysis factor Ya
(2.9.2)
(2.9.3)
where,
M,
Md
M',
M'd
Ya
:
:
:
:
:
(b) In the calculation of deformation moment, earth pressure is considered only in terms of the horizontal
component The vertical component is not taken into consideration. The vertical force of the surcharge is
not taken into consideration in the calculation of deformation moment However, the surcharge is taken into
consideration in the calculation of active earth pressure, see Fig. 2.9.7.
L.W.L.
pressure...::::::==:=:L_____J
Fig. 2.9.7 Loads and Resisting Forces to be taken into consideration in the Examination of Shear Deformation
-775-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
4.0 r::N;;ote-,---::P:::;l-ottec--:d-:v-al;-ue-s-are-m-ean--:1, - - - - - . . , .
I
I
I
~I
s
riS-"l
I
"'
I
~\V'
:-, I
n,\}
// I I:/'
.q; I #'-"
I ~
2
2.0
Case No.
1.o ~ - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - 0 ilioupA.
GroupB
Group C
e GroupD
'"Group E
D
i:>
0.5
1.0
1.5
(2.9.4)
where
M, : resistance moment with respect to cell bottom CkNm!m)
M..o : resistance moment of the filling with respect to cell bottom CkNm/m)
M,, : resistance moment due to the friction force of sheet pile joints, with respect to cell bottom
(kNm/m)
D : embedded length (m)
H : height from wall bottom to wall top (m) (see Fig. 2.9.9)
a : required additional rate against the embedded length ratio (D/H)
For the required additional rate a, it is recommended to use 1.0, which is close to the lowest value found in the
test results shown in Fig. 2.9.8, because the equation given above has been derived based on tests and not fully
clarified theoretically.
-776-
L.W.L.
0
Fig. 2.9.9 Assumed shear surface of filling soil
sa, = :
1-sind
active earth pressure Pa, = Kawdh, Ka= 1 + sinjtSd
_
l+sinjtSd
passive earth pressure PP, -Kpwah, KP= l-sinj6d
(2.9.5)
where
<P
The design values in equation (2.9.5) may be calculated using the equation below.
(2.9.6)
The moment caused by the earth pressure acting on the shear surface may be calculated by using equation
(2.9.7) see Fig. 2.9.9.
(2.9.7)
When the geotechnical constants of the ground and those of the filling differ, equation (2.9.7) becomes
complex as the failure angle and the earth pressure level vary from one soil layer to another. However, when
there is no significant difference in the internal friction angle between the ground and filling, or when the
embedded length ratio is large and the failure surfaces do not reach the filling portion, the following simplified
equation may be used. In the equations below, subscript d stands for the design value.
(2.9.8)
(2.9.9)
where
w0
equivalent unit weight offilling, unit weight of the filling which assumes that the unit weight is
-777-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
w,
h1
(2.9.10)
The design values in the equation may be obtained using the following equation.
(2.9.11)
All the partial factors used in calculating the resistaoce moment of the filling soil may be taken to be 1.0.
(d) Equation for Calculating Resistance moment due to Friction Force of Joints of Sheet Piles
The resistance moment due to friction force ofjoints is calculated as follows. In the equations below, subscript
d stands for the design value.
(2.9.12)
3
2
R,,=-v., f
taofld
(2.9.13)
where
H,
: The equivalent wall height employed to calculate the resistance moment due to the friction
force between the sheet pile joints when the equivalent unit weight of the filling is used. It is
evaluated using equation (2.9.14) so that the resultant force of the distributed earth pressure in
diagram (a) becomes equal to that of (b) in Fig. 2.9.10. In this calculation, 0.5tanfl can be used
'
(2.9.14)
The design value in the equation can be calculated using the following equation:
(2.9.15)
Note that all partial factors used in the equation for calculating resistance moment due to friction force of the
joints can be set at 1.00.
-778-
y1
ILW.L.
""!!!""L.W.L.
H,
-----+----------r,
lyH,tanfl
(a) Earth pressure
distribution diagram
,
Mn1
I
6
, '
= -WodR,,dHod
(2.9.16)
(2.9.17)
where
M,' : resistance moment of sheet pile cell with respect to seabed (kNm/m)
Ho' : equivalent wall height is employed to calculate the resistance moment due to the filling by using
the equivalent unit weight of the filling. It is evaluated by means of equation (2.9.18).
'
w'1
h'1
:
:
(2.9.18)
unit weight of the filling of the i-th layer above sea bottom (kN/m')
thickness of the i-th layer above seabed between seabed and top of quaywall (m)
vo'=B!Ho'
(2.9.19)
Note that all partial factors used in the equation for calculating resisting of the filling with respect to the
seabed can be set at LOO.
@ Increasing the strength of the filling enhances the rigidity of the cell wall. Therefore, improvement work of
filling is effective in increasing the stability of the cell wall.
(2) Calculation of the amount of deformation of wall structures under permanent situations and variable situations
associated with Level I earthquake ground motion may be carried out based on the following items.
CD
General
(a) In the examination of the stability of the wall as a whole, the subgrade reaction generated against the load and
the displacement of the wall are calculated by considering the wall as a rigid body elastically supported by the
ground.
(b) Within the elastic range of the ground, the subgrade reaction force is calculated as the product of the modulus
of subgrade reaction and the displacement. Here it is considered that the stability of the wall as a gravity wall
is obtained when the subgrade reaction force and the displacement of the wall do not exceed the respective
-779-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
allowable limits.
kCH =2N
(2.9.23)
where
kcH :
N
When the ground consists of the strata of different characteristics, the modulus of horizontal subgrade
reaction should be calculated fur each stratum.
k, =Ak.
(2.9.24)
where
-780-
r- --- --r------ -
i\
I
I
I
I
Cell
V
I
I
I
I
Backfilling soil
Cell
embedment
portion
'I
,__,._,_..___ _ __,
L.W.L.
Active
earth
pressure
Residual
water
pressure
Seabed
(Trapezoidal distribution)
~ (Triaogular distribution)
Fig. 2.9.13 Distribution Patterns of External Forces Acting on Steel Sheet Pile Cellular-bulkhead Quaywall
(e) Displacement modes of cell
As shown in Fig. 2.9.14, it is assumed that the cell wall rotates around its center of rotation 0, which is
horizontally away from the center axis of the cell by the distance e and vertically away from the seabed by the
depth h. When the center of rotation is located inside the cell, the horizontal subgrade reaction is generated
in the rear of the wall for the part below the center of rotation.
-781-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
r-
''
'
'
''
'
-----
'
''
'
'
''
'
:tJ,._.,.o
----
r'
'
''
'
'
1------
'
''
--
h
L..- - - - -
' -----------------------v
Cell:
I
I
I
I
Seabed surface
Backfill
e
ith stratum
Horizontal ground reaction
Q 0
Pn2 nth straum
Shearing reaction--------q,
d. -
t11llllIDlfll1
fTTTTIJJ>"
q2
Triangular distribution
lJJY
-782-
Trapezoidal distribution
= kCH, ( h -
di)()
(2.9.25)
n-1
Jo
q1 =ky(e+B!2'y} }
qi =ky(e-B!2'y}
(2.9.26)
iii) Shear reaction force that acts at the wall bottom (kN/m)
Q=ks{h-nYJA.
(2.9.27)
o = (h-z'}o
(2.9.28)
8= MK2 +HK3
K1K4 -K2K3
vi) Depth of the center of wall rotation (m)
(2.9.29)
h= MK2 +HK4
MK1 +HK3
(2.9.30)
vii) Distance from the wall center axis to the center ofrotation ofthe wall (m)
dJ }
{V
n
n
( i-1
e =I- --h'LkCH,d;
tanloil+ LkCH,d; Ld+_!_ tanloil
k,A (}
M
i=l
j-1
2
where
K 1 = LkCH,d; +k,A
1-1
n{ kCH, di
K2 = L
1=1
(H
d.J} + k,AD
L dj + ___.!_
J=I
2
-783-
(2.9.31)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
The angle of wall friction is negative for strata whose horizontal subgrade reaction force acts on the front
of the wall, and positive for strata whose horizontal subgrade reaction force acts on the rear of the wall.
2) When the vertical subgrade reaction acts in a triangular distribution
The horizontal subgrade reaction, horizontal wall displacement, angle of rotation, and depth of the center
of rotation are expressed in the same form as those in!).
i) Vertical subgrade reaction (kN/m2)
q,.
=k.(e+ ~)e
(2.9.32)
Qk =k,(h-D)OA'
(2.9.33)
where
B
A'=e+2
iii) Distance between the wall center axis and the center of rotation of the wall (m)
e=
~ {~ -h~)CH,d,lo,1+ ~)CH,d.(Ldi
+; )1an1a,1}-:
(2.9.34)
where
The angle of wall friction should be negative for strata whose horizontal subgrade reaction acts on the
front of the wall, and positive for strata whose horizontal subgrade reaction acts on the rear of the wall.
The notations used in equations in I) and 2) are as follows:
V : vertical force acting on the wall (kN/m)
H
horizontal force acting on the wall (kN/m)
M : moment acting on the center of the wall at the level of ground surface (kNm/m)
Provided external forces that act on the wall are those for the unit length in the direction along the face
line of wall
d1
B
kcHi
k,,
k,
A
A'
-784-
CD
For the examination of wall stability against sliding, refer to the examination on wall sliding in 2.2 Gravitytype Qnaywalls.
@ Sliding can be examined using equation (2.9.35). Io this equation, y represents the partial factor for its subscript,
and subscripts d and k respectively stand for the design value and the characteristic value.
(2.9.35)
where
@ The vertical components of the earth pressure acting on the front and rear of the wall that should be taken into
consideration include (a) the vertical component of the active earth pressure, (b) the friction force due to the
earth pressure below the ground surface, (c) the vertical component of the passive earth pressure, and (d) the
vertical component of subgrade reaction. The vertical component of earth pressure is considered a positive
force when it acts in the same direction as that of the wall weight.
@ When the internal friction angle of the soil above the wall bottom is diffurent from that below the wall bottom,
it is recommended to use the smaller value as the internal friction angle at the wall bottom.
(5) Verification of Stability against Circular Slip Failure
When the ground is soft, examination of stability against circular slip failure shall be made as necessary. When
the angle of shear resistance of the soil behind the wall and the ground is 30 or larger, the examination of stability
against circular slip failure is often omitted. Io the case of cellular-bulkhead quaywalls, it may be assumed that
the wall is a rigid body and thus the circular slip surface does not go through the inside of the wall.
(6) Layout of Cells
The cells shall be arranged to make the area equal to the area of the wall with the equivalent width obtained in (1)
and (2) above.
(a) Cells should be arranged evenly along the total length of the face line of the quaywall wherever possible. Io
general, it is advisable to set the cell center interval 10 to 15% longer than the cell diameter.
(b) Arcs should be arranged in such a way that they are connected perpendicularly to the wall of cell shell. The
radius of the arc should be made smaller than that of the cell shell.
(c) Io general, front tips of arcs tend to shift forward during and/or after the filling work. Therefore it is advisable
to arrange arcs in such a way that their front surface are located about 100 to 150 cm inside the front face line
of cell walls. It is also advisable to arrange cells in such a way that their front face line is located about 30 cm
-785-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
inside the design face line of the quaywall.
CD
Analysis of the plate thickness of the cell units and the arcs is normally carried out using equation (2.9.38). In
the following equation, y is the partial factor corresponding to its subscript, and the subscripts k and d indicate
the characteristic value and design value respectively.
uy.=Tdlt
(2.9.38)
where,
uy
Also, the tensile force acting on the cell may be calculating using equation (2.9.39).
(2.9.39)
where,
a.,.=ru,u>'' K;.=rx.,Kt.
hw.i =RWL-LWL=yhw
q.=rqqt
wod=rw Wot
0
LWL+~(HWL-LWL)}-LWL
(2.9.40)
where,
RWL : residual water level (m)
LWL : mean monthly lowest water level (m)
HWL : mean monthly highest water level (m)
@ The equivalent wall height H 0 ' can be calculated using equation (2.9.18) in (1) above.
When materials such as gravel with large angle of shear resistance are used for the filling or when no compaction
is performed, the characteristic value of the coefficient of filling earth pressure can be normally set as 0.6.
When the filling is to be compacted, tan,P can be used as the characteristic value of coefficient of filling earth
pressure, because the internal pressure of the cell and the angle of shear resistance of the filling become larger.
The characteristic value of the filling earth pressure coefficient for the arc sections can be taken at l/2tan,P.
In determining the plate thickness of the cells and the arcs of the steel cellular-bulkhead quaywalls with
embedded sections, fabrication, construction, and maintenance aspects must be considered sufficiently. If a
corrosion allowance is considered for the cells and arcs, the corrosion allowance shall be added to the plate
thickness obtained from equation (2.9.38) to give the plate thickness. Equation (2.9.41) has been proposed as
a method of obtaining the plate thickness of the cells necessary for the stresses during driving, from tests on
buckling of cylindrical cells and from construction experience of the past.91)
t
~ 0.032(RND'/ Ef-5
(2.9.41)
where,
Also, the minimum plate thickness of the cell for which there is experience of driving in the past is Smm, so
it is desirable that the minimum plate thickness is about 8mm.
(8) Verification of T-shaped Sheet Piles of the Steel Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls with Embedded Sections
CD Normally, cells and arcs are connected by using T-shaped sheet piles.
special cross section to join the cell to arcs, see Fig. 2.9.16.
The structure of T-shaped sheet pile shall have sufficient safety against the tensile forces acting on the sheet pile
of cells and arcs. The standard structures ofT-shaped sheet pile are shown in Figs. 2.9.17 and 2.9.18.
200
Rivet ;25(SV-400)
Rivet spacing 85mm
60
+----+------f+H-Hi'-'
75
75
75 60
270
~---400----">
(Units;mm)
Fig. 2.9.17 Standard Cross Section of T-shaped Sheet Pile for Rivet Connection with Rivet Intervals
200
200
~--400
(Units;mm)
Fig. 2.9.18 Standard Cross Section ofT-shaped Sheet Pile for Welding Connection
Strength of the cross sections shown in Figs. 2.9.17 and 2.9.18 has been confirmed by a breaking test where the
tensile strength of the joint ofthe sheet pile in a cell is 3,900 kN/m and the arc diameter is 2/3 or less ofthe cell,
tensile strength = 2,600 kN/m. The rivet and welding joints for tests were made in a workshop.
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
known such as plate thickness of cells and plate thickness of arcs. In other words, the system failure probability
based on equilibrium of forces was obtained from the index expressing the risk that the tensile stress in the cell and
arc units will exceed the yield stress, assuming a standard limiting value of P1 =4.0xlO-IS for the cell units and P1
= 3.JxJ0-15 for the arc units. The other partial factors were determined taking the settings of the design methods
of the past into consideration.
Table 2.9.1
1.00
All facilities
a
IX,
-
v
-
y,
1.00
'Yw, 'Yw1
Unitwei~ht
1.00
Ywo
YPa 'IPr
1.00
1.00
1.20
1.26
0.073
0.20
IV.
t;j
~
.a
.s
ta
.ll
"'
YP1 YP2
y,,
.
,g
-"'
=
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.20
7.77
7.6
0.65
1.15
0.805
-0.593
0.60
1.00
1.00
I.OS
--0.012
1.00
o.os
7.8
~
~
7.8
0.65
0.817
-O.S76
1.26
0.073
0.60
0.20
1.00
1.05
--0.023
1.00
0.05
I.IS
1.00
*1: a: Sensitivity factor, /Xk: Deviation of average values, average value I characteristic value, V: Coefficient of variation.
(b) Variable situations of Level 1 earthquake ground motion
y
1.00
1.00
Ykb
y,
1.00
"Yw
YPv
~
~
Yton
Yu
Ya
y"
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
All facilities
a
IX,
-
*1: a: Sensitivity factor, IX,;. Deviation of average values, average value I characteristic value, V: Coefficient of variation.
-788-
Article 52
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria ofplacement type cellularbulkhead quaywalls with embedded sections shall be such that the risk of occurrence of overturning under
the variable action situation, in which the dominant action is Level 1 earthquake ground motions, is equal
to or less than the threshold level.
[Technical Nole]
2.10.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
For the action on placement-type cellular-bulkhead quaywalls, refer to 2.9 Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls with
Embedded Sections. The characteristic value ofseismic coefficient for verification used in the performance verification
of placement-type cellular-bulkhead quaywalls under variable situations associated with Level 1 earthquake ground
motion shall be appropriately calculated taking into consideration the structural characteristics. For the purpose
of convenience, the characteristic value of seismic coefficient for verification of placement-type cellular-bulkhead
quaywalls may be calculated in accordance with 2.2 Gravity-type Quaywall, 2.2.2(1) Seismic Coefficient for
Verification used in Verification of Damage due to Sliding and Overturning of Wall Body and Insufficient
Bearing Capacity of Foundation Ground in Variable Situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion.
-789-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
verification
---------------------------------r-------------------------------------
..
Permanent situations :
''
I Verification of shear deformation and sliding of wall,
''
bearing capacity of foundation soils
'
'
---------------------------------
''
''
'
~-------------------------------------
-------------------------------- r
- -- - -- - -- - -- - -- - -- -
-variaiiie-siiuations of
,.
-------------------- -----------------------1-------------------------l'
3
~--------------------
------------------------ -------------------------
--------------------------------.------------------------------------
Permanent situations
*4
and arcs
wbulkhead quaywalls
---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------t------------------------------------l _ -- - -- - -- - -- - --
Permanent situations :
c--------------------------------!-------------------------------------'
*1: The evaluation of the effect of liquefaction is not shown, so this must be separately considered.
*2: Analysis of the amount of deformation due to Level 1 earthquake ground motion may be carried out by dynamic analysis when necessary.
For high earthquake-resistance facilities, analysis of the amount of deformation by dynamic analysis is desirable.
*3: For high earthquake-resistance facilities, verification is carried out for Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
*4: For steel sheet pile cellular-bulkhead quaywalls, verification is carried out for the connections of flat-type sheet pile.
Fig. 2.10.1 Example of the Sequence of Performance Verification of Placement-type Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls
The width of the wall structure used in performance verification may be the equivalent wall width, which is an
imaginary wall width obtained by replacing the cell and arc parts with a rectangular wall structure. For the converted
wall structure width, refer to 2.9 Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls with Embedded Sections.
-790-
CD
Examination of the shear deformation of the wall body shall be made in accordance with the performance
verification methods described in 2.9 Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls with Embedded Sections. The resistance
moment shall be calculated appropriately in consideration of the structural characteristics of the cellularbulkhead and the deformation of the wall. The deformation moment to be used in the verification shall be the
moment at the sea bottom due to external forces acting on the wall body above the sea bottom, including active
earth pressure and residual water pressure.
@ When the deformation of the wall body is not allowed, i.e. when the horizontal displacement of the cell top is
approximately less than 0.5% of the cell height, the resistance moment against deformation can be calculated
using equations (2.10.1) and (2.10.2).
I
Mrd, =(jWo,Hd,
(2.10.1)
(2.10.2)
where
=rwowok
(2.10.3)
All partial factors used in calculating the cell's resistance moment can be set at LOO.
In the calculation of resistance moment, the equivalent wall height of the cell Hi is calculated by means of
equation (2.10.4). The height Hi is that above the sea bottom.
were
h
(2.10.4)
In the calculation ofthe equivalent wall height HJ, surcharge may be ignored as in the case of resistance moment
calculation discussed in the performance verification of 2.9 Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls with Embedded
Sections. The design values in the equations can be calculated using the following equations. Here, the symbol
yrepresents the partial factor for its subscript, and subscripts k and d respectively stand for the characteristic
value and the design value. Refer to Table 2.10.1 for partial factors to be used for the verification.
Woa =rwowo.1:
wd =rwwk
(2.10.5)
w,a = Yw,wt.1;
Hw" =rHwHw"
@ When the filling material can be regarded as uniform, the height Hd of the quaywall top above the sea bottom
can be used in place of the equivalent wall height HJ of equation (2.10.1).
-791-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) In the calculations to examine the stability of a cell against overturning, the stability of cell shall be examined
against the external forces acting above the wall bottom, including earth pressure, residual water pressure, and
ground motion.
@ For performance verification fur overturning, normally equation (2.10.6) can be used. In the equation, the
subscripts k and d indicate the characteristic and design values respectively. For verification of overturning of
cell structures, the structural analysis factor shall be an appropriate value 1.10 or higher, and all other partial
factors can be 1.00.
(2.10.6)
where,
M,.,, : resistance moment against overturning of steel cell (kNm/m)
Md : deformation moment of cell bottom surface (kNm/m)
@ The resistance moment of cell against overturning can be calculated using equations (2.10.7) and (2.10.8).
I
'3
M,.,,, =6wo,Hd R,,
(2.10.7)
2
+P2)+ 6vdp
(2.10.8)
v,'=v-(a+P)
where
For other symbols, refer to those used in equations (2.10.1) and (2.10.2).
The design values in the equation can be calculated using equations below:
(2.10.9)
@ The equivalent wall height H' used to calculate the resistance moment against overturning can be calculated
using equation (2.10.10).
(2.10.10)
where
H' : equivalent wall height used to calculate the resistance moment against overturning (m)
Hd : distance from the bottom of the cell to the top of the quaywall (m)
Hw : distance from the bottom of the cell to the residual water level (m)
@ In general, the filling of a cell used as a quaywall is not uniform because the major portion of such filling
is under the water and thus subjected to buoyancy. Therefore, the equivalent wall height is used here as in
the calculation of the resistance moment of the cell against deformation. When the filling material can be
considered as uniform, the total wall height of the cell H may be used in the same calculation in place of the
equivalent wall height H' of equation (2.10.7).
Although the actions of the filling against overturning is not uniform,!) since the main part of the filling's
resistance is the hanging effect, the margin of error is minimal and safety is secured even when the ratio of
equivalent wall width to equivalent wall height v is used as in equation (2.10.8). In this case, surcharge can be
ignored.
@ The overturning moment is the moment at the bottom of cell due to the external forces acting above the bottom.
The equivalent wall height of the cell JI' used in the calculation of the resistance moment should be a height
above the cell bottom.
-792-
Q) The maximum subsoil reaction force generated at the front toe of the cell shall be calculated appropriately in
consideration of the effect of the filling material acting on the front wall of the cell.
@ The maximum front toe reaction force on the cell front toe may be obtained from equation (2.10.11).
I
2
2
V.,=-w,H tan ,P,
2
(2.10.11)
where,
v;
wd
tP
maximum front toe reaction force on the cell front toe (kN/m)
unit weight offilling soil (kN/m3)
total wall height of the cell (m)
angle of shearing resistance of filling soil ()
The design values in the equation may be calculated using the following equation. For calculation of the
maximum front toe reaction force on the cell front toe, all partial factors may be taken to be 1.00.
(2.10.12)
Equation (2.10.11) is an equation giving the weight of the filling soil weighing down on the front wall, with
the product of the earth pressure coefficient of the filling soil and the wall surface friction coefficient given by
tan2tfi. Therefore, when the filling is not uniform, it is necessary to carry out the calculation for the same domain
as the earth pressure calculation.
@ The wall height H should normally be considered as the height of the wall top above the wall bottom. However,
when the superstructure of the cell is supported by foundation piles, it may be considered as the height of the
bottom of the superstructure above the wall bottom.
Equation (2.10.11) represents the cell front toe reaction force when the overturning moment is roughly equal
to the overturning resistance moment of equation (2.10.7). Without occurrence of overturning, the reaction
force is smaller than the value obtained from equation (2.10.11). According to a model test, the maximum front
toe reaction force V, is nearly proportional to the overturning moment.92J Therefore reaction force without
occurrence of overturning should be calculated using equation (2.10.12).
V,=V.,(M,/M, 0 , ) (Md/M, 0, )
(2.10.13)
where
v
M
M,.
front toe reaction force of the cell corresponding to overturning moment M (kN/m)
overturning moment (kNm/m)
resistance moment against overturning (kN-m/m)
Hence, use oflarger cell radius makes the cell safer against overturning by increasing the resistance moment
Q) Examination of the plate thickness of the cells and arcs may be carried out in accordance with the examination
ofplate thickness given in the performance verification in 2.9 Performance Verification of Cellular-bulkhead
Qnaywalls with Embedded Sections.
@ From the point of view of cell stiffness and corrosion, a minimum cell shell thickness of 6mm is necessary.
(6) Partial Factors
For standard partial factors for use in verification of the permanent situations and variable situations in respect of
Level I earthquake ground motion, refer to the values in Table 2.10.1. The partial factors in Table 2.10.1 have
been determined considering the setting of design methods of the past.
-793-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 2.10.1
y
Shear deformation
Ytan
YW' Yw;
Unit weight
Ywo
Y
y,
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.20
a
-
IX,
*1: a: Sensitivity factor, IX,;. Deviation of average values, average value I characteristic value, V: Variable factor.
Overturning
Yw
l'P.
l'P
Yk,
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
y,
1.10
'Ytanlli
*1: a: Sensitivity factor, IX,;. Deviation of average values, average value I characteristic value, JI: Variable factor.
For the performance verification of the structural members of placement-type cellular-bulkhead quaywalls, refur to the
performance verification of the structural members in 2.9 Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls with Embedded Sections.
-794-
(!) The following is applicable to upright wave-absorbing type quaywalls, but it may also be applied to the performance
verification of seawalls.
(2) The upright wave-absorbing type quaywall shall be structured so as to have the required capability of wave energy
dissipation and shall be located at strategic positions for enhancing the calmness within the harbor.
(3) Waves within a harbor are the result of superposition of the waves entering the harbor through the breakwater
openings, the transmitted waves over the breakwaters, the wind generated waves within the harbor, and the
reflected waves inside the harbor. By using quaywalls of wave-absorbing type, the reflection coefficient can be
reduced to 0.3 to 0.6 from that of 0.7 to 1.0 of solid quaywalls. To improve the harbor calmness, it is important
to design the alignments of breakwaters in a careful manner. The suppression of reflected waves through the
provision of wave energy absorbing structures within the harbor is also an effective means of improving the
calmness.
(4) Determination of Structural fype
CD
Quaywalls of wave-absorbing block type are constructed by stacking layers ofvarious shape of concrete blocks.
This type is normally used to build relatively small quaywalls. The quaywall width is determined by stability
calculation as a gravity-type quaywall.
@ Upright wave-absorbing caisson type quaywalls include slit-wall caisson type and perforated-wall caisson
type. This type is normally used to build large size quaywalls. The wave-absorbing performance can be
enhanced by optimizing the aperture rate ofthe front slit wall, the water chamber width, and others for the given
wave conditions.
The reflection coefficient is preferably determined by means of a hydraulic model test whenever possible, but
it may also be determined in accordance with Chapter 4, 3.5 Gravity-type Breakwater (Upright Waveabsorbing Block 'fype Breakwaters) and Chapter 4, 3.6 Gravity-type Breakwater (Wave-absorbing
Caisson 'fype Breakwaters).
@ It is recommended that the crown elevation of the wave-absorbing section of a wave-absorbing block type
quaywall is set as high as 0.5 times the significant wave height or more above mean monthly-highest water level,
and that the bottom elevation of the wave-absorbing section is set as deep as 2 times the significant wave height
or more below mean monthly lowest water level.
2.11.2 Performance Verification
(!) An example of the sequence of the performance verification of upright wave-absorbing type quaywalls is shown
in Fig. 2.11.1.
(2) The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification of upright
wave-absorbing type quaywalls for the variable situations associated with Level I earthquake ground motion
shall be appropriately calculated taking the structural characteristics into consideration. For convenience, the
characteristic value of the seismic coefficient of upright wave-absorbing type quaywalls may be calculated in
accordance with that for gravity- type quaywalls shown in 2.2.2(1) Seismic Coefficient for Verification used in
Verification of Damage due to Sliding and Overturning of Wall Body and Insufficient Bearing Capacity of
the Foundation Ground in Variable Situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion.
-795-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
'-
:"""'
r------------------------- -------------------pennanentSih.&tiODS~
''
''
Verification of sliding and overturning of wall, I
'
'''
foundation soils
'
I and bearing capacity of
__________________________________ ,'
''
-------------------------------------------------- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - v~rialil; ;i1.;,;-t1.;.;-;,;y'
*2
I
--------------
----~
'
--- ----
----------------------~-----------------------!
,----------
''
'
''
'
''
----------------------,
Accidental situations of :
Level 2 earthquake '
ground motion :
'
Verification of deformation by dynamic analysis
,.
-------------- ----------------------~-----------------------l'
r------------------------------------------------------------11
1
Permanent situations
'
''
''
I Verification of circular slip failure and settlement I'
'"-------------------------~----------------------------------''
J.
*1: Evaluation of liquefaction, settlement, etc., are not shown, so it is necessary to consider these separately.
*2: When necessary, an examination of the amount of deformation using dynamic analysis can be carried out for Level 1
earthquake ground motion.
For high earthquake-resistance facilities, it is desirable that an examination of the amount of deformation be carried out
using dynamic analysis.
*3: Verification for Level 2 earthquake ground motion is carried out for high earthquake-resistance facilities.
Fig. 2.11.1 Example of the Sequence of Performance Verification of Upright Wave-absorbing Type Quaywalls
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
Miyazaki, S.: Practice of Hydrography implemented in the course of port construction, Notice of Construction Division of
Port and Harbors Bureau, Ministry of Transport, No. 61, 1972
Japan Port Associating: Handbook of design of port construction works, pp. 215, 1959
Matsunaga. Y., K. Oikawa and T. Wako: Structural limit of wharves, Journal of JSCE, Vol. .36 No.8, pp. 26-27, 1951
C. Zimmerman, H. Schwarze, N. Schulz, and S. Henkel: International Conference on Coastal and Port Engineering in
Developing Countries, 25/29 September, Rj, Brazil, pp.2437-2451, 1995
Matsunaga. Y., K. Oikawa and T. Wako: Deformation of foundation ground of gravity type port facilities due to HanshlnAwaji Large Disaster, Proceedings of Academic Papers on Hanshin-Awaji Large Disaster, pp.383-390,1996
Nakahara. T., Kohama. E. and Sugano, T.: Model shake table test on the seismic performance of gravity type quaywall with
-796-
8)
Morishita, T., G. Kimura, K. Shiramizu and H. Tanaka: Discussion on behavior of caisson type wharves with sloping bottom
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
armored embankment on man-made islands during earthquakes, Soil sand Foundations, Japanese Geotechnical Society,
Vol.41-6, 2001
23) Takahashi, T., H. Sai and K. UkaiProposal of safi:ty examination method against liquefaction of dikes by Finite Element
25) Sugano, T. : U-Japan Symposium on earth quake resistance of port and City function- Prototype experiment at Tojkachi PortDisaster Prevention, No.190, pp3-5, 2003
26) Kotsutsumi, 0., S. Shiozaki, K. Kazui, S. Iai and H. Mori : Examination of the improvement in the presiceness of the analysis
of2-Dimensional effective stress preciseness improvement
27) IA!, S., Koji ICHII and Toshikazu MORITA: Mechanism of Damage to Port Facilities during 1995 Hyogo-Keo Nanbu
Earthquake (Part ?)Effective Stress Analysis on a Caisson Type Quay Wall, Technical Note of PHRI No.813,1995
28) Ishihara, K., Yasuda, S. and Nagase, H.: Soil characteristics and ground damage, Special Issue of Soils and Fouodations,
Japanese Geotecholcal Society, pp.109-118, 1996
29) Toshikazu MORITA, T., Susumu !AI, Hanloog LIU, Koji !CHI and Yukihiro SATO: Simplified Method to Determine
Parameter of FLIP, Techoical Note of PHRI No.869, 1997
30) Handbook of Couotermeasure against Liquefaction of Reclaimed Land (Revised Edition), CDIT, 1997.
31) FLIP Study Group: Summary of the resuhs of sensitivity analysis of various FLIP parameters for damaged cross section of
RF3 wharf at Rokko Island, 1999
32) FLIP Study Group: Lecture note of FLIP utilization method, 2004
33) Kazui, Y.: Utilization of FEM in designing and orientation, Soil aod Fouodation, VoL53 No.8 Ser. No.571, pp.10-12,2005
34) Kazui, K., H. Takahashi, T. Nakamoto and Y. Akakura: Evaluation of allowable damage deformation of gravity type wharf
during earthquake, Proceedings of 10th Symposium of Japanese earthquake Engineering, K-4,1998
35) Koji Ichii, Susumu Iai, Yukihiro Sato and Hanlong Liu: Seismic performance evaluation charts for gravity type quaywalls,
Structural Eng./Earthquake Eng., JSCE, Vol.19,No.l, 21s-31s, 2002
36) KASUGAI, Y., Kenichlro MINAMI and Hiroyuki TANAKA: The Predictioo of the Lateral Flow of Port and Harbour
Structures, Technical Note of PHRI No.726, 1992
37) Ishii, Y. (Translation): Tschbotarioff's Soil Mechanics (Vol. I), Gilio-do Publishing, p.308,1964
-797-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
38) P.W. Rowe: Anchored sheet pile walls, Proc. OfL.C.E., Vol.I Pt.I, 1955
39) Arai, H., S. Yokoi and T. Furube: Study on earthquake-resistance perfurmance of sheet pile walls Second Report, Proceedings
of 2nd annual conference of PHRI, p.73, 1964
40) Arai, H. and S. Yokoi: Study on earthquake-resistance performance of sheet pile walls Third Report, Proceedings of 3rd
annual conference of PHRI, p.100, 1965
41) Sawada, G.: Calculation metbod of passive earth pressure of embedded portion of sbeet piles in tbe sloped ground, Technical
Note of PHRI, No. 9, 1964
42) Nagao, T., N. Iwata, K. Fujimura, M. Morishita, H. Satou and R. Ozaki: Seismic coeffiects of caisson type and sheet pile type
quay wall against tbe level-one earthquake ground motion, Technical Note of National Institute fur Land and Infrastructure
Management No.310, 2006
43) Nagao, T. and R. Ozaki: Study on perfurmance specification of sbeet pile wbarfwitb vertical pile anchorage against Levelone earthquake motion, Proceedings of Earthquake Engineering, JSCE, 2005
44) Ishii, Y. (Translation): Tschbotarioff's Soil Mechanics (Vol. II), Giho-do Publishing, p.192, 1%4
45) Suzuk~ M: Port Engineering, Kazama Shoten Publishing, p.474,1955
46) R.W. Rowel: A tbeoretical and experimental analysis of sheet-pile walls, Proc.of L.C.E., Vol.4. Pt.I, 1955
47) lshiguro, K., M. Shiraishi and H. Umiwa: Steel pile method Vol. 1, Sanka-do Publishing, p,95,1982
48) Takahashi, K., Y. Kikuchi and K. Ishiguro:Aualysis of dynamic behavior of Tie-rod type sheet pile wall, Proceedings of
Structural Engineering, JSCE, Vol.42A, P.1195, 1996
49) Takahashi, K., Y. Kikuchi and Y. Asaki Analysis of Flexural Behavior of Anchored Sbeet Pile Walls, Technical Note of PHRI
No,756,1993
50) Takahashi, K. and K. Ishiguro: Resolution of piles and sheet piles as vertical beam under transverse loads, Sankaido
Publishing, pp.177-183, 1992
51) Terzaghi: Evaluation of coefficients of subgrade Reaction, Geotechnique, Vol.5, pp.297-326, 1955
52) Tschbotarioff: Large scale earth pressure tests witb model flexible bulkbeads, Princeton Univ., 1949
53) Terzaghi and Peck (Translated by Hoshi): Soil Mechanics (Application), Maruzen Publishing, p.192,1970
54) KUBO, K., Fujio SAIGUSA and Atsurni SUZUKI: Lateral Resistance of Vertical Anchor Piles, Rcpt. of PHRI Vol.4 No.2,
1965
55) National Association of Disaster Prevention: Design manual for disaster restoration works, 2005
56) Japan Road Association: Guideline for construction of temporary structures for earth works for roads, pp.107-109,1999
57) AKATSUKA, Y. and Kuniichi ASAOKA: Experimental Studies on High Strengtb Tie Rod, Rep!. of PHRI Vol. 7 No.
3,pp.135-167, 1968
58) Nagao, t., R. Shibazaki and R. Ozaki: Ordinary Level-one reliability design method of port facilities based on minimum
expected total cost considering economic losses, Proceedings of Structural Engineering, JSCE, Vol. SIA, pp. 389-400, 2005
59) Ozaki, R. and T. Nagao: Analysis of behavior of sbeet pile wharves during earthquake utilizing tbe location of coupled-pile
anchorage as a parameter, Proceedings of 60th Annual Conference of JSCE, 2005
60) Katayama, T., T. Nakano, T. Hasurni and K. Yamaguchi: Analysis of tbe Damage to Harbour Structures by tbe 1968
TOKACHI-OKI Eartbquake, Technical Note of PHRI No,93,pp.89-98,p.136,1969
61) Port and Harbour Bureau, First Port Construction Bureau and PHRI Ministry of Transport: Report of Damages of Ports due
to Niigata Earthquake Part I, .101,1964
62) MITSUHASHI, !.: Inferring tbe value oftbe 2-dimensional k-value, Technical Note of PHRI No.219, 1975
63) Kotsutsurni, 0., S. Shiosak~ K. Kazu~ S. Iai and H. Mori : Examination of prescisinn improvement of2-dimensional effuctive
stress analysis, Proceedings of Offshore Development, JSCE, Vol. 20,pp.443-448, 2004
64) Iai, S., M. Tatsuta, 0. Kotsutsurn~ Y. Tame, Y. Yamamoto and H. Mori: Analytical examination of effuct of initial stress
conditions of ground on tbe behavior of sheet pile wbarf during earthquake, Proceedings of26tb Conference on Eartbquake
Engineering, pp.809-812,2001
65) Okada, T., S. Miwa, K. lshikura, S. Hiraoka, E. Matsuda and N. Yoshida: Verification of modeling method of initial stress
state for effective stress analysis based on the examples of the damages of steel sheet pile wharves, Proceedings of 26th
Conference on Earthquake Engineering, pp.813-816, 2001
66) Miwa, S., 0. Kotsutsurn~ T. Ikeda, T. Okada and S. Iai: Evaluation of earthquake damage of steel sheet pile wharves based
on stress analysis considering initial stress states, Proceeding of Structural Engineering, Vol. 49A, pp. 369-380, 2003
67) Shiozaki, S., T. Sugano andE. Kohama: Experiment and analysis on earthquake resistance of sheet pile wharves, Proceedings
of Offshore Development, JSCE, pp.131-136, 2004
68) Japan Port Association: Guideline for construction of steel sheet piles, 1963
69) lshiguro, K., N. Shiraishi and H. Umiwa: Steel Sbeet pile method (Vol. 1). Sanakai-do Publishing, pp,297-328,1982
70) Ooshima, M. M. Sugiyama: Design method of sheet pile walls with batter pile anchorage, Soil and Foundation, Vol. 13, No.
3, pp. 11-18, 1%5
71) Ishiwata, T., K. Ishiguro and Y. Higuchi: Sheet pile walls with batter pile anchorage and measurement of their behavior,
Technical Report of Fuji Steel Corporation, Vol. 13 No. 4, pp. 73-87, 1964
72) Sawaguc~ M.: Lateral Behavior of a Double Sheet Pile Wall Structure, Soils and Foundations, Vol.14 No.I, pp.45-59,1974
73) OHORI, K., Yoshihiro SHOil, Kunio TAKAHASHI, Hiroshi UEDA, Michihiko HARA, Yutaka KAWAI and Keisuke
SHIOTA: Static Behavior of Double Sbeet Pile Wall Structure, Rcpt. of PHRI Vol.23 No.1,pp.103-151, 1984
-798-
-799-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
3 Mooring Buoys
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Mooring Buoys
Article27
1 The performance requirements for mooring buoys shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism shall be
satisfied to enable the safe mooring of ships.
(2) Damage due to variable waves, water flows, traction by ships, or other damage shall not impair the
function of mooring buoys nor affect their continued use.
2 In addition to the provisions ofthe preceding paragraph, the performance requirement of mooring buoys in
the place where there is a risk of having a serious impact on human lives, property, and/or socioeconomic
activity by the damage to the mooring buoys concerned shall be such that the structural stability of the
mooring buoy is not seriously affected even in cases when the function of the mooring buoys concerned is
impaired by tsunamis, accidental waves, and/or other actions.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Mooring Buoys
Article 53
1 The performance criteria of mooring buoys shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The buoy shall have the necessary freeboard in consideration of the usage conditions.
(2) The buoy shall have the dimensions required for containment of the swinging area of moored ships
within the allowable dimensions.
(3) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the variable action situation in which the dominant
actions are variable waves, water flow, and traction by ships.
(a) The risk of impairing the integrity of the anchoring chains, ground chains, and/or sinker chains of
the floating body shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(b) The risk of losing the stability of the buoy due to tractive forces acting in mooring anchors shall be
equal to or less than the threshold level.
2 In addition to the requirements of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of the mooring
buoys for which there is a risk of serious impact on human lives, property, or socioeconomic activity
by the damage to the facilities concerned shall be such that the degree of damage under the accidental
action situation, in which the dominant action is tsunamis or accidental waves, is equal to or less than the
threshold level.
-800-
[Commentary]
(1) Performance criteria of mooring buoys
..,
Public Notice
..,
e~< 5
"'
e~< 5
27
53
"
1
"
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Jl
Situation
3a Serviceability Variable
Variable
dominating
action
Self weight,
waves
water
~water flow)
pressure,
water flow
traction by
ships)
2b
Verification item
Non-
Dominating
action
Yield of chains of
Design yield stress
floating bodies, ground
chains, or sinker chains
Stability of mooring
Resistance force of mooring
anchors, etc. (horizontal,
anchors, etc.
vertical)
(a) The setting for performance criteria of mooring buoys of facilities against accidental incident and the
design situations (only accidental situations) shall be in accordance with Attached Table 43.
Attached Table 43 Setting for Performance Criteria of Mooring Buoys of Facilities against Accidental Incident and
Design Situations only limited to Accidental Situations
Ministerial
Ordinance
~<
27
..,
} J
u
e
Jl ~
<
Design situation
Public Notice
53
e
Jl
-
Performance
requirements
Safety
Situation
Nondominating
Dominating
action
Accidental Tsunami
Waves of
Verification item
action
Self weight,
Stability of mooring
-801-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
[Technical Note]
(2) Mooring buoys are structurally categorized into three types; sinker type, anchor chain type, and sinker and anchor
chain type. The sinker type mooring buoy comprises a floating body, anchoring chain of floating body, and sinker.
It does not have a mooring anchor, as shown in Fig. 3.1.1 (a). The anchor chain type mooring buoy comprises a
floating body, anchor chain, and mooring anchor. It does not have a sinker, as shown in Fig. 3.1.l(b). Although
the construction cost of this type is lower than the other types, it is not suitable for cases where the area of the
mooring basin is limited, because the radius of ship's swinging motion is large. The sinker and anchor chain type
mooring buoy comprises a floating body, anchoring chain, ground chain, mooring anchor, and sinker, as shown
in Fig. 3.1.l(c). The sinker and anchor chain type mooring buoys are being used widely in ports and harbors.
This type of buoy could be used even when the area of the mooring basin is limited, because the radius of ship's
swinging motion could be reduced by increasing the weight of the sinker.
Floating body
Floating body
Floating body
Anchoring chain
of floating body
Anchor chain
Ground chain
Mooring
anchor
Anchoring chain
of floating body
Sinker chain
Evaluation of actions
.-Performance verification
~---------------------------
-----------------------------------
,.
''
'
''
I
-------------------------- -----------------------------------'
----------------------------------Variable states in respect of actions of ships :
''
'
''
'
''
I Verification of stability of floating body I'
'
'---------------------------~----------------------------------'
Verification of stresses in mooring system :
~--------------------------
..
-802-
L----.
,,,
Lift
chain---,~,~
1
'
G----;~----,-'-/-~~N
EF
B; Anchor shackle
C; Swivel piece
D; Joining shackle
E; Mooring piece
F;Longring
G; Joining shackle
H; Anchor shackle
I; Joining shackle
J; Anchor shackle
K;Chain
M; Sinker chain
N;Chainorgroundchain
O; Sinker
P; Anchor or screw
Q;Buoy
3.2 Actions
(1) In principle, the tractive force acting on a mooring buoy can be calculated considering structural characteristics
of the mooring buoy in accordance with the provisions in Part II, Chapter 8, 2.4 Actions due to Traction by
Ships. When setting the tractive force, consideration should be given to the effects of winds, tidal currents and
waves. However, it should be noted that these are dynamic loads, and thus there are many uncertainties on their
relationships with the tractive forces of ships.
(2) It is preferable that the tractive force acting on a mooring buoy be determined considering the actions that exert
upon moored ships such as winds, tidal currents, and waves and referring the existing tractive force data on the
buoys of the similar type.
(3) When the motions of buoy due to wave actions are not negligible, their effect of motions needs to be considered in
the calculation of the wave force and the resistance force.
(4) In a dynamic analysis of a floating body, the response characteristics of the floating body vary widely depending
on the wave period. Therefore, if the analysis is made based on monochromatic waves only, the results would be
either underestimated or overestimated. When performing a dynamic analysis of the motions of a floating body,
therefore, it is preferable to employ random waves with spectral characteristics.
(5) Table 3.2.1 shows examples of design conditions and tractive forces on mooring buoys.
-803-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 3.2.1 Examples of Design Conditions for Mooring Buoys
Design ship
DWT(t)
Mooring
1,000
3,000
15,000
20,000
130,000
260,000
30,000
100,000
Single buoy
method
Dual buoy
6-points
Wind velocity
(mis)
Tidal current
(mis)
Wave height
Tractive force
(m)
(kN)
50
50
15
20
60
25
15
20
0.5
0.5
0.51
1.0
0.67
0.51
-
2.0
4.0
0.7
10.0
3.0
1.5
185
409
245
589
1,370
1,840
1,490
1,470
CD
The sizes and required strengths of each part of a mooring buoy, including the mooring anchor, sinker, sinker
chain, ground chain, main chain, and floating body need to be determined appropriately in accordance with
the relevant provisions in 6 Floating Piers and in consideration of the tractive forces of ships, the structure of
mooring buoy, and the mooring method.
@ Normally three mooring anchors are attached to a mooring buoy. In verifying the performance of a mooring
buoy, however, it can generally be assumed that only one of the three anchors resists the horizontal force. It is
preferable for the mooring anchors to be designed in such a way that the buoy will not capsize even when one of
the anchor chains is broken down.
@ It should be assumed that the horizontal force acting on the mooring buoy is resisted only by the mooring
anchors' resistance. 6 Floating Piers may be referred to in calculating the holding power of the mooring
anchors.
(2) Sinker and Sinker Chain
CD Normally a sinker chain of3 to 4 min length is used for a mooring buoy.
@ The vertical and horizontal forces acting on the sinker can be calculated based on the chain tension of floating
body and the distance of horizontal movement of the floating body as calculated in accordance with (4)
Anchoring Chain of Floating Body using equation (3.3.1) below.s) In the following equations, symbol y shall
represent the partial factor for its suffix and suffixes k and d shall respectively represent characteristic values
and design values.
(3.3.1)
where
Py,PH : vertical and horizontal forces acting on the sinker, respectively (kN)
11,
TA
Tc
w
angle that main chain makes with the horizontal plane at the sinker attachment point ()
tension of main chain at the sinker attachment point (kN)
tension of main chain at the floating body attachment point (kN)
weight of the main chain per unit length in water (kN/m)
length of main chain (m)
The design values in the equation can be calculated using the following equation. The partial factor can be set
at 1.0.
Ted =rTcTc"
111 may be obtained by solving the following equations.
-804-
(3.3.2)
where
(3.3.3)
@ The weight of a sinker most commonly used for 5,000 GT ships and 10,000 GT ships are about 50kN and 80kN,
respectively. The sinker weight can be determined using these values as references. The values mentioned
above indicate the weight in water. Sinkers may be of any shape and material as long as they satisfy the weight
requirement, but in Japan disk-shaped cast iron sinkers are used commonly and concrete is seldom used. It is
said that disk-shaped cast iron sinkers with a slightly concaved bottom surface improves the adhesion of the
sinker to the soft sea bottom ground significantly.
@ The role of the sinker is to absorb the impact force acting on the chain and to make the main chain shorter.
When the main chain is to be shortened to reduce the distance of ship movement, therefore, the weight of the
sinker must be increased accordingly.
CD
The angle that the chain makes with the sea bottom at the mooring anchor attachment point is desirably smaller
than 3' because the holding power of the mooring anchor decreases sharply as the angle increases beyond 3' In
many cases, the weight of the ground chain is determined in such a way that the ground chain satisfies the above
mentioned condition when the tractive force acts on the buoy. When the tractive force is large, the attachment
angle that the mooring anchor makes with the ground chain may be made smaller using a ground chain longer
than the above-mentioned value. The inclination angle 111 of the ground chain at the mooring anchor attachment
point can be calculated by equation (6.4.8) described in 6.4. Performance Verification. The symbols in
equation (6.4.8) are redefined as follows (see Fig. 3.3.1):
l : length of the ground chain(, in Fig. 3.3.1) (m)
h : vertical distance between the upper end of the ground chain and the sea bottom, in other words
the sum of the length of the sinker chain, height of the sinker, and allowance (hg in Fig. 3.3.1)
(m)
PH : horizontal component of the tractive force acting on the floating body (kN)
3 or less.
@ The maximum tension T, of the ground chain can be calculated using equation (6.4.5) described in 6.4
Performance Verification. Here PH represents the horizontal component of the tractive force of ship acting on
the buoy, and 82 represents the inclination angle of the ground chain at the upper end of the chain.
@ The tensile yield strength of chain can be set based on 6 Floating Piers. In the case of mooring buoys, however,
the diameter of chain is usually determined not only on the basis of strength, but on the basis of comprehensive
analysis that elaborating such measures to reduce forces acting on the chain as the use of a heavier chain to
absorb the energy of impact forces, and as known from equation (6.4.8) in 6.4 Performance Verification the
use of a shorter chain to reduce the radius of the vessel's swinging motion. In general, the chain diameter is
designed in such a way that the maximum tension to be exerted upon the chain is equal to 1/5 to 1/8 of the
maximum strength.
-805-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Fig. 3.3.1 Notation for Sinker and Anchor Chain Type Mooring Buoy
CD
It is preferable to determine the length 1 ofthe anchoring chain of floating body in such a way to lessen the
tension acting on both the anchoring chain of floating body and the mooring hawser as well as to reduce the
radius of the ship's swinging motion. The ratio ofthe anchoring chain length to the water depth may affect the
degree of abrasion of the anchoring chain, but their relationship has not been clarified yet.
@ It is preferable that the tension acting on the main chain and the displacement of the floating body be derived by
means of a simulation analysis, but the results under similar conditions in the past may also be used to determine
the tension and displacement. Or these may be calculated using the method described below.
@ The weight of the main chain per unit length in water w1 (kN/m) can be calculated using equation (6.4.8)
@ It is preferable to calculate the tension of the anchoring chain at the upper end using equation (6.4.8)
described in 6.4 Performance Verification. Here the horizontal component of the tractive force can
be used as the horizontal external force. The angle 02 that the floating body chain makes with the
horizontal plane at the floating body attachment point can be calculated by equation (6.4.8) described
in 6.4 Performance Verification with the previously calculated weight of the anchoring chain per unit
length in water. In general, This tension is used to verify the stress on the anchoring chain.
-806-
@ The horizontal displacement AK of the floating body can be calculated by means of equation (6.4.9) described
in 6.4 Performance Verification. Here (Ji' and Oz' of the equation are defined below.
81 : angle that the anchoring chain makes with the horizontal plane at its lower end
(81' in Fig. 3.3.1) (")
82 : angle that the anchoring chain makes with the horizontal plane at its upper end
(8,' in Fig. 3.3.1) (0 )
The resultant value of displacement should be examined in comparison with the area of the mooring basin.
If it is found too large, the anchoring chain need to be shortened, the weight of the sinker need to be increased,
or the unit length weight of the anchoring chain need to be increased.
(5) Floating Body
In variable situations in respect of the action of ships, the floating body should be designed in such a way that it
does not submerge. Even when no ship is moored, the floating body should be afloat with a freeboard equal to 112
to 1/3 of its height. It must be afloat the water surface under the condition that the anchoring chain, and in some
cases part of the ground chain and sinker chain, are suspended beneath it. It is preferable to set the buoyancy to
meet these two requirements. The floating body buoyancy required to meet the first requirement can be calculated
by equation (3.3.4).
F=V.
p
(3.3.4)
where
References
I)
2)
3)
4)
5)
Yoneda, K.: Wind tunnel experiment on drifting motion of buoy moored ship, Proceedings of 28th Conference of Japao
Institute of Navigation, (mooring buoy- process for standardization- reference), 1962
SUZUKI, Y.: Study on the Design of Single Point Buoy Mooring, Technical Note of PHRI No.829, 1996
HIRAISHI, Y. and Yasuhiro TOMITA: Model Test on Countermeasure to Impulsive Tension of Mooring Buoy, Technical
Note of PHRI No.816, p.18,1995
JSCE Edition: Commentary of guideline for design of offshore structure (Draft), 1973
Dep. Of the Navy Bureau of Yards & Docks: Mooring Guide, Vol.I, p.61, 1954
-807-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
4 Mooring Piles
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Mooring Piles
Article28
The performance requirements for mooring piles shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(I) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism shall be
satisfied so as to enable the safe mooring of ships.
(2) The damage due to berthing, traction by ships, and/or other actions shall not impair the function of the
mooring piles nor affect their continued use.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Mooring Piles
Article 54
The performance criteria of mooring piles shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The mooring piles shall have the dimensions required for the usage conditions.
(2) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the variable action situation in which the dominant action
is ship berthing or traction by ships:
(a) In the case of mooring piles having a superstructure, the risk of impairing the integrity of the
superstructure members shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(b) The risk that the axial forces acting on the piles may exceed the resistance capacity due to failure of
the ground shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(c) The risk that the stress in the piles may exceed the yield stress shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Mooring Piles
Public notice
e~< 5
"'
e~< 5
54
..,
28
"
1
..,
"
1
Jl
Design situation
Performance
requirement
Situation
Dominating
action
Nondominating
Verification item
action
2b
Yielding of pile
2c
-809-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
5 Piled Piers
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Piled Piers
Article29
1 The performance requirements for piled piers shall be as specified in the subsequent items in consideration
of the structure types:
(1) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism shall be
satisfied so as to enable the safe and smooth berthing of ships, embarkation and disembarkation of
people, and handling of cargo.
(2) Damage to the piled pier due to self weight, earth pressure, Level 1 earthquake ground motions,
berthing and traction by ships, imposed load and/or other actions shall not impair the functions of the
pier concerned and not adversely affect its continued use.
2 In addition to the provisions of the previous paragraph, the performance requirements for piled piers
which are classified as high earthquake-resistance facilities shall be such that the damage due to Level
2 earthquake ground motions and other actions do not affect the restoration of the functions required of
the piers concerned in the aftermath of the occurrence of Level 2 earthquake ground motions. Provided,
however, that as for the performance requirements for the piled pier which requires further improvement
in earthquake-resistant performance due to environmental conditions, social or other conditions to which
the pier concerned is subjected, the damage due to said actions shall not adversely affect the restoration
through minor repair works of the functions of the pier concerned and its continued use.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Piled Piers
Article 55
1 The provisions of Article 48 shall be applied to the performance criteria of piled piers with modification
as necessary.
2 In addition to the requirements of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of piled piers shall be
as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The access bridge of a piled pier shall satisfy the following criteria.
(a) It shall have the dimensions required for enablingthe safe and smooth loading, unloading, embarkation
and disembarkation, and others in consideration of the usage conditions.
(b)It shall not transmit the horizontal loads to the superstructure of the piled pier, and it shall not fall
down even when the piled pier and the earth-retaining part are displaced owing to the actions of
earthquakes or similar one.
(2) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the variable action situation in which the dominant
actions are Level 1 earthquake ground motions, ship berthing and traction by ships, and imposed load:
(a) The risk ofimpairing the integrity of the members of the superstructure shall be equal to or less than
the threshold level.
(b) The risk that the axial forces acting in the piles may exceed the resistance capacity owing to failure
of the ground shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(c) The risk that the stress in the piles may exceed the yield stress shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level.
(3) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the variable action situation in which the dominant action
is variable waves:
(a) The risk oflosing the stability of the access bridge due to uplift acting on the access bridge shall be
equal to or less than the threshold level.
(b) The risk ofimpairing the integrity of the members of the superstructure shall be equal to or less than
the threshold level.
(c) The risk that the axial forces acting in piles may exceed the resistance capacity owing to failure of
-810-
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Piled Piers
~< l~
29
"
2
,!!
2
Public Notice
1
~< ~
55
"
I
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation Dominating
action
Restorability
and
Serviceability
Variable
,!!
Nondominating
action
L2
Self weigh~
earthquake surcharges
ground
motion
Verification item
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
transport of main cargo)) of open-type wharves on vertical piles shall satisfy the performance criteria
of high earthquake-resistance facilities (designated (for transport of emergency goods)).
4) High earthquake-resistance facilities (standard (for transport of emergency goods)) (restorability)
Setting of the performance criteria for the piled piers of high earthquake-resistance facilities
(standard (emergency supply transport)) of open-type wharves on vertical piles and the design
conditions only limited to accidental situation shall comply with setting of the performance
criteria of high earthquake-resistance facilities (designated (emergency supply transport)) and
the design conditions, except for only the verification items for full plasticity of piles.
Full plasticity of piles
The verification of full plasticity of piles is such that full plasticity does not occur at more than
two points on a pile among the piles comprising the piled pier. The state of reaching the full
plasticity means that the flexural moment acting on a pile reaches the moment to cause fully
plastic state.
(b) Open-type wharves with a coupled raking piles
The performance criteria of piled piers of high earthquake-resistance facilities of open-type wharves
with coupled raking piles shall apply the performance requirements of high earthquake-resistance
facilities of open-type wharves on vertical piles. The performance criteria of raking piles of opentype wharves with coupled raking piles shall apply the performance criteria of piles in open-type
wharves on vertical piles.
(c) Structures with stiffening members
The performance criteria of piled piers of high earthquake-resistance facilities of structures with
stiffening members shall apply the performance criteria of high earthquake-resistance facilities of
open-type wharves on vertical piles.
-812-
Attached Table 46 Setting of Performance Criteria of Superstructure of Piled Piers and Design Situations (excluding
accidental situations)
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
~<
} }
29
,!!
~<
55
,!!
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
Dominating
action
traction by
ships
Nondominating
action
Self weight,
surcharges
Verification item
Serviceability of
2b
Self weight,
Surcharges
(including
surcharges
during cargo
handling)
Repeatedly
Self weight
applied
Fatigue failure of
superstructure
state)
surcharges
~
Jb
-813-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Attached Table 47 Setting of Performance Criteria of Piles of Piled Piers and Design Situations {excluding accidental
situations)
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
~<
} }
29
,!!
~<
55
,!!
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
Dominating
action
Nondominating
action
Self weight,
surcharges
traction by
ships
Verification
item
Axial forces
in piles
(pushing, pulling)
Yielding of
piles
during cargo
handling)
~
2c
Berthing and
traction by
ships
Self weight,
wind acting
oncargo
handling
equipment and
ships
Self weight,
surcharges
Surcharges
(including
surcharges
during cargo
handling)
Self weight,
wind acting on
car~ohand~
equipment
ships
3c
The setting of the performance criteria of access bridges of open-type wharves on vertical
piles and the design conditions excluding accidental situations shall be as shown in Attached
Table 48.
-814-
];!
"'e-
Jl
29
:g
~ Jl
2
Design situation
Public Notice
55
"'e-
Performance
1 "'
2
requirements
3a Serviceability
Situation
Dominating
action
Nondominating
action
Verification item
t:
<
} }
29
-1l
e -1l
.!! t:
<
2
Design situation
Public Notice
55
Performance
e
.!!
requirements
Serviceability
Situation
Variable
Dominating action
Berthing and traction
by ships
Non-dominating
action
Self weight,
surcharges
(Self weight,
(Ll earthquake ground surcharges)
motion) (Surcharges
(Self weight,
Verification item
Self weight
Variable waves
Self weight
limit value
Yielding of
Design yield stress
stiffening members Design shear force
Failure of
resistance
connections at
~oints
Index of standard
-815-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-816-
[Technical Note]
........
*1
-Layout of mooring posts,
fenders
Evaluation of actions including setting
-Assumptions regarding
seismic coefficient for verification
seabed soils
Perfiormance verification
r--1
-------------------------- -------------------------------------I
~
..
r---
I
I
...
-------------------------- ------------------------------------*2
------------- ------------------------1------------------------~
-------------------------------------- -------------------------------------
Permanent states :
I
I
I
I
-------------------------- -------------------------------------
I
I
...
*1: Evaluation of the effect ofliquefaction and settlement is not shown on the diagram, so it is necessary to separately into consider.
2: Verification shall be carried out for high earthquake-resistance facilities against the Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
-817-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(1) The following refers to open-type wharves on vertical piles using steel pipe piles or steel sections, but it may also
be applied to similar facilities provided that their dynamic characteristics are taken into account.
(2) For the procedure of performance verification of open-type wharves on vertical piles, it is possible to refer to Fig.
5.1.1 of 5.1 Common Items for Piled Piers. However, evaluation ofthe effect ofliquefaction is not shown in Fig.
5.1.1, so it is necessary to appropriately investigate the potential for liquefaction and measures against it, (refer to
Part II, Chapter 6 Ground Liquefaction).
(3) In the performance verification of open-type wharves on vertical piles, normally the cross-section is set with
respect to actions other than that of Level 2 earthquake ground motion, while the seismic performance is verified
with respect to Level 2 earthquake ground motion. This is because for verification ofvariable situation in respect
ofthe action of ships and Level 1 earthquake ground motion, the performance verification is carried out based on
the yield stress for the steel pipe piles, but for seismic performance verification of seismic-resistant with respect
to Level 2 earthquake ground motion, a verification method that takes the extent of damage to the piled pier into
account is used.
(4) For the variable situation in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion, it is possible to carry out verification
by obtaining the natural periods of the piled pier based on a frame analysis, and then calculating the seismic
coefficient for verification using the obtained natural periods and the acceleration response spectrum. However,
for high earthquake-resistance facilities, verification may be carried out using an appropriate dynamic analysis
method, such as nonlinear seismic response analysis taking into account the 3-dimensional dynamic interaction
effect between piles and the ground. For open-type wharves on vertical piles other than high earthquake-resistance
facilities, it is possible to omit the verification of the accidental situation for Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
(5) An example of cross-section of an open type piled pier on vertical piles is shown in Fig. 5.2.1.
(6) When cargo handling equipment, such as container cranes, is to be installed on an open-type wharf on vertical
piles, it is preferable to install it in such a way that all of its feet are positioned on either the pile-supported section
or earth-retaining section. If, for example, one foot of a cargo handling equipment is positioned on the pilesupported section and another on the earth-retaining section, the equipment becomes susceptible to adverse effects
by uneven settlement and ground motions, due to the difference in the response characteristics ofthe two sections.
When it is unavoidable to position one foot on the pile-supported section and another on the earth-retaining
section, sufficient foundation work such as foundation piles should be provided to prevent uneven settlement due
to the settlement on the earth-retaining section. In this case, in general, the fixed foot ofcargo handling equipment
such as portal crane should not be installed. When installing cargo handling equipment, such as container cranes,
seismic response analysis should be performed, taking into consideration the coupled oscillation of the cargo
handling equipment and the open-type wharf.
Bollard
/
Superstructure
Design
water depth
Steel i e ile
Rubble for
foundation
- - - - Steel pipe pile
1 - - - - + + - - - Steel pipe pile
-818-
(1) The size ofa deck block, the distances between piles, and the number ofpile rows shall be determined appropriately
in consideration ofthe following:
CD apron width
@ location of sheds
@ seabed, especially slope stability
existing revetments
@ matters related to construction work such as the concrete casting capacity
surcharges, especially crane specifications
(2) In such a case that large quay cranes for ships of 10,000 ton class are to be installed, piles are usually designed to
be placed by Sm with 3-4 pile rows in the cross-section.
(3) The dimensions of the superstructure of open-type wharf shall be determined appropriately considering the
following
CD distances between piles, number of pile rows, and the shape and dimensions of piles
@ construction problem of shattering forms and scaffold
@ ground conditions
arrangement of mooring posts
@ arrangement, shape and dimensions offenders
(4) Assumptions regarding the Seabed Condition
CD
(a) When an earth-retaining structure is provided behind the slope, the position of the earth-retaining structure
should be appropriately determined considering the stability of the slope.
(b) It is necessary to examine the stability of slope with respect to circular slip failure. When an earth-retaining
structure is installed behind the slope, it is preferable that the structure is not constructed in front of the slope
surface from the toe of the slope at the slant angle indicated by equation (5.2.1) (see Fig. 5.2.2).
a=-e
(5.2.1)
where,
-819-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
und surface
CD
In the calculation of the lateral resistance of piles, it is preferable to obtain the coefficient of lateral subgrade
reaction of the subsoil through lateral loading tests of piles in-situ. In case that no tests are conducted, it may
be estimated by means of appropriate analytical methods derived from lateral resistance tests.
@ There are some measured data available on the coefficient oflateral subgrade reaction obtained by the tests in
which the lateral loads were applied to piles up to the yield points as observed in the case of piles of open-type
wharves. Although some of these data have been related to the N-value, the coefficient of lateral subgrade
reaction cannot be estimated accurately from the N-value. Thus, it is preferable to estimate the coefficient by
lateral loading tests in-situ.
@ When lateral loading tests of piles are not carried out due to small scale construction works or time constraints,
the coefficient oflateral subgrade reaction of the subsoil may unwillingly use the mean value of the minimum
value and central value obtained from lateral resistance tests. When using Chang's method, equation (5.2.2)
may be utilized and Chapter 2, 2.4.5 [4] Estimation of Pile Behavior using Analytical Methods can be
referenced. However, some in-situ measurement data indicate that the coefficient value of lateral subgrade
reaction of rubble stones is smaller than the estimate by equation (5.2.2) with Chang's method. In this case it is
recommended to set the coefficient oflateral subgrade reaction equal to 3.0-4.0 N/cm2 in Chang's method.
ken= l.5N
(5.5.2)
where
P=vkCHD
4EI
<=-1)
(5.2.3)
where
-820-
5.2.3 Actions
(!) For the calculation of the self weight of reinforced concrete superstructures, each part of the dimensions is
assumed based on the dimensions of the superstructure, and the volume is calculated on them. The self weight
can be obtained by multiplying unit weight obtained from Part II, Chapter 10, 2 Self weight by the volume. In
addition, for the calculation of the self weight of reinforced concrete superstructures, 21kN per 1.0m2 of deck area
of the superstructure of the piled pier may be assumed.
(2) At the site expected to be subject to waves, the following items should be examined regarding wave uplift on the
super structure of piled pier and the access bridge.
Q) Stability of the access bridges and pulling resistance of piles against uplift.
@ Member strength of the superstructures and access bridges against uplift.
For uplift, refer to Part II, Chapter 2, 4.7.4(1) Uplift Acting on Horizontal Plates near the Water Surface.
(3) The static loads may be determined in accordance with Part II, Chapter 10, 3.1 Static Load. The earthquake
inertia forces due to static loads may normally be considered to act on the upper surface of the deck slab. However,
when the center of gravity of the static loads is located at an especially high elevation, it is important to take the
height of the center of gravity as the point of application of the horizontal force.
(4) Live loads should be determined in accordance with Part II, Chapter 10, 3.2 Live Load. The seismic force due to
a rail mounted crane should be calculated by multiplying its self weight by the seismic coefficient for verification,
and the force can be considered to be transmitted from the wheels of the crane to the pile-supported section. It is
also necessary to carry out seismic response analysis considering the coupled oscillations of the cargo handling
equipment and the open-type wharf (refer to Part ill, Chapter 7 Cargo Handling Facilities, 2.2 Fundamentals
of Performance Verification). In this case, ground motion shall be applied in the form of a time-series seismic
wave profile. The wind load acting on crane may be determined in accordance with Part II, Chapter 2, 2.3 Wind
Pressure.
(5) The fender reaction force can be calculated in accordance with Part II, Chapter 8, 2.2 Actions Caused hy Ship
Berthing and Part II, Chapter 8, 2.3 Actions Caused by Ship Motions and 9.2 Fender Equipment.
(6) The tractive force of vessels can be determined in accordance with Part II, Chapter 8, 2.4 Actions due to
Traction by Ships. In many cases one bollard is installed to one deck block.
(7) When rubber fenders are installed as a damper on an ordinary large wharf with a unit deck block of 20 to 30m
in length, a common practice is to provide two rubber fenders on one block. In many cases, fender intervals of
8 to 13m are used. The berthing behavior of various sizes of ships has been examined by installing 1.5-meterlong rubber fenders on an ordinary large wharf. The results of examination has revealed that it is appropriate
to calculate the berthing force on the assumption that the ship's berthing energy is absorbed by one fender.
Therefore, the reaction force may basically be calculated on the assumption that the berthing energy is absorbed
by one fender when using rubber fenders as a damper. However, this does not apply when fenders are installed
continuously along the face line of a wharf.
(8) The berthing energy is also absorbed by the displacement of the main structure of the pier. However, it is a
common practice not to take this into consideration because in many cases the energy absorbed by the main
structure of the pier accounts for less than 10% of the total berthing energy.
(9) Fig. 5.2.4 shows an example of the displacement-energy curve and the displacement-reaction force curve of a
rubber fender. If a single fender absorbs a berthing energy of El, the corresponding fender deformation 51 is
obtained. Then, using the other curve, the corresponding reaction force acting on the pier is obtained as ffi(51
-+C-+ffi). However, iffenders are installed too close to each other and the berthing energy is absorbed by two
fenders, the berthing energy acting on one fender becomes E2 ~ El/2 and the corresponding fender deformation
becomes 52 . As can be obtained from the figure (52 -+D -+HZ), the reaction force acting on the pier in the
two fender case is almost the same as that generated in the single fender case because of the characteristics of
rubber fender. Thus the horizontal reaction force acting on the pier becomes 2H2'72ffi, which means that the
horizontal force to be used in the performance verification becomes twofold. When using fenders that have such
characteristics, therefore, it is preferable to give careful consideration to this behavior of reaction force in the
-821-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Displacement-absorbed
energy curve
Energy or
reaction force
Displacement
Fig. 5.2.4 Rubber Fender Characteristics Curve
CD
Ground motion used in perforJilance verification of seismic-resistant is set considering the effect of the surface
strata using a ground seismic response analysis. It is necessary to use a seismic response analysis code capable
of appropriately evaluating the BIIlplification of ground motions in soft ground (refer to ANNEX 4, 1 Seismic
Response Analysis of Local Soil Deposit).
@ Using a one-dimensional seismic response analysis as described in ANNEX 4, 1 Seismic Response Analysis of
Local Soil Deposit, the acceleration tillle history at a position IIP below the virtual ground surface is calculated
with the acceleration time history of the ground motion set at the seismic bedrock as the input ground motion.
When calculating the acceleration tillle history, the average depth of the lip ground point for each pile may
be taken, as shown in Fig. 5.2.5. From the acceleration response spectrum obtained in this way, the response
accelerations corresponding to the natural periods of the piled pier are calculated, and the value obtained
by dividing this by the gravitational acceleration can be regarded as the characteristic value of the seismic
coefficient for verification. A damping factor of 0.2 may be used when calculating the acceleration response
spectrum. An example of a typical procedure for setting the seismic coefficient for verification is shown in Fig.
5.2.6. When verifying the seismic performance of earth-retaining parts using the seismic coefficient method,
the structural characteristics are different from those of the piled pier, so the seismic coefficient indicated here
may not be used. For the calculation of the seismic coefficient for verification for earth-retaining parts, refer to
@below.
-822-
...
J.
'
...
.!.
J.
Fig. 5.2.6 Typical Procedure for Setting of Seismic Coefficient for Verification
For variable situations under Level 1 earthquake ground motion, the minimum of the design value of seismic
coefficient for verification is 0.05, and the maximum is 0.25. However, when the characteristic value of the
seismic coefficient for verification exceeds 0.25, this value does not apply, and the characteristic value can be
adopted as the design value of seismic coefficient for verification. In summary, the design value of seismic
coefficient for verification is as follows.
(0.05,,:; kh, ,,:; 0.25)
(0.25 <kh,)
(5.2.4)
where,
khd : design value of seismic coefficient for verification
k,.. : characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification
@ The natural periods of the piled pier may be calculated using a frame analysis. If the relationship between the
displacement and load is obtained from the frame analysis, as shown in Fig. S.2.7, when minute loads are acting
on the piled pier, the spring constants of the piled pier can be set and the natural periods can be obtained from
equation (S.2.S). The ground spring constants used in the frame analysis may be calculated using equation
(S.2.2).
T, =2K~;
(5.2.5)
where,
-823-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
equation (S.2.2)
Displacement a
Fig. 5.2.7 Relationship between Load and Displacement from Frame Analysis
The natural period of the piled pier obtained from the spring constants ofthe piled pier by frame analysis usually
involves some amount of errors. Therefore, if the value in the acceleration response spectrum corresponding
to the natural period is a local minimum, the seismic coefficient for verification could be underestimated, and
this should not be applied as it is. In addition, as indicated in 5.2.5 Performance Verification of Structural
Members, repeated verification for the variable situation under Level 1 earthquake ground motion is needed.
Therefore, it is preferable that the spectral value be determined to calculate the seismic coefficient for verification
with a certain range of natural periods. Thus, the number ofrepetitions of the performance verification may be
reduced. However, this does not deny the importance of avoiding a local maximum in the acceleration response
spectrum caused by the site effects. In the case that the natural period of the piled pier corresponds to a local
maximum in the acceleration response spectrum, it is very likely that the cross-section will not be optimum
from the viewpoint of seismic resistance performance and cost. It is necessary to pay attention to this point for
setting the cross-section for verification.
I
I
I
I
I
I
14----+-..I
I
T [s]
(a) General
performance verification of seismic-resistant of earth-retaining sections can be carried out by directly
evaluating the deformation of the earth-retaining section using a detailed method such as non-linear effective
stress analysis. But simple methods such as the seismic coefficient method can be also used. In this case, it
is necessary to appropriately set the seismic coefficient for verification used in the performance verification
corresponding to the amount ofdeformation ofthe facility, considering the effect ofthe frequency characteristics
of the ground motion and the duration. The normal procedure of calculating the seismic coefficient for
verification is as shown in Fig. 5.2.9. For the calculation of the seismic coefficient for verification of earthretaining sections of gravity-type, basically refer to 2.2.2 Actions, prepared for gravity-type quaywalls.
However, setting the filter taking into consideration the frequency characteristics as shown by the thick lines
is different from gravity-type quaywalls, and this point should be carefully reflected in the analysis.
-824-
--------------------~--------------------
~---------------------------------------
'
Consideration of the effect of duration of seismic motion with the reduction ratio (a, x p)
Calculation of maximum value of
corrected acceleration a,,
I
Calculation of characteristic value of
(b) For the basic flow and points to be noticed in calculating the seismic coefficient for verification of earthretaining sections of gravity-type structures, 2.2.2, Actions for gravity-type quaywalls may be referred to.
However, it is necessary to consider the effect on the deformation of the earth-retaining section influenced
by the slopes at the front of the earth-retaining section and deep rubble mound. And thus setting of the filter
considering the frequency characteristics shall be done by the calculation method described below.
(c) Setting of the filter considering the frequency characteristics
(5.2.6)
where,
H
: Height from the virtual ground surface to the top of the earth-retaining section (m)
-825-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2) Calculation of the natural period of the background soils and soils underneath the wall structure
The method of calculation of the initial natural period Tb of the background soils used in setting the
frequency filter that takes into consideration the ground motion of the earth-retaining section of gravitytype structures may be the same as the method for gravity-type quaywalls. Also, the initial natural
period T., of the soils underneath the wall structure may be calculated by evaluating the section from the
virtual ground surface including rubble mound down to the seismic bedrock as a ground, and ignoring the
ground from the virtual ground surface up to the bottom of the wall structure. In the case of gravity-type
quaywalls, the T., used in setting the filter is evaluated replacing the material properties of the original
ground with the material properties of the rubble mound. However, when calculating the T11 of earthretaining section of gravity-type structures, this may not be applied, so it is necessary to be careful about
this. In other words, Tb and T., should be calculated at the positions shown in Fig. 5.2.10.
Crown of earth-retaining section
Ground surfuce
Rubble stom:s
Virtual ground
rn-situ soils
surface
-T=---..
In the performance verification of open-type wharves on vertical piles, the necessary items among the following
items shall be appropriately investigated and set as necessary.
CD
The cross-sectional forces in the superstructure (Variable situations: action of ships, Level l earthquake ground
motion, surcharge and action of waves, accidental situations: Level 2 earthquake ground motion)
@ Stresses in piles (Variable situations: action of ships, Level 1 earthquake ground motion and surcharge,
Accidental situation: Level 2 earthquake ground motion)
Bearing capacity of piles (Variable situations: action of ships, Level 1 earthquake ground motion, surcharge and
action of waves, accidental situations: Level 2 earthquake ground motion)
-826-
piled pier either. Therefore, the dimensions of the piles are assumed, and the seismic coefficient for verification
is calculated from the acceleration response spectrum corresponding to the natural periods, then the verification
is carried out. If the performance requirements are not satisfied, the pile dimensions are changed, and the same
calculation needs to be repeated.
(4) Performance verification of the deformation may be carried out by setting an appropriate limiting value taking
into consideration the dynamic deformation of the piled pier. For example, the amount of deformation to ensure
that the access bridge does not fall down may be taken as the limiting value. In that case, it is appropriate to use
the response displacement considering the dynamic action, such as the displacement response spectrum, and not
the displacement considering the static action.
(5) Performance verification for stresses in the piles under design situation for other than accidental situations in
respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion
CD
Verification of the stresses occurring in the piles of a piled pier may be carried out using equation (5.2.7). In
the following equations, the symbol y is the partial factor corresponding to the suffix, where the suffixes d and
k indicate the design value and characteristic value respectively.
(a) When the axial forces are tensile
+ (jbcd
(jcyd
(jbyd
(5.2.7)
::;; 1.0
where,
u1,uc : tensile stress due to axial tensile forces acting on the cross-section, and compressive stress due
to axial compressive forces, respectively (N/mm2)
f1btf1bc: maximum tensile stress and maximum compressive stress due to the flexural moment acting on
the cross-section, respectively (N/mm2)
ury.ucy: tensile yield stress and axial compressive yield stress for the weak axis, respectively (N/mm2)
u17y
: bending compressive yield stress (N/mm2)
The design values in the equations may be calculated from equation (5.2.8). The values shown in Table 5.2.2
may be used as the partial factors in the equations.
(5.2.8)
where,
A
P
Z
M
@ For the yield stress of piles, refer to Part II, Chapter 11, 2 Steel. The axial compressive yield stress may be
calculated from the equation in Table 5.2.1.
-827-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 5.2.1 Axial Compressive Yield Stresses (N/mm)
SKK.400
SHK.400
SHK400M
SKY400
SKK.490
SHK490M
SKY490
f.
l
a) When-:;;16 315
r
l
b)When16<-:;;79
r
a)When-:;;Js 235
r
f.
b)When18<-:;;92
r
235-1.3{;-18)
2.0lxl0 6
f.
c)When- >92
r
6.7x!O'
l
c) When->79
r
+(;r
315-2.0{;-16)
2.04x10 6
5.0x!O'
+(;r
l: Effective buckling length of member (cm), r: Radius of gyration of member gross cross-section (cm)
@ The design values of cross-sectional forces on the piles can be calculated by multiplying the characteristic
values of parameters such as the coefficient of subgrade reaction, the action in the horizontal direction, and other
probabilistic variables by the partial factors.
@ It is preferable to calculate the flexural moments on the piles for the direction both normal and parallel to the
face line of the wharf. As in the example shown in Fig. 5.2.1, ifthe ground surface under the floor slab of the
piled pier has a sloping surface, it is often the case that the flexural moments in the frontmost row of piles are
maximized when the ground motion acts in the direction parallel to the face line.
@ When it is considered necessary to examine the rotation of the piled pier unit when evaluating the actions,
the verification should take this into consideration. In this case the distribution of forces on each pile may be
(5.2.9)
where
12~1)3
KH, _ [
h,+-
p,
h1
vertical distance between the pile head and the virtual ground surface (m)
p, : inverse of the distance between the virtual ground surface and the virtual fixed point of pile
(m')
-828-
l3u
J:I..
Center of gravity
of the pile group
Symmetry ax
Ji
X;
i-th pile
Fig. 5.2.11 Distance between the Center of Gravity of the Pile Group and Individual Piles
(b) The row of piles bearing the maximum total horizontally distributed forces is subject to the verification.
(c) When obtaining Kn1, it is necessary to appropriately set the coefficient of subgrade reaction in the lateral
direction of the ground, and calculate p.
Apart from accidental situations in respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion, basically the performance
is prescribed by yielding of the edge of the pile head. However, the piled pier is characterized with structural
robustness, which means the capacity of structure may not be fatally damaged by local failure caused by ground
motions, to the extent that the original function of the structure is lost. The reliability index for yielding of the
edge of the pile within the ground is reported about 2.0-2.7 larger than that of the pile head.8)
(6) Performance verification of the bearing capacity in piles under design situations other than accidental situations
in respect of Level 2 earthquake ground motion
Q) Verification of the bearing capacity of piles in piled piers can be carried out appropriately in accordance with
Chapter 2, 2.4.3 Static Maximum Axial Pushing Resistance of Piles Foundations, and Chapter 2, 2.4.4
Static Maximum Pulling Resistance of Piles Foundations, corresponding to the ground characteristics and
an analysis method for pile lateral resistance. In this case, for calculating the bearing capacity of piles on a
sloping surface, the soil strata below the virtual ground surface can be considered as the effective bearing strata.
@ Regarding the virtual ground surface, refer to 5.2.2 Setting the Basic Cross-section.
(7) Partial factors under the design situations other than accidental situations in respect ofLevel 2 earthquake ground
motion
Q) Regarding partial factors for stresses occurring in the piles of open-type wharves on vertical piles and partial
factors for the bearing capacity of piles, refer to Table 5.2.2. The target reliability indices and target failure
probabilities for stresses in piles shown in 1) and 4) of Table 5.2.2 mean the values for edge yielding of the
pile head of each single pile in the piled pier. In the table, for the variable situations in respect of the action
of ships, the reliability index is 4.1 (failure probability of 2.3X 10-S), being based on the average level of safety
in the conventional design methods. When the expected total cost represented by the sum of the initial cost
and the expected value of the restoration cost due to failure is taken into consideration, the reliability index
that minimiz.es the expected total cost is 3.2 (failure probability of 9.1X10-4) for high earthquake-resistance
facilities, and 2.9 (failure probability of 1.9X 10-3) for other piled piers.9) If here the level of safety is evaluated
from reliability theory based on minimization of the expected total cost, the partial factors are as shown in
Table 5.2.2 1).9) Concerning the variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion shown
in the Table 5.5.2 (4), the average level of safety of a piled pier in accordance with the conventional design
methods is evaluated and shown. Besides the above, the partial factors of Table 5.2.2 are defined taking into
consideration the settings based on the conventional design methods.
-829-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 5.2.2 Standard Partial Factors
(1) Variable situations in respect of the action of ships
(ship berthing, traction by ships), Variable situations in respect of surcharge (during operation)
(a) When SKK400 is used
High earthquake-resistance facility
Pile
stress
3.2
9.lx!0-4
IX,
Probability
distribution
Yuy
1.00
0.719
1.260
0.08
Normal
Y"cH
0.60
0.257
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Ypu
Horizontal forces
1.35
-0.645
0.870
0.25
Normal
Yq
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.00
2.9
1.9xl03
Pile
stress
IX,
Probability
distribution
Yuy
1.00
0.719
1.260
0.08
Normal
Y"cH
0.60
0.257
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Ypu
Horizontal forces
1.30
-0.645
0.870
0.25
Normal
Yq
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.00
Bearing
capacity
IX,
Cohesion
1.00
YN
N-value
1.00
Structural
analysis
coefficient
Pulling piles
0.33
Ya
Pushing piles
0.40
*1: a: Sensitivity factor, IX,,;. Deviation of average value (average value I characteristic value), V: coefficient of variation.
*2:Horizontal forces include fender reaction forces (during ship berthing), tractive forces (during traction), and crane horizontal forces
(during operation of the crane).
*3:The design value of axial forces in piles used in the verification of bearing capacity can be obtained from the verification of stresses in
piles.
-830-
3.2
Pile
stress
9.JxJ0-4
IX,
Probability
distribution
Y,,,,
0.95
0.719
1.1%
0.08
Normal
Y~H
0.60
0.257
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Ypu
Horizontal forces
1.35
-0.645
0.870
0.25
Normal
Yq
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.00
2.9
Pile
stress
J.9xJO~
IX,
Probability
distribution
Y,,,,
0.95
0.719
1.1%
0.08
Normal
Y>rH
0.60
0.257
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Yp ..
Horizontal forces
1.30
-0.645
0.870
0.25
Normal
Yq
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.00
Bearing
capacity
IX,
Yo-
Cohesion
1.00
YN
N-value
1.00
0.33
Ya
0.40
~1: a: Sensitivity factor, /Xk- Deviation of average value (average value I characteristic value). V: .Coefficient of variation.
*2: Horizontal forces include fender reaction forces (during the ship berthing). tractive forces (during traction), and crane horizontal. forces
(during operation of the crane).
*3:The design value of axial forces in piles used in verification of bearing capacity can be obtained from the verification of stresses in piles.
-831-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) Variable situations in respect of surcharges (during strong winds}
All facilities
Pile
stress
IX,
y.,
1.00
y._,u
1.00
Ypu
Horizontal forces
1.00
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.12
Y<'
Cohesion
1.00
YN
N-value
1.00
Ya
Structural
analysis
coefficient
Bearing
capacity
Pulling piles
0.40
0.66
0.50
piles
Pushing: friction piles
*1: a: Sensitivity factor, /Xk: Deviation of average value (average value I characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation.
*2:The design value of axial forces in piles used in the verification of bearing capacity can be obtained from the verification of stresses in
piles.
All facilities
Bearing
capacity
IX,
y,
1.00
y,.
Cohesion
1.00
YN
N-value
1.00
Pulling piles
0.40
Ya
Structural
analysis
0.66
0.50
coefficient
-832-
3.65
l.3xl0-4
Probability
IX;
distribution
Yoy
1.00
0.423
1.260
0.08
Normal
Y>eH
0.66
0.194
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Horizontal forces
1.68
-0.885
1.000
0.20
Log normal
Yq
Surcharges
1.00
ya
1.00
2.67
3.8xl0-'
IX;
Probability
distribution
Yoy
1.00
0.443
1.260
0.08
Normal
Y>eH
0.72
0.215
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Horizontal forces
1.36
-0.870
1.000
0.20
Log normal
Yq
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.00
2.19
J.4xJ02
IX;
Probability
distribution
Yoy
1.00
0.455
1.260
0.08
Normal
Y;cn
0.80
0.195
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Horizontal forces
1.23
-0.869
1.000
0.20
Log normal
Yq
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.00
IX,
y,'
Cohesion
1.00
YN
N-value
1.00
Ya
Strnctural
analysis
Bearing
capacity
coefficient
Pulling pile
0.40
Pushing: end
bearing pile
0.66
Pushing: friction
pile
0.50
*1: a: Sensitivity factor, IX,,: Deviation of average value (average value I characteristic value), V: coefficient of variation.
*2:The design value of axial forces in piles used in the verification of bearing capacity can be obtained from the verification of stresses in
piles.
-833-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 5.2.2 Standard Partial Factors
(4) Variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion
(b) When SKK490 is used
High earthquake-resistance facility (specially
designated)
Target reliability index PT
3.65
J.3xJ0-4
Pile
stress
IX,
Probability
distribution
y.,
1.00
0.423
1.196
0.08
Normal
YkCH
0.66
0.194
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Ykh
Horizontal forces
1.77
-0.885
1.000
0.20
Log normal
Yq
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.00
2.67
Pile
stress
3.8xJ0-3
IX,
Probability
distribution
y.,
1.00
0.443
1.196
0.08
Normal
YkCH
0.72
0.215
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Ykh
Horizontal forces
1.43
-0.870
1.000
0.20
Log normal
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.00
2.19
J.4x!0-2
Pile
stress
!Xk
Probability
distribution
y.,
1.00
0.455
1.196
0.08
Normal
YkCH
0.80
0.195
1.333
0.76
Log normal
Ykh
Horizontal forces
1.30
-0.869
1.000
0.20
Log normal
Surcharges
1.00
Ya
1.00
IX,
y,.
Cohesion
1.00
YN
N-value
1.00
Pulling pile
0.40
Ya
Structural
analysis
Pushing: end
bearing pile
0.66
0.50
Bearing
capacity
coefficient
Pushing: friction
pile
*1: a: Sensitivity factor, /Xk: Deviation of average value (average value I characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation.
38(2:The design value of axial forces in piles used in the verification of bearing capacity can be obtained from the verification of stresses in
piles.
-834-
Q) The embedment length of each vertical pile may be determined appropriately in accordance with the method of
analysis of the pile lateral resistance.
@ The embedment lengths of vertical piles are generally set at 3/P below the virtual ground surface based on the
results of pile lateral resistance analyses. The value of P can be set in accordance with 5.2.2 Setting of Basic
Cross Section.
(9) Examination of Pile Joints
Q) When a pile joint is needed in a pile, it is preferable to ensure that the pile can keep its stability against the impact
stress generated in the joint during driving.
@ The location of pile joint shall be determined carefully in such a manner as to avoid the portion with excessive
stress.
@ For the method for joining piles, refer to Chapter 2, 2.4.6 [4] Joints of Piles.
(10) Change of Plate Thickness or Material of Steel Pipe Pile
Q) Any change on the plate thickness or material along the same steel pipe pile shall be made in accordance with
Chapter 2.2.4.6 [5] Change of Plate Thickness or Material 'fype of Steel Pipe Piles.
@ The strengths of joints and portion with steel thickoess change should be examined carefully because there are
some examples in which piles of open-type wharves buckled at these portions due to ground deformation in a
deep ground where no bending stresses are generated under normal load conditions.
(11) Verification of Level 2 Earthquake Ground Motion with a Dynamic Analysis Method
Q) For setting the cross-section for the verification, a nonlinear dynamic analysis of a spring-mass model with
single mass or double masses if there is a container crane installed may be used. The system consists of a spring
equivalent to the modeled load-displacement relationship of the piled pier structure obtained from an elasticplastic analysis.
@ If container cranes or other cargo handling equipment are installed oo a piled pier, the seismic response
characteristics of the piled pier may be greatly altered depending on the ratio of the mass of the cargo haodling
equipment to that of the piled pier aod the ratio of their natural periods. Therefore, it is necessary to carry
out a seismic response analysis that takes into consideration the coupled oscillations of the cargo haodling
equipment and the piled pier. For details, refer to Chapter 7 Cargo Handling Facilities, 2.2 Fundamentals of
Performance Verification.
@ Besides the inertia forces acting on the superstructure of the piled pier, factors that have an adverse effect
on the piles include transmission of the deformation of the ground around the earth-retaining section to the
superstructure through the access bridge, and transmission of forces to the piles when the soil around the piles
moves towards the sea due to the deformation of the soils there. Therefore, a structure of the access bridge
should be such that deformation of the soils around the ground earth-retaining section does not adversely affect
the superstructure of the piled pier.
(12) Performaoce Verification for the Stability of the Earth-retaining Section
Q) The examination of the structural stability of the earth-retaining section of open-type wharf on vertical piles
can be made in accordance with the performaoce criteria prescribed in 2.2 Gravity-type Quaywalls, 2.3 Sheet
Pile Quaywalls depending on its structural type.
@ The superstructure aod the earth-retaining section of an open-type wharf should be connected by a simply
supported slab having clearances on its both ends or buffer material provided oo the both ends of slab, in
order to prevent the forces acting on the earth-retaining section from being traosmitted to the superstructure.
It is also preferable to prepare measures against the relatively uneven settlement between the wharf and the
earth-retaining section. Furthermore, the clearance between the superstructure and the earth-retaining section
should be determined appropriately by considering the dynamic deformation of the superstructure aod the
earth-retaining section.
@ The stability of the earth-retaining section of open-type wharf on vertical piles against circular slip failure
should be examined by applying Chapter 2, 3.2.1 Stability Analysis by Circular Slip Failure Surface.
-835-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
been achieved as a result of salt injury, so a detailed maintenance management plan should be prepared and carried
out.
(2) It shall be verified that the flexural moment, axial force, and shear force acting on the connections between the
steel pipe piles and the superstructure do not reach the ultimate limit state.
(3) In the performance verification of piled piers, the analysis is carried out by assuming that rigid connections
between the pile heads and the concrete beams are formed. Then, it is necessary that the pile head flexural moment
can be smoothly distributed to the pile head and the concrete beam. The flexural moment that can be distributed
to the beam Mua may be calculated using the following equation, ignoring the reinforcement connection plates or
vertical ribs which are provided, as necessary.
(5.2.10)
where,
Mua : flexural moment that can be distributed to the part of the pile embedded in the beam (N.mm)
D
L
rb
(5.2.11)
where,
Pua : axial force that can be distributed to the part of the pile embedded (N)
L
rp
lb"
j',,
y,
Ap
Yb
(5) It shall be verified that failure due to punching shear forces in the horizontal direction shall not occur in the
beam at the end of which the steel pipe pile is embedded. In this case the punching shear resistance, V,," may be
calculated from the following equation.
VP', =0.2[.l: PaPpPrA./rb
(5.2.12)
where,
VP'd : design value of punching shear resistance in the horizontal direction (N)
j',d : design compressive strength of concrete (N/mm2)
Pa =eflid
Pp=lJIOOpw
P, = 1.0
A, : shear resistance area (mm2)
Yb
-836-
(!) The following may be applied to the open-type wharves with a structure in which the horizontal forces acting on
the piled pier are distributed to coupled raking piles.
(2) The performance verification of open-type wharves on coupled raking piles may be carried out in accordance with
5.2.4 Performance Verification for open-type wharves on vertical piles, as well as the following.
(3) The open-type wharf on coupled raking piles is a structure that resists the horizontal force acting on the wharf
such as the seismic actions, fender reaction force, and tractive force of ships with coupled raking piles. Therefore,
this type of wharf must be constructed on the ground that yields sufficient bearing capacity for coupled raking
piles. Because the coupled raking piles are so laid out to resist the horizontal forces in the direction normal to the
face line of the wharf, the horizontal displacement in that direction is smaller than that of open-type wharves on
vertical piles. Coupled raking piles are seldom laid out to resist the horizontal forces in the direction of wharf face
line. Therefore, it is preferable to examine the strength of the wharf against the horizontal force parallel to the face
line in the same manner as the examination for open-type wharves on vertical piles.
(4) In the case of coupled raking piles, the piles come close to adjacent vertical piles and the earth-retaining section,
so it is preferable that the layout of the piles be carefully determined considering the construction conditions and
the conditions of use.
(5) For the procedure for performance verification of open-type wharves on coupled raking piles, refer to Fig. 5.3.1
of 5.2.4 Performance Verification for open-type wharves on vertical piles.
(6) Verification for the variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion may be carried out by
obtaining the natural periods of the piled pier with frame analysis and calculating the seismic coefficient for
verification with the acceleration response spectrum corresponding to the natural periods.
(7) An example of the cross-section of the open type wharf on coupled raking piles is shown in Fig. 5.3.1.
Concrete paving
Access bridge
Fenders
'-rnF.~~==~Cf=''====fF====o-~~~~'S7 L.W.L
Superstructure
\
Earth-retaining section
Rubble mound
Fig. 5.3.1 Example of Cross-section of Open Type Wharf on Coupled Raking Piles
(!) For setting the basic cross-section of open-type wharves on coupled raking piles, refer to 5.2.2 Setting of Basic
Cross-section.
(2) A large wharf for design ship size of 10,000 DTW class has one or two sets of coupled raking piles behind one
vertical pile in the direction normal to the wharf face line. The distance between piles or between centers of
-837-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
coupled raking piles is usually set to be 4 to 6 m in consideration ofloading conditions and construction work. It is
preferable to use a small raking angle of coupled piles from the viewpoint of securing resistance against horizontal
force, but in many cases an inclination of 1: 0.33 to 1: 0.2 is used because of constraints related to the required
distances from other piles and construction work-related constraints such as the capacity of pile driving equipment
available.
5.3.3 Actions
The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification used in performance verification of open-type
wharves on coupled raking piles for the variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion shall
be appropriately calculated considering the structural characteristics of the wharf. For calculation of the seismic
coefficient for verification of open-type wharves on coupled raking piles, refer to 5.2.3(10) Ground Motion used in
Performance Verification of Seismic-resistant.
CD The pushing-in and pulling-out forces of each pair of coupled raking piles shall be calculated appropriately based
on the vertical and horizontal forces defined in consideration of the wharf operation conditions.
@ The pushing-in and pulling-out forces on each raking pile are obtained with a frame analysis method, taking
into consideration the effect of the raking angle of the pile as indicated in Chapter 2, 2.4.S Static Maximum
Lateral Resistance ofPiles, calculating the ratio ofthe coefficient oflateral subgrade reaction, and appropriately
correcting the coefficient oflateral subgrade reaction.
@ For verification of pushing-in and pulling-out forces in each raking pile, refer to Chapter 2 2.4.3 Static
Maximum Axial Pushing Resistance of Pile Foundations, and 2.4.4 Static Maximum Pnlling Resistance
of Pile Foundations.
(3) Verification of Stresses in Piles
The cross-sectional stress in each pile may be calculated by applying S.2.4 Performance Verification for piles
subject to axial forces or piles subject to axial forces and flexural moments.
(4) Horizontal Forces Distributed to the Pile Head of each Group when Rotation of the Piled Pier Block is
Considered
CD
When it is necessary to consider rotation of the piled pier block, the horizontal forces distributed to the pile
head of each group of piles in an open type wharf on coupled raking piles may be appropriately calculated in
accordance with the cross-section of each pile and the raking angle and length of the raking piles. In this case, it
may be assumed that all horizontal forces are distributed to the coupled raking piles. Normally the row of piles
having the maximum distributed horizontal force among all the rows of piles is adopted as the row of piles used
in the verification.
@ In the case where the cross-section of each pile group and raking angle of the raking piles are different, the
horizontal force distributed to the pile head of each group may be calculated using equation (5.3.1) (see Fig.
S.3.2).
(a) When the piles can be regarded as fully end bearing piles
(5.3.1)
where,
c,
H
(Nim)
x1
f1
are acting.
cross-sectional area of each pile (m2)
: Young's modulus of each pile (N/m2)
811 ,(la : angle of each pile with the vertical direction (0 )
A1
E1
(1
+A,
3
2) Cohesive soil
for f 1
where, J.1: Pile length of the part over which the peripheral surface resistance force is not effectively
working (m), f 1: Total pile length (m).
~!
Horizontal force H
'
0
00
Vertical piles
00
00
Xl
00
00
X2
Coupled piles
X3
X4
Fig. 5.3.2 Pile group Center Line and Distance from each Pile Group
@ When the cross-section, raking angle and length ofthe raking piles of each pile group are all equal, the horizontal
force distributed to each pile group may be calculated from equation (S.3.2).
x.
~x1
H; =-H +--'eH
2
(5.3.2)
-839-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) For the performance verification of earth-retaining sections, refer to 5.2.4 Performance Verification.
@ It shall be ensured that the action due to deformation of the earth-retaining section by earthquakes shall not
be transmitted to the superstructure of the piled pier via the access bridge, and that the piles are not adversely
affected by significant deformation of the soil around the piles towards the sea.
-840-
5.3 Open-type Wharves on Coupled Raking Piles, and also refer to the Strutted Frame Method Technical
Mannal.22)
(2) The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification used in the performance verification of
strutted frame type piers against the variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion shall
be appropriately calculated considering the structural characteristics. For calculation of the seismic coefficient
fur verification of strutted type piers, refer to 5.2.3(10) Ground Motions used in Performance Verification or
Seismic-resistant.
-841-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 55
1 The provisions of Article 48 shall be applied to the performance criteria of piled piers with modification
as necessary.
2 In addition to the requirements of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of piled piers shall be
as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The access bridge of a piled pier shall satisfy the following criteria:
(a) It shall have the dimensions required for enablingthe safe and smooth loading, unloading, embarkation
and disembarkation, and others in consideration of the usage conditions.
(b) It shall not transmit the horizontal loads to the superstructure of the piled pier, and it shall not fall
down even when the piled pier and the earth-retaining part are displaced owing to the actions of
earthquakes or similar one.
(2) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the variable action situation in which the dominant
actions are Level 1 earthquake ground motions, ship berthing and traction by ships, and imposed load:
(a) The risk ofimpairing the integrity of the members of the superstructure shall be equal to or less than
the threshold level.
(b) The risk that the axial forces acting in the piles may exceed the resistance capacity owing to failure
of the ground shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(c) The risk that the stress in the piles may exceed the yield stress shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level.
(3) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the variable action situation in which the dominant action
is variable waves:
(a) The risk oflosing the stability of the access bridge due to uplift acting on the access bridge shall be
equal to or less than the threshold level.
(b) The risk ofimpairing the integrity of the members of the superstructure shall be equal to or less than
the threshold level.
(c) The risk that the axial forces acting in piles may exceed the resistance capacity owing to failure of
the ground shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(4) In the case of structures having stiffening members, the risk of impairing the integrity of the stiffening
members and their connection points under the variable action situation in which the dominant actions
are variable waves, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, ship berthing and traction by ships, and
imposed load shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
3 The provisions of Article 49 through Article 52 shall be applied with modification as necessary to the
performance criteria of the earth-retaining parts of piled piers in consideration of the structural type.
[Technical Note]
(1) The performance verification of jacket type piled piers or piled piers whose structure has stiffening
members shall apply 5.2 Open-type Wharves on Vertical Piles, and 5.3 Open-type Wharves on
Coupled Raking Piles, and for details refer to the Jacket Method Technical ManuaJ.23)
(2) The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification used in the performance verification
of jacket type piled piers in the variable situations in respect of Level 1 earthquake ground motion shall
be appropriately calculated considering the structural characteristics. For calculation of the seismic
coefficient for the verification of jacket type piled piers, refer to 5.2.3(10) Ground Motions used in
Performance Verification of Seismic-resistant.
(3) Verification of Level 2 Earthquake Ground Motion with the Dynamic Analysis Method
The performance verification of jacket type piled piers in accidental situations in respect of level 2 earthquake
ground motion shall be appropriately carried out considering the concerned circumstances around the facilities,
-842-
importance of the facility, and the accuracy of the method. The perfurmance verification of jacket type piled
piers may comply with that of open-type wharves on vertical piles, but the actions occurring in the members shall
be appropriately set considering the structure of the trusses. The different points in the dynamic characteristics
between jacket type piled piers and open-type wharves on vertical piles are as fullows.
(a) The natural periods are short due to the nature of truss structure
(b) Because the structure has panel points, the failure mechanisms are complex
(c) Separate verification of the panel points is necessary
-843-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
5.6 Dolphins
5.6.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) The following may be applied to the performance verification of such mooring facilities as pile type, steel cell
type, caisson type, and other type dolphin structures. Depending on their function, the types of dolphin include
breasting dolphins, mooring dolphins and loading dolphins.
(2) The guidelines outlined in 5.6.2 Actions, and 5.6.3 Performance Verification may be used in simple verification
methods, thus, this point should be noted when they are adopted.
(3) It is preferable that performance verification of dolphins be carried out considering the following items. For other
items, it is preferable to appropriately carry out the performance verification in accordance with each structural
form.
CD
The direction of actions on dolphins is not necessarily a constant direction, hence, the verification should be
@ It is preferable to appropriately set the crown height of the dolphin in accordance with its function. In this
connection the position of installation of the fenders for breasting dolphins, the level of the deck of the ship
for mooring dolphins, and the working range of the loading arm for loading dolphins should be taken into
consideration. For connecting bridges, it is preferable that the height be sufficient not to be affected by the
action of waves.
(4) An example of the cross-section of a pile type dolphin is shown in Fig. 5.6.1.
Breasting dolphin
Mooring dolphin
Loing piled>pier
W=::#:::::tfl:=i:~~~O=:~~E*~~;'.!~~~~~*Mooring post
Mooring post
Mooring post
Bitt
Bit!
Bearing ground
(5) Layout
Q) The layout of a dolphin-berth shall be determined appropriately to avoid adverse effects on the navigation and
anchorage of other ships in consideration of the dimensions of the design ships, water depth, wind direction,
wave direction, and tidal currents.
@ In the determination of the layout of breasting dolphins, the following items need to be examined:
(a) Dimensions of the design ship
1) The side of design ships is usually composed of curve lines forming the outlines of the bow and stem
parts, each of which accounts for about 1/8 of the length overall (L) of ship, respectively and a straight line
forming the outline of the central part which accounts for about 3/4 of the length overall (L) of ship.. It is
preferable that the breasting dolphins are installed in such a way that the ships can be berthed to them with
the straight line part. Normally the number of breasting dolphins is one each toward the bow and stern,
but for dolphins serving for both large and small ships, two each toward bow and stem are sometimes
provided.
2) When special cargo handling equipment is required for dolphins in such a case as dolphins for oil handling,
-844-
a cargo handling platform is installed midway between the breasting dolphins. In this case, it is preferable
to locate the cargo handling platfurm with its seaside front slightly backward from that of the breasting
dolphins, in order that the ship berthing force does not act directly on the cargo handling platform.
(b) It is prefurable to layout dolphins in a way that the longitudinal axis of dolphins becomes parallel to the
prevailing directions ofwinds, waves, and tidal currents. This helps to ease ship maneuvering during berthing
and unberthing and to reduce external forces acting on the dolphins when the ship is moored.
@ Mooring dolphins are normally set at the positions with the angle of 45 from the rope bitts on ship's bow and
stern, having a certain setback from the front face of the breasting dolphins.
@ The distance between breasting dolphins is closely related to the length overall (L) of the design ships. Fig.
5.6.2 gives the relationship between the breasting dolphin interval and the water depth derived from the past
construction data for reference.
180
~
,,
"ii 140
.i:El
~
bl)
/::i. ;
Caisson type
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
,_
-' ...r.D
10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28
30
Water depth(m)
Fig. 5.6.2 Distance between Breasting Dolphins
5.6.2 Actions
(!) For calculation of the reaction force from the fenders onto the dolphins, refer to Part II, Chapter 8, 2.2 Action
Caused by Ship Berthing, and Chapter 5, 9.2 Fender Equipment.
(2) For calculation of the tractive force of ships, refer to Part II, Chapter 8, 2.4 Action due to Traction by Ships.
(3) For calculation of vertical loads due to self weight and live load, refer to Part II, Chapter 10, Self Weight and
Surcharge, 5.2.3 Actions, as applied for open-type wharves on vertical piles.
(4) For the action due to earthquakes, refer to Part II, Chapter 4, Earthquakes and 5.2.3 Actions, as applied for
open-type wharves on vertical piles.
(5) For calculation of the dynamic water pressure during an earthquake, refer to Part II, Chapter 5, 2.2 Dynamic
Water Pressure.
(6) For calculation ofwind pressure forces acting on cargo handling equipment, refer to Part II, Chapter 2, 2.3 Wind
Pressure.
-845-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(!) For the performance verification of steel cell type dolphins, refer to 2.9 Cellular-bulkhead Quaywalls with
Embedded Sections.
(2) The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for the verification for the performance verification of steel
cell type dolphins in variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion shall be appropriately
calculated considering the structural characteristics. The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for
verification of steel cell type dolphins may be calculated in accordance with gravity-type quaywall by applying
2.2.2(1) Seismic coefficient for verification used for verification of sliding and overturning of wall body and
insufficient bearing capacity of foundation grounds in variable situations in respect of level 1 earthquake
ground motion when soil pressure is acting, or composite breakwaters by applying Chapter 4, 3.1.4(12) Seismic
Coefficient for Verification of Sliding, Overturning, and Bearing Capacity of Upright Sections for Level 1
Earthquake Ground Motion, when soil pressure is not acting.
(3) For the foundations of cargo handling equipment and mooring posts, refer to Chapter 2, 2.4 Pile Foundations,
and 9.15 Foundations for Cargo Handling Equipment.
(4) In the case of a cylindrical cell type dolphin, the equivalent wall width can be calculated using equation (5.6.1).
(5.6.1)
where
(!) For the performance verification of caisson type dolphins, refer to 2.2 Gravity-type Quaywalls.
(2) The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification of caisson type dolphins may apply steel cell
type dolphins.
(3) Rotation of a caisson occurs when an eccentric external force acts on a dolphin. Examination of stability against
rotation must be made even when the stability against sliding and overturning as well as against failure of the
foundation ground due to insufficient bearing capacity are found to be satisfactory, because the confirmation of
the stability with respect to these items does not guarantee that the caisson is safe against rotation. In this case,
in calculating the resistance force, attention should be given to the friction force of the caisson bottom which is
proportional to the bottom reaction force as described in Chapter 2, 1.2 Caissons.
(3) For the performance verification of structural members, refer to [1] Pile Type Dolphins. In addition, for the
verification of caisson members, refer to Chapter 2, 1.2 Caissons.
-846-
(3) Anexample of the procedure of oerformance verification of the detached piers is shown in Fig. 5.7.1.
.
.
1~
,_
,~
*I
Evaluation of actions
Performance verification
-------------------------~-------------------------------:
Permanent state :
'
I Verification of earth-retaining section :
'
''
'
''
'
''
'
''
--------------------------------1'
r------------------------ --------------------------------
! ________________________
'
! _________________________________________________________
~------------------------
''
''
'
''
'
''
r--------------------------------
'
'------------------------+--------------------------------''
-847-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
H.W.L
L.W.Lv
Yard bridge
(PC slab bridge)
Yard bridge
(PC slab bridge)
sz
=
Caisson
(5) It is necessary to pay adequate attention to the deformation of the earth-retaining section due to the action of
earthquakes.
(6) The performance verification of the detached pier shall be conducted so that it is stable against all the actions on
the piles and girders. In addition, it is preferable for the detached pier to have a structure with due consideration
for the type and dimensions of portal bridge crane, the traveling characteristics, and the settlement of rails after
installation.
(7) Rail mounted cranes are installed on detached piers, therefore it is preferable that the structure shall have a small
deformation.
5.7.2 Actions
(1) For the wheel loads of cargo handling equipment, refer to Part II, Chapter 10, 3.2 Live Load.
(2) For tractive forces of ship, refer to Part II, Chapter 8, 2.4 Action due to Traction by Ships.
(3) For the self weight of superstructures, and self weight of piles, refer to Part II, Chapter 10, 2 Self Weight, and
Chapter 10, 3 Surcharge.
(4) For fender reactions, refer to Part II, Chapter 8, 2.2 Action Caused by Ship Berthing, Part II, Chapter 8, 2.3
Action Caused by Ship Motions.
(5) For wind loads acting on cargo handling equipment and superstructures, refer to Part II, Chapter 2, 2.3 Wind
Pressure.
(6) For the ground motions acting on cargo handling equipment, superstructures, and piles, refer to Part II, Chapter
4, 2 Seismic Action.
(7) The characteristic value of the seismic coefficient for verification for the performance verification of the detached
piers against the variable situations in respect of Level I earthquake ground motion shall be appropriately
calculated considering the structural characteristics. For calculation of the seismic coefficient for verification of
the detached piers, refer to 5.2.3(10) Ground Motion used in Performance Verification of Seismic-resistant.
(8) For the performance verification of the detached piers, it is preferable to consider wave forces, uplift pressure, and
wind loads acting on superstructures, when necessary.
(9) For the performance verification of the beams, braking forces on cargo handling equipment shall be considered as
a horizontal force, but for piles shall be considered, as necessary.
(10) For the performance verification of the access bridges and the floor slabs, a live load of 5.0kN/m2 may be assumed.
5.7.3 Performance Verification
-848-
Q) The perfurmance verification of girders shall be conducted so that they are safe against the vertical as well as
horizontal furces and loads.
@ Structural elements with sufficient strength against the designated vertical and horizontal furces shall be used
fur the girders of the detached pier, because the crane rails fur a crane are directly installed on the girders. In
the examination of vertical loads, the increase in the wheel loads due to the wind load or seismic force acting on
the bridge crane shall be taken into account.
@ When both legs of the bridge crane are fixed ones, the horizontal load acting on each leg is determined by
distributing the total horizontal load to each leg based on the proportion of the wheel load. When the bridge
crane has a fixed leg and a suspended leg, the whole horizontal load shall be borne by the fixed leg fur making
the design on the safer side. At the same time, however, the horizontal force being one-half of the force acting
on one fixed leg in the case of the both legs being fixed shall be borne by the suspended leg.
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
SUZUKI, A., Koichi KUBO aod Yoshio TANAKA: Lateral resistaoce of vertical piles embedded in sandy layer with sloping
surface, Rep!. of PHRI VoL5,No.2, 1966
Kikuchi, Y., T. Ogora, M. lshimaru aod T. Kondo: Coefficieot of lateral subgrade reaction of rubble grouod, Proceedings of
53rd Annual Conference of JSCE, 1998
YAMASHITA, I.: Equivalent Rigid Frame to Vertical Pile Structure on the Basis of the PHRI Method, Technical Note of
PHRI No.105,pp.1-12,1970
KUBO, K.: A New Method for the Estimation of Lateral Resistance of Piles, Rep!. of PHRI VoL2No.3,pp.1-37,l964
YAMASHITA, I. and M. ARATA: The Staodard Curves for the Built-in Head Staodard Pile Partially Embedded in the
C-Type Soil, Technical Note ofPHRI No.650ppJ3-25,1969
YAMASHITA, I., T. INATOMI, K. OGURA and Y. OKUYAMA: New Staodard Curves in the PHRI Method, Rep!. ofPHRI
Vol. 10 No. 1, pp. 107-168, 1971
Nagao, T. and S. Tashiro: Analytical study on earthquake resistant evaluation method for pile-supported wharves, Jour. JSCE
No.710,1-60,pp, 385-398,2002
Nagao, T., Y. Kikuchi, M. Fujita, M. Suzuki aod T. Saouki: Reliability design method of pier type mooring wharf against
Level-one earthquake, Proceedings of Structure Engineering, JSCE, Vol. 52A, pp. 201-208, 2006
Nagao, t., R. Shibazaki and R. Ozaki: Ordinary Level-one reliability design method of port facilities based on minimum
expected total cost considering economic losses, Proceedings of Structural Engineering, JSCE, Vol. 51A, pp. 389-400, 2005
Minami, K., K. Takahashi, H. Yokota, T. Sonoyarna, N. Kawabata and K. Sekiguchi: Earthquake damage of Kobe Port T Pier
and static and dynamic aoalysis, Soil aod Foundation, Vol. 25 No.9, pp. 112-119, 1997
Kotsutsumi, 0., S. Shiozaki, K. Kazui, S. Iai and H. Mori: Examination of analysis precision improvement of2-dimensional
effective stress aoalyzing method, Proceeding of Offshore Development, JSCE, Vol. 20, pp. 443-448, 2004
FLIP Study Group, Examination of modeling method of pile foundation
K, Kitade, Y. Kawamata, K. lchii aod S. Iai: Analysis oflaterally loaded pile groups using 2-D FEM, 11th ICSDEE aod 3rd
ICEGE, Berkeley, CD-ROM, 2004
Kotsutsum~ 0., Y. Tame, T. Okayoshi, K. Kazui, S. Iai aod Y. Umeki: Modeling of interaction of pile aod liquefied ground in
two-dimensional effective stress aoalysis, Proceedings of 38th Conference on Geotechnical Engineering,, 2003
Kotsutsurn~ 0., Y. Tame, T. Okayoshi, S. Iai aod Y. Umeki: Modeling of interaction of pile aod liquefied grouod in twodimensional effective stress aoalysis, Proceedings of 58th Annual Conference of JSCE, 2003
Kawaoaka, M., M. Andou, Y. Tame, S. Iai aod S. Tagawa: Two-dimensional Finite Element Method aoalysis of horizontal
loading test of a single pile utilizing interaction spring on formation law of soil,- sandy ground-. Proceedings of 58th Annual
Conference of JSCE, 2003
Yoshikawa, S., D. Kyoku, Y. Tame, Y. Tame, S. Iai aod Y. Umeki: Two-dimensional Finite Element Method aoalysis of
horizontal loading test of a single pile utilizing interaction spring on formation law of soil,- Clayey ground-. Proceedings of
58th Annual Conference of JSCE, 2003
Kotake, N., Y. Tame, 0. Kotsutsumi, S. Iai and S. Tagawa: Two-dimensional Finite Element Method analysis of horizontal
loading test of a single pile utilizing interaction spring on formation law of soil,- Influence of ground surface-,. Proceedings
of 58th Annual Conference of JSCE, 2003
Jyuraku, K., K. Kazui, H. Shinozaki, S. Iai aod S. Tagawa: Examination of influence of group piles using pile-ground
interaction spring in two-dimensional aoalysis, Proceedings of 58th Annual Conference of JSCE, 2003
Kawamata, Y., K. Kazui, H. Shinozaki, S. Iai and Y. Umeki: Simulation of Stanamic horizontal loading test utilizing twodimensional aoalysis incorporated with pile-ground interaction spring, Proceedings of 58th Annual Conference of JSCE,
2003
Okayoshi, T., H. Satou, T. Kawabe, S. Shiozak~ S. Iai aod Y. Umeki: Stress of ground about piles- Tow-dimensional Finite
Element Method analysis of pile foundation utilizing interaction spring dependent on the relationship of strains, Proceedings
-849-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
22)
23)
24)
25)
-850-
6 Floating Piers
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Floating Piers
Article JO
1 The performance requirements for floating piers shall be as specified in the subsequent items in consideration
of its structure type.
(1) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism shall be
satisfied so as to enable the safe and smooth mooring of ships, embarkation and disembarkation of
people, and handling of cargo.
(2) The damage due to self weight, variable waves, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, ship berthing and
traction by ships, and/or other actions shall not impair the function of the floating pier nor affect its
continued use.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirement of the floating piers
in the place where there is a risk of having serious impact on human lives, property, and/or socioeconomic
activity by the damage to the mooring buoys concerned shall be such that the structural stability of the
floating pier is not seriously affected even in cases when the function of the mooring buoys concerned is
impaired by tsunamis, accidental waves, and/or other actions.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Floating Piers
Article 56
1 The provisions of paragraph 1 of Article 48 (excluding item ii)) shall be applied to the performance criteria
of floating piers.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of floating piers shall be
as specified in the subsequent items in consideration of the structural type:
(1) The floating pier shall have the dimensions required for containment of their movements and tilting
within the allowable range in consideration of the usage conditions.
(2) The risk of capsizing of the floating body under the variable action situation in which the dominant
action is variable waves shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(3) The floating pier shall have the freeboard required for the dimensions of the design ships and the usage
conditions.
(4) The following criteria shall be satisfied under the variable action situation in which the dominant
actions are Level 1 earthquake ground motions, ship berthing and traction by ships, and imposed load:
(a) The risk ofimpairing the integrity of the members of the superstructure shall be equal to or less than
the threshold level.
(b) The risk of impairing the integrity of the members of the floating mooring facilities and losing the
structural stability shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
3 In addition to the provisions of the preceding two paragraphs, the performance criteria of floating piers for
which there is a risk of serious impact on human lives, property, or socioeconomic activity by the damage
to the facilities concerned shall be such that the degree of damage under the accidental action situation, in
which the dominant actions are tsunamis or accidental waves, is equal to or less than the threshold level.
4 The provisions of Article 64 and Article 91 shall be applied with modification as necessary to the
performance criteria of the access facilities of the floating body by taking account of the utilization
conditions.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Floating Piers
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
appropriately verified that the amount of motions of the floating body and the amount of tilting of the
floating body are within the allowable range, in accordance with the envisaged conditions of use, as
necessary.
(b) Freeboard (usability)
For the performance criteria of floating piers, the freeboard of the floating pier shall be appropriately
set considering the dimensions of the design ships and the envisaged conditions of use to allow safe
and efficient embarkation and disembarkation of passengers and safe and efficient handling of cargo.
(c) Structural stability and soundness of members (serviceability)
1) The setting of the performance criteria for the structural stability and soundness of members
of floating piers and the design situations excluding accidental situations shall be in accordance
with Attached Table 50. In the performance verification of floating piers, the performance
criteria for variable situation in respect of variable waves, Level 1 earthquake ground motion,
berthing and traction by ships, surcharges, for which performance verification is necessary, shall
be appropriately set, in accordance with the structure type of the facility. The items within
parentheses in the column of"Design situation" in Attached Table 50 may be applies individually.
Attached Table 50 Setting of Performance Criteria for Structural Stability and Soundness of Structural Members of
Floating Piers and Design Situations (excluding accidental situations)
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
1 "'
Ii
:g
Jl
""e-
30
:2
Design situation
1 "'
Ii
requirements
Jl
""e-
56
Serviceability
Index of
Performance
Situation
Verification item
Dominating
action
Non-dominating action
standard limit
value
body
4a
4b
Soundness of
members of floating
body
Soundness of
members of mooring
equipment
Structural stability of mooring equipment
-852-
Ordinance
u
];!
t:
"'~
Public Notice
u
~
t:
56
<
1 "'
30
<
"'~
~ "'
"
2
Design situation
Performance
requirements
4b Serviceability
Situation
Variable
Dominating
action
Non-dominating
Verification item
action
Variable
waves
water pressure,
waterfiow
Yielding of mooring
ropes
(Self weight,
Stability of mooring
(Berthing and support reactions of anchors, etc.
traction by
connecting facilities,
ships)
wind, water
pressure, water flow,
Resistance force of
mooring anchors
(horizontal, vertical)
surcharges)
Public Notice
-1l
"
<
} }
30
e
.!! ~
<
56
e
.!!
-
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Safety
Verification item
Resistance force of
mooring anchors
(horizontal, vertical)
@ Access facilities
The setting of the performance criteria of access facilities of floating piers shall apply the performance
criteria for vehicle ramp, which is ancillary equipment of mooring facilities defined in the Standard
Public Notice Article 64, and the performance criteria of fixed facilities for embarkation and
disembarkation of passengers defined in Article 91, in accordance with the envisaged conditions of use
of the floating pier. The access facilities of floating piers are those which function between a floating
body and the land or between floating bodies as the passage of passengers or vehicles, such as access
bridges, connecting bridges, and adjustment towers.
-853-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
[Technical Note]
(2) The perfurmance verification methods given in this chapter can be applied to the floating piers installed in places
where the actions from waves, tidal currents, and winds are relatively weak.
(3) In setting the cross-sectional dimensions of the floating body of floating piers, it is necessary to appropriately
verify that the amount of motion ofthe floating bodies and the amount of tilting ofthe floating bodies are controlled
within the allowable range in accordance with the envisaged conditions of use.
(4) Freeboard
In the perfurmance verification ofthe floating piers, it is necessary to appropriately set the freeboard of the floating
pier to enable safe and smooth embarkation and disembarkation of passengers, and safe and smooth loading of
cargo, considering the dimensions of the design ships and the envisaged conditions of use of the facility.
(5) Fig. 6.1.1 and Fig. 6.1.2 show the main components of a floating pier and the structure of a pontoon. A floating pier
comprises pontoons, an access bridge that connects the pontoons with land, connecting bridges that interconnect
pontoons, mooring chains that moor pontoons, mooring anchors, and other elements.
71;X , '
~hY'/Ao.~
""'--..
\"
\ \,
__
Access bridge
,.l
\._
,.,---
--~ Pontoon
-r
__,~..,__ __,.l!\.,..._-___'.;l>.cc::,;::::
..:-::..
,./ .___
~,,-
.,, ,,:
,,{
.,,
bl
Connecting bridge
Fig. 6.1.1 Notation of Respective Parts of Floating Pier
r ;"
i 1 i. i %;
Fender
rnooor
<L
~;==;;Manhole
Chain hole
ar:<. ~::-;;;;"'
Protective steel sheet
Partition wall
Slab
Supporting beam
r" 1 --~0uterwall
I
Partition wall
Bottom slab
(6) When the site conditions are outside the coverage of this chapter, The Technical Manual for Floating Body
Strnctnres'" can be referred to. In addition, Part II, Chapter 2, 4.7.4 Wave Foree acting on Strnctnres near
the Water Surface, Part II, Chapter 2, 4.9 Actions on Floating Body and its Motions, and Chapter 4, 3.10
Floating Breakwaters can be used as references as necessary.
(7) Normally, the floating piers are not used in locations where the waves or currents are large, but are frequently used
-854-
in locations where the wave height is lm or less, and the current is 0.5m/s or less.
(8) An example of the procedure of performance verification offloating piers is shown in Fig. 6.1.3.
Evaluation of actions
p erfonnance verification
..
--------------------------~,--------------------------------------
1
1
-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_----;~---_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-_-
of ships
,,
I
I
--------------------------~---------------------------------------!
-855-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
h'=d-
w,
(6.2.1)
rwA
where,
-856-
6.3 Actions
(!) The fender reaction force, wave force and current force need not be considered unless required to do so. However,
when there is an anticipated risk that the pontoon may be subjected to wave actions, it is necessary to consider
the following forces: the wave forces exerted upon the stationary pontoon that are assumed to be rigidly fixed in
position and the fluid forces due to the oscillations of the pontoon >) (refer to Part II, Chapter 2, 4.9 Actions on
Floating Body and its Motions). In this case, the mooring force is to be calculated by considering the oscillations
of the pontoon.
(2) A live load of 5.0 kN/m2 for passengers is commonly used for floating piers, which are mainly used for passenger
of ships.
(3) The funder reaction forces used in the performance verification of mooring chains may be calculated by reference
to Part II, Chapter 8, 2.2 Actions Caused by Ship Berthing, and Part II, Chapter 8, 2.3 Actions Caused by
Ship Motions. Also, for the tractive force of ship, refer to Part II, Chapter 8, 2.4 Actions Caused by Traction
by Ships.
(4) The wave forces used in the performance verification of mooring chains may be calculated by an appropriate
method by reference to Part II, Chapter 2, 4.7.4 Wave Forces acting on Structures near Water Snrface, Part
II, Chapter 2, 4.9 Actions on Floating Body and its Motions. The drag coefficient for cubes may be used. The
area over which the drag force acts may be taken to be that below the still water surface. The above mentioned
wave forces are those that act on a stationary pontoon, but if the natural period of the oscillations of the pontoon
is close to the natural period of the waves, resonance may occur, causing a large force in the chain. This point
should be carefully considered. In particular, for floating piers located in places where it is envisaged that swells
and other long period waves penetrate, it is preferable that an motion analysis of the moored floating bodies be
carried out using a numerical simulation method.7l
-857-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) Structural stability levels required for the pontoons should be secured appropriately in accordance with the
conditions of use.
@ In the examination of the stability of a pontoon, the following requirements should be satisfied:
(a) The pontoon must satisfy the stability condition of a floating body with the required freeboard against actions
of the reaction force from the access bridge supporting point, full surcharge on the deck and even against the
presence of some water inside the pontoon owing to leakage of the pontoon.
(b) Even when the full surcharge is placed on only one side of the deck divided by the longitudinal symmetrical
axis of the pontoon and the reaction force from an access bridge supporting point acts on this side, if the
bridge is attached there, the pontoon must satisfy the stability condition of a floating body and the inclination
of the deck should be equal to or less than 1:10 with the smallest freeboard ofO or more.
@ The height of the water accumulated inside the pontoon by leakage is usually assumed at 10% of the height of
pontoon in the examination of pontoon stability. The freeboard to be maintained in this case is mostly about 0.5
m.
When being subjected to a uniformly distributed load, the pontoon may be regarded as stable, if equation (6.4.1)
is satisfied.
Ir
_w__ CG>O
(6.4.1)
where
I
W
Yw
C
G
: geometrical moment of inertia of the cross-sectional area at the still water level with respect to
the longitudinal axis (m)
: weight of pontoon and uniformly distributed load (kN)
: unit weight of seawater (kN/m3)
: center of buoyancy of pontoon
: center of gravity of pontoon
When the pontoon is partially filled with water by leakage, the pontoon may be regarded as stable when
equation (6.4.2) is satisfied. The symbols W, I, C, and G ofthe equation refer to those at the state with water inside.
(6.4.2)
where
i : geometrical moment of inertia of the water surface inside each chamber with respect to its
central axis parallel to the rotation axis of the pontoon (m)
When being subjected to an eccentric load, the pontoon may be regarded as stable if the value of tana
obtained by solving equation (6.4.3) satisfies equation (6.4.4) (see Fig. 6.4.1).
( W.1
P)[ 12dcos'a
+
2
b tan a
( :d tan' a+c-f)tao a
]-p[
a+(h-c)taoa J= O
(6.4.3)
tana<where
10
(6.4.4)
-858-
L
b
c
J
1:
'
a
~
G:C.- 1
of gravity
C: Center of buoyancy
WI
CD
Stresses generated in the structural parts of the pontoon shall be examined by using an appropriate method
selected considering the use conditions of the pontoon, external actions on the respective parts, and their
structural characteristics.
@ A floor slab can normally be verified for performance as a two-way slab fixed on four sides with supporting
beams and side walls against the actions that yield the largest stress out ofthe following combinations of actions:
(a) When only static load acts on a pontoon
(Static load) + (Self weight)
(b) When live load acts on a pontoon
(live load) + (Self weight)
(c) When the supporting point of an access bridge is set on a pontoon without adjustment tower
(Supporting point reaction force of an access bridge) + (Self weight)
@ A outer wall can normally be verified for performance as a two-way slab fixed on four sides with a floor slab,
a bottom slab, and outer walls or supporting beams, against hydrostatic pressure acting when the pontoon
submerges by 0.5 m above the deck.
@ A bottom slab can normally be verified for performance as a two-way slab fixed on four sides with outer walls
or supporting beams, against hydrostatic pressure acting when the pontoon submerges by 0.5 m above the deck.
A partition wall can normally be verified for performance as a slab fixed on four sides when one compartment
has become fully waterlogged and is exerting hydrostatic pressure .
@ The supporting beams of the floor slab, bottom slab and outer walls and the center support can normally be
calculated as a rigid frame box under the condition that the maximum action is on the floor slab of the pontoon
and the hydrostatic pressure for the draft of the pontoon being equal to its height is applied.
<J) When the wave actions are to be considered, calculations of section forces are made using Muller's equation,
11) the method of Prestressed Concrete Barge, or Veritus Rule. When it is necessary to consider effects of the
oscillations of the floating body, wave parameters, and water depth, the method with cross-sectional division by
Ueda et al. S). 12). 13) may be used.
(4) Performance Verification of Mooring Chain
CD
The structure of mooring chains should be examined by using an appropriate method in such a way that the
chains can hold securely a pontoon in position under the action of whichever force is the largest among the
-859-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
fender reaction force generated during berthing, the tractive force of ship and the wave force, with the addition
of the tidal current force to each of aforementioned forces.
@ Normally, the length of a mooring chain is 5 times the water depth plus the tidal range. When a chain is
stretched, it is necessary to pay attention to the following points:
(a) During high tide, the chain should not be over stretched causing an excessive tension force in it
(b) During high tide there should be no interference with ship berthing.
(c) Sufficient anchor holding power should be ensured for mooring anchors during high tide.
(d) The amount of horizontal movement of the pontoon during low tide should be small.
@ It is said that the anchor holding power of steel mooring anchors is significantly reduced when the angle between
the chain at the connection part and the horizontal surface is 3 or higher.
The maximum tension acting on each chain is ideally determined through dynamic analysis of the chain and
the pontoon, but as this is very difficult, static analysis may be used as the second-best method. A chain can
normally be verified for performance on the condition that only one chain is assumed to resist against all the
external forces as shown in Fig. 6.4.2.
Assuming that the chain forms a catenary line, the maximum tension acting on the chain is given by equation
(6.4.5). In the equations below, the symbol y represents the partial factor ofits suffix and suffixes k and d stand
for the characteristic value and the design value, respectively.
Ta =Pa secB2
(6.4.5)
The horizontal force acting on the mooring anchor is the same as the horizontal force acting on the pontoon,
and the vertical force acting on the anchor is given by equation (6.4.6).
od = Pa tan 01
(6.4.6)
The vertical force acting on the joint between the chain and the pontoon is given by equation (6.4.7).
e,
bd =Pa tan
(6.4.7)
The angles 111 and 112 are calculated by equation (6.4.8) with an assumed chain length I and an assumed chain
weight w per unit length of the chain.
~ (secB -secB
2
)1
1)
(6.4.8)
The horizontal distance between a mooring anchor and the pontoon when a horizontal force is acting on the
pontoon is given by equation (6.4.9), and thus the amount of horizontal shift of the pontoon from its stationary
position under no horizontal force can be evaluated.
K, =
(6.4.9)
Because the catenary line of the chain of normal diameter can be approximately represented with a straight
-860-
line, it can be assumed in equations (6.4.5) to (6.4.9) that 02= 01=sinl(h/l) and K = ~12 -h 2
where
T
P
V,,
Vb
@ In the determination of the diameter of the chain, careful consideration should be given to the abrasion,
corrosion, and biofouling of chain. In addition, appropriate maintenance work needs to be carried out on the
chain, including periodical checks on the chain and its replacement, as necessary.
@ When determining the chain diameter with numerical ship motion simulation, the characteristics ofdisplacement
-restoration force relationship of the mooring system need to be determined using an appropriate method such
as the catenary theory.14)
(5) Performance Verification of Mooring Anchor
CD
A mooring anchor shall be capable of providing the resistance forces required to keep the pontoon stable against
the maximum tension acting on the mooring chain and shall have an appropriate stability.
@ For the verification of the stability of mooring anchors, equation (6.4.10) may be used. In the following, the
subscripts k and d indicate the characteristic values and design values respectively. Also, the structural analysis
factor may be taken to be an appropriate value equal to or greater than 1.2.
Rhd"C:.raPd
R,,~r.v.,
(6.4.10)
where,
Rh : horizontal resistance force of mooring anchor (kN)
R, : vertical resistance force of mooring anchor (kN)
P : horizontal force acting on mooring anchor (kN)
V,, : vertical force acting on mooring anchor (kN)
Ya : structural analysis factor
In calculating the design values in the equation, the following equations may be used. Here, V., P, and 01 in
the equations are as shown in Fig. 6.4.2. For the characteristic value of the maximum tension force acting in the
mooring chain P,,, the value obtained in (4) Performance Verification of Mooring Chains, may be used. The
@ Normally the following forces are considered as the resistance forces of a mooring anchor, but it is preferable
that in-situ stability tests be made for a mooring anchor:
(a) In the case of concrete block:
1) For clay ground:
Horizontal resistance force Rh : Cohesion of the surfaces of bottom and sides, difference between
the passive and active earth pressures
-861-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Horizontal resistance force Rh : Bottom friction force, diffurence between tbe passive and
active earth pressures
Vertical resistance force Rv
: Weight in water, effuctive overburden weight in water
The vertical force employed in tbe calculation of tbe bottom friction force is tbe difference between tbe
weight of the block in water and the vertical component of the chain tension acting on the block.
(b) In tbe case of steel mooring anchor:
Horizontal resistance force Rh : Holding power
Vertical resistance force Rv
: Weight in water
The holding power of a steel mooring anchor is calculated by equation (6.4.11).
on soft mud:
on hard mud:
on sand:
on flat rock:
TA= 17 Jf'A,f'3
TA= 10 Jf'A;.'3
TA=3WAd
TA =0.4 Jf'Ad
(6.4.11)
where
WAa=rw,WAk
@ When a rectangular solid anchor block is deeply embedded in a cohesive soil, Hansen obtained equation (6.4.12)
for the horizontal resistance force by assuming the slip surface around the block.
P = ll.4ch
(6.4.12)
Also, Mackenzie experimentally obtained equation (6.4.13) for blocks embedded to a depth of 12 times or
more the height of the block.15)
P= 8.5ch
(6.4.13)
where,
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Technical Manual for floating structure, 1991
Yonekawa, M.: Design and calculation examples of port facilities (Enlarged and revised edition)Kazama Publishiog, 1983
JSCE: Standard Specifications fur concrete, 2002
Nippon Kaiji Kyokai (NK): Steel barge, 1997
UEDA, S., S. SHIRAISHI and K. KAI: Calculation Method of Shear Force and Bending Moment Induced on Pontoon Type
Floatiog Structures in Random Sea, Technical Note of PHRI No.505, 1984
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary fur Highway Bridges, Part IV Substructures, Maruzen Publications,
2002
Ueda, S. : Analysis Method of Ship Motions Moored to Quay Walls and the Applications, Technical Note of PHRI
No.504,1984
Oogushi, M.: Theoretical naval architect, Kaibun-do Publishing, 2004
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, Part II Steel Bridge, Maruzen Publications,
2004
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, Part III Concrete Bridge, Maruzen
Publications, 2004
Jean Muller: Structural Consideration Configurations II, University of California Extension Berkeley, Seminar on Concrete
and Vessels Sedt., 1965
UEDA, S., S. SHIRAISHI and T. ISHISAKI: Calculation Method of Forces and Moments Induced on Pontoon Type Floating
Structures in Waves, Rept. of PHRI Vol. 31 No.2, 1992
UEDA, S. S. SHIRAISHI and T. ISHISAKI: Example of Calculation of Forces and Moments Induced on Pontoon Type
Floatiog Structures and Figures and Tables of Radiation Forces, Technical Note of PHRI. No.731,1992
-862-
-863-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article31
The provisions of Article 26 or Article 29 shall be applied correspondingly to the performance requirements
for shallow draft wharves.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Shallow Draft Wharves
Article 57
The provisions of Article 48 through Article 52, or Article 55 shall be applied with modification as necessary
to the performance criteria of shallow draft wharves in consideration of the structural type.
[Technical Nole]
-864-
8 Boat Lift Yards and Landing Facilities for Air Cushion Craft
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Boat Lift Yards
Article32
The performance requirements for boat lift yards shall be as specified in the subsequent items in consideration
of its structure type:
(1) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism shall be
satisfied so as to enable the safe and smooth lifting and launching of boats.
(2) Damage due to self weight, earth pressure, water pressure, variable waves, berthing and traction of
boats, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, imposed loads, and/or other actions shall not impair the
function of the boat lift yards nor affect their continued use.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Boat Lift Yard
Article 58
1 The performance criteria of boat lift yards shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The boat lift yard shall have the necessary water depth and length corresponding to the dimensions of
the design ships.
(2) The boat lift yard shall have the necessary ground elevation in consideration of the tidal range, the
dimensions of the design ships, and the usage conditions.
(3) The boat lift yard shall have the necessary ancillary equipment in consideration of the usage conditions.
2 The provisions of Article 49 through Article 52 shall be applied with modification as necessary to the
performance criteria of the front wall portion of the boat lift yard in consideration of the structural type.
3 The performance criteria of the pavement of the boat lift yard shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The pavement of the boat lift yard shall have the dimensions required for enabling the safe and smooth
handling of boats.
(2) The risk of impairing the integrity of the pavement under the variable action situation, in which the
dominant action is imposed load, shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(3) The risk of impairing the integrity of the pavement under the variable action situation, in which the
dominant actions are water pressure and variable waves, shall be equal to or less than the threshold
level.
[Technical Nole]
(!) A boat lift yard is a facility used to retrieve ships to the land and launch to the sea fur such purposes as repair,
refuge from storm waves and storm surges, and land storage of ships during winter.
(2) In many cases, rails or cradles are employed in the retrieving and launching of ships of 30 tons or larger in gross
tonnage, but the provisions in this section can be applied to the performance verifications of the facilities used to
lift and launch ships smaller than 30 tons in gross tonnage directly over the slope of slipway.
(3) Fig. 8.1.1 Notations of Various Parts of boat lift yard.
-865-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Concrete block cov
Slope
Foundation
Concrete pavement
Intermediate
. . wall
Foundatioo
Retaining wall
Location of boat lift yards needs to be determined in such a way that the following requirements are satisfied:
CD
There is an adequate space in the background for the work for ship lifting and launching as well as for ship
storage.
CD
(a) Length
In setting the length of slipways for the performance verification, the dimensions of the design ships shall be
appropriately considered.
(b) Water depth
In setting the water depth of slipways for the performance verification of boat lift yards, the dimensions of the
design ships and the envisaged conditions of use of the facility shall be appropriately considered.
@ Crown height
In setting the crown! height of slipways for the performance verification of boat lift yards, the dimensions of the
design ships and the envisaged conditions of use of the facility shall be appropriately considered to enable the
slipway to be safely and efficiently used.
@ Slope angle of the slipway
In the performance verification of boat lift yards having slipways, the slope angle of the slipway shall be
appropriately set considering the dimensions and shape of the design ships, the ground conditions, the tidal
range, and the envisaged conditions of the use of the facility in order to enable smooth retrieving and launching
of ships.
[2] Height of Each Part
(!) It is preferable that the crown height of the front wall of the slipway section be located at a level lower than the
mean monthly-lowest water level (LWL) by the draft of the design ships. This requirement indicates that it is
necessary lift ships even at the low water of neaps. The draft of the ship should be the light draft for the case of
repair, refuge, and wintertime storage, and should be the full-load draft for the case of lifting small fishing boats
filled with catches. For boat lift yards that are to be constructed in the areas where tidal ranges are small or for the
boat lift yards that are to be used even at the low water springs during high waves, it is possible to lower the crest
height of the front wall further.
(2) The ground elevation of the ship storage yard can be determined by applying 2.1.1 Dimensions of Quaywalls.
However, when the ship storage area is located adjacent to a quaywall, the crown height of the ship storage area
can be set equal to the crown height of the quaywall to facilitate ease ofuse. In cases where waves are high in the
water area in front of the boat lift yard, consideration of the wave runup height is preferable.
(3) It is preferable not to change the gradient of the slipways considering the convenience of retrieving and launching
of ships.
-866-
CD
characteristics of foundation, and the tidal range, so that the lifting and launching of ships can be performed
smoothly.
(2) When the slipway is to be utilized by small ships, it is preferable to have a slope with a single-gradient. Singlegradient slopes are frequently used in slipways for human power-based ship lifting in shallow waters. For this
type of slipways, a slope inclination of 1:6 to 1:12 may be used as a reference.
(3) When the water in front of the slipway is deep or the area of the construction site is limited, the slipway may be
built with two or more gradients. When this is the case, a two-gradient slipway may be adopted when the crown
elevation of the front wall is about-2.0 m, and a three-gradient slipway may be adopted when the crest height of
the front wall is lower than-2.0 m. The following values may be used as reference gradients:
CD
(3) When the ship is launched to the sea gently by wire ropes, a distance of about three times of the ship's length
overall will suffice to secure the required width of water area.
Flmdble skirt
(4) An eumplo oftho main dlmemlona of air c:ush!CG craft la shown Ill. TallJe 8.2.L
Tlble 8.2.1 Exmnplll DI Dlmanal- or Air CUelllcn Craft
Tcalhc!sbl
Sklrtdcplb
(m)
Bomdh!a
~
Tolall!IBU
gpeed
'TS
14
4S
65
(m)
18.2
24.7
1.6
12.1
4..4
1.9
1..6
11.S
c
d
23.l
14.8
11.0
6.5
L2
105
50
SI
7.0
4.6
L2
38
9.1
Malmum
iii\
50
60
...1m.,,..,
(3) As. noisoa :ll:om an air cashlca craft may be as high as 100 dB at 111 clll!ance of SO m :hm tho aaft, it Is prcftireblo
to locate air wshion craft landing fadlltles far enough any ftomhoqltall, sdlDols and houallla - . or to abut
offtho DOiie& bf sunolllldln& tho &.dlllle& wilh aoand-proofwalla.
-868-
addition, lighting facilities, hangers, sound-proof walls, oil supply facilities and repair facilities and others shall be
provided as necessary.
[1] Slipway
(!) The structure of the slipway can be determined by referring to the slipway structure described in 8.1.3
Dimensions of Each Part.
(2) The width of the slipway should be determined considering of the lateral movement of the air cushion craft
during the landing or gliding-down operation due to beam winds. Usually a width of about three times the
width of the craft is adopted.
(3) The gradient of the slipway needs to be determined considering its psychological etTuct on passengers,
performance of the air cushion craft, and use ofland. Usually a gradient of 1:10 or gentler is adopted.
[2] Apron
In many cases the apron width is the same as that of the slipway and the apron length is about two times the length of
the air cushion craft. In cases where two or more air cushion crafts use the landing facility simultaneously, a parking
space should be provided alongside the apron.
[3] Hangar
When a hangar is to be constructed, it is preferable to locate it adjacent to the apron to facilitate the servicing and
maintenance of air cushion craft and to provide the refuge space of air cushion craft in rough weather. The dimensions
of the hangar are preferably as follows:
.5 times the width of the air cushion craft (per one craft)
Width:
Length:
1.2 times the length of the air cushion craft (per one craft)
Height:
There should be a clearance of about 0.5 m from the ceiling to the top of the air cushion craft when
the craft is lifted afloat.
References
I)
Kimura., K.: Design method of plastering blocks for slipway, Journal of Public Works Research Institute (PWRI), Hokkaido
Regional Development Bureau, No. 369, 1984
-869-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article33
1 The performance requirements for ancillary facilities of mooring facilities shall be as specified in the
subsequent items in consideration of the type of facilities:
(1) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism shall be
satisfied so as to facilitate the safe and smooth use of mooring facilities.
(2) The damage due to self weight, earth pressures, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, berthing and
traction of ship, imposed loads, collision with vehicles, and/or other damage shall not impair the
function of the ancillary facilities nor affect their continued use.
2 In addition to the provisions of the previous paragraph, the performance requirements for the ancillary
facilities for mooring facilities which are classified as high earthquake-resistance facilities shall be
such that the damage due to Level 2 earthquake ground motions and other actions do not affect the
restoration through minor repair works of the functions required of the piers concerned in the aftermath
of the occurrence of Level 2 earthquake ground motions. Provided, however, that as for the performance
requirements for the ancillary facilities of the mooring facilities which require further improvement in
earthquake-resistant performance due to the environmental conditions, social or other conditions to which
the pier concerned is subjected, the damage due to said actions shall not adversely affect the restoration
through minor repair works of the functions of the facilities concerned and their continued use.
9.1 Mooring Posts and Mooring Rings
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Mooring Posts and Mooring Rings
Article 59
The performance criteria of mooring posts and mooring rings shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Mooring posts and mooring rings shall be appropriately placed so as to enable the safe and smooth
mooring of ships and cargo handling works by taking into account the positions of the mooring lines
for the ships using the mooring facilities concerned.
(2) The risk of impairing the integrity of the members of mooring posts and mooring rings and losing their
structural safety shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the variable action situation in
which the dominant action is the traction by ships.
[Commentary]
-870-
Public Notice
~
"
<
} }
33
,!!
~<
59
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Serviceability
,!!
Verification item
Non-dominating
Situation Dominating
actions
actions
Variable
Traction by
ships
Soundness of mooring
post and mooring ring
components
Stability of mooring
post and mooring ring
structures (sliding of
superstructures)
Stability of mooring
post and mooring ring
structures (overturning
of superstructures)
(!) The performance verification of mooring posts and mooring rings shall require their proper layout to allow the
safe and smooth mooring of ships and cargo handling, considering the positions of the mooring lines of the ships
using the mooring facilities concerned.
(2) In general, mooring posts are installed at around both eods of the berth and away from waterlines as far as possible
for the mooring of ships in a storm, whereas bollards are installed close to the berth face line for the mooring or the
berthing and leaving of ships in ordinary conditions.
(3) The positioning and names of the mooring lines of ships during berthing may refer to 2.1.1 (2) Length, Water
Depth and Layout of Berths.
(4) The distance intervals between bollards and their minimum number of installation per berth may refer to the
values given in Table 9.1.1.
Table 9.1.1 Placement of Bollards
Maximum interval
between bollards (m)
Minimum number of
installation per berth (unit)
10-15
20
25
35
45
(5) In the cases where mooring lines are not pulled upward at such mooring facilities for small ships mooring posts
at intervals of 10 - 20 mare installed without bollards. Instead of bollards, small ship mooring facilities may be
installed with mooring rings or similar with equivalent strengths to bollards at intervals of 5 - 10 m.
(6) For some small ship mooring facilities, mooring rings or equivalents may be installed to moor small ships.
Mooring rings or similar shall be installed at a proper height taking tide levels into consideration. Small ships are
-871-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
often tied to mooring rings with the mooring lines from their bows and sterns, and hence mooring rings or similar
may be placed at intervals of 5 - 10 m.
(7) Mooring posts are installed according to use conditions by ships. They are often installed in such manner that
angles between ship axes and mooring lines would be set closely to a right angle as much as possible so that they
could react effectively against the furces perpendicular to the ship axes. In many cases, one mooring post is
installed at each end of a berth.
The angles of bow lines and stern lines with respect to their ship axes are set to be small to control the
movement of ships in the ship axes direction. It is preferable to install bollards so that these angels are kept larger
than 25 - 30 . Fig. 9.1.1 shows the typical installment examples of mooring posts.
(8) There are cases where the mooring lines stretched from two adjacently moored ships are tied to one mooring post
installed at the junction of two berths. Since the lines are stretched from different directions and their resultant
furce is not larger than the tractive furce from either of the ships, there is no need to install larger-size mooring
posts at the junctions of two berths. However, in some cases, it would take time to release mooring lines for
unberthing, resulting in accidents. 1\vo bollards shall be hence installed at an interval of several meters in the
junction. In the case oflarge mooring facilities, sometimes fuur or more lines are tied from each of bow and stem
of the both sides of ships. In such a case, it is preferable to install two bollards at an interval of several meters at
the places to tie these lines.
Stern line
Bowline
900
Moorigpost
(a) The case of right angle
45
45
Zsollard
~
45
CD
The tractive forces by ships shall be calculated appropriately considering the berthing and mooring conditions
of ships.
@ The tractive forces by ships can be calculated in accordance with Part II, Section 8, 2.4 Actions due to Traction
by Ships.
(2) The verification of the sliding and overturning of superstructures shall be performed on tractive forces from
the most dangerous traction angles. The traction angles of the most dangerous tractive forces can be calculated
from equations (9.1.1) and (9.1.2). The expected ranges of traction angles depending on conditions such as the
dimensions of design ships and tide levels shall be considered.
CD
-1 {
~ 2 + 2WP, + P, 2 -T 2 + P, 2
(T _I P.) ( W + P, - W
)}
(9.1.1)
where
-872-
(9.1.2)
where
(J
x2
h1
:
:
P,
P,
x,
hi
P,
(a) Sliding
+---x;--+
x,
P,
..l.~'---
(b) Overturing
(!) Examination on the Stability of the Superstructures on which Mooring Posts and Mooring Rings are Installed
CD
Examination on sliding
The following equation may be used for examining the stability of the superstructures on which mooring posts
and mooring rings are installed. The subscript d indicates design value.
(9.1.3)
where
f : friction coefficient
W : weight of superstructure (kN/m)
(J : traction angle (rad) (see 9.1.2 Actions)
T : tractive force (kN/m)
P, : resultant vertical earth pressure acting on superstructure (kN/m)
Ph : resultant horizontal earth pressure acting on superstructure (kN/m)
Ya : structural analysis factor
The design values in the equation can be calculated from the following equation, where the symbol y is the
partial factor corresponding to its subscript, where suffix k and d indicate the characteristic values and design
values, respectively.
P,,,
=.
where
/; : wall friction force
If/ : angle between wall and vertical line ( )
@ The following equation may be used for examining the stability of the superstructures on which mooring
posts and mooring rings are installed. The subscript d indicates design value.
XiWd + x,P,,,
where
W : weight of superstructure (kN/m)
-873-
(9.1.5)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(} : traction angle (rad) (see 9.1.2 Actions)
T : tractive force (kN/m)
P v : resultant vertical earth pressure acting on super structure (kN/m)
Ph : resultant horizontal earth pressure action on super structure (kN/m)
x 1 : distance from the faceline of quaywall to superstructure weight acting point (m)
x 2 : distance from faceline of quaywall to tractive force acting point (m)
x 3 : distance from faceline of quaywall to acting point of resultant vertical earth pressure (m)
h1 : distance from bottom of superstructure to tractive force acting point (m)
h2 : distance from bottom of superstructure to acting point of resultant horizontal earth pressure (m)
Ya : structural analysis factor
The design values in the equation can be calculated from equation (9.1.4).
@ Partial Factors
In examining the stability of the sliding and overturning of the superstructures on which mooring posts and
mooring rings are installed, the values shown in Table 9.1.2 may be used as standard partial factors. These
partial factors are determined taking account of the setting used in previous design methods.
Table 9.1.2 Partial Factors used in the Performance Verification of the Stability of Superstructures
Yt
YP,
;;;
a~
~
t:
~
Friction coefficient
y,.
Yw
Weight of superstructore
YT
Tractive force
Yo
Ya
YP,
Traction angle
YPh
Yw
YT
Tractive furce
Yo
Ya
Traction angle
y
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.20
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.00
1.20
a
-
IX,
a: sensitivity coefficient, IX,;. deviation of average (average value/characteristic value). V: coefficient of variation
-874-
Article 60
The performance criteria for fender system shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The fender system shall be properly installed and provided with the function satisfying the necessary
specifications so as to enable the safe and smooth berthing and mooring in consideration of the
environmental conditions to which the system concerned are subjected, the berthing and mooring
conditions of ships, and the structure type of mooring facilities.
(2) The risk that the berthing energy of ships may exceed the absorption energy of the fender system under
the variable action situation, in which the dominant actions is ship berthing, shall be equal to or less
than the threshold level.
[Commentary]
..,
Public Notice
..,
e- Ii
1 "'
'.$!
e- Ii
1 "'
33
60
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Non-dominating
Situation Dominating
action
action
Serviceability
Variable Variable
Ship
berthing
Verification item
Berthing energy of
fender equipment
Absorption energy
(b) Variable Situations where Dominating Actions are Ship Berthing (Serviceability)
The verification of ship berthing is such that the risk of the berthing energy of ships exceeding the absorption
energy of fender equipment shall be equal to or less than the limit value when ships are berthing.
[Technical Nole]
9.2.1 Fundamentals of the Performance Verification of Fender Equipment
{I) When a ship is berthed to a wharf or when a moored ship moves owing to wind and wave forces, berthing force
and friction force are generated between the ship and the mooring facility. To prevent damages to the ship's hull
and mooring facility due to these forces, fender equipment are installed on the mooring facility. However, in
case that ships are provided with fender equipment such as ship fenders or tires for small ships or certain types of
ferries and the maneuvering of such a ship is done very carefully considering the energy absorption capacity of the
fender equipment, the mooring facility does not necessarily have to be equipped with fender equipment, because
the berthing force to the mooring facility is relatively low.
(2) For fender systems used as fender equipment, rubber and pneumatic fenders are commonly selected. Other types
such as foam types, water pressure types, oil pressure types, suspended weight types, pile types, and timber types
are also used.2>
(3) The performance verification procedure of rubber fenders, pneumatic fenders, and pile type fenders is as shown
in Fig. 9.2.1.
(4) The performance of fenders has significant effects on the construction costs of mooring facilities, the maintenance
costs after construction, and berthing efficiency. It is preferable for the section of fenders to consider not only
their construction costs but also comprehensive costs of all aforementioned factors. In the cases of piled piers
and dolphins, the effects of the reaction forces offender systems are normally relevant, and hence in some cases
-875-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
selection of high-performance funder systems, even if they are expensive, results in reducing the construction
costs of quaywalls as a whole. In the cases of gravity-type quaywalls and sheet pile quaywalls on which the
reaction forces of funder systems have no effects on the structural dimensions, the performance of funder system
does not affect the construction costs of quaywalls. In some cases, however, selection of easy maintenance type
fender system, even if they are expensive, results in cost saving in the long run, due to their maintenance costs
after completion. There are also cases in which high-perfurmance funder systems are selected to reduce the delay
of ship berthing due to oceanographic and meteorological phenomena. Because this results in improving cargo
handling efficiency.
Determination of design ships
Layout offenders
For berthing ships
Determination of fenders
Fig. 9.2.1 Example of Performance Verification Procedures of Fenders
9.2.2 Actions
CD
For calculating the berthing energy of ships in the performance verification of funders, refur to Part II, Chapter
8, 2.2 Actions Caused by Ship Berthing.
@ The partial factors used for calculating the berthing energy of ships in the performance verification of funders
shall be set at 1.0 for all the parameters.
(2) The calculation of berthing force is performed in general by obtaining the load-absorption energy curve of
mooring facility and then preparing the load-absorption energy curve of a whole fender system at a certain point
As shown in Fig. 9.2.2, the berthing force P for a given berthing energy E1 can be obtained based on the loadabsorption energy curve prepared by adding the absorption energy Efl caused by fender deformation and the
absorption energy Ep caused by quaywall deformation.
-876-
(Quaywall) +(Fender)
Quaywall
Ep.
p
Reaction force
(3) In case of mooring facilities that are exposed to wave actions, ships move in both the horizontal and vertical
directions. The ship's motions may cause excessive shear deformation in fenders in addition to the normal
compressive deformation, which sometimes leads to breakage of fenders. If the shearing force is assumed to be
the friction force, the force is estimated at about 30% to 40% of the reaction force of the fender.
(4) Contact panels and similar means shall be installed on fender equipment as necessary to reduce surface pressure
and thus to prevent berthing forces from acting on ships as a concentrated load. Synthetic resin plates or other
materials are sometimes fixed in front of contact panels to reduce the shearing forces acting on fender systems.
9.2.3 Layout of Fenders 2), 7)
(!) The layout and specification setting in the performance verification offender equipment need to be appropriately
performed to allow the safe and smooth berthing and mooring of ships, considering the natural conditions where
the facilities concerned are placed, the berthing and mooring conditions of ships, and the structure type of mooring
facilities.
(2) Fender equipment need to be appropriately placed so that ships have no direct contact with mooring facilities
before the fender equipment absorb the berthing energy of design ships.
(3) Rubber fenders are normally placed at intervals of 5 to 20m. When a ship berths, a part near the bow or stern
contacts the quaywall at first. It should be noted that since the ship has a curved surface at aforementioned contact
parts, excessively wide fender intervals cause the ship to directly contact the quaywall, to which fenders are not
placed, before the fenders sufficiently absorb the berthing energy. The intervals of about 5m normally cause no
problem, but in the case that the intervals are !Om or more and thus, the part of the ship might directly contact the
part of the quaywall to which fenders are not placed, it is preferable to construct the coping offender placing parts
projected out 0.2 to 0.5m from other parts. Another method is to hang a wood block in front of a rubber fender to
make the block projected from other parta.
(4) In the cases of large quaywalls where fenders are placed at wide intervals and the fenders for small ships are
placed in between them, it is preferable to adjust the front surfaces of the fenders for small ships backward of
those for large ships to some extent. If the front surfaces of the fenders for small ships are inadequately adjusted,
large ships may contact the fenders with a small energy absorption capacity before the fenders for large ships
sufficiently absorb the berthing energy of the ships, causing the serious increase in the reaction forces of the
fenders for small ships.
9.2.4 Performance Verification
[1] General
(!) It is preferable to appropriately select the types offenders taking account of the following:
CD
@ For mooring facilities subject to the effect of waves, the motions of moored ships and ship berthing conditions
such as berthing angles.
@ Effects of the reaction forces of fender systems generated during ship berthing on the structures of mooring
facilities
Variation ranges of the physical characteristics offenders due to manufacturing errors, dynamic characteristics
and thermal characteristics.
-877-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD It can be generally assumed that there is no energy absorption due to the deformation of the main bodies of such
rigid mooring facilities as gravity-type quaywalls, sheet pile quaywalls, quaywalls with relieving platform, and
cellular-bulkhead type quaywalls.
@ Detached piers, dolphins, piled piers, open-type wharves are classified into two types: one is the type with a
rigid structure and the other with a flexible structure. There is no energy absorption due to the deformation of
the former type facilities. On the other hand, there is energy absorption due to the deformation of the latter type
facilities because of their flexibility, and the energy absorption is generally given by equation (9.2.1).
'"
E 1 = ,1, g(y1)c:(y1
(9.2.1)
where
E1 : absorption energy due to the deformation of main body of mooring facility (Nm)
Yj : maximum displacement of main body of mooring facility (m)
g(y1) : characteristics of reaction force caused by the deformation of main body of mooring facility
(N)
Flexible facilities are normally made of steel materials. Since their performance required for the actions
caused by the berthing forces of ships is serviceability and the responses are within an elastic limit, the
relationship between the deflection and reaction forces of such mooring facilities is linear. When a mooring
facility and its fender systems completely absorb the berthing energy of a ship, the absorption energy of the
mooring facility is expressed by equation (9.2.2), where C denotes the spring constant of the quaywall.
(9.2.2)
The same shall apply to the absorption energy of pile type fenders.
@ The single pile structure (SPS) is a type of structure that absorbs the berthing energy by the deformation of
piles made of high tensile strength steel. In the performance verification of berthing dolphins that use SPS, it
is preferable to evaluate the amount of energy absorption considering the residual deformation of the piles due
to repeated berthing. As shown in Fig. 9.2.3, the amount of energy absorbed by piles is calculated from the
displacement obtained by subtracting the residual displacement from the loading point displacement.)
The loading point displacement with the residual displacement is calculated from equation (9.2.3).
Ph'
(9.2.3)
where
Ytop : displacement of the pile at loading point, considering residual displacement (m)
Yo : pile displacement at sea bottom at the time of initial loading (m)
i 0 : pile deflection angle at sea bottom at the time of initial loading (rad)
P : horizontal load (N)
h : height ofloading point (m)
EI : flexual rigidity of pile (Nm2)
Ai. A2 : influence coefficients due to repeated loading
The time of initial loading indicates the situation where the largest load is initially applied among the past
loadings.
-878-
Absorption energy
Absorption energy
The values of influence coefficients due to repeated loading based on the result of an in situ full-scale
loading experiment > and a model test 10) are proposed in Table 9.2.1.
Ai
1.4
0.4
0.8
Az
1.2
0.6
0.5
(9.2.4)
where
E, : absorption energy by fender (kNm)
iP : manufacturing error offender (tolerance)
Ecat : specified value of the absorption energy by fender (kNm)
Et : berthing energy of ship (kNm)
The characteristic value of the berthing energy of a ship Eft can be expressed by equation (2.2.1) in Part :n;
Chapter 8, 2.2 Actions Caused by Ship Berthing. Since the partial factors used for calculating the berthing
energy of a ship are set at 1.0 for all parameters, the design value of the berthing energy of the ship E1d is equal to
its characteristic value Eft.
(3) Energy Absorption by Fenders
There are various types of rubber fenders such as V-shaped, circular hollow, and rectangular hollow. Each of
these types differs from others in terms of the relationship between the reaction force and deformation as well as
the energy absorption rate. Manufacturers' catalogs show diagrams of the amount of energy absorption versus
the deformation, and those of the reaction force versus the deformation for each type of fenders. It is convenient
to use these diagrams.
Constant-reaction force type fenders such as V-shaped fenders are characterized with low reaction forces and
high energy absorption rates. It should be borne in mind, however, that the total reaction force to the mooring
facility may become large when a ship comes in contact with two to three fenders simultaneously. This is because
of the fact that the reaction force level rises nearly to the maximum value when the energy absorption rate reaches
to 1/3 of the design capacity on each fender.
(4) Consideration of Variation in Characteristics of Rubber Fenders
Factors that cause variations in characteristics of fenders include the product deviations from the standards,
-879-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
aging in quality, dynamic characteristics i.e. velocity-dependent characteristics, creep characteristics, repetition
characteristics i.e. compression frequency-dependent characteristics, oblique compression characteristics, and
thermal characteristics. In the fenders for floating structures, these factors are important in the evaluation of the
safety of the mooring equipment. In the funders for mooring facilities, it is necessary to verify the performance of
the fenders in consideration ofthe product deviations, dynamic characteristics, oblique compression characteristics
and thermal characteristics. For example, when the product deviation (tolerance) of the fender is 10%, it is
preferable to employ the energy absorption characteristics lowered by 10% from the catalog value and to use the
reaction force characteristics raised by 10% from the catalog value in the performance verification of the funders
and the mooring facility. With regard to dynamic characteristics, it is preferable to confirm that the reaction force
of the fender at the time of ship berthing shall not exceed the standard value shown in the catalog in consideration
of the berthing velocity of ships. It should also be borne in mind that the funder reaction force becomes higher in
a low-temperature environment than in the standard temperature environment.
It has been recommended by a working group of the International Navigation Association (PIANC) to
perform correction on the absorption energy and reaction force by applying correction coefficients of velocity and
temperature in the selection offender, in order to reflect changes in characteristics due to the environment in which
the funder is used such as the ship's berthing velocity and the temperature 11). The guideline 12) for the selection of
fenders by using these correction coefficients is published. Actual values of these correction coefficients should
be checked with the manufacturer, as they vary depending on the berthing velocity, temperature, and kind of
rubber used for the fender. It should also be borne in mind that the reaction force exerts on the quaywall may
become larger when a small ship is berthing at a high berthing velocity than when a large ship is berthing at a low
berthing velocity.
(5) The berthing forces of ships may cause a permanent deformation of ship hull, and hence the type offender systems
should be carefully selected)3). 14) It is preferable to fix contact panels in front of funders as necessary to reduce
loads on ship hull.
Since damage to ship hull is affected by not only the magnitude ofberthing force but also structural strength of
the ship hull, it is preferable to widen the contact area of each funder system so that the fender contacts two ribs of
the ship hull at the same time. Nagasawa 15) assumed that actions at the maximum berthing forces distributed over
a sufficiently wide area are uniform over more than the rib space. He proposed to calculate the critical berthing
forces causing plastic hinges to form at both ends of ship hull plate between ribs assumed as fixed condition. The
report 16) of PIANC's Fender COll3mittee includes the results of analyzing the effects of fender reaction forces on
the strengths of ship hull structures. Kawakami et al.13) performed the stress analysis of the ship hull structures
on which the reaction forces of fender systems were acted. The results indicate that when a fender system contacts
two or more ribs at the same time, the stresses exerted on the ship hull and the ribs are not greater than the yield
points if the surface pressure is 290 kN/m2 or less.
(6) A fender system should also be safe against the shearing force due to the friction between the fender and the ship
hull generated by oblique berthing of ships. This force can be normally calculated by the equation suggested by
Vasco Costa 17). When a ship is berthing to the quaywall at an angle of6 to 14with the face line of the berth, this
force becomes 10% to 25% of the berthing force of the ship.
-880-
Article 61
The performance criterion of lighting facilities shall be such that appropriate lighting facilities are installed
so as to enable the safe and smooth utilization of the mooring facilities where cargo handling works, berthing
and unberthing of ships, and going-in and going-out of people are taking place in consideration of the
utilization conditions of the mooring facilities concerned.
[Technical Nole]
9.3.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) Appropriate lighting facilities shall be provided at the wharves and related areas where cargo handling works such
as loading, unloading and transfer, berthing I leaving of ships, and use by passengers and others are carried out at
night, in consideration of the use conditions of the concerned mooring facilities.
(2) The description here may be applied to the installation, improvement, and maintenance of the lighting facilities at
the wharves where cargo handling, berthing and leaving, passenger use, etc. are performed at night.
(3) Many lighting facilities are designed these days to highlight the night views of structures, parks, watersides, etc. in
urban fringes and tourist sites in particular to meet social needs for the lighting and other facilities in port facilities.
In these cases, not only illumination but also light colors and color rendering properties are needed to give people
pleasure, familiarity, and peace of mind. On the other hand, as lighting facilities have come into wide use, it has
become essential to consider at the adverse effects oflighting oflighting on the surroundings and energy saving.
The performance verification of lighting facilities should fully take account of these demands. It is preferable
for the places where people interact such as amenity-oriented revetments, marinas, parks, promenades, etc. to
properly examine lighting functions and individually take necessary measures suited to individual facilities.
9.3.2 Standard Intensity of Illumination
[1] General
(!) Standard intensity of illumination is an average horizontal-plane illumination and defined as the minimum value
to safely and effectively use the facilities concerned. The objective generally used in designing lighting facilities
is illumination. The horizontal illumination means the illumination of a floor surface or a ground surface. The
The values shown in Table 9.3.1 may be used for the standard intensity of illumination of each type of outdoor
facilities.
-881-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 9.3.1 Standard Intensity of Illumination for Outdoor Lighting
Standard intensity
of illumination (Ix)
Facility
Apron
Yard
Wharf
Path
Security
50
30
20
20
c~o
75
50
Other paths
20
All facilities
1-5
Main roads
20
Other roads
10
For ferries
20
Others
10
Garden paths
Road
Road and Park
Parking lot
Park
Greensnace
The values shown in Table 9.3.2 can be used for the standard intensity of illumination of each type of indoor
facilities.
Table 9.3.2 Standard Intensity of Illumination of Indoor Lighting
Standard intensity
of illumination (Ix)
Facility
Waiting rooms
300
100
200
100
70
50
Passenger terminal
Shed and
Warehouse
{I) Light source for wharf lighting is preferably selected considering the following requirements:
CD
The light source shall be of a high efficiency and long service life.
@ The light source shall be stable against the variations of ambient temperature.
@ The light source shall provide a good light color and good color rendering performance.
@ The time of the stabilization of the light after turning-on shall be short.
(2) Any light source other than a light bulb shall be used together with an appropriate stabilizer.
-882-
Q) Lighting equipment shall be rainproof. When a large amount of flammable dangerous goods is to be handled in
the proximity of the lighting equipment, lighting equipment shall be explosion-proof.
@ Materials for the lamp, reflector surface, and illumination cover shall be of good quality and have high durability
and good resistance against deterioration and corrosion.
@ Sockets shall be of appropriate type for the respective light source.
@ Stabilizers and the internal wiring shall be capable of withstanding the expected increase in the temperature of
the equipment.
@ Luminous intensity distribution shall be controlled appropriately in consideration of the use of the equipment.
[2] Indoor Lighting
Lighting for indoor illumination shall be selected in consideration of the following requirements:
Q) Luminous intensity distribution shall be controlled appropriately in consideration of the use of the equipment.
@ Sockets shall be of appropriate type for the respective light source.
@ Stabilizers and the internal wiring shall be capable of withstanding the expected increase in the temperature of
the equipment.
@ Lighting equipment shall be of high-efficiency type.
9.3.5 Performance Verification
In the designing of lighting, the layout of lighting facilities shall be determined considering the items listed below for
the lighting method, light source, and equipment selected, in consideration of the characteristics of the area where the
equipment is to be installed. Those equipment whose influence area extends to the sea shall be deployed in such a way
that they do not hinder the navigation of nearby ships.
Q) Lighting status
@ Stain and damage to apparatuses
@ Flaking of paint
(2) Illumination intensity should be measured at several selected points in the typical places of each facility.
-883-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 62
The performance criteria of lifesaving equipment shall be such that appropriate lifesaving equipment is
provided and readily available as necessary so as to secure the safety of human beings on the mooring
facilities to serve for passenger ships with the gross tonnage being equal to or larger than 500 tons.
9.5 Curbings
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Curbing
Article 63
The performance criteria of curbing shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Curbing shall be installed at appropriate locations and provided with the dimensions necessary for
ensuring the safe utilization of the mooring facilities while not hindering ship mooring and cargo
handling in consideration of the structure types and the utilization conditions of the mooring facilities
concerned.
(2) The risk of impairing the integrity of curbing shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the
variable action situation in which the dominant action is collision of vehicles.
[Commentary]
Ordinance
<
33
lif
Design situation
Public Notice
requirements
l
~ ~< ~ ~
Non-dominating
Situation Dominating
action
action
Serviceability
Variable
"
63
"
1
Performance
Car crash
Verification item
Soundness of curbing
[Technical Nole]
9.5.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
The structure, shape, layout, and materials of curbing shall be set properly in such a way that the safety of users is
ensured and cargo handling work is not hindered, in consideration of the structural characteristics and the conditions
of use of the mooring facilities.
9.5.2 Performance Verification
The distance intervals between curbings need to be shorter than the wheel treads of the cargo handling equipment and
vehicles. They may be set at about 30cm in general to drain rainwater from the aprons. It is preferable, however, to set
the intervals of curbings, which are installed at both side of mooring posts, at 1.5 - 2.Sm. In the cases where vehicles
are not eXPected to pass because fences or other barriers are set up to prohibit the passage of vehicles, there is no need
to install curbings.
-884-
Article 64
The performance criteria of vehicle ramps shall be such that they satisfy the necessary specifications
corresponding to the dimensions and characteristics of vehicles which use the ramps.
[Technical Nole]
(!) A proper value not less than those given in Table 9.6.1 may be used as the widths of vehicle loading facilities.
Regarding movable bridges, it is preferable, however, to properly take account of the characteristics of their
structures. Small facilities means loading facilities exclusively used for small and light vehicles.
(2) A proper value not more than those given in Table 9.6.1 may be used as the slopes of vehicle loading facilities.
Regarding extension lengths of the horizontal parts, 7m and 4m are used for general type facility and small
facility, respectively. It is preferable to properly set the slopes of the facilities frequently used for loading large
container cars, taking account of the safety and conditions of use of large container car loading.
(3) The radii of the center lanes of curved sections may refer to the Enforcement Regulations for Road Strnctnres.
A proper radius of !Sm or more may be generally used for the curve radii.24)
(4) The range ofvertical movement distance ofthe movable part of small and general facilities is frequently determined
by adding Im to tidal range.
(5) It is preferable to properly install signs and marks depending on the characteristics and use conditions of the
structures of the facilities concerned.
Table 9.6.1 Widths and Gradient of Vehicle Loading Facilities
Number of
lanes
Width
(m)
3.00
5.00
3.75
6.50
4.00
7.00
fype offacility
Facility exclusively used for loading vehicles with a
width ofnot more than 1.7m (small facility)
-885-
Gradient (%)
Fixed part
Movable part
12
17
10
12
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Ordinance
..,
e-
1 "'
33
Public Notice
u
:S!
..,
e-
Performance
requirements
Serviceability
Variable
<
Jl
67
Design situation
Surcharge
-886-
Verification item
Soundness of fueling
pipes
[Technical Note]
(!) A mooring facility shall be provided, as necessary, with fueling and/or electric power supply facilities that allow
safe and efficient fueling and power feeding, in consideration of the size of ships to moor at the facility, situation
of the cargo handling, and structural characteristics of the mooring facility.
(2) Fueling and electric power supply facilities shall safely and efficiently supply a required quantity within the
mooring time of ships without disturbing cargo handling work, considering the scales of the ships at berth.
9.10 Passenger Boarding Facilities
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Passenger Boarding Facilities
Article 68
The provisions in Articles 91 or 92 shall be applied to the performance criteria of passenger boarding
facilities with modification as necessary.
9.11 Fences, Doors, Ropes, etc.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Fences, Doors, and Ropes
Article 69
The performance criteria offences, doors, ropes, and others shall be such that they are installed at appropriate
locations as necessary and provided with the necessary dimensions so as to secure the safety of passengers,
to reserve the space for passenger paths, to prevent the intrusion of vehicles, and others in the mooring
facilities and the related facilities.
9.12 Monitoring Equipment
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Monitoring Equipment
Article 70
The performance criteria of monitoring equipment shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The monitoring equipment shall be installed at appropriate locations as necessary and satisfy the
necessary specifications so as to secure the safety of passengers, to maintain the public security, to
prevent the intrusion of vehicles, and others in the mooring facilities and the related facilities.
(2) The monitoring equipment shall be provided with the functions necessary for preserving the monitoring
records.
[Technical Note]
[1] Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) International port facilities such as quaywalls and basins used by international ships shall provide and maintain
equipment to ensure security in compliance with the Law on Ensuring the Secnrity of International Ships and
Port Facilities (Law No. 31 of 2004). International ships mean the passenger ships engaged in international
voyage, i.e. voyage from a port in a country to a port in another country, and the cargo ships with a gross tonnage
of 500 tons or more.
(2) Monitoring equipment needs to be installed to enable monitoring in restricted areas considering the conditions of
use of the mooring facilities concerned and natural conditions in its vicinities.
(3) Monitoring equipment means monitoring cameras and related equipment.
-887-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
9.13 Signs
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Signs
Article 71
The performance criteria of signs shall be such that they are installed at appropriate locations as necessary
and satisfy the specifications required for indicating the locations of various facilities, guiding users, and
warning possible dangers, and others with the objectives of securing the safety and convenience of users and
preventing accidents and disasters.
[Technical Nole]
9.13.1 Placement of Signs and Marks
(!) In order to ensure the safety of port users and convenient use of ports, it is preferable to place signs and marks in
Q) When it is necessary to ensure that port users could arrive at their destinations smoothly and safely and to
provide guideboards for the location of port facilities.
@ When it is necessary to warn port users about dangers associated with the use of facilities and cargo handling
works.
@ When it is necessary to provide instructions to port users about methods to use facilities and guide them to
ensure safe and smooth use of facilities.
@ When it is necessary to regulate the behavior of port users to ensure their safety and smooth activities, to prevent
disasters such as fire and falling accident, and to prevent environmental pollution by littering.
9.13.2 Forms and Installation Sites of Signs
The forms of signs shall be such that those used for ordinary roads. It is preferable to properly determine the sizes,
colors, and character sizes so that port users can easily recognize them.
-888-
9.14 Aprons
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Aprons
Article 72
The performance criteria of aprons shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(I) Aprons shall be provided with the necessary dimensions for enabling the safe and smooth cargo
handling works.
(2) The surface of aprons shall be provided with the gradient necessary for draining rainwater and other
surface water.
(3) Aprons shall be paved with appropriate materials in consideration of imposed load and the usage
conditions of the mooring facilities.
(4) The risk of incurring damage to the pavement to the extent of affecting cargo handling works shall be
equal to or less than a threshold level under the variable action situation in which the dominant action
is imposed load.
[Commentary]
CD Width (usability)
Apron widths shall be properly set to allow safe and smooth cargo handling.
Gradient (usability)
Gradient of apron shall be properly set to drain water and other surface waters.
Pavements (serviceability)
Attached Table 58 shows the setting on the performance criteria and design situations (except
accidental situations) of apron pavements.
Attached Table 58 Setting on the Performance Criteria and Design Situations (excluding accidental situations) of Apron
Pavements
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
"
<
} }
33
-1l
e -1l
.!! "
<
2
72
e
.!!
4
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Serviceability
Non-dominating
Situation Dominating
action
action
Variable
Surcharge
Verification item
Soundness of pavement
[Technical Nole]
15
20
-889-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) The determination of apron widths of general cargo wharves shall normally take account of the spaces for cranes,
temporary storage, cargo handling, and traffic paths. It is preferable to set the widths at not less than 15 - 20m
when sheds are installed at the back and fork lifts are used, and not less than 10 - 15m when roads are at the back
and open storage yards are in the immediate vicinity and trucks are allowed to drive into the aprons for cargo
handling operations.
[2] Gradient of Apron
(1) Aprons are where cargo handling is performed and closely related to the conditions of cargo handling operation at
the backyards, and hence cross slopes need to be properly determined taking these conditions into consideration.
(2) Aprons normally have a down slope of 1 - 2% toward the sea. Shallow draft wharves have steep slopes. Aprons
in snowy places often have relatively steep slopes. In some cases, reverse slopes are used depending on the
conditions of use of aprons and environmental consideration.
(3) Since the settlement of backfilling may cause slopes to be reversed, construction should be carefully performed.
[3] Countermeasures for Apron Settlement
(1) For aprons, appropriate countermeasures need to be taken to prevent excessive settlement due to sand washingout or consolidation of the lower landfill material that would hinder cargo handling operation and the traffic of
vehicles.
(2) In general, the material below the subgrade of apron pavement is subject to settlement due to consolidation. There
is also a risk of settlement due to washing-out ofthe landfill material used as part ofthe layers below the subgrade
through joint sections of quaywall, or compression of the backfilling material behind the quaywall. There are
many cases of the failure of pavement that are thought to be attributable mainly to these types of settlement.
Therefore, it is preferable to consider measures for preventing these types of settlement such as the provision of
countermeasure against sand washing-out and the compaction ofthe backfilling material behind the quaywall.
9.14.2 Performance Verification
[1] General
The types of apron pavements shall be properly selected in a comprehensive judgment taking account of the soil
properties below the subgrade, constructability, surrounding pavement conditions, cargo handling methods, economic
efficiencies, and maintenance.
[2] Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(1) The performance verification of apron pavements shall be such that pavement structures are stable under the
surcharges by cargo handling vehicles and related equipment.
(2) Fig. 9.14.1 shows an example ofthe performance verification procedures of apron pavements.
Setting of design conditions
Evaluation of actions
Performance verification
,,
: ::
r--------------------- -----------------------------,
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
----------------------i-----------------------------"
Fig. 9.14.1 Example of Procedures for the Performance Verification of Apron Pavements
[3] Actions
-890-
the ground contact areas on which surcharges are applied, setting the maximum surcharges and the ground contact
pressures to make the pavement thickness become maximum.
(2) The characteristic values ofthe surcharges used for the verification ofapron pavements may refer to Table 9.14.2.27>
Outriggers are applied to the cases of movable cranes, where a wheel means a single wheel or dual wheels i.e. two
wheels are laterally connected. In the cases where the loads of actually used cargo handling equipment can be
precisely set, this table may not be used.
-891-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 9.14.2 Characteristic Values of the Actions considered in the Performance Verification of Apron Pavements
Type of action
(cargo handling equipment load)
Movable crane
truck crane,
rough terrain crane,
all terrain crane
Truck
Tractor trailer
Fork lift truck
Type20
Type25
Type 30
Type40
Type 50
Type 80
Type 100
Type 120
Tvoe 150
25 ton class
for 20ft
for 40ft
2t
3.5t
6t
lOt
15t
20t
25t
35t
Straddle carrier
Ground contact
pressure (N/Cin2)
176
200
221
236
247
271
277
290
300
100
50
50
71
75
75
81
82
83
85
86
81
It is preferable to perform the verification of concrete pavements both on base course thickness, and concrete
slab thickness considering, cyclic numbers of actions, conditions of the bearing capacities of roadbeds.
-892-
..
I
;
I Evaluation of actions I
-
Performance verification
r--------------------'
''
'
''
-------y~ri;.;,-;,-sbt~ ~; -s~;~:h;.:g~ :
''
'
----------------------~-----------------------------"'
Fig. 9.14.2 Example of the Procedures of Performance Verification for Concrete Pavements
(2) Design Conditions
Q) The design conditions considering the performance verification are generally as follows:
(a) Design working life
(b) Conditions of Action
(c) Cyclic numbers of actions
(d) Subgrade bearing capacity
(e) Materials used
@ Action conditions
The design action conditions are those requiring the maximum concrete slab thickness among the types of
actions to be considered. The characteristic values of actions may be set referring to Table 9.14.3. The partial
factors used for calculating design values may be set at 1.0. The "Action classification" in Table 9.14.3 is the
classification needed when using (3) @ (d) Empirical method of setting concrete slab thickness.
-893-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 9.14.3 Reference Values for the Action Conditions of Concrete Pavements used for the Aprons of Quaywalls and
Other Facilities
Action classification
Type of action
Fork lift truck
Tractor trailer
Fork lift truck
Fork lift truck
CP1
CP2
Truck
Fork lift truck
Straddle carrier
CP3
Action(kN)
Ground contact
radius (cm)
2t
for 20ft, 40ft
3.5t
25
50
10.6
17.8
13.8
17.8
6t
25 ton class
lOt
75
100
125
125
17.8
22.2
22.2
15t
185
26.8
Type20
220
19.9
20t
245
30.7
Type25
260
20.3
45
(a) The design bearing capacity coefficient K 30 of the subgrade can be obtained from the results of the plate
loading test specified. The design bearing capacity coefficient K 30 is generally set as the value corresponding
to a settlement of 0.125cm. It is preferable to perform plate loading tests at one or two locations per 50m in
the faceline directions of quaywalls.
(b) When setting the design bearing capacity coefficientK30 in an area ofsubgrade made of the same materials, it
is preferable to calculate the values of K 30 from equation (9.14.1) using the measured values of three or more
points excluding extreme values.
(Bearing capacity coefficient K 30 of subgrade)=
(Average of bearing capacity coefficients of multiple points)
-{ (Maximum value ofbe~g capacity coefficient)- (Minimum value of bearing capacity coefficient)}
(9.14.1)
where
C : coefficient used for calculating bearing capacity coefficients. The values in Table 9.14.4 may
be used.
Table 9.14.4 Reference Values for the Coefficient C
Number of test
ooints (n)
10 or more
1.91
2.24
2.48
2.67
2.83
2.96
3.08
3.18
(c) When the subgrade has already been constructed, the bearing capacity coefficient should be obtained by
performing a plate load test on the subgrade at the condition of maximum moisture content. When it is not
possible to conduct a plate loading test in such condition, the bearing capacity coefficient should be obtained by
correcting the value using equation (9.14.2). The CBR values in equation should be obtained from undisturbed
soil samples.
-894-
(9.14.2)
K1
K
(b) The base course thickness of concrete pavements may be set referring to Table 9.14.S prepared based on the
past records.
-895-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 9.14.5 Reference Values for Base Course Thickness of Concrete Pavements
Design condition
Design bearing
Uooer subbase course
capacity
coefficient of base Cement stabilized
Graded grain
courseK30
base
material
rN/cm3)
40
50 or more and
20
less than 70
25
20
70 or more and
20
less than 100
15
15
20
100 or more
15
20
30
20
15
-
20
-
15
-
15
-
60
40
55
35
40
30
30
20
15
2.5
[1Q)
CP~
40
45
50
55
-896-
= 10{(!.000-SL)/0.044)
'
N = 10{(!.077-SL)/o.011)
'
N = 10{(!.224-SL)/o.118)
where
'
I.O;>:SL>0.9
0.9;>:SL>0.8
O.S;>:SL
(9.14.3)
(9.14.4)
where
FD : degree of fatigue
n1 : cyclic number of wheel load i
N 1 : allowable cyclic number of wheel load stress imposed on concrete slab
3) Setting of Concrete Slab Thickness
Using the degree of fatigue as the failure criterion of a concrete slab, concrete slab thickness is set so that
the degree of fatigue FD is equal to 1.0 or less.
(d) Empirical method of setting concrete slab thickness
1) The concrete slab thickness set referring to the empirical values given in Table 9.14.5 may be considered
to have the same performance as the one set using the method of (c) Setting Concrete Slab Thickness.
Action classification
CP1
20
CP2
25
CP3
30
CP4
Applied to piled pier slab
35
10
2) The "Action classification" in Table 9.14.6 corresponds to the one given in Table 9.14.3. It should be
noted in classifying actions that there are cases where the maximum loads are not equivalent to the value
shown in Table 9.14.2. In such cases, the classification with the closest and larger value is used. For
example, if the maximum load per outrigger of a truck crane is 120kN, it is regarded as a type 20 truck
crane; if the maximum load per wheel of a fork lift truck is 64kN, it is regarded as a 6 ton fork lift truck.
3) In Fig.9.14.4, it is preferable to verify the concrete slab thickness by separately, for the load plotted at the
right side of a curve of type 25 truck crane.
4) Regarding the setting of concrete slab thickness based on the values given in Table 9.14.6, it is preferable
to take account of PC pavement and continuously reinforced concrete pavement for the design load
exceeding CP4, because non-reinforced concrete pavement needs a very thick slab. Since cranes such as
truck cranes have larger ground contact pressures than other cargo handling equipment, it is preferable to
lay iron plates or the like under the outriggers to reduce pressure when using them on aprons.
(4) Structural Details
CD
-897-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
@ Ironmesh
(a) It is effi:ctive to bury iron mesh in a concrete slab structure to prevent cracking.
(b) It is preferable to overlap the junctions of reinforcing bars. The overlap length and the depth ofthe reinforcing
bars from the surface need to be properly set considering the thickness of the concrete slab.
@Joints
It is preferable to place joints on concrete pavements to allow the concrete slabs to expand, shrink, and warp
freely to some extent, reducing stresses.
(a) Joints of the concrete pavement of apron shall be arranged appropriately, considering the size of apron,
structure of mooring facilities, the type ofjoint and load condition. In addition, joints shall have a structure
that is appropriate for the type of joint.
(b) Longitudinal joint
l} Longitudinal construction joints shall generally be press-type structured and made of tie bars. Tie
bars are, however, not used for piled pier slabs. It is preferable for the longitudinal joints adjoining the
superstructures of quaywalls and sheds to have a structure using both joint sealing compounds and joint
fillers. It is preferable to set longitudinal joints at proper intervals depending on paving machines used,
total pavement widths, and traveling crane beds. It is preferable to place longitudinal joints on the shoulder
of backfill, the joints of quaywalls, and the position of sheet-pile anchorages to reduce the effects of change
in bearing capacity of and below base courses and the joints of quaywalls.
2) Tie-bars are provided to prevent adjoining slabs from separating, and sinking I rising of either slab at
joints. Tiebars also serve as a reinforcement to transfer the sectional force. Because the apron pavement
has a relatively small width and is peysically constrained by the main structure of the quaywall or sheds,
separation of apron concrete slabs at joints rarely occurs. However, it is necessary to provide tie-bars
at longitudinal construction joints to prevent sinking I rising of either slab at joints due to differential
settlement of layers below the base course, and to accommodate a wide variety in the directions of traffic
load that is not observed on ordinary roads.
(c) Transverse joints
1) Transverse shrinkage joints
Transverse shrinkage joints shall generally be dummy-type structured and made of dowel bars. On piled
pier slabs, however, dowel bars are not used. It is preferable for shrinkage joints to be placed on the joints
of quaywalls.
2) Transverse construction joints
Transverse constructionjoints shall generally be press-type and made of dowel bars. On piled pier slabs,
however, dowel bars are not used. Transverse construction joints are placed at the end of daily work
or inevitably placed due to rain during construction or the failures of construction machines or other
equipment. It is preferable for transverse construction joints to fit position with transverse shrinkage
joints.
3) Transverse expansion joints
It is preferable for transverse expansion joints to generally have a structure using both joint sealing
compounds and joint fillers in upper and lower parts and use dowel bars. On piled pier slabs, however,
dowel bars are not used. It is preferable to set transverse expansion joints at proper intervals depending
on construction conditions. Expansionjoints are the weakest points of pavements, hence, consideration is
needed for reducing the number of their placement points as much as possible.
4) Dowel bars
Dowel bars have a function to transfer loads and prevent the unevenness of adjoining slabs. In either case
of transverse shrinkage joints, transfer construction joints, or transfer expansion joints, dowels bars are
placed to fully transfer loads.
-898-
6-lOmm
~
(1/4 -1/6)h
/Tie bar
----'--1~;:::;:::::::::::::;::::::::s::====::::::::~
Chair
Wood stand
Dowel bar
(This side is coated with paint and grease, or with two layers ofbitumen.)
Fig. 9.14.5 Longitudinal Construction Joint
20-30mm
40-50mm
h/2
h L i=;:;:~::;:;::~~:==:;:;:~...,_ 25 -
35mm
Cap
Chair
Joint filler
Dowel bar
(11s side is coated with paint
and grease, or with two layers of bitumen.)
(a) Tie bars and dowel bars shall be properly selected considering the traveling loads imposed on apron pavements
in all directions.
(b) The specifications and placement intervals of tie bars and dowel bars may refer to the values shown in Table
9.14.7.
Table 9.14.7 Reference Values for the Specifications and Placement Intervals of Tie Bars and Dowel Bars
Action
classification
Slab
thickness
(cm)
CP1
20
Diameter
<cm)
25
Tiebar
Length
Interval (cm)
Diameter
(cm)
Dowel bar
Length
(cm)
fem)
Interval (cm)
80
45
25
50
45
CP2
25
25
100
45
25
50
45
CP3
30
32
100
40
32
60
40
CP4
35
32
100
40
32
60
40
Note: The values of tie bars and dowel bars are those ofSD295A (deformed steel bar) specified inns G 3112
and ofSS400 (round steel bar) specified in JIS G 3101, respectively.
@ End protection
An end protection work along the landward side ofpavement shall be provided at a location where there is a risk
of destruction of the base course due to infiltration of rain water or destruction of the concrete slab and base
course due to heavy loading.
-899-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) The design conditions considered in the performance verification are generally as follows:
(a) Design working life
(b) Action conditions
(c) Cyclic numbers of actions
(d) Bearing capacity of subgrade
(e) Materials used
Conditions of action
Among the kinds of subject actions, the conditions of action shall be those requiring the maximum asphalt
pavement thickness.
,------------------------
'
I
~------------------------ -------------------------------~
Determination of pavement section
(9.14.5)
Design CBR can be obtained from equation (9.14.6) using the above-defined CBR excluding extreme values.
Design CBR = Average CBRs for all test points -
(9.14.6)
where C is given in Table 9.14.4.
-900-
pavement sections are not less than required equivalent conversion sections.
(b) Required equivalent conversion asphalt concrete pavement thickness
Required equivalent conversion asphalt concrete pavement thickness TA is calculated from equation (9.14.7).
The variables subscripted with d mean design values.
T
Ad
_ 3.84N/
CBR 0'
16
(9.14.7)
where
(9.14.8)
where
P1
n1
:
:
T:=f [ak]
(9.14.9)
l=l
where
Layer
Requirements
Equivalent
conversion
factor
Remark
LOO
AC I-AC IV
0.80
A-treated material II
0.55
A-treated material I
Grading adjustment
Corrected CBR 80 or
greater
0.35
Grading adjusted
material
Corrected CBR 30 or
s:reater
0.25
Corrected CBR 20 to 30
0.20
Construction method I
material
Surface and
Hot asphalt mixture for
binder courses surface and binder courses
Bituminous stabilization
Base course
Subbase
course
etc.
Grain material
-901-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
replace it with one using good quality materials or to add a water sealing layer. If it is less than 2, it is preferable
to replace it with good quality materials and set the pavement thickness once again.
Table 9.14.9 Reference Values for Action Conditions of Action for Asphalt Pavements on Aprons of Quaywalls
Cargo handling machine
Action classification
AP1
AP2
AP3
AP4
Tractor trailer
Fork lift truck
Fork lift truck
20ft, 40ft
2t
3.5t
6t
10!
!St
25 ton class
Tvne 20
fype25
@ The type and material quality of asphalt concrete can be set as listed in Table 9.14.11
ACI
ACII
For surface course
50times
75times
4.9 or greater
8.8 or greater
20-40
20-40
3-5
2-5
75-85
75-85
AC III
ACIV
For binder course
50times
75times
4.9 or greater
8.8 or greater
15-40
15-40
3-6
3-6
65-80
65-85
Note: The columns of "number of blows 75 times" apply to cases where the ground contact pressure of tire with the design load is 70 N/cm2
or greater, or where the traffic of large vehicles is heavy and rutting is expected.
-902-
AP1
Equal to or above 3
Equal to or above 5
and less than 8
Equal to or above 8
and less than 12
Equal to or above
12 and less than 20
Equal to or above
20
AP2
Equal to or above
12 and less than 20
Equal to or above
20
APi
AP4
Surface course
Composition of pavement
Base course
Subbase
Total thickness
course
Type
h1(cm)
Type
h2(cm)
Type
hi(cm)
"4(cm)
H(cm)
TA (cm)
AC!
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
s
AC III
2S
3S
70
2S.8
AC III
Grading adjusted
material
A-treated material I
Grading adjusted
2S
20
3S
2S
6S
2S.8
22.0
material
A-treated material I
SS
Grading adjusted
20
IS
30
AC III
20
45
material
A-treated material I
AC III
Grading adjusted
IS
IS
30
IS
40
material
A-treated material I
IS
20
40
17.3
AC III
Grading adjusted
IS
IS
40
18.3
material
A-treated material I
IS
IS
AC III
4or
3S
9or
16.3
-
AC!
AC!
AC!
AC!
AC!
AC!
AC!
AC!
AC!
AC!
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
ACII
20
Binder course
ACII
ACII
realer
ACIV
2S
3S
70
2S
3S
2S
6S
2S.8
20
SS
22.0
Grading adjusted
ACIV
ACIV
ACIV
s
4or
realer
ACIV
IS
ACIV
ACIV
10
IS
ACIV
ACIV
10
IS
ACIV
ACIV
10
IS
ACIV
ACIV
10
IS
ACIV
ACIV
10
4or
ereater
ACIV
IS
19.3
18.3
ACIV
so
22.0
19.3
Grading adjusted
material
A-treated material I
ACIV
SS
material
A-treated material I
Grading adjusted
material
A-treated material I
Grading adjusted
material
A-treated material I
Grading adjusted
material
A-treated material. I
realer
2S.8
20
30
SS
22.0
IS
20
4S
19.3
IS
30
so
19.3
IS
IS
40
18.3
IS
20
40
17.3
IS
IS
40
18.3
IS
IS
3S
9or
16.3
-
realer
Grading adjusted
material
A-treated material Il
30
4S
9S
40.0
20
2S
4S
80
30
7S
40.0
34.8
20
IS
20
20
SS
SS
3S.O
29.3
IS
IS
IS
IS
4S
Grading adjusted
30.0
28.3
material
A-treated material Il
so
IS
IS
4S
Grading adjusted
IS
IS
material
A-treated material n
so
IS
IS
4S
9or
Grading adjusted
material
A-treated material Il
Grading adjusted
material
A-treated material Il
30.0
28.3
30.0
-
Grading adjusted
40
60
120
46.0
material
A-treated material n
20
Grading adjusted
30
70
4S
!OS
9S
39.S
ereater
ACIV
ACIV
10
IS
ACIV
ACIV
10
material
A-treated material Il
20
40
7S
39.0
IS
Grading adjusted
2S
30
7S
34.8
ACIV
ACIV
10
IS
3S
6S
34.0
IS
2S
60
30.3
ACIV
ACIV
10
IS
IS
IS
IS
IS
4S
Grading adjusted
30.0
28.3
ACIV
ACIV
10
4or
material
A-treated material Il
so
IS
IS
4S
30.0
9or
IS
a:reater
material
A-treated material Il
Grading adjusted
material
A-treated material Il
a:reater
4S.O
Note: In case of the deck slab of piled pier, the boxes of the binder course in Table 9.14.10 refer to the value for the total of filling material and binder course. This
does not necessarily have to be asphalt concrete.
-903-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 73
1 The performance criteria of the foundations for cargo handling equipment shall be as specified in the
subsequent items in consideration of the types of cargo handling equipment and the structural type of
foundations:
(1) The foundations shall have the dimensions necessary for enabling the safe and smooth operations of
cargo handling works, traveling of cargo handling equipment, and others.
(2) The foundations shall satisfy the following criteria under the variable action situation in which the
dominant actions are Level I earthquake ground motions and imposed load:
(a) In the case of pile-type structures, the risk that the axial force acting on a pile may exceed the
resistance stress caused by ground failure shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(b)In the case of pile-type structures, the risk that the stress in a pile may exceed the yield stress shall
be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(c) The risk of impairing the integrity of beam components shall be equal to or less than the threshold
level.
(d) In the cases of pile-less structures, the risk ofbeam sliding shall be equal to or less than the threshold
level.
(3) The amount of beam deflection shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the variable
action situation in which the dominant actions is imposed load.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria for the foundations of
cargo handling equipment to be installed on the higb earthquake-resistance facilities shall be such that
the degree of damage owing to the action of Level 2 earthquake ground motions, which is the dominant
action of the accidental action situation, is equal to or less than the threshold level corresponding to the
performance requirement.
[Commentary]
-904-
Ordinance
];!
t:
"'~
<
1 "'
33
Public Notice
u
~
t:
<
73
"'~
~ "'
"
1
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
Dominating Non-dominating
action
action
2a Serviceability Variable L1
earthquake
Self weight,
earth pressure
Verification item
pile1)
ground
f--
2b
motion
Yield ofpileIJ
(Surcharge'~)
f--
2o
f--
2d
f--
(Surcharge'~)
Self weight,
earth pressure
Sliding ofbeam*2)
Deflection of beam
*1) L1m1ted to the structures where foundation piles are used for the foundations for cargo handling equipment
*2) Limited to the structures where foundation piles are not used for the foundations for cargo handling equipment
*3) It is an action applied from a cargo handling machine to its foundation and is properly set according to design situations.
-905-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Attached Table 60 Setting on the Performance Criteria and Design Situations limited to Accidental Situations of the
Foundations for Cargo Handling Equipment in High Earthquake-resistance Facilities
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
,!!
~
<
73
~
"
<
33
1
8
,!!
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Situation
Dominating Non-dominating
action
action
Restorability Accidental L2
earthquake
ground
motion
Self weigh~
surcharge, earth
Verification item
Damage
value
pressure
[Technical Nole]
9.15.1 Fundamentals of Performance Verification
(!) The specifications of the foundations for cargo handling equipment shall be properly set according to the types
of cargo handling equipment and the structural types of foundations to allow safe and smooth cargo handling
operations and the safe and smooth traveling of cargo handling equipment.
(2) The foundation for rail-type traveling cargo handling equipment needs to be designed appropriately in consideration
of the external forces that act on the foundation, allowable displacement for the foundation, degree of difficulty of
maintenance, effects on the wharf structure, and construction and maintenance costs.
(3) Fig. 9.15.1 shows an example of the procedures for the performance verification of the foundations for cargo
handling equipment.
-906-
4----------------,
. - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - . i , Determination of design conditions 1
1
.,
.....----Performance verification--------+-------------------~
Variable states on
surcharges and
Level 1 earthquake
g~U_!l~ ~~!_i~~ - - - -
,.
other facilities
Examination of effects
on mooring facility I
Examination on stresses
generated in piles and
axial forces acting on piles
Examination on section
forces generated in concrete
beams and other components
Examination on section
forces generated in concrete
beams and other components
...
Examination on
concrete beam sliding
Variable states in
respect of surcharges
~-----------
surcharges
Examination on deflection
::
~-------,----~
11
i
~+----Y
1
'
..-----------~
~----------- -----------~:
Examination on deflection
amounts of concrete beams
1__ - - - - - - - - -
H'C-------'J:---------1--1
-- - -- - -- - -- -
*2
.-----~----~
:1
Examination on overall
structures and components
according to structural types
'
:------------------ -----------------------1----~~f~~~:;i:~~~~!~i
:
..
l-------------------~-----------------------1---------------------------J
1 Since the evaluation of the effects of liquefaction is not included in this chart, it should be considered separately.
2 The foundations for cargo handling equipment installed in high earthquake-resistance facilities are verified on Level 2 earthquake ground
motions.
Fig. 9.15.1 Example of Procedures of the Performance Verification forthe Foundations for Cargo Handling Equipment
(4) Types of Foundations for Rail Traveling Equipment
CD Foundation type that connects piles by reinforced concrete beams on pile foundations
This type is used for soft ground where uneven settlement is expected. It is also used for the foundations for
large cargo handling equipment on good quality sand ground.
@ Foundation type that uses other facilities such as the main bodies of mooring facilities
This type uses the reinforced concrete beams of piled piers, the main bodies of mooring facilities, such as the
superstructures of caisson-type quaywalls or the wall anchorages of sheet-pile quaywalls as the foundation
for the cargo handling equipment. The performance verification of facilities shall be conducted in advance
considering the actions caused by cargo handling equipment. In such cases, overall construction costs are
-907-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
often reduced. When one leg is on the main body of a mooring facility and the other leg is on an independent
foundation, caution is needed to avoid uneven settlement. It should be noted that ground motions may cause the
displacement of crane foundations, resulting in the displacement or derailing of crane legs. Rigid legs of gantry
cranes are normally not placed on piled piers. Since the tip of jetty-type piled piers are weak to the actions
caused by ship berthing or tractive forces or earthquakes, special reinforcement is needed.
Item
Rail span
Lateral and vertical warps ofrail
Elevation difference between
seaward and landward rails
Gradient in the travelling direction
Installation standards
Maintenance requirements
1/500 or less
50 mm or less for the entire rail
leno1:h
Rail joints
11250 or less
80 mm or less for the entire rail
len2th
Vertical and lateral differences: Imm
or less
Gap: 5 mm or less
Straightness
9.15.2 Actions
(I) Forces that act on the foundation for cargo handling equipment shall be determined appropriately in due
consideration of the type, and operation conditions.
(2) The forces are assumed to act on the entire length of rails during operation or earthquakes. At the time of storms,
the forces assumed to act on the section where the crane is stationed.
(3) For the wheel loads that act on the rails when the crane is operational, a traveling load that is equal to 1200/o of the
maximum static wheel load can be considered. However, this can be considered to be ll0% of the maximum static
wheel pressure of the crane when the traveling speed is less than 60 m/min.34)
9.15.3 Performance Verification of Pile-type Foundations
[1] Concrete Beams
(I) The performance verification of concrete beams placed on pile foundations may be conducted assuming that they
are continuous beams supported by pile heads. The effects of beams contacting the ground are ignored.
(2) Concrete beams constructed on pile foundation need to be stable against the contact pressure between the rail and
concrete, and against the stress transmitted from the rail.
(3) The rail stress is usually calculated by assuming that the rail is an infinite continuous beam supported by elastic
foundation. This method is often used for the cases where the wheel loads are spread over the beam by inserting
an elastic material such as rubber pads between the rail and the concrete beam to prevent crushing of concrete.
(4) Solving Method of the Infinite Continuous Beam Supported by Elastic Foundation
The rail stress and the contact pressure between the rail and concrete can be calculated using the method described
in 9.lS.4 [2]Concrete Beams. In this case, the symbols Ee, Jc, and Kin equation (9.lS.4) should be replaced as
follows:s
Ee : modulus of elasticity of the rail
-908-
(7) The fastening force between the rail and the foundation can be calculated by using the beam theory on elastic
foundation,36) but it is necessary to have a sufficient allowance to avoid the effect of impact. For calculation of the
fastening force for the cases where the double elastic fastening method is employed, refer to Minemura's study.37)
In many cases, bolts with a diameter of about 22 mm are used at intervals of about 50 cm.
[2] Maximum Static Resistance Forces of Piles
(!) Piles shall be stable against the actions caused by cargo handling equipment and foundations.
(2) The action that exerts on the piles should be the reaction force at each supporting point calculated in accordance
with [1] Concrete Beams.
(3) The maximum static resistance forces of piles may be calculated referring to Part Ill, Chapter 2, 2.4 Pile
Foundations.
(4) In the cases where piles are affected by the surfaces of rupture of active earth pressures, the performance
verification of bearing piles described in 2.8 Quaywalls with Relieving Platforms may be referred to.
(5) When piles are under the influence of the active earth pressure failure plane, the required embedment length
differs between the seaward piles and landward piles. However, it is common practice to use foundation piles of
the same length for both the seaward and landward, to avoid a differential settlement of the foundation. When the
piles are driven into the bearing stratum, there is no need to use the same embedded length.
9.15.4 Performance Verification in the Cases of Pile-less Foundation
[1] Analysis of Effect on Quaywall 38)
(!) When no pile is used to support the foundation for cargo handling equipment, the effect of the actions of the cargo
handling equipment and its foundation on the main structure of mooring facilities shall be examined.
(2) Application of surcharge on the area behind a gravity-type structure increases the earth pressure and may cause
forward sliding of the quaywall. The influence of a concentrated load on the earth pressure is large in the zone at
the levels immediately below the loading point. But the influence becomes smaller as the depth increases. When
the quaywall height is small and the quaywall lengthis short, care should be given because of strong influence
of concentrated load. When the load is applied directly on a quaywall, the subsoil reaction force increases.
In particular, when the load is applied on the quaywall at its front end, the subsoil reaction force at the front
toe becomes significantly large. In a quaywall of small width and short length, this tendency of reaction force
increase is amplified and thus care should be given.
(3) In ordinary sheet pile quaywalls, the maximum stress occurs between the tie member installation point and the
sea bottom. However, when a concentrated load is expected to act on the area behind the sheet pile wall, the
maximum stress may occur at the level near the tie member installation point. The concentrated load, however,
rarely causes an adverse effect on the embedded part of the sheet pile. It is preferable to provide a sufficient causes
earth covering thickness for the tie members to avoid adverse effects on the tie members.
(!) The reinforced concrete beams placed on the rubble foundations laid on the ground shall ensure stability against
flexural moments, shear forces and deflection, and their amounts of settlement shall be less than a limit value of
settlement.
(2) The characteristic values of the flexural moments, shear forces and deflection of the reinforced concrete beams
placed on rubble foundations can be obtained from equations (9.15.1) - (9.15.6). The variables subscripted with k
denote characteristic values.
CD
M,
= ~:~~L,w;e-P"(cospx; -sinpx;)
-909-
(9.15.1)
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(9.15.2)
y
64EJ,K 3
~)v,e-P'(cosftx, +sinpx,)
(9.15.3)
(9.15.5)
(9.15.6)
where
M : flexural moment at subject section (N- mm)
S : shear force at subject section (N)
y : amount of deflection at subject section (mm)
P=~
E,
w;
l,
K
C
b
x,
(3) The reinforced concrete beams placed on rubble foundations are assumed to be supported by continuous elastic
foundations of a uniform section over the entire length. In other words, it is assumed that the reaction forces of
loaded beams are continuously distributed and their strengths are directly proportional to the amount of deflection
at each point. Assuming the moment generated at a point of a distance X from the traveling wheel as Mand the
deflection as y, Mandy are expressed by equations (9.15.7) and (9.15.8), respectively, by an elastic theory.39), 49)
M,
= W'fEJ:e-P'(cospx-sinftx) = W~EJ, (\
y=
V64K'
W
~64EI K'
' '
64K
e-P(cospx+sinpx)
~64E I K'
' '
(9.15.7)
;,
(9.15.8)
When two or more wheels are close to each other, the flexural moment directly under an arbitrary wheel is
obtained from equation (9.15.9).
M1,
=W,.Jfil
\J64K
(9.15.9)
(9.15.10)
The resultant moment directly under the first wheel can be determined from M = M 1 + M2 Equation (9.15.1)
can be derived from this expression. Deflection can be obtained in the same way. The values given by the
following expression may be used for the values of C.39), 41)
C = 5.0XJ0-2-0.15 (N/mm2)
-910-
References
I)
Inagaki, M., K. Yamaguchi and T. Katayama: Standard design of mooring post (Draft),, Technical Note of PHRI No.102,
1970
2) UEDA, S. and E. 00!: On the Design ofFending Systems for Mooring Facilities in a Port, Technical Note ofPHRI No596,1987
3) Ueda, S., T. Umemura, S. Shiraishi, S. Yamamoto, Y. Akakura and H. Yamase
4) Ueda, S., Hirano, T., Shiraishi, S., Yamamoto, S. and Yamase, S.: Reliability Design Method of Fender for Berthing Ship,
Proc. Int'! Navig. Congr. (PIANC), Sydney, pp.692-707, 2002
5) Nagao, T., T. Okada, N. Iwata, H. Matsumoto, M. Ishida and Y. Sato: A study on the performance-based design of quay walls
under berthing condition, Technical Note of National Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management No.63, 2003
6) YONEYAMA, H., Hironao TAKAHASHI and Ayako GOTO: Proposition of Partial Factors on Reliability-Based Design
Method for Fenders, Technical Note of PAR! No.1115,2006
7) Kitajima, S., Hiroshi SAKAMOTO, Shohei KISHI, Takuji NAKANO and Syusaku KAKIZAKI: On Some Problems Being
Concerned with Preparation for the Design Standards on 'Port and Harbour Structures, Technical Note of PHRI No,30,
1967
8) Coastal Development Institute of Technology : Guideline for design of SPS (Single pile structure), 1992
9) Kiuchi, S., M. Matsushita, M. Takahashi, M. Kakee, S. lsozaki and M. Suzuki
10) KIKUCHI, Y., K. TAKAHASHI and M. SUZUKI: Lateral Resistance of Single Piles under Large Repeated Loads, Rept. of
PHRI Vol. 31 No.4, PP. 33-60, 1992
11) PIANC: Report of PIANC Working Group No.33 "Guidelines for the Design of Fenders", Supplement to Bulletin, 2000
12) Permanent International Association ofNavigation Congress: Guideline of Fender system 2002Version, Sea Port Committee,
33rd Report of Working Group, p,133, 2005
13) Kawakami, M., H. Shinkawa, K. Tanaka and J. Kurasawa: Relation between structural strength of hull and fender, Report of
School of Engineering, Hiroshima Univ., Vol. 24, Part I, p,133, 2005
14) Tukayama, A.: Strength of ships for docking, Journal of Nippon Kaiji Kyokai,No.151,1975
15) Nagasawa, J.: Berthing force and strength of onter plate of ship, Ships, Vol.40 No,3, pp.46-50, 1967
16) PIANC: Report of the International Commission for Improving the Design of Fender Systems, Supplement to Bulletin,
No.45, 1984
17) Vasco Costa: The berthing ship, The Dock & Harbour Authority, Vol.XLV, May-July, 1964
18) Japan Port Association, Examples of design calculation of port structures (Vol. I), pp.112-153, pp.257-300, 1992
19) UEDA, S. and S. SHIRAISHI: On the Design of Fenders Based on the Ship Oscillations Moored to Quay Walls, Technical
Note of PHRI No.729, 1992
20) Japan Road Association: Standard and Commentary of Highway Lighting Facilities, Maruzen Publishing, 1996
21) Japan Lighting Committee: Guide for lighting of outdoor work place, HCA Translation Publications No. 9, Maruzen
Publishing, 1989
22) The illumination Engineering Institute of Japan: Maintenance rate for lighting design and maintenance planning, Technical
Guideline of The illumination Engineering Institute of Japan,, HEG-001, Maruzen, 1987
23) Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Design Manual of Buffer Stop, 1994
24) Japan Road Association: Commentary of enforcement regulations for road structures and application, Maruzen Publishing,
execntion, pp.309-316,2004
25) Japan Road Association: Road earth works- Guideline of drainage works, pp.9-75,1994
26) SATO, K., H. MORIGUCHI, T. ASAHMA and H. SHIBUYA: Control of shrinkage Cracking of Concrete Pavements on Pier
Slabs, Rept. ofPHRI Vol. 14, No. 2, pp. 111-138, 1975
27) Ozawa, K. and S. Kitazawa: Setup method of deciding number ofloads by cargo handling machine, in designing of pavement
wharf apron, Technical Note of National Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management No.285, 2006
28) Japan Road Association: Design and Construction Guideline for Pavement, Maruzen Publishing, 2002
29) JSCE: Standard Specifications for concrete, (Pavement), 2002
30) NAGAO,T., Hiroshi YOKOTA,Koichiro TAKECHI,Susumu KAWASAKI and Noboru OKUBO: Fatigue Limit State Design
Method for Superstructures of Open 'fype Wharves in view of Cargo Handling Machine Loads, Rept. ofPHRI Vol.37 No.2,
pp.177-220, 1998
31) Japan Association of Cargo-handling Machinery System: Survey report on standardization ofrelated facilities, (6ht Report),
1998
32) Japan Association of Cargo-handling Machinery System: Survey report on standardization of related facilities, (5th Report),
1997
Japan Association of Cargo-handling Machinery System: Report of Survey and Study Committee of Container cargohandling facilities, 1993
34) Architectural Institnte of Japan: Design standards for steel structure, p.4, 1994
35) Yokoyama, Y.: Design and construction of steel piles, Sankai-do Publishing, pp.99-111, 1963
36) Japan Society of Mechanical Engineers: Mechanical Engineering Lectures Cargo handling equipment, p.239,1959
33)
37) Minemura, Y.: Lecture note for rail connection and maintenance course, Japan Railway Maintenance Association, p,4,1958
38) KITAHMA, S. and 0. HORII: The Influence of Mobile cranes on Quaywalls, Technical Note ofPHRI No.29, pp4-62, 1967
-911-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
39)
40)
41)
42)
-912-
Ministerial Ordinance
General Provisions
Article JS
1 The performance requirements for port transportation facilities shall be such that the port transportation
facilities satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism
so as to enable the safe and smooth usage of vehicles and ships in consideration of its facility type in
light of geotechnical characteristics, meteorological characteristics, sea states and/or other environmental
conditions, as well as the traffic conditions in the port and its hinterland.
2 The performance requirements for port transportation facilities shall be such that port transportation
facilities have structural stability against self weight, earth pressure, water pressure, waves, water currents,
earthquake ground motions, imposed loads, winds, flames and heat from fires, collision with ships and/or
other actions.
Ministerial Ordinance
Necessary Items concerning Port Transportation Facilities
Article 40
The items necessary for the performance requirements of port transportation facilities as specified in this
chapter by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism and other requirements shall be
provided by the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Article 74
The items to be specified by the Public Notice under Article 40 of the Ministerial Ordinance concerning
the performance requirements of port transportation facilities shall be provided in the subsequent article
through Article 79.
Public Notice
Article 75
The performance criteria common to port transportation facilities shall be such that port transportation
facilities are appropriately located and have the required dimensions in consideration of the trip generation,
the projected traffic volume, the environmental conditions to which they are subjected, smooth connection
with other traffic facilities, the utilization of other traffic facilities, and others so as to secure the safe and
smooth traffic in the port.
-913-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
2 Roads
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Roads
Article36
1 The performance requirements for roads shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Roads shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and
Tourism so as to ensure the safe and smooth flow of traffic within the port and between the port and the
hinterland in consideration of the traffic characteristics in the port.
(2) Damage due to imposed loads shall not adversely affect the continued use of the relevant roads without
impairing their functions.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for roads having
tunnel sections shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Damage due to self weight, earth pressure, water pressure, and Level 1 earthquake ground motions,
and/or other actions shall not adversely affect the continued use of the relevant roads and not impair
their functions.
(2) Damage due to Level 2 earthquake ground motions, flames and heat from fires, and/or other actions
shall not affect restoration through minor repair works ofthe functions required for the roads concerned.
[Technical Note]
Tunnels
Stability of facility
It is necessary to ensure the restorability in an accidental situation regarding Level 2 earthquake ground
motion and flames and heat from a fire. This is specified considering the facts that when a tunnel is
heavily damaged as a result of the effect of the accidental situation, there are serious consequences on
human lives, properties and/or social and economic activities and it is difficult to perform large-scale
restoration work in the tunnel.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Roads
Article 76
The performance criteria of roads shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) In the case of a road which is used by many tractor-semitrailers and others, the tractor -semitrailers may
be set as the design vehicle.
(2) The pavement structure shall be appropriately specified in consideration of the traffic volume of special
vehicles such as tractor-semitrailers and mobile cranes.
(3) The lanes and others shall satisfy the following criteria so as not to cause traffic congestion in the port
area:
(a) The number of lanes shall be appropriately set in consideration of the projected traffic volume,
which is determined by taking account of the utilization conditions of the port situated near the road
concerned, and the design standard traffic volume, which is the maximum allowable vehicle traffic
volume per hour on the road.
(b) The lane width shall be 3.25m or 3.5m in principle. Provided, however, that the lane width of 3.5
m shall be the standard in the case where the traffic of large vehicles is heavy, and the lane width
may be reduced to 3m under unavoidable circumstances such as the constraints of topographical
conditions and others.
(c) A stopping lane shall be provided in the leftmost part of the road as necessary so that it may not
hinder the safe and smooth passage of vehicles.
(4) Roads that are exclusively used for pedestrians and bicycles shall have appropriate structure in
consideration of the utilization conditions of the facilities of the port situated near the road concerned.
(5) In case of the roads on which special vehicles such as tractor-semitrailers carrying tall containers,
-914-
mobile cranes and others are expected to travel, the clearance limits of the road shall be appropriately
set so as to secure the safe passage of these vehicles.
(6) Roads that are connected to the high earthquake-resistance facilities shall be appropriately routed so
as to secure the functions required for the facilities concerned in the aftermath of the action of Level 2
earthquake ground motions.
(7) With regard to the structure, place and facilities of roads, the matters which are not prescribed in the
preceding items shall be pursuant to the provisions of the Enforcement Regulations for Road Structures
(Cabinet Order No. 320 of 1970) in consideration of the characteristics of the traffic generated in the
port.
[Commentary]
(1) Performance Criteria of Roads
Lanes
(a) Number oflanes
1) When verifying the performance of a road, the number of lanes may be set based on the values
of the design standard traffic volume according to the type of the road shown in Attached Table
61.
Attached Table 61 Design Standard Traffic Volume
Design standard traffic volume
TypeofRoad
(vehicles per hour)
Roads that connect a port and a national highway
650
Other roads
500
volume associated with the industries located in and around the port, the traffic volume associated with such facilities
as green areas and marinas.
-915-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) Estimation of the Originating and Terminating Traffic Volume of a Road in a Port
CD
@ Estimation method for the traffic volume associated with physical distribution
(a) The traffic volume associated with physical distribution may be estimated using the basic units which are
obtained from the past records or forecasts of the cargo handling volume in the port (FT unit), and the number
of containers handled in the port (TEU unit). It is preferable to determine the basic units based on the past
records of the cargo handling volume and container handling volume in the ports of which characteristics
are similar to that of the target port and the actual records of the traffic volume obtained from the actual
condition survey data, and road traffic censuses. However, when it is difficult to estimate these basic units,
the following estimation methods may be used as a reference.
The concept of setting the coefficient here may also apply to the setting of other coefficients in the
performance verification of roads.
(b) Estimation method based on the cargoes handling volume in the port (FT/year) for the case of cargo other than
containers
1) Estimation method using the total cargo handling volume in the port
The trip generation and attraction per year may be estimated using equation (2.2.1) based on the total
cargo handling volume in the port (FT/year) at the target year.
Trip generation and attraction per year (vehicles/year)
~ Total quantity of cargoes handled in the port a0bc
where,
a0
(2.2.1)
coefficient for conversion into the number of loaded large vehicles which carries cargoes, which
cover all commodity items
a coefficient for conversion into the number of loaded large vehicles which carries cargoes
(vehicles/FT), which is the reciprocal value of the capacity tonnage per a large vehicle which
carries cargoes (FT/vehicle), on the assumption that most of the cargoes handled in ports are
transported by large vehicles.
-916-
2) Estimation method using the item-specific cargo handling volume in the port
In cases where the volume of certain cargo items are especially large, the annual trip generation and
attraction per year may be estimated using equation (2.2.2) based on the item-specific cargo handling
volume in the port (FT/year) at the target year.
Trip generation and attraction per year (vehicles/year)
= {
(2.2.2)
where,
a; : coefficient for conversion into the number of large vehicles which carry cargoes by item
a coefficient for conversion into the number of large vehicles which carries cargoes (vehicles/
FT), which is the reciprocal value of the capacity tonnage per a large vehicle which carries itemspecific cargoes (FT/vehicle), on the assumption that most of the cargoes handled in ports are
transported by large vehicles.
b : coefficient for conversion into the number of all large vehicles
c : coefficient for conversion into the number of all vehicles
(c) Estimation method based on the number of containers handled in the port (TEU/year)
(for the case of container cargoes)
The trip generation and attraction per year may be estimated using equation (2.2.3) based on the number
of containers handled in the port {TEU/year) at the target year.
Trip generation and attraction per year (vehicles/year)
= Number of containers handled in the port (1-T, )F.B.a.P.r10.
where,
T7
Fe
Be
ae
Pc
ycl
Yeo
Yet
t5c
(2.2.3)
Transshipment ratio
A coefficient to subtract the number of containers transshipped at the terminals from the number
of containers handled in the port (TEU/year) by the subtraction (1-T,.).
: Full container ratio
The ratio ofthe number of full containers to the number ofnon- transshipped containers, which
is used to calculate the number of containers transported from the terminals to the hinterland.
: Extension coefficient to include the flow of empty containers
The transport of a full container into or out of the port is always accompanied by the transport
of an empty container. For this reason, Be is used to convert the number of transports of full
containers into the number of transports of both full and empty containers. The maximum
value of2.0 is generally set for Be, but a smaller value may be used in cases where it is expected
that the container van transport becomes more efficient. For domestic trade containers, a value
between 1.0 and 1.5 may be used for Be because empty containers are less transported.
: Coefficient for conversion into the actual number of vehicles which carry containers
In a port, 20-feet containers and 40-feet containers are handled together. Normally, the transport
of a 20-feet container requires one vehicle, while the transport of a 40-feet container also
requires one vehicle. For this reason, ac is used to convert the number of containers expressed
in the TEU unit (i.e. twenty-foot equivalent unit) to the actual number of containers.
: Coefficient for conversion into the number of all container-related vehicles
A coefficient to convert the number of vehicles which carry containers into the number of all
container-related vehicles including the head vehicles and chassis tractors which do not carry
containers.
: Coefficient for conversion into the number of all large vehicles
A coefficient to convert the number of all container-related vehicles into the number of all large
vehicles including ordinary large cargo vehicles. The coefficient Yci has the following two
coefficients according to the conditions of the target area.
: For cases where it is assumed that an integrated physical distribution center is not constructed
: For cases where it is assumed that an integrated physical distribution center is constructed
: Coefficient for conversion into the number of all vehicles
The ratio of the number of all vehicles including small and medium vehicles to the number of
all large vehicles. The reciprocal of t5c represents the occupancy ratio oflarge vehicle.
:
Estimation method of the traffic volume associated with the industries located in and around the port
(a) The traffic volume associated with the industries located in and around the port may be estimated using the
basic units which are obtained from the past records or forecasts, based on the lot area, total floor space,
and number of employees of the industries. It is preferable to determine the basic units based on the actual
-917-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
conditions of the industries in the ports which are similar to the examined target port such as the lot area, total
floor space, number of employees and the past results of traffic volume which are obtained from the actual
condition survey data, and road traffic censuses. However, when it is difficult to estimate these basic units,
the following estimation methods may be used as a reference.
(b) Estimation method using the basic units presented in the National Survey on the Net Movement of Cargoe11
(Physical Distribution Censu11) 3)
The traffic volume associated with the industries located in and around the port may be generally estimated
using the staged estimation method shown in Fig. 2.2.2.
Assumption of the lot area and number of employees ofthe industry by type of business
CD Estimation ofthe incoming and outgoing cargo volume (MT unit) using the basic units for the incoming and
outgoing cargo volume per lot area (m2) by type of business
Estimation of the incoming and outgoing cargo volume (MT unit) using the basic unitsfor the incoming and
outgoing cargo volume per one employee by type of business
Setting of the incoming and outgoing cargo volume (MT unit) through comparative examination of
the estimation results of both CD the lot areas and the numbers of employees
Estimation of the annual incoming and outgoing cargo volume by type ofbusiness (MT unit) carried by
automobile using the automobile transport share by type of business and the following formula:
Annual incoming and outgoing cargo volume by type of business (automobile)=
Annual incoming and outgoing cargo volume by type of business xautomobile transport share
Estimation of the annual incoming and outgoing cargo volume from the annual incoming and outgoing cargo
volume carried by automobile (MT unit) using equation (2.2.4) or (2.2.5)
Fig. 2.2.2 Estimation Method of the Traffic Volume associated with the Industries Located in and around the Port based
on the "National Survey on the Net Movement of Cargoes"
1) In the case of an estimation intended for the total value of all items:
Trip generation and attraction per year (vehicles/year)
(2.2.4)
2) In the case of estimation intended for the values by type of business (by item):
'frip generation and attraction per year (vehicles/year)
~
={
(2.2.5)
where,
aMT :
0
coefficient for conversion into the number ofloaded large vehicles which carry cargoes (intended
for all items)
A coefficient for conversion into the number of loaded large vehicles which carry cargoes
(vehicles/MT), which is the reciprocal value of the capacity tonnage per a large vehicle which
carry cargoes (MT/vehicle), on the assumption that most of the incoming and outgoing cargoes
are transported by large vehicles.
-918-
aMT';
Estimation method of the traffic volume associated with green areas, marinas and other facilities
(a) The traffic volume associated with green areas, marinas and other facilities may be estimated using various
basic units obtained from past results and forecasts. It is preferable to determine the basic units based on the
size and capacity ofthe existing facilities which are similar to those of the target facilities, and the past results
of the traffic volume obtained from the field survey data, road traffic censuses and other sources. However,
when it is difficult to estimate these basic units, the following estimation methods may be used as a reference.
(b) Estimation method of the traffic volume associated with green areas
The traffic volume associated with green areas may be estimated in terms of the peak daily traffic volume,
usually using equation (2.2.6) and equation (2.2.7).
Peak traffic volume per day (vehicles/day)
= Number of peak users per day Pa Pb
Round trip traffic volume conversion coefficient
Number of peak users per day (persons/day)(
)
1
=Total area of the green areas (m2) area of
area
erson (m2)
Turnover number
green
per p
Return trip traffic volume conversion coefficient = 2
(2.2.6)
(2.2.7)
where,
Pa : Utilization rate of automobiles to visit green areas
Pb : Passenger vehicle conversion coefficient(=! /average number of boarding persons)
(2.2.8)
(2.2.9)
CD
-919-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(a) In general, when estimating the design daily traffic volumes, it is preferable to use the 4-stage estimation
method based on the incoming and outgoing traffic volume, which is a technique for traffic planning. The
4-stage estimation method is the technique to estimate traffic volumes in 4 stages as shown in Fig. 2.2.3. 6)
Estimation of the incoming and outgoing traffic volume
-920-
(2.2.10)
(2.2.11)
where,
m = monthly peak ratio
w = day-of-week peak ratio
[(I+[;;;')/(I+~;;")]
(2.2.12)
where,
T.port : Share oflarge vehicles assumed for roads in the port(%}
T.IDwn : Share oflarge vehicles assumed for roads at the periphery of the port
(S)Estimation of the Design Hourly Traffic Volume of Roads in a Port
(2.2.13)
where,
K : Ratio of the design hourly traffic volume (usually the 30th hourly traffic volume) to the design
daily traffic volume (annual average daily traffic volume) (%)
It is preferable to determine the value of K corresponding to the 30th per hour traffic volume (hereinafter
referred to as "the K30 value") based on the characteristics of each port. There are several methods to estimate
the K 30 value: the estimation using a model which includes the design daily traffic volume. The following shows
the concrete techniques of each method.
K,o
where,
K 30
IOO{(aQp + b) I Qn}
(2.2.14)
percentage ("/o) of 30th hourly traffic volume relative to design traffic volume (annual average of
daily traffic volume). Provided, however, that K 30 is 18% or less.
Qp : peak hourly traffic volume (total of inbound and outbound) (vehicles/hour)
Q12 : daytime 12-hour hourly traffic volume (total of inbound and outbound) (vehicles/hour)
a, b : coefficients for calculating 30th hourly traffic volume from peak hourly traffic volume; values
are shown in Table 2.2.1.
:
-921-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Table 2.2.1 Coefficients for Calculating 3Qth Hourly Traffic Volume from Peak Hourly Traffic Volume
Roadside condition
Ci"'
Flatland area
Mountainous area
a
1.12
1.06
1.01
b
20.4
167.5
377.6
(2.2.15)
where,
AADT: Annual average of daily traffic volume (vehicles/day)
....
.
20
\
\a.-
18
16
-. -.
14
~
~
~"
>c
12
10
8
.
_
-
y = 248.9JC-0 3283
R'=0.7435
2
'
10,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
50,000
CD
(2.2.16)
-922-
(2.2.17)
@ Determination method of the number oflanes for multi-lane roads (2 or more lanes in one side)
(a) Judgment as to whether multiple lanes are required
When setting the number of lanes, the number of lanes in the following cases shall be multilane, ie. 2 or
more lanes in one direction. In this case, the number of lanes in one direction may be set according to the
procedures described in (b) and (c).
1) Roads that connect a port with a national highway etc.:
Design hourly traffic volume (for both directions) (vehicles/hour)
>650 (vehicles/hour)
(2.2.18)
2) Other roads:
Design hourly traffic volume (for both directions) (vehicles/hour)
>500 (vehicles/hour)
(2.2.19)
where,
D
(K,.
)(_IJ_)
100 100
(2.2.20)
: Ratio of the traffic volume in the heavier-traffic direction to the design hourly traffic volume(%)
If the traffic volumes are analyzed on an hour-by-hour basis, it can be seen that the peak-hour traffic
volumes in both directions differ significantly. If the numbers of lanes are set based on the total value of the
design hourly traffic volumes in both directions, the serviceability of the road during the peak hour is low.
Therefore, it is preferable to estimate the design hourly traffic volume for the heavier-traffic direction using
theDvalue.
In addition, it is preferable to set the D value according to the characteristics of the target ports.
(c) Determination of the number oflanes ofone side
The number oflanes of one side in the case ofa multi-lane road may be set comparing the design hourly traffic
volume for the heavier-traffic direction with the design standard traffic volume for multi-lane roads which
have 2 or more lanes in each direction described above. In principle, the integer obtained by rounding up the
result of the calculation with equation (2.2.21) or equation (2.2.22) shall be used as the required number of
lanes in the heavier-traffic direction.
1) Roads that connect a port with a national highway etc.:
Number oflanes in the heavier-traffic direction (lanes)
=Design hourly traffic volume fur the heavier-traffic direction (vehicles/hour)
I 600(vehicles/hour/lane)
(2.2.21)
2) Other roads:
Number oflanes in the heavier-traffic direction (lanes)
=Design per hour traffic volume for the heavier-traffic direction (vehicles/hour)
I 350(vehicles/hour/lane)
(2.2.22)
The total number of lanes of a road may be set by doubling the number of lanes obtained according to
the above procedures, because the number oflanes of the road should be an even number except fur special
cases.
@ Estimation of the D value
Procedures to estimate the D value in concrete way are as follows ; the estimation from results of continuous
traffic volume observations and the estimation from actual measurements taken on the routes with similar
characteristics and traffic conditions. Actual procedures are shown below.
(a) Estimation method based on the actual measurements taken on the similar roads or on the neighboring roads
Traffic Capacities of Roads 9) presents equation (2.2.23), which uses heavier-traffic direction coefficients for
-923-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
the peak hour of the survey day to accurately calculate the diffurence between the traffic volumes in the two
opposite directions, thinking of the fact that the D value is almost constant during the heavy traffic hours. In
equation (2.2.23), the passenger vehicle equivalent number of vehicles (pcu/hour) for the 2 opposite directions
is used.
D
(2.2.23)
where,
D : Ratio of the traffic volume in the heaviel'-traffic direction to the design hourly traffic volume(%)
Pu : Traffic volume in the inbound direction during the peak hour (pcu/hour)
Pd : Traffic volume in the outbound direction during the peak hour (pcu/hour)
-924-
CD
The Guidelines for Designing and Constructing Pavements IO) present, as the method of determining the
traffic volumes for structural design of pavements, (a) the method based on the large vehicle traffic volume and
(b) the method based on the wheel loads of moving vehicles.
:
:
:
:
:
In the Guidelines, the term "large vehicles" stands for ordinary freight vehicles, buses and special
vehicles.
(b) The method based on the wheel loads of moving vehicles
The method based on the wheel loads of moving vehicles is the method to estimate the size distribution
of moving vehicles. The cumulative 5-ton-equivalent number of wheels during the design working life is
calculated from the numbers of moving vehicles for each wheel load range, taking into account the rates of
traffic volume increase. When converting the traffic volume (NJ for the given wheel load (P J into the traffic
volume (N15 ) for the 5-ton wheel load, the so-called "fourth power method" shown in equation (2.2.24) is used.
N, 5 =
/',)4
(-t N,
(2.2.24)
where,
N,5
P1
N1
:
:
@ The method described in (a) above is simpler than the method described in (b). However, in cases where
circumstances require, such as where it is expected that heavy vehicles such as semi-trailer trucks and mobile
cranes go through, it is preferable to apply (b) in which the properties of the traffic can be considered.
-925-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
References
Takahashi, H.: Study of designing roads in the port area A standard fur designing roads in the port area : A proposal-,
Research Report of National Institute fur Land and Infrastructure Management No.21,2005
2) Information Management Department, policy Bureau, Ministry of Land, Infrastructure and Transport: Port Statistics (
2002),, 2004
3) Ministry of Land, Infrastructure and Transport (MLlT): Survey Report of National Cargo Net Flow, MLIT, 2002
4) Traffic survey division, Urban transport Bureau, Ministry of Construction: Manual for planning of transport related to large
scale development zones, Gyosei, 1999
5) Japan Port Association, Manual for development of port green belt, Japan Port Association, 1976
6) JSCE Edition: Transport Planning, New Series Civil Engineering 60, Gilio-do Publishing, 1993
7) Japan Road Association: Traffic capacity of roads, Japan Roads Association, 1984
8) OKUDA, K., MURATA, T. and OKANO, H.: An Analysis on Characteristics of the Road Traffic in Port Area Based on the
Yearly Traffic Observation, Technical Note of PHRI No.876, 1997
9) JSCE: Concrete Standard Specifications, Specifications for concrete (Pavement), 2002
10) Japan Rosa Association: Guideline fur design and construction of pavement, 2001
1)
-926-
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Roads
Article36
1 The performance requirements for roads shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Roads shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and
Tourism so as to ensure the safe and smooth flow of traffic within the port and between the port and the
hinterland in consideration of the traffic characteristics in the port.
(2) Damage due to imposed loads shall not adversely affect the continued use of the relevant roads without
impairing their functions.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for roads having
tunnel sections shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Damage due to self weight, earth pressure, water pressure, and Level 1 earthquake ground motions,
and/or other actions shall not adversely affect the continued use of the relevant roads and not impair
their functions.
(2) Damage due to Level 2 earthquake ground motions, flames and heat from fires, and/or other actions
shall not affect restoration through minor repair works ofthe functions required for the roads concerned.
Public Notice
Performance Criterion of Underwater Tunnels
Article 77
1 The performance criteria of underwater tunnels shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Underwater tunnels shall be covered with an appropriate material of the required thickness so as to
secure the integrity of the structural members and the stability of their structures against dropping and
dragging of ship anchors, scouring of seabed by waves and/or currents, and others.
(2) Underwater tunnels shall be equipped with the control facilities necessary for their safe and smooth
use.
(3) The degree of damage owing to the actions of Level 2 earthquake ground motions, and fires and heat by
fires, which are the dominant actions in the accidental action situations, shall be less than the threshold
level.
2 In addition to the provisions of the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of underwater tunnels
shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The risk of failure due to insufficient bearing capacity of the foundation ground under the permanent
action situation, in which the dominant action is self weight, shall be less than the threshold level.
(2) The risk of impairing the integrity of structural members under the permanent action situation, in
which the dominant action is earth pressures, shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(3) The risk of floating-up of the immersed tunnel elements, ventilation facilities and shafts under the
variable action situation, in which the dominant action is water pressures, shall be equal to or less than
the threshold level.
(4) The risk of impairing the integrity of structural members and losing the stability of immersed tunnel
elements, ventilation facilities, shafts, joint sections and others under the variable action situation, in
which the dominant action is Level 1 earthquake ground motions, shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level.
[Commentary]
-927-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
When determining the covering material and covering thickness in the perfurmance verification of
an underwater tunnel, appropriate consideration should be given to the stability of the underwater
tunnel against uplifting, the effects of the penetration of anchors caused by casting and dragging
from ships navigating over the underwater tunnel and the scouring of the covering sections due to
water flows and waves.
(b) Accidental situations (restorability)
1) The settings of the performance criteria common to underwater tunnels and the design situations
limiting to accidental situations are shown in Attached Table 63. [The reason why setting
"damages" as the verification item in the Attached Table 63 is that it aims to describe in a
comprehensive manner considering that the verification items vary depending on the structure
and structural type of the facility].
Attached Table 63 Settings relating to the Design Situations limiting to Accidental Situations and Performance Criteria
Common to All Underwater Tunnels
Ministerial
Ordinance
~< l~
35
36
Design situation
Public Notice
~< l~ l;
requirements
77
"
" "
I
Performance
Dominating action
Index of standard
Verification item
Non-
Situation
limit value
dominating
action
L2 earthquake ground
motion
Damages
Self weight,
earth pressures,
water pressures,
surcharges
Ministerial
Ordinance
u
:g
1~
35
Public Notice
u
:g
-ae
Design situation
Performance
requirements
11
77
36
Earth pressures
2
~
Variable
Water pressures
Non-dominating
action
L1 earthquake
ground motion
Bearing capacity
limit value
Uplifting of immersed
tunnel elements,
ventilation facilities and
shafts
Index of
standard limit
value
Verification item
-928-
3.1 General
(!) The explanations in this section may be used for the performance verifications of tunnels constructed ofroads in
a port by the immersed tunnel method (hereinafter referred to as immersed tunnels). For tunnels of other use or
other type, it is necessary to apply other relevant standards.
(2) In the performance verifications of immersed tunnels for port roads, The Technical Manual for Immersed
Tunnels I) may be used as a reference. When making a general study on the design, fabrication and construction
of the immersed tunnel method, Refurence 2) may serve as a reference. In addition, when examining the seismicresistant performance, it is prefurable to use Reference 3) as a reference.
Ventilation tower
Ventilation tower
\J
'-/_
en-cut
Section
Land tunnel
section
Land tunnel
section
Access road
Open-cut
sectioh
Access road
Immersed tunnel
-929-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(4) Main body of an immersed tunnel shall be a fireproof structure, and safety facilities and equipment, and evacuation
passages for use under fire shall be provided. In addition, evacuation passages and emergency telephones for use
in the event of an accident or a disaster should be provided as necessary.
(5) The longitudinal slope of an immersed tunnel may be made as steep as possible within the restriction of design
speed for the road to enable reduction of construction cost in general. However, consideration should be given to
the fact that smoke and dust concentration in the exhaust gas of vehicles increases rapidly as the slope becomes
steeper, thus raising the cost of ventilation equipment.
(6) Immersed Tunnel Elements
CD The structural types of immersed tunnel elements are classified into steel shell type,
reinforced concrete or
prestressed concrete type, and composite or hybrid type. The most appropriate structure should be selected in
light of their individual characteristics.
@ A steel shell type immersed tunnel element is constructed by building the steel shell first and then filling the
inside space of the shell with concrete. The loads that act on a completed steel shell type immersed tunnel
element are basically borne by the reinforced concrete in the steel shell. Concrete type immersed tunnel
elements also have a covering made of thin steel sheet for protection and waterproofing. Therefore, there is no
clear essential difference between these two types. It is considered that in a composite type, concrete and steel
sheet are integrated with shear connectors and that not only the concrete but also the steel sheet bears the loads.
@ Steel shell type immersed tunnel elements require a large amount of steel, but do not always require a dry dock
because they can be constructed in a shipway. On the other hand, concrete type immersed tunnel elements do
not require a large amount of steel, but do require a deep dry dock. When selecting the type of an immersed
tunnel element in a specific case, consideration should be given to the fabrication yard, economical efficiency,
and constructability.
Composite type elements, particularly that ofsteel-concrete combined structure, may be designed and constructed
according to the references 4) and 5).
(7) Management Facilities and Equipment
Management facilities and equipment include the facilities and equipment for ventilation, emergency, lighting,
electric-power, security and measurement, monitoring and control, and drainage. In cases where a ventilation
tower is constructed as a ventilation facility, it is necessary to allocate functionally the ventilation equipment,
electrical equipment, control equipment and other ancillary equipment. It is also necessary to install connection
ducts that connect the ventilation tower with the main body of the tunnel, inlet ports and exhaust ports so that
efficient ventilation may be achieved.
CD
The top surface ofimmersed tunnel elements shall be covered with appropriate material ofthe required thickness
so that the structural safety of the elements may be ensured taking into consideration the penetration depth of
anchor caused by casting and dragging of ship's anchor, the frequencies of anchoring and dragging of anchor,
the buoyancy of the tunnel, and the scouring due to waves and water flows. In principle, it is preferable that the
thickness of the cover layer, which includes the thickness of the concrete layers to protect the upper slab, is 1.5m
or greater
@The depth of immersion shall be set appropriately in consideration of any future plan of deepening of the water
in and around the tunnel.
@ The structural type and the length of an immersed tunnel element shall be determined in consideration of the
sectional forces, the joint structure, the size of the fabrication yard, the tunnel element installation and joint
construction methods, and the economical efficiency of the immersed tunnel structure including joints. In
general, an immersed tunnel element length of around lOOm is employed.
In accordance with the structure of an immersed tunnel element, fireproof material may be required. In such
cases, the thickness of fireproof material shall be considered in determining the dimensions of inner cross
section of the tunnel.
(2) Ventilation Towers
CD
The structures of the ventilation towers for an immersed tunnel need to be studied with an appropriate method
corresponding to the characteristics of the facilities and grounds.
@ Ventilation machines, electrical facilities and equipment, and control facilities and equipment should be installed
-930-
@ Sufficient space should be provided inside a ventilation tower so that monitoring, inspection, and minor repair of
the installed equipment can be performed smooth. In particular, large components such as ventilation machines
should be so designed that their transport into and out of the tower is easily executed.
@ The location and structure of inlet ports should be such that the intake of exhaust gas from the outlet or from the
entrance of the tunnel is kept as little as possible.
@ The location of outlet ports should ensure that concentration of exhaust gas at the ground level remains under a
tolerable level.
Q) The structure of access roads shall be designed with due consideration to the traffic under planning, natural
conditions, social conditions, construction methods and construction cost.
@ The road surface elevations of the entry and exit sections of an access road should be determined taking into
consideration the connection with other roads, the elevation of the neighboring grounds, the infiltration of
seawater or river water during storm surges, and the longitudinal gradient of an immersed tunnel.
Q) It shall be standard to examine the structural stability of the immersed tunnel section in both the longitudinal
and transverse directions of the tunnel.
@ When examining the stability in the transverse direction ofthe immersed tunnel, its main body may be generally
regarded as a rigid frame structure. In the longitudinal direction of the immersed tunnel, its main body may be
regarded as a beam supported on elastic springs of the ground.
@ Whether the foundation has the sufficient capacity to support the weight of the immersed tunnel including the
soil on its top should be examined. Due consideration should also be given to the settlement of foundation.
@ Ground motion can be transmitted to the immersed tunnel from every direction. However, in the performance
verification, the tunnel is usually examined for two directions; the transverse direction, in which the tunnel is
subjected to the maximum flexural moment and shearing force, and the longitudinal direction, in which the
tunnel is subjected to the maximum axial force.
An immersed tunnel can be constructed in a soft ground. In such a case, it is necessary to confirm that no
sliding will occur in the surrounding ground when subjected to ground motion. In addition, it is necessary to
perform analyses and evaluations to ensure stability against liquefaction.
@ Appropriate materials should be selected for filling considering the safety against settlement and surfacing,
liquefaction due to earthquake, and maintenance dredging to keep the depth of navigation channel.
!J) An immersed tunnel is a structure under the seabed and is often constructed in soft ground. Sufficient
examination should be made so that its functions should not be lost due to water seepage from cracks or joints.
(2) Examination of the Stability oflnunersed Tunnel Elements
Q) Immersed tunnel elements shall have safe structure in consideration of the following factors as necessary.
(a) watertight capability
(b) cracking of the concrete
(c) uplifting of the element body due to buoyancy after installation
(d) ventilation and disaster prevention functions
(e) other functions attached in the immersed tunnel elements
@ It is preferable to apply waterproof coating on the circumference of the elements to make assurance double sure
on watertightness.
-931-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) Joints of an immersed tunnel shall have sate structure against the stresses generated by the action of ground
motion.
@ The location and structure of joints of immersed tunnel elements are normally determined in consideration of
the size of fabrication yard, shifting of waterways, capacity of construction machines, uneven settlement of
the foundation after completion, and influence of temperature variation. However, the location and structure
of joints are also important factors in assessing the earthquake resistance of an immersed tunnel. Thus, the
earthquake resistance needs to be adequately examined when determining the joint location and structure.
@ A joint between an immersed tunnel element and a ventilation tower should also be analyzed and evaluated
adequately in the same manner as in the case ofjoints between immersed tunnel elements.
Immersed tunnel joints are generally classified into two structural types: "continuous structure" which has
the same stiffness and strength as those of the cross sections of the immersed tunnel elements so as to endure
deformation, strain during the permanent actions, earthquake and other actions; and "flexible structure" which
has the sufficient flexibility to absorb the deformations during the permanent actions, earthquake and other
actions
The water pressure connection method and the underwater concrete casting method are popular as the connection
method for connecting immersed tunnel elements together underwater and making the primary water sealing.
In recent years, the water pressure connection method has been used more than the underwater concrete casting
method.
@ For joints of the last part of an immersed tunnel, the dry work method, the waterproof panel method, the
V-block method, and the key element method have been proposed. It is preferable to determine the method in
consideration of the location, structure, construction method, and workability.
Coastal Development Institute of Technology : Technical Manual for immersed tunnel (Revised Edition), 2002
Kiyomiya, T., K. Sonoda, M. Takahashi: Desigo and constructioo of immersed tunnels, Gihi-do Publishing, 2002
Earthquake Eogineeriog Committee, Sub-committee oo Earthquake-resistaot performance of tunnel,: Earthquake-resistaot
desigo of tunnel and problems, 1998
4)
Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Design of steel-concrete sandwich structure type immersed tunnels and
5)
Coastal Development Institute of Technology: Manual for the construction of high-fluidity filling concrete that is constructed
with simultaneous use of vibrator and that is designed for the use for steel-concrete sandwich structure type immersed
tunnels, 2004
-932-
4 Parking Lots
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Parking Lois
Article37
The performance requirements for parking lots shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(I) Parking lots shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport
and Tourism for the safe parking of vehicles without hindering port utilization and the safe and smooth
flow of traffic.
(2) Damage due to imposed load shall not adversely affect the function and continued use of parking lots.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Parking Lots
Article 78
1 The provisions in items (1) and (5) of Article 76 shall be applied to the performance criteria of parking lots
with modification as necessary.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of parking lots shall be
such that the size, location and layout of parking lots are appropriately set in consideration of the utilization
conditions of the facilities concerned and the surrounding area, and others.
[Technical Note]
4.1 Examination of Size and Location of Parking Lots
(!) The size and location of a parking lot shall be determined so as not to pose any obstacle to the use of port facilities
and the smooth road traffic, in consideration of the traffic generated in a port and the condition of roads in the
vicinity.
(2) A parking lot shall not be located on a road. Iftopographical conditions or other reasons necessitate a parking lot
to be located on a roads the size and location of a parking lot shall satisfy the following requirements:
Q) It shall not be located on a road connecting a port and a major inland highway.
@ It shall not be located at a place which may hinder vehicles from going in and out the cargo handling area or
sheds.
It shall not be located at a place adjacent to a dangerous cargo handling area, unless there are unavoidable
Q) When verifying the performance of a parking lot, it is necessary to determine its size and location so that the
originating and terminating traffic from the objective parking lot may not hinder the smooth traffic in a port,
giving proper consideration to the parking demand generated accompanying the anticipated port activities and
the utilization circumstances of the surrounding roads.
@ Location
In principle, parking lots shall not be located on roads taking into consideration the characteristics of the
traffic in a port. Provided, however, that in cases where a parking lot has to be located on a road because
of unavoidable reasons including topographical constraint, the objective parking lot shall set the following
-933-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
requirements regarding disposition as necessary:
The parking lot shall not be located on arterial roads that connect the port with an inland area.
The parking lot shall not be located at a place which may hinder vehicles from going in and out the cargo
handling area or sheds.
The parking lot shall not be located at a place adjacent to a dangerous cargo handling area.
(3)Parking Lots for Mooring Facilities for Ferries
Q) A parking lot for mooring facilities for ferries should have sufficient space taking into consideration the number
of vehicles carried on the relevant terries, the utilization rate and the concentration rate so as not to make the
neighboring traffic conditions worse.
@ When determining the area of a parking lot, it is prefurable to consider the following factors:
(a) the number of berths
(b) the number of vehicles carried on a ferry (both the number of passenger cars and trucks)
(c) the arrival and departure intervals of ferries and the loading and unloading time
(d) the arrival patterns of vehicles (patterns of both passenger cars and trucks)
(e) the operation system of a parking lot
@ The area of a parking lot on a ferry wharf is sometimes determined by multiplying the area of 50m2required to
park an 8-ton vehicle by the maximum number of 8-ton- equivalent vehicles carried on the ferry which uses the
wharf. In addition, it is also necessary to take into account the ratio of the vehicles which are transported on the
terries without a driver and the ratio of trailers.
References
1)
2)
3)
Japan Association of car park engineers: Car Park Manual, 1981, (additional Material)1990
Japan Road Association: Guideline and commentary for Design and construction of car park, 1992
Japan Road Association: Commentary of enforcement regulatioos for road structures aod application, Maruzeo Publishing,
execution, pp.623-631, 2004
-934-
5 Bridges
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Bridges
Article38
1 The performance requirements for bridges shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Bridges shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and
Tourism so as to ensure the safe and smooth flow of traffic within the port and between the port and the
hinterland in consideration of the characteristics of traffic in the port.
(2) Damage due to self weight, variable waves, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, imposed load, winds,
and ship collisions, and/or other actions shall not adversely affect the continued use of said bridge
without impairing its function.
(3) Even in cases that the functions of bridges are impaired by damage due to Level 2 earthquake ground
motions, such damage shall not have a serious effect on the structural safety of the bridges. Provided,
however, that as for the performance requirements for bridges which requires further improvement
in earthquake-resistant performance due to environmental, social conditions and/or other conditions
to which the bridges concerned are subjected, the damage shall not adversely affect the restoration
through minor repair works of the functions of the bridges concerned.
2 In addition to the requirements provided in the preceding paragraphs (J) and (2), the performance
requirements for the bridge constituting a part of a road which is connected to high earthquake-resistance
facilities shall be such that the damage due to Level 2 earthquake ground motions and other actions do
not affect restoration through minor repair works of the functions required of the bridge concerned in
the aftermath of the occurrence of Level 2 earthquake ground motions. Provided, however, that as for
the performance requirements for the bridge which requires further improvement in earthquake-resistant
performance due to environmental, social conditions and/or other conditions to which the bridge concerned
is subjected, damage due to said actions shall not affect the restoration through minor repair works of the
functions of the bridge concerned and its continued use.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Bridges
Article 79
The performance criteria of bridges shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) In the case of a bridge which overpasses the facilities to which the Technical Standards apply or
equivalent facilities, the piers, girders, and others of the bridge shall be installed in such a way that they
do not adversely affect the safe and smooth use of respective facilities.
(2) Fenders shall be provided as necessary to prevent the damage to piers that may be caused by the
collision of ships.
(3) The degree of damage owing to the action by collision of a ship, which is the dominant action in the
accidental action situation, shall be less than the threshold level.
[Commentary]
CD Bridges associated with a road that connects to a high earthquake-resistance facility (restorability,
serviceability)
Performance criteria shall be set to secure restorability against accidental situations associated with
Level 2 earthquake ground motion. In addition, it shall also be set for the bridge which is required
to have enhanced seismic resistance according to the natural and social conditions surrounding the
objective bridge to ensure serviceability. Provided, however, that serviceability is a performance
requirement regarding the functions which are required of the bridge after it is subjected to the action
of Level 2 earthquake ground motion, and is not the performance requirement regarding the original
functions required of the bridge in ordinary conditions.
@ Accidental situations where the dominating action is the collision of ships against the bridge
(serviceability)
-935-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
The settings relating to the performance criteria and design situations limiting to accidental situations
for bridges are shown in Attached Table 65. Damages are set as the verification item in Attached
Table 65, because verification items vary depending on the structure and structural type of the relevant
bridge.
Attached Table 65 Settings relating to the Performance Criteria and Design Situations Common to All Bridges
Ministerial
Ordinance
Public Notice
"'e-
1 "'
ii
11
38
79
];!
"'e- "'e3
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Non-dominating
action
Index of
standard limit
Verification item
Damages
Serviceability Accidental Collision of ships Self weight. earth
against the bridge pressures, water
pressures, surcharges
value
-
[Technical Note]
Q) The bridge girders shall be constructed at an appropriate elevation above the highest high water level to ensure
safe navigation of ships.
@ The bridge piers shall neither be located near the waterway nor obstruct the navigation of ships, unless the safi:ty
of navigation is ensured otherwise.
@ Indicators or signs shall be posted as necessary to prevent ships from colliding with the bridge girders or piers.
(2) A bridge crossing over the space above any mooring equipment or cargo handling facilities shall meet the following
requirements:
Q) The location of piers and the elevation of girders shall be set appropriately so that they may not obstruct the safe
and smooth use of the mooring or cargo handling facilities.
@ Indicators or signs shall be posted as necessary to prevent cargo handling equipment and vehicles from colliding
with the bridge piers or girders.
(3) The base level for indicating the bridge height above the water surface shall be the nearly highest high water
level. The nearly highest high water level as the reference water level was adopted in response to the decision
by the International Hydrographic Organization (IHO) saying that "when graphing the height of a bridge over a
navigable waterway, it must be indicated the minimum vertical clearance height."
(4) The design of a bridge should take into consideration the future situation of the activities in the area when there is
any areal development plan.
(5) When determining the clearance for the case where a bridge is constructed overpassing a ship navigating waterway,
the following factors should be taken into consideration:
Q) Height between the water surface and the highest point of the navigating ship
@Tides
@ Trims of ships
@ Wave heights
@ Psychological effects on ship crew
The clearance from the nearly highest high water level should be determined by adding an allowance which is
set taking into consideration the above-mentioned factors and other relevant factors to the height between the
water surface and the highest point of a navigating ship. In the case of a bridge located in a river mouth area, it
is preferable to pay full attention to the design river high-water level as well.
The height between the water surface and the highest point of a navigating ship should be determined
appropriately on the studies regarding actual conditions and future trends of the ships entering the port, because
it varies widely depending on the ship type, and ship size. A study case on the ship height by Takahashi et al.IO)
may be used as a reference.
-936-
members as necessary.
(3) When verifying the performance of a concrete bridge, it is necessary to appropriately evaluate timewise changes in
the performance due to the deterioration of the superstructure and substructure caused by salt injury. Performance
verifications of concrete bridges may follow Chapter 2, 1.1 General.
(4) Salt content usually comes flying through sea breeze and sea water splashes and adheres to the bridges in waterfront
areas. Therefore it is necessary to pay attention to the fact that the steel members of the steel bridges in waterfront
areas are more corrosion-prone than those of steel bridges located in inland areas.
Q) In the case ofa bow collision, the collision energy is absorbed by the sum of the displacement of the fender and
the crush displacement of the bow.
@ In the case of a hull collision, the collision energy is absorbed by the displacement of the fender.
(a) With regard to the kinetic energy of the collided ship, Part II, Chapter 8, 2.2 Actions Caused by Ship
Berthing may be used as a reference. Provided, however, that for bow collisions, the eccentricity factor C,
and virtual mass factor Cm may usually be set at 1.0 and I.I, respectively, and the ship flexibility factor C, and
bridge pier shape factor C, may usually be set at 1.0.
-937-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(b) The energy absorbed by the displacement of the fender may usually be obtained based on the following
concept:
1) The energy absorbed by a rubber fender may be obtained based on the displacement restoration
characteristics of the rubber fender.
2) The energy absorbed by a wire rope type fender may be obtained from the relationship between the
elongation and tensile strength of the wire rope.
3) The energy absorbed by the crush displacement of the bow in a bow collision may be obtained from the
relationship between the bow load and displacement.
(c) In cases where consideration should be made so that the hull of a small vessel may not break at the time of
collision, it is preferable that the reactive force of a fender at the time of collision is smaller than the bow
strength for the bow collision and smaller than the hull strength for the hull collision. If it is assumed that the
maximum collision force is distributed across a sufficiently wide area ofthe exterior plate of the ship side hull,
that it uniformly works on spreading to the distance between the rib centers and above, and that both ends of
the exterior plate are fixed and plastic hinges come into existence at both ends of the exterior plate, the design
ship hull strength of a steel ship may usually be calculated using the following equation.17)
P..,
3u,, , (1)'
-
,J1-v+v' S
(5.4.1)
where,
PM
uy
t
S
v
A
The strength of a steel fender may be obtained from the strengths of the members that comprise the steel
fender. The design value used in the equation may be calculated using the following equation:
(5.4.2)
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, General, Maruzen Publications, 2002
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, Steel Bridges, Maruzen Publications, 2002
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, Concrete Bridges, Maruzen Publications,
2002
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, Substructures, Maruzen Publications, 2002
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, Seismic Design, Maruzen Publications,
2002
Railway Technical Research Institute: Standard and commentary of design of railway structures- Earth structures, Maruzen
Publishing, 2000
Railway Technical Research Institute: Standard and commentary of design of railway structures- Concrete structure,
Maruzen Publishing, 2004
Railway Technical Research Institute: Standard and commentary of design of railway structures- Composite structure,
Maruzen Publishing, 2000
Railway Technical Research Institute: Standard and commentary of design of railway structures- earth pressure resistant
structures, Maruzen Publishing, 2000
Takahashi, H. and F. Goto; Study on Ship Height by Statistical Analysis-Standard ofHeight of Design Ship (Draft)-, Research
Report of National Institute for Land and Infrastructure Management No.33, 2007
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, General, Maruzen Publications, pp.10-20,
2002
Sato, H., R. lnamuro and K. lwata:Wind-resistant performance of the three clear span continuous steel slab double box girder
bridge (Tomari-Ohasbi), Proceeilings of 39th Annual Conference of JSCE, 1984
Nagai, K., M. Oyadomari and R. Inamuro: Wind-resistant performance of the three clear span continuous steel slab double
box girder bridge (Tomari-Ohashi)(Second report), Proceeilings of 40th Annual Conference of JSCE, 1985
Japan Road Association Bridge Committee: Handbook of painting and corrosion protection of bridges, Japan Road
-938-
-939-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
6 Canals
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Canals
[Commentary]
Article39
The performance requirements for canals shall be such that the requirements specified by the Minister
of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied for the sake of securing the safe and smooth
navigation of ships in harbors by taking into consideration the traffic characteristics in the port including
navigating ships and others.
[Technical Note]
-940-
Article 41
1 The performance requirement for cargo sorting facilities shall be such that the requirements specified
by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied in light of geotechnical
characteristics, meteorological characteristics, sea states and/or other environmental conditions, as well as
the conditions of cargo handling.
2 The performance requirement for cargo sorting facilities shall be such that the facilities have stability
against self weight, waves, earthquake ground motions, imposed load, winds, and/or other actions.
Ministerial Ordinance
Necessary Items Concerning Cargo Sorting Facilities
Article 44
The items necessary for the performance requirements of cargo sorting areas as specified in this Chapter by
the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism and other requirements shall be provided by
the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Cargo Sorting Facilities
Article 80
The items to be specified by the Public Notice under Article 44 of the Ministerial Ordinance concerning
with the performance requirements for cargo sorting facilities shall be as provided in the subsequent article
through Article 83.
!Technical Note]
1.1 General
(!) This chapter may be used for performance verifications of cargo sorting facilities.
References
I)
2)
3)
Fujino, S. and Y. Kawasaki: Port Planning, New Series Civil Engineering 81, Giho-do Publishing, pp.135-138, 1981
Nakayama, S.: Port Engineering, Sankai-do Publishing, pp.36-37, 1985
Civil Engineering Handbook, Part 37, Port and harbours, Giho-do Publishing, pp.1620-1621, 1989
-941-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(2) The performance requirements for cargo handling equipment installed at high earthquake-resistance
facilities shall be such that the damage due to Level 2 earthquake ground motions and other actions do
not affect restoration through minor repair works of the functions of the equipment concerned.
Public Notice
Performance Criterion of Cargo Handling Equipment
Article 81
1 The performance criteria of cargo handling equipment shall be as specified in the subsequent items in
consideration of the type of cargo handling equipment:
(1) Cargo handling equipment shall be arranged appropriately and provided with the necessary dimensions
in consideration of the design ship, the type and volume of cargo, the structure of the mooring facilities,
and the condition of cargo handling.
(2) In order to protect the environment surrounding the facilities concerned, cargo handling equipment
shall be provided with the functions appropriate for prevention of dust, noise, and the like as necessary.
2 In addition to the provisions specified in the preceding paragraphs, the performance criteria for petroleum
cargo handling equipment shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is self weight, the risk of impairing
the integrity of structural members shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(2) Under the variable action situation in which the dominant actions are Level 1 earthquake ground
motions, winds, and the weight and pressure of oil cargoes, the risk of impairing the integrity of
structural members and losing the structural stability shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
3 In addition to the provision in the first paragraph, the performance criterion for cargo handling equipment
to be installed on the high earthquake-resistance facilities shall be such that the degree of damage owing to
the action of Level 2 earthquake ground motions, which is the dominant action under the accidental action
situation, is equal to or less than the threshold level.
-942-
[Commentary]
..,
Public Notice
..,
~ ~
~ ~
~< 5
~< 5
"'
" "'
"
42
81
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Winds, earth
Verification item
Non-dominating
Situation Dominating action
action
Soundness of members
pressures,
surcharges
value
L1 earthquake
ground motion
(winds) (weights
Self weight,
Soundness of members, earth pressures, stability of the structure
surcharges
and pressures of
I netroleum)
1
~< ~
e
.!! ~
<
42
"
2
Design situation
Public Notice
81
Performance
e
.!!
requirements
Restorability
Situation
Accidental L2 earthquake
ground motion
-943-
Self woight,
earth pressures
Verification item
Damages
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
[Technical Note]
2.1 General
(!) The purpose of introducing cargo handling equipment in ports is to reduce labor works, to speed up cargo handling
activities, and to ensure safety. The selection of the type, structure and capacity of cargo handling equipment is
preferably made by sufficiently considering the design ships, the type, shape, volume, and particular of cargoes,
as well as the relations with yard facilities behind, and the mode of secondary transportation.
(2) Cargo handling equipment installed in cargo handling facilities or mooring facilities shall have the required
structure and capacity, and location. The equipment shall be structurally sound, be provided with anti-pollution
systems against dust and noise, and ensure smooth and safe operation in cargo handling activities.
(3) Sufficient space should be secured around cargo handling equipment for its various operations by clearing the
space of obstacles such as buildings and power lines. Cargo handling equipment should be designed and located
so that it does not come into contact with ships at berthing and leaving or during mooring.
(4) Countermeasures against noise and dust are required for bulk cargoes handling equipment because their handling
is likely to produce noise and dust. In particular, inflammable dust shall require countermeasures against blast.
CD Determination of the assumed Level I and Level 2 earthquake ground motion on the seismic bedrock
@ Calculation ofthe changes over time in Level 1 and Level 2 earthquake ground motion at the site where the crane
rails are located
In case it is necessary to take into consideration the dynamic interactions between the cargo handling
equipment and mooring facility, on a pier type quaywall the changes over time in the horizontal accelerations
at the rail site are calculated taking into consideration the dynamic interactions between the crane and the pier.
In the case where the installation of an earthquake-resistance crane is expected, a combination of rigidity and
damping that reproduces the natural period of the earthquake-resistance container crane shall be given, (see
Fig. 2.2.1).
In the case of a type other than a pier type, the changes over time in the ground surface acceleration shall
be calculated through a seismic response analysis of the ground and the data obtained is used as the ground
motion at the crane rail site.
-944-
If the displacements that would occur are out of the allowable ranges, the dimensions of the earthquakeproofing mechanism section will be changed and step @ will be performed again.
@ Evaluation of the rail span displacement in relation to the displacement of the crane leg section
The maximum rail span displacement is calculated from results of seismic response analyses of the mooring
facility. Then, an evaluation is made to determine whether the maximum rail span displacement is within the
sum of the elastic deformation range of the crane leg section and the displacement of the half-amplitude stroke
of the earthquake-proofing mechanism, see Fig. 2.2.2.
(3) In the case where it is necessary to take into consideration the dynamic interactions between the cargo handling
equipment and mooring facility under the action of ground motion:
In the case of cargo handling equipment installed on top of a mooring facility, the response accelerations of
the cargo handling equipment during an earthquake may be amplified and the oscillation characteristic under
the action of ground motion may affect the mooring facility when the scale is large, and these must be taken into
consideration regardless of whether the state is a variable situation associated with Level 1 earthquake ground
motion or an accidental situation associated with Level 2 earthquake ground motion.
The oscillation characteristic such as the natural period in the sea-land direction of cargo handling equipment
such as cranes varies depending on the scale and type of the cargo handling equipment, but it usually falls within
the range of 0.5 to 3 seconds. Container cranes equipped with an earthquake-proofing mechanism often have
a long natural period of around 4 seconds. In the case where such cranes are installed on piers with a natural
period of 0.5 to 2.0 seconds, it is necessary to be cautious about the possibility that coupling behaviors, dynamic
interactions, may occur in the performance verification of the pier with respect to ground motion. In the case
where, regardless of the structural type of the mooring facility, the predominant period of the ground motion at
the location where the cargo handling equipment is installed is about 1.5 seconds or longer, it is expected that
response accelerations of the cargo handling equipment will become high and thus it may become necessary to
conduct a dynamic analysis-based evaluation in the performance verification of the cargo handling equipment. In
either case, it is preferable to reduce the response accelerations of the cargo handling equipment through the use of
an earthquake-proofing mechanism or a damping mechanism, to prevent derailing and ensure that the soundness
of the members will be secured. For details of the performance verifications, explanations about performance
verifications of facilities in this Part as well as the Guide to Earthquake-resistance Design of Container Cranes
3) may be referenced.
(4) Modeling of Cranes Installed on Piers
In the case where a crane is installed on a pier, performance verification of seismic-resistant should in principle be
through dual lumped mass system analyses that use the equivalent rigidity of the piles for one block of the pier (k),
the mass of the superstructure (m), the damping factor (c), the equivalent rigidity of the crane (kJ, the mass of the
crane (mJ and the damping factor for the crane (cJ. With regard to the oscillation characteristic of the crane, the
natural period should be similar to that of the actual crane. With regard to the damping factor, a value between
1% and 3% should be used unless the damping factor value is specified by the crane manufacturer. The equivalent
rigidity values for the pier and the crane are the values for the number of piles per block of the pier and the number
of crane leg, respectively, and are represented by the mass system springs shown in Fig. 2.2.1. The equivalent
rigidity (k) in the mass system model of the pier part is modeled on the assumption that the nonlinear stress-strain
relationship used in the design of the pier applies.
(5) Modeling of Cranes Installed on Mooring Facilities other than Piers
In the case of mooring facilities other than piers, the effects of the dynamic interactions are small because the
mass of the mooring facilities are large in relation to the mass of cargo handling equipment, which means that it
suffices to evaluate, through dynamic analyses, the responses of the cranes themselves during earthquakes. That
is, the ground surface ground motion at the location in question is entered in the single mass system that represents
the crane part only as shown in Fig. 2.2.1.
-945-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
example, in the case of a container crane whose span is 30.5m as shown in Fig. 2.2.2, the elastic deformation range
of the crane leg section accommodates widening of the span up to around 700mm, that is a reference value and
the actual value varies among cranes. By adding this amount of deformation, namely elastic deformation range of
the crane leg section, to the displacement of half-amplitude stroke of about 300mm, that is also a reference value
and the actual value varies among cranes, of the earthquake-resistance mechanism section, the allowable amount
of displacement of about l,OOOmm in the maximum for the crane span is obtained. Therefore, the earthquakeresistance mechanism needs to be so designed, as necessary, that it is appropriate for the amount of rail span
displacement calculated from results of seismic response analyses of the mooring facility.
Stroke of the
earthquake-proofing
o
mechanism
30, 500
~~~7~0~0~f-----~~~--=--"=-~~~~~
When it is assumed
that the land side rail is fixed
1 000
Fig. 2.2.2 Relationship between Deformations of the Crane Leg Section and Rail Span Displacements
-946-
References
1)
2)
3)
-947-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 43
1 The performance requirements for cargo sorting areas for the safe and smooth sorting of cargo shall be as
specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Cargo sorting areas shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure,
Transport and Tourism so as to ensure the safe and smooth sorting of cargo.
(2) Damage due to imposed load and other actions shall not adversely affect the continued use of the cargo
sorting areas and not impair their functions.
2 In addition to the requirements specified in the preceding paragraph, the performance requirements for
cargo sorting areas which need to function in an integrated manner with high earthquake-resistance facilities
during disasters shall be such that the damage due to Level 2 earthquake ground motions and other actions
do not affect restoration through minor repair works of the functions required of the areas concerned in
the aftermath of the occurrence of Level 2 earthquake ground motions. Provided, however, that as for the
performance requirements for cargo sorting areas which require further improvement in earthquake-resistant
performance due to environmental, social and/or other conditions to which the cargo sorting areas concerned
are subjected, the damage due to said actions shall not affect the restoration through minor repair works of
the functions of the cargo sorting areas concerned and their continued use.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Cargo Sorting Areas
Article 82
1 The performance criteria of cargo sorting areas are as specified in the subsequent items:
(I) Cargo sorting areas shall have the appropriate shape and sizes in consideration ofthe types and amounts
of cargoes and the way cargoes are handled.
(2) The passageways in a cargo sorting area shall have the appropriate widths and alignments so as to
ensure the safe and smooth traffic of cargo handling equipment, vehicles, and/or others.
(3) Cargo sorting areas shall be equipped with the appropriate lighting facilities so as to enable the safe and
smooth utilization of the cargo sorting areas in consideration of the utilization conditions of the areas
concerned.
(4) In the case of cargo sorting areas that are dangerous for people to enter, the cargo sorting areas shall be
provided with appropriate means to keep people off the areas.
(5) Cargo sorting areas shall have appropriate drainage facilities to prevent retention of water in the areas.
(6) The risk that a pavement in a cargo sorting area is damaged to the extent which may adversely affect
cargo handling works under the variable action situation, in which the dominant action is imposed load,
shall be equal to or less than the threshold level.
(7) Cargo sorting areas which deal with cargoes that may be scattered by winds shall be provided with
appropriate means to prevent scattering of cargoes.
(8) In the case of a cargo sorting area that is used to handle lumber, the following requirements shall be
satisfied:
(a) Appropriate facilities and equipment to dispose of bark shall be provided as necessary.
(b) Appropriate means to prevent lumber from drifting away shall be provided for the cargo sorting area
on the water.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of the cargo sorting area
that shall function in combination with the high earthquake-resistance facilities during disasters shall be
such that the degree of damage owing to the action of Level 2 earthquake ground motions, which is the
dominant action in the accidental action situation, is equal to less than the threshold level corresponding
to the performance requirements.
-948-
[Commentary]
(!)Performance Criteria of Cargo Sorting Areas
~<
} }
43
e .1J
"
,!!
2
Design situation
Public Notice
<
82
Performance
requirements
Restorability
,!!
Self weight,
earth pressures
Verification item
Damages
Cargo sorting areas that need to function in combination with a high earthquake-resistance facility
during disasters
The settings relating to the design situations, limited to accidental situations only, and performance
criteria for cargo sorting areas that need to function in combination with a high earthquake-resistance
facility during disasters are as shown in Attached Table 69. The reason for indicating "damages" in
the "Verification item" column of Attached Table 69 is that it is necessary to use a comprehensive
term taking account that the verification items vary depending on the structure and structural type of
the facilities.
Attached Table69 Settings for to the Design Situations. limited to Accidental Situations only. and Performance Criteria
for Cargo Sorting Areas
Ministerial
Ordinance
..,
Public Notice
u
Ii
:g
82
1 "'
43
..,
Design situation
Performance
,!!
requirements
Restorability
-949-
Self weight.
surcharges
Verification item
Damages
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
[Technical Note]
3.1 General
(!) Cargo sorting areas shall be paved appropriately in respect of their purposes and the ways they are used.
With regard to the structures of pavements, Part III, Chapter 5, 9.14 Aprons may be referenced.
(2) The widths and curves of passageways shall allow safu and smooth operation of vehicles and cargo handling
equipment.
(3) With regard to lighting facilities of cargo sorting areas that are operated at night, the provisions of Chapter 5, 9.3
Lighting Facilities may be referenced.
(4) A cargo sorting area that is dangerous for the public is necessary to take appropriate measures to prohibit the
entrance of public with provisions of signs, boards, and fences.
-950-
(2) When calculating or determining the scale of a container terminal area, the basic principles described in (3) to (8)
below, which are proposed by Takahashi, 8) may be adopted.
Target route
'
"
"
Ship
length
(Lo)
Ship
breadth
(Bo)
'
'
YI
.
.--j Peak coefficient (f)
Full load
draft
(d,)
~
Intersecting
~ angle coefficient
(a)
..
H and departure
rate for arrival at
I
from
(ft,)
Draft
port
11
...
..
:-1
Marshaling area
coefficient U)
-.
...
I Dry
container ground slot ratio I
(V, ~ V, (1-h))
Fig. 3.5.1 Size Estimation Model for Typical Container Berth Terminal Area 2si
CD
@ Apron areas
(a) An apron area is an area in which container cranes and vehicles fur cargo handling travel and containers hatch
covers of container ships are temporarily stored. The L61 in Fig. 3.5.2 8) represents the apron area width.
-951-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
(b) The apron area width L61 may usually be determined from the rail-normal line distance, the rail span of gantry
crane and the width of the strip for the vehicle traveling.
@ Marshaling areas
(a) A marshaling area is an area in which containers to be loaded onto and containers unloaded from container
ships are arranged. The L 62 in Fig. 3.5.2 8) represents the marshaling area width.
(b) With regard to the width of the marshaling, a width of L 62 that is appropriate in relation to the berth length may
usually be adopted according to the required marshaling area size.
L.
-~
L"
--rn1I
ifil
y----1--
I A:Apronarea [--
ITTTII- - - - - -
11
----
IT
888888888888888 888888888888888
888888888888888 888888888888888
888888888888888 888888888888888
L"
L
I II I
8888888888~~~~~m11"~~~~8888888888 I II I
1I I
1~~moooo
Fueling statinn
MWreO Qlml
I C: Back J.'ard area I
main~[]
Transtainer
L.,
~area
LJG-
Gatehouse
CTS
Power reception
station
Cleaning facility
Administration buildin
g
--
containers.
2) Maintenance shops
A maintenance shop is a building where inspections of containers and repairs of dan3aged containers and
cleaning of containers before and after use are performed.
-952-
Q) Berth length
With regard to the berth length of a container terminal, Chapter S, 2.1 Common Items for Wharves may be
referenced.
(3.5.1)
where,
a1
a2
a3
Ifthe rail span determined based on the structural dimensions of the crane is larger than the required lane width
mentioned above, it is necessary to use the former value.
@ Determination of the width of the strip for the vehicle traveling behind the crane (a.)
The width of the strip for the vehicle traveling behind the crane should preferably be determined appropriately
with consideration given to the dimensions of the cranes, and the allowance width.
In the case where tractor-trailers are used, the width of the strip for the vehicle traveling behind the crane
may be calculated by adding an allowance width of 3m to the sum of the total width of the temporary storage
areas for hatch covers (4 rows: llm; 5 rows: 13.Sm) 9J and the minimum lane width of3.5m.9J For example, if the
number of rows of hatch cover storage areas is 5, a strip width of 20m is obtained. In the case where straddle
carriers are used, a strip width of 37m which is calculated by adding an allowance width of !Sm to the width of
22m 9) for the turning of carriers may be used.
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Q) The area of a marshaling area may usually be calculated using the procedure shown in Fig. 3.5.4 based on the
design handling volwne (Vo (TEU)).
Calculation of the nmnber of containers handled for marshaling area design (Vi):equation (3.5.2)
Fig. 3.5.4 Example of a Procedure for Performance Verifications with respect to the Area of the Marshaling Area
The area of a marshaling area may usually be calculated using equations (3.S.2) through (3.S.7):
V.=fV0 /e
Vz = v; /(g1g2)
(3.5.2)
(3.5.3)
~=Vz(l-h)
(3.5.4)
~=Vzh
(3.5.5)
(3.5.6)
(3.5.7)
where,
: design handling volume (TEU)
Vi : number of containers handled for marshaling area design (TEU)
e : annual turnover (number of times I year)
V0
e=Dy!Dr
(3.5.8)
f : peak coefficient
V2 : number of ground slots (TEU)
g 1 : coefficient for the maximum number of stacks
g2 : effectiveness factor
V3 : number of dry container ground slots (TEU)
h : reefer container ground slot ratio
~ : number ofreefer container ground slots (TEU)
Gy : ground slot area (m2)
i 1 : floor area per one TEU of dry container (m2)
i2 : floor area per one TEU of reefer container (m2)
B : area of the marshaling area (m2)
j : marshaling area coefficient
-954-
The marshaling area width Lb2 may be calculated by equation (3.5.9) from the area of the marshaling area.
L., = Bj L.
(3.5.9)
where,
B : area of the marshaling area (m2)
CD
The area of a back yard area may usually be calculated by equation (3.5.10).
C=B,k
(3.5.10)
where,
By : total area of the back yard area facilities (i.e. total floor area of the container freight stations,
maintenance shops, administration buildings, gates, constructed in the back yard area) (m2)
k : back yard area coefficient
The back yard area widthLb3 may be calculated by equation (3.5.11) from the area of the back yard area.
L., =CIL.
(3.5.11)
-955-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
where,
C : area of the back yard area (m2)
La : berth length
@ With regard to the specific settings of the individual coefficients, Reference 8) may be referenced.
I) Total area of the back yard area facilities (By)
B1 ~ 7,SOO m2 (for area of marshaling area: less than 90,000 m2)
B1 ~ 9,000 m2 (for area of marshaling area: 90,000 m2 or more)
CD
where,
Lb1 : apron area width
Lb2 : marshaling area width
Lb3 : back yard area width
Lb ~ 300 to 400m (when the berth water depth is less than !Sm)
Lb ~ 3SO to 600m (when the berth water depth is !Sm or more)
References
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
Fujino, S. and Y. Kawasaki: New Series Civil Engineering 81, Giho-do Publishing, pp 184-189, 1981
JSCE: Civil Engineering Handbook: Part 37, Ports and Harbours, Giho-do Publishing,, pp. 1605, 1989
Japan Fishing Port Association: Handbook for fish port planning (1992), pp.109-135,1992
Sato, T: .Utilization planning (4)ofland area for fish port facilities, Fish Port, Vol. 13 No. 4, pp 51, 1971
Sato, r. .Utilization planning (5)oflaod area for fish port facilities, Fish Port, Vol. 14 No. 4, pp 42, 1972
Sato, r. .Utilization planning (ll)oflaod area for fish port facilities, Fish Port, Vol. 16 No. 2, pp.28-33, 1972
Fujino, S. and Y. Kawasaki: Port Planning, New Series Civil Engineering 81, Giho-do Publishing, pp.191-193, 1981
Takahasi, H.: A model for estimation scales of container terminal areas at the stage of port and harbour planning- A standard
for designing principal size in container terminals : A proposal-, Research Report of National Institute for Land and
Infrastructure Management No,10,2003
Port and Harbour Bureau Ministry of Transport and Over seas Coastal Area Development Institute of Japan: Report of
container terminal facility plans, 1993
-9S6-
4 Sheds
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Sheds
Article 83
1 The provisions of the first paragraph of the previous article (Items (1) through (4) only) shall also be used
as performance criteria for sheds.
2 For sheds, the following performance criteria shall be used in addition to the performance criteria specified
in the previous paragraph.
(1) Sheds in which dusts are generated as a result of the handling of cargoes shall have appropriate
ventilation facilities and equipment.
(2) Sheds into which water may enter as a result of storm surges shall be provided with appropriate facilities
and equipment to prevent ingress of water as necessary.
4.1 General
(!) Sheds shall meet the following requirements to ensure smooth cargo handling before the entrance and after the
departure of ships.
(a) The size of a shed shall be determined appropriately by considering the kinds and quantities of cargoes and their
handling conditions.
(b) The widths and curves of passageways in a shed shall be determined to allow safe and smooth operation of cargo
handling equipment.
(2) With regard to lighting facilities of sheds in which cargoes are handled at night, the provisions of Chapter S, 9.4
Lighting Facilities may be referenced.
Sheds shall be equipped with the provisions of appropriate signs and broads to ensure safe and smooth use as
necessary.
-957-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 45
The performance requirements for storage facilities shall be such that the storage facilities satisfy the
requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so as to enable
the safe and appropriate storage of cargo in consideration of geotechnical characteristics, meteorological
characteristics, sea states and/or other environmental conditions, as well as the conditions of cargo handling.
Ministerial Ordinance
Necessary Items concerning Storage Facilities
Article 46
The items necessary for the performance requirements of storage facilities as specified in this Chapter by the
Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism and others shall be provided by the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Storage Facilities
Article 84
The items to be specified by the Public Notice under Article 46 of the Ministerial Ordinance concerning
the performance requirements for storage facilities shall be as provided in the subsequent article through
Article 87.
2 Warehouses
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Warehouses
Article 86
The provisions in Article 83 shall be applied to the performance criteria of warehouses with modification as
necessary.
[Technical Note]
The structure and location of warehouses shall be set appropriately in accordance with the requirements
specified in Chapter 7, 3 Cargo Sorting Areas and 4 Sheds and Article 3 of the Enforcement Rules for
the Warehousing Business Law (Ministerial Ordinance of the Ministry of Transport No.59 of 1956) as a
reference.
Article 85
The provisions in item i) of Article 82 shall be applied to the performance criteria for open storage yards,
timber storage yards and ponds, and coal storage yards with modification as necessary.
[Technical Note]
Open storage yards are subject to the requirements specified in Chapter 7, 3 Cargo Sorting Areas. With
regard to calculations of the areas of open storage yards, Reference 1) may be used as a reference.
-958-
Article 85
The provisions in paragraph I of Article 82 shall be applied to the performance criteria for open storage
yards, timber storage yards and ponds and coal storage yards with modification as necessary.
[Technical Nole]
The requirements specified in Chapter 7, 3 Cargo Sorting Areas shall be applied to the timber storage
yards and ponds.
5 Coal Storage Yards
Public Notice
Performance Criteria for Open Storage Yards, Timber Storage Yards and Ponds, and Coal Storage Yards
Article 85
The provisions in paragraph 1 of Article 82 shall be applied to the performance criteria for open storage
yards, timber storage yards and ponds and coal storage yards with modification as necessary.
[Technical Note]
The requirements specified in Chapter 7, 3 Cargo Sorting Areas shall be applied to the coal storage yards.
6 Hazardous Materials Storage Facilities
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Hazardous Materials Storage Facilities and Oil Storage Facilities
Article 87
1 The provisions in Article 83 or paragraph 1 of Article 82 shall be applied to the performance criteria of
hazardous materials storage facilities and oil storage facilities with modification as necessary.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of hazardous materials
storage facilities and oil storage facilities shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Hazardous materials storage facilities and oil storage facilities shall be located in such a way that they
are not scattered over an area. However, noncompliance with this requirement may be permitted in the
case where compliance is impossible because of the topography or other reasons.
(2) Hazardous materials storage facilities shall be surrounded by a band ofvacant land having an appropriate
width in consideration of the types of the hazardous cargoes, the structures of the facilities and other
relevant conditions.
7 Oil Storage Facilities
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Hazardous Materials Storage Facilities and Oil Storage Facilities
Article 87
1 The provisions in Article 83 or paragraph 1 of Article 82 shall be applied to the performance criteria of
hazardous materials storage facilities and oil storage facilities with modification as necessary.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of hazardous materials
storage facilities and oil storage facilities shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Hazardous materials storage facilities and oil storage facilities shall be located in such a way that they
are not scattered over an area. However, noncompliance with this requirement may be permitted in the
case where compliance is impossible because of the topography or other reasons.
(2) Hazardous materials storage facilities shall be surrounded by a band ofvacant land having an appropriate
width in consideration of the types of the hazardous cargoes, the structures of the facilities and other
-959-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
relevant conditions.
References
I)
JSCE: Civil Engineering Handbook, Part 11, Port and harbours, Giho-do Publishing, pp.1606, 1989
-960-
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Facilities for Ship Service
Article 47
1 The performance requirements for ship service facilities shall be such that the requirements specified by
the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied for the provision of safe and
smooth services to ships in light of geotechnical characteristics, meteorological characteristics, sea states
and/or other environmental conditions, as well as the conditions of ship entry.
2 The performance requirements of water supply facilities for ships shall be such that the requirements
specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied for the sanitary
supply of water to ships.
3 The performance requirements for ship storage facilities shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied
so as to enable the safe bringing-in and bringing-out of ships.
(2) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied
so as to enable the proper fixing of ships.
Ministerial Ordinance
Necessary Items concerning Facilities for Ship Service
Article 48
The items necessary for enforcement of the performance requirements for ship service facilities as specified
in this Chapter by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism and other requirements shall
be provided by the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Facilities for Ship Service
Article 88
The items to be specified by the Public Notice under Article 48 of the Ministerial Ordinance concerning the
performance requirements of ship service facilities shall be as specified in the subsequent article.
2 Water Supply Facilities to Ships
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Water Supply Facilities for Ships
Article 89
The performance criteria of water supply facilities for ships shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) The facilities shall be installed at appropriate locations, corresponding to the condition of use by
ships.
(2) The facilities shall have an appropriate capacity of water supply corresponding to the dimensions of the
design ship.
(3) The facilities shall have a structure which is capable of preventing water pollution, and the water
hydrants shall be maintained in a sanitary condition.
[Technical Note]
(!)The layout and capacity of hydrants shall be determined appropriately according to the type of vessels.
(2) Water supply facilities shall meet the fullowing sanitation requirements:
-%1-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
The hydrants of water supply facilities shall be of a construction that can prevent contamination of water.
@ Periodic and ad-hoc water quality tests shall be conducted and the hygiene of the hydrants of the water supply
facilities shall be appropriately maintained.
(3) Intakes of hydrants should be so located that intake hoses can be easily attached and shall be so constructed that
contamination of water can be prevented. In addition, means to drain water shall be provided in the case where
they are buried beneath the apron floor. Intakes need to be equipped with caps.
(4) Water Supply Volume
With regard to the water supply volume to ships, the values shown in Table 2.1 may be used as reference values.
In the case of large ships, the capacities of water tanks are in many cases around SO Om' because such ships have
their own fresh water production equipment.
Table 2.1 Hydrants and Water Supply Volume
Tonnage of ship
(gross tonnage)
500
1,000
3,000
5,000
10,000
Required water
supply volume
(m')
40
80
250-300
500
800
Time required
to supply
water
Hydrant spacing
(m)
Number of hydrants
per berth (number
of points)
Water supply
capacity of each
hydraot
(m'/h)
30
30-40
40-50
40-50
40-50
2
2
3-4
4
4
4
8
16
18
28
(h)
5
5
5
5
5
-962-
Article 53
The items necessary for the performance requirements for fixed and movable passenger boarding facilities,
waste disposal seawalls, beaches, and plazas and green space as specified in this chapter by the Minister of
Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism and other requirements shall be provided by the Public Notice.
Public Notice
Other Port Facilities
Article 90
The items to be specified by the Public Notice under Article 53 of the Ministerial Ordinance concerning
the performance requirements for fixed and movable passenger boarding facilities, waste disposal seawalls,
beach and plaza, and green spaces shall be as provided in the subsequent article through Article 95.
-963-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 49
The performance requirement of the fixed and movable passenger boarding facilities shall be as specified in
the subsequent items for the safe and smooth embarkation and disembarkation of passengers in consideration
of its structure type:
(1) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism shall be
satisfied so as to enable the safe and smooth embarkation and disembarkation of passengers.
(2) Damage due to self weight, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, imposed load, winds, and/or other
actions shall not adversely affect the continued use of the fixed or movable passenger boarding facilities
and not impair their functions.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Fixed Passenger Boarding Facilities
Article 91
The performance criteria of fixed passenger boarding facilities shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Passageways of fixed passenger boarding facilities shall satisfy the following requirements so that they
allow passengers to embark and disembark in the safe and smooth manner:
(a) The passageway shall have an appropriate width and gradient.
(b) The passageway shall be provided with the means for preventing slipping or constructed with
materials that are not prone to slipping.
(c) The passageway shall have side walls, railing, or the like on both sides.
(2) The facilities shall not have a staircase. However, in the case where it is unavoidable to provide a
staircase, consideration shall be given to the safety of passengers in setting the rises of its steps and
provision oflandings as necessary.
(3) The facilities shall not be used for dual services for both passengers and vehicles. However, this
requirement does not apply in the case where their structures allow the traffic of passengers and the
traffic of vehicles to be separated from each other.
(4) The allowable range of vertical movement of the tip section of a movable bridge of the passenger
boarding facilities shall be appropriately set by taking into consideration the tide levels, the changes in
ship draft and the ship movements.
(5) The risk of impairing the integrity of structural members shall be equal to or less than the threshold
level under the permanent action situation in which the dominant action is self weight.
(6) The risk of impairing the integrity of structural members and the risk of losing the stability of the
foundation section shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the variable action situation
in which the dominant actions are Level 1 earthquake ground motions, imposed load, and winds.
[Commentary]
CD Stability of facility
(a) The settings relating to the design situations excluding accidental situations and performance criteria
of fixed passenger boarding facilities are as shown in Attached Table-70.
-964-
Design situation
Public Notice
~
"
<
} }
,!!
49
5 Safety
,!!
~<
91
Performance
requirements
Surcharges,
Verification item
Structural soundness
Variable
L1 earthquake
ground motion
Self weight,
Structural soundness
(Surchaiges)
(Winds)
(Self weight,
earth pressures,
water pressures)
(Self weight,
surcharges, earth
pressures, water
pressures)
[Technical Nole]
Q) The structure of passenger boarding facilities shall meet the following requirements.
(a) The passages of the passenger boarding facility shall be an appropriate width of about 75cm or more.
Considering the fact that such passages are used by senior citizens and physically handicapped people as well,
it is preferable to have a width of 1.2m or more.
(b) A passageway shall have ancillary provisions such as the side wall and hand rail on both sides, and a skid proof
agent shall be applied or a non-slippery material shall be used on the surface of passageway.
(c) The rises ofthe steps ofthe staircases affixed passenger boarding facilities shall be set giving out consideration
to the safety of passengers. In addition, landings shall be provided as necessary. The rise of each step may
usually be set at around 16cm, and the step width may usually be set at 30cm or more. In the case where
the height of such a staircase exceeds 3m, it is preferable to provide, for every 3m (or less) of height of the
staircase, a landing with width of 1.2m or more.
(d) The boarding facility shall not be used both for passengers and vehicles. If passengers can be separated from
vehicles, however, the facility may be used for both passengers and vehicles.
(e) The inclinations of passages of the passenger boarding facilities shall be ones that are appropriate in terms
of the safety of passengers. The inclinations of passages of the passenger boarding facilities shall normally
be 12% or less. However, considering the fact that such passages are used by senior citizens, and physically
handicapped people as well, it is preferable to use slopes between 5% and 8%.
@ The allowable range of vertical movement of the tip section of a movable bridge of the passenger boarding
facility shall be set taking into consideration the tide range, the changes in ship draft and the ship oscillations.
The range of vertical movement of the tip section of a movable bridge may be calculated by adding I.Om to the
mean monthly tide range.
@ When designing the passenger boarding facilities that are to be used for public traffic, the fact shall be taken into
consideration that they will be used by senior citizens and physically handicapped people as well and sufficient
consideration shall be given to ensuring that they allow people in wheelchairs to move safely on them.
-965-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 49
The performance requirement of the fixed and movable passenger boarding facilities shall be as specified in
the subsequent items for the safe and smooth embarkation and disembarkation of passengers in consideration
of its structure type:
(1) The requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism shall be
satisfied so as to enable the safe and smooth embarkation and disembarkation of passengers.
(2) Damage due to self weight, Level 1 earthquake ground motions, imposed load, winds, and/or other
actions shall not adversely affect the continued use of the fixed or movable passenger boarding facilities
and not impair their functions.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Movable Passenger Boarding Facilities
Article 92
1 The provisions in the preceding article except those in item (6) shall be applied to the performance criteria
of movable passenger boarding facilities with modifications as necessary, in consideration of the type of
the facilities.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criterion of movable passenger
boarding facilities shall be such that the risk oflosing the stability of the facilities due to uplifting of the leg
section of the facilities shall be equal to or less than the threshold level under the variable action situation
in which the dominant actions are Level I earthquake ground motions, imposed load, and winds.
[Commentary]
(!)Performance Criteria of Movable Passenger Boarding Facilities
CD Stability of facilities
(a) Stability of the leg section (serviceability)
The settings relating to the design situations except accidental situations and performance criteria
of movable passenger boarding facilities are as shown in Attached Table 71. When verifying the
performance of a movable passenger boarding facility with respect to the risk of uplifting of the leg
section, appropriate performance criteria regarding its stability shall be established.
-966-
Design situation
Public Notice
Index of
Performance
~<
} ~}
,!!
49
,!!
2
<
91
requirements
Situation
Dominating action
limit value
Non-dominating action
Surcharges, earth
Structural soundness
pressures, water pressures of the members,
stability of the
foundation section
of the members,
pressures
stability of the
standard
Verification item
Variable
L1 earthquake
ground motion
Structural soundness
foundation section
(Surcharges)
(Self weight, earth
pressures, water pressures)
(Winds)
Ll earthquake
ground motion
pressures
(Surcharges)
(Self weight, earth
(winds)
References
1)
2)
3)
Transport Ecology and mobility Foundation: Guideline ofthe facilities for elderly and handicapped people in public transport
terminals, 2001
Japan Road Association: Specifications and Commentary for Highway Bridges, Maruzen Publications, 2002
Japan Road Association: Technical Standards and commentary of grade separation facilities for pedestrians, 1979
-967-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 50
1 The performance requirements of waste disposal sites shall be such that the requirements specified by the
Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism are satisfied so as to appropriately dispose waste
materials and protect disposal sites.
2 The provisions of Article 16 shall be applied correspondingly to the performance requirements for waste
disposal sites.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Waste Disposal Sites
Article 93
1 The provisions in Article 39 shall be as applied to the performance criteria of waste disposal sites with
modifications as necessary.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the performance criteria of waste disposal sites
shall be such that waste disposal sites are appropriately located with the necessary dimensions so as to
prevent washing out of the wasted materials by waves, storm surges, tsunamis, and others by taking into
consideration the environmental conditions to which the facilities concerned are subjected.
[Technical Note]
2.1 General
(!) Wastes disposal sites are classified, according to what types ofwastes are disposed of, into three types: (a) inert type
wastes disposal sites where inert type industrial wastes, dredged material and excavated soil from construction
site are dumped, (b) controlled type disposal sites where municipal solid wastes and controlled industrial wastes
are disposed of, (c) strictly controlled type wastes disposal sites in which harmful specially controlled industrial
wastes are sealed.
(2) The purposes of constructing wastes disposal seawalls are to ensure the availability of wastes disposal and
to utilize completed disposal sites. The area and location of the wastes disposal sites shall be determined in
consideration of the demands of the land use and the constraint to be imposed under the Wastes Management and
Public Cleaning Law when it is applicable.
(3) No wastes disposal sites has been constructed in areas other than sea areas and it is expected that most of the
wastes disposal sites tbat will be constructed in the future will also be located in sea areas. Therefore, the term
"wastes disposal sites" here refers only to be sites constructed in seas. The characteristics of the wastes disposal
sites are; CD to take into consideration the actions of waves and seismic motion, @ in the case of a site for
controlled disposal area, to ensure the stability of the seawall and seepage control work by controlling the water
levels of the retained water.
Inert type wastes disposal sites are facilities to create a reclaimed land by using inert type industrial wastes excavated
soil from construction seawalls and dredged material.
-968-
CD
If a landfill site has continuous layer whose thickness is Sm or more and whose coefficient of permeability is k
~ lxlO"cm/s or less (an impermeable layer) at the bottom and at the sides of the site, it is not necessary to provide
any seepage control work.
@ The case where there is no impermeable layer that covers the entire bottom of the landfill site;
It is regulated that, if there is no impermeable layer, seepage control work that satisfies the requirements
given below (this is called surface seepage control work) or seepage control work having the equivalent or
better seepage control capability be provided. In addition, wastes disposal seawalls located in areas where
deteriorations of impervious sheets due to sunlight may occur are subject to the surface seepage control work
protection requirements including spreading of the light-blocking nonwoven fabric.
(a) The impervious sheet is laid on the surface of a layer of clay or other material having a thickness of 50cm or
more and a coefficient of permeability of k ~1xJOcmis or less.
(b) The impervious sheet is laid on the surface of a layer of asphalt concrete of a thickness of 5cm or more and a
coefficient of permeability of k ~1xJ07cm/s or less.
(c) Double impervious sheets are laid on the surface of a non-woven fabric or any other material. A non-woven
fabric or any other material which has a sufficient thickness and strength fur preventing simultaneous damage
of both impervious sheets is provided between the impervious sheets.
@ The case where there is a impermeable layer that covers the entire bottom of the landfill site;
It is regulated that, if there is a impermeable layer, seepage control work that satisfies the requirements given
below or seepage control work having the equivalent or better seepage control capability be provided. It is also
required that such seepage control work reach the impermeable layer.
-969-
(a) The ground around the landfill site is solidified to impermeable layer to a Lugeon value of 1 or less by grouting
of chemicals.
(b) There is provided a wall of a thickness of50cm or more and a coefficient ofpenneability of k=lxl06cm/s or
less around the landfill site to the impermeable layer.
(c) There are provided steel sheet piles (limited to those which have measures taken to prevent leaching ofretained
water or the like from the part ofjoint with the other sheet piles) around the landfill site to the impermeable
layer.
(d) Seepage control work that satisfies the requirements specified in (a) to (c) of@ above.
(3) In the case of inland wastes disposal sites, it is often the case that impervious sheets are used to ensure that
sufficient seepage control perfurmance of the bottom is achieved. On the other hand, in the case of wastes disposal
sites located in areas in seas, it is often the case that cohesive soil below the bottom is used to ensure that sufficient
seepage control performance ofthe bottom is achieved. In such a case, it is necessary to confirm whether a layer
of cohesive soil which is equivalent to an impermeable layer exists at the bottoms ofthe disposal sites located in
seas and to confirm that the sttata of cohesive soils have a impermeability equivalent to that of an impermeable
layer specified in the Ministerial Ordinance Determining Engineering Standards Pertaining to Final Disposal Site
for Municipal Solid Wastes and Final Disposal Site for Industrial Wastes.
It can be considered that a stratum having a seepage control capability equivalent to that of an impermeable
layer is evaluated by the permeation time. The permeation time can usually be calculated by equation (2.4.1).
L2
t=-
kh
(2.4.1)
where,
t : permeation time (s)
L : permeation distance (thickness of layer) (cm)
le : coefficient of permeation (cm/s)
h : water level difference in the layer, see Fig. l.4.1 (cm)
- ----r---
~ ---- ~--. .... .. ... .. ... . .. ... . .. . . .. . . .. . . .. . . .. . . .. . .. .
. . . . . . . . .
L
Layer of cohesive soil
.. .. ... .. ... .. ... .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. .. . ' ... ..
. . .. . .. . .. . ..
.-.........
. ..
... ..... .. ... ....... ......
Calculations ofthe thicknesses oflayers which are equivalent in terms ofthe permeation time to a impermeable
layer whose thickness is 5m or more and coefficient of permeability is k=lxl0-5cm/s or less using equation (2.4.1)
result in a layer thickness of 1.6m or more in the case ofa layer ofa cohesive soil whose coefficient of permeability
is k =lxI0-6cm/s. The layer thickness and continuity ofan impermeable layer shall be confirmed through a boring
survey. When determining the layer thickness, it is desirable to add an allowance taking into consideration the
non-uniformity ofthe soil layer.
(4) To prevent leaching ofthe retained water from the inside ofa costal wastes disposal site, it is preferable to maintain
the water level of the retained water low.
(5) Controlled type wastes disposal sites retain their seepage control capability after the wastes disposal areas cease
to be used., and it is possible that the structural stability of seawalls for controlled type wastes disposal site may
be impaired when the level of the retained water exceeds the control water level as a result of rain etc. Therefore,
it is necessary to confirm during the performance verification the stability of the seawalls ofwhich the level ofthe
retained water reaches the expected highest level after the disuse ofthe wastes disposal site.
-970-
References
1)
Port and harbour Bureau, Ministry of Transport: Manual for design, construction and maintenance of revetment of controlled
disposal (Under preparation for publishing)
-971-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
3 Beaches
Ministerial Ordinance
Performance Requirements for Beaches
Article 51
1 The performance requirements for the beaches shall be as specified in the subsequent items to facilitate the
maintenance of the port and harbor environment:
(1) Beaches shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and
Tourism so that they will contribute to the development of the port and harbor environments.
(2) Beaches shall be capable of maintaining a stable state over a long term against variable waves and water
flows.
2 In addition to the requirements specified in the preceding paragraph, the beaches which are utilized by
an unspecified large number of people shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land,
Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so as to ensure the safety of the users of the beaches concerned.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Beaches
Article 94
1 The performance criteria of beaches shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(1) Beaches shall be appropriately located with the necessary dimensions so as to ensure the safe and
comfortable use by people and to contribute to the enhancement of good port environments.
(2) The risk of losing the stability of the beach profiles and plan shape shall be equal to or less than the
threshold level under the variable action situation in which the dominant actions are variable waves and
water flows.
2 In addition to the provisions in the preceding paragraph, the beaches which are utilized by an unspecified
large number of people shall be provided with the dimensions required for securing the safety of the users
by taking into consideration the environmental conditions to which the facilities concerned are subjected
and the utilization conditions.
[Commentary]
...
Public Notice
u
...
Ji ~ Ji
51
94
~
2
Design situation
Performance
requirements
Serviceability Variable
Variable waves,
water flows
-972-
Verification item
value
[Technical Note]
3.1 General
(!) Beaches can be classified into two types according to the grain size distribution of the sediment; beaches of
that consist of mud, sand, and gravel and beaches that consist of base rock and rocky reefs . Each beach can be
zoned into the backshore, fureshore, tidal flat and shoal zones, which are defined based on their relative height
to intertidal zone. Each beach can also be zoned into seagrass meadows and coral reefs based on the types of
ecosystems of floras and faunas. Fig. 3.1.1 shows a cross section of a typical sandy beach.
Backshore
Backshore
width
' '
: .
: '.
Foreshore
Inshore
Foreshore
Inshore width
Offshore
width
.. Backshore zone
. . :height
Slope of
the foreshore
Slope of the inshore
-973-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
-974-
0.04i;;H0 1L,,>0.02
o 0.02<:H0 / L,>0.01
O.Oli;;H,l L,,>0.005
1/5
M,M;ymokieo..t
N : Niigata Coast
K : Kanazawa Coast
0.1
1/10
,N
oN
N N
oS
os
.......
os
1/30
0.01
L __
lo-"
10..
1/15
1/20
1/60
1/100
H>-3
d,r/Ho
Fig. 3.4.1 Relationship between Sea Bottom Slope and Sediment Grain Size>
(tan/l, d 50 and H0 denote the sea bottom slope, median grain size and deepwater wave height, respectively.)
(6) In a verification of stability, it is necessary to predict the short- and long-term changes of the shoreline or the
changes in water depth and the sediment transport amount by using appropriate numerical calculations and
estimation formulas taking into consideration the effects of the facilities for wave control and sediment movement
control facilities.2). 4) The initial shoreline configuration shall remain similar to the shape of the shoreline of the
landscape of the beach after stabilization that is determined based on the actions of waves and the locations of
jetties and detached breakwaters.
(7) When examining a project to constructing or restoring a tidal flat, it is necessary to; (a) give consideration to
ensuring that the landscape of the tidal flat will remain stable and the functional requirements established during
the planning phase will be satisfied, and (b) devise measures to allow organisms desirable for the area to live in
the area. In other words, it is necessary to examine the basic facilities to maintain the landscape of the tidal flat
and measures to allow desirable organisms to live in the tidal flat area, and to facilitate the succession of such
organisms. With regard to this, the following basic principles may be used as a source of reference:
Q) In principle, the crest height of the backshore should be the H.W.L. or higher.
@ The crest height of the backshore of a tidal flat and the inclination of the foreshore of the tidal flat is determined
based on the actions of waves.
@ The foreshore and backshore of a tidal flat should be located in such a way that they will not be frequently
subjected to high waves, so that the stability of the landscape of the beach will be ensured.
@ It is difficult to fix the landscape of the inshore of a tidal flat by waves because the inclinations of the inshore of
tidal flats are very gentle.
In the case of a river mouth tidal flat, the stability of the sediment against the water flow is sometimes taken into
consideration. There is sometimes the case that changes in salinity affect habitats and activities of organisms.
In the case of a foreshore tidal flat, consideration should be given to ensuring the stability of the basic facilities
by, for example, making the beach as flat as possible and so designing the foreshore section that its length is
sufficient. The numbers of organisms that live in the area are sometimes affected by whether the silty clay
contents of the tidal flat and beach are appropriate and whether the water retention capability is appropriate.
<J) The landscape of the foreshore of a foreshore tidal flat sometimes consists of both flat sections and multi-step
bar trough sections. There is sometimes the case that many benthoses such as shellfish and sand lugworms live
in the water depth below the M.W.L.
(8) In a lagoon tidal flat where the surrounding environment becomes important, the sea water circulation and the sea
water quality maintenance will be an important point for the performance verification. The height and slope of
the ground and the settings relating to vegetation are determined based on such considerations. In such a case, the
following basic principles may be used as a source ofreference:
-975-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
CD
With regard to introduction of sea water, it should be ensured that connection with the surrounding waters is
maintained by channels or training jetties.
Introduction of sea water to exchanged is an essential measures of controlling the water levels, salinity,
nutrients and dissolved oxygen. Sluice gates are sometimes used to control these conditions. In such a case,
examinations regarding the water balance are performed that take into consideration the freshwater inflows, sea
water exchanges, sea water circulation, vaporization, precipitation, overflows and underseepage.
Sea water circulations are essential also from the perspective of ensuring that larvae oftransport and recruitment
to and from rivers and the open sea.
@ To avoid the formation of hypoxic water masses near the bottom of a lagoon, it is advisable to be set the ground
height that the water depth will not exceed Im during lowest tide periods.
@ When making the landscape by soil dumping, the height ofthe land shall be determined taking into consideration
of the settlement of the land.
@ Certain kinds of birds have preferences in respect of the water depths of tidal flats and the slope of beaches.
Snipes and plovers prefur water depths of 0.4m or less, and ducks prefer water depths of 0.5m or more.
(9) There are two methods to maintain beaches. One is the sand bypass method which makes the sediment accumulated
on the upstream side of a coast structure flow continuously to the downstream side. The other one is the sand back
pass method which moves the sediment to eroded areas located upstream of the coast structure.
3.5 Amenity
(!) Beaches should be appropriately evaluated in relation to the requirements of the amenity function with the
frequencies of their use for swimming, shellfish gathering and other purposes taken into consideration.
(2) Beaches should be appropriately provided with resting areas and planted vegetation according to their purposes.
When examining the plant vegetation, it is necessary to perform sufficient analyses taking into consideration the
fact that coastal areas are subjected to special environmental conditions such as strong winds, salt water splashes
and saline soils.
(3) It is necessary to take into consideration the fact that the main purpose of beaches is human use and give sufficient
consideration to ensuring the safety of the users so that accidents due to beach deformations should be avoided.
Once a newly constructed or restored beach is opened for public use, it is necessary to conduct periodic patrols
and inspections to confirm that the safety measures are functioning properly. In particular, it is important to take
measures to prevent sand outflows from nourished beaches, which may cause collapses or create cavities that
cannot be recognized from the surface of the ground, and to continuously check for and monitor phenomena that
may affect the safety of the users by conducting periodic patrols and inspections after the beach is opened for
public use.
(4) Beaches provide spaces where people can relax and enjoy recreational activities. However, the safety of beach
users is occasionally threatened by tidal waves, storm surges and tsunamis. Therefore, beaches should be provided
as necessary with emergency communication equipment such as alarm equipment and telephones that is necessary
to allow the beach users to evaluate whether their safuty is being secured.
(2) Beaches can be broken down into such constituents as seaweed colony areas, tidal flats and coral reefs based on
the types of ecosystems of floras and faunas.
References
I)
2)
Port and Harbour Bureau, Ministry of Transport Eclition, Working Group for regeneration of marine nature: Handbook of
Marine Natural reclamation Vol. 2, Tide land, p.138, 2003
Working Group for marine natural reclamation: Handbook of Marine Natural reclamation, Gyose~ 2003
3)
Bureau of Ports and Harbours, Ministry of Transport (Edition)and Japan Port Association: Planning and design manual for
4)
5)
-976-
(Environment friendly Administration of Ports and Harbours, Independent Administrative Institution National Printing
Bureau, 2005.
-977-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
Article 52
The performance requirements for the plazas and green spaces shall be as specified in the subsequent items
to facilitate development of port environments as well as the restoration and reconstruction of the port and
its surrounding areas:
(1) The plazas and green spaces shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land,
Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so that they contribute to the development of good port
environments and to ensure the safety of the users of the plazas and green spaces.
(2) The plazas and green spaces shall satisfy the requirements specified by the Minister of Land,
Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism so that they can be utilized as a base for the restoration and
reconstruction of the port and its surrounding areas in the aftermath of the occurrence of Level 2
earthquake ground motions.
(3) The damage due to Level 2 earthquake ground motions and other actions shall not affect restoration
through minor repair works of the functions required of plazas and green spaces in the aftermath of the
occurrence of Level 2 earthquake ground motions.
Public Notice
Performance Criteria of Plazas and Green Spaces
Article 95
The performance criteria of plazas and green spaces shall be as specified in the subsequent items:
(I) Plazas and green spaces shall be appropriately located with the necessary dimensions so as to ensure the
safe and comfortable use by people and to contribute to the enhancement of good port environments.
(2) Plazas and green spaces shall be capable of being utilized as the bases for restoration and reconstruction
of ports and their surrounding areas after they are subjected to Level 2 earthquake ground motions, and
shall be provided with the dimensions necessary for ensuring smooth transport of goods and materials
and providing the areas for refuges.
(3) The degrees of damage by the action of Level 2 earthquake ground motions, which are the dominant
action in the accidental action situation, shall be equal to or less than the threshold limit.
[Commentary]
-978-
Design situation
Public Notice
~
"
<
} }
,!!
52
,!!
~<
95
Performance
requirements
Verification item
Damages
[Technical Nole]
Plazas and green spaces should preferably be appropriately provided with rest areas and planted vegetation
according to their purposes.
References
1)
2)
3)
Bureau of Port and Harbours, Ministry of Transport (Edition) and Waterfront Vitalization and Environment Research Center:
Design and construction of manual fur tbe arrangement of garden plants on port green belt, 1999
Parks & Open Space Associatinn of Japan: Standard commentary of urban park engineering, 2004
Port and Harbour Bureau, Ministry of Land, Infrastructure and Transport: "Greenization " of Port Administratinn
(Environment friendly Administration of Ports and Harbours, Independent Administrative Institution National Printing
Bureau, 2005.
-979-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
-980-
INDEX
INDEX
A
acceleration response spectrum
827, 837
acceleration time history 245, 609, 610, 611, 693, 694, 696, 697,
484, 486, 487, 491, 522, 523, 524, 525, 536, 545, 546, 547,
600, 602, 604, 605, 613, 623, 624, 627, 631, 634, 649, 706,
707, 777, 778, 779, 785, 786, 788, 791, 819
angular spreading method
92
annual average of daily traffic volume
920, 921
333, 334, 335, 336
aoode
AP!
947
apparent cohesion 223, 224, 430, 431, 432, 484, 486, 487, 600,
602, 703, 704
apparent seismic coeflicient
274, 275, 277, 278, 546, 763
apron
312, 314, 315, 338, 339, 343, 865, 869,
882, 884, 888, 889, 890, 891, 892, 893, 897, 898, 899, 900,
911, 951, 952, 953, 956, 962
apron pavement
338, 339, 890, 891, 897, 898, 899
apron width
865, 869, 889, 890
arc welding
326
armoring work
603, 605, 624
armor stones
128, 129, 411, 412, 413, 414, 415, 416, 417, 418,
420, 424, 614, 690
array observation
204 256
asperity
176, 237, 241, 242, 262, 263, 264, 265, 267, 269
asphalt concrete pavement
asphalt mats
asphalt pavement
Asphalt Paving Guidelines
asphalt stabilization
assessed value offailure probability
assigned traffic volume
astronomical tide
attenuation distance
autocorrelation
average degree of consolidation
average strength of skin friction
axial spring constant of pile
901
si,
469
B
backfilling materials
backfilling stones
back scattering method
backshore
back yard area
bank
6, 75, 212, 224, 225, 226, 353, 356, 482, 485, 490, 492, 493,
503, 540, 547, 561, 568, 569, 570, 571, 628, 650, 669, 797
Bascom
198
base course material
346, 350, 351
basic ship maneuvering width
554
basin
6
7, 122, 175, 178, 179, 194, 196, 200, 250, 251, 363, 552, 554:
577, 578, 579, 580, 581, 582, 588, 590, 651, 662, 674, 802,
807,863,867,868,887,936,950
beach deformation
180, 183, 193, 194, 199, 976
beach erosion
194, 583, 652
beach nourishment
974
beach slope
195
bearing capacity
15, 16,
17, 25, 207, 225, 245, 346, 358, 390, 426, 427, 428, 429, 430,
431, 432, 434, 435, 436, 437, 438, 441, 443, 444, 446, 448,
449, 450, 451, 453, 454, 455, 458, 466, 467, 469, 470, 471,
472, 479, 480, 481, 482, 484, 488, 489, 504, 506, 510, 511,
529, 536, 537, 544, 587, 592, 593, 594, 600, 607, 612, 620,
626, 630, 633, 643, 648, 649, 691, 693, 699, 701, 702, 703,
704, 738, 750, 757, 767, 768, 785, 789, 793, 799, 819, 829,
830, 831, 832, 834, 835, 837, 839, 840, 844, 846, 893, 894,
895,896,898,900,927
bearing capacity coefficient
443, 444, 511, 894, 895, 896
bearing pile
207, 208, 440, 441, 451, 741, 832, 833, 834, 839,
-981-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
909
bearing stress
909
bedload
181, 182, 183, 196
5, 7, 230, 235,
bedrock
236, 238, 248, 250, 251, 253, 258, 262, 263, 264, 265, 358,
441, 608, 609, 610, 614, 615, 693, 694, 696, 822, 826, 944
bending compressive stress
373, 375, 760, 769
bending failure
347, 470
benlhos
975
berm
129, 134, 135, 137, 182, 412, 418, 597, 598, 617
berth 298, 304, 308, 678, 680, 683, 686, 687, 688, 689, 690, 844,
871, 872, 880, 887, 942, 944, 951, 952, 953, 955, 956, 962
berth configuration factor
289, 297, 298, 304
berthing energy
289, 297, 298, 304, 821, 844, 846, 875, 876,
877, 878, 879
berthing velocity
297,298,299,300,301,302,880
bilge keels
689
Bio 495
Bisbop's method
489
bituminous material
19, 343, 358
blast furnace slag
338,350,351,352,521,550
block coefficient
302,303,304,305,556,564
block load
140
block type improvement
498
965, 966
boarding facility
865, 866, 867
boat lift yard
308, 309, 723, 733, 734, 742, 821, 871, 872
bollard
174
bore type tsunami
Borgman
147, 169
bottom frictioo
73, 87, 174, 176, 179, 862
387, 388, 389, 390, 396, 407, 409, 699, 846
bottom reaction
517
bottom seated
bottom slab
280, 373, 374, 377, 378, 379,
382, 383, 384, 385, 387, 388, 390, 391, 392, 394, 395, 396,
397,399,406,409,410,423,469,640, 707, 708,859
boundary element method
305
Boussinesq's solution
475
bulk cargo
buried anchor
buttress wall
312,314, 702,944
805
392,395,396,397
c
caisson
20, 77,
78, 116, 122, 132, 133, 134, 136, 137, 139, 140, 141, 142, 167,
215, 244, 259, 280, 351, 354, 358, 367, 371, 372, 373, 374,
375, 376, 377, 378, 379, 381, 382, 383, 384, 385, 386, 388,
389, 390, 391, 392, 401, 403, 404, 405, 406, 407, 408, 409,
410, 416, 420, 423, 434, 485, 491, 498, 519, 539, 540, 590,
591, 592, 593, 594, 597, 598, 599, 600, 606, 609, 610, 611,
612, 614, 622, 628, 629, 630, 632, 633, 643, 644, 649, 691,
704, 706, 707, 795, 797, 798, 799, 844, 846, 847, 907
caisson breakwater 140, 141, 167, 416, 485, 590, 591, 594, 628,
632, 633, 644
caisson type composite breakwater
592, 593
caisson type dolphin
20, 846
244, 691, 795
caisson type quaywall
93
characteristic value
-982-
4,
5, 7, 9, 11, 20, 21, 22, 129, 150, 180, 210, 211, 212, 213, 215,
277, 280, 298, 304, 305, 306, 307, 312, 314, 317, 323, 328,
329, 330, 335, 338, 339, 340, 345, 347, 348, 349, 358, 368,
369, 370, 378, 382, 383, 388, 400, 401, 411, 418, 421, 427,
429, 434, 435, 436, 437, 439, 440, 441, 442, 443, 444, 450,
451, 452, 453, 454, 455, 456, 457, 458, 486, 487, 488, 500,
502, 503, 504, 505, 508, 510, 511, 512, 519, 520, 525, 526,
INDEX
527, 537, 538, 599, 600, 601, 602, 604, 605, 606, 609, 611,
612, 613, 621, 623, 624, 627, 631, 634, 648, 649, 694, 697,
701, 702, 703, 704, 706, 707, 708, 722, 725, 728, 731, 736,
738, 741, 742, 746, 747, 750, 753, 757, 763, 764, 773, 774,
785, 786, 788, 789, 791, 794, 795, 822, 823, 827, 828, 830,
831, 832, 833, 834, 836, 838, 840, 841, 842, 846, 848, 860,
861, 874, 879, 890, 891, 893, 909, 910
chart datum level
68
chemical grouting method
357, 544
chloride ion
338,369,370,423
Christensen
416, 424
circular slip failure
24, 34, 312, 429, 430, 431, 484, 486, 487, 488, 490, 491, 493,
516, 523, 525, 528, 533, 537, 538, 544, 551, 592, 600, 601,
603, 605, 620, 623, 624, 626, 630, 633, 665, 703, 704, 705,
706, 714, 734, 736, 766, 767, 769, 785,819,836,969
Civil Engioeering Handbook
67, 356, 587, 941, 956, 960
clearance limits
686, 915, 924
cliff
137, 173, 180, 198
closed ended pile
474
closing dike
424
coal ash
19, 350, 352, 545
coal storage yard
7, 958, 959
coarse sand
521
coating material
19, 333, 335
coating method
13, 333, 336, 367
coefficient of active earth pressure
434, 526, 527, 724, 792
coefficient of consolidation
211, 213, 220, 477, 495, 496, 541
coefficient of curvature
521
coefficient of earth pressure 226, 272, 273, 275, 385, 394, 400,
456, 511, 527, 530, 724, 773, 778
coefficient of earth pressure at rest 272, 273, 385, 456, 530, 724
coefficient of horizontal subgrade reaction
436, 437, 820
coefficient of lateral subgrade reaction 458, 464, 468, 820, 838
coefficient of passive earth pressure
740
coefficient of secondary compression
478
coefficient of stress distribution
493, 540
coefficient of variation
22, 28, 34,
36,211,212,213,232,502,603,604,605,613,621,623,624,
627, 631, 634, 649, 706, 707, 736, 830, 832, 833, 834, 874
coefficient of vertical subgrade reaction
437
coefficient of volume compressibility
213, 219, 476, 540
coefficient of wave transmission
116, 117, 632, 638
cohesive material
547
cohesive resistance
435
Collins
168
collision energy
937
collision force
938
color rendering performance
882, 883
compaction method
542, 548, 551
component wave method
88
composite breakwater
19, 116, 132, 133, 134, 137, 166, 259, 358, 412, 413, 418, 420,
421, 424, 592, 593, 595, 596, 598, 603, 605, 612, 615, 618,
619, 622, 624, 625, 626, 628, 630, 632, 633, 644, 649, 650,
846
composite ground
481, 533, 535, 536, 540
composite seismic angle
274, 275, 277, 278
composite slab
407, 409
composite structure
407
compressibility 209, 213, 219, 223, 445, 475, 476, 480, 522, 540
compression curve
218
compression frequency-dependent characteristics
880
compression index
212, 219, 222, 356, 476, 478, 540
compressive strength
209, 225, 227, 232,
258, 274, 339, 345, 352, 366, 432, 448, 452, 464, 500, 502,
511, 519, 520, 524, 525, 534, 535, 544, 545, 836
366, 836
96, 97, 589, 614
331, 332, 333, 334, 336
concentrated load
315, 317, 384, 475, 908, 909
concrete aggregate
350
concrete block type upright hreakwater
625
concrete lid
339, 387, 388, 390, 410, 597, 614
concrete pavement
347, 892, 893, 894, 895, 897, 898, 901
concrete pile
340, 341, 473
concrete slab
409, 892, 893, 894, 896, 897, 898, 899
concrete slab thickness
892, 893, 894, 8%, 897
concrete wall anchorage
16, 20, 684, 685, 722, 737, 738
confining pressure 225, 259, 260, 269, 432, 444, 511, 519, 523,
533, 709
consistency
216, 261, 338, 339
consolidated drained condition
223
consolidated undrained condition
223
consolidation characteristics
207, 218
consolidation rate
493, 540, 541
consolidation settlement 222, 288, 441, 452, 475, 476, 477, 491,
494, 503, 516, 517, %9
consolidation test
218, 219, 221, 222, 226, 475, 477, 478, 496
consolidation theory
221, 222, 476, 477
consolidation yield stress 210, 213, 219, 221, 222, 227, 477, 520
constant coefficient method
161
constructability 9, 10, 40, 49, 325, 342, 490, 588, 637, 890, 930
constructionjoints
340, 614, 898
construction method 40, 41, 49, 55, 441, 443, 447, 529, 551, 619,
690, 718, 723,930,931,932
construction works 41, 180, 224, 345, 350, 384, 431, 446, 447,
449, 518, 588, 633, 796, 820
container crane
322, 818, 835, 944, 945, 946, 947, 951
container freight station
952, 955
container ship
124, 294, 295, 296, 300, 309, 951, 952, 953
container terminal
950, 951, 952, 953, 956
container terminal area
951, 952, 956
continuous slab
395, 396, 740
continuous underground wall
340, 434
controlled industrial wastes
968
converged embedded length
724, 728
coping
197, 723, 733, 734, 743, 877
coral reef
973, 976, 977
Coriolis force
176
corrected acceleration
503, 504, 537
corrosion control
43, 331, 333, 410, 473
corrosion rate
331, 332, 333, 334
Coulomb's equation
470
coupled oscillations
821, 835
coupled-pile anchorage
19, 684, 685, 721, 723, 738, 740, 741,
798
coupled piles
18, 457, 466, 467, 468, 481, 482, 740, 741, 765,
766,838
covering
117, 136, 138, 139, 269, 298, 325, 333, 335, 336, 411,
418,521,522,560, 706,909,928,930
covering work
706
crack caosed by bending
402, 403
cracking
7, 369, 448, 615, 898, 931
crack width
366, 367, 369, 371, 373, 374, 375, 813
crawler crane
317
creep characteristics
452, 880
crest height
10, 139, 165, 866, 867, 974, 975
crest line
107, 195, 204
critical wave height for cargo handling works
122, 123
cross-shore sediment transport
183, 189, 196
614, 615, 625
crown concrete
cumulative distribution function
28,29
curbing
884,885
compressive strength of concrete
concave corner
concentrated corrosion
-983-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
current force
current pressure coefficient
current pressure force
curtain wall
D
damage rate
411, 415, 416, 417, 418, 419, 420, 422
damping factor
230, 231, 232, 248, 255, 256, 257, 260, 520,
822, 945
Darcy's law
217, 667, 668
Davenport
306, 310
dead weight tonnage
290, 298, 300
Dean
169, 198
deep foundation
434,435,436,437,450,452
deep mixing method 19, 352, 498, 499, 500, 503, 506, 548, 549,
694
188
deepwater wave energy flux
deepwater wavelength
136, 184, 187, 413
deepwater waves
88, 89, 126, 127, 132, 202
deepwater wave steepoess
109, 119, 135, 136
deflection curve equation
724
deformation modulus
210, 218, 499, 520
deformation moment
715, 757, 768, 775, 791, 792
deformation of ship hull
304, 880
degree of damage
6,
7, 8, 9, 14, 30, 38, 403, 411, 415, 417, 418, 431, 586, 655, 656,
660, 682, 849, 851, 904, 927, 935, 942, 948
degree of saturation
214, 229
density currents
178, 179
density currents at river mouth
178, 179
deposit layer
7
depth of navigation channel
122, 556, 558, 559, 931
design bearing capacity coefficient
894
design CBR
900, 902
design daily traffic volume
920, 921, 923
design depth
558
design high water level
666
desigo hourly traffic volume
915, 921, 922, 923, 924
design parameter 4, 6, 13, 14, 21, 22, 36, 225, 228, 590, 601, 603
design point
29, 31
design section force
905
design ship
55, 289, 290, 293, 294, 296, 297,
298, 302, 303, 306, 308, 553, 554, 555, 556, 558, 560, 563,
570, 573, 574, 575, 576, 577, 578, 579, 580, 581, 661, 682,
686, 687, 689, 837, 842, 844, 845, 851, 852, 854, 865, 866,
867, 871, 872, 877, 937, 938, 942, 944, 961
design significant wave height
132, 419, 597
design situation
11, 12, 13, 271, 373, 374, 375, 376, 387,
392, 403, 404, 406, 407, 411, 586, 587, 592, 594, 635, 641,
655, 681, 682, 683, 685, 686, 691, 711, 712, 713, 714, 758,
759, 767, 801, 808, 827, 829, 850, 852, 853, 864, 875, 884,
886,889,904,905,928,936,943,949,964,966,972,978
desigo standard traffic volume
914, 915, 922, 923
desigo tide level
139, 156, 388
desigo traffic volume
915, 916, 921, 925
desigo value
5, 21, 22, 129,
210, 213, 215, 314, 331, 366, 368, 369, 411, 412, 418, 421, 426,
427, 428, 429, 430, 434, 436, 437, 439, 440, 442, 450, 452,
453, 454, 455, 456, 457, 466, 472, 484, 486, 487, 488, 489,
500, 505, 508, 510, 511, 512, 516, 526, 527, 537, 538, 598,
599, 600, 601, 602, 606, 612, 649, 699, 701, 702, 703, 704,
708, 725, 731, 732, 733, 734, 736, 737, 738, 739, 740, 741,
743, 747, 748, 763, 764, 775, 777, 778, 779, 785, 786, 791,
792, 793, 804, 823, 827, 828, 830, 831, 832, 833, 835, 836,
857, 860, 861, 862, 873, 874, 879, 892, 893, 901, 938, 944
design vehicle
914, 924, 933
design water depth
616, 690
design water level
138, 389, 620
design wave
119, 136, 137, 141, 145, 151, 154, 155, 156, 166,
169,386,556,590,593,605,607,644,666
design working life
4, 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 19, 23, 39, 42, 43, 44, 45, 50, 55,
79, 123, 152, 155,311,325,344,365,368,369,373,374,375,
403, 411, 593, 605, 607, 624, 836, 893, 895, 896, 900, 901,
925
detached breakwater 92, 93, 95, 96, 98, 142, 180, 194, 416, 424,
589, 674, 973, 974, 975
detached pier
151, 676, 847, 848, 849
detailed desigo
643
diffracted wave
91, 92, 133, 142, 589
diffraction
83, 88, 89, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 98, 142, 146,
148, 159, 163, 164, 173,305
diffraction coefficient
91, 92, 93, 95
diffraction diagram
91, 92, 94, 95
diffraction force
305
diffraction theory
146, 148, 159, 305
dike 20, 114, 116, 165, 167, 168, 197, 424, 498, 669, 671, 672,
797,940,973
dilatancy
223, 544
directional spreading
81, 82, 84, 89, 92, 96, 416
directional spreading function
81, 84
directional spreading parameter
81, 82
directional wave spectrum
81, 84, 86, 88, 117
directivity
237, 242, 264, 267
discontinuous part
139
discrete method
600, 700
displacement of the stabilized body
516, 517
displacement stroke
679
displacement tonnage
293
distribution function
28, 29, 152, 153, 154, 644
divergent wave
124, 125, 127, 128
DOL criterion
154
dolphin 17, 18, 20, 122, 148, 156, 298, 581, 676, 844, 845, 846,
856,875,878
dolphin mooring
156
domestic gross tonnage
290, 293, 687, 689
dominating actions 4, 6, 7, 10, 11, 19, 374, 404, 411, 656, 682,
683,684,685,691,851,853,871,886
Donnelly
418, 424
double-buoy mooring
579
double exponential distribution
60, 153
downdrift
651, 652, 657
DP model
86, 87
drag coefficient 145, 146, 147, 158, 159, 196, 197, 305, 306, 857
drag force
144, 145, 147, 148, 157, 158, 161, 196, 422, 857
drag force by currents
157, 158, 161
drainage 114, 120, 200, 218, 220, 223, 224, 227, 228, 232, 493,
494, 495, 550, 659, 886, 910, 911, 930, 932, 948
drainage distance
220, 494, 495
drainage facilities
114, 200, 886, 932, 948
dredged soil
19, 350, 351, 352, 518, 544, 551
dry container
954
drying shrinkage
435
dry unit weight
214
dry work method
932
DT
298, 837, 922
dual anchoring
579
-984-
INDEX
dual lumped mass system
945
dual main truss
65
DWT
124, 290, 291, 293, 294, 295, 296, 298, 300, 301, 560,
687,688,689,804
dynamic analysis
15, 16,
17, 18, 244, 247, 431, 499, 520, 595, 608, 609, 612, 692, 701,
716, 717, 723, 742, 745, 749, 752, 756, 762, 770, 772, 790,
796, 803, 818, 820, 835, 847, 849, 860, 945
dynamic modulus of deformation
230
dynamic penetration resistance
471
dynamic response
138, 146, 147, 168, 643
dynamic water pressure 271, 280, 394, 504, 505, 506, 509, 526,
527,597,612,665, 702, 708, 723, 725, 731, 794,845
280, 845
dynamic water pressure during an earthquake
DYNEQ
256, 257, 268
E
earth pressure calculation furmula
524
earth pressure offilling
401, 792
earth pressure reduction effect
523, 701, 728
earthquake fault model
176
earthquake ground motion 4, 5, 7, 10, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 25, 235,
238, 240, 243, 245, 246, 255, 264, 265, 266, 267, 269, 271,
364, 365, 372, 373, 374, 375, 378, 379, 380, 382, 384, 391,
392, 407, 431, 440, 455, 484, 489, 499, 500, 504, 508, 510,
512, 513, 515, 516, 537, 585, 586, 587, 592, 593, 594, 595,
598, 607, 608, 609, 610, 611, 612, 624, 635, 654, 655, 656,
657, 659, 660, 676, 677, 678, 679, 680, 681, 682, 683, 684,
685, 691, 692, 693, 694, 697, 698, 701, 702, 703, 704, 707,
708, 709, 711, 712, 713, 714, 715, 716, 719, 720, 722, 723,
725, 731, 732, 734, 736, 737, 739, 740, 741, 742, 743, 744,
745, 746, 747, 748, 749, 750, 752, 753, 755, 756, 757, 758,
759, 760, 762, 763, 767, 768, 769, 770, 772, 774, 775, 779,
787, 789, 790, 794, 795, 796, 797, 798, 810, 811, 812, 813,
814, 815, 817, 818, 823, 824, 826, 827, 829, 833, 834, 837,
838, 840, 841, 842, 843, 846, 848, 851, 852, 865, 870, 903,
904, 905, 906, 907, 913, 914, 915, 927, 928, 935, 941, 942,
943,944,945,948,949,964,965,966,967,969,978,979
earthquake motion 7, 176, 240, 245, 266, 267, 268, 545, 797, 798
earthquake-resistance container crane
944
earthquake-resistance crane
944, 945
earthquake-resistance mechanism
946
earth-retaining section 817, 818, 819, 824, 825, 826, 835, 837,
840, 845, 847, 848
earth-retaining structure
819
ebb tide
179, 181, 188
ebb tide shoreline
181
eccentric and inclined load
488, 597, 598, 600, 613, 620
eccentric distance
438
eccentricity factor
289, 297, 298, 937
economical design
413
eddy viscosity
70, 87
edge wave
174
effective confining pressure
259, 523, 709
effective diameter
495, 496, 497
effective diameter of drain
495, 496, 497
effective fetch
85
effective fetch lengtb
85
effective grain size
217
effective harbor entrance width
588
effective length
456, 457, 460, 663, 748
effective overburdeo pressure
220, 226, 227, 229, 230, 258,
259, 444, 456, 476, 477, 511, 525, 530, 532
effective stress
220, 223, 225, 226, 227, 244, 247, 256, 257, 275, 504, 537,
550, 600, 602, 698, 700, 703, 704, 719, 797, 798, 847, 849
effective stress analysis 244, 256, 257, 275, 504, 537, 698, 700,
-985-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
F
facilities fur wave control
975
facilities prepared fur accidental incident
586, 587
facilities subject to the technical standard 39, 40, 41, 47, 48, 49,
50, 178, 271
500, 501, 512, 513
factor fur effective cross-sectional area
failure mode
6, 7, 24, 36, 37, 38, 445, 547
510
failure of bearing capacity
failure probability
6, 7, 14, 21, 23, 24, 27, 28, 29,
30, 31, 33, 34, 36, 37, 506, 507, 510, 512, 513, 514, 516, 592,
593, 594, 603, 604, 605, 623, 624, 626, 627, 630, 631, 633,
634, 691, 704, 706, 712, 713, 714, 715, 734, 759, 768, 788,
814,829,830,831,833,834
fast Fourier transform (FFT)
609, 693
fatigue failure
79, 367, 409, 410, 813, 815, 826
fatigue limit 5, 365, 367, 373, 374, 375, 391, 399, 403, 815, 895
fatigue limit state 5, 365, 367, 373, 374, 375, 391, 399, 403, 815,
895
fatigue strength
374, 375, 403, 410, 813, 815
FDEL
256, 257
funder
156, 160, 297,
298, 302, 303, 304, 307, 519, 709, 723, 742, 743, 753, 764,
821, 822, 830, 831, 837, 842, 844, 845, 846, 848, 856, 857,
860, 875, 876, 877, 878, 879, 880, 910, 911, 937, 938, 947
funder equipment
875, 877
funder reaction force
723, 742, 753, 764, 830, 831, 837, 854,
857, 860, 880
297, 298, 302, 304, 875, 876, 877, 878, 880
funder system
126, 294, 299, 919, 934
furry
~
K~anm
retch length
84, 85, 86, 87
filler
342, 343, 344, 898
filling
222, 278, 280, 350, 355, 368, 377, 385, 386, 388,
390, 399, 400, 401, 410, 474, 490, 491, 519, 520, 523, 597,
599,614,615,699, 707, 708, 757, 773, 774, 775, 776, 777
filling sand
342, 410, 599, 604, 613, 621, 623, 627, 631, 634,
649, 665, 667, 702, 706, 707, 708
475, 476
fines content
491, 494, 521, 524, 529, 531, 532, 533, 534, 544,
550
finite amplitude standing wave theory
135
finite amplitude wave theory
133, 135, 145
finite diffurence method
93, 265, 477
First-Order Muhinormal approach
38
21, 30
First-Order Reliability Method
fixed passenger boarding facilities
964, %5
FLAC
797
flexibility 86, 246, 289, 297, 298, 304, 343, 421, 726, 728, 878,
932,937
flexibility factor
289, 297, 298, 304, 937
flexibility number
726, 728
FLIP
256, 257, 669, 797, 849
17, 156, 157, 158, 159, 160, 161, 162, 163, 304,
floating body
373, 376, 641, 642, 643, 645, 801, 802, 803, 804, 805, 806,
807,849,851,852,854,858,859
floating breakwater
156, 160, 641, 642, 643
floating bridge
156
floating disaster-prevention base
156
124, 384
floating dock
851
floating mooring facilities
floating pier
4, 5, 156, 577, 578, 643, 676, 851, 852, 853, 854,
855, 856, 857, 858
floating structure
129, 156, 157, 160, 853, 862, 880
floating type
516
flocculation
178
floodgate
659, 660
flood tide
179, 188
150,343,367,847,849,859
floor slab
fluctuating drift furce
159
161, 306
fluctuating wind
fluorescent sand tracers
185, 186
FLUSH
256, 257, 268, 797
fly asb
338, 549
foam treated soil
518
FOMN
38
fuoting
15, 20, 133, 134, 373, 374, 378, 389, 391, 392, 396,
403, 407, 409, 479, 597, 598, 599, 600, 601, 603, 606, 608,
615,640,645,649, 704
foot protection block
339, 351, 615, 616
forced replacement
490
fureshore
181, 182, 188, 973, 974, 975
FORM
21, 29, 30, 31, 33, 37, 38, 167
foundation for cargo handling equipment
908, 909
foundation grouod
15, 16,
17, 25, 140, 230, 233, 244, 245, 352, 426, 429, 430, 432, 488,
498, 504, 506, 534, 537, 587, 592, 594, 597, 598, 600, 601,
603, 604, 607, 609, 612, 613, 620, 623, 626, 627, 630, 631,
633, 634, 648, 649, 650, 665, 668, 691, 693, 699, 701, 702,
703, 704, 706, 707, 714, 768, 796, 797,846,927,928
foundation replacement by excavation
490
Fourier spectrum
235, 250, 252, 263
four principal tidal constituents
68, 69
frame strncture
751, 931
freeboard
801, 807, 849, 851, 852, 854, 856, 858
free earth support method
717, 725
709
frequency domain analysis method
frequency filter
826
frequency spectrum
71, 80, 81, 89, 120, 133, 306
frequency spectrum of wind velocity
306
frictional resistance 127, 307, 358, 426, 434, 505, 526, 527, 614,
708
friction coefficient 20, 244, 306, 347, 358, 359, 506, 507, 508,
598,599,606,607,612,648, 793,873
friction drag
157
342, 358, 599, 611
friction enhancement mat
friction pile
440, 441, 470, 471, 832, 833, 834, 839
front toe reaction force
793
front wall slit
403, 404
fueling facilities
5, 886
290, 302, 581
full load draft
fully plastic state moment
684, 685
950
fumigation
G
galvauic anodes method
334
gate
15, 660, 662, 663, 929, 953
general cargo ship
124, 298, 299, 300, 301
generated electricity flux
334
724, 726, 728, 732, 858
geometrical moment of inertia
geophysical exploration
207, 210
geostrophic wind
59
geosynthetic
353
geotecbnical condition
207, 553, 694, 695
176
Global Positioning System
global warming
78, 201
God.ts formula 129, 130, 131, 132, 133, 134, 137, 139, 140, 141,
142, 144, 605
176, 203
GPS buoy system
gradient wind
58, 59
grain siz.e 180, 184, 187, 196, 210, 213, 216, 217, 229, 271, 343,
344,491,494,521,524,532,533,535, 727,973,974,975
granulated blast furnace slag
350, 352, 521, 550
gravity type breakwater
591, 643, 644
gravity type quaywall
245, 797
-986-
INDEX
gravity type special breakwater
15, 20
gravity type structure
76, 342
Green function
92, 238, 253, 261, 262, 264, 265
Green's law
174
green space
50, 963, 978, 979
Gringorten
152, 169
groin 6, 15, 20, 180, 181, 189, 194, 333, 338, 579, 651, 652, 653,
658, 672
gross tonnage 289, 290, 291, 292, 293, 294, 298, 308, 309, 577,
687, 689, 865, 866, 884, 887, %2
ground bearing capacity
390
17, 800, 801, 802, 804, 805, 806, 807
ground chain
ground contact area
891
ground slots
954, 955
ground stress
426
ground subsidence
288
ground water level
75, 258, 450
group velocity
84,86,90, 128, 186, 195
355, 357, 544
grouting method
152, 153, 154
Gumbel distribution
gust factor
61
Gutenberg-Richter equation
252
H
hammer driving method
443
hanger
869
Hansen
862
harbor calmness
15, 79, 80, 93, 122, 123, 154, 155, 204, 577,
581,583,585,586,588,590,642, 795
harbor entrance
72, 73, 92, 93, 122, 588, 590, 650, 651, 652
harbor paradox
73
harbor resonance
71, 73, 74, 83, 84, 121, 122
hardener
337, 351, 352, 547
hazard curve
253
hazardous cargo
4, 7,376,595,636,642,678,950,959
hazardous cargo handling facilities
376
hazardous materials storage facilities
959
headed stud
409
head loss
76, 217, 494, 496
160,556,557,690,902
heaving
548
heavy tamping method
493, 540
height of embankment
high cube container
924
high-density blocks
416
high earthquake-resistance facilities
365, 375, 376, 398, 540, 676, 678, 679, 680, 681, 682, 683,
685, 686, 704, 716, 734, 736, 737, 745, 746, 749, 752, 756,
762, 768, 772, 790, 796, 810, 811, 812, 814, 817, 818, 829,
830, 831, 833, 834, 903, 904, 907, 915, 935, 942, 948
69, 599, 604, 613, 621, 623, 627, 631,
highest high water level
635, 649, 936, 937
116
highest one-tenth wave
highest water level
68, 69, 172, 173, 174, 590, 596, 597, 599,
619, 653, 689, 786, 795
highest wave
83, 102, 104, 129, 131, 132, 133, 134, 135, 137,
139, 143, 145, 149,588
highest wave height 83, 102, 104, 131, 132, 134, 135, 137, 139,
143, 145, 149
high-fluidity concrete
932
high replacement ratio
533, 536, 541
high-speed ferry
126
high-strength concrete
340
high water level 68, 69, 331, 599, 604, 613, 621, 623, 625, 626,
627,628,631,632,635,649,650,666, 719,936,937
Highway Bridge Specifications and Commentary 64, 316, 330
Hiley's equation
Hiroi's formula
471
133
477
117
Hudson's formula
HWL
HWOST
hybrid caisson
hybrid structure
hydraulic gradient
hydraulic model experiment
420,421
Hyogoken Narnbu Earthquake
hyperbolic model
hypocenter
hypocenter parameter
hysteresis
437, 819
780, 784, 785
404, 628
327, 407, 446, 447, 452
411, 412, 413, 416, 417, 418
68,69,332,333,653, 786
69
407, 408, 409, 410, 597, 614
409, 424
76, 217
193, 194, 404, 405, 412, 418, 419,
256, 261
230
235,240,250,251,656,678
240
230
!HO
936
immediate settlement
288, 475, 478
immersed tunnel
246, 341, 927, 928, 929, 930, 931, 932
immersed tunnel element
341, 927, 928, 929, 930, 931, 932
929
IMO 166, 167, 168, 169, 176, 177, 199, 205, 206, 643, 645, 650,
799
impact load
322
importance sampling
29
improved subsoil 498, 499, 500, 503, 504, 505, 506, 507, 508,
509, 510, 511, 512, 515, 516, 517, 518, 533, 535, 536, 537, 538,
539, 540, 542, 544
503, 504, 506, 509
improved subsoil system
improvement ratio
529, 544
55, 56
975
218
678, 679
182
181, 975
217, 228
14, 226, 232, 461, 480, 500
227
45, 47
installation depth
143, 599, 601, 606, 607, 612
130, 134, 136, 597
intensity of wave pressure
74
Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change
intermediate buoy
156, 856
intermediate soil
223, 225, 228
intermediate weight
156
-987-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
internal earth pressure 373, 375, 378, 379, 380, 382, 385, 386,
389, 391, 392, 399, 400, 401, 407
internal stability
500,503,511,512
internal water pressure
378, 385, 386, 389, 401, 407
290, 294, 687
international gross tonnage
International Hydrographic Organization
936
International Navigation Association
880
International Organization for Standardization
247, 268, 316
international ship container
924
331,332,333,336,973
intertidal zone
inverse fast Fourier transform
609, 693
IPCC
74, 78
Iribarren-Hudson's formula
413
lsbash's constant
421, 422
ISO
11, 21, 29, 39, 244, 247, 268, 314, 316
J
jacket
18, 20, 841, 842, 843
jacket type pier
817
Japanese Industrial Standards
19
Japanese Unified Soil Classification System
216, 217
Japan Society of Civil Engineers
170, 310
jetty
15, 657, 658, 659, 908, 974
joint 16, 27, 31, 58, 60, 76, 77, 79, 88, 147, 154, 155, 156, 157,
326, 327, 328, 340, 353, 354, 389, 390, 410, 449, 454, 456,
473, 614, 615, 665, 667, 668, 699, 719, 732, 747, 757, 764,
768, 776, 778, 779, 787, 815, 835, 857, 860, 861, 890, 898,
899, 908, 927, 928, 929, 930, 931, 932, 970
joint board
353
joint distribution
147
joint frequency distribution
58, 79, 154, 155
joint probability density function
27
joint structure
473, 899, 930
IB~
~n~~K~n
78, 163, 164, 165, 166, 167, 168, 169, 170, 171, 177, 198, 199,
200, 204, 205, 206, 247, 268, 269, 278, 309, 326, 337, 341,
344, 345, 352, 356, 358, 359, 423, 424, 425, 480, 481, 482,
548, 550, 551, 587, 643, 644, 645, 648, 650, 659, 669, 671,
796, 797, 798, 799, 847, 849, 850, 862, 911, 926, 938, 956,
960, 976
judgment of liquefaction
229
K
Kana
165, 198, 269, 547, 548, 797
Karman
149
KDvalue
413, 415, 417
keel clearance
299, 304, 377, 554, 578, 580, 662, 686
Kelvin
125, 128
Keulegan-Carpenter number
145
key element method
932
KiK-net
238,250,268
kinematic viscosity of water
127
K-NET
238,250,251
Kuroshio
74
L
laboratnry mixing test
500, 525
laboratnry permeability test
217
landfill material
19, 350, 351, 523, 761, 890
landscape
49, 50, 176, 931, 937, 974, 975, 976
large isolated structure
148
large-scale triaxial compression test
345, 431
lateral bearing capacity
435, 458, 466, 480, 481, 482, 738
lateral displacement
288, 467, 478, 516, 520, 718
lateral flow
717
lateral loading test
458, 464, 820
lateral resistance of pile
459, 747, 748, 820
-988-
INDEX
lock
661, 662, 663
logarithmic normal distribution
22
log loader
317
longitudinal constructionjoint
898
longitudinal gradient
931
long-period wave 71, 73, 120, 121, 122, 123, 124, 165, 166, 170,
204,205,206,582
long pile
456, 459, 460, 461, 738, 742
longshore bar
181, 189, 191, 192, 198
longshore currents
165
longshore sediment transport 180, 181, 183, 185, 186, 195, 196,
651,652,657,672
longshore sediment transport rate
180, 181, 185, 186, 195
long-term consolidation
475, 477
Longuet-Higgins
117, 165
long wave
98, 164, 172, 173, 175, 176
low crested upright wall
133
low water level
68, 331, 333, 519, 596, 602
LPG carrier
294, 298
L-shaped block type quaywall
691
L-shaped member
197
L-type scouring
192
luni-solar diurnal component of tides
69
L\VL
68,331,332,333,537,699, 704, 719, 773, 786,866
LWOST
69
M
Mach-stem wave
588, 652
Mackenzie
862
Magnitude
236, 237, 243, 252, 253, 269
maintenanceability
9, 10
maintenance cost
55, 876, 906, 907
maintenance dredging
43, 674, 931
maintenance level
44, 45
maintenance planning document
42
maintenance program
41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 47
maintenance shop
952, 955
maintenance work
5, 42, 43, 44, 45, 337, 861, 939
Manning's roughness coefficient
176
manoeuverability index of turning
575
marina
120, 122, 194, 881, 915, 916, 919
Markov Chain Monte Carlo
29
marshaling area
951, 952, 954, 955, 956
901, 902
Marshall stability
mass concrete block type upright breakwater
625
mastic asphalt
342, 343, 344, 652
material factor
365, 368, 369
mattress work
617
Mavis
145, 168
maximum allowable vehicle traffic volume
914
maximum draft
553, 554, 578, 579, 580, 581, 686
maximum instantaneous wind speed
61
maximum moment model
252
maximum scouring depth
190, 191
maximum wave 98, 105, 126, 127, 130, 131, 132, 135, 136, 137,
147, 151, 152, 417, 558
mean adhesion
435, 444, 455
meandering damage
142
mean low water level
331, 333, 596
mean monthly-highest water level 68, 590, 596, 597, 599, 619,
653,689, 795
mean monthly-lowest water level
68, 596, 699, 719, 866
106, 155
mean period
mean sea level
68, 69, 74, 75
mean uneven settlement ratio
478
mean water level
57, 69, 70, 104, 105, 117, 119, 201, 596, 597
mean wave height
83, 116
median diameter
184, 185
member factor
365, 370, 371, 836, 837
metacenter
377, 558
metenrological tide
68, 69
method with cross-sectional division
859
microtremor
238, 248, 251, 252, 266
mild-slope equation
88, 93
minimization of expected total cost
24, 25
Ministry of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and Tourism
21,
40,43
MIR criterion
154
mixing blades
501
MLIT
926
mobile crane
61, 63, 914, 915, 925
model test
13, 14, 91, 92, 96, 103, 104, 105, 107, 109, 116,
122, 128, 129, 134, 135, 136, 138, 139, 140, 141, 143, 144,
145, 148, 150, 151, 156, 157, 160, 161, 162, 163, 165, 169, 259,
275, 302, 411, 460, 544, 620, 622, 625, 628, 629, 632, 636,
637,642,648, 726, 727, 770, 773, 775, 776, 793, 795,879
model vibration test
700
moderate heat portland cement
338
modified Fellenius method
429, 430, 486, 487, 488, 537, 600
modified seismic coefficient method
246
modified virtual slope method
106
modulus of elasticity
458, 474, 475, 909, 910
modulus of subgrade reaction 717, 718, 724, 726, 727, 728, 731,
779, 780
modulus of volume
257
moment of inertia 303, 378, 468, 724, 726, 728, 732, 858, 909
monitoring 50, 179, 201, 205, 482, 486, 661, 887, 888, 930, 931,
932
mooring anchor 17, 156, 578, 579, 641, 643, 801, 802, 804, 805,
851, 853, 854, 858, 860, 861, 862
mooring buoy
5, 157, 159, 676, 800, 801, 802, 803, 804, 805,
807, 849, 851
mooring chains
854, 857, 858, 859
mooring dolphin
844
mooring equipment 156, 160, 161, 163, 297, 852, 853, 880, 936
mooring facilities 6, 15, 18, 24, 38, 43, 50, 83, 84, 122, 245, 279,
289, 297, 298, 299, 303, 304, 308, 309, 314, 324, 363, 577,
578, 584, 662, 676, 678, 679, 686, 749, 755, 844, 851, 853,
857, 870, 871, 872, 875, 877, 878, 879, 880, 881, 882, 884,
886, 887, 888, 889, 892, 893, 898, 900, 907, 909, 934, 942,
944, 945, 947
mooring force
156, 157, 160, 161, 162, 857
mooring line
121, 156, 157, 160, 641, 642, 643, 686, 870, 871,
872
mooring pile
5, 20, 577, 578, 676, 808
mooring post 297, 304, 308, 309, 709, 844, 846, 870, 871, 872,
873, 874, 884, 910, 911, 953
mooring ring
18, 870, 871, 872, 873, 874
mooring rod
156
mooring rope
120, 163, 204, 307, 308, 309, 853
mooring system
121, 156, 157, 160, 204, 289, 304, 307, 579,
642,850,852,858,861
Morihira's formula
139
motions of floating body
643
movable bed
193, 194
movable bridge
885,964,965
movable passenger boarding facilities
963, 964, 965, 966
MRI
86, 87, 163
MSL
68
Muller's equation
859
multi directional random waves
81, 88, 104, 147
multi-layered ground
268
multiple integrals
21, 27, 28
multiple lanes
922,923
-989-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
multiple reflection theory
multiple-wing type permeable breakwater
multi-purpose wharf
Munk
mvmethod
Myers' formula
248, 696
117
950
84, 163
219, 476
59
N
National Institute for Laod aod Iofrastructure Maoagement
48, 78, 248, 269, 296, 423, 553, 576, 643, 797, 798, 799, 911,
926, 938, 956
natural beach
180, 188, 189, 973
natural frequency
71, 72, 120, 146, 173, 695, 696
natural frequency of gronnd
695, 696
natural frequency period
71, 72, 120, 146, 173
natural period 73, 121, 124, 204, 246, 696, 721, 818, 820, 822,
823,824,826,827,837,842,843,857,944,945
natural period of gronnd
696
nautical chart
68
navigation channel
7, 122, 178, 194, 553, 554, 555, 556, 558,
559, 560, 571, 574, 575, 588, 652, 931
nearshore cnrrents
178, 179, 186, 196
nearshore zone
198
negative friction
451
negative skin friction
435, 441, 442, 451, 452, 453, 474, 503
negative wave force
134, 135
negative wave pressure
134, 135
nentral axis ratio
366
NHHWL
69
nominal diameter
366, 413, 414, 415
non-breaking
128, 139, 174, 412, 413, 415, 417
non-dominating actions
11, 19, 404
non-exceedance probability
152, 153, 154
nonlinear aoalysis
255, 256, 257, 260
nonlinear dynamic aoalysis
835
nonlinear interaction
86, 87, 88
nonlinearity 33, 98, 147, 148, 151, 156, 218, 219, 230, 304, 650
nonlinear seismic response analysis
14, 30, 500, 818
nonlinear wave transformation model
96
non-reinforced concrete 338, 339, 365, 599, 604, 613, 621, 623,
627,631,634,649, 702, 706, 707,897
normal consolidation
218, 219, 222, 476
normal distribution
22, 23, 28, 161, 162, 211, 233, 502
normal random variable
28, 30, 31
normal stress
223, 224, 225, 501, 537
NOWPHAS
155, 170, 205, 206
NS value
412
N-type sconring
192
nnrnber of containers handled
916, 917, 954
nnrnber of lanes
914, 915, 921, 922, 923
nnrnerical computation
92, 129, 178, 195
numerical simulation
108, 161, 164, 174, 175, 176, 177, 193,
194, 201, 304, 648, 858
N-value
207, 211,
225, 229, 232, 432, 433, 443, 444, 445, 452, 453, 455, 459,
460, 464, 465, 491, 4%, 525, 529, 530, 531, 532, 534, 542,
543, 727, 728, 741, 742, 820, 830, 831, 832, 833, 834
0
oblique berthing
oblique compression characteristics
obliquely incident wave
occupancy ratio of large vehicle
occurrence frequency
occurrence probability
occnrrence probability distribution
ocean currents
880
880
91, 92
917
83, 155
69
69
172, 178
offshore
41, 67, 70, 80, 82, 83, 84, 87, 90, 117, 122, 130, 132,
135, 143, 144, 155, 156, 157, 168, 170, 180, 181, 183, 188, 189,
194, 195, 196, 202, 203, 204, 205, 297, 299, 301, 341, 344,
490, 502, 581, 589, 616, 645, 652, 686, 807, 969, 974
offshore berth
297, 299, 301, 581
offshore petrolenrn stockpiling base
156
offshore waves
80, 82, 83, 84, 144, 155
offshore wind
67, 87
oil handling equipment
942
oil storage facilities
7, 959
one-dimensional seismic response analysis
609, 822
one-line theory
194
open ended pile
446, 474, 480
open storage yard
7, 314, 890, 958, 959
open-type quaywall with sheet pile wall anchored by furward
batter piles
752
open-type wharf
339, 369, 371, 719, 818, 819, 820, 821, 835,
836, 837, 903
open-type wharf on vertical piles
818, 820, 835, 836
open-type wharves on coupled raking piles 817, 837, 838, 839
optimization problem
31, 38
ore carrier
297
original sea bottom depth
690
overburden pressure
213, 219, 220, 226, 227, 229, 230, 258,
259, 429, 444, 456, 476, 477, 511, 525, 530, 532
overconsolidation ratio
213, 228
overturning
14, 15, 16, 36, 38, 74, 141, 245, 373, 376, 458,
504, 506, 508, 509, 536, 537, 586, 587, 592, 593, 594, 599,
603, 606, 608, 609, 612, 620, 623, 626, 630, 633, 648, 649,
654, 655, 691, 693, 699, 701, 703, 704, 707, 708, 758, 759,
767, 770, 773, 789, 792, 793, 846, 871, 872, 873, 874, 944
overturning resistance coefficient
792
p
packed drain
494
parallel system
7, 36
parapet
6, 15, 20, 109, 116, 136, 165, 167, 339, 598, 614, 654,
655, 674
parking lots
6, 678, 933
partial factor
4, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 21, 22, 24,
25, 36, 129, 210, 212, 213, 215, 315, 368, 370, 390, 391, 411,
426, 427, 428, 429, 430, 431, 434, 436, 437, 440, 441, 450,
452, 453, 454, 455, 472, 485, 486, 487, 488, 489, 491, 493,
500, 505, 506, 508, 509, 510, 511, 512, 513, 514, 515, 516,
525, 526, 527, 528, 538, 590, 598, 599, 600, 601, 602, 603,
605, 606, 607, 612, 613, 620, 623, 624, 626, 630, 633, 648,
649, 701, 703, 704, 705, 706, 707, 708, 725, 731, 733, 734,
736, 737, 738, 739, 740, 743, 747, 748, 764, 778, 779, 785,
786, 787, 788, 791, 792, 793, 794, 804, 827, 828, 829, 839,
857,860,861,862,874,876,879,892,893,901
partial factor method
14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 21, 22
particle density
209, 210, 214, 350, 524
particle size distribution
49, 445
partition wall
139, 373, 374, 375, 377, 384, 385, 387, 389, 390, 391, 392,
400, 401, 402, 403, 406, 407, 409, 410, 708, 757, 859
passenger boarding facilities
43, 869, 887, 963, 964, 965, 966
passenger ship
50, 309, 552, 678, 884, 887
passive earth pressure
272, 273, 277, 435, 436, 437, 469, 470, 503, 507, 508, 510,
515, 516, 709, 717, 719, 725, 732, 737, 738, 739, 740, 742,
743, 746, 763, 764, 766, 775, 777, 780, 781, 785, 798
PC
38, 74, 78, 155, 292, 294, 298, 326, 327, 328, 340, 341,
550, 576, 688, 733, 897, 933
586
peak cut effect
peak frequency
81, 121
peak honrly traffic
919, 921
-990-
INDEX
peak wave height
Peck
penetration depth
perfurated wall
perfurated-wall caisson
perfurmance-based design
132, 152
450, 480, 548, 798
434, 435, 437, 447, 456, 930
404, 645
136, 142, 628
8, 911
performance criteria
4, 6, 7, 8, 12, 13, 19,
58, 79, 289, 365, 372, 373, 374, 375, 376, 391, 392, 398, 403,
404, 407, 411, 544, 553, 577, 582, 585, 586, 587, 592, 593,
594, 635, 640, 641, 651, 654, 655, 657, 659, 660, 661, 664,
669, 672, 674, 681, 682, 683, 685, 686, 691, 711, 712, 713,
714, 744, 755, 758, 759, 767, 770, 789, 800, 801, 808, 810,
8ll, 812, 813, 814, 815, 816, 835, 841, 842, 847, 851, 852,
853, 864, 865, 870, 871, 875, 884, 885, 886, 887, 888, 889,
903, 904, 905, 913, 914, 927, 928, 929, 933, 935, 936, 942,
943,948,949,957,958,959,961,964,966,968,972,978
performance requirements
42, 43, 44, 45, 79, 364, 365, 409, 410, 499, 500, 516, 517, 518,
520, 552, 553, 577, 582, 583, 584, 585, 586, 622, 625, 651,
654, 655, 657, 659, 660, 661, 664, 669, 671, 672, 674, 676,
678, 680, 682, 808, 810, 811, 812, 827, 836, 849, 851, 864,
865, 870, 913, 914, 927, 933, 935, 940, 941, 942, 944, 948,
958, 961, 963, 968, 972, 978
performance verification
4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,
~~~~~~~~~~~~n~~
68, 70, 71, 75, 79, 80, 81, 82, 84, 93, 105, 109, 114, 119, 121,
132, 134, 135, 141, 142, 143, 146, 152, 154, 156, 173, 176,
178, 200, 201, 207, 208, 210, 212, 213, 221, 224, 225, 226,
227, 228, 230, 239, 244, 245, 247, 248, 255, 264, 271, 279,
280, 289, 294, 297, 304, 309, 312, 314, 317, 325, 328, 333,
337, 338, 339, 340, 341, 343, 358, 372, 373, 374, 375, 376,
378, 379, 381, 382, 383, 384, 385, 387, 389, 391, 392, 394,
395, 396, 397, 398, 399, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 408, 409,
410, 411, 412, 415, 418, 419, 424, 426, 432, 439, 441, 442,
458, 470, 473, 475, 477, 478, 485, 490, 492, 493, 494, 496,
498, 499, 500, 501, 503, 505, 506, 518, 519, 521, 523, 525,
529, 533, 536, 537, 540, 542, 543, 544, 545, 553, 554, 555,
578, 579, 581, 583, 586, 587, 590, 593, 595, 596, 597, 598,
600, 605, 606, 607, 608, 609, 611, 612, 613, 614, 618, 619,
622, 624, 625, 628, 629, 632, 636, 641, 642, 643, 647, 648,
650, 651, 655, 656, 657, 660, 661, 664, 665, 672, 676, 684,
686, 691, 693, 697, 698, 700, 702, 703, 708, 709, 715, 717,
719, 720, 722, 723, 725, 731, 734, 737, 740, 742, 744, 745,
746, 749, 750, 751, 753, 754, 755, 757, 760, 761, 762, 763,
770, 771, 773, 775, 789, 790, 791, 792, 793, 795, 797, 801,
802, 803, 817, 818, 821, 822, 824, 826, 836, 837, 838, 839,
840, 841, 842, 843, 844, 846, 847, 848, 849, 852, 853, 854,
855, 857, 864, 865, 866, 871, 875, 876, 877, 878, 880, 881,
890, 891, 892, 893, 894, 900, 907, 908, 909, 915, 916, 928,
929, 931, 933, 937, 941, 945, 951, 952, 965, 970, 975
performance verification method
21, 22, 210, 213, 226, 230, 415, 490, 498, 518, 590, 605, 691,
717, 744, 751, 757, 770, 789, 791, 852, 854
performance verification of seismic-resistant
230, 255, 595,
607, 608, 719, 818, 822, 824, 945
permanent action
4, 6, 7, 9, 372, 373, 392, 592, 659, 691, 711,
744, 755, 758, 767,927,932,942,964,969
permanent situation
24, 272, 314, 372, 373, 432,
486, 489, 592, 594, 601, 603, 623, 626, 630, 643, 691, 701,
702, 703, 704, 712, 713, 714, 715, 725, 728, 733, 734, 738,
741, 743, 747, 759, 768, 769, 773, 775, 779, 787, 789, 793,864
permeability test
217, 228
permeable detached breakwater
194
permeable rubble-mound breakwater
73
permeable type
ll7, 404, 589, 638
permeation coefficient
76
phase lag function method
161
phase velocity
87, 128, 251, 266, 267
PHC
340
Phillips
87
PHRI method
458, 459, 461, 747, 748
physically handicapped person
929
PIANC
309, 880, 910, 9ll
pier 4, 5, 17, 18, 20, 36, 148, 150, 151, 156, 169, 196, 203, 297,
312, 315, 339, 367, 577, 578, 579, 643, 676, 751, 753, 754,
810, 811, 812, 815, 816, 817, 818, 820, 821, 822, 823, 824,
826, 827, 828, 829, 835, 836, 837, 838, 840, 841, 842, 843,
847, 848, 849, 851, 852, 853, 854, 855, 856, 857, 858, 870,
875, 878, 894, 895, 897, 898, 903, 907, 908, 935, 936, 937,
944, 945
Pierson-Moskowitz
87
piled pier
18, 20, 148, 150, 151, 297,
315, 751, 753, 754, 810, 811, 812, 815, 816, 817, 818, 820, 821,
822, 823, 824, 826, 827, 828, 829, 835, 836, 837, 838, 840,
841, 842, 843, 878, 894, 895, 897, 898, 903, 907, 908
pile driving test
472
pile fuondation
426, 434, 439, 449, 469, 470, 479, 480, 482,
640,849,850,907,908
pile group
439, 450, 452, 453, 454, 456, 466, 470, 480, 482,
838, 839, 847, 849
pile head displacement
457, 458, 470
pile joint
76, 454, 665, 667, 668, 719, 776, 778, 835
pile-supported section
818, 821
pile type breakwater
20
pile type dolphin
18, 20, 844, 846
pile type fender
875, 878
pipeline
168, 196, 246, 882
pipe type permeable breakwater
ll7
piping
353, 732
piping phenomenon
732
pitching
160, 556, 557, 690
placement-type cellular-bulkhead
485, 789, 795
placement-type cellular-bulkhead quaywall
485, 789, 795
plastering block
801
plastic board drain
543
plastic defurmation
219
plastic flow
343, 426, 475
plasticity index
228, 232, 259
plate loading test
894
platform
17, 20, 157, 384, 685, 686, 726, 757, 758, 759, 760,
761, 762, 763, 764, 765, 766,845,878
plaza
5, 963, 978
pneumatic caisson
434
pneumatic fender
875
pneumatic flow mixing method
544, 548, 551
pneumatic unloader
322, 323
pocket dredging
674
point mass model
709
Poisson's ratio
218, 232, 328, 474, 475, 520, 938
pontoon
353, 641, 854, 856, 857, 858, 859, 860, 861
porous wall
628
portal bridge crane
848
Port and Airport Research Institute
48, 93, 164, 370
Port and Harbour Law
3
Port and Harbour Research Institute
170, 171, 309, 310, 738
port area
49, 50, 343, 351, 428, 477, 478, 488, 914, 926
port steel structure
334, 335, 336
Poulos
482
Prakash
481
pre-consolidation pressure
223
premixing method
523, 524, 525, 545
premixing-type stabilization method
550
pressure coefficient 61, 63, 64, 137, 139, 158, 307, 786, 788, 793
pressure gradient
58
-991-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
pressure moment coefficient
305
pressure type wave gauge
202
primary consolidation
221, 477
principal dimensions of ship
293
principal direction
89, 147
probabilistic variable
828
probability density
21, 27, 31, 161, 301
probability density function
21, 27, 301
probability of action
9
Product of Conditional Marginals
38
progressive waves
125, 133, 136, 143, 149, 151, 305
projected area
62, 64, 65, 66, 157, 158, 196, 305, 306, 307
propagation path effects 235, 238, 249, 250, 251, 253, 261, 262,
263,264
protective facilities for harbor
43, 363, 583, 969
protective potential
335
PS logging method
232
Public Notice ofMinistry of Land, Infrastructure, Transport and
40, 43
Tourism
pulling resistance of pile
454, 455, 456, 821
pulling test
455, 750
punching shear
167, 392, 429, 836
punching shear failure
167, 392, 429
punching shear force
836
pure car carrier
300
R
radiation coefficient
262, 265
radiation stress
117
radioactive glass sand
180, 183
radius of gyration
303
rail mounted cargo handling equipment
317
rail span
679, 683, 908, 944, 945, 946, 952, 953
rail-type traveling cargo handling equipment
906
Ramberg-Osgood model
230
random variable
6, 27, 28, 30, 31, 32
random waves
80, 81, 82, 83, 88, 89, 90, 91, 93, 95, 96, 98,
99, 104, 105, 106, 109, 129, 131, 136, 147, 151, 159, 161, 164,
165, 167, 173, 412, 417, 418, 419, 420, 424, 803
rapid load test
442
ratio of reinforcement to concrete sections
366, 837
Rayleigh distribution
83, 147, 155, 161, 162, 163
Rayleigh wave
251, 266, 267
RC
340, 604, 613, 621, 623, 627, 631, 634, 649, 706, 707
rebound coefficient
472
REC criterion
154
reclamation revetment
664, 665, 667, 668
recompression
226
recreation
973, 976
recyclable material
350
recycled asphalt
356
recycled rubber
355
reduction coefficient
139, 503, 504, 536, 537, 540, 542
reduction of earth pressure
525, 526
reefer container
954
reflected wave
93, 94, 95, 156, 174, 305, 583, 588, 590, 614,
628,637,645,652,653, 795
reflection
73, 83, 93, 95,
96, 97, 122, 142, 143, 148, 159, 189, 192, 237, 248, 250, 257,
583, 625, 628, 629, 635, 637, 638, 696, 709, 795, 799
reflection coefficient
95, 96, 97, 122, 143, 159, 189, 625, 628,
629, 637, 638, 795, 799
refraction 71, 80, 83, 88, 89, 90, 91, 93, 94, 95, 96, 98, 128, 163,
164, 173, 174, 179, 186, 202, 203, 588
refraction coefficient
71, 88, 89, 90, 93, 96, 186
region segmentation method
160
regular waves 73, 80, 88, 96, 99, 103, 105, 106, 108, 114, 128,
129, 136, 137, 143, 159, 165, 173, 304, 305, 412, 417, 558
reinforced concrete
313, 327, 328, 338, 339, 340, 341,
365, 372, 373, 376, 391, 392, 398, 403, 407, 409, 410, 473,
599, 604, 613, 621, 623, 627, 631, 634, 649, 702, 706, 707,
708, 753, 760, 821, 854, 856, 897, 907, 909, 910, 930
reinforced concrete pavement
897
reinforced concrete pile
340, 473
reinforcement 280, 326, 338, 339, 340, 342, 344, 369, 408, 409,
410, 482, 644, 650, 754, 836, 837, 898, 908
reinforcing bar 43, 339, 366, 367, 368, 369, 370, 371, 372, 373,
374, 375, 392, 395, 397, 614, 709, 740, 898
relative density
215, 216, 229, 529, 532, 727
relative roughness
197
reliability analysis
33, 74, 378, 516, 737
reliability-based design method 7, 13, 14, 19, 21, 22, 23, 27, 29,
38,605,643
reliability index
21, 22, 25, 29, 30, 31, 32,
33, 36, 500, 502, 506, 507, 510, 512, 513, 514, 516, 539, 540,
603, 604, 605, 623, 624, 627, 631, 634, 704, 706, 734, 735,
788, 829, 830, 831, 833, 834
reliability theory
506, 603, 623, 829
replacement method
215, 490
replacement rate
533,534,550,694, 705, 706
Residnal Water Level
275
residnal water pressure
271, 279, 397, 399, 400, 401, 406,
504, 506, 509, 519, 701, 702, 704, 708, 717, 718, 719, 724,
725, 730, 731, 746, 747, 750, 754, 763, 764, 775, 791, 792
resistance coefficient
77, 127, 741, 791, 792
resistance moment offilling soil
775
resistance wire type wave gauge
203
resistant moment
431, 537, 707, 708
response spectrum
20, 246, 720, 818, 822, 824, 826, 827, 837
responsible engineer
473, 620, 624
restorability 9, 655, 656, 680, 681, 682, 683, 684, 685, 811, 812,
914, 928, 935, 943, 978
restoration cost
734, 829
restoring force
157, 160, 246, 256, 297, 304, 307
retarder
338
return period 4, 5, 10, 14, 19, 23, 55, 58, 79, 123, 152, 154, 155,
156, 593, 607
return wave height
152, 153
revetment
4, 6, 15, 16, 17,
20, 105, 114, 115, 122, 124, 189, 336, 342, 398, 401, 407, 410,
485, 498, 503, 505, 519, 521, 523, 533, 540, 664, 665, 666,
667, 668, 669, 819, 881, 969, 971
RI
215
rigid frame structure
751, 931
riverflow
156, 178
river mouth
128, 170, 178, 179, 199, 583, 657, 936, 975
-992-
INDEX
river mouth terrace
179
rocking
606
rod compaction method
542
rolling 21, 49, 160, 301, 302, 327, 338, 343, 556, 557, 558, 583,
672,690,968,969,976
roll-on roll-off ship
298
119
root mean square amplitude
rope bill
845
rough terrain crane
891, 892, 894, 902
Rowe's method
rubber fender
821, 875, 877, 879, 938
rubber mat
353, 359
20, 73, 76, 106, 117, 135, 138,
rubble
192, 259, 312, 313, 314, 336, 343, 344, 345, 353, 358, 378,
411, 412, 416, 417, 418, 421, 422, 423, 424, 430, 431, 432, 481,
491, 509, 512, 597, 598, 599, 600, 606, 607, 612, 613, 615,
616, 617, 619, 620, 622, 643, 644, 650, 652, 696, 700, 703,
704, 825, 826, 847, 849, 908, 909, 910
rubble mound
76, 135, 192, 259, 336, 343, 353,
358, 378, 418, 423, 424, 430, 512, 597, 598, 599, 600, 612,
615, 616, 617, 619, 620, 622, 643, 644, 650, 825, 826
424
rubble mound breakwater
76, 418, 424, 598, 615, 616
rubble mound foundation
rubble stone 76, 345, 411, 412, 416, 417, 421, 422, 491, 606, 616,
652, 696, 820
running-up waves
181, 653
RWL 506, 537, 539, 702, 704, 706, 707, 731, 735, 736, 786, 788
s
safety
28, 29, 36, 40, 41, 42, 43, 48, 74, 75, 114, 145, 157, 166, 176,
177, 189, 212, 238, 331, 365, 367, 368, 369, 411, 418, 421, 434,
436, 439, 440, 449, 453, 454, 469, 473, 475, 486, 488, 493,
503, 506, 516, 533, 536, 544, 552, 560, 578, 583, 584, 585,
586, 588, 590, 592, 593, 594, 603, 623, 643, 646, 655, 664,
669, 678, 704, 728, 734, 757, 764, 787, 788, 792, 797, 829,
851, 853, 857, 870, 880, 884, 885, 887, 888, 924, 930, 931,
935, 936, 937, 940, 944, 947, 950, 964, 965, 968, 969, 972,
974, 976, 978
19, 23, 24, 368, 411, 418, 421, 475, 493, 594
safety factor
29, 74
safety index
salt concentration
215
salt injury
836, 937
181, 182, 674
sand bar
Sand Compaction Pile
481, 485, 529, 533, 534, 541, 548, 550,
551, 706
sand compaction pile method 350, 521, 529, 530, 531, 533, 536,
537, 538, 541, 542, 550, 551, 603, 605, 624, 705
sand drain method
494, 543
sand invasion prevention cloth
353
sand invasion prevention sheet
543, 700
sand mastic
342, 343, 344, 345, 644, 652
sand mastic asphalt
342, 343, 344, 652
350, 493, 494, 533
sand mat
sand replacement method
215
sand ripples
182
sand spit
179
sand supply rate
529, 530, 531, 532
sand wave
674
181, 199, 583, 588, 973
sandy beach
sandy ground
216, 225, 426, 430, 432,
434, 441, 443, 444, 450, 453, 459, 461, 475, 486, 487, 488,
510, 511, 533, 550, 600, 602, 703, 704, 849
Sarpkaya
168, 169
saturated copper sulfate electrode
335
Savage
186, 198
Saville
106, 165
Sawaguchi's method
758
scouring
42, 124, 175, 178, 189, 190, 191,
192, 342, 343, 353, 354, 365, 421, 423, 598, 614, 615, 616,
638, 641, 651, 653, 659, 690, 691, 866, 927, 928, 930, 973
scouring prevention mat
342, 343
scouring prevention works
189
scour prevention
617, 650, 690
SCP 19, 20, 352, 358, 485, 533, 539, 540, 550, 551, 603, 605, 624,
694, 705, 706
seabed slope
102, 103, 135, 144, 412
sea bottom ground
635, 718, 805
sea bottom slope
99, 102, 105, 117, 974, 975
sea bottom topography
70, 82, 105, 106, 109, 114
seal plate
353
seawall
4, 6, 15, 20,
93, 105, 106, 107, 108, 109, 114, 115, 165, 176,224,351,478,
654,655,656, 789, 795, 797,963,968,969,970
334
secondary consolidation
Second-Order Reliability Method
section modulus
sedimentation
42, 178, 198, 222, 344, 352, 597, 651, 657, 668
6, 15, 20, 333, 651, 652, 653, 672
sediment control groin
180, 184, 187, 974
sediment grain size
180
sediment transport 180, 181, 183, 185, 186, 189, 195, 196, 198,
199, 651, 652, 657, 672, 674, 975
seepage 75, 76, 217, 355, 356, 654, 655, 660, 665, 667, 668, 669,
931,968,969,970,976
seepage control work
968, 969
217, 667
seepage flow
seepage flow analysis
667
seicbe
71, 77, 120, 122, 172
seismic bedrock
5, 7, 235, 236, 238, 248, 250, 251, 253, 262,
263, 264, 265, 608, 609, 610, 696, 822, 826, 944
seismic coefficient
19, 20, 230, 233, 244, 245, 246, 247, 268, 271, 274, 275, 277,
278, 280, 437, 499, 500, 503, 504, 506, 509, 515, 526, 527,
536, 537, 545, 546, 609, 610, 611, 612, 693, 694, 697, 698,
700, 701, 702, 719, 720, 722, 723, 725, 731, 746, 750, 753,
757, 763, 773, 774, 789, 795, 819, 821, 822, 823, 824, 825,
826,827,837,838,840,841,842,846,848,944
246
seismic force
230, 358, 430, 432, 484, 698, 765, 847, 849, 947
seismic inertia force
774
seismic moment
236, 240, 241, 242, 243, 262, 263, 265
seismic observation
238, 248, 256, 259
seismic-resistant performance
seismic response analysis
14, 30, 230, 239, 240, 245, 247, 255, 256, 257, 258, 264, 268,
500, 609, 610, 611, 679, 693, 694, 695, 696, 698, 700, 709,
720, 722, 783,818,820,821,822,835,944
self weight
6, 15, 16, 17, 55, 150, 222, 312, 317,
372, 373, 378, 379, 384, 385, 386, 391, 392, 394, 404, 430,
437, 438, 455, 476, 484, 486, 519, 585, 592, 594, 601, 654,
659, 680, 691, 704, 711, 712, 713, 714, 715, 719, 753, 758,
759, 767, 768, 810, 821, 823, 843, 845, 848, 851, 864, 865,
870,913,914,927,935,941,942,947,964,966
semi-infinite breakwater
95, 97
475
semi-infinite elastic body
-993-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
141
924, 925
sensitivity factor
21, 22, 32, 36, 38, 603, 604, 605, 613, 621,
623, 624, 627, 631, 634, 649, 706, 707, 736, 737
series system
7, 36
serviceability 5, 9, 14, 79, 155, 365, 366, 367, 372, 373, 374, 375,
376, 378, 398, 403, 404, 423, 441, 453, 641, 679, 680, 681,
682, 683, 684, 712, 713, 714, 760, 767, 769, 808, 811, 812,
813, 850, 852, 864, 870, 871, 878, 884, 886, 889, 923, 928,
935,943,949,966,972
serviceability limit
5, 155, 365, 366, 372, 373, 374, 375, 376,
378, 398, 403, 441, 453, 713, 760, 769, 813
serviceability limit state
5, 155, 365, 366, 372, 373, 374, 375,
376,378,398,403,453, 713, 760, 769,813
service conditions
367
settlement of mound
377
settlement of pile
454, 472
settlement reduction ratio
540, 541
semi-submerged type
semi-trailer truck
~~nn~1~m
shaft 127, 439, 440, 441, 442, 444, 471, 480, 501, 502, 560, 563,
570,572,573,576,927,928,929,931
shaft resistance
439, 440, 441, 442, 444
shaft resistance of pile
440
SHAKE
256, 257, 268
shaking table test
500, 709, 773, 797
shallow spread foundation
426, 444
shallow water area
86, 174, 553
shallow water waves
126, 132
shape factor of foundation
427, 428
shear characteristic
207
shear connector
407, 409, 410, 930
shear deformation
475, 478, 669, 711, 715, 755, 757, 767, 768,
194
168, 198, 417, 424
224, 484
457, 458, 460
426, 434, 435
317
70, 80, 82, 83, 84, 85, 86, 92,
94, 103, 104, 106, 108, 116, 120, 121, 124, 130, 131, 132, 133,
136,139,143,145, 151, 152, 155, 190,204,412,413,417,418,
419,558,590,597,598,625,626,632,653, 795
significant wave height
70, 80, 82, 83, 92, 94, 103, 104, 106, 116, 120, 121, 124, 130,
131, 132, 139, 143,151, 155,190,204,412,413,417,418,419,
558,590,597,598,625,626,632,653,795
significant wave method
84, 85
significant wave period 80, 83, 84, 94, 131, 132, 133, 136, 145,
413, 419
signs
290, 593, 616, 669, 885, 888, 936, 937, 950, 957
silica fume
370
siltation
43, 178, 179, 196, 198, 552, 651, 674, 866
similarity law
163, 709
similarity number
726, 728
simplified Bishop method 429, 430, 431, 486, 487, 488, 598, 600
simultaoeous occurrence
11, 13, 19, 156, 242
single anchoring
579
single pile 36, 439, 440, 441, 450, 451, 453, 454, 455, 456, 457,
458,467,847,849,878
single pile structure
878
sinker 17, 156, 641, 643, 801, 802, 803, 804, 805, 806, 807, 851,
853
sinker chain
17, 800, 801, 804, 805, 806, 807
sinker type
802, 803
site aroplification factors 235, 238, 243, 248, 250, 251, 253, 261,
263
site effucts
235, 237, 238, 248, 249, 261, 263, 264, 824
Skempton
222, 479
skin friction
435, 439, 441, 442, 444, 446, 450, 451, 452, 453,
455,456,471,474,503, 757, 765
slag 19, 338, 345, 346, 350, 351, 352, 521, 522, 536, 545, 550,
614, 901
slenderness ratio
449
sliding 14, 26, 36, 38, 74, 137, 138, 141, 142, 182, 244, 245, 271,
331, 342, 358, 431, 484, 488, 504, 506, 516, 523, 525, 526,
527, 528, 536, 537, 587, 592, 593, 594, 598, 600, 603, 605,
606, 608, 609, 612, 615, 620, 623, 626, 630, 633, 643, 644,
648, 649, 654, 655, 691, 693, 699, 701, 702, 704, 708, 711,
714, 715, 755, 757, 758, 759, 767, 768, 785, 787, 792, 846,
867, 871, 872, 873, 874, 903, 904, 905, 909, 931
sliding resistaoce
342, 525, 598, 606
sliding stability
605
sliding surface
271, 484, 488, 600, 606
slip failure
15, 16, 17,
24, 25, 34, 312, 429, 430, 431, 432, 484, 485, 486, 487, 488,
489, 490, 491, 493, 505, 506, 516, 523, 525, 528, 533, 536,
537, 538, 539, 540, 544, 551, 592, 594, 596, 597, 600, 601,
603, 605, 607, 613, 614, 620, 623, 624, 626, 630, 633, 665,
691, 701, 703, 704, 705, 706, 711, 714, 715, 734, 736, 758,
759, 766, 767, 768, 769, 785, 819, 836, 969
slipway
5, 20, 384, 801, 866, 867, 868, 869
slit
114, ll5, 117, 122, 141, 142, 391, 403, 404, 405, 406, 628,
637, 795
slit caisson
122, 142, 391, 405, 628
slit wall partition
406
slope failure
488
slope gradient
135, 136, 189, 345, 413, 598, 619, 620, 632, 633
slope stability aoalysis
484, 486, 487, 489
sloping breakwater
20, 74, 116, ll7, 139, 140, 358, 411, 412,
shoreline change model
Shore Protection Manual
short-period stability problem
short pile
side resistaoce
side roller
significant wave
-994-
INDEX
413, 415, 416, 418, 593, 619, 620, 621
sloping-top caisson
136, 140, 141, 167, 590, 594, 632, 633
sloping-top caisson breakwater 140, 141, 167, 590, 594, 632, 633
slow drift
159
slow drift oscillations
159
small amplitude wave theory
98, 145, 147
small cargo ship
298, 687
small craft basin
7, 122, 552, 579, 581, 582
SMB method
85
smear
495, 496
soft cohesive soil ground
224, 475
soil improvement
215, 218, 227, 228, 350, 351, 356, 426, 485, 490, 492, 493,
498, 503, 506, 523, 536, 537, 538, 544, 548, 549, 550, 551,
597, 601, 640, 668, 669, 694, 696, 705, 706, 717
soil improvement methcd
227, 351, 548, 549, 550
soil test
207, 210, 211, 212, 213, 222, 225, 258, 269, 272, 274,
356, 524, 549
solidified geotechnical material
545, 547
solitary wave
104, 128
sorting pond
950
sounding
207,208,216,556
soundness
18,852,853,871,929,943,945,965,967
235, 236, 238, 249, 250, 251, 253, 261, 263
source effects
spatial autocorrelation
33
spatially-distributed load
475, 538
spectrum energy
86, 87
splash zone
331, 336, 367
spreading method
92
spring line
308, 309
spring rise
69
squeezed-out failure
429
SRC
407,410
stability against overturning
508
stability against sliding 26, 523, 525, 526, 527, 648, 649, 701,
757, 785, 846
stability analysis
212, 225, 484, 486, 487, 488, 489
stability number
411, 412, 413, 415, 416, 418, 419, 420
stability of slope
484, 485, 486, 529, 819
stabilized body
355, 498, 499, 500, 501, 503, 505, 506, 509,
510, 511, 512, 513, 514, 516, 517, 526
stabilized soil
346, 498, 499, 500, 501, 502, 544, 549
standard design strength 340, 500, 502, 512, 514, 520, 521, 523,
528
standard deviation
6, 21, 30, 32, 38, 154, 162, 212, 213, 233,
293, 298, 301, 502, 666
695
standard initial natural frequency of ground
standard intensity of illumination
881, 882
standard penetration test 207, 210, 225, 228, 229, 230, 443, 459
Standard Specifications of Concrete
43
standing wave domain
192
standing wave force
129, 133
standing wave height
97, 143
standing wave pressure
139
standing waves
96, 98, 132, 133, 135, 138, 148, 149, 151, 168,
174, 192
static bearing capacity formula
441, 454, 455
static friction coefficient
244, 347, 358, 506
static load 150, 151, 246, 312, 314, 315, 343, 439, 442, 475, 821,
823,856,859
static maximum. lateral resistance
456,458,470
static maximum pulling resistance
454, 455, 456
static performance verification method
230
stationary jib crane
323
stationary pneumatic unloader
323
steel beam
64,66
352
steel manufacture slag
steel material 326, 328, 330, 332, 333, 334, 340, 410, 732, 736,
737, 743, 787, 878
steel pile 327, 329, 359, 446, 447, 449, 452, 456, 464, 471, 472,
473,474,475,479,480,481,482, 799,911
329, 330, 331
steel pipe sheet pile
steel sheet pile
326, 327, 330, 331, 333, 334, 336, 338, 667, 669, 670, 715,
717, 719, 728, 732, 751, 757, 768, 775, 780, 781, 790, 798,970
steel sheet pile quaywall
334, 715, 728
steel sheet pile revetment
336
steel shell type
930
Steel Ship Regulations
309
steep slope
137, 167, 174, 416, 424, 588, 890
Stelson
145, 168
step-resistance type wave gauge
202
Sternberg
186, 198
stern line
686,872
Stewart
117, 165
stiffening member
811, 812, 815, 841, 842
Stokes' third order wave
150
storage facilities
5, 7, 363, 958, 959, 961
storm surge
68, 69, 70, 74, 75, 77, 144, 156, 176, 203, 583, 585, 586, 590,
596, 647, 650, 654, 659, 665, 865, 931, 957, 968, 973, 976
storm surge height
156
storm surge protection breakwater
586, 647
straddle carrier
317, 891, 953, 955
straight sliding surface
484, 488
strain dependency
520
strain energy
231
strain level
218, 256, 260, 265, 475, 520
stress concentration
536, 703
stress concentration coefficient
536
stress distribution method
537
stress reduction coefficient
536, 540, 542
stress sharing ratio
536, 541, 542
strip method
160, 305
structural analysis factor 365, 506, 509, 511, 512, 514, 515, 516,
528, 600, 606, 612, 648, 649, 702, 703, 704, 708, 732, 733,
734, 738, 739, 743, 747, 748, 775, 785, 792, 861, 873, 874
structural robustness
39, 829
structure factor
365, 368, 369, 370, 371
structure with steel plates
407
strntted frame type pier
840, 841
strnt type pier
18
S-type ground
459
subgrade reaction
435, 436, 437, 438, 458, 459, 461, 463,
464, 465, 468, 477, 481, 503, 505, 512, 513, 550, 717, 718,
723, 724, 726, 727, 728, 731, 779, 780, 781, 782, 783, 784,
785, 820, 828, 829, 830, 831, 832, 833, 834, 838, 847, 849
subgrade reaction of sheet pile
726
submerged breakwater 117, 176, 192, 194, 196, 199, 413, 422,
425
submerged member
128, 147
subsurface structure
246, 251, 252, 261, 265, 498
suction dredger
490, 491, 665
superstructure
15,
36, 139, 140, 151, 203, 333, 339, 367, 369, 371, 392, 393, 397,
399, 412, 428, 434, 439, 454, 456, 469, 470, 491, 498, 503,
504, 505, 506, 509, 512, 520, 523, 537, 594, 597, 598, 620,
622, 635, 684, 685, 709, 710, 711, 713, 714, 723, 732, 741,
742, 751, 753, 754, 755, 757, 767, 769, 770, 793, 808, 810,
811, 812, 813, 819, 821, 826, 835, 836, 840, 841, 842, 848,
851, 871, 872, 873, 874, 894, 895, 898, 907, 937, 945
superstructure of piled pier
148
supervision of construction work
473
surcharge
7, 10,
-995-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
14, 55, 200, 272, 273, 277, 278, 288, 312, 314, 346, 373, 374,
379, 386, 387, 388, 389, 390, 400, 407, 429, 432, 484, 486,
491, 492, 493, 494, 495, 503, 504, 506, 509, 520, 532, 537,
546, 600, 601, 604, 624, 628, 632, 635, 682, 683, 684, 685,
691, 696, 700, 702, 703, 704, 706, 712, 713, 714, 715, 725,
731, 739, 742, 759, 760, 763, 764, 765, 768, 769, 770, 773,
775, 778, 786, 791, 792, 812, 813, 814, 815, 819, 826, 830,
831, 832, 850, 852, 853, 858, 865, 890, 891, 905, 906, 909,
928, 936, 943, 949, 965, 967, 979
surcharge method
492, 494, 495
surface layer sediment movement
180, 184
surface roughness
145, 412, 423
surface wave exploration
207
surface wave profile
202, 203
surfbeat
119, 144, 165
surf similarity parameter
105, 413
surf zone
70, 139, 181, 183, 186, 189, 190, 191, 198, 651, 652
surging
120, 124, 160, 413
surging breaker
413
suspended sediment
182, 186, 198, 653
Sverdrup
84, 163
swash zooe
181, 183, 187
S wave
177, 206, 232, 236, 237, 242, 250, 251, 255, 258, 259,
262,263,264,266,267,268,269
swaying
160
swell 85, 86, 96, 122, 163, 164, 223, 224, 228, 554, 556, 581, 858
system failure probability 37, 507, 510, 512, 513, 514, 516, 593,
594, 603, 604, 623, 627, 631, 634, 704, 706, 788
system reliability 37, 38, 506, 604, 623, 627, 631, 634, 704, 705,
706, 734, 735
system reliability index 506, 604, 623, 627, 631, 634, 704, 706,
734, 735
T
Tanimoto's formula
418, 419, 420
tauker
159, 297, 298, 299, 301, 304, 686, 846
target reliability index
22, 25, 36, 506, 623
target safety level
23,24,36
taut mooring
156
Technical Manual fur Floating Structures
170, 310
Technical Manual fur Immersed Turmel
929
Technical Manual for Maintenance of Port Facilities
47
Technical Manual for the Deep Mixing Method in Marine
Construction Works
499
Technical Manual of New Type Breakwaters
628
Technical Standards of Rail Truck Laying
908
temporary structure
154, 333, 798, 799
teosile strength
325, 326, 330, 340, 456, 500, 501, 733, 768,
787, 878, 938
teosile stress
329, 330, 392, 410, 733, 768, 781, 788, 827
teosile yield strength
805
teosion leg platfurm
157
Terzaghi's consolidation theory
476, 477
the first limit resistance
441, 442, 454
thermal characteristics
877, 880
the second limit resistance
440, 442, 443, 454
threshold depth of sediment movemeot 180, 182, 183, 184, 195
threshold rate of wave overtopping for inducing of damage 114
thruster
578
Tickell-Elwany
147
tidal constitueot
68, 69
tidal current furce
860
tidal fiats
179, 973, 975, 976
tidal waves
976
tides in river
178
tie
16, 25, 542, 684, 685, 713, 715, 717, 718,
723, 725, 726, 728, 729, 730, 731, 732, 733, 734, 735, 736,
737, 738, 739, 740, 741, 742, 743, 755, 764, 897, 898, 909
tie bar
898, 899
tie installation point
726, 728, 731, 732, 734, 764
tie rod 16, 25, 542, 684, 685, 715, 718, 723, 725, 726, 728, 733,
734, 764
tie wire
733
timber handling facilities
552
timber sorting pond
950
time-dependent mild-slope equation
93
time factor
220, 221, 476, 495, 496
time-series seismic wave profile
821
Timosheoko
912
tire-mounted multi-purpose jib crane
317
Tload
316
toe pressure
506, 510, 511, 513
total trip
920
towing
127, 377
TP
69, 168
tracer
183, 185, 186, 198
tractive furce
7, 297, 304, 308, 309, 641, 650, 723, 733, 734,
742, 743, 764, 801, 803, 804, 805, 806, 807, 821, 830, 831,
837, 843, 845, 848, 853, 857, 860, 872, 873, 874, 907, 908
tractor crane
317
traffic load
898
training jetty
15, 657, 658, 659
train load
312, 314, 316
transfer craoe
317, 955
transmission characteristic
625, 630
transmitted wave height
116, 585, 586, 619, 632
transmitted waves
116, 117, 589, 619, 622, 625, 628, 630, 637,
641, 795
transport of wave energy
86, 87, 88
transverse constructionjoint
898
transverse wave
124, 125, 126, 128, 232
transverse wave velocity
232
trapezoidal caisson
133
traveling of cargo handling equipment
904, 906
treated soil
351, 352,
498, 500, 501, 503, 504, 505, 506, 507, 509, 510, 511, 512,
515, 516, 518, 519, 520, 523, 524, 525, 528, 545, 548, 549
trench type earthquake
679
triaxial compression test 218, 227, 228, 345, 431, 432, 444, 524,
525
trigger level
248
trim 544, 553
trip generation and attraction
916, 917, 920
trough 80, 134, 135, 149, 172, 189, 265, 380, 381, 383, 386, 401,
606, 700, 975
Tschbotarioff method
487
T-shaped sheet piles
787
tsunami
4, 10, 14, 55, 68, 74, 75, 77, 169, 172, 173, 174, 175, 176, 177,
197, 203, 204, 205, 240, 364, 365, 422, 583, 585, 586, 587,
598, 612, 613, 648, 649, 650, 654, 655, 656, 659, 660, 800,
849, 851, 853, 968, 973, 976
tsunami arrival time
173
tsuoami height
172, 174, 176
tsunami period
173
tsuoami protection breakwater 197, 422, 586, 587, 648, 649, 650
tsuoami record
172, 176
tsuoami reduction effect
176, 650
tsuoami run-up
177
tsunami wave force
176
tsuoami wave height
172, 173, 174
turning basin
578, 662
turning of bow
578
type of breakwaters
167, 644, 645
-996-
INDEX
typhoon
42, 59, 60, 69, 70, 74, 85, 163, 166, 590
u
Veda's formulae
643
ultimate bearing capacity
427,435,449,467,479
ultimate equilibrium
484
ultimate limit
5, 152,365,370,371,373,374,375,378,403,404,407,684,
685, 712, 713, 760, 769, 808, 811, 813, 815, 836, 905
ultimate limit state
5, 152,365,370,371,373,374,375,378,403,404,407,684,
685, 712, 713, 760, 769,808,813,815,836,905
ultimate load
458
ultrasonic current meter type directional wave recorder
203
ultrasonic type wave gauge
202, 203
unconfined compressive strength
225, 227, 232, 258, 274, 345, 352, 432, 448, 452, 502, 519,
520, 524, 525, 534, 535, 544, 545
unconsolidated undrained condition
223
underwater tunnel
927, 928
underwater welding
334
undisturbed sample
214, 215, 216, 225, 227, 232, 475
undrained shear strength
212, 213, 218, 223, 224, 225, 226, 227, 230, 428, 429, 430,
443,444,450,486,487,503,520,535,600,602, 703, 704
unevenly distributed load
315
uneven settlement 288, 391, 441, 478, 615, 662, 818, 835, 907,
908,932
uni-directional random waves
80
uniformity coefficient
216, 217, 431, 521
uniformly distributed load
430, 475, 734, 858
universal joint
157
unmooring basin
578, 580
uplift pressure 131, 139, 140, 174, 383, 387, 388, 390, 405, 421,
848
upper beam
404, 406
upright breakwater
20, %, 117, 593, 618, 619, 622, 625, 632
upright wall
96, 129, 130, 131, 132, 133, 134, 135, 136, 137,
138, 139, 140, 141, 143, 144, 147, 174, 192, 415, 418, 570
upright wave-absorbing caisson
141, 403, 404, 405, 406
upright wave-absorbing type quaywall
795
upright wave-dissipating block
485, 594
upward displacement of piles by pulling
467
usability 8, 10, 14, 200, 215, 238, 553, 554, 577, 578, 579, 586,
661,664,672,850,852,864,888,889,927
uu
223,224
v
vacuum consolidation method
494, 495
Van der Meer
106, 165, 413, 415, 424
Van der Meer's formula
415
vane shear test
227, 234
variable action
6, 7, 9, 11,
80, 84, 123, 367, 372, 373, 392, 403, 411, 592, 635, 641, 654,
659, 660, 691, 711, 744, 755, 758, 767, 789, 808, 810, 811,
841, 842, 851, 865, 875, 884, 886, 888, 889, 904, 927, 942,
948,964,966,972
519
variable load
variable situation
11, 13, 14, 19, 374, 411, 416, 484, 489, 499,
500, 504, 537, 592, 593, 594, 603, 608, 609, 611, 613, 620,
623, 626, 630, 649, 693, 701, 702, 703, 704, 713, 714, 715,
720, 723, 725, 731, 733, 734, 739, 741, 743, 746, 748, 750,
753, 757, 763, 769, 770, 774, 775, 779, 787, 789, 794, 795,
807, 812, 814, 818, 823, 824, 829, 837, 838, 840, 841, 842,
846,848,852,864,904,905,945
Variance Reduction Techniques
21, 29
V-block method
932
vegetation
975, 976, 979
vehicle load
312, 314, 316, 885
vehicle loading facilities
885
vehicle ramp
853, 885
148, 159, 160
velocity potential
velocity pressure
61, 62, 63, 64
ventilation equipment
930
vertical bearing capacity
434, 436, 437, 480, 757, 785
vertical coefficient of consolidation
477
vertical drain method
227, 228, 492, 493, 494, 496, 548, 549
354, 615
vertical joint
vertical loading test
441, 446
19
vertical-pile anchorage
vertical slit-wall caisson
628
very large crude oil carrier
294
very large floating structure
156, 160
very large ship
581
very soft clay
227
vibratory pile driving method
446
vibro-flotation method
542, 543
virtual fixed point
754, 820, 828
virtual ground surface 763, 819, 820, 822, 825, 826, 828, 829,
835
virtual mass factor
289, 297, 298, 302, 937
VLCC
560, 563, 570, 572, 573, 576
void ratio
96, 150, 195, 214, 216, 218, 219, 223, 225, 232, 271,
476, 484, 521, 540
~
~~
w
Wagner
150
waiting room
678
waling
16, 711, 713, 714, 733, 734, 743
wall type improvement
498
WAM model
87, 164
warehouse
7, 61, 312, 314, 315, 773, 882, 958
waste disposal seawall
963
waste disposal site
351, 518, 968
water-cement ratio
43
water content 179, 209, 210, 214, 271, 347, 348, 349, 351, 356,
524
waterfront area
937
water gate
4, 6, 20, 660
water hydrant
961
water particle acceleration
145
water particle velocity
144, 145, 168
waterproofuess
342
water purification function
974
water quality test
%2
water supply volume
%2
water-tightness
367, 660
waterway
6, 43, 124, 179, 294, 363, 552, 553, 554, 555,
558, 560, 561, 566, 567, 568, 570, 575, 578, 580, 588, 590,
651,658,674,675,929,932,936,937,950
waterways and basins
6, 179, 363, 552, 588, 590, 651
wave-absorbing caisson 141, 403, 404, 405, 406, 628, 629, 630,
795
wave-absorbing caisson type breakwater
628, 629, 630
wave-absorbing performance
625, 628, 629, 630, 795
wave action 22, 88, 94, 128, 129, 130, 139, 140, 167, 189, 412,
415, 645, 658, 674, 854, 857, 859, 877
wave breaking 68, 70, 93, 99, 102, 103, 104, 106, 117, 119, 127,
131, 132, 136, 139, 179, 186, 195, 415, 419, 420, 973
wave breaking point
99, 106, 119, 136, 186, 195
wave crest 107, 124, 128, 135, 145, 149, 169, 195, 204, 380, 383,
386
wave diffraction
95, 98, 159
-997-
TECHNICAL STANDARDS AND COMMENTARIES FOR PORT AND HARBOUR FACILITIES IN JAPAN
wave direction
81, 82, 84, 85, 87, 88, 89, 92, 94, 95,
96, 98, 121, 127, 129, 130, 133, 136, 137, 138, 154, 155, 169,
183, 202, 203, 204, 416, 418, 419, 558, 597, 651, 844
wave-dissipating block
20, 36,
96, 107, 138, 139, 140, 385, 389, 415, 416, 417, 421, 485, 590,
593, 594, 605, 607, 622, 623, 624, 632, 633, 637
wave-dissipating type seawall
109, 114
wave-dissipating work
97, 114, 135, 138, 139, 589, 603, 605,
622,624,632, 706
wave drift force
159
wave drift force coefficient
159
wave energy balance equation
88
wave energy tlux
185, 186, 188, 195
wave-exciting force
157, 159, 160, 161, 304
wave group
83, 94, 132, 133, 151, 412
wave hindcasting
84, 86, 87, 88, 93, 152, 154, 156, 597
wavelength
73, 80, 83, 92, 94, 95,
96, 97, 98, 117, 119, 124, 125, 126, 130, 131, 132, 134, 136,
137, 139, 140, 144, 145, 148, 149, 159, 172, 175, 184, 186, 187,
192, 413, 419, 597
wave-making resistaoce
157, 160, 304, 305
wave-making resistance force
160, 304, 305
wave observation
77, 154, 155, 169, 177, 186, 202, 203, 204,
205,206
wave overtopping
70, 74,
93, 105, 108, 109, 114, 115, 119, 124, 133, 156, 165,421,586,
590, 619, 625, 628, 630, 638, 646, 648, 654, 664, 666, 667,
669,940,973
wave overtopping quantity
109, 114, 115, 666
wave overtopping rate
70, 109, 114, 115, 165, 666, 667, 973
wave profile
119, 128, 167, 202, 203, 204, 232, 235, 241, 255,
263, 264, 821
wave ray
87, 88, 173
wave retlection 73, 93, 95, 96, 142, 148, 189, 192, 583, 625, 635,
638
wave refraction
88,89,93,96, 174,588
wave refraction coefficient
88, 89, 96
wave run-up
165
waves entering into river mouth
178
wave setup
68, 70, 77, 103, 117
wave shoaling
83, 173, 179
81, 84, 86, 88, 117, 147, 161, 164, 166, 412
wave spectrum
wave steepness 109, 117, 119, 124, 127, 133, 135, 136, 144, 189,
413
wave traosformation
88, 93, 95, 96, 109, 136, 650, 651
wave traosmission
116, 117, 586, 628, 632, 638, 642
wave transmission coefficient
638, 642
Weiboll distribution
152, 153, 154, 301
welded joint
410, 473
welded part
410
well point method
543
wharf
5, 18, 20, 25, 50, 148, 267, 339, 369, 371, 550,
676, 680, 686, 687, 690, 719, 751, 753, 754, 755, 797, 798,
818, 819, 820, 821, 828, 835, 836, 837, 838, 847, 849, 882,
902,903,906,911,934,950
width of embankment
492
width of navigation channel
554, 555, 560, 574, 575
width of sediment movement zone
195
wind blown sand
674
wind drag force
157, 158, 161
wind-driven current
74, 178
wind duration
84, 85
wind field
84, 85, 86
wind load
61, 63, 305, 322, 846, 848, 849
wind pressure 57, 58, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66, 157, 158, 297, 304,
305, 308, 309, 315, 597, 846, 947
wind pressure coefficient
61, 63, 64, 158
wind setup
wind tunnel test
wind waves
workability
woven cloth
WTO
70, 71
61, 63, 64, 158, 306, 565
85,86,87, 122, 163, 164, 173
338,342,470,473,932
353
560, 574
y
yawing
160, 302, 561, 566
yield load
458
yield stress 213, 219, 221, 222, 227, 329, 374, 375, 392, 453, 474,
477, 520, 635, 641, 684, 711, 712, 713, 732, 733, 734, 736,
737, 743, 748, 758, 760, 767, 768, 769, 786, 788, 801, 808,
809, 810, 814, 815, 818, 827, 841, 842, 853, 904, 938
z
zoning
-998-
251, 252
'